Folklore - An Encyclopedia of Beliefs, Customs, Tales, Music, and Art (3 Volume Set) PDF
Folklore - An Encyclopedia of Beliefs, Customs, Tales, Music, and Art (3 Volume Set) PDF
Folklore
AN ENCYCLOPEDIA OF BELIEFS,
CUSTOMS, TALES, MUSIC, AND ART
Second Edition
ISBN: 978-1-59884-241-8
EISBN: 978-1-59884-242-5
15 14 13 12 11 1 2 3 4 5
ABC-CLIO, LLC
130 Cremona Drive, P.O. Box 1911
Santa Barbara, California 93116-1911
v
List of Entries
Applied Folklore/Folkloristics
Arab Gulf States Folklore
Academic Programs in Folklore,
International Arabian Nights
Academic Programs in Folklore, Archetype
North American Architecture, Folk
Acculturation Archives and Archiving
Activism Art, Folk
Aesthetics Arthurian Lore
African American Folklore Asian American Humor and Folklore
African Folklore Asian American Literature and
Aging Folklore
Altar, Home Asian American Popular Culture and
Folklore
Amerasians: Folklores of Mixed
Heritage, Mixed Race Asian Assault, Supernatural
Americans Audience
American Indian Folklore Authenticity
Scholarship Autograph Book
American Indian Tales
Anansi Ballad
Anecdote Bard
Animals Beauty and the Beast
Animal Tale Belief, Folk
Anthropological Approach Belief Tale
Anthropology, Symbolic Bluegrass: Homegrown Music
Antiquarianism Borderlands Folklore
Appalachian Folklore Broadside Ballad
vii
viii | List of Entries
Cantometrics Deconstruction
Carnival Diachronic/Synchronic
Celtic Folklore and Mythology Dialogism
Chapbook Diffusion
Charivari/Shivaree Dilemma Tales
Charm Discourse Analysis
Childbirth and Childrearing Dite
Children’s Folk Heroes Divination
Children’s Folklore Drama, Folk
Chinese Folklore
Choreometrics
Cinderella Emic/Etic
Clever Question/Wisdom Question Enigma, Folk
Communal Origins Theory Environmentalism
Communitas Ephemera
Community-Based Research Epic
Comparative Mythology Epic Laws
Computer-Mediated Folklore Erotic Folklore
Conduit Theory/Multiconduit Theory Eschatology
Contestation Esoteric/Exoteric Factor
Context Ethnic Folklore
Cosmology Ethnoaesthetics
Costume, Folk Ethnography
Craft, Folk Ethnology
Creation Myths Ethnomusicology
Cryptozoology Ethnopoetics
Cultural Property Etiological Narrative
Cultural Relativism Euhemerism
Cultural Studies Evolutionary Theory
Culture Hero Exorcism
Custom
Cyberculture Fabulate
Faerie and Fairy Lore
Dance, Folk Fairy Tale Heroes
Deathlore Fakelore
List of Entries | ix
xiii
List of Contributors
xv
xvi | List of Contributors
Guntis Smidchens Edith Turner
University of Washington University of Virginia
Paul Smith Kay Turner
Memorial University of Brooklyn Arts Council
Newfoundland Leea Virtanen
Joseph Daniel Sobol University of Helsinki
East Tennessee State University John Michael Vlach
Emily Socolov George Washington University
Independent Scholar Nancy L. Watterson
Brian Stableford Cabrini College
University College Winchester Linda S. Watts
Virginia E. Swain University of Washington
Dartmouth College Mickey Weems
Richard Sweterlitsch Columbus State Community
University of Vermont College
Timothy R. Tangherlini Elizabeth E. Wein
University of California, Independent Scholar
Los Angeles Kathryn E. Wilson
Gerald Thomas University of Pennsylvania
Memorial University of Margaret R. Yocom
Newfoundland George Mason University
Jeff Todd Titon Don Yoder
Brown University University of Pennsylvania
Peter Tokofsky Ayako Yoshimura
University of California, Los Angeles University of Wisconsin, Madison
Rebecca L. Torstrick Katherine Young
Indiana University South Bend University of California, Berkeley
Tad Tuleja M. Jane Young
Independent Scholar University of New Mexico
Foreword
Almost twenty years ago, I was audacious (or na€ve) enough to accept the chal-
lenge to edit a folklore encyclopedia that could serve as a comprehensive refer-
ence work for general readers, students, and academic researchers. I survived
only because of the editorial guidance of Gary Kuris of ABC-CLIO and the men-
torship of my editorial board: Roger D. Abrahams, Linda Degh, Henry Glassie,
Sylvia Grider, Bruce Jackson, and Juha Pentik€ainen. In developing the list of
entries and the perspectives from which contributors would consider these topics,
we decided to focus on forms and methods developed in the discipline of folklore
and those derived from related fields such as anthropology and linguistics. Bio-
graphical entries and character types (‘‘Bluebeard,’’ for example) were avoided
in order to permit the inclusion of a larger number of genres, customs, and theo-
retical perspectives within 350,000–400,000 words projected for the two-volume
work. For the writing of these entries, the board members were joined by an
international roster of over eighty other contributors, including both younger
scholars and academics whose reputations had been established for decades. The
result was Folklore: An Encyclopedia of Beliefs, Customs, Music, and Art.
At this writing, our younger contributors have joined the ranks of the estab-
lished scholars and the latter maintain their prestige, just as their contributions to
Folklore remain reliable guides to the topics addressed. Thanks to the group
effort, the reference has proved useful enough for the publisher to propose a sec-
ond, revised edition expanded to more than 500,000 words. As with many other
things, I felt once was enough. Therefore, I nominated one of the contributors to
the 1997 encyclopedia, Charlie T. McCormick, to take on the second iteration.
Charlie agreed to serve as coeditor along with Kim Kennedy White. The task
they set for themselves was to survey the existing encyclopedia entries, to revise
any that required an update, to eliminate any that were no longer relevant in the
twenty-first century (very few, I am happy to report), and to add new entries to
address concepts that had been overlooked in the first edition or that had gained
prominence over the years since its publication, and to add entries that could sup-
port the original collection. For example, ‘‘Globalization,’’ ‘‘Hybrid,’’ and
‘‘Shape-shifting’’ could have fit easily into the framework of the first edition and
xxi
xxii | Foreword
are welcome additions here. ‘‘Cyberculture’’ and ‘‘Internet’’ join the original
entry on ‘‘Computer-mediated Folklore,’’ a piece that was considered cutting
edge in 1997. After all, the Internet was not really defined until 1995; Google
was founded in 1998, and YouTube has only been with us since 2005. All have
profoundly influenced folklore and the ways in which folklorists conduct
research. The term ‘‘Postfolklore’’ (which was introduced into Russian folkloris-
tics in the late twentieth century) has gained currency since the first edition and
now appears in the revised encyclopedia. ‘‘Martial Arts and Folklore’’ and
‘‘Environmentalism’’ recognize the fact that both areas now attract the attention
of folklore scholars. The second edition’s editors also have chosen to devote
some of the additional space to providing specific examples of more generalized
entries: ‘‘Ethnic Folklore’’ and ‘‘Hero/Heroine, Folk,’’ for example. Therefore,
entries devoted to specific ethnic groups and regions (African, African Ameri-
can, Asian, the Arab Gulf States, etc.) and individual folk heroes and heroines
and heroic types (e.g., ‘‘William Tell,’’ ‘‘Dragonslayers’’) were added.
The editors of the revised edition have reconsidered the configuration of the
first edition in minor, but significant, ways. Overall, the alphabetical organiza-
tion of the original publication has been retained. In some cases, however,
shorter, more specific entries have been repositioned to serve as sidebars to
major entries. Therefore, ‘‘Evil Eye,’’ ‘‘Luck,’’ and ‘‘Omen/Portent’’ have been
rearranged to supplement the major entry ‘‘Folk Belief.’’
New authors appear in the second edition. David Leeming (‘‘Creation Myth’’),
Don Yoder (‘‘Pennsylvania Dutch’’), and Warren Roberts (‘‘Thompson, Stith’’)
need no introduction to folklorists, and their contributions in their areas of exper-
tise will likely become required reading for novices in the discipline. The inclu-
sion of other contributors enriches the diversity of Folklore, particularly in
Asian, Asian American, and Latino traditions.
The result is an updated and fleshed-out version of the first edition. As was the
case with the 1997 edition, reviewers and the editors themselves (after a well-
deserved rest) will look back on their efforts and wish for the inclusion of some
overlooked entry or question the decision to include ‘‘this rather than that.’’
Unfortunately, despite the name, encyclopedias can only aspire to being encyclo-
pedic. Editors make their best choices given the choices available under the cir-
cumstances at hand. Editors Charlie T. McCormick and Kim Kennedy White
have successfully managed to add significant content to Folklore: An Encyclope-
dia of Beliefs, Customs, Music, and Art while preserving the intent and the best
content of the original. I applaud their efforts.
Thomas A. Green
Standard Folklore Indices
and Classifications
The following works are cited within entries in the short forms shown in
brackets.
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1964. The Types of the Folktale: A Classification
and Bibliography. 2nd rev. ed. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 184. Helsinki:
Academia Scientiarum Fennica. [Cited as AT, Type, or Tale Type, followed by the
appropriate number.]
Baughman, Ernest W. 1966. Type and Motif-Index of the Folktales of England and
North America. Indiana University Folklore Series, no. 20. The Hague: Mouton. [Cited
as Baughman Type or Baughman Motif, followed by the appropriate letter or number.]
Child, Francis James. [1882 1898]. 1965. The English and Scottish Popular Ballads.
5 vols. New York: Dover. [Cited as Child, followed by the appropriate number from 1
through 305.]
Laws, G. Malcolm, Jr. 1957. American Balladry from British Broadsides: A Guide
for Students and Collectors of Traditional Song. American Folklore Society, Biblio-
graphical and Special Series. Vol. 8. Philadelphia. [Cited as Laws, followed by the let-
ter J through Q followed by the appropriate number.]
Laws, G. Malcolm, Jr. 1964. Native American Balladry: A Descriptive Guide and a
Bibliographical Syllabus. Rev. ed. American Folklore Society, Biographical and Special
Series. Vol. 1. Philadelphia. [Cited as Laws, followed by the letter A through I, fol-
lowed by the appropriate number.]
Thompson, Stith. 1955 1958. The Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. Rev. ed. 6 vols.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press. [Cited as Motif, followed by the appropriate
letter and numbers.]
xxiii
A
Academic Programs in Folklore, International
1
2 | Academic Programs in Folklore, International
and no systematic inquiry has been conducted in Europe since the late 1960s.
Two surveys were undertaken, however, in 1953–1954 and in 1965, the former
on behalf of the Commission Internationale des Arts et Traditions Populaires
(CIAP) and the latter in conjunction with its successor, the Societe Internationale
d’Ethnologie et de Folklore (SIEF). These surveys yield a certain amount of in-
formation with regard to the presence of folklore studies in European institutions
of higher learning.
The 1965 survey, for example, ascertained that, at that time, there were about
150 chairs-cum-institutes in ‘‘folklore’’ in European academic establishments. In
some countries, practically every university offered courses and conducted research
in the subject; in others, formal offerings were more sporadic or nonexistent. It also
was quite common for the pursuit of folklore studies to be linked to or incorporated
within departments devoted to adjacent areas of academic endeavor (e.g., geogra-
phy, cultural history, German), rather than conducted within independent depart-
ments. It would be misleading, however, to gauge the presence and development
of folklore studies in Europe solely in terms of the universities, for much research
in the field in the last two centuries has been carried out by individuals or clusters
of individuals attached to academies, archives, and museums; many of the incum-
bents of related research posts also have had part-time or honorary lecturing posi-
tions in universities. A rich crop of publications testifies to the range and intensity
of the research carried out by individual scholars or as cooperative ventures.
One reason why development and evolution are so difficult to measure for the
field of folklore studies involves the change in direction that the discipline has
undergone in certain parts of Europe, especially in reaction to the politicization
of the topic in the 1930s and early 1940s. A sociological orientation is now not
unusual, often coupled with expressions of a social conscience. The investigation
of modern phenomena often takes precedence over more traditionally oriented
approaches. In a sense, such directional shifts may be interpreted as progressive,
as may the increase in the number of students entering this field. Occupational
opportunities in the public sector are practically nonexistent in Europe, unlike
the United States.
The most obvious advance in academic folklore on the international scene has
been through joint projects such as the European Folklore Atlas, the Interna-
tional Folklore Bibliography, and the International Dictionary of Regional Euro-
pean Ethnology and Folklore; through conferences and symposia organized, in
most instances, by national and international scholarly societies such as CIAP
and SIEF, the International Society for Folk-Narrative Research, or the fledgling
International Society for Contemporary Legend Research, or through the summer
schools organized by the revitalized Folklore Fellows of Helsinki. Within SIEF,
the Ballad Commission has been particularly successful in arranging annual sym-
posia that have resulted in fruitful personal contact among scholars not only
Academic Programs in Folklore, North American | 3
within Europe but also across the Atlantic. Therefore, in terms of a wide defini-
tion of what folklore is and of what folklorists do, it can be said that the research,
teaching, and study of the subject undoubtedly are prospering in much of Europe,
and the current situation can with justification be described as encouraging.
W. F. H. Nicolaisen
See Also Academic Programs in Folklore, North American.
References
Anttonen, Pertti J. 1993. Profiles of Folklore 2: Department of European Ethnology,
Lund University, Sweden. NIF Newsletter no. 2: 1 11.
Erixon, Sigurd. 1951. Ethnologie regionale ou folklore. Laos 1: 9 19.
Erixon, Sigurd. 1955. The Position of Regional Ethnology and Folklore at the European
Universities: An International Inquiry. Laos 3: 108 144.
Nicolaisen, W. 1965. Regional Ethnology in European Universities (French summary).
Volkskunde 66: 103 105.
spread the study of folklore to Mexico, where he introduced folklore studies and
taught a folklore techniques course at the National University in 1945. Through its
curriculum in folklore, the University of North Carolina remains one of the leading
centers for the study of folklore in North America. Supported by major research
collections—including the papers of D. K. Wilgus, the labor song collection of
Archie Green, the Southern Folklife Collection, the John Edwards Memorial Col-
lection, and the American Religious Tunebook Collection—and a large library col-
lection in southern literature and culture, the North Carolina program is especially
strong in the study of folksong and southern folklife. The program also emphasizes
African American folklore, ethnographic filmmaking, occupational folklore, public
sector folklore, and immigrant folklore. The curriculum in folklore at North Caro-
lina is designed mainly for graduate students, though undergraduates may put to-
gether an interdisciplinary degree with an area in folklore.
Trained by Kittredge and inspired by the historic-geographic studies of the Fin-
nish folklorists of the late nineteenth and early twentieth centuries, Stith Thomp-
son, who joined the English faculty at Indiana University in 1921, introduced the
first folklore course there in 1923 and directed a number of folklore theses and dis-
sertations of graduate students in the English department. Thompson founded the
first U.S. doctoral program in folklore, emphasizing the comparative study of folk
narratives, at Indiana University in 1949. After Thompson’s retirement in 1955, his
successor, Richard M. Dorson, expanded the concept of folklore studies at Indiana
and elevated an expanded folklore program to departmental status in 1963. A grad-
uate of the Harvard program in the history of American civilization, Dorson pro-
vided an Americanist orientation for a generation of folklorists trained at Indiana
University between 1957 and 1981. Warren E. Roberts, Thompson’s protege in
comparative folktale studies and recipient of the first U.S. doctorate in folklore in
1953, introduced the first course in material culture at Indiana in 1961; he also con-
tributed significantly to broadening the scope of the Indiana program, which now
combines humanistic and social scientific approaches. The program emphasizes
theoretical approaches to folklore and, true to its comparative heritage, continues
to cover many of the world’s folk traditions. A program in ethnomusicology within
the department and the renowned Archives of Traditional Music strengthen the
teaching and research programs. Nearly 60 percent of all university teachers of
folklore who hold doctorates in the subject have been trained at Indiana University.
Under the direction of MacEdward Leach, the University of Pennsylvania
introduced the second U.S. doctoral program in folklore in 1959. After receiving
a PhD in Middle English literature at the University of Pennsylvania in 1930,
Leach remained on the university’s English faculty and changed an epic and
short story course into an introductory folklore course and a literary ballad course
into a folk ballad course. Eventually, Leach developed an interdisciplinary grad-
uate program in folklore at the University of Pennsylvania and trained a number
6 | Academic Programs in Folklore, North American
offer the PhD with a concentration in folklore, but the MA degree in folklore is
more common in North America. In addition to master’s programs in folklore at
Alberta, George Mason, Georgia, Hawaii, Indiana, Laval, Louisiana, Memorial,
Missouri, North Carolina, Ohio State, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Texas A&M, Uni-
versity of Texas at Austin, UCLA, and Utah, a master’s in folklore also is offered
in the Department of Anthropology at the University of California, Berkeley, and
a master’s in folk arts is offered through the Tamburitzans Institute of Folk Arts
in the School of Music at Duquesne University. Western Kentucky’s program in
folk studies is housed in the Department of Modern Languages and Intercultural
Studies and offers an undergraduate minor as well as a master’s in folk studies.
Furthermore, several institutions offer the bachelor’s degree with a major, minor,
and concentrations in folklore including Arkansas, George Mason, Georgia, Har-
vard, Idaho State, Indiana, Memorial, Ohio State, Utah State, and the Universities
of Alberta, Hawaii, Kentucky, North Carolina, Oregon, and Wisconsin.
At least eighty North American institutions offer majors in other disciplines
(notably, English, anthropology, and American studies) that permit either a folk-
lore minor or a folklore concentration. These programs range from formal curric-
ula to informal concentrations at all degree levels. For example, an MA and a
PhD in anthropology or English with a folklore concentration is offered at the
University of Texas, Austin, and undergraduates there may design a special con-
centration in folklore. Undergraduate majors as well as graduate majors in anthro-
pology at Texas A & M University also may elect a concentration in folklore.
Degrees in folklore at the University of Oregon are coordinated through its Folk-
lore and Ethnic Studies Program, which is supported by the Randall V. Mills
Archive of Northwest Folklore. At Oregon, master’s students create their own
plans of study through individualized programs, and doctoral students may elect
folklore as an area in English or anthropology. Through its Program in Folklore,
Mythology, and Film Studies, the State University of New York, Buffalo awards
an MA in English or humanities and a PhD in English with a folklore and mythol-
ogy concentration.
George Washington University’s Folklife Program grants an MA in American
studies or anthropology and a PhD in American studies with a concentration in
traditional material culture. Well situated in Washington, DC, the Folklife Pro-
gram utilizes the resources of the Smithsonian Institution, the American Folklife
Center, and other museums, libraries, archives, and historical societies in the
area. The Folklore Program at Utah State University is administered through the
American Studies Program, and undergraduate and master’s degrees in American
studies with a folklore emphasis are offered. Folklore concentrations also are
available in history or English at Utah State.
Master’s candidates may elect areas in general folklore, public folklore, or
applied history/museology. Ohio State University has offered folklore courses
8 | Academic Programs in Folklore, North American
since the 1930s and now has a Center for Folklore and Cultural Studies, allowing
undergraduate and graduate students a folklore concentration in an interdiscipli-
nary program. A folklore archives and the Francis Lee Utley Collection in the
university library support the academic program, which emphasizes folklore and
literary relations and narrative theory.
Although more folklore courses are offered in English and, to a lesser degree,
anthropology departments than in any other departments or programs, folklore
courses are found in a wide variety of academic departments and programs, from
architecture to women’s studies. At a number of institutions, folklore courses, of-
ten cross-listed, are housed in more than one department. Though degrees in
folklore and departments of folklore have not developed to the extent anticipated
in the late 1960s and early 1970s, folklore courses and concentrations in allied
departments and programs, after a slow beginning, have increased significantly
in North America since that time. Public institutions, doctoral-granting institu-
tions, and large institutions are more likely to offer folklore courses than private
institutions, two-year institutions, and small institutions.
Ronald L. Baker
See Also Academic Programs in Folklore, International.
References
Baker, Ronald L. 1971. Folklore Courses and Programs in American Colleges and
Universities. Journal of American Folklore 84: 221 229.
Baker, Ronald L. 1978. The Study of Folklore in American Colleges and Univer-
sities. Journal of American Folklore 91: 792 807.
Baker, Ronald L. 1986. Folklore and Folklife Studies in American and Canadian
Colleges and Universities. Journal of American Folklore 99: 50 74.
Baker, Ronald L. 1988. The Folklorist in the Academy. In One Hundred Years of
American Folklore Studies, ed. William M. Clements. Washington, DC: American
Folklore Society.
Boggs, Ralph Steele. 1940. Folklore in University Curricula in the United States.
Southern Folklore Quarterly 4: 93 109.
Bronner, Simon. 1991. A Prophetic Vision of Public and Academic Folklife: Alfred
Shoemaker and America’s First Department of Folklore. The Folklore Historian 8: 38 55.
Bynum, David E. 1974. Child’s Legacy Enlarged: Oral Literary Studies at Harvard
since 1856. Harvard Library Bulletin 22: 237 267.
Dorson, Richard M. 1950. The Growth of Folklore Courses. Journal of American
Folklore 63: 345 359.
Dorson, Richard M. 1972. The Academic Future of Folklore. In Richard M. Dorson,
Folklore: Selected Essays. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Leach, MacEdward. 1958. Folklore in American Colleges and Universities. Journal
of American Folklore Supplement, pp. 10 11.
Acculturation | 9
Acculturation
References
Barnett, H. G., Leonard Broom, Bernard J. Siegel, Evon Z. Vogt, and James B. Wat-
son. 1954. Acculturation: An Exploratory Formulation. American Anthropologist 61:
973 1000.
Herskovits, Melville J. 1938. Acculturation: The Study of Cultural Contact. New
York: Augustin.
Linton, Ralph, ed. 1940. Acculturation in Seven American Indian Tribes. New York:
Appleton-Century.
Padilla, Amado M. 1980. Acculturation: Theory, Models, and Some New Findings.
Boulder, CO: Westview Press.
Redfield, Robert. 1953. The Primitive World and Its Transformations. Ithaca, NY:
Cornell University Press.
Redfield, Robert, Ralph Linton, and Melville J. Herskovits. 1936. Memorandum for
the Study of Acculturation. American Anthropologist 38: 149 152.
Activism
Any intentional action to bring about social change, to right social injustices,
improve environmental, economic, physical, cultural, or material well-being, to
name but a few causes. Can take many forms, from persuading individuals to
change behavior, to changing structures through grassroots efforts as well as offi-
cial ‘‘political’’ channels.
Individuals disagree on how to characterize activism—from repeated public
displays and dramatic actions built on regular daily acts, to the routines of persis-
tent and resilient organizing, to acts of personal change (including internal, trans-
formational activism) that may help in preparing people to address issues of
injustice. Definitions of activist are similarly hotly contested. What many do
agree upon is the range of strategies useful for bringing about change: socially
responsible daily behavior; direct service; community and economic develop-
ment; voting and formal political activities; direct action strategies (such as ral-
lies, protest, artistic forms of dissent and resistance); grassroots political activity
and public policy work; community organizing and community building; and ad-
vocacy through community educations. Indeed, many folklorists’ work resonates
with, combines, or extends some of these strategies as part of their folkloristic
strategies for community involvement. Folklorists also work closely with the
12 | Activism
in our cultural representations and help to widen the scope of what counts as evi-
dence, then we may be doing activism in folklore. When we work alongside peo-
ple—if requested—to assist them to improve the physical, material, economic,
cultural, and structural dimensions that perpetuate oppressive conditions, we
may be folklore activists.
Nancy L. Watterson
See Also Applied Folklore/Folkloristics; Community-Based Research; Occupational
Folklife/Folklore; Protest; Public Sector Folklore.
References
Ancelet, Barry Jean. 2003. The Theory and Practice of Activist Folklore: From
Fieldworking to Programming. In Working the Field: Accounts from French Louisiana.
Westport, CT: Greenwood.
Back, Adina, and Sally Charnow. 2002. The Folklorist as ‘‘Cultural Activist’’: An
Interview with Steve Zeitlin. Radical History Review 84: 125 136. Accessed June 18,
2009 from http://muse.jhu.edu/journals/radical history review/v084/84.1back.html.
Baron, Robert, and Nicholas R. Spitzer, eds. 2007. Public Folklore. Jackson: Univer-
sity Press of Mississippi.
Jones, Michael Owen, ed. 1994. Putting Folklore to Use. American Folklore Series.
Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Kodish, Debora. Folklore: Activism. Journal of American Folklore (forthcoming
2010).
Lorence, James J. 2007. A Hard Journey: The Life of Don West. Urbana: University
of Illinois Press.
Politics, Folklore and Social Justice section of the American Folklore Society. http://
www.afsnet.org/sections/politics.
Reed, T. V. 2005. The History of Art and Protest: Culture and Activism from the
Civil Rights Movement to the Streets of Seattle. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota
Press.
Scott, James C. 1990. Domination and the Arts of Resistance: Hidden Transcripts.
New Haven, CT: Yale University Press.
Shuldiner, David. Founder of journal Folklore in Use. Memorial lectures in his name
are held annually at the American Folklore Society meetings, sponsored by the Politics,
Folklore and Social Justice (PFSJ) section.
‘‘Social Change Wheel.’’ Civic Engagement and Campus/Community Partnerships.
Minnesota Campus Compact. http://www.mncampuscompact.org.
Stoecker, Randy. 1997. Are Academics Irrelevant?: Roles for Scholars in Participa-
tory Research. Paper presented at the American Sociological Society Annual Meetings.
Available online from: http://comm-org.wisc.edu/papers98/pr.htm.
Stoecker, Randy. 2008. Challenging Institutional Barriers to Community-Based
Research. Action Research 6: 49 67. Available online from: http://arj.sagepub.com/cgi/
content/abstract/6/1/49.
Aesthetics | 15
Tripp, Peggy, and Linda Muzzin, eds. 2005. Teaching as Activism: Equity Meets
Environmentalism. Montreal: McGill-Queen’s University Press.
Westerman, William. Critical Edge (forthcoming).
Williams, John. 1975. Radicalism and Professionalism in Folklore Studies: A Com-
parative Perspective. Journal of the Folklore Institute 11(3): 211 234.
Aesthetics
As Boas and later scholars demonstrate, this stress on the customary is further
bolstered by the communal creation of objects. In a traditional barn raising or
quilting bee, for instance, individual tastes or experimentation are limited by the
communal execution of the work. Communal production, characteristic of many
varieties of traditional material culture, thus exerts a leveling influence on artistic
variation and helps ensure the maintenance of a communal aesthetic over time.
When traditional performers become separated from this ambient collective tra-
dition of evaluation and production, their work may change greatly, incorporat-
ing new ideas and departing to some degree from old standards. Richard Bauman
addresses changes of this sort in his study of a folk raconteur turned professional.
Similarly, Michael Owen Jones examines the conscious interplay of tradition and
innovation in the products of a professional Kentucky mountain chair maker.
Jones stresses that aesthetic choices do not occur mechanistically but as the result
of personal decisions and values over time.
Given this analytical framework, a prime issue for the folk art collector lies in
the question of whether to value typicality in a piece of folklore (an act presumably
valued in the traditional community) or to privilege instead those works that trans-
gress typical norms or tastes (an act valued in elite art circles). Judgments of this
sort have direct bearing on folk artists, as the monetary value attached to a given
work may influence artistic trends within the community itself. Collector interest
in a particular physical form or color scheme, for instance, may alter a commun-
ity’s evaluation of that form and lead to its triumph over other types. An obscure
performer or style may thus become central, while a community’s own evaluative
standards lose cogency. By contrast, changes that appear significant to an outside
audience may be regarded as minor creative alterations within the ambient com-
munity itself, of little consequence to the tradition or its maintenance. Alterations
in technique, materials, or use only become significant if they transgress important
rules within the community’s aesthetic system. Questions of aesthetics thus present
intriguing issues for both public sector and academic folklorists alike.
Aesthetics in Communication
Aesthetics becomes an explicit concern of linguistic folklorists through the writ-
ings of Roman Jakobson. Jakobson’s attention to poetics provides a new basis
for the analysis of the aesthetic form and uses of language. In Jakobson’s analy-
sis, poetic language draws ordinary words into new frameworks of meaning
through attention to criteria (e.g., rhyme) normally ignored in speech. This new
axis of equivalence distinguishes the poetic utterance from the ordinary. Studies
such as William Pepicello and Thomas Green’s examination of riddling demon-
strate the ways in which folklore can capitalize artfully on such normally unno-
ticed similarities between words or utterances. The study of ethnopoetics further
examines the ways in which equivalence operates in the narrative traditions of
Aesthetics | 17
Contrastive Analysis
Folklorists have often addressed aesthetic features within a given genre or com-
munity from a contrastive perspective. The aesthetic values of a certain kind of
folklore, for instance, may be contrasted with the values of elite art or with those
of some other community. Typical of a genre-based approach is Max L€uthi’s
study of European M€ archen (see Folktale entry). Concentrating on the formal
aspects of the genre (e.g., characters, setting, plot), L€uthi demonstrates the
M€ archen’s distinctiveness from elite narrative literature. Similarly, Breandan
Breathnach’s study of Irish folk music contrasts the means of ornamentation and
style in folk music with that of European art music. The features favored by the
elite tradition (e.g., variation in intensity of sound—‘‘dynamics’’) remain unex-
ploited by the folk performer, and other features (e.g., grace notes, rhythm)
become prime means of varying and evaluating performances.
John Michael Vlach offers a community-based approach to contrastive aes-
thetics in his examination of African American arts. In his discussion of quilting,
for instance, Vlach not only stresses the survival of West African techniques and
styles but also examines how the particular aesthetic embodied in such works con-
trasts with the Euroamerican aesthetic of quilt form. Whereas Anglo quilt makers
of the nineteenth century valued geometric regularity and naturalistic representa-
tional depiction, African American quilters valued works that employed both
‘‘improvisational’’ patternings and stylized figures.
Such contrastive analysis is particularly enlightening when the groups or gen-
res compared have existed side by side for an extended period, leading to the
more or less conscious creation and maintenance of contrastive evaluative stan-
dards. Differential aesthetics can become a means of creating and defending cul-
tural boundaries, of resisting a threatened loss of communal identity.
18 | Aesthetics
References
Bauman, Richard. 1975. Verbal Art as Performance. American Anthropologist 77:
290 311.
Bauman, Richard. 1986. Story, Performance and Event: Contextual Studies in Oral
Narrative. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Ben-Amos, Dan. 1971. Toward a Definition of Folklore in Context. Journal of Amer-
ican Folklore 84: 3 15.
Boas, Franz. 1927. Primitive Art. New York: Dover.
Breathnach, Breandan. 1971. Folk Music and Dances of Ireland. Dublin: Mercier.
Gossen, Gary. 1974. Chamulas in the World of the Sun. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
Jakobson, Roman. 1960. Closing Statement: Linguistics and Poetics. In Style in Lan-
guage, ed. Thomas A. Sebeok. New York: John Wiley.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1989. Craftsman of the Cumberlands: Tradition and Creativity.
Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
African American Folklore | 19
Pepicello, W. J., and Thomas A. Green. 1984. The Language of Riddles: New Per-
spectives. Columbus: Ohio State University Press.
Toelken, Barre. 1979. Worldview and the Traditional Material Artifacts of the Nav-
ajo. In The Dynamics of Folklore, ed. Barre Toelken. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Vlach, John Michael. 1978. The Afro-American Tradition in Decorative Arts. Cleve-
land, OH: Cleveland Museum of Art.
Witherspoon, Gary. 1977. Language and Art in the Navajo Universe. Ann Arbor:
University of Michigan Press.
overcoming the powerful, greed, sex, violence, alcohol and drug abuse, male-
female relationships, dominance and subordination, identity and race, and other
such themes are transmitted from generation to generation. Along with material
folk culture, they represent some of the most important cultural resources that
comprise the African American experience.
Because of the importance of the spoken word among African groups from which
slaves were captured, many of the most ubiquitous folklore forms are cast in Black
English dialect. A subject that has received considerable interest among sociolin-
guists and folklorists, Black English dialect varies from Standard English in at least
three ways: grammar (for example, dropping the /s/ in nouns to indicate plurality
and lack of verb tense, such as ‘‘He got five dollar’’), pronunciation (for instance,
substituting d for th in ‘‘the’’), and vocabulary (such as gumbo, jazz, and okra).
Zora Neale Hurston offers an excellent example of dialect in Mules and Men
(1935), in which she records a number of folk narratives she collected in Florida
during the 1930s. Her collection of stories and jokes contrasts with Joel Chandler
Harris’s earlier publication Nights with Uncle Remus (1883), a collection of tales
that Harris (who was white) heard from blacks while growing up in the South.
Uncle Remus, a fictional black servant who tells the plantation owner’s son the
stories Harris edited, employs phonetic dialect (often called eye dialect) as a lit-
erary device to underscore the quaintness of black southern characters. That and
later publications by Harris offered to white readers the richness of folk wisdom
but also sparked a scholarly debate about the origins of these so-called dialect
tales. Conversely, Hurston’s collection was based on ethnographic research she
conducted among fellow blacks in and around her hometown of Eatonville, Flor-
ida, and comes closer to capturing the spoken word in print.
Did the tales from these and other collections originate from Europe or from
Africa? Folklorist Richard Dorson, who employed research tools that indexed
folk narrative motifs and folktale types, favored a predominantly European ori-
gin. After reviewing the work of black and white collectors of African American
folklore who preceded him, Dorson concluded that his collection of tales was
non-African in origin. For example, he claimed that ‘‘Coon in the Box,’’ among
the best-known Old Marster stories, derives from a motif (K1956, ‘‘Sham wise
man’’), which appears in ‘‘Doctor-Know-All’’ (AT 1641), collected and pub-
lished by the Grimm brothers.
‘‘The Coon in the Box’’ is a story of black servant Jack who endangers himself
when his boss wagers that Jack is a ‘‘know-it-all’’ who can guess the contents of a
box. What the boss does not realize is that Jack always investigates the facts ahead
of time so that he appears to have an uncanny ability to know things in advance.
But this time, Jack did not know the contents of the box, in which the boss had
placed a raccoon. Jack gives up and proclaims, ‘‘You got that old coon at last,’’
thereby correctly ‘‘guessing’’ the contents and guaranteeing his boss considerable
African American Folklore | 21
Spirituals were also masked messages about freedom and escape in this world:
for example, ‘‘Go down Moses, way down in Egypt land / Tell Ole Pharaoh to let
my people go’’ and ‘‘Swing low, sweet chariot, comin’ for to carry me home.’’
‘‘Follow the Drink’ Gourd’’ may have been a celestial map, a guide to the under-
ground railroad for blacks seeking to escape slavery. Nevertheless, as most folk-
lorists have observed, spirituals—which W. E. B. DuBois dubbed ‘‘sorrow
songs’’—also express the hardships slaves endured and the hope for freedom that
African American Folklore | 23
would come to God’s chosen people, espousing their confidence of getting into
heaven while assuring them that sinful whites would not. In short, spirituals
could appeal either to the secular world of enslaved people or to the sacred one
that offered hope for freedom.
This chapter in the emergence of a distinctly African American expressive
form is a recurring one as American blacks find cause to remember their cultural
legacy in the form of folk festivals, or what have been called freedom celebra-
tions. Freedom celebrations remind celebrants of their legacy, the saga of which
passes from one generation to another through colorful pageants. William H.
Wiggins Jr. (1987) describes the saga as having four epochs. The first deals with
the African past with scenes that depict the glories of Egypt, Ethiopia, and other
ancient civilizations. The second period is slavery, which includes episodes such
as forms of physical and psychological torture, slave revolts, the Underground
Railroad, and the emergence of slave spirituals.
Emancipation follows slavery, with scenes of Lincoln issuing the Emancipa-
tion Proclamation, the Civil War, the role of black soldiers, slaves who felt
morally obligated to run the plantation while their masters were away at war, and
their subsequent experiences of freedom. The final epoch describes the continual
struggle for freedom that began with Emancipation, underscoring that forms of
slavery still exist, and this part of the saga also includes the disfranchisement of
blacks during Reconstruction, mass migrations from the South to the North, par-
ticipation of black soldiers in American wars, the civil rights movement, the rise
of black nationalism, race riots, and the emergence of blues, jazz, gospel, and
other musical contributions blacks have made to American culture and history.
These annual events give celebrants opportunities to pass along to younger gen-
erations their histories, songs, and stories, thereby reminding them of their roots
and their continuing struggle for first-class citizenship in the New World.
The plantation culture that depended upon slavery represented the second
epoch in these freedom celebrations. Such a context gave rise to spirituals as a
worldview emerged that linked the slave’s world with that of the Hebrews under
Moses and also included aspects of a belief system with African antecedents. In
this worldview, certain gifted individuals such as conjure doctors could manipu-
late supernatural forces to achieve their own ends. Practitioners of these beliefs
were sometimes at odds with Christian converts, though in some respects the two
systems influenced each other. Moses, like the fictional John de Conqueror popu-
lar in plantation oral traditions, was a mystical figure possessing the power to
help others. However, conjurers were also capable of countering a bad spell, or
juju, and believers seeking to control supernatural forces as well as faith healers
combined both natural remedies for the sick and injured with magic. For those
who worked close to the soil, knowledge of plants with medicinal properties
played an important role in combating the numerous maladies slaves regularly
24 | African American Folklore
faced. Many overseers and slaveowners relied on the skills of black healers and
midwives familiar with such herbs and plants. These folk healers were indispen-
sable on plantations, particularly those lacking access to trained physicians.
However, if natural cures or everyday methods for solving problems were inef-
fective or unavailable, then a patient might find it necessary to consult a special-
ist who could manipulate unseen forces to thwart an enemy, avenge a wrong
toward oneself or loved one, or create a love potion. The belief system therefore
incorporated both religion and magic, though practitioners of vodou, derived
from the Caribbean Vodun religion, were often held in awe and often feared by
both blacks and whites. Stories abound on plantations of hoodoo doctors capable
of transforming themselves to evade capture, while folk healers such as mid-
wives were depended upon by whites on plantations where white doctors were
not always available. The efficacy of such healers was sometimes even preferred
at times. When white physicians were unsuccessful in delivering the mistress’s
baby, she often sent for a black plantation midwife. According to one account,
two white doctors attempted to discredit a particular midwife’s claims in a suc-
cessful delivery and ridiculed her, warning, ‘‘Get back darkie, we mean business
an’ don’ won’t any witch doctors or hoodoo stuff.’’ Nevertheless, the white
woman insisted she stay and perform her work. Such healers were more inclined
to place their faith in their knowledge of plants and herbs than in controlling su-
pernatural forces characteristic of hoodoo doctors.
However, many who believed that supernatural forces could be controlled
through magic and ritual received reinforcement in those beliefs whenever mis-
fortune befell their white captors, such as when the dreaded boll weevil
destroyed cotton crops or when floods threatened to ruin a white landowner’s
investment. These were acts of an angry God who sought revenge against evil
whites who mistreated slaves. These conditions also fostered the development of
a rich body of trickster tales, stories that often depicted the subservient black
slave outwitting his master, such as the cycle of Marster-John tales that was per-
vasive throughout plantation communities in the southern United States.
Typically in these tales, John would invert the power relations between him
and his white master. In a version of ‘‘Old Marster Eats Crow’’ recorded by Rich-
ard Dorson, John was caught hunting on Master’s place and was warned not to
do so anymore, but John did anyway and shot a crow. Marster told John to give
him his gun, and he then aimed it at him and demanded John to pick the feathers
off the crow, saying, ‘‘Now start at his head, John, and eat the crow up to where
you stopped picking the feathers at.’’ After John finished eating, Marster returned
his gun, but when John started walking away, he turned toward Marster, pointed
the gun at him, and said, ‘‘Lookee here, Old Marster,’’ and threw the rest of the
crow at him. ‘‘I want you to start at his ass and eat all the way, and don’t let a
feather fly from your mouth.’’
African American Folklore | 25
Stories also circulated that would teach young listeners about what happens to
careless slaves who fail to adhere to an informal code of conduct such as not tell-
ing others everything you know or cooperating with white authority figures.
‘‘Talking Turtle’’ is about a turtle who scolded John: ‘‘Black man, you talk too
much,’’ whereupon John ran to get Old Marster to come with him to the bayou to
see the talking turtle. But Old Marster did not want to go see a talking turtle
because he did not believe John. He warned him he would give John a good beat-
ing if he was lying. When they arrived at the bayou, the turtle said nothing as his
head receded into his shell, so John received a beating. A bewildered John
returned to the bayou, and the turtle said, ‘‘Black man, didn’t I tell you you talked
too much?’’
Trickster Tales
The trickster figure played a prominent role in folktales heard on Southern slave
plantations, but the animal tricksters bore the closest resemblance to their Afri-
can counterparts. Tricksters such as Hare or Rabbit (found throughout East
Africa) and Spider (a transformation of Anansi common in much of West Africa
and the Caribbean) were relatively small and weak creatures and therefore
reached their goals through wit and guile rather than through physical power.
What they craved—food, sex, and other prizes—were much the same as the
desires of the slaves who told of their exploits. Storytellers and listeners identi-
fied with them, and such animal tales explained how the alligator got his mouth,
why the rabbit has a short tail, and how a protagonist outwits his stronger foe
(for example, ‘‘Tar Baby’’). Most important, the victories of Brer Rabbit became
the victories of the slaves. Narrators also told supernatural and religious tales as
well as other kinds of explanatory tales: how the church evolved, why the black
man’s hair is nappy, and why African Americans are black. But after slavery,
these tales gave way to a different kind of protagonist, one who figured in a type
of narrative that came to be known as toasts and who was also often incorporated
into other expressive forms.
In the animal tale ‘‘Tar Baby,’’ which Harris popularized in his early Uncle
Remus collection, the trickster Rabbit ‘‘signifies’’ on his antagonist Fox, implor-
ing him not to throw him into the briar patch, which is, of course, the rabbit’s
natural habitat, and thus ridiculing his adversary’s ignorance. The rabbit’s signi-
fying is one of the most striking features in black oral tradition and most often
implies indirect insult. The toast ‘‘The Signifying Monkey’’ tells how Monkey
tells Lion that Elephant has been saying bad things about him and that it is Ele-
phant who is king of the jungle. This causes Lion to seek Elephant in a duel,
much to the delight of Monkey, whose satisfaction comes from his ability to cre-
ate chaos through his verbal skills. When Lion discovers Monkey’s deception, he
returns to the tree where Monkey is laughing hysterically. Monkey further incurs
26 | African American Folklore
the wrath of Lion, again signifying on him by hurling insults at Lion and ridicul-
ing his gullibility while sitting safely high on a tree limb. But while jumping up
and down in laughter, the monkey slips and falls and finds himself at the mercy
of Lion. He again quickly fools Lion into forgiving him, scurries back up the
tree, and continues ranting and berating the Lion’s gullibility. This toast illus-
trates some of the most important features of signifying, and the situational con-
text in which the word applies narrows its meaning.
Toasts
Toasts, sometimes known as jokes, are long narratives often in rhymed couplets
that frequently employ signifying as one of their most significant features. They
are often heard in prisons, on street corners, and at barbershops, restaurants,
meeting halls, or wherever men gather to tell stories. Besides the well-known
‘‘Signifying Monkey,’’ there are other toasts that include a trickster-badman fig-
ure. Unlike trickster John in the John-Marster tale cycle specific to Southern
slave plantations, the protagonist in black toasts takes on much different charac-
teristics. For instance, the character Shine appears in one of the best-known
toasts in black oral tradition, ‘‘The Titanic.’’
After the superliner Titanic sank in 1912, the toast appeared in a variety of
versions in both song and prose narrative among blacks and whites, but the toast
most popular in black oral tradition depicted the character Shine, a lowly boiler
room worker, rebelling against the ultimate white authority figure aboard ship,
the captain. Perhaps because the Titanic refused passage to African Americans
(except those who worked in subservient positions like Shine), including black
heavyweight boxing champion Jack Johnson, the toast must have had a particular
appeal among those it circulated. Essentially, Shine, a trickster-type character
who possesses badman qualities, responds to the captain’s demands for him to
return below and continue shoveling coal, despite Shine’s warning that the ship
is sinking, by ultimately refusing the order. The following excerpt comes from a
collection of toasts that Bruce Jackson recorded from a black convict at a south-
east Texas prison farm:
The Dozens
The dozens, a form of verbal dueling, is often associated with toasts. The dozens
is embedded in the ‘‘The Signifying Monkey’’ as Monkey exchanges insults with
Lion, but the dozens primarily involves black adolescents who engage in ritual
insults until somebody ‘‘loses.’’
‘‘Playing the dozens’’ also goes by names that vary regionally, such as ‘‘signify-
ing’’ or ‘‘sigging’’ (Chicago), ‘‘joning’’ (Washington, DC), ‘‘woofing’’ (Philadel-
phia), and ‘‘capping’’ (West Coast). Played by and performed among an audience
that most often involves black adolescent males, the object is to hurl creative
insults or ‘‘snaps’’ against one’s opponents (often targeting a close relative such as
one’s mother), whereupon the recipient of the snap responds accordingly. ‘‘Sound-
ing’’ also refers to the ritualized insult, and for somebody to ‘‘sound on’’ somebody
else refers to a ritualized attribute of that person: for example, ‘‘If ugliness were
bricks, your mother would be a housing project.’’ A clever response would build
on this insult, receiving either praise or groans from listeners. It is a verbal activity
28 | African American Folklore
that can take on a wide range of meanings. According to the civil rights leader H.
Rap Brown, ‘‘The real aim of the Dozens was to get a dude so mad he’d cry or get
mad enough to fight.’’ Moreover, Brown pointed out, ‘‘Some of the best Dozens
players were girls.’’ Therefore, the game is not necessarily gender-specific,
although the content of the insults differ according to a performer’s gender.
Major themes of the dozens include poverty (‘‘Your family is so poor, they go
to Kentucky Fried Chicken to lick other people’s fingers’’), ugliness (‘‘Your
mother is so ugly, when she walks in the bank they turn off the cameras’’), stu-
pidity (‘‘Your sister is so stupid, she went to the baker for a yeast infection’’),
and sexual promiscuity (‘‘Your mother’s like a bag of chips, she’s free-to-lay’’).
Other interpretations of the dozens include the notion that this form of activity
is a reflection of tensions black males face in an environment where one must
prove masculinity and reject femininity. Roger D. Abrahams (1970) suggests that
the dozens enables a boy to attack some other person’s mother and consequently
diminish his own mother’s influence. Another explanation, proposed by Onwu-
chekwa Jemie (2003), holds that the disrespect shown the mother in the dozens is
the means by which a boy eventually disengages himself from the comfort of his
mother’s intimacy—an issue more important for African American males than
their African counterparts, given the abuse black males have suffered in the New
World and their frequent difficulties in protecting family members. Playing the
dozens includes considerable signifying, as is evident in ‘‘The Signifying
Monkey.’’
Such notes include both major and minor thirds, major and minor sevenths, and
perfect and flatted fifths. The music of the blues is very similar to that of its pre-
cursors, and the line between sacred and secular music is not always clear.
The religious experience, particularly chanted speech, affected the blues. Indeed,
the preaching tradition and the blues tradition involve verbal skills their practi-
tioners acquire by supernatural means. For example, songster Robert Johnson is
reputed to have ‘‘bought’’ blues skills by selling his soul at the ‘‘crossroads.’’ Both
black preachers and bluesmen employ a pattern of call-and-response. Phrases that
are formulaic in preaching are also typical among blues performers. Other parallels
are evident during performances, such as audience-congregation participation.
Early hymnody, spirituals, and gospels helped shaped the blues. ‘‘Dr. Watts’’
hymns, named after the late-eighteenth-century composer Isaac Watts, were per-
formed among nonliterate black congregations by ‘‘lining-out,’’ a style wherein a
song leader recites a line that congregants repeat in a slow rhythmic tempo.
Although spirituals had their settings in the Old Testament, they contained livelier
melodies than Dr. Watts hymns, with patterned stanzas, a chorus easily learned and
sung and that was infinitely expandable. Spirituals stressed otherworldliness and
the rewards of the life to come, themes with potential for a good deal of emotion.
Gospel music took shape during the last quarter of the nineteenth century with the
advent of the gospel quartet, and it is more upbeat than spirituals with lyrics con-
cerned with this world rather than the afterlife, focusing on more positive images
of proper behavior in the here and now. It remains one of the most popular kinds of
religious music in black oral tradition. It is not unusual to see blues performers be-
ginning their careers singing hymns, gospels, and spirituals while growing up with
a church, and later turning to blues and other types of secular music.
Having emerged at least by the 1890s, the blues draws from traditional motifs,
images, and stanzas. A performer was flexible in his composition particularly in
non-thematic, country, and folk blues (and more so than in city, urban, popular,
and thematic blues). The songs’ themes deal with problems in the everyday secu-
lar world, especially male-female relationships. This topic is common because of
the uncertainty of relationships, but also because of the festive contexts in which
bluesmen often performed such as juke joints, known for gambling, sexual prom-
iscuity, and sometimes even lethal fights over women. Other subjects a bluesman
might raise include unemployment, ill health, crime and prison, and other kinds
of tragedy that formed part of the everyday experience of black audiences. Lyrics
employ culturally specific images and metaphors, such as comparing the object
of one’s desire to a horse or to a ‘‘handyman.’’ A distinctive blues vocabulary—
such as rider referring to ‘‘woman’’ and diddy-wah-diddy as an ideal community
or place—emerged in the tradition.
Scholars have classified blues in terms of regional styles and the musical instru-
ments frequently accompanying their performances: ‘‘country,’’ ‘‘classic,’’ and
African American Folklore | 31
‘‘urban.’’ Country blues includes the eastern seaboard blues of Peg Leg Howell,
Brownie McGhee, and Sonny Terry; Delta blues exhibits ‘‘heavy’’ texture, shout-
ing, and frenetic vocal style typical of songsters Robert Johnson (dubbed ‘‘King of
the Delta Blues’’) and his predecessor Charley Patton; Texas blues commonly has
a single-string guitar, relaxed vocal qualities, and ‘‘light’’ texture, as heard in
recordings by Blind Lemon Jefferson, Mance Lipscomb, and Lightnin’ Hopkins;
and jug bands use jugs, washboards, and kazoos as exemplified in the music of
ensembles from Memphis, Tennessee, such as that of Gus Cannon and Will Shade.
‘‘Classic’’ blues, sometimes referred to as city blues, is typically associated with
early recording artists Bessie Smith and Ma Rainey and features string bass, elec-
tric guitar, drums, and sometimes a piano as accompanying instruments. These
singers were popular blues artists whose recordings appeared on ‘‘race’’ records
that targeted black customers and that often inspired the careers of other blues per-
formers who heard them. Urban blues includes bands with drums and electric
instruments—for example, groups fronted by B. B. King, Jimmy Reed, Muddy
Waters, and Howlin’ Wolf.
Growing out of these earlier forms is the rap music of modern hip-hop culture.
Unlike its predecessors, rap music relies on the manipulation of technology as it
explores poverty, urban blight, and violence. Rap is a form of music employing
rhyme, rhythmic speech, chanting, and street speech—all performed over a musi-
cal soundtrack. Economic development that has changed areas of cities such as
the Bronx in New York generated an outcry among adolescents who have reacted
by employing expressive forms that resulted in rap music. The word rap is very
similar to terms that have been used to refer to the dozens (for example, joning,
capping, and sounding) and therefore has considerable affinity with earlier black
oral traditions.
enabling one to fire a shotgun through the entire length of the house. A typical
shotgun house has three or more small rooms connected directly to one another.
Like its West African and Caribbean counterparts, the shotgun house matched
perfectly the warm southern climate in which African slaves found themselves,
but it also reveals a worldview that values close interactions among its occupants.
There is a distinct tradition of highly ornamental ironwork in African Ameri-
can blacksmithing, though ironworking has also taken on a more utilitarian
dimension as well—as seen in the work of African American blacksmiths in East
Texas and elsewhere who are continuing a tradition in which the blacksmith is
the pivotal craftsman of his community. His importance in the New World is tied
to an African legacy in which he was master of the four elements—air, earth,
fire, and water—and capable of transforming himself at will into various animals
and plants. He is an ambivalent figure in West African folklore, an intermediary
between the living and the dead. In Central Africa, blacksmith kings appear in
legend as founders of their state, and in the Congo the blacksmith’s authority
ranks him with chiefs, priests, and sorcerers. Although such mythical powers did
not manifest themselves in the Western Hemisphere, the African American
blacksmith’s social status in Southern rural communities today reveals parallels
to the status enjoyed by his African forebears. Intense involvement in their com-
munities allows black ironworkers in East Texas and elsewhere to enjoy a status
similar to the role of a blacksmith in the pre–Civil War South. Writers have
noted that some blacksmiths were particularly capable of subversive activities
such as making weapons for uprisings. Because so much depends upon the work
of a skilled ironworker, slaveowners recognized their value. The interrelationship
of a blacksmith with his community and an accounting of the role blacksmiths
have played in Southern communities is revealed in many of the ex-slave narra-
tives collected by federal workers during the Great Depression.
Another aspect of the plantation experience that continues today is the quilt,
also a subject embedded in ex-slave narratives. African American applique and
strip quilts often juxtapose contrasting colors and designs, a distinct African
American characteristic. An applique quilt of Harriet Powers of Georgia, for
example, included two pictorial quilts, and her 1896 Bible quilt contrasts eleven
panels arranged in three horizontal bands, rendering scenes from the Bible in an
overall arrangement that appears random despite following a linear sequence.
Asymmetrical and unpredictable designs or ‘‘offbeat’’ patterns are esthetic options
in West and Central African fabrics, which folklorists have recently recognized in
other expressive forms among African Americans in the southern United States.
Among West Africans, colors are also extremely important in cloth. African
American women in Suriname value strong colors in their pieced textiles so much
that colors should ‘‘shine’’ or ‘‘burn.’’ The color of one piece should ‘‘lift up’’ the
one next to it—that is, it should provide strong contrast.
African American Folklore | 33
The esthetic at work in this kind of material culture manifests itself in similar
ways in African American folk art, such as that of Nathaniel Barrow of Helena,
Arkansas. Barrow has been painting telephones; carving airplanes, boats, and
trucks; crafting whirligigs; and fashioning wall hangings from wood since 1977.
The content in his artworks include color schemes and asymmetry similar to what
appear in the quilts. Some paintings by Barrow include drawings of snakes, an im-
portant motif in African American folklore that also figures into voodoo rituals.
The African American experience cannot be understood unless traditional ex-
pressive forms, whose contents and forms have changed over the centuries, are
considered. Folk music and song, trickster tales, toasts, the dozens, proverbs,
legends, and folk arts and crafts are a small sampling of many more cultural
resources that comprise much of the black diaspora and give meaning to a
diverse ethnic group that continues to shape American culture and history.
Richard Allen Burns
See Also African Folklore; Anansi; Ethnic Folklore.
References
Abernethy, Francis E., Patrick B. Mullen, and Alan B. Govenar, eds. 1996. June-
teenth Texas: Essays in African-American Folklore. Denton: University of North Texas
Press.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1985. Afro-American Folktales: Stories from Black Traditions
in the New World. New York: Pantheon Books.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1990 (1963). Playing the Dozens. In Mother Wit from the
Laughing Barrel: Readings in the Interpretation of Afro-American Folklore, ed. Alan
Dundes. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 295 309.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1994 (1962). Deep Down in the Jungle: Negro Narrative Folk-
lore from the Streets of Philadelphia. Chicago: Aldine Publishing.
Barber, Karin. 2007. The Anthropology of Texts, Persons and Publics: Oral and
Written Culture in Africa and Beyond. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Bascom, William. 1992. African Folktales in the New World. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Burns, Richard Allen. 1996. African-American Blacksmithing in East Texas. In June-
teenth Texas: Essays in African-American Folklore, ed. Francis E. Abernethy, Patrick B.
Mullen, and Alan B. Govenar. Denton: University of North Texas Press. 166 193.
Burns, Richard Allen. 2002. The Shotgun Houses of Trumann, Arkansas. Arkansas
Review 33: 44 51.
Christian, Marcus. 2002. Negro Ironworkers of Louisiana, 1718 1900. Gretna, LA:
Pelican Press.
Cooke, Benjamin G. 1972. Nonverbal Communication among African Americans:
An Initial Classification. In Rappin’ and Stylin’ Out, ed. Thomas Kochman. Urbana:
University of Illinois Press, 32 64.
34 | African American Folklore
Currie, Stephen. 2009. African American Folklore. Farmington Hills, MI: Lucent
Books.
Dance, Daryl Cumber, ed. 2002. From My People: 400 Years of African American
Folklore. New York: Norton.
Dillard, J. L. 1972. Black English: Its History and Usage in the United States. New
York: Vintage Books.
Dorson, Richard M. 1970. (1956). American Negro Folktales. New York: Fawcett
World Library.
Dundes, Alan, ed. 1990 (1973). Mother Wit from the Laughing Barrel: Readings
from the Interpretation of Afro-American Folklore. Jackson: University Press of
Mississippi.
Holloway, Joseph E. 1990. Africanisms in American Culture. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Hurston, Zora Neale. 1990 (1935). Mules and Men. New York: Harper Perennial.
Jackson, Bruce. 1999 (1972). Wake up Dead Man: Hard Labor and Southern Blues.
Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Jackson, Bruce. 2004 (1974). Get Your Ass in the Water and Swim like Me: African-
American Narrative Poetry from the Oral Tradition (with sound recording). New York:
Routledge.
Jemie, Onwuchekwa, ed. 2003. Yo’ Mama! New Raps, Toasts, Dozens, Jokes, and
Children’s Rhymes from Urban Black America. Philadelphia: Temple University Press.
Keyes, Cheryl L. 2002. Rap Music and Street Consciousness. Urbana: University of
Illinois Press.
Kochman, Thomas, ed. 1972. Rappin’ and Stylin’ Out. Urbana: University of Illinois
Press.
Labov, William. 1972. Rules for Ritual Insult. In Rappin’ and Stylin’ Out: Communi-
cation in Urban Black America, ed. Thomas Kochman. Chicago: University of Illinois
Press, 265 314.
Levine, Lawrence. 1977. Black Culture and Black Consciousness: Afro-American
Folk Thought from Slavery to Freedom. New York: Oxford University Press.
Lomax, Alan. 1993. The Land Where the Blues Began. New York: Pantheon Books.
Minton, John, and David Evans. 2001. ‘‘The Coon in the Box’’: A Global Folktale in
African-American Tradition. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Mulira, Jessie Gaston. 1990. The Case of Voodoo in New Orleans. In Africanisms in
American Culture, ed. Joseph E. Holloway. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 34 68.
Oliver, Paul. 1990 (1960). Blues Fell This Morning: Meaning in the Blues. London:
Cambridge University Press.
Palmer, Robert. 1981. Deep Blues. New York: Penguin Books.
Perkelay, James, Monteria Ivey, and Stephen Dweck. 1994. Snaps. New York: Wil-
liam Morrow.
Perkelay, James, Monteria Ivey, and Stephen Dweck. 1995. Double Snaps. New
York: William Morrow.
African Folklore | 35
African Folklore
African folklore is part of the oral tradition of black culture. They are oral tra-
ditional tales of Africa that have survived and transformed by African Ameri-
can and Caribbean storytelling and cultural practices. When they needed to
write about the literature of their ancestors, West African intellectuals of the
1960s turned to the griot to preserve the age-old traditions of African storytell-
ing. The griot, whose inherited wisdom was acquired through legacy, age, and
experience, was the only person who could keep the African past from falling
into oblivion at a time when modernization was casting its shadows over the
continent. A troubadour par excellence, the griot was an erudite poet whose
knowledge and wisdom came not only from his function of historian and gene-
alogist, but also from his role of diplomat and diviner. He retained sacred
knowledge of the unmatched arts of praise-poetry, story collecting, reciting,
and negotiating.
The griot was traditionally a public servant, counselor, and artist at the service
of the royal authority and the people that it governed. His fate depended on the
survival and prosperity of the king or queen next to whom he would walk, ride,
and run, even during wartime. This unity between the griot and royal personages
was manifested in the continuing relationships between the families of the griots
and royalty. In the empires that used to be in current Mali, Guinea, Senegal, and
36 | African Folklore
the Gambia, ‘‘it was understood that a son would succeed his father as griot to a
particular line of kings.’’ When author Djibril Tamsir Niane went to collect infor-
mation about the epic of Sunjata Keita, Guinean griot Djeli Mamadou Kouyate
told him, ‘‘The hero’s father, Maghan Kon Fatta, the king of Mali, had as his
griot a certain Gnankouman Doua; when the king died and Sunjata succeeded to
the throne, he inherited as griot the son of Doua, Balla Fasseke Kouyate’’ (Niane,
1965, 9). Djeli Mamadou Kouyate rendered the exact words that Maghan Kon
Fatta had spoken to his son Sunjata before he died: ‘‘In Manden each prince has
a griot; the father of Doua [that is, Duga] was my father’s griot; Doua is my
griot; the son of Doua, Balla Fasseke, is to be your griot’’ (cited in Austen, 1999,
34). These statements demonstrate the vital role that the griot plays as a historian
and keeper of oral tradition in Africa. By transmitting unwritten knowledge of
the past, the griot becomes the purveyor of African oral tradition. Djeli Kuyate’s
repetition of the word griot, his emphasis on names, and the distinctive tonality,
cadence, and rhythm in which he narrates Maghan Kon Fatta’s last words to his
son are patterns of the old poetic tradition from which contemporary African oral
strategies derived. The manner in which the griot recites or interprets traditional
epics, such as that of Sunjata, helps us understand the origins and characteristics
of African discursive strategies. In this epic, Sumanguru Kante, king of Sosso,
African Folklore | 37
old Mali, had a conversation with his new griot, Bala Faasege, whom he had
taken from his rival, Sunjata. Sumanguru told Bala:
This epic, which was narrated by Malian griot Demba Kanute in the early
1970s, reflects the importance of orality and understated meaning in traditional
African poetry. As the tone of the conversation between Sumanguru and Bala
Faasege suggests, in traditional African epic poetry, the importance of the word
depends on the way meaning is encoded and expressed in a verbal exchange.
When Sumanguru tells his new griot Bala, ‘‘I am going to take your name from
you,’’ he intends to go further than just removing the civil name and identity that
Bala had in the past. Sumanguru envisions to completely eradicate Bala’s previ-
ous status as griot of the Keita family by transforming him into the bard of the
Kante household. This shift of identity requires substituting Bala’s previous alle-
giance to the ‘‘Dookha’’ for a new commitment to the ‘‘Kuyate.’’ Once complete,
this transformation of Bala’s status, which shifts both his royal and ethnic loy-
alty, is irreversible. The unalterability of Bala’s new social position accounts for
the seriousness and solemnity of Sumanguru’s tone when he says, ‘‘I will cut
your Achilles tendons.’’ What Sumanguru does here is not to perform the act lit-
erally but to signify on his intent to kill the old personality of his new griot in the
same way a knife would have cut through the ‘‘Achilles tendons’’ of a person.
While he has no intent to hurt Bala, Sumanguru wants to sever Bala’s ‘‘tendons’’
metaphorically, signifying his affective conviction that no one other than Bala
deserves to become his griot. The understated meaning of Sumanguru’s words is
a central feature in African oral poetry. Behind the literal aspect of words, the
griots convey subtle and implicit meaning through the use of symbolic images.
Because of the transatlantic slave trade, which resulted in the forced transpor-
tation of millions of Africans to the Western world, African folklore found its
38 | African Folklore
way to the Americas. In order to preserve the memory of their homelands, ances-
tors, and cultures, the enslaved Africans held tightly to the folktales and world-
views that they either brought from Africa or learned from their forebears in the
Americas. These Africans passed down knowledge of the tales from generation
to generation, making it possible for scholars to find their traces in the rich litera-
ture of blacks in the Americas.
The African influence in the folklore of the Americas is visible in the similar
ways in which tales are told on both sides of the Atlantic Ocean. A few examples
are in Zora Neale Hurston’s book of folklore, Mules and Men (1935). Here, Hur-
ston’s storytellers develop rhetorical devices that are traceable to cultures and
places in Africa. Such devices include opening formulas and calls-and-responses.
Examples of opening formula in Mules are the sentences, ‘‘Well, once upon a
time was a good time’’ in ‘‘The Turtle Watch’’ (p. 84) and ‘‘Ah got to say a piece
of litery [literary] fust to git mah wind on’’ in ‘‘How Jack Beat the Devil’’ (p. 47).
These phrases are analogous to the ones used in Wolof and Fulani folktales,
where they serve to arouse the audience members to listen attentively and partici-
pate in the process of the storytelling. The Wolof storyteller begins his or her
narrative in a similar way with the formula ‘‘leb-on’’ (there was a story) to which
the audience responds ‘‘lup-on’’ (it happened here).
Like the African American formula, the Wolof version invites the audience to lis-
ten attentively and participate actively in the process of storytelling by answering to
the teller’s calls. In Talking and Testifying (1977), Geneva Smitherman found in the
African American church a call-and-response exchange in which the preacher tells
the audience, ‘‘Y’all don’t want to hear dat so I’m gone leave it alone,’’ to which the
congregation responds by saying, ‘‘‘Naw, Tell it, Reb! Tell it! Tell it!’’ A similar
verbal exchange occurs in Wolof storytelling. Here, the teller establishes a rapport
of communication by saying, ‘‘Am-on a fi’’ (it happened here), to which the audi-
ence responds by saying, ‘‘da na am’’ (it was so). The sentence ‘‘Naw, Tell it, Reb!
Tell it! Tell it!’’ that Smitherman described as a usual formula in African American
sermon, rap, comedy, and storytelling is visible in James Baldwin’s Go Tell It on
the Mountain (1953), when the congregation in the Temple of the Fire Baptized
responds to Gabriel’s call ‘‘Woe is me!’’ by shouting ‘‘‘Yes! Tell it! Amen! You
preach it, boy.’’ This pattern of call-and-response in the African American sermon
is consistent with the Wolof communicative exchange described earlier.
Moreover, the African influence in the Americas is visible in the trickster fig-
ures of Brer Rabbit and Brer Dog that Hurston depicts in Mules to represent the
unequal power relations between planters and slaves during slavery. One example
is the tale ‘‘What the Rabbit Learned,’’ in which Brer Dog seeks revenge against
Brer Rabbit, who had taken the former’s girlfriend, Miss Saphronie, from him and
cut his tongue during their previous conflict in ‘‘How Brer Dog Lost His Beautiful
Voice.’’ In ‘‘What the Rabbit Learned,’’ Brer Rabbit and Brer Dog were walking
African Folklore | 39
peacefully in the bush, as if no grudge existed between them, when, all of a sud-
den, the Rabbit heard the sound of barking dogs. Noting that Brer Rabbit was
frightened by the sound of the hounds, Brer Dog told the Rabbit, ‘‘Ain’t we done
held a convention and passed a law dogs run no mo’ rabbits? Don’t pay no ‘tention
to every lil’l bit of barkin’ you hear’’ (pp. 146–147). The Rabbit, who knew that
some trick was being played against him, responded, ‘‘Yeah, but all de dogs ain’t
been to no convention, and anyhow some of dese fool dogs ain’t got no better
sense than to run over dat law and break it up.’’ Saying this, Brer Rabbit took off,
remembering the old-time saying ‘‘Run every time de bush shake’’ (p. 147).
The intelligence, charm, wisdom, and verbal dexterity that Brer Rabbit exhib-
its in his capacity to outsmart Brer Dog in the bush signifies on the subversive
strategies that slaves developed to outwit the slave holders and slave catchers
who chased them when they ran away from plantations. The wisdom that makes
Brer Rabbit ‘‘run every time de bush shakes’’ alludes to the intelligence that the
African slaves in America such as Frederick Douglass and Solomon Northup
demonstrated by running away or hiding in secret places whenever they were
chased by cruel slave owners. Such subversive strategies of resistance derive
from the vigilance that African tricksters like Leuk, who is Brer Rabbit’s grand-
father, used to survive oppression in the mythological world of Ndoumbelane. In
Birago Diop’s ‘‘The Tricks of Leuk-the-Hare’’ (1966), Leuk charmed a princess
and escaped her father’s plan to execute him by simply telling the king, ‘‘Bour
[your majesty] . . . you cannot kill the father of your grandchild!’’ (p. 81). The
wisdom and verbal skill that Leuk used to subvert a stratified traditional Wolof
society is the source from which Brer Rabbit and the African slaves in the Amer-
icas drew in order to outsmart their oppressors.
African folklore has a rich history that is traceable from the traditional epic of
Sunjata to the contemporary literature of blacks in the Americas. In both Africa
and the Americas, folklore has served as an important means of entertainment,
education, and cultural survival. The Africans who survived the Middle Passage
have used it to preserve their past and resist domination. In this sense, black writ-
ers of the Americas have inherited the role of preservers of the past that griots
used to play in Africa.
Babacar M’Baye
See Also African American Folklore; Anansi; Ethnic Folklore.
References
Austen, Ralph A. 1999. In Search of Sunjata: The Mande Oral Epic as History, Lit-
erature, and Performance. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Baldwin, James. 1953. Go Tell It on the Mountain. New York: New American
Library.
40 | Aging
Bascom, William R. 1992. African Folktales in the New World. Bloomington: Indi-
ana University Press.
Berry, Jack. 1991. West African Folktales. Evanston, IL: Northwestern University Press.
Cosentino, Donald. 1982. Defiant Maids and Stubborn Farmers: Tradition and Inven-
tion in Mende Story Performance. Cambridge and New York: Cambridge University
Press.
Dadie, Bernard. 1987. The Black Cloth: A Collection of African Folktales. 1955.
Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press.
Diop, Abdoulaye-Bara. 1965. La Soci
et
e Wolof: Tradition et Changement. Paris:
Karthala.
Diop, Birago. 1966. Tales of Amadou Koumba: Birago Diop. 1959. Reprint, Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Frobenius, Leo, and Douglas C. Fox. 1966 (1937). African Genesis. New York: Ben-
jamin Bloom.
Hale, Thomas. 1998. Griots and Griottes: Masters of Words and Music. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Hurston, Zora Neale. 1990 (1935). Mules and Men. New York: Harper & Row.
Niane, Djibril Tamsir. 1965. Sunjata: An Epic of Old Mali. Trans. G. D. Pickett.
London: Longman.
Okpewho, Isidore. 1992. African Oral Literature: Backgrounds, Character, and Con-
tinuity. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Smitherman, Geneva. 1977. Talkin and Testifyin: The Language of Black America.
Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Aging
Folklore relating to material objects, narratives, and beliefs about death. Aging is
the natural process by which living organisms develop biologically and grow
older. This process includes a decline in biological functions and ultimately
death. In human beings, gender is an important variable in the aging process; bio-
logical changes affecting women have profound social, psychological, emo-
tional, medical, and economic consequences. Ageism, whether personal or
institutional, is the stereotyping of and discrimination against individuals on the
basis of age, and specifically old age. Reflecting societal attitudes toward aging,
folkloric images of maturing women range from the nurturing, postmenopausal
wise woman endowed with supernatural powers (Germany’s Mother Holle and
the Oracle in The Matrix) to the ugly, hungry hag (Russia’s Baba Yaga and Gre-
tel’s witch) whose disposition evokes terror.
In the United States and Canada and throughout most of the industrialized
world, an unprecedented number of individuals are living well into old age. In
1900 in the United States, life expectancy for men was 48.3 years and for women
Aging | 41
51.1 years; the number of individuals who survived to old age was relatively
small. However, because of medical innovations and advances in public health
education, the number of older people in the U.S. population has tripled since the
turn of the century.
In The Coming of Age (1972), French philosopher Simone de Beauvoir exam-
ines the universally grim plight of older people throughout time. She describes
how they suffer from lack of respect from younger people, loss in productivity,
and other negative experiences; she provides poignant evidence that most cultures
deny the intrinsic worth of older people despite their repertoires of fables that exalt
the elderly. It is a modern phenomenon that women live longer than men by
approximately seven years. As a result, women outnumber men in the general
population, especially at the older end of the age spectrum. Judith Worell charac-
terizes the increasingly long lives of women compared with men in the second half
of the twentieth century as a ‘‘historic feminization of the world’’ (2001, 96).
Because of social double standards regarding gender and aging, many women
grow old with much greater apprehension than do men. The dread of growing
older—and so purportedly less sexually attractive—in patriarchal societies is a
long-held attitude illustrated by the saying, ‘‘Old age is woman’s hell,’’ attributed
to Ninon de Lenclos, a seventeenth-century French writer and courtesan. Whereas
a man’s graying hair may mark him as ‘‘distinguished’’ by age, a same-aged
woman suffers social denigration for having lost her youthful physical appearance.
Consider the social significance of feminine beauty and youth reflected in the
folktales collected by Wilhelm and Jacob Grimm in the nineteenth century. In
many of the original 168 tales, youthful beauty is not only emphasized as the
ideal for women, it is associated with goodness, wealth, and social privilege. In
contrast, aged women are generally characterized as mean and ugly villains.
Although most of these tales are no longer widely recognized by North American
audiences, those that have survived in the contemporary imagination—and mar-
ketplace—include those in which beautiful young women (such as Cinderella,
Snow White, and Sleeping Beauty) in conflict with infamous older women domi-
nate the plot.
The youthful feminine ideal has been perpetuated during the past 150 years
through adaptations and retellings of folktales produced by the children’s book
and film industries, most notably by the Walt Disney Company’s films and related
product merchandising. Compare, for example, the benevolent Sea Witch of Hans
Christian Andersen’s tale, ‘‘The Little Mermaid,’’ with Ursula, the terrifying vi-
rago of the Disney film of the same name. It has long been noted there are few
roles for women film actors over forty. When images of women of advanced years
do appear in film, popular culture, and narrative folklore, they are often poor and
ill or overly ambitious, menacing, or otherwise distasteful—self-absorbed wealthy
matrons, witches with gnarled arthritic hands, impoverished peasant ladies
42 | Aging
laboring in the fields, black-draped widows in mourning, and old hags devouring
children for food.
The late twentieth-century boom in the cosmetic industry and an increasing
demand for cosmetic plastic surgeries attest to the struggle that some women,
especially those from the middle and upper classes, face with self-esteem as they
age. Their desire for continued social acceptance, fear of losing the opportunity
for sexual intimacy, and anxiety about the potential onset of debilitating medical
conditions are among the reasons that they view aging as a psychological chal-
lenge. While rural Mexicans and Canadians are more likely to exhibit the tradi-
tional respect accorded to the aged than are Americans reared on unrelentingly
promoted images of ‘‘Generation X,’’ old women are increasingly invisible in
these societies as well, and their life experiences dismissed as irrelevant.
While women’s medical problems that accompany aging are similar to those
of aging men, among whom heart disease and cancer are leading causes of death,
older women suffer more frequently than men from gender-linked medical con-
ditions such as osteoporosis, urinary incontinence, insomnia, and depression.
And unlike those of previous generations, today’s geriatric illnesses are chronic
rather short term. Chronic illnesses have economic consequences that affect
women disproportionately, including the likelihood that middle-aged women will
provide their unpaid eldercare. Coupled with their own weakening and, in some
cases, crippling medical conditions, elderly women commonly find their finan-
cial security at risk. In the United States, ‘‘women over the age of sixty-five are
twice as poor as men in the same age group’’ (Eisler). And older (unmarried) les-
bians, particularly if African American, face the distinct possibility of homeless-
ness upon the death of a property-owning partner (Shavers).
Ironically, older women were historically the first medical practitioners; as
such, they enjoyed social reverence. As healers, their curative knowledge and
power aligned them with the wisdom of ancient goddesses. Today, their wisdom
is often scorned as ‘‘old wives’ tales.’’ Many historians and anthropologists
locate the Spanish Inquisition in Europe as the beginning of the demise of the
‘‘wise old women’’ archetype. Threatened by the status of women healers, Catho-
lic Church authorities declared them agents of the Devil and effectively changed
public opinion about them through witch hunts. In addition, traditional myths of
Pagan origin were revised to further stigmatize the image of the once-powerful
older woman.
To counter some of the stereotypes about women and aging, a proliferation of
publications began appearing in the last decades of the twentieth century, includ-
ing Women of a Certain Age by Lilia Rubin (1979); In Full Flower: Aging
Women, Power and Sexuality (1993) by Lois W. Banner; The Fountain of Age
(1993) by Betty Friedan; and The New Ourselves, Growing Older: Women Aging
with Knowledge and Power (1987; 1994) by Paula Doress-Worters. In 1989, feminist
Aging | 43
studies reached a significant milestone with the first issue of the Journal of
Women and Aging, a scholarly venue for interdisciplinary research.
Public policy in the United States is increasingly reflecting a demographic shift
in favor of aging women. While reproductive choice, inequality in the workforce,
and child care were the prominent social issues in the later part of the twentieth
century, the concerns of older women are becoming more evident in the new mil-
lennium. These include displaced homemakers, widowhood, elder caregiving,
social isolation and poverty, and gender-related medical research and health care.
Older women’s activism has spawned several influential advocacy organizations.
Two of them, the Gray Panthers and the Red Hat Society, have produced positive
new icons to celebrate the aging process; and there has been a renewed interest
among scholars about colonial midwives, Mexican curanderas (folk healers), Hopi/
Navajo Spider Woman stories, to name a few areas of research. For example, today
we know that pre-Columbian Aztec elder women participated in the ritual ingestion
of pulque, a liquid fermented from the maguey plant, along with male priests.
Recognition of the inestimable value of older women is, however, emerging in
literature. Ultima, the curandera of Rudolfo Anaya’s Bless Me, Ultima, the most
widely read novel by a Mexican American author, is a prime example. Sharply
diverging from typical characterizations of elderly women, Ultima represents
goodness and wisdom. She also serves as tradition bearer and a model for keep-
ing cultural traditions alive.
Gilda Baeza Ortego
See Also Medicine, Folk; Women’s Folklore.
References
Anaya, Rudolfo. 1999. Bless Me, Ultima. New York: Warner Books.
Baker-Sperry, Lori, and Liz Grauerholz. 2003. The Pervasiveness and Persistence
of the Feminine Beauty Ideal in Children’s Fairy Tales. Gender and Society 17(5):
711 726.
Banner, Lois W. 1993. In Full Flower: Aging Women, Power and Sexuality: A His-
tory. New York: Vintage.
Beers, Mark H., ed. 2004. The Merck Manual of Health and Aging. Whitehouse Sta-
tion, NJ: Merck & Co., Inc.
De Beauvoir, Simone. 1972. The Coming of Age. New York: G. P. Putman’s Sons.
Doress-Worters, Paula. 1994. The New Ourselves, Growing Older: Women Aging
with Knowledge and Power. New York: Simon & Schuster.
Eisler, Riane. 2007. The Feminine Face of Poverty. http://www.alternet.org/rights/
50727 (accessed June 22, 2007).
Friedan, Betty. 1993. The Fountain of Age. New York: Simon and Schuster.
Perrone, Bobette, H. Henrietta Stockel, and Victoria Krueger. 1989. Medicine
Women, Curanderas, and Women Doctors. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.
44 | Altar, Home
Shavers, Regina, as told to Daisey Hernandez. 2005. Gay, Gray and Black. Color-
lines (Fall): 23 24.
Weigle, Marta. 1982. Spiders and Spinsters: Women and Mythology. Albuquerque:
University of New Mexico.
Worrell, Judith, ed. 2001. Encyclopedia of Women and Gender: Sex Similarities and
Differences and the Impact of Society on Gender. San Diego, CA: Academic Press.
Altar, Home
Mothers often donate images to their newly married daughters’ altars, or leave al-
tar objects and images to them as a legacy after death. Through this image, a
woman inherits a relationship with a particular deity who, like a revered family
member, is known, honored, and relied upon for help.
The history of women’s creation and use of domestic altars continues from an-
cient times to the present. In the West, the earliest home altars known to have
been created by women date from the Neolithic period (4000–6000 BCE) in Old
Europe and Anatolia (now Turkey). Reserved primarily as sites for presenting
offerings or sacrifices to fecund, earth-based goddesses and their consort gods,
ancient altars presumably were used to enhance fertility, to invite protection, and
to memorialize ancestors.
These same functions prevail today; women still pray at their home altars for a
good birth, for security of home and family, and to honor the dead. In its long
history—evident in the archaeological and historical record for Mycenaean,
Greek, Roman, Pagan, and early Christian cultures—the domestic altar in West-
ern tradition has changed little in basic construction. To view a contemporary
Catholic Mexican American woman’s home altar side by side with a Transylva-
nian house cult table from the fifth millennium BCE or to see an altar dedicated to
the goddess by a feminist in 1985 next to an altar dedicated to the goddess in
Mycenae 4,000 years earlier, immediately confirms their visual similarity.
On a simple table or other platform surface, votive statues or pictures of local
deities are surrounded by instruments for communicating with them: lamps, can-
dles, incense burners, amulets, and offerings such as shells and flowers. Contem-
porary altars also feature printed materials such as prayer books and secular
items such as family photographs and personal mementos, but the visual aes-
thetic of the altar is consistent, and its communicative purpose has remained vir-
tually unchanged for millennia.
Though bound by certain conventions, the tradition still invites variation; no
altar looks exactly the same, nor is it used in exactly the same way. Certain items
(the inherited central image, for example) may remain for a lifetime, but home
altars are not fixed sites; they change as the women who make them change. Al-
tar makers affirm the particularity of the tradition to themselves as individuals
and as women; for them, personal devotion trumps institutional dogma. At their
altars, women remake and reinvent the usefulness of cultural symbols, both sa-
cred and secular, according to their own histories, purposes, needs, desires, and
beliefs. Altar makers take the received aspects of the tradition and wed them to a
creative—and often highly imaginative—impulse. For example, amid typical
saint statues and votive candles arranged on a shelf or dresser, folk Catholic
home altars may be covered with family photos, display pictures of local political
figures, feature unusual personal symbols such as a child’s stuffed animal, or
make use of homemade decorative effects such as hand-embroidered altar cloths
46 | Altar, Home
Family members of Kim Sun-il, who was kidnapped in Iraq, mourn beside their family altar
in Busan, South Korea in 2004. (AP/Wide World Photos)
or glittered paper plates. It is not unusual to find modern altar makers using their
home desks and computers as the base around which their altars are composed.
The visual aesthetic of altars is defined by a propensity for layering and accu-
mulation. Objects and symbols are integrated into a coherent visual field that
marks their interdependence and connection to each other. Altars exemplify the
process that feminist artist Miriam Schapiro aptly named femmage (derived from
‘‘collage’’ and ‘‘assemblage’’) referring to women’s artistic process of collecting
and creatively joining seemingly disparate elements into a functional whole
(Meyer and Schapiro, 66–69).
All the objects on the altar are signs of relationship; each one tells a story of
attachment to others, whether they are sacred, social, or nature-based relations.
An image of the Virgin Mary testifies to the altar maker’s ongoing relationship
with her; a son’s photo bespeaks his mother’s care; a small heap of stones signi-
fies a love of the earth.
The altar specifies a context for building and sustaining relationships by serv-
ing as a site to seek divine help in initiating, repairing, restoring, remembering,
and protecting the vitality of human social life. Appeals made there constitute a
catalog of situations requiring care and help such as healing the sick, seeking a
blessed union in love or marriage, or finding a new home. The intimacy and fa-
miliarity of the altar provides an ideal setting for meditation, prayer, and petition.
Amerasians: Folklores of Mixed Heritage, Mixed Race Asian Americans | 47
The home altar’s longevity is no doubt related to the singular privacy it affords
in giving women a place to speak to the divine without restraint. There, a woman
meets her deities and speaks to them with assurance in their mutual ability to cre-
ate change and to heal. Women ascribe great efficacy to the personal prayers and
petitions for help made at their altars. What women ask for most—and receive—
at their altars is healing. Healing of body, mind, and spirit is the active result of
the good relationships between women and their divine allies promoted at the al-
tar site. Asking and receiving fashion a bond of trust, and this bond fortifies a
fundamental labor performed at the altar: the movement from problem to solu-
tion in the work of living. As Mexican American altar maker Margarita Guerrero
affirms, ‘‘Here with my saints and the Virgin I have accomplished many things. I
have prayed and they answer me. And always I have made things better for
myself and others’’ (Turner, 47).
Kay Turner
See Also African Folklore; African American Folklore; Art, Folk; Latino Folklore; Mate-
rial Culture; Women’s Folklore.
References
Gargaetas, Patricia. 1995. Altared States: Lesbian Altarmaking and the Transforma-
tion of Self. Women and Therapy 16(2-3): 95 105.
Gimbutas, Marija. 1982. The Goddesses and Gods of Old Europe. Berkeley: Univer-
sity of California Press.
Meyer, Melissa, and Miriam Schapiro. 1978. Waste Not/Want Not: Femmage. Heresies
4: 66 69.
Raven, Arlene. 1983. The Art of the Altar. Lady-Unique-Inclination-of-the Night,
Cycle 6. Special Issue on Women’s Home Altars, ed. Kay Turner. Austin, TX: Sowing
Circle Press, 29 41.
Turner, Kay. 1999. Beautiful Necessity: The Art and Meaning of Women’s Altars.
New York and London: Thames & Hudson.
Amerasians are war babies, or so the folklore goes. The myth is that they con-
tinue to be children of war, at war with themselves, infantilized by their public
image as the children of U.S. soldiers and passive and sexualized Asian and Pa-
cific Islander women. The other myth is that the Amerasians are a population of
the past; now that U.S. wars in Asia are over, why should there continue to be
‘‘war babies’’? This folklore ignores contemporary wars in West Asia (Afghani-
stan and Iraq) as well as U.S. military bases in those regions.
48 | Amerasians: Folklores of Mixed Heritage, Mixed Race Asian Americans
References
Chuong, Chung Hoang, and Le Van. 1994. The Amerasians from Vietnam: A California
Study. Folsom, CA: Southeast Asia Community Resource Center.
Dolgin, Gail, and Vicente Franco. 2002. Daughter from Danang. Video.
Mankelar, Purnima. 2002. ‘‘India Shopping’’: Indian Grocery Stores and Transna-
tional Configurations of Belonging. Ethnos 67(1): 75 97.
McKelvey, Robert. 2000. The Dust of Life: America’s Children Abandoned in Viet-
nam. Seattle: University of Washington Press.
Murphy-Shigematsu, Stephen L. H. 1999. The Voices of Amerasians: Ethnicity, Identity,
and Empowerment in Interracial Japanese Americans. Published by Dissertation.com.
Yarborough, Trin. 2005. Surviving Twice: Amerasian Children of the Vietnam War.
Dulles, VA: Potomac Books, Inc.
Yoshimura, Ayako. 2009. Oriental Shop: An Ethnography of Material Communica-
tion Inside an Asian Grocery Store in Madison, Wisconsin. MA Thesis, Memorial Uni-
versity of Newfoundland.
American Indian Folklore Scholarship | 51
scholars with an equally ambitious if secular zeal not to save souls but to save
whole cultures. U.S. policy toward American Indians in the nineteenth century
was a mix of outright antagonism and misguided charity, both of which resulted
in physical and cultural genocide. The fear in the scholarly community was that
American Indian culture would soon be wiped out, whether by having no one left
to continue it, or by assimilating the remaining American Indians into the culture
of the colonial powers. This fear spurred many anthropologists into the field to
record cultural practices before they disappeared forever.
At the vanguard of this charge were two men: John Wesley Powell, Director
of the Bureau of American Ethnology; and Franz Boas, anthropologist, ethnogra-
pher, and close ally of the American Folklore Society. Their students would
dominate anthropological and folklore research in American Indian studies for
the next fifty years, including Frank Cushing, James Mooney, Washington Mat-
thews, and Alice Fletcher (Powell), and Ruth Benedict, Ruth Bunzel, Melville
Jacobs, Alfred L. Kroeber, Robert H. Lowie, Elsie Clews Parsons, Paul Radin,
Gladys Reichard, Frank Speck, and John Swanton (Boas).
From the perspective of folklore research, Franz Boas has had the greatest
enduring impact. Boas refuted the theory of cultural evolution that suggested cul-
tures evolved in a linear path, pioneered the ethnographic method favored by many
folklorists today, and attempted close translation of oral traditions, myths in partic-
ular. Boas and his focus on American Indian culture and folklore also heavily
shaped the formative years of the American Folklore Society. His close alliance
with William Wells Newell, founder of the Journal of American Folklore, ensured
that American Indian folklore would be at the center of the nascent field of folk-
lore, a topic that appears not only in the charter for the publication, but also in ev-
ery issue of the journal for the first twenty-four issues, in every one of the first
thirty-nine volumes, and regularly afterwards for decades to come.
Due to the historical origins of the study of American Indian folklore, oral tradi-
tions generally, and myth specifically, have received the greatest amount of atten-
tion. At its outset, the American Folklore Society was divided into two groups: the
literary folklorists and the anthropological folklorists, a division that continues to
describe the departmental homes for academic folklorists today. The division ini-
tially seems paradoxical. Housed almost exclusively in English departments, the
literary folklorists had a broad sense of the lore but a restricted sense of the folk.
Literary folklorists were willing to accommodate both oral and customary lore,
but only for the Europeans and European immigrants. For anthropologists, how-
ever, where culture comprised their entire enterprise, only oral traditions were
given over to folklore. The ‘‘folk,’’ on the other hand, included Euro-Americans,
African Americans, and Native Americans. The result was that study of American
Indians was tackled almost exclusively by the anthropological folklorists and
therefore focused specifically on oral narrative.
American Indian Folklore Scholarship | 53
The first person to devote himself to the thorough collection of a tribe’s oral
traditions was Henry Rowe Schoolcraft, labeled by some as the father of Ameri-
can folklore. Schoolcraft was the first U.S. Indian agent for the Ojibwa and mar-
ried Jane Johnston, a member of the Ojibwa who collaborated with him on his
work documenting the oral traditions of her tribe. Although Schoolcraft followed
the trends of his day by editing his collections with the stylistic flourishes of his
fellow Victorian writers, his work was a landmark effort that spurred other writ-
ers, most notably Henry Wadsworth Longfellow, to pay attention to American
Indian narrative as literature.
Schoolcraft, an avid but amateur collector, was followed by Franz Boas and
his students who took a far more systematic, scientific approach to the collection
and analysis of folklore. Ruth Bunzel’s work among the Zuni highlights this shift
with her careful interlineal translations that attempt to preserve the structure and
aesthetics of the myths she recorded (1933). Ruth Benedict’s study of Zuni narra-
tive remains a classic work today, examining American Indian narratives for
what they reveal not only about Zuni culture, but also about narrative form, func-
tion, and aesthetics (1935).
The attempts by Boas and his students to understand oral narrative structurally
and thematically as well as culturally were adopted by folklorists in English
departments as well, most notably by Stith Thompson, whose interest in narrative
at the level of the tale type and motif guided his compilation of a century of
North American Indian storytelling (1929). Thompson’s book is organized by
broad thematic categories, gathering tribes from across the continent into dia-
logue with one another, favoring recurring themes over cultural distinctions. The
bulk of the collections of American Indian narrative, however, have favored the
54 | American Indian Folklore Scholarship
origin stories provide explanations for important aspects of tribal life, including the
placement of the sun, moon, and stars, the origin of corn, social taboos, and mar-
riage rules. Myths and legends typically blur in American Indian narrative, where
time is not marked clearly as mythical or historical. Migration stories, and encoun-
ters with supernatural beings, for example, are referred to both as myth and legend
in folklore scholarship, highlighting the lack of utility of these etic categories. This
blurring has also impacted how scholars have approached folklore as evidence of
cultural and historical life. Of much greater concern outside folklore studies than
within it has been the extent to which oral traditions can inform our understanding
of historical events and beliefs. American Indian writers and activists such as Vine
Deloria Jr. have argued that creation myths should be held with the same regard as
archaeological evidence for determining historical migrations, land claims, and
repatriation claims (1997). Anthropologist Ronald J. Mason takes the opposite
point of view, valuing native oral traditions within their cultural contexts, but not
as part of a valid historiography. Folklorists have tended to avoid such arguments
by focusing on the analysis of emic systems of belief and the assumption that folk-
lore is an intensely powerful tool for understanding the present.
Common tale types and themes in American Indian narrative in addition to crea-
tion myths include tales of culture heroes, spiritual journeys, animals, and trick-
sters. Trickster in particular has received a lion’s share of attention. A figure cast
both as a culture hero and as insatiable and self-serving, both tricked and trickster,
trickster and his narrative cycles are common throughout North America, with dif-
ferent animals serving in the role according to region—raven in the Northwest,
coyote in the Southwest and Plains, and rabbit in the Southeast. Autobiographies
and life histories have also been widely recorded and analyzed, often by anthropol-
ogists who felt that a culture could not be truly understood unless captured holisti-
cally and in the personal particulars of a single life lived. With the recognition of
personal experience narratives as a viable and valid category of folk narrative, in
the 1980s, narratives that captured the contemporary individual experience began
to be included in general surveys and case studies of American Indian narrative.
While oral narrative has continued to dominate the study of American Indian
folklore, the full range of lenses and theories applied in folklore scholarship have
also been applied to the breadth of expressive genres of American Indian folk-
lore. Whether as isolated ‘‘texts’’ embedded within larger performance contexts,
or approached on the macro level as coherent, complex events such as festivals
and rituals, oral, aural, visual, material, kinesthetic, and customary lore among
the American Indian tribes of North America has been surveyed broadly and
deeply, though not always evenly. Some tribes have received the bulk of schol-
arly attention—the Navajo, Apache, Zuni, Sioux, and Anishinabe (also known as
the Chippewa and Ojibwa)—while others have been virtually ignored in the folk-
lore scholarship, particularly tribes that have not received federal recognition.
56 | American Indian Folklore Scholarship
Similarly, some genres and themes have garnered more attention than others.
In the study of material culture, a handful of artistic forms have emerged as domi-
nant in one region or another, garnering the bulk of the scholarly attention. While
pottery was made across the continent, it has remained particularly vital in the
Southwest, where pueblo potters in particular have thrived. Folklorists have been
especially effective at exploring individual artistry among these pueblo potters,
making names such as Helen Cordero, Lucy Lewis, Lillian Salvador, and Wanda
Aragon widely recognizable in folklore, art history, and art collector circles alike
(see Babcock, Monthan, and Monthan 1992). Weaving has also been studied in
the Southwest, particularly among the Navajo; wood carving, particularly masks
but also totem poles, in the Northwest; beadwork in the Plains, upper Midwest,
and Southwest, and basket weaving in the Southwest and Southeast.
Folklorists and ethnomusicologists have also conducted significant work in the
study of music and dance, particularly as embedded in specific social and religious
contexts. The systematic study of American Indian music began approximately
forty years after the more general study of American Indian culture. Many of the
early collectors were focused on the analysis of American Indian music as a means
to understand ‘‘primitive music’’ and indigenous styles. In the last few decades of
the nineteenth century, European and European-American composers seized upon
these collections as inspiration for their own compositions, an impulse that
emerged at the same time as the Arts and Crafts movement that drew similar inspi-
ration from ‘‘the folk’’ for architecture, domestic design, and decorative arts. Also
at the turn of the century, comparative musicologists (later ethnomusicologists)
had begun to study American Indian music both as an artistic form worthy of
broad audience, as well as part of the ceremonial lives of American Indians. Alice
Cunningham Fletcher working with the Omaha and Pawnee and Jesse Walter Few-
kes with the Passamaquoddy helped blaze the trail, followed by Boas’s student
George Herzog who studied American Indian music across the United States, and
Frances Densmore who became one of the most prolific collectors and scholars of
American Indian music, publishing over a hundred books and articles on the topic.
Many of these studies were comparative. Herzog, for example, not only com-
pared music from one tribe to another, but also ambitiously attempted to isolate
key stylistic markers in Ghost Dance songs throughout the Great Basin (1935).
The study of American Indian music continues to be informed both by compara-
tive studies as well as tribally focused case studies that analyze music traditions
within their specific social and cultural contexts, whether at the level of the tribe,
or of the particular event or phenomenon. Bruno Nettl has published treatises on
‘‘primitive’’ music generally (1956), as well as on Blackfoot music more specifi-
cally (1989). James H. Howard has studied tribal music and dance forms among
the Oklahoma and Mississippi Choctaw (with Victoria Lindsay Levine, 1990), as
well as pan-Indian forms throughout Oklahoma (1983). William K. Powers has
American Indian Folklore Scholarship | 57
worked most closely with the Oglala Sioux, but has also tackled the pan-Indian
phenomenon of the powwow (1990). In fact, the growth of intertribal powwows
has engendered wide discussion of American Indian music and dance, particu-
larly within the context of cultural borrowing and the negotiation of identities,
both tribal and ethnic.
The construction of various collective identities—ethnic, cultural, regional, gen-
dered, occupational, religious, political, and national—through expressive culture
is a common focus in folklore studies. American Indian folklore has been most of-
ten addressed as part of ethnic folklore. American Indians are grouped with immi-
grant populations who have maintained a distinct ethnic identity within a separate
nation’s borders. One major result of this classification has been a focus on how
identity, and specifically ethnic identity, is constructed through folklore. Tribally
focused studies have facilitated this approach, resulting in the analysis of tribal
lore that implicitly argues for a distinct tribal identity. To perform a particular rit-
ual, narrate a particular story, hunt with a particular weapon, or shape a particular
type of pot has been studied as an expression of one’s group identity. Such studies
can serve as powerful statements about distinct tribal identity, particularly in con-
trast to pan-Indianism. Pan-Indianism describes patterns shared broadly across
tribes to articulate a common American Indian ethnicity and shared cultural traits,
many of which are distinct from any one tribe, though often owing their origins to
one or another. The very concept of pan-Indianism has been highly politicized. At
one end of the spectrum, the term has been used as a synonym with the loss of
tribal culture, and at the other end, descriptive of collective movements that unite
American Indians as a coherent ethnic group. The concept has received particular
attention in studies of American Indian music and dance, not least of which is
because of the explosive growth of powwows across the continent.
Tribal, intertribal, and pan-Indian identities are often explored as part of more
general processes of cultural borrowing. As the evolutionary models of culture of
the early nineteenth century disappeared, scholars shifted away from analysis that
presupposed authentic folklore as distinct from deteriorated forms corrupted by
outside influences, particular European, particularly biblical. Today, folklorists
examine expressive culture as part of a dynamic system of cultural exchange.
Tom Mould
See Also American Indian Tales; Ethnic Folklore.
References
Babcock, Barbara A., Guy Monthan, and Doris Monthan. 1992. The Pueblo Story-
teller. Tucson, AZ: University of Arizona Press.
Benedict, Ruth. 1935. Zuni Mythology. New York: Columbia University Press.
Bunzel, Ruth Leah. 1933. Zuni Texts. Vol. 15, Publications of the American Ethno-
logical Society. New York: G. E. Steckert & Co.
58 | American Indian Tales
Deloria, Vine, Jr. 1997. Red Earth, White Lies: Native Americans and the Myth of
Scientific Fact. Golden, CO: Fulcrum Publishing.
Herzog, George. 1935. Plains Ghost Dance and Great Basin Music. American
Anthropologist 37(3): 403 19.
Howard, James H. 1983. Pan-Indianism in Native American Music and Dance. Eth-
nomusicology 27(1): 71 82.
Howard, James H., and Victoria Lindsay Levine. 1990. Choctaw Music and Dance.
Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.
Hymes, Dell H. 1981. ‘‘In Vain I Tried to Tell You’’: Essays in Native American Eth-
nopoetics. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Nettl, Bruno. 1956. Music in Primitive Culture. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Nettl, Bruno. 1989. Blackfoot Musical Thought: Comparative Perspectives. Kent,
OH: Kent State University Press.
Pane, Fray Ramon. 1999 [1498]. An Account of the Antiquities of the Indians. Dur-
ham, NC: Duke University Press.
Powers, William K. 1990. War Dance: Plains Indian Musical Performance. Tucson,
AZ: University of Arizona Press.
Swann, Brian. 1992. On the Translation of Native American Literatures. Washing-
ton, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Swann, Brian, and Arnold Krupat. 1987. Recovering the Word: Essays on Native
American Literature. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1999. Finding the Center: The Art of the Zuni Storyteller. Lincoln,
NE: University of Nebraska Press.
Genres
Nevertheless, generic distinctions among Native American narrative traditions gen-
erally reflect the same differentiating criteria that William Bascom identified in his
international survey of prose folk narratives. Though the differences may not be as
definite as they are in the conventional European model of myth, legend, and folk-
tale, story categories usually can be defined in varying permutations of the contrasts
between true and fictional, sacred and nonsacred, and whether they are set in the
remote past or in the recent past. In some communities, these may represent continua
more than oppositions, and some story types may straddle what seem to be contrast-
ing features from a Western perspective. Furthermore, some traditions ignore one or
more of the continua when defining narrative genres. Among the Arikara, a group
whose traditional homeland was the Northern Plains, for example, two fundamental
categories of story have existed: ‘‘true stories’’ and ‘‘tales’’ (now called ‘‘fairy tales’’
by contemporary Arikara). The indigenous term for the latter category is
naa’iikaWI s. No indigenous term exists for true stories, so unless a narrative is
assigned to a generic category, it is assumed to be true. The true (unmarked) story
category includes sacred narratives analogous to myths in the Western sense (which
deal with the genesis of sacred medicine bundles and recount events that occurred
before the earth assumed its present form and before human institutions developed)
as well as ‘‘historical legends,’’ many etiological, which tell of dreams and supernat-
ural encounters. Nonsacred true stories may deal with exploits during warfare, recent
historical events, or personal experiences. Naa’iik aWI s include stories about the
Coyote trickster, other animal tales, and children’s stories. However, these tales often
have the same characters as the true stories, so the basis of distinction may be nebu-
lous. Moreover, different tellers of the same story may disagree on its genre identity.
Currently, the Choctaw, traditional inhabitants of the Southeast—some of
whom live in their ancestral homeland in Mississippi and others of whom live in
Oklahoma—use only one native-language term for narrative. Shukha anumpa lit-
erally means ‘‘hog talk’’ (perhaps ‘‘hogwash’’ would be an idiomatic English
equivalent) and refers to jokes, tall tales, and animal stories. Choctaws also recog-
nize another genre of stories, for which they use the English phrase ‘‘talk of the
elders’’: creation stories and myths, historical legends, supernatural legends, and
prophecy. They also make a temporal distinction between stories that have been
passed along from earlier generations of tellers and narratives that describe events
that have occurred recently. The latter kind of stories may also be categorized
according to their truth value. Among the Dene Nhaa, who live in the Canadian
Subarctic, tonhat’onh wodih e encompasses all traditional stories (or ‘‘stories of
long ago’’). Subclasses of narrative include wodih (primarily stories about culture
heroes and animal people, though also used for accounts of recent events, hunting
stories, moral lectures, and prophecies), n oghe wodih e (stories about the Wolver-
ine trickster), and Mbetsun Yend ehsh
ehi wodih e (stories about ‘‘The Boy Raised
60 | American Indian Tales
Raven by John Frazer Mills illustrated in ‘‘The Wild Woman of the Woods’’ in Once upon a
Totem by Christie Harris. (Library of Congress)
Plains and Nanabozho among the Ojibwe, traditional inhabitants of the Great
Lakes area, and among other speakers of Algonquian languages. Frequently,
trickster stories from various Indian traditions end with etiological tags, which
purport to explain the origins of some aspect of culture or nature. Often, though,
these tags serve more to ground the stories in an observable reality than to offer
definitive explanations about origins. The indigenous stories with the most simi-
larity to European fairy tales are those that depict the adventures of an unprepos-
sessing central character, often an orphan who lives on the margins of a
community, sometimes with a grandparent. Through his or her personal efforts
and talents, the assistance of spiritual beings or forces, or luck, the protagonist
attains power, prestige, and occasionally material wealth. Like trickster stories,
these narratives often have didactic purposes and, particularly when they are set
in the mythic past, may be regarded as having some truth.
Despite the inappropriateness of doing so, many early collectors and commenta-
tors on American Indian narrative traditions compared them to European fairy ta-
les. One of these collectors was Henry Rowe Schoolcraft, whose Algic Researches
(1839) was the first important collection of Native American oral literature. Some
collectors documented fairy tales that had apparently entered various Native
American narrative repertoires from European sources. For example, Stith Thomp-
son’s anthology Tales of the North American Indians (1929) concludes with a sec-
tion entitled ‘‘Tales Borrowed from Europeans.’’ Included are versions of ‘‘The
Seven-Headed Dragon’’ from an Ojibwe source, an Assiniboine version of ‘‘John
the Bear,’’ a Zuni retelling of ‘‘Cinderella,’’ and a text of the ‘‘The Clever Num-
skull’’ from the Micmac. Linguist Anthony Mattina translated and published a
tape-recorded performance of ‘‘The Golden Woman’’ (1985), a European fairy tale
from the repertoire of a Colville storyteller.
Performance Styles
The generic differences and similarities that have manifested themselves in
American Indian storytelling are paralleled by differences and similarities associ-
ated with narrative performance. In some societies, performance of all narrative
genres might be the province of anyone with no particular restrictions on where
or when stories might be told. In other communities, though, certain individuals,
often cultural elders, might emerge as storytelling specialists, and some perform-
ers might have more or less exclusive rights, based perhaps on lineage or clan
membership, to particular stories. For example, Edward W. Gifford, an anthro-
pologist, reported that among the Kamia, a California group, what he called
‘‘myths’’ were told on winter nights only by men, who adopted a particular story-
telling stance while performing. Storytellers would stand with hands at their
sides and sway their bodies slowly from side to side as they narrated. William
Jones noted that among the Meskwaki (a Midwestern group formerly known as
62 | American Indian Tales
the Sauk and Fox), storytellers would sit in a circle and take turns delivering their
tales in a pace so rapid and elliptical that outsiders would be unable to follow the
thread of narration. The literary style of the Maidu of California has been marked
by repetition of words, parallelism, and alternation of prose and poetry. The most
successful Clackamas storytellers reminded anthropologist Melville Jacobs of
Western actors giving solo readings of plays. Paralinguistic manipulations char-
acterized the performance styles of many Native American narrative traditions.
Raconteurs might, for example, adopt different vocal timbres to represent dia-
logue spoken by a tale’s characters. The character Skunk in stories of the Alsea,
another California group, would speak in a whining tone. Gestures also played
an important role in the delivery of many tales. Some traditions also placed
restrictions on when storytelling might occur. Some genres, for instance, were
intended exclusively for winter performance, and a narrator who performed a tale
in one of these genres in the inappropriate season might face supernatural retri-
bution for doing so. In fact, some societies believed that telling stories might
invoke the presence of the creatures whose deeds the tales related. Telling the
stories in winter, when beings such as snakes and bears were in hibernation,
could prevent that from happening.
Hiawatha (Haiohwatha)
Probably legendary Onondaga (Iroquois) chief of the late sixteenth century, cele-
brated as shaman and culture hero for uniting into one political unit the usually
warring Algonquin, Oneida, Mohawk, Cayuga, and Iroquois peoples. Henry Wads-
worth Longfellow, inspired by Algonquin rather than Iroquois traditions, used the
meter of the Finnish folk epic The Kalevala in his 1855 verse treatment of Hiawa-
tha’s story, The Song of Hiawatha (1855), bringing this Native American hero to the
attention of a broader audience. There is a considerable body of indigenous legen-
dry concerning Hiawatha and his political activities. One of these legends involves
his attempts to persuade the magician and tyrant of the Onondaga tribe, Atatarho,
to join the League of the Iroquois.
Atatarho is a ruthless and deadly enemy of the league who manages to wreck its
attempts to come together. Eventually, a meeting of all the chiefs is called near the
lodge of the great chief, Hiawatha. All the people attend, but Atatarho, who has al-
ready caused the deaths of Hiawatha’s wife and two of his three daughters, uses his
evil magic to have the people trample the only surviving daughter to death. Grief
stricken, Hiawatha wanders into the wilderness, coming eventually to a lake that he
causes the ducks to drain. In the bed of the lake, he finds many colored shells,
which he strings in patterns and calls wampum. He travels on until he comes to the
cabin of Dekanawida, another Iroquois hero, who offers him hospitality. Hiawatha
tells his host his tale of woe and of the madness of Atatarho, and Dekanawida calls
the chiefs together and tells them the situation. The chiefs decide to go to Atatar-
ho’s home with wampum to heal his sickness. Hiawatha shows them his colored
wampum, which they immediately adopt, as it is more beautiful and powerful than
the common shells they have been using. They decide that the wampum will always
be used in their councils and that it will endure for all time.
Two spies are then sent to Atatarho’s place. These men transform into crows and
fly over the forest until they spot the rising smoke of Atatarho’s lodge. They enter
the lodge and find Atatarho with serpents for hair, turtle claws for hands, and feet
like bear’s claws. Hastily, the two spies retreat from the appalling sight and hurry back
to the chiefs. They report that Atatarho is a demon, no longer human. The chiefs
then travel to Atatarho’s house, singing the Six Sacred Songs along the way. When
they arrive, they invite the local chiefs to come to their fire, explaining their purpose
in coming. Then the newcomers begin singing the Six Sacred Songs again. When they
finish, they go to Atatarho’s lodge to heal him, but when they enter they are as horri-
fied as the spies were. But Dekanawida reminds them that they are chiefs and that
they should continue singing and open their wampum. The horrific wizard responds
positively to the singing, and Dekanawida is able to sing three more songs to him and
to give him a string of wampum. By these means the chiefs heal Atatarho’s mind,
body, and spirit and make him a natural man again, and he becomes a good leader of
his people, ultimately through Hiawatha’s discovery of the powerful wampum.
Graham Seal
American Indian oral narratives are concerned, the two most influential ethno-
poetic approaches have been the ‘‘verse analysis’’ of Dell Hymes and the ‘‘pause
phrasing’’ of Dennis Tedlock. Though both approaches begin with the assump-
tion that oral narration can better be represented on the printed page as poetry
than as prose, they differ in the kinds of source material they use and in their per-
ception of what constitutes the aesthetic essence of verbal art.
Using verse analysis, Hymes has effectively shown how the many indigenous-
language texts punctiliously documented by BAE researchers and Boasian anthro-
pologists using the aesthetically inhospitable dictation technique nevertheless
retain elements of the original artistry that can be recovered by careful linguistic
investigation. Hymes’s approach suggests that tales printed as prose in original-
language texts can be recast in poetic lines by noting the recurrence of grammati-
cal markers such as particles. Lines then can be organized into verses and stanzas
using such cues as the pattern number of the culture from which the stories come
(three or five in most of the Northwest Coast groups whose oral literature Hymes
has studied). These, then, form scenes and acts to result in final products struc-
tured as dramatic poetry. Since verse analysis often works with previously
recorded material and frequently has only written versions of the words used in
the performances, it cannot represent the totality of oral performance, including
66 | American Indian Tales
paralinguistic and kinesic devices used by the storytellers. But it does, according
to its advocates, allow some of the verbal art to emerge out of material whose
provenance did not encourage art.
While verse analysis seems to suggest that the art of storytelling can transcend
the particulars of a performance situation, pause phrasing situates that art precisely
in those particulars. Developed by Dennis Tedlock as he worked with storytellers
from Zu~ni Pueblo in the 1960s, this approach to representing orally expressed
verbal art in print relies upon tape recordings of specific performances. The verbal
component of these performances is cast in lines based upon pauses made by the
narrator, many of which correspond to the same kinds of grammatical markers that
verse analysis uses to define lines. Since Tedlock worked with tape recordings, he
was also able to reflect paralinguistic features such as changes in volume, tempo,
and vocal quality. These he represented with typographic manipulation to produce
what he called ‘‘scores,’’ which a reader might articulate aloud to recreate some-
thing very similar to what might be heard on the tape recording of the story. Pause
phrasing thus captures many of the precise details of a specific telling of a story,
and many of those details would change each time the story was told.
While these two approaches to presenting Native American tales in print have
become prominent among serious students of those tales, some translators have
continued to opt for prose, though they are likely to take care to meet the goals
of ethnopoetics more scrupulously than did their predecessors. Popular presenta-
tions of Native American tales, however, often continue to represent the stories
using an esthetic that reflects the influence more of Euro-American printed liter-
ature than of American Indian oral literature.
Interpretations
Just as there have been a variety of ways to represent Native American tales in
print throughout the history of European and Euro-American interest in them, a
number of approaches to analyzing and understanding them have also emerged.
As early as the seventeenth century, commentators viewed oral literature as a
source of data about other aspects of Native American cultures. Stories were
cited as reflections of a generalized American Indian worldview or of the spe-
cific mindset of a particular group. For example, the Jesuits in New France as
well as later missionaries in other parts of North America cited the stories they
heard as evidence of the benighted perspective of Indians and, more positively,
as evidence of a collective intelligence that could be receptive to the tenets of
Christianity. Lewis Cass, who represented the U.S. federal government to Indians
in the Old Northwest during the early nineteenth century, encouraged his
agents–—one of whom was Schoolcraft—to gather information on oral literature
for what it could tell them about how to manage their charges most effectively.
Using tales as an information source was an important data-gathering technique
American Indian Tales | 67
among anthropologists in the late nineteenth century. Franz Boas and his stu-
dents systematically collected stories not only as sources for language informa-
tion but for the general cultural data they might preserve. In many cases—
particularly on the Northwest Coast and later in California—Boasians might col-
lect stories from the few remaining speakers of a language whose cultural base
had been supplanted. They would then attempt to reconstruct that culture using
descriptions of kinship organization, marriage practices, rituals, and material cul-
ture preserved in the stories. Arguing that folklore in general and tales in particu-
lar ‘‘mirror’’ culture, some anthropologists continue to view the primary
significance of oral literature in what it can reveal about a society’s way of life.
A predominant approach to studying folktales in Europe during the first half
of the twentieth century, the historic-geographic method did not enjoy similar
popularity among students of American Indian tales. However, the American
folklorist Stith Thompson used a Native American narrative, ‘‘The Star Husband
Tale,’’ to demonstrate how this method might be applied in ‘‘laboratory’’ condi-
tions. The purpose of the historic-geographic method was to trace tales to their
time and point of origin, to define routes of diffusion from that point, to recon-
struct the original form of the story, and to identify subtypes that may have
developed. European storytelling traditions had, according to critics of the
method, been corrupted by printed versions of tales, which might nullify attempts
to delineate the processes of oral transmission over time and space.
Thompson suggested that looking at an American Indian story would pose no
such problem. What Thompson defined as the original form of ‘‘The Star Husband
Tale’’ has two young women wishing to marry stars. Each has her wish granted
and finds herself in the ‘‘upper world.’’ They are warned against digging there but
disobey and make a hole in the sky. They can see their earthly home below and
long to return there. They successfully return home using a long rope. Thompson
worked with eighty-six versions of this story that he located, for the most part, in
academic and museum publications. An examination of these yielded what he took
to be the story’s original form, which he believed to have originated in the Central
Plains. He was not at all successful in dating the tale’s origin, though he noted that
the earliest publications of the original form occurred in the 1890s. Thompson also
identified two subtypes of the story—one involving a porcupine that the young
women follow into the upper world, and the other having the young women de-
pendent on a series of animal trickster figures when they become trapped in a tree-
top upon their return to earth. While he was able to plot the original form and the
subtypes on maps, he could not clearly define routes of diffusion.
The use of tales for ethnographic information and the historic-geographic
method came under criticism because both ignored the stories as verbal art. Other
attempts to understand American Indian storytelling have often been just as
unsuccessful in revealing their artistry. For example, the morphological approach
68 | American Indian Tales
that Alan Dundes borrowed from Russian folklorist Vladimir Propp to study
Native American tales did effectively counter critics of those stories, who
believed them to be formless, episodic hodgepodges. For example, Dundes noted
a movement from the lack of something desirable to a liquidation of that lack as
a recurrent formula. Another frequent pattern has a tale’s protagonist being given
a warning, his or her not heeding that warning, and the consequences of such
irresponsibility. A range of motifs might flesh out these formulaic outlines,
which Dundes perceived as transcending cultural and linguistic boundaries. Few
analysts followed up on Dundes’s preliminary work, though, and he himself did
not go beyond identifying formulaic patterns to examining how those patterns
were realized in actual story performances. More influential has been the work
of French anthropologist Claude Levi-Strauss, who brought his investigations
into the fundamental structures of human thought processes to bear on Native
American tales. Levi-Strauss has repeatedly identified a structural mediation of
binary opposition underlying narratives from throughout the Americas, including
the origin account from Zu~ni Pueblo and a number of stories recorded from nar-
rators on the Northwest Coast. Pursuing psychological approaches, analysts have
also used the theories and methods of depth psychology to interpret the signifi-
cance of American Indian tales. The work of Sigmund Freud has informed read-
ings of Mescalero Apache narratives and Mohave Coyote tales, while Carl
Gustav Jung has often been invoked to explain such material as the cycle of sto-
ries about the Winnebago trickster.
Literary Redactions
Retellings of Native American oral narratives have been a staple of children’s lit-
erature since the nineteenth century. Many of the period’s anthropologists and
other students of indigenous cultures believed they were examining people whose
way of life represented an immature stage of development—maturity being repre-
sented by European and Euro-American civilization. Since Native Americans
were considered childlike, it seemed reasonable that their stories were suitable for
children, though only after objectionable scatological and sexual elements had
been expurgated. Consequently, children’s magazines such as St. Nicholas often
included American Indian stories retold for young readers. Some early Native
American writers, such as the Santee physician Charles Alexander Eastman,
explored the potential of marketing their culture’s narrative traditions for an audi-
ence familiar with European fairy tales. Smokey Day’s Wigwam Evenings (1909),
which Eastman prepared in collaboration with his wife Elaine Goodale Eastman,
exemplifies this trend, as do some of the collections published by Zitkala-Sa (Ger-
trude Bonnin), a Yankton. The practice of retelling Native American tales for
children has continued with work by the writer-illustrator Paul Goble providing
particularly attractive examples. Contemporary Native American writers such as
American Indian Tales | 69
Ojibwe novelist and poet Louise Erdrich have also written children’s books based
upon oral narrative traditions.
Erdrich is only one of several modern Native American writers who perceive
their work as continuing the traditional storytelling practices of their communities.
Some, such as N. Scott Momaday, have used those practices as a way of exploring
their cultural identity. His book The Way to Rainy Mountain (1969) recounts a
multidimensional pilgrimage that he made in search of his identity following the
death of his Kiowa grandmother. In addition to physically retracing the route that
his ancestors followed as they migrated from the Plateau of western Montana to
the Southern Plains, Momaday uses the stories told by his grandmother and other
raconteurs as a way of discovering that identity. In presenting these stories, he also
ensures that they will endure more securely and reach a wider audience than
would be the case had they depended entirely on oral transmission.
Meanwhile, Leslie Marmon Silko from Laguna Pueblo in New Mexico has
emphasized her identity as storyteller in the tradition of her female ancestors and
relatives and has stressed the continuing significance of traditional narrative
motifs and patterns in contemporary life. Her novel Ceremony (1977), for exam-
ple, depicts a Laguna World War II veteran who can reintegrate into his commu-
nity only by following the patterns of traditional story. Silko has also updated
such figures as the Coyote Trickster, showing how the techniques and values that
he represents are more than appropriate for survival in the twentieth century. The
continuing valence of Trickster provides a dominant theme in the fiction and cul-
ture commentary of Ojibwe novelist and scholar Gerald Vizenor, who insists that
‘‘tricksterism’’ provides the only method by which American Indians can survive
in the modern era.
Meanwhile, a number of recent anthologies of Native American tales have
helped to make this material accessible to the general public. Some of these are
essentially collections of rewritten materials, but others include texts that attempt
to represent original performances faithfully. Perhaps the best-known recent an-
thology is Richard Erdoes and Alfonso Ortiz’s American Indian Myths and
Legends (1984). However, while some of the material in the volume was col-
lected from storytellers by the authors themselves, much of it comes from previ-
ously published sources that the editors have rewritten without returning to
original-language texts. More successful are several anthologies edited by Brian
Swann, especially Coming to Light (1994) and Voices from Four Directions
(2004), both subtitled Contemporary Translations of the Native Literatures of
North America. These volumes include texts translated (or retranslated) from ei-
ther oral performances or earlier published versions that use the principles of eth-
nopoetics to capture both the original storytelling aesthetic and to represent some
of the features of oral performance. Moreover, each example is accompanied by
a thorough introduction that provides the reader with essential information about
70 | American Indian Tales
the cultural context. These anthologies have been faulted for not including
Native-language texts, an absence that Swann himself has lamented. But thriving
programs for publishing such texts have emerged in several Native American
communities, especially in Alaska and on the Northwest Coast. Concurrently,
storytellers have begun using English in their performances, so that even in situa-
tions where the original language may not be available, the storytelling tradition
flourishes.
Since the beginnings of Euro-American interest in American Indian narrative
traditions, two perceptions have colored collection, publication, and analysis. One
of these is the commonplace belief that oral literature and storytelling are bound
to disappear under the influence of literacy and the mass media. While this idea
has been a motivation for collecting and studying oral literature in a range of con-
texts since the inception of such scholarship, the Native American situation has
also been affected by the trope of the ‘‘vanishing American,’’ central to views of
Indian life since colonial days and a principal influence on government policies
regarding Indians. The assumption has been that ‘‘primitive’’ Indian cultures will
inevitably give way to the advance of Western civilization. Native American
tales, hence, have been affected not only by the threat of literacy but by the de-
mise of their cultural matrices. The late twentieth-century revival of interest in
Native American verbal art, termed the ‘‘Native American Renaissance’’ by critic
Kenneth Lincoln, indicates that concerns about the survival of Indian cultures and
their literatures either were unfounded or contributed to attempts by scholars and
by communities to ensure that they did not disappear. In the twenty-first century,
narrative and other verbal art traditions of Native Americans continue to thrive
both orally and as an influence on written literature.
William M. Clements
See Also American Indian Folklore Scholarship; Folktale; Performance.
References
Boas, Franz. 1940. Race, Language, and Culture. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Erdoes, Richard, and Alfonso Ortiz, eds. 1984. American Indian Myths and Legends.
New York: Pantheon.
Hymes, Dell. 2004. ‘‘In Vain I Tried to Tell You’’: Essays in Native American Ethno-
poetics. New edition. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.
Jacobs, Melville. 1959. The Content and Style of an Oral Literature: Clackamas
Chinook Myths and Tales. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Mattina, Anthony. 1985. The Golden Woman: The Colville Narrative of Peter J.
Seymour. Tucson: University of Arizona Press.
Momaday, N. Scott. 1969. The Way to Rainy Mountain. Albuquerque: University of
New Mexico Press.
Anansi | 71
Schoolcraft, Henry Rowe. 1992. Algic Researches: Indian Tales and Legends. 1839.
Baltimore: Clearfield.
Swann, Brian, ed. 1992. On the Translation of Native American Literatures. Wash-
ington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Swann, Brian, ed. 1994. Coming to Light: Contemporary Translations of the Native
Literatures of North America. New York: Random House.
Swann, Brian, ed. 2004. Voices from Four Directions: Contemporary Translations of
the Native Literatures of North America. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1972. Finding the Center: Narrative Poetry of the Zu~
ni Indians.
New York: Dial Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1983. The Spoken Word and the Work of Interpretation. Philadel-
phia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1929. Tales of the North American Indians. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press.
Anansi
Spider trickster of West and Central Africa and of the African diaspora in the Ca-
ribbean, northern South America, and the United States of America. Anansi (also
spelled Ananse, Anancy, or Nansi) goes by numerous localized names, including
‘‘Ti Malice’’ in Haiti, ‘‘Boy Nasty’’ or ‘‘B’Rabby’’ in the Bahamas, ‘‘Nancy’’ in
Curacao, and ‘‘Aunt Nancy’’ or ‘‘Miss Nancy’’ along the Carolina and Georgia
coasts. Wherever he is found, Anansi is a cunning trickster, making full use of his
insect abilities, such as eight feet and a sticky web, along with his magical powers
to attain his usually greedy, self-centered ends. Anansi is able to transform into a
hare, a fox, or even a human and is usually thought to be the origin of Brer Rabbit,
as popularized by Joel Chandler Harris in his Uncle Remus stories from 1880.
Like many trickster figures, Anansi is amoral, duplicitous, and greedy and is
sometimes shown being outwitted by other animals, or even by humans.
Among the most frequently encountered Anansi tales are those that tell of his
tricking Tiger into letting him ride on his back and of how Anansi stole the sun.
Also typical of Anansi tales are those that show him being bested, as in the story
of the farmer who, fed up with Anansi’s thieving of his property, places a tar or
gum baby in his field. When Anansi comes to the field, he greets the tar baby and,
receiving no response, slaps the sticky figure with his hand, which immediately
sticks to the doll. Anansi tries to kick the tar baby with the same result. The
farmer arrives, finds Anansi struggling to escape the tar baby, and, gleefully, beats
Anansi flat, thus explaining how spiders came to be such flattened-out creatures.
As well as explanatory legends of this kind, trickster tales often point to a
moral, a characteristic well illustrated by a Jamaican Anansi story in which the
trickster is living in a country where the queen is also a witch. Her secret name is
72 | Anansi
the word five, and she decrees that anyone who speaks the word will die on the
spot. Scheming Anansi, known as ‘‘Buh Anansi’’ in Jamaica, is hungry because
there is a famine. He has an idea. He decides to build a house on the river where
people come to get their water, and he makes a pile of yam hills. Whenever any-
one comes for water, he calls out to them, saying that he cannot count and so will
they help him out by counting the yam hills. They count ‘‘one, two, three, four,
five’’ and, according to the witch-queen’s curse, drop dead. Then Anansi plans to
preserve all the bodies so he will have plenty to eat, whether there is a famine or
not. A guinea fowl comes down to the river, and Anansi calls out for her to count
how many yam hills he has. The guinea fowl sits on one of the yam hills and
counts: ‘‘one, two, three, four, and the one I’m standing on.’’ ‘‘No,’’ Anansi says,
thwarted, ‘‘you can’t count.’’ So the guinea fowl moves to another yam hill and
counts again the same way. ‘‘You don’t count right at all,’’ says the frustrated
Anansi. ‘‘How do you count then?’’ asks the guinea fowl. Like this, replies Anansi:
‘‘one, two, three, four, five.’’ At the last word, he drops dead, and the guinea fowl
eats him up. The moral of the story is: ‘‘being greedy chokes the puppy.’’
Among the Ashanti and related Akan peoples of Africa, Anansi the spider, of-
ten called ‘‘Uncle Anansi,’’ is a major figure, appearing in many tales. These ta-
les often portray him as a fool trying, usually without much success, to outwit
animals, humans, and even the gods. Although sometimes shown as wise, Anansi
is also greedy, cunning, and ruthless, though his occasional victories over bullies
are often used as moral examples. As well as these cultural roles, Anansi may
take on the functions of a creator hero in Ashanti and Akanese tradition, where
he is credited with the creation of the moon and the founding of customary and
other traditional activities. Less positively, he is also blamed for bringing debt
and greed into the world.
Significantly, Anansi is also said to own all the tales ever told, as recounted in
an Ashanti legend in which Anansi displays some of his most heroic and cunning
traits. In the beginning, all stories were owned by the sky-god Nyame, but
Anansi wants them and so asks the god if he will sell them to him. The price
Nyame demands is that Anansi bring him the hornets (Mmoboro), the great
python (Onini), and the leopard (Osebo). Using his skill, cunning, and bravery,
Anansi captures all three and delivers them to Nyame, who, astonished at Anan-
si’s success where great warriors had tried and failed, decrees that from then on
all stories shall belong to Anansi the spider.
Anansi also features in West African proverbs that reflect well his ambivalent
importance, including: ‘‘Woe to him who would put his trust in Anansi—a sly,
selfish, and greedy fellow’’; and ‘‘The wisdom of the spider is greater than that of
all the world put together.’’ Anansi and his doings have been the raw material of
much children’s fiction and of numerous popular folktale anthologies.
Graham Seal
Anecdote | 73
See Also African Folklore; African American Folklore; Animal Tale; Trickster.
References
Abrahams, R. 1985. Afro-American Folktales, New York: Pantheon Books.
Arnott, K., ed. 1962. African Myths and Legends, London: Oxford University Press,
pp. 64 67, 74 77.
Bascom, W. 1992. African Folktales in the New World. Bloomington: Indiana Uni-
versity Press, 1992.
Bennett, M. 1994. West African Trickster Tales. Oxford: Oxford University Press,
pp. 61 69, 89 101.
Courlander, H., comp. 1975. A Treasury of African Folklore. New York: Crown,
pp. 118 140.
Dadie, B., trans. Hatch, C. 1987. The Black Cloth: A Collection of African Folktales.
Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press.
Dorson, R., ed. 1979. African Folklore. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Evans-Pritchard, E., ed. 1967. The Zande Trickster. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Jekyll, W., coll. and ed. 1966. Jamaican Song and Story. New York: Dover. (1907),
pp. 7 156.
Sherlock, P., ed. 1966. West Indian Folk-Tales. Oxford: Oxford University Press,
pp. 45 64, 71 85, 97 111, 118 124.
Anecdote
ascribed to an individual (‘‘To show you what I mean, let me tell you a story I heard
about so-and- so’’). Whether they are believed to be true or known to be apocry-
phal, anecdotes can be powerful rhetorical tools thinly disguised as narrative enter-
tainment. Mutatis mutandis, these hallmarks also apply to anecdotes told about
distinguishable, named groups, whether in praise (soldiers of a particular regiment,
a famous clan, Londoners during World War II) or in mocking contempt (the East
Frisians, the Irish, the people of Aarhus, the men of Gotham, city officials).
Although allegedly relating the actions or sayings of named individuals, anec-
dotes essentially express general human traits or universal human concerns, such
as stupidity, cleverness, boastfulness, curiosity, cowardice, miserliness, laziness,
drunkenness, gaucheness, ignorance, credulity, absentmindedness, shrewdness,
courage, quick-wittedness, slow-wittedness, and so on. The diplomatic gaffe of
an ambassador representing a powerful country or the simple mistake made in a
foreign language by a prominent politician not only creates a certain amount of
schadenfreude and exposes the imperfections of those in high places but also, in
some representative fashion, compensates for our own occasional lack of tact or
behavioral competence and our own linguistic struggles when abroad. Thus,
anecdotes are convenient vehicles for overt or covert social criticism. Drunken-
ness may itself be deplored or lead to hilarious narrative accounts—the story of a
drunken priest highlights the incongruity of the condition and the status of the
person afflicted. Courage may be admired in the strong, but it gains much poi-
gnancy when displayed by the timid in adversity. Group rivalry between sports
teams, neighboring cities, universities, fraternities, the different armed services,
ethnic communities, religious persuasions, and so on may find otherwise elusive
expression in the short, sharply focused narrative of the anecdote.
Structurally, anecdotes, like jokes and contemporary legends, rely heavily on
and therefore work toward a final revelation or punch line. But unlike the other
two genres, they do not lose their effectiveness in repetition; quite the contrary,
those who tell anecdotes are often asked to repeat them to reinforce a particular
view or opinion of an individual or group in an entertaining manner. Antti Aarne
and Stith Thompson’s The Types of the Folktale lists many of the traditional anec-
dotes in section 1200–1999 (‘‘Jokes and Anecdotes’’), together with other monoe-
pisodic stories. The majority of motifs are likely to be found under J (‘‘The Wise
and the Foolish’’), K (‘‘Deceptions’’), W (‘‘Traits of Character’’), and X
(‘‘Humor’’) in Stith Thompson’s Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. Despite the pop-
ularity of the anecdote in oral tradition, folklorists have paid comparatively little
attention to the anecdote as a genre per se. Not surprisingly, the anecdote, with its
strong affinity to the short story, also has become a well-honed literary genre.
W. F. H. Nicolaisen
See Also Esoteric/Exoteric Factor; Ethnic Folklore; Folktale.
Animals | 75
References
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1964. The Types of the Folktale. 2nd ed., rev.
Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 184. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Brunvand, Jan Harold. 1986. The Study of American Folklore: An Introduction. New
York: Norton.
Degh, Linda. 1972. Folk Narrative. In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed.
Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Grothe, Heinz. 1984. Anekdote. Sammlung Metzler Band 101. Stuttgart: Metzler.
Ranke, Kurt. 1972. European Anecdotes and Jests. European Folklore Series, no. 4.
Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and Bagger.
Thompson, Stith. 1946. The Folktale. New York: Holt, Rinehart and Winston.
Thompson, Stith. 1966. Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. 2nd ed., 6 vols. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Animals
Living creatures that are a major source and subject of—as well as co-partici-
pants in—human created folklore. Our stories feature animal characters. Our folk
arts use their fur, feathers, skin, and bones. We eat them in our foodways. We
emulate and relate to them in fashioning folk groups. Animals participate with us
in the traditional activities of hunting and domestic life and many varieties of our
pets, working animals, and livestock are ‘‘living folk art’’ products of vernacular
processes that in turn contribute to human folkways.
Fantastic animal stories have long been a recognized major tale type. Many
societies’ mythologies depict archetypal animals acting in human or god-like
ways such as the trickster figures Coyote in Native American lore, Brer Rabbit
and Brer Fox among African Americans, and Anansi the Spider in the Caribbean
and West Africa. Stith Thompson’s seminal reference work The Types of the
Folktale begins with an ‘‘Animal Tales’’ section (Thompson 1995).
Sometimes animals are an occupational or avocational interest around which folk
groups organizes themselves—cattle for cowboys (Stanley and Thatcher 2000),
chickens for cockfighting (Dundes 1994), and foxes and hounds for foxhunting
(Hufford 1992, Eliason 2004). Animals also shape identity as totems in tribal soci-
eties, such as bears among the Ainu of Northern Japan, or modern American sports
teams such as baseball’s Arizona Diamondbacks or football’s St. Louis Rams.
The animals we will or will not keep as pets, or will or will not eat, and how
we treat them become boundary markers for religious, ethnic, national, regional,
and social groups. Religious dietary laws often prohibit the consumption of cer-
tain animals and demand the sacrifice of others. Among Muslims, it is said
Mohammed once cut off the corner of his coat when he got up so as not to dis-
turb a sleeping cat, but taught that angels will not enter a house that keeps a dog.
Wealthy Arab keepers of graceful saluki hunting dogs often maintain that their
noble animals are different than the semi-feral mutts exiled to the outskirts of
town by the pious who tend to be ‘‘cat people.’’
Devout Muslims demand that food animals be killed by slicing open the jugular
vein and carotid artery in one motion without damaging the spinal cord in part
because they deem this more humane. Inversely, some animal rights activists con-
demn dhabihah slaughter because they find it inhumane. In the Philippines, many
see cockfighting as the national sport embodying virtues of courage and persistence,
while in Western Europe and the United States it is regarded as cruel and is banned.
A 1998 city ordinance pushed by cosmopolitan Manilans bans the slaughter of
dogs for food. Other Filipinos ignore the law, seeing no need to kowtow to Western
sensibilities and abandon traditional foodways. While the countries out of which
animal rights activism flows often make a sharp moral distinction between pet-type
animals and food-type animals, Filipinos see dogs as appropriate for both. People
know puppies considered as pets should wear a collar or be considered fair game.
Iguanas are common to both the islands of Saba and Aruba in the Dutch Carib-
bean. While Sabans would recoil from eating one, Arubans barbeque iguana on
the beach in self-conscious displays of island identity. Similarly, Ghanaians con-
sider Nigerians barbaric for eating the bones of their fried chicken, while Niger-
ians consider Ghanaians foolish for passing up the nutrients.
Animals | 77
In the United States, ball pythons are bred as pets to an increasingly numerous
variety of rare and expensive ‘‘morphs’’ or distinctive color patterns desired by
collectors who are as likely to be teenage girls as tattooed bikers. In Turkey,
snakes are more often considered wild animals inappropriate for pets, whereas
keeping turtles enjoys a strong cultural cache reinforced by Turkey’s most fa-
mous and most reproduced painting, The Turtle Trainer by Osman Hamdi Bey
that depicts what was a common pursuit in the court of Ottoman Sultans (Pamu-
cak 2005). All of these distinctions are traditional and passed on as identity-
defining attitudes through the generations.
While folklorists have regarded animals as subject matter for lore or as signifi-
cant identifiers for folk groups, animals’ own forms and behaviors in and of
themselves have not yet been widely understood as folklore. Nevertheless, ani-
mals themselves can be the products of, and participants in, folkloric processes.
In traditional hunting and agricultural settings as well as suburban accessories,
animals are at the same time living folk art fashioned by humans but also active
tradition bearers, cultural creators, and competent performers who in turn shape
humans’ traditional activities.
The many breeds of dogs, whose diverse shapes are the legacy of former, and
sometimes continuing, traditional working and sporting uses, can be seen as folk-
lore genres expressed according to vernacular knowledge, passed on through
generations, and shaped from natural organic materials just as handmade baskets
are from reeds or carved saddles are from leather. With dog breeds, the organic
medium craftsmen work in is still alive. They are not artifacts, but rather biofacts
as would be any living things shaped by, and emergent from, traditional human
creative activity.
Not only as lore products but as lore producers, working animals pass on occu-
pational knowledge to apprentices. In foxhunting, hounds will wear a coupling
collar so the younger can follow the elder’s lead. In Great Plains coyote coursing
younger dogs informally learn form older ones how to cross a barbed wire fence
without getting cut. Stephen Budiansky suggests that the etiological legends
explaining domestication common in many societies—where man goes into the
wild, captures a wolf cub and tames it—give far too much credit to conscious
human dominion in domestication’s long evolutionary processes (Budiansky
1999,19–21). Rather, animals such as dogs, cows, cats, and chickens—generalists
all, adept at exploiting the changing habitats humans tend to create—have infil-
trated themselves into human society as a highly successful survival strategy as
evidenced by the numerical success of domestic animals compared to their much-
dwindled wild counterparts (Budiansky 2000, 6) as well as the extraordinary
lengths human pastoralists like the Maasai will take to follow and protect cattle on
what are more or less the herd’s natural cyclical migration paths or the fact that
there are more pet dogs than human children in San Francisco (Sappenfield 2002).
78 | Animals
Perhaps our lives are as much the creation of animal preferences as the other way
around.
In the wild, it is becoming clear that some animals understand and use aesthetic
principles and can respond to beauty and craftsmanship much the same way
humans do even with no human involvement. The male bowerbird of New Guinea
constructs an elaborate house made from a wide variety of materials that have to
be arranged just so. These bowers do not protect the male from predators or the
elements or serve any immediately clear survival purpose. However, when a
female bowerbird inspects the bower and any detail doesn’t meet her fancy or dis-
pleases her in any way, she rejects the male as a mate (Hansell 2007, 216–251).
In recent decades, ethologists have chipped away at the list of things once
thought to distinguish humans from animals—namely, tool use (Goodall 1986),
fashioned weapon use (Pruetz 2007), tradition, custom, language (Hillix and
Rumbaugh 2003, Slobodchikoff 2002, Pepperberg 2002), kinship understand-
ings, psychological awareness (Griffin 1976) and emotions (Ridley 1993, 312,
326; Masson and McCarthy 1996) as well as art (Gould and Gould 2007, Hansell
2005) and the appreciation of beauty (Hansell 2007). This list shows remarkable
overlap with the very purview folklorists have claimed, but so far, folklorists
have mostly looked at such phenomena only in human societies.
Eric Eliason
See Also Animal Tale; Belief, Folk; Foodways.
References
Budainsky, Stephen. 1999. The Covenant of the Wild: Why Animals Chose Domesti-
cation. New Haven: Yale University Press.
Budainsky, Stephen. 2000. The Truth about Dogs: An Inquiry into the Ancestry,
Social Conventions, Mental Habits, and Moral Fiber of Canis Familiaris. New York:
Viking.
Dundes, Alan. 1994. The Cockfight: A Casebook. Madison: University of Wisconsin
Press.
Eliason, Eric. 2004. Foxhunting Folkways under Fire and the Crisis of Traditional
Moral Knowledge. Western Folklore 63(1&2): 123 167.
Goodall, Jane. 1986. The Chimpanzees of Gombe: Patterns of Behavior. New York:
Belknap Press.
Gould, James L., and Carol Grant Gould. 2007. Animal Architects: Building and the
Evolution of Intelligence. New York: Basic Books.
Griffin, D. R. 1976. The Question of Animal Awareness. New York: The Rockefeller
University Press.
Hansell, Mike. 2005. Animal Architecture. New York: Oxford University Press.
Hansell, Mike. 2007. Built by Animals: The Natural History of Animal Architecture.
New York: Oxford University Press.
Animal Tale | 79
Hillix, W. A., and Duane Rumbaugh. 2003. Animal Bodies, Human Minds: Ape, Dol-
phin, and Parrot Language Skills. New York and Heidelberg: Springer Books.
Hufford, Mary T. 1992. Chaseworld: Foxhunting and Storytelling in New Jersey’s
Pine Barrens. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Masson, Jeffrey Moussaieff, and Susan McCarthy. 1996. When Elephants Weep: The
Emotional Lives of Animals. New York: Random House.
Pamucak, Emin. 2005. Osman Hamdi Bey’s The Turtle Trainer. http://lightmillennium
.org/2005 16th/epamucak osman hamdi.html (last accessed June 23, 2009).
Pepperberg, Irene Maxine. 2002. The Alex Studies: Cognitive and Communicative
Abilities of Grey Parrots. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Pruetz, Jill. 2007. ISU Anthropologist’s Study Is First to Report Chimps Hunting
with Tools. http://www.iastate.edu/nscentral/news/2007/feb/chimpstools.shtml (accessed
March 1, 2007).
Ridley, Matt. 1993. The Red Queen: Sex and the Evolution of Human Nature. New
York: Macmillan.
Sappenfield, Mark. December 20, 2002. In San Francisco, Pet Owners Recast as
‘‘Guardians.’’ http://www.csmonitor.com/2002/1220/p01s02-usgn.html (accessed Septem-
ber 9, 2006).
Slobodchikoff, Don. 2002. Cognition and Communication in Prairie Dogs. In Mark
Bekoff, Colin Allen, and Gordon Burghardt, eds., The Cognitive Animal: Empirical and
Theoretical Perspectives on Animal Cognition. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Stanley, David, and Elaine Thatcher. 2000. Cowboy Poets & Cowboy Poetry.
Chicago and Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1995. The Types of the Folktale: A Classification and Bibliography.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Animal Tale
A fictional oral narrative in which animals perform the principal plot actions. As
a folklore genre, animal tales are distinct from the closely related genres of mim-
ologisms and etiological legends. Mimologisms are verbal expressions and dia-
logues, sometimes introduced by a very short narrative, that interpret the sounds
of animals in humorous ways. Etiological legends relate events, supposed to have
taken place once in the distant past, to explain particularities of the animal and
natural world still observable nowadays—for example, to tell why the bat is
blind and flies only at night (AT 222A, a version of which appears as the twenty-
third tale in the Fables of Marie de France), or to explain why the bear has no tail
(AT 2, ‘‘The Tail-Fisher’’).
In certain cases, animal tales so closely resemble etiological legends that they
share the same plot, although the two genres put that plot to different uses. Medi-
eval versions of ‘‘The Tail-Fisher,’’ for example, pit the fox against the wolf: the
fox convinces the wolf to use his tail as a fishing line. As the wolf sits on a hole
80 | Animal Tale
in a frozen pond, waiting for the fish to bite, ice forms around his tail and traps
him. Farmers arrive and beat the wolf; in order to survive, he has to cut off his
own tail. The version just summarized comes from the medieval Roman de
Renart, a twelfth-century collection of fictional tales. But in some modern oral
traditions, the tale is told about a bear, and after the bear loses his tail in the ice,
the narrator ends by explaining that this is why, today, bears have no tails.
Like ‘‘The Tail-Fisher,’’ most animal tales feature two major characters. And,
also like ‘‘The Tail-Fisher,’’ most are simply structured stories of deceit involving
two basic plot actions. First, there is the deceit or deception (the fox tricks the wolf
into using his tail as a fishing line); second, the outcome, a sudden ending (the
wolf is beaten and loses his tail). In the actual practice of storytelling, however, a
narrator may string together many such short tales into long narratives. Because
the episodes are all similar in structure, they may occur in any order, thus allowing
gifted performers great freedom to compose their own chains of episodes. Never-
theless, some chains have proved remarkably stable in practice. For example, in
both medieval literature and in recent oral tradition, ‘‘The Tail-Fisher’’ is often
prefaced by ‘‘The Theft of Fish’’ (AT 1), in which a hungry fox plays dead; fisher-
men find him in the road and, eager to skin him, throw him into their fish basket
(or in the Roman de Renart, a cart full of eels); as the fishermen make their way
home, the fox throws the fish out of the basket and then escapes to eat them.
The animal tales of oral folk tradition are organized around a few clear seman-
tic oppositions: physical weakness combined with cunning conflicts with physical
strength combined with stupidity. Wild animals conflict with domestic animals.
These two sets of oppositions generally coincide, as both stupidity and savagery
are stigmatized while cunning and domesticity are valorized. In European tradi-
tion, strength and stupidity are most often embodied in the figure of the wolf,
though in the Nordic countries the bear frequently fills this role. The trickster par
excellence is the fox, but his status is more ambiguous. When opposed to domes-
tic animals, he represents physical strength and is sometimes the loser, but when
opposed to the wolf or bear, he is the embodiment of cunning, thus acquiring
some of the traits normally attached to the human/domestic sphere.
In medieval literature, animal tales were told for moral and edifying purposes,
in fables and exempla; for didactic purposes, in bestiaries; but above all, for
comic and satiric purposes, in the vast cycle of Reynard the Fox—the immensely
popular and influential Roman de Renart (1174–1250), its antecedents in clerical
Latin poetry, and its many continuations into the fifteenth century.
Generally speaking, the fable, of learned origin and cultivated by clerics, is writ-
ten to convey a moral message; the animal tales of oral folk tradition, on the con-
trary, tend to be told for entertainment. This difference affects their respective
narrative structures. For example, fables tend to end with a pointed moral,
whereas animal tales seldom do.
Although medieval fables ultimately derive from the antique fables of Aesop
and Phaedrus, a number of them are retellings of animal tales from folk traditions.
Compilers of fable collections used a variety of sources. A case in point is the
Fables of Marie de France, possibly the first such collection to appear in a Euro-
pean vernacular. It includes twenty stories derived from classical fable tradition
as well some twelve fabliaux, but the remainder are animal tales rooted in medie-
val oral folk traditions. Three of the folk-derived fables feature the fox: ‘‘The
Cock and the Fox’’ (AT 6), ‘‘The Fox and the Dove’’ (AT 62), and ‘‘The Fox and
the Bear’’ (AT 36). Significantly, all three tales also appear in the major beast epic
collections Ysengrimus and Renart. Eight others commonly associated with folk
tradition feature the wolf. In contrast to the fox tales, the wolf tales seem to have
come more immediately from clerical sources. In these tales, animals fast, offici-
ate at mass, and serve as bishops! One of Marie’s wolf fables (no. 90) follows the
plot of the popular tale of ‘‘The Wolf and the Seven Kids’’ (AT 123).
After 1250, medieval fables featuring the fox and the wolf are likely to borrow
from the widely popular Roman de Renart rather than directly from folk tradi-
tion. For example, the Liber parabolarum (Book of Parables) by Odo de Cheri-
ton contains 116 fables, of which 15 can be traced back to classical tradition
through the Romulus and others to bestiaries, while several are connected with
the cycle of Reynard the Fox. For example, Odo’s fable 74 is the tale of ‘‘The
Tail-Fisher’’ (AT 2). Fable 23, ‘‘De fraudibus vulpis et catti’’ (On the Tricks of
the Wolf and the Cat), is a folktale: the cat’s only trick saves him. When in dan-
ger, the cat climbs up the tree, whereas the fox is captured in spite of his many
tricks (AT 105, ‘‘The Cat’s Only Trick’’). The protagonists of this fable are given
the names—Reynard the Fox and Tibert the Cat—earlier bestowed upon them in
the Roman de Renart, although the story itself does not appear in the Roman.
Fables by Jean de Sheppey (between 1354 and 1377) include such narratives as
‘‘Lupus et vulpes in lardio’’ (The Wolf and the Fox in the Larder), a version of
the popular animal tale ‘‘The Wolf Overeats in the Cellar’’ (AT 41, also found in
the fables of Odo of Cheriton).
Preachers often employed animal tales in their sermons, first exploiting the
entertaining features of the folktale to gain the attention of the audience and then
shaping the tale to underscore moral points. Such tales, known as exempla,
became increasingly popular in the later Middle Ages. The French exemplum
collection Chastoiement d’un p ere a son fils (A Father’s Warning to His Son)
includes the tale of the wolf and fox in the well (AT 32). The Chastoiement is a
82 | Animal Tale
Aesop
Aesop has been known since the fifth century BCE as the Greek author of the world’s
best-known fables. However, most modern scholars doubt that he existed as a real
person, maintaining instead that already in antiquity the name Aesop was invented to
provide authorship for diverse fables from various anonymous sources. Supporting
this theory, many of the earliest references to the stories of Aesop refer to Aesopic
(or Aesopian) fables rather than Aesop’s fables. Thus, the adjective Aesopic describes a
kind of tale and a storytelling tradition but does not identify a specific author.
The most frequently cited ancient reference to the man Aesop is found in the His-
tory of the Greco-Persian Wars by the Greek historian Herodotus (ca. 425 BCE).
Here we learn little more than that Aesop lived during the sixth century BCE, was
the slave of a Samian, and was murdered. There are also a number of medieval
manuscripts that depict the life of Aesop, but they often contradict each other, and
many of the events they describe are so fantastic as to be unbelievable by modern
standards. According to these accounts, Aesop was born a dark-skinned slave or
possibly captured into slavery at a young age. He is reputed to have been ugly and
deformed. Furthermore, in his early years he suffered from a speech impediment,
but he was miraculously cured and became an eloquent orator. His quick tongue
and sharp wit often got him into trouble, for he had a sarcastic response for every
occasion, and he was an unrepentant trickster. With time, Aesop’s cunning, wisdom,
and oratory skills brought him freedom from slavery, but in the end they cost him
his life. The citizens of Delphi were so offended by his lack of respect for their aris-
tocracy and for their principal deity, Apollo, that they planted a golden cup in his
baggage, accused him of temple theft, and executed him by throwing him over a cliff.
The lack of surviving written records makes it impossible to establish an authorita-
tive canon of stories attributable to Aesop. The oldest extant collection of Aesopic
fables, containing some 94 tales, was recorded in Latin verse by Phaedrus during the
first century CE. It was based on earlier manuscripts, now lost. The oldest surviving
collection of Aesopic fables in Greek was authored in the second century CE by Bab-
rius, a Hellenized Roman. This collection included more than 200 fables, 143 of
which are still extant in their original verse form, with an additional 57 having sur-
vived in prose paraphrases. Many collections of ‘ Aesop’s fables’’ compiled in the Mid-
dle Ages were based on the versions of Phaedrus and Babrius.
Aesopic fables were highly valued as teaching tools in medieval and Renaissance
Europe. The development of movable-type printing, beginning about 1455, greatly
facilitated the publication of fable collections. In fact, various compilations of ‘ Aesop’s
fables’ were among the first books published in a number of European vernacular
languages, including an English edition published in 1484 by William Caxton.
D. L. Ashliman
Exemplum
A short narrative using real or at least realistic events to illustrate a cultural belief.
This type of story was recognized as one of the basic devices of rhetorical argu-
ment by Aristotle, who termed it paradiegma (paradigm). Roman rhetoricians such
as Cicero and Quintilian termed such stories exempla, a word originally meaning ‘a
clearing in the woods.’’ The genre was based on historically verifiable incidents but
often included frankly fictional narratives that involved animals (fables), comparisons
drawn from ordinary life (parables), or realistic stories that were not verifiable but
that could have happened.
Exempla became an important element in Christian homelitic writing, as preach-
ers used such stories in sermons to lay audiences. As a guide, anthologies of such
narratives circulated, beginning in the sixth century with Pope Gregory the Great’s
Homiliae in Evangelia. Such ‘example-books’’ enjoyed their greatest vogue from 1200
to 1400, when they circulated in Latin and many vernacular languages. The Gesta
Romanorum was one of the most influential of these works in Latin, and several of
Chaucer’s Canterbury Tales, including the Pardoner’s, Summoner’s, and Monk’s Tales,
drew on vernacular versions from this genre.
Originally drawn from classical histories or saints’ lives, these collections eventu-
ally included many traditional narratives. Hence, example-books have proven a use-
ful guide to anecdotal oral narratives of the medieval and Renaissance periods.
Exempla were used for a wide variety of purposes: Preachers could employ histori-
cal figures as good or bad examples to exhort listeners to practice virtue and avoid
sin. But many more contemporaneous examples were used to frighten them with
the wages of blasphemy.
One such exemplum was ‘ The Dancers of Kolbeck,’ about individuals who insisted
on dancing and singing outside a church during mass and were punished by being
compelled to dance without stop for an entire year. Word of this event, which alleg-
edly occurred in 1012, spread rapidly through Europe as a sermon exemplum, and
beggars even carried letters claiming to prove that they had themselves been partici-
pants in the event. A number of other horrific events, such as accounts of bleeding
hosts, accidental cannibalism, ritual sacrifice, and penis captivus (imprisoned penis),
also are found in collections of exempla.
As time passed, however, these collections began to emphasize stories intended
to amuse rather than scare. Hence, many examples in later collections resemble
jokes or fabliaux, illustrating the sexual lapses of monks or priests and their parish-
ioners. However, traditional narratives remain an integral part of folk preaching, and
Veronique Campion-Vincent, in fact, has argued that contemporary legends are best
understood as the historical descendants of exempla. Indeed, many such legends
continue to circulate as sermon illustrations: Televangelist Oral Roberts recently
used a version of ‘ The Vanishing Hitchhiker’ as an exemplum.
Bill Ellis
Animal Tale | 85
Hand-colored engraving of The Re-Electing of Reynard, or Fox the Pride of the Geese,
1783. (The Bridgeman Art Library International)
same order, in the earliest branch of the Renart cycle (branch II): Renart and the
cock, Renart and the titmouse (though the role of titmouse is filled by a cock in
Ysengrimus), Renart’s insult of Isengrin’s cubs, and his rape of Isengrin’s wife.
These early animal epics in the form of Latin poetry are themselves inspired
by Aesopian fables, but they are amply developed and are given an ecclesiastic
twist through such features as the wolf dressed as priest, which was a widespread
religious topos in the Middle Ages.
Although undeniably influenced by the Ysengrimus, the Roman de Renart dis-
plays some distinctive innovations. Written in the vernacular, it appeals to a
much larger audience, more interested in laughter than in philosophical and
moral speculations. Plot and characters are no longer confined to monastic life.
Roman de Renart is not a unified work. Rather, it is a cycle of independent
poems in the French vernacular, centered around the trickster figure of Reynard
the Fox. These poems, called ‘‘branches,’’ were composed at different times by
different authors, most of them anonymous. Sometimes they relate a single epi-
sode, and sometimes a string of episodes. Although they sometimes refer to each
other, these poems were meant to be read independently and therefore often
overlap or contradict each other. The numerical order of the branches established
by Ernest Martin in the 1880s is still used by scholars for practical purposes,
although it differs both from the chronology of the events in the narration and
from the presumed chronology of their writing.
86 | Animal Tale
As early as the thirteenth century copyists tried to assemble the branches into
comprehensive collections. Three different collections survive from the Middle
Ages, none of which contains all 28 of the branches identified by scholars today.
The choice of branches and their order of appearance are also different in the
three collections. Furthermore, even the total of 28 branches is misleading
because some branches (e.g., V) have been subdivided into subbranches a and b,
each of which may be counted as a separate branch. The earliest 6 branches were
written between 1174 and 1178, another 12 between 1178 and 1205, and yet
another 12 between 1225 and 1250. These three groups total about 25,000 lines.
The earliest six branches (II–Va, III, V, XV, IV, XIV) constitute the sections of
the Roman de Renart that most strongly parallel the tales of oral folk tradition. In
branches II and Va, the oldest poem of the Roman (1174–1177), written by a
cleric, Pierre de Saint-Cloud, Renart catches the cock Chanticleer by inducing
him to crow with his eyes closed; Renart leaps and seizes the cock in his jaws
(AT 61). Chanticleer escapes by persuading Renart to talk and taking advantage
of the situation to fly out of the fox’s mouth (AT 6). Defeated by the cock, the fox
then tries to beguile the titmouse into closing his eyes and kissing him, claiming
that King Noble, the lion, has ordered peace among all animals. Suspicious, the
titmouse touches Renart with a twig, and the fox snaps at it. The titmouse escapes
unharmed (AT 62, ‘‘Peace among Animals’’). Renart, pretending to make friends
with Tibert the cat, proposes that the two run a race; Renart’s plan is to steer
Tibert into a trap, a pit dug in the path by a peasant; Tibert sees the pit and
swerves just in time, but eventually steers Renart into it (AT 30). Renart flatters
Tiecelin the raven into singing. Tiecelin drops his cheese and Renart gets hold of
it (AT 57). The poem then turns to the origin of the mortal feud that opposes
Renart and Isengrin the wolf. One day Renart finds himself by accident in the
wolf’s den, and Hersent, Isengrin’s wife, makes advances to him. Renart embra-
ces her, but fearing the return of Isengrin, he soon leaves, after having stolen her
food and insulted her cubs. The cubs reveal their mother’s behavior to their father.
Isengrin forces Hersent to help him catch Renart. Renart flees to his den. Isengrin
and Hersent pursue him with such speed that Hersent gets trapped, with her head
in the den and her hindquarters outside. Renart goes out through another entrance
and rapes her, while insulting Isengrin, who is witness to the scene.
In branch III, Renart plays dead on the road. A peasant takes him up and throws
him in his wagon, which is full of eels, and Renart throws them one by one out of
the wagon (AT 1, ‘‘The Theft of Fish’’). Isengrin, pursued by dogs, takes refuge in
a monastery and puts on monk’s robes. Renart induces him to catch fish with his
tail through a hole in the ice. The wolf’s tail freezes fast, and when he is attacked
and tries to escape, he loses his tail (AT 2, ‘‘The Tail-Fisher’’).
In branch V, Renart helps Isengrin steal a ham, but the wolf tricks him and eats
it alone. Renart tries in vain to eat the cricket. In branch XV Renart and Tibert
Animal Tale | 87
the cat find a sausage. Tibert tricks Renart into letting him carry it, climbs up a
cross, and eats the sausage alone. In branch IV (written in 1178), Renart dives in
the well of the monastery, mistaking his reflection for his wife Hermeline (AT
34). When Isengrin arrives, Renart pretends that he is in heaven, inducing Isen-
grin to descend into the well in one bucket, thus bringing Renart up in the other
one (AT 32). Branch XIV (written in 1178) features Renart and Tibert in the cel-
lar (AT 41); Renart plays tricks on Primaut, a wolf whose adventures are very
similar to those of Isengrin.
After 1178, the poems of the cycle diverge substantially from oral traditional
animal tales and take on themes related to professional life and upper-class soci-
ety. Branch I (1179) is devoted to the trial of Renart, branch VI (1190) to his duel
with Isengrin and his becoming a monk, branch XII (1190) to Renart and Tibert
in the cloister, branch VIII (1190) to Renart’s pilgrimage, and branch Ia (1190–
1195) to the siege of Renart’s den Maupertuis. In branch Ib (1195), Renart
becomes a jongleur, in branch VII (1195–1200) Renart confesses, and in branch
XI (1196–1200) he becomes emperor. Branch IX (1200) presents Renart, the
peasant, and the bear; branch XVI, Renart’s will; and branch XVII (1205),
Renart’s death and burial.
Characters in the Roman de Renart, especially in the earlier branches, are
described as both humans and animals. Renart is a seigneur who owns a fortified
castle, Maupertuis, and a fief, and fights a duel with Isengrin. The society around
him is a close reflection of the feudal world of the twelfth century. Yet he has to
crawl on four legs through the kitchen garden in order to catch a chicken. The
other protagonists, too, have their traditional animal characteristics: Brun the
bear is clumsy and greedy; Tibert the cat is agile, fastidious, and hypocritical;
Chanticleer the cock is vain and protective; and Bernart the donkey is immensely
credulous and silly. This does not apply to the female protagonists, however.
Queen Fiere, the lioness, is as noble and beautiful as a queen in an Arthurian
romance; Renart’s wife Hermeline appears largely in the role of devoted wife
and mother; and Isengrin’s wife, Hersent, is as sensuous and unfaithful as the
wives in fabliaux—but these traits do not reflect the characteristics of their ani-
mal species in folk tradition.
From its very beginning, the Roman de Renart displays both a comical and a
satirical aspect. The balance between these two aspects changes progressively,
from the more comical to the more satirical. The earliest branches, closer to folk-
lore, introduce a strong parodic element alongside the simple comedy of tradi-
tional animal tales. Writers of the Roman de Renart continually parody the
scenes and rhetorics of courtly literature, chansons de geste, legal procedures,
and other realms of refined aristocratic and ecclesiastical life.
The Roman de Renart has had many continuations, new poems that can be con-
sidered as new branches in a way, but whose style and purpose infuse the figure
88 | Animal Tale
of Renart and his adventures with more and more satire and less overt comedy.
The characters also become increasingly anthropomorphic. In Renart le bestourn e
(1261), Rutebeuf delivers a violent attack on friars, as does the anonymous poem
Le couronnement de Renart (1263–1270). Renart le nouvel (1289), by Jacquemart
Gielee, is a long allegoric and didactic poem, a prose adaptation often copied and
published in the course of the following 300 years. New branches are composed
in the fourteenth century. The anonymous Roman de Renart le contrefait (1319–
1342) is an enormous work of encyclopedic knowledge.
The first six branches of the Roman de Renart inspired Reinhart Fuchs, writ-
ten about 1190 in Alsatian, a German dialect, by Heinrich le Glichez^are. A new
branch of Renart developed in Italy: Rainardo e Lisengrino, written in Franco-
Italian dialect in the thirteenth century.
English-language versions of the Renart tales are relatively rare before the fif-
teenth century. The short thirteenth-century poem ‘‘The Fox and the Wolf’’
relates the story of Renart and Isengrin in the well. Renart next appears in the last
years of the fourteenth century in Chaucer’s ‘‘Nun’s Priest’s Tale,’’ a free adapta-
tion of the episode of Renart and Chanticleer the cock.
The popularity and diffusion of the Roman de Renart has been especially
strong in the countries north of France. The Flemish poem Reinaert de Voes (ca.
1250), which combines and translates several French branches, inspired a prose
adaptation in Dutch (published 1479). The Dutch version was in turn translated
into English by Caxton under the title of History of Raynard the Fox (1481) and
became the source of a number of German and Scandinavian translations and
reworkings in subsequent centuries, even serving as the main source of inspira-
tion of Goethe’s Reinecke Fuchs.
Numerous allusions in chansons de geste, fabliaux, and other literary works
testify that by the twelfth century all classes of society were already very familiar
with the tales of Renart. A verse in Gautier de Coincy’s Miracles de Notre-Dame
implies that scenes from the Renart epic were painted even in priests’ houses
(Pocquet ed., col. 59, vers. 168–172). The extraordinary popularity of the animal
epic created around the figure of the trickster fox is perhaps best attested by the
fact that since the thirteenth century the personal name of the protagonist, Renart
(adapted from the German name Raginhard, ‘‘He who wins through cunning’’),
has replaced goupil to mean ‘‘fox’’ in the French language—and has become the
basis of another French word, renardie (hypocrisy or craftiness).
Renart the trickster is cruel, unscrupulous, vicious by inclination as much as
by necessity, and, above all, cunning. Originating partly in the animal tales of
medieval folklore, but mostly in the learned Latin animal poems written by cler-
ics influenced by the fables of Phaedrus, the Roman de Renart and its continua-
tions have become the most powerful expression of the satiric spirit of the
Middle Ages. Progressively, the trickster figure of Reynard the Fox becomes the
Animal Tale | 89
Fabliau
A humorous narrative treating a sexual or obscene theme. Originally a medieval
French dialect variant of fable (meaning story or folktale), the term fabliau first
appeared as a self-descriptive label in a series of verse poems at the end of the
twelfth century. Though literary in nature, these works may have been intended for
oral performance; in any case, they incorporated themes from contemporary oral
tradition. About 125 poetic versions of fabliaux survive from medieval French, and
the genre was also used in Boccaccio’s Decameron (ca. 1350) and Chaucer’s Canter-
bury Tales (ca. 1380), two literary works that mimic oral storytelling sessions.
Critics of the literary fabliaux agree that their distinctive style and structure
reflect awareness of an underlying folk narrative aesthetic. Fabliaux tend to be brief,
focusing on an intrigue that is usually erotic in nature. The typical plot structure
involves some kind of deception or ruse perpetrated by the main figure, who uses
the ruse as license to commit some kind of cultural misdeed. In medieval examples,
the story presents women as unfaithful and sexually unrestrained (modern exam-
ples often invert this stereotype). The story’s style is characterized by irony, both
in its commentary on events and in its use of elevated, ‘courtly’ language to
describe sexually explicit or scatological events. Many narrative themes found in
the literary fabliaux have since been collected from oral tradition in many cultures.
In contemporary American folklore, fabliau-type narratives survive in several dis-
tinct formal genres. Themes of female infidelity appear in ballads such as ‘ Our
Goodman’ (Child 274), in which a husband finds more and more evidence of his
wife’s infidelity, such as ‘ a head lying on my pillow.’’ He is, however, pacified by her
witty explanations of the incriminating items as common household objects, such
as ‘ a cabbage head.’’ Many folktales and jokes also continue fabliau themes: the wide-
spread ‘ Rabbit Herd’ (AT 570), for instance, shows the hero using a magical object
to seduce a king’s daughters and wife and humiliate the king, often by having him
kiss his donkey’s rump.
Some medieval fabliaux begin by asserting the ‘ truth’ of the story that follows;
hence, it is interesting that some contemporary legends relate fabliau-like plots that
‘ really happened.’’ In ‘The Nude Birthday Party,’ for example, a would-be philan-
derer is taken home by his secretary. Assuming a conquest is forthcoming, he strips
naked and jumps through a doorway, only to find that his wife and friends have
arranged a surprise party for him there.
The fabliau in the modern sense is best characterized as a narrative that plays
with the bounds of public decency, both in its subject and in its style. Most of the
modern examples deal with potentially obscene themes but in ways that leave them
suitable for ‘ polite’’ mixed audiences. Thus, perhaps the hallmark of the genre is its
ability to deal with sexual or scatological topics through clever indirection rather
than directly through vulgarity.
Bill Ellis
90 | Anthropological Approach
symbol of cunning and of hypocrisy, two aspects of evil, one of the major preoc-
cupations of medieval culture.
Michele Simonsen
See Also Animals; Trickster.
References
Hines, John. 1993. The Fabliau in English. London: Longman.
Lyons, John D. 1989. Exemplum: The Rhetoric of Example in Early Modern France
and Italy. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Mann, Jill. 2009. From Aesop to Reynard: Beast Literature in Medieval Britain.
Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Mosher, Joseph Albert. 1911. The Exemplum in the Early Religious and Didactic Lit-
erature of England. New York: Columbia University Press.
Terry, Patricia. 1983. Renard the Fox. Boston: Northeastern University Press.
Anthropological Approach
the study of narrative and other oral forms, and there have been a number of
widely accepted structural analyses of conversational genres such as riddles and
proverbs. Claude Levi-Strauss’s paradigmatic structuralism—the quest for
underlying deep structures (usually sets of binary oppositions)—was extremely
popular for a period of time in the middle of the twentieth century. Levi-Strauss
claimed that his sets of binary opposites were universal and reflected the basic
nature of human thought. The theory had become less influential and widely
accepted in folklore by the 1990s.
Benedict’s insistence that all spheres of culture are meaningfully related pro-
vided a rationale for approaches attempting to discover how folklore functions.
The idea that all forms of folklore satisfy some important psychological, social,
or cultural function is a basic axiom of most folklore research.
Symbolic anthropology, interpreting symbols in the context of the processes of
social and cultural life, is another anthropological approach to folklore. Victor
Turner disagreed with the rigidity and conformity that he felt had become a part
of structural and functional anthropology and argued instead for an analysis of
symbols. Turner and other symbolic anthropologists saw symbols as conscious
and unconscious representations and objects of power. His method and his insist-
ence upon interpreting symbols from the broadest possible perspective as com-
plex data reflecting multivalence and condensation have been widely accepted as
an anthropological approach to folklore; moreover, his approach is yet another
way of saying, as did Benedict, that all cultural traits have meaning. Anthropol-
ogy in general, throughout its long history, has studied man; folklore has studied
the products of the human imagination; and symbolic anthropology studies the
products of the human imagination in order to understand man.
Anthropology and folklore both developed and changed over their histories
from Tylor to Turner. Folklore continued to broaden its field of study, method,
and theoretical orientations as it developed as a discipline. Since the 1990s, func-
tional, structural, and symbolic anthropology has been part of anthropological
approaches to folklore. A major feature of the discipline of folklore since the last
decades of the twentieth century is the fact that it is eclectic. Most folklorists pur-
sued research in terms of a limited number of topics, but most recognized as an
ideal a truly complete anthropological approach. This approach would examine
people of all cultures as revealed by research methods emphasizing the firsthand
experiencing of material culture, custom, and oral lore.
Many American folklorists and American graduate programs have defined
their field of study not in terms of lore—item or genres—but in terms of anthro-
pological approaches to folklore. Over the last 20 years, folk cultural field
research has concentrated upon people and their lore and is one of the most com-
monly used methods for dissertation research in major American folklore gradu-
ate schools, and for that reason, such research is apt to be one of the most
94 | Anthropology, Symbolic
References
Ackerman, Robert. 1991. The Myth and Ritual School: J. G. Frazer and the Cam-
bridge Ritualists. New York: Garland.
Benedict, Ruth. 1934. Patterns of Culture. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Dorson, Richard M. 1972. Concepts of Folklore and Folklife Studies. In Folklore
and Folklife: An Introduction, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Geertz, Clifford. 1973. The Interpretation of Culture. New York: Basic Books.
Kroeber, A. L., and C. Kluckhohn. 1963. Culture: A Critical Review of Concepts
and Definitions. New York: Vintage Books.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1963. Structural Anthropology. New York: Basic Books.
M€uller, Friedrich Max. 1856. Comparative Mythology. In Oxford Essays. London:
John W. Parker.
Propp, Vladimir. 1984. Theory and History of Folklore. Minneapolis: University of
Minneapolis Press.
Turner, Victor. 1967. The Forest of Symbols: Aspects of Ndembu Ritual. Ithaca, NY:
Cornell University Press.
Tylor, E. B. 1873. Primitive Culture. Vol. 1. London: John Murray.
Anthropology, Symbolic
The study of the nature of the symbols used in different cultures, in ritual, in per-
formances, and in daily life where full meaning requires more than literal expres-
sion. A symbol has two components—a solid, visible, or otherwise sensory sign
and the idea to which it points. Symbolic anthropology interprets symbols in the
context of the processes of social and cultural life.
In the history of the symbolizing process, investigators are able to trace sym-
bolization to Homo erectus, who lived a million to a hundred thousand years
ago, before Homo sapiens. Symbolization was evidenced in the signs of ocher
pigment on the bones of these earliest hominids. Later (ca. 35,000 to 19,000
years ago), the caves of Lascaux and Altamira were filled with pictures of sha-
manic scenes, pictures that themselves are thought to have been objects of
power. Human beings appear to possess a predisposition for symbolization
(indeed, this trait is shared by some animals). The practice of producing an
Anthropology, Symbolic | 95
Prehistoric painting of a bull (which appears to be wounded), one of about 600 Paleolithic-
era paintings found at Lascaux Cave near present-day Dordogne, France, in 1940. (Corel)
alternative object to the ordinary one—a picture of a bull, for example—is deep
in the techniques of ritual and usually goes beyond representation. There exists
the ordinary object, the bull, and the picture of it—two things thrown together.
Within the depiction lies not only meaning and ideological message, a teaching
device, but also actual sacredness and efficacy. The nature of the sacredness is
very hard to determine.
The use of the word symbol was first known to have appeared in ancient
Greece, though undoubtedly a reflexive process about what we call symbols was
afoot much earlier. Certainly, the history of the concept is considerably older
than the discipline of anthropology. The word symbol itself derives from the
Greek sym, meaning together, and ballein, meaning to throw—that is, two things
thrown together. A pair of friends would mark their alliance by breaking a pre-
cious token in half, whereupon each treasured one of the halves as a mark of
identification. The Church took up the Greek idea of a mark or symbol and
termed the creed itself a symbol. Later, the Church developed a field of symbolic
theology in which symbol began to take on its present meaning based on the mys-
teries inherent in a religious object—its double nature, outward and inward.
Symbolism came under the close attention of thinkers during the romantic
movement in the nineteenth century, mainly in the theorizing of Johann Bachofen
(1815–1887)—specifically, his notion of an original ‘‘mother right’’ among early
96 | Anthropology, Symbolic
humanity and his theory that the symbolism of funerary rituals was related to fer-
tility. However, as we have seen, symbolism in the activities of the world’s peo-
ples was flourishing for ages without scholarly analysis. It is how we look back
on symbolism now that appears to determine our definitions. We already see two
ways of looking at symbols—as a mark or really a sign and as having power—
which Jung as a scholar began to recognize in the early twentieth century in his
work on the living symbol and dream archetypes. In modern religious studies,
Mircea Eliade held that symbols are true parts of religion itself; he pointed out
that an ordinary object could become genuinely sacred while remaining just the
same as it is.
Clearly, to obtain an unbiased view of symbolism, only genuine participant
study can pinpoint what is actually going on, even at such simple occasions as a
folk wedding or when a hunter takes an animal.
Within the discipline of anthropology, the basic thinking on symbolism was
founded on the concepts of Emile Durkheim and his school centered in France in
the first decade of the twentieth century. Durkheim taught the primacy of the
social in symbolic analysis and held that symbols were always social representa-
tions. Durkheim even attempted to bring theology down to earth by claiming that
symbols were the building blocks society constructed for itself for the task of
deifying itself. After Durkheim, the study of symbolism became ramified and di-
vided, notably in the work of the folklorist Arnold van Gennep, who broke free
of Durkheim’s strictures by drawing attention to the liminal, in-between phase in
rites of passage, that no-man’s-land beyond the provenance of normal social
structures and their self-deifying tendencies.
Others, notably the linguist Edward Sapir, began to reveal the complexity of a
symbol as multivalent, that is, possessing many meanings and condensing them.
David Schneider, a down-to-earth functionalist and authority on kinship and mar-
riage, showed how the major (though hidden) symbol driving our conceptions of
kinship and marriage was semen itself, at the core. In the 1930s and 1940s, the study
of kinship became central in anthropology. (Interestingly, kinship studies have been
vindicated by contemporary theorists working on the symbolism of the body.)
Then Victor Turner appeared on the scene, breaking from the sole focus on
kinship and social structure and resuscitating van Gennep’s work from the obliv-
ion it had suffered while most anthropologists were following the course of struc-
tural functionalism, which taught, as Durkheim had, that symbols serve the main
structures of society and follow them in style. Turner claimed a distinctly crea-
tive and different character for the symbols of rites of passage—liminal symbols,
as he termed them; these symbols might even carry a revolutionary message,
subverting social structures while sheltered in that temporarily antistructural
phase of the rite of passage. Turner became the principal analyst of symbolism in
anthropology, emphasizing—and here he followed Durkheim—that symbols
Anthropology, Symbolic | 97
were factors in social processes. However, he argued that these processes were
not necessarily structure-bound.
In his analysis of the symbol itself, Turner exposited the important likeness
between the symbolic object (the signifier) and its meaning (what is signified).
Symbols were semantically ‘‘open’’: The meaning was not absolutely fixed.
Turner saw how a symbol might become an independent force that was a product
of many forces, even opposing ones. He was much influenced by the symbolic
anthropologists, psychologists, and other theorists who went before him—Freud,
with his polarization of the symbol into the ideological pole and the sensory pole
of meaning (Turner cited the example of the Ndembu initiation symbol, the
‘‘milk tree,’’ whose sensory pole was the bodily and emotional experience of
milk and whose ideological pole, dynamized by the sensory pole, connoted the
tribal virtues and the principle of matriliny), and also Jung, with his insight that a
live symbol works and possesses power when pregnant with meaning but dies
when it is dissected and analyzed. On the basis of this insight, Turner realized
that there is no need for participants to render into words what symbols say, for
symbols transmit their messages in a number of sensory codes simultaneously.
Yet Turner himself analyzed. He followed Sapir in his discovery of the multiva-
lence and condensation of meaning in dominant symbols. He noted conscious
and unconscious levels in the symbols’ meanings. He perforce had to alternate
between regarding symbols as representations and as objects of power. He
described the shrine pole of the Ndembu hunters of Zambia as not so much an
object of cognition, a mere set of referents to known phenomena, but rather as ‘‘a
unitary power,’’ the slaughterous power of the hunter spirit itself. His analysis of
symbolism stood, whether he took the representationist view or the power view.
Other symbologists abounded. Raymond Firth pointed out that the relation
between the two elements of a symbol, the signifier and the signified, was that of
concrete to abstract, particular to general. Claude Levi-Strauss saw symbols as
key items in the universal cognitive structures of the mind. Clifford Geertz’s defi-
nition of a symbol, similar to Firth’s, was ‘‘any object, act, event, quality, or rela-
tion which serves as a vehicle for a conception.’’ He explained how symbols are
layered in multiple networks of meanings and warned that the symbols of each
culture should be studied in situ, without attempting a universalist theory. Mary
Douglas was a universalist, regarding symbols as corresponding to the attitudes
held by a culture toward the human body—which is very much a basic universal.
Further hints of the independent character of symbols have appeared. Roy Wagner
showed how symbols become independent entities, ever obviating themselves in
new forms. He became interested in the way a percept in the brain may be formed at
some central location in the visual system by using stimuli that could not possibly
produce that percept at an earlier, more primary location. The percept requires its
own special, internal ‘‘retina’’ for the formation of the image. In other words, a
98 | Anthropology, Symbolic
percept with its rich meaning—a symbol, for instance—arrives in human minds as a
manufactured item produced in its own peculiar way. Wagner said that this
‘‘abstracting’’ process is not the kind of abstraction that produces items useful in
logic and the like but is part of the generative and ongoing process of complex sym-
bol production itself. This appears to be parallel to the processes that produce poetry.
Barbara Babcock pointed out an important characteristic of symbols in festi-
vals and celebrations that is of particular interest to folklorists: a well-marked
surplus of signifiers—multitudes of symbols produced to bespeak the meaning of
the celebration in an exuberantly fantastic multiplication of color, cloth, masks,
costumes, and fireworks, even to the point of indeterminate nonsense. This sur-
plus creates a self-transparent discourse that mocks and subverts the monological
arrogance of ‘‘official’’ systems of signification. Here are hints of Victor Turner’s
‘‘antistructure,’’ which, he said, is the mark of the rite of passage; there are also
reminders of Mikhail Bakhtin’s praise of the vitality of the people’s second life,
as expressed in Rabelais and His World.
Another extension of symbol theory comes from Don Handelman’s work on
the symbolic type, again of significance in the study of folk festivals. The sym-
bolic type may be a Hopi clown, the wau (a disreputably disguised uncle in Iatmul
initiation in New Guinea), a lascivious old man figure in Pakistani weddings, or
the hobbyhorse intruder muddling the neat figures of Morris dancing. There are
many examples in folklife literature of this clumsy, contradictory figure, often
suggestive of overfertility; it is a figure that will not stabilize like the respectable
gods of the Hopi, for instance, or the royals in Midsummer Night’s Dream. The
fool figure classically appears within the boundaries of rites of passage or yearly
rites, demonstrating uncertainty and also process itself, and thereby it is able to
shift ritual occasions through their sequential phases.
Another school, that of critical anthropology and postmodernism, looks at
modern symbolism under the rubric of commodity fetishism, including the sym-
bolism of store goods, advertising, and land development, as displayed in the
contemporary popular scene.
Meanwhile, in the most contemporary discussion, the Africanist Michael Jack-
son has held that the controversial question of whether the effect of a symbol is
objective or subjective should be subsumed under the performance and experi-
encing of the ritual process—thus downplaying the word symbol as a nonissue: If
one actually experiences ritual, mere representation is left behind. Is symbology
really the way to study human ritual or action sequences of deepest fundamental
importance? Robert Desjarlais has looked back on a generation of anthropolo-
gists who worked under the guiding assumption that culture consists of networks
of symbols and webs of significance, so much so that later ethnographers even
considered human bodies as texts, emotions as discourses, and healings as sym-
bolic. He has argued that here we have drifted away from experience of the body.
Anthropology, Symbolic | 99
We must go back and consider ritual direct, from the plane of the body and not
as interpreted through the mind.
In short, an anthropology of the senses is emerging that is returning to the study
of bodily experience. And paradoxically, we are gaining an even richer under-
standing of what we have called symbolic objects. Our understanding is richer
because the object (such as a sacred tree, a ritual food, or perhaps a song) may be
given a deeper respect—a respect that ethnographers (and certainly the people
themselves) often have actually felt, with something like Rudolf Otto’s awe. We
may now be able to accept that, for example, the whale meat from the self-sacri-
ficing spirit being, the whale, is both bodily delicious and charged with the
whale’s spirituality—a direct process in which representation has no part. This
brings symbolism out in its full dimensions; we see no cutoff point where logic
steps in and says, this is only blubber.
From this summary, incomplete as it is, the depth and diversity of thought on
symbols in anthropology can be inferred. Symbols are all around us. To para-
phrase Vasilii Kandinsky, there is no form, there is nothing in the world, that
says nothing.
Edith Turner
See Also Anthropological Approach; Freudian Psychology; Jungian Psychology; Phe-
nomenology; Semiotics.
References
Babcock, Barbara. 1978. Too Many, Too Few: Ritual Modes of Signification. Semio-
tica 23: 291 302.
Desjarlais, Robert. 1992. Body and Emotion: The Aesthetics of Illness and Healing
in the Nepal Himalayas. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Douglas, Mary. 1966. Purity and Danger. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Durkheim, Emile. [1911] 1954. The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life. Lon-
don: Allen and Unwin.
Firth, Raymond. 1973. Symbols: Public and Private. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University
Press.
Geertz, Clifford. 1973. The Interpretation of Culture. New York: Basic Books.
Handelman, Don. 1990. Models and Mirrors: Towards an Anthropology of Public
Events. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1963. Structural Anthropology. New York: Basic Books.
Turner, Victor. 1967. The Forest of Symbols: Aspects of Ndembu Ritual. Ithaca, NY:
Cornell University Press.
Turner, Victor, ed. 1982. Celebration: Studies in Festivity and Ritual. Washington,
DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Wagner, Roy. 1986. Symbols That Stand for Themselves. Chicago: University of Chi-
cago Press.
100 | Antiquarianism
Antiquarianism
References
Bourne, Henry. 1977 (1725). Antiquitates Vulgares; or, The Antiquities of the Com-
mon People. New York: Arno.
Brand, John. 1777. Observations on Popular Antiquities: Including the Whole of
Mr. Bourne’s Antiquitates Vulgares. Newcastle: J. Johnson.
Thoms, William J. 1846. Folk-lore. Athenaeum (August 22): 862 863.
Appalachian Folklore
as in-between ranges, most notably the Black Mountains); the Valley and Ridge
Province (incorporating the Great Valley of the Appalachians and featuring a
network of rivers and ridges); the Alleghenies (located primarily in West Vir-
ginia, western Maryland, and western Pennsylvania); the Cumberland Mountains
(a range on the Virginia–Kentucky border known for its coal deposits); and the
plateau (collectively referred to as the Appalachian Plateaus, including the coal-
rich Cumberland Plateau of eastern Kentucky and eastern Tennessee).
Because its mountains block eastward-drifting air carrying moisture from the
Gulf of Mexico, the Appalachian region generally receives more rainfall than do
the lower elevation areas to its west or east. Frequent rain, the region’s temperate
climate, and its wide range of elevations have encouraged considerable diversity
of plants and animals. The first human inhabitants of Appalachia were aboriginal
people who lived in the region during the Paleo-Indian period, approximately
10,000 years ago. During the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries CE, Europeans
in Appalachia—first, Spanish and, later, French and English explorers—encoun-
tered two Native American tribes: the Cherokee and the Shawnee. European
groups who settled on the Appalachian frontier during the eighteenth century—
Scots-Irish, English, German, French Huguenot, Swiss, and Welsh—engaged in
warfare with Native Americans before the American Revolution, then co-existed
peaceably in southern Appalachia for several decades through the late 1830s,
when the Cherokee were forced to march to Indian Territory by the federal gov-
ernment during the notorious Trail of Tears. Historically, Appalachia’s distance
from population centers, combined with the region’s mountainous terrain and
extensive forestland, necessitated that settlers from Europe learn survival tech-
niques from indigenous peoples as well as from settlers of other ethnicities. For
instance, Scots-Irish settlers, when arriving in Appalachia, had little prior experi-
ence living in wilderness, having previously dwelled in deforested, densely
populated Ulster. Hence, they needed to learn hunting-gathering and woodcraft
techniques from members of other ethnic groups—specifically, Cherokees and
Germans—already in Appalachia. Each of the aforementioned ethnicities con-
tributed to the repository of folkways used and shared in Appalachia.
The primary migration route for the European settlement of Appalachia—from
central Pennsylvania southwestward into Virginia, then through the Great Valley
of the Appalachians into North Carolina—created the historical circumstances
that led to the mixing of cultural influences. In the early eighteenth century, Ger-
mans from eastern Pennsylvania established many of the first farmsteads along
Virginia’s Shenandoah River. During this same era, economically marginal peo-
ple of English descent ventured westward from the Virginia Tidewater over the
Blue Ridge into the fertile Shenandoah Valley. By the mid-eighteenth century,
Scots-Irish immigrants, also journeying from eastern Pennsylvania, bypassed that
104 | Appalachian Folklore
already occupied valley for available properties on the slopes of the Virginia and
North Carolina Blue Ridge.
From the early eighteenth century through the late nineteenth century, most peo-
ple of European ancestry residing in rural Appalachia maintained a largely self-
sufficient way of life combining various food-producing folkways (foraging, hunt-
ing, stock-raising, and crop-farming) with such traditional trades as blacksmithing,
gunsmithing, and woodworking. Before the twentieth century, most products—
whether wagon axles, tools, quilts, musical instruments, or moonshine—were
handmade within home communities or were obtained through bartering.
Religious Beliefs
Belief systems within Appalachia were based on Protestant Christianity (even
the region’s Native American groups such as the Cherokee had embraced Euro-
pean faiths), and yet many Appalachian people observed traditional beliefs struc-
tured around non-standardized interpretations of Christian doctrine. Folk
religions emerged and proliferated in Appalachia because of the region’s long-
standing geographical remoteness from population centers. Beginning in the
mid-eighteenth century, members of several European Protestant denomina-
tions—including German Dunkards, Mennonites, and Amish—intentionally set-
tled in Appalachia to preserve their anti-establishment belief systems in relative
distance from mainstream society. As a general rule, rural Appalachian commun-
ities relied on formally untrained, sometimes illiterate preachers whose interpre-
tations of scripture were inherently esoteric. Embracing the teachings of such
preachers, sects prospered with little or no obeisance to mainline churches. Most
such sects were fundamentalist, reflecting strictly literal readings of the Bible.
Several Baptist sects in Appalachia, for instance, practiced such traditional
Christian rituals as full-immersion baptisms in rivers and creeks (metaphorical
re-creations of Christ’s baptism in the River Jordan) and footwashing (based on
John 13: 14–15). Serpent handling, another Appalachian ritual from a biblical
source, allegedly emerged in the early twentieth century after east Tennessean
George Went Hensley was directed by God in a vision to take literally lines of
scripture from the Book of Mark (16: 17–20), which urged believers to ‘‘take up
serpents’’ and to observe other ‘‘signs’’ in order to prove their faith. A small num-
ber of Pentecostal and Holiness congregations in Appalachia and the wider South
subsequently incorporated the handling of snakes into special worship services,
during which time congregations also engaged in displaying other ritual ‘‘signs’’
of faith, including poison-drinking (most often strychnine) and fire-touching (for
example, hot coals or a lit torch).
Some facets of the Appalachian belief system evolved from non-Christian
influences, reflecting traditional secular ideas about causal relationships between
two phenomena or two actions. Most so-called superstitions involved notions
Appalachian Folklore | 105
The Reverend Dewey Chafin takes a poisonous snake out of its box, May 15, 1992, in
Jolo, West Virginia. (Getty Images)
knowledge base. Some rhymes were verbal components of traditional games for
children. In many parts of the region, folk sayings have historically been painted on
handmade signs to make public pronouncements of religious conviction.
The first myths told in Appalachia were Native American creation stories, some
of which were documented by white ethnologists (most notably James Mooney,
who collected, transcribed, and published Cherokee myths). Virtually all the myths
held sacred by whites in Appalachia were from Judeo-Christian sources. Many
white settlers in Appalachia told local legends that communicated the significance
of places (for instance, the mysterious lights seen near Brown Mountain in the
North Carolina Blue Ridge), events (such as the railroading disaster commemo-
rated in the song ‘‘The Wreck of the Old ‘97’’), or people (such as Daniel Boone).
Historically, folktales abounded in Appalachia. Most of these oral narratives ei-
ther related seemingly supernatural occurrences or endeavored to explore human
morality (overtly through stories about human characters or covertly through
anthropomorphic, fable-like ‘‘animal’’ stories). The best-known cycle of folktales
associated with the region, the Jack tales, originated in the British Isles. Absorbing
certain American traits, including mountain settings, Jack tales also retained Euro-
pean elements, including such traditional characters as giants, devils, and kings.
The protagonist of these tales was a poor Appalachian boy named Jack, a trickster
figure who outsmarted all who would oppress him. Several tales from this cycle,
especially ‘‘Jack and the Bean Tree,’’ became widely popular in the twentieth cen-
tury after members of the Hicks, Harmon, and Ward families—whose ancestors
first told Jack tales in western North Carolina during the eighteenth century—
shared their versions with folklorists and writers (most crucially, Richard Chase),
who disseminated the Appalachian Jack tale repertoire to the American public.
celebrated a historic event (for example, Gold Rush Days in Dahlonega, Georgia);
or honored a prominent individual associated with the region (the John Henry
Days Festival in Talcott, West Virginia). Today, Appalachia not only hosts the
longest-running annual folk music festival in the United States (the Mountain
Dance and Folk Festival, held in Asheville, North Carolina, since 1928), but also
the nation’s largest music festival (Merlefest in Wilkesboro, North Carolina).
mills, were all likely based on designs brought by German settlers from Pennsylva-
nia. Historically, one of the more distinctive barn designs built in Appalachia was
the cantilever barn, today still visible in a few eastern Tennessee and southwestern
Virginia counties. This design, accommodating Appalachia’s topography, allowed
farmers to carry crops grown up the slope directly onto the barn’s second floor for
storage and also permitted the easy loading of crops onto wagons parked on the
barn’s first floor. To protect crops and control animals, people in Appalachia built
fences—generally out of wood, since that was more accessible than stone. Two gen-
eral types of wooden fences were dominant in Appalachia—picket and split-rail, the
latter of which was probably a variation of a Scandinavian prototype.
Given the abundance of trees in the region, Appalachian craftspeople created
an array of furniture—tables, chairs, stools, benches, and beds—for their own
use according to localized traditional designs. Furniture makers in Appalachia
utilized only basic tools—axes, saws, knives, braces, and bits—and often worked
without nails, screws, and glue, yet they built furniture of lasting quality using a
system of tightly fitted, interlocking wooden parts. Also made from wood were
containers (including baskets, bowls, and boxes); decorative figurines; toys
(stilts, tops, limberjacks, and whimmy diddles); and musical instruments (fiddles,
banjos, dulcimers, and whistles).
Some common toys in Appalachia—such as dolls and cornstalk construc-
tions—were built from materials other than wood. Additional regional crafts
included shoes (generally incorporating leather produced at home), clothes (wo-
ven on the loom from local wool), and quilts featuring a range of designs from
the highly structured Log Cabin design to the essentially random Crazy Quilt.
Food
Appalachian foodways combined European food traditions with those borrowed
from Native Americans. The earliest European settlers in Appalachia survived
by hunting wild game (primarily deer and bear), fishing, gathering wild plants
(including berries, nuts, roots, leaves, stems, and edible mushrooms and fungi),
and growing cultivated vegetables (corn, beans, pumpkins, and squash) obtained
from Native Americans. As the availability of wild animals decreased as a result
of over-hunting, Appalachian people began to depend upon the meat of domesti-
cated animals, primarily pigs, cows, and chickens. In addition to the aforemen-
tioned foodstuffs, people in the region ate orchard fruits (especially apples and
cherries), enjoyed sweeteners (primarily honey and molasses), and drank various
beverages (ranging from milk, tea, and cider to various liquors—whiskey being
the most popular—brewed in local stills). Historically, cooking was done either
in outdoor fire pits or indoor fireplaces, and cooking paraphernalia (racks, hooks,
pokers, shovels, pots, and pans) were made from iron obtained outside the com-
munity but crafted by local blacksmiths.
Appalachian Folklore | 111
References
Billings, Dwight B., and Kathleen M. Blee. 2000. The Road to Poverty: The Making
of Wealth and Hardship in Appalachia. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
112 | Appalachian Folklore
Cavender, Anthony. 2003. Folk Medicine in Southern Appalachia. Chapel Hill: Uni-
versity of North Carolina Press.
Conway, Cecilia. 1995. African Banjo Echoes in Appalachia: A Study of Folk Tradi-
tions. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Crissman, James K. 1994. Death and Dying in Central Appalachia: Changing Atti-
tudes and Practices. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Dabney, Joseph Earl. 1998. Smokehouse Ham, Spoon Bread, & Scuppernong
Wine: The Folklore and Art of Southern Appalachian Cooking. Nashville: Cumberland
House.
Drake, Richard B. 2001. A History of Appalachia. Lexington: University Press of
Kentucky.
Dunaway, Wilma A. 1996. The First American Frontier: Transition to Capitalism in
Southern Appalachia, 1700 1860. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Eller, Richard D. 1982. Miners, Millhands, and Mountaineers: Industrialization of
the Appalachian South, 1880 1930. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
The Frank C. Brown Collection of North Carolina Folklore. 1952 1964. 7 vols. Dur-
ham: Duke University Press.
Gainer, Patrick W. 2008. Witches, Ghosts, and Signs: Folklore of the Southern Appa-
lachians. Morgantown: West Virginia University Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1968. Pattern in the Material Folk Culture of the Eastern United
States. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Green, Archie. 1972. Only a Miner: Studies in Recorded Coal-Mining Songs.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
McNeil, W. K., ed. 1995. Appalachian Images in Folk and Popular Culture. 2nd edi-
tion. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Montell, William Lynwood. 1993. Upper Cumberland Country. Jackson: University
Press of Mississippi.
Montgomery, Michael, and Joseph S. Hall. 2004. Dictionary of Smoky Mountain
English. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Mooney, James. 1992 (1900). History, Myths, and Sacred Formulas of the Chero-
kees. Asheville, NC: Bright Mountain Books.
Olson, Ted. 1998. Blue Ridge Folklife. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi.
Shapiro, Henry D. 1978. Appalachia on Our Mind: The Southern Mountains and
Mountaineers in the American Consciousness, 1870 1920. Chapel Hill: University of
North Carolina Press.
Sharp, Cecil J., and Maud Karpeles, eds. 1932. English Folk Songs from the South-
ern Appalachians. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Suter, Scott Hamilton. 1999. Shenandoah Valley Folklife. Jackson: University Press
of Mississippi.
Whisnant, David E. 1983. All That Is Native and Fine: The Politics of Culture in an
American Region. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Wigginton, Eliot, ed. 1972. The Foxfire Book. Garden City, NY: Anchor.
Appalachian Folklore | 113
Apparitions
Belief of the supernatural manifestation of the paranormal. Apparitions may
include paranormal beliefs in areas such as ghosts, witches, wizards, vampires,
aliens, phantoms, poltergeists, spirits, saints, demons, or angels. These beliefs
are commonly communicated as ghost lore through the use of folk narrative.
Folklorists examine apparitions through the study of these ghost, or revenant,
narratives, which include subjects such as inexplicable occurrences, spook lights,
campus legends, and haunted places (most commonly a cemetery, haunted house,
battlefield, or ship). These narratives are related by adults and children, of both
the male and female gender in cultures worldwide. The reasons for why they are
communicated, however, reflect a vast subject matter that includes but is not lim-
ited to: environment, culture, ethnicity, community, folk religion, belief system,
or the individual. Revenant narratives have characteristics of being only slightly
dramatic, having unfitting rational explanations, manifest for a specific reason,
and have been firmly established in a particular place.
Unlike other folk narratives, the subjects of apparitions cannot be confirmed
as either fiction or nonfiction, depending on what they are being communicated
to reflect. In a folk religion, apparitions of the manifestations of a saint, an angel,
or a spirit are meant to be interpreted as true and absolute. In another folk cul-
ture, such as the children folk group, the sharing of narratives of vampires,
witches, and ghosts are a form of play, and are in this instance portrayed as fan-
tasy, or as subjects for jokes or riddles. Some apparitions are seen as instances of
applied folklore, for in many cases apparitions are used as reasoning for perplex-
ing circumstances, such as the movement of inanimate objects or an inexplicable
recovery from a terminal illness.
Aside from their appearance in folk narrative, apparitions can also be depicted
in folk art. Artistic renditions of saints, religious icons, incarnations, and spirits
are widespread subjects of folk art, seen in a variety of decorative art forms, such
as the various portrayals of Jesus Christ in the Christian religions. Other examples
include the folk art of the Vodun religion and related religions of Umbanda or
Quimbanda, which depict various spirits and demons, incorporated into the folk
practices of these groups.
Subjects of supernatural appearances have deep historical backgrounds, and
many of these have been transformed from cultural memories into popular cul-
ture. In American folklore, for example, the secular holiday of Halloween has
roots in both the Celtic festival of the dead, Samhain, and the Christian All Saints’
114 | Applied Folklore/Folkloristics
References
Brunvand, Jan H. 1978. The Study of American Folklore: An Introduction. 2nd ed.
Toronto: W. W. Norton & Company.
Dorson, Richard M. 1972. Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction. Chicago: Univer-
sity of Chicago Press.
Goldstein, Diane E., Sylvia A. Grider, and Jeannie B. Thomas. 2007. Haunting Expe-
riences: Ghosts in Contemporary Folklore. Logan: Utah State University.
Goodman, Felicitas D. 1988. How about Demons? Bloomington and Indianapolis:
Indiana University Press.
Applied Folklore/Folkloristics
regionalist Thomas Hart Benton included folksong themes, fiddling, and other
Ozark folklife in his murals and lithographs.
Folklore has long been manipulated for political purposes. In 1630, the king of
Sweden decreed that ancient traditions be documented; as records of the way of
life in ancient times, they would demonstrate to older European countries that
Sweden, too, had a long history. The Antiquities Council, founded in Stockholm
in 1666, implored the local clergy to gather old narrative songs because they con-
tained ‘‘much truth about the heroic deeds of the forefathers.’’ Nineteenth-cen-
tury nationalism motivated some of the folklore collecting in Germany, Finland,
Ireland, and other countries suffering from outside cultural or political domina-
tion. In the twentieth century, Nazi Germany exploited the Aryan myth, Soviet
Russia promoted folklore for its propaganda value, and Communist China
attempted to indoctrinate children through folksongs, dance, and puppetry. On
the other side of the coin, labor and civil rights activists and social reformers
have used folklore to educate, agitate, and rally people to a cause.
Folklore was also used to help immigrants adjust to their new social environ-
ments. Jane Addams established Hull House in Chicago in 1889 as a place where
people could gather to celebrate familiar holidays, dress in traditional costume,
sing the old songs, and reminisce. In 1900, she created a labor museum with tools
and products, photographs, and demonstrations. By showing similarities in crafts
and work, the museum linked various nationalities, revealed a continuity in expe-
riences from the native country to the new, and bridged the gap between immi-
grants and their children. Phyllis H. Williams, who interviewed and observed
more than 500 Italian immigrants over eleven years’ time, published a volume in
116 | Applied Folklore/Folkloristics
1938 on southern Italian folkways in Europe and the United States. A handbook
for social workers, medical personnel, and teachers, the work surveyed both Old
World and New World traditions and advised the reader on how to ease the
adjustment of families and individuals. In the 1940s, Rachel Davis DuBois, a
social worker, utilized folklore in schools to increase understanding among peo-
ple of different ethnic backgrounds. Dorothy Mills Howard created child devel-
opment programs through which children became aware of the folklore process
and how it operated in their lives and communities.
Public agencies in the United States have played a role in applied folklore,
from the Bureau of American Ethnology (founded in 1879) to the Archive of
Folksong (established in 1928 and renamed the Archive of Folk Culture in 1981)
and the Works Progress Administration’s Federal Project Number One, which
operated between August 2, 1935, and August 31, 1939. The latter included folk-
lore documentation, festivals, or publications by the art, music, theater, and writ-
ers’ projects in addition to the Historical Records Survey. During World War II,
the National Research Council created the Committee on Food Habits, dedicated
to the belief that studies of ethnic and regional customs revolving around food
were crucial to solving nutritional problems.
More recently, three federal organizations have been active in folklore applica-
tions in the United States. The Office of Folklife Programs at the Smithsonian
Institution sponsors research, exhibits, films, and publications as well as a Festival
of American Folklife (established in 1967), defending this annual event for its ad-
vocacy on behalf of cultural equity. The National Endowment for the Arts’ Folk
Arts Program (founded in 1974) funds local traditional festivals, workshops, dem-
onstration programs in schools, and other activities that present folk art and
artists, in part to help perpetuate traditional art forms, skills, and knowledge. This
organization also provides the first years of funding for folk arts coordinator posi-
tions in arts councils; by the late 1980s, fifty of the fifty-six states and territories
and several cities had hired people to document and present traditional arts, per-
formers, and craftspeople. In 1976, the American Folklife Preservation Act estab-
lished the American Folklife Center as the country’s first national agency devoted
to the study, preservation, and presentation of folk culture. Located in the Library
of Congress, the center provides technical assistance, carries out model documen-
tary projects, and organizes public forums in the name of cultural conservation.
The folksong and folk dance revivals of the 1950s and 1960s brought many to
the halls of academe seeking information, resources, and training. Some became
scholars; others continued to pursue careers in the arts as singers, musicians, puppet-
eers, dancers, choreographers, directors of folk dance troupes, radio programmers,
creative writers, journalists, editors, filmmakers, and consultants to the entertain-
ment industry (advising on costume, dialect, sets, and scripts). Folklore studies com-
plement and supplement arts training by providing: knowledge about varied forms
Applied Folklore/Folkloristics | 117
and examples of folklore through time and space; familiarity with bibliographical
tools and archive resources; and an understanding of the historical, social, cultural,
and biographical contexts in which folklore is generated and perpetuated. Arts prac-
titioners enrich their repertoires, tend to be more concerned with authenticity, and
usually add an interpretive, educational dimension to entertainment.
Many folklorists find employment in public agencies such as state arts coun-
cils, city cultural affairs divisions, and parks and recreation departments (some-
times referring to their specific field as ‘‘public folklore’’ or ‘‘public sector
folklife programming’’). They locate and document the behaviors of individuals
who are the active tradition bearers. Through films, tape recordings, festivals,
exhibits, publications, and interpretive programs, they honor local artists and per-
formers, educate the public about the community’s history and culture(s), and
foster intergroup communication and cooperation. Apprenticeship programs and
venues for showcasing artists help perpetuate the traditions. Attention to folklore
in these agencies democratizes support of the arts and enlarges the public served.
The same is true for museums of art, history, and science and industry in
which folklorists have found employment as curators and directors. Those
trained in folklore studies know their way around archives and historical collec-
tions, can establish the traditionality and cultural representativeness of objects,
and are able to discern and communicate the meanings, symbolic significance,
and functions of the things that people make. With their interviewing and obser-
vation skills, folklorists can elicit information from resource persons while locat-
ing and presenting craft demonstrators for educational programs. Oriented to the
documentation and study of traditional, expressive behavior in everyday life,
folklorists are well suited to working in living- history museums and community
cultural centers, and they can help prevent or overcome elitist tendencies in other
museums. Their efforts and emphases assist established residents in valuing their
heritage, newcomers in understanding what daily life was like for early settlers,
and tourists in comprehending the social and cultural forces shaping the region.
Increasingly, teachers, curriculum planners, and educational consultants are
seeking training in folkloristics and utilizing folklore materials and folkloristic
methods. Effectiveness in the multicultural classroom requires that a teacher
communicate with those whose heritages differ from one another’s and from the
teacher’s own; the teacher must also discover what the various traditions are and
uncover fundamental similarities. Learning to do folklore fieldwork develops
these skills. Student fieldwork projects promote experiential learning, nurture the
enjoyment of discovery, and can help reduce intergroup stereotyping and disso-
nance as individuals learn about each other. The sharing of folklore in the class-
room establishes common ground between the student and teacher, among the
students, and between generations when class assignments involve the student in
conversations with younger siblings or with parents and grandparents.
118 | Applied Folklore/Folkloristics
to develop adequate measures of their success. The fact that so much program-
ming in the folk arts depends on a few governmental agencies (and the decisions
of their directors) raises concerns over the exercise of power and control. Folk-
lorists in the private sector must guard against misapplication or abuse of their
findings. Efforts at cultural resources management or economic development
may disrupt some segments of a community while benefiting others. Folklorists
have resolved some of these issues through the use of a partnership approach or
participatory action research in which the impetus for programs or inquiry origi-
nates with the community or organization, representatives of all interests are
included, and collaboration occurs to understand the problems and to plan and
take action.
To conclude, applied folklore has evolved from a simple and sometimes simplis-
tic use of folklore forms and examples per se to the discipline of applied folkloris-
tics with a body of theory, methods, and techniques that establishes research
problems and hypotheses along with a code of ethics. From the inception of their
field two centuries ago, folklorists have focused on populations often ignored by
others (children, the elderly, various ethnic groups), providing a forum through pub-
lications, exhibits, festivals, and films for underrepresented groups or individuals
and their traditions. Some folklorists have become activists on behalf of particular
groups (such as Alice Fletcher, the first woman president of the American Folklore
Society [1905], who studied the lore of the Winnebago and Omaha and lobbied for
the passage of federal legislation giving Native Americans greater control over their
lands). Whether they work in academe or applied fields, folklorists are trained to
identify, document, analyze, and present forms and examples of traditional symbolic
expression in which ordinary people engage in their everyday interactions. They
appreciate these traditions and respect the bearers of them. They understand and can
interpret the historical, social, cultural, and biographical circumstances of traditional
behavior. With such skills, knowledge, and abilities informed by values and philoso-
phy, folklorists are particularly suited to both pursuing theoretical research that
increases understanding of the species and participating in applications that improve
the quality of life and benefit the welfare of individual members.
Michael Owen Jones
See Also Occupational Folklife/Folklore; Organizational Folklore; Public Sector
Folklore.
References
Baron, Robert, and Nicholas R. Spitzer, eds. 1992. Public Folklore. Washington,
DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Bauman, Richard, Patricia Sawin, and Inta Gale Carpenter. 1992. Reflections on the
Folklife Festival: An Ethnography of Participant Experience. Indiana University Spe-
cial Publications of the Folklore Institute, no. 2. Bloomington, IN.
Arab Gulf States Folklore | 121
Camp, Charles, ed. 1989. Time and Temperature: A Centennial Publication of the
American Folklore Society. Washington, DC: American Folklore Society.
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1961. Folklore Research around the World: A North Ameri-
can Point of View. Indiana University Folklore Series, no. 16. Bloomington, IN. Also
published as a special issue of Journal of American Culture 74(294).
Feintuch, Burt, ed. 1988. The Conservation of Culture: Folklorists & the Public Sec-
tor. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Jackson, Bruce, ed. 1989. Teaching Folklore. Rev. ed. Buffalo, NY: Documentary
Research.
Jones, Michael Owen, ed. 1993. Putting Folklore to Use: Essays on Applied Folklor-
istics. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Loomis, Osmond, coordinator. 1983. Cultural Conservation: The Protection of Cul-
tural Heritage in the United States. Washington, DC: Library of Congress.
Sweterlitsch, Dick, ed. 1971. Papers on Applied Folklore. Folklore Forum Biblio-
graphic and Special Series, no. 8. Bloomington, IN.
Wilson, William A. 1976. Folklore and Nationalism in Modern Finland. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Gulf Arabs pride themselves on their cultural traditions and folklore, emphasiz-
ing the need to disseminate information not only to educate the young, but also
to encourage cultural understanding between expatriates and locals. Folklore is
literally the ways, beliefs, and crafts of the folk, which in the Gulf context trans-
lates to the Bedouin. However, much of the folklore associated with the Bedouin
emerges as the foundation of nationalism within the Gulf’s recently formed
states. Common symbols, such as the falcon or date palm, decorate everything
from house gates to government institutions to currency. Heritage centers bring
to life key symbols, weaving stories of the past while demonstrating material cul-
ture: women weave tents and speak about life in the oasis, while men demon-
strate falconry or traditional dances such as the sword dance.
Throughout the major cities of the Gulf states, cultural symbols in the form of
public monuments dot major intersections and traffic circles, heralding the heri-
tage of the region. In downtown Doha, next to the site of the new national
library, stands a large pillar with a statue of an oryx (a type of gazelle), paying
tribute to the state’s wildlife and Bedouin past. Omani traffic circles display
giant statues of everything from coffeepots and cups, which symbolize Bedouin
and Arab hospitality, to Omani-styled chests, which are unique in the region
and reflect numerous influences, including the presence of the Portuguese. Both
Bahrain and Qatar have pearl monuments in Manama and Doha, respectively. Mod-
ern architecture also pays homage to the past through the incorporation of symbolic
122 | Arab Gulf States Folklore
Bedouin dancers perform the Arda, a traditional war dance using swords, in Abreq, Ku-
wait, 2003. (Getty Images)
elements. Numerous buildings are built in the shape of ships, recalling the impor-
tance of the sea. In Dubai, the famous Burj al-Arab (Tower of the Arab) hotel
evokes the image of a ship replete with a white sail, while the new Etisalat (the
United Arab Emirates [UAE] state-owned telecommunications company) building
stands with its bow facing a major intersection. Likewise, wind tower motifs are also
popular in new construction, branching off from the roofs of houses and other struc-
tures. With the convenience of air-conditioning, the wind tower is no longer needed
for cooling but is instead used as a decorative architectural element. Many other
symbols, including the khanjar (dagger), camel, bukhoor (incense burner), and
dhow, enjoy popularity as a reference to tradition.
Pearls occupy a special place in local folklore because of the region’s former
pearl-diving industry. Pearls are considered items of beauty and value; some people
also think pearls have mystical powers for healing or finding a lost love. Pearl div-
ing demanded much strength and fortitude from the divers; they spent large periods
of time away from their families, and the job itself was physically taxing. With a
stone attached to his foot, a peg attached to his nose, and wax stuffed into his ears,
the diver plummeted to the sea bottom, where he quickly filled a basket with shells.
After a tug, the diver was then pulled to the surface, where the shells were emptied
onto the boat (Gillespie 2006; Seery 1993). The naham, or performance leader, led
the men in fidjeri, or sea-faring songs, particular to pearl divers. Punctuating the
rhythmic songs were the drum and hand clapping. The songs provided the divers
with motivation as they called out together, singing songs of their toil. People also
Arab Gulf States Folklore | 123
tell stories about the origin of the pearl. In Bahrain, parents tell their children that a
mermaid’s teardrop fell into an oyster shell and created the pearl.
Many folkloric traditions revolve around the safety of the individual and espe-
cially how to ward off evil spirits, or djinn, from oneself and one’s family and
community. Taboos and amulets protect those considered especially vulnerable
(pregnant women, children, and the sickly). In the UAE, pregnant women wear
amulets with verses of the Quran, which is thought to shield them and their
unborn children from danger. Moreover, the pregnant woman and some of her
family members observe a number of taboos such as avoiding looking at an ugly
person or animal, lest the child develop a resemblance; being shielded from bad
news; and not walking alone at night unless armed with an iron knife, which is
thought to protect against evil (Hurreiz 2002, 86–87). Some groups treat a child
for forty days with smoke from khatf, a seed that is thought to protect against the
evil eye. The belief in spirit possession, or zar, is not in accordance with Islam,
yet many people continue to believe that spirits can cause harm and take one’s
soul. Certain places are deemed especially dangerous; Oman’s inner mountain
area is reputed to be a place where djinn collect the souls of visitors.
Before the twentieth century, modern medicine was quite rare in the Gulf
states, and thus people relied on four different types of folk healers: al-mutabbib
(the traditional healer), al-ashshab (the herbalist), al-daya (the midwife), and al-
mutawwa (the Muslim religious leader). At other times, others played minor
roles. For example, the village barber might perform a circumcision, or other
healers might specialize in animals. Everyone was expected to have a general
knowledge of herbs and practices for the treatment of common problems such as
coughs and diarrhea. However, when more serious ailments arose, it was time to
turn to particular kinds of folk healers, who were considered specialists in differ-
ent areas (Hurreiz 2002, 108).
Two commonly practiced forms of traditional healing were bloodletting (al-
hijama) and curing by iron (al-kay). There are varying forms of bloodletting, from
incisions, similar to surgical procedures, to minor procedures, where blood is not
forced from the body. In curing by iron, the healer places a hot iron rod next to the
afflicted area. This practice has similarities to branding, which is used to mark the
ownership of animals (called al-wasm). Both bloodletting and curing by iron cured
everything from backaches to whooping cough and are considered part of pro-
phetic medicine, a body of literature that details the incorporation of medical prac-
tices within Islam (Hurreiz 2002, 108–109). Herbalists used the many available
plants and perfumes to cure disease as well as to encourage good health, while
midwives attended to gynecological disorders and obstetrics. Religious leaders
were consulted for what would be considered problems of the mind and/or soul.
Rebecca L. Torstrick and Elizabeth Faier
See Also Arabian Nights; Ethnic Folklore.
124 | Arabian Nights
References
Gillespie, Frances. 2006. Discovering Qatar. Rimons, France: Creative Writing and
Photography.
Hurreiz, Sayyid Hamid. 2002. Folklore and Folklife in the United Arab Emirates.
London: Routledge.
Seery, Gail. 1993. Kuwait: A New Beginning. Dubai: Motivate.
Arabian Nights
The Thousand and One Nights, in English commonly known as The Arabian Nights’
Entertainments or, in short, the Arabian Nights or simply the Nights, was originally
an Arabic collection of stories that has become an integral part of world literature
ever since its French translation (1704–1717) by Antoine Galland. Rather than
denoting a specific book, the Arabian Nights imply a phenomenon, since the work
is both anonymous and authored by many contributors over an extended period of
time, and since its character as a shape-shifter has led to numerous differing versions
in Arabic manuscripts and printed texts, as well as in European translations.
Textual History
The History of the Arabian Nights before Galland
European Orientalist research has brought forth various arguments for an Indian
and/or Iranian origin of the collection that later materialized as the Arabian
Nights. An Indian origin is suggested by the fact that Indian versions of the tales
given in the collection’s frame narrative, including the stratagem of telling tales
to prevent death, predate the Arabian Nights. An Iranian origin may be surmised
from the Persian background of the main characters in the frame tale (King Shah-
riyar and his brother Shahzaman, Sheherazade and her sister Dunyazade) and
from the fact that the earliest-known references to the Arabian Nights explicitly
mention a Persian-language predecessor. These references have been preserved
in the works of Arab historian al-Mas’^ud^i (died 956) and Baghdad bookseller Ibn
al-Nad^im (died 995). Both authors state that the Arabic book Alf layla (A Thou-
sand Nights) derives from an earlier Persian book named Hez^ ar afs^
an (A Thou-
sand Stories). Ibn al-Nad^im also mentions details of the work’s frame tale in that
a king used to marry a young woman every day only to kill her the next morning,
and that Sheherazade by telling him stories for a period of a thousand consecu-
tive nights reformed him and finally convinced him to quit this bloody habit by
showing him their child. The references do not, however, mention the actual con-
tent of those tales. This content is, albeit summarily, intimated by a paper frag-
ment dating from the ninth century and preserving the first pages of The Book of
the Tale of the Thousand Nights. Here, a certain Dinazad asks Shirazad (for She-
herazade) if she is not asleep, to tell her a story and give ‘‘examples of the excel-
lencies and shortcomings, the cunning and stupidity, the generosity and avarice,
and the courage and cowardice that are in man, instinctive or acquired, or pertain
to his distinctive characteristics or to courtly manners, Syrian or Bedouin.’’
While none of the actual tales are quoted in the fragment, the description, only
to some extent, matches the content documented in later Arabic manuscripts.
Evidence for the physical existence of the Arabian Nights is found in the note-
book of a Jewish physician who also sold, bought, and lent out books in mid-
twelfth-century Cairo. The notice pertains to a book called The Thousand and
One Nights and thus bears testimony to the fact that the collection’s elaborate
title as known today had come into use. The oldest preserved text of the Arabian
Nights is contained in a three-volume Arabic manuscript that most probably
dates from the middle of the fifteenth century. The manuscript, which was
acquired and used by Galland for the first part of his translation, is fragmentary
and contains the beginning of the Arabian Nights up to night 282, breaking off at
some point in the ‘‘Tale of Qamar al-Zam^an and Bud^ur.’’ Besides this manu-
script, fewer than a dozen Arabic manuscripts predating Galland are known. In
addition to these, early Turkish translations of the work were available in the
Royal Library in Paris when Galland prepared his translation.
published in the nineteenth century are those prepared by Edward W. Lane and
Richard Francis Burton. Lane’s translation, published in three volumes in Lon-
don (1839–1841), largely follows the Bulaq I edition.
While prepared by an excellent scholar of Arabic, the translation submits itself
to Puritan Victorian morality by eliminating various objectionable scenes and
even complete tales. Lane’s translation is, moreover, supplied with profuse and
often distracting ethnographic annotation, since he intended the book to be read
as a mirror of Arabic customs. Burton’s translation was published in ten volumes
in ‘‘Benares’’ (London, 1885–1886). While profiting to a considerable extent
from the previous limited English edition by John Payne (1882–1884), Burton
took pleasure in employing archaic language and in stressing, rather than sup-
pressing, any sexual undertones or explicit scenes to be found; in particular, his
‘‘Terminal Essay’’ is notorious for his predilection with sexual matters.
While the bulk of his translation is based on the Calcutta II edition, he later
published a six-volume installment of ‘‘Supplemental Nights’’ (1886–1888) con-
taining additional tales from other versions of the Arabian Nights. A third Eng-
lish-language translation was published by Powys Mathers (1937) based on the
French version prepared by Joseph Charles Mardrus in sixteen volumes in Paris
(1899–1904). Even though it has been reprinted numerous times until today, this
translation is the least faithful to the Arabic original, as it contains numerous addi-
tions from a large variety of different sources, particularly in its later volumes.
Meanwhile, the Mardrus version was widely acclaimed in France by famous writ-
ers Andre Gide and Marcel Proust and also contributed to the fame of the Arabian
Nights in its English version. Since, according to modern critical standards, none
of the available English versions of the Arabian Nights are satisfactory, Malcolm
C. Lyons and Robert Irwin are currently preparing a new translation.
Characteristics
The various versions of the Arabian Nights differ in content, but particularly in
their later parts, all of them contain both a specific frame tale and a largely iden-
tical initial set of stories. In the frame tale, Sheherazade tells her stories to the
cruel king over consecutive nights. Sheherazade’s stratagem of breaking off her
tales at a critical point not only saved her life but also turned the frame tale into a
powerful engine driving a potentially endless number of stories. Some of the ear-
lier tales are closely linked to Sheherazade’s own intention of saving her life by
telling stories, such as the tale of ‘‘The Trader and the Jinn^i,’’ the tales told by the
Qalandars in ‘‘The Porter and the Three Ladies of Baghdad,’’ the tale of ‘‘The
Three Apples,’’ and ‘‘The Hunchback’s Tale,’’ including the tales of the Broker,
the Reeve, the Jewish Doctor, the Tailor, and the Barber. In his programmatic
essay on ‘‘Narrative-Men,’’ Tzvetan Todorov has identified this device as one of
the major individual characteristics of the Arabian Nights: to reveal who they
128 | Arabian Nights
are, the characters relate their experiences by telling stories. In this manner, tell-
ing a story signifies life, and, in consequence, the absence of narrative signifies
death. As the characters are ‘‘merely narrative’’ who must narrate to be able to
live, their storytelling generates the overwhelming abundance of embedding and
embedded tales in the Nights. The device of having characters within a tale tell
their own tales on subsequent levels creates a labyrinthine structure that greatly
contributed to the fascination of the Arabian Nights, particularly among Western
audiences.
As a consequence of the frame tale’s narrative potential, and probably result-
ing from the fact that ‘‘complete’’ manuscripts of the Arabian Nights were not
always available, the compilers of later versions incorporated tales of the most
divergent categories, including folktales, fairy tales, romances, religious tales,
didactic tales, fables, jokes, and anecdotes, many of which are culled from either
classical Arabic literature or from numerous anonymous collections of tales.
Research has classified those tales and their hypothetical origin or integration
into several strata, including an Indian stratum, probably encompassing the
‘‘wiles of women’’ stories about extramarital sexual relations and some of the
fables; an Iranian stratum, encompassing those tales closest to the European
understanding of the fairy tale, in which wonder and magic occur on an unques-
tioned and natural level; a Baghdad stratum, encompassing tales of the Harun-
cycle (see Harun al-Rashid) as well as jokes and anecdotes from the times of
the Abbasid dynasty; and a Cairo stratum, encompassing Mamluk tales of deceit
and roguery.
These strata cannot be clearly separated; the collection rather resembles a pal-
ace, one from whose ruins new buildings were erected at consecutive periods.
Moreover, several originally independent tales or collections were at some point
integrated into the Arabian Nights, such as the Persian Sindbad-Name (also
known in the West by way of its Latin version Dolopathos), the tales of Sind-
bad’s travels (already integrated into a seventeenth-century Turkish manuscript),
or the lengthy romance of ‘Umar ibn al-Nu’m^an. Even some European transla-
tors could not resist the temptation to enlarge the repertoire of the Arabian
Nights by adding tales from extraneous sources. Burton added, from an uniden-
tified source, the jocular tale about a man whose breaking wind led to a new
reckoning of time, and Mardrus exploited various works of historical literature
as well as recent contemporary collections of folktales and fairy tales from the
Arab world.
A major characteristic of the narrative universe presented in the Arabian Nights
is the predominance of the ethical values of the merchant class, who probably
constituted the major audience for oral performances of tales from the Arabian
Nights in their indigenous context. This led Aboubakr Chra€bi to classify the Ara-
bian Nights, in allusion to the widespread literary genre of ‘‘mirror for princes,’’
Arabian Nights | 129
Ulrich Marzolph
130 | Arabian Nights
Aladdin
Son of a poor Chinese tailor’s widow, the legendary Aladdin is one of the best-
known characters of The 1,001 Nights. Like many other heroes, he has an unprom-
ising beginning as a lazy good-for-nothing who is one day sought out by a magician
to enter a cave of treasure. In particular, the magician wants Aladdin to bring him a
copper lamp that lies within the cave. The magician gives Aladdin his signet ring as
protection, and the boy enters the cave, eventually coming back to the entrance
with handfuls of treasure. He asks the magician to help him out, but the magician
fears Aladdin is trying to trick him and closes the boy into the cave. Here, Aladdin
accidentally rubs the magician’s signet ring, and a jinni (‘‘genie’’) appears and helps
him return to his mother. Aladdin returns as a much more useful member of soci-
ety, still carrying the copper lamp. He discovers that there is a jinni in the lamp,
who comes to his aid later in the story. One day when cleaning the lamp, Aladdin’s
mother releases the jinni within and their wishes are granted, allowing them to
escape their life of poverty.
With the help of a jinni, Aladdin accomplishes numerous impossible tasks set by
the sultan and marries the sultan’s daughter, Princess Badr al-Budur. One day, the
magician, having heard about the lamp and wanting it for himself, cleverly pretends
to be giving away new lamps for old. The princess unwittingly hands over the magic
lamp, and the magician is able to command the jinni of the lamp to abduct the prin-
cess and transport her to Africa. Assisted by the jinni of the ring, Aladdin pursues
them and is able to rescue the princess and kill the magician.
This is the basic story familiar in one version or another to most people as ‘Alad-
din and the Lamp,’’ staple fare of pantomimes, storybooks, and animated movies,
the majority of which portray Aladdin as Middle Eastern rather than as Chinese.
Scholars have determined that the Aladdin story is a mixture of Asian and Euro-
pean elements.
The poor boy, often as initially worthless as Aladdin, unexpectedly developing into
a hero is a near-universal theme of folktale. Many of the other motifs in the story are
also widespread, including the discovery of a magic object beneath the ground, a mag-
ical lamp that grants wishes, magical transportation by air, and, of course, the happy
ending. These elements have contributed to the longevity and popularity of Aladdin
in many forms of cultural expression, including folklore, literature, theater, and film.
Graham Seal
References
Ali, Muhsin Jassim. 1981. Scheherazade in England: A Study of Nineteenth-Century
English Criticism of the Arabian Nights. Boulder, CO: Three Continents.
Caracciolo, Peter L., ed. 1988. The Arabian Nights in English Literature: Studies in the
Reception of the Thousand and One Nights into British Culture. New York: St. Martin’s.
Archetype | 131
Gerhardt, Mia I. 1963. The Art of Story-Telling: A Literary Study of the Thousand
and One Nights. Leiden: Brill.
Irwin, Robert. 2004. The Arabian Nights: A Companion. London: I. B. Tauris.
Mahdi, Muhsin. 1984 1994. The Thousand and One Nights (Alf Layla wa-Layla)
from the Earliest Known Sources. 3 vols. Leiden: Brill.
Marzolph, Ulrich, ed. 2005. The Arabian Nights Reader. Detroit: Wayne State Uni-
versity Press.
Marzolph, Ulrich, ed. 2007. The Arabian Nights in Transnational Perspective.
Detroit: Wayne State University Press.
Marzolph, Ulrich, and Richard van Leeuwen, eds. 2004. The Arabian Nights Ency-
clopedia. 2 vols. Santa Barbara, CA: ABC-CLIO.
Pinault, David. 1992. Story-Telling Techniques in the Arabian Nights. Leiden: Brill.
Archetype
Word derived from the Greek archetypon, signifying the first stamp, pattern, or
model.
As a term, archetype is instrumental in two major theoretical approaches to the
study of culture: (1) the Finnish School employing the historic-geographic method
toward reconstructing the original form of an international tale type (or other rela-
tively intricate items of lore that exist in a variety of forms); and (2) Jungian ana-
lytical psychology. In the works of the Finnish School, archetype denotes the
reconstructed first form argued hypothetically to be the original form of the item
under scrutiny. The term archetype is also closely linked to the psychological pos-
tulates advanced by C. G. Jung. Jung proposed that a number of primordial images
common to all individuals of a given nation or historical epoch and—to some
extent—to any human being exist in the collective unconscious of the social group
(race). These images are externalized (expressed) in the form of streams of intui-
tive notions, bits of common knowledge, or apprehensions recurrent to mankind.
In this respect, the archetype is analogous to Adolf Bastian’s concept of the ele-
mentary idea (Elementargedanke), which holds that certain thoughts may be gener-
ated independently by different peoples at various time periods due to the psychic
unity of mankind. Jung labeled this phenomenon transcendental imagination.
By their nature, according to this reasoning, archetypes are preexisting deter-
minants of mental/psychological experiences that render an individual disposed
to behave in a manner similar to that manifested by his or her racial ancestors.
Typically, archetypes are primordial potentials for generating thoughts, images,
and emotions (to be differentiated from learned feeling, or sentiments). Arche-
types exist only in the collective unconscious of the individual; they impose
themselves on a person when the conscious mind is inactive and is generating no
images, as during sleep, or when the consciousness is caught off guard, as in
132 | Archetype
telling impersonal tales. They tend to personify natural processes and to present
them in concrete terms—god and devil, life and death, male and female, for
example—a characteristic of mythological imagery. Less pivotal belief-charac-
ters (such as spirits, fairies, ogres, and dragons), as well as abstractions (such as
good and evil) and individuals in the social group (or mother and father), also
serve as prominent archetypes. In daily living, archetypes are experienced as
emotions and mental images associated with such significant events in the life of
a human as birth or death or with a stage in life (adolescence or becoming a man
or woman, for example).
Of the many archetypes Jung designated, four seemed to him to be more recur-
rent, laden with emotional significance, and traceable directly to ancient myths of
origins. Consequently, Jung considered them separate personality systems. These
four are: the persona, the anima, the animus, and the shadow. The persona (or outer-
most aspect of personality) conceals the true self; it is the mask that an individual
wears publicly and is comparable to the concept of role-playing. The anima is the
feminine characteristics in the male. The animus is the masculine characteristics in
the female. The shadow (or darker self) is the inferior, animal-like part of the person-
ality; it is something primitive in our human nature. Yet, the most important arche-
type in Jung’s system is the self; it comprises all aspects of the unconscious and is an
integrative force that provides stability and unity to the structure of personality.
Thus, a cultural account of a hero slaying a monster (dragon) that had
impounded water (Motif A1 111, ‘‘Impounded water’’; AT 300, ‘‘The Dragon
Slayer’’) would signify conflict between life and death, right and wrong, and so
forth; meanwhile, a wager between truth and falsehood (Motif N61, ‘‘Wager that
falsehood is better than truth’’; AT 613, ‘‘The Two Travelers [Truth and False-
hood]’’) would be symbolic of conflict between god and devil, good and evil. Sim-
ilarly, an elaborate folktale in which a youth sets out to learn fear (Motif H1376.2,
‘‘Quest: learning what fear is’’; AT 326, ‘‘The Youth Who Wanted To Learn What
Fear Is’’) and encounters many socially significant individuals and groups, of
whom only one succeeds finally in teaching him fear, would be indicative of the
struggle between individual and society; it is the struggle of a youngster with no
independent social identity seeking to wrest his place in society (represented by
parental authority) by going through the process (archetype) of individuation.
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Historic-Geographic Method; Jungian Psychology; Monogenesis/Polygenesis;
Psychological Approach.
References
Campbell, Joseph. 1949. The Hero with a Thousand Faces. New York: Pantheon.
Jung, C. G. 1916. Psychology of the Unconscious. Leipzig, Germany: Franz Deuticke.
Architecture, Folk | 133
Jung, C. G., and C. Kerenyi. 1969. Essays on a Science of Mythology. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Koepping, Klaus-Peter. 1983. Adolph Bastian and the Psychic Unity of Mankind.
New York: University of Queensland Press.
Stephens, Anthony. 1983. Archetypes: A Natural History of the Self. New York:
Quill.
Van Eenwyk, J. R. 1991. Archetypes: The Strange Attractors of the Psyche. Journal
of Analytical Psychology 36: 1 25.
von Franz, Marie-Louise. 1975. C. G. Jung: His Myth in Our Time. Trans. William
H. Kennedy. New York: Putnam’s.
Architecture, Folk
Regional traditions in building. In the study of cultural traditions past and pres-
ent, folk architecture has found its niche among academic fields that document,
conserve, and interpret cultural heritage. Folk architecture, also known as tradi-
tional or vernacular architecture, values concepts based on enduring patterns that
often express regional or ethnic personality. Tradition is the chosen utilization of
older, agreed-upon, and sometimes transplanted ideas in a new thing. Though
tradition is manifest in every sort of experience, it is the conservative, commu-
nity-based tradition accrued over time and trial that provides the rootstock for
the ordinary structures and landscapes that constitute folk architecture. Research-
ers interested in traditional building study all kinds of domestic, agricultural,
industrial, and sacred structures. Like other expressions of cultural heritage, folk
architecture has patterns and decorations that have evolved over generations of
execution and variation.
When people build, they intend to build structures that look good, whether they
are constructing a new house, a church, or a garden shed. ‘‘Style’’ makes the surfa-
ces of buildings look good in the context of the expectations of the community.
Vernacular architecture operates in a system related to high-style design but sep-
arate from many of its pressures and goals. Traditional architecture continually
changes, even if subtly and slowly, and one can chart the nuances of social and cul-
tural history in the varieties of buildings and their revealing individualized details.
However, though change for the high-style designer means trying to forge
beyond boundaries of popular taste, change in folk design occurs within the flex-
ible boundaries of custom. An 1880s traditional farmhouse in Maine, Iowa, or
California may sport a stylish Gothic dormer window above the front door to
express the owner’s participation in the popular culture of the day.
Folk buildings are not anonymous; their builders simply have not been identi-
fied. All buildings reflect the individual designer, builder, or owner’s personality.
To be conservative is not necessarily to be old-fashioned or resistant to fashions
134 | Architecture, Folk
Windmills in Pyrohiv, Ukraine, home to the outdoor Museum of Folk Architecture and Ru-
ral Life. (Valeriy Barishpolets/Dreamstime.com)
or entire structures as they expand and tinker with their landscapes and take
advantage of local climate and terrain. Construction may depend upon locally
available materials, but even builders in remote areas import construction materi-
als when desired or needed.
Traditional builders acquire most of their skills through apprenticeship, prac-
tice, and emulation of respected models and artisans, rather than through classes
at schools of design. Instead of being called an architect, the maker of a common-
place traditional building was and continues to be called a builder or contractor,
craftsperson, bricklayer, carpenter, and so on. Special cases result in special
names; the group of skilled stonemasons from northern Italy who settled and built
in Paradise Valley, Nevada, were called ‘‘cement men’’ and ‘‘pic-a-pierre.’’
One feature of folk design that differentiates it from high-style design is the degree
to which the client and members of the community participate in the design process.
Forms are often familiar. Neighbors understand what is being built and why. The
contractor knows similar buildings; work is attuned to the needs of the client. People
apply decorative details and variations to give the building special character.
For studies of diffusion and cultural connections, typologies continue to be use-
ful. Typology—classification—is important because, on many levels, form and
surface structure are important. Form is reasonably stable through time and differ-
ent regions and gives the researcher discernible patterns with which to trace routes
of diffusion and variation. Floor plan (horizontal layout) is important because form
is relatively stable over time and scholars can use form to study cultural diffusion.
Looking for background patterns and comparative examples is only one of
numerous approaches to the study of buildings as culture. We can learn about
comparable buildings in other regions, communities, or countries; folk buildings
vary regionally and culturally more than they vary chronologically through time.
In looking at building types, several elements can be documented and ana-
lyzed. In 1968, Henry Glassie implemented a three-part approach to typology, in
which the elements form, construction, and use were employed to classify and
identify different types of houses and agricultural structures with European par-
entage. In 1981, Howard Marshall, a student of Glassie’s, added a fourth ele-
ment, decoration (stylistic detailing), when analyzing folk buildings in the Little
Dixie region of British Missouri. Other scholars concentrate on different ele-
ments, such as function or the decoration that overlays a structure. Although
Glassie, a theoretical and methodological innovator, has also written about new
and different areas of material culture research, his early books continue to be
the basis for many studies.
The hunt for origins and paths of diffusion, the classic approach in examining
folk architecture, usually leads to more questions. Some building types can be
seen as successfully established; other types of structures simply do not take root
in a new environment. We have yet to understand completely why certain
136 | Architecture, Folk
features of folk culture do not get carried to new places. For example, one of the
oldest settings for people and their possessions, produce, and animals is a build-
ing type that comes in two basic forms in the British Isles and Europe—the long-
house and the housebarn. The longhouse has been built for hundreds of years in
the British Isles, alongside separate house and byre farm steadings that devel-
oped in late medieval times. In this long, one-story building that is one-room
deep, the spaces for the family, the dairy, the storehouse, and the beasts are lined
up to form a row of rooms with special purposes. The longhouse or housebarn
tradition is deeply ingrained in the shared cultural heritage of western Europe,
Scandinavia, and the British Isles. However, though a number of distinctive Eu-
ropean and British folk-building elements were carried to the Americas—seen
most clearly and immediately in the prevalence of the ‘‘I house’’ type across Brit-
ish America—the long- house or its continental cousin, the housebarn, was rarely
situated in North America. Finding vast tracts of new land and forest, immigrants
were quick to assert control, order, and ownership. One way of asserting control
was to break apart and scatter the old European longhouse and housebarn over
space into a series of buildings. Perhaps the saga of the longhouse—its interrup-
tion or rejection—helps illustrate the point that ethnic groups, even in substantial
numbers, do not necessarily reestablish old and familiar patterns. People may
adopt and adapt other forms of architecture when the new forms have a good fit
with the character of the group’s sense of place and architectural preferences.
One of the challenges of the folk architecture researcher is to try to disentangle
the various vines of architecture and view architecture’s parts both as reflections
of old folk ideas and as continually evolving new ideas as well.
One may investigate roles played by the Industrial Revolution and the factory
system as factors in the processes of folk architecture. Shifts in technology
brought changes in traditional building. The influence of pattern books and car-
penter’s manuals in the nineteenth century is interesting in terms of the accom-
modations builders made and make still to new tools and techniques that become
widespread nationally. Mail-order house plans for a ‘‘vernacular cottage’’ from a
Sunday newspaper today provide a self-selected style that means much in terms
of private values. Mobile homes (manufactured housing) sell fast in growing
communities not only because they are relatively inexpensive and efficient but
also because their interior spaces and their layer of ‘‘style’’ makes them livable to
people. Prefabricated housing is a very old tradition in the United States; the dy-
namics of a production model speak to folk ideas, or the company loses business.
American folklorists who study folk buildings tend to study those of the colo-
nial period through the mid-twentieth century. Most leave precontact Native
American architecture to experts in archaeology and today’s built environment to
scholars in American studies or anthropology. Yet the entire range of traditional
buildings needs attention, and the increasingly complicated matter of ethnicity in
Architecture, Folk | 137
Field study is fundamental because folk buildings have not been accorded the
historical documentation that high-style buildings have received. Combined with
the recording of the physical scene, including elements of the material culture of
a farmstead or household and the landscape itself, we include oral interviews and
discussions with knowledgeable citizens. To these field techniques can be added
research in public records to establish property histories as well as research in
historical photograph collections, ordnance survey maps, manuscript archives,
museums, and a variety of libraries and repositories.
There always will be debates over terms when describing culture. Many folklo-
rists divide culture into categories reflecting the degree of tradition found among
cultural items in the categories. For example, some use a threefold division of folk,
popular, and elite, as positioned in the literature by Henry Glassie in his pathbreak-
ing Pattern in the Material Folk Culture of the Eastern United States (1968). R.
W. Brunskill posed two categories, vernacular and ‘‘polite.’’ We try to avoid cul-
turally biased terms such as primitive, naive, untrained, and country. Actually,
buildings, each exhibiting different shares of traditionality or progressivist design
(style), can be located somewhere along a horizontal scale from conservative
through commonplace to futuristic. Viewed this way, folk buildings are at the
more conservative, community-oriented, and indeed restrictive end of the scale.
Folk architecture specialists frequently are involved with historical preserva-
tion groups and agencies in their local districts. More and more, preservation
agencies will deal with traditional buildings and cultural landscapes, and the
folklorist’s theories and practical approaches to the study of artifacts in context
will be helpful in the coming years.
Traditional buildings comprise the bulk of the built environment globally and
thus are significant within a broad context. Traditional buildings provide clues to
understanding historical patterns and intersections between methods of design,
form, construction, and function as people alter buildings to meet trends and
changing economies while still finding ways to accommodate them to personal
and aesthetic ideals. Folk architecture’s ideas and preferences are versatile. They
endure and change, and they can be studied through field research and observa-
tion. From Thomas Jefferson’s Monticello to Abraham Lincoln’s log cabin to
Elvis Presley’s Graceland, architecture is a crucial element in our lives. All of us
shape our personal spaces to one degree or another according to deeply held tra-
ditions in our family or community or both. When we have choices, we select
forms and styles in a dwelling that reflect a number of forces in us as people,
whether these forces are obvious and objective—to impress our neighbors, mark
success, or meet a limited budget—or obscure and subjective—for psychological
comfort and safety, order, balance, predictability, or tradition.
Howard Wight Marshall
See Also Material Culture.
Architecture, Folk | 139
References
Brunskill, Ronald W. 1970. Illustrated Handbook of Vernacular Architecture. New
York: Universe Books.
Bunting, Bainbridge. 1976. The Early Architecture of New Mexico. Albuquerque:
University of New Mexico Press.
Carter, Thomas R., and Bernard L. Herman, eds. 1989. Perspectives in Vernacular
Architecture, vol. 3. Columbia: University of Missouri Press.
Carter, Thomas R., and Bernard L. Herman, eds. 1991. Perspectives in Vernacular
Architecture, vol. 4. Columbia: University of Missouri Press.
Cummings, Abbott Lowell. 1979. The Framed Houses of Massachusetts Bay, 1625
1725. Cambridge, MA: Belknap.
Fenton, Alexander, and Bruce Walker. 1981. The Rural Architecture of Scotland.
Edinburgh: John Donald.
Gailey, Alan. 1984. Rural Houses of the North of Ireland. Edinburgh: John Donald.
Glassie, Henry. 1975. Folk Housing in Middle Virginia: A Structural Analysis of His-
toric Artifacts. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1977. Pattern in the Material Culture of the Eastern United States.
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Hubka, Thomas. 1984. Big House, Little House, Back House, Barn: The Connected
Farm Buildings of New England. Hanover, NH: University Press of New England.
Marshall, Howard Wight. 1981. American Folk Architecture: A Selected Bibliography.
Washington, DC: Library of Congress, Publications of the American Folklife Center, no. 8.
Marshall, Howard Wight. 1981. Folk Architecture in Little Dixie: A Regional Cul-
ture in Missouri. Columbia: University of Missouri Press.
Marshall, Howard Wight. 1995. Paradise Valley, Nevada: The People and Buildings
of an American Place. Tucson: University of Arizona Press.
Mercer, Eric. 1975. English Vernacular Houses: A Study of Traditional Farmhouses
and Cottages. London: Her Majesty’s Stationery Office.
Pocius, Gerald L. 1991. A Place to Belong: Community Order and Everyday Space
in Calvert, Newfoundland. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Roberts, Warren E. 1988. Viewpoints on Folklife: Looking at the Overlooked. Ann
Arbor, MI: UMI Research Press.
Smith, Peter. 1975. Houses of the Welsh Countryside. London: Her Majesty’s Sta-
tionery Office.
Upton, Dell, and John Michael Vlach, eds. 1986. Common Places: Readings in
American Vernacular Architecture. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Vlach, John Michael. 1993. Back of the Back House: The Architecture of Plantation
Slavery. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Wells, Camille, ed. 1986. Perspectives in Vernacular Architecture, vol. 2. Columbia:
University of Missouri Press.
Wiliam, Eurwyn. 1986. The Historical Farm Buildings of Wales. Edinburgh: John
Donald.
140 | Archives and Archiving
renamed the Archive of Folk Culture. It is a repository for all formats of ethno-
graphic documentation.
Folklife archives often are research institutions as well as repositories, and
their staffs initiate ethnographic research and compile the collected materials.
Archivists also have found ways to sponsor or support fieldwork in order to add
to their collections. Archivists at universities with folklore programs often en-
courage and preserve student collections. Some are able to provide training in
fieldwork and collections management through internships. Others provide for
the loan of documentary equipment, such as tape recorders, to collectors who
then may place their documentation in the archive.
Folklorists often joke that in order to become an effective field-worker, one
must learn everything there is to know. Folklife archivists must master the skills
of a field-worker and those of archival science as well. Managing materials in
fieldwork situations is practical experience for managing collections in an archive.
But an archivist must be able to preserve and duplicate various media, which may
entail such things as knowing the technical specifications for the preservation of
audiotapes, the chemistry of different types of film, and the methods for conserv-
ing aging manuscripts. Folklife archivists usually are trained folklorists who have
studied archival science or learned it through on-the-job experience. Some also
have training in library science, history, or another related discipline; all should be
familiar with computer networking and database construction.
Archivists first arrange a collection. When possible, mixed-media documen-
tary collection materials are processed together in keeping with the collector’s
intent in compiling them. The documentary goals of the collector are a guiding
principle in organizing and providing access to ethnographic documentation.
This means that the better collections are documented and organized by a collec-
tor before they arrive at the archive, the more thoroughly the collector’s purpose
and method can be conveyed to researchers. Ideally, a collection arrives at an
archive already arranged by the collector. If a collector fails to give the collection
a clear order and it is no longer possible to contact the collector for further infor-
mation (as is often the case with historical collections), the archivist must decide
on an order. This frequently involves attempting to reconstruct the collector’s
purpose as much as possible in order to arrange the materials in a coherent way.
The next step is to preserve collection materials by housing them in protective
enclosures or by duplicating them onto more durable media. Many ethnographic
materials have finite life spans. The primary task of the archivist is to preserve
the information the materials contain through duplication. Duplicates also can be
used as reference copies so that the life of the originals may be lengthened. Fund-
ing is not always available for duplication, and the originals of sound and video
recordings must be preserved because duplicates may lose signal with each gen-
eration. For these reasons, preservation care and storage for the original media
142 | Archives and Archiving
cultural background of songs sung in the 1930s, for example, may be frustrated to
find that the collector of a historical ethnography turned the disc recording machine
off just as the singer began to explain the provenance of the song or that only a few
verses of a long ballad were recorded. But the rest of the information the researcher
seeks may be jotted on the protective disc sleeve or painstakingly written into note-
books. Similarly, photographic documentation of culture changed as photography
became less cumbersome and society became more accustomed to the camera.
Researchers using historical collections need to become aware of what they can
expect to find there and how to gain the most from the materials available.
Changing technology also affected archival practice. In the 1950s, ethnogra-
phers eagerly took up the new medium of reel-to-reel tape recording, allowing
them to record long interviews, cultural events, and ambient sound without con-
cern for duration. But these long recordings posed new problems for the archi-
vist. Formerly, songs, stories, and other short items recorded on identifiable
tracks on discs or cylinders could be readily cataloged. Interviews and other long
recordings collected with tape recorders could not so easily be broken down and
cataloged by item. In addition, as tape recording became inexpensive and tape
recorders became increasingly portable and as the number of scholars in the field
increased, the quantity of recorded folklore documentation contributed to ar-
chives became overwhelming. Increased use of photography and videotape
added to the large bodies of ethnographic documentation that folklife archivists
now needed to preserve and make accessible.
Today, folklore archives often can only catalog collections at a general level.
Archivists typically rely on the fieldnotes, photograph logs, and audio- or video-
tape logs of the folklorists who created the collections they house. Researchers
may be startled to find that materials available through the 1950s have been care-
fully cataloged (complete with song titles, references to individual performers,
and cross-references to other collections) but that the more modern archival hold-
ings are far less accessible. Researchers doing work with modern collections will
need to examine manuscripts of tape logs and fieldnotes of collectors to deter-
mine which recordings will be most useful to their study. Fortunately, in the
1980s, many field-workers began using computers in the field. Computer-read-
able fieldnotes and logs can be entered into archival databases to create search-
able collection information. As technology provides field-workers with better
methods of managing their collections, they will be able to donate more accessi-
ble documentation to archives, making work with the collections far easier for
both archivists and researchers.
The possibilities for data retrieval created by computers are causing many eth-
nographic archivists to change their methods of cataloging materials. In the past,
concern for the care of various documentary formats caused archivists to break
up collections by format: recordings might go to one repository or storage
Archives and Archiving | 145
Historic collections once broken up by format can now be reunited for the
researcher by means of digitized versions of the sound recordings, photo-
graphs, and texts linked together on a multi-media server or CD-ROM.
Online communications are making it possible for archives to share their
collection finding aids and catalog records with the world. A new standard
cataloging format for multi-format collections, Mixed Materials MARC,
makes possible standardized cataloging of ethnographic collections as
whole intellectual works, rather than as separate media. . . .
The computer and information revolutions provide marvelous new possi-
bilities for compiling, preserving, and providing access to ethnographic
collections. However, these new options come at a time when ethnographic
archives are losing funding and staff and are often unable to support the
technology that makes these techniques possible. Archives need computers
to build the databases, staff trained in using them, and staff to develop cat-
alogs and other access tools.
possible, if they receive the intellectual and material support needed to realize
these goals.
Stephanie A. Hall
See Also Academic Programs in Folklore, International; Academic Programs in Folklore,
North American; Applied Folklore/Folkloristics.
References
Bartis, Peter, and Hillary Glatt. 1994. Folklife Sourcebook: A Directory of Folklife
Resources in the United States. Washington, DC: Library of Congress.
Hall, Stephanie, and Lani Herrmann. 1994. The State of the Discipline: Remarks
from the Archiving Section. Report prepared by the Archiving Section of the American
Folklore Society for its report on the state of the discipline.
Hatuala, Jouko, and Urpo Vento. 1965 1966. The Folklore Archives of the Finnish
Literature Society. The Folklore and Folk Music Archivist 8: 39 53.
Kodish, Deborah. 1986. Good Friends and Bad Enemies. Urbana: University of Illi-
nois Press.
List, George. 1972. Archiving. In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed. Richard
Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Stielow, Frederick J. 1986. Relations with the Public and the Law. In The Manage-
ment of Oral History Sound Archives, ed. Frederick J. Stielow. New York: Greenwood.
Art, Folk
The creation of aesthetic forms that emulate or reproduce techniques and designs
taught, learned, and displayed primarily in situations of informal interaction.
Much of what people make in everyday life and the procedures they employ in
making these things are derived from the behavior of predecessors and peers.
With time and repetition, these objects and behaviors become pervasive and
commonplace. When they do, they are thought of as traditional. Rooted in the
past and associated with particular groups or communities, they are called ‘‘folk’’
because of the continuities and consistencies they exhibit in form and design,
materials, or techniques of manufacture.
Art entails the creation of aesthetic forms, that is, products or performances
capable of being perceived by the senses, acting upon people’s feelings, and
being judged according to standards of excellence as well as personal preference
(taste). In principle, folk art comprises both non-utilitarian objects (such as paint-
ings and sculpture) and useful products (crafts and architecture), as well as danc-
ing, singing, and music making. Many researchers, however, limit folk art to
material culture. Some restrict it further to ornamentation, decorative designs,
and sculptural forms lacking utility. Others include useful objects that may elicit
Art, Folk | 147
aesthetic responses in the course of making and using them, such as unadorned
but well-designed chairs or clay vessels, iron or wooden implements, baskets,
duck decoys, musical instruments, fishing flies and lures, and customized cars.
Most folk art belongs to ordinary, day-to-day experiences: the way people dec-
orate their homes and work spaces, dress or adorn themselves, create altars and
ornaments or other objects for holidays, prepare and serve food, and craft such
things as quilts, furniture, pottery, rugs, clothing, toys, gifts for friends, and
paintings of special or memorable events. Some people fashion particular things
as an occupation or preoccupation, becoming noted in their communities as, for
example, carvers, weavers, needlelace makers, boat builders, chair makers,
stonemasons, or makers of headstones and grave markers.
Many non-utilitarian creations display the virtuoso’s skill. One person makes
highly detailed miniature chairs, sofas, and rocking horses from discarded soft
drink cans. Others fashion amazingly lifelike dolls from corn husks or dried
apples and small figurines from concrete. Some build elaborate birdhouses
with fancy trim, carve chains from matchsticks, and construct larger-than-life
animals or small-scale windmills as yard decorations. Certain Native Ameri-
cans in California and Mexico weave decorated baskets no larger than a
fingernail.
Objects intended for practical use also exhibit skill and mastery of technique
and even great ingenuity and virtuosity. Technical excellence in carving a paddle
or wooden buoy, weaving a blanket, preparing a meal, building a haystack or
boat, or setting stones in a fence without mortar suffices to evoke admiration.
One or more formal principles (unity, harmony, rhythm, balance) will likely be
evident, and the product will serve its purpose with distinction. For example, a
rocking chair with a deeply curved back, sculpted armrests to enhance comfort,
and legs at just the right angle to the rockers so that a slight breeze will set the
chair in motion is a joy to use.
Folk art has been studied from four perspectives. One perspective views forms
and examples of folklore as artifacts because they have histories. Hypothesizing
that many examples of traditional objects hark back to earlier eras, some folklo-
rists have conceptualized folk art as survival, continuity, or revival. Survivals are
objects and behaviors known to have been more common historically or more
compatible with former norms rather than with present norms. Living-history
farms, open-air museums, and pioneer villages typically associate folkways,
crafts, and arts with the past. Colonial Williamsburg (Virginia), Upper Canada
Village (Ontario), Skansen Open Air Museum (Stockholm), the Welsh Folk Mu-
seum at St. Fagan’s (Cardiff, Wales), and other sites consist of restored or recon-
structed buildings and period furnishings, tools, and utensils, as well as role-
playing interpreters in costume who discuss life in the past, demonstrate skills,
and answer questions.
148 | Art, Folk
Numerous exhibits and publications also point out the durability of tradition
and the continuity of attitudes, behaviors, and objects. Tourist markets perpetuate
the making of things for which there once was widespread local use. Ethnic dis-
play events perpetuate traditional foods, dances, and crafts from the Old Country.
Activities such as decorating homes, donning costumes, coloring eggs, creating
shrines or altars, and building floats during holidays all help to define events
and make them special. Taking part in traditions creates a sense of continuity
and connectedness with others. Sometimes, people revive or revitalize forms and
designs, such as the making of storytelling dolls among Pueblos, pottery produc-
tion in rural North Carolina, or lei making in Hawaii. Motivations range from
self-esteem to financial benefit and community redevelopment.
A second perspective views folk art creations as describable and diffusible
entities. Folklorists establish genres, such as textiles, metalwork, and ceramics,
in addition to subgenres (pottery, for example, can be further categorized on the
basis of purpose or use—cream pitchers, butter jars, and milk crocks—or accord-
ing to glazes, such as salt, lead, and alkaline). Researchers also configure types
and subtypes from the many examples of houses, barns, outdoor bake ovens,
chairs, garments, rugs, wooden clogs, sickles, harrows, and foods, among other
forms. Questions asked about the distribution of types and subtypes leads to map-
ping, illustrated by Swedish, Austrian, and other European folklife atlases. Rec-
ognition of widespread examples of what seem to be the same design, technique,
or form raises questions about origins. Although folklorists attribute some
designs to polygenesis or multiple origins (for example, variations of a
Art, Folk | 149
problems, loss of a loved one). Physical expression helps objectify complex, uncon-
scious, or vague feelings and issues. Doing something rhythmic and repetitious
when troubled tends to calm, free the mind, or unlock emotions. Once produced,
forms can symbolize achievement, garner praise, and increase self-esteem. Creating
memory paintings, applying craft skills learned in youth at a later point in life, or
making things in traditional ways with or for others can comfort through symbolic
connectedness.
Art triggers aesthetic experiences. A positive response involves physiological
reactions such as muscular tension and release along with a heightened awareness of
form, the subordination in importance of other stimuli, and the suspension of time.
The percipient likely feels a sense of unity with the object and with others. Immer-
sion in pleasurable activities can help resolve tensions and reenergize a person.
Since no society has been discovered without traditions or aesthetic forms and
experiences in everyday life, these behavioral tendencies appear to be inherited
predispositions in human beings. If so, then folk art may be crucial to the adapta-
tion of the species and survival of individual members.
Michael Owen Jones
See Also Craft, Folk; Material Culture.
References
Bronner, Simon J. 1985. Chain Carvers: Old Men Crafting Meaning. Lexington:
University Press of Kentucky.
Eff, Elaine. 1988. The Screen Painters of Baltimore. Direct Cinema Limited. Color,
1/200 , 28 min. videotape.
Ferrero, Pat. 1981. Quilts in Women’s Lives. California State University, San Fran-
cisco. Color, 16mm., 28 min. film.
Fry, Gladys-Marie. 1990. Stitched from the Soul: Slave Quilts from the Ante-Bellum
South. New York: Dutton Studio Books, in association with the Museum of American
Folk Art.
Glassie, Henry. 1989. The Spirit of Folk Art: The Girard Collection at the Museum
of International Folk Art. New York: Abrams.
Johnson, Geraldine Niva. 1985. Weaving Rag Rugs: A Women’s Craft in Western
Maryland. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1989. Craftsman of the Cumberlands: Tradition and Creativ-
ity. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Joyce, Rosemary O. 1989. A Bearer of Tradition: Dwight Stump, Basketmaker. Ath-
ens: University of Georgia Press.
Sherman, Sharon. 1991. Spirits in the Wood: The Chainsaw Art of Skip Armstrong.
University of Oregon. Color, 1/200 , 28 min. videotape.
Vlach, John Michael. 1978. The Afro-American Tradition in Decorative Arts. Cleve-
land, OH: Cleveland Museum of Art.
Arthurian Lore | 151
Arthurian Lore
Traditional narratives and motifs, attitudes, and beliefs associated with Arthur,
his court, and his followers. The legend of Arthur was one of the most productive
themes of medieval literature in Western Europe. Grounded in popular beliefs in
the Celtic-speaking regions of Great and Little Britain—primarily Wales, Corn-
wall, and Brittany—Arthurian tales were adapted first by Norman, Anglo-Nor-
man, and French authors and then by others, especially German and English.
Arthurian lore is preserved mainly in literary narrative genres—histories, vitae
sanctorum (saints’ lives), prose and verse romances, poems—and its stories and
episodes are therefore found at some remove from their primary oral forms.
Nevertheless, though the legend takes many forms in various cultural contexts,
it has some salient features. There is a core Arthurian entourage and a number of
characteristic types of adventure (hunts; quests; journeys to unknown regions;
combats with monsters, giants, hags, or with other knights). There developed an
Arthurian ethos of service and magnanimity centered upon Arthur’s court. But
the two themes that caught the imagination of writers and of their audiences
(leaving aside the related but independent Merlin and Grail legends) were the
abduction of Arthur’s wife Guinevere and, especially, Arthur’s final defeat,
death, and prophesied return. These became the enduring features of the legend,
which developed on the one hand into one of the great tragedies of world litera-
ture and on the other into a symbol of renewal and restoration.
Merlin
Master magician, prophet, and poet first appearing in the Arthurian romances in
the twelfth century, though said to have lived many centuries earlier. Merlin’s con-
siderable presence in Celtic legend, literature, and popular culture is due to his piv-
otal roles in the Arthurian romances, which are themselves the products of an
extensive intertwining of myth, tradition, and literary refinement. Celtic and medie-
val traditions, especially those of Wales, Ireland, and Brittany, include stories of a
prophetic wild man of the woods. In particular, the Welsh version of this story
about an aristocratic poet of the sixth century, Myrddin, is perhaps the most likely
source of the name and character of Merlin. In the 1130s, with his fanciful History of
the Kings of Britain, scholar and early popularizer Geoffrey of Monmouth gave the
Arthurian stories the basic shape in which they have continued. Here, Merlin
appears as prophet and wizard, a role that Monmouth extended (and to some
extent contradicted) in his later Merlin (ca. 1150). From around 1200, French treat-
ments of Merlin and other aspects of Arthurian romance appeared, often mingled
with local traditions and further influencing the development of the romances in
Britain. Sir Thomas Malory’s Morte d’Arthur (1485) presented the defining shape of
the English-language versions of the romances, which are the basis for most of the
considerable subsequent Arthurian treatments and which establish Merlin in his
most familiar modern role as portrayed in fiction, film, and Broadway musicals.
In addition to—though usually independent of—these many literary treatments,
Merlin makes occasional appearances in folklore. In the Tom Thumb tales, for
example, he helps a childless couple bear a child, Tom himself. Merlin also appears
in the ballad ‘ Child Rowland’’ as a magical helper in the quest to rescue the daugh-
ter of Arthur from the underworld, or fairyland. There are local legends concerning
Merlin in those areas of England that cultivate a connection with the larger Arthur-
ian romances, such as ‘Merlin’s Cave’’ at Tintagel, and there are some faint echoes
of a tradition that Merlin was born on the ^Ile de Sein off Brittany. Many of these
traditions may owe their origins and survival more to the needs of the tourist trade
than to the beliefs of local populations.
Considerable scholarly and not-so-scholarly research has been, and continues to
be, carried out regarding Merlin and his important roles in the Arthurian romances.
From a folkloric point of view, he is generally considered to be a literary refinement
of the common folktale character of the magician or wise man. This figure, either
male or female, often occupies an ambiguous space between good and evil, helping
or hindering in sometimes whimsical ways and also often displaying many of the
characteristics of the trickster.
Graham Seal
in modern Welsh orthography), impressed upon it during the hunt for the boar
Porcum Troit. This familiar explanation of a peculiarly marked stone is linked to
another common motif, for though the stone may be removed it always returns to
its original location. The Arthurian association provides a more specific context.
Arthurian Lore | 153
Cafall is Old Welsh for ‘‘horse,’’ and as the name of Arthur’s hound it reflects the
gigantic size of the dog and, by implication, of its owner. These two stories are
the earliest examples of a widespread element in Arthurian folklore, the use of
Arthur’s name to identify topographic features. In 1113, Hermann of Tournai
noted Arthur’s Chair and Arthur’s Oven in the West Country, and there are scores
of later examples throughout Britain. Nevertheless, it cannot be assumed that ev-
ery Arthur’s Seat, Quoit, Bed, or Stone had an onomastic tale attached to it,
though they are certainly evidence of the popularity and magnetism of Arthurian
associations.
and the Fortress of Intoxication—from which only seven men returned. The allu-
sions to the features of the otherworld are similar to those found in early Irish lit-
erature, but the purpose of the voyage was to free a prisoner, Gweir, and to win
the richly ornamented cauldron of the head of Annwfn; kindled by the breath of
nine maidens, its peculiarity was that it would not ‘‘boil the meat of a coward.’’
The same cauldron, now that of Dyrnwch the giant, is listed elsewhere as one
of the thirteen treasures of Britain, all of which appear to be, in origin, other-
world talismans. It seems likely that Diwrnach’s cauldron in Culhwch and Olwen
is another version of the same story, one that seems to have been a common type:
of expeditions to win otherworld treasures—even if, in Culhwch and Olwen, Ire-
land has replaced Annwfn as the site of the cauldron. Taliesin is not usually one
of Arthur’s followers, but a number of other characters named in the list in
Culhwch and Olwen reappear in another early dialogue poem in which Arthur,
seeking entrance at the gate of a fort, is made to declare the worth of his men.
What follows is a catalog of heroes and warriors—pride of place being given to
Cai (Kay) and Bedwyr (Bedivere)—and a series of allusions to their exploits
against human enemies and supernatural monsters and hags. Another poem
describes the heroism of Emperor Arthur in a human battle. Even more allusive
are references to Arthur in the Welsh Triads of the Island of Britain. The general
outlines of the persona of Arthur remain unchanged, but there are hints of an
extensive lost Arthurian literature.
and Hueil, Gildas’s brother; this rivalry also appears in the writings of Gerald of
Wales and survives as a Welsh folktale at least as old as the sixteenth century.
The second is the earliest account of the abduction of Arthur’s wife (called
Guennuvar by Caradog and generally known as Gwenhwyfar in Welsh): Melwas,
king of aestiva regio (the summer country), carries the queen to Glastonbury,
which the author calls Urbs Vitrea (Glass City). After a year’s search, Arthur
learns that she is a captive in Glastonbury and besieges the city to win her back.
Gildas intervenes to have Gwenhwyfar returned to Arthur peaceably. The fact
that the hero saint outshines Arthur by restoring Gwenhwyfar without a fight
demonstrates that this particular version of the story is steeped in clerical values.
Yet the abduction theme recurs constantly in Arthurian literature: in an obscure
Welsh dialogue poem, in the Lancelot of Chretien de Troyes (where the abductor
is Meleagant and the rescuer Lancelot, her lover), and in later romances.
and that ancient songs prophesy his return,’’ a belief that was given powerful
expression when a near riot erupted in Bodmin, Cornwall, because some visiting
monks were foolish enough to voice their doubts, according to the 1113 account
given by Hermann of Tournai. Other twelfth-century writers, including Henry of
Huntingdon, Gerald of Wales, and Etienne de Rouen, refer to this belief, which
was to become the most abiding piece of Arthurian folklore. The earliest narra-
tives of the king’s survival, those of Geoffrey of Monmouth and Wace, tell of
Arthur’s passing to an otherworld island to be healed of his wounds and to await
the hour and occasion of his messianic return. A more popular form of the theme
is the cave legend of the sleeping lord. The earliest of these stories is related by
Gervase of Tilbury in his Otia imperialia (Imperial Pastimes, ca.1211), which
locates the cave in Mount Etna, Sicily, but a sixteenth-century Welsh chronicler
provides the earliest evidence locating the legend in Wales, at south Cadbury.
Romance Traditions
Some familiar Arthurian themes are found for the first time in French romances.
Arthurian stories, and perhaps an Arthurian legend as a frame of reference and
context for them, were clearly well established in early and medieval Britain, as
the narratives and allusions found in Welsh and in Latin attest. Arthurian heroes,
stories, and ambiance apparently had a particular appeal for Normans in England,
Wales, and Brittany, and these were transmitted to the French and Anglo-Nor-
man cultural environments where Arthurian romance, verse, and, later, prose
flourished, but it cannot be assumed that either the plots or all the episodes con-
tained in the romances have a Welsh or other Celtic origin or that anything more
has been borrowed in many cases than a traditional Welsh or Breton personal
name. Wace, in Roman de Brut (Chronicle of Brutus, 1155), is the first to refer
References
Barber, R. 1999. Myths and Legends of the British Isles. Rochester, NY: Boydell
Press.
Bromwich, Rachel, A. O. H. Jarman, and Brynley F. Roberts, eds. 1991. The Arthur
of the Welsh: The Arthurian legend in Medieval Welsh Literature. Cardiff: University
of Wales Press.
Golnick, J., ed. 1991. Comparative Studies in Merlin from the Vedas to C. G. Jung.
Lewiston, NY: Edwin Mellen Press.
Stewart, R. J., and Mathews, J. eds. 1995. Merlin through the Ages: A Chronological
Anthology and Source Book. London: Blandford.
Westwood, J. 1985. Albion: A Guide to Legendary Britain. London: Granada.
158 | Asian American Humor and Folklore
the lack of scholarly attention given to minority humor spurred John McNally to
compile Humor Me: An Anthology of Humor by Writers of Color (2002), which
does contain a few selections by Asian Americans.
Such underrepresentation is not surprising because historically Asian Ameri-
cans have contributed to American humor culture more as targets of mainstream
caricature than as humor producers. From the Chinaman in Cal Stewart’s ‘‘Uncle
Josh in a Chinese Laundry’’ (a classic ‘‘No tickee, no washee’’ scenario) to Long
Duk Dong in the film Sixteen Candles, the image of Asians (and Asian Ameri-
cans) in mainstream America has typically been that of the goofy and incompe-
tent foreigner.
But the current is shifting now that multiple Asian Americans have emerged
as humor producers. Margaret Cho and Bobby Lee, both Korean Americans, are
at the forefront of Asian American humorists, while others are following in their
wake as standup comics, developing their own performance styles and routines.
A pivotal moment in the history of American humor was the victory of the Viet-
namese American Dat Phan in the first season of the comedy competition televi-
sion series Last Comic Standing.
As have those from other minority groups, Asian American comedians have
adopted the tactic of lampooning majority-prescribed ethnic characteristics. For
example, speech accent is a primary source of ethnic humor because it is one
Comedian Margaret Cho performs at the Bonnaroo Music and Arts Festival in Manches-
ter, Tennessee, June 10, 2010. (AP/Wide World Photos)
160 | Asian American Humor and Folklore
the hearts of these Oriental girls’’ who do not conform to the stereotype con-
cocted by mainstream America.
Margaret Cho also works political statements into her standup show. Well
known as an advocate for women’s rights and gay rights, Cho often rants about
social injustices that she attributes to the Republican government. She recounts
that during the George W. Bush administration she was condemned by conserva-
tives for stating that although the president was not Hitler, ‘‘he would be, if he
applied himself’’ (Assassin 2005). For this she was inundated with hate mail that,
rather than denouncing her political stance, attacked her personally on the basis of
her perceived nationality and sexuality. To such a remark as ‘‘Go back to your
country, you fat dyke!’’ Cho replies, ‘‘I can’t go back to my country because I was
born here; I am already in my country,’’ so as to criticize the majority’s tendency
to lump Asians and Asian Americans together into a single category (‘‘Asians’’),
and its inability or unwillingness to distinguish between Asians in America and
Americans of Asian descent. For comedians like Cho, humor is the platform that
allows them to deliver political statements and social critiques.
A tamer brand of humor can be useful for educational purposes. The Minne-
sota-based Hmong comedian Tou Ger Xiong visits schools as a diversity-educa-
tion consultant to perform stand-up comedy and tell stories about his early life in
Laos and Thailand, migration, and experiences growing up in America. Switch-
ing between English and Hmong, he exhibits competence in both American and
Hmong cultures and confidence in his ability to find humor in life’s hardships.
The Hmong are still underrepresented in the Midwest despite the size of their
population, and racial discrimination against them is a grim part of everyday
reality. For minority children it is encouraging to hear a public figure recounting
personal experiences to which they can relate: coping with the trials of growing
up a young immigrant child, being greeted with ethnic slurs such as ‘‘Chink’’ and
‘‘Gook,’’ acing the dilemma of having to be American at school while trying to
be Hmong at home, having to fend for himself because his parents neither spoke
English nor understood what he was going through due to not having grown up
in America themselves. Immigrant and minority children need to learn how to
balance mainstream culture with their household cultures, as they often discover
that their cultural values are incongruent with mainstream norms. Comedians
like Tou Ger Xiong enlighten minority children on the importance of embracing
their own backgrounds, while teaching majority children about the experiences
of their new neighbors and the diversity of people’s lives.
For ethnic humor to be effective, it is necessary that both producer and audi-
ence share an awareness of the differences between majority and minority in the
perception of ethnic characteristics, and it is because of this prerequisite that
studying humor helps folklorists to understand the ways in which group character-
istics are perceived, and group identities constituted. In contemporary American
Asian American Humor and Folklore | 163
Asians and Asian Americans constitute not one coherent group but a mix of
people with varied personalities, in addition to differences in terms of race, reli-
gion, and culture. The success of Asian American humor will depend upon ap-
proval and support from inside as much as upon recognition from outside. The
rest of the century has a lot to look forward to.
Ayako Yoshimura
See Also Chinese Folklore; Ethnic Folklore; Japanese Folklore; Joke.
References
Asmussen, Kerry, and Konda Mason. 2005. Assassin. Videorecording. Written by
Margaret Cho. Cho Taussig Productions.
Cassinelli, Sarah M. 2008. ‘‘If We Are Asian, Then Are We Funny?’’: Margaret
Cho’s All-American Girl as the First (and Last?) Asian American Sitcom. Studies in
American Humor, New Series 3(17): 131 144.
Center for the Study of Upper Midwestern Cultures. Tou Ger Xiong, Hmong Comedian.
http://csumc.wisc.edu/cmct/HmongTour/locations/madison/tougerxiong.htm (accessed July
26, 2009).
Cho, Margaret. 2001. I’m the One That I Want. New York: Ballantine Books.
Dundes, Alan. 1987. Cracking Jokes: Studies of Sick Humor Cycles and Stereotypes.
Berkeley: Ten Speed Press.
Leary, James P., ed. 2001. So Ole Says to Lena: Folk Humor of the Upper Midwest,
2nd ed. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
McNally, John, ed. 2002. Humor Me: An Anthology of Humor by Writers of Color.
Iowa City: University of Iowa Press.
Mieder, Wolfgang. 1996. ‘‘No Tickee, No Washee’’: Subtleties of a Proverbial Slur.
Western Folklore 55(1): 1 40.
Nilsen, Alleen Pace. 2000. Encyclopedia of 20th-Century American Humor. Phoenix,
AZ: Oryx Press.
Oring, Elliott, ed. 1984. Humor and the Individual. Los Angeles: California Folklore
Society.
Oring, Elliott. 1992. Self-Degrading Jokes and Tales. In Jokes and Their Relations.
Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, pp. 122 134.
Oring, Elliott. 2003. Engaging Humor. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Sloane, David E. E., ed. 1998. New Directions in American Humor. Tuscaloosa: Uni-
versity of Alabama Press.
Asian American folklore is an abstract term that employs broad definition of folk-
lore. The term stretches to accommodate the narrative history of Asians in Amer-
ica, Asian ethnic legacy including Asian material culture, religious traditions,
Asian American Literature and Folklore | 165
aliens. The most evident example is found in the case of Japanese internment
camps in both the United States and Canada during World War II. Japanese peo-
ple and American-born Japanese descendents were not distinguished by the
United States and Canadian governments. Such racist treatment of people in
North America influenced the attitudes of many people of Asian descent toward
their Asian heritage. Asian Americans can secure their American citizenship by
‘‘claiming America’’ rather than maintaining their ethnic heritage.
Some Asian Americans claim their America through literary works. Their
writings reflect their desire to be recognized as American with a full membership
in the United States. Amy Tan’s The Joy Luck Club (1989) and Gish Jen’s Typi-
cal American (1991) were written from the assimilationist point of view. In those
books, America was described as a country of utopianist possibilities. Aiiieeeee!
(1974), the first Asian American anthology, accentuated authors’ American na-
tivity and later equivocated to include foreign-born writers. Currently, the label
Asian American has broadened to include writings by Americans of Bangladeshi,
Burmese, Cambodian, Chinese, Filipino, Hmong, Japanese, Korean, Indian, In-
donesian, Laotian, Malaysian, Mongolian, Nepali, Pakistani, Pacific Islander,
Punjabi, Sri Lankan, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese descent.
While early Asian American writings focused on American nativity, Asian
immigrants in the 1960s and 1970s stressed their ethnic legacy. As the 1965 Im-
migration Act resulted in demographic changes, immigrant writers have pro-
duced works with the voices of diverse ethnic origins. Many Asian American
literary works portray immigration and relocation to the United States. A loss or
transmission of the ‘‘original’’ culture is frequently represented in some Asian
American literature. Some American-born Asians have also begun to take
renewed interest in their ethnic ancestry and heritage. In Asian American litera-
ture, cultural nationalism seemed to be important in defending against marginali-
zation. Scholars Oscar Campomanes, Elaine Kim, and Stephen Sumida began to
call for specific forms of cultural alliances. Each scholar put emphasis on the dis-
tinctness of each Asian subgroup in America. Race and nation center around
Asian American construct.
Scholars attempt to adopt an array of theoretical stances in interpreting a text.
To approach a text, readers can use interpretive tools in many ways rather than
one right way. Race and ethnicity are a meaningful category in Asian American
literary studies. Asian American literature that concerns itself with the issues of
ethnicity and race deals with the imbalance of power between dominant white
groups and peoples of color, which is the attempt to change the unequal relation-
ships. Ethnic literary criticisms concern themselves with the reality of people of
color, the opportunities that have been denied them, and racial discrimination
and prejudice that are salient themes in literature that portrays experiences of
Asian Americans.
Asian American Literature and Folklore | 167
that writing for children made him connect with the emotional core of his stories.
It fascinated him and he began to write about what he knew and experienced as a
Chinese American. Yep’s first work for children was Dragonwings (1975),
which resembled the process of self-discovery in exploring his cultural heritage.
Beginning in 1975 with the publication of Dragonwings, Yep chronicled seven
generations of Chinese Americans in the series of The Golden Mountain
Chronicles. The two novels in the series The Serpent’s Children (1996) and
Mountain Light (1985) are about the first group of Chinese ancestors’ adventures
in surviving in the wilderness. In Dragon’s Gate (1993), when the next genera-
tion came to America, they faced the reality of working on the transcontinental
railroad. In that novel, a Chinese boy, Otter, is depicted as the helpless victim
created by adults. The Traitor (2004) portrayed the generational and cultural gap
between Otter and his son, Joseph, and their identity issue between the two cul-
tures. The Red Warrior (2005) depicted the lives of Yep’s father in the Great
Depression of the 1930s. Child of the Owl (1977) and Sea Glass (1979) were
about his own generation, which had lost their cultural heritage rooted in China.
The characters in his novels reach for their dreams while paying with shadows.
Yoshiko Uchida and Laurence Yep wrote books from insider perspectives and
captured the frustration and hardships of Japanese Americans and Chinese Amer-
icans realistically. Their writings depicted the worldview that Japanese Ameri-
cans and Chinese Americans uniquely hold.
Some scholars use psychoanalytic theory to understand representations of Asian
Americans and their identity formation. Kingston’s The Woman Warrior can be
understood from a psychoanalytic lens. Psychological doubles represent two char-
acters: the socially acceptable personality and the uninhibited self. The conven-
tional double results from defense mechanisms of projection, repression, reaction,
and so forth. The defenses are an unconscious mechanism in many cases, and the
extremely positive or extremely negative mechanisms are not controlled.
Another major category in Asian American literary studies is gender and femi-
nist literary criticism, which is also the attempt to resist dominant privileged posi-
tions as in ethnic studies criticism. While disrupting the naturalization of white
male culture, feminist literary criticism is concerned with the imbalance of power
relationships between women and men. This criticism attempts to resist Asian
American historical imbalances between Asian American women and men. Femi-
nist critics have also considered the interaction of gender and race categories in
the construction of Asian American identity. These categories have been con-
structed historically and socioculturally. Kingston’s personal memoir, The Woman
Warrior, is a work of art that could share category of gender beyond racial boun-
daries in the dominant national culture. The novel achieved its literary excellence
with the rise of the feminist approach. The story also contains folkloric elements.
For example, in her fantasy in the section of White Tigers, Kingston is a warrior
Asian American Literature and Folklore | 169
and avenger like Fa Mulan, a female warrior in a Chinese folk legend. However,
in reality, she realizes that she cannot escape from the power of Chinese folkloric
meaning of the place of women among Chinese immigrants. They think that
women are considered to be worthless and entirely dependent on men. At the end
of the story, she decides to use her words as weapons for vengeance.
The ethnic nationalist and feminist phases in Asian American construct were
questioned by newly developed theories, including postmodernism, poststructur-
alism, diaspora, transnationalism, and postcolonialism. Contemporary Asian
American criticism has been engaged with difference and diaspora in poststruc-
turalist discourse. The new theory pointed out the underestimation of heterogene-
ity, hybridity, and transnationalism among Asian Americans. The Asian diaspora
produced writings of transnationals that resist ethnic and nationalistic appropria-
tion. Lin Tai-yi’s The Eavesdropper (1958) provides a critique of historical and
cultural hegemony of China and America. In that novel, native place and exilic
themes are removed, and the national boundaries are blurred. The individual is
attached to a social world without national boundaries or natal place. The novel
contains Confucian morals and Chinese virtues as folkloric elements the main
character has inherited from China. He tries to reconcile himself between the two
worlds with different cultural backgrounds.
Postcolonial theory is used for interpreting writings of Asian immigrants who
come from places like Hawaii or the Philippines. Immigrants from colonized
countries often bring memories of colonialism and inherit colonialism; some
Asian American literature has emerged as a postcolonial phenomenon. Their
local memories signify their colonial history. Today, descendents of imported
Asian laborers in Hawaii vocalize their local memory through fiction, poetry,
and media outlets. Their narratives expose how they inherit colonialism even
when they are free of it. Postcolonial literature comes from a critique of the in-
heritance of a U.S. imperial culture. A similar case is found in Filipino American
literature. It opposes and resists colonial standards. While Filipino American
experiences are viewed as part of diaspora or immigrant writing, Filipino Ameri-
can writings could be read as postcolonial and neocolonial discourse. N. V. M.
Gonzalez’s The Popcorn Man (1993) and Meena Alexander’s Nampally Road
(1991) are written from postcolonial perspectives. Lois-Ann Ymanakas’s poem
Parts (1991), a postcolonial literature of Hawaii, is written in pidgin language
through which the voice of one person speaks to others. Hawaii’s Creole English
as a folkloric element conveys colonial history of local Hawaiians.
Asian Americans who are gay or lesbian seek to voice their opinions and posi-
tions through literature. Queer studies stresses that queer sexuality cannot be
deemed to be downplayed nor culturally produced by the West. They resist ste-
reotypes of queer bodies and sexuality. The Oriental stereotypes define queer
Asian American males as effeminate, weak, and passive, and queer Asian
170 | Asian American Popular Culture and Folklore
References
Adam, Bella. 2008. Asian American Literature. Edinburgh: Edinburgh University
Press.
Cheung, King-Kok. 1997. An Interethnic Companion of Asian American Literature.
New York: Cambridge University Press.
Li, David Leiwei. 1998. Imagining the Nation: Asian American Literature and Cul-
tural Consent. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.
Lim, Shirley Geok-lin, John Blair Gamber, Stephen Hong Sohn, and Gina Valentino.
2006. Transnational Asian American Literature. Philadelphia: Temple University.
Lowe, Lisa. 2004. Heterogeneity, Hybridity, Multiplicity: Marking Asian American
Differences. In Julie Rivkin and Michael Ryan, eds. Literary Theory: An Anthology,
2nd ed. New York: Wiley-Blackwell Publishing, pp.1031 1050.
Yep, Laurence. 2006. Paying with Shadows. The Lion and the Unicorn 30: 157 167.
Wong, Sau-ling Cynthia. 1993. Reading Asian American Literature. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Since the 1960s, Asian Americans have frequently been portrayed as ‘‘the model
minority,’’ a racial group that is uniformly depicted as successfully assimilated to
American (read: Euro-American) culture. To highlight this, Sandra Oh and Kal
Penn have leading roles as likeable doctors on two separate Emmy-winning
broadcast series, Grey’s Anatomy and House, respectively. In 2009, Penn, a New
Jersey native, left House for a position as Associate Director for the White House
Office of Public Engagement. He serves as the liaison within the arts and the
Asian Pacific Islander American communities. These ubiquitous stereotypes of
the model minority stand in direct contrast to previously held dominant images of
Asian Americans in the media as the ‘‘pollutant’’ (a threat to white racial purity in
the mid-nineteenth century), the ‘‘coolie’’ (a threat to white working-class mascu-
linity), the ‘‘deviant’’ (a threat to white sexuality), the ‘‘yellow peril’’ (a threat to
Asian American Popular Culture and Folklore | 171
the American nation), and the ‘‘gook’’ (a slur popularized during the Cold War to
dehumanize Asians). Despite this history of narrow Asian American constructions
in U.S. popular culture, Asian Americans are and always have been a heterogene-
ous group, representing dozens of distinct nationalities (e.g., Hmong, Japanese,
and Vietnamese) to religions (e.g., Christianity, Buddhism, and Muslim) to lan-
guages (e.g., Mandarin, Korean, and Tagalog), cuisines, and spanning across ev-
ery imaginable socioeconomic group.
Generalizing the experiences of Asian Americans as a singular group with a
unified history would be a grave mistake. However, it is important to acknowl-
edge the significance of the term Asian American. It has served as a politically
potent umbrella term for the Asian American community as it challenges the de-
rogatory designation by the Western world to all of Asia as the exotic ‘‘oriental.’’
In the 2000 U.S. Census Bureau count, Asian Americans represented roughly 4
percent of the total population; this figure is expected to more than double by
2050. Compared to other racial groups, they also exhibit the highest rates of out-
marriage and producing interracial children, further complicating what it means
to be, look, or behave ‘‘Asian American.’’ While we recognize the heterogeneity
of Asian Americans, identifiable values and beliefs, or folklore, certainly do exist
in this racial subculture.
Up to the mid-twentieth century, Asian Americans, like other racial minority
groups, have historically been denied citizenship rights in the United States;
these include, but are not limited to, the right to fair wages, to vote, to testify
against whites, to own property, to marry whites, and to become citizens. Mar-
ginalization in the political sphere have contributed to the rising importance of
the cultural sphere, an active site for creation, resistance, and identification for
minority groups who have been historically denied a voice in the political arena.
Today, this voice often transcends the boundaries of face-to-face interactions and
expands globally through technological advances, including satellite broadcast-
ing and the Internet. In this way, folklore is no longer limited to oral traditions
but is captured and transmitted to a global cyberspace audience. Asian Ameri-
cans, in particular youth, are a highly ‘‘connected’’ demographic, technologically
speaking. Many of them are first- and second-generation Asian Americans who
grew up during the proliferation of the Internet, and coincidentally, the globaliza-
tion of mass media, which forever altered the landscape of popular culture by
morphing time and space. As a result, contemporary Asian American popular
culture and folklore are deeply intertwined with each other.
The terms popular culture and mass culture have often been used interchange-
ably. They are both believed to represent the values of ordinary folks rather than
the refined tastes of elites whose social capital (i.e., who they know) and cultural
capital (i.e., what they know) are expected to correlate with their financial capital
(i.e., wealth). Hence, popular culture is more likely to reflect the values of non-
172 | Asian American Popular Culture and Folklore
elites. As such, popular culture serves as a rich site to explore Asian American
folklore, highlighting the mundane traditions of their everyday life to the trans-
mission of their morals and values from one generation to the next. Popular cul-
ture as an examination of folklore reveals a group’s expression of their way of
living, whether it is disseminated through oral tradition (e.g., stand-up comedy),
written narratives (e.g., films), and/or cyberspace (e.g., websites). In no way are
these categories meant to be exhaustive or mutually exclusive. The examples
offered in this summary demonstrate that Asian Americans are not merely con-
sumers of popular culture, but more importantly, producers of it, as well. In
essence, Asian American popular culture as folklore represents the manners by
which Asian Americans express their values and beliefs, or folklore, in a society
that continues to marginalize their existence through the perpetuation of stereo-
types in American mass media. The entry in this encyclopedia examines a cross-
section of Asian American popular culture and folklore, as expressed through
stand-up comedy, film, and the Internet.
as she makes jokes about race, gender, and sexual orientation. Considering her-
self a minority in all these spheres, she suggests her voice is an authentic one and
often takes a subversive stance. For example, Cho confronts the ways in which
Asians are often mocked for having small eyes and asks Anglo-Americans,
‘‘Why your eyes are so big?’’ She turns the table on Anglos by normalizing small
eyes and questioning their big eyes. In another show, she brings up the topic of
the Asian glow that some are afflicted with when they drink alcohol. Cho admits:
‘‘I’m not sunburned, I’m just f*cked up.’’
Unlike ‘‘joke-telling,’’ ‘‘acting’’ as an aspect of folklore has been under-exam-
ined and under-theorized. Hollywood is predominantly white and Asian Ameri-
cans continue to face barriers because of their race. Anna May Wong (1905–
1961) has been heralded for paving the way for Asian American actors. Often
relegated to the limited number of orientalist roles that were commonplace at that
time in the United States, Wong learned to speak with a British accent, as well as
learn French and German in order to acquire work in Europe. In 1935, Wong
rejected a role in the film adaptation of Pearl S. Buck’s novel The Good Earth,
which boasted the largest budget in cinematic production to date. She found it
insulting to be offered the only unsympathetic role in a picture with an all-white
cast portraying Chinese characters; although the use of blackface was becoming
obsolete, the use of yellowface was commonly practiced.
Although Asian Americans are becoming more visible, they still constitute a
minority in Hollywood. Daniel Dae Kim initially considered a profession in
174 | Asian American Popular Culture and Folklore
Film as Folklore
Written narratives, in the form of films, are another way to explore Asian Ameri-
can popular culture and folklore. In particular, two Asian American films have
received notable mainstream success, Joy Luck Club (1993) and Better Luck
Tomorrow (2002). Both films explore Asian American folklore, offering more
nuanced representations of Asian Americans than any other previous mainstream
films. Joy Luck Club, directed by Wayne Wang, was based on a novel written by
Amy Tan and was considered a watershed film for Asian Americans. The film
explored the relationships of four Chinese American women and their immigrant
mothers. Employing a majority cast of Asian Americans, this film received
praise for its portrayal of Asian American women and their family roles. On the
other hand, many Asian Americans criticized the film for its largely negative
portrayal of Asian American men as cold, abusive, and/or undesirable.
Better Luck Tomorrow, written and directed by Justin Lin, is another staple of
Asian American folklore. Lin grew up in Orange Country and attended UCLA
film school. Lin subverted the model minority stereotype by writing about four
Asian American, Ivy League bound, honor roll students who get caught up in a
world characterized by cheating, robbery, drugs, and murder. In this manner, Lin
challenges the unidimensional characterization of Asian Americans as model
minorities, exposing a darker side often left unexplored. Despite the many acco-
lades this film received, some felt it was a betrayal to the Asian American com-
munity. Like Joy Luck Club, Better Luck Tomorrow was subject to criticism for
portraying Asian Americans in a negative light. Most critics overlooked the
larger structural problems facing Asian Americans—that is, the lack of substan-
tive roles in Hollywood.
Asian American Popular Culture and Folklore | 175
References
Davis, Shilpa, Leilani Nishima, and Tasha G. Oren, eds. 2005. East Main Street:
Asian American Popular Culture. New York and London: New York University Press.
Hamamoto, Darrell Y. 1994. Monitored Peril: Asian Americans and the Politics of
TV Representation. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Lee, Robert G. 1999. Orientals: Asian Americans in Popular Culture. Philadelphia:
Temple University Press.
176 | Assault, Supernatural
Nguyen, Mimi Thi, and Thuy Linh Nguyen Tu, eds. 2007. Alien Encounters: Popu-
lar Culture in Asian America. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Rubin, Rachel, and Jeffrey Melnick. 2007. Immigration and American Popular Cul-
ture. New York: New York University Press.
Assault, Supernatural
Attack by a spirit or by spiritual means. The term supernatural has had many
meanings, some of them very complex and culturally specific. However, a cross-
culturally applicable concept can be derived from the simplest common denomi-
nator of the word’s various usages. Most basically, supernatural refers to spirits,
sentient beings that can exist and act without a physical body. Supernatural
assault, then, is assault by spiritual means. This definition is well suited to a
great many folk beliefs, but it does leave an ambiguous category of ‘‘extraordi-
nary’’ creatures who sometimes assault humans, according to certain traditions.
These range from werewolves and other shape-shifters to occupants of unidenti-
fied flying objects (UFOs) who abduct people from their beds. Some believe that
such creatures have spiritual significance, others think that they in fact are spirits
of some kind, and still others believe them to be entirely physical. This uncertain
category will be considered last.
The idea that human beings could be supernaturally injured appears to be both
ancient and ubiquitous. The events taken to constitute such assault are quite
varied, including ordinary illness or injury in which a supernatural cause is
inferred, special classes of illness considered always to result from supernatural
attack in which the evidence of a particular supernatural cause is still indirect, and
experiences in which the perception of the supernatural attacker is a central fea-
ture. Each of these kinds of assault has been associated with practically every sort
of supernatural agent, from witches to ghosts to vampires to demons. The result is
a very complex set of categories, and many of the characteristics attributed to each
kind of attacker differ from one locale to another. A cross-cultural description fol-
lows that sets out rough conceptual categories of supernatural assault found in
many traditions around the world. Each is briefly illustrated with reference to one
or two specific traditions. This process inevitably downplays local, culture-specific
differences. This is a necessary result of summary description and not an indication
that these local variations are of lesser importance. This discussion is presented in
sufficiently general terms to apply to the traditions of most cultures, but it should
be understood that although the general statements that follow refer to widely
found phenomena, they are not necessarily universal in application.
The human soul is supernatural, that is, although it spends part of its career in
a body, it does not require that body for its existence. In some traditions, the soul
Assault, Supernatural | 177
exists before the body and chooses the body in which it will be born. In practi-
cally all traditions, the soul animates the body and survives the body at death,
and under some circumstances, it can leave the body and return during life. In
some traditions, people are believed to have more than a single soul. Supernatu-
ral assault sometimes may produce a direct physical effect, such as bruises or
scratches, but effects on the body are more often seen as operating through
effects on the soul.
During life, one’s soul can be dislodged. The resulting condition of ‘‘soul loss’’
is often called ‘‘magical fright’’ or ‘‘fright illness’’ in the literature because the
condition is often believed to be produced by sudden fear or emotional shock.
The most frequently described tradition of soul loss is the Latin American susto,
but similar traditions are found in many parts of the world. This is usually an ex-
planation attached retrospectively to explain a condition of sickness. The charac-
teristics of such sicknesses are often distinctive, as in the case of susto, and are
probably not merely derived from local names for medically recognized diseases.
Some of them may truly be culture-bound syndromes; others may represent the
recognition of sicknesses not yet known to modern medicine. Many circumstan-
ces can cause soul loss, including such natural events as seeing a terrible accident
or hearing of the unexpected death of a loved one. But this loss also can be
caused by sorcery or by a ghost or other spirit, and then it is a consequence of su-
pernatural assault. In these cases, the person who has suffered the magical fright
may have no memory of the event, in which case the event took place entirely at
the spiritual level.
Another widely believed supernatural cause of illness is the ‘‘evil eye.’’ The
best-known example of this concept is the Italian mat ojo, but the idea is found
in many places. In many versions, an attack by means of the evil eye barely
qualifies as assault because the damage is done unintentionally. Most commonly,
sickness or misfortune is brought on one person by the envy of another. As with
supernatural magical fright, the victim—and in this case, the perpetrator—is
unaware that anything is happening at the time.
Some living persons, because of training or a special aptitude, can leave their
physical bodies and travel as disembodied spirits. In this state, they are believed
to be able to see and interact with other spirits. This technique is used by some
healers to find and bring back a lost soul and cure a case of magical fright. Some
wicked people can travel in soul form to do harm. They may attempt to kill per-
sons or terrify them and disturb their sleep. In English tradition, this is called
‘‘hagging’’ or ‘‘witch riding.’’ The victim is held helpless and oppressed to the
point that breathing becomes difficult.
Normally, a person’s soul ‘‘goes on’’ to the afterlife or to be reincarnated at
death, but some souls remain close to where they have lived or return under spe-
cial conditions. Since this is not the normal course, these ghosts are especially
178 | Assault, Supernatural
likely to be dangerous. Some people with special knowledge and aptitude are
able to cause these ghosts to do their bidding.
Ghosts can assault people in a great variety of ways. Haunted locations are pla-
ces to which ghosts are bound either because of intense attachment during life or
because of the circumstances of their deaths. Whatever the reason, most haunted
places are dangerous. Earth-bound spirits are themselves in a ‘‘sick’’ state (other-
wise, they would have progressed), and their anger, envy, and other negative emo-
tions cause them to accost people who trespass in their places. (It should be noted,
though, that some haunting ghosts are said to be innocuous or even friendly, and
sometimes, a haunting ghost handsomely repays good treatment.) The assaults
committed by such ghosts range from intentionally causing fear by producing
weird sounds and apparitions to effecting a variety of transitory physical effects
and inducing terrible dreams to causing potentially fatal diseases. In animist tradi-
tions, ghosts are not the only spirits associated with particular places; in Southeast
Asia, for example, there are many risks encountered from ‘‘wild spirits.’’
Ghosts sometimes return to particular people rather than places. Their motives
may be very positive but still result in assault. This is the case when a ghost
returns to admonish a parent or spouse who is abusing someone the ghost cared
for in life. Sometimes, a ghostly assault is an act of revenge, visited on a person
who inflicted injury in life. The avenging ghost may strike a person and cause a
cancer to grow at the site of the blow, harass the guilty party into confession, or
otherwise make life miserable. Less severe is the case of a ghost whose purpose
is to force a living relative into a more prudent and honorable life path, as in the
case of the Hawaiian tradition of aumakua, which has been translated as ‘‘behav-
ioral direction visions.’’
A common reason for ghostly return is the absence of proper burial and
mourning. This situation has been especially difficult for some of the refugee
groups who fled Southeast Asia in the 1970s. In the process of fleeing, many rel-
atives were killed under conditions that prevented proper funerary rites, and
many problems, including illness and sometimes death, have been attributed to
the resulting ghostly returns.
An assaulting spirit actually may seek to displace one’s soul in order to pos-
sess the body. Motives for such possession vary, and many traditions allow for
benign possession, as for mediumistic communication between the living and the
dead. But most traditions also acknowledge harmful possession. In Christian tra-
dition, it has generally been believed that demons—fallen angels who were never
in human form—carry out possession of this type. Such non-ghost possession is
found in many traditions, but ghosts also are widely believed to possess the liv-
ing. The act of possession itself may be perceived as an assault in which the vic-
tim struggles and feels an alien spirit entering the body by force, attempting to
push out the soul of the rightful owner. In other cases, the victim is unaware of
Assault, Supernatural | 179
anything but gaps of ‘‘missing time’’ and must have the events of the possession
recounted. During possession, the victim’s body may do antisocial acts or physi-
cally harm itself. Somewhat less intrusive is the attachment of spirits to the living
in a way that influences their behavior, sometimes called ‘‘obsession.’’ In spiritist
traditions, such influences may be either good or bad; for other believers, the
influences are more consistently detrimental. Most traditions have techniques for
identifying harmful spirit possession or influence and treating it by expelling the
offending spirits.
In many cultures, there exists the concept of supernatural sexual assault. In Eu-
ropean tradition, such attacks were carried out by both male (incubi) and female
(succubi) demons. Some held that the demon actually had no gender but merely
took the form opposite to its victim. Reports of sexual assault by spirits continue
to the present.
Magical assault is sometimes carried out at a distance through the principles
of magic described by Sir James George Frazer in The Golden Bough: that like
produces like (the principle of similarity) and that once in contact, things con-
tinue to act on each other even after contact has been severed (the principle of
contagion). Both principles are illustrated by the use of an effigy that includes,
for example, some of the victim’s hair or nail parings (contagion) to cause that
person pain and sickness by injuring the effigy (similarity). This and a variety of
other techniques of magical assault, such as ‘‘bone pointing,’’ are found all over
the world. A more directly supernatural kind of sorcery is spirit magic, in which
a spirit is bound by the sorcerer to do his or her bidding. Spirit magic is often
used for healing and other benign purposes (many healers have one or more spirit
helpers or ‘‘guides,’’ what the Laotian Hmong call ‘‘tame spirits’’ in translation),
but the same spirits can do all kinds of mischief.
Magical assault, like the attack of a ghost, sometimes may be directed against
an evil one. In Japan, for example, the experience known as hagging or witch ri-
ding in English is called kanashibani, which is sometimes translated as ‘‘metal
bound.’’ The term derives from the magic of Fudomyoo, a Buddha who fights
against evil. His statue is placed at the entrance to temples, where it is said to
bind evil ones so they cannot move, preventing them from entering. In medieval
Japan, Ninjas and Buddhist monks were said to be trained to bind their opponents
as if by metal strings. Similar ‘‘spellbinding’’ traditions, used against enemies
and evildoers, are very widely found.
It was noted earlier that some categories of assault (and attackers) are ambigu-
ous with regard to the previously outlined definition of supernatural. These types
of assaults and attackers do not constitute an entirely new category so much as a
boundary where opinion, often within a single tradition, differs on the physical/
spiritual nature of events. Fairies sometimes appear to be a physical race with
magical powers, but others consider them to be spirits. Some Newfoundlanders,
180 | Assault, Supernatural
for example, said that the fairies were fallen angels who were not bad enough to
be consigned to hell. Fairies often mislead wanderers and sometimes strike them
or wound them with fairy weapons. Bell’s palsy, a neurological condition caus-
ing temporary paralysis on one side of the face, was attributed to fairies by some
Newfoundlanders. Fairies also can cause blindness and all sorts of other injury.
Similar races of ‘‘little people’’ are found all over the world.
The activities of witches are sometimes similarly ambiguous. During the
witchcraft persecutions in Europe, there was a great debate over whether witches
flew in their physical bodies or after leaving their physical bodies behind. The
European witchcraft tradition clearly included the possibility that witches might
not only leave their human bodies but also either change them or enter alternative
bodies such as those of animals. In such a case, injury to the animal would then
be found on the body of the witch at a later time, confirming the identity. The
belief in shape shifting is found universally, and shape-shifters usually are very
dangerous. Shape shifting is often associated with witchcraft, as in the Navajo
‘‘skinwalker’’ who transforms itself by putting on the skin of a coyote or wolf.
This image is similar to the European werewolf; here too the transformation
process appears supernatural, but the result seems to be a physical agent who can
do direct bodily harm. Another related belief is that witches can ‘‘slip out of their
skins’’ and travel about invisibly, a belief reported from the U.S. South. Although
this sounds like a metaphorical description of witches traveling in spirit form,
some informants say that, though invisible, the witches can be touched when they
are out of their skins and that they feel rubbery, like raw meat.
Vampires also share some of this physical/supernatural ambiguity. Traditional
vampires, unlike the movie variety, do not live above ground in closed caskets that
they can conveniently open and exit at night. Rather, their bodies remain in the bur-
ied casket, and their travel and attacks seem to involve either spectral appearance
or shape shifting. Some accounts suggest that a burrow connects the casket with
the surface and that the vampire can leave in the form of a small animal. But the
blood of the victim, in European belief, somehow gets to the corpse of the vampire,
which is found filled with it when the vampire is finally identified and destroyed.
In other traditions, creatures like the vampire (such as the ‘‘viscera sucker’’ of the
Philippines) seem to take vital essence rather than physical nourishment from their
victims. The result, of course, can be the same: sickness and death.
One final ambiguous category indicates the continued vigor of traditions of su-
pernatural assault. This is ‘‘UFO abduction.’’ Until the mid-1980s, even people
fascinated by UFOs considered those who claimed to have been taken aboard the
flying objects to be part of a lunatic fringe. But by the late 1980s, the topic of
UFO abduction was being taken much more seriously. Stories in the media docu-
mented the increasing number of people claiming to have been taken against
their will to strange craft, where they were subjected to painful physical and
Assault, Supernatural | 181
sexual examinations and had semen or ova taken from them. At present, there
are at least dozens of investigators and abductee support groups in the United
States, and a substantial number of mental health professionals are taking the
abductees’ claims seriously. Although many investigators are convinced that
recent abduction events have been carried out by a technologically advanced
alien civilization, others, including many abductees, believe that what is happen-
ing is metaphysical rather than physical. Abductees are often accosted in their
bedrooms and paralyzed in events much like those involved in hagging. Subse-
quently, they may be taken right through the ceilings of their rooms. The differ-
ing opinions on how this occurs recall the earlier debate about whether the flight
of witches was physical or spiritual. The alien hybridization program has many
elements reminiscent of fairy abduction, which sometimes included sexual union
between fairies and humans.
There have been many theories about why the belief in supernatural assault
recurs in so many cultural settings, and most of them probably supply pieces of
the explanation. Such a belief can serve social control functions, suggesting, for
example, consequences for antisocial behavior—consequences against which
wealth and power cannot necessarily protect. Also, as an explanation of disease,
the belief offers a course of action. Psychoanalytic authors have suggested
explanations in terms of repressed sexuality.
In addition to such theories, there is now evidence that a substantial number of
supernatural belief traditions (both negative and positive) are partially supported
by experiences that occur cross-culturally. Such experiences seem to play a cen-
tral role in the formation and persistence of these traditions. The category that
has been most completely described is what Newfoundlanders call ‘‘the Old
Hag’’ or hagging, although the perpetrator may be either male or female. In this
experience, people awaken to find themselves paralyzed, although fully awake.
They may hear shuffling footsteps approach; they may see a grotesque creature
clamber up on the bed and squat on their chests, making it difficult to breathe; or
they may be overwhelmed by a ‘‘sense of presence.’’ The great majority of vic-
tims are convinced that something evil is in their immediate vicinity. Most sur-
prising is the fact that this type of experience, complete with its complex set of
grotesque features, is found in different cultural settings all over the world,
including modern North America where most victims have no cultural frame in
which to place the event. This experience is what sleep researchers and physi-
cians call ‘‘sleep paralysis.’’ There are known physiological mechanisms that
explain the paralysis, but the peculiar, cross-culturally stable patterning of the
subjective experience is still puzzling.
The sleep paralysis experience is a universally available empirical basis for su-
pernatural assault traditions, and it has been attributed to each of the spiritual
attackers described earlier. Although this event is the most thoroughly described,
182 | Assault, Supernatural
it appears that there may be other ubiquitous experiential foundations for these
assault traditions, just as there are for more positive belief traditions (such as the
near-death experience). For example, in multiple personality disorder, the alter
personality sometimes claims to be a demon or other spirit alien to the host. This
does not happen only to those with a strong prior belief in possession. There may
well be many other underlying experiential categories. In order to find such pat-
terns and make theoretical sense of them, it is first necessary to take traditions of
the supernatural seriously—that is to inquire into them as though they may refer
to actual experiences. To do this, one must not only seek the cultural repertoire
of beliefs but also interview those who claim to be direct observers. Many will
reveal a retrospective interpretation of mundane events. But others may give us
new knowledge about phenomena that are genuinely puzzling, as is sleep paraly-
sis. In turn, such empirical elements put the traditions in a new light, making
their logical structures more understandable. Sleep paralysis by itself, occurring
among about 20 percent of the population, provides an empirical basis for the
belief that evil spirits exist. If that belief is established, the reference to such
powerful agents in theories of disease etiology is not so difficult to understand.
David J. Hufford
See Also Belief, Folk; Exorcism; Magic; Night Hag; Possession; Vampire; Werewolf.
References
Barber, Paul. 1988. Vampires, Burial, and Death: Folklore and Reality. New Haven,
CT: Yale University Press.
Davis, Winston. 1980. Dojo: Magic and Exorcism in Modern Japan. Stanford, CA:
Stanford University Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1981. The Evil Eye: A Folklore Casebook. New York: Garland.
Goodman, Felicitas D. 1988. How about Demons? Possession and Exorcism in the
Modern World. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Hufford, David. 1982. The Terror That Comes in the Night: An Experience-Centered
Study of Supernatural Assault Traditions. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Noll, Richard. 1992. Vampires, Werewolves and Demons: Twentieth Century Reports
in the Psychiatric Literature. New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Otten, Charlotte F., ed. 1986. A Lycanthropy Reader: Werewolves in Western Cul-
ture. Syracuse, NY: Syracuse University Press.
Perkowski, Jan L. 1989. The Darkling: A Treatise on Slavic Vampirism. Columbus,
OH: Slavica.
Rubel, Arthur J., Carl W. O’Nell, and Rolando Collado-Ardon. 1984. Susto: A Folk
Illness. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Simons, Ronald C., and Charles C. Hughes. 1985. The Culture-Bound Syndromes:
Folk Illnesses of Psychiatric and Anthropological Interest. Dordrecht, Netherlands:
D. Reidel.
Audience | 183
Summers, Montague. 1960. The Vampire, His Kith and Kin. New Hyde Park, NY:
University Books.
Summers, Montague. 1966. The Werewolf. New York: Bell.
Audience
A word derived from the Latin audientia, meaning a hearing or listening. In folk-
lore scholarship, the term audience may refer to a variety of social groups (or
individuals) who constitute the actual (or intended) receiving party in a transmis-
sion process. Depending on the dynamics of the activity involved, the term may
signify a listener to verbal or musical communication or a spectator of visual pre-
sentation or activity. In a broader sense, closely related labels (e.g., the public,
fans, clients) also are used to refer to a customary audience or to consumers of a
material culture product (artifact). Typically, an audience is physically present
with the source of the communication; the audience may also be intended (as in
the case of producing a commodity for a certain category of a population) or
imaginary (symbolic interactional—e.g., in AT 894, ‘‘The Ghoulish Schoolmas-
ter and the Stone of Pity,’’ a persecuted heroine tells her sorrows to a stone,
which bursts out of compassion for her).
During the early stages of folklore scholarship, only casual references were
made to the audience, especially with reference to narrative materials (e.g.,
M€archen, ballads). The most pronounced emphasis placed by a folklorist on the au-
dience came in the 1920s as part of Walter Anderson’s ‘‘Law of Self-Correction.’’
Anderson credited the audience of orally communicated tales with censoring narra-
tors into conforming to established characteristics of a tale text, thus exerting a sta-
bilizing influence on traditions. Other folklorists defined some genres in terms of
the presence or absence of an audience and its expectations. For example, Iouri
Sokolov argued that one can chant a song for one’s self but that there is no solitary
tale telling since narrating a tale presupposes the presence of an audience; simi-
larly, C. W. von Sydow distinguished between the long chimerates and novellates,
on the one hand, and the short animal fables and jocular fables, on the other,
according to a raconteur’s purpose vis-a-vis a listening audience.
Subsequent theoretical developments led to the inclusion of the audience as a
basic factor in studying lore. One such development was the anthropological
functional approach, which was heavily influenced by behavioristic theories of
learning wherein labels such as cues and intervening variables designated the
context for a learning process. Under the terms of functional studies, the audi-
ence becomes a component of the context within which cultural institutions oper-
ate, and recurrent practices are learned or unlearned.
As did Anderson earlier, many folklorists came to view social reward by an
audience as a major factor in motivating narrators, singers, minstrels, dancers,
184 | Audience
and other performers to publicly perform their art or exercise their craft. Stith
Thompson pointed out the impact of such rewards on raconteurs; Albert Lord
reported the influence of a ‘‘critical audience’’ on minstrels’ performances; Bengt
Holbeck concluded that if meaning in tales were to be understood, the traditional
audience had to be seen in conjunction with the narrators. Likewise, in the field
of material culture, the role of the consumer is emphasized. Warren E. Roberts
noted a craftsperson’s eagerness to produce ‘‘satisfactory items’’ due to a close
personal contact with the customer and expectations to serve the customer again,
and Henry Glassie pointed out the folk artist’s sensitiveness to the ‘‘audience’s
needs and pleasures.’’
This form of interaction (as compared with feedback) between a source and a
recipient in terms of effect (reward and punishment or absence thereof) received
further indirect elaboration in the ‘‘ethnography of speaking’’ espoused by Dell
Hymes and in ‘‘performance-centered’’ approaches advocated by Roger Abra-
hams, Richard Bauman, and others. The new nomenclature for this formula is
the responsibility/accountability assumed by a speaker/performer to an audience
(and vice versa). Imbedded in this view of ‘‘cultural behavior’’—to use Hymes’s
words—is the audience’s response, which will reward or punish the performer.
According to behavioristic learning theories, effect is the basic force responsible
for the continuity and discontinuity of behavior, especially that category of tradi-
tional cultural behavior that may be designated as ‘‘folkloric behavior.’’
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Performance; Psychological Approach; Superorganic Theories; Tradition.
References
Anderson, Walter. 1923. Kaiser und Abt (Emperor and Abbot). Folklore Fellows
Communications, no. 42. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Bauman, Richard. 1975. Verbal Art as Performance. American Anthropologist 77:
290 311.
Glassie, Henry. 1972. Folk Art. In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed. R. M.
Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Holbeck, Bengt. 1987. Interpretation of Folktales: Danish Folklore in European Per-
spective. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 239, Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum
Fennica.
Hymes, Dell. 1975. Breakthrough into Performance. In Folklore: Communication
and Performance, eds. Dan Ben-Amos and Kenneth Goldstein. The Hague: Mouton.
Lord, Albert B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. New York: Atheneum.
Roberts, Warren E. 1972. Folk Crafts. In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed.
R. M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
El-Shamy, H. 1967. Folkloric Behavior. PhD dissertation, Indiana University,
Bloomington.
Authenticity | 185
Authenticity
Despite its ancient Greek roots, the meaning of the term authenticity is thor-
oughly modern. It emerged in the mid-eighteenth century, concurrently with both
the political transformations brought about by the French Revolution and the soci-
oeconomic changes initiated by the Industrial Revolution. Both the political and
the economic changes furthered the growth of increasingly individualistic world-
views in place of the communal ethos dominant in feudal societies. The excite-
ment of dramatic change and technological progress therefore also entailed a
sense of loss of community, and the romantically inspired search for authenticity
around the turn of the nineteenth century attempted to counteract this loss.
Emphasizing the need for getting in touch with their own innermost feelings and
emotions, romantic writers and thinkers sought to uncover the lost origins of po-
etry. This was closely entwined with the perception of natural purity, on the one
hand, and civilization as a spoiling agent, on the other. Works such as Ossian
(later discovered to be a fraud) inspired the collection of folksong and folk narra-
tive on a grand scale, as upper-class individuals hoped to regain their own lost au-
thenticity by reading and imitating folk poetry. A vocabulary relying on tropes
such as cleanliness and genuineness of natural manifestations, threatened loss of
paradise, and alienation from society was employed by the Romantics, who were
initially driven by a largely emotional desire to recoup the authentic. Although
this vocabulary lingers to the present, the desire to restore authentic origins
moved from the emotional realm and became an increasingly scholarly, scientific
preoccupation. Scholars began to devise techniques of collecting and representing
the essence of folkness in the form of texts and artifacts. In the work of Jacob and
Wilhelm Grimm, for instance, one recognizes the effort to turn the sociopolitical
quest for authenticity into a scientifically valid enterprise. Folklore materials, the
standards used in collecting them, and the groups and individuals from whom
scholars collected were subjected to explicit or implicit authenticity criteria. This
perception of more and less genuine groups and cultural productions grew into a
rarely questioned scientific canon. The ideology that relative isolation from mod-
ern forces such as mass communication and technological advances preserves cul-
tures in a purer (hence, superior) state continued to inform choices in fieldwork
sites until the romantic mystique of fieldwork itself began to be examined.
In contrast to authenticity standards in the domain of high culture, where indi-
vidual, known authorship of artistic production served as a means to determine
originality, the authenticity of an item of folklore was established by proving
anonymous authorship and continuity through traditional channels of communi-
cation. Individual performers living within presumably untainted communities
were considered only as vessels through whom folklore materials were passed
on. In a variety of theoretical folkloristic projects, such as those of the historic-
geographic school, the scholar’s task consisted of cleansing from folklore materi-
als the impurities that had crept into them through human error and establishing
Authenticity | 187
the original or Urform. In the public sphere, the appeal of authenticity was con-
siderable as well. Folkloristic notions of originality and cultural purity fueled
applications in anything from (romantic) nationalist rhetoric to small-scale pres-
ervational or restorational associations.
In the second half of the twentieth century, folklorists began to move from an
item- or text-oriented focus that had disregarded intentionality and creativity on
the part of the folk to a processual approach in which actors and audiences were
recognized as active shapers of folklore. Simultaneously, scholars faced a variety
of cultural manifestations that forced them to examine the latent dichotomies
informing much of their thinking. By adhering to the folk-versus-nonfolk dichot-
omy and the corresponding differentiation between the genuine or authentic ver-
sus the spurious, folklorists artificially isolated the materials they studied from the
cultural processes in which they were embedded. Issues such as the mechanical
reproduction of folk art or the touristic exploitation of costume, festival, and food-
ways brought forth the folklorismu discourse in Europe and the concept of fake-
lore in the United States. Both notions were initially conceived to separate out
authentic folk culture from the machinations of mass markets. Closer examination
of issues such as the commodification of cultural goods in the larger framework
of the politics of culture forced scholars to recognize the artificial boundaries that
they themselves had constructed around folklore and folk communities. Cases
where the purported authenticity of folkloric materials was foregrounded began to
be studied, for instance, in the intersection of folk art and the art market, the dis-
play of ethnicity, or the encounter of tourists and natives. Agents in these settings
clearly constructed authenticities according to arbitrary criteria suiting their par-
ticular needs. Such insights helped the discipline to recognize its own complicity
in endowing some cultural goods with greater significance than others. The hege-
monic implications of disciplinary theory and practice in the discourse on authen-
ticity thus finally became an object of analysis itself.
Regina Bendix
See Also Fakelore; Folklorismus/Folklorism; Invented Tradition; Tradition.
References
Appadurai, Arjun. 1986. Introduction: Commodities and the Politics of Value. In The
Social Life of Things, ed. A. Appadurai. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Bendix, Regina. 1992. Diverging Paths in the Scientific Search for Authenticity.
Journal of Folklore Research 29: 103 132.
Benjamin, Walter. [1936] 1968. The Work of Art in the Age of Mechanical Reproduc-
tion. In Illuminations, ed. H. Arendt (trans. Harry Zohn). New York: Harcourt, Brace.
Berman, Marshall. 1972. The Politics of Authenticity. New York: Atheneum.
Cohen, Erik. 1988. Authenticity and Commoditization in Tourism. Annals of Tour-
ism Research 15: 371 386.
188 | Autograph Book
Autograph Book
A volume for collecting handwritten verse and prose. This written material can
be traditional or original, comically irreverent or high-mindedly serious. It can
represent very personal feelings or repeat customary formulas. Messages are usu-
ally quite brief, perhaps consisting only of a traditional greeting phrase with the
writer’s signature (‘‘Best wishes, Spike’’).
Also called friendship books and memory books, autograph books existed as
early as the fifteenth century. A vogue for keeping them emerged early in the
1800s and continued as a mark of gentility until the beginning of the twentieth
century. Writers of autographs at least until the mid-nineteenth century treated
the custom as an opportunity for offering homiletics on such subjects as friend-
ship (‘‘Remember well and bear in mind, / A constant friend is hard to find’’).
Although some might compose their own messages, most writers probably drew
upon traditional materials that originated or were preserved in almanacs, school
readers, and collections of sentimental verse. Later in the century, messages
became more comic, a trend that has continued until the present.
During the 1900s, the custom of keeping autograph books flourished most
among children, who employed a variety of folk rhyme formulas (‘‘Roses are red,
/ Violets are blue, / There has never been a friend / That’s better than you’’) as
well as visual manipulations (‘‘U R 2 Good 2 B 4 Gotten’’) to memorialize rela-
tionships. Sometimes, symbols took the place of a word or concept (a heart substi-
tuted for the verb love or a ‘‘smiley face’’ representing happiness). Autograph
book inscriptions also commented humorously and sometimes sardonically about
such concerns as schoolwork and boy-girl relationships. Though writers still stress
the importance of friendships, twentieth-century autograph verse is often comi-
cally insulting. Inscriptions may be preserved in albums designed especially for
Autograph Book | 189
the purpose. Today, school yearbooks, produced even for elementary schools, are
designed to accommodate autographed sentiments from one’s classmates. In fact,
administrators may set aside part of a day at the end of the school year for an ‘‘an-
nual’’ party, during which students write in each other’s yearbooks.
Most studies of autograph books published by folklorists have focused entirely
on the verses and prose written therein. Changes through time in the nature of
the sentiments expressed have received considerable attention. Some attempts
also have been made to typologize autograph verse on the basis of form and to
view the content of the verse as reflecting the worldview of the writers and col-
lectors. Little attention, though, has been paid to the dynamics of autograph
exchange. A study by folklorist Stephen Stern provides some rare insights into
why particular children write particular sentiments.
A related autograph book custom involves the collection of signatures from
celebrities. Some participants in this custom specialize in particular kinds of
celebrities (for instance, country-and-western musicians); others are more general
in their approach. Some sites where a number of celebrities may be available for
autographs market special books to collect their signatures. The Disney theme
parks, for instance, sell books in which children can collect signatures from peo-
ple dressed in the costumes of Disney characters.
William M. Clements
See Also Children’s Folklore; Inscription.
References
Bronner, Simon J. 1988. American Children’s Folklore. Little Rock, AR: August
House.
Green, Thomas A., and Lisa Devany. 1989. Linguistic Play in Autograph Book
Inscriptions. Western Folklore 48: 51 58.
Knapp, Mary, and Herbert Knapp. 1976. One Potato, Two Potato: The Folklore of
American Children. New York: Norton.
McNeil, W. K. 1968. The Autograph Album Custom: A Tradition and Its Scholarly
Treatment. Keystone Folklore Quarterly 13: 29 40.
McNeil, W. K. 1969. From Advice to Lament: New York Autograph Album Verse,
1820 1850. New York Folklore Quarterly 25: 175 194.
McNeil, W. K. 1970. From Advice to Lament Again: New York Autograph Album
Verse, 1850 1900. New York Folklore Quarterly 26: 163 203.
Stern, Stephen. 1973. Autograph Memorabilia as an Output of Social Interaction and
Communication. New York Folklore Quarterly 29: 219 239.
Zeitlin, Steven J. 1974. As Sweet as You Are: The Structural Elements in the Signed
High School Yearbook. New York Folklore Quarterly 30: 83 100.
B
Ballad
191
192 | Ballad
Ballads are found throughout Europe and, as a result of outward European migra-
tion, in northern Africa, the Americas, and Australia, with analogues reported in
India, the Orient, and Oceania. But the desire to deal with an apparently global tradi-
tion is frustrated by the need to grapple with regional forms whose differences are as
apparent as their common characteristics. The most obvious distinctions are metrical.
In northern Europe, ballads are stanzaic, commonly written in rhymed quatrains of
alternating tetrameter and trimeter lines or, less frequently, four tetrameter lines.
Couplet stanzas, often thought to be an older form, normally have interspersed
refrains, whereby they are equivalent to quatrains. By contrast, many southern and
eastern European ballads are stichic and exhibit varying metrical and acoustic struc-
tures: The Spanish romanceros are based on octosyllabic verses linked by assonance
rather than rhyme; verses in Romanian ballads, normally trochaic trimeter or tetra-
meter, are subject to considerable variation in metrical length. It should be noted,
however, that ballad scansion is variable within the confines of the melody, and
rhythm is dictated primarily by four-beat melodic phrases grouped in four-line stro-
phes. Hypermetrical or abbreviated constructions are common enough that it seems
quite inappropriate to describe them as ‘‘irregular,’’ and when ballads are sung, incon-
sistencies that might otherwise be apparent on the printed page are smoothed out.
One might argue here, in light of defining the ballad from the perspective of
narration, that prosody is a secondary consideration having little to do with the
actual way a story is told. It has been shown, however, that form has a direct
bearing on style. Stichic ballads permit expansion and development more easily
than strophic ones, and thus they tend to be more descriptive. Since this has
implications for how formulas and other repetitive patterns function in the vari-
ous traditions, researchers attempting to understand the precise details of balladic
style have tended to deal with regional forms as distinct entities.
Although it is difficult to generalize about ballads on a broad scale, one can
perhaps identify two overarching elements that encompass the most significant
stylistic features: (1) a paratactic linking of concise narrative images (noted by
David Buchan), the so-called gapped quality of the ballad, and (2) a reliance on
repetition. Forgoing descriptive detail and elaborated character or scene develop-
ment, the ballad tells its story through flashes of imagery, a process M. J. C.
Hodgart likened to the cinematic technique of ‘‘montage.’’ Each action and scene
is clearly articulated, with actors characteristically frozen in tableau, glancing
back over a shoulder, taking the hand of another, shouldering a cape, or peering
over a castle wall; Lajos Vargyas described balladry as a poetry of gestures.
Many other metaphors applied to the genre also point to its highly concentrated
narrative style. Thomas Gray recognized the ballad tendency to ‘‘begin in the
fifth act,’’ often at a moment of imminent conflict; from there, it is said to ‘‘leap
and linger’’ from one scene to the next. To the overall narrative structure, Wil-
helm Grimm applied the analogy of rows of mountain peaks with the valleys
between hidden from view. These characterizations, along with such typical
Ballad | 193
Barbara Allen
Heroine of a ballad composed or adapted from tradition by Allan Ramsey, perhaps
as early as 1724 (Oliver Goldsmith [1730–1774] recalled it being sung to him by
‘‘our old dairy-maid’’). The basic Barbara Allen story, of which numerous variations
exist, is of a beautiful woman who scorns the affections of a young man. Unable to
bear his rejection, the young man commits suicide. Barbara Allen is overcome with
remorse and dies from grief; she usually requests to be buried beside the unre-
quited lover. The last verse often revolves around the motif of entwined roses
growing from the graves of Barbara Allen and her disappointed suitor, a motif also
found in other ballads on similar themes. However, tradition supports less cliched
conclusions to the story, as in the version from Percy’s Reliques (1765), given by
Child (1965):
The apparent over sentimentality of the basic story disappears in the often powerful
renditions of good ballad singers. The ‘‘died for love’’ motif is one found in many hero
and heroine traditions and is especially favored in ballads. Barbara Allen is still sung
widely in Britain, America, and Australia.
Graham Seal
Incremental Repetition
Narrative development through sequential, verbally patterned episodes in which at
least one element changes with each progression. The term incremental repetition
was coined by Francis B. Gummere to refer to clusters of ballad stanzas based on
close repetition that move the narrative forward through the introduction of a new
idea with each iteration, as in the following statement and response sequence from
the opening of ‘‘Child Waters’’ (Child 63B).
In balladry, there are many variations on the basic concept of incremental repeti-
tion. W. F. H. Nicolaisen has shown that the repetitive element ranges from half
lines to binary and trinary stanza groupings to sequences of as many as four sepa-
rate stanzas, as in the murder episodes of the ballad ‘‘Babylon’’ (Child 14). The de-
vice, however, is not confined to the ballads and commonly appears in such oral
genres as m€archen and jokes. Though incremental repetition has been regarded
mainly as a compositional device, an important one in oral transmission in which
patterned units allow for easy learning and recall in performance, it has an impor-
tant aesthetic function as well. As in the prior example, where the opposition of
prohibition and violation creates a dynamic tension, successive repetitions not only
advance the narrative but also intensify the conflict, presenting what MacEdward
Leach called a ‘‘minor climax.’’ Much of the tension in oral narrative is created and
sustained through the artful manipulation of these repetitive patterns.
James Moreira
For the most part, ballad theory has struggled to understand the cultural basis of
ballad style. Early in the twentieth century, communal creationists and cultural
devolutionists attempted, from contrasting perspectives, to explain ballad style in
terms of long-term transmission processes. The debate was finally resolved by the
notion of ‘‘communal re-creation,’’ advanced by Cecil Sharp in England and Phil-
lips Barry in the United States. This concept assumed individual authorship but
declared it irrelevant to ballad process and focused instead on the continual reshap-
ing of texts through a total interaction between the ballad story, the singer, and his
or her community. Philological studies of the same period focused on the genre’s
relationship to epic, metrical romance, and other ostensibly medieval forms.
Present research tends to be more synchronically oriented and attempts to locate
the role of formulas and other repetitive patterns within the larger framework of
ballad poetics. Two main schools of thought have emerged, one focusing on
Ballad | 195
References
Andersen, Flemming G. 1985. Commonplace and Creativity. Odense University
Studies from the Medieval Centre, no. 1. Odense, Denmark: Odense University Press.
Bronson, Bertrand. 1959 1972. The Traditional Tunes of the Child Ballads. 4 vols.
Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Buchan, David. 1972. The Ballad and the Folk. London: Routledge & Kegan Paul.
Catalan, Diego, J. Antonio Cid, Beatriz Mariscal, Flor Salazar, Ana Valencio, and
Sandra Robertson. 1984. Cat alogo general del romancero. 3 vols. Madrid: Seminario
Menendez-Pidal.
Child, Francis James. [1882 1898] 1965. The English and Scottish Popular Ballads.
5 vols. New York: Dover.
Entwistle, William J. [1939] 1951. European Balladry. Oxford: Clarendon.
Nicolaisen, W. F. H. 1978. How Incremental Is Incremental Repetition? In Ballads
and Ballad Research, ed. Patricia Conroy. Seattle: University of Washington Press.
Richmond, W. Edson. 1989. Ballad Scholarship: An Annotated Bibliography. New
York: Garland.
Vargyas, Lajos. 1973. Hungarian Ballads and the European Ballad Tradition. 2 vols.
Budapest: Akademiai Kiado.
196 | Bard
Bard
region, in Mongolia, and also among the Buriats, who inhabit the region around
Lake Baikal. The epic of Geser was spread mainly within the sphere of Tibetan
cultural influence in Tibet, Mongolia, and among the Buriats, and also in Nepal,
Bhutan, Sikkim, and Ladakh. This heroic epic can still be encountered in some
rather inaccessible areas. Convincing evidence of existing epics is to be found
among various Turkic peoples (e.g., the Kirghiz Manas) and also among other
peoples living in the Middle East, Central Asia, and Siberia. There are also rich
epic poetry cultures in some parts of Southeast Asia and the Indian subcontinent.
Formerly, unfamiliarity with the material and inadequate knowledge of local
oral traditions, cultural history, and other relevant contextual information led
some scholars to assert that there were no bardic traditions in Africa. At present,
there is enough evidence to demonstrate that there are several rich and influential
epics in different parts of the continent—for example, the jeli (often called
griots) among the Mande-speaking populations in West Africa, the epics called
mvet of Cameroon, Gabon, and Equatorial Guinea, and the Nyanga epic from
Zaire. The performing of the epics (such as Sunjiata) is often only one of the
manifold social roles of the bards.
On the basis of new fieldwork methods and materials, it is possible to draw a
more complete picture of the art of the bards from all over the world, considering
topics such as the variety of epic genres; modes of performance; differences
between mythic, historical, and lyric-epic songs, and roles in society. One of the
most interesting areas of contemporary research focuses on the coexistence and
mutual influence between oral and literary epics and the use of epics in modern
culture. In many cases, dominant concepts or ideologies have helped to
strengthen the vitality of the impulsive use of epic poetry. This kind of situation
also inspired a large number of new epic songs. Bardic poetry has been in con-
stant use as a productive tradition adapting to new situations.
Parry’s basic aim was to prove that the Iliad and the Odyssey too were composed
orally in a traditional style. South Slavic epic poetry was proved to be oral and tradi-
tional. Since the Greek heroic epics also revealed the same type of features of tradi-
tionality and orality, Parry and Lord asserted that they were composed using the
same mode of composition. In his study The Singer of Tales, published in 1960, Lord
presented a summary of Parry’s theses as well as his own research. It is necessary to
note, however, that only the starting point of the Parry-Lord theory was literary in
the sense that the authors aimed at solving the classical Homeric question. During
the years since Lord’s work appeared, this approach, originally devoted to classical
literature, has expanded into a universal school. In the bibliography Oral-Formulaic
Theory and Research by John M. Foley, over 1,800 monographs on materials from
more than 90 language areas are mentioned. In addition to the Homeric and south
Slavic epic, the advocates of the oral-formulaic school have focused on the Anglo-
Saxon Beowulf, as well as a number of other classic epics and living traditions.
Milman Parry and Albert Lord’s argument can be supported by many bardic
traditions. In fact, an oral singer can produce an epic song longer than the Iliad
and Odyssey and the Finnish Kalevala put together. The Tajik singer of the Gur-
guli epics Hikmet Rizo has sung a version with a total length of 101,596 verses.
Sayaqbay Qaralaev, one of the best-known Kirghiz epic singers (manasc€), has
produced a version of the Manas-cycle (Manas, Semetey, Seytek) totaling more
than half a million verses. Another famous Kirghiz singer, S. Orozbaqov, has
produced a version that comprises over 180,000 verses.
By using a set of narrative techniques, a singer is capable of composing long
epics without having memorized them or created them beforehand. Singers are
able to use this technique to vary and compose long narrative structures during
performance. As singers produce their versions of epics, they make use of the
line sequences commonly encountered in tradition, some of which are suitable
for setting the scene for several plot structures or describing different events,
others for rather few entities. In studies of epic singing among various peoples,
one often finds mention of singers who are able to repeat a long narrative poem
after only a single hearing or rapidly producing a new poem on a given theme.
The singer has at his or her disposal the traditional means of epic poetry: metrical
patterns, parallelism, alliteration, rhyme, anaphora, or other devices of diction. Dur-
ing the composition process, the bard elaborates on the song according to his or her
own preferences and the circumstance. In order to perform an entire epic song, the
singer has to master simultaneously a number of systems. The memory of the
singer works on multilevel representations containing features of surface and mean-
ing structure. Formulas, ideas, and images join in a coherent whole; certain scenes
and themes include particular details and clusters of forms. As a result of this com-
position process, bardic art is simultaneously innovative and traditional.
Bard | 199
The training of the bard takes place over a long period, involving numerous
stages of development. A. B. Lord’s account of the south Slavic oral- formulaic
learning process is famous. According to Lord, this process consists of three
stages. The first is a period of passive listening, during which the singer learns
the general themes and plot structures of his region. This stage is followed by a
period of practice, during which the singer-to-be, who already knows how to
sing, gradually learns to fit the material learned into traditional metrical and mu-
sical frameworks. The third stage is the making of the singer: the first perfor-
mance of an entire song before a critical audience. Albert Lord mentioned the
learning capabilities of the Bosnian master singer Avdo Medjeovia, describing a
situation in which another singer—Mumin Vlahovljak—performed a song that
Avdo had never heard. After Mumin had finished, Avdo praised the song but
stated that he could perform it better. Although Mumin’s version was already
thousands of lines in length, Avdo’s interpretation was even longer. Avdo’s
poem was more complete than that which Mumin had presented, and it made use
of standard elements characteristic of Avdo’s repertoire in its construction.
Although the skill of the gifted singer made it possible to improvise on the ba-
sis of traditional forms and to repeat a song after hearing it only once, as a general
collective expression it was considered that the epic poems had to be repeated in
a traditional, standard form. The study of epic poetry nonetheless reveals signs of
considerable variation. Among the features of epic poems (and indeed of folklore
in general) is a tendency to preserve the linguistic and poetic conventions that
have become familiar and primary in the community and also to produce folklore
tied to the history, social development, and cultural conditions of the community.
One may find abundant examples of these concepts in studies of epic songs
among various peoples. In some poetic cultures, the performers generally produce
relatively fixed entities (small-scale epics); in others, the singers compile poems
by drawing on traditional devices in relatively free combinations (large-scale
epics). According to this distinction, Finnish-Karelian and Russian bards normally
belong to the former category; the epic poetry of the southern Slavs, especially
the Bosnian and the Herzegovinian Muslim singers as well as those in numerous
Mongolian and Turkic traditions, belongs largely to the latter category.
In addition, it has to be noted that there are abundant examples of epic tradi-
tions in which diverse genres play an important role. Epics in such traditions
might contain chapters in verse hagiography or panegyric, prose sections (or
prosimetric) forms, fragments of lyric elegy or laments, or even proverbs and
riddles.
The mode of performance may be flexible and varied. The singers can perform
on various occasions, for different audiences, and they are able to choose the
chapter to be performed according to the context. Such ‘‘eposes in the making’’
200 | Beauty and the Beast
clearly show how important it has been to challenge the literary-based concept of
the epics and bardic traditions.
Lauri Harvilahti
See Also Ethnopoetics; Folksong, Narrative.
References
Foley, John Miles. 1985. Oral-Formulaic Theory and Research: An Introduction and
Annotated Bibliography. New York: Garland.
Honko, Lauri, ed. 1990. Religion, Myth, and Folklore in the World’s Epics. New
York: Mouton de Gruyter.
Honko, L., S. Timonen, and M. Branch. 1993. The Great Bear: A Thematic Anthol-
ogy of Oral Poetry in the Finno-Ugric Languages. Helsinki: Finnish Literature Society.
Johnson, John, ed. 1992. The Epic of Son-Jara: A West African Tradition. Text by
Fa-Digi Sisoko. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Lord, A. B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard.
Oinas, Felix, ed. 1978. Heroic Epic and Saga: An Introduction to the World’s Great
Folk Epics. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Reichl, Karl. 1992. Turkic Epic Poetry: Traditions, Forms, Poetic Structure. New
York: Garland.
‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ is one of the most beloved and enduring fairy tales of
our time. Although it was first published in 1740 in a French novel for young
adults by Gabrielle-Suzanne Barbot de Villeneuve, similar animal groom stories
existed in the oral tradition of cultures around the world long before. It is possi-
ble they took their inspiration from the primitive ritual of sacrificing a virgin to
appease a menacing supernatural being or serpent. Beauties and beasts make
their appearance in European, rural American, and Native American folklore, as
well as in folktales from India, Turkey, Israel, Zimbabwe, China, Indonesia,
Jamaica, and Colombia, among others. Some of these tales are quite ancient.
However, in a reversal of the more frequent pattern, the existing oral tradition
did not influence the literary fairy tale. Instead, Villeneuve’s original story—
especially the widely disseminated version of it by Jeanne-Marie Le Prince de
Beaumont (1756)—has made a lasting mark on folk narrative.
Fairy Tale
Scholars have suggested that Villeneuve may have taken the general outlines of
her novel from two late seventeenth-century antecedents, Marie-Catherine
d’Aulnoy’s story ‘‘Le Mouton’’ (‘‘The Ram,’’ 1698) and Charles Perrault’s
Beauty and the Beast | 201
Beauty and the Beast, illustrated by Henry Matthew Brock in 1910. (Archives Charmet/
The Bridgeman Art Library International)
Folktale Variants
The proliferation of literary and children’s versions of ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ in
the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries paralleled the dissemination of the
Beauty and the Beast | 203
folktale variants. ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ is the eponymous example of tale type
425C in the Aarne-Thompson-Uther index of international folktales. This is one
of several variants of the tale-type cycle known as The Search for the Lost Hus-
band (AT 425), another variant of which is the myth of Cupid and Psyche (linked
to both AT 425A, The Animal as Bridegroom, and to AT 425B, Son of the
Witch). It is easy to see the kinship between these two tales. Both involve the
meeting of the supernatural or enchanted groom and the beautiful girl, their sepa-
ration as a result of the girl’s transgression, and their ultimate reunion. Unlike
the Cupid and Psyche tale, however, where the emphasis is on the breaking of
the taboo that forbids the young woman to look at her husband (the god of love),
‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ emphasizes the animal qualities of the groom and his
ultimate transformation from a monster into a human being.
The similarity and differences between ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ and ‘‘Cupid
and Psyche’’ are representative of the relationship among variants of a single tale
type. Thus, the many folktale versions of ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ exhibit differ-
ent characters and motifs while adhering to a basic structural pattern. For exam-
ple, they may describe the beast as a bear, dog, serpent, pig, or other creature;
explain the meeting of the groom and the maiden as unwitting or intended; and
cite different taboos and different means for disenchanting the beast.
In the Russian tale ‘‘The Enchanted Tsarevitch,’’ the groom is a three-headed
snake. The father meets the reptile when he retrieves a flower for his daughter
and promises to give the snake whatever he first encounters when he arrives
home; unwittingly, he has promised the girl. After several nights in the company
of the snake, who comes to sleep in her bed, the girl returns home, where her
older sisters convince her to stay too long. When she returns to the snake, he is
lying dead in a pond, but her kisses revive him and transform him into a hand-
some prince, whom she marries.
In the Appalachian tale ‘‘A Bunch of Laurel Blooms for a Present,’’ the girl volun-
tarily goes to the house of a witch in place of her father, who is being punished for
picking flowers to give to his daughter. The witch installs the girl in a little house,
where a huge toad-frog is her companion. He is kind to the girl, he cooks and keeps
house, and, when she is asleep, he sheds his warty skin and becomes a handsome
young man. One night the girl burns the skin, lifting the witch’s spell, and the pair
lives happily together among the laurel blooms. In this tale there is no transgression.
As these examples indicate, except for a few core elements involving family
relationships and symbolic objects, the folktale, like the literary tale, is suscepti-
ble to an infinite number of variations.
Artistic Legacy
In addition to its oral transmission, ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ has been carried for-
ward in a remarkable number of works of art. It has been made into many plays,
204 | Beauty and the Beast
often for performance by young people, and it has given rise to at least two
operas, Z emire et Azor by Jean-Francois Marmontel and Andre-Ernest-Modeste
Gretry (created in 1771 at Fontainebleau and recreated as recently as 2003 in
Liege) and Robert Moran’s Desert of Roses, which premiered in Houston, Texas,
in 1992. Two famous films—Jean Cocteau’s La Belle et la B^ ete (1946) and the
Walt Disney Company’s Beauty and the Beast (1991)—are based on the tale. It
was featured in a television series (1987–1990) in the United States and also in a
Disney-produced musical on Broadway. Finally, this vital narrative has been
retold in feminist and science-fiction versions that reflect the changing mores of
the late twentieth and early twenty-first centuries.
Angela Carter’s short story ‘‘The Tiger’s Bride’’ (1979), imagines that a man
loses his daughter and all his other possessions to a beast in a game of cards. The
beautiful young woman (who displays her feistiness and feminist turn of mind as
she narrates her adventure) is transferred to the beast’s abode, a run-down palazzo
in wintery northern Italy, where the horses are housed in the ruined dining room
and the beast sleeps in a rudimentary den. The plot reverses the original storyline
when the young virgin, rather than the beast, undergoes a transformation, shed-
ding her clothes and eventually her skin to become a tiger like her mate.
In Tanith Lee’s ‘‘Beauty’’ (1983), a science-fiction tale that challenges racism
and homophobia, Estar, the third daughter of Mercator Levin, undergoes a pro-
cess of growing self-awareness and sexual awakening when she is transported to
the dwelling of an alien who has a muscular catlike form. Always the outsider in
her own family, she quickly adapts to her new surroundings and feels love for
this beast, who seems to read her mind. As the story unfolds, Estar learns the
secrets of this alien race and discovers that, although her outward appearance is
different, she is one of them. She has been summoned home—to her real home
among the black, leonine ‘‘aliens’’—by the delivery of an unusual rose.
Although critics such as Jack Zipes have decried the way ‘‘Beauty and the
Beast’’ and other classic fairy tales have been taken over by the culture industry
and turned into uninspiring romances or cute animated films for blatantly com-
mercial purposes, the retellings by Carter and Lee suggest that there are still peo-
ple of various ages who want to create and read provocative new imaginings of
the story.
husbands who respected them and women could choose to enter into marriage
more or less freely. In Villeneuve’s novel, Beauty’s actions (unlike Psyche’s) are
never commanded or forced. In a way that is difficult for present-day readers to
comprehend, the original ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ reflects the eighteenth-century
emphasis on individual rights and freedoms—and tentatively suggests that they
might even be extended to women.
However, the Beast’s passivity and Beauty’s agency are not always central in
the modern tales, even in the feminist retellings. Instead, some recent literary
versions of the story emphasize issues of self-awareness and psychological de-
velopment that are more in keeping with the theories of adolescence engendered
in the wake of Sigmund Freud. Some promote acceptance of racial or sexual
others and teach that fear stems from resisting knowledge and difference.
‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’ has always been a vehicle for its authors’ social or politi-
cal messages or the popular ideas of their time.
Setting aside this inevitable updating of the story, however, certain elements
remain and ensure the tale’s underlying stability. These are the persistent arche-
types and symbolic objects that allow audiences to recognize the story despite its
shifting external and time-bound trappings. Instead of being situated in a particu-
lar time and place, the action is removed from any locatable reality and becomes
dreamlike. In most versions, the Beast’s residence is surrounded by a garden that
could be a kind of Eden; or it may be in a remote part of northern Italy, or in an
alien compound somewhere on earth.
Furthermore, the fact that the principal characters are named for abstract qual-
ities (Beauty) or generic beings (Beast) makes them available as types, rather
than particular individuals, and signals the universal, allegorical import of the
tale. Even in a modern retelling such as Lee’s, where the names are changed,
their abstraction is maintained: the Beauty figure, Estar, translates as ‘‘Psyche,’’
and the Alien is said to have a name that can only be intuited, not uttered or
written.
Perhaps most important, basic family relationships form the core of the tale,
which wrestles with the problem of exogamy, or marrying out. The daughter
must make a successful transition from living with her father to entering into an
adult relationship with another man. The flower the girl requests, which leads to
her meeting with the Beast, symbolizes this transition. It can be understood either
as a figure for male power, which is in play between the father and his daughter’s
suitor, or as a sign of the young woman’s sexual innocence, which will soon be
lost. In the end, the tale’s durability may be due to the very fact that its meanings
are not spelled out; they are not fixed once and for all.
Virginia E. Swain
See Also Cinderella; Fairy Tale Heroes; Shape-Shifters; Sleeping Beauty; Snow White.
206 | Belief, Folk
References
Griswold, Jerry. 2004. The Meanings of ‘‘Beauty and the Beast’’: A Handbook. Peter-
borough, Ontario: Broadview Press.
Hearne, Betsy, ed. 1989. Beauty and the Beast: Visions and Revisions of an Old
Tale. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Hearne, Betsy, ed. 1993. Beauties and Beasts. Phoenix: Oryx Press.
€
Swahn, Jan-Ojvind. 1955. The Tale of Cupid and Psyche. Lund: CWK Gleerup.
Warner, Marina. 1994. From the Beast to the Blonde: On Fairy Tales and Their Tell-
ers. New York: Farrar, Straus and Giroux.
Zipes, Jack. 1994. The Origins of the Fairy Tale. In Fairy Tale as Myth/Myth as
Fairy Tale. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, pp. 17 48.
Belief, Folk
Luck
The belief that human activities are determined by chance. Luck is a significant idea
in folklore studies, not just in the obvious area of folk belief but also in other gen-
res such as legends, proverbs, and children’s games. Luck and chance are reflected
in folk expressions because of human concerns with fate, with uncertainties in life,
and with control of those uncertainties. Attitudes toward luck will vary depending
on different cultural contexts, specific social situations, and individual concerns.
The proverb ‘‘Work hard and you shall be rewarded’’ suggests a straightforward
value of achievement, but the existence of other proverbs in the same culture such
as ‘‘Who knows what tomorrow will bring?’’ indicates a qualification of the first value
and a tension in cultural worldview. Luck and chance modify the value of the work
ethic: ‘‘Work hard and you may not be rewarded.’’ Buried treasure legends seem to
express what Alan Dundes has called the folk idea of unlimited good since the stories
usually end with the treasure not being found; it is still waiting for someone willing to
work hard and find it. However, treasure tales often emphasize luck rather than hard
work as the reason for a treasure being found, so there is a qualification of the work
ethic. Children’s treasure hunts reflect some of these same concerns.
Because of the chance element in human endeavors, folk traditions provide means
to control one’s luck—folk beliefs, rituals, and charms—especially in areas of life
where there is more uncertainty. Gambling is a good example: Racetrack bettors,
poker players, and lottery players are notorious for being superstitious—trying to
control their luck by wearing charms, cutting the cards in a certain way, arriving at
the track at a certain time, playing numbers that they dream about, and so forth.
Scientific and technological advances probably have given humans a greater sense
of control of their lives, but as long as there is some uncertainty in existence, the
folklore of luck will be found.
Patrick B. Mullen
Evil Eye
An ancient belief, still commonly held, that certain people can cause damage to
something valuable by gazing at it. In the third century CE, Heliodorus wrote,
‘‘When anyone looks at what is excellent with envious eye he fills the surrounding
atmosphere with a pernicious quality and transmits his own envenomed exhalations
into whatever is nearest him.’’ The common view, as illustrated here, has been that
the eye is a source, rather than a receptor, of light and other emanations.
It is widely reported that envy is the motivating force behind the evil eye. That is, the
malefactor sees something desirable, experiences envy, and emits a force from his or her
eyes that damages the object. It is usually people (most often, a child or a bride), crops,
or animals that are harmed, and it is the excellent or beautiful that is most at risk. Also,
the damage is usually specific, not general; the evil eye is responsible for children failing to
thrive or cows going dry, rather than for famines or droughts. The person who casts the
evil eye, however, may not be aware that he or she has this power. Often, suspicion falls
on particular individuals because they are outsiders or have a distinctive look to them,
such as eyes of a color different from the norm or eyebrows that meet in the middle.
Because envy motivates the evil eye, expressions of admiration may be seen as
dangerous and either be avoided or followed by reciting a formula (e.g., ‘‘God bless
him’’) or committing an act intended to avert the evil, such as spitting on or touch-
ing the supposed victim (or even touching spit onto the victim) or perhaps giving
the praised object to the person who praised it. Reversals are often reported: One
may deliberately call a pretty child ugly or, in dressing a child, turn a sock inside out
so as to ward off the evil eye.
Such protection takes many forms. Often, something is put near or on the envia-
ble object to draw the gaze, such as a smudge of dirt or a colored ribbon or thread.
The colors and objects vary by area: a black goat’s tail or pot in Morocco, blue
beads in rural Greece, the red mano cornuta (or horned hand) among Italian-Ameri-
cans. Because the point of these objects is either to attract the gaze—thereby
deflecting it from the vulnerable person or animal—or to ward off the evil, both the
obscene (phalluses) and the holy (crucifixes) can serve for protection.
Paul Barber
Folklorists have long recognized the need for a neutral term to designate tradi-
tional beliefs in order to avoid ethnocentric bias in studying human behavior.
In 1930, Alexander Krappe wrote, ‘‘Superstition, in common parlance, designates
the sum of beliefs and practices shared by other people in so far as they differ
from our own. What we believe and practise [sic] ourselves is, of course, Reli-
gion.’’ More recently, in 1977, Lawrence W. Levine noted that ‘‘in the cultures
from which the [African American] slaves came, phenomena and activities that
we might be tempted to dismiss as ‘superstitious’ were legitimate and important
modes of comprehending and operating within a universe perceived of in sacred
terms. To distinguish these activities and beliefs from religion is a meaningless
exercise.’’ Religious beliefs and folk beliefs may be similar in terms of structure
Belief, Folk | 209
and function; their differences lie in the way they are perceived by different
groups. As many folklorists have pointed out, folk beliefs are found not just
among isolated, uneducated, or exotic groups but among all peoples.
Given the diversity and cross-cultural spread of folk belief, one of the central
problems in the scholarship in this field is classification. What scheme will be able
to handle the seemingly unending variety of topics and examples from different
cultures all around the world? Wayland D. Hand formulated a classification based
on ‘‘the cycle of life,’’ which has proven useful in organizing folk belief collec-
tions. The categories are: (1) birth, infancy, childhood; (2) human body, folk medi-
cine; (3) home, domestic pursuits; (4) economic, social relationships; (5) travel,
communication; (6) love, courtship, marriage; (7) death and funereal customs; (8)
witchcraft, ghosts, magical practices; (9) cosmic phenomena: times, numbers, sea-
sons; (10) weather; (11) animals, animal husbandry; (12) fishing and hunting; (13)
plants, plant husbandry; and (14) miscellaneous. These categories are subdivided
into more specific topics—for instance, the fourth category (economic, social rela-
tionships) is divided into (a) prosperity, wealth; (b) works, trades, professions; (c)
religion; (d) friends, enemies; (e) recreation, sports, games; and (f) lying, thievery,
legal guilt, murder, etcetera. The stuff of human drama, this list gives some idea
of the range of topics and concerns that make up folk belief.
The cycle of life classification system is based on the concept of the rite of pas-
sage as formulated by Arnold van Gennep. Rites of passage take place at points in
the life cycle where important transitions from one stage of life to another occur.
Ritual and magic tend to be concentrated at these points to aid in the transition;
Hand’s classification system illustrates this with major categories of folk belief
located at birth, marriage, and death. In many circumstances, folk belief as part of
human cultural activity can only be understood as it relates to ritual. For example,
beliefs about marriage are often expressed as part of the ritual of weddings, so that
the traditions of throwing rice at the newly married couple or wearing ‘‘something
old, something new, something borrowed, something blue’’ have to be studied in
terms of the overall customs and behavior associated with the wedding itself.
In the past, folklorists tended to collect superstitions as statements of belief
without exploring related behavior or varying degrees of belief, concentrating on
texts and ignoring contexts. Developments in the anthropological study of magic
and ritual, specifically the work of Bronislaw Malinowski and other functional-
ists, have caused folklore research in folk belief to become more contextual.
Malinowski conducted fieldwork on magic and ritual among Trobriand Islanders,
and out of this research, he formulated the anxiety-ritual theory: Wherever there
is uncertainty in life, anxiety will arise, and magic and ritual will be used to gain
a sense of control. Numerous researchers have pointed out how the anxiety-ritual
theory applies to various occupational groups involved with high-risk work. For
instance, the research of Patrick B. Mullen indicates that commercial fishermen
have a system of occupational folk belief that helps them to cope with the
210 | Belief, Folk
physical and financial risks of their work. When they start out on a long fishing
trip in potentially dangerous waters, they perform rituals such as throwing coins
overboard, they avoid saying words such as alligator or rabbit, and they avoid
particular actions such as turning the hatch cover upside down in order to ensure
a safe and profitable trip. The pattern of anxiety and ritual can be observed
among athletes involved in big games, actors on opening night, students taking
exams, and lovers who are suspicious of their mates—in other words, among any
group or in any individual who faces any form of uncertainty and anxiety.
Scholars have criticized this functional explanation of superstitious behavior
because it concentrates on abstract cultural forces as determinants of behavior to
the exclusion of varying individual causes. The idea that folklore, in this case folk
belief, is only a reflection of preexisting cultural patterns such as anxiety-ritual
oversimplifies the complex ways in which folklore can be an imaginative means of
dealing with life. Folk belief in a specific context can serve many other individual
needs as well as relieve anxiety. For instance, some commercial fishermen who
work as deckhands have been known to follow the traditional occupational belief in
throwing coins overboard to buy wind in order to get off work early, and coal min-
ers who do not want women working in the mines can cite the traditional belief that
women are bad luck in mines. In both cases, folk belief is used in individual crea-
tive ways as part of strategies to control specific situations, not to relieve anxiety. A
person who expresses a folk belief may not actually believe it and may be using it
to parody another’s behavior, to challenge accepted rules rather than reinforce
them. In order to comprehend the multiple meanings and functions of folk belief,
we have to examine the specific circumstances in which it occurs, noting such fea-
tures as verbal expression, behavior, responses of others present, and so forth.
Recently, folklorists have begun to apply performance theory to the study of folk
belief in order to get at the ways in which expressions of belief do more than sim-
ply reflect worldview but actually help to reconstruct the culture itself. Folk belief
as part of a dynamic, ongoing tradition is not static but continually undergoing
change as individuals adapt received knowledge to specific circumstances. Per-
formance theory provides an approach for examining the nuances of verbal expres-
sion and behavior when superstitions are discussed or acted upon. Definitions of
folklore from a performance perspective seem to exclude folk belief since they
emphasize artistic communication and the utterance of a belief or the practicing of
a superstition is not ordinarily thought of as an artistic expression. An argument
could be made that these behaviors contain an artistic component in that they often
depend on metaphor and analogy, but even if they are not artistic communication,
they are subject to certain formulas and framing devices, in performance terms, the
keys that set them off from other kinds of expressions and establish clues to their
rhetorical purpose. Gary R. Butler has done extensive research on folk belief in a
French Newfoundland community, applying concepts of performance to identify
and analyze narrative and conversation frames in the ‘‘discourse of belief.’’
Belief, Folk | 211
As Butler and others have discovered, folk beliefs are often expressed in other
genres of folklore, such as narratives (memorates and legends), customs, rituals,
foodways, proverbs, and rhymes. Examples of the cross-genre nature of folk
belief also indicate the cross-cultural pervasiveness of superstitious behavior.
Memorates are stories told from a first- or secondhand point of view with a belief
at their core—for instance, a story about a personal encounter with a ghost would
be a memorate because the belief in ghosts is essential to the narrative. A story
one tells about a friend walking under a ladder and then being hit by a car also
would be classified as a memorate because it is based on a superstition. The story-
teller does not necessarily have to believe in the core folk belief; for example, a
person could tell about starting a trip on Friday and having good luck on the trip,
a story that would counter the traditional belief in Friday as an unlucky day. Of-
ten, folk beliefs are expressed in narrative form to prove or disprove them.
Legends are usually removed from the first- or secondhand point of view of
the memorate; they are told about events in the past that were not observed by
the teller or someone the teller knows. In addition, certain kinds of legends also
have folk belief at their core. The legend of the Flying Dutchman is about a ship
doomed to sail the seas for eternity because of the actions of a blasphemous cap-
tain. The central belief here is that blasphemy (the cause condition in structural
terms) can bring about a supernatural punishment (the result), indicating an area
where religious and folk beliefs overlap.
Customs and rituals also contain folk beliefs that are essential to their mean-
ings. The aforementioned wedding customs have many beliefs associated with
them, mostly ones meant to guarantee good luck for the bride and groom as they
begin a new stage of life. Folk beliefs are also an integral part of holiday cus-
toms, where they often intersect with foodways. In the southern United States
among certain groups, there is a custom of eating black-eyed peas (always made
with salt pork) on New Year’s Day to ensure good luck for the rest of the year,
an example that illustrates how belief, custom, and foodways interact. Beliefs
exist as folk knowledge and are then put into practice as customary behavior. It
is through the behavior that the belief itself is usually learned; a child may never
hear that it is good luck to have black-eyed peas on New Year’s but will learn
the belief when the dish is served. A novice coal miner may not hear that it is
bad luck to whistle in the mine until he whistles and is fired for breaking the ta-
boo. Folk beliefs do not exist solely in the abstract but also in actual practice and
behavior. Again, folklore is not merely a reflection of an abstract cultural world-
view; it exists in everyday life as a means of creating culture.
Often, folk beliefs are expressed as proverbs or rhymes in situations in which
such communication is appropriate. Weather signs can be more easily remembered
and passed on if they are given in the form of a rhyme: ‘‘Red sun at night, sailor’s
delight; red sun at morning, sailor’s take warning.’’ Children’s rhymes sometimes
have expression of folk belief in them, such as ‘‘Step on a crack, and you’ll break
212 | Belief, Folk
Omen/Portent
Folk beliefs that are signs of future events. Some of these can be controlled and
some cannot. Weather signs, such as a halo around the moon predicting rain, are
indicators of weather changes that cannot be controlled by humans; by contrast,
spilling salt is an omen of bad luck that can be altered by the conversion ritual of
throwing the salt over one’s shoulder.
Omens and portents have been widely employed as devices in literature, from
Shakespeare’s soothsayer warning ‘‘Beware the ides of March’’ in Julius Caesar to Mark
Twain’s Huck Finn accidentally flipping a spider into a flame in Adventures of Huckle-
berry Finn. Huck used a conversion ritual, turning around three times and crossing his
breast each time, to ward off the bad luck, but he still feared the evil consequences.
Shakespeare and Twain had the ethnographer’s sense of how omens influence human
behavior and the artist’s sense of how they work for dramatic purposes.
Some omens come about of their own accord, and others are believed to appear
at the behest of a witch, medicine man, or prophet attempting to divine the future.
Divination can be as formal as a shaman reading the entrails of a dead animal for
omens of the future or as informal as a young lover plucking the petals of a daisy,
‘‘She loves me, she loves me not.’’ Popular manifestations of consulting omens
include palm reading, tea-leaf reading, and astrological reading of the stars.
Everyday folk beliefs are full of omens that, depending on degree of belief, can
affect people’s behavior. Dropping a dishcloth is a sign that a visitor is coming; an
itchy palm means that you will receive money; an aching joint can mean that a storm
is coming. Other omens predict death or disaster: a bat flying into a room, a meteor
falling, a certain bird or animal calling after dark. Omens range in consequence from
the everyday to the cosmological and are found across the spectrum of expressive
culture, from shamans to Shakespeare.
Patrick B. Mullen
your mother’s back.’’ Some children may believe this to the extent that it affects
their behavior: While walking down a sidewalk, they will avoid stepping on any
cracks out of fear that they may hurt their mothers. An expression such as ‘‘An
apple a day keeps the doctor away’’ is also a folk medical belief that has come to
be expressed in the fixed form of a traditional proverb. ‘‘Rats leave a sinking ship’’
can be used as a metaphorical proverb to express contempt for someone who aban-
dons a failing project, but it is also a folk belief, an omen of impending disaster.
Omens, portents, and signs indicate human concern with the uncertainty of the
future; science cannot predict what the future holds, but folk belief provides ways
for people to believe they can foretell future events. We have everything from as-
trology, numerology, tarot cards, and palm reading to Ouija boards, children’s
games, and jump rope rhymes for predicting the future. Many of these devices
could be thought of as divination rituals, ways of divining the future. For exam-
ple, children make folk toys out of folded paper, which they then inscribe with
predictions and color codes. By moving the folded paper with their fingers a
Belief, Folk | 213
certain number of times and identifying colors within, they can predict whom they
will marry, what kind of cars they will drive, what kind of houses they will live
in, and so forth. Children’s traditional play activities often have underlying belief
elements that help to explain the child’s concerns and developing worldview.
Folk beliefs are often part of complex cultural processes that involve not only
belief but also values and other behaviors and that find expression in different gen-
res of folklore. The widespread cross-cultural belief in the evil eye is expressed
verbally as a direct statement, through gestures and sayings as a conversion ritual,
and through elaborate cures to take away the effects of the evil eye; underlying this
complex of behaviors are certain values that help to explain its meanings. Known
in Spanish as mal de ojo and in Italian as mal’occhio and found throughout the
Mediterranean and other parts of the world settled by ethnic groups from the Medi-
terranean region, the concept of the evil eye varies from culture to culture, but cer-
tain patterns persist. Often, the evil eye is given unintentionally by someone who
is praising a person or an object. ‘‘What a beautiful vase on your mantel,’’ someone
remarks; two days later, the vase falls and breaks. ‘‘What a darling little girl,’’ com-
ments another; the next day, the child becomes ill, and the doctors cannot diagnose
what is wrong with her. The evil eye may be the cause, according to folk belief.
The underlying value that seems to inform the belief and the behavior lies in the
importance of envy. The assumption is that to praise a person or an object is an indi-
rect expression of envy. The belief in the power of the evil eye is actually, then, a
warning against envy because even the unconscious feeling of envy can cause
destruction and illness. The cultures that have a belief in the evil eye also have folk-
loric means of dealing with it; there are conversion rituals that, when used with
expressions of praise, can prevent the evil eye from having an effect. For example, in
Puerto Rico, if one praises a young girl, one also touches her lightly on the head to
ward off the evil eye. Among Italian-Americans, the praise is accompanied by a
blessing: ‘‘What a darling little girl; God bless her.’’ There are also traditional cures
for the evil eye in Italian and Italian-American culture. A bowl of water is placed near
the person suspected of having an illness caused by the evil eye, oil is dropped into
the water, and words from Scripture are recited. The movement of the oil indicates
the efficacy of the cure. In a large city in the northern United States, an Italian Ameri-
can woman has even performed the cure over the telephone, indicating the way folk
belief adapts to technological change. Since the ritual involves both healing and reli-
gion, the evil eye can be studied as both a medical and a religious phenomenon.
Folk medicine and folk religion are major areas of study in themselves, but
both are fundamentally concerned with the study of belief and associated behav-
ior. Folk medical beliefs or folk cures are traditional ways of dealing with health
problems. They are often used in conjunction with scientific medicine, and, in
fact, there is no clear distinction between folk and scientific medicine in terms of
efficacy. Herbal cures, for instance, have been tested by traditional usage over
long periods of time and are often found to have an empirical basis when
214 | Belief, Folk
crops. As with folk medicine, planting by the signs is often used in conjunction
with current scientific agricultural techniques.
These examples from rural and ethnic groups should not be taken as an indica-
tion that folk belief is confined to cultures outside the mainstream; there is copi-
ous evidence to suggest that folk beliefs and associated behaviors are widespread
throughout the population—at all income and education levels, in urban and sub-
urban environments, and in technological fields of endeavor. Alan Dundes
pointed out the influence of the magic number three on scientific and medical pat-
terns and in academic textbooks. So-called New Age activities are another area in
which folk beliefs currently are being widely practiced. Many New Age beliefs
are borrowed from other cultures, such as the Native American culture, or are
revived based on historical records of pre- Christian religions. We find educated,
middle-class people in urban areas carrying crystals in pockets or purses in order
to ensure good luck in their daily lives or people practicing ancient forms of belief
such as Wicca, calling themselves witches. These new forms of traditional behav-
ior have not been widely studied by folklorists, but they should be seriously
examined by scholars interested in folk belief as part of human behavior.
The study of folk belief has come a long way from the nineteenth-century con-
cern with primitive survivals to the late-twentieth-century concern with everyday
behavior, from a model based on the progress of civilization to a model based on
the social construction of reality. The early scholars thought of themselves as
References
Butler, Gary R. 1990. Saying Isn’t Believing: Conversation, Narrative and the Dis-
course of Belief in a French Newfoundland Community. St. John’s, Newfoundland:
Institute of Social and Economic Research.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. Analytic Essays in Folklore. The Hague: Mouton.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1964 [1961]. Popular Beliefs and Superstitions from North
Carolina, vols. 6 and 7 of The Frank C. Brown Collection of North Carolina Folklore,
ed. Newman Ivey White. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Jahoda, Gustav. 1969. The Psychology of Superstition. London: Penguin.
Krappe, Alexander H. 1930. The Science of Folklore. New York: Barnes and Noble.
Lessa, William A., and Evon Z. Vogt, eds. 1979. 4th ed. Reader in Comparative Reli-
gion: An Anthropological Approach. New York: Harper and Row. See these chapters:
George C. Homans, ‘‘Anxiety and Ritual: The Theories of Malinowki and Radcliffe-
Brown,’’ Bronislaw Malinowski, ‘‘The Role of Magic and Religion,’’ and A. R. Radcliffe-
Brown, ‘‘Taboo.’’
Levine, Lawrence W. 1977. Black Culture and Black Consciousness: Afro-American
Folk Thought from Slavery to Freedom. New York: Oxford University Press.
Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1948. Magic, Science and Religion and Other Essays. Bos-
ton: Free Press.
Maloney, Clarence, ed. 1976. The Evil Eye. New York: Columbia University Press.
Mullen, Patrick B. 1978. I Heard the Old Fishermen Say: Folklore of the Texas Gulf
Coast. Austin: University of Texas Press.
van Gennep, Arnold. 1960. The Rites of Passage. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Belief Tale
Folk narratives that, in the context of their telling, have degrees of belief as a fac-
tor. Folklorists classify folk narratives into a multitude of categories (genres) that
overlap and cause confusion because these genres are based on different principles,
Belief Tale | 217
such as content (themes, motifs, concepts, and ideas), context (degree of belief,
social function, and distance between storyteller and audience), and texture (point
of view, imagery, tone, and other stylistic variables). Belief tale is sometimes used
as a term synonymous with legend because legend, in its broadest sense, is thought
of as a story in which belief is a contextual factor that is either wholly or partially
believed or rejected. Some folklorists define belief tales more narrowly as stories
about the supernatural and distinguish them from historical legends about individu-
als and events. The classification problem in this case arises from using content
and context in inconsistent ways; the broad category is based on context (belief),
and the narrow is based on content (supernatural events).
Another problem is that the classification systems often combine etic catego-
ries, imposed from the outside by scholars, and emic ones, based on native dis-
tinctions. A particular story may be told as a joke in certain circumstances
(emic), but based on the scholars’ examination of content, it may be classified as
a belief tale (etic). For instance, old sailors tell a story about a man who was
becalmed while out on his sailboat; he followed an ancient folk belief and threw
a half-dollar overboard to buy wind. The wind came, blew his sails and mast
down, and overturned the boat, and his wife and children were drowned. The
same basic story is often told without the tragic ending and with a punch line: ‘‘If
you get that much wind for a half-dollar, fifteen cents’ worth would have been
plenty.’’ Both stories contain the core folk belief about buying the wind, but the
first story would be classified as a legend or belief tale by a folklorist, and the
second story, with the same content except for the ending, would be called a joke
by storyteller and audience alike.
The classification of belief tales is further complicated by shifting points of
view. The story on buying the wind is told about an event that happened in the
past and was not observed by the storyteller or by someone he or she knew.
Because the event was removed from the experience of the storyteller, folklorists
classify it as a legend, as opposed to a memorate—that is, a belief tale based on
first- or secondhand personal experience. If someone tells a story about his or her
own experience of throwing coins overboard to buy wind, then that narrative is a
memorate. But, we might ask, who cares about this distinction? Certainly, the
persons telling the stories do not care what folklorists label their narratives;
again, we have the problem of scholarly categories not having much to do with
actual behavior in specific situations.
Folklorists are now more interested in the processes of tradition, the ways in
which belief, behavior, and storytelling about belief interact in everyday life.
Telling ghost stories may serve to reinforce a belief in ghosts, or it may make
fun of the belief in ghosts. Stories about supernatural events can help to relieve
anxiety over fears of the unknown and provide ways of expressing emotions that
may be difficult to articulate directly. For example, some people tell of visita-
tions by the recently deceased. Often, the spiritual visitor reassures the person
218 | Bluegrass: Homegrown Music
about the afterlife and advises the loved one not to mourn excessively. The belief
tales based on these experiences help the person to cope with the loss and get
through the mourning period.
The belief tale concentrates on inexplicable experiences in human life and helps
to explain the mysterious and unknown. Whether the stories are ancient ones passed
down as legends or new ones based on personal experience in the recent past, they
are concerned with the supernatural and become part of the ongoing debate about
the existence of a spiritual realm beyond the empirically observable world.
Patrick B. Mullen
See Also Belief, Folk; Legend.
References
Bennett, Gillian. 1987. Traditions of Belief: Women, Folklore, and the Supernatural
Today. New York: Penguin Books.
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1976. Legend and Belief. In Folklore Genres,
ed. Dan Ben-Amos. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1971. American Folk Legend: A Symposium. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Honko, Lauri. 1964. Memorates and the Study of Folk Beliefs. Journal of the Folk-
lore Institute 1: 5 19.
Mullen, Patrick B. 1978. I Heard the Old Fishermen Say: Folklore of the Texas Gulf
Coast. Austin: University of Texas Press.
von Sydow, C. W. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and
Bagger.
A style of harmonic country music that comes from the southern United States
usually played on fiddle, guitar, mandolin, and banjo. Fiddles and banjos, high-
speed instrumental duels, three- and four-part harmonies rendered a cappella that
send shivers up your spine—American music that can quicken your pulse or melt
your heart with emotion. More pervasive and present in our everyday lives than
it has ever been, bluegrass is all around us. From children’s cartoons to car com-
mercials, on the small screen and the big screen, bluegrass has been a colorful
thread in American music since its infancy in the 1930s.
What is this homegrown music that has captured worldwide attention, this
word bluegrass that newscasters are no longer avoiding and that television pro-
grams and movies are working into scripts? Is it new? Is it old? Where did it
come from, has it been around long, and why do we seem to be hearing so much
of it lately?
Bluegrass: Homegrown Music | 219
novice pickers who bravely join in, learning on the fly. Participatory workshops
are popular elements of festivals. Eager youngsters will approach bluegrass
‘‘stars’’ backstage and ask to be shown a lick or two. Instructional materials from
the ‘‘masters’’ are plentiful, ranging from books to DVDs, with gaps left in the
audio to permit the learner to play along with the teacher.
Although hundreds of bluegrass artists get paid (on extremely varying finan-
cial scales) for making music, there are, to date, relatively few groups that
actually make enough money to sustain themselves and their families without
relying on a second or day job. Although a growing minority of bluegrass musi-
cians actively pursue income from bluegrass on a full-time basis, the remainder
are essentially ‘‘in it for the love of the music.’’
This love of the music lends itself to a sense of bluegrass community. Once
you are hooked on bluegrass, you are part of the family, no matter where you land
to hear it—at a mountaintop festival in Colorado, in a valley outdoor concert in
California wine country, or in a cozy, unadorned basement club in New York
City’s Greenwich Village. So, in a broad sense, bluegrass has become folk music
with its own regionally diverse traditions, handed down at pickin’ parties in peo-
ples’ living rooms, local community centers, festival parking lots, and via video
and computer screens in homes across the United States—and around the globe.
sound. This becomes quickly apparent as a song unfolds, when most, if not all,
instrumentalists take a ‘‘break’’ between verses or chorus, playing several meas-
ures of a tune solo and then giving way for the next musician to step up to the
mic. The bottom line is interaction, and a successful bluegrass group demon-
strates great teamwork.
Musicianship in bluegrass is not just the ability to take a break. Technical pro-
ficiency, precision, along with lightning-quick speed, such as in breakdowns
(e.g., ‘‘Foggy Mountain Breakdown,’’ also known as the theme from Bonnie and
Clyde), are of prime importance. The degree of excellence required of bluegrass
musicians is equal to that found in classical music or jazz, for example. How fast
the musicians execute a tune becomes something of a competition within a band.
The lead instrument on a particular number speeds up and steps ahead of the
others momentarily, egging the others on to the finish line. This subtle accelera-
tion is nearly imperceptible to the listener but almost certainly a crowd pleaser
when it ends to rousing applause.
Speaking of jazz, bluegrass and jazz have a number of things in common. The
genres are considered uniquely ‘‘American’’ music forms, created in the United
States, albeit both derive from other traditions. The second commonality is that
both bluegrass and jazz are improvisational. The previously mentioned instru-
mental breaks allow musicians the opportunity to show off their licks and let
their individuality and creativity flow. Such improvisation can lay groundwork
for instrumental challenges, such as those in the familiar ‘‘Dueling Banjos.’’ Fur-
thermore, improvisation is the mother of invention; contemporary bluegrass has
taken many twists and turns, in part due to such explorations.
Suffice it to say for the moment that improvisation has expanded the definition
of bluegrass over the years. Even early on, there were variations within the most
traditional artist circles, in spite of Bill Monroe being recognized as the music’s
patriarch. Others were carrying essentially the same music to audiences but in
subtly different styles. Brothers Carter and Ralph Stanley can be pointed to for
their contribution of a less polished, more raw-edged presentation of bluegrass,
or ‘‘mountain music,’’ as Ralph Stanley describes it.
Another element that carries through to today is stage dress. Albeit not part of
the ‘‘sound’’ of bluegrass, it is considered an aspect of the persona of traditional
bluegrass. Approaching his pursuit of music as a professional means, that is, a
business venture, Bill Monroe dressed the part. His was not a hillbilly or cowboy
band; therefore, farm clothes and cowboy outfits from head to toe were not
appropriate. After a number of years touring, Monroe and his supporting musi-
cians settled on tasteful business suits topped off with Western hats, which has
become an enduring, sophisticated image still followed by many traditional blue-
grass bands. Other contemporary groups, at the very least, go with the ‘‘casual
222 | Bluegrass: Homegrown Music
Monroe understood that music was not just creativity, it was a business. He
shrewdly embraced Presley’s rendition and returned to the studio to rerecord it
himself, adopting a split style to his own song, utilizing his slow waltz tempo in
the first half of the number and breaking into a lively gallop to conclude. In
doing so, he seized the opportunity to expand the bluegrass audience, in effect,
by ‘‘modernizing’’ his own material.
Bluegrass is music with a message, whether contained in lyrics or in a searing
banjo tune or a soulful fiddle lament. It is from the heart and always compelling.
Bluegrass was built on many sounds and styles. Its influences were, and continue
to be, diverse and sometimes diluted, yet there is always something distinctive
about it. It is an American music that, when examined more closely, reflects this
country’s landscape.
Bill Monroe was an innovator who interpreted and expanded on other preexist-
ing forms of music, honing his new work of art into an American genre. To para-
phrase what legendary guitarist Doc Watson is fond of saying, if it is good music,
why categorize it? Yes, there are basic elements to bluegrass, but as you continue
your journey of discovery, definitive and restrictive labels will peel away.
Stephanie P. Ledgin
See Also Appalachian Folklore.
References
Carney, George O. 1998. Baseball, Barns, and Bluegrass: A Geography of American
Folklife. Lanham, MD: Rowman & Littlefield.
Cohen, Ronald D. 2005. Alan Lomax, Selected Writings 1934 1997. New York:
Routledge.
Library of Congress. 1977. Bluegrass Music: A Select Bibliography. Washington,
DC: The Archive.
Borderlands Folklore
The vernacular cultural knowledge and practices (lore) of the people (folk) who
inhabit or hail from the binational swath of land encompassing the U.S.-Mexico
border region.
This zone of approximately sixty miles radiating north and south from the ‘‘line’’
is variously described as a buffer zone, third country, open wound, edge, rim, mar-
gin, and a number of other evocative metaphors that point to the in-between char-
acter of cultural processes rooted in various degrees of transculturation.
Derived from European roots, in its most widely used forms, the word folklore
and the more recent interchangeable term folklife refer to: (1) groups loosely or
formally organized around ethnicity, occupation, religion, or various other kinds
224 | Borderlands Folklore
or taste) to establish ties or absorb cultural influences from their neighbors. Some
borderlanders, he has written, actually go to great lengths to avoid contact with
those on the other side of the border. Nonetheless, given the pockets of xenopho-
bia one can find even in areas along the border resolutely embedded in bicultural
worlds, the general ethos of the region is one of mythical opportunities for rein-
vention, adaptation, and convergence. While Mexican-derived and Mexicano
working-class folklore is most strongly represented along the region, one can eas-
ily detect the vitality of other folk traditions, such as old-time fiddling, whittling,
and peach carving connected to the westward migration of workers from Appala-
chia and Arkansas and the African American southern postbellum diaspora.
In popular usage, the term folklore is sometimes used as a code for quaint, eccen-
tric, or peculiar. In the borderlands, this connotation is usually attached to the ster-
eotypical ideas about border towns and their reputation for unruly behavior, excess
entertainment, and the saturation of material goods known as curios (for example,
velvet paintings, plaster statuary, and garish souvenirs). As a totality, these multiple
cultural nodes and flows are seldom separated into neat rubrics that distinguish
folkloristic-type cultural forms from broader notions of something simply called
border culture. Insofar as the borderlands function as crucible (intense laboratories
for dynamics of borrowing and rejecting), the region has also incubated important
resistance movements. This is true not only of folk heroes such as Gregorio Cortez
or Juan Garcıa, or the widely influential ‘‘sanctuary movement’’ on behalf of
migrants and refugees that emerged in Arizona in the 1980s, but as Baja California
scholar Jose Manuel Valenzuela Arce has noted, also of more recent massive phe-
nomena such as cholismo (a youth subculture that borrows styles and social ideolo-
gies from Chicano barrios in many U.S. cities). Hence, the folklore of the border is
also inscribed by a residual body of legends, jokes, stories, styles, and attitudes con-
cerning bohemians and maverick passers-by, day-trippers, writers, and artists seek-
ing to escape civilization, as well as the hippies, ecologists, humanitarian activists,
outlaws, rebels, and the transgressive characters that the late and notable border
scholar Americo Paredes called tequileros and sediciosos. A widespread body of
folk practices has come to be associated with drug smugglers; these include the
controversial narco corridos and the recent rise in devotion to the Santa Muerte.
Paredes, a former professor of English at University of Texas in Austin, was
the single-most prolific recorder and analyst of borderlands folklore. His scholar-
ship, primarily focused on the border folk ballad known as corrido, but extensive
to many other genres embedded in working-class Lower Rio Grande Mexican
American cultural life, set a precedent that inspired dozens of scholars. Today, a
robust body of scholarship is available, not only on borderlands vernacular prac-
tices specifically but also on Chicano arts and culture, that owes a substantial in-
tellectual debt to Paredes’s work. Within this academic corpus, women scholars
have stepped in to bring attention to the feminist dimensions of border expressive
226 | Borderlands Folklore
life—from the historical role of gardens in the transition from Mexican to U.S.
rule, to patriarchal ideologies inscribed in children’s songs, to life-cycle rituals
such as Quincea~ neras, and the musical legacy of female icons such as Lydia Men-
doza and Selena. Alive as well is a sturdy tradition of avocational folklorists and
community scholars—school teachers, librarians, amateur photographers, family
members, social workers, health educators, and others who have set out to record
and document local traditions. Several university libraries have archives contain-
ing many useful folklore materials—University of Texas Austin, University of Ar-
izona, and Utah State are among the most comprehensive. The Folklife Center in
the Library of Congress also boasts an extensive collection. Occasionally, border-
lands folklore materials will appear bound up with folklore of the U.S. West or, in
the case of states like New Mexico, Chihuahua, Arizona, and Sonora, in specific
references to the Native groups in each area (Raramuri, Apache, Yoeme, and so
on). Borderland cultural ways have been affected by increasingly porous social
and economic dynamics of globalization, thus research on Mexican American
communities in U.S. cities like Chicago, New York, or Los Angeles frequently
leads to various forms of vernacular border practices transmigrated to urban
barrios.
One common approach to the study of folklore is to group expressive forms into
three major categories: verbal, material, and customary. The study of borderlands
folklore could be pursued accordingly. In terms of material culture, some topics of
interest include various forms of folk architecture, such as adobe bricks and rama-
das; decorative arts such as paper flowers, bordados, pi~ natas, ironwork, blown
glass, and leatherwork such as saddles and boots; religious folk art such as roadside
altars or capillas, nichos, grave markers, and home altars; visual culture and public
art such as low riders, murals, yard art, and signage; and the many and rich tradi-
tions associated with vernacular foods. Among this cuisine the whole phenomenon
denominated Tex-Mex is worth considering, as are unique varieties of produce and
vegetables (chiltepin chiles in Arizona, verdolagas in New Mexico, fajitas in
Texas), the prevalence of panaderias and carnicerias throughout border towns,
delicacies such as the Lent dessert capirotada and tripitas de leche among meat
lovers; unique stories associated with food origins (the ‘‘invention’’ of the quesa-
dilla in Imuris, Sonora, or the margarita in various competing border locations).
Verbal art forms include various forms of folk narratives, among which jokes,
casos, legends, and tales are most common (La Llorona, El Cucui, La Corua, the
Devil appearing disguised at various festive settings, and more recently, the Chu-
pacabras); various forms of folk speech, among which the underground dialect
known as calo is most prominent, together with arbur (double-entendre joking),
naming practices (diminutives, terms of endearment, and derisions), proverbs,
dichos, riddles, and declamacion of folk poetry; music in all its forms, from reli-
gious alabanzas to dance-oriented varieties such as Waila and boleros, and the
Broadside Ballad | 227
remarkable growth of Mariachi in the border region since the 1950s. The realm
of customary practices incorporates a wide range of well-known folk expres-
sions: Fiestas Patrias, Day of the Dead, charreadas, and horse races are among
the best-documented ones, but children’s games, backyard barbacoas, and rite-
of-passage events such as weddings, baptisms, and funerals are also quite promi-
nent; customs associated with specific occupations, such as that of miners, gar-
deners, and ranch hands, offer interesting insights into historical developments of
the border region. Recent years have also seen a rise in interest in folk medicine,
including herbal remedies, curanderas, parteras, and a number of folk beliefs
associated with health and well-being, including devotions directed to noncanon-
ical folk saints such as Don Pedrito Jaramillo, El Ni~no Fidencio, Teresita Urrea-
La Santa de Cabora, and Pancho Villa.
Maribel Alvarez
See Also Latino Folklore.
References
‘‘Borders and Identity.’’ 1993. Smithsonian Folklife Festival. http://www.smithsonia-
neducation.org/migrations/bord/borders.html.
Cantu, Norma, and Olga Najera-Ramırez, eds. 2002. Chicana Traditions: Continuity
and Change. Chicago: University of Illinois Press.
Graham, Joe S. 1997. Hecho en Tejas: Texas-Mexican Folk Arts and Crafts. Den-
ning, TX: University of North Texas Press.
Griffith, James S. 2003. Folk Saints of the Borderlands: Victims, Bandits, and
Healers. Tucson, AZ: Rıo Nuevo Publishers.
Broadside Ballad
In its more general sense, a narrative song (ballad) printed on one side of a single
sheet of paper (broadside) and sold by a mobile peddler of the marketplace, fair-
ground, and street corner sort.
The broadside phenomenon emerged in Europe in the early years of the sixteenth
century, flourished in major Old World and, later, American cities and towns up to
the middle of the nineteenth century, and continued in less progressive locales (Ire-
land, for instance) into the early years of the twentieth century; it may be found in
towns and villages of some developing nations, such as Brazil and India, even
today. In lay speech, the phrase broadside ballad (or more commonly, just ballad
or balet) was not restricted to narrative songs but applied to any street-hawked
printed songs at all; for the past two hundred years or so, however, folklorists have
reserved the word ballad for a song that recounts a plotted story.
228 | Broadside Ballad
Each year from the early sixteenth century onward, many such newly made
song-stories appeared for the first time on broadsides and were peddled in public
places. Some were fictional, but most chronicled imaginatively some current,
newsworthy event, such as a military victory, a sensational crime, or a society
scandal. Few of them, however, changed their original status as popular literature
to become folklore; that is to say, like their many nonliterary broadside kin—pro-
clamations, pamphlets, tracts—they were bought, read, or sung a few times and
then forgotten. They did not, as we say, ‘‘enter folk tradition,’’ becoming imprinted
in memory and re-created in diverse day-to-day social encounters, sung by moth-
ers to children by evening candlelight, by upstairs maids to each other after a
lengthy day’s domestic service, or by a soldier to his comrades over a campfire far
from home. But over time, the public showed a distinct preference for hearing, for
singing, for remembering, and for experiencing again and again ballads from
broadsides that exhibited a fairly distinctive set of traits. So in British folksong tra-
dition, to take just one European example, the public had developed a preference
for a certain ‘‘style’’ of such ballads by the latter half of the eighteenth century,
and it is this style that folklorists have in mind when they talk about the broadside
ballad in a specific sense: They do not mean just any song printed on broadside,
and they do not mean—in the general sense mentioned earlier—just any narrative
song printed on broadside. (Of those, we just say that they ‘‘appeared on broad-
side’’ or some such thing, as we do, for example, of the many lengthy, virtually
unsingable song-tales printed in the older, heavy, ornate Gothic or black letter
typeface common in Tudor and Stuart England that never became folklore.) What
folklorists do mean in a specific sense is a folksong exhibiting a certain set of for-
mal conventions, the development and popularization of which was closely bound
up with broadside printing and dissemination. Indeed, in folklore terminology, a
broadside ballad may never actually have appeared on a broadside at all—it only
needs to exhibit the relevant stylistic traits of the genre!
In the tradition we know by far the most about, that of the British Isles and its
North American continuation, these characteristics are best described in terms of
their differences from the other major ballad style originating in Europe, the older
medieval or ‘‘Child’’ ballad style. Thus, a broadside ballad, first of all, usually
tells its story in a more linear, expository way than does the medieval ballad,
which is more allusive, dramatic (with much direct, unascribed speech that retards
the forward movement of the narrative), internally repetitive, and tableauxed in
style. Consider, for example, the step-by-step account in ‘‘The Flying Cloud,’’ a
nineteenth-century broadside ballad of slavery and piracy:
To the burning shores of Affaric, where the sugar cane does grow.
The Flying Cloud was a clipper ship, four hundred tons or more.
She could easily sail round any ship that sailed from Baltimore.
Her sails were as white as the driven snow and on them not one speck;
She had thirty-two brass guns, my boys, she carried upon her deck.
And in a short time after we had struck the African shore
Eighteen hundred of those poor souls on board with us we bore.
We made them walk out on our planks as we stored them down below;
Scarce eighteen inches to the man was all that she would go.
The very next day we set to sea with our cargo of slaves.
It would have been better for them poor souls had they been in their graves.
For the plagued fever came on board and swept one half away;
We drew their bodies up on deck and hove them in the sea.
And in a short time after we struck the Cubian shores.
We sold them to the planters there to be slaves for ever more,
To hoe in the rice and coffee fields beneath the burning sun,
To worry out a wretched life till their career was done.
As this excerpt from ‘‘The Flying Cloud’’ suggests, a second, related feature of
the broadside ballad style is its relative concreteness and specificity—people,
places, dates, professions, and motives are all detailed. The broadside ballad uni-
verse is quite distinguishable from the adumbrated, stylized, and more homoge-
neous medieval ballad world—and even more so, for that matter, from the
extremely generalized world of another folksong type, the non-narrative lyric
song: Each story tends to be particularized, situated, and contextualized. To put
this trait another way, a broadside ballad contains far more information of the
quantifiable sort than does its medieval forebear, as the first two stanzas of ‘‘The
Greenland Whale Fishery’’ illustrate:
It was in the year eighteen hundred and one, On March the twentieth day,
Our sheets were spread, and our anchors weighed, And for Greenland we
bore away, brave boys,
And for Greenland we bore away.
‘‘Speed’’ it was our Captain’s name,
And our ship the ‘‘Lion’’ bold,
And we sailed away to that cold countrie,
For to face the storms and the cold, brave boys, For to face the storms and
the cold.
A third distinguishing feature of the broadside ballad, in contrast with the oft-
noted impersonality and objectivity of the narrator point of view prominent in
230 | Broadside Ballad
the medieval ballad, is that it strives for subjectivity. Songs often pass
explicit moral judgment on the events at hand or express overt sentimentality.
They expose clearly their characters’ attitudes and values, often going so far as
to instruct the listener how to react emotionally or ethically to the events
recounted. More often than not, this subjectivity is emphasized with the device,
rare in the older ballad format, of a first-person narrator, as in ‘‘The Sheffield
Apprentice’’:
A fourth characteristic is that broadside ballads treat their subjects more realis-
tically than do medieval ballads. In the newer ballad style, for example, supernat-
ural personnel are rare; we find few revenants (ghosts who return from the dead
to bid their sweethearts a final farewell), household spirits, and magical plants
that, embodying the souls of dead lovers, sprout and entwine above the de-
ceased’s graves. Similarly, broadside ballad language itself is less exaggerated,
stylized, and formulaic, paralleling more closely the everyday standard language;
few broadside ballad horses in folk tradition are shod in gold and silver, fewer
heroines dressed in red while their accompanying retainers are clad in green,
fewer trips away from home are described in the same way (‘‘He hadn’t been in
fair England / A week but barely three’’). Of course, like all folklore, broadside
ballads are imaginative art and do exhibit stock epithets (‘‘Come all you gallant
Christians, I pray you lend an ear’’), but the broadside style of telling a story
seems far more bound by empirical constraints than the medieval style; thus,
broadside representations and language are more prone to reflect the world as
experienced in everyday life.
Finally, a closely related trait should be noted: the distinctive world portrayed
in the broadside ballad. In the medieval ballad, social organization, material cul-
ture, and customs and habits are distinctly premodern: Many heroines have page-
boys at their command, live in castles, or can escape a parentally arranged
marriage only by dying. In contrast, broadside ballads depict a more familiar,
more recognizable world. Perhaps the clearest example of this sort of difference
can be seen in the dramatis personae themselves. Even in twentieth-century ver-
sions, protagonists of medieval ballads are usually leisure-class men and women,
often nobility and sometimes even royalty. Protagonists of broadside ballads,
however, are much more commonly working people—laboring men and women,
artisans, merchants, and formally trained professionals such as physicians and
sea captains. And in this more modern world, heroines and heroes enjoy more
Broadside Ballad | 231
options in all aspects of life than do their medieval forebears, most notably in the
folksong’s favored topic, love relationships:
This ballad tells of a father who disapproves of his daughter’s choice of mate
and has the sailor pressed to sea, but the daughter, disguised in male clothing,
follows her lover and shares his nautical life. The two eventually return home to
marry.
The five traits mentioned in the preceding passages constitute the primary tex-
tual markers of the broadside ballad as a folksong type. Other tendencies may be
found in the genre that have less to do with the broadside ballad’s literariness and
more with its poetics—for example, an affection for 7/7/7/7 meter and for abba
tunes, especially in the Irish-influenced strand of English-speaking tradition—but
those qualities are not pervasive enough for definitional purposes. All five pri-
mary traits (most notably, the last two) are doubtless a function of the historical
conditions attending the broadside ballad’s more contemporary era (in Britain, the
medieval ballad style had virtually ceased to be employed as a vehicle for new
songs by 1700). The five traits also reflect the broadside ballad’s greater depend-
ence on print, as opposed to orality, for its origin, transmission, and reproduction.
In England by the mid-eighteenth century and in North America somewhat
later, this broadside song-story style had achieved clear prominence in the folk
aesthetic. Printers and the song makers they employed or contracted with turned
out a much more varied set of items for sale on street corners and market stalls,
but the public accepted into its personal performance repertoire of songs for
everyday social use mainly ballads that manifested the characteristics described.
Even amateur village rhymesters who were moved to share with family, work-
mates, and friends songs on topics of strictly local interest that might never see a
printed page—the drowning of some neighbor’s son in a nearby stream, a Maine
woods logging accident—were as likely as not to follow the broadside model, as
in this twentieth-century example:
Broadside shows a man with the body of a snake in the center of a group of skulls, repre-
senting the disease cholera. The image is accompanied by a sarcastic and ironic ballad
describing how cholera has afflicted the various social classes of Mexican society. Death
kills everyone, regardless of their place in society. (Library of Congress)
Broadside Ballad | 233
Our guns and ammunition we got without delay, Lou Lemmon had the
first shot I’m very sure to say.
George Croucher had the second shot if you want to know his name,
Bill Munden had the third shot which brought him to his end.
There were men, women, and children all gathered round the hill
All looking for a piece of meat their appetite to fill.
Just as the populace preferred a certain way of telling a story in song when
accepting popular culture into folk tradition, so too did it prefer certain topics.
Ballads of armed conflict, by land and sea; of crime and outlaws; of tragedies
and disasters (earthquakes, train wrecks, coal-mining cave-ins); of occupational
experience (in Britain, especially of agricultural work and seafaring and in North
America, of lumbering and cowboying); of sports and pastimes (horse races, fox-
hunting); and, of course, of the most popular topic by far (and the one most often
made up rather than based on actual events), love relationships, with recurring
plot-types about female warriors, returned and unrecognized lovers, murdered
sweethearts, and so on. Over the years, these were the broadside songs that peo-
ple preferred to learn, to pass on, and to remember. We base this assertion not on
the numbers and kinds of actual broadsides preserved in museums, archives, and
libraries or on printers’ inventory and sales figures but on just what songs folk-
lore collectors have found prominent in the repertoires of ordinary men and
women over the last century or so.
The broadside ballad declined in popularity after the midpoint of the nine-
teenth century, with the greater availability and affordability of professional
entertainment and the general decline of singing as a custom in everyday life.
Concomitantly, the broadside style of song became overshadowed by the more
sophisticated ditties that were heard in music halls and traveling shows, played
on radios and phonographs, and transcribed in sheet music and songbooks.
Increasingly, the public preferred songs of loftier topic and finer sentiment, of
more mature humor, of greater inventiveness and skill, and of more general inter-
est. The public now favored songs that were less dependent on the apparently
dated plot-types (not to mention language, meter, and even tunes favored by the
broadside muse) and songs that were more closely identified with particular pro-
fessional composers and performers, rather than with anonymous, itinerant versi-
fiers or with the even more anonymous ‘‘tradition.’’ In short, the broadside ballad
style did not survive well in an era that was more technologically advanced,
more market driven, more consumer oriented, and more supportive of bourgeois
sensibilities.
Roger deV. Renwick
See Also Ballad; Chapbook; Folksong, Lyric; Folksong, Narrative.
234 | Broadside Ballad
References
Dugaw, Dianne. 1989. Warrior Women and Popular Balladry, 1650 1850. Cambridge
Studies in Eighteenth-Century English Literature and Thought, vol. 4. Cambridge: Cam-
bridge University Press.
Laws, G. Malcolm Jr. 1957. American Balladry from British Broadsides: A Guide
for Students and Collectors of Traditional Song. American Folklore Society, Biblio-
graphical and Special Series, vol. 8. Philadelphia.
Laws, G. Malcolm Jr. 1964. Native American Balladry: A Descriptive Study and a
Bibliographical Syllabus. Rev. ed. American Folklore Society, Bibliographical and Spe-
cial Series, vol. 1. Philadelphia.
Paredes, Americo. 1958. ‘‘With His Pistol in His Hand’’: A Border Ballad and Its
Hero. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Travitsky, Betty S., and Anne Lake Prescott. 2005. Women and Murder in Early
Modern New Pamphlets and Broadside Ballads. Burlington, VT: Ashgate.
W€urzbach, Natascha. [1981] 1990. The Rise of the English Street Ballad, 1550
1650. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
C
Cantometrics
A method for defining societies’ singing styles and correlating them with other
cultural features. Coined by Alan Lomax, cantometrics refers to a method
devised in the 1960s by Lomax, Victor Grauer, and other participants in the
Columbia University Cross-Cultural Study of Expressive Style, which identifies
stylistic patterns in singing from societies throughout the world. Based on thirty-
six variables grouped under seven headings, culture-specific approaches to sing-
ing receive ratings that have allowed the definition of ten performance regions.
Song performance features in each region correlate with and derive from social
structure.
The cantometric method emerged with the availability of a body of recorded
song samples from across the globe. Significant, recurrent features of perfor-
mance, based on as few as ten individual examples from a society, have become
the measures for creating a cantometric profile of the society’s singing style. Such
a profile identifies these characteristics of singing: vocal qualities, use of ornamen-
tation (for example, glissandos and tremolos), dynamic features, melodic features,
rhythmic features, level of cohesiveness, and group organization. Subcharacteris-
tics of each of these general traits are scaled between two poles: For example,
melodic form (one of nine melodic features) ranges from complex to simple, and
vocal width (one of six vocal qualities) ranges from narrow to wide.
Similar profiles among several societies produce song-style regions, which
correspond roughly to culture areas in George P. Murdock’s Ethnographic Atlas.
Song-style region 1, for example, represents pockets of hunter-gatherer cultures
in Africa; region 6 corresponds to the tropical gardener cultures of Oceania and
central Africa, and region 8 is the Old High Culture that extends from North
Africa throughout most of southern and central Asia.
Moreover, the method adds an explanatory dimension to the construction of
profiles and the definition of regions. Researchers using cantometric scales
hypothesize correlations between singing performance and social structure. For
example, harsh vocal timbres predominate in cultures that stress the development
of aggressiveness in males. Narrow vocal widths and a high degree of nasality
occur in cultures with tightly controlled sexuality. Rhythmic regularity reflects the
inculcation in childhood of habits of obedience and adherence to structured rules,
and irregular rhythms occur in cultures with indulgent child-rearing practices.
235
236 | Carnival
Lomax and his colleagues, who have done similar measures on dance and
other expressive though nonverbal aspects of culture, have generated the bases
for defining singing styles and the ways in which to scale them. They also have
produced tapes for classroom use that afford students a global sample of singing
styles and enable them quickly to master ways to identify specific performances
according to song-style regions. Familiarity with these tapes also instructs stu-
dents in constructing cantometric profiles.
To some extent, objections to cantometrics reflect folklorists’ uneasiness with
broad syntheses of data. Moreover, a society’s song-style profile, critics aver, may
reflect the scorer’s subjective judgment, though informal experimentation has shown
considerable consistency among individuals using the system. A general profile also
can blur important variations within the society. That Lomax tended to release infor-
mation about cantometrics piecemeal over a twenty-year period also contributed to
hasty, often negative appraisals of what was essentially a work in progress.
William M. Clements
See Also Choreometrics.
References
Lomax, Alan. 1959. Folk Song Style. American Anthropologist 61: 927 954.
Lomax, Alan. 1967. The Good and the Beautiful in Folksong. Journal of American
Folklore 80: 213 235.
Lomax, Alan. 1968. Folk Song Style and Culture. Washington, DC: American Asso-
ciation for the Advancement of Science.
Lomax, Alan. 1972. The Evolutionary Taxonomy of Culture. Science 177: 228 239.
Lomax, Alan. 1976. Cantometrics: A Method in Musical Anthropology. Berkeley:
University of California Extension Media Center.
Murdock, George Peter. 1967. Ethnographic Atlas. Pittsburgh, PA: University of
Pittsburgh Press.
Carnival
Revelers dance to calypso music in Kingstown, St. Vincent, July 8, 2003, during Mardi
Gras, one of this Caribbean island’s largest carnival events. (AP/Wide World Photos)
crossed the Atlantic and Mediterranean to mix with the traditions of indigenous
and former slave populations in North and South American and certain African
countries, creating new forms of celebration. Common to carnival throughout its
historical and geographic ranges are masking and costuming (generally restricted
to the three to five days before Lent but also occurring sporadically from as early
as St. Martin’s Day, November 11, or Epiphany, January 6), public dramas and pri-
vate ceremonies, and the stylized expression of social and political attitudes. Local
social or occupational groups, known variously as guilds, schools, or cliques, often
serve as festival organizers and actively prepare carnival celebrations throughout
much of the year. More generally, carnival is an occasion for individuals to behave
in manners that either invert or exaggerate the behavior practiced at other times of
the year.
Carnival costuming ranges from the extravagant and elaborate regalia worn by
performers in those groups known as samba schools in Brazil and troupes of
Mardi Gras ‘‘Indians’’ in New Orleans to a bit of makeup or a nose mask worn by
parade spectators. Costumes may draw on mundane materials, such as agricultural
waste and rags, or utilize exquisite paraphernalia in their designs. In European tra-
dition, fool and wild man figures predominate. Animals, witches, and local
demons and comical figures frequently appear in Europe and elsewhere. Some
costumes are ephemeral, making their only appearance during the few days before
Lent in a single year; other traditions (such as those in southwest Germany or in
certain Belgian towns) require that local residents preserve their costumes for use
238 | Carnival
each year. Through such repeated appearances, these durable costumes come to
represent the localities where they are worn. In all of these cases, costuming and
the change of identity it creates encourage alternative behavior—from growling
like a bear to revealing private body parts. However, individuals do not have com-
plete license to behave as they choose during carnival.
Carnival dramas range in complexity from an individual reading a text or sing-
ing a ballad to parades, processions, and choreographed dances and festival plays
lasting a day or more. These dramas frequently reorient the distinctions made
between public and private spheres. For example, readings of ‘‘scandal sheets’’
(poetic accounts of local escapades, such as the priest who ‘‘lost’’ his foul-
mouthed parrot) make public knowledge that previously was passed through pri-
vate gossip. Likewise, the practice of wearing underwear or nightshirts on the
streets during carnival brings the private out into the open. Visits to homes by
troupes of performers collecting donations for community celebrations and/or
their own inebriation thrust reckless outdoor behavior into the private domain.
Although these diverse displays form the centerpiece of the public carnival spec-
tacle, smaller groups of locals hold annual balls, parties, and formal ceremonies
behind closed doors.
The relative freedom of behavior afforded by the joyous carnival mood seems
to encourage participants to voice their opinions about current affairs. Whether
in the form of scandal sheets, street theater, or politically apropos costumes (e.g.,
that of a Chernobyl victim), carnival antics regularly mock local, national, and
international citizens, institutions, and events, giving the playful festival atmos-
phere an underlying tone of seriousness. The politics of carnival also encompass
struggles over the privilege to enact and shape the celebration. Historically, these
struggles were played out between church and secular authorities and plebeian
populations. More recently, competing ethnic groups have battled over control of
the festival in urban settings, and established carnival organizers and local offi-
cials have tried to stage regulated, presentable festivals in opposition to the
wilder revelry advocated by some participants.
Peter Tokofsky
See Also Charivari/Shivaree; Festival.
References
Bakhtin, Mikhail. 1984. Rabelais and His World. Trans. Helene Iswolsky. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Cohen, Abner. 1993. Masquerade Politics: Explorations in the Structure of Urban
Carnival Movements. Oxford: Berg.
Damatta, Roberto. 1986. Carnival as a Cultural Problem: Toward a Theory of For-
mal Events and Their Magic. Kellogg Institute Working Paper no. 79. Notre Dame, IN:
Helen Kellogg Institute for International Studies.
Celtic Folklore and Mythology | 239
Kinser, Samuel. 1990. Carnival, American Style: Mardi Gras at New Orleans and
Mobile. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Le Roy Ladurie, Emmanuel. 1979. Carnival in Romans. Trans. Mary Feeney. New
York: George Braziller.
Mezger, Werner. 1991. Narrenidee und Fastnachtsbrauch: Studien zum Fortleben des
Mittelalters in der Eeurop€
aischen Festkultur. Constance, Germany: Universit€atsverlag.
The progression from darkness to light would appear to have been rationalized
among the prehistoric Celts into a dialectical relationship between the figures
Dhuosnos (the dark one) and Vindos (the bright one). This emerges in medieval
Irish and Welsh narratives in hints at contests (carried out in human, fairy, or ani-
mal form) between figures named Donn and Find in Irish narratives, or kindred
characters in Welsh such as Arawn and Hafgan or Gwythyr and Gwynn. The
ubiquitous Find or Finn (Fion, Fionn) in Irish tradition is a derivative of Vindos,
while Donn (from Dhuosnos) was in persistent Irish lore a lord of the dead whose
‘‘house’’ was a solitary rock off the southwest coast.
The belief that the dead passed to an otherworld island in the West was held
by the ancient Celts of the Continent as well as of Britain and Ireland. This realm
became known by a variety of names, such as Tır na nog (the land of the young)
or Ynys Avallach (the isle of apples), and ancient tradition that envisaged the Isle
of Man in this way gave rise to lore concerning a great lord of that island, a ma-
gician called in Welsh Manawydan and in Irish Manannan. The idea of an other-
world island off the west coast survived not only in Gaelic areas but also in
Welsh, Cornish, and Breton traditions of the Middle Ages. It was often elabo-
rated into legends of a city on the coast or under a lake that had been submerged
by a great catastrophe due to some human error or some rash act that brought
about the anger of the elements or of God himself.
Early Irish and Welsh sources contain echoes of a mythical contest at a great
rock in the western sea, an idea that must have sprung from similar archaic Celtic
beliefs. This was developed—probably in the prehistoric period—by associating
it with the far-flung plot of a primordial battle between two sets of deities. In its
most elaborate form, in the early medieval Irish text Cath Maige Tuired, a great
battle is described between the divine Tuatha De Danann (people of the goddess
Danu) and the sinister Fomorians (Fomoire) (underspirits, who had strong aquatic
connections). Such development of mythic symbolism into historical legend is
typical of how the detritus of ancient myth came to be treated in medieval lore.
The Tuatha De Danann are described in the text as inhabitants of Ireland with
their royal center at Tara, and the Fomorians as sea pirates who oppress them in a
variety of ways. The cast of characters includes several Celtic deities, such the
Daghdha himself, his consort the goddess Morrigan (Mor-Rıoghain, ‘‘phantom
queen’’), the smith god Goibhniu, and the polytechnic god Lug (Lugh).
Lug wins the battle for the Tuatha De Danann by slaying the Fomorian leader,
Balar, who has a terrible eye that destroys all on which it looks. This Balar (from
Celtic Bolerios) dwells on the rocky island of Tory off the northwest coast, and
perhaps of equal significance, he is also associated with Mizen Head, the extreme
southwest point of Ireland. In fact, the extreme southwest area of Britain was
anciently known as Bolerion, a cognate of his name. Balar’s connections with
both the scorching and the setting sun are therefore clear, and Lug may represent
Celtic Folklore and Mythology | 241
the sun in its more constructive role. Such a basic format was developed into a
plot that had Lug as the prophesied son of Balar’s daughter, a format that echoes
a well-known mythic structure of the eastern Mediterranean region (such as
accounts of Sargon, Cyrus, Moses, and Perseus). It seems likely that this plot had
been borrowed in antiquity by the Continental Celts from the Greeks and attached
to their deity Lugus, of whom Lug is the Irish development. Traces of it have also
been argued for Lleu, the Welsh equivalent of the deity, who is described in the
Mabinogi and other medieval Welsh sources. The plot was further used in medie-
val Irish accounts of the heroic youth of Finn mac Cumaill, and in the Breton
source that Marie de France used for her lay Yonec.
Other Celtic deities survived strongly in medieval lore, and in even more human
forms. A noted example was the Celtic goddess Rigantona (exalted queen), cog-
nate with the above-mentioned Irish Morrigan. In the Mabinogi, she appears in the
guise of Rhiannon, an otherworld woman riding on a large white horse that out-
strips all her pursuers. Morrigan was in fact the original name of the otherworld
lady known as Macha in medieval Irish literature. As the goddess of Ulster king-
ship, she acquired the new name from that of the area that was the center of that
kingdom—Macha meaning ‘‘plain’’ or ‘‘pasture.’’ Macha was described as a great
runner, and her most celebrated achievement was winning a race against horses.
Such a Rigantona-personage, paralleling the ancestor deity in equine associations,
must have been the same as the Continental Celtic goddess of horses known as
Epona (exalted horse lady).
Medieval Irish literature relates that Macha warned her husband not to boast of
her running skills, but he does so, leading to the tragic end of their union. This
exemplifies the process by which suitable narratives were borrowed to underline
the importance of mythical personages. The narrative plot here concerns an other-
world woman coming to live with an ordinary man and then leaving him after he
breaks a prohibition she had put on him. This seems to have been a floating folk-
lore plot in Western Europe in the early Middle Ages, for it appears later in French
legends of Melusine. The floating motif easily attached itself to the goddess of
Ulster kingship, as the marriage of the king to the land goddess was an ancient
conceit in Celtic inauguration rites. The maintaining of kingship was of course a
precarious business, and immemorial tradition had added many types of gessa
(magical prohibitions) to the ordinary social pressures that a king had to endure.
Lofty personages were made the subjects of floating medieval plots in other
contexts also. A popular story in early medieval Ireland told of how the Daghdha
was made to relinquish control of his dwelling in the prehistoric tumulus of Brugh
na Boinne (Newgrange in County Meath) to his son Aenghus. According to this,
Aenghus got a loan of the dwelling ‘‘for a night and a day’’ and then kept it for-
ever by claiming that all time is computed as night and day. There are several
other ruses of the ‘‘tomorrow never comes’’ type described in Irish tradition, and
242 | Celtic Folklore and Mythology
clearly the plot has been borrowed here from popular lore. Again, however, it
underlines the ancient mythic idea of son superseding father or by extension the
ritual idea of a king gaining tenure of his realm from the ancestor deity. The name
Aenghus meant ‘‘true vigor,’’ and the process is again revealed in the name of a
character in the Ulster cycle who also relinquishes a kingdom: Fergus mac Roig
(or Ferghus mac Ro-eich, literally, ‘‘male vigor son of great horse’’). The archaic
basis of the ritual may further be exemplified by the pseudonym of Aenghus,
Maccan Og, which scholars regard as a development from the archaic Celtic
youth deity Maponos, son of Matrona (‘‘exalted mother’’ or ‘‘great mother’’).
Maponos appears in medieval Welsh sources as Mabon.
As in the case of narrative plots, the mythological personages themselves
could gain popularity in comparatively mundane form. A clear instance is the
smith god known in Irish as Goibhniu and in Welsh as Gofannon. His memory
survived in a Christian context as a marvelous craftsman called Goban Saer, and
legends were told of how this Goban built monasteries and round towers for
saints throughout the length and breadth of Ireland. The images of Celtic deities,
particularly Lug, have been deciphered by scholars in the cults of several early
Irish saints, while the celebrated St. Brighid (Brigid) of the sixth century CE has
attracted to her tradition much of the cult of her namesake, the Celtic goddess
Brighid (the highest one), and accordingly was portrayed as a patroness of agri-
culture, of fertility, and of poetry. The cult of St. Brighid, in turn, exerted a large
influence on the lore concerning other female saints, not only in Ireland but
throughout much of the medieval Celtic world.
The goddess persona persisted into medieval Ireland in two ways: as a conven-
tion in the verses of poets, where goddesses were mentioned as consorts and pro-
tectresses of great kings and chieftains, and in ordinary folklore, where they were
described as fairy queens ruling from palaces within several of the archaeological
structures that dot the Irish countryside. One of the most famous of these ladies
was Aine (the bright one), patroness of the Eoghanacht dynasty in Munster and
later of the Norman family of Fitzgerald. Many folk legends tell of how she
appeared from time to time to assist families in need. The patronage of the god-
desses, indeed, developed through medieval tradition into one of the most cele-
brated of all spirits in Irish culture, the banshee (bean sı, meaning ‘‘woman of the
tumulus,’’ or ‘‘fairy woman’’). She is heard to lament the death of a member of the
old Gaelic race, thus showing her special connection with and affection for such
a person. Another retention of goddess imagery is exemplified by lore of the
Cailleach Bhearra, an old hag who was said to have lived from time immemorial
and was particularly associated in Ireland with farming and harvesting and in
Scotland with the wilderness and forests.
Druidic lore did not survive in direct form from ancient Celtic belief, but the
learned castes preserved into the Middle Ages and to more recent times much of
Celtic Folklore and Mythology | 243
with other countries; through the travels of clerics, pilgrims, and merchants; and
also through the Viking settlements in many Celtic areas. Dozens of such interna-
tional plots have been identified in medieval Welsh and Irish literature, often
being used in association with the names of mythical and historical characters
from indigenous tradition. This was another aspect of the tendency to develop de-
tritus of rituals and beliefs into romantic narratives, a process that modern schol-
ars, from their different perspectives, might view as either a confusion of the
earlier tradition or as a dramatic perpetuation of it.
One singular example of a very ancient folktale being embedded in early Irish
ın. Both of these characters, as
tradition is the story of Mider and his love for Eta
well as several others in the story, were mythical personages, and there are several
echoes of ancient ritual and history involved. In the actual story, however, Mider
ın and has to perform stupendous tasks to regain her—this and other
loses Eta
motifs in the story possess relatives in AT 313, ‘‘The Girl as Helper in the Hero’s
Flight,’’ one of the earliest and most far-flung international tale types known. It
must have been connected with the ancient Irish traditional material sometime in
the early centuries of the Common Era.
A celebrated story in the Welsh Mabinogi tells of a male child born to Rhiannon
being stolen away by a giant. Rhiannon is accused of killing the baby. A foal is
later stolen by the same giant, but the owner of the foal cuts off the giant’s hand
and manages to recover both baby and foal. Rhiannon and other characters belong
to ancient Celtic tradition, but the plot of the story possesses strong parallels in AT
653 (‘‘The Four Skillful Brothers’’), AT 712, and other international narrative ma-
terial. In fact, a similar use of some of the same material occurs in a later medieval
Irish story in which Finn mac Cumaill recovers stolen children and puppies from a
giant. Finn enlists the assistance of marvelous helpers in his task, a plot based on
AT 653; and the related helper tale AT 513 (‘‘The Helpers’’) is in fact the plot base
for another celebrated Mabinogi story, that of Culhwch and Olwen.
Metamorphosis was a trait often associated with the deities of early Celtic
myth, perhaps originating in druidic emphasis on such mystical faculties. By the
medieval period it had become commonplace among Welsh and Irish writers
when describing the great worthies of old, especially those who had divine names
or divine attributes. It was claimed that they could take the forms of various ani-
mals and birds and could, when necessary, live for long periods in such forms. To
underline and dramatize this belief, narrators made use of episodes and motifs
well known elsewhere in international traditions, such as the final episode of the
folktale ‘‘The Magician and His Pupil’’ (AT 325), in which two magicians take on
various forms as they fight each other. Such tales of transformation influenced the
contest of the bulls in the Ulster cycle and the Welsh story of Taliesin. One very
popular tradition, frequently used by medieval storytellers in both Wales and Ire-
land, concerned the great age of particular animals, whose names were celebrated
246 | Chapbook
in tradition, and the task of seeking out these animals and comparing their ages.
The two principal plots in question—AT 80A (‘‘Who Gets the Beehive’’) and AT
726 (‘‘The Oldest on the Farm’’)—were very old in European lore, but their com-
bination would appear to have been a particular development in the Celtic areas.
Of the many other international narrative plots utilized in medieval Celtic folk-
lore, we may quote one example to show how such material could be at once simple
in its structure and pervasive in its influence. This is the story of the king with ass’s
ears (AT 782), which was well known in classical sources (where the king is often
said to be King Midas) and in other sources. A good deal of tradition centered on a
king called March, reputed to have been the elderly lover of Essyllt, and thus the
rival of Drystan (these three characters are commonly known as Mark, Tristan, and
Iseut in the Continental literature of the Middle Ages). The name was a corruption
of the Latin one, Marcus, borne by a sixth-century local ruler in southwest Britain. It
could, however, be interpreted as ‘‘horse’’ by speakers of Celtic. It was natural, then,
for the ass’s ears, transformed into horse’s ears, to be attributed to him. The story
was told in Wales, Cornwall, and Brittany that he concealed his ears, but his barber
grew sick from keeping the secret and whispered it to a tree or to reeds. A musical
instrument was made from the tree or the reeds, and when it was played it sang out
the dreadful secret! This March was famous in tradition as a seafarer (llynghessawc),
and thus the story traveled across the Irish Sea and became told of the ancient mythi-
cal Leinster king Labhraidh, who was also known as a seafarer (loingseach).
Daithı O hOg
ain
See Also Arthurian Lore; Folktale; King Arthur.
References
Aldhouse-Green, Miranda J. 1992. Dictionary of Celtic Myth and Legend. London:
Thames and Hudson.
MacCana, Proinsias. 1970. Celtic Mythology. New York: Hamlyn.
Matson, Gienna. 2004. Celtic Mythology A to Z. New York: Facts on File.
hOg
O ain, Daithı. 1999. The Sacred Isle: Belief and Religion in Pre-Christian Ire-
land. Cork, Ireland: Collins Press.
hOg
O ain, Daithı. 2006. Ireland’s Pre-Celtic Archaeological and Anthropological
Heritage. New York: Edwin Mellen Press.
Chapbook
important part of the stock of such peddlers, and their subject matter included
prophecies and fortune-telling, fables and fairy tales, and stories of devils and
angels, love and hate, and scoundrels and heroes.
Chapbooks, with their modern typography, replaced the earlier black letter
broadside ballads; usually measuring 3.500 by 600 , they also were easier to carry
about than a pile of ballad sheets. By the end of the seventeenth century, they
were typically printed in octavo, a sheet of paper folded three times to make
eight leaves or sixteen pages, but chapbooks of four, eight, twelve, and twenty-
four pages were also common. Printed on both sides of a sheet of paper, they
were a better value than broadside ballads and became the main reading matter
available for the poor, although they also were read by more well-to-do individu-
als. Chapbooks containing ballads were called ‘‘garlands.’’
In the nineteenth century, chapbooks were increasingly produced for children.
No longer printed on coarse rag paper, they were better produced and often
smaller in size. The quality of woodcuts and other illustrations was improved,
and the illustrations were sometimes colored. Broadside ballads, no longer
printed in black letter, replaced chapbooks for adult readers of the poorest class.
During the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, more than 250 firms and individ-
uals were involved in the production of chapbooks in London alone, with many
more in such cities and towns as Newcastle upon Tyne, Banbury, Northampton,
Gloucester, and York. Chapbooks were printed in Belfast, Dublin, Glasgow,
Edinburgh, Aberdeen, and throughout the English-reading world.
Ephemeral literature seems to exist wherever its means of production exist, and
it is often late in its history before it becomes an object of study; its forms differ
somewhat from country to country. Folhetos (pamphlets or little books)—or, collo-
quially, folhetes—are known to have been printed in Brazil since the late nineteenth
century. Often 400 by 6.500 in size and of eight, sixteen, thirty-two, and occasionally
sixty-four pages, these little books are much like English chapbooks. Printed on
newspaper-weight paper, they contain stories in verse (with the exception of a small
number of prayers in prose), thus differing from English chapbooks, which often
were written in prose. In subject matter, folhetos reflect the culture in which they
are produced. Most stories represent a series of trials, and their heroes and heroines
are either saints or sinners. Almost all have explicit, serious messages, even though
many are humorous and a few are pornographic. A recent title, A contagiosa AIDS
matando a humanidade (Contagious AIDS killing humanity), reflects both a highly
conservative view of sexual behavior and a plea for help for AIDS victims.
Because of the interest of middle-class visitors and their common use of the
Portuguese phrase literatura de cordel (stories on a cord) for folhetos, such a lit-
tle book is now commonly called a cordel, even though the items produced in
Brazil differ from the Portuguese chapbooks to which they are related. The rela-
tionship between the little ephemeral books of Brazil and Portugal may be
248 | Chapbook
References
Ashton, John. 1882. Chap-Books of the Eighteenth Century. Reprint. New York:
Benjamin Blom.
Neuburg, Victor E. 1968. The Penny Histories: A Study of Chapbooks for Young
Readers over Two Centuries. London: Oxford University Press.
Neuburg, Victor E. 1972. Chapbooks: A Guide to Reference Material on English,
Scottish and American Chapbook Literature of the Eighteenth and Nineteenth Centu-
ries. Reprint. London: Woburn.
Neuburg, Victor E. 1977. Popular Literature: A History and Guide, from the Begin-
ning of Printing to the Year 1897. Harmondsworth, England: Penguin.
Preston, Cathy Lynn, and Michael J. Preston. 1995. The Other Print Tradition:
Essays on Chapbooks, Broadsides, and Other Ephemera. New York: Garland.
Preston, Michael J., M. G. Smith, and P. S. Smith. 1977. Chapbooks and Traditional
Drama: An Examination of Chapbooks Containing Traditional Play Texts, Part 1:
Alexander and the King of Egypt Chapbooks. CECTAL Bibliographical and Special
Series, no. 2. Sheffield, England: University of Sheffield.
Shepard, Leslie. 1969. John Pitts: Ballad Printer of Seven Dials, London (1765 1844)
with a Short Account of His Predecessors in the Ballad & Chapbook Trade. London: Pri-
vate Libraries Association.
Slater, Candice. 1982. Stories on a String: The Brazilian ‘‘Literatura de Cordel.’’
Berkeley: University of California Press.
Spufford, Margaret. 1981. Small Books and Pleasant Histories: Popular Fiction and
Its Readership in Seventeenth-Century England. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Spufford, Margaret. 1994. The Pedlar, the Historian and the Folklorist: Seventeenth
Century Communications. Folklore 105: 13 24.
Watt, Tessa. 1991. Cheap Print and Popular Piety: 1550 1640. Cambridge: Cam-
bridge University Press.
Charivari/Shivaree | 249
Charivari/Shivaree
References
Davis, Natalie Zemon. 1975. The Reasons of Misrule. In Natalie Zemon Davis, Soci-
ety and Culture in Early Modern France, pp. 97 123. Stanford, CA: Stanford Univer-
sity Press.
Le Goff, Jacques, and Jean Claude Schmitt, eds. 1981. Le Charivari. Paris: Ecole
des Haute Etudes en Science Sociales.
Palmer, Bryan D. 1978. Discordant Music: Charivaris and Whitecapping in Nine-
teenth-Century North America. Labour/le travailleur 3: 5 62.
Thompson, E. P. 1993. Rough Music. In Customs in Common: Studies in Traditional
Popular Culture, ed. Edward P. Thompson. New York: New Press.
Charm
Folk belief and practice in which humans use magic to bring about particular out-
comes in activities where there is uncertainty. Charms can be verbal or material,
they can involve action, and they seem to be cross-cultural and found in all his-
torical periods. Charms are important in several different areas of folk belief
scholarship, including folk medicine, folk religion, ritual, and custom.
One of the most common forms of behavior involving charms is the practice of
keeping or carrying amulets, fetishes, or talismans—material objects thought to
ward off evil forces or bring good luck. People in ancient Rome used garlic to
keep witches away; in medieval times, monks used the mullen plant as a charm
against devils although the plant also was thought to be used in witches’ brew; the
Chinese sometimes carry peach wood or peach stones to ward off evil; and many
people carry a rabbit’s foot or hang horseshoes over doors for good luck in the
contemporary United States. In religious terms, carrying a saint’s medal or small
statue is thought to help people avoid accidents on trips. This practice is not con-
fined to Catholics; Protestant commercial fishermen in the Gulf of Mexico often
Charm | 251
carry saints’ medals given to them by priests at annual blessings of the fleet.
Scholars must examine the ritual context in order to understand why Protestants
would carry Catholic medals. As with any kind of folk belief, it is important to
study charms within the specific context of belief and behavior.
Verbal charms or incantations are an important part of healing traditions
among many cultural groups. For example, the practice of bloodstopping in
Appalachia depends on reciting a verse from the Bible several times. The verse
is learned from certain family members and is usually thought of as a secret ritual
that has to be learned and practiced in very specific ways. People who believe
that excessive bleeding can be stopped through this verbal charm tell stories
about the times they have witnessed the charm succeed, saving the lives of indi-
viduals who would have bled to death before they reached a hospital.
Often, to be effective, use of a verbal charm also must be accompanied by cer-
tain actions. For instance, Italian fishermen have a charm for dispersing a water-
spout that could sink their boats. They recite words from Scripture, make the sign
of the cross with a special knife, and say ‘‘tail of the rat’’ to keep the magic from
harming anyone. As with bloodstopping, this charm must be learned from a special
person under certain conditions—in this case, from an elderly woman on Christmas
Eve. Again, stories are told about experiences that validate when a person has seen
this charm work to break up a waterspout. Catholic Croatian fishermen in the Adri-
atic have a similar charm for waterspouts, but it involves an inscription, combining
material and behavioral methods: They draw a Star of David on a piece of paper
and throw it overboard in the direction of the waterspout. This is another instance
of using the religion of others as a source for folk belief.
Folk charms are associated with particular groups or communities, but knowl-
edge of charms can pass to a broader, mass-media context. Traditional African
American charms have been popularized through music, novels, and the public in-
terest in conjuration. Chicago blues singer Muddy Waters sang, ‘‘Got my mojo
working, but it just don’t work on you.’’ The mojo, an amulet that can be made of
different materials, is a powerful love charm; hence, the singer referred to his frus-
tration that his mojo was not working on the woman he loved. Recordings of
Waters’s song have been played all over the world, and other singers have done
versions of it. Charms are a cross-cultural phenomena, so that even though specific
amulets and incantations vary widely, the concept of using a magical means for
controlling fate seems universal.
Patrick B. Mullen
See Also Magic; Medicine, Folk.
References
Dundes, Alan, ed. 1973. Mother Wit from the Laughing Barrel: Readings in the
Interpretation of Afro-American Folklore. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall. See
252 | Childbirth and Childrearing
these chapters: Ruth Bass, ‘‘Mojo,’’ and Mimi Clar Melnick, ‘‘‘I Can Peep through
Muddy Water and Spy Dry Land’: Boasts in the Blues.’’
Leach, Maria, ed. 1984. Funk and Wagnall’s Standard Dictionary of Folklore, My-
thology, and Legend. San Francisco: Harper and Row. See these entries: ‘‘Amulets,’’
‘‘Charms,’’ ‘‘Fetish,’’ and ‘‘Talisman.’’
Lessa, William A., and Evon Z. Vogt, eds. 1979. Reader in Comparative Religion:
An Anthropological Approach, 4thed. New York: Harper and Row. See these chapters:
James G. Frazer, ‘‘Sympathetic Magic,’’ Claude Levi-Strauss, ‘‘The Effectiveness of
Symbols,’’ and Bronislaw Malinowski, ‘‘The Role of Magic and Religion.’’
Wigginton, Eliot, ed. 1972. The Foxfire Book. Garden City, NY: Doubleday.
Childbirth is the act or process of giving birth (parturition), and childrearing the
acts or processes of protecting, caring for, feeding, and otherwise facilitating the
development of offspring from infancy to relative self-sufficiency. For the major-
ity of human history in both Western and non-Western societies, the practices of
childbirth, midwifery, and early infant care have been shaped by societal issues
and beliefs and have undergone great changes, new understandings, and different
practices. Influences on childbirth and childrearing practices have included
advances in medical knowledge, industrialization and urbanization, the rise of
the middle class, changes in belief patterns and structures in both organized reli-
gions and in community-based household or folk religions, and new scientific
and cultural understandings about women’s bodies, health, and roles.
In the nineteenth century, early folklorists and antiquarians began to collect what
they regarded as survivals (relics of the past, particularly traditions and beliefs
common to rural areas). Examples associated with pregnancy, childbirth, and
infancy included notions about dietary intake and prenatal marking, including pica
(the desire to eat non-food items, such as ice, chalk, ashes, or starch, and particu-
larly geophagy—dirt-eating during pregnancy); divination practices regarding the
sex of the fetus; practices and styles of delivery; methods of pain relief and pos-
tures; customs and rituals of birth chambers and attendants; and societal attitudes
and beliefs regarding general birthlore and early infant care. These were recorded
in large collections of folkways and rural practices. Fanny Bergen’s Current Super-
stitions: Collected from the Oral Tradition of English Speaking States (1996) and
Charles Skinner’s Myths and Legends of Our Own Land (2003) are examples.
In contrast, histories of birth presented by members of the medical profession
were based on cultural evolutionary ideas involving projections of progress to-
ward social ideals; in the main, they advocated and described cultural advances
and technological developments. Conventional histories, however, did not cap-
ture or discuss the experiences of the vast majority of women giving birth, the
Childbirth and Childrearing | 253
role and beliefs of the community in the birth process, or the practices, traditions,
and beliefs of midwives.
More recent efforts to create a history of birth from a folklife or social histori-
cal perspective placed traditions and practices within chronological periods. Typ-
ically, early histories describe a period in the deep past when women were
highly involved in delivery as midwives and assistants practicing a noninterven-
tionist approach that was centered on serving mothers. A second period in West-
ern Europe and in North America is seen as beginning in the mid-1700s with the
growing professionalization of medicine, an increase in the study and practice of
midwifery by males, and the definition of birth as a disease state. A third period,
from the mid-nineteenth century until the present day, is characterized as a pe-
riod of consolidation of medical control over birth, with a countermovement to
reclaim birth as a female-centered, natural event, and a glorification of the early
period of what is now called ‘‘social birth.’’
In the first period of social birth, from the early years of America until the mid-
1700s, the process of labor and delivery was a community event. Childbirth was
viewed as a normal process, and community members were content to allow nature
to follow its course. The predominant practices, material objects, and language
254 | Childbirth and Childrearing
associated with birth were predicated upon this understanding and approach. Inter-
vention was rare, and doctors were called only in the case of an impossible deliv-
ery, the death of the mother, or the death of the child in utero (as yet unborn).
Near the time of delivery, the neighborhood midwife was alerted that her serv-
ices would be required in the days to come. When the moment arrived, the father,
a child, or a neighbor was sent to fetch her to the pregnant woman’s home to assist
in the delivery. The midwife would bring along the tools of her trade—twine, scis-
sors, cloth, and perhaps a birth stool or chair. The latter would be assembled and
the expectant mother would spend her labor talking with her friends and neighbors
who had gathered. When she reached the point of delivery, she would sit upon a
birth chair, makeshift stool, or the lap of attendants, and deliver her child. Fathers
participated if needed; doctors were seldom present.
A diary account from 1677 by Samuel Sewall of Massachusetts portrays such
a visit by a midwife:
April 2, 1677. Father and I sitting in the great Hall, heard the [summon-
ing] child cry. . . . Went home with the Midwife about 2 o’clock, carrying
her Stool, whose parts were included in a Bagg. Met with the watch at
Mr. Rocks Brew house, who baid us stand, enquired what we were. I told
the Woman’s occupation, so they baid God bless our labours, and let us
pass. (Banks 1999, 6)
After the Revolutionary War, the growing influence of physicians’ guilds and
colleges, the increase in the numbers of doctors being trained and practicing, and
the discovery of possibilities for profit in midwifery threatened the practice of tra-
ditional midwifery and the livelihood of female midwives in the United States.
By increasingly defining birth as a dangerous, pathological crisis, the medical
profession undermined society’s belief in the skills of midwives, thereby increas-
ing doctors’ incomes. In 1820, Walter Channing, professor of obstetrics at
Harvard, wrote, ‘‘Women seldom forget a practitioner who has conducted them
tenderly and safely through parturition. . . . It is principally on this account that
the practice of midwifery becomes desirable to physicians. It is this which insures
to the permancy [sic] and security of all their other business’’ (Banks 1999, 40).
Physicians developed and substantiated a definition of pregnancy and birth as
disease states. Displacing traditional folk medicine in order to supply a specific
etiology (cause) and catalogue of symptoms, they offered elaborate birth-chair
designs and began to innovate invasive practices and the liberal use of technolog-
ically advanced tools. Forceps, crochets, and hooks, previously only utilized as a
last resort to save the life of the mother, the child, or both, became common-
place. Changes in the folk practices of delivery and in the beliefs and attitudes
that had supported them are most evident in changes in styles and postures for
delivery—from upright in a birth chair to recumbent in a bed (necessary for tool
use); in the sex of the birth attendant—from female to male; in attitudes toward
laboring women; and in language regarding pregnancy and birth. Terms such as
‘‘teeming’’ and ‘‘breeding’’ were replaced in nineteenth-century diaries, litera-
ture, and other texts with terms like ‘‘sick,’’ ‘‘confined,’’ and, tellingly, ‘‘ill.’’
Midwifery manuals gave way to obstetrical texts, and in the titles of these
works, pregnancy and birth were increasingly referred to as the ‘‘diseases of
women.’’ Advice booklets appeared that instructed women as to proper behavior
during pregnancy exams and birth, and provided general guidance for the selec-
tion and use of doctors. This portrayal of birth as a disease state fed the growing
conception within society of the fragility of women. As Dr. Mary Putnam Jacobi
stated in 1895, ‘‘I think, finally, it is in the increased attention paid to women,
and especially in their new function as lucrative patients, scarcely imagined a
hundred years ago, that we find explanation for much of the ill health among
women, freshly discovered today’’ (Banks 1999, 41).
The actual practice of childbirth was also affected by other significant societal
changes, including shifts in the general attitude of the populace about femininity
and womanhood, industrialization, changing economic structures, and the emer-
gence of the middle class. Women were eventually understood to be as weak and
fragile as doctors and scientists thought they were. Exertion and activity were
regarded as dangerous to their health and general well-being. If a woman did not
experience illness as a result of such activities, she must not be ‘‘truly female.’’
Childbirth and Childrearing | 257
Thus, fragility and ill health became acceptable and common indications of a
refined sensibility and high social status.
The cultivation of upper-class women’s ill health as a sign of status and civi-
lized behavior further contributed to the growing conception that the whole pro-
cess of childbearing was well beyond a refined woman’s capability. If a woman
was ‘‘civilized,’’ it was believed, she needed medical help in delivery. As mem-
bers of the growing middle class sought to emulate the wealthy classes in all
ways, it became critical for them to show that the active economic participation
of their wives and daughters to provide for the family’s welfare was unnecessary.
Female idleness, once considered sinful, was now a status symbol.
Yet in the nineteenth century, birth in some ways became more difficult. Life
in the industrialized city and standards of fashionable dress made the image of
unhealthy women into reality. Years of use of supports such as corsets and strait
lacing seriously altered a woman’s anatomy. Malformed torsos and pelvic areas
made delivery difficult or impossible, and fetuses were damaged when women
continued to wear fashionable undergarments throughout pregnancy.
By the late nineteenth century, the practice of delivery was strikingly different
from what it had been 100 years earlier. The strong bonds of female community,
particularly noticeable through women’s earlier participation in the delivery of a
community member, were weakened by popular migration to cities where
friends, family members, and neighbors were no longer available. Knowledge
about pregnancy and childbirth declined as these topics became increasingly
unacceptable in polite conversation; when people did speak of them, they used
euphemisms and told fictional stories about where babies come from (for exam-
ple, brought by the stork or found in a cabbage patch). Even practitioners used
such euphemisms when advertising their services.
Drugs were used to hasten delivery, bloodletting was practiced, and obstetrical
tools were extensively employed to remove the infant mechanically from the
mother. Birth-chair design was first radically altered, and then the chairs them-
selves gradually were dismissed as archaic items; horizontal delivery in bed was
preferred. Such changes may have made doctors physically more comfortable and
enhanced their feeling and appearance of control, but they increased the actual bur-
den on the mother and removed control of the event from her. The elements and
practices associated with the earlier, more natural approach came to be regarded
with apprehension and dread, representing a period before treatment was available.
The nineteenth century also saw the development of the cult of motherhood in
the United States, with the glorification of ‘‘true womanhood’’ and the invention
of childhood as a distinct stage of life. In her separate domestic sphere, a wife as
full-time homemaker and mother was valued as a nurturer, not as a worker. More
children were kept at home into their late teens because they were no longer con-
sidered economic assets who could be employed in household industries or
258 | Childbirth and Childrearing
bound out as child apprentices. Children were treated as beings in emotional and
social formation instead of as miniature adults to be trained in the skills and nec-
essary tasks of society (Kertzer and Barbagli 2002).
By the middle of the nineteenth century, these changes in the view of children
had spread from the elite to the urban (and largely Protestant) middle class. Books,
magazines, poetry, and fiction were being written especially for children who now
enjoyed prolonged childhoods. Parents eagerly read advice books on how best to
rear children. Merchants began offering dolls, trains, and other children’s play-
things, and stores specializing in games, toys, and children’s goods opened in
larger cities. Attitudes about children’s early learning also changed. As late as the
1830s and 1840s, infant schools in the northern states enrolled children as young
as three years; reading at an early age was encouraged. Elizabeth Palmer Peabody
established the first formally organized kindergarten in Boston in 1860. Influenced
by German educational experiments, Peabody sought to offer children learning
activities such as clay modeling and paper cutting, rather than specific instruction
in reading or writing, or training in the chores and tasks of their elders as in the
past. The former activities, she argued, stimulated children’s educational develop-
ment; the latter merely exploited and broke them (Mann and Peabody 1869).
Unfortunately, not all children lived such a privileged existence. Although urban
middle-class families could prosper without having to put their children to work,
for most families a child was still a necessary economic asset. Children of the poor,
the indentured, and the enslaved were still sent out to work in fields, mines, and
mills until the enactment of child-labor laws, beginning in 1916. Children were
expected to contribute to the well-being and support of the family and work the
same hours as adults; they could be prosecuted and punished under the same laws.
While maternity hospitals or lying-in centers were first used only by poor
women who were delivered free of charge in exchange for their use as test cases
for medical students, birth in hospitals among women of the upper classes and
paying customers rose sharply following the introduction of obstetrical anesthe-
sia, known as ‘‘twilight sleep,’’ at the turn of the twentieth century.
Delivery in hospitals took place in operating rooms or theaters, with women
highly anesthetized on flat tables or hospital gurneys with arm straps, shoulder
straps, and stirrups with leg restraints, attended by licensed medical personnel.
Birth was a medical procedure conducted by doctors on the unconscious woman.
Texts on childbirth available to and intended for women were treatises on home
economics: advice on mothering, scientific housekeeping, diapering, and tips for
the care and nurturing of children. Little information about becoming pregnant
and the processes of gestation and delivery was made available; women were
instructed to speak about their condition to no one but their doctors. S. Weir
Mitchell of Philadelphia stated in 1888, ‘‘Wise women choose their doctors and
trust them. The wisest ask the fewest questions’’ (Banks 1999, 49).
Childbirth and Childrearing | 259
In the early years of the twentieth century, midwives, already radically com-
promised, increasingly lost access even to indigent women as clients. Hired by
governments and municipalities, midwives performed home visits following
delivery to check on the mother and to monitor the infant’s progress, but were
infrequently, if ever, participants in the actual birth process. Only in very rural
areas or among the very poor were midwives still the primary birth practitioners.
While in the past midwives had been cast as witches, in the early twentieth cen-
tury, practicing midwives were assumed to be abortionists.
The widespread commonality of experience due to the surge in childbirth in
North America from the mid-1940s until the early 1960s (‘‘the baby boom’’),
combined with massive family movement to the suburbs, provided new forums
for contact and community among women. These new circumstances created
contexts in which the topic of birth was once again considered acceptable for dis-
course. As women discussed birth in general and the actual details of the delivery
process, they questioned the standard medical approach to childbirth, debated
whether medicalized birth in hospitals was really the best approach to delivery,
and expressed concern over the absence of the laboring woman in the event.
Bolstered by information about the growing popularity in Europe of methods
of birth like accouchement sans douleur (birth without pain, the Lamaze method),
Ina Mae Gaskin, left, shows Tamar Kalta, center, how to feel the position of Cayla White-
head’s baby during a class in midwifery at The Farm in Summertown, Tennessee, June 26,
2007. Gaskin, 69, a midwife who never formally studied nursing, helped bring back home
birth and lay midwifery from the brink of extinction in America. (AP/Wide World Photos)
260 | Childbirth and Childrearing
References
Arnup, Katherine, Andre Levesque, and Ruth Roach Pierson, eds. 1990. Delivering
Motherhood: Maternal Ideologies and Practices in the 19th and 20th Centuries. New
York: Routledge.
Banks, Amanda Carson. 1999. Birth Chairs, Midwives, and Medicine. Jackson: Uni-
versity Press of Mississippi.
Davis-Floyd, Robbie E. 1992. Birth as an American Rite of Passage. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Ehrenreich, Barbara. 1989. For Her Own Good: 150 Years of the Experts’ Advice to
Women. New York: Anchor Books Doubleday.
Forbes, Thomas Rogers. 1966. The Midwife and the Witch. New Haven: Yale Uni-
versity Press.
Haines, Michael. 2005. Fertility and Mortality in the United States. EH.Net Encyclo-
pedia of Economic and Business History, ed. Robert Whaples. http://www.eh.net/ency-
clopedia (accessed July 22, 2005).
Hoffert, Sylvia. 1981. Private Matters: American Attitudes toward Childbearing and
Infant Nurture in the Urban North, 1800 1860. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Kertzer, David, and Marzio Barbagli, eds. 2002. Family Life in the Long Nineteenth
Century, 1789 1913: The Rise of the European Family, Volume 2. New Haven, CT:
Yale University Press.
Leavitt, Judith Walzer. 1988. Brought to Bed: Childbearing in America, 1750 1950.
London: Oxford University Press.
Mann, Mary Tyler Peabody, and Elizabeth P. Peabody. 1869. Moral Culture of Infancy,
and Kindergarten Guide: With Music for the Plays. New York: J. W. Schemerhorn.
Stearns, Peter N. 2003. Anxious Parents: A History of Modern Childrearing in
America. New York: New York University Press.
Welter, Barbara. 1966. The Cult of True Womanhood, 1820 1860. American Quar-
terly 2(1): 151 174.
Williams, Selma R., and Pamela Williams Adelman. 1992. Riding the Nightmare:
Women & Witchcraft from the Old World to Colonial Salem. New York: Harper Peren-
nial Editions.
whose identity is long lost in time. The rhyme ‘‘Jack and Jill,’’ in its longer ver-
sion, has Jill in the role of nurse:
Other nursery rhyme characters with heroic personas include Little Jack
Horner and his Christmas pie who: ‘‘stuck in his thumb and pulled out a plum /
And said ‘what a brave boy am I!’’’
Children may also adapt heroes and heroines from tale traditions into their
own expressions, as in the case of these skipping rhymes:
Or:
Children are also skilled at adapting known historical heroes and heroines into
their lore. An Australian children’s rhyme makes use of the figure of Captain
James Cook, who claimed the continent for Britain in 1770:
Many versions of these and other children’s rhymes (as opposed to nursery
rhymes) are scatological or intendedly obscene.
Since the rise of mass media at the start of the twentieth century, children’s
lore has increasingly appropriated characters from popular fiction, including
comics, film, television, and advertising. Frequently such characters are parodied
or otherwise satirized, often rudely, as in the case of the popular song and Disney
film about Davy Crockett during the 1950s. This early example of ‘‘cross-
marketing’’ involved the sale of Crockett items like knives, guns, and the all-
important coonskin cap. It also generated a good deal of childhood and young
adolescent ‘‘Crockett-lore,’’ including jokes (Why does Davy Crockett have three
ears? He has a left ear, a right ear, and a wild frontier.) and numerous parodies of
the movie’s theme song, which became a hit in Britain, America, Australia, and
elsewhere. The original lyrics of the song concerned the circumstances of Crock-
ett’s birth, his bear-slaying exploits, and his besting of his father, all at the preco-
cious age of three. In children’s lore, these lyrics rapidly became the following,
recorded in many variants around the English-speaking world:
References
Factor, J. 1988. Captain Cook Chased a Chook: Children’s Folklore in Australia.
Victoria, Australia: Penguin Books.
Halliwell, J. 1970. The Nursery Rhymes of England. London: The Bodley Head.
Opie, I. and P., eds. 1951. The Oxford Dictionary of Nursery Rhymes. Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Opie, I. and P. 1959. The Lore and Language of Schoolchildren. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Turner, I., J. Factor, and W. Lowenstein, eds. 1978. Cinderella Dressed in Yella, 2nd
ed. Melbourne: Heinemann, 1978.
Children’s Folklore
Those traditions that are learned, transmitted, and performed by children without
the influence of adult supervision or formal instruction. Historically, concepts of
childhood have varied widely. According to social historian Philippe Aries, in
Western Europe up until about the twelfth or thirteenth centuries, children were
depicted in paintings and other visual media as miniature adults, complete with
adult clothing and facial expressions. By the seventeenth century, there was a
growing tendency to recognize and acknowledge children as separate from adults
and worthy of special attention regarding their dress, food, behavior, and so
forth. Today (and certainly in the United States), children are generally regarded
as a privileged class with special schools, toys, amusements, and medical care.
It was only in the late nineteenth century that the peculiar traditions of
childhood—or children’s folklore—were noticed, collected, and documented.
The focus of scholarly interest in children’s folklore has been primarily on West-
ern European culture.
Children’s Folklore | 265
The distinctive folklore that children acquire and perform on their own exists
within what folklorists characterize as the ‘‘child-to-child conduit.’’ In general,
scholars agree that such childhood traditions are an integral part of the overall
enculturation process because through mastering the rules of the games or the lit-
erary structure of oral genres such as riddles and rhymes, children learn some of
the fundamental aspects of cooperation and strategy that are so integral to con-
temporary Western society. Furthermore, much of the interaction that takes place
when children play games together involves negotiation of rules and the status of
various players more than the actual performance of the game itself. Many
researchers believe that analyzing the social interactions in which the games are
embedded is at least as important as documenting the exact texts and tunes of the
songs children sing or the rhymes they recite during hand-clap routines.
Children’s folklore contains practically all of the principal genres of tradition,
including games, narratives of many kinds, songs, customs, and material culture.
The defining characteristic, of course, is that the targeted traditions circulate
within an informal children’s network or folk group. A growing body of recent
research concerns scatological materials, which are more common among chil-
dren than many more conservative educators have been willing to accept.
Comparative scholarly research makes it clear that many of these genres of
children’s folklore are extremely widespread, enjoying international distribution
in form if not in language. Riddling, storytelling, and games, for example, are
almost universal among European, Australian, Canadian, and American children.
One notable aspect of children’s folklore is the rapid transmission of the ever-
changing materials over vast distances, such as from one coast of the United
States to the other in a matter of days. The general hypothesis is that children,
just as adults, rely on the media (including long-distance telephone service as
well as television and other electronic media) for the spread and transmission of
these shared materials. The mass media certainly play a role in the transmission
of traditions that involve popular culture, such as games played with various
action figures or the wearing of Halloween costumes based on media characters.
Another characteristic of children’s folklore is that many of the genres involve
both a kinesic component and an oral component, as in singing games, jumping
rope and its distinctive rhymes, or hand-clapping routines. The physical action
and the verbal texts are so integrated that children find it almost impossible to
satisfactorily perform one without the other, as evidenced when researchers ask
for jump-rope rhymes without letting the children jump rope as they recite them.
Likewise, many children who are accustomed to the traditional versions of the
game cannot maintain the intricate rhythms of jumping rope unless they recite
the rhymes. Folklorists in the past who collected the verbal components without
266 | Children’s Folklore
Lullaby
A type of song used to soothe a baby to sleep; also known as a cradle song. It is a
widespread oral genre, found to a lesser extent in written and recorded forms.
The large number of lullaby examples from diverse societies suggests that lullabies
are nearly as universal as childbirth and children. Like laments and wedding songs,
the lullaby is a special occasion genre usually tied to its function, in this case, to
reassure and calm a child to hasten slumber.
Lullabic lyrics commonly are built around short, repetitious phrases or stanzas
that engage a range of linguistic modes, from adult language to ‘ baby talk’ vocables
or combinations thereof. The semantic content that marks a song unambiguously as
a lullaby contains phrases of endearment for the child and makes reference to going
to sleep. Examples with less overt lyrics also are found on any number of topics,
used, it has been suggested, because their rhythmic structure is suitable to the
song’s function. Bess Lomax Hawes’s own family, for instance, favored the Protes-
tant hymn ‘‘I Am Bound for the Promised Land.’’
Although there has been less research on music than on lyrics, lullabies generally
are melodically repetitious—monotony, for lullabies, appears to be functional—with
rhythmic and metric characteristics that correspond to the culturally defined kinetic
motions of rocking a child. Some lullabies, however, lack one or both of these com-
ponents; certain Hopi examples, for instance, contain no metric pulse and show no
coordination between kinetic and musical rhythm. Lullabies employed within liter-
ate or concert traditions may be elaborated with contrasting musical structures, as
with those of Brahms and Berg.
In common performance, lullabies underscore the close relationship between par-
ent (usually the mother) and child. The intimate context suggests that lullabies are
not invariably derived from precomposed (lullabic) sources, oral based or otherwise.
Though most societies cherish established lullabies, many performances are undoubt-
edly simply personal musical/textual expressions of the parent’s feeling for the child.
Leslie C. Gay Jr.
the physical components of the games were usually collecting ‘‘fossilized’’ mem-
ories from adult informants rather than collecting from the children, the active
bearers of the traditions.
Perhaps one reason for the widespread distribution of children’s traditions is in-
herent in the very nature of tradition itself, namely, the informal, noninstitutional
nature of the acquisition, maintenance, and transmission of these various cultural
items, whether they be oral, customary, or material. The informality and expan-
siveness of this vast communicative network is due, in large part, to its lack of de-
pendence on literacy and fixed form. Children, although taught in school to read
and write, operate among themselves in a world of informal and oral communica-
tion, unimpeded by the necessity of maintaining and transmitting information by
Children’s Folklore | 267
written means. In fact, one could theoretically regard the performance, process,
and content of children’s folklore as a paradigm for folklore in general.
The concept of the folk group is fundamental to folkloristics. Folk groups,
quite simply, are groups of people, no matter how large or how small, who are
validated and bonded primarily by the traditions they share. Children, therefore,
constitute one of the largest and most accessible folk groups that folklorists regu-
larly study.
Of course, within the larger folk group of children as a whole are innumerable
smaller and more intimate folk groups in which children interact and transmit
their almost infinite repertoire of folklore. It is also likely that any individual
child can be part of numerous such groups, including the child’s family, grade
cohort and playground playmates at school, neighborhood playmates of varying
ages, day-care members, as well as many others such as groups at church, at
camp, on vacation, and so forth. The guiding principle in recognizing children’s
folk groups is that they provide a context in which the children can teach, learn,
and share their distinctive traditions without outside influence or interference.
Because the concept of the folk group is integral to folklore theory, researchers
do not regard those materials that adults teach to children as being within the
268 | Children’s Folklore
Girls playing Double Dutch, a jump rope game in which two ropes are turned in opposite
directions with one or more players jumping simultaneously. (Getty Images)
purview of children’s folklore. The social matrix within which playground supervi-
sors or day-care attendants teach songs, games, and such to groups of children
under their care is quite different from the process of transmission when children
learn from and teach one another. If, however, a child who has learned a particular
item from a teacher at school in turn teaches a version of that item to younger
brothers and sisters at home and then that item becomes part of the active reper-
toire of that small folk group, the item would be of interest to folklorists.
Age is also a factor that must be taken into consideration in identifying child-
ren’s folklore because the traditions commonly shared by children are quite dis-
tinctive from those of adolescents. In general, childhood has been regarded as
the span from kindergarten through about the sixth year of school or about ages
five through twelve. Recently, the pervasiveness of child care for the children of
working parents has lowered the age bracket to about age four because the social
context of many day-care centers is quite conducive to very young children
learning traditional items from the older children with whom they are in such
constant contact. The limited language acquisition and undeveloped physical
coordination of very young children prevent children’s folklore from circulating
among those younger than about four years old.
Children’s Folklore | 269
Until the 1960s, the main studies of children’s folklore were in the English
language, undertaken primarily in England and the United States. Since the mid-
1970s, Australian folklorists have produced a sizable and well-regarded body of
scholarship and collections. Scholars throughout Europe also have begun to pub-
lish collections and analytical studies based on their fieldwork.
The earliest studies of children’s folklore were the massive collections under-
taken by the noted British scholar Lady Bertha Gomme (1894–1898) and the
American William Wells Newell, a founder of the American Folklore Society and
first editor of the Journal of American Folklore (1888–1900). Both of these early
scholars in the discipline of folklore were interested in preserving what they
regarded as the dying traditions of childhood; both also focused on games, espe-
cially games with a spoken or sung component.
Since the 1940s, American and British folklorists have produced a large body
of scholarship, encompassing both field-collected material and analytical studies.
Dorothy Howard was a pioneer in the technique of collecting directly from chil-
dren rather than focusing on adult memories of their childhood traditions; she
advocated this technique in her 1938 dissertation on ball-bouncing rhymes, one
of the first analytical studies of childlore. Howard continued her study of child-
ren’s folklore throughout her long lifetime. The most influential phase of her ca-
reer was the period she spent studying and collecting children’s folklore in
Australia in 1954–1955 on a Fulbright grant. Her work greatly influenced a num-
ber of younger scholars, including New Zealand native Brian Sutton-Smith and
June Factor of Australia, founder of the Australian Children’s Newsletter and the
author, collector, and editor of numerous studies of Australian childlore.
Perhaps the most significant of Dorothy Howard’s proteges were the British
husband-and-wife team of Peter and Iona Opie, who depended on her early in
their careers for advice and support. The Opies devoted their professional lives
to the documentation of the world of childhood, including not only folklore but
also literature and commercially produced toys and games.
A number of studies have followed the trend established in the Opies’ Lore
and Language of Schoolchildren, the most highly regarded collection in the field.
The annotated collections of Simon Bronner and Mary and Herbert Knapp are
widely used as textbooks in American folklore courses. In Finland, Leea Virta-
nen edited a similar volume, Children’s Lore. There are, of course, numerous
other studies in this field.
In 1979, the Children’s Folklore Section of the American Folklore Society
was established. This section has flourished over the years and produces the jour-
nal Children’s Folklore Review. A Handbook of Children’s Folklore was pub-
lished in 1995.
A perusal of the early studies of children’s folklore reveals the outdated and
largely discredited theoretical styles and trends of the times. For example, Lady
270 | Children’s Folklore
Gomme, an ardent survivalist, was convinced that the words and lyrics of child-
ren’s songs and rhymes contained references to or were survivals of ancient rites.
In the game of London Bridge, for example, she saw evidence of ancient ‘‘foun-
dation sacrifices’’ made when bridges were built.
Children’s folklore also was used in the service of another popular late nine-
teenth-century theory, namely, devolution. According to this theory, children’s
traditions were really misunderstood remnants of adult traditions that had filtered
down or ‘‘devolved’’ from adults of previous generations to the current genera-
tion of children. Another feature of this theory held that children represented the
savage stage of human development and therefore had to be civilized (in part, by
learning how to behave) before they could become responsible adults.
Those who study and document children’s folklore today grapple with what
Brian Sutton-Smith termed the ‘‘triviality barrier’’ or the lack of respect stem-
ming from the refusal of scholars in other fields and disciplines to take seriously
any research dealing with the world of children. Folklorists are unusual among
humanists and social scientists for their acceptance of children and their tradi-
tions on the children’s own terms, as a folk group worthy of study in its own right
rather than an adjunct of an older or more sophisticated body of informants.
Collecting and documenting children’s folklore presents both problems and
delights for the serious researcher. In general, children do not perform their folk-
lore within earshot of adults, in order to avoid the interference or derision of
those adults who are on the other side of the ‘‘triviality barrier.’’ Folklorists,
therefore, must first convince the children from whom they wish to collect that
they are seriously interested in the materials and that the children will not be
punished for revealing any traditions of which adults generally disapprove, such
as scatological jokes and rhymes.
The spontaneity of much of children’s folklore frequently precludes advance
notice of its performance. Consequently, folklorists must be ready to note down
or observe these performances as they occur, which frequently makes video tap-
ing or audio recording difficult. However, members of a play group who are very
comfortable with a particular adult researcher usually are willing to perform their
traditional lore ‘‘on cue’’ if the researcher asks them to do so. The ideal research
situation would be to document the same item both as a spontaneous perfor-
mance and under prearranged circumstances and then compare the two.
Another approach to collecting children’s folklore is by way of what many call
‘‘adult memory culture’’—adult memories of the traditions they knew as children.
This was the preferred method of the early nineteenth- century folklorists. Since
many adults have a tendency to remember selectively, this method is less reliable
than collecting directly from the children themselves. Adult memory culture,
however, does provide a diachronic context for contemporary children’s folklore.
Sylvia Grider
Chinese Folklore | 271
References
Aries, Philippe. 1962. Centuries of Childhood: A Social History of Family Life. New
York: Vintage.
Bronner, Simon. 1988. American Children’s Folklore: A Book of Rhymes, Games,
Jokes, Stories, Secret Languages, Beliefs and Camp Legends for Parents, Grand-
Parents, Teachers, Counselors and All Adults Who Were Once Children, ed. Simon
Bronner. Little Rock. AR: August House.
Ebeogu, Afam. 1991. The World of Lullaby: The Igbo Example. Research in African
Literature 22: 99 118.
Gomme, Lady Alice Bertha. [1894 1898] 1964. The Traditional Games of England,
Scotland, and Ireland. 2 vols. Reprint. New York: Dover.
Howard, Dorothy. 1938. Folk Rhymes of American Children. Ed. D. dissertation,
New York University.
Knapp, Mary, and Herbert Knapp. 1976. One Potato, Two Potato: The Secret Educa-
tion of American Children. New York: W. W. Norton.
McDowell, John H. 1983. Children’s Folklore. In Handbook of American Folklore,
ed. Richard Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Mechling, Jay. 1986. Children’s Folklore. In Folk Groups and Folklore Genres: An
Introduction, ed. Elliott Oring. Logan: University of Utah Press.
Newell, William Wells. [1883] 1963. Games and Songs of American Children.
Reprint. New York: Dover.
Opie, Iona, and Peter Iona. 1959. The Lore and Language of Schoolchildren. Oxford:
Clarendon.
Simpson, J., and S. Roud. 2000. A Dictionary of English Folklore. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Sutton-Smith, Brian. 1970. Psychology of Childlore: The Triviality Barrier. Western
Folklore 29: 1 8.
Chinese Folklore
and study projects are still carried out by folklore workers and scholars at local, re-
gional, and national levels. In recent years, scholars in research institutes and uni-
versities such as the Chinese Academy of Social Sciences (Zhongguo shehui
kexue yuan), Beijing University (Beijing daxue), and the Central Nationalities
University (Zhongyang minzu daxue) have experimented with new approaches to
folklore analysis and fieldwork, influenced to some degree by Western trends.
instances, native terms have been utilized. Given the huge corpus of folklore in
China, it is difficult to give a comprehensive picture in limited space. The goal
here is to present an overview that will allow some sense of the big picture, while
illuminating a few representative local traditions drawn mostly from southern and
southwestern China.
Myths
Accounts of Han Chinese myths date to records such as The Classic of Moun-
tains and Seas (Shan hai jing), based on material compiled between the third
century BCE and the second century CE. These early texts include accounts of the
creation of the earth and cosmos out of chaos and tell of the creator Pan Gu,
whose body transformed into the myriad phenomena of the natural world.
Among the early beings are the male Fuxi and the female N€u Wa, who shaped
humans from clay and patched holes that had formed in the sky. Another figure,
Hou Yi, is an archer who at the bequest of Emperor Yao shoots down nine of the
ten suns overheating the earth. Important gods that figure in many myths and
other stories and folk beliefs include the Jade Emperor, Queen Mother of the
West, and the Yellow Emperor. A favorite of these early accounts is associated
with the Mid-Autumn Festival (Zhongqiu jie), held on the fifteenth day of the
eighth lunar month. The archer Hou Yi meets a charming young woman named
Chang’e. Wishing to live with her forever, Hou Yi convinces the powerful Queen
Mother of the West (who controls the peaches of immortality) to give him a spe-
cial elixir. Versions differ over what happens next, but eventually Chang’e drinks
the elixir, becomes an immortal, and flies up to the Moon, where she lives today
with her pet rabbit. A number of Han myths have parallels in the folklore of
many ethnic groups in southern China, and some of the myths (such as that of
Pan Gu) may be of ancient southern origin.
In recent decades, lengthy epics charting creation have been collected among
Miao, Yao, Yi, Hani, Lahu, Dong, Drung, Dai, and other ethnic groups in the
south and particularly the southwest of the country. Common motifs include sep-
aration and coalescence of heavy and light material out of chaos, measuring the
seam between the resulting heaven and earth, sewing the sky and earth together,
propping up the sky with pillars, creation of living things, early generations of
protohumans or giants, destruction of life by a great flood, re-peopling of the
earth (often by a female creator or as a result of incest between a brother and sis-
ter), the distribution of the peoples of earth (often the historic ethnic groups
within a particular region), and sometimes the acquisition of language, agricul-
ture, marriage, and so on. A calabash gourd figures in many of the southern mi-
nority epics, especially as an ark to carry the brother and sister who escape the
flood. In one Miao epic from Guizhou province an important creator figure is a
butterfly called Mais Bangx (Mother Butterfly), who lays eggs that hold the early
ancestors of humans, tigers, dragons, mythical birds, and so on in a sacred sweet
gum tree that later splits into myriad living beings.
Narrative Poems
Narrative poems ranging from a few dozen lines to some of the world’s longest
epics are found in the northern border regions and the mountains of the south-
west. The northern epics include the Kirgiz epic Manas (claimed to be the lon-
gest epic poem in history), the Mongol epic Janggar, and the epic of the Tibetan
hero Gesar. All three epics feature divine, exemplary heroes who win contests,
take beautiful brides, fight evil forces, build kingdoms, and lead armies of highly
skilled warriors. Flying and talking horses, shape-shifting, and battles with ene-
mies (human and monster) are typical themes. Multi-headed anthropomorphs
known as manggus are typical foes in the Mongol Janggar epic as well as Mon-
gol versions of Gesar. A singer or relays of singers recite the epics in the open
air at festivals. Some Tibetan singers employ the convention of ‘‘paper-singing,’’
in which a singer holds a blank sheet of paper in front of him as if reading as he
recites the epic. In recent decades singers have included both men and women.
Heroic epics and fairy tale-like narrative poems circulate among several Yi sub-
groups in the southwest. Typical is the story of Zhyge Alu, a Yi martial hero
whose exploits are told among the Nuosu of northern Yunnan and Sichuan. An
illegitimate child, he was born after drops of blood from a flying eagle stained
Chinese Folklore | 275
his young mother’s skirt. Left in the wild, the child was raised by dragons. Later,
Zhyge Alu is said to have shot down the excess suns and moons in the sky.
Among the Sani of the Stone Forest area of Yunnan, narrative poems are sung
about Ashima, a lovely, hard-working young woman who was captured and
imprisoned by an evil landlord. Her brother (in more recent versions, her lover)
Ahei rescues her, but on the way home she is killed by a sudden flood. Her
inspiring echo is still said to resound in the strange limestone formations in the
region. The epic tradition of the Dai, a people located in the Xishuangbanna (Sip-
songpanna) area of southern Yunnan province, has been strongly influenced by
Theravada Buddhism.
Chang’an (today’s Xi’an), where the incomparably lovely concubine Yang Guifei
was said to have bathed and cavorted with Emperor Xuanzong. In the ancient
Yangzi deltal city of Suzhou, stories about the sixteenth-century poet-painter Tang
Bohu are still part of local storytelling as well as many drama traditions. In the
nearby city of Yangzhou, many legends exist about the eight unusual painters in
the eighteenth century, still known as the ‘‘Yangzhou Eight Eccentrics’’ (Yangzhou
baguai). Bai nationality towns in western Yunnan have legends about their benzhu,
or beneficent ancestor, whose spirit looks over the welfare of the populace.
One Bai legend is associated with a natural feature called ‘‘Butterfly Spring’’
near the small town of Zhoucheng. According to a version told by Zhang Qisheng,
a hunter named Du Chaoxuan heard that a giant, supernatural snake was eating
local people. Surprising the snake, he managed to shoot it with an arrow before it
escaped. The next day, Du went to a nearby spring and saw two young women
washing a bloodied cloth on a rock. Though at first he suspected they might be
incarnations of the giant snake, they told him how they had been forced to become
the wounded snake’s wives. They then helped Du steal the snake’s magic sword,
whereupon he sliced the creature into three parts. Although the women begged to
become his wives, he left them behind to go hunting in the mountains. The women
were so distraught that they drowned themselves in the spring. Returning from the
mountains the next day, Du heard of the women’s fate. Wracked with grief, the
snake-killing hero jumped into the spring and drowned. Soon after, three butter-
flies, two leading and one following behind, emerged from the spring. Today many
colorful butterflies gather on an ancient tree nearby.
Popular religion in China continues to be a source of legends about spirits
(shen), immortals (xian), bodhisattvas (pusa), and wise men, many of whom are
regarded as being actual people in earlier ages. The ‘‘Eight Immortals’’ of popular
Daoism are especially well represented in oral traditions, dramas, and festival
parades. The Ming Dynasty vernacular romance, Tales of Gods and Spirits
(Fengshen yanyi), includes many legends associated with historical figures such
as an early adviser of the Zhou Dynasty kings, Jiang Taigong (who learned
patience while fishing without hooks), which have correlates in oral tradition. In
certain areas of Guizhou, the work is the basis of productions of folk ritual-drama.
In recent years, images of legendary leaders of the communist party, including
Mao Zedong, have been integrated into local religious beliefs in some rural areas.
Folksongs
China has one of the world’s richest heritages of folksongs, written records be-
ginning with the fifth century BCE collection the Book of Songs (Shijing), based
in part on local folksong traditions, and the yuefu folk ballads dating to the Han
Dynasty (220 BCE–220 CE). Large collections of folksongs by literati such as Feng
Menglong date to the Ming Dynasty (1368–1644 CE). Large-scale collection by
Chinese Folklore | 277
modern intellectuals began around the time of the May Fourth Movement in
1919 and continued into the 1930s. During this time, Western folklore methods
began to be utilized by young intellectuals like Liu Fu, Gu Jiegang, Zhou Zuoren,
and Zhong Jingwen. In the 1950s and 1980s, the government of the People’s
Republic of China launched massive folksong collecting projects. Huge cadres
of folksong collectors (many of whom were students) were mobilized at national,
provincial, and county levels all over the country, resulting in collection, editing
(sometimes for political correctness), and publication in both public and ‘‘inner-
circulating’’ print media.
Folksongs in China include courting songs, bridal laments (sung by brides leav-
ing home), hosting songs, drinking songs, ritual songs asking for blessings and
good luck, funeral songs and chants, work songs (sung in rice fields, on fishing
boats, and at the loom), lullabies, and other themes. While many folksongs are
associated with rural cultures or labor, a kind of refined lyrical singing tradition
called xiaodiao (small tunes) was common in urban settings all over China, some-
times performed by professional singers. Receiving and sending off guests are im-
portant acts in Chinese social interaction. In many parts of China (particularly in
the ethnic minority areas today) hosts and guests traditionally exchange songs of
welcome and departure. Among some ethnic groups, songs may also be sung dur-
ing banquets in praise of guests or hosts and conveying good wishes and praise.
Drinking songs may also be part of banquets, drinking parties, and festivals,
depending on the ethnic group. Various forms of distilled alcohol made from rice,
wheat, maize, and millet, as well as thin beer-like beverages made from fermented
rice, buckwheat, barley, and other grains or vegetables, figure importantly in the
social cultures in many parts of China. Drinking is usually associated with eating,
and singing may be a part of home and public banquets or after-banquet activities
(impromptu sings or karaoke sessions) all over China. Drink also plays a role in
many rituals, in which alcohol is offered along with songs and chants to various
gods, local nature spirits, or ancestral spirits in order to gain blessings.
Although arranged marriages were for millennia the norm for Han Chinese,
many ethnic groups allowed young people to engage in courting activities from
the early teen years until marriage. Popular activities in the courting process were
singing gatherings or parties in which young men and women sang antiphonal
folksongs to each other. The antiphonal style, in which songs are traded back and
forth between singers in a kind of song talk, was an important social skill. Today
in many areas of northwest and southwest China, courting songs are still sung in
gatherings by both unmarried and married people. In some areas, the best singers
are middle-aged or older.
In northwest China, a common style of folksong among many ethnic groups,
including Han, Salar, Hui, Dongxiang, Tu (Monguor), and Yugu is the so-called
hua’er or ‘‘flower songs,’’ known in some places as shaonian (often translated as
278 | Chinese Folklore
‘‘courtship songs’’). Rural people in Shanxi and Shaanxi sing a style of song known
as xintianyou while working in the vast ‘‘yellow earth’’ areas of north-central
China. In many parts of China, short lyrics, often sung in antiphonal form, have
for centuries been called shan’ge (mountain songs) as well as by many local terms.
Such songs were especially popular in the Yangzi delta and all across southern
China. Today they are still popular in parts of Fujian, Hunan, Guizhou, Guangxi,
and Yunnan, though in many places fewer young people know how to sing.
In the area of Liuzhou, a small city in northern Guangxi, mountain songs are a
pan-ethnic phenomenon. Singers from Zhuang, Dong, Mulam, Maonan, Han, and
other groups sing similar songs in their own languages as well as in Chinese. Song
contests are still held during the mid-autumn festival at Carp Peak (Yufeng shan)
in Liuzhou city, where most songs are sung in a southwest version of Mandarin
Chinese. A common singing style features two male singers simultaneously sing-
ing in turn with two female singers. Such antiphonal lyrics are filled with nature
imagery (often stressing reproduction) and feature similes, metaphors, and some-
times riddles. In the past, young people got to know each other through lengthy
song exchanges, and lovers or spouses were chosen by the mental dexterity and
skill exhibited by the singers. Today groups of older singers gather in parks or at
riversides to limber their voices and minds in impromptu tests of singing skill.
The following excerpt from a song exchange comes from the Dong nationality
of the Guizhou and Guangxi borderlands. Songs are sung on intricately constructed
covered wooden bridges, near ancient trees, stream banks, and springs, or in other
special places. The reference to ‘‘black rice’’ is a metaphor for eating a dark variety
of rice in the marriage ceremony. The singers were Wu Jinsong and Lu Jinmeng:
Folksongs have been incorporated into local-color films, orchestral music, and
other media. The 1961 film Third Sister Liu (Liu Sanjie) featured romanticized
versions of Zhuang antiphonal singing. Over thirty years later, a musical version,
produced by renowned film director Zhang Yimou in 2003, was staged live in nat-
ural settings in scenic Yangshuo, Guangxi. The film Ashima (1964) featured artis-
tically enhanced folksongs of the Yi subgroup called Sani. In the early 1980s,
folksongs from the barren northern Shaanxi (Shaanbei) area were interwoven into
the script of the innovative ‘‘Fifth Generation’’ film Yellow Earth (Huang tudi),
which featured more folksinging than dialogue. Folksongs and music from vari-
ous ethnic groups have influenced composers such as Nie Er in the 1930s and
1940s. More recently, composer Bright Sheng has drawn on folksongs and music
in northwest China in his orchestral compositions. Urban folksinger Yang Yi has
recreated rural folksongs under the influence of American singer Bob Dylan. Yi
(Nuosu subgroup) minority poets such as Jidi Majia and Aku Wuwu have drawn
extensively on folksongs, myths, chants, and customs in their poetic works.
and West Wing (Xixiangji) have been a major component in the tanci repertoire
since at least the early nineteenth century. A number of these stories are also repre-
sented in local drama traditions. Stories in the pinghua repertoire are often about
outlaw or martial heroes and tend to involve amazing displays of stylized gestures
and verbal agility, which may include rhyming, folk ditties, and paralinguistic
sounds of everything from firecrackers to a fritter rolling on the floor. Stories
include heroes such as the twelfth-century patriot Yue Fei and episodes from works
of vernacular fiction such as Three Kingdoms (Sanguo yanyi), Journey to the West
(Xiyouji), Outlaws of the Marsh (Shuihu zhuan), and Three Heroes and Five Gal-
lants (Sanxia wuyi). The Yangzhou pinghua story about the outlaw hero Wu Song
and his fight with a tiger high on a mountain ridge after a drinking bout in a tavern
is among the best known of the pinghua narratives. Tanci performances usually
begin with a lyrical ballad known as a kaipian (opening piece), many of which are
also sung at informal gatherings of amateurs or by professionals in contests.
Storytelling traditions (with written vernacular correlates) known as precious vol-
umes (baojuan) were once widespread, some with ritual components incorporating
Buddhism and other beliefs. A surviving tradition from the Yangzi delta is known
as Jingjiang jiangjing (Jingjiang telling scriptures). Stories of local gods and devo-
tees as well as more secular tales are told in lengthy ‘‘services’’ combining narration
and singing in performances led by a specialist known as a ‘‘Buddha-head’’ (fotou)
and enhanced by a special chorus comprised of older audience members.
A number of related styles of rap-like ballads known as kuaiban (clapper-tales)
and kuaishu (fast-story) exist in northeast China. Performers sing stories to the
beat provided by bamboo, wooden, or metal clappers, depending on the tradition.
Very short in comparison to some of the southern forms like Suzhou tanci, these
story songs include humorous anecdotes and condensed tales of heroes from ver-
nacular literature such as Wu Song. Styles of narrative using drums, sometimes in
concert with stringed or other percussion instruments, include the dagu (big drum)
traditions of Beijing and the extinct form of Manchu (Manju) drum storytelling
known as zidishu (bannermans’ songs). Some zidishu texts relate passages from
works of vernacular fiction, including the famous eighteenth-century novel-length
work Dream of the Red Chamber (Honglou meng). Many similar storytelling tra-
ditions using a variety of instruments are found in Han areas all over China,
though in some areas traditions are a mere shadow of what they were in the past.
Opera
Images of Beijing opera tend to dominate perceptions of Chinese traditional
drama. While that particular dramatic form rose to the level of a national art in
the late twentieth century, its roots are in local forms of drama that coalesced in
Beijing during the early nineteenth century. Besides the Beijing tradition, many
regional forms still have followings today, including the Cantonese Yueju;
Chinese Folklore | 281
Drama
Although the convention of painting the faces of major characters is one of the
most recognizable features of Chinese drama, in recent decades ethnographers
have discovered traditions of local drama in southern China where performers
wear carved wooden masks. Many of the masked-opera traditions are known as
Nuo or Nuotangxi (Nuo hall opera). In parts of Guizhou province, where Nuo tra-
ditions are especially strong, Nuo performances are an important part of New
Year ritual activities. Dozens or hundreds of masks are assembled and worshipped
at the beginning of the rituals. Amateur troupes of actors (which may include sha-
mans and men who grow long hair to play women’s roles) enact the plays, accom-
panied by percussion instruments. A common play concerns Kaishan, a mythical
figure who loses his ax in a river and must go to the Dragon King’s palace to
retrieve it. Another wooden mask tradition, known as Dixi (local, or ‘‘earth’’ op-
era), is associated with the Anshun area of Guizhou.
Featuring colorful masks and elaborate costumes, the song-and-dance dramas uti-
lize a narrator and present martial themes from the classic fictional work Three King-
doms (Sanguo yanyi) and similar stories. In ritual dramas once common throughout
China, actors enact scenes from the Buddhist story of Mulian, who descends to
Hell in order to rescue his suffering mother. Harvest festival dramas in the stories
from Tibetan history include stories of the ancient king Srongsam-gampo.
282 | Chinese Folklore
involves teams of young men and women throwing embroidered balls with cloth
tails (xiuqiu) back and forth through a hoop at the top of a long pole. This sport
is a direct adaptation of a traditional courting game of the Zhuang and related
groups, in which young people sang antiphonal songs and young women tossed
the handmade balls to prospective lovers.
Folk games, again differing by region and ethnic group, include children’s games,
contests, festival entertainments, song-and-dance plays and routines, knowledge
games, word games and songs that play on features of language, small animal tricks,
cards, and board games. Lantern parades and fireworks are part of the Spring Festi-
val in Han areas. Wooden swings were once popular in many parts of China, espe-
cially with young women. Swings are still part of festival events in some Yi
communities in the southwest and ethnic Korean communities in the northeast.
Popular children’s games of the Han people include Eagle Catches the Chicks
(laoying zhua xiaoji). To play, an ‘‘eagle’’ attempts to catch the ‘‘chicks’’ hiding in a
line behind a vigorously protective ‘‘hen.’’ Another common activity involves kick-
ing small bundles of old coins trimmed with feathers (tijianzi) that are kept in the
air as long as possible by multiple kicks, sometimes between more than one player.
Other games include the popular girl’s activity of dancing between long strings of
rubber bands (tiaopiji’er) and grabbing games involving stones (zhuashizi) or
painted pig knuckle bones (chuagu), similar to the Western game of jacks.
Historical records from very early times note contests between various crea-
tures at festivals and private gatherings. In recent decades, these have included
struggles between water buffalo, rams, goats, chickens, ducks, birds, dogs, and
ants, especially in certain areas in south and southwest China. Crickets have long
been favorite pets all over China, and special breeds are used in fighting contests.
Paper playing cards seem to have been invented in China during the Song
Dynasty (960–1279 CE), and long and thin cards are still found in some areas. All
over the country, Western and Chinese card games as well as traditional table
games such as mahjong and xiangqi (go) are extremely popular pastimes.
decorations and costumes; objects used in life cycle rituals (births and child pro-
tection rites, courting and wedding rituals, important birthdays, and funerals);
charms and good luck tokens; musical instruments and implements used by
storytellers; accoutrements of ritual specialists and personal worship; boats,
carts, and sleds; eating utensils and household furnishings; tea drinking imple-
ments; smoking tools; alcohol stills; personal hygiene items; sewing and weaving
tools; tattooing equipment (in southwest China); and many others.
The styles of vernacular architecture are easy to see on train or bus rides
through rural China. They range from round communal compounds (tulou) hold-
ing 300–500 people in Hakka areas of the Fujian-Guangdong border areas to
wooden homes of the Naxi nationality in Lijiang, Yunnan, and the elaborate
wooden post-and-lintel architecture of the Chenyang Wind and Rain Bridge and
drum towers in the Dong ethnic region of Sanjiang in northern Guangxi. There
are hewn granite homes in the Bouyei nationality regions of Guizhou and the Bai
of Dali, Yunnan. Rammed-earth and adobe-walled towns and courtyards featur-
ing heated brick beds (kang) are found across northern China.
Skillfully excavated cave homes appear in parts of the northwest. Adobe com-
pounds with low roofs pitching down into central courtyards are found in the
oases of Gansu and other northwest desert areas, while white-washed brick cot-
tages with black tile roofs line some canals in the lower Yangzi. Felt ger (yurts)
are still seen on parts of the northern grasslands, though birchbark wigwams once
used in the northeast forests would be difficult to find. Expansive timber and
adobe Tibetan homes with peaked roofs in the Shangrila region of northwest
Yunnan contrast with flat-roofed Tibetan homes in other areas. Qiang nationality
dwellings and watchtowers in the Aba Tibetan and Qiang Autonomous Prefec-
ture of Sichuan province are skillfully built of irregular broken rock and timbers.
Bamboo and wooden stilt houses of the Dai and Jino nationalities are common in
rural areas of the Xishuangbanna region of southern Yunnan. Within the homes
of the matriarchal Moso people around Lake Lugu on the Yunnan-Sichuan bor-
der, dwelling and eating areas are designated according to age and gender.
Stylized patterns, decorations, and symbols, sometimes with almost universal
meaning in China and other parts of East Asia, manifest themselves in many
regions and mediums. Examples are images of cranes, bamboo, evergreens,
lotuses, peaches, plum blossoms, chrysanthemums, peonies, pear wood, dragons,
phoenixes, mythical beasts, and pairs of ducks, fish, fowl, butterflies, and the Chi-
nese characters for ‘‘double-happiness’’ or ‘‘long life’’—all with auspicious mean-
ings related to wealth, status, health, harmony, longevity, offspring, and marital
bliss. In other cases, items are regional or local in occurrence. Weaving and em-
broidery patterns from Miao, Zhuang, Bai, and other ethnic minority groups
include many of the images just mentioned as well as mountains, rivers, local
water plants, and algae.
Chinese Folklore | 285
Paper Cutting
China invented paper by 105 CE, and paper cuts have been traced to as early as
207 CE in northern China. Many paper arts are still current, including elaborate
grave offerings burned at funerals and a wide variety of good luck charms and
decorative items. Mulberry bark, rice straw, wood, or rags are among the materi-
als used to make paper. The art of paper cutting is still practiced in many areas
and has a commercial market, especially for weddings and Chinese New Year.
Thin sheets of paper, colored on one side, are stacked in a specially prepared
wooden box frame, the bottom tempered with a mixture of fat, charcoal, and
beeswax. The auspicious color red is very traditional, though many other colors
or mixtures of colors are used. In some styles, ten to fifty sheets of paper are cut
at one time, using sharp knives driven down through the paper. Other styles
employ large-handled, fine-bladed Chinese scissors. Designs may be cut free-
hand or transferred to the paper by the use of patterns outlined in smoke or chalk.
Themes include good luck items such as peaches, pairs of fish or ducks, scenes
from Chinese opera, or daily life. Once cut, paper cuts can be placed on walls or
windows or mounted on white paper.
All over China carved woodblocks were used to print images of protector gods
and spirits, magic tokens, and good luck pictures displayed at the New Year
(nianhua). Flourishing by the Song Dynasty, pictures were produced on various
grades of paper and sometimes in several colors applied with a series of different
blocks. In rural areas, doors are often guarded by colorful paper posters of an-
cient generals known as ‘‘door gods’’ (menshen) who are pasted on the outside
doors to protect the families from unlucky forces.
References
Bamo, Qubumo. 2001. Traditional Nuosu Origin Narratives: A Case Study of Ritual-
ized Epos in Bimo Incantation Scriptures. Oral Tradition 16(2): 453 479.
Bender, Mark. 2001. A Description of Jiangjing (Telling Scriptures) Services in
Jingjiang, China. Asian Folklore Studies 60: 101 133.
Bender, Mark. 2003. Plum and Bamboo: China’s Suzhou Chantefable Tradition.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Bender, Mark. 2004. Hunting Nets and Butterflies: Ethnic Minority Songs from
Southern China. In The Poem behind the Poem: Translating Asian Poetry, edited by
Frank Stewart. Port Townshend, WA: Copper Canyon Press, pp. 39 54.
Bordahl, Vibeke, ed. 1996. The Oral Tradition of Yangzhou Storytelling. Nordic
Institute of Asian Studies Monograph Series, No. 73. London: Curzon.
Bordahl, Vibeke, ed. 1999. The Eternal Storyteller: Oral Literature in Modern
China. Nordic Institute of Asian Studies. Surrey, England: Curzon.
Chao Gejin. 1997. Mongolian Oral Epic Poetry: An Overview. Oral Tradition 12(2):
322 336.
Drums of the Ancestors: Manchu and Mongol Shamanism (film). 1995. The Founda-
tion for Shamanic Studies.
Harrell, Steven, Bamo Qubumo, and Ma Erzi. 2000. Mountain Patterns: The Sur-
vival of Nuosu Culture in China. Seattle: University of Washington Press.
Johnson, David. 1995. Mu-lien in Paochuan: The Performance Context and Religious
Meaning. In Ritual and Scripture in Chinese Popular Religion: Five Studies, ed. David
Johnson. Publications of the Popular Culture Project 3. Berkeley, CA: IEAS Publications,
pp. 55 103.
Jones, Stephen. 2004. Plucking the Winds: Lives of Village Musicians in Old and
New China. Leiden, Netherlands: CHIME Foundation.
Mueggler, Eric. 2001. The Age of Wild Ghosts: Memory, Violence, and Place in
Southwest China. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Rees, Helen. 2000. Echoes of History: Naxi Music in Modern China. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Schein, Louisa. 2000. Minority Rules: The Miao and the Feminine in China’s Cul-
tural Politics. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Schimmelpenninck, Antoinette. 1997. Folk Songs and Folk Singers: Shan’ge Tradi-
tions in Southern Jiangsu Chinese. Leiden, Netherlands: CHIME Foundation.
Wu, Sue-mei. 2003. Hand Puppet Theater Performance: Emergent Structures and the
Resurgence of Taiwanese Identity. In Religion and the Formation of Taiwanese Identi-
ties, eds. Paul R. Katz and Murray A. Rubenstein. New York: Palgrave.
Choreometrics
A method for describing and rating dance and everyday movements in general qual-
itative terms, with the aim, according to Alan Lomax, of ‘‘recording and noting reg-
ularities and contrasts in movement patterns which are sufficiently frequent and
Choreometrics | 289
References
K€ong€as-Maranda, Elli. 1970. Deep Significance and Surface Significance: Is Canto-
metrics Possible? Semiotica 2: 173 184.
Lomax, Alan. 1968. Folk Song Style and Culture. Washington, DC: American Acad-
emy for the Advancement of Science.
290 | Cinderella
Cinderella
Usually said to have been first written down in the ninth century CE in China,
Cinderella may well be the world’s number one fairy tale, though this claim is
also made of other widespread tale types such as ‘‘Red Riding Hood,’’ ‘‘Snow
White,’’ and ‘‘Sleeping Beauty.’’ The story is, then, perhaps more than one-thou-
sand years old and, like all such stories, has undergone many transformations
through time, between cultures, and across distances. Despite much speculation,
we can never know what the original story of Cinderella was like, but we can be
reasonably sure that it involved a heroine from the bottom of the social order
undergoing various tests and tribulations in order to win the love of a hero from
the opposite end of the economic scale. These are the timeless and seemingly
universal themes of many folk hero narratives.
Modern audiences have taken to the story of the put-upon sister forced to sleep
in the garret by her three ugly stepsisters and her nasty stepmother. Cinderella is
the classic oppressed innocent and victim. However, in the earliest European lit-
erary version, called ‘‘The Cat Cinderella’’ and included in Giambattista Basile’s
The Pentamerone (1634–1636), the heroine is a schemer who meets a just fate.
Almost all subsequent versions, though, present Cinderella as the wronged figure
who, usually through some recognition device, manages to get her prince.
The most important early publication of Cinderella is that of Charles Perrault in
his 1697 Histoires ou contes du temps pass e (Historical tales from the past), also
subtitled Contes de ma m ere l’oie (Tales of my mother goose), thus beginning the
long-standing tradition of nursery rhymes and fairy tales being published under the
name of Mother Goose. As with a number of other now-classic fairy tales, Perrault
was responsible for a considerable refining of the story and for the detail of the
glass slipper as a recognition device. In Perrault’s version, Cinderella’s actions are
determined more by the fairy godmother than by Cinderella herself. Mostly she
does as the fairy godmother tells her and wins the prince, rather oddly rewarding
her unpleasant sisters with marriage to wealthy aristocrats.
Perrault’s genteel telling of the tale (that on which the Disney animated feature
of 1950 was based), in which the girl is a rather saccharine young innocent,
stands in sharp contrast to that of the Grimms, titled ‘‘Ashenputtle’’ or ‘‘Ash
Girl.’’ In this story, published in 1812, the heroine is much more self-motivated
and in control, and it ends with the sisters getting their proper punishment. Birds
pluck out their eyes as they make their way to and from Cinderella’s wedding.
‘‘Thus for their malice and treachery they were punished with blindness for the
rest of their lives,’’ ends the Grimms’ version, with more than a hint of vengeful
sanctimony. The Grimms also included a number of other Cinderella-type tales
in their collection, including ‘‘Allerleirauh,’’ a ‘‘Cap o’ Rushes’’ version, and a
‘‘One-eye, Two-eyes, Three-eyes’’ tale.
The longevity and wide distribution of the Cinderella story and the consistency
of many of its motifs from one version to another, notably that of the shoe as a
recognition device, has made it one of the most studied of all fairy tales. There is
an extensive literature on Cinderella that stretches from the numerous literary
rewrites and anthologies, through the mythological speculations of nineteenth-
century anthropologists and folklorists, and deep into recent Freudian and Jung-
ian psychology. Folklorists have also devoted considerable time and effort to
analyzing and understanding what is perhaps the world’s best-known folktale.
In a collection entitled Cinderella: A Casebook, American folklorist Alan
Dundes presents a variety of folkloric approaches to the story of Cinderella,
including essays on Russian, Chinese, English, Greek, Indian, and French ver-
sions of the Cinderella tale and its distribution in Europe, Africa, and parts of
Asia. Other selections in this work deal with a Muslim women’s ritual reuse of
the story and with spiritual, Jungian, and Freudian interpretations of the story.
Further essays cover the actual folkloric rendition of a Tuscan version of the tale
and a consideration of the popularization of the Cinderella story in America.
Dundes makes it clear that these are but a sampling of the rich variety and diver-
sity of folkloric Cinderella studies, most of which are beholden to the astonishing
work of Marian Roalfe Cox, who published her Cinderella: Three Hundred and
Forty-Five Variants of Cinderella, Catskin, and Cap o’ Rushes, Abstracted and
Tabulated, with a Discussion of Medieval Analogues and Notes in 1893. In 1951,
the Swedish folklorist Anna Birgitta Rooth published her Cinderella Cycle, using
about 700 different versions of the tale. These are the foundation works of
292 | Cinderella
folklore scholarship on this heroine, and together with the large number of other
works on this one story and with its variations and entries in Aarne and Thomp-
son’s The Types of the Folktale (1910 and 1961), they constitute a convincing
case for the antiquity and the persistence of the Cinderella cycle.
The use of the term cycle in connection with Cinderella stories is appropriate
and advisable. Scholarship has discovered and delineated at least five distinct sub-
types of the Cinderella story. One of these is the basic Cinderella story that will be
familiar to most Western readers; another is the group of tales revolving around a
figure called ‘‘Catskin’’; a third involves a ‘‘Cap o’ Rushes’’; and a fourth ‘‘One-
eyes, Two-eyes, and Three-eyes.’’ In a fifth subtype, the Cinderella role is taken by
a male, as in the Native American story of Amala and in some Hungarian stories.
Other versions of Cinderella include the Norwegian ‘‘Katie Woodencloak,’’ the
Georgian ‘‘Conkiajgharuna,’’ or ‘‘The Little Rag Girl,’’ the Serbian ‘‘Pepelyouga,’’
and the Italian ‘‘Rosina,’’ to name only a few. Some of these versions combine
Cinderella with motifs from other stories.
Graham Seal
See Also Children’s Folk Heroes; Children’s Folklore; Fairy Tale Heroes; Hero/Heroine,
Folk.
References
Argenti, P., and H. Rose. 1949. The Folk-Lore of Chios, 2 vols. London: Cambridge
University Press, vol. 1.
Asbjrnsen, P., and J. Moe. 1888. Popular Tales from the Norse. Trans. G. Dasent.
Edinburgh: David Douglas.
Bettelheim, B. 1976. The Uses of Enchantment: The Meaning and Importance of
Fairy Tales. New York: Knopf.
Calvino, I. (trans. Martin, G.). 1980 (1956). Italian Folk Tales: Selected and Retold
by Italo Calvino. New York: Harcourt Brace Jovanovich, Penguin.
Cox, M. 1893. Cinderella: Three Hundred and Forty-Five Variants. London: David
Nutt.
Dawkins, R., comp. and trans. 1974 (1953). Modern Greek Folktales. Westport, CT:
Greenwood Press.
Degh, L. 1969. Folktales and Society: Story-Telling in a Hungarian Peasant Com-
munity. Trans. E. Schossberger. Bloomington/London: Indiana University Press.
Dundes, A., ed. 1982. Cinderella: A Folklore Casebook. New York: Garland.
Eberhard, W., ed. 1965. Folktales of China. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Einfeld, Jann, ed. 2001. Fairy Tales. San Diego: Greenhaven Press.
Falassi, A. 1980. Folklore by the Fireside: Text and Context in the Tuscan Veglia.
London: Scolar Press.
Hallett, M., and B. Karasek, eds. 1996. Folk and Fairy Tales. Ontario: Broadview
Press.
Clever Question/Wisdom Question | 293
Irizar, L., ed., 1988. A View from the Witch’s Cave: Folktales of the Pyrenees. Coll.
J. Barandiaran and trans. L. White. Reno: University of Nevada Press.
Lang, A. 1889. The Blue Fairy Book. London: Longmans, Green, and Co.
L€uthi, M. 1976. Once upon a Time: On the Nature of Fairy Tales. Trans. L. Cha-
deayne and P. Gottwald. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Massignon, G. 1968. Folktales of France. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
McCarthy, William Bernard, ed. 2007. Cinderella in America: A Book of Folk and
Fairy Tales. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi.
Opie, I. and P. 1974. The Classic Fairy Tales. London: Oxford University Press.
Petrovich, W. 1917. Hero Tales and Legends of the Serbians. London: George G.
Harrap.
Rooth, A. 1951. The Cinderella Cycle. Lund: C. Gleerup.
Wardrop, M. 1894. Georgian Folk Tales. London: David Nutt.
A type of traditional enigma in which the solution cannot be guessed from the
question but lies in specialized cultural knowledge. The clever question is found
as a pastime in cultures that emphasize the oral examination in question-and-an-
swer form as a means of socialization.
In many Protestant U.S. communities, the tradition of catechism in religious
instruction has given rise to the posing of biblical questions. In strict groups, this
instructive pastime often substitutes for other amusements viewed as immoral.
Biblical clever questions do not address central questions of faith and doctrine
but stretch the wits in a different way, as in the question, ‘‘How many names in
the Bible begin with an h?’’ Others, although their solutions are still literal, come
closer to trick questions (‘‘Who in the Bible speaks and yet goes to neither
Heaven nor Hell?—Balaam’s ass’’).
In the United States, the clever question has become a profitable means of
structuring and encouraging popular participation in mass culture. The manufac-
turers of baseball cards expanded their market after World War II by covering
the backs of the cards with questions about batting averages and World Series
scores, thus giving their customers a way to use the cards in interaction and mul-
tiplying the number of cards to be collected. A radio station connects with its lis-
teners by offering a prize to the first person who calls in and correctly names, for
example, the first drummer of the Beatles. Television quiz shows increase the
prestige to be gained in a display of knowledge by carrying it to a national audi-
ence, with the added inducement of financial gain. The board game Trivial Pur-
suit takes the burden off the players’ shoulders by posing the questions for them.
Even the high-culture industry has learned from popular culture’s example.
A few years after the Trivial Pursuit fad of the early 1980s, literary scholar E. D.
294 | Communal Origins Theory
Hirsch declared the ‘‘culturally literate’’ to be those who could successfully iden-
tify a series of quotations, literary figures, scientific theories, and other things
‘‘that literate Americans know.’’ Hirsch’s proposed list of 5,000 items constitut-
ing the Western cultural lexicon provoked a more anxious form of trivial pursuit
among those seeking to be literate and created a miniature publishing boom in
rival lists and dictionaries.
The Christian catechism and university entrance exams demand the display of
knowledge encapsulated in succinct answers to specific questions as the price of
admission to a group. In the same way, the clever question can be a means of gain-
ing entry or prestige. The lasting effects of adolescent male ludic competitions pro-
vide the comic subject for Barry Levinson’s film Diner, in which a young man
subjects his fiancee to an excruciating football trivia quiz before he consents to
marry her.
The popularity of the clever question in the contemporary United States also
relates to a lingering utilitarian contempt for most forms of amusement as ‘‘wasted
time’’—practices such as Trivial Pursuit and crossword puzzles can be defended as
educational. Finally, games of clever questions exemplify an important assumption
in the socialization of Americans: Knowledge, construed as a collection of discrete
facts, leads to advancement and financial reward. The ethos of competitive accu-
mulation (of both facts and goods) is played out in miniature in boys’ trading of
baseball cards and in the nightly broadcast of the television show Jeopardy.
Dorothy Noyes
See Also Enigma, Folk.
References
Abrahams, Roger D., and Alan Dundes. 1972. Riddles. In Folklore and Folklife, ed.
Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Green, Thomas A., and W. J. Pepicello. 1979. The Folk Riddle: A Redefinition of
Terms. Western Folklore 38: 3 21.
Taylor, Archer. 1943. The Riddle. California Folklore Quarterly 2: 129 147.
Friedrich Karl Savigny—one of the founders of the historical school and men-
tor to Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm—argued that ‘‘each historical process does not
spring from conscious individual intention but rather carries in itself its own or-
ganic life, which develops through the effect of a force inaccessible to reason.’’
Reflecting this mystical postulate, Jacob Grimm stated that ‘‘every epos must
compose itself.’’ Taken along with the conviction that ‘‘the folk creates,’’ the two
basic building blocks of the communal origins theory were put together.
By combining these two beliefs about creativity as an inevitable historical proc-
ess and the folk as an active entity, the view that certain artistic cultural expressions
arose through inevitable accident at the hands of unsophisticated social groups was
formulated.
The most explicit expression of this idea is associated with Francis B. Gum-
mere’s explanations of how ballads originated through a singing-dancing throng.
Gummere asserted that in the ‘‘primitive’’ stage of the development of poetry and
in certain surviving cases, groups of illiterate individuals, without the ability to
conceive of the future or to relate their experiences either to the past or to the
experiences of other groups, gathered in festive settings, and through singing,
accurate rhythm keeping, and dancing, these individuals expressed sentiments
about local events that held immediate appeal and reflected a common interest.
This, according to Gummere, was the cultural foundation of poetry: ‘‘In point of
poetic process here is the social as opposed to the individual element. This festal
throng and its rude choral verse are just as much a fact, apart from question of
value, as a young man in the library and his poem.’’
The exact process by which such a creative exercise actually works has never
been observed. Half a century after the introduction of Gummere’s theory, ballad
scholars such as D. K. Wilgus argued that ‘‘no adequate summary of Gummere’s
theory of communal origins has ever been made, possibly because no critic
seems to have understood the peculiar union of faith and method by which Gum-
mere convinced a generation of literary scholars that the ballad must be studied
as a survival of primitive poetry.’’ Today, the communal creation theory has been
largely discredited. Arguing for a process of ‘‘communal re-creation’’ of narra-
tive poems composed by individual authors constitutes a more plausible theory
of ballad origins.
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Ballad; Bard; Evolutionary Theory; Folksong, Narrative.
References
Cocchiara, Giuseppe. 1981. The History of Folklore in Europe. Trans. John N.
McDaniel. Philadelphia: ISHI.
Gummere, Francis B. 1909. The Popular Ballad. New York: Dover.
296 | Communitas
Communitas
maintain the spontaneity and immediacy of communitas for very long. Commu-
nitas then produces its own structure in which free relationships between individ-
uals become converted into norm-governed relationships between social
personae. The relationships or structure that communitas produces can be distin-
guished into three categories: (1) existential or spontaneous communitas; (2) nor-
mative communitas, in which, under the influence of time, the need to mobilize
and organize resources, and the necessity for social control among members of
the group in pursuance of these goals, the existing communitas is reorganized
into a better social system; and (3) ideological communitas, which is a label one
can apply to a variety of utopian models of societies based on communitas.
Juha Pentik€
ainen
References
Helander, Eila. 1986. To Change and to Preserve: A Study of the Religiosity of
Evangelical University Students and Graduates in Trinidad. Annals of the Finnish Soci-
ety for Missiology and Ecumenics (50).
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1986. Transition Rites. In Transition Rites, ed. Ugo Bianchi.
Rome: ‘‘L’Erma’’ di Bretschneider.
Turner, Victor W. 1969. The Ritual Process: Structure and Anti-Structure. Chicago:
Aldine.
Turner, Victor W. 1974. Dramas, Fields and Metaphors: Symbolic Action in Human
Society. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Community-Based Research
References
Baron, Robert, and Nicholas R. Spitzer, eds. 2007. Public Folklore. Jackson: Univer-
sity Press of Mississippi.
Cruz, N. I., and D. E. Giles Jr. 2000. Where’s the community in service-learning
research? Michigan Journal of Community Service Learning Special Issue (Fall): 28 34.
Jones, Michael Owen, ed. 1994. Putting Folklore to Use. American Folklore Series.
Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Kodish, Debora. Folklore: Activism. Journal of American Folklore (forthcoming).
National CBR Networking Initiative. http://www.cbrnet.org.
Power, Judith, Sharon Ann Cumbie, and Clarann Weinert. 2006. Lessons learned
through the creative and iterative process of community-based participatory research.
International Journal of Qualitative Methods 5(2): 1 9.
Savan, Beth. 2004. Community University Partnerships: Linking Research and
Action for Sustainable Community Development. Community Development Journal
39(4): 373 384.
Staub, Shalom, and Ashley Finley. Spring 2009. Service Learning and Learning
Communities: Promising Pedagogies. Diversity and Democracy: Civic Learning for
Shared Futures 12(2): 18 19.
Stoecker, Randy, and Charity Schmidt. 2008. The Community Side of Service Learn-
ing. Conference Report. http://comm-org.wisc.edu/sl/page.php?13.
Strand, Kerry, et al. 2003. Community-Based Research and Higher Education: Prin-
ciples and Practices. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Comparative Mythology
The most famous of the more generic aspects of M€uller’s theories of myth was
the ‘‘solar’’ hypothesis—essentially, the claim that mythology was produced as a
spontaneous poetic reaction to observed celestial phenomena; the thesis was
enthusiastically embraced by many followers. The solar hypothesis was accompa-
nied by a postulated ‘‘disease of language,’’ processes of inevitable change in lan-
guage, including a contraction in the range of meanings of particular terms. Such
changes rendered the original poetic utterances unintelligible, if not bizarre, for
later generations, who designated such utterances as ‘‘mythology.’’ The solar and
the disease hypotheses were illustrated by M€uller largely through Indo-European
material, but many of his followers, swept up in the solar hypothesis, were much
more interested in a programmatic theory of myth interpretation than in working
out specifically Indo-European issues. And methodological distinctions that are
clear in the abstract are often muddy in practice. From M€uller onward and even in
James Frazer’s world-spanning myth study, The Golden Bough, it is often simply
unclear whether, at any given moment, the comparative dimension rests on a uni-
versal human psychology or a postulated cultural-historical interrelationship.
Comparative mythology of the narrower kind underwent a change—in certain
respects, a decline—toward the end of the nineteenth century. Several reasons
can be cited. The methods of M€uller and his followers had many shortcomings,
most notably a tendency to rest great claims on small bits of evidence—in some
Comparative Mythology | 303
cases, a postulated cognate relation between words or even single syllables. The
vast sweep of world languages characteristic of M€uller and his followers con-
veyed the impression of enormous linguistic erudition. But their work was fre-
quently carried out on the level of words and syllables, and much of it required
little more than patience and a set of dictionaries. The smallness of the data was
mirrored, inversely, by the extravagance of the speculation. It was largely the
looseness and ad hoc nature of the methods that Andrew Lang, gadfly of the solar
mythology movement, attacked, once even parodying such methods by using
them to prove that M€uller was himself a solar myth. Increasing data and types of
data rendered some of the original postulated connections untenable.
Finally, as has been suggested, much of the swirl surrounding M€uller had been
stimulated by those aspects of his theories that were least intimately bound up
with Indo-European mythology specifically. So the seeming contraction of inter-
est in comparative mythology in the narrower sense at the end of the nineteenth
century perhaps marked not so much a decline in Indo-European mythology as a
decline in certain extravagant theories, such as the solar hypothesis and the dis-
ease of language, on whose coattails Indo-European mythology had ridden into
an unusually prominent place in scholarly and popular consciousness. Compara-
tive mythology of the narrower type, following the decline of M€uller’s school,
tended to become the specialized province of disciplines concerned directly with
Indo-European languages, such as departments of classical languages and litera-
tures, and it was supported by such fields as ancient history and archaeology.
The most influential theories of myth in the twentieth century have not been
constrained by an Indo-European border but have instead been comparative in the
broader sense—seeking to isolate underlying commonalities in myths of different
cultures, often with little interest in historical interrelationships. Among these one
may count the ‘‘myth-ritual’’ school, the Freudian and Jungian schools, and the
structuralist school of Claude Levi-Strauss. The myth-ritual school and the Freud-
ian and Jungian schools retained some of the assumptions of nineteenth-century
evolutionism, especially the so-called comparative method. This method, a corol-
lary of unilinear evolution, consisted of the assumption that one could expect to
find correlations between non-European ‘‘primitive’’ cultures and the culture of
the European historical past. The Freudian and Jungian schools also frequently
invoked a further parallelism—between the psychic development of the individ-
ual and the general cultural evolution of humanity, so that, for example, childhood
anxieties would have counterparts in the myths and rituals of ‘‘primitive’’ peoples.
Levi-Strauss utilized the methods of structural linguistics (especially as devel-
oped by Roman Jakobson and Ferdinand de Saussure) to discover and analyze
underlying patterns in myths and in their transformations through time and space.
Though he dealt with patterns at many levels, Levi-Strauss’s most celebrated and
controversial claims had to do with postulated universal patterns, which he
304 | Comparative Mythology
in which Dumezil juxtaposed the war and eventual merging of the Romans and the
Sabines, as recounted in Livy’s history of Rome, with Scandinavian accounts of a
war and eventual merging of two tribes of gods, the sir and the Vanir. Taking a
clue from the fact that the Vanir, like the Sabines, represented the values of fecun-
dity and opulence, Dumezil found a commonality between the Roman and the
Scandinavian narratives. In each case, claimed Dumezil, there was a depiction of
the completion of the tripartite ideology through the addition of fertility, the third
function. In this sense, the Roman and Scandinavian accounts, one ‘‘historical’’
and the other ‘‘mythical,’’ reflected a shared Indo-European ideology.
One of the main criticisms of Dumezil is reminiscent of a criticism that had
been made of M€uller—that the methods of comparison allowed the scholar
to incorporate too much, eventually obliterating any border around the Indo-
European family. In M€uller’s approach, this happened because of the smallness of
the pieces compared: One could always find a syllable that could be postulated as
cognate with some syllable in the next language family. In Dumezil’s approach,
the same thing happened, but it happened because of the largeness—the abstract-
ness and generality—of the entity compared, that is, the tripartite ideology. For it
could reasonably be argued that what was depicted in Dumezil’s tripartite ideol-
ogy was not so much an Indo-European specialty as a set of functional prerequi-
sites for any society. In fact, Dumezil’s arguments frequently have been picked
up by scholars working in societies without any demonstrable connection with the
Indo-European world. Once again, theories originating within the study of Indo-
European mythology have had, for some scholars, the effect of breaking down the
alleged distinctiveness of Indo-European mythology vis-a-vis other mythologies.
Dumezil’s methods have occasioned many criticisms, but even the critics have
often applauded his fresh insights into the relation of myth and society and his
refocusing of interest on Indo-European mythology and/or mythology in general.
The present climate is not particularly favorable to cross-cultural methodolo-
gies; emphasis is on the local and the incommensurable, and there is acute skepti-
cism of methodologies that suggest ‘‘totalizing’’ ambitions. Still, there are signs
that the present-day skepticism is discovering its own limits and that a conviction
is returning regarding the value and even the necessity of a discourse of human
commonalities and interrelatedness to complement the discourse of differences.
Fueled by developments within maturing fields such as cognitive science, we can
expect a resurgence of interest in comparative mythology in both the narrower
and broader forms—that is, both bounded by particular, historically related lan-
guage families and oriented toward human universals. The vastly enlarged pool
of ethnographic and textual data now available will permit analyses to be more
empirically grounded than was possible in M€uller’s time, yet our findings may
prove to be no less amazing than anything devised in M€uller’s speculative flights.
Gregory Schrempp
306 | Computer-Mediated Folklore
References
Bernal, Martin. 1987. Black Athena. Vol. 1. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University
Press.
Dumezil, Georges. 1970. Archaic Roman Religion. Vol. 1. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Frazer, James. 1911. The Golden Bough, Vol. 1. London: Macmillan.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1969. The Raw and the Cooked. New York: Harper & Row.
Littleton, C. Scott. 1982. The New Comparative Mythology. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1954. Magic, Science, and Religion and Other Essays. New
York: Doubleday Anchor Books.
M€uller, Friedrich Max. 1856. Comparative Mythology. In Oxford Essays. London:
John W. Parker.
Puhvel, Jaan. 1987. Comparative Mythology. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins Univer-
sity Press.
Schrempp, Gregory. 1983. The Re-education of Friedrich Max M€uller. Man 18: 90 110.
Tylor, E. B. 1873. Primitive Culture, Vol. 1. London: John Murray.
Computer-Mediated Folklore
Folklore generated by the computer-user subculture or, more generally, any folk-
lore communicated through computer networking (electronic messaging). Elec-
tronic messaging began in the late 1960s as a brainstorming tool for computer
programmers. Today, a giant maze of electronic pathways referred to as ‘‘the
Network’’ (or usually, just ‘‘the Net’’) links computer users around the world via
fiber-optic telephone cables, making it possible to send almost instantaneous
messages (electronic mail, or e-mail) to a user on the other side of the globe.
An outgrowth of these networks since about 1980 has been a proliferation of
topical information-sharing forums in which individual users can take part. Topics
range broadly and include academic specialties and subspecialties and also hobbies
and special interests. Thus, small, temporary communities defined by special inter-
ests provide the context and the occasion (and computer networking provides the
medium) for communication that is both like and not like that which folklorists
more commonly study. Familiar genres such as contemporary legends and topical
jokes are frequently communicated via the Net, along with audience commentary,
additional variants, and analysis. The extent to which the medium and its technol-
ogy influence the content and performance of folklore transmitted via the Net,
however, and the exact nature of that influence are topics still being explored.
Conduit Theory/Multiconduit Theory | 307
References
Cerulo, Karen A., Janet M. Ruane, and Mary Chayko. 1992. Technological Ties That
Bind: Media-Generated Primary Groups. Communication Research 19: 109 129.
Dorst, John. 1990. Tags and Burners, Cycles and Networks: Folklore in the Telec-
tronic Age. Journal of Folklore Research 27: 179 190.
Fox, William S. 1983. Computerized Creation and Diffusion of Folkloric Materials.
Folklore Forum 16: 5 20.
Jennings, Karla. 1990. The Devouring Fungus: Tales from the Computer Age. New
York: W. W. Norton.
Raymond, Eric, ed. 1991. The New Hacker’s Dictionary. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
A theory developed by Linda Degh and Andrew Vazsonyi to explain why folklore
genres persist in a limited number of remarkably stable and crystallized conven-
tional forms while in the process of transmission and dissemination. Reproduction
308 | Conduit Theory/Multiconduit Theory
References
Anderson, Walter. 1923. Kaiser und Abt: Die Geschichte eines Schwankes (Kaiser
and Abbot: The History of a Joke). Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 42. Helsinki:
Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Anderson, Walter. 1951. Ein Volkskundliches Experiment. Folklore Fellows Commu-
nications, no. 141. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Bartlett, Frederick C. 1920. Some Experiments on the Reproduction of Folk Stories.
Folklore 31: 30 47.
Degh, Linda. 1993. The Legend Conduit. In Creativity and Tradition in Folklore:
New Directions, ed. Simon J. Bronner. Logan: Utah State University Press.
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1975. The Hypothesis of Multi-Conduit Trans-
mission in Folklore. In Folklore, Performance and Communication, ed. D. Ben-Amos
and K. Goldstein. The Hague: Mouton.
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1976. Legend and Belief. In Folklore Genres,
ed. Dan Ben-Amos. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Fine, Gary Alan. 1992. Manufacturing Tales. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Hemenway, Robert. 1976. The Functions of Folklore in Charles Chesnutt’s ‘‘The
Conjuring Woman.’’ Journal of the Folklore Institute 13: 283 309.
Lewis, Mary-Ellen B. 1976. Burns’ ‘‘Tale O’ Truth’’: A Legend in Literature. Jour-
nal of the Folklore Institute 13: 241 262.
Lowie, Robert H. 1942. Some Cases of Repeated Reproduction. Reprinted in The
Study of Folklore, ed. Alan Dundes. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Oring, Elliott. 1978. Transmission and Degeneration. Fabula 19: 193 210.
Wehse, Rainer. 1983. Volkskundliche Erz€ahlforschung. In M€
archenerz€
ahler, Erz€
ahl-
gemeinschaft. Kassel, Germany: R€oth.
Contestation
The struggle amongst a culture consisting of two or more factions competing for
dominance within its own society. Contestation is often attributed to class oppo-
sition and oppression (Hulsether 1993, 2). Contestation, however, can be found
in more than just class systems, such as in contestatory literature or within soci-
eties that are communist or classless because there will always be a ruling elite
(Rodriquez 2000).
The term hegemony is often used synonymously with contestation and is the
domination by a seemingly superior culture over an inferior culture (Hulsether
310 | Contestation
1993). Contestation can be found within American studies through the various
segments of African American history. African Americans have been involved in
a power struggle of culture since the time of slavery. The struggle of power and
culture amongst African American slaves and the elite slave owners emphasizes
the cultural domination of one group over another (Hulsether 1993). As slavery
ended in America, a black nationality movement arose. One group involved in
this idea of nationality, led by Marcus Garvey, wanted a return to Africa, while
another group wanted to create a Black Canada. Slavery was outlawed in Can-
ada, and officially Canada was a place where African Americans would be wel-
comed in large quantities. African Americans, however, who moved to the
Canadian provinces found themselves encountering the same type of discrimina-
tion that they found in the United States. This discrimination existed generally in
less distinct forms than the Jim Crowe laws and extreme segregation in the
American South (Rhodes 2000).
Women in various cultures around the world, also exhibit this contestation
involving a power structure. Mary Hegland researched the power paradox found
within Pakistan Shi’a women’s roles in the mourning rituals of Imam Hussein. In
the Islamic religion, women are taught that they should be covered and veiled.
During the mourning rituals, however, women experience a greater sense of in-
dependence. The rituals, which occur for a period of two months, are sex segre-
gated. During the ritual period, women are able to travel great distances and
associate with others who are generally looked down upon within Muslim soci-
ety, such as show girls. Through this position, the power still resides in the males
of the society. One well-known female Muslim preacher, interviewed by Heg-
land, is not allowed to marry because her brother enjoys a higher status due to
her preaching (Hegland 1998).
Melissa Frazier
See Also Ethnic Folklore.
References
Hegland, Mary E. 1998. The Power Paradox in Muslim Women’s Majales: North-West
Pakistani Mourning Rituals as Sites of Contestation over Religous Politics, Ethnicity, and
Gender. Signs: Journal of Women in Culture and Society (University of Chicago) 23(2):
391 428.
Hulsether, Mark. 1993. Evolving Approaches to U.S. Culture in the American Stud-
ies Movement: Consensus, Pluralism, and Contestation for Cultural Hegemony. Cana-
dian Review of American Studies 23(2): 1 55.
Rhodes, Jane. 2000. The Contestation over National Identity: Nineteenth-Century
Black Americans in Canada. Canadian Review of American Studies 30(2): 175 186.
Rodriquez, Ralph E. 2000. Chicana/o Fiction from Resistance Contestation: The
Role of Creation in Ana Castillo’s So Far from God. MELUS 25(2): 63 82.
Context | 311
Context
References
Degh, Linda. 1969. Folktales and Society: Storytelling in a Hungarian Peasant Com-
munity. Bloomington: University of Indiana Press.
Herskovits, Melville J., and Frances Herskovits. 1958. Dahomean Narrative, A Cross
Cultural Analysis. Evanston, IL: Northwestern University Press.
Jacobs, Melville. 1959. The Content and Style of an Oral Literature: Clackamas,
Chinook Myths and Tales. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Jacobs, Melville. 1964. Pattern in Cultural Anthropology. Homewood, IL: Dorsey.
Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1944. A Scientific Theory of Culture. Chapel Hill: University
of North Carolina Press.
El-Shamy, H. 1967. Folkloric Behavior. PhD thesis, University of Indiana,
Bloomington.
El-Shamy, H. 1979. Brother and Sister. Type 872*: A Cognitive Behavioristic Text
Analysis of a Middle Eastern Oikotype, Folklore Monograph Series, vol. 8. Blooming-
ton, IN: Folklore Publications Group.
Cosmology
The culturally appropriate view of and way to study or contemplate the universe
in its creation and present aspect. A people’s cosmology includes their cognitive
and ideational accounts of how the universe came into being and its physical
characteristics. Often, the accounts include a set of moral imperatives as well.
The accounts may be in prose or in poetry and usually are highly metaphorical
Cosmology | 313
and full of allusion. In some societies, cosmology may be fully known only to a
select and highly trained few. In other societies, any member of the group who
expresses an interest will be taught the cosmology. In mainstream U.S. culture,
young people often complain of being forced to learn cosmology through attend-
ance at Sunday schools or similar religious training classes.
Cosmologies usually include not only philosophy and moral precepts but also
theories about how and why the universe came into being. They provide a ration-
ale for who we are, what we represent, why we are here, and what our proper
behavior should be. Often, in discussing cosmology, as much attention is given
to the consequences of a failure to believe or behave properly as to the details of
the construction of the universe.
Cosmology is closely related to cosmogony, which is an account of the physi-
cal creation—and usually also the ordering—of the universe; cosmogony, how-
ever, does not normally include morality or offer exemplars of proper behavior.
The terms cosmology and cosmogony also are used by those in other disciplines,
especially by astronomers. However, folklorists put a slightly different spin on
these words. For an astronomer, cosmogony refers to the physical construction—
or coming into being—of the universe, and cosmology concerns ideas on the
functioning of the universe.
Folklorists usually look for cosmology in the myth sequences of a people and
expect the cosmology to be peopled with animals that have the ability to speak
or at least communicate, with feats of will and character seldom seen in the mod-
ern world, and/or with beings who are larger than life and greater than human;
they also expect to find in cosmology lessons on how not to live as well as how
to construct a proper life.
Once having established the universe, the world of the people, and acceptable
patterns of living, the cosmology portion of mythic narrative is completed. Addi-
tional episodes that follow the cosmology usually are considered to be an integral
portion of mythic narrative but qualitatively different from the cosmological por-
tion of the narrative. There may be competing cosmologies in operation in any
given culture; in contemporary American culture, for example, the Judeo-Christian-
Muslim account, creationism, and science all offer differing cosmologies. However,
once a cosmology is accepted by a person or group and established within a culture,
it remains essentially fixed; myth, by contrast, is subject to change in response to a
changing world and interactions within it.
Claire R. Farrer
See Also Creation Myths; Culture Hero; Myth.
References
Blackburn, Thomas C. 1975. December’s Child: A Book of Chumash Oral Narratives.
Berkeley: University of California Press.
314 | Costume, Folk
Boas, Franz. 1894. Chinook Texts. Bureau of Ethnology, Bulletin 20. Washington,
DC: Smithsonian Institution.
Farrer, Claire R. 1991. Living Life’s Circle: Mescalero Apache Cosmovision. Albu-
querque: University of New Mexico Press.
Kroeber, Alfred L. 1976. Yurok Myths. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Costume, Folk
Iranian women soldiers, carrying AK-47 rifles with carnations in their barrels, march during
the military parade marking the beginning of Iran’s ‘‘Sacred Military Week’’ in Tehran,
September 22, 1999. (AP/Wide World Photos)
Costume, Folk | 315
and group identity, as well as how folk manipulate and transform adornment
signs and practices within the framework of their own aesthetics.
Costume often is conceived as a symbolic language, composed of clothing
signs. Petr Bogatyrev, in his influential study of folk costume in modern Slovakia,
pointed out that costume is both an object and a sign having multiple functions,
such as the ritual, aesthetic, practical, and ideological. In contexts in which a cos-
tume’s practical function is downplayed, costume functions as a sign; it becomes
an ideological reality. As ideological reality, costume embodies the associations
individuals have with the social structures of family, economy or polity, region,
ethnicity, religion, and caste or class. The type of folk costume discussed by Boga-
tyrev often has emerged in colonial or touristic contexts in which self-conscious
presentation to outsiders is a key way of negotiating identity. In Western and East-
ern Europe, such folk costumes are invariably codifications of past peasant styles
representing regional differences, and they often involve symbolic inscription on
women’s bodies as regional or ethnic symbols. In this way, folk costume is impli-
cated in the maintenance of the cultural or political boundaries of ethnic groups,
regions, or nations, particularly in touristic, festival, or colonial contexts.
Folk costume plays a key role in the negotiation of personal and community
boundaries, both inside and outside folk groups. Significantly, folklorists who dis-
cuss adornment have concentrated on costume’s socializing force—its relationship
to the maintenance of individual and group identities and the articulation of power
relations. This important work on folk costume has considered adornment as an
important means of communicating an individual’s relationship to a group or com-
munity and its traditional values. According to Don Yoder, folk costume expresses
identity in a symbolic way, functioning as a ‘‘badge of identity’’ for members of
ethnic, religious, and occupational groups. Costume outwardly represents the iden-
tity of the folk community and expresses the individual’s manifold relationships to
and within that community. In many plain religious sects discussed by Yoder, such
as the Amish, Mennonites, and Shakers, the rejection of fashion in plain dress his-
torically articulated group separation from mainstream society by embodying the
principles of sectarian doctrine and establishing a ‘‘hedge’’ against the temptations
of the world. In this way, sect members would be perceived and perceive them-
selves as different from others. Thus, folk costume promotes group solidarity and
maintains personal and group boundaries as individuals embody a community by
reshaping their bodies in keeping with group values.
In addition to outwardly embodying identities, costume also plays a key role
in the definition and reconfiguration of personal identities and social boundaries
within any folk group. In ritual contexts such as rites of passage, for example,
adornment practices articulate an individual’s relationship to the community by
marking culturally significant moments in that individual’s life. Young men and
women passing from childhood to adulthood often adopt adult attire (such as
316 | Costume, Folk
long trousers or skirts) as a symbol of their new status in the community. Their
change in status is accomplished, in part, by the reconfiguration of their physical
appearance in costume—physical transformation embodies personal transforma-
tion. Marriage and mourning costumes, contrasted with everyday clothing, indi-
cate the wearers’ participation in ritual passage and transformation. In this way,
clothing induces individuals to become or remain members of a community by
physically representing their integration into the community and their acceptance
of group values and distinctions related to age, sex, and status. Within this
approach, clothing perpetuates a dominant social code by defining hierarchies
and marking separations.
Costume also possesses the power to reconfigure those hierarchies and separa-
tions. In other ritual and festival contexts, costume transforms the body’s everyday
appearance and redefines its boundaries temporarily in fanciful costuming, masking,
or clothing that represents and helps enact new, fictional, or performative roles.
Masquerade and cross-dressing are major media for inversion and other renegotia-
tions of social boundaries, commonly adopted when individuals try on new roles or
identities and when the barriers between individuals are broken down during a pe-
riod of license. In carnival contexts, elaborate costumes are an important way in
which a sense of fun and license is engendered. A key feature of such carnival cos-
tumes is often their aesthetic of excess. Elaborate and expensive, these carnival cos-
tumes exaggerate and distort the features and proportions of the body, opening up
the body and extending its boundaries. This exaggeration and excess contribute to
the sense of spectacle and a carnivalesque aesthetic that celebrates the excesses of
the body and its pleasures. Costume signs in carnival contexts are multivalent and
often potentially subversive; that is, they involve the play and transformation of
everyday attire, renegotiating its conventional meanings, if only temporarily.
Costume is likewise dynamic and subversive in cultural contexts in which dress
is contested or manipulated through what Elizabeth Wilson has termed ‘‘opposi-
tional dress.’’ In oppositional dress, the body is transformed into a site of struggle
by disenfranchised groups or disaffected subcultures as they attempt to define
themselves by redefining the appearance and meaning of their bodies. Opposi-
tional dress can take several forms, usually through processes of refusal and appro-
priation. For instance, retentions or revivals of traditional dress by indigenous
peoples in colonial contexts in the face of pressures to adopt fashionable, Western
dress constitute a form of refusal—self-definition as a strategy of resistance to co-
lonial control or Western cultural imperialism. In some cases, traditional dress
becomes a symbol of political movements for economic and political indepen-
dence. Mahatma Gandhi’s use of traditional Indian textiles and dress as a symbol
of resistance to British imperial control in the mid-twentieth century signified both
economic and cultural independence. By advocating traditional dress, he redefined
the colonial social body as Indian, not British, and reasserted the power of native
Costume, Folk | 317
References
Bogatyrev, Petr. 1971. The Function of Folk Costume in Modern Slovakia. Trans.
Richard Crum. The Hague: Mouton.
Hebdige, Dick. 1979. Subculture: The Meaning of Style. London: Routledge.
Hollander, Ann. 1993. Seeing through Clothes. Berkeley: University of California
Press.
Mercer, Kobena. 1987. Black Hair/Style Politics. New Formations 3: 33 54.
Polhemus, Ted, and Lynn Procter. 1978. Fashion and Anti-Fashion: An Anthropol-
ogy of Clothing and Adornment. London: Thames and Hudson.
Roach, Mary Ellen, and Joanne Bubolz Eicher. 1965. Dress, Adornment and the
Social Order. New York: John Wiley & Sons.
Wilson, Elizabeth. 1985. Adorned in Dreams: Fashion and Modernity. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Yoder, Don. 1972. Folk Costume. In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed.
Richard Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Yoder, Don. [1969] 1990. Sectarian Costume. In Discovering American Folklife: Stud-
ies in Ethnic, Religious and Regional Culture, ed. Don Yoder. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI.
Craft, Folk
Skill or process of creating goods, usually by hand. Craft first attracted folkloris-
tic interest in the nineteenth century because the skills involved clearly showed
transmission through tradition and because the products of these skills could be
compared across time and space. Craft was essential to utilities in daily life and
also could have decorative and spiritual functions. In addition to the skills and
processes that provide the basic equipment of domestic life—tools, furnishings,
houses, clothes—crafts include ritual, religious, and artistic objects, and they fos-
ter beliefs about the highly skilled workers who produce them, as in oft-collected
legends of blacksmiths.
The concept of craft is closely related to perceptions of art. Craft in nine-
teenth-century conceptions of folk cultures characterized folklore more than art
because of the assumption that art represented originality and leisure and craft
symbolized work and repetition more in keeping with the stereotype of folk cul-
ture. In a modification of this view, scholars pointed to arts such as Pennsylva-
nia-German painted furniture that grew out of traditional crafts. Up until the
1970s, the dominant perspective viewed craft as having utilitarian intent and
application and art as having a principally aesthetic character. Thus, many of the
objects categorized as art were decorative, and crafts were treated as tools. The
limitation of this simplification emphasizing form and function is that artifacts
have multiple functions, and the artistic appreciation of skill and beauty in folk
design can apply to non-decorated objects. Considering craft and art as behavior
rather than form, scholars recognized craft and art as parts of each other, a sym-
bolic kind of action. Craft had an active role, referring to the process of construc-
tion and its integration with aesthetic or artistic judgments and traditions.
The shifts in the conception of craft and art reflect changes since the nine-
teenth century in the kinds of approaches used to study craft. Many early folklor-
istic studies of craft considered the products of traditional crafts in a ‘‘natural
history of civilization’’ or cultural evolution from the primitive to the industrial.
Another early approach took up questions of diffusion and transmission of tradi-
tion across cultures and used variations among crafts to interpret cultural borrow-
ings and map regions. Because crafts reflected daily life, another approach arose
to document the folklife or historical folk culture of a regional-ethnic commu-
nity. Closely related to the examination of crafts as products meant for an entire
community is the role of craft as the product of an individual with creative and
aesthetic goals. Especially since the 1970s, other approaches have arisen that
focus on craft as a form of communication. The process of creating, consuming,
using, and changing crafts has received attention as an important type of nonver-
bal behavior humans use to express themselves.
Evolution
In 1871, following Charles Darwin’s theories of origin and development in na-
ture, Edward Tylor promoted the study of cultural evolution through ‘‘survivals.’’
Traditional crafts among tribal societies in the world, he surmised, were evidence
of a low, ‘‘primitive’’ stage of development that led to the highest level of indus-
trial invention in ‘‘civilization.’’ Evolutionists following Tylor organized crafts
by technological type and typically arranged them by level of advancement to
form a global evolution of civilization.
Craft, Folk | 321
Diffusion
One problem with early evolutionary doctrine was that it did not explain similar-
ities in customs and crafts among widely separated groups. The comparisons that
were made were typically ahistorical in that the cultural occurrence was assumed
to be part of a universal level of advancement rather than a period in a group’s
history. If cultures move and influence custom because of historical migrations
and cultural contact, however, then the progressive explanation for civilization
could be challenged. In addition to questions of origin and development, ques-
tions of diffusion and transmission arose to show that cultures not only devel-
oped in place but also moved and influenced others. Crafts became important
evidence of such movements because types of crafts could be visibly traced and
comparisons could be made according to date of manufacture. The most promi-
nent example is the explanation for the similarity of many Native American and
Asian folk shelters and crafts. In 1904, Waldemar Bogoras, for example, wrote
on the comparable material culture in Siberia and Alaska, supporting a migration
from Asia across the Bering Strait into North America.
A notable movement called the Kulturkreiselehre (culture-cluster school)
arose in German-speaking countries to examine diffusion of folk ideas as demon-
strated in folk crafts. Fritz Graebner, Wilhelm Schmidt, and Wilhelm Koppers,
to name some notable figures in this movement, reconstructed the diffusion of
crafts by determining clusters of cultural traits that moved together. The assump-
tion was that migrations and contacts reduced the importance of the environment.
Mapping diffusion according to this assumption could lead to a failure to deal
with historical accidents, local or individual developments, and social change.
Communication
The results of close examinations of individual crafts workers suggested that the
process of craft is an everyday activity that often arises in response to certain sit-
uations. Although popular belief in postindustrial societies suggested that humans
would not be involved in creative activities because of the rise of electronics and a
service economy, folkloristic studies, since the 1980s particularly, have proposed
a close examination of the symbols and metaphors communicated when humans
‘‘make things.’’ Crafting in such a view becomes a metaphoric model for doing,
rather than a technical procedure for turning out a product. With craft, there is the
suggestion of drawing on tradition and innovation for use, of taking time to con-
vert nature into something personal and meaningful. Stories and environments can
be crafted as well as chairs and baskets.
The material process of crafting grasps ideas in ways that speech cannot. In
addition to the recovery of historical crafts, such as basketry or pottery, that is
common in scholarship, some folklorists suggested many non-canonized tradi-
tions, such as cooking meals, renovating houses, arranging yards, and folding
papers, as everyday efforts of grasping ideas through craft processes. In a study
of the construction and readjustment of tract houses in Los Angeles, Michael
Owen Jones argued that such modern activities revealed processes of tradition
and creativity. Homeowners often announced their intentions for establishing an
identity through the process of construction. The approach implied more directly
behavioral interpretations rather than sociocultural ones, with attention to the
Creation Myths | 323
References
Boas, Franz. [1927] 1955. Primitive Art. New York: Dover.
Bronner, Simon J. 1985. Chain Carvers: Old Men Crafting Meaning. Lexington:
University Press of Kentucky.
Bronner, Simon J. 1986. Grasping Things: Folk Material Culture and Mass Society
in America. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Glassie, Henry. 1968. Pattern in the Material Folk Culture of the Eastern United
States. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1975. The Hand Made Object and Its Maker. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Roberts, Warren E. 1988. Viewpoints on Folklife: Looking at the Overlooked. Ann
Arbor, MI: UMI Research.
Vlach, John Michael. 1981. Charleston Blacksmith: The Work of Philip Simmons.
Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Creation Myths
A basic myth type through which all cultures clothe their beliefs and aspirations in
the fanciful stories we refer to as myths. Myths can be said to be cultural dreams.
324 | Creation Myths
Like dreams, they are marked by impossible events, a confusion of characters, and
often a radical disregard of time sequence and place consistency. If we believe that
dreams, when analyzed, can reveal useful information about ourselves, it is not
surprising that we look to our myths as symbolic vehicles for significant collective
understandings of the world and cosmos in which we find ourselves.
No cultural dream type is more universal than the creation myth. The creation
myth is a cosmogony, a composite of the sense conveyed by the Greek words
kosmos (order) and genesis (birth). All cultures have stories of their beginnings.
In their often bizarre events creation myths answer the collective need of cultures
to know where they came from and how they were formed. As the classic psy-
choanalytic patient searching for self-identity is led to an examination of the
beginnings, the details of birth, the details of parentage, the same process applies
to cultures in search of identity and significance. So it is, for instance, that psy-
chologist and mythologist Marie-Louise von Franz defines the creation myth as
‘‘an awakening toward consciousness’’ (24). In that process, since no one was
there to see the beginning, we construct metaphorical and symbolic narratives
clothed in the elements of real life experience—fathers, mothers, sexuality, birth,
death, the shortcomings of human beings. To be sure, creation myths are affected
deeply by particular cultural understandings, themselves in part the result of
particular environments and social conditions. The creator-father god of a patri-
archal warrior culture creates in a way that reflects such a culture. The creator-
mother earth goddess of an agricultural society creates in quite another way.
As culturally based as they naturally are, however, creation myths, when com-
pared, reveal certain universal or semi-universal patterns, or motifs. The historian
of religion Mircea Eliade, sees the creation myth as a universal narration describ-
ing a process by which chaos becomes cosmos. The earliest humans faced disorder
in a desperate quest for survival. Creation myths gave them meaning in an ulti-
mately ordered or purposeful universe. When a culture dreams its creation story it
tells how ultimate reality takes form in the elements of the particular known world,
whether that world is a pueblo of the American Southwest or a village along the
Tigris in ancient Mesopotamia. Cultures always see creation as having taken place
at the center of the world wherever the given culture believes that center to be.
Furthermore, it might be said that the creation myth is the most important story
we have to tell, because it serves as a model for everything we do, for the human
act of creation in whatever form it takes—the creating of a family, the destroying
of what we do not like, the building of a house, the planting of a field, the making
of a work of art. Mircea Eliade understands creation myths as symbolic descrip-
tions of a reality in which all creative acts are ‘‘paradigmatic models’’ (Eliade, Sa-
cred, 45), reflections of an ‘‘eternal return’’ to an identifying center.
A more specific comparison of the world’s creation myths reveals certain ba-
sic creation types within the overall form. Commentators on these myths have
Creation Myths | 325
References
Eliade, Mircea. [1958] 1967. Patterns in Comparative Religion. Trans. Rosemary
Sheed. Cleveland and New York: Meridian.
Eliade, Mircea. 1959. The Sacred and the Profane: The Nature of Religion. New
York: Harcourt, Brace and World.
von Franz, Marie Louise. 1972. Patterns of Creativity Mirrored in Creation Myths.
Zurich, Switzerland: Spring Publications. Revised as Creation Myths. Boston: Sham-
bala, 1995.
Leeming, David A. The World of Myth. New York: Oxford University Press, 1990.
326 | Cryptozoology
Long, Charles H. 1963. Alpha: The Myths of Creation. New York: George Braziller.
Sproul, Barbara C. [1979] 1991. Primal Myths: Creation Myths around the World.
San Francisco: HarperCollins.
Cryptozoology
Cryptozoology is the search for ‘‘hidden’’ animals, those once thought to have
become extinct but that still survive, animals that were thought to have been only
mythical but that actually existed or were based on actual animals, and animals that
have yet to be named by science. This field is one that teeters on the edge of legiti-
macy, as there have been examples of animals discovered that fit the criteria just
listed—the most famous examples are those of the coelacanth, the okapi, the giant
panda, and the mountain gorilla. The first, the coelacanth, is a lobe-finned fish
thought to have become extinct along with the dinosaurs; the others were thought
to be mythical by Western scientists who discounted stories of the creatures from
local inhabitants. Unknown, noncryptid species are found by mainstream science
on a regular basis.
Cryptozoology finds its modern genesis in the work of Bernard Heuvelmans
(1916–2001) and Ivan Sanderson (1911–1973). Both trained scientists, they
began writing about anomalous animals in the 1940s and 1950s. In 1955,
Heuvelmans, a French-born Belgian zoologist, released Sur la Piste des B^ etes
Ignor ees (On the Track of Unknown Animals). This was the first influential work
in the field and inspired legions of followers and intellectual children. He auth-
ored many books on the subject, including the seminal In the Wake of the Sea
Serpents (1965). His friend and colleague, Scottish zoologist Ivan Sanderson,
produced Abominable Snowmen: Legend Come to Life (1961). It was the first
major work on what Sanderson called ABSMs (Abominable Snowmen). Heuvel-
mans attributes the term cryptozoology to Sanderson. In his work, Heuvelmans
argues that the search for cryptids (individual organisms that fall into the cate-
gory) must be thorough and scientific, as the object is to look for not only ani-
mals in the field, but also to discover the folkloric nature of such creatures. It is
up to the cryptozoologist to weed through the mountains of legends, artwork, and
national and cultural legends to find whether such stories and descriptions of
strange animals have any basis in reality.
Following this tradition, Adrienne Mayor produced the groundbreaking work The
First Fossil Hunters (2000), which argued that many Greek legends of monsters,
heroes, and other exotic life were attempts by ancient writers to make sense of their
discovery of fossil bones. While Heuvelmans was a generalist, most modern crypto-
zoologists specialize in one particular area, as Sanderson did. Like Mayor, Richard
Ellis, and Jeff Meldrum, they study fossils, sea monsters, or Bigfoot, respectively.
Cryptozoology | 327
Current leading practitioners who take a more generalist approach include Karl
Shuker and Loren Coleman.
As an intellectual endeavor, cryptozoology has been studied as much as cryp-
tozoologists have sought hidden animals. For example, literary scholar Peter
Dendle has looked at the hunt for cryptids as filling a number of psychological
roles—including as a vehicle by which to explore the problems of deforestation,
environmentalism, and the profound impact of human society on animal species
worldwide. In addition, he sees the fascination with cryptids as a holdover from
medieval times and the wide array of modern books on the subject as the latest
incarnation of illuminated bestiaries. Cryptozoologists focus on the search for
large, imposing beasts that could be labeled monsters. They search for the dark,
slouching hulks that lurk in the darker corners of the human psyche as much as
they do the dark corners of the world.
One of the difficulties faced by cryptozoologists is explaining just what they
do and how they go about it. Where zoologists, biologists, botanists, and the like
have established methodologies for studying living things and general paradigms
for making sense of what they are doing, cryptozoologists as yet do not. Though
many practitioners attempt to be as ‘‘scientific’’ as they can, there are no
accepted, uniform, or successful methods of pursuing cryptids. Certain technolo-
gies, like motion sensitive cameras, night vision devices, and audio recorders are
utilized. Adding that none of the most famous cryptids, the Loch Ness Monster,
Sasquatch, Yeti, and Chupacabra, has yet to be proven to exist with certainty, it
has been difficult for cryptozoology to make a breakthrough into mainstream
328 | Cryptozoology
References
Arment, Chad. 2004. Cryptozoology: Science and Speculation. Lancaster, PA:
Coachwhip.
Dendle, Peter. 2006 (August). Cryptozoology in the Medieval and Modern Worlds.
Folklore 117: 190 206.
Heuvelmans, Bernard. 1958. Sur la Piste des B^
etes Ignorees. Paris: Plon. English
trans. On the Track of Unknown Animals. New York: Hill and Wang.
Sanderson, Ivan. 1961. Abominable Snowmen: Legend Come to Life. Philadelphia,
PA: Chilton.
Cultural Property | 329
Cultural Property
impact the cultural property rights of tradition bearers and indigenous communities.
The debates surrounding the IP rights to traditional heritage have been ongoing (at
this writing) for over seven years, with no international agreement reached on the
appropriate way to protect the IP rights of tradition bearers to their traditional
knowledge and traditional cultural expressions (i.e., folklore).
the crux of regional and local legal actions. Beyond the defensive protection of
monuments, sites, artifacts, and the intangible cultural heritage of traditional
communities, we have seen the rise of legislation that attempts to protect cultural
property by restricting the transmission and use of oral traditions, and advocates
the repatriation of cultural artifacts from cultural institutions that have been cus-
todians for decades. The issues surrounding cultural property and its relation to
folklore and traditional culture promise to be a point of contention for many
years to come.
Peggy Bulger
See Also Cultural Relativism; Cultural Studies.
References
Bell, Catherine, and Robert K. Paterson, eds. 2009. Protection of First Nations Cul-
tural Heritage: Laws, Policy, and Reform. Vancouver: UBC Press.
Blake, Janet. 2006. Commentary on the 2003 UNESCO Convention on the Safe-
guarding of the Intangible Heritage. Leicester, UK: Institute of Art and Law.
Cuno, James. 2008. Who Owns Antiquity? Museums and the Battle over Our Ancient
Heritage. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Gillman, Derek. 2006. The Idea of Cultural Heritage. Leicester, UK: Institute of Art
and Law.
Hutt, Sherry, Caroline Blanco, Walter Stern, and Stan Harris. 2004. Cultural Prop-
erty Law: A Practitioner’s Guide to the Management, Protection, and Preservation of
Heritage Resources. Chicago: American Bar Association.
International Council on Monuments and Sites. Convention for the Protection of Cul-
tural Property in the Event of Armed Conflict. http://www.icomos.org/hague.
Lemley, Mark A. 2005. Property, Intellectual Property and Free Riding. Texas Law
Review 83: 1031 1042.
Lessig, Lawrence. 2004. Free Culture: How Big Media Uses Technology and the
Law to Lock Down Culture and Control Creativity. New York: Penguin Press.
Messenger, Phyllis Manch, ed. 1999. The Ethics of Collecting Cultural Property:
Whose Culture? Whose Property? Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.
Miles, Margaret Melanie. 2008. Art as Plunder: The Ancient Origins of Debate about
Cultural Property. New York: Cambridge University Press.
World Intellectual Property Organization. 2008. Intellectual Property and Traditional
Cultural Expressions/Folklore. WIPO Pub. #913(E). Geneva, Switzerland: WIPO.
Cultural Relativism
that they are alike because of the unity of the human mind, (2) the existence of
like traits in different cultures is not as important as the comparative school
claims, (3) similar traits may have developed for very different purposes in differ-
ing cultures, and (4) the view that cultural differences are of minor importance is
baseless. The differences between cultures were, Boas asserted, of major anthro-
pological significance. Boas did not stop his critique of the comparative school
there. He also delineated a methodology to replace it. His new method empha-
sized that culture traits have to be studied in detail and within the cultural whole
and that the distribution of a culture trait within neighboring cultures also should
be examined. This approach suggests that a culture needs to be analyzed within
its full context.
Boas thought that this approach would help the anthropologist understand the
environmental factors that shape a culture, explain the psychological factors that
frame the culture, and illuminate the history of a local custom. Boas was trying to
establish the inductive method in anthropology and abandon the comparative
method. He emphasized that the primary goal of anthropology was to study indi-
vidual societies and that generalizations could come only on the basis of accumu-
lated data. Thus, he argued that anthropology should be an objective and inductive
science. In an age when the scientific method was important, this change in the
discipline resulted in the establishment of anthropology in universities. Boas’s
Cultural Relativism | 335
students were among the first to establish some of the most important anthropol-
ogy programs on U.S. campuses.
Moreover, Boas attacked racism throughout his career; he summarized his
views on racism in The Mind of Primitive Man (1911). According to Boas, the
sweep of cultures, to be found in association with any subspecies, was so exten-
sive that there could be no relationship between race and culture.
Following Boas and his emphasis on studying as many societies as possible,
Alfred Kroeber, the best-known anthropologist of the period, produced a good
deal of ethnography. In his ‘‘Eighteen Professions’’ (1915), which is a credo,
Kroeber affirmed two of the basic tenets of cultural relativism: (1) all men are
completely civilized, and (2) there are no higher and lower cultures. Much later
in his career, Kroeber made three additional points in regard to cultural relativ-
ism: (1) that science should begin with questions and not with answers, (2) that
science is a dispassionate endeavor that should not accept any ideology, and (3)
that sweeping generalizations are not compatible with science. Another major
cultural relativist of the period was Robert Lowie, whose work is most signifi-
cant among his peers for its development of cultural relativism.
Lowie probably came closer to Boas’s views on the proper practice of anthro-
pology than any other anthropologist of his time. He was deeply rooted in the
philosophy of science and accepted cultural anthropology as a science. His views
and criticism of theoreticians such as Lewis Henry Morgan were based on this
scientific worldview. His critique of Morgan’s evolutionary theory was based on
epistemology, namely, that Morgan’s evolutionary scheme for the development
of kinship systems was speculative and had no proof. Furthermore, Morgan’s
data were often erroneous, according to Lowie.
Additional refinements of the concept of cultural relativism were suggested by
Ruth Benedict. For Benedict, cultural anthropology was the discipline that studied
the differences between cultures. This approach was fully Boasian in character. In
this approach, the ‘‘s’’ that was added to the word culture by Boas and others
became crucial. The interest had shifted from culture to cultures. In addition, when
the focus shifted to a particular culture, there was a concern with what happened to
the individual in that culture. A culture was integrated, and it was more than
the sum of its parts. Finally, every culture was different from every other culture.
Benedict took the Boasian program a step further through the concept of cultural
configurations or patterns that allowed her to engage in cross-cultural comparison.
Although her use of this approach was extremely reductionistic, it represented a
new direction in cultural relativism by transcending the data collection of historical
particularism and attempting to organize the data in an explanatory manner.
The attempt to understand cultures on their own terms and the attempt to pur-
sue objective ethnography are the major accomplishments of cultural relativism.
These accomplishments have sometimes led to a lack of theoretical depth and an
336 | Cultural Studies
References
Benedict, Ruth. 1934. Patterns of Culture. New York: Houghton Mifflin.
Boas, Franz. 1911. The Mind of Primitive Man. New York: Macmillan.
Boas, Franz. 1948. Race, Language and Culture. New York: Macmillan.
Garbarino, Merwin S. 1977. Sociocultural Theory in Anthropology. New York: Holt,
Rinehart, and Winston.
Goldschmidt, Walter. 1990. The Human Career. Cambridge: Basil Blackwell.
Harris, Marvin. 1968. The Rise of Anthropological Theory. New York: Thomas Y.
Crowell.
Kroeber, Alfred. 1915. The Eighteen Professions. American Anthropologist 17:
283 289.
Kroeber, Alfred. 1944. Configurations of Culture Growth. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Kroeber, Alfred. 1949. An Authoritarian Panacea. American Anthropologist 51:
318 320.
Lowie, Robert. 1936. Lewis H. Morgan in Historical Perspective. In Essays in
Anthropology Presented to A. L. Kroeber, ed. Robert Lowie. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Lowie, Robert. 1937. History of Ethnological Theory. New York: Farrar and Rinehart.
Lowie, Robert. 1944. Franz Boas. Journal of American Folklore 57: 288 296.
Cultural Studies
one hand, ‘‘understanding that folklore is already (in Derrida’s terms) a politics
of culture’’ and, on the other hand, understanding that the discipline of folkloris-
tics is, through its representational practices, also a politics of culture. In other
words, when folklorists address how folklore is shaped by and in turn shapes
sociocultural power relations, they participate in the cultural studies project.
Exploring the matrix of folk, vernacular, popular, and local performances as a
politics of culture, folklorists have begun to theorize cultural production from
both global and local positionings. Marxist folklorist Jack Zipes, for example, has
disclosed the workings of ideology in popularly reproduced fairy tales. John Dorst
has described the traditionalizing practices of an elite U.S. suburb that, in a post-
modern turn, inscribes and markets itself through ‘‘pamphlets, brochures, glossy
travel magazines, gallery displays, postcards, tourist snapshots, amateur art, styles
of interior decoration, and suburban architecture and landscaping.’’ And Susan
Davis has analyzed the way in which public parades, although frequently used to
assert the dominant culture’s ideological agendas, may also function for subordi-
nated groups ‘‘as vehicles for protest as well as for historical commemoration.’’
Jose Limon has historicized and localized the study of social contradictions of
race, class, and gender in Mexican American social poetry, and Barbara Babcock
has explored how Cochiti women ‘‘have contrived to tell stories’’ through their
pottery about men’s storytelling, thereby subverting ‘‘masculine discursive con-
trol’’ and disturbing ‘‘the distribution of [local] power profoundly.’’ Alesia Garcıa
has articulated the ways in which indigenous storytelling functions as a form of
cultural resistance and preservation. Deborah Kapchan has explored the emergent
politics of gendered performances in the Moroccan marketplace, and Arjun Appa-
durae and colleagues, focusing on South Asian expressive traditions, have brought
together a set of essays that cumulatively call for a ‘‘full and direct encounter
between the problematics of performance and textuality, on the one hand, and of
social and cultural history, on the other.’’ Situating their work in respect to a
movement ‘‘toward somewhat larger-scale ideas of context, in which broader ide-
ological frameworks, historical currents, and social formations are brought into
the conceptualization of’’ such key concepts among folklorists as ‘‘context,’’
Appadurae and colleagues foregrounded a process that is furthered in ‘‘Common
Ground: Keywords for the Study of Expressive Culture,’’ a 1996 special issue of
the Journal of American Folklore edited by Burt Feintuch that invoked Raymond
Williams’s seminal work.
Finally, disclosing folkloristics as a politics of culture, folklorists such as
Richard Bauman and John W. Roberts have addressed the ways in which the disci-
pline has been, from its early foundation in Romantic Nationalism, participatory in
the dominant culture’s appropriations of folk culture as a means of enhancing hege-
monic ideological agendas. Like their anthropological colleagues, folklorists have
begun to critique the scientific essentialism of folkloristic paradigms and methods,
Cultural Studies | 339
in particular, as Camilla Collins has argued, the fallacy of scientific objectivity and
the subject-object relations constructed with the discourse of older participant-
observation positionings. In short, the broad range of folkloristic representational
practices, as well as the ways in which those practices are enmeshed within the
socioeconomic politics of our supporting institutions, have been re-situated through
discursive practices that are increasingly self-conscious and politically aware.
Cathy Lynn Preston
See Also Cultural Property; Deconstruction; Feminist Perspectives on Folklore Scholar-
ship; Gender; Marxist Approach; Postmodernism.
References
Appadurai, Arjun, Frank J. Korom, and Margaret A. Mills. 1991. Gender, Genre,
and Power in South Asian Expressive Traditions. Philadelphia: University of Pennsyl-
vania Press.
Babcock, Barbara A. 1993. ‘‘At Home, No Women Are Storytellers’’: Potteries, Sto-
ries, and Politics in Cochiti Pueblo. In Feminist Messages: Coding in Women’s Folk
Culture, ed. Joan Newlon Radner. Chicago: University of Illinois Press.
Brantlinger, Patrick. 1990. Crusoe’s Footprints: Cultural Studies in Britain and
America. New York: Routledge.
Briggs, Charles, and Amy Shuman, eds. 1993. Theorizing Folklore: Toward New
Perspectives on the Politics of Culture. Western Folklore (Special Issue) 52: 2 4.
Collins, Camilla A., ed. 1990. Folklore Fieldwork: Sex, Sexuality, and Gender.
Southern Folklore (Special Issue) 47: 1.
Davis, Susan. 1986. Parades and Power: Street Theatre in Nineteenth-Century Phil-
adelphia. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Dorst, John D. 1989. The Written Suburb: An American Site, An Ethnographic Di-
lemma. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Feintuch, Burt. 1995. Common Ground: Keywords for the Study of Expressive Cul-
ture. Journal of American Folklore (Special Issue) 108: 430.
Grossberg, Lawrence, Cary Nelson, and Paula Treichler, eds. 1992. Cultural Studies.
New York: Routledge.
Hoggart, Richard. 1957. The Uses of Literacy. Fair Lawn, NJ: Essential Books.
Kapchan, Deborah A. 1996. Gender on Market. Philadelphia: University of Pennsyl-
vania Press.
Kirshenblatt-Gimblett, Barbara. 1988. Mistaken Dichotomies. Journal of American
Folklore 101: 140 155.
Limon, Jose. 1992. Mexican Ballads, Chicano Poems: History and Influence in Mex-
ican- American Social Poetry. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Mukerji, Chandra, and Michael Schudson, eds. 1991. Rethinking Popular Culture:
Contemporary Perspectives in Cultural Studies. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Preston, Cathy Lynn, ed. 1995. Folklore, Literature, and Cultural Theory: Collected
Essays. New York: Garland.
340 | Culture Hero
Thompson, Edward P. 1963. The Making of the English Working Class. New York:
Pantheon.
Williams, Raymond. 1958. Culture and Society, 1780 1950. New York: Columbia
University Press.
Williams, Raymond. 1961. The Long Revolution. New York: Columbia University
Press.
Williams, Raymond. 1976. Keywords: A Vocabulary of Culture and Society. London:
Fontana/Croom Helm.
Zipes, Jack. 1983. The Trials and Tribulations of Little Red Riding Hood: Versions
of the Tale in Sociocultural Context. South Hadley, MA: Bergin & Garvey.
Culture Hero
The central figure in a myth or myth cycle whose story tells that he lived at the be-
ginning of—or before—time, experienced extraordinary adventures and achieve-
ments, conquered or tamed environments for human use, gave life, provided the
things needed to exist, and was responsible for the life designs that exist in cul-
tures. Oedipus of Greece, Se’ehe of the Pima Native Americans, Cu Chulainn of
Ireland, Manixi of New Guinea Highlands, and I’itoi of the Papago, for example,
are culture heroes.
Most scholars who have analyzed culture heroes have attempted either to dis-
cover the formulaic structure of the myth cycles or to interpret them as meaning-
ful expressions of societal values, beliefs, and behaviors. In 1864, Johann Georg
von Hahn published the earliest documented analysis of the formulaic pattern of
culture hero myth cycles in the modern sense. Many mythologists since then—
including Alfred Nutt, Otto Rank, Vladimir Propp, Joseph Campbell, Jan de
Vries, and Clyde Kluckhohn—have applied the method to the study of culture
heroes. Most of these studies have agreed that folk culture heroes are a very com-
mon part of myth traditions of the world. They have also noted that there are dis-
tinct similarities in the biographies of heroes from many cultures and that there
are clearly detectable trends toward regularities in the narrative content and
structures of culture hero myths. This research has proved that duplication, tripli-
cation, and quadruplication of elements, reinterpretation of borrowed narratives
to fit preexisting cultural aesthetics, and endless variation upon central themes
are constant structural tendencies of hero tales.
Structural mythologists advanced many other theories and descriptions as a
result of their attempt to discover and explain the formulaic pattern of culture
hero myth cycles. Lord Raglan’s myth-ritual theory held that the worldwide
monomyth—the culture hero narrative structural pattern—reflected a birth, ini-
tiation, and death ritual for an individual, possibly a royal personage, who also
was considered the incarnation of a god. He also concluded that the similarities
Culture Hero | 341
of the cycles around the world proved culture heroes were not historical, that reli-
gious ritual was the source of all myths, and that, in turn, myths were the precur-
sors of all other folklore.
Following the division in approaches developed in linguistics, Claude Levi-
Strauss argued for a structuralist approach to myth that sought to reveal culture hero
stories’ ‘‘deep’’ structure rather than their surface structures. He analyzed many
myths from many cultures and found binary opposition underlying them all. He
used his analyses to develop his theory that myth and mythic thought proceeded
from an awareness of binary opposition toward their progressive mediation.
Joseph Campbell’s popular books and lectures presented a simple, three-part
summation of the pattern of culture hero myths: separation, initiation, and return.
Campbell’s pattern was a composite that drew single incidents from the lives of
many heroes from multitudinous cultures in order to create a hypothetical
monomyth.
Otto Rank applied the psychoanalytic approach to myth developed by Sigmund
Freud and adapted by Carl Jung to the analysis of culture hero stories as a guide
to understanding the unconscious mind. Clyde Kluckhohn supported psychoana-
lytical interpretations of culture hero stories that held that some themes and the
linking of certain features of them exemplify a large number of ego defense
mechanisms, and he provided supporting examples from his fieldwork with the
Navajo. These mythologists, with the exception of Kluckhohn, based their varied
theories upon library research rather than fieldwork and shared the methodology
of structural analysis of culture hero texts.
R. R. Marett issued the first call in the modern era for research interpreting cul-
ture heroes as meaningful expressions of societal values, beliefs, and behaviors.
In his 1914 presidential address to the Folk-Lore Society and in subsequent pre-
sentations, he argued that researchers had to understand and interpret oral folklore
as a meaningful expression of a culture. His call was very much in keeping with
the ideas and methods of the functional movement in anthropology. Two years
later, Franz Boas published his seminal work Tsimshian Mythology, in which he
emphasized the importance of fieldwork in order to understand folklore in general
and myth in particular. Boas, however, attempted to use myths primarily to recon-
struct the past of cultures rather than to understand how they function in the pres-
ent. The first forty years of the twentieth century were, in retrospect, a golden age
for the collection of culture hero stories and for attempts to interpret culture hero
stories in terms of their meaning to the people who were their customary audience
and performers. Many of Boas’s students collected culture hero tales in their natu-
ral contexts, and some—most notably Ruth Benedict—used their data for under-
standing how the stories functioned in cultures.
Functionalism gained even more support in the 1950s when William Bascom
presented his functional approach to folklore in his presidential address before
342 | Custom
the American Folklore Society. By the 1990s, it had become a truism that culture
hero stories function directly, indirectly, and inversely within cultures.
Many field research–oriented anthropologists and folklorists of the 1960s,
1970s, 1980s, and 1990s applied a functionalist approach to the study of culture
heroes. Brian M. Du Toit collected a cycle of stories about a culture hero of the
Gadsups of the New Guinea Highlands, recorded their performance and cultural
context, and interpreted the stories as meaningful expressions in the culture of
their audience and performers. Tomas o Cathasaigh analyzed the concept of the
hero in Irish myth and concluded that myths and their structures evince native
ideology and explore a culture’s concepts of the nature of men and the gods.
Many theories developed by the functionalist researchers who attempted to dis-
cover and understand the formulaic structure of culture hero myth cycles had few
adherents in cultural studies by the 1990s, but the general conclusions they reached
remained very important. Cultural studies of the 1990s, in general, accepted the
later functionalist field studies that interpreted culture hero myths as meaningful
expressions of societal values, beliefs, and behaviors. The most promising method-
ology for future folk culture hero research is a structural-functional approach unit-
ing the study of lore with the study of the folk and the study of the past with the
study of the present.
Keith Cunningham
See Also Hero/Heroine, Folk; Myth-Ritual Theory.
References
Campbell, Joseph. 1949. The Hero with a Thousand Faces. New York: Pantheon.
Du Toit. 1964. Gadsup Cultural Hero Tales. Journal of American Folklore 77:
315 330.
Kluckhohn, Clyde. 1959. Recurring Themes in Myths and Mythmaking. Deadulus:
Journal of the American Academy of Arts and Sciences 88: 268 279.
o Cathasaigh, Tomas. 1985. The Concept of the Hero in Irish Mythology. In The
Irish Mind, ed. Richard Kearney. Dublin: Wolfhound.
Ragland, Lord. 1934. The Hero of Tradition. Folklore 45: 212 231.
Rank, Otto. 1952. The Myth of the Birth of the Hero. New York: Robert Brunner.
Custom
The calendar offers various groups opportunities for practicing different cus-
toms. Ringing in the New Year may be replaced by shooting in the New Year
among German and Italian Americans. Recently arrived ethnic groups such as
the Vietnamese and Cambodians have introduced the celebration of Tet with its
accompanying customs into American culture. Many Catholics continue to have
their throats blessed on St. Blaise’s Day, February 3.
Regional customs often mark the changing seasons. Vermonters customarily
start their tomato and pepper plants indoors on or shortly after Town Meeting
Day, the first Tuesday of March. Many Vermonters who tap maple trees for their
sap customarily celebrate the beginning of a new sugaring season by using the
first maple syrup for sugar-on-snow, which is customarily accompanied by dill
pickles and plain doughnuts.
Some U.S. calendar customs, such as sending Father’s Day and Mother’s Day
cards or passing out sweets and flowers on St. Valentine’s Day, are supported
more by commercial interests than by folk tradition.
Rites of passage serve to mark major transitions in the lives of individuals, and
customs associated with them are important ways for folk groups to recognize the
changes. From conception to death, folk groups have produced an enormous num-
ber of customs that measure the growth and development of its members. Deciding
on the name of a child may be left up to the whim of parents, but in many cases,
family or ethnic custom dictates that the parents follow the custom of naming the
child after an ancestor or other relative. Customarily, the tooth fairy trades candy
or money for the child’s baby tooth when it falls out. Although this tradition may
have had ancient roots in superstition, the custom as now practiced in most of the
United States simply marks a stage in the physical transition into childhood, and it
also promotes a safe and easy way for parents to dispose of an unneeded tooth.
Peers may punch the arm of the birthday child, one punch for every year of age.
Customs associated with courtship and marriage persist in the United States. Among
some Mexican Americans, it is customary for a group of the young man’s friends to
visit the girl’s family to ask permission for the courtship to begin. Decorating cars
after a wedding and parading through the bride’s and groom’s neighborhoods while
honking the car horn remain part of community and ethnic traditions. In parts of the
southern and midwestern United States, the marriage celebration does not end until
after the newlyweds’ first night is disrupted with a surprise and customary shivaree.
The bride and groom are expected to invite the nighttime revelers into their home
and give them food and drink. Customs associated with dying and death are equally
widespread. Some families consider it customary to stop their clocks to mark the
time that someone in the house died. In parts of the South, pottery and medicine bot-
tles decorate graves. A widespread practice that is held after the graveside ceremony
is the meal to which the mourners are invited in order to celebrate life. In many pla-
ces, it is customary for the survivors to maintain their relative’s gravesite and to
Custom | 345
decorate it with flowers, candles, or other ornaments on the anniversary of the death
and on particular calendar celebrations.
Folk festivals provide the opportunity for a large degree of community
involvement. In the Scottish-American Highland games held annually in New
Hampshire, descendants of Scottish families can celebrate their heritage. The
women prepare the customary dishes of Scotland; the children, dressed in kilts,
perform the Highland dances, and the men compete in games that test their
strength. Folks in backwater communities of Louisiana celebrate Mardi Gras fol-
lowing old customs unlike those practiced in the massive, more commercialized
Mardi Gras celebration in New Orleans. Among many Italian Americans, De-
cember 26 is visiting day. They customarily leave their front doors open, set out
drinks on nearby tables, and arrange for viewing the gifts received on Christmas.
Then they visit their neighbors’ homes, calling on folks who themselves may be
out making other visits. The custom provides the opportunity to show generosity
to friends and to display signs of prosperity.
Festivals also provide a context in which to perform various customs. Native
Americans gather for national powwows, at which they share, invigorate, and
revitalize traditional, tribal, and newly created pan–Native American customs.
Most state and national folk festivals are hybrid products of surging popular in-
terest in folk traditions, especially folk music, storytelling, and crafts. Many of
346 | Custom
these would not exist on the scale they do without federal and state support and
without large, professionally oriented organizations behind them.
Certain customs are closely associated with folk belief, sometimes making it dif-
ficult—and perhaps unnecessary—to distinguish custom and ritual. But the custom
and ritual, at least in the abstract, are different. Ritual is usually performed in order
to affect the future. Custom, in the abstract, is practiced to influence the present.
To break custom can bring criticism or censure from members in the folk commu-
nity. The practice of dressing a male infant in blue and the female in pink, for
instance, partly derives from a primitive European belief that blue protects infants
from harm. Although the belief itself generally has died out in the United States,
many Americans follow the practice because ‘‘that’s the way things are done.’’
Similarly, if the gender of an expected child is not known, baby gifts are bought in
a neutral color—yellow or green. The origin of this custom is probably unknown
to most of those who follow it, but custom demands that the practice be followed.
To avoid bad luck, some people customarily throw salt over the left shoulder
after having accidentally knocked over a saltshaker. But when the original belief
associated with the custom disappears, customary actions often continue to be
practiced. These actions may be associated with new beliefs, or they may simply
be practiced by habit. Many Americans may still knock on wood even though
they do not know or believe in the Germanic belief behind the custom.
In the broadest sense, much of folklore is itself a part of custom because folk-
lore is appropriate and often expected behavior in certain contexts. An ill person
by custom seeks advice from the herb doctor; custom tells the Native American
storyteller to wait until winter to tell certain tales; the singer frames the perfor-
mance of a song with customary opening and closing formulas. Though rem-
edies, tales, and songs are not necessarily considered customs, the practice of
each may be decided by folk custom.
Material culture may also be directed by custom. Historically, custom dictated
whether a chimney was built inside or outside the house or where outbuildings
were located in relationship to the house. Custom may also limit the functional
design for the interior of a house. For many years in the East and Midwest, lilac
bushes were customarily planted in the front yards of country homes. Even the
most modern styles of housing may reflect customary expectations as folk tastes
adopt them to a certain way of life.
As folklorists look at folk traditions in the workplace, they discover a whole
range of customs. Richard Dorson’s research among lumberjacks in the Upper
Peninsula of Michigan discerned a code of behavior that prescribed a number of
customs. For example, the jack, after spending months in the woods, was by cus-
tom expected never to walk away from a fight, to be courteous toward women,
and to spend all of his wages on drinks for himself and his fellow lumberjacks.
Lumberjacks also hold their own carnivals at which they customarily compete in
Cyberculture | 347
various games that demonstrate their logging skills. In other occupations, custom
dictates a hierarchy—for example, new workers on an assembly line may be
expected to do the unpleasant tasks. The customary coffee break provides both
white- and blue-collar workers with a time for gossip, sharing stories, and play-
ing practical jokes. In this context, too, new workers learn more about the social
and work protocols expected of them.
Determining when a traditional craft should be undertaken also may be bound
with custom. In some regions of the United States, it is a custom for a young girl
to complete her first quilt—usually a doll-sized version—before reaching pu-
berty. The finished quilt is stored in her hope chest until she marries, and eventu-
ally, it is used to bundle her first child.
Families may have their own customs, such as parents sitting at the head of the
table or the youngest child opening the first gift on Christmas morning. Custom
may dictate that the main meal on Sunday will be eaten in the early afternoon,
although dinner meals throughout the rest of the week are eaten in the evening.
Richard Sweterlitsch
See Also Belief, Folk; Foodways; Holidays and Commemorations.
References
Brewster, Paul G., ed. 1952. Beliefs and Customs. The Frank C. Brown Collection of
North Carolina Folklore, Vol. 1, ed. Newman Ivey White. Durham, NC: Duke Univer-
sity Press.
Hand, Wayland. 1970. Anglo-American Folk Belief and Customs: The Old World’s
Legacy to the New. Journal of American Folklore 7: 136 155.
Newall, Venetia. 1971. An Egg at Easter: A Folklore Study. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Smith, Robert Jerome. 1972. Festivals and Celebrations. In Folklore and Folklife: An
Introduction, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Summer, William Graham. 1960. Folkways. New York: Mentor Books.
Cyberculture
Cyberculture studies focus on the cultural origins and evolving legacies of com-
puting technologies, and include the study of their related scientific, technologi-
cal, and philosophical contexts. Cyberculture encompasses early automata and
calculating machines, computing machines (those capable of manipulating data
according to instruction), robotics (the science of complex machines), cybernet-
ics (the science of complex systems), virtual environments (artificially generated,
nonmaterial environments), the Internet, artificial intelligence (AI), and, at its
broadest, the philosophical concept of ‘‘simulation.’’
348 | Cyberculture
As an expression of the basic human drives for building and for navigation,
cyberculture is closely tied to folklore, myth, and fiction. In The Cybercultures
Reader (2000), Timothy Leary uses the term cybernaut to describe all engineers,
architects, explorers, and cartographers in virtual and/or physical geographies,
comparing the voyages of Renaissance explorer Marco Polo and fictional hero of
Greek epic poetry Odysseus with the midnight activities of teenage hackers
engrossed in online gaming. Such terminology captures a primary conflict that
has characterized the development of cyberculture, one of particular importance
to the student of folklore—a violent striation between the concerns of authorita-
tive rule on the one hand and populist practice on the other. At the same time,
stereotypical and hierarchized categories of ‘‘male’’ and ‘‘female,’’ ‘‘controller’’
and ‘‘machine,’’ and ‘‘creator’’ and ‘‘created,’’ have tended to be reduplicated in
all areas to do with computing technologies, both in official discourse and in com-
puting subcultures.
Perhaps unsurprisingly, published histories of early computing have largely
championed the accomplishments of men. When female pioneers in the field are
included, gender stereotypes detract from public perception of their contribu-
tions. The portrayal of computing progenitors Charles Babbage and Lady Ada
(Byron) Lovelace speaks directly both to the perpetuation of gender stereotype in
established histories and to cyberculture’s competing claims of authority and
populism. Babbage’s Analytical Engine (1840) is widely cited as the first mod-
ern analog computer. Lady Lovelace constructed what has been described as the
first computer program, a set of instructions for the Analytical Engine intended
to be utilized in a manner similar to the cards of Jacquard’s loom. She also pub-
lished A Sketch of the Analytical Engine (1845), a treatise describing in prophetic
terms the potential use to which such a machine might be put. Officially, Bab-
bage envisioned the Analytical Engine performing sophisticated astronomical
calculations for the British Navy. However, Lady Lovelace envisioned the
machine generating musical combinations, pieces of text, and other representa-
tional output.
The more colorful biographies also record the pair’s fondness for horse racing
and speculate that the Analytical Engine’s calculating potential fuelled their
dream of a reliable, predictive system of betting based on mathematical probabil-
ities. Yet Lovelace’s significant contribution has been forgotten or seriously
downplayed. While Babbage has been presented by computing historians as the
authoritative inventor of the machine, the scientist interested in astronomy and
naval procedure, and a risk taker intent on cracking the mathematics of random
variables, Lovelace has been characterized as ‘‘Babbage’s muse,’’ as a ‘‘dreamer’’
predicting computer-driven art and music, and as an opium addict who lost a for-
tune ‘‘on the ponies.’’ Yet the Analytical Engine’s presumed transposition from
naval research to entertainment (art, music, and horse racing) did foreshadow the
Cyberculture | 349
butterflies. The association of femininity with friendship, love, and the private
sphere versus the warrior’s code of video gaming and the publicity of lone-male
hacking suggests just how stereotyped computing lore and practice remains.
Further, many commentators believe that the potential for virtual gender play
that feminist critics had envisioned so positively in the heady first days of Internet
expansion has been curtailed through both authoritative and populist mechanisms.
The economic realities of niche marketing, from video games to the online auction
mall eBay, have resulted in products and associated advertising that exaggerate
gender stereotypes. Unofficial online practice has also reinforced rigid gender
identity in many subcategories, from chat room humor that makes gender mas-
querade a staple comic subject to the use of e-mail and chat room space for por-
nography distribution. Certainly, cyberspace has offered women new access to
public expression, with many sites dedicated to the publication of women’s writing
about women’s concerns, along with online versions of feminist magazines like
Bitch, which have a wider virtual than print readership. However, cybercultures
have failed to bring gender-egalitarian principles to the mainstream, and have more
easily translated standard gender roles from the physical world to the digital.
Andrea Austin
See Also Folklife; Internet; Urban Folklore.
References
Bell, David, ed. 2001. An Introduction to Cybercultures. London: Routledge.
Bell, David, and Barbara Kennedy, eds. 2000. The Cybercultures Reader. London:
Routledge.
Blank, Trevor J. (Ed.). 2009. Folklore and the Internet: Vernacular Expression in a
Digital World. Logan, UT: Utah State University Press.
Graber, Christoph Beat, and Mira Burri-Nenova. 2008. Intellectual Property and
Traditional Cultural Expressions in a Digital Environment. Northampton, MA: Edward
Elgar.
Hanson, F. Allen. 2007. The Trouble with Culture: How Computers Are Calming the
Culture Wars. Albany: State University of New York Press.
Haraway, Donna. 1991. Simians, Cyborgs, and Women: The Reinvention of Nature.
New York: Routledge.
Haraway, Donna. 2000. A Manifesto for Cyborgs: Science, Technology, and Social-
ist Feminism in the 1980s. In The Gendered Cyborg: A Reader. New York: Routledge,
pp. 50 57.
Hayles, N. Katherine. 1999. How We Became Posthuman: Virtual Bodies in Cyber-
netics, Literature, and Informatics. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Kirkup, Gill, Linda Janes, Kath Woodward, and Giona Hovenden, eds. 2000. The
Gendered Cyborg: A Reader. New York: Routledge.
Leary, Timothy. 2000. The Cyberpunk: The Individual as Reality Pilot. In The Cyber-
cultures Reader, eds. David Bell and Barbara Kennedy. London: Routledge, pp. 529 539.
Cyberculture | 353
Lupton, Ellen. 1993. Mechanical Brides: Women and Machines from Home to
Office. New York: Princeton Architectural Press.
Palumbo, Maria Louisa. 2000. New Wombs: Electronic Bodies and Architectural
Disorders. Basel, Switzerland: Birkhauser.
Ross, Andrew. 2000. Hacking Away at the Counter-Culture. In The Cybercultures
Reader, eds. David Bell and Barbara Kennedy. London: Routledge, pp. 254 267.
Toole, Betty Alexandra. 1998. Ada, the Enchantress of Numbers: Prophet of the
Computer Age. Mill Valley, CA: Strawberry Press.
Wakeford, Nina. 1997. Networking Women and Grrrls with Information/Communi-
cation Technology: Surfing Tales of the World Wide Web. In Processed Lives: Gender
and Technology in Everyday Life, eds. J. Terry and M. Calvert. London: Routledge,
pp. 52 66.
D
Dance, Folk
355
356 | Dance, Folk
Through this contrastive use, folk dance developed even stronger associations
with the old as opposed to the modern, the peasantry as opposed to the urban
working class, the native as opposed to the foreign, and the national as opposed
to the international. As a result, an ideal model of the peasantry as the bearers of
a distinctive and homogenous national culture was firmly established, a model
that still is prominent in the field of folk dance today.
Before and immediately after World War II, folk dancing again became popu-
lar in western Europe and the United States, often as a means to promote regional
or national cultural identity but also as a symbol of peace and feelings of interna-
tional understanding. In San Francisco, New York, Amsterdam, Stockholm, and
many other cities, so-called international folk dance clubs were established,
where young urban people met to practice dances from different parts of the
world, especially the British Isles, the Balkans, the Nordic countries, and Israel.
Although some of the dances belonged to the traditional repertoire of these coun-
tries, others were new compositions in folk style, made specifically to meet the
demands of these new organizations.
After World War II, folk dancing became very popular in the new socialist
states in Eastern Europe. In Yugoslavia, a whole generation enrolled in amateur
organizations to learn the folk dances of their new confederates. This movement,
described as folkloromanija by the Serbian ethnochoreologist Olivera Mladenovic,
had its counterparts in all socialist countries and was enthusiastically supported by
the prevailing regimes as a means to instill new socialist national and cultural iden-
tity in the population. During this period, parts of the old romantic concept of folk
merged with the socialist notion of ‘‘the people’’ to form a rather unique Eastern
European definition of folk, which later came to influence the discourse about the
folk and folk dance in many Western countries, as well as in the Third World.
The postwar interest in folk dance brought about the development of a class of
highly stylized, typified, and formally representative national folk dances
intended for stage use, together with certain types of events (international folklore
festivals) at which such dances could be performed. To improve the standards of
folk dancing, professional state folk dance and folk music ensembles were set up
in all Eastern European socialist countries (e.g., the Kolo ensemble in Belgrade,
Yugoslavia, in 1948). These ensembles were modeled upon existing state ensem-
bles in the Soviet Union (especially the Pyatnitskij and Moisejev ensembles), and
sometimes they even were under the direct control of Soviet advisers. The crea-
tive mixing of old folk dance traditions with the organized forms of folk dance
cultivated in the amateur associations, modern dance theater, and ballet gave rise
to a new dance genre, which, under the name of folklore, was exported to Egypt,
Sudan, Iraq, Mongolia, and many other countries in the Third World. Paradoxi-
cally, this very national, even nationalistic, genre today has become one of the
most international dance genres in the world and probably the one that attracts the
Dance, Folk | 359
and cultural changes have called forth new fields and questions. For example,
small and cheap but technically advanced video cameras have made it possible
to document and analyze not only dances but also entire dance events, which has
led to a growing number of studies on improvisation, creation, and dancing as
process. Continuing massive urbanization and large-scale migration from the
poor regions of the world to the rich areas has led to a growing interest in the
meanings and functions of dance among migrants in urban and multicultural
societies. The creation and rapid, worldwide distribution of new forms and types
of dancing, as well as contexts and reasons for dancing, has led to an interest in
the roles of dance in transcultural processes and culture building at large.
Folk dance researchers today often call their subject ‘‘ethnochoreology,’’
‘‘dance ethnology,’’ or ‘‘dance anthropology’’ (‘‘anthropology of dance’’), depend-
ing on their education, professional affiliation, and fields of interest. Although
there are special national organizations for folk dance researchers in some coun-
tries (for example, in the Nordic countries), most ethnochoreologists and dance
anthropologists are members of national and international anthropological, ethno-
logical, and musicological scientific associations. This can be explained by close
theoretical and methodological connections and also by the continuing strong per-
sonal connections between researchers in these fields.
Two major trends in modern dance studies that may arise from this situation
can be identified. First, there is a strong tendency to give up the notion of ‘‘folk
dance’’ for ‘‘dance,’’ to pass on from ‘‘folk dance research’’ to ‘‘dance studies’’—
which gives room for studies of all kinds of dance, in all parts of the world. Sec-
ond, there is a tendency to extend the scope of interest from dance as an object to
dancing as a process. Taken together, these tendencies imply a broadening of
perspectives that may lead to a more general focus on dance as human expressive
behavior.
dance in Europe, especially Eastern Europe, there still are few from most other
parts of the world. Even in Europe, the results of the research are often fragmen-
tary, scattered, and difficult to compare and synthesize. Nevertheless, attempts at
developing an overview have been made, the most notable and initially promising
perhaps being Alan Lomax’s grand-scale choreometrics project. The results, how-
ever, raise as many questions as the study attempts to answer.
A limited overview of existing folk dances in Europe today, however, is possi-
ble. Historical studies of folk dance in Europe have revealed the existence of sev-
eral different layers of dance types and forms. The most ancient layer, surviving
mainly as parts of old rituals and ceremonies, consists mainly of dances with a
rather simple formal structure, which are performed collectively by large groups.
There are, in addition, some more complicated solo dances with turns, skips,
jumps, and movements imitating animals. The medieval layer consists mainly of
collectively performed round dances and chain dances, and the Renaissance layer
consists more of solo dances, dances performed with sticks and weapons. To the
baroque layer belong a rich variety of group dances in squares and lines (contre-
danse, country dances), and during the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, cou-
ple dances, such as the waltz, schottische, and polka, became popular in most
parts of Europe. The twentieth-century layer is primarily composed of a large
number of couple dances (e.g., foxtrot, one-step, tango, jive) and by a type that
could be termed ‘‘mass solo dances’’ (in many countries, these are called ‘‘disco
dances’’), a new phenomenon in the Western world.
The folk dances in Europe also could be surveyed from a geographical per-
spective. In southeastern Europe, there is a predominance of chain dances and
round dances (the Serbian kolo, Bulgarian horo, Greek choros, Rumanian hora),
often led by a specially gifted dancer. In central Europe, couple dances of differ-
ent kinds are predominant (csardas, polka, waltz); in northern and western
Europe, both couple dances (schottische, polka, polska, waltz, krakowjak) and
group dances of different kinds (chain dances, round dances, and ‘‘contra dan-
ces’’ in squares and lines) have been popular.
From a structural point of view, it may be noted that a very common pattern in
European dances can be schematically written A-B-B 1 (a step, followed by a differ-
ent step in the same direction, then the last step again but with reversed direction).
This simple formula is known all over Europe and the Near East—from the Turkish
hasap, the Romanian sirba, the branle simple of the medieval aristocracy, the danc-
ing to ballad singing in the Faroe Islands, and the foxtrot of today’s dance restau-
rants. A structural analysis of a number of dances from Bulgaria and the former
Yugoslavia demonstrates that many other and more complex dances, with longer
motives and more phrases, are built on the same structural pattern as well. A similar
structural analysis of Hungarian men’s dances, legenyes, by the Hungarian dance
researchers Gy€orgy Martin and Ern€o Pesovar, has revealed the existence of a kind
of dance vocabulary, consisting of a large number of short formulas that are repeated
and combined in different ways, according to certain structural rules. A subsequent
structural analysis of chain dances in Europe by the Danish ethnochoreologist Lisbet
Thorp has shown that most chain dances are constructed by combining a fairly small
number of formulaic motives in different ways, according to a kind of ‘‘grammar.’’
These and many other studies point to redundancy as a fundamental quality in
folk dancing. The redundancy leads to a well-known phenomenon in the field of
folk dance (as well as in other forms of folklore) that could be described by para-
phrasing the English historian Peter Burke: The same dance is different, and dif-
ferent dances are the same. A dance may be differently performed at different
occasions and by different dancers, yet it is considered as the same dance. Like-
wise, two dances can be made up almost entirely by the same set of motives or
phrases and still be considered different.
Owen Ronstr€ om
See Also Choreometrics.
References
Buckland, Teresa. 1983. Definitions of Folk Dance: Some Explorations. Journal of
the English Folk Dance Society 4: 315 332.
Dunin, Elsie, ed. 1989. Dance Research Published or Publicly Presented by Mem-
bers of the Study Group on Ethnochoreology. Los Angeles: International Council for
Traditional Music, Study Group on Ethnochoreology.
Deathlore | 363
Giurchescu, Anca. 1983. The Process of Improvisation in Folk Dance. Dance Studies
7: 21 56.
Hanna, Judith Lynne. 1979. To Dance Is Human: A Theory of Nonverbal Communi-
cation. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Kaeppler, Adrienne L. 1978. Dance in Anthropological Perspective. Annual Review
of Anthropology 7: 31 49.
Kurath, Gertrude P. 1960. Folk Dance of the USSR: Bibliography. Ethnomusicology 4:
142 150.
Martin, Gy€orgy. 1982. A Survey of the Hungarian Folk Dance Research. Dance
Studies 6: 9 45.
Martin, Gy€orgy, and Ern€o Pesovar. 1961. A Structural Analysis of the Hungarian
Folk Dance. Acta Ethnographica 10: 1 27.
Staro, Placida. 1985. Bibliografia sulla danza popolare italiana. Culture Musicali 4:
147 194.
Torp, Lisbet. 1990. Chain and Round Dance Patterns: A Method for Structural Analy-
sis and Its Application to European Material. Copenhagen: Museum Tusculanum Press.
Deathlore
Folklore relating to material objects, narratives, and beliefs about death. Death-
lore includes, but is not limited to, funeral customs, afterlife beliefs, tombstones,
angels, demons and gods relating to death, stories told about death, omens, and
the Day of the Dead. Beliefs about death may differ based on age, religion, or
ethnicity.
A few examples of material objects included in deathlore are: tombstones,
roadside memorials, coffins, and cemeteries. Such objects are commonly noticed
and universally related to death. These objects have changed throughout the
years as humankind’s beliefs and perceptions about death have altered. For
example, cemeteries have changed a great deal since the mid-nineteenth century.
Before this time, the word cemetery was not used and was instead replaced with
burying grounds or graveyard. Additionally, the actual tombstones have changed
with the transformation of beliefs. Tombstones began to focus more on hope and
less on death by having engravings of angels rather than skulls. The epitaphs on
the stone began to become more personal and conventional.
Narratives included in deathlore consist of songs, jokes, stories, and slang
related to the idea of death. One song related to death is called The Worms. This
ballad dates back to the nineteenth century and has hundreds of alternate versions
that have developed throughout the years. Stories about death have been told in
many different countries. These stories help the reader better understand a coun-
try’s beliefs towards death. These stories may be witty, gruesome, or teach the
reader a lesson. Slang related to death includes the phrase, ‘‘He is a goner.’’ The
364 | Deathlore
word goner is slang used to describe someone who has already died or a person
expected to die soon.
Beliefs related to death include ideas and customs from many different cul-
tures. For example, in Africa death is viewed as a journey and the funeral service
is absolutely necessary to continue this journey. The funeral service and burial is
so important that certain African cultures will even replace the body in order to
properly mourn someone whose body is no longer intact or whose body is miss-
ing. The Luo of Kenya have been known to replace a missing body with the yago
fruit found in their area. On the other hand, the oceanic cultures prefer to avoid
death and actually deny its existence. In Australian indigenous cultures, the body
is placed on a platform until the flesh decays. Then, the bones are collected and
rituals are performed. Gods, angels and demons related to death are also common
amongst many cultures.
Melissa Phillips
See Also Belief, Folk; Custom; Family Folklore.
References
Axelrod, Alan, and Harry Oster. 2000. The Penguin Dictionary of American Folk-
lore. New York: Penguin Group.
Deconstruction | 365
Jones, Lindsay, ed. 2005. Encyclopedia of Religion. 2nd ed., Vol. 1. Farmington
Hills, MI: Macmillan Reference.
The Mythology and Folklore of Death. http://www.alsirat.com/deathlore/index.html.
Deconstruction
The critical activity that attempts to subvert the idea that there can ever be clo-
sure in interpretation. This activity, whose formal origin is attributed to the
French philosopher and literary critic Jacques Derrida, defies classification as a
theoretical branch of poststructuralism due to its transitory and often playful ren-
dering of its own construction, which continually reinterprets and redefines the
function and form of the idea of deconstruction.
As an activity, deconstructionism subverts the meaning or the truth of an inter-
pretation by revealing that which an interpretation must necessarily repress—
conflicting and anomalous interpretations—in order to give the illusion of mean-
ingfulness. In doing so, the deconstructionist grants an audience to the multiple
meanings available for interpretation and thereby endlessly defers the anticipa-
tion of arriving at an ultimate conclusion. The deconstructionist, then, is gener-
ally skeptical of the traditional methods used in interpretation whereby closure is
achieved. This is not to suggest that the deconstructionist views interpretation as
meaningless; rather, the deconstructive activity presumes that interpretation is
capable of infinite meaningfulness.
One of Derrida’s most effective conceptual activities used in subverting the
idea of closure is the anomalously spelled diff erance. This term plays on the
French verbs for ‘‘to differ’’ and ‘‘to defer’’ by insinuating both of their meanings.
In doing so, the term confronts Ferdinand de Saussure’s notion that meaningful
language depends on the recognition of distinctive signs by proposing that mean-
ing must be infinitely deferred since the play of meaning goes on and on. In other
words, meaning cannot be passed between minds through words since additional
oppositional distinctions lie, for instance, on both sides of the original distinction
that informs the transmitted sign, and these oppositional distinctions extend out-
ward in a chain that lures the listener from the speaker’s intended meaning.
In deconstructionism’s desire to upset the traditional methods of interpretation,
deconstructionist texts often prove difficult to read. This difficulty is not due to
any inherent complexities of the activity, but it serves as another attack on the
certainty upon which interpreters and their audiences traditionally have relied.
Deconstructionism, continuing its attack on traditional interpretation, encourages
a suspicion of all research and scholarship that has laid claim to a stable interpre-
tive context for the research, for stability has little place in an activity that values
continual rereadings.
366 | Diachronic/Synchronic
Although there tend to be few folklorists who explicitly adopt the critical ac-
tivity of deconstructionism (i.e., the rigorous inversion of the binary and a teas-
ing out of the multiple meanings) in their scholarship and research, the idea that
meaningful closure is illusory is being reflected in much of the discipline’s cur-
rent work. This reluctance to adopt a deconstructive activity is shared with many
other academic disciplines as well, for the admission that terms such as meaning
and truth are relative at best and fictive at worst undermines the perceived role
of the educational institution and its efforts at interpretive analysis, critical inves-
tigations, transmission of knowledge, and, therefore, the institution’s mission.
Charlie T. McCormick
See Also Cultural Studies; Postmodernism.
References
Barnes, Julian. 1990. A History of the World in 101/2 Chapters. New York: Vintage
International.
Derrida, Jacques. 1977. Of Grammatology. Trans. Gayatri Chakravorty Spivak. Balti-
more, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Hutcheon, Linda. 1988. A Poetics of Postmodernism: History, Theory, Fiction. New
York: Routledge.
Norris, Christopher. 1982. Deconstruction: Theory and Practice. New York:
Methuen.
Warshaver, Gerald E. 1991. On Postmodern Folklore. Western Folklore 50: 219 229.
Diachronic/Synchronic
Distinctive approaches to the study of language that have been extended to folk-
lore studies. Ferdinand de Saussure sharply differentiated a diachronic (or histor-
ical) approach to the study of language, which views language as constantly
dynamic, from a synchronic (or nonhistorical) approach, which perceives lan-
guage in unchanging stasis at a particular point in its continual development. The
distinction has entered the discourse of folklore studies in two ways.
When Claude Levi-Strauss introduced his structural study of myth, he suggested
that two ways of reading myth corresponded to langue (Saussure’s synchronic
approach) and parole (the diachronic approach). Interpreting myth diachronically
resulted in a narration that presented the elements of myth in the non-revertible
sequence demanded by the story chronology. For Levi-Strauss, understanding
myth synchronically meant that one should focus on recurrent patterns that appear
at different points in the narration. Reading several instances of a recurrent pattern
in relation to occurrences of other patterns allowed an understanding of how the
myth reflected the tendency of the human mind to work toward mediated binary
Diachronic/Synchronic | 367
opposition. Some folklorists and other students of narrative have used the term
syntagmatic synonymously with diachronic and paradigmatic to equate with
synchronic.
The distinction between the terms diachronic and synchronic has had more sig-
nificant impact on folklore studies through their application to general methods of
research and analysis. Diachronic approaches to folklore involve looking at par-
ticular genres or specific text types in terms that remove them from their perfor-
mance context. These approaches (for example, the historic-geographic method)
work toward constructing genre and text-type histories, but they do so by conceiv-
ing folklore as an artifact that can be isolated from its immediate contexts. Syn-
chronic approaches, influenced by the ethnography of speaking introduced by
Dell Hymes and John J. Gumperz, view folklore as text and/or process within a
specific context that includes the immediate performance situation, the cultural
background in which that situation occurs, and the psychosocial influences that
have affected the participants (performers and audience) of the community.
Critics of diachronic approaches have argued that focusing on the historical or
cross-cultural dynamism of texts without contexts makes folklore a lifeless en-
tity, analogous to a collection of museum specimens. Critics of synchronic
approaches have suggested that they lose what is distinctive in the study of folk-
lore, substituting the methods and interpretive tools of ethnography and sociolin-
guistics for those that have developed within the history of folklore studies. The
study of folklore becomes an examination of behavior rather than of the products
of artistic creativity.
The gulf between diachronic and synchronic approaches to folklore study was
wide in the late 1960s and throughout the 1970s. Although the first generation of
academically trained folklorists in the United States had defined folklore study in
diachronic terms, many of their successors, whose manifesto was a special issue
of the Journal of American Folklore published in 1971, advocated synchronic
perspectives. That gulf persisted into the 1990s, but its significance for folklore
studies lessened as some folklorists found ways of bridging it and as new con-
cerns in folklore study emerged.
William M. Clements
See Also Paradigmatic/Syntagmatic.
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1993. After New Perspectives: Folklore Study in the Late
Twentieth Century. Western Folklore 52: 379 400.
de Saussure, Ferdinand. 1966. Course in General Linguistics. Trans. Wade Baskin.
New York: McGraw-Hill.
Georges, Robert A. 1980. Toward a Resolution of the Text/Context Controversy.
Western Folklore 39: 34 40.
368 | Dialogism
Dialogism
Sawin adds that many of Eldreth’s forms of self-expression (her ghost stories,
practical jokes, use of reported speech, and playful talking back to romantic
songs) appear to have been developed as means of dialogically ‘‘contesting the
specific forms of male dominance she experienced in a loveless marriage to a
shiftless man.’’ Sawin explores this theme by analyzing how Eldreth engages in
dialogic self-construction, creating an identity through communicative interac-
tion with others and with herself.
Danielle M. Roemer
See Also Carnival.
References
Bakhtin, M. M. 1981. The Dialogic Imagination. Four Essays. Ed. Michael Holquist,
trans. Caryl Emerson and Michael Holquist. Austin: University of Texas Press. Bakhtin,
M. M. 1984. Rabelais and His World. Trans. Helene Iswolsky. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Holoquist, Michael. 1990. Dialogism: Bakhtin and His World. New York: Routledge.
Sawin, Patricia. 2004. Listening for a Life: A Dialogic Ethnography of Bessie
Eldreth through Her Songs and Stories. Logan: Utah State University Press.
Diffusion
Their shared frontier afforded the point of interchange for the movement of folk-
lore from one to the other through the often-routine firsthand contact between
members of two neighboring societies. Indirect diffusion occurred through an inter-
mediary. A commercial traveler might hear folktales, for example, as he did busi-
ness with members of a group of people. He could retell those folktales to another
group who were not necessarily neighbors of the source of the stories. The power
of the mass media, though, has probably made most, if not all, diffusion direct. Tel-
evision programs, video and audio recordings, and the Internet have effectively
made everyone neighbors—at least as far as communication is concerned. An
urban legend originating in Mexico may now make its way directly through e-mail,
chat rooms, and Web sites to people in Spain or the Philippines.
Diffusion, direct or indirect, has provided for folklorists one answer to the problem
of multiple occurrence: Why is it, folklorists and their predecessors in philology and
mythography have asked, that the same or similar folklore appears cross-culturally?
Specific folklore items such as ‘‘Cinderella’’ (AT 510A) or general formulas such as
the hero pattern have been recorded in a diversity of cultures, some of which have no
obvious historical connections. Diffusionists have suggested that those historical con-
nections do indeed exist and particularly that specific folklore items and sometimes
even general formulas originated at one place at one point in time and spread else-
where at frontiers (direct diffusion) or along trade and other travel routes (indirect
diffusion). Extremists have argued that cultural similarities always result from diffu-
sion and that, in fact, similar folklore proves that societies have had historical contact.
Franz Boas endorsed this argument for the Native groups of the Pacific Coast of
North America, for example. Some students of dialect vocabulary usages and of ma-
terial culture forms have advocated similar ideas for other parts of the world.
Some diffusionists have identified certain times and places as particular fonts of
certain folklore traditions. For example, during the nineteenth century, Theodor
Benfey—influenced by the valuation placed on Sanskrit as the forerunner of many
Indo-European (or Aryan) languages—proposed that India was the source of much
European folklore, particularly narratives. Other diffusionists, not so monolithic in
their views, focus on particular genres or particular stories and songs. The historic-
geographic method of the Finnish school—so called because it was developed by
the pioneer Finnish folklorist Kaarle Krohn—has attempted to trace the routes of
diffusion, especially of folktales. The goals of the method have been to locate a pre-
cise time and place of origin of a story such as the ‘‘Kind and Unkind Girls’’ (AT
480), define geographically and historically the directions in which it spread, and
place and date localized forms of the folktale (oikotypes). Some historic-geographic
studies of particular folktales have tended to stress a superorganic view—that is,
they imply that a folktale spreads on its own in a way that metaphorically resembles
the rings that spread out from a stone dropped into a pool of water. The Swedish
372 | Diffusion
folklorist C. W. von Sydow, though, forcefully pointed out that the dissemination of
folklore depends on individuals—particularly persons who can effectively sing
songs and tell stories. These active bearers of tradition (traditors) were necessary if
a folktale or any other kind of folklore were to spread by means of diffusion. That
process might move along much more irregularly than the rings-of-water metaphor
suggested. Another critique of the Finnish school’s methodology pointed out that
the presence of written and especially printed versions of folklore materials tended
to skew their findings. This caveat inspired the American folklorist Stith Thompson
to undertake a historic-geographic study under ‘‘laboratory’’ conditions. ‘‘The Star
Husband Tale,’’ known by many Native North Americans, had spread entirely by
word of mouth until folklorists, linguists, and anthropologists began to record and
publish versions of it in the late nineteenth and early twentieth centuries.
Perhaps the most important product of the historic-geographic method of folk-
tale study was the publication of The Types of the Folktale by Finnish folklorist
Antti Aarne in 1910 (revised by Stith Thompson in 1928 and again in 1964, and
by Hans-J€org Uther in 2004). An assumption underlying this index is that all
folktale texts that can be subsumed under the same type number—for example,
every story that follows the plotline familiar to many in Western audiences as
‘‘Rumplestilzchen’’ (AT 500)—stem from the same source and are interrelated
by the process of diffusion.
For proponents of the historic-geographic method, identifying the particulars of
the diffusion of a specific tale type was often an end in itself. Though folklorists
still study the process of diffusion, they are now more interested in what that pro-
cess reveals about the creative contributions of each traditor in the chain of trans-
mission. Since purely oral transmission prevents a text from being ‘‘frozen’’ in a
particular form, every performer—storyteller, singer, riddler, quilt maker—trans-
forms what he or she has heard or seen. Such transformations result not only in
deletions from what the performer encounters (despite the implications of the ‘‘de-
volutionary premise’’ in folklore studies) but in additions and substitutions as well.
Performers may inadvertently make changes when they mishear or misunderstand
what they have heard, or they may consciously alter the received material to suit
the needs of localization and rationalization. They may bowdlerize material they
deem inappropriate for performance, and they may attach explicit morals to ensure
that their audience understands the ethical implications they mean to convey.
The American ballad scholar Phillips Barry suggested that the process of bal-
lad composition might be termed ‘‘communal recreation’’—each singer in each
performance of a narrative folksong reconfiguring the song to reflect the exigen-
cies of the specific performance situation and the general cultural and psycholog-
ical contexts. For Barry—and for most folklorists today—diffusion is a creative
process, as each performer reshapes what he or she has heard (and perhaps per-
formed previously) to fit specific performance situations.
Diffusion | 373
Though the distinction between direct and indirect diffusion has lost much of
its value in the face of globalization, some subtypes of diffusion remain valuable
constructs. Anthropologists have identified, for instance, a process called ‘‘stimu-
lus diffusion.’’ This occurs when a society encounters something in another
group’s culture that stimulates the creation of a similar cultural development in
their own. The classic example is the invention of the Cherokee syllabary by
Sequoyah (George Guess), stimulated apparently by his observation of the use of
the English alphabet as a way of more or less permanently recording words and
ideas. Another specific form of diffusion is acculturation, usually referring to dif-
fusion that occurs between societies that are unequal economically, politically,
and/or militarily. Acculturation occurs when cultural forms pass from a dominant
society to a subordinate society. In this sense, the adoption of Hindi words like
pajamas and bungalow into English represents diffusion, while the use of Eng-
lish by Hindi speakers exemplifies acculturation.
Though diffusion has been occurring between societies throughout human his-
tory, it has rarely if ever been a smooth process in which new ideas from outside
find automatic acceptance. Particularly in situations of acculturation, diffusion
may result in defensive responses. Such processes include every aspect of culture
in every society—including the most past-oriented folklore—reflecting the
results of cultural merging generated by diffusion.
William M. Clements
See Also Folktale; Historic-Geographic Method; Oikotype/Oicotype; Performance;
Worldview.
374 | Dilemma Tales
References
Barry, Phillips. 1961. The Part of the Folk Singer in the Making of Folk Balladry. In
The Critics and the Ballad, eds. MacEdward Leach and Tristram P. Coffin. Carbondale:
Southern Illinois University Press, pp. 59 76.
Benfey, Theodor. 1859. Pantschatantra: F€ unf B€ucher indischer Fabeln, M€ archen
und Erz€
ahlungen. Leipzig: F. A. Brockhaus.
Boas, Franz. 1891. Dissemination of Tales among the Natives of North America.
Journal of American Folklore 4: 13 20.
Krohn, Kaarle. 1971. Folklore Methodology. Trans. Roger Welsch. Austin: Univer-
sity of Texas Press.
Roberts, Warren. 1958. The Tale of the Kind and Unkind Girls. Berlin: Walter de
Gruyter.
Thompson, Stith. 1953. The Star Husband Tale. Studia Septentrionalia 4: 93 163.
von Sydow, C. W. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and
Bagger.
Dilemma Tales
A narrative verbal puzzle (Motifs H620, ‘‘The unsolved problem: enigmatic end-
ing of tale,’’ and Z16, ‘‘Tales ending with a question’’). Presenting a dilemma tale
to an audience constitutes a synthesis between riddling and narrating activities.
These two broad attributes of the genre may be clarified further. With reference
to riddling, the dilemma tale belongs to the category of the ‘‘puzzle’’ in which em-
phasis in solving the problem is placed on the riddlee’s own abilities (such as in-
tellectual or motor skills); in this respect, a puzzle differs from a ‘‘true riddle,’’ in
which emphasis is on the riddle’s structure and contents that contain clues to the
camouflaged answer. As for the narrative component, the dilemma tale is typi-
cally a traditional ‘‘fantasy’’ prose narrative, told with the intent of entertaining or
instructing and training; although some dilemma tales may contain a historical or
belief component, they seem not to be narrated as legends or belief narratives.
A dilemma tale differs from similar non-dilemma tales that incorporate true rid-
dles or puzzles as part of the plot; in this category, the tale’s characters (dramatis
personae) may debate among themselves and offer answers, but members of the
audience are not required to participate, and they remain spectators (e.g., AT 851,
‘‘The Princess Who Cannot Solve the Riddle’’; AT 875A, ‘‘Girl’s Riddling Answer
Betrays a Theft’’; and AT 1579, ‘‘Carrying Wolf, Goat, and Cabbage across
Stream’’). By contrast, in the dilemma tale situation, the audience is required to
take part by offering answers to the problem the tale poses. The various and often
conflicting solutions offered by members of the audience (each acting in dual roles
as listener to the tale and as riddlee) reflect the personal viewpoints of the members
proposing them; also, the answers would be based on the cultural norms (mores,
Discourse Analysis | 375
References
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1964. The Types of the Folktale: A Classification
and Bibliography. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Bascom, William. 1975. African Dilemma Tales. The Hague: Mouton.
El-Shamy, Hasan. 1980. Folktales of Egypt: Collected, Translated and Annotated
with Middle Eastern and African Parallels. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1958. Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. 6 vols. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Discourse Analysis
References
Butler, Gary. 1991. ‘‘Saying Isn’t Believing’’: Conversation, Narrative and the Dis-
course of Tradition in a French Newfoundland Community. St. John’s, Newfoundland:
Institute of Social and Economic Research.
Ensink, T., A. van Essen, and T. van der Geest, eds. 1986. Discourse Analysis and
Public Life: Papers of the Groningen Conference on Medical and Political Discourse.
Dordrecht, Netherlands: Foris Publications.
Kaivola-Bregenhj, Annikki. 1989. Factors Influencing the Formulation of Narration.
Studia Fennica 33: 73 89.
Philips, Susan Urmston. 1983. The Invisible Culture: Communication in Classroom
and Community on the Warm Springs Indian Reservation. New York: Longman.
Tannen, Deborah. 1984. Conversational Style: Analyzing Talk among Friends. Nor-
wood, NJ: Ablex.
Dite | 377
Dite
A statement that implies but does not recount a narrative. C. W. von Sydow
coined the term dite in 1937 to help classify a broad body of materials grouped as
Sagn (a concept comprising both narrative and non-narrative statements of folk
belief). He defined it as ‘‘what people have to say about one thing or another with-
out characterizing that which is said as true or false, believed in or fictitious.’’
He divided this concept into two subcategories: (1) the affirmate, a statement
that points out a generalized fact (‘‘In that place, a light has been seen’’), and (2)
the consiliate, a precept that asserts what should or should not be done in a given
case (‘‘One should spit three times when a cat runs across the road’’). Sydow also
characterized whimsical or fanciful dites as ficts, expressions that have no basis
in truth (such as ‘‘that stone will spin round whenever it catches the smell of
newly baked bread’’).
In Anglo-American taxonomies, many of Sydow’s dites would be termed
proverbs or superstitions. But Sydow intended the term dites to contrast with
memorates and fabulates, these being fully developed narratives that tell
exactly what happened in a given instance. The dite may be a summary of a
given narrative, he noted, or a dite may inspire an informant to expand it into a
narrative.
For this reason, many scholars have seen such brief texts as types of legend.
Susan Kalcik, for instance, found ‘‘kernel narratives’’ told in conversational con-
texts in which those present were familiar with the full story. Such ‘‘metonyms’’
(as condensed, allusive narratives also are called) still function as complete, fin-
ished performances in context. Linda Degh argued that ‘‘the legend text’’ itself
consists of all elements, fully narrated or not, as long as they form part of a con-
tentious conversational dynamic.
But some dites express beliefs that are never narrated. Sylvia Grider described
the common claim that Halloween sadists put razor blades in trick-or-treat
goodies as a ‘‘legend’’ but never found it related in the form of a story. Similarly,
John Widdowson studied verbal threats that control children’s behavior by
invoking evil (often supernatural) entities as completed linguistic performances,
not summary narratives. In such cases, the term dite may be appropriate and use-
ful. Likewise, the term fict accurately characterizes the widespread whimsical
378 | Divination
References
Ellis, Bill. 1989. When Is a Legend? In The Questing Beast, eds. Gillian Bennett and
Paul Smith. Sheffield, England: Sheffield Academic Press.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1971. American Folk Legend: A Symposium. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
von Sydow, Carl Wilhelm. 1978. Selected Papers on Folklore. Copenhagen:
Rosenkilde and Bagger and New York: Arno.
Widdowson, John. 1977. If You Don’t Be Good: Verbal Social Control in Newfound-
land. St. John’s, Newfoundland: Memorial University of Newfoundland.
Divination
Intuitive, revealed, and inspired knowledge obtained through the use of diverse
methods, techniques, tools, and devices, eliciting the nature of time and events,
the path of human life and destiny, and the unfolding of a meaningful cosmos. A
general term, divination (from the Latin divinus, meaning ‘‘one inspired by the
gods’’ or ‘‘soothsayer’’) refers to the culturally encoded processes of extraordinary
human insight arising spontaneously from intuition and reflection or through the
extra-human agency of inspiration and prophecy by indwelling spirits and the
direction of deities. Divination entails perspectives on time and space spanning
regression into the past and foreknowledge of the future. Another related term,
the mantic arts (from the Greek mantis, meaning ‘‘prophet’’) is often used to refer
to the range of techniques and methods that form systems of divination, from the
systematic interpretation of the personal and idiosyncratic to the perception of
meaningful patterns in the natural world and the cosmos. Many types of divina-
tion have been named by the suffix mancy, (e.g., oneiromancy, hydromancy, and
geomancy), identifying their status as disciplines that engender inspired and pro-
phetic activity. Divination is a subject of interest within the study of folklore and
folklife because it is a realm of human experience that is virtually always initially
Divination | 379
expressed and practiced orally, even though it is often later recorded in writing, in
art and architecture, and in the material culture of domestic space. Divination is
also equally folkloristic in that it is universally a folk practice, embraced by the
common people and expressing their concerns, as well as an elite, empowered,
hierarchically privileged practice of rulers, aristocracies, and professional adepts.
Since its historical range is enormous, its cultural and linguistic expression
complex, and its range of tools and techniques bewilderingly diverse, divination
may be best categorized along phenomenological lines. Such an approach facili-
tates cross-cultural and diachronic comparison and analysis. The following phe-
nomenological categories, therefore, are offered as a comprehensive listing not
of particular manifestations of divination but of types of divinatory experience.
Personal visionary and auditory experiences form a wide range of divinatory
media, particularly dreams (or oneiromancy) and conscious presentiments, such
as second sight, visions, soothsaying, psychic awareness, and extrasensory per-
ception (or ESP). The mediation of knowledge communicated by the world of
spirits is another important arena of divination, especially when communicated
by the spirits of the dead as in necromancy, shamanism, seance, and channeling.
These inspired communications can be transmitted in various ways: by indwell-
ing spirits, gods, and the powers of nature both during and after possession and
mediumship, as in speaking in tongues (or glossolalia); by prophecy via direct
divine inspiration as found within Judeo-Christian-Islamic scriptures, the Zoroas-
trian Avesta, the Hindu Vedas and Upanishads, and so forth; by the wisdom liter-
ature embodied in the Greek and Chaldean theurgic oracles; and by other
mythopoeic oracles such as archives of interpretive verses in West African and
Afro-Caribbean Ifa divination.
The principle of meaningful chance and the importance of randomization are
central to many divining systems. Thus, the perception and interpretation of signs
or omens of luck, fate, or meaningful chance are represented in divination by lots
(or sortilege, also called cleromancy); divination by the flight of arrows or the
casting of arrowheads; divination by the use of mirrors; or divination by games of
chance such as dice (or lithomancy). The meaningful randomization of numeric
and symbolic forms together is central to several interrelated families of divining
systems, including alphabetic and numeric correspondence and the creative and
cosmogonic power of numbers known as numerology, as in the medieval systems
that continue into modernity of Jewish gematriya and Islamic jafr, inspired by the
Pythagorean and neoPythagorean numerology of late antiquity. Related is the
practice of name reading (or onomancy) and various types of name magic that
calculate the numerical values of the letters in names and interpret their effect
(for good or ill) on the life path or destiny of the individual so named. Other sys-
tems based upon meaningful chance (or randomization) of numbers and pictorial
symbols usually combine with narrative or poetic traditions of interpretation.
380 | Divination
Stone reading, allied with the magical and medical use of crystals, gemstones,
and minerals in Greco-Roman antiquity, became widespread in the late medieval
and Renaissance West and continues in modern times. Crystal gazing usually
involves use of clear and translucent colored quartzes; diamonds and other trans-
lucent gemstones (such as emerald, beryl, ruby, sapphire, and topaz); opaque and
mirrorlike stones and gems (such as polished hematite, black obsidian, jet, and
black onyx); or opalescent and reflective stones, frequently in spherical or semi-
spherical shapes or cut as cabochon jewelry (such as varieties of agates, moon-
stone, rainbow and golden obsidian, tiger’s eye and cat’s eye, and opals). The
interior reflection and mirrorlike intensity of stone reading and crystal gazing are
direct parallels to the guided searching of mirrored surfaces of water described
earlier. Related to this type of earth divination is the reading of meaningful pat-
terns in natural materials such as tea leaves or coffee grounds, which are believed
by tea- and coffee-drinking cultures worldwide to bear the print of life left by the
one who held the cup and drank the brew.
Finally, patterns of meaning within the bodies and movements of animate
creatures are divined as animal signs and omens. Within the cultures of Mediter-
ranean antiquity and pre- and early Christian Europe, as well as diverse tribal
cultures worldwide, these patterns of meaning have been established and com-
municated through augury and auspices, as in interpreting the passage and flight
of birds and their cries (or ornithomancy), as well as interpreting the behavior
and movements of herd animals such as the horse and the behavior and move-
ments of fish, insects, or reptiles. Through the perception and interpretation of
animal portents and prodigies, the diviner alerts the community to the often ma-
lign significance of spontaneous appearances of extraordinary, anomalous, or
unnatural animal forms. The divining of portents focuses individual and commu-
nal awareness on the advent of unavoidable hazards, whether stemming from the
gods or from the forces of nature or human society. The reader of portents
advises how to minimize and contain their danger by propitiating the forces that
sent them with rituals of purification and sacrifice. Portents also can function as
signs foretelling and confirming a path of extraordinary destiny communicated
to an individual or community by the gods and personifications of fate.
As a subset of divining the body, there are divining systems, elements of which
can be found virtually worldwide, that concentrate on the observation and analysis
of the meaningful characteristics of the human body alone, believing it to be a mi-
crocosm of the meaningful universe. The divination of meaningful patterns in the
human microcosm is generally identified as physiognomy, or anthroposcopy. The
divination of the bodily and facial features can be broken down into several sub-
systems, among which are phrenology, or reading the character and mental
capacity from the conformation of the skull, and metoposcopy, interpreting the
lines that appear in the soles of the feet and the palms of the hands, the latter being
Divination | 383
underlie and motivate recourse to divination. The sacrificial, ritual, verbal, and
material prescriptions that often append the act of divination encompass a range
of healing processes, techniques, substances, and interactions. This dual preventa-
tive and curative function encompasses roles that modern society has separated
and secularized. In the Western context, for example, these functions include,
among others, psychological therapy, spiritual ministry, physical medicine, family
counseling, communal arbitration, government liaison, international negotiation,
environmental lobby, and science and technology advising.
The history of the scholarly literature on the subject of divination and the
mantic arts is extremely diverse, with the greatest emphasis on historical and liter-
ary systems. Theoretical discussions and analytical categorizations of divination
have been offered by the history of religions approach to this material, such as the
useful summary by Evan M. Zeusse in the Encyclopedia of Religion (1987),
which emphasizes the types of religious experience and categories of perception
that are the dominant features of particular divinatory systems even though they
may be (and usually are) found in combination. Zeusse’s typology of divination
offers three main rubrics of experience and perception within which to understand
divination: intuitive divination through dreams and visionary experience; posses-
sion divination by spirits and deities of nonhuman agents and of human agents;
and lastly, wisdom divination, or systems of knowledge and techniques of inter-
pretation based on numeric, geologic, and bodily patterns. Zeusse also distin-
guishes the ecstatic (intuitive and possession divination) from the nonecstatic
(wisdom divination), based upon Plato’s criteria of categorization (Phaedrus 244
and Timaeus 72) and the criteria of many later thinkers. He correctly emphasizes
the importance of concepts and practices of sacrifice in relation to all divining
systems since all divining is seen as a gift of wisdom and healing that requires a
propitiating response on the part of the diviner and/or the client to the gods, ances-
tors, spirits of nature, powers and directions, or the cosmos as a whole.
The divination systems of the ancient and late antique world based in the cul-
tures of the Middle East and the Mediterranean (Babylonian-Mesopotamian,
Canaanite-ancient Israelite, Egyptian, Greco-Roman), which left partial to exten-
sive textual and archaeological records, have perhaps received the greatest share
of academic attention from scholars of ancient Near Eastern languages, histori-
ans, and classicists, second only to the study of Indian and Chinese divination by
south and east Asian specialists. Attention has been focused on the place of divi-
nation primarily as religious and philosophical institutions of the aristocracy and
ruling body, administered through a priestly class or technical college or guild of
practitioners. Systems of divination that flourished during the medieval period in
the West, whether Islamic, Jewish, or Christian in orientation—astrology, numer-
ology, cards, geomancy, necromancy, hydromancy, pyromancy, dreams and sec-
ond sight, physiognomy, foreknowledge and insight through the holiness of
Divination | 385
with its attendant faculty of empathy or sensing the emotions of persons, places,
and objects, can involve direct physical contact (laying on of hands, placing an
object on the face or body) or nonphysical apprehension (which can include visual
or auditory experience) or emotional sensation alone. The generic label psychic
reader includes several interrelated faculties and types of divinatory prediction
that operate independent from divining tools such as psychometry, seance with
the dead, discovering past lives, and others. A specific application of the empathic
talent as part of the psychic reading is the practice of psychometry, or the em-
pathic reading of objects brought by the client (photographs, jewelry, or small me-
mentos of family, loved ones, children, close friends, or suspected enemies). The
perspective that objects bear a unique and personal emotional ‘‘signature’’ that
can be read by the psychic encompasses two interrelated beliefs: (1) the reader’s
innate ability to perceive empathically, whether in physical contact or not, and (2)
the principle of contagious magic—that objects are believed to absorb the emo-
tional and spiritual energies and intentions of persons and events by direct physi-
cal contact or propinquity. In the modern Western context, with its prevailing
rationalism and empiricism, the intuitive, empathic, and precognitive faculties
assigned to the psychic are often considered to be extraordinary and the result of a
unique and personal gift, innate to the individual. This gift cannot be taught or
otherwise transmitted, although there is a strong folk belief, which survives in this
popular context, that these faculties are inheritable (similar to folk beliefs that the
seventh son or daughter has second sight or that second sight runs in families) and
arise spontaneously. It is perhaps an irony that the diverse rituals and techniques
of divination that continue in living folk and popular practice around the world
are all that remain and survive intact of many of the great religious and philosoph-
ical traditions of the ancient and medieval worlds. The relegation of divination as
a folk practice to the fringes of religious attention and historical and contemporary
inquiry is, from this perspective, all the more questionable.
The cultural range of the treatments of divination as a living practice within
folklore scholarship and treatments of folk systems outside of folklore as a whole
has been amazingly narrow. Such treatments are limited, for the most part, to indi-
vidual examples within tribal and simple societies or rural communities within
complex societies that have strong oral traditional elements and folk art forms. If
the subject of divination and its theoretical exploration within folklore and folklife
is restricted to early definitions of the ‘‘little’’ community, if religious belief and
practice are limited to oral and traditionally received forms, and if religious mate-
rial culture is confined to a narrow characterization of folk art, then the range of
contemporary belief, practice, artifact, environment, and lifeways that relate to
divining worldwide is not being addressed. A vast range of contemporary systems
of divination, communicated by various forms of print and electronic media (as
well as oral traditional received forms), are yet to be found by folklorists—systems
390 | Divination
that exist within and outside living world religious systems, in rural and urban
communities within complex societies, and in simple agrarian and nomadic
communities.
Kathleen Malone O’Connor
See Also Belief, Folk; Magic; Myth; Religion, Folk.
References
Abimbola, Wande. 1976. Ifa: An Exposition of Ifa Literary Corpus. Ibadan, Nigeria:
Oxford University Press.
Bascom, William. 1969. Ifa Divination: Communication between Gods and Men in
West Africa. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Bascom, William. [1980] 1983. Sixteen Cowries: Yoruba Divination from Africa to
the New World. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Campbell, Joseph, and Richard Roberts. 1987. Tarot Revelations, 3rd ed. San
Anselmo, CA: Vernal Equinox Press.
Caquot, Andre, and Marcel Leibovici, eds. 1968. La Divination: Etudes recueillies. 2
vols. Paris: Presses Universitaires de France.
Cumont, Franz. 1960. Astrology and Religion among the Greeks and Romans. New
York: Dover.
Evans-Pritchard, Edward E. 1937. Witchcraft, Magic, and Oracles among the
Azande. Oxford: Clarendon.
Fahd, Toufic. 1966. La Divination arabe: Etudes religieuses, sociologiques et folk-
loriques sur le milieu natif de l’Islam. Leiden, Netherlands: E. J. Brill.
Feuchtwang, Stephan. 1974. An Anthropological Analysis of Chinese Geomancy.
Vientiane, Laos: Vithagna.
Fontenrose, Joseph. 1978. The Delphic Oracle: Its Responses and Operations. Berke-
ley: University of California Press.
Jaulin, Robert. 1966. La G
eomancie: Analyse formelle. Paris: Mouton.
Lessa, William A. 1968. Chinese Body Divination: Its Forms, Affinities and Func-
tions. Los Angeles: United World.
Lewis, I. M. 1989. Ecstatic Religion: A Study of Shamanism and Spirit Possession.
London: Routledge.
Lewy, Hans. 1978. Chaldaean Oracles and Theurgy: Mysticism, Magic and Platon-
ism in the Later Roman Empire. Paris: Etudes Augustiniennes.
Loewe, Michael, and Carmen Blacker, eds. 1981. Oracles and Divination. Boulder,
CO: Shambhala.
€
Roeder, Guenther. 1960. Kulte, Orakel und Naturverehrung im alten Agypten.
Zurich: Artemis Verlag.
Trachtenberg, Joshua. 1984. Jewish Magic and Superstition: A Study in Folk Reli-
gion. New York: Atheneum.
Turner, Victor. 1975. Revelation and Divination in Ndembu Ritual. Ithaca, NY: Cor-
nell University Press.
Drama, Folk | 391
Virtanen, Leea. [1977] 1990. That Must Have Been ESP! An Examination of Psychic
Experience. Trans. John Atkinson and Thomas DuBois. Bloomington: Indiana Univer-
sity Press.
Vogt, Evon Z., and Ray Hyman. 1979. 2nd ed. Water Witching U.S.A. Chicago: Uni-
versity of Chicago Press.
Wilhelm, Hellmut. 1977. Heaven, Earth and Man in the Book of Changes: Seven
Eranos Lectures. Seattle: University of Washington Press.
Drama, Folk
qualify as traditional if its auspices are specifically theatrical, that is, if the social
activity concerned (going to the theater, sitting on the beach in front of the
Punch-and-Judy stall) is for the sake of the dramatic performance itself. Tradi-
tional drama is always part of something else that would live (if less vitally)
without it. Much medieval drama and Renaissance pageantry are delicately
poised on this functional axis: Were performances of the medieval mystery
cycles, which qualify as traditional drama under most other headings, theatrical
occasions accompanied by some pious festivity, or were they piously festive
occasions accompanied by some drama (which only in the latter case qualifies as
traditional)? Did Renaissance monarchs go to their banqueting houses to see
masques (which would make these theatrical occasions) or were masques put on
to provide diversion at royal banquets (which would qualify them as traditional)?
It is this contextual factor that militates against traditional drama being too
dramatic (in terms of mimesis) or too theatrical (in terms of the distinction
between performers and audience). The purpose of the performance, ultimately,
is less, more, or other than an entertainment achieving absolute mimesis; other
factors are operative and even dominant. And unlike the other features that
define traditional drama, subservience to context is the one criterion of which
there can be too little but not too much.
Traditional drama was one of the terms suggested in the 1970s and 1980s in
the pursuit of an acceptable alternative to the term folk drama, whose connota-
tions were considered no longer accurate or appropriate and which had become
associated with a research approach that had gone out of fashion. Indigenous the-
ater also was mooted, but vernacular drama may be a better alternative. Origi-
nally referring to homebred as opposed to imported slaves in the Roman Empire
and later applied to language, handwriting, and architecture, vernacular has
appropriate connotations of the local and the useful—not to mention the under-
privileged—for those who see traditional drama as essentially different from and
opposed to the theatrical traditions of the social and cultural elite. The important
segment of traditional drama forming part of seasonal or occasional customs
might then usefully be distinguished within the overall field as customary drama.
From its inception in the mid-nineteenth century and until fairly recently,
research on traditional drama was almost exclusively approached from a surviv-
alist perspective, focusing on ultimate origins, which were believed to be the fer-
tility rituals of savage communities. Folk drama, largely in the form of the
English mummers’ plays and analogous European forms, was therefore seen as a
direct survival of the fertility-inducing ritual (involving the death and rebirth of a
king, scapegoat, god, or the fertility principle itself) posited by anthropologists
of the evolutionary school, such as Wilhelm Mannhardt and James G. Frazer.
The connection was manifest in the seasonal incidence (typically, the dead of
winter when fertility needed invigorating), the animal or vegetal costumes, the
394 | Drama, Folk
exclusively male performers, the ambient scatology, and appropriate action such
as death and revival or wooing and mating.
This approach had both positive and negative consequences for the study of the tra-
ditions concerned. On the positive side, the ancient pedigree accorded the otherwise
humble and obscure customs of modern villages considerable significance for the
study of primitive religion and mentality and hence for the later cultural traditions
believed to spring from them. In consequence, folk drama was appealed to in ‘‘myth
and ritual’’ approaches to ancient Greek drama, medieval theater, and the Elizabethan
stage, to medieval literature as diverse as the Elder Edda and the grail romances, and
to witchcraft, as providing evidence of the prehistoric ritual for which prehistoric evi-
dence was inevitably scarce. This celebrity came at the price, however, of neglect
and distortion in other ways. Only those forms of folk drama with credibly ritual fea-
tures were accorded attention, to the neglect of those not so endowed, and the focus
of study was these supposedly ritual features rather than others that might, from per-
spectives other than ultimate origins, be interesting or significant. Given that the pe-
riod concerned is as recent as about 1850–1950, we are surprisingly ill informed
about aspects of the performance itself (such as the text or the comic figures and epi-
sodes) and, above all, about aspects of the context (such as who performed the plays,
for whom, why, and on which subjects). Indeed, the major legacy of the ritual origins
theory, whatever its merits, is the neglect of the living traditions of folk drama that
might have been observed in hundreds of villages in the period concerned in England;
the picture is similar—and for similar reasons—in much of Europe.
The general shift of folkloristics in the 1970s to a more social orientation mani-
fested itself in this field in the widening of focus to encompass other dramatic tradi-
tions, together with an increasing awareness of material outside the European sphere,
and, above all, in the emphasis accorded to the recording and analysis of recent tradi-
tions and their contexts; this was accomplished by direct observation where possible,
by interviewing those with memories (as performers or spectators) of now defunct
local traditions, and by searching in local documentary (typically journalistic) sour-
ces. This approach, too, has its drawbacks, particularly the reluctance to contemplate
historical dimensions and the consequent lack of work on the undoubted significance
of traditional drama within late medieval and early modern cultural history—for
example, as an influence on (as opposed to the origin of) the early theater.
Distinctions within the field of traditional drama can be made according to a
number of criteria, which include (not surprisingly, given their significance in its
definition) the auspices of performance, that is, the recurrent social activity of
which the performance is a part.
Of such auspices, the most significant, certainly in scholarship and probably
also in tradition itself, are the customary auspices, and of these, the seasonal cus-
toms are the most familiar. In most parts of the world, the passing year is marked
by the recurrence of regular calendrical festivals. Their precise incidence depends
Drama, Folk | 395
on cultural factors such as religion and agricultural practices, but there is a distinct
tendency to reflect the near universal rhythms of light and darkness, warmth and
cold, rain and drought. Many such observances involve spectacular displays, often
with quasi-religious status, and many such spectacles (or parts of them) evince
distinctly dramatic features. Their incidence can be strictly calendrical, on the
same date each year (in relation to the locally relevant calendar), or merely sea-
sonal (for example, concurrent with the onset or completion of agricultural tasks,
which vary slightly from year to year). Other customs providing the milieu for
dramatic performances have a biographical rhythm, marking important phases or
transitions in the human life cycle (birth, maturity, couple formation, death), as,
for example, the wake-games of Ireland. A third, smaller cluster of customs is
purely sporadic, prompted by events (political, social, domestic) unrelated to any
other rhythm; most familiar is the demonstrative parade (charivari) provoked by
domestic behavior found unacceptable by the community.
Traditional dramatic performances also can occur under purely recreational aus-
pices, that is, when a group of people gather under circumstances and in a mood con-
ducive to entertainment, some of which can have mimetic characteristics. Some of
these occasions are afforded by seasonal festivals, but the dramatic performances are
less organically embedded in the occasion and can feasibly occur under other aus-
pices. Many of the semi-dramatic dance games more recently associated with chil-
dren previously were dramatic entertainments at convivial gatherings of adults or
adolescents. Dramatic skits of various kinds likewise figure among gatherings of
pupils and students of North American educational institutions.
Some performances, finally, are effectively utilitarian, in that they are a means
to a quite practical end, such as selling goods or services. Advertising cures for
sale has been accompanied by entertainment of a distinctly dramatic character,
from the medieval charlatan to the Wild West medicine show. And the spiel of
other vendors, in street markets, for example, also can acquire dramatic elements.
An alternative system of typology can be applied on the basis of the immediate
context of performance, particularly in terms of the processes by which perform-
ers and audience are brought together. Amidst much variation, there are basically
two such alternative systems.
When performers and spectators already are gathered at the venue, the context is
an assembly, be it in an enclosed indoor space or an outdoor one defined by some
focal point or perimeter. There will be considerable variation in the degree to
which an area is physically adjusted for the performance. The more this is the case
(for example, with a substantial raised stage and/or seating arrangements for spec-
tators) and the more this is done in advance, the closer the performance is to the
theatrical and the less traditional its contextual status becomes. Most performances
qualifying as purely recreational under the preceding heading tend to belong, con-
textually, to the assembly.
396 | Drama, Folk
revival’’ theme common to many traditions, of which much was made by scholars
employing a ritualist approach, may owe its ubiquity, if not its origins, to a simple
dramaturgical circumstance: A figure falling down and getting up is the most
striking visual effect that can be achieved in traditions whose theatrical resources
are largely confined to the bodies of the performers and what is done with them.
Whatever the specific matters and forms involved, the dominance of context
over mimesis gives traditional drama a characteristically presentational, rather
than fully representational, dramaturgy. While consciously representing some-
thing other than themselves and the time and place of performance, performers
remain conscious of themselves as presenting a show to an audience in a given
time and place. Dramatic illusion, though aimed for or gestured at to one degree
or another, is therefore breached consistently by awareness of context and rela-
tionship to the audience: in prologues and epilogues that refer to the occasion
(for example, the season or the venue and purpose of the show) and facilitate the
transition between the real and dramatic worlds; by the elaborate introduction of
new figures; by direct address from within the fiction of the play world to the au-
dience or even interaction (verbal and/or physical) with spectators.
Thomas Pettit
See Also Charivari/Shivaree; Custom; Evolutionary Theory; Festival; Fool; Mask; Mumming;
Myth-Ritual Theory.
References
Bergeron, David M. 1971. English Civic Pageantry 1558 1642. London: Arnold.
Billington, Sandra. 1984. A Social History of the Fool. Brighton, England: Harvester.
Brody, Alan. 1969. The English Mummers and Their Plays. London: Routledge &
Kegan Paul.
Chambers, E. K. 1969. The English Folk-Play. Oxford: Clarendon.
Glassie, Henry. 1975. All Silver and No Brass: An Irish Christmas Mumming. Bloo-
mington: Indiana University Press.
Green, Thomas A., ed. 1981. Folk Drama Issue. Journal of American Folklore 94(4).
Washington, DC: American Folklore Society.
Helm, Alex. 1981. The English Mummers’ Play. Woodbridge, England: Brewer.
Kirby, Michael, ed. 1974. Indigenous Theatre Issue. The Drama Review 18(4). New
York: School of the Arts, New York University.
O’Suilleabhain, Sean. 1967. Irish Wake Amusements. Cork, Ireland: Mercier.
Schmidt, Leopold, ed. 1965. Le Th
eatre populaire europ
een. Paris: Maisonneuve
et Larose.
Weimann, Robert. 1978. Shakespeare and the Popular Tradition in the Theater.
Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
E
Emic/Etic
399
400 | Emic/Etic
References
Dundes, Alan. 1962. From Etic to Emic in the Structural Study of Folktales. Journal
of American Folklore 75: 95 105.
Harris, Marvin. 1964. The Nature of Cultural Things. New York: Random House.
Harris, Marvin. 1976. History and Significance of the Emic/Etic Distinction. Annual
Review of Anthropology 5: 329 350.
Harris, Marvin. 1979. Cultural Materialism: The Struggle for a Science of Culture.
New York: Random House.
Headland, Thomas N., Kenneth L. Pike, and Marvin Harris. 1990. Emics and Etics:
The Insider/Outsider Debate. Vol. 7 of the Frontiers of Anthropology series. Newbury
Park, CA: Sage Publications.
Enigma, Folk | 401
Pelto, Pertti, and Gretel Pelto. 1978. Anthropological Research: The Structure of In-
quiry. New York: Harper and Row.
Pike, Kenneth L. 1971. Language in Relation to a Unified Theory of the Structure of
Human Behavior. Paris: Mouton.
Enigma, Folk
A cluster of genres that share a structure of puzzle and solution and a norm of
dialogic performance. The riddle and such related forms as the clever question,
catch question, riddle joke, and neck riddle generally take an overtly interroga-
tive form. The poser asks a puzzling question, and the respondent attempts to
guess the answer; the proffered solution is then accepted, rejected, or, if the re-
spondent could give no answer, provided by the poser.
Enigmas are not ordinary questions; the poser does not want the information
contained in the answer. They also are not rhetorical questions, in which the an-
swer is assumed beforehand or contained in the question. They are true questions
in that they demand an answer. But the answer, like the question, is conventional,
and the enigma is constituted of both elements together.
Traditional enigmas are one of the most widespread and earliest documented
forms of verbal art, found in Sanskrit hymns, the Bible, and Greek tragedy (as in
the famous riddle of the Sphinx from Oedipus Rex). There appears, however, to
be a correlation between the prevalence of riddling in a society and the presence
of oral interrogation as a means of carrying on such business as the education of
children and the exercise of justice. Where questioning is important in the work
of a culture, it is important in play as well.
Cross-culturally, enigmas are most important among children, although they
are never limited to them entirely. Many scholars have observed the ways in
which riddling functions to socialize and enculturate children. In African cultures
in which skills in argumentation are vital to adult prestige and power, children
engage in vigorous debate over the acceptability of riddle solutions. In European
peasant cultures, riddles seem to be less flexible and serve principally to teach
cultural rules and categories. In Madagascar, Lee Haring argues, the importance
of the enigma lies primarily in its question-and-answer form, which becomes the
paradigm for more complex dialogic interactions in adult speech genres.
Although children generally perpetuate riddling traditions on their own, with-
out encouragement from adults, adults also appropriate the enigma as a technique
of formal pedagogy. The Socratic method and the Christian catechism, not to
mention school entrance examinations, are part of a worldwide use of enigmas in
initiation ceremony, as the means of access to a restricted code and entry into a
restricted group. Deliberate obscurity and special or archaic language often
enhance the exclusionary power of the enigma. An outsider who successfully
402 | Enigma, Folk
penetrates this obscurity displays intelligence and resource and thus worthiness
to be accepted into the group.
Enigmas construct a hierarchical relationship between poser and respondent.
The questioner has authority over the questioned and may refuse a solution. Cer-
tainly, a refusal may be disputed by the larger group or undercut by the ques-
tioner’s failure to provide the acceptable alternative solution, and a group may set
limits to the questioner’s control of the floor in a riddling session. However, as a
rule, the riddler retains authority as long as he or she shows competence in the
role. Good riddlers often take advantage of their skill to humble rivals in other
domains, and riddling sessions easily become contests for prestige and power.
Young children seem to understand riddling as a model of parental authority.
Their first riddles are simply questions with arbitrary answers, as arbitrary as
adult instructions and reasonings often appear to be. To be the riddler is to have
a parallel authority within the riddling frame: A solution is right ‘‘because I say
so.’’ Moreover, play with enigmas prepares participants for other hierarchies of
knowledge. Not everyone in a society has the right to ask questions or to acquire
privileged information; low position generally means low access. However, play-
ing at riddles also teaches a helpful lesson in coping—someone in a low position
can rise in or overturn the hierarchy by virtue of cleverness. In narratives incor-
porating neck riddles, the protagonist triumphs by posing or guessing an appa-
rently insoluble riddle. In the same way in life, younger children can gain
prestige among their elders by skillful riddling performance, old women rich in
traditional knowledge can disconcert their university-educated grandchildren by
posing questions they cannot answer, or a presuming folklorist from outside the
community may be put in his or her place with an embarrassing catch.
The power relationships negotiated in the riddling process often are reflected
in the content of enigmas. West Indian riddles often present the object described
as the property of the father, the chief authority figure (‘‘My father have a cock
and every time it crow, it crow fire—A gun’’). In Malagasy riddles, paradoxes
based on size allude to inversions of power relations (‘‘When the little one
comes, the great one takes off his hat—The great water pot’’).
Riddling sessions form part of various larger events and forms of sociability.
A riddling session may open an evening of singing and storytelling in European
peasant cultures or come in the middle of an event to revitalize interaction after a
long series of monologic performances. Often, the riddling brings children and
outsiders into active participation, not only out of a desire to test and initiate
newcomers but also for a quite practical reason: A community’s stock of riddles
is generally limited, and it is not easy to find a native adult who has not heard
them all before. In Scotland in the 1960s, Kenneth S. Goldstein found that the
only adults to riddle were the ‘‘travelers’’ or ‘‘tinkers,’’ a subculture of peddlers,
who, because of their itinerant lifestyle, had constant access to new enigmas.
Enigma, Folk | 403
The rebus is a kind of enigma that exploits ambiguities in the literate code as
the true riddle exploits ambiguities in the oral one. The familiar contemporary
forms of the rebus play on the multiple readings of letters, numerals, and punctu-
ation marks:
r/e/a/d/i/n/g
(Reading between the lines)
YYUR YYUB ICUR YY4 me
(Too wise you are; too wise you be; I see you are too wise for me)
I have to paid
because
work I am
(I have to overwork because I am underpaid)
A riddle about reading, the rebus entertains children struggling to master the
conventions of written language; it enables them to distinguish ‘‘text’’—a linear
sequence of conventional signs—from ‘‘picture,’’ a spatial arrangement of iconic
signs.
Older forms of the rebus (Latin for ‘‘by things,’’ that is, a representation using
things instead of words) exploit iconic signs instead of the alphabet. In this way,
they may convey a message that is understandable but less compromising than
an explicit verbal representation. When the young Julius Caesar was administra-
tor of the Roman mint, he put the picture of an elephant on the coinage. Since he
was a private citizen at that time, he could not use his own portrait, but the word
for elephant in Oscan dialect sounded like ‘‘Caesar.’’ We also may think of the
early Christian use of a fish symbol to mark secret meeting places: The Greek
word ichthys could be read as an acrostic for ‘‘Jesus Christ Son of God Savior.’’
Rebuses are also found in heraldic emblems, playing with the folk etymologies
of proper names. Thus, the city of Solsona in Catalonia has a blazing sun on its
arms, a reference to the Latin word sol. And the abbot of Ramsey in thirteenth-
century England made his arms legible even to the illiterate with a drawing of a
ram in the sea.
The pictorial rebus leads us to such contemporary amusements as the droodle,
a visual form of the riddle joke. The droodle is a simple, apparently abstract
drawing, revealed by the poser to stand for some absurdly complex phenomenon.
Thus, the narrator of Antoine de Ste.-Exupery’s The Little Prince draws what
looks to his parents like the outline of a man’s hat: he tells them it is really a boa
constrictor that has swallowed an elephant. Other droodles rely on an unfamiliar
Print shows a letter in the form of a rebus portraying Britannia as a mother urging her
daughter America to jilt the Frenchman she is planning to marry and stop rebelling. This
political satire was published in May 1778. (Library of Congress)
406 | Enigma, Folk
References
Abrahams, Roger D., and Alan Dundes. 1972. Riddles. In Folklore and Folklife, ed.
Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Augarde, Tony. 1984. The Oxford Guide to Word Games. Oxford: Oxford University
Press.
Fernandez, James. 1986. Edification by Puzzlement. In Persuasions and Performances,
ed. James Fernandez. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Environmentalism | 407
Environmentalism
the beginning of the twentieth century. Many scholars started to examine folk nar-
rative in particular as a way for people to negotiate the relationship between the
natural, the cultural, and the supernatural worlds. Joseph Campbell, in his influen-
tial (if outdated) book The Hero with a Thousand Faces, discusses the folkloric
monster as something that crosses the normal boundaries between these catego-
ries: ‘‘By a monster I mean some horrendous presence or apparition that explodes
all of your standards for harmony, order, and ethical conduct’’ (222). The reason
the monster existed in folklore was to come to terms with apparent violations in
commonly understood norms in the environment. Others have looked at folkloric
symbols and found harmony, not conflict, between the realms of nature and cul-
ture: ‘‘The Green Man, as a composite of leaves and a man’s head, symbolizes the
union of humanity and the vegetable world. He knows and utters the secret laws
of Nature’’ (Anderson 1990, 14). Etiologies, or stories explaining the origins, of
places, names, and traditional activities relating to the environment have been col-
lected across the globe. Folklorists have paid attention to the relationship between
human and environment in other realms of folklore beyond just narrative. The
study of material culture especially has looked at human manipulation of the envi-
ronment by examining how people use wood, bone, stone, vegetation, and more
to make everything from musical instruments and tools to clothing and dwellings.
More recently, from the later twentieth century to today, folklore has found new
relevance as people’s attitudes toward the natural environment have shifted. The
rise of environmentalism as a social movement has caused many people to ques-
tion the ways humans have interacted with the environment, especially since the
advent of industrialization and globalization. The environmental movement of the
1970s and 1980s largely assumed a complete division between the natural envi-
ronment and human action. People were a destructive force, and environmental-
ism’s cause was to stop the destruction of the natural world by removing or
preventing human activity. As the environmental movement matured, however,
the rhetoric moved from preservation to conservation. The natural world was not a
bubble into which people were an intrusion. Rather, humans were a part of the nat-
ural world, and the long-standing relationships of people and the environment
started to be acknowledged as useful. Mary Hufford is perhaps the most prominent
folklorist studying these relationships. She describes folklore’s ability to focus ‘‘on
what we might call the vernacular management and interpretation of resources—
cultural as well as natural. What are all the possible relationships between people
and natural resources? How are these relationships formalized? How do ‘guardians
of the landscape’ name, classify, and transform the land and its resources?’’ (1988,
227) Folklorists, trained in collecting and interpreting folk or vernacular knowl-
edge, are able to contribute to current conversations about how to protect the liv-
ing environment. The authority given by an academic discipline allows folk
knowledge to have a place at the table that it previously did not have: ‘‘When
Ephemera | 409
biologists use only Latin names or official English names for flora and fauna
[. . .], they cancel out the hard-won authority of local people over their environ-
ments’’ (Hufford 1988, 222). By recognizing the hard-won authority that comes
with intimate experience, folklorists are able to put vernacular knowledge on a
closer footing to knowledge from biology and other hard sciences.
The idea of folk knowledge being useful to environmental questions has moved
beyond just the discipline of folklore in the twenty-first century. Biologists and
anthropologists have begun to explore, individually and together, the relationship
of humans and the natural world, creating new categories of study called variously
folk biology, ethnobiology, or ethnoecology. These new areas of study recognize
that ‘‘much of human history has been spent (and is being spent) in intimate con-
tact with plants and animals, and it is difficult to imagine that human cognition
would not be molded by that fact. [. . .] People’s actions on the natural world are
surely conditioned in part by their ways of knowing and modeling it’’ (Medin and
Atran 1999, 1). As discussions around the environment become more complex,
different disciplines with different points of view are coming together. Various
groups are recognizing that they each have pieces of the puzzle, and that sharing
those pieces with one another provides a clearer and fuller picture. The current dis-
course almost removes the divide between nature and human altogether, stating
more simply that ‘‘natural habitats are also folklife habitats’’ (Hufford 1988, 225).
Michael Lange
See Also Celtic Folklore and Mythology; Material Culture; Myth; Romantic Nationalism.
References
Anderson, William. 1990. Green Man. London: Harper Collins.
Campbell, Joseph. 1968 [1948]. The Hero with a Thousand Faces, 2nd ed. Princeton,
NJ: Princeton University Press.
Hay, Peter. 2002. Main Currents in Western Environmental Thought. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Hufford, Mary. 1988. The Protection of Folklife. In The Conservation of Culture, ed.
Burt Feintuch. Lexington, KY: University Press of Kentucky, 1988.
Hufford, Mary, ed. 1994. Conserving Culture: A New Discourse on Heritage.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Medin, Douglas, and Scott Atran. 1999. Folkbiology. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press,
1999.
Ephemera
Wide range of minor, everyday documents usually intended for onetime or short-
term use. Examples of ephemera include postcards, broadsides and posters, base-
ball cards, tickets, bookmarks, and photographs. The amount of use of ephemeral
410 | Ephemera
objects is based on the quality of the object, meaning the material does not last
forever, or the use is for a particular event.
The first account of the making of ephemera occurred in the 1720s in Great
Britain and its colonies. The wooden printing press was the main way to print
ephemera during this time. In order to make ephemeral objects, two people were
required to operate the press. One person transferred the image onto a sheet of
paper by putting the image in relief, which means the image is at a higher point
than the background, and the image comes into contact with the paper through
an inking process. The other person makes the paper into sheets with a pressure
plate normally 12 inches x 18 inches. The wooden press would remain in use for
almost one hundred years, until the creation of the iron press.
The iron press substituted the need for more manpower with advanced technol-
ogy. The sheet that was printed was placed on a parchment covered tympan. The
tympan was supported by steel points and a paper covered frisket, which was cut
so it did not cover portions of the sheet to be printed. During printing, the type
form was inked and the carriage was brought under the pressure plate. The pres-
sure plate was lowered from a combination of levers and a beam, which produced
the image on the paper. In addition to the iron press, the concept of lithography
and steam power also affected the printing of ephemera.
Lithography represented the continuing evolution of printing ephemera from wood
to metal. Lithography was developed by Jacob Perkins, a native of Philadelphia who
used steel to print ephemera rather than wood. The lithographic handpress made
ephemera when the stone was damped and inked. The paper was then laid on the
Ephemera | 411
tympan and lowered, and this was then pushed beneath the part of the machine known
as the scraper. Next, the bed was lifted, which brought the tympan into contact with
the scraper, and then the stone was cranked through the press. Because lithography
used steel for the plate, this type of printing was also known as siderography.
The introduction of steam power to the printing of ephemera replaced the need
for manual labor with a basic knowledge on how to work machinery. The main
machine used to print ephemera driven by steam was the stop-cylinder machine.
The paper ready for printing was first stacked on the feed board. The form of the
type was then pressed between inking rollers and the impression cylinder, which
rotated counterclockwise. After a brief halt, the paper would go into cylinder grip-
pers. When the motion resumed, the paper came into contact with the type and
was transferred onto and over the take-off cylinder. The final process of the print-
ing involved the sheet of paper transferred onto the flyers and delivery board.
During the twentieth century, the scarcity of paper resulted in the decline of
paper ephemera and the rise of revolutionary types that defied tradition. During
the 1930s, photography increasingly replaced paper ephemera. In addition, the
invention of the computer in the 1970s allowed ephemera to become digitized.
The production of ephemeral objects on the computer not only reduced the need
for paper, but also broadened the horizons in which ephemera could be created.
Ephemeral objects have been used in a variety of ways throughout the history of
the United States, which include rewards of merit in the educational system and as
broadsides, particularly in the Pennsylvania Dutch culture. Rewards of merit signi-
fied the progress of pupil and the esteem of their teacher for hard work and dedica-
tion to school. The tradition of giving educational rewards has been a part of the
American educational system for nearly three hundred years. Most merit rewards
were pieces of paper, either printed or handwritten, and conveyed a potent message
of the relation between the student and teacher. The student went to school, per-
formed exceptionally, and received praises by the teacher for the hard work.
Giving rewards to students in the American educational system was not an
original concept. The giving of prizes or rewards is as old as history. The first
known school rewards imitated the giving of rewards from kings to loyal aristo-
crats or athletes at competitions. The first rewards of merit to survive in the
United States convey the religious views of the time period. Many people in the
United States were Puritans, who believed that lives were short and bleak. They
also displayed an unsentimental view of childhood. The rewards of merit were
also used to create a hierarchical order between student and teacher. The clear
boss was the teacher, whom the children obeyed in order to receive rewards.
The result of the strict discipline of students was the creation of distinct groups.
The students who received numerous rewards became known as the exceptional
ones. Joseph Lancaster wished to address the needs of the unprivileged majority
by creating monitorial schools because only the minority was taught basic skills
412 | Ephemera
such as reading and writing. The result of the creation of monitorial schools was
the debate in the philosophy of the rewards of merit, whether they should be used
as emulation for honoring special students or encouragement for all students to
strive for achievement.
The term broadside refers to a piece of paper with print on one side distributed to
interested clients. The Pennsylvania Dutch used broadsides for cultural, religious,
and political purposes. When Pennsylvania Dutch ancestors came to America, they
created songs and ballads that represented their culture. The songs contained ephem-
era in them because they were used at specific, onetime events like dinner gatherings
and church services. Many song broadsides praised the hard work of farmers in the
culture. Broadsides were also used in the medical field of the Pennsylvania Dutch
culture. The ephemeral objects were used to describe the three types of medicine in
the culture: academic medicine, popular medicine, and native occult healing. In
this case, ephemeron refers to the durability of the object. The economics of the
Pennsylvania German culture were displayed by sale bills and advertisements. The
ephemeral objects are used not only to display onetime events such as auctions or
sales, but the quality of object is meant for only short-time use. Many of the sale
bills, along with advertisements for other community events, were written in the dia-
lect of the Pennsylvania Dutch culture of the time. A popular community event of
the Pennsylvania Dutch culture written in native dialect was the ‘‘Liars Contest.’’
The Pennsylvania Dutch used broadsides for a variety of religious purposes. In
addition to writing hymns on broadsides that were significant to local religion,
they were also used for house blessings, heaven letters, and religious rites of pas-
sage. House blessings were used as a means to protect the house from evil spirits.
Each house blessing served as a unique event, which makes them ephemeral in
nature. Heaven letters served the same purpose of house blessings, but on an
individual basis. Broadsides were also used to recognize significant rites of pas-
sage such as baptism, confirmation, marriage, and death.
The Pennsylvania Dutch also used broadsides to communicate political
beliefs. Around the time of the American Revolution, the Pennsylvania Dutch
did not always participate in the political arena or in conflicts because they felt
that they would be going against their faith and against a pledge to the govern-
ment of England. The political and military broadsides reflected the views of the
Pennsylvania Dutch. For example, in 1766 the Pennsylvania Dutch produced a
broadside that hailed King George III of England. In spite of this, the Pennsylva-
nia Dutch also created broadsides in German of the Declaration of Independence
and the song ‘‘Yankee Doodle.’’ Broadsides only serve as one example of an
ephemeral object, but all examples of ephemera share one common characteris-
tic—they have a limited use and are common, everyday documents.
Brian Shinehouse
See Also Broadside Ballad; Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore.
Epic | 413
References
Fenn, Patricia. 1994. Rewards of Merit: Tokens of a Child’s Progress and a Teach-
er’s Esteem as an Enduring Aspect of American Religious and Secular Education.
Charlottesville, VA: Ephemera Society of America/Howell Press.
Hudson, Graham. 2008. The Design and Printing of Ephemera in Britain and
America, 1720 1920. London: Oak Knoll Press.
Yoder, Don. 2005. The Pennsylvania German Broadside. University Park: Pennsyl-
vania State University Press.
Epic
religious concepts. Such concepts materialize in the roles of the hero or heroine
as shaman or warrior, in certain concepts of space, order, time, and deity, as well
as in fundamental interpretations of the meaning of death and salvation.
The theme of the shaman who travels to the netherworld and establishes
defenses against the evil forces that impinge on the human world is less common,
however, than the theme of the warrior in the world of the living who conquers not
by supranormal powers but by such qualities as strength, courage, and personal
honor. Certain theories developed in the comparative analysis of myth may explain
this widespread tradition. Comparative studies have suggested the religious signifi-
cance of a proto-Indo-European warrior tradition and have argued that the warrior
occupies an important median position in a three-class human social hierarchy.
Another prevalent epic theme describes founding the world anew: reestablish-
ing world order, time, and space by means of the holocaust of battle. Narratives
turn into epics when, drawing on the poetic power of the blood shed by popular
heroes or heroines, they serve as the songs of peoples who are striving to estab-
lish national or ethnic identities, to legitimize traditions of particular places and
events, and to validate authority.
The Finnish epic the Kalevala, compiled and edited by Elias L€onnrot (1802–
1884), serves to illustrate these epic features. This epic presents a more unified
interpretation of the history of the world than do the Finnish folk narratives from
which L€onnrot drew. Utilizing a variety of folk materials, he developed a narrative
that proceeds from primal creation to destruction of the supreme god, V€ain€am€oinen.
In L€onnrot’s nineteenth-century Lutheran Christian worldview, the Kalevala
described the ‘‘good’’ pagan Finnish prehistory before the advent of Christianity; the
latter, of course, was considered the high point of ‘‘real history’’ (i.e., Western Euro-
pean academic history). The Kalevala ends with the victory of the Christian faith
over the pre-Christian religion of the ancient Finns. As a consequence, the pagan
myths of the epic are arranged according to the Christian linear concept of time and
history, a concept in which time is seen as a segment of a line with beginning and
end points and in which God creates the world but then withdraws to appear again
during the eschatological events that end the world. Though the structure of the epic
is fundamentally Western and Christian, the worldview of the rune singers is cyclic.
Nevertheless, the Kalevala, like epics in general, provides an ethnic and historical
reference point that validates identity and solidarity within the group.
Even outside their original contexts, the epics of many peoples have proved to
be universally appealing. During the performance of epics, channels open to a
more pliable time and space; thus, the primal ‘‘drama of transformation’’ itself
becomes a powerful means of renewal.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Bard; Culture Hero; Hero/Heroine, Folk; Myth; Oral-Formulaic Theory.
Epic Laws | 415
References
de Vries, Jan. 1963. Heroic Song and Heroic Legend. New York: Oxford University
Press.
Lord, Albert B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Oinas, Felix J., ed. 1978. Heroic Epic and Saga: An Introduction to the World’s
Great Folk Epics. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1989. Kalevala Mythology. Trans. Ritva Poom. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Vansina, Jan. 1985. Oral Tradition as History. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
Epic Laws
Superorganic and transcultural ‘‘laws,’’ which give rise to the traditional structure
of narratives. The concept of epic laws was introduced by Danish scholar Axel
Olrik, who formulated eighteen such laws at the beginning of the twentieth century.
Although the Norwegian folklorist Moltke Moe introduced, in 1889, the con-
cept of fundamental epic laws to denote the operative forces in the process of tra-
ditional composition, the scholar who focused particular attention on the question
of regularities in narrative formation was Olrik, who developed the theory of epic
laws in narration in 1908. Olrik argued that, cross-culturally, narrative tradition is
governed by universally applicable rules; he made a departure from the terminol-
ogy of his time to employ the concept of Sagenwelt (world of folk narrative, folk-
tale world) to characterize the cross-culturally applicable rules that operate within
folk narratives. Although Olrik agreed that particular national traits also exist in
narrative, he believed that, in comparison with general regularities, these varia-
tions were analogous to differences in dialects. Olrik stated that these principles
were termed laws because they limited the composition of oral literature by
means of a strict set of rules.
The first rule concerns the formalized opening and closing sentences that
begin and end narratives (the Law of Opening and the Law of Closing). The Law
of Repetition concerns the reiteration that occurs at many levels; for example,
events, dialogues, phrases, and single words are often repeated three times, thus
forming a kind of rhythmic emphasis at different structural levels. The Law of
Three alludes to the fact that, for instance, there are three tasks or that a task is
performed in the course of three days. According to Olrik’s theory, there are usu-
ally only two people occupying the narrative’s ‘‘stage’’ at one time (the Law of
Two to a Scene). Opposed character types come into confrontation: protagonist
and villain, good and bad, rich and poor (the Law of Contrast). The weakest and
youngest proves in the end to be the strongest and cleverest (the Importance of
Initial and Final Position). The Law of Action means that characteristics are not
416 | Epic Laws
References
Dundes, Alan, ed. 1965. The Study of Folklore. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. Analytic Essays in Folklore. The Hague: Mouton.
Oinas, Felix J., ed. 1978. Heroic Epic and Saga: An Introduction to the World’s
Great Folk Epics. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Erotic Folklore | 417
Olrik, Axel. 1915. Personal Impressions of Moltke Moe. Helsinki: Academia Scien-
tiarum Fennica.
Olrik, Axel. 1992. (1921). Principles for Oral Narrative Research. Trans. Kirsten
Wolf and Jody Jensen. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1989. Kalevala Mythology. Trans. Ritva Poom. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Erotic Folklore
Traditional and emergent sexual practices and representational practices that are
expressive of love, desire, and sociosexual relations. Erotic folklore and folklife
encompass the sexual acts we engage in, our beliefs about those acts and the
bodies we perform them with, the language (both literal and figurative) we use to
articulate our desires and fears, the material erotic objects we make, and the sto-
ries, jokes, rhymes, songs, gestures, and games we perform. Erotic folklore consti-
tutes the entire domain of that which is variously identified as ‘‘romantic,’’
‘‘bawdy,’’ ‘‘vulgar,’’ ‘‘obscene,’’ ‘‘pornographic,’’ or simply ‘‘the dirty bits,’’ each
‘‘putting your floppy in someone’s disk drive’’ (twentieth century). Similarly, the
male genitalia—the ‘‘penis,’’ ‘‘privy part,’’ ‘‘prick,’’ ‘‘whang,’’ or ‘‘whacker’’—
which is frequently envisioned as the active agent, may be provided with a ‘‘Chris-
tian’’ name (‘‘Peter,’’ ‘‘Dick,’’ or ‘‘John’’) or euphemized as a man’s ‘‘third leg’’ or
as one of various ‘‘tools’’ and ‘‘instruments.’’ The female body and female genita-
lia are envisioned, most frequently in the passive mode, as, for example, a land-
scape to be cultivated, an instrument to be played, or a fruit to be harvested. The
extent to which such language usage constructs a system of gender dominance has
been noted by many, but just as language may be used to construct dominant
ideologies, it also can be used to deconstruct and contest assertions of dominance.
This idea is hinted at (either intentionally or unintentionally) in the recuperative
language of the title of Barbara Babcock’s essay ‘‘Taking Liberties, Writing from
the Margins, and Doing It with a Difference’’ (emphasis added)—a feminist dis-
closure of male uses of the female body as a semiotic object.
Similarly, plastic and visual art objects, both those for everyday use and other-
wise, encode a variety of human erotic acts as well as cultural attitudes toward
those acts. For example, a pre-Columbian Andean culture, the Moche (or Moch-
ica), crafted pots that were decorated with three-dimensional body parts (penis and
vulva) and with three-dimensional subjects caught in various erotic positions: con-
ventional heterosexual intercourse, heterosexual anal intercourse, male homosex-
ual anal intercourse, lesbian digital stimulation of the vagina, fellatio, cunnilingus,
male masturbation, and zoophilia. Although the erotic has been associated with the
spiritual in many cultures (for example, in ancient Greece and Persia), artifacts like
the Moche stirrup-spout pots suggest the ways that the erotic can simultaneously
be a source of a more worldly humor—in this case, the drinking spout configured
as a penis or a vulva requires that the drinker perform a type of displaced fellatio
or cunnilingus in order to quench his or her thirst. Analogously, the margins of me-
dieval European manuscript pages were sometimes decorated with figures engaged
in a variety of erotic acts, and forms of twentieth-century photocopy and fax lore
provide graphic visual representations of erotic fears and pleasures.
And what our linguistic lexicons and our art objects encode, our sex manuals
(ancient and modern), conduct books, collections of literary and vernacular tales
and songs, and inscriptions of folklife elaborate on. Sex manuals, for example,
circulated in China as early as the second century BCE, Rome had Ovid’s Ars
Armatoria by the end of the first century BCE, and India produced the Kamasutra
sometime between the third and fifth centuries CE. Each is a complex mixture of
public and folk practice and fantasy that, to varying degrees, is inflected by theo-
logical and ideological prescription. During the Middle Ages, bawdy folktales
were appropriated for literary use (The Arabian Nights, Boccaccio’s Decameron,
Chaucer’s Canterbury Tales). Also, early modern Europe transmitted sexual prac-
tices and fantasies through (among other genres) song, both in oral performance
420 | Erotic Folklore
and print; examples may be found in Thomas D’Urfey’s Wit and Mirth, Or Pills
to Purge Melancholy (1719–1 720) and Vivian de Sola Pinto and Allan Rodway’s
The Common Muse: An Anthology of Popular British Ballad Poetry, XVth–XXth
Century (1957). Additionally, books such as Aristotle’s Masterpiece, an anony-
mous compendium of information drawn from earlier printed sources and period
folklore and first printed in the late seventeenth century, documented early mod-
ern beliefs concerning the body, its genders, and its sexualities.
Western modernity has had its Freudian case studies, its Kinsey reports, and
the work of Havelock Ellis and of William H. Masters and Virginia E. Johnson.
A myriad of popular articles frequently linking sex, etiquette, and domestic and
public economy have appeared in women’s and men’s magazines. Oral histori-
ans, such as Steve Humphries, have recorded vernacular personal narratives
about the heteroglossic erotic life of a nation during a specific historical period.
Similarly, cultural anthropologists Elizabeth Lapousky Kennedy and Madeline
D. Davis have used women’s oral histories to document the life of a particular
sexual community in Buffalo, New York, from 1930 to 1960. Other anthropolo-
gists have inscribed the erotic life of diverse cultures and subcultures: Owen M.
Lynch’s Divine Passions: The Social Construction of Emotions in India (1990);
Richard Parker’s Bodies, Pleasures, and Passions: Sexual Culture in Contempo-
rary Brazil (1991); Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia, edited by Gilbert
Herdt (1984); Will Roscoe’s The Zuni Man-Woman (1991); and Esther
Newton’s, Mother Camp: Female Impersonators in America (1979).
In turn, folklorists have focused on various representational practices. For
example, collected folktales as well as folksongs and ballads (although some-
times elliptical, particularly when ‘‘adapted’’ for public consumption) encode
various peoples’ attitudes toward the body, sexuality, and hierarchical social sys-
tems based on class and gender. Different textual traditions and situated perform-
ances of ‘‘Cinderella,’’ ‘‘Little Red Riding Hood,’’ ‘‘Beauty and the Beast,’’ and
‘‘Bluebeard,’’ for example, at once assume and construct heterosexuality as a cul-
tural norm while exploring, according to differently situated scholarly interpreta-
tions, the erotic in children’s developing sexualities, the relationship between sex
and violence, incest, and the erotic attraction of the gender-ambivalent cross-
dresser. Similarly, romantic songs and ballads construct heterosexual and homo-
erotic relations while sometimes documenting various cultural-specific erotic
taboos. For example, in Anglo-American ballads of domestic tragedy, sibling
incest is invoked in versions of ‘‘Lizzie Wan,’’ ‘‘The King’s Dochter Lady Jean,’’
‘‘Bonny Hind,’’ ‘‘The Cruel Brother,’’ ‘‘Babylon,’’ and ‘‘Sheath and Knife.’’
Folktales and their popular redactions in particular have been critiqued by West-
ern feminist scholars Marcia Leiberman, Kay Stone, and Jane Yolen as misogynis-
tic constructions of female gender, female sexuality, and cross-gender relations, as
well as for their production of an erotic economy based on the mystique of
Erotic Folklore | 421
romance and female domesticity. However, scholars also have suggested that such
tales, when contextualized by specific performance frames, may be negotiated by
women for their own purposes. Finally, such tales also have been analyzed as sites
for the disclosure of male fears of both female and male sexuality.
Other textual and performance traditions revel in graphic sexual representation
and witty euphemism. Although publicly censored (for example, the blank space
that potentially categorized sexual themes in the Stith Thompson Motif-Index
was not redressed until Frank Hoffmann began the task in 1973), sexually
explicit folklore not only survives but also thrives, providing, as do the trickster
figures of bawdy tales, important forms of psychological and cultural renewal.
As social theorist Mikhail Bakhtin has argued, bawdry—with its emphasis on the
‘‘grotesque’’ material body—is at the heart of cultural deconstruction and
renewal: ‘‘The essence of the grotesque is precisely to present a contradictory
and double-faced fullness of life. Negation and destruction (death of the old) are
included as an essential phase, inseparable from affirmation, from the birth of
something new.’’ In this way, bawdy stories (folktales, as well as personal narra-
tives, anecdotes, and contemporary legends), poems, jokes, songs, ballads, blues,
graffiti, gestures, and toasts encode attitudes toward the body and the erotic
while using representations of the body and the erotic for purposes of psycholog-
ical release, group and dyadic bonding, and sociopolitical commentary.
As editor of Kriptadia: The Journal of Erotic Folklore and author of The Horn
Book: Studies in Erotic Folklore (1964), The Rationale of the Dirty Joke (1968),
No Laughing Matter: Rational of the Dirty Joke, Second Series (1975), The
Limerick (1964), and The New Limerick (1977), as well as innumerable articles,
prefaces, and introductions, Gershon Legman has been, in the twentieth century,
the leading bibliographer and editor of sexually explicit folklore. But of particular
importance for folklorists are the field collections of scholars such as Vance
Randolph, whose Pissing in the Snow & Other Ozark Folktales (1976), Roll Me
in Your Arms: ‘‘Unprintable’’ Ozark Folksongs and Folklore, Volume 1 (1992),
and Blow the Candle Out: ‘‘Unprintable’’ Ozark Folksongs and Folklore, Volume
2 (1992), when contextualized within Randolph’s entire collected corpus, bawdy
and non-bawdy, offer what Rayna Green has described as ‘‘a picture of expressive
behavior unparalleled by any other American region’s or group’s study.’’
Although Randolph’s field collections record the erotic representational prac-
tices of a particular region during a particular time, other scholars have focused
on different communities and various genres. Ewan MacColl and Peggy Seeger’s
Travellers’ Songs (1976) records, in the context of a broad singing tradition, the
bawdy songs collected primarily in Scotland from a specific social and ethnic
group, and Guy Logsdon’s The Whorehouse Bells Were Ringing (1989) docu-
ments the bawdy song tradition of a specific occupational group (American cow-
boys). Roger Abrahams’s Deep Down in the Jungle: Negro Narrative Folklore
422 | Erotic Folklore
References
Babcock, Barbara. 1987. Taking Liberties, Writing from the Margins, and Doing It
with a Difference. Journal of American Folklore 100: 390 411.
Beck, Horace P. 1962. Say Something Dirty! Journal of American Folklore 75:
195 199.
424 | Eschatology
Foucalt, Michel. 1978. The History of Sexuality. Trans. Robert Hurley. New York:
Pantheon.
Green, Rayna. 1990. ‘‘Magnolias Grow in Dirt’’: The Bawdy Lore of Southern
Women. In Calling Home: Working-Class Women’s Writings, An Anthology, ed. Janet
Zandy. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.
Hoffmann, Frank. 1973. An Analytical Survey of Traditional Anglo-American Erot-
ica. Bowling Green, OH: Bowling Green University Press.
Kodish, Debora. 1987. Absent Gender, Silent Encounter. Journal of American Folk-
lore 100: 573 578.
Laqueur, Thomas. 1990. Making Sex: Body and Gender from the Greeks to Freud.
Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Legman, Gershon. 1990. Erotic Folksongs and Ballads: An International Bibliogra-
phy. Journal of American Folklore 103: 417 501.
Paros, Lawrence. 1984. The Erotic Tongue. Seattle, WA: Madrona.
Preston, Cathy Lynn. 1994. ‘‘Cinderella’’ as a Dirty Joke: Gender, Multivocality, and
the Polysemic Text. Western Folklore 53: 27 49.
Eschatology
Mythic narratives about teachings concerning the last things, the end of the world,
the destruction of the old world, and the creation of a new world. In the religious
traditions of mankind, eschatological texts differ greatly. Eschatological myths,
theories, and stories that deal with the end of the universe are to be found in
almost every society. These works give descriptions of the developments of the
universe after the final catastrophe in varying styles, either in imaginative mythic
narrative or in scientific formulas or the language of physics. Eschatological
myths lay the ground for the ethical requirements of human existence, describing
the future expectations and destiny of both mankind and the universe.
In prophetic religions like Parsism, Judaism, Christianity, and Islam, the end
of this world implies entering into the realm of God. Based on this model, world
and human history are unified and based on a linear model. In contrast, the Hindu
philosophy of religion espouses a cyclical concept of time. The destruction of the
world is expected to take place several times: The world will return to chaos
again but will be created anew. Eschatological myths (e.g., ‘‘The Revelation of
St. John’’) characteristically tell about the collapse of the firmament, floods, uni-
versal conflagration, terribly cold winters, bloody wars, and other horrors.
Myths are central to the religions of the world. They usually are held sacred in
their cultures and are considered to be true explanations of the origins of the cos-
mos as well as the events related to both the genesis and the collapse of culture.
They relate in detail how the world, humans, the animal kingdom, and central
elements of culture were created, thus establishing the world order. These myths
Esoteric/Exoteric Factor | 425
are often incorporated into the present by means of rituals. In myths, religions
offer provocatively different answers to people’s ‘‘why questions.’’ Myths, how-
ever, deal not only with the questions of origin but also with the end of the uni-
verse and destiny of man; therefore, a culture’s cosmogonic and eschatological
myths together form an essential fabric of the culture’s worldview.
There is always a difference between reality as depicted in myths and the
human, societal, cultural, and physical realities of the people that maintain these
fundamental explanations about their human existence. The crucial difference
between historical and mythic time interpretation is related to the model used for
comprehending temporality. Historical time is linear, continuous, and composed
of unique events, but mythic time is cyclical and repetitive. The latter encom-
passes and unites two temporal dimensions: the original time and the present. In
traditional cultures, a wealth of myths are devoted to explaining the origin and
destination of the universe. These myths can be categorized, respectively, as cos-
mogonic and eschatological myths that clarify the structure, function, and origin
of time, as well as its end. The fundamental questions about the origin and desti-
nation of the universe are addressed in every human culture or community, with-
out exception. Although the creation and the end of the universe and mankind are
characteristically dealt with as elements of the myths of human cultures, very dif-
ferent promises and expectations are provided. In their efforts to locate the causes
of variation, scholars have noted that there is a relationship among certain ecolog-
ical settings or niches, worldview, and eschatological expectations and beliefs.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Cosmology; Myth.
References
Dundes, Alan, ed. 1984. Sacred Narrative. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Eliade, Mircea. 1971. The Myth of the Eternal Return, or Cosmos and History.
Trans. Willard R. Trask. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Long, Charles. H. 1963. Alpha: The Myths of Creation. New York: George Braziller.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1989. Kalevala Mythology. Trans. Ritva Poon. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Sproul, Barbara C. 1979. Primal Myths: Creating the World. San Francisco: Harper
& Row.
Esoteric/Exoteric Factor
Element in folklore that stresses a group’s sense of its identity in relation to other
groups. Coined by William Hugh Jansen, the set of contrasting terms has four
dimensions. The esoteric factor in folklore refers both to a group’s self-image
426 | Esoteric/Exoteric Factor
and to its perception of what people from other groups think of it. The exoteric
factor includes a group’s image of another group and its notions of what that
group believes that image to be. Examples of folklore evincing the esoteric factor
are origin myths and legends that relate an ethnic community’s beginnings (for
instance, emergence myths among some Native American groups in the South-
west) and jokes told by African Americans about white attitudes toward blacks.
Folklore with strong exoteric tendencies is represented by ethnic jokes—those
that offer actual characterizations of the targeted population and those that depict
the population’s alleged perception of the joke teller’s attitudes.
Jansen believed that the esoteric/exoteric factor figures with particular promi-
nence in the folklore of groups that demonstrate three features. Most important is
isolation, whether the distancing factor be geography, religion, ethnicity and lan-
guage, age, or some other marker of difference. A second contributor to a strong
esoteric/exoteric component in a group’s folklore is its being privy to knowledge
and skills that seem especially arcane or specialized. Finally, Jansen suggested,
groups that come to be regarded as especially prestigious or admirable may pos-
sess a pronounced esoteric/exoteric factor in their folklore.
Though Jansen himself viewed the esoteric/exoteric factor in folklore as perti-
nent to groups whose focus of identity might be occupational, religious, regional,
or, in fact, related to any other distinguishing trait, most applications of his idea
have occurred in the study of interethnic folklore, especially joking. Moreover,
emphasis has most usually been directed at the exoteric member in the set of
terms. Folklorists have, for example, defined a set of traits imputed to ethnic (and
sometimes regional) others by mainstream culture in the United States: lack of ef-
ficiency, dirtiness, sexual promiscuity, inappropriate appetite, and laziness being
some of the features that comprise a generic exoteric characterization. To these
(and occasionally in place of some of them), particular features may be added to
complete mainstream culture’s exoteric view of a particular ethnic other. The Jew
may be mercenary, the Scot may be stingy, the Italian may be cowardly, and the
African American may be criminally violent, for example. Occasional studies
have focused on exoteric depictions of mainstream culture and its participants
from the perspective of ethnic minorities, one of the most developed presentations
being Keith Basso’s treatment of Western Apache skits depicting the ‘‘whiteman.’’
Some folklorists have recognized that ethnic jokes have esoteric as well as ex-
oteric significance since the qualities imputed exoterically to the ethnic outsider
stand in direct contradistinction to how the joke teller would characterize his or
her own group, at least ideally. Consequently, the joke teller who mocks the lazi-
ness and inefficiency of the ethnic other also may be asserting a sense of his or
her own group’s qualities of industry and efficiency.
William M. Clements
See Also Ethnic Folklore; Joke.
Ethnic Folklore | 427
References
Basso, Keith A. 1979. Portraits of ‘‘the Whiteman’’: Linguistic Play and Cultural
Symbols among the Western Apache. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Clements, William M. 1986. The Ethnic Joke as Mirror of Culture. New York Folk-
lore 12(3 4): 87 97.
Davies, Christie. 1990. Ethnic Humor around the World: A Comparative Analysis.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1971. A Study of Ethnic Slurs: The Jew and the Polack in the United
States. Journal of American Folklore 84: 186 203.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. Slurs International: Folk Comparisons of Ethnicity and National
Character. Southern Folklore Quarterly 39: 15 38.
Jansen, William Hugh. 1957. A Culture’s Stereotypes and Their Expression in Folk
Cliches. Southwestern Journal of Anthropology 13: 184 200.
Jansen, William Hugh. 1959. The Esoteric-Exoteric Factor in Folklore. In The Study
of Folklore, ed. Alan Dundes. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Ethnic Folklore
general national culture or as the lore of alien minority groups, language islands,
or colonies within nations. In the first instance, ethnographic field data are placed
in the context of historical, geographical, ecological, and demographic factors
believed to account for the specific combination of cultural elements that charac-
terize the ethnicity of a regional group. Thus, ethnic specifics, local variations of
national stereotypes, have been the focus of much of the research on the expres-
sive culture of European ethnic groups.
Although research on the folklore of what Degh has called ‘‘alien ethnic colo-
nies’’ within larger European nations produced similar investigative strategies,
the overall goal of that research was quite different. In fact, scholars often were
completely disinterested in alien minorities such as itinerant Gypsy tribes or
communities of eastern European Jews; the research of these scholars often sup-
ported assimilationist government policies. Historically oriented and profoundly
influenced by Herderian nationalism, these ethnographers regarded the lore of
emigrant colonies as the final vestiges of the national ideal. The Soviet school of
ethnology provides one of the best examples of the justification of folklore
research, especially research on ethnic folklore, for political reasons.
Likewise, in Germany, where World War I had both crippled the economy and
deflated national pride, the study of ethnic folklore, grounded firmly in the heri-
tage of the German Romantic Nationalists, became one of the most powerful
tools of Nazi folk and race theorists. Focusing particularly on German ethnic
groups in southeast Europe, agents of the Reich worked to organize individual
communities as German nationals. Ethnic folklore research, then, was almost
exclusively directed ideologically, toward imperialistic expansionism.
After World War II, a new generation of scholars finally came forward to cri-
tique the reconstructionism of traditional German Volkskunde. The postwar era
provided these ethnographers with a rich variety of contexts for the study of Ger-
man ethnic folklore as the resettlement of various groups began to take place.
This focus on the processes of change that occur as ethnic groups interact
became most prominent in European ethnology after the war, as ethnic group
relocation between nations and internal migration became so widespread. In
these contexts, studies of acculturation flourished, and folklore forms were ana-
lyzed as clear indicators of the acculturative process.
In Europe since the 1950s, the study of interethnic relations has grown into a
special field. Community studies of areas in which several ethnic groups and/or
nationalities interact have often included the analysis of folklore genres. In multi-
ethnic regions of southeastern Europe, for example, a number of cooperative
studies have produced careful folklore analyses of multilingual interethnic com-
munities. Such studies have served to disturb the traditional definition of ethnic
groups according to trait combinations since the research indicates that changing
contextual factors continually disrupt the stability of those very combinations.
Ethnic Folklore | 429
Blason Populaire
Brief characterization of a group of which one is not a member. Sometimes, blason
populaire (literally, popular emblem) is used as a synonym for ethnic joke, but the term
more accurately applies to the stereotype that informs the joke. Ethnicity has been the
most usual factor in generating such out-group (or exoteric) folklore. But other kinds
of out-groups (religious, geographical, or occupational, for example) may become the
targets for pithy depictions; these, in fact, appear in a variety of folklore genres.
Perhaps the simplest form of blason populaire is the group nickname. Although they
may communicate nothing specific in their characterizations of the groups they target,
terms such as nigger or spick suggest derogation through their harsh, cacophonous
sounds. Slightly more complex is the use of group names to characterize objects and
behaviors (Indian giver or French letter). The blason populaire may also appear in tradi-
tional similes: ‘‘as tight as a Scotsman’’ or ‘‘like a Chinese fire drill.’’ In addition, prov-
erbs can arise from blasons populaires: ‘‘A Swabian has no heart but two stomachs.’’
Ethnic jokes and other narratives provide the opportunity for more developed use
of the blason populaire in folklore. Such forms may assign particular characteristics to
particular groups and play upon conventional stereotypes, such as that of the ‘‘dumb
blonde.’’ But specific characterizations often rest on a foundation that seems to figure
into blasons populaires in general: that of the Other, one whose most important traits
stem from differentness from the group among whom the blason populaire circulates.
Hence, in ethnic jokes in the United States, where such virtues as efficiency, cleanli-
ness, and orderliness are valued, the target of exoteric folklore, no matter what the
particular group, is depicted as inefficient, dirty, and disorganized. Blasons populaires
often imply the lack of humanity of their targets. For example, when Europeans
began to contact the indigenous peoples of the Western Hemisphere in the six-
teenth century, they often depicted them as naked cannibals, their alleged eating hab-
its and lack of clothing assigning them to subhuman status. During particular periods
in a group’s history, members of the group may be the target of blasons populaires.
During the last half of the nineteenth century, for instance, Irish immigration to the
United States produced stereotypical depictions of Irish men and women in various
media. Joke cycles occasionally center for a while upon a particular group. The next
time the cycle comes around, the same jokes may target another group. M€archen,
novelle, folk songs, and material culture also make use of blasons populaires.
Research into blasons populaires by folklorists has focused mostly upon their manifes-
tations in ethnic jokes. Some studies simply have reported and cataloged the phenom-
enon, but others have delved more deeply into the sociological, historical, and cultural
factors that generate the stereotypical attitudes that the blason populaire captures. Sel-
dom have studies of blasons populaires examined how these exoteric characterizations
emerge in performance, an important exception being Keith Basso’s investigation of
depictions of the ‘‘whiteman’’ among Western Apaches. Sociologists and psychologists,
who often rely on questionnaires rather than the ways blasons populaires occur in tra-
ditional culture, also have worked with these exoteric characterizations.
William M. Clements
430 | Ethnic Folklore
Feast of the Epiphany in Tarpon Springs, Florida, in 2006, the 100th year of the celebra-
tion since the founding of its Greek Orthodox community. (AP/Wide World Photos)
and learn a new language and new ways? How much of the old lore is retained
and transmitted to their children? What parts are sloughed off, what intrusions
appear, what accommodation is made between Old Country beliefs and the
American physical scene? These are the large questions that confront the asses-
sor of immigrant folk traditions.’’
Many folklorists took up Dorson’s call for studies of immigrant traditions and
answered these questions. A fine example of such acculturation studies is Robert
Georges’s work with the Tarpon Springs, Florida, Greek community, in which he
analyzes the ways narratives, rites of passage, and holiday celebrations help to
maintain the traditional belief system of these fairly isolated transplanted Greek
fishermen. Georges demonstrates both the survival and reinforcement of Greek
traditions in one small American community. Folklorists have continued to docu-
ment both persistence and change in the ethnic traditions of immigrant groups.
Barbara Kirshenblatt-Gimblett’s study of traditional storytelling in a Toronto Jew-
ish community, Robert Klymasz’s study of Ukrainian folklore in Canada, and Elli
K€ong€as-Maranda’s analysis of Finnish-American lore, for example, document the
various factors effecting change in ethnic traditions in the New World.
European models of ethnological research have formed the basis for the
‘‘acculturation model’’ research of folklorists such as Linda Degh, who has called
Ethnic Folklore | 433
for case studies that will provide an analysis of the assimilation process as it
affects groups in contiguous and intermittent contact over a period of time. This
process of ‘‘cultural adjustment’’ requires the observation of trans-generational
folkloric expression as various ethnic groups come in contact with each other.
Degh has continually suggested that the determination of ethnic boundaries and
the examination of intercultural borrowing should be the focus of research on
ethnic folklore.
In this insistence on the analysis of the process of ethnic interaction, Degh’s
work is representative of the ways in which American ethnic folklore scholarship
since World War II has moved away from a concern with ‘‘survivals’’ of Old
World forms as the cultural content of ethnic groups and toward an understand-
ing of the processes of ethnic boundary maintenance or negotiation. Like their
European colleagues, American folklorists have drawn extensively on the work
of Norwegian ethnographer Fredrik Barth in making this shift in theoretical em-
phasis. Barth’s 1969 Ethnic Groups and Boundaries proposed an understanding
and definition of ethnic groups based not on the identification of a cluster of cul-
ture traits for each particular ethnic group but rather on the process that a group
and others use to separate and define the group itself. Barth argued that the focus
for the analysis of ethnicity should be ‘‘the ethnic boundary that defines the
group, not the cultural stuff that it encloses.’’ This simple but powerful notion of
boundaries has proven to be one of the most theoretically useful concepts in clar-
ifying the ways in which ethnic identity is articulated and actively negotiated in
interaction within and between ethnic groups. Such a perspective points clearly
to the influence of contextual variability on ethnic identity: As social, economic,
and political conditions change, so may systems of ethnic identification.
Attention to the role of folklore in the process of boundary making was first
articulated by William Hugh Jansen in his 1959 ‘‘The Esoteric-Exoteric Factor in
Folklore.’’ Jansen discussed the range of factors associated with boundary mak-
ing and maintenance as they are revealed in oral narrative. His work suggested
that by examining the folklore of a group’s own self-image as well as that of its
images of other groups, one might better understand the role folklore plays in the
creation, negotiation, and maintenance of ethnic boundaries. Jansen’s work
focused primarily on the ways in which folklore operates as a ‘‘function of shared
identity,’’ binding groups together, but Richard Bauman has pointed out that dif-
ferential identities and asymmetrical relationships also can be the basis for folk-
lore performance. Americo Paredes has explored the relationship between
‘‘gringos’’ and ‘‘greasers’’ in the joking behavior of Mexican Americans as dram-
atizations of real social inequities. Roger Abrahams also has suggested that folk-
lore performances may additionally operate as a means of distinguishing
separate or even antagonistic segments within the same ethnic community, as
Alan Dundes’s work on Jewish-American humor demonstrates.
434 | Ethnic Folklore
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1980. Folklore. In Harvard Encyclopedia of American Ethnic
Groups, ed. Stephen Thernstron. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Barth, Fredrik. 1969. Ethnic Groups and Boundaries: The Social Organization of
Cultural Difference. Boston: Little, Brown.
Bauman, Richard. 1971. Differential Identity and the Social Base of Folklore. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 84: 31 41.
436 | Ethnoaesthetics
Danielson, Larry, ed. 1977. Studies in Folklore and Ethnicity. Los Angeles: Califor-
nia Folklore Society.
Davies, Christie. 1990. Ethnic Humor around the World: A Comparative Analysis.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Degh, Linda. 1975. The Study of Ethnicity in Modern European Ethnology. Journal
of the Folklore Institute 12: 113 129.
Dorson, Richard M. 1959. American Folklore. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1971. A Study of Ethnic Slurs: The Jew and the Polack in the United
States. Journal of American Folklore 84: 186 203.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. Slurs International: Folk Comparisons of Ethnicity and National
Character. Southern Folklore Quarterly 39: 15 38.
Georges, Robert A., and Stephen Stern. 1982. American and Canadian Immigrant
and Ethnic Folklore: An Annotated Bibliography. New York: Garland.
Herskovits, Melville. 1942. The Myth of the Negro Past. New York: Harper.
Jansen, William Hugh. 1959. The Esoteric-Exoteric Factor in Folklore. In The Study
of Folklore, ed. Alan Dundes. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Kirshenblatt-Gimblett, Barbara. 1983. Studying Immigrant and Ethnic Folklore. In
The Handbook of American Folklore, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Klymasz, Robert B. 1973. From Immigrant to Ethnic Folklore: A Canadian View of
Process and Transition. Journal of the Folklore Institute 10(13): 1 139.
Paredes, Americo. 1959. With His Pistol in His Hand. Austin: University of Texas
Press.
Royce, Anya Peterson. 1982. Ethnic Identity: Strategies of Diversity. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Stern, Stephen, and John Allan Cicala, eds. 1991. Creative Ethnicity: Symbols and
Strategies of Contemporary Ethnic Life. Logan: University of Utah Press.
Ethnoaesthetics
the verbal arts as it does to the visual arts and would be quite productive in delin-
eating the interrelationship between the two communicative processes.
Historically, the designation ethnoaesthetics has been employed more fre-
quently by anthropologists than folklorists, indicating especially the cultural
expressions of non-Western peoples, including those aptly described by Nelson
Graburn as inhabiting ‘‘the fourth world,’’ that is, native peoples without coun-
tries of their own whose art is seldom manufactured for their own use. Whether
they specifically adopted this terminology or not, folklorists began to apply the
methodology consonant with this concept as they became more concerned with
context, performance, and dynamic process, giving less credence to their former
emphasis on isolated objects and texts that were often regarded as if frozen in
time and generated anonymously. This new direction in folklore scholarship
reflected a major shift in the discipline that took place in the mid-1970s, entailing
a concentration on the individual rather than on broad generalizations, classifica-
tions of types, delineations of groups, and regional trends.
In folk art studies, the behavioral orientation is well represented by Michael
Owen Jones’s wide variety of publications that demonstrate his interest in individ-
ual motivation, focusing on the material object as a means by which to illuminate
the mind of a particular maker and user. Significantly, Jones, like anthropologists
who study tourist art, explores appreciation as well as creation, considering the
attitudes of both the consumer and the traditional artist. Jones’s influence is evi-
dent in a range of later publications whose authors began to question overarching
assumptions about tradition and culture. John Vlach, for instance, directly
acknowledges Jones’s intellectual contribution to his own research. In Charleston
Blacksmith: The Work of Philip Simmons, Vlach examines the perpetuation of tra-
dition in the urban environment, stressing the ways in which this environment
actually encourages the retention of folk aesthetics and creative processes. Many
of Simon Bronner’s numerous books and articles also situate studies of individual
craftspersons within specific community, economic, and environmental contexts.
Additionally, although his early regional and structural studies would hardly fall
within this disciplinary shift, Henry Glassie’s Passing the Time in Ballymenone is
exemplary in its attention to context, as well as its interweaving of the multiple
verbal and visual expressive performances that occur in this folk community.
All of these studies have been the subject of controversy as well as admiration.
Their emphasis on individual creativity is laudable, but their lack of attention to
the politics of production is highly problematic. Too frequently, folk art scholars
underscore the importance of aesthetics while neglecting critical aspects of social
conflict and power relationships. Issues of race, class, ethnicity, gender, and sex-
ual identity have yet to become central to this area of academic concern.
An extensive overview would reveal that the canon in folk art or folk material
culture scholarship is composed largely of the publications of male folklorists
438 | Ethnoaesthetics
writing about male artists. The tacit assumption behind the existence and perpetua-
tion of such an accepted body of scholarly works is that women neither study nor
make the most significant forms of folk objects. Yet the most recent generation of
folk art scholars comprises quite a number of women who have moved into the
seemingly male-dominated and public realm of folk art study. But it is not the con-
centration on a specific category of folk art that distinguishes the scholarship of
these women; rather, it is their endeavor to interrelate a variety of forms of artistic
communication. Motivated by advances in feminist theory and performance
theory, they have dissolved the traditional boundaries between verbal and visual
expressive behavior, investigating the aesthetic principles that unite rather than
separate these domains. It is this sort of research, conducted by scholars who
sometimes designate themselves as folkloristic anthropologists, anthropological
folklorists, or symbolic anthropologists, that fits most clearly within the ethnoaes-
thetic approach to human creativity. These innovative scholars include Barbara
Babcock, Claire R. Farrer, Nancy Munn, and Barbara Tedlock, among others.
They, in turn, have influenced their students and colleagues to analyze multidisci-
plinary, multivalent aspects of traditional artistic or symbolic behavior. Whether
they explicitly describe this method as ‘‘ethnoaesthetic’’ or not, their approach con-
stitutes one of the most productive directions in contemporary folk art studies.
M. Jane Young
See Also Aesthetics; Text; Tradition.
References
Babcock, Barbara, Guy Monthan, and Doris Monthan. 1986. The Pueblo Storyteller:
Development of a Figurative Ceramic Tradition. Tucson: University of Arizona Press.
Bronner, Simon. 1984. Chain Carvers: Old Men Crafting Meaning. Lexington: Uni-
versity Press of Kentucky.
Farrer, Claire R. 1991. Living Life’s Circle: Mescalero Apache Cosmovision. Albu-
querque: University of New Mexico Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1982. Passing the Time in Ballymenone. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Graburn, Nelson H.H., ed. 1976. Ethnic and Tourist Arts: Cultural Expressions from
the Fourth World. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1975. The Hand Made Object and Its Maker. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Munn, Nancy. 1973. Walbiri Iconography. Ithaca, NY, and London: Cornell Univer-
sity Press.
Tedlock, Barbara. 1992. The Beautiful and the Dangerous: Encounters with the Zuni
Indians. New York: Viking.
Vlach, John M. 1981. Charleston Blacksmith: The Work of Philip Simmons. Athens:
University of Georgia Press.
Ethnography | 439
Ethnography
Franz Boas. During the same period, English anthropology produced its own set
of ethnographers who affected the form, including A. R. Radcliffe-Brown, Broni-
slaw Malinowski, and Edward Evans-Pritchard. These British ethnographers
tried to demonstrate the efficacy of functional theory, whereas the Americans
attempted to salvage the past and accepted functionalism later. Both groups,
however, produced classic ethnographies. Malinowski’s 1922 description of the
ethnography method as ‘‘an attempt to grasp the native’s point of view and see
his world through his eyes’’ characterized the approach of both groups.
These early, classic ethnographies—also called realistic ethnographies because
of their similarities to the realist movement in literature—were far from uniform,
and some of them were innovative and experimental. As time passed, however,
ethnographers developed an inflexible set of genre conventions that included the
use of a third-person, omniscient point of view to present a set of topics in a set
sequence, as well as the elimination of any references to the investigator.
This predictable pattern was broken in the 1960s, 1970s, 1980s, and 1990s by
pressures from different directions. In the 1960s and 1970s, ethnoscience argued
that ethnographers should bring the rigor of the scientific method to ethnography,
urged the replacement of the nonstandard selection of information of classic eth-
nography with a more precise framework for data collection and interpretation,
and developed statistical tools to achieve these goals.
In the 1980s and 1990s, other voices argued for making ethnographies more per-
sonal and literary. Reflexive, interactive, postmodern, experimental, and narrative
are all terms used to describe the varied attempts during these decades to restruc-
ture ethnography as a literary genre. Most ethnographers of this period included
the field researcher as a part of the field, used the first-person voice, and did not
follow chronological order, and many of them experimented with novelistic tech-
niques. Drawing inspiration from Schoolcraft, Cushing, Hurston, James Agee, and
Hunter S. Thompson, and supported by the theoretical works of Clifford Geertz,
David Schneider, Michael Owen Jones, Robert Georges, and many others, experi-
mental ethnographers sought ways to include more direct representation of the ex-
perience of fieldwork itself into their written reports and to use writing to gain
theoretical insights and more fully present the experience of other cultures.
Ethnography proliferated in the second half of the twentieth century in
research fields other than folklore and anthropology. Nonanthropological, non-
folkloristic ethnographers adapted and developed methodologies to fit their
needs from scientific, classical, and experimental ethnographies.
Various critics attacked both classical and experimental ethnographies in the
1980s and 1990s as unscientific and scientific ethnographies as too subjective
and nonreflexive. It is impossible to predict the future directions the form may
take with absolute certainty. Considering the long and useful history of ethnogra-
phies, however, it seems highly likely that ethnography will continue as a major
Ethnology | 441
research method and literary genre in some form—or forms—within folklore, an-
thropology, and other research fields.
Keith Cunningham
See Also Anthropological Approach; Fieldwork.
References
Georges, Robert A., and Michael O. Jones. 1980. People Studying People. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Marcus, George E., and Michael M. L. Fischer. 1986. Anthropology as Cultural Cri-
tique. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Oswalt, Wendell H. 1972. Other People, Other Customs: World Ethnography and Its
History. New York: Holt, Rinehart, and Winston.
Ethnology
In anthropology, the term ethnology describes the social, cultural, and psycholog-
ical study of peoples. The letter ‘‘s’’ in the word peoples is significant, indicating
that the subjects of ethnology are treated as groups rather than as individuals. In
ethnological work these groups are usually regarded as tribal, ethnic, national, or
other corporate social entities. Ethnologists study culturally determined practices
and environmental ethics as part of interactive social and behavioral systems.
Ethnography focuses on the descriptive study of cultures; it analyzes, classifies,
and interprets problems arising from ethnographic knowledge. These may be
comparative, theoretical, economic, social, or other kinds of questions. Ethnol-
ogy thus tends toward the systemic and theoretical, while fieldwork-based eth-
nography is more local and informational. In practice, however, there is
considerable overlap between ethnographic methods and ethnological theory.
Thick description, artifacts, and other ethnographic data provide the empirical
foundations of ethnological analysis.
Lowie (1937) defined culture as the aggregate of customs, habits, beliefs, skills,
practices, and norms that individuals acquire, not through their own creativity or
actions but from their societies and kin. Culture in this sense is an omnibus term
meaning all that people learn at a conscious or unconscious level from others in their
surroundings; at the same time, culture itself is made by individuals acting in con-
cert. Franz Boas shifted the ethnological usage of the term away from the nine-
teenth-century meaning of ‘‘culture’’ as a universal human condition found at
differing stages of development, toward the plural ‘‘cultures’’ as historically particu-
lar, unique, and local complexes. Talcott Parsons, following Max Weber, reinter-
preted the concept of culture as a symbolic system. Methodological considerations
of ethnography and ethnology include recognizing, gathering, and translating
442 | Ethnology
Quebec, Louisiana, and the Caribbean have maintained many distinct local ele-
ments of language and culture rooted in old French forms that died out in Europe
centuries ago.
The weaknesses of diffusionism as an ethnological theory and historical method
included its bias against the possibilities of independent invention and its insist-
ence on a top-down model of imperial cultural drift from the so-called high civili-
zations to the rest of the world’s peoples, rather than a dynamic, interactive model
of mutual influence and exchange. Diffusionists were unable to fully recognize
human agency and the ingenious adaptive creativity that produces similar solu-
tions to fundamental problems in widely varying environmental circumstances.
Adolf Bastian was a major figure in late nineteenth-century German ethnol-
ogy. Bastian’s concept of an underlying psychic unity of mankind was used
against the polygenist racial formulations of the time, which sought to prove that
human races were descended from different species. Boas, who had been
schooled in the German tradition, was key to the development of an American
style. He defined ethnology as ‘‘the science of the psychical phenomena of man
considered as a member of society, not as an individual’’ (from the Franz Boas
archives, American Philosophical Society Library, Philadelphia). When British
anthropology was established as an academic discipline during the first decade
of the twentieth century, it distinguished ethnology from sociology. Ethnology
was to be the psychological branch of anthropology (also called anthropogeogra-
phy), as the study of environmental influences on humanity and culture. Its pur-
pose was the comparative classification of the world’s peoples based not on
physical characteristics but on ‘‘conditions of material culture, language, and re-
ligious and social institutions and ideas’’ (Kuper, 1996, 2–3). This school tended
to favor diffusionist ideas, opposing the neo-Darwinian social evolutionists who
schematized races of man in taxonomic hierarchies.
Twentieth-century British and French ethnology (or social anthropology) devel-
oped along somewhat different lines from U.S. ethnology (or cultural anthropol-
ogy). Structuralism, functionalism, and structural-functionalism stripped away the
past-oriented approach of historical reconstruction in favor of present models of
living cultures as integrated systems. Cultures are represented as approximations
of internally defined idealized social forms suspended in a timeless ethnographic
present. This method has the advantage of self-contained explanation, not needing
to refer to factors outside a culture to make sense of its practices and beliefs.
Among its disadvantages are the possibility of yielding static, ahistorical represen-
tations. There is also the ever-present possibility that these ethnological categories,
as abstract idealized forms, are in fact more the mental constructions of the anthro-
pologist than internally verifiable ideas or principles indigenous to the cultures
under scrutiny. The structural-functionalism of Radcliffe-Brown and Evans-Pritch-
ard, at first closely tied to colonial administration, was a link between knowledge
444 | Ethnology
and power in Africa and throughout the British empire. This approach elaborates
the conceptual underpinnings of societies and cultures, stressing the importance
and complexity of social organization, kinship relations, exchange, and ritual. Dur-
ing the 1960s, the French structuralism of Claude Levi-Strauss, intellectually
rooted in the sociology of Durkheim and Mauss and the semiological approach of
Saussurean linguistics, brought a systemic, cognitive approach to the study of
myth, ritual, and kinship. Structural analyses are based on principles of binary
opposition in form and in psychological symbols.
American culture-historical ethnologists, led by Boas, relied on the inductive
methodology of carefully observing and accumulating empirical data. They devel-
oped methods of delineating the unique aspects of each particular culture, without
constructing broad, overarching, comparative theoretical frameworks. This
resulted in a wealth of ethnographic knowledge, while limiting the synthesis of
ethnological knowledge beyond the specific data pertaining to each society. The
influential culture and personality school, which included Boas’s students Ruth
Benedict, Margaret Mead, and Edward Sapir, focused on psychological factors in
the individual’s development in society, emphasizing the study of childhood,
learning, family, and socialization. Sapir emphasized that the environment affects
each person individually, and that culture is not a reified entity but the aggregate
of separate human-environment interactions. Gregory Bateson was the son of
William Bateson, a nineteenth-century biologist who coined the word genetics.
The younger Bateson advocated the adaptation of deductive natural science
Ethnology | 445
References
Clifford, James. 1986. The Predicament of Culture. Cambridge: Harvard University
Press.
Geertz, Clifford. 1973. The Interpretation of Cultures. New York: Basic.
Hymes, Dell, ed. 1972. Reinventing Anthropology. New York: Pantheon.
Kuper, Adam. 1996. Anthropology and Anthropologists: The Modern British School,
3rd ed. London: Routledge.
Lowie, Robert H. 1937. The History of Ethnological Theory. New York: Holt, Rine-
hart and Winston.
Sahlins, Marshall. 1972. Stone Age Economics. Chicago: Aldine.
Steward, Julian H. 1955. Theory of Culture Change: The Methodology of Multilinear
Evolution. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Ethnomusicology
The study of music that stresses the importance of music in and as culture. Eth-
nomusicology holds that music takes meaning from its cultural context. The
term, which contracts ethnology with musicology, was first used to denote the
Ethnomusicology | 447
the discipline’s central feature. Two technical developments made the compari-
son of oral-tradition music feasible: the invention of the phonograph by Thomas
Edison in 1877 and the development of a pitch measurement system by the Eng-
lish physicist and phonetician Alexander J. Ellis. The phonograph facilitated the
collection of music data, previously a Herculean task limited by one’s musical
ear and access to cooperative performers. Ellis’s cents system of measurement,
outlined in his 1885 article ‘‘On the Musical Scales of Various Nations,’’ made
possible a more objective comparison of pitch elements based on the division of
the octave into 1,200 equal units.
Comparison as practiced by Erich M. von Hornbostel of the Berlin Phono-
gramm-Archiv, along with his students and colleagues, was concerned largely with
analysis of music elements such as scale tones, intervals, melodic movement, and
rhythms. Based on analyses of recordings and musical instruments collected by co-
lonial ethnologists, these studies produced grand, if not grandiose, classification
schemes. The most renowned sought to illustrate global distribution of musical
styles and artifacts. Important works of this period were Hornbostel’s Blasquinten
(blown fifths) theory relating the structure of musical scales, now discredited (see
Kunst’s ‘‘Around von Hornbostel’s Theory of Cycle of Blown Fifths’’ for discus-
sion), and Hornbostel and Curt Sachs’ ‘‘Classification of Music Instruments,’’ pub-
lished in 1914, still a standard for musical instrument classification.
Comparison also infused much early ethnomusicological research in the United
States. From the nineteenth century, scholars working on Native American music,
most conspicuously Alice Cunningham Fletcher and Frances Densmore, created
monographs on the music of individual Native American cultures. Stemming, in
part, from the Austrian Kulturhistorische Schule (culture history school), students
of Franz Boas, however, sought to organize Native American cultures into
geographic areas established by shared cultural traits. George Herzog, who had
worked with both Hornbostel and Boas, applied the notion of culture areas in his
‘‘The Yuman Musical Style’’ (1928). Helen Roberts used this approach to classify
Native American musical styles and instruments in her 1936 book Musical Areas
in Aboriginal North America.
Comparison was explicit in researching the relationships between African
American musical practices and those found in Africa, seen most notably in the
work of Melville Herskovits and Richard Waterman. Alan Lomax’s research
methodology of cantometrics, exemplified in the 1968 publication Folk Song
Style and Culture, linked musical style with social organization and took com-
parison as its central feature.
The use of the term comparative musicology declined in the 1940s, to be
replaced eventually by ethnomusicology. The new term gained credence with
Kunst’s call to rename the discipline and was institutionalized with the establish-
ment of the Society for Ethnomusicology in 1955. Coupled with this change in
labels, there was a sharp decline in work concerned with cross-cultural compari-
son. In this new milieu, comparison was criticized and seen as premature until
more detailed, accurate descriptions of individual cultures existed. Alan Merriam,
in his 1964 book The Anthropology of Music, admonished much early research as
considerably less than systematic in its use of comparison. In a 1966 review of
Merriam’s book, John Blacking added that comparison could yield spurious
results in that superficial musical elements might seem similar but be based on
different cultural models of behavior and belief. Such discussions corresponded to
a realization that each culture’s music deserved study in its own right, in terms
appropriate to that culture and built around methods and theories that emerged
from the study of that culture and its music.
Early comparative studies invariably focused on music expressions as artifacts,
with little concern for the context of their existence. The shift toward the view of
music as part of culture stressed methods of fieldwork, thereby making fieldwork
a defining feature of ethnomusicology. Indeed, Bruno Nettl suggested in The
Study of Ethnomusicology that a history of ethnomusicology could be written as a
history of fieldwork. From the 1890s to about 1930, the collection of artifacts was
accomplished with only short periods in the field. Data usually were collected by
people other than the music researcher, with the exception of the fieldwork-based
research by Americans on Native American music. During and beyond this pe-
riod, some scholars were equally concerned with collecting and preserving entire
music repertories. Scholars feared that much of the music of the world was on the
verge of extinction, and as a result, major archives of recordings were begun in
Germany and the United States. The next period, roughly from 1920 to 1960,
stressed research for extended periods in small communities. Studies from this pe-
riod took a broader concept of fieldwork, in which the collection of music
450 | Ethnomusicology
artifacts was coupled with a concern for the complete context of any music’s exis-
tence. Since the 1950s, parallel to the conviction that music expressions are im-
portant facets and indicators of a culture, there has been a further shift toward
participant observation and more involvement with music. Moreover, interest in
the music of complex and urban societies, where mediated forms of music such
as radio broadcasts and sound records must be considered, has brought new meth-
ods of fieldwork while maintaining the significance of the participant observation
method for ethnomusicology.
Since the late 1950s, ethnomusicological activity often has been characterized
as oriented toward the methods and theories of either anthropology or historical
musicology. Alan Merriam, the foremost champion of the anthropological orien-
tation in ethnomusicology, suggested in The Anthropology of Music that the label
ethnomusicology, combining ethnology with musicology, implies this division.
Merriam drew upon methods and theories of anthropology, notably participant
observation with extended periods of fieldwork and the theories of structuralism
and functionalism. He argued as early as 1960 that ethnomusicology should be
concerned with music in culture, later refined to music as culture, and he explic-
itly joined music to its cultural context in The Anthropology of Music through a
definition of music that connected musical sound and musical behavior to a cul-
ture’s beliefs and concepts of music. Mantle Hood, though sharing with Merriam
a disapproval of the early comparative research and an endorsement of extended
periods of fieldwork, was the strongest advocate for the musicological orienta-
tion to ethnomusicology. Hood’s approach centered research around the mastery
of non-Western music performance—what he called in 1960 ‘‘bi-musicality’’—
and he argued that training in performance, long basic to the European art music
tradition, was equally applicable to the study of non-Western music. One compo-
nent of this method was the development of a conservatory of music at the Uni-
versity of California, Los Angeles, Institute of Ethnomusicology (now the
Department of Ethnomusicology), with artists representing cultures from around
the world. Since the 1970s, there has been a general move away from interest in
artifacts such as music compositions and genres toward an interest in processes.
This change in emphasis has drawn the musicological and anthropological orien-
tations within ethnomusicology closer together.
In Europe during the nineteenth century, research into local, oral traditions
was driven by an interest in creating nationalist music fortified and sustained
through materials from peasant cultures. Composers such as Bela Bartok and
Zoltan Kodaly working in Hungary, Romania, and Transylvania, and Percy
Grainger in England drew upon indigenous folk music to create new art music
compositions. Similarly, folk music enthusiasts, collectors, and analysts such as
Cecil Sharp and Maud Karpeles researched the music of England and its immi-
grant offspring in the United States. Sharp’s interest in melodic analysis and
Ethnomusicology | 451
the wide range of research and activities that now fall under the rubric
ethnomusicology.
Leslie C. Gay Jr.
See Also Ballad; Broadside Ballad; Cantometrics; Folksong, Lyric; Folksong, Narrative;
Hymn, Folk; Musical Instrument, Folk.
References
Aubert, Laurent. 2007. The Music of the Other: New Challenges for Ethnomusicology
in a Global Age. Burlington, VT: Ashgate.
Barz, Gregory, and Timothy J. Cooley, eds. 2008. Shadows in the Field: New Per-
spectives for Fieldwork in Ethnomusicology. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Behague, Gerard. 1991. Reflections on the Ideological History of Latin American
Ethnomusicology. In Comparative Musicology and Anthropology of Music, eds. B.
Nettl and P. V. Bohlman. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Blacking, John. 1966. Review of The Anthropology of Music. Current Anthropology
7: 218.
Bohlman, Philip V. 1988. The Study of Folk Music in the Modern World. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Bronson, Bertrand. 1959 1972. The Traditional Tunes of the Child Ballads with
Their Texts According to the Extant Records of Great Britain and America. Princeton,
NJ: Princeton University Press.
Christensen, Dieter. 1991. Erich M. von Hornbostel, Carl Stumpf, and the Institution-
alization of Comparative Musicology. In Comparative Musicology and Anthropology of
Music, eds. B. Nettl and P. V. Bohlman. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Ellis, Alexander J. 1885. On the Musical Scales of Various Nations. Journal of the
Society of Arts 33: 485 527.
Herzog, George. 1928. The Yuman Musical Style. Journal of American Folklore 41:
183 231.
Hood, Mantle. 1960. The Challenge of ‘‘Bi-musicology.’’ Ethnomusicology 4: 55 59.
Hood, Mantle. 1963. Music, the Unknown. In Musicology, ed. Mantle Hood. Engle-
wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Kunst, Jaap. 1948. Around von Hornbostel’s Theory of Cycle of Blown Fifths.
Mededeling 76: 3 35.
Kunst, Jaap. [1950] 1959. Ethnomusicology: A Study of Its Nature, Its Problems,
Methods and Representative Personalities to Which Is Added a Bibliography. The
Hague: M. Nijhoff.
List, George. 1979. Ethnomusicology: A Discipline Defined. Ethnomusicology
23(1): 1 4.
Lomax, Alan. 1968. Folk Song Style and Culture. Washington, DC: American Asso-
ciation for the Advancement of Science.
McAllester, David P. 1963. Ethnomusicology: The Field and the Society. Ethnomusi-
cology 7(3): 182 186.
Ethnopoetics | 453
Ethnopoetics
References
Bar-Itzhak, Haya. 2001. Jewish Poland: Legends of Origin, Ethnopoetics and Leg-
endary Chronicles. Detroit: Wayne State University.
Fine, Elizabeth C. 1984. The Folklore Text: From Performance to Print. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Hymes, Dell. 1992. Use All There Is to Use. In On the Translation of Native Ameri-
can Literatures, ed. Brian Swann. Washington DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Hymes, Dell. 2003. Now I Know Only So Far: Essays in Ethnopoetics. Lincoln: Uni-
versity of Nebraska Press.
Hymes, Dell. 2004. ‘‘In Vain I Tried To Tell You’’: Essays in Native American Eth-
nopoetics. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.
Hymes, Virginia. 1987. Warm Springs Sahaptin Narrative Analysis. In Native Ameri-
can Discourse: Poetics and Rhetoric, eds. Joel Sherzer and Anthony C. Woodbury.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Sammons, Kay, and Joel Sherzer, eds. 2000. Translating Native Latin American
Verbal Art: Ethnopoetics and Ethnography of Speaking. Washington: Smithsonian Insti-
tution Press.
Sherzer, Joel, and Anthony C. Woodbury. 1987. Native American Discourse: Poetics
and Rhetoric. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1983. The Spoken Word and the Work of Interpretation. Philadel-
phia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1990. From Voice and Ear to Hand and Eye. Journal of American
Folklore 103(408): 133 156.
Etiological Narrative | 455
Etiological Narrative
An explanation of how things came to be the way they are or were at a given time
or under certain conditions. The adjective etiology is derived from a late Latin
and Greek composite word: aetiologia, meaning ‘‘cause description’’ (atia, cause
þ logia, description); it is used in a number of fields to signify the science of
causes or origins (e.g., in medicine to refer to the origins of a specific disease).
In folklore, the term etiology has been applied frequently in conjunction with
other folkloristic concepts to designate the explanatory function of an item, com-
monly in narrative form. A story may belong to any of a number of genres, depend-
ing on the story’s form, style, and contents, as well as on the narrator’s intent for
telling it (or the tale’s function). Generally speaking, a traditional account of how a
thing originated would be perceived as factual and taken seriously by narrator and
listeners. Thus, etiological narratives are typically classified as falling within one
of two main categories: belief (religious-sacred, mythological) and historical
(legend, ethnic history, historical anecdotes). These two categories often overlap;
such narratives also appear in instructional didactic roles (e.g., as moralistic fables
or religious exempla). Laurits Bdker cites such Germanic terms as Aetio fable,
A˚tiologische sage, A˚tiologische m€ archen, and A˚tiologische tierfabel.
An etiological belief narrative may be labeled a myth or sacred story (e.g., bib-
lical, Koranic)—myth being a belief whose validity is not accepted by the person
applying the term. Consequently, Stith Thompson classifies the bulk of etiologi-
cal themes as ‘‘Mythological’’; Hasan El-Shamy expands the scope to ‘‘Mytho-
logical [and related belief] motifs.’’
Examples of such motifs include the following: A20, ‘‘Origin of the creator’’;
A1 10, ‘‘Origin of the gods’’; A5 10, ‘‘Origin of the culture-hero (demigod)’’;
A980, ‘‘Origin of particular places’’; A 1335, ‘‘Origin of death’’; A1370, ‘‘Origin
of mental and moral characteristics’’; A1610, ‘‘Origin of various tribes’’; and
A2221, ‘‘Animal characteristics reward for pious act.’’ Examples of legendary
(historically possible) motifs are: A1464.1.1, ‘‘First poetry composed in imitation
of tone of hammer on anvil,’’ and Z21.1. ‘‘Origin of chess.’’ Meanwhile, the for-
mulaic theme to which such a tale belongs has been recently designated as new
Motif Z19.3§, ‘‘Etiological tales: ‘that-is-why’-tales’’ (the sign § designates addi-
tions to Thompson’s motifs).
A number of etiological tales appear cross-culturally as tale types. Among
these are a few animal tales, such as ‘‘Why Dogs Look One Another under the
Tail’’ (AT 200A) and ‘‘Why Dog Chases Hare’’ (AT 200C*). Infrequently, an eti-
ological tale may be an ordinary folktale (compare with M€ archen), such as
‘‘Why the Sea Is Salt: Magic Salt Mill’’ (AT 565); it may also appear as a for-
mula tale, as in the case of ‘‘Origin of Chess’’ (AT 2009). The majority, however,
are cited under the category of religious tales (AT 750–849), such as ‘‘Origin of
456 | Euhemerism
Physical Defects among Mankind’’ (AT 758A), ‘‘Mushroom from Peter’s Spit-
tle’’ (AT 774L), and ‘‘Why Big Trees Have Small Fruit’’ (AT 774P).
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Belief Tale; Folktale; Legend; Myth.
References
Bdker, Laurits. 1965. Folk Literature (Germanic). International Dictionary of Re-
gional European Ethnology and Folklore, Vol. 2. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde.
Christiansen, Reidar Th. 1958. The Migratory Legend. Helsinki: Academia Scientia-
rum Fennica.
El-Shamy, Hasan. 1995. Folk Traditions of the Arab World: A Guide to Motif Classi-
fication. 2 vols. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1955 1958. The Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. 6 vols. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
von Sydow, C. W. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and
Bagger.
Euhemerism
References
Dorson, Richard M. 1971. American Folklore and the Historian. Chicago: University
of Chicago Press.
Feldman, Burton, and Robert D. Richardson, eds. 1972. The Rise of Modern Mythol-
ogy, 1680 1860. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Seznec, Jean. 1953. The Survival of the Pagan Gods: The Mythological Tradition
and Its Place in Renaissance Humanism and Art. Trans. Barbara F. Sessions. Princeton,
NJ: Princeton University Press.
Vansina, Jan. 1965. Oral Tradition: A Study in Historical Methodology. Chicago:
Aldine.
Vitaliano, Dorothy. 1973. Legends of the Earth: Their Geologic Origins. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Evolutionary Theory
That theory that proposed that human culture evolved through stages over time
according to a uniform and logical process. This theory was a mainstay of folk-
lore and anthropological studies in the late nineteenth and early twentieth centu-
ries, especially in Great Britain. It related to folklore in that folk traditions were
458 | Evolutionary Theory
seen as ‘‘survivals’’ from earlier times that could help in understanding earlier
culture and the development of culture.
As the science of anthropology developed in the mid-nineteenth century, it
adopted an evolutionary paradigm. Although Charles Darwin (1809–1882) did
not originate thinking about evolution, his ideas in natural history were influen-
tial. Especially with his second landmark book, The Descent of Man (1871),
Darwin—as well Thomas Henry Huxley (1825–1895), who played a key role in
making known and defending Darwin—put human beings into the context of bi-
ological processes by establishing that humans did not remain apart from physi-
cal evolution. Knowledge of fossils and prehistory also was expanding in this
period, and physical anthropology was developing as a field of study. The
knowledge gained in these areas of study provided a new scientific basis for
indicating not only the antiquity of the human race but also a continuous process
of human advancement. As the science of anthropology took shape, its propo-
nents logically looked to evolution (though evolution remained a controversial
idea in society at large) as a theory that could unify their endeavors, for those
who shaped the science of anthropology sought to understand the origin and his-
torical development of humanity and of such social institutions as law, religion,
and morality.
Anthropologists came to see human societies as evolving through stages, gen-
erally referred to as savagery, barbarism, and, finally, civilization. The American
Lewis Henry Morgan (1818–1881) argued, for example, in Ancient Society
(1877), that humans were a unitary group and followed certain logical steps in
their advancement. He further divided the first two stages of development into
lower, middle, and upper and associated particular developments with each stage
(such as the use of pottery with the stage of lower barbarism).
Folklore became an aspect of evolutionary theory primarily through the writ-
ings of Sir Edward Burnett Tylor (1832–1917), commonly regarded as the princi-
pal founder of cultural anthropology, and his disciples, notably Andrew Lang
(1844–1912). Tylor sought to show that culture evolved and to establish a com-
parative method for examining that process of development. In part, he was
attempting to refute the positions of certain religiously oriented thinkers who
argued that some humans had, in fact, devolved from a higher state to a lower
one. This conception ultimately went back to the biblical story of a fall from
grace but was primarily the result of an upsurge in the European Christian mis-
sionary activity that followed upon the expansion of colonial empires. For mis-
sionary work, it became useful to believe not only that the ‘‘savages’’ who were
being evangelized had degenerated but also that, as a result, they were incapable
of spiritual progress without the help of the ‘‘superior’’ white race. Tylor relent-
lessly amassed evidence to prove the consistent evolution of culture and to bol-
ster the optimism of those who believed in the inevitability of human progress.
Evolutionary Theory | 459
Tylor thought that archaeology could fill in some of the gaps in the history of
early humanity but that it could provide knowledge only about material culture,
not about the mental and spiritual sides of human development. To fill in that
particular gap, ‘‘survivals’’ were to be examined, compared, and analyzed. Like
Morgan, he believed that nothing happens but in logical sequence. In terms of
material culture, all evidence pointed to evolution. None of his contemporaries,
he reasoned, would use an arrow as the ultimate weapon, and one could readily
see how the bow was replaced by the gun and how simple tools were replaced by
more complex ones. The same was true of nonmaterial aspects of culture, he
asserted. Tylor began by asking how it was that a whole range of customs,
beliefs, and processes that did not seem sensible for present-day culture nonethe-
less existed. The answer, he said, was because these were ‘‘survivals’’ from ear-
lier cultural stages (just as antique bows and arrows were left over from earlier
days). These beliefs and customs made perfect sense in their own historical con-
text, and though society in effect evolved around them as a result of ‘‘sound judg-
ment and practical reason,’’ the beliefs and customs remained (because of some
‘‘efficient cause,’’ such as psychological dependence) and could guide us in
understanding that earlier context. According to Tylor, survivals were ‘‘pro-
cesses, customs, opinions . . . which have been carried on by force of habit into a
new state of society different from that in which they had their original home,
and they thus remain as proofs of an older condition of culture out of which a
newer has evolved’’ (from his 1871 work, Primitive Culture). Tylor probably
took a clue from the work of earlier scholars and antiquarians who had estab-
lished that folk traditions were ‘‘remains’’ or ‘‘relics’’ of earlier times and hence
460 | Evolutionary Theory
historical documents. Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm, for example, had argued that
the folktales in their famous collection were among the last surviving pieces of
an older Germanic culture. But Tylor established a more systematic and more
informed and sophisticated conception within the grand framework of evolution.
Though Tylor looked at a wide range of cultural facts (particularly in Primitive
Culture), many of the aspects of culture he examined were folkloric elements, for
these often involved actions or ideas that seemed not to be fully rational in terms
of the perspective of the educated elite of the late nineteenth century and that also
could be presumed archaic. In looking at culture, Tylor developed a comparative
method that involved fixing upon a particular presumed survival and then examin-
ing whatever information was available on manifestations of culture that appeared
to be similar and related. Information might be drawn from older written materials,
travel literature, the accounts of human behavior (which were multiplying as the
result of observations made in colonial contexts), or other sources. The information
might be about the mores of historical peoples, newly encountered, contemporary
‘‘primitives’’ (who had not yet evolved as fully as had civilized peoples), or Euro-
pean peasants (who, of course, were coming to be considered the prime reposito-
ries of folklore). Once the information had been amassed and compared,
conclusions could be drawn as to what was revealed about earlier culture, how ear-
lier humans thought and acted, and how certain aspects of culture had developed.
Tylor’s best-known analysis, which explained a custom very widespread even
today, aptly illustrates his method—his explanation of why we say ‘‘God bless
you’’ (or something similar) when someone near us sneezes. Looking to a num-
ber of cultural contexts, he noted various similar customs. A member of the Zulu
(who believe themselves surrounded by both good and evil spirits) said, when he
sneezed, ‘‘I am now blessed; the ancestral sprit is with me,’’ and asked for favors.
He believed that a good sprit had entered his body. At one time in Guinea, when
someone important sneezed, others would fall to their knees, kiss the earth, clap
hands, and wish each other prosperity. Pacific islanders considered a sneeze a
bad omen. Among the Amakosa, a sneeze was an occasion to call upon divine
ancestor spirits. The Zulu also saw in repeated yawning a sign of approaching
spirit possession. Persians ascribed yawning to demoniac possession, and modern
Muslims, Tylor added, avoided yawning because the devil could leap into one’s
mouth when it was opened so wide. A Jewish proverb said, ‘‘Open not thy mouth
to Satan,’’ Celtic sneezers might be carried off by fairies, and members of a cer-
tain religious sect would spit and blow their noses to expel evil spirits that they
might have breathed in. And the Zulu saw a sick person’s sneeze as a sign of
impending recovery. This compilation of information on oral lore, customs, and
beliefs indicated to Tylor that at an earlier stage of culture, men and women
believed that spirits could enter and leave the human body through the facial ori-
fices. Though we have evolved beyond such a belief, its vestiges survive,
Evolutionary Theory | 461
argued, in a number of publications, that his colleagues were not sufficiently tied
to specific historical or geographic contexts, implying that to be concerned only
with cultural evolution in the broadest terms was to deal with the development of
human institutions too vaguely.
As the twentieth century moved ahead, the evolutionary perspective in folk-
lore studies declined in interest and importance. Folklorists and anthropologists
increasingly realized that the equivalences that had been drawn between customs
and beliefs in widely diverse cultures had often been based on tenuous similar-
ities. Careful fieldwork frequently showed that seemingly similar cultural prac-
tices had very different functions and meanings for different groups and thus
really could not be compared to yield evolutionary explanations. Further, written
sources that described various cultures had often been accepted uncritically and
in fact presented very incomplete or misunderstood data. In general, particularly
because of the trend toward fieldwork (which gave individual researchers pro-
found insights into contemporary, whole societies), there was a move away from
historical and genetic explanations and toward functional and symbolic ones.
Frank de Caro
See Also Anthropological Approach; Comparative Mythology; Myth-Ritual Theory.
References
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1968. Peasant Customs and Savage Myths: Readings from
the British Folklorists. 2 vols. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Dorson, Richard M. 1968. The British Folklorists: A History. London: Routledge and
Kegan Paul.
Evans-Pritchard, Edward. 1981. A History of Anthropological Thought. New York:
Basic Books.
Harris, Marvin. 1968. The Rise of Anthropological Theory: A History of Theories of
Culture. New York: Thomas Y. Crowell.
Hodgen, Margaret T. 1936. The Doctrine of Survivals. London: Allenson.
Lowie, Robert H. 1937. The History of Ethnological Theory. New York: Holt, Rine-
hart, and Winston.
Voget, Fred W. 1975. A History of Ethnology. New York: Holt, Rinehart, and
Winston.
Exorcism
with some type of divination, which identifies the spirit and determines propi-
tious signs for a cure. Both exorcist and patient typically put themselves into a
hypnotic state by means of drumming, dancing, and various other forms of either
sensory stimulus or sensory deprivation.
The exorcist expels the spirit not through his or her own efforts but through an
appeal to a higher authority. He or she typically talks to the demon rather than
the patient and tries to induce it, by threats or commands and in the name of the
friendly deity or spirit, to leave the possessed person. The demon (or demons)
may balk or even strike a deal, demanding something in return for leaving the
victim, and it is not uncommon for the exorcist to profit from such transactions.
Cures by exorcism may be quick and efficient, although in the Christian church,
cures by a single application of exorcism appear to have been rare; more often,
exorcisms have lasted days, weeks, months, and even years. If the first attempt at
exorcism is unsuccessful, the methods used may become more extreme. Some-
times, patient and healer negotiate the cure. Carmen Blacker describes a Japa-
nese healer telling a patient that she will have to undergo the ‘‘cold water
austerity’’ night and morning for twenty-one days; then, when the patient rejects
this solution, the healer proposes the recitation of the Heart Sutra every night at
half past midnight.
Often, the exorcism ceremony involves a laying on of hands. In the Japanese
Mahikari cult, the hands are held up, palms out, and thought to exert a curing
force on the subject. Here, as in many other belief systems, if the subject
becomes physically sick and vomits, a purification is believed to be taking place.
Historically, outside observers have often viewed curing rituals by exorcism
as a kind of flimflam intended to bedazzle gullible subjects and spectators. Such
a view supposes the curer to exist in another belief system than the audience.
As Seth and Ruth Leacock have pointed out in their study of an Afro-Brazilian
cult, ‘‘Far from being a ceremony designed to mystify the uninitiated, a curing
ritual is a performance before a knowledgeable and critical audience.’’ More-
over, some contemporary scholars have recognized that, just as modern medi-
cine has advantages over traditional medicine, the converse is also true.
Winston Davis has observed that ‘‘although [modern medicine] can diagnose
terminal illnesses with terrifying accuracy, it may offer no hope at all for their
cure.’’ Traditional curing, involving the exorcism of spirits, virtually always
offers the possibility of a cure; it is steadfastly optimistic. And it is difficult to
deny the evidence from modern scholars, such as William Sargant, that a good
deal of real curing, in particular of psychological trauma, does take place in cur-
ing ceremonies.
Paul Barber
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Medicine, Folk; Possession; Shamanism.
464 | Exorcism
References
Blacker, Carmen. [1975] 1986. The Catalpa Bow: A Study of Shamanistic Practices
in Japan. London: Unwin Paperbacks.
Davis, Winston Bradley. 1980. Dojo: Magic and Exorcism in Modern Japan. Stanford,
CA: Stanford University Press.
Kemp, Patience. 1935. Healing Ritual: Studies in the Technique and Tradition of the
Southern Slavs. London: Faber and Faber.
Leacock, Seth, and Ruth Leacock. 1972. Spirits of the Deep: A Study of an Afro-
Brazilian Cult. Garden City, NY: Doubleday Natural History Press.
Sargant, William. 1974. The Mind Possessed: A Physiology of Possession, Mysticism
and Faith Healing. New York: Lippincott.
Walker, Sheila S. 1972. Ceremonial Spirit Possession in Africa and Afro-America.
Leiden, Netherlands: E. J. Brill.
F
Fabulate
A migratory legend that does not reflect personal experience but instead is told
principally for entertainment. Coined in 1934 by C. W. von Sydow, the term fabu-
late was intended as a contrast to memorate, a narrative reflecting an individual’s
contact with the supernatural. Fabulates, Sydow said, may have some elements
based in experience, ‘‘yet they do not immediately come from these, but from a
mental image that has originated from elements of this type in which they, so-to-
say, crystallized.’’ To this extent, he concluded, the events narrated in the fabulate
‘‘could not have actually happened in the form that they take in the telling; they
were shaped much more by the creative art of the folk’’ (von Sydow 1978).
Sydow used the term fabulate to refer to a variety of narratives, many of which
would be classified as legends in the Anglo-American system. But his sense of the
term extended beyond the belief legend to jocular narratives, such as the ‘‘person
fabulates’’ told about Germanic trickster Till Eulenspiegel—these would more
likely be termed Schwanks or jocular tales today. Sydow’s vague sense of the con-
cept’s defining trait, Juha Pentik€ainen has noted, led succeeding folklorists to use
the term in confusingly diverse senses. It has been used as everything from a
global term for all prose narration to a more judgmental label for a story that
‘‘clearly contains invented, empirically unbelievable elements’’ (von Sydow 1978).
This emphasis on the notion that fabulates were objectively untrue has raised
opposition. Such a claim assumes that truth-falsehood claims, particularly about
supernatural events, can be resolved objectively by folklorists. So the term fabu-
late (like the related term urban legend) may imply the collector’s belief that the
teller is ignorant or irrational.
But Sydow’s essential distinction between stories as stories and stories as evi-
dence for belief has some basis. Gillian Bennett has contrasted urban legends told
with conviction and those told more for their value as narratives, and she found a
large number of rhetorical differences. For her, legends told ‘‘for laughs’’ may be
morphologically identical to folktales, and so there is value to identifying them
and considering them separately from narratives told ‘‘for true.’’ However, the
term fabulate then becomes a descriptive term appropriate only to a given per-
formed text; given changes in context, the same informant may relate the same
events ‘‘for laughs’’ or ‘‘for true.’’ Judgments about the empirical truth behind the
narrative simply become irrelevant.
465
466 | Faerie and Fairy Lore
Pentik€ainen, like most European scholars, restricts the term fabulate to narra-
tives that subordinate matters of belief to the artistic form of the performance
itself. Hence, the fabulate is essentially a narrative developed and standardized
by the narrator’s desire to tell an entertaining story. Characters included may take
roles or perform actions that are more in line with characters in M€ archen than in
belief legends. Consequently, the fabulate is a better guide to a culture’s story-
telling aesthetic than to living folk belief.
Bill Ellis
See Also Legend.
References
Bennett, Gillian. 1988. Legend: Performance and Truth. In Monsters with Iron Teeth,
eds. Gillian Bennett and Paul Smith. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1971. American Folk Legend: A Symposium. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha. 1973. Belief, Memorate, and Legend. Folklore Forum 6: 217 241.
von Sydow, Carl Wilhelm. [1948] 1978. Selected Papers on Folklore. New York:
Arno Press.
within prehistoric burial places, as with the Irish sidhe (‘‘people of the mounds’’),
within mountains, as with the ‘‘Little People’’ of Mount Kilimanjaro, within caves,
forests, or even underwater. Wherever fairyland, or faerie, is located, it is a world
without change, decay, illness, or aging, and a realm without time—or rather, with a
sense of time different from the human, as one fairy day may be 100 mortal years.
Elfin behavior is best described as capricious and amoral. Fairies love and
reward cleanliness and order, yet have no qualms about stealing from mortals;
they are known to take the ‘‘goodness’’ or essence out of human food. Yet they
are generous and reward mortals who aid them. Passionate about protecting their
privacy, they severely punish those who spy on them or visit them uninvited, yet
they are capable of great hospitality. As befits creatures linked to fertility, they
are often wanton and highly sexual in nature; they take mortal lovers at whim
and can literally destroy them with amorous actions. They must always be treated
with caution and, above all, with politeness and respect. At their worst, they are
capable of considerable evil; they can paralyze with elf-shot or fairy-stroke,
cause madness, and kill humans. Many of their actions, however, fall between
these categories. They love mischief and are fond of pranks.
Fairy infertility may explain their kidnapping of human infants, substitution of
their own imperfect offspring, and frequent abduction of women to serve as mid-
wives, nurses, or breeders. Tales of changed children and of fairy changelings
abound. Other frequently told stories deal with the love between mortals and
fairies. These often follow patterns similar to tales of animal brides and animal
grooms. There are numerous accounts of mortals visiting the fairy realm and a
host of homier legends of fairies asking for and gaining human aid.
However, fairy tales (M€ archen) and tales about fairies (often legends or memo-
rates) are not the same thing. Nursery tales often lack fairies, and accounts of
encounters with them are often devoid of the elements of M€ archen. Moreover, the
fairies in Geoffrey Chaucer’s Canterbury Tales and William Shakespeare’s plays
are amalgams of folklore and literary conventions. The literary fairy tale or conte
de fees of French seventeenth-century society compounds the mixture both by
giving the ‘‘fairy tale’’ its name and by adding to the ranks of supernatural crea-
tures. The authored French stories of the seventeenth century are the sources of
the benevolent fairy godmother, and of aristocratic, powerful female supernatural
creatures whose magic can make or break the fortunes—especially the loves—of
mortals. Utilized and rendered mystical in the literary fairy tales of the German
Romantics, fairy creatures passed into the mainstream culture of Europe.
Even in the twenty-first century, fairy lore is not yet dead. The resemblance of
the small grey creatures from UFOs to the fairies has given the transformed elfin
races a new and only slightly different life.
Carole G. Silver
See Also Celtic Folklore and Mythology.
Fairy Tale Heroes | 469
References
Briggs, Katharine M. 1967. The Fairies in English Tradition and Literature. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
Silver, Carole G. 1999. Strange and Secret Peoples: Fairies and Victorian Con-
sciousness. New York: Oxford University Press.
of scholars have revealed, the Grimms not only tidied up their collected tales for
publication, but Wilhelm, especially, also progressively rewrote them for subse-
quent editions of the Kinder- und Hausm€ archen (Children’s and Household Tales,
2 vols., 1812–1815; first translated into English in 1884). This complex work is
now widely referred to in English simply as Grimms’ Fairy Tales and is consid-
ered the touchstone of the fairy tale genre. However, in editing the tales for publi-
cation, the Grimms usually excised or ameliorated suggestions of cannibalism,
sexuality, and unmotivated evil, all well and truly part of the folkloric versions of
these stories. Heroes who appeared in the original stories unnamed were given af-
fectionate names, like Hansel and Gretel. Motives were created to account for the
often cruel and evil actions of characters, especially parents. The infamous
‘‘wicked stepmother’’ was introduced as a substitute for the natural mother as the
frequent villain of stories. Wicked stepmothers existed in tradition, but the
Grimms, apparently unable or unwilling to deal with the notion that a ‘‘natural’’
Fairy Tale Heroes | 471
Goldilocks
In its most widely known version, the tale of the little girl who blunders into the house
of the three bears, eating their porridge, sitting in their chairs, and sleeping in their
beds, is one of the most unsatisfying of all heroine stories, lacking both motivation and
a proper resolution. This has not worried generations of parents, children, and publish-
ers of children’s literature or makers of pantomimes in the slightest. Goldilocks is one
of the best-loved nursery stories of the modern era, with the heroine’s preference for
the food or furniture of the baby bear ensuring its popularity with young children.
The origin of what we now know as ‘‘Goldilocks and the Three Bears’’ is usually
traced to a Scots story in which three bears are disturbed by a female fox, or
vixen, who is then eaten by the bears, but the basic elements of ‘‘Goldilocks and
the Three Bears’’ are drawn from the common pool of European folktale. The
apparently abandoned house in the woods, the invasion of its privacy, and the insis-
tent three-fold structure of the story are widespread motifs and devices of folktale
and are adapted to good effect for this much-told tale.
In its modern form, the story of Goldilocks and the three bears can be traced to
the early nineteenth century and a book by the English poet Robert Southey (The
Doctor, 1837). The heroine—a small woman, not a girl called Goldilocks—escapes
the wrath of the bears by jumping out the window. Southey’s story offers no further
information about what might have happened to her. Southey may have based his
version on an earlier tradition, known to have been in existence in 1831 (and almost
certainly before that), in which an elderly woman takes the Goldilocks role. Joseph
Cundall made further changes to the tale between 1849 and 1904, when in his vari-
ous retellings of the tale, he first made the heroine a small girl and then successively
named and renamed her Silver-Hair, Silver-Locks, Golden-Hair, and finally Goldilocks.
These changes were complemented by the Mother Goose’s Fairy Tales anthology of
1878, which changed the Great Huge Bear, Middle Bear, and Little Small Wee Bear
into Father Bear, Mother Bear, and Baby Bear. The cumulative effect of these
changes was to render what was originally a far more fearsome oral tale into a rea-
sonably comfortable family story that, with its suspense and unrealized hint of men-
ace, made it ideally suited for the nursery, where it remains stubbornly to this day.
Graham Seal
By contrast to the other vast world of folk narrative outside the genre of the
fairy tale, in these stories heroines outnumber heroes. Many fairy tale heroes do
not even have a proper name and generally play out their pre-plotted roles auto-
matically and often without much grasp of what is going on or what is at stake.
Nevertheless, either despite or because of their stupidity, and often with the more
than magnanimous assistance of bands of helpers, they win through in the end,
getting the girl, the gold, and the kingdom. But although the heroine, through the
agency of the hero, shares in this good fortune, she rarely does anything heroic.
She is generally the object of actions carried out by others, good or bad, and is
frequently humiliated in the course of the story, Cinderella being one example of
many. Those seeking heroines with greater volition will not often be satisfied by
the fairy tale but will seek out the more full-blooded traditions of the folktale.
Graham Seal
See Also Cinderella; Grimm Brothers; Hero/Heroine, Folk; Jack and the Beanstalk; Little
Red Riding Hood; Rapunzel; Sleeping Beauty; Snow White.
References
Bacchilega, C. 1997. Postmodern Fairy Tales: Gender and Narrative Strategies.
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Bottigheimer, R., ed. 1986. Fairy Tales and Society: Illusion, Allusion, and Para-
digm. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Dundes, A. 1986. Fairy Tales from a Folkloristic Perspective. In Fairy Tales and
Society: Illusion, Allusion, and Paradigm, ed. R. Bottigheimer. Philadelphia: University
of Pennsylvania Press, pp. 259 270.
Ellis, J. 1983. One Fairy Story Too Many: The Brothers Grimm and Their Tales.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Hallett, M., and B. Karasek, eds. 1996. Folk and Fairy Tales. Ontario: Broadview Press.
L€uthi, M. [1975] 1984. The Fairytale Hero. In The Fairytale as Art Form and Por-
trait of Man. Trans. J. Erickson. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, pp. 135 144.
McGlathery, J., ed. 1988. The Brothers Grimm and Folktale. Urbana and Chicago:
University of Illinois Press.
Opie, I. and P. 1974. The Classic Fairy Tales. London: Oxford University Press, pp.
199 205.
Tatar, M. 1986. Born Yesterday: Heroes in Grimms’ Tales. In Fairy Tales and Soci-
ety: Illusion, Allusion, and Paradigm, ed. R. Bottigheimer. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press, pp. 95 114.
Tatar, M. 1987. The Hard Facts of the Grimms’ Fairy Tales. Princeton, NJ: Prince-
ton University Press, pp. 85 105, 106 133, 137 178.
Thomas, J. 1989. Inside the Wolf’s Belly: Aspects of the Fairy Tale. Sheffield: Shef-
field Academic Press.
Warner, M. 1994. From the Beast to the Blonde: On Fairy Tales and Their Tellers.
London: Chatto and Windus.
Fakelore | 475
Yearsley, M. 1974. The Folklore of the Fairy Tales. London: Oxford University
Press.
Zipes, J. 1997. Happily Ever After: Fairy Tales, Children, and the Culture Industry.
New York and London: Routledge.
Zipes, J. 1999. When Dreams Came True: Classical Fairy Tales and Their Tradition.
New York and London: Routledge, pp. 30 48, 61 79.
Zipes, J., ed. 2000. The Oxford Companion to Fairy Tales. Oxford: Oxford Univer-
sity Press.
Fakelore
References
Bendix, Regina. 1988. Folklorismus: The Challenge of a Concept. International
Folklore Review 6: 5 15.
Degh, Linda. 1977 1978. Grape-Harvest Festival of Strawberry Farmers: Folklore or
Fake? Ethnologia Europaea 10: 114 131.
Dorson, Richard M. 1950. Folklore and Fakelore. American Mercury 70: 335 343.
Dorson, Richard M. 1962. Folklore and the NDEA. Journal of American Folklore
75: 160 164.
Dorson, Richard M. 1976. Folklore and Fakelore: Essays toward a Discipline of
Folk Studies. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1985. Nationalistic Inferiority Complexes and the Fabrication of Folk-
lore. Journal of Folklore Research 22: 5 18.
Fox, William. 1980. Folklore and Fakelore. Journal of the Folklore Institute 17:
244 261.
Handler, Richard, and Jocelyn Linnekin. 1984. Tradition, Genuine or Spurious. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 97: 273 290.
Miller, Frank J. 1991. Folklore for Stalin: Russian Folklore and Pseudofolklore of
the Stalin Era. New York: Sharpe.
Family Folklore
Traditional expressive behavior and its products that are transmitted by family
members to family members and that pertain to relatives, family events, and fam-
ily ways of being and doing. Family folklore includes stories, jokes, and songs
Family Folklore | 477
about family members and events, as well as the ways relatives share those items
with one another; festivals the family celebrates, such as religious and national
holidays; festivals that celebrate family, such as weddings, reunions, and funerals;
foods, cooking instruction, ways of eating, and ways of gathering to eat within a
family; family naming traditions; a family’s ways of dancing; expressions and
gestures a family uses; visual records of family life, such as arrangements of items
inside and outside the home, photographs, photograph albums, videotapes,
embroideries, and quilts; occupational, song, story, and craft traditions carried on
within a family; and fieldwork methods used within family settings.
A review of folklore studies shows that folklorists have long been welcome in
the homes of families. Once back at their desks, however, most professional and
amateur folklorists before the 1970s discussed the rich material they collected in
families as regional or ethnic, religious or occupational folklore. They approached
the family as a source of folklore materials, not as the subject of their study.
Several folklorists, though, published a family story or two as ‘‘family folklore,’’
usually without analysis, in state journals. Then, in 1958, Mody Boatright put out
the call to folklorists to collect ‘‘an important source of living folklore’’—the ‘‘fam-
ily saga,’’ featuring individual stories with a variety of themes that preserved a
family’s way of seeing itself in history. Interested in a generic approach, Boatright
asked what forms and motifs made up the family saga. A second mode of inquiry,
a small-group approach, came in 1961 when Kim Garrett suggested that every
family that recognizes itself as a unit has its own traditions, including stories,
taboos, and expressions.
In the mid-1970s, the study of family folklore burgeoned. Folklorists’ growing
interest in folklore as communication within and between small groups, their con-
tinuing interest in contextual studies, the focus of feminist scholarship on wom-
en’s lives and concerns, the consideration of more privatized forms of folklore
such as personal experience narratives, and the airing of Alex Haley’s television
series Roots exploring his African American family’s history, all contributed to
an increased interest in studying the family as the subject of its own folklore.
Future scholarship may see more family folklorists writing of the traditions
alive in all forms of committed relationships.
Transmission
How traditional materials are passed down through extended families has been
the subject of several studies. Lucille Burdine and William McCarthy, for exam-
ple, show how folklore is not handed down ‘‘en bloc’’ from person to person,
generation to generation; rather, each element of folklore finds its own sympa-
thetic channel of transmission in different members of a family. Other studies by
Baldwin, Margaret Yocom, and Jane Beck discuss gender differences in trans-
mission, as well as attitudes of ownership and deference between generations.
Gender Studies
Folklorists have been concerned about the ways in which gender intersects with
family folklore. Some have turned to evidence of gender-role stratification in sto-
ries. Others have explored how gender difference influences folkloric forms and
processes. Baldwin and Yocom, for example, have studied how family stories
and storytelling differ among men and women in their Anglo-American and
Pennsylvania German families. They found women’s telling to be more collabo-
rative, interruptable, and filled with information and genealogy; men’s telling,
by contrast, is often uninterrupted and more competitive, the story beginnings
and endings are formally marked, and the men’s stories ‘‘make a point worth tell-
ing.’’ Yocom has explored gender differences in the transmission of woodcarving
and knitting skills in an extended Anglo and French Acadian family in Maine.
And Thomas Adler’s study of gender and family food preparation shows that
men’s cooking traditions in the family are often limited to one or two celebratory
meals a week—often Sunday breakfast—or to outdoor meals with meat; women
cook the mundane, everyday, diversified meals.
Genre Studies
Folklorists have puzzled over the generic nature of family stories and how the
individual stories relate to the whole of a family’s repertoire. Family stories, often
brief and elliptically told, usually do not take the form of legend, folktale, or mem-
orate. Boatright and William Wilson see family stories as anecdotes that together
comprise a larger ‘‘saga’’ or ‘‘novel’’ and emphasize that each anecdote must be
heard in light of other anecdotes for the larger story to be understood. Baldwin
stresses that a family’s ‘‘narrative’’ is a ‘‘composite of changing and interchange-
able parts’’ and that since no one person is the ultimate source, many people must
be heard so their ‘‘piece’’ of the ‘‘narrative composite’’ can be included. Zeitlin
details the similar themes that sweep through family stories in the United States,
themes that revolve around the characters of family members (heroes or heroines,
survivors) and the transitions in family histories (migrations, courtships).
Family as Context
Folklorists primarily interested in craft, occupation, and storytelling have turned
to families as sources of information. Though family folklore is not the subject
of their studies, much about the family context of tradition can be seen in their
work. Beck’s work with the last basket maker in Vermont’s Sweetser family and
John Burrison’s study of the pottery families in Georgia show how families
amassed and passed on their skills.
We will trade anecdotes and faint memories, trying to swell them with the
order of dates and asides, interlocking them all as if assembling the hull
of a ship. No story is ever told just once. Whether a memory or funny hid-
eous scandal, we will return to it an hour later and retell the story with
additions and this time a few judgements thrown in. . . . All day my Aunt
Phyllis presides over the history of good and bad Ondaatjes and the people
they came in contact with. Her eye . . . will suddenly sparkle and she will
turn to us with delight and begin ‘‘and there is another terrible story.’’
References
Baldwin, L. Karen. 1985. ‘‘Woof!’’ A Word of Women’s Roles in Family Storytell-
ing. In Women’s Folklore, Women’s Culture, eds. Susan Kalcik and Rosan Jordan. Phil-
adelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Beck, Jane. 1983. Newton Washburn: Traditional Basket Maker. In Traditional
Craftsmanship in America, ed. Charles Camp. Washington, DC: National Council for
the Traditional Arts.
Boatright, Mody C. 1958. The Family Saga as a Form of Folklore. In The Family Saga
and Other Phases of American Folklore, eds. Mody C. Boatright, Robert B. Downs, and
John T. Flanagan. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Brandes, Stanley. 1975. Family Misfortune Stories in American Folklore. Journal of
the Folklore Institute 12: 5 17.
Burdine, Lucille, and William B. McCarthy. 1990. Sister Singers. Western Folklore
49: 406 417.
Dizard, Jan E., and Howard Gadlin. 1990. The Minimal Family. Amherst: University
of Massachusetts.
Goodwin, Joseph P. 1994. My First Ex-Lover-in-Law: You Can Choose Your Fam-
ily. Southern Folklore 51: 35 47.
Morgan, Kathryn L. 1980. Children of Strangers: The Stories of a Black Family.
Philadelphia: Temple University Press.
Ondaatje, Michael. 1984. Running in the Family. London: Picador.
Sherman, Sharon R. 1986. ‘‘That’s How the Seder Looks’’: A Fieldwork Account of
Videotaping Family Folklore. Journal of Folklore Research 23: 53 70.
Feast | 483
Stone, Elizabeth. 1988. Black Sheep and Kissing Cousins: How Our Family Stories
Shape Us. New York: Penguin.
Wilson, William A. 1991. Personal Narratives: The Family Novel. Western Folklore
50: 127 149.
Yocom, Margaret R. 1982. Family Folklore and Oral History Interviews: Strategies
for Introducing a Project to One’s Own Relatives. Western Folklore 41: 251 274.
Zeitlin, Steven J., Amy J. Kotkin, and Holly Cutting Baker. 1993. A Celebration of
American Family Folklore: Tales and Traditions from the Smithsonian Collection.
Cambridge, MA: Yellow Moon.
Feast
Ceremonial meal that reaffirms social solidarity while providing culinary gratifi-
cation to an assembly of individuals. A feast is the sensuous and symbolic dis-
play of food and a quintessential metaphor for a surfeit of consumption. As
eating beyond the point of satiation, feasting is forever shadowed by its obverse:
socially mediated hunger, food asceticism, or fasting. In addition, feasting often
has sacrificial connotations. Humans may share with deity in the consumption of
specially consecrated foods and ritually slain divine victims.
Although food customs and habits vary significantly from culture to culture, feast-
ing often occurs at key points in a community’s food supply cycle: sowing, first
fruits, harvest, beginning of the hunting season, and so on. Cosmic events relating to
the agricultural cycle also may cause feasting: the change of seasons, the new year,
or the appearance of moon, sun, or stars. As symbolic imitation of hypertrophy,
bountiful feasting provides a means for redistributing an abundant harvest or kill in
the spirit of celebration and thanksgiving. Mundane work responsibilities usually are
suspended on feast days, during which hard work is compensated by the meal.
Feasts often are scheduled to mark special periods in the life of the individual.
Here, banqueting is one element in a complex of celebratory events, including
ceremony, procession, or dance. Birth, circumcision/naming, weaning, confirma-
tion/initiation, marriage, retirement, anniversaries, or funerals are some of these
life-passage events. Solidarity between social groups may be invoked through
exchanges that include food sharing, as in the case of potlatch funerary feasts of
the Native American cultures of the Northwest.
The term feast (from the Latin festum) has a specialized use to describe major
celebrations in organized religion and is often used interchangeably with festival.
Feast days are devoted to celebrations of faith and are times to refrain from pro-
fane work (aside from the work of food preparation). Feasts usually occur in rela-
tionship to fasts or other penitential observances in the religious calendar.
Until the latter part of the twentieth century, writers on Jewish tradition used
feast to discuss the weekly Sabbath, the first day of the new lunar month, and a
484 | Feast
Every year on the eighth day of the fourth moon on the Chinese traditional calendar, peo-
ple celebrate the Feast of the Drunken Dragon, Feast of Buddha, and Feast of the God
Tam Kung. The Drunken Dragon dance is now an important folk activity in Macao, featur-
ing dancing fishermen with wooden dragon heads and tails. The dancers, shown here in
2009, imbibe copious amounts of wine, which they spit out in ritual manner, while the
organizers will distribute rice for blessings. (Sayid09/Dreamstime.com)
References
Bakhtin, Mikhail. 1984. Rabelais and His World. Bloomington: Indiana University
Press. Originally published as Tvorchestvo Fransua Rable, Moscow, 1965.
Bynum, Caroline Walker. 1987. Holy Feast and Holy Fast: The Religious Signifi-
cance of Food to Medieval Women. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Kan, Sergei. 1989. Symbolic Immortality: The Tlingit Potlatch of the Nineteenth
Century. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
MacCulloch, J. A. 1925. Feasting. In Encyclopaedia of Religion and Ethics, ed.
James Hastings. New York: Charles Scribner’s Sons, 801 805.
Weiser, Francis X. 1958. Handbook of Christian Feasts and Customs: The Year of
the Lord in Liturgy and Folklore. New York: Harcourt, Brace.
equation of men with culture in folklore theory leads not just to the absence of
folklore about women and performed by women but also to the omission of that
which is specifically men’s lore. The solution to this dilemma from the perspec-
tive of feminist scholarship entails challenging implicitly male-oriented para-
digms and constructing alternative and oppositional models that incorporate
women’s experience within the realm of folk culture and performance.
It has been a slow and arduous task to change the historical orientation of the
discipline. Few publications focusing on gender and folklore appeared between
1975 and 1995, and those that have seen print frequently have been subjected to
such extensive revision and scrutiny that their timely publication has been impos-
sible. Furthermore, such scholarly writings—and more specifically those pro-
duced by women—are largely missing from the ‘‘folklore canon,’’ that is, the
academic books and articles accepted by folklorists as most significant to the
field, such as those that appear on the PhD reading lists of major folklore depart-
ments, those that receive major disciplinary awards, or those that are included in
histories and overviews of the field. Courses on gender and folklore, women and
folklore, and/or men’s folklore are not regarded as standard offerings for most
folklore curricula, and the number of female faculty hired by the major folklore
departments and programs is insufficient. Not only do the majority of folklorists
neglect the gendered aspects of folklore but folklorists who are women also find
themselves in situations that involve the unequal distribution of status and power.
It is of special note that this disciplinary gap persists at a time when most folklo-
rists are proudly discussing new directions in the theoretical underpinnings of the
discipline, explicitly questioning who they are and what they study. Edited volumes
with titles containing phrases such as ‘‘new perspectives,’’ ‘‘frontiers of folklore,’’
and ‘‘urban folklore’’ and consisting mostly of contributions by men have been par-
tially responsible for changing the shape of the field. Academic discourse during the
early and mid-1970s gave rise to an innovative approach to the study of folklore—
one that emphasized performance and context, behavior, communication, and pro-
cess, bringing about more dynamic definitions of ‘‘the folk’’ and ‘‘folklore’’ and
breaking down rigid traditional genres so that they became regarded as emergent,
flexible social phenomena rather than normative, mutually exclusive categories.
Still, although this new perspective has greatly benefited the practical and theoreti-
cal study of folklore in general, it has done little to give the folklore of and about
women its proper place in folklore scholarship. An exciting new concept of social
group now characterizes the discipline, but attention to gender and related concerns
is often lacking; the voices of women, both folklorists and folk, remain largely
unheard, and their presence goes unnoticed in this reexamination of the field.
Nevertheless, some academics have developed gender-oriented scholarship in
folklore and in other related disciplines, such as anthropology and literary stud-
ies. The recent evolution of feminist folklore scholarship was initiated by the
Feminist Perspectives on Folklore Scholarship | 487
cultural identity and social continuity. Finally, these scholars point out that wom-
en’s humor is not only distinctive but also artfully used to negotiate gender inter-
actions, often in a manner that is oppositional or contestational.
Ten years after the publication of Farrer’s groundbreaking edited volume, Wom-
en’s Folklore, Women’s Culture edited by Rosan A. Jordan and Susan Kalcik
appeared. The various articles included in this book serve to describe women’s ex-
pressive behavior in a variety of situations, emphasizing its frequently collaborative
nature. This volume is divided into sections that portray the private world of women
and discuss performances within the intimate circle of family and friends, as well as
outline the neglected areas of women’s folklore in the public arena. Additionally,
the essayists examine the dynamic interactions between public and private spheres
and between male and female activities. The book as a whole, however, neither
characterizes ‘‘new genres’’ that are exclusively women’s genres nor provides a
coherent theoretical framework within which to analyze these genres. A number of
significant categories of women’s folk performances are missing from this book, as
is serious attention to the claim that ‘‘studying women makes a difference.’’ This
volume achieves significance by focusing scholarly attention on women and folk-
lore, pointing to the need for the development of a theoretical framework that would
give the folklore of and about women its proper place in folklore scholarship and
lay the foundation for new orientations in data collection and analysis.
In 1985, concerned that feminist theory was not being adequately addressed or
developed within contemporary folkloristics, a group of women scholars associated
with the Folklore Program at the University of Texas, Austin, with the help of
many other folklorists, formulated and organized an all-day symposium on folklore
and feminist theory. This conference stemmed from the belief that folklore, like all
academic disciplines, operates within certain paradigms that reflect the ideologies
of the intellectual climate in which they originate. Thus, in the mid-1980s, gender
bias in all forms of folklore scholarship—publication, fieldwork, research, and
teaching—was reflected in the absence of the female and/or the dominance of the
male, or it appeared as the denigration of female experience, all of which served
the interest of male privilege. The need to address specifically such biases within
the formal organization of folklore as a discipline was regarded as a necessary step
in reorienting disciplinary concerns. The conference, officially entitled ‘‘A Femi-
nist Retrospective on Folklore and Folkloristics,’’ was part of the 1986 annual
meeting of the American Folklore Society in Baltimore, Maryland. The purpose of
the symposium was to discuss and debate not only women’s folklore (as had a
1979 women and folklore conference held at the University of Pennsylvania and
several earlier publications on women’s folklore) but also and more importantly to
introduce feminist theory into the study of folklore and bring folklore scholarship
to bear on feminist theory. This included the consideration of why and how the
analysis of women’s lore changes the study of all folklore, why studying any
490 | Feminist Perspectives on Folklore Scholarship
folklore with a feminist eye makes a difference, and how folklorists can contribute
to the growing body of feminist scholarship that is developing in many disciplines.
Several publications directly or indirectly arose from this conference: special
issues of the Journal of American Folklore (‘‘Folklore and Feminism’’ edited by
Bruce Jackson) and the Journal of Folklore Research (‘‘Feminist Revisions in
Folklore Studies’’ edited by Beverly J. Stoeltje), and two edited volumes, Femi-
nist Theory and the Study of Folklore and Feminist Messages: Coding in Wom-
an’s Folk Culture. The conference and these publications have been variously
successful in meeting the challenges as noted previously.
Published in 1993, Feminist Theory and the Study of Folklore edited by Susan
Hollis, Linda Pershing, and M. Jane Young is a collection of essays that achieves
a new degree of sophistication in feminist approaches to the study of folklore,
calling into question not only case studies but also any theoretical formulations
that fail to take into account women’s experiences and perceptions. This book is
an attempt to provide a resource for those seeking a more comprehensive view of
the contemporary research being conducted on the intersection of feminist theory
and folklore. Additionally, many of the authors in this volume focus on women’s
expressive genres to further an understanding of symbolic modes that serve
women’s own interests, distinguished by a process-centered female aesthetic.
The book is divided into three parts, each addressing a specific theme and begin-
ning with a theoretical introduction to that theme: feminist reexaminations of
folklore theory and the development of the discipline, new ways of looking at
the types of materials conventionally studied by folklorists, and the exploration
of hitherto unapproached or little-recognized materials in folklore and feminism.
Joan Radner’s edited volume, Feminist Messages: Coding in Women’s Folk
Culture, also published in 1993, takes a somewhat different direction, specifically
addressing the coding of women’s folklore forms rather than the more general
application of gender-related concepts to the study of folklore. The articles in this
volume draw extensively on feminist theory, pointing to a need for increased com-
munication with feminist theorists across a variety of disciplines and conducting
research in diverse cross-cultural areas. Coding, as it is defined by these authors,
refers to women’s frequently disturbing or subversive expressions of resistance,
necessitated by the fact that their lives often have been controlled, dominated, or
made peripheral by men. Such coding—sometimes deliberate, sometimes uncon-
scious—is essentially ambiguous, conveying diverse messages and thus serving to
protect women from those who might find such messages rebellious, and, there-
fore, threatening. Radner’s book is especially significant in providing a framework
within which to interpret women’s creative practices that have conventionally
gone unnoticed or have been devalued by the dominant culture.
All of the conferences and publications mentioned since the appearance of Far-
rer’s 1975 edited volume concentrated primarily on folklore of and about women
Feminist Perspectives on Folklore Scholarship | 491
in cross-cultural contexts; the need for new images, genres, and approaches; and
the significance of using feminist theory to illuminate this area of inquiry.
Although the political implications of the analysis and interpretation of women’s
folklore was central to these discussions, the political nature of the fieldwork con-
ducted by folklorists remained largely ignored until the 1990 publication of
‘‘Folklore Fieldwork: Sex, Sexuality, and Gender,’’ a special issue of Southern
Folklore edited by Camilla A. Collins. As indicated by the title of this particular
issue, the authors emphasize gender in general and from a number of perspectives
rather than choosing only to highlight women’s traditional artistic behavior. Fur-
thermore, this publication delineates the way in which folklorists discuss gender
issues in their fieldwork, constructing personal anecdotes frequently passed on
informally. Thus, the distinction between ‘‘folk’’ and ‘‘folklorist’’ becomes blurred
as the folklorists create their own folk narratives to describe their experiences
doing fieldwork. The various essays make it clear that sex, sexuality, and gender
influence the methods employed by folklorists to collect data, as well as the sorts
of phenomena that they choose to investigate. Here, too, rigid categories and
boundaries are discarded so that the divisions between subject and object or folk-
lore and folklorist become more fluid as fieldwork is characterized as made up of
conversations rather than formal interviews and the establishment of friendships
rather than reserved relationships. These authors stress the subjectivity of such
interactions, pointing out the necessity for folklorists to recognize their own feel-
ings and perceptions, as well as those of their interviewees. They also insist that
folklorists give more thought to the attitudes and perspectives generated by the
gendered aspects of all fieldwork, recognizing the need to negotiate and intercon-
nect both men’s and women’s domains in the field.
Fieldwork that incorporates the perspective of ‘‘the other’’ is crucial to contem-
porary folklore scholarship, just as it is to the ‘‘new ethnography’’ in anthropol-
ogy. Certainly folklorists must revise the authoritative way in which they write
about ‘‘the folk,’’ but first they must examine the biases inherent in their field-
work. Too often, perhaps because of their academic status, folklorists are blinded
by their own perceptions of their importance, entirely unable to perceive the fre-
quently negative manner in which they are regarded by those they presume to
study. Seen from this viewpoint, folklorists take on a more marginal position;
rather than valiant discoverers of folk performances—usually male ‘‘heroes’’ who
compose romantic tales of their fieldwork exploits—they are sometimes
unwanted intruders who are skillfully managed in the everyday lives of the folk
who themselves are fully aware of the value and power of their artistic behavior.
Feminist scholars suggest that folklorists listen more carefully to what their
informants say about the interrelationship of form, function, and audience in their
expressive behavior—a point that is significant to the discipline in general, over
and above gender considerations.
492 | Feminist Perspectives on Folklore Scholarship
The volumes on gender or women and folklore published since the mid-1970s
demonstrate that folklore and feminism can contribute a new understanding of
women’s marginal status in defined cultural contexts. On the one hand, women’s
marginality in male-dominated cultures is imposed; patriarchy enforces the rule
of men from the very center of a society’s organization (i.e., through the forma-
tion of laws, customs, and institutions that promote and preserve male domina-
tion) and leave women at its periphery. On the other hand, marginality
encourages women to remain detached from the status quo. Their peripheral posi-
tion may point to an incompatibility with established norms, leading to innova-
tion, especially in expressive domains, and the development of alternative
theories of knowledge. In reviewing women’s expressive culture from a feminist
stance, it is particularly important to look for ways in which women use their
marginal status to creatively undermine the prevailing system by the invention or
maintenance of traditions that signal the viability and appropriateness of a differ-
ent way of thinking and behaving.
The feminist lens has given folklorists a new way of looking at the gendered
nature of their endeavors. It is, however, important to recognize that other sorts
of social concerns have remained largely unaddressed. For instance, none of the
publications discussed here sufficiently incorporate feminist approaches to the
folklore of women who are often doubly marginalized in our society by virtue of
other factors in addition to their gender; these include women of color, lesbians,
women with disabilities, and older women, who seldom have been the focus of
folklore research. Although attempts have been made to fill this gap, it remains
an area of folklore scholarship that deserves considerable attention in the near
future. Furthermore, the broader focus on gender that feminism brings to folklore
also points to the necessary inclusion of other critical concerns, such as the inter-
section of gender with race, class, ethnicity, and sexual identity.
Although feminist theory can expand and enhance folklore theory by generat-
ing new analytical models, this is not a one-way process. Women’s folklore also
can supply new data for and encourage the development of theories that define
feminist scholarship. By providing a cross-cultural spectrum of traditional texts
in various aesthetic media that address gender-related difference, women’s folk-
lore significantly enriches the examination of sexual difference in regard to hier-
archy, power differentials, and the political imagination. A claim for the value of
traditions that formulate female-centered considerations presupposes a need to
allow folklore to speak for and about the traditions of women’s difference as this
is manifested in their material life activities and then given voice through a range
of expressive means. These specific features of women’s material life activity
carry important consequences for understanding and constructing all social rela-
tions, not just those that pertain to a particular arena of traditional production or
performance. Thus, both folklore and feminism conjoin in their mutual validation
Festival | 493
References
Collins, Camilla A., ed. 1990. Folklore Fieldwork: Sex, Sexuality, and Gender.
Special issue of Southern Folklore 47(1).
de Caro, Frank A. 1983. Women and Folklore: A Bibliographical Survey. Westport,
CT: Greenwood.
Farrer, Claire R., ed. 1975. Women and Folklore. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Hollis, Susan, Linda Pershing, and M. Jane Young, eds. 1993. Feminist Theory and
the Study of Folklore. Chicago: University of Illinois Press.
Jackson, Bruce, ed. 1987. Folklore and Feminism. Special issue of Journal of Ameri-
can Folklore 100(938).
Jordan, Rosan A., and Frank A. de Caro. 1986. Women and the Study of Folklore.
Signs: Journal of Women in Culture and Society 11(3): 500 518.
Jordan, Rosan A., and Susan J. Kalcik, eds. 1985. Women’s Folklore, Women’s
Culture. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Locke, Liz and Theresa A. Vaughan. 2009. Encyclopedia of Women’s Folklore and
Folklife. Westport, CT: Greenwood.
Radner, Joan N., ed. 1993. Feminist Messages: Coding in Women’s Folk Culture.
Chicago: University of Illinois Press.
Stoeltje, Beverly J., ed. 1988. Feminist Revisions in Folklore Studies. Journal of
Folklore Research 25(3).
Festival
single structural elements of the festival or forms of it. Festa were sacred offer-
ings in Latin, a feast in English is a very abundant and joyful meal, a fiesta in
Spanish is a public combat to show ability and bravery, a festa in Romanian is a
malicious and humorous prank, and a f^ ete in French is also a birthday celebration
or simply a rather formal party. In current usage, festival may mean: a time of
celebration, sacred and/or secular; the annual celebration of a special person or a
memorable event; the harvest of a particular crop; a series of performances in the
fine arts, dedicated to an author or genre or mass medium (i.e., Shakespeare,
music, cinema); or generic gaiety and cheerfulness.
In the social sciences, festival commonly means a periodic celebration com-
posed of a multiplicity of ritual forms and events, directly or indirectly affecting
all members of a community and explicitly or implicitly showing the basic val-
ues, the ideology, and the worldview that are shared by community members and
are the basis of their social identity.
Festivals traditionally have been classified as either secular or religious. This
conventional dichotomy, made popular by Emile Durkheim, is currently main-
tained in the social sciences, despite the fact that each type of festival usually
includes several elements of the other. Secular festivals resort to religion and
metaphysics to deepen their impact and social significance; religious festivities
always have political and economic aspects.
Festival | 495
they are a very eloquent way to represent and enjoy abundance, fertility, and pros-
perity. Ritual food is also a means to communicate with gods and ancestors, as
expressed in the Christian belief that Christ is present in the sacred meal of Com-
munion, the Greek tradition that Zeus was invisibly present at the ritual banquets
of the Olympic Games, or the practice of the Tsembanga Maring people of New
Guinea who raise, slaughter, and eat pigs for and with the ancestors. In far less
frequent cases, as in the Native American potlatch, objects with special material
and symbolic value are ritually consumed, wasted, or destroyed.
Ritual dramas are usually staged at festival sites, as rites have a strong tie to
myths. Their subject matter is often a creation myth, a foundation or migratory
legend, or a military success particularly relevant in the mythical or historical
memory of the community staging the festival. By means of the drama, the com-
munity members are reminded of their golden age, the trials and tribulations of
their founding members in reaching the present location of the community, the
miracles of a saint, or the periodic visit of a deity to whom the festival is dedi-
cated. When the sacred story is not directly staged, it is very often hinted at or
referred to in some segments or events of the festival.
Rites of exchange express the abstract equality of the community members,
their theoretical status as equally relevant members of a communitas, a commu-
nity of equals under certain shared laws of reciprocity. At the fair, money and
goods are exchanged at an economic level. At more abstract and symbolic levels,
information, ritual gifts, or visits may be exchanged; public acts of pacification,
symbolic remissio debitum (remission of debt) or thanksgiving for a grace
received may take place in various forms of redistribution, sponsored by the
community or a privileged individual who thus repays the community or the gods
for what has been received in excess.
Dragon Boat Race in Foshan, China, in 2009. The Dragon Boat Festival is thought to
commemorate the Chinese hero Qu Yuan. Dragon Boat racing is now an international
sport. (Guangliang Huo/Dreamstime.com)
Festival | 499
Festival typically includes rites of competition, which often constitute its cathartic
moment in the form of games. Even if games are commonly defined as competitions
regulated by special rules and with uncertain outcomes (as opposed to rituals, the
outcomes of which are known in advance), the logic of festival is concerned with
the competition and the awards for the winner; the rules of the game are canonic,
and its paradigm is ritual. The parts or roles are assigned at the beginning to individ-
uals as equal and undifferentiated ‘‘contestants,’’ ‘‘hopefuls,’’ or ‘‘candidates.’’ Then,
the development and the result of the game create among them a final hierarchical
order—either binary (winners and losers) or by rank (from first to last). Games show
how equality may be turned into hierarchy. Besides games in the strict sense, festival
competitions include various forms of contests and prize giving: electing the beauty
queen; selecting the best musician, player, singer, or dancer, individual or group; or
giving an award for a newly improvised narrative or work of art of any kind or for
the best festive decorations. By singling out its outstanding members and giving
them prizes, the group implicitly reaffirms some of its most important values.
Athletic or competitive sporting events include individual or collective games
of luck, strength, or ability. These have been considered ‘‘corruptions’’ of older
plays of ritual combats with fixed routine and obligatory ending, such as the fight
between Light and Darkness representing cosmogony; fights of this type were then
progressively historicized and territorialized into combats between, for example,
the Christians and the Moors or representative individuals, with the champion (lit-
erally meaning the sample) carrying the colors of the whole group.
In their functional aspects, these types of games may be seen as display and
encouragement of skills, such as strength, endurance, and precision, that were
required in daily work and military occupations; this was, for instance, the rationale
of medieval mock battles. In their symbolic aspect, festival competitions may be
seen as a metaphor for the emergence and establishment of power, as occurs when
the ‘‘winner takes all’’ or the winning faction symbolically takes over the arena (or
the city) in triumph.
At the end of the festival, a rite of devalorization, symmetrical to the opening
rite, marks the conclusion of the festive activities and the return to the normal
spatial and temporal dimension of daily life.
It is obvious that one should not expect to find all the morphological elements
listed here in each festival, just as one should not expect to find all of Vladimir
Propp’s ‘‘functions’’ present in every fairy tale. A complete festival morphology
will correspond to the complete festive cycle, and several of its parts will form the
configuration of each of the actual festive events. This fragmentation of the festive
complex into events distributed all along the calendrical cycle follows the course
of history and its trends of centralization and decentralization in social life, as well
as the interplay of religious and secular powers and their division in the running of
social and symbolic life and its ‘‘collective rituals.’’ Furthermore, in today’s
500 | Festival
Western and Westernized cultures, larger and often more abstract and distant enti-
ties try to substitute themselves for the older, smaller, tightly woven communities
as reference groups and centers of the symbolic life of the people. Today, we try
to bring the audience close to the event by means of the mass media or to
bring the event close to the audience by delegating smaller entities, such as the
family, to administer the event everywhere at the same time; we also may try to
fragment the old festivals into simpler festive events centered on one highly signif-
icant ritual. Such fragmentation is seen in the United States, where the ritual meal
is the focus of Thanksgiving, the exchange of gifts is the highlight of Christmas,
and excess is the hallmark of New Year’s. Military might and victories are cele-
brated on the Fourth of July, and civic pride is championed at the Rose Parade.
Carnivalesque aspects underlie Mardi Gras and Halloween. And symbolic reversal
is nowhere more evident than in the demolition derby. Even the tradition of dynas-
tic anniversaries is present, modified though it may be, in celebrations of George
Washington’s and Abraham Lincoln’s birthdays; competitions are perfectly typi-
fied by the Indianapolis 500, the Superbowl, and the Kentucky Derby. Even the ar-
chaic tendency to consider the ritual games of the festival as cosmic events may
be surfacing in the use of the term world championship, obstinately applied to
events that, in the strict sense, are really encounters of local teams playing a cul-
ture-bound and territorially limited game, such as American football or baseball.
Festive rites of passage take place on Valentine’s Day, at debutante balls, and in
drinking celebrations on one’s twenty-first birthday and at fraternity and sorority
rushes. Rites of deference and confirmation of status include presidential inaugu-
rations, Father’s Day, and Mother’s Day. The archaic Kings and Queens of the
May have their functional equivalents in the yearly beauty pageants of Miss, Mis-
ter, and Mrs. America. Plays have been grouped in various yearly festivals of the
arts that range from Shakespeare festivals to the Oscars ceremonies in Los
Angeles, through symphonies, jazz festivals, and fiddling contests. And the mod-
ern ferias, the county fairs, are numerous and ever present.
If not festival proper, such events are part of a festive cycle, a series of events that
in other times and cultures would fall within tighter boundaries of time, space, and
action. This festive complex is constantly changing and evolving. But with all its
modifications, festival has retained its primary importance and continues to celebrate
life, remaining the most important showcase for culture’s values and worldview.
Alessandro Falassi
See Also Carnival; Custom; Feast; Fool.
References
Berce, Yves-Marie. 1976. F^
ete et r
evolte. Paris: Hachette.
Caillois, Roger. [1939] 1940. Theorie de la f^ete. Nouvelle revue francaise 28: 49 59
and 27: 863 882.
Fieldwork | 501
Cox, Harvey. 1969. The Feast of Fools: A Theological Essay on Festival and Fan-
tasy. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Falassi, Alessandro, ed. 1987. Time Out of Time: Essays on the Festival. Albuquer-
que: University of New Mexico Press.
Hatch, Jane M. 1978. The American Book of Days. 3rd ed. New York: Wilson.
Lloyd, Warner W. 1959. The Living and the Dead: A Study of the Symbolic Life of
the Americans. New Haven, CT: Yale University Press.
Ludwig, Jack Barry. 1976. The Great American Spectaculars: The Kentucky Derby,
Mardi Gras, and Other Days of Celebration. Garden City, NY: Doubleday.
MacAloon, John J. 1983. Rite, Drama, Festival, Spectacle. Philadelphia: Ishi.
Pieper, Joseph. 1965. In Tune with the World: A Theory of Festivity. New York:
Harcourt.
Stearns, Peter, ed. 1994. Encyclopedia of Social History. New York: Garland.
Stoeltje, Beverly. 1983. Festival in America. In Handbook of American Folklore, ed.
Richard Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Turner, Victor, ed. 1982. Celebration: Studies in Festivity and Ritual. Washington,
DC: Smithsonian Institution.
Wilson, Joe, and Lee Udall. 1982. Folk Festivals: A Handbook for Organization and
Management. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Fieldwork
(interviewing, asking for items, asking for explanations), or they may be passive
(waiting, observing, recording).
Some folklore researchers use preexisting print or electronic media as the
sources of primary information (e.g., studies of the apparent scope, character,
and function of folklore materials in commercial advertising or political speeches
or folklore in the works of Homer, Shakespeare, and Mark Twain or folklore on
the Internet). But such studies are predicated on ideas of folklore derived from
fieldwork. Milman Parry and Albert Lord’s hypothetical and theoretical work on
the nature of Homeric performance and composition was extrapolated from their
extensive fieldwork among Serbian epic singers. They were able to assert that
certain materials in classical texts were grounded in folklore performance and
transmission only because their fieldwork let them understand the character of
such performance and transmission.
Even folklore scholars whose work is totally theoretical are dependent for the
substance underlying their generalizations and speculation on the fieldwork of
others. It would be difficult, if not impossible, to theorize cogently and relevantly
about the meaning of folklore in a community unless someone had first gathered
information about what folklore exists in that community and what functions the
folklore performs. Comparative folklore studies (texts or behaviors from differ-
ent places or times compared for differences in aesthetic or functional aspects)
are predicated on the quality and scope of the field-gathered material.
Folklorists doing fieldwork may be looking for specific genres or kinds of folk
behavior: ballads, recipes, survivals of older traditions in modern communities,
modern folkways in technological communities, or the nature of folk perfor-
mance. It is difficult to know the social meaning of an item of performance with-
out knowing about the conditions of performance. For example, the place and
function of ballads in a community are interpreted differently if many people in
that community sing many long ballads on a regular basis to a wide local audi-
ence that knows and enjoys such ballads or if, by contrast, the performers sing
their songs only when collectors come in from the outside to solicit them. The
words and tunes may be the same, but what we make of them may vary. One
may analyze a particular ballad text differently if it was learned from a book, a
recording, a school chum, or a grandparent.
In the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries, scholars often examined texts
alone, much as literary scholars examined texts of poems as freestanding items.
Today, however, folklore texts are rarely examined without consideration of col-
lateral information. Only through fieldwork can researchers gather the items,
provide information for identifying folk genres, and locate the nature of folklore
performance in ordinary life.
It is not just that scholars are more sophisticated now about the questions that
might be asked; it is also that the equipment available today frees the field-worker
Fieldwork | 503
Informant
The person who has a competent knowledge of the target community’s cultural per-
formances and who is willing to share this knowledge with the field-worker. Although
an informant usually is a member of the target community, he or she might also inter-
act with the target community on a frequent basis as an accepted outside associate.
An informant’s primary role is interpreting, from an insider’s (emic) point of view,
the different aspects of the target community’s cultural system. Although the in-
formant need not be an active bearer of the culture’s traditions to function effec-
tively, he or she should be thoroughly versed in what constitutes an appropriate
performance of the tradition, and the informant should furthermore be able to
interpret this performance in a manner that is consistent with the rest of the com-
munity’s interpretation. Additionally, informants should introduce the field-worker
to other community members who may have special knowledge or performance
abilities that they will share with the field-worker.
The informant’s roles will be fulfilled only after the field-worker establishes a
truthful dialogue with the informant (occasionally this does not happen). This dia-
logue results from the field-worker’s and the informant’s realization that the inform-
ant is more than just a paid employee (if the informant receives some type of
compensation); instead, the informant is the link between the outside world and the
target community. The cultivation of this dialogue is further assisted by the field-
worker’s realization that the informant must be guided through a discussion if the
necessary information is to be elicited.
Charlie T. McCormick
will define their options differently if they have access to various kinds of image
and sound recorders and know how to use them effectively and efficiently. Field-
workers studying material culture have different questions and therefore may
incorporate different technologies than field-workers interested in narrative tradi-
tion or matters of custom or belief. Field-workers trying to document the folklife
of a community may need a wider range of technical expertise than field-workers
focusing on genres or items.
Nineteenth-and early twentieth-century folklorists depended on simple record-
ing devices and techniques, including notebooks and memory. They used bulky
machinery to record musical performances on cylinders and then on large flat
disks. These machines were capable of recording only a few minutes of perfor-
mance before they had to be wound up and supplied with a new recording surface.
Furthermore, unless the recordist struck a tuning fork or other device of known
frequency at the beginning or ending of the recording, there was no way for a lis-
tener to know exactly at what speed these recordings were to be played. That
meant listeners never knew if they were hearing the recordings at the right tempo
or pitch. Because the equipment was so bulky, movement was difficult, and per-
formers often had to be brought to where the machine was located. Cameras used
large glass plates and required a great deal of light, either natural or flash powder.
What the great folklorists of the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries pro-
vided us were not so much records of performances but rather interpretations or
versions of performances—they were not only editors of what they found but
also participants in the line of performers they documented. When, for example,
folklorist Vance Randolph spent an evening listening to stories or songs and then
went home and wrote up the stories he had heard or sat at the piano and worked
out songs he had heard, he was doing exactly what many folk performers do.
Folklorists now can gather more complex field documents because they have at
their disposal instruments that provide a record of transient detail that was impossi-
ble to obtain a half century ago, such as: small, automated, 35mm cameras weigh-
ing less than a pound that zoom from wide-angle to telephoto shots and focus and
set apertures automatically, using film capable of making images in moonlight;
video cameras easily held in one hand that record high-quality images in low light
and high-fidelity stereo sound on tape, using rechargeable batteries that last two
hours each; audio recorders controlled by crystals, with tapes that are therefore rep-
licable on any crystal-controlled machine anywhere; and, for the truly sophisticated
user, digital audiotape (DAT) machines with real-time coding. A field-worker can
carry a full complement of this new equipment—video camera, still camera, crys-
tal-controlled audio recorder, enough tape for a dozen hours of video and sound re-
cording and enough film for hundreds of separate images—in a shoulder bag.
The effects of all this technology are multifold. First, the field-worker is capable
of acquiring an enormous amount of information—far more than was ever
Fieldwork | 505
References
Clifford, James, and George Marcus, eds. 1986. Writing Culture: The Poetics and
Politics of Ethnography. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Dorson, Richard M. 1964. Collecting Oral Folklore in the United States. In Buying
the Wind: Regional Folklore in the United States, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Chicago:
University Chicago Press.
Finnegan, Ruth. 1992. Oral Traditions and the Verbal Arts: A Guide to Research
Practices. New York: Routledge.
Georges, Robert A., and Michael O. Jones. 1980. People Studying People: The
Human Element in Fieldwork. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Goldstein, Kenneth S. 1964. A Guide for Field Workers in Folklore. Hatboro, PA:
Folklore Associates.
Ives, Edward E. 1964. The Tape-Recorded Interview: A Manual for Field Workers in
Folklore and Oral History. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Jackson, Bruce. 1987. Fieldwork. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Jackson, Bruce, and Edward D. Ives, eds. 1996. The World Observed: Reflections on
the Fieldwork Process. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Lord, Albert. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1983. The Spoken Word and the Work of Interpretation. Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania Press.
Film, Folklore
A term commonly applied to a film that documents folklore for research and other
purposes. Such films, when edited to be shown to an audience, are called, in the
term coined by Sharon Sherman, folkloric films. The terms folkloric film and film
and folklore also refer to nonacademic or so-called Hollywood films that use folk-
lore as a major theme. Videotape use and production often are encompassed in
the larger term of film and folklore. As the scope of videography increases and its
Film, Folklore | 507
use continues to grow, video has become the medium of choice (at least until the
next major technological development), and folklore and video—or, preferably,
folkloric videos—will become the commonplace term, incorporating film within
its definition, much as the current term incorporates video.
Compared to their contemporaries in the social sciences and other fields, folk-
lorists began to use film as a tool at a much later date, but the film movement in
folklore reflects all of the techniques and preoccupations of earlier filmmakers
who created the field of documentary film. Like the ‘‘films of fact’’ shot in the
early 1900s, folkloric films are often made up of short clips of interesting phe-
nomena captured for posterity. The earliest such documentation of folklore on
celluloid is a March of Time series film made in 1935, which depicts John Lomax
interviewing musician Leadbelly (Huddie Ledbetter) and recording his folksongs
for the folksong archive of the Library of Congress; a second film on Leadbelly
appeared in 1945. American folkloric films were not produced again until the
late 1950s. The first call for film reviews in the Journal of American Folklore
(published by the American Folklore Society) did not appear until 1974. Despite
this somewhat late acknowledgment of the importance of film, these reviews
demonstrate the growing interest in film among folklorists during the 1970s
when new theories about performance began to gain acceptance.
In Europe, short, straightforward camera shots of folkloric subjects were taken
for documentation purposes by the Institut f€ur den Wissenschaftlichen Film. Af-
ter World War II, the institute sponsored a program in fieldwork to train ethnolo-
gists in the use of film equipment. In 1959, the institute published its own rules
for documenting ethnology and folklore and demanded that field-workers docu-
ment only authentic events and film them without elaborate camera work. The
institute organized a film archive in 1952 and began editing the Encyclopaedia
Cinematographia. These ethnological films, which are categorized first by world
region, then by country, and finally by region within each country, are of great
value for comparative folklore research. They are short and unnarrated and deal
with only one subject, such as a children’s game from West Africa, a festival
dance in South Africa, or the performance of an epic heroic song in Romania.
Other folkloric films have a heavily narrated and expository style similar to
those documentaries made prior to World War II and on through the 1960s. Cer-
tain folkloric films utilize either a cinema verite or post-verite approach, which
combines synchronous sound or voice-over with linear depictions for the record-
ing of complex expressive events (including interactions, performances, and the
many facets of creative processes) in their entirety. Yet others are reflexive
and intersubjective, incorporating the filmmaker as one of the subjects. In the
realm of nonfiction film, certain trends have become firmly established. Stylisti-
cally, then, the folkloric film does not differ from documentary and ethnodocu-
mentary film.
508 | Film, Folklore
Nanook prepares to harpoon a walrus in a scene from the first documentary film, Nanook
of the North. Robert Flaherty wrote, directed, produced, and edited this landmark film in
1922. (Library of Congress)
On a theoretical level, many folklorists who use film are tied both to the mod-
els used by their documentary film forerunners and to the conceptual premises of
early folklore scholars. Some folkloric filmmakers tend to focus on romantic
visions of the noble savage or preindustrial folk. Just as this bias on the part of
folklorists gave way to more enlightened notions of the folk as any people with a
common tradition, filmmakers also shifted their attention from romanticism to
examine present-day issues involving diverse groups of people. In folkloric
films, one can find both attitudes existing side by side.
In Nanook of the North (1922), Robert J. Flaherty’s romanticization of native
Arctic life, the focus on the individual as a representative figure for a culture that
Flaherty saw fading, and the involvement of Nanook and the Inuit in the filming
process are elements of a filmic model that folklore documentary filmmakers
emulated. In folkloric films, the rural often takes precedence over the urban and
the past assumes greater importance than the contemporary. John Cohen’s search
for Child ballads in Appalachia, documented in The High Lonesome Sound, Jorge
Preloran’s documentation of little-known peoples in the isolated regions of Ar-
gentina, and Les Blank’s depiction of Cajun and Creole culture in the Louisiana
bayou all fit this pattern. Yet none of these filmmakers is locked into this pattern.
All of them have examined very contemporary activities and the urban scene as
well. Often, like Flaherty, they begin with a romantic, stereotypic notion of the
folk for their initial films and then recognize a need to broaden the definition of
their work as their film corpus grows.
Film, Folklore | 509
constructed. Both styles underscore how subjective film is, but Vertov’s work is
more blatant about the impossibility of objectivity. Likewise, the admonition of
British filmmaker John Grierson that documentary must expose social problems
has led to a number of films whose editing styles reveal the ideologies of their
makers. In folkloric film, the montage structure employed in such films as Ferris’s
I Ain’t Lying and Made in Mississippi and Blank’s food films (e.g., Garlic Is as
Good as Ten Mothers) provides a means for discovering what the filmmaker
thinks about the subject being documented.
For folklorists, cinema verite provided the first real opportunity to document
events from beginning to end and to allow fieldwork tools to match the new theo-
retical perspectives about folklore as human behavior established in the late 1960s.
Long takes and sync-sound filming became the rage. At last, the people being stud-
ied could speak for themselves in sync-sound and provide their own functional
analyses without the imposition of a narrator or scholar. A number of documentary
films demonstrated to folklorists how filmmakers might focus on and document
individuals to arrive at a ‘‘truth’’; such films included Salesman (1969), which pic-
tured the life of a door-to-door Bible salesman; Showman (1962), a portrait of
movie mogul Joseph E. Levine by Charlotte Zwerin and Albert and David May-
sles; Lonely Boy (1961) by Wolf Koenig and Roman Kroiter, about teenage idol
Paul Anka; and Don’t Look Back (1967), D. A. Pennebaker’s film on Bob Dylan.
The problem was that cinema verite did not provide ‘‘the answer’’ folklorists
wanted. If anything, it raised more questions. Films are edited to suit filmmakers’
theories. Those films that seem most appropriate for documentary in general and
folklore in particular acknowledge their power to seemingly represent experience
and reveal the means by which they do so. Such films go beyond the ideals of cin-
ema verite into the openly subjective realm of what Sharon Sherman terms post-
verit e, in which the art form of the documentary is a given. Whereas cinema ver-
ite was art masquerading as objectivity, post-verite unmasks the illusion of objec-
tivity and displays it. For example, in Gimme Shelter, flashbacks confuse what is
‘‘real’’; in Woodstock, an observational camera style is fused with split-screen
images, sound mixes, and rhythmic shots chosen for their balance with the audio
track. The long takes disappear into edited rhythms, as they do in Roberta Can-
tow’s folkloric film Clotheslines. The interview, abhorred by cinema verite for
proclaiming the constructed nature of film, may occupy a central role in post-ver-
ite, as in such folkloric films as Tom Davenport’s A Singing Stream, Judy Peiser’s
All Day, All Night: Memories from Beale Street Musicians, and Paul Wagner’s
The Grand Generation. For Paris Is Burning, Jennie Livingston creates a post-
verite film from a melange of interviews, cinema verite, and intertitles.
In the United States, for the most part, cinema verite films were used to tell the
stories of the ‘‘other people,’’ those without access to media production. With
post-verite, the ‘‘others’’ may become the cinematic weavers of their own stories,
Film, Folklore | 511
is determined openly by both the filmmaker and the persons being filmed, and
the process of the negotiation becomes part of the completed film.
A unique twist to the study of film and folklore is the popular use of folklore
as the primary plotline or unifying thread for feature films. The Serpent and the
Rainbow, for example, exploits the practices of voodoo. The urban legend about
a babysitter frightened by a telephone caller is the basis for When a Stranger
Calls. Avalon plays upon family and ethnic narratives to structure the larger nar-
rative of family and ethnic neighborhood dissolution in the United States of the
1940s through the 1960s, using one family as exemplar. When Harry Met Sally
relies on the courtship narratives of many different couples as a transition device.
Memorable in its re-creation of folklore is Candyman, in which a folklore gradu-
ate student conducts research on the legend or horror tale of ‘‘the hooked-arm man,’’
who has scared teenagers in lovers’ lanes for decades. In this film, the legend comes
to life, and the man with the hook torments the graduate student. That which is
being studied within the film becomes the framework for the film. With the popular-
ity of Jan Brunvand’s books on urban legends, this genre of folklore is familiar to a
vast audience, and thus viewers have undoubtedly seen the irony.
Nonacademic feature films in general release often incorporate folklore as a
detail—for example, a woman singing ‘‘Barbara Allan’’ (Child 84) in The Piano.
Animated films, such as Anansi the Spider and John Henry, are targeted at the
educational market, but the folkloric films perhaps the most popular with general
audiences are Walt Disney’s animated M€ archen. From Cinderella to Snow White
and the Seven Dwarfs and Beauty and the Beast, the Disney studio has presented
a number of ‘‘Disneyized’’ folktales to huge audiences. The viewers may accept
these renditions as the original tales, an idea reinforced by spin-off products such
as books, dolls, games, and other toys.
On a thematic level, a similar process occurs. Folk beliefs about vampires and
werewolves have spawned a whole genre of horror films. Folklike heroes and plots
emerge in stories created or adapted from books by screenwriters, such as The
Never-Ending Story, The Princess Bride, and Friday, the 13th. Other visual forms of
popular culture appropriate themes such as ‘‘the quest,’’ ‘‘journey,’’ or ‘‘adventure’’
found in folktale and epic, reconfiguring them in video and computer games. In
these ways, popular culture ‘‘swallows’’ folklore, reinterprets it, and spits it out in a
new form. The facile quality of video cameras has encouraged people everywhere to
become videographers who document their lives. In essence, what filmmakers and
videographers choose to record in both professional films and home movies or ama-
teur videos often involves presenting a vision of the self by documenting the central
aspects of life, such as rites of passage (birthdays, bar mitzvahs, sweet sixteens,
graduations, weddings); calendrical and religious holidays (Christmas, Passover,
Mardi Gras); and performance events (from children’s sports to ethnic festivals).
Folkloric films also create biographies of individual folk artists, documenting the
514 | Film, Folklore
traditional processes in which they are engaged (e.g., play activities, folk singing,
craft creation). These subjects form the key narratives of the folkloric film and the
folkloric video, which build upon these ‘‘narratives of life’’ by explaining how such
events and processes function in the lives of those depicted. At the same time, film-
makers who document, interpret, and present folkloristic themes actually use such
themes to present self-images. Thus, film not only offers a multilevel means of cap-
turing facets of a culture, an ethnic community, a family, and/or an individual folk
artist or performer, it also constructs a comprehensive image of the self.
Sharon R. Sherman
See Also Fieldwork; Popular Culture.
References
Barsam, Richard. 1988. The Vision of Robert Flaherty: The Artist as Myth and Film-
maker. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Collier, John, Jr. [1967] 1986. Visual Anthropology: Photography as a Research
Method. Revised and expanded, with Malcolm Collier. Albuquerque: University of
New Mexico Press.
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1983. Handbook of American Folklore. Bloomington: Indi-
ana University Press.
Heider, Karl. 1976. Ethnographic Film. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Hockings, Paul, ed. 1975. Principles of Visual Anthropology. The Hague: Mouton.
Jackson, Bruce. 1987. Fieldwork. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Jacobs, Lewis, ed. [1971] 1979. The Documentary Tradition, 2nd ed. New York: W.
W. Norton.
Koven, Mikel J. 2008. Film, Folklore, and Urban Legends. Lanham, MD: Scarecrow
Press.
Nichols, Bill. 1991. Representing Reality: Issues and Concepts in Documentary.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Rollwagen, Jack R., ed. 1988. Anthropological Filmmaking: Anthropological Perspec-
tives on the Production of Film and Video for General Audiences. New York: Harwood.
Rosenthal, Alan, ed. 1988. New Challenges for Documentary. Berkeley: University
of California Press.
Rotha, Paul. [1952] 1963. Documentary Film, 3rd ed., with Sinclair Road and Rich-
ard Griffith. London: Faber and Faber.
Ruby, Jay, ed. 1982. A Crack in the Mirror: Reflexive Perspectives in Anthropology.
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Sherman, Sharon R. 1998. Documenting Ourselves: Film, Video, and Culture. Lex-
ington: University Press of Kentucky.
Sherman, Sharon R., and Mikel J. Koven, eds. 2007. Folklore/Cinema: Popular Film
as Vernacular Culture. Logan: Utah State University Press.
Waugh, Thomas, ed. 1984. ‘‘Show Us Life’’: Toward a History and Aesthetics of the
Committed Documentary. Metuchen, NJ: Scarecrow Press.
Film, Folklore | 515
Folk Culture
The customary beliefs, social forms, and material constructions of specific folk
groups. Folk culture includes the totality of associated elements such as speech
patterns, social actions and activities, beliefs, behaviors, ideology, and artifacts
specific to the group. It arises out of the organizational core of the group’s iden-
tity to reflect the particular aims, interests, standards, and activities of the group.
As opposed to more academic forms of culture, it is learned by interaction and
participation within the group rather than through formal channels.
Culture can be defined in terms of the learned patterns of behavior, beliefs,
art, rituals, institutions, and expressions characteristic of a particular group and
how these elements are expressed. This pattern of learning and transmission is
not limited to strictly oral or strictly written forms of transmission—either or
both may be employed in the learning process. Folk culture is both a representa-
tion and a reaffirmation of the total identity of a particular group, and it is
learned by way of membership and interaction within the group.
Folk culture is usually viewed in contrast to elite culture. Some of the early defi-
nitions of folk culture focused on the idea that it was something separate from urban
or mass culture, and that is representative of the beginnings of civilized culture. Folk
culture was considered something that existed only within small, isolated, homoge-
neous, nontechnological groups, whose members were generally illiterate or nonli-
terate and lived in some form of pre-urban society. Early studies focused their
attention on groups considered to be representative of pre-urban culture: peasants,
aboriginal groups, or ethnic minorities, for example. Since the 1960s, studies of folk
groups have broadened the scope of folk culture to include groups of any level on
the folk-to-urban continuum and recognize that the folk culture of ‘‘rural’’ groups
can and does manifest itself in new forms in an urban setting.
Closely allied with the concept of folk culture is the notion of folk society, a
group of individuals who are organized around some common interest, shared
institutions, and a common culture. The folk society is a self-perpetuating entity
that bases its identity on shared institutions and culture. There is generally a di-
chotomy between folk culture and folk society, which views culture as the val-
ues, ideas, and symbols of the group and society as the actual mechanics, the
way culture is represented through the social interaction of the group’s members.
Some scholars and studies have and do use the terms interchangeably and con-
sider the distinction a moot point. To some extent, there is very little difference
between the concept of folk culture and folk society, for the two do not exist in
singular and separate states. However, the distinction between folk culture and
folk society is beneficial for distinguishing between a study that focuses on the
ideological constructs of a group versus one that focuses on how those constructs
are manifested through group interaction.
Folk Culture | 517
The study of folk culture may encompass such diverse methodological tools as
ethnography, folklore theory, cross-cultural comparisons, historical documentation,
historic-geographic corollaries, psychological analyses, economic impact analyses,
and a host of other methodologies. Folk culture studies also occur in a ‘‘hyphen-
ated’’ form, in which one particular feature of the culture is the focus. For example,
studies of material folk culture (alternately, folk material culture) focus on the ma-
terial constructs of a particular group as representations of the group’s culture.
As noted earlier, the definition of folk culture and the focus of its study have
changed. Early ideas of folk culture tended to be based on romantic ideas of anti-
quarian survivals, wherein the folk culture of peasants, whether their own or bor-
rowed from their ‘‘betters’’ (gesunkenes kulturgut) could be viewed as vignettes
of our more civilized culture in its earlier stages. Some early ideas and studies
focused on folk culture in nationalistic terms in an attempt to trace cultural line-
age and establish ethnic superiority and like reasoning. Though the views of
Romantic Nationalism are not in the fore of modern folklore theory, there are
some applications in which such a study of folk culture has been used to establish
tribal claims on property or recognition as a truly distinct group.
Richard Dorson pointed to the 1960s as the period in which folk culture stud-
ies were broadened by what he called a new type of folklorist. These changes are
identified by a shift from concentrating strictly on rural groups and looking for
romantic survivals to an acceptance of modern realities and a search for reinter-
preted traditions in the urban setting and even emergent traditions. Studies have
included changes and retentions in folk culture among urban immigrant groups,
such as Hungarian steelworkers and Hmong and Vietnamese shop owners, as
well as the uses of new technologies to carry on old traditions and even emergent
traditions in gay and lesbian groups, occupational groups, avocational groups,
and so on. As with earlier definitions and studies of folk culture, there is an inter-
est in finding the continuities within which to identify the culture of the group.
Randal S. Allison
See Also Anthropological Approach; Folk Group; Folklife; Folklore.
References
Bronner, Simon J. 1986. Grasping Things: Folk Material Culture and Mass Society
in America. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1972. Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction. Chicago: Uni-
versity of Chicago Press.
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1983. Handbook of American Folklore. Bloomington: Indi-
ana University Press.
Silverman, Eric Kline. 1990. Clifford Geertz: Towards a More ‘‘Thick’’ Understanding?
In Reading Material Culture: Structuralism, Hermeneutics and Post-Structuralism, ed.
Christopher Tilley. Cambridge, England: Basil Blackwell.
518 | Folk Group
Vlach, John Michael. 1985. The Concept of Community and Folklife Study. In Amer-
ican Material Culture and Folklife: A Prologue and Dialogue, ed. Simon J. Bronner.
Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research.
Folk Group
The term folk has been used in a variety of academic fields and over a period
of more than one and a half centuries. Various nationalistic and political ideolo-
gies, in addition to recent academic orientations, have contributed to the develop-
ment of a variety of interpretations of that term and have generated a number of
controversies about who the folk may be.
As a discipline, folklore is historically a European science, emerging out of elite
intellectual developments subsequent to the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries’
philosophy of romanticism. Following the postulates advanced by the French phi-
losopher Jean-Jacques Rousseau (1712–1778), romanticists believed that human
beings came into this world in a state of savagery, yet it was a noble state because
nature accorded everyone freedom and equality. They also viewed ‘‘civilization’’
as corruptive, for it robbed individuals of nature’s gifts of freedom and equality,
as exemplified at that point in history by life under European imperial governmen-
tal systems. Longing for that past ‘‘state of nature,’’ romanticists began a search
for the ‘‘noble savage’’ overseas, beyond the geographic and cultural boundaries
of civilized Europe and its extensions in the new (colonized) world. Romanticists
focused their attention on the tales, proverbs, riddles, songs, manners, customs,
beliefs, and related traditions of peoples perceived then to be living at stages of
human development closer to savagery and not yet corrupted by civilization. They
also reflected on the meanings and inherent goodness of these ‘‘savage’’ forms of
expression but discovered that inequality and loss of freedom already had marred
the lives of those nations thought to be free of the evils of civilization.
The failure to locate the philosophical ideal of the noble savage gave rise to
disillusionment and futility in the works of the romanticists. Yet they became
aware of the cultural creations of the non-European peoples within whose cul-
tures they had searched for purity, equality, and freedom. Subsequent reflections
on residuals of the ‘‘noble state of savagery’’ led Romanticists to theorize that
such a state also must have existed in Europe prior to the onset of and consequent
corruption by civilization. This evolutionary notion led to the discovery in
Europe of forms of cultural expressions similar to those gleaned overseas and
thought to date back to the ancient past and its noble savage.
These materials characteristically were sought among the least ‘‘civilized’’
groups in Europe. Consequently, the association was made between a certain social
group of lower-class standing and the cultural data resembling those gleaned from
non-European groups. In England, such materials were labeled popular antiquities
until William Thoms, in 1846, offered the term folk-lore as a substitute.
The word folk first appeared in ethnological studies in Germany as an adjec-
tive in such composite terms as Volksleben (folklife), Volkslied (folksong), and
Volksglaube (folk belief). In the English language, it was used first by William
Thoms for the purpose cited earlier. Thus, from the time of its emergence on the
academic stage, the term folk has been used to denote social groups other than
520 | Folk Group
the cultural elite and similar social and cultural categories of a population; typi-
cally, it referred to the segment of the population whose members were perceived
to have not been corrupted by civilization. However, with the fading of the
romantic glorification of savagery, the introduction of the evolutionary theory,
and the application by Sir Edward B. Tylor of that theory to the realm of culture,
the term folk lost its connection with nobility and acquired new connotations.
Among these are the following, identified by Åke Hultkranz:
• Folk refers to the nation. This definition is quite adequate in certain lan-
guages such as German (Volk), French (pueble), Spanish (pueblo), and Arabic
(sha’b); however, it is impossible in English.
• Folk designates the lower stratum (Unterschicht). This interpretation, given
by M. Manhardt, Eduard Hoffmann-Krayer, and Hans Naumann, played a
major role in German Volkskunde. It designated social masses who were
unsophisticated and unanalytic. Since the 1920s, this distinction between the
‘‘elite’’ and the ‘‘folk’’ has been severely criticized.
• Folk refers to an old-fashioned segment within a complex civilization—civiliza-
tion being complex and typically widespread culture characterized by advanced
technological resources and spiritual achievements of high order (in science and
art). In Europe and Latin America, the lower stratum was considered identical with
peasant society and rural social groups. Robert Redfield described the ‘‘folk’’ as
including ‘‘peasants and rustic people who are not wholly independent of cities.’’
In this respect, reference is to the concept of a dependent society or ‘‘half society,’’
which, unlike a ‘‘primitive’’ community, does not stand in isolation from the rest
of the nation. By contrast, primitive cultures are excluded from the folk category
because they are, at least theoretically, complete in themselves and are isolates.
• Folk labels the basic culture-carrying social stratum within a complex society.
This viewpoint has been particularly emphasized by the American sociologists.
It is especially applicable to large societies with a population composed of
diverse ethnic groups, each with its corresponding culture (e.g., Italian, French,
Japanese, and African American). One ‘‘culture’’ is perceived as the basic one;
others are not.
• Folk denotes a social group connected by a common tradition and a peculiar
feeling of communion, the basis of which is a common historical background.
This mystical definition is based on a group’s esprit de corps; it allows for a
very flexible view of the criteria according to which a primary group is reck-
oned, with an individual’s sense of belonging playing the decisive role.
More recently, folklorists and anthropologists have found these and similar
descriptions of the ‘‘folk’’ unsatisfactory in light of a number of theoretical
Folk Group | 521
considerations. The most dissonant of these is the fact that certain non-European
social groups that could not be characterized as ‘‘folk groups’’ possessed folklore
and that individuals from all walks of life—including the most sophisticated—
use folklore during the course of their daily living.
Anthropologists sought to eschew the term folk altogether; consequently, such
labels as oral literature (Robert Redfield) and verbal art (William Bascom) were
proposed as substitutes. Some anthropologists (e.g., Ruth Finnegan) adamantly
refuse to consider ‘‘oral literature’’ (in Africa) as folklore.
Seeking to provide a rationale for a folklorist’s presence among nonfolk groups,
folklorist Richard Dorson adopted a radical form of the viewpoint expressed in
Hultkrantz’s third definition, cited earlier. He stated that two conditions for the
study of folklore were then, in the 1970s, being realized in sub-Saharan Africa.
These were ‘‘the appearance of an intellectual class with a culture partly different
from that of the mass of the people’’ and ‘‘the emergence of a national state.’’ Dor-
son explained that ‘‘in the tribal culture all the members share the values, partici-
pate in the rituals, and belong fully to the culture, even if some hold privileged
positions as chiefs or diviners.’’ Meanwhile, ‘‘in the national culture a schism
divides the society.’’ Dorson concluded that ‘‘at this stage of development the con-
cept of folk becomes useful. Tribal culture, as it fragments under the impact of
modern ways, turns into submerged folk culture in the new nation’’ (Dorson 1972).
Previously, in 1965, Alan Dundes had sought to redefine the term folk in a
manner that would allow for the presence of lore among those who, according to
academic definitions, may not be viewed as ‘‘folk.’’ He stated that the term ‘‘can
refer to any group of people whatsoever who share at least one common factor. It
does not matter what the linking factor is’’ (Dundes 1965).
Bold as these and other justifications may be, students of folklore should
remember that ‘‘lore’’ is a category of culture, whereas ‘‘folk’’ is a sociological en-
tity. Although it is believed that there is no folk without ‘‘lore,’’ it should be
stressed that there is no person who is lore free. The likelihood that the presence
of folkloric components in the culture that an individual shares with other mem-
bers of the community would not automatically transform that individual into one
of the ‘‘folk’’ is equal to the likelihood that the presence of an academic compo-
nent in the culture of a genuine member of a folk group would transform that indi-
vidual into a member of the elite.
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Folk Culture; Great Tradition/Little Tradition.
References
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1972. African Folklore. New York: Doubleday.
Dundes, Alan. 1965. The Study of Folklore. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
522 | Folklife
Finnegan, Ruth. 1970. Oral Literature in Africa. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Hultkrantz, Åke. 1960. General Ethnological Concepts, International Dictionary of
Regional European Ethnology and Folklore, Vol. 1. Copenhagen: Rosenhilde and
Bagger.
Oring, Elliott, ed. 1986. Folk Groups and Folklore Genres: An Introduction. Logan:
Utah State University Press.
T€onnies, Ferdinand. 1887. Gemeinschaft und Gesellschaft. Trans. and ed. C. P. Loo-
mis as Fundamental Concepts of Sociology. New York: American Book, 1940.
Folklife
The total lifeways of any human community, including its artifacts, arts, crafts,
architecture, beliefs, customs, habits, foodways, costumes, narratives, dances, and
songs, among other cultural expressions. In this sense, folklife means specific cul-
tural creations, as well as the discipline for the study of the process and form of
such creativity. Folklife studies refers to the discipline or scholarly movement and
its sensibility for appreciating the culture of everyday life in complex societies. It
also evokes the long-standing disciplinary dichotomy between oral culture and
material culture that represents a major intellectual fissure within world folkloris-
tics. The contemporary folklife studies movement asks its own scholars to be as
attentive to the documentation and analysis of contemporary culture as they have
been to rural, agricultural, and peasant historical and traditional life. Folklife stud-
ies challenges both academic and nonacademic sectors to appreciate, learn from,
and analyze the cultural production of all people and communities within a soci-
ety, not just the socially elite, academically trained, or politically powerful. Folk-
life especially emphasizes that scholarly attention be paid to all those cultures
found within the context of the local region.
Within the European context, the foundation of the discipline of folklife studies
can be observed in a long history of antiquarian interest evidenced in Latin and
vernacular texts and in a series of royal questionnaires sent to municipalities
essentially as inventories of the geography, buildings, trades, shrines, relics, cus-
toms, honors, and so forth of those territories, with an eye to their value as eco-
nomic or political resources. There are several important sources in this regard. In
the 1200s, Saxo Grammaticus’s Gesta Danorum (The tales of the Danish people)
described legendary accounts of Danish kings, as well as religious practices of the
people. Olaus Magnus’s Historia de gentibus septentrionalibus (History of the
northern peoples) recorded a 1555 view of the countryside and people of Sweden.
Philip II’s 1575–1580 questionnaires (Relaciones geograficas) concerned the cul-
tural and regional history of all elements of his Spanish empire (including Latin
America). Swedish King Gustavus Adolphus’s Council on Antiquities in 1630
commissioned its representatives to conduct comprehensive research on the old
Folklife | 523
objects, ideas, and practices of the king’s subjects, as well as the geography of
their regions. A 1789 questionnaire administered only to Catalonia by an official
of the Spanish Crown inquired about cultural geography, agricultural practices,
games and pastimes, labor organization, behavior during public festivals, and
other similar matters. The questionnaires of 1811 sent to many of Napoleon’s pos-
sessions also asked about diverse dialects, customs, and practices of countryside
inhabitants. The Napoleonic example served as a transition point between the old-
style royal surveys of local resources and the romantic nationalist concern with
the particularities of cultural difference. Such writings suggest an early attention
to recording historical and contemporary regional culture, with the idea of custom
being specifically bound up in place and material life.
Folklife developed as a scholarly discipline in Scandinavia and Germany. Folk-
life studies was conceived within the context of a number of influential movements
and ideas. European Romanticism had great enthusiasm for examining the lives of
the peasant class, who, it was believed, maintained a simpler and less complicated
style of life evocative of a cherished rural past. These qualities, according to the
Romantics, were eroded by industrial changes, and they needed to be salvaged and
documented. Folklife, therefore, developed because of the feared disappearance of
the essential culture that scholars wished to study. Another major influence was
the fervor of European nationalism, in which the identification of distinctive forms
of culture could be used to help bolster national identity.
The primary genesis of the English word folklife comes from the Swedish folk-
liv, a term formulated in the nineteenth century and defined as the life and ways
of the folk (the common people or, more specifically, the peasant class) as subject
to rigorous, empirical scholarly investigation. In 1909, the term folk- life research
(in French, etude de la vie populaire; in Spanish, estudio de la vida delpueblo; in
Greek, laographeia; and in Norwegian, folkelivsgransking) was coined at the Uni-
versity of Lund when lectures in Svensk folklivsforskning (Swedish folklife
research) were begun by Sven Lampa. This term was an equivalent of the German
term Volkskunde (the knowledge of the folk, folklore), which first appeared in
1805–1808 when Clemens Brentano and Achim von Arnim edited and published
their folksong collection Des Knaben Wunderhorn (The boy’s magic horn).
Volkskunde has been defined and explained in many different ways by scholars
in Germany, Switzerland, and Austria since that time. As Volkskunde developed,
the emphasis was on the collection and preservation of the oral and material life of
the German ‘‘Volk.’’ Attention usually fell on the rural peasantry as the ‘‘Volk’’ or
‘‘people’’ in question, but scholars did not investigate the traditions of this group
solely to gain a historical or cultural understanding of this perceived ‘‘lower level’’
of German society. Rather, Volkskunde scholars strove to understand something
about the essential nature of the German people as a whole, and the study of peas-
ants and their narratives and customs was seen as the key to this understanding.
524 | Folklife
Their research produced rich studies, with folk art and architecture as well as folk
religion of the Roman Catholic and Protestant regions given special attention.
Volkskunde developed into a complex discipline, and it experienced many chal-
lenges, changes, and crises. The most disturbing development was its use by the
National Socialists prior to and during World War II for furthering their agenda of
Germanic biological determinism and racial superiority. The discipline was used
during this time to discern what was perceived as the true and false characteristics
of German culture as evidenced in the pure German Volkskunde of the peasant.
Today, German Volkskunde could best be described as the discipline that studies
the variety of cultural traditions found within German-speaking countries. It is a
vital field focusing scholarly concern on the central issue of culture and its empiri-
cal analysis as related to all segments of society, with a specific interest in contem-
porary issues such as the impact of mass media, representations and falsifications
of the traditional, tourism, ethnic relations, and the culture of everyday life.
Folklife studies was greatly influenced by theories of history and culture current
during the early twentieth century in Germany and Scandinavia. The philological
and historical orientation of folklore studies, affected as it was by evolutionist and
diffusionist theories of culture, had a profound influence on the work of the early
folklife scholars. The historic-geographic mapping employed as a way to show the
development of oral forms and the illustration of regional variations were applied
to material culture as well. Peasant culture continued to be the source for discov-
eries of ancient remnants of history evidenced in the peasants’ simple, pastoral
lives. Scandinavian folklife research was influenced by the German ethnology of
the pre-1914 period to follow a cultural-historical approach. This meant that it
usually opposed evolutionary explanations of cultural transformation emphasizing
diffusionary explanations of cultural movement and dispersion. Like the German-
speaking scholars, the Scandinavian and Nordic folklife scholars emphasized the
study of the culture area as central to typologizing a region’s elements of material
culture, such as houses, barns, carts, or farm implements. The distribution and
relation of these elements to traditional peasant culture could then be plotted onto
cultural maps to see evidence of development, similarity, and survival. After this
was accomplished, it was the scholar’s task to turn to well-documented archives
and historical sources for purposes of comparison and assessment. This cartologi-
cal and research method for studying all aspects of folk culture and their historical
development became a hallmark of European folklife methodology, and folk cul-
tural atlases were produced as evidence of this meticulous research.
Sigurd Erixon (1888–1968), an influential leader of Swedish folklife research
(and the second professor of Nordic and comparative ethnology at the University
of Stockholm), saw folkliv as a regional branch of general anthropology. In his
conceptualization, regional ethnology was comparative cultural research on a re-
gional basis with a sociological and historical orientation and certain psychological
Folklife | 525
implications. It emphasized the study of material life, custom, and belief, but
Erixon also included oral folklore as a part of the overall picture. Erixon believed
in the importance of collecting traditional resources, preserving them in archives,
and seeing how they functioned for individuals, families, and small communities.
German and Swedish folklife scholars promoted methods of empirical and data-
based research, such as personal visits, extended field interaction, field interviews,
questionnaires, indexes of materials collected, and direct correspondence for the
study of still existing cultural expressions, as well as the examination of newspa-
pers, travel accounts, wills, memoirs, diaries, autobiographies, collections of let-
ters, and account books to assist historical work.
Gradually, especially after World War II, many scholars of European folklife
began to expand the scope of their work away from survivalistic, static, peasant-
based studies. Regional groups were no longer perceived as permanent static cul-
ture bearers. Erixon himself felt that, by this time, the phase of folklife collection
was coming to an end due to the gradual dilution of traditional material among ru-
ral informants. Under the influence of functionalist theory in the 1940s and 1950s
and a more sophisticated view of cultural systems, the focus of folklife research
shifted away from the historical and developmental concerns of the researchers
and their culture and toward the complexity of the informants’ cultural context. As
the twentieth century progressed, the objective, positivist research that emphasized
elements in life (the hammer, the sled, the patchwork quilt, the song, the memo-
rate) over the context and process of living (work, play, craft, speech, belief) gave
way to a focus on research with humans as subjects. Scandinavian and Nordic eth-
nologists, like their German-speaking counterparts, still engage in historical
research, but they also recognize the potential for folklife research in varying con-
texts of contemporary culture, including urban life, social class dynamics, and cul-
tural transformation due to immigration and emigration.
An important corollary to the agenda of folklife research in Sweden was the de-
velopment of a new type of museum. Beginning in 1891, Artur Hazelius (1833–
1901) founded, near Stockholm, the first open-air folklife museum and called it
‘‘Skansen.’’ (Hazelius had previously opened the Nordic Museum [Nordiska
Museet] to study Swedish peasant culture.) Skansen served as the public access to
rural and town vernacular architecture from all parts of the country, placed on dis-
play in re-created natural settings. These rebuilt structures (e.g., farmhouses,
manor houses, barns, a church) were complemented by furnishings brought from
many areas to represent the variety and excellence of regional types. This museum
concept presented the results of ethnological research of the material and social
aspects of national and regional culture. Such research could represent everything
from investigations of past methods of beekeeping in Wales and funeral customs
in the Romanian countryside to the making of fish spears in coastal Norway and
sickles, hooks, and scythes in Bavaria. These institutions exist to teach visitors
526 | Folklife
Rural farm and windmill at Skansen, an open-air folklife museum located on the island of
Djurgården in Stockholm, Sweden. (Gallofoto/Dreamstime.com)
about the past as well as to conserve significant examples of cultural history. They
maintain agendas of research, as well as being repositories of tape recordings, pho-
tographs, tools, furniture, clothing, decorative arts, paintings, and religious mate-
rial culture—from silver votive offerings to carved wooden statues to hand-
colored religious chromolithographs. Open-air museums, or outdoor museums of
folklife, vary in size and quality, and they spread from Scandinavia to other loca-
tions throughout continental Europe, Great Britain, and North America. The folk-
life museum concept continues to exist in every size and international context,
from sixteen different open-air museums in Romania to unmarked, even clandes-
tine museums of revolutionary culture in Central America.
Folklife studies in Great Britain can be traced to eighteenth-century antiquar-
ianism, but it was more specifically influenced by the Volkskunde and Folklives-
forskning movements and their historical-cultural approach to ethnological
research. Retaining a strong tie to the study of traditional life—that is, rural, pre-
industrial life—the documenting and analysis of material culture forms continue
to be central concerns of folklife studies in Wales, Scotland, Ireland, and Eng-
land. Work also has been conducted on calendar customs, festival, occupation,
leisure, and systems of belief. The first institutionalized folklore and folklife
research in the British Isles was conducted by the Irish Folklore Institute, com-
missioned by the Irish government in 1930. This development occurred because
the Folklore of Ireland Society (formed in 1927 on a voluntary basis), with its
Folklife | 527
voluntary associations have been organized with a focus on local traditional cul-
ture. Individuals interested in their own regions may lack a theoretical focus but
enjoy the investigation of their own past and present cultural forms.
The multiplicity of regional names representing the expressions of traditional
culture and the study of those expressions—folklore, folklife, ethnology, folklivs-
forskning, Volkskunde—has not assisted the discipline of folklife and its search
for an acceptable identity and presence in the academic world. Sigurd Erixon pre-
ferred to call folkliv research regional ethnology, which he proposed as an interna-
tional designation for the discipline that studies national folk cultures or folk
culture in general. He also worked to achieve a uniform notion of European folk-
life research, or ‘‘European ethnology,’’ among the diverse European academic
communities. Participants at two meetings of folk culture scholars attempted to
resolve this terminological issue. The first was the Arnhem Congress, which met
at the Dutch Open-Air Museum at Arnhem in Gelderland in 1955 for the specific
purpose of determining disciplinary terminology for folklore/folklife research.
Certain delegates favored ethnology or European ethnology for the international
name of the discipline. The German-speaking contingent opposed the decision to
stop using Volkskunde because of its established presence in academics and gov-
ernment in their countries. In 1969, Scandinavian and Finnish scholars met jointly
in Jyv€askyl€a, Finland, and agreed that etnologi should replace folkliv as the offi-
cial name for their academic subject. By 1970, German scholars also were agree-
ing with the change as a positive response to the search for an international term.
Most contemporary academics in Western Europe now refer to the study of folk-
life as ethnology, with the thought of emphasizing its international aspect. Still,
multiple names and institutional auspices responsible for what could be called
folklife abound in various regions in European nations. For example, for local his-
torians or individuals working in the public sector in the Romance-language-
speaking countries, folklore or culture populaire are used, especially if the indi-
viduals are openly engaged in local promotion, preservation, or resistance. In
France, ethnology, along with ethnography and anthropology, are seen as stages
in the overall process of research into human cultures, whether at home or else-
where. In Canada and the United States, contemporary terminological usage and
conceptual understanding of ‘‘folklife studies’’ maintains its close association with
folklore studies, and the two scholarly fields are understood as one discipline,
referred to as folklore and folklife.
The term ethnology may exist, but it still stands for two disciplinary orienta-
tions: one with a material and social outlook (folklife) and the other with an oral
folkloristic character (folklore). Standard European and North American concep-
tualizations of folklife describe it as the total traditional lore, behavior, and mate-
rial culture of any folk group, with particular emphasis on the customary and
material categories. In reality, folklife has represented the study of material
Folklife | 529
aspects of folk culture, especially rural, agricultural, and peasant culture, in the
face of a predominant emphasis by scholars on oral and text-centered products of
a community. This division can be best exemplified by the two contemporary
academic journals of ethnology in Sweden, Etnologia Scandanavica and ARV-:
Nordic Yearbook of Folklore, or by the journals Folk Life and Folklore that serve
folkloristic interests in Great Britain. This disciplinary split personality makes
little difference to some academic communities and is a point of contention for
other groups of scholars, especially those competing for meager financial resour-
ces or academic positions. Such divisions manifest themselves in the composi-
tion and direction of academic departments, museums, and government agencies;
in the contents of scholarly journals, books, and other community publications;
and in the funding of programs for the preservation and maintenance of living
but sometimes barely surviving or visible traditional ways of life.
Folklife remains an autonomous discipline in the sense that it is not a composite
of various disciplines concerned with the study of regional culture; however, it has
not become a theoretically self-sufficient discipline. In this sense, folklife’s greatest
strength has been phenomenological, but it has provided little epistemology for its
students. It continues to depend heavily on theory and analytical studies of history,
material culture, architecture, performance, language, religion, culture, and society.
Among the other disciplines that are related to folklife studies in sharing subject
matter and a kinship with examining regional culture and that the folklife approach
may have directly or inadvertently influenced are: agricultural history, rural and
urban sociology, human relations, ethnohistory, oral history, ethnomusicology,
social psychology, medical history, art history, architectural history, history of diet
and nutrition, cultural geography, medieval studies, historical archaeology, histori-
cal preservation, local history, maritime history, industrial archaeology, history of
technology, dialectology and linguistic geography, and cultural studies.
More than a field of otherwise excluded categories of expressive culture, the past
and present folklife sensibility represents an integral approach to noticing, collect-
ing, mapping, preserving, archiving, displaying, analyzing, protecting, and promot-
ing the entire traditional creative and/or utilitarian output of the individual, family,
community, region, or nation. These traditions may be transmitted by face-to-face
communication, imitation, or various forms of media, such as print, film, computer,
audio tape, telephone, or facsimile. Some folklife scholars also are working on the
dynamic nature of the culture of the individual as an important corollary to studies
of community tradition.
Contemporary folklife studies shares with folklore studies a common interest
in describing, analyzing, and comparing the culture of small communities and
the variety of traditional cultural systems interacting within such communities.
These communities can be defined through shared geography; age; gender; occu-
pation; leisure; and religious, medical, political, or other belief systems. Both
530 | Folklife
References
Dorson, Richard, ed. 1972. Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction. Chicago: Univer-
sity of Chicago Press.
Erixon, Sigurd. 1967. European Ethnology in Our Time, Ethnologia Europaea 1: 3 11.
Erixon, Sigurd. 1962. Folk-Life Research in Our Time: From a Swedish Point of
View. Gwerin 3: 275 291.
Erixon, Sigurd. 1993. Folklore and Ethnology: Past, Present, and Future in British
Universities. Folklore 104: 4 12.
Fenton, Alexander. 1985. The Shape of the Past: Essays in Scottish Ethnology, Vol.
1. Edinburgh: John Donald.
Gailey, Alan. 1990. ‘‘. . . such as pass by us daily, . . .’’: The Study of Folklife. Ul-
ster Folklife 36: 4 22.
Hall, Patricia, and Charlie Seemann. 1987. Folklife and Museums: Selected Read-
ings. Nashville, TN: American Association for State and Local History.
Higgs, J. W. Y. 1963. Folk Life Collection and Classification. London: Museums
Association.
Jacobeit, Wolfgang, Hannjost Lixfeld, and Olaf Bockhorn, eds. 1994. Volkische Wis-
senschaft (Nationalistic folklore studies [of the Third Reich]). Vienna: Bohlau Pub.
Kavanagh, Gaynor. 1983 1984. Folk Life: Present and Future Tenses. Folk Life
22: 5 16.
Lindqvist, Mats. 1992. Between Realism and Relativism: A Consideration of History
in Modern Ethnology. Ethnologia Scandinavica 22: 3 16.
Owen, Trefor M. 1981. Folk Life Studies: Some Problems and Perspectives. Folk
Life 19: 5 16.
Paredes, Americo. 1969. Concepts about Folklore in Latin America and the United
States. Journal of the Folklore Institute 6: 20 38.
Reiakvam, Oddlaug. 1994. Norwegian Ethnology: Sketches for the Ancestors’
Gallery. Ethnologia Scandinavica 24: 9 21.
Segalen, Martine. 1988 1989. Current Trends in French Ethnology. Folk Life 27: 5 25.
Tokarev, Sergei Aleksandrovich. 1966. Istoriya russkoi etnografii (The history of
Russian ethnography). Moscow: Hauka.
Folklore | 531
Yoder, Don. 1963. The Folklife Studies Movement. Pennsylvania Folklife. 13: 43
56. Reprinted in Don Yoder, Discovering American Folklife: Studies in Ethnic, Reli-
gious, and Regional Culture. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI, 1990.
Yoder, Don. 1976. Folklife Studies in American Scholarship. In Don Yoder, ed.,
American Folklife. Austin: University of Texas Press. Reprinted in Don Yoder, Discover-
ing American Folklife: Studies in Ethnic, Religious, and Regional Culture. Ann Arbor,
MI: UMI, 1990.
Folklore
Term coined by Briton William John Thoms who, in 1846, proposed that the
Anglo-Saxon compound folklore be used instead of the Latinate popular antiquities
to describe ‘‘the manners, customs, observances, superstitions, ballads, proverbs’’
and other materials ‘‘of the olden time.’’ Although the word folklore appears to
have been new at that time, an interest in the phenomena of the field was not. Rul-
ers in different parts of the world had long ordered the collecting of heroic songs
and other traditions through which they could glorify themselves. Religious leaders
and learned scholars periodically gathered superstitions in order to expose them
and weed them out. However, during the romantic currents in late eighteenth- and
early nineteenth-century Europe, intellectuals insisted that the traditions of peasants
were valuable remnants from a remote past and should be collected before they dis-
appeared. Thoms himself was inspired by the works of the brothers Jacob and Wil-
helm Grimm. They in turn were indebted to Johann Gottfried von Herder (1744–
1803) who saw in the arts of common people (das Volk) a reflection of the true spi-
rit of a nation. It is not astonishing that the idea of folklore as a priceless national
or panhuman testimony from antiquity gained force at a time when industrializa-
tion caused rapid transformations of traditional landscapes and ways of life. Also
today, both the formal study of folklore (folkloristics) and the informal interest in it
are linked to nostalgia for the past and uneasiness with modernity.
Long used primarily by English speakers, the word folklore is now accepted
internationally. In some countries, it has replaced native terms; in others, it is used
alongside them. But though nineteenth- and early twentieth-century scholars often
investigated the origin and distribution of selected tales, songs, or games, folklorists
today employ a wide range of approaches to study an impressive variety of verbal,
material, and other expressive practices, including funeral laments, quilt making,
and vernacular house building. Some investigate traditional tales to understand the
structures of human thought. Others study storytelling as a social accomplishment,
paying attention to the relationship between folklore forms, the people creating
them, and other contexts. Many scholars, among them feminists and representatives
of formerly colonized peoples, also are engaged in changing the biases that in the
view of many contemporaries have been inherent in folklore research.
532 | Folklore
Folkloristic Perspectives
It has, not unexpectedly, proven difficult to define the term folklore. Recent
attempts range from suggestions that folklore stands for ‘‘traditional cultural forms
that are communicated between individuals through words or actions and tend to
exist in variation’’ (Bengt af Klintberg) to the idea that it is ‘‘artistic communica-
tion in small groups’’ (Dan Ben-Amos). Many folklorists, however, dispense with
definitions. Concerned that folklore not be regarded as lists of things, they prefer
to look at it as one of several perspectives from which ‘‘a number of forms, behav-
iors, and events may be examined’’ (Elliott Oring). Among the many words used
to characterize such perspectives, the following will be considered here: folk, me-
dium of communication, tradition, genre, and aesthetic processes.
Folklorists around the world long took it for granted that the word folk con-
noted illiterate peasants and other groups that from the folklorists’ standpoints
were old-fashioned or exotic. It was self-evident that these groups would be more
tradition bound and would carry more folklore than the elites, who were believed
to shun the yokes of tradition. However, during the last few decades, folklorists
have increasingly come to think that the folk are all human beings. All people
are involved in folklore processes, regardless of group—sometimes as perform-
ers, often as audiences. During their lifetimes, all people come to share the folk-
lore of many groups, often crosscutting social and territorial boundaries.
Yet despite their conviction that all humans partake in folklore processes, folk-
lorists continue to study some humans more than others. Some critics argue that
folklorists privilege male informants and masculine forms, and others point out
that folklorists continue to study and celebrate the creative expressions of poor
and marginal peoples even as they ignore the deplorable living conditions of
these individuals. The ways in which researchers come to terms with such issues
are of central importance to the future of folklore study.
Mode of communication is another phrase that recurs in discussions of folklor-
istic perspectives. Scholars long emphasized that folklore is primarily communi-
cated orally or in the practices of everyday life. They also stressed that, largely
due to such informal channels of communication, folklore forms exhibit varia-
tions within standardized structures or plot outlines. Each time a traditional log
house is built, there are changes of a kind that do not occur in industrially pro-
duced houses. In oral tradition, there are as many versions of the Cinderella story
as there are narrators, whereas the wording of a poem written to be printed is not
changed even if it is read aloud.
However, informal channels cannot be seen as the sole modes of communica-
tion because folklore has long been transmitted in numerous other ways, not least
in legal or religious documents, in newspapers, or, recently, via television, video,
and all the electronic media. Furthermore, traditional themes and structures have
long been communicated through the works of well-known artists and authors.
Folklore | 533
Late-nineteenth century print depicts the child Moses floating in a basket on the river.
(Library of Congress)
Western classical ballet shares some of its stylized and repetitive character with
the European folktale, and Shakespeare often built his plays on folklore. Para-
doxically, folklorists say that they study orally communicated forms, yet these
forms are available for investigation thanks to various media, including print.
Some of the success of many films, comic books, and advertisements can be
attributed to the fact that they are based upon ancient and widely circulating
themes. Superman travels through space in a womblike vessel, only to be found
and raised by a poor North American couple. His story has parallels in the stories
of Moses, Cyros, and other heroes who are similarly found as children floating
around in small containers. Furthermore, identity changes are characteristic not
only of Superman but also of most heroes and heroines of tradition. The transfor-
mation of the poor and orphaned fairy tale heroine into a rich and beautiful queen
is reenacted over and over in films, magazines, and real-life stories. Some folklore
themes have a psychological force that makes people re-create them century after
century in different modes and media.
This brings us to tradition, a slippery key word in discussions of folkloristic
perspectives. Basically, folklorists long regarded tradition as a store of standar-
dized themes, structures, and forms of knowledge, more or less widely distrib-
uted in the world and at the same time adapted to diverse cultures. These themes,
structures, and forms were said to have been passed on from generation to gener-
ation in tradition-directed groups.
534 | Folklore
One is that people articulate both the best and the worst in their lives in folklore.
To those who have fled from one part of the world to another, a few beloved songs,
stories, or dishes become symbols of a precious inheritance that must be preserved
in order to be reconstituted. Conversely, folklore can incarnate some of the worst
aspects of life, such as detested symbols of racism and humiliating jokes directed
at one’s own group. Folklore can be invoked to hold communities together or
cruelly separate them from one another.
Another paradox is that folklore materials, at one and the same time, can be inter-
national and national, global and regional, local and deeply personal. The patterns
of a hero tale may be spread across the earth at the same time as one special hero
incarnates the fate of a nation. The guessing game ‘‘how many horns has the buck’’
is ancient and widely distributed, but it lives in the fleeting moments when it is
played; a simple, mundane event is thus placed in a vast comparative perspective.
Some of the paradoxes of folklore materials and processes are true also of the
study of them. Folkloristics regards itself as an international field. At the same
time, it is almost everywhere a construction in service of national or other politi-
cal interests. The vagaries in the designations of the field are indications of this.
In post–World War II Germany, the previously used term Volkskunde has
increasingly been avoided because Hitler used it for propaganda reasons. Many
Latin American scholars prefer popular antiquities over folklore because they as-
sociate folklore with colonial imperialism. In India, various native terms, among
them the south Indian janapada, have been proposed as translations of folklore, a
word that was introduced by the British during the occupation. In Sweden, etno-
logi is now used instead of the older term folklivsforskning (folklife research)
because the component folk is regarded as a tainted leftover from the class-biased
days when the objects of study were peasants and manual laborers.
Folklorists everywhere have been involved in nation building and concomitant
class and power struggles. In the nineteenth century, when Finland was freeing
herself from Sweden and Russia, the Kalevala epic, which scholars pieced to-
gether from songs collected in oral tradition, became the first example of litera-
ture in the native language. At that time, the field of folkloristics was a matter of
national concern in Finland, just as it is today. And in recently reestablished
nations, folkloristics plays an important part in efforts to recapture a national
identity. In post-Soviet Latvia, for example, the most up-to-date scholarly meth-
ods are applied to reconstitute the country’s folksong tradition.
In other previously colonized nations, the study of native folklore by native
scholars is a way of self-assertion not only vis-a-vis colonial occupants but also
vis-a-vis anthropology, in the sense that the scholars themselves or their forebears
have been the perpetual ‘‘others’’ in studies by Western anthropologists. In the
views of some contemporary Asian and African folklorists, anthropology is even
more of a colonialist creation than folkloristics. Although there are well-established
536 | Folklore
folklore departments in such large countries as Japan, India, or Nigeria, the folklore
of other African and Asian nations is still primarily studied by Westerners. But
many scholars who now wish to investigate the folklore of their own countries face
obstacles. Which of the many ethnic or tribal groups inside the borders are to study
which other groups? To what extent is it possible or desirable to establish unifying
folklore archives and folklore centers?
Over and over, folklorists have set out to collect, preserve, and protect national
folklore heritages that have been seen as vanishing. Over and over, they have estab-
lished national institutions, ranging from the impressive Folklore Archives in Hel-
sinki to the American Folklife Center at the Library of Congress in Washington,
DC. However, in recent years, some folklorists have worked to expand the national
confines, calling for the safeguarding of folklore everywhere under the auspices of
the United Nations Educational, Scientific, and Cultural Organization (UNESCO).
Yet such efforts raise many questions. Whose heritages and what materials should
be safeguarded by whom? Will the peoples with power preserve and protect the
traditions of the powerless? Future understandings of folklore depend to a great
extent on how issues such as these are resolved.
Barbro Klein
See Also Folk Group; Folklife; Genre; Tradition.
References
Bausinger, Hermann. 1990. Folk Culture in a World of Technology. Trans. Elke
Dettmer. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Briggs, Charles, and Amy Shuman, eds. 1993. Theorizing Folklore: Toward New
Perspectives on the Politics of Culture. Western Folklore 52: 109 400.
Cocchiara, Giuseppe. 1981. The History of Folklore in Europe. Trans. John N.
McDaniel. Philadelphia: ISHI.
Dundes, Alan, ed. 1965. The Study of Folklore. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Frykman, Jonas, and Orvar L€ofgren. 1987. Culture Builders: A Historical Anthropology
of Middle Class Life. Trans. Alan Crozier. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.
Khan, Shamsuzzaman, ed. 1987. Folklore of Bangladesh. Dhaka, Bangladesh: Ban-
gla Academy.
Oring, Elliott, ed. 1986. Folk Groups and Folklore Genres: An Introduction. Logan:
Utah State University Press.
Paredes, Americo, and Richard Bauman, eds. 1972. Toward New Perspectives in
Folklore. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Radner, Joan Newlon, ed. 1993. Feminist Messages: Coding in Women’s Folk Cul-
ture. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Siikala, Anna-Leena, and Sinikka Vakimo, eds. 1994. Songs beyond the Kalevala:
Transformations of Oral Poetry. Helsinki: Suomalaisen Kirjallisuuden Seura.
Toelken, Barre. 1979. The Dynamics of Folklore. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Folklorismus/Folklorism | 537
Folklorismus/Folklorism
Folklore outside its primary context, or spurious folklore. The term folklorismus
has been applied to visually and aurally striking or aesthetically pleasing folk
materials, such as costume, festive performance, music, and art (but also foods)
that lend themselves to being extracted from their initial contexts and put to new
uses for different, often larger audiences. The term surfaced first at the turn of the
twentieth century as an analogy to primitivism when avant-garde circles took an
interest in the expressive visual and musical forms of both ‘‘primitive’’ and West-
ern folk cultures. Before the 1960s, the term appeared as neofolklorism in French
and Russian discussions, referring particularly to the adaptation of folkloric mate-
rials in the high cultural contexts of music, art, and literature. In the German dis-
course, the term appeared in a sociological lexicon in 1958, but it was the
folklorist Hans Moser who introduced it into German Volkskunde in 1962 and
who urged his colleagues to study the seemingly fake in addition to ‘‘real’’ folklore
and folk cultures. Over the course of nearly three decades and against much initial
resistance, the discourse about and study of folklorism contributed to a thorough
revision of Volkskunde’s canon, and it broadened the interdisciplinary scope and
relevance of the discipline. Although the term itself is now rarely used, the issues
originally addressed under the label have become major foci of research. For
instance, the staging of folk dances or festivals for tourists, previously shunned as
commercial and hence spurious, is now an important area of study. The same
holds true for political applications of folklore, be this in historical eras, such as
romantic nationalism or Stalinist communism, or in contemporaneous settings,
such as ethnic territories struggling for political independence. Less contested but
equally vigorous was the folklorism discourse in the Soviet Union and the former
Eastern Bloc countries. Communist cultural policy openly valued the use of folk
materials for altering societal patterns, and depending on the particular situation of
academe in a given state, applied folkloristics and sophisticated analyses of folk-
lorism-related processes occurred side by side. From 1979 until the mid-1980s,
the Hungarian scholar Vilmos Voigt sporadically organized conferences on the
theme and published the Folklorismus Buletin, which offered ready access and
overviews to these otherwise difficult-to-trace developments. In the United States,
a similar but more narrow discussion centered on the term fakelore.
The German folklorism discourse unraveled the dichotomous premise underly-
ing the definition of folklore that had confined true folklore to communal, prefera-
bly peasant settings and excluded materials and groups tainted by the forces of
modernity, such as industry or media. This eventually led to a differentiated view
of cultural processes, involving folklore in modernity. Moser suggested folklorism
as a term for the journalistic promotion of culture and the propagandistic use of
folklore in branches of the economy. The term was purposely conceived broadly:
538 | Folklorismus/Folklorism
On the one hand, it addressed the interest in and nostalgia for things folk in an age
in which mass communication and industrialization seemed to lead to a loss of cul-
tural distinctiveness; and on the other hand, it encompassed the ways in which the
need for distinctiveness was satisfied, strengthened, or awakened. Moser isolated
three forms of folklorism: the performance of traditionally and functionally deter-
mined elements of folk culture outside that culture’s communal context; the per-
formance of folk motifs in another social stratum; and the purposeful imitation and
creation of folklike elements outside any tradition. Moser also acknowledged dif-
ferences in folklorism arising from political economies. In Western capitalist
nations, he saw a preponderance of folklorism due to the expansion of industrial
markets, ranging from tourism to commodity goods. In communist states, the cul-
tural-political mission of folklorism was emphasized. And in developing, postcolo-
nial nations, folklorism seemed to be used as a shield against radical progress.
Most productive for an introspective turn in Volkskunde was Moser’s discus-
sion of folklorism and R€ ucklauf (literally, flowing back) of academic theories and
studies into communities and voluntary organizations. This necessitated an exam-
ination of the history and present of the cultural and political roles of public sector
Volkskunde and opened up the way toward recognizing the discipline’s interrela-
tionship with nationalism. More fundamentally, such introspection revealed the
dichotomous bias in the way ‘‘authentic’’ folklore was defined as separate from
spurious cultural materials.
Although a majority of scholars throughout the 1960s and 1970s preferred to use
folklorism as a descriptive label for everything not included in their discipline, a vig-
orous minority pressed for a complete revision of Volkskunde’s canon. Hermann
Bausinger argued that contrasting folklorism with ‘‘genuine folk culture’’ drew the
latter into a closed circle in which it inevitably mutated toward folklorism, that so-
called first- and secondhand traditions merged in many respects, and that, by
excluding one realm from research, scholarly results were inevitably falsified. Bau-
singer and Konrad K€ostlin linked folklorism to processes of modernization and
globalization that increasingly rendered identity into a consciously molded rather
than a traditionally provided set of practices and symbols—a dynamic that has been
closely documented for ethnic groups in the United States. Furthermore, industriali-
zation had made possible the mechanical reproduction of what had formerly been
unique items of expressive culture embedded in communal contexts. Rather than
confining themselves to vanishing cultural enclaves untouched by modernity, Ger-
man scholars recognized the need to study folklore’s altering roles through time in
settings such as political displays, tourism, and arts, crafts, and music markets.
The term folklorism has been increasingly abandoned because it lacks specific-
ity. In its stead, more accurate explanatory concepts have been sought. The prepa-
ration and presentation of folkloric materials in emblems representing a more
wholesome age or way of life has been called cultural therapy, the medicinal
Folk Schools | 539
effect likened to that of a placebo. The English terms invention of tradition and,
more frequently, revitalization have been adopted to describe the use or manipula-
tion of isolated folkloric materials for anything from efforts at regional promotion
to politically inspired movements. The Hungarian Tamas Hofer has labeled the
emergence of the discipline at the turn of the nineteenth century—intertwined as it
was with the rise of nation-states—a revitalization movement whose ideology
simmers latently in folkloristic theory and practice. The discourse on folklorism
has contributed substantially to making folklorists conscious of these legacies.
Regina Bendix
See Also Authenticity; Fakelore; Invented Tradition.
References
Bausinger, Hermann. [1966] 1986. Toward a Critique of Folklorism Criticism. In
German Volkskunde: A Decade of Theoretical Confrontation, Debate, and Reorienta-
tion (1967 1977), eds. J. Dow and H. Lixfeld. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Bausinger, Hermann. [1982] 1991. Zum Begriff des Folklorismus. In Der blinde
Hund, ed. H. Bausinger. T€ubingen, Germany: Verlag Schwbisches Taglatt.
Bausinger, Hermann. 1990. Folk Culture in a World of Technology. Trans. Elke
Dettmer. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Bendix, Regina. 1988. Folklorism: The Challenge of a Concept. International Folk-
lore Review 6: 5 15.
Hrander, Edith, and Hans Lunzer, eds. 1982. Folklorismus. Neusiedl/See, Austria:
Verein Volkskultur am Neusiedl See.
K€ostlin, Konrad. 1969. Folklorismus und Ben-Akiba. Rheinisches Jahrbuch f€
ur Volk-
skunde 20: 234 256.
Moser, Hans. 1962. Vom Folklorismus in unserer Zeit. Zeitschrift f€
ur Volkskunde 58:
177 209.
Moser, Hans. 1964. Der Folklorismus als Forschungsproblem der Volkskunde. Hessi-
sche Bl€atter f€
ur Volkskunde 55: 9 57.
Newell, Venetia J. 1987. The Adaptation of Folklore and Tradition (Folklorismus).
Folklore 98: 131 151.
Rihtman-Augustin, Dunja. 1978. Tradition, Folklore, and Mass Culture in Yugosla-
via. In Folklore in the Modern World, ed. Richard M. Dorson. The Hague: Mouton.
Voigt, Vilmos. 1979 1980. Confines of Literature, Folklore, and Folklorism. Neohe-
likon 7: 123 140.
Folk Schools
Elise Bryant, left, and Naazima Ali celebrate during a gathering held to mark the anniver-
sary of the Highlander Folk School (now known as the Highlander Research and Educa-
tion Center) on September 1, 2007, in New Market, Tennessee. (AP/Wide World Photo)
their character differs from school to school, they tend to be focused on providing
young adults with a wide variety of residential and extension courses over a short
period of time, without exams or credentials.
Well known in the field of education, folk schools are of interest to folklorists
because of the way that an explicitly marked folk culture—particularly oral tradi-
tions, music, and dance—has been part of the life and curriculum of these
schools. The emphasis on folklore has often been integral to folk schools’ mis-
sion within wider social movements and development interventions, whether as a
way of connecting to local populations or as part of a larger endeavor to nourish
patriotic spirit and nationalism.
Folk high schools were initially driven by the same Romantic Nationalist ideol-
ogies that motivated the collecting of folktales, sagas, ballads, and folksongs in
the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries. The founder of the folk high school
movement is the Danish pastor N. S. F. Grundtvig (1783–1872), who shared
many of the romantic nationalist ideas of Fichte and Herder. Like Herder, Grundt-
vig was interested in popular ballads and folksongs, and believed that the oral
word—‘‘the living word’’—was the key to a nation’s revival. Like other romantic
writers, he wrote romantic poetry and rewrote Norse legends into the vernacular,
contributing 1,600 hymns and songs to his church. Grundtvig felt that his era was
in its old age, and the heroic spirit of the North needed to be awakened in order
Folk Schools | 541
for rebirth to occur. In order for this to occur, people must look at their image in
mythology as if it was a mirror, not in order to exalt paganism or return to the past
but to revive a new life, activated by the ancient spirit of the North.
Grundtvig saw the Spirit of the People (folkeånd) as an invisible and powerful
force that acted in the community and that could only be expressed through the
mother tongue. Folkeånd created a unity that was a living organism, surpassing the
mass of individuals that made it up (a folklighed, corresponding to Jahn’s sense of
Volkstum and the French term nationalit e, an essential national character). Grundt-
vig, like Fichte, felt that each people had a function or mission in the unfolding of
world history, in accordance with God’s plan. To Grundtvig, the Jewish people were
the archetype of a nationality, from which he took the lesson that only a people with
a strong and intense national character can become Christian. The people of the
North had a strong national character between the eighth and thirteenth centuries,
before they converted to Christianity. But the culture of the North died in the same
century in which Dante was born, and the Renaissance suppressed national culture.
The Renaissance exercised its tyranny in what Grundtvig called the School of Death
or the Black School, devoted to books and a universalistic and cosmopolitan culture.
Grundtvig outlined his thoughts for a folk school at a series of lectures at
Borch’s College given during the summer and fall of 1838 that were open to the
public; the hall was generally packed. Grundtvig described ‘‘a folk or patriotic high
school’’ as ‘‘open to all the young of the populace, in which the mother tongue will
have absolute power, and in which the uncomplicated but magnificent task is to
enlighten the people as to their own natural temperament and their fatherland’’
(quoted in Fain 1980a, 66). He imagined classes given in the native language, folk-
song, the history of the country, and the nation’s literature. Teaching would be
oral—stimulating lectures would animate and awaken the students to the Spirit of
the people. Happy songs would be the sign of life at a school. The school would
not prepare students for a profession and there would be no exams or diplomas.
Grundtvig also felt that students should be between the ages of eighteen and
twenty-five, as youth is the creative hour of the Spirit.
Grundtvig’s dream of a folk high school at existing Sor Academy never came
to fruition. Instead, folk high schools were begun by people inspired by his ideas;
they were small, private schools rather than the government-sponsored school
Grundtvig imagined. In the 1830s and 1840s, some of the young theologians whom
Grundtvig taught became pastors, and Grundtvig’s ideas began to spread in the
countryside. Some of the schools were founded by peasants who demanded educa-
tion; others were founded by pastors and intellectuals influenced by Grundtvig. The
folk school movement was a popular movement occurring in concert with sweeping
changes in Danish society, as it transformed from roughly 1760 to about 1870 from
a predominantly feudal social system to a modern, rich, and highly developed capi-
talist society. The folk school movement was only one of many peasant
542 | Folk Schools
movements. During this same time period, peasants founded other organizations to
serve their needs, such as savings banks, newspapers, and political parties. These
popular movements encouraged the transformation to a new political and economic
system that allowed the lower classes to have more of a political voice and eco-
nomic influence, but within the framework of liberal bourgeois democracy with an
emphasis on personal, political, religious, and economic freedom. Though these
movements sometimes appeared to be revolutionary, the revolutionary tendencies
tended to be blunted—an issue that recurs in the history of folk schools.
The first folk high school was founded to preserve Danish-ness in the duchy of
Slesvig. In the 1830s, people in the duchies of Holstein and Slesvig began to agi-
tate for the two provinces to be united and freed from the Danish monarchy. In
both duchies, the language of the church, towns, bourgeoisie, and administration
was German. During the early 1840s, a Danish lecturer at Kiel University, Pro-
fessor Christian Flor (1792–1875), tried to rouse the peasantry in Slesvig to their
Danish-ness. Flor founded Rdding folk high school based on Grundtvig’s ideas
in 1844. In the program for the school, he wrote that here
peasants and burghers can receive such knowledge and skills as can be of
use and for pleasure, not so much with regard to the individual’s particular
occupation and business as to his position as a son of the nation and a citi-
zen of the state. . . . We call it a folk high school because members of every
trade and profession can gain entry into it, even if it is to be established
mainly for the peasantry and expects to draw its pupils mainly from that
class. (Quoted in Skovmand 1983, 324)
found other schools—both folk high schools and agricultural schools. At first the
agricultural schools taught Norse mythology and history, but gradually they con-
centrated on more technical subjects.
From Denmark, the folk school model spread to other areas of Scandinavia, to
Norway, Sweden, and Finland. Like Scandinavian folklorists of the time, those in the
folk school movement felt that peasants were the most faithful to the national charac-
ter, and the elite had adopted alien customs; the national language was the most im-
portant characteristic of the nation; and the divide between the elite and the
peasantry threatened the unity of the nation. At moments of high nationalism, and
times of ‘‘national crisis,’’ interest in folklore collecting and enrollment in and found-
ing of folk schools peaked. As in Denmark, the folk school movement in other parts
of Scandinavia was associated with the romanticism of linguistic nationalism and the
use of the vernacular. The language of the peasant was considered to be descended
from Old Norse, and only it could be used to express and revive the national charac-
ter. Folk schools were also founded to prepare peasants for political participation, as
parliaments introduced peasant deputies. They were founded not simply by intellec-
tuals—mainly pastors and schoolteachers—many of whom were from peasant back-
grounds themselves, but also peasants, albeit those who owned larger plots of land
and could engage in political life, who were demanding education. Folk schools were
one kind of education that was emerging during this time period for non-elites. This
era also saw the expansion of free primary school for peasant children, as well as
worker, technical, and agricultural schools for urban and rural adults.
Folk schools in Denmark continued to attract the attention of educators and
social activists in other countries, and in the early twentieth century, some of the
ideas and practices spread to Eastern Europe, Japan, and the United States, among
other countries. Two of the most famous schools in the United States shaped by
the Danish folk school movement have been the John C. Campbell Folk School,
founded by Olive Dame Campbell in 1925, and Highlander School, founded by
Myles Horton and others in 1932, both located in Appalachia and attempting to
meet the needs of local people and foster their social, political, and economic de-
velopment. Olive Dame Campbell explicitly founded her school on the Danish
folk school model, because she saw the folk schools as crucial to the transforma-
tion of Danish society from feudalism to democracy, a process that she saw also
occurring in Appalachia. Her school taught local people Danish folk dancing and
arts and crafts and began several agricultural cooperatives. But her romantic view
of Appalachia meant that she concentrated on cultural revival and revitalization,
rather than its power to organize communities politically, as Myles Horton at
Highlander sought to do. While Horton, like Campbell, visited Danish folk high
schools, he drew his inspiration for Highlander School from multiple sources,
including Jane Addams’s Hull House, as well as a pragmatic sense of what worked
in particular, local conditions. In the 1930s and 1940s, Highlander supported union
544 | Folk Schools
organizing in the South through its educational and extension programs for union
workers, but evolved in the 1950s to focusing on racial equality, providing a haven
for civil rights organizing. Highlander was thus much more tied to social move-
ments around the rights of workers and African Americans in the South than was
the John C. Campbell School. Folksongs were taught and revised (such as ‘‘We
Shall Overcome’’) for the purpose of creating unity and lifting spirits on picket
lines. Both Highlander and the John C. Campbell School are still in existence, with
the Campbell School focusing on the teaching of traditional crafts, music, and
dance, and Highlander Research and Education Center continues to work with
grassroots leaders on a wide variety of social concerns.
Folk schools have never educated many people, in comparison to the standard
schools for children, Grundtvig’s School of Death. As the movements––whether
romantic nationalism or civil rights—with which folk schools were aligned have
shifted, the purpose and meaning of folk schools have also changed, many
becoming more technical and vocational, and others suffering from lack of inter-
est and having to find a new purpose. However, they remain an important alter-
native for ways of educating for individual and collective transformation.
Cati Coe
See Also Romantic Nationalism.
References
Fain, E. F. 1980. Grundtvig, Folk Education, and Scandinavian Cultural Nationalism.
In Other Dreams, Other Schools: Folk Colleges in Social and Ethnic Movements, ed.
Rolland G. Paulston. Pittsburgh: University Center for International Studies, University
of Pittsburgh.
Glen, John M. 1996. Highlander: No Ordinary School. Knoxville: University of Ten-
nessee Press.
Paulston, Rolland G. 1980. Other Dreams, Other Schools: Folk Colleges in Social
and Ethnic Movements. Pittsburgh: University of Pittsburgh.
Rrdam, Thomas. 1980. The Danish Folk High Schools, 2nd rev. ed. Trans. Alison
Borch-Johansen. Copenhagen: Det Danske Selskab.
Simon, Erica. 1960. Reveil National et Culture Populaire en Scandinavie: La gen
ese
de la hjskole nordique, 1844 1878. Copenhagen: Scandinavian University Books.
Skovmand, Roar. 1983. Grundtvig and the Folk High School Movement. In N. F. S.
Grundtvig: Tradition and Renewal, ed. Christian Thodberg and Anders Pontoppidan
Thyssen. Trans. Edward Broadbridge. Copenhagen: Det Danske Selskab.
Thodberg, Christian, and Anders Pontoppidan Thyssen. 1983. N. F. S. Grundtvig:
Tradition and Renewal. Trans. Edward Broadbridge. Copenhagen: Det Danske Selskab.
Wåhlin, Vagn. 1980. The Growth of Bourgeois and Popular Movements in Denmark,
ca. 1830-1870. Scandinavian Journal of History 5: 151 183.
Whisnant, David. 1983. All That is Native and Fine: The Politics of Culture in an
American Region. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Folksong, Lyric | 545
Folksong, Lyric
Traditional song type that ‘‘expresses’’ rather than ‘‘depicts’’ or ‘‘narrates.’’ A lyric
folksong does not so much examine a situation by listing salient component parts
(as catalog folksongs, often called just songs, do) or re-create an event by recount-
ing the sequence of its stages from beginning, through middle, to end (as ballads
do) as it expresses an emotional reaction to a significant experience. Religious
lyric folksongs, for example, often look forward eagerly to the release from
earthly travail that death will bring when the individual is finally united with the
heavenly family in a joyful, eternal afterlife:
O when shall I see Jesus and dwell with him above; And from the flowing
fountain drink everlasting love? When shall I be deliver’d from this vain
world of sin? And with my blessed Jesus drink endless pleasures in?
In contrast, secular lyric songs more often look backward and lament rather
than rejoice, as does this Irish emigration song from the nineteenth century that
expresses grief at forced departure from a beloved native land:
The morning was bright, But my heart is now low, For far from those dear
hills I’ll soon have to go
Across the wide ocean, Forever to roam,
And leave far behind me The hills of Tyrone.
My poor heart is breaking With sorrow and pain
For friends and companions I’ll ne’er see again.
I’m bidding farewell
To the friends I have known, And adieu to the wee lass
I leave in Tyrone.
However, religious lyric songs such as ‘‘O When Shall I See Jesus’’ that treat
our relationship with a deity and even those secular lyric songs such as ‘‘Hills of
Tyrone’’ that treat our relationship with social conditions, institutions, or habita-
tions are in a distinct minority in British and American folksong repertoires, as
they almost certainly are in other cultures as well. By far the most common kind
of lyric folksong is that which treats interpersonal relationships with ‘‘significant
others,’’ particularly male/female romantic entanglements. Indeed, such a topic
is so dominant within the genre that many folklorists would consider ‘‘love
song’’ virtually the equivalent of ‘‘lyric song’’—or at the very least, definitive of
the type.
As epitomized in love songs, the most striking feature of a lyric folksong (or
just lyric) is the aforementioned quality of its appeal to affect. The lyric song is
546 | Folksong, Lyric
Come, all young maidens, take a warning from me Never build your nest
on the top of the tree
The roots they will wither, the branches decay
Like that false-hearted young man, they will soon fade away.
Other features common to lyric songs seem to be logical extensions of the pri-
mary trait. For instance, lyric folksongs almost always adopt the first-person point
of view, so that the circumstances, the worldview, and most prominently of
course, the feelings are all offered from the perspective of the speaker himself or
herself, as in this ancient Chinese example:
The meadow grasshopper chirps And the hillside grasshopper leaps. Until
I have seen my lord,
My anxious heart is disturbed. But as soon as I shall see him, As soon as
I shall join him,
My heart will have peace.
I climb that southern hill There to gather the ferns. Until I have seen my
lord, My anxious heart is tortured. But as soon as I shall see him, As soon
as I shall join him, My heart will be gay.
I once had a sweetheart but now I have none, And since he has left me
I care for none;
Folksong, Lyric | 547
And since he has left me, I’ll have you all know That men are deceitful,
wherever they go.
A fourth characteristic of the lyric love song folklorists often stress in describing
the type is its heavy employment of verbal formulas. This feature is found in all folk-
lore that depends extensively on oral composition, acquisition, retention, and trans-
mission, but it is, once again, especially prominent in the lyric. Thus, the Anglo-
American folksinger has lamented in song after song that ‘‘if I had wings like an
eagle I’d fly’’ or that ‘‘I wish, I wish, but I wish in vain / I wish I were a maid again,’’
and the African American blues singer has claimed over and over that he or she
‘‘woke up this morning feeling sad and blue / Woke up this morning, didn’t hardly
know what to do.’’ Such set pieces have been called ‘‘floating stanzas’’ by some folk-
song scholars because they seem to fit comfortably into quite distinct songs.
A fifth trait is the lyric’s consistent employment of figurative imagery.
Favored images are those of the natural environment: topographical features of
the landscape, such as mountains and valleys; birds, such as larks, nightingales,
and linnets; and a wide range of botanical phenomena, especially flowers—roses,
for instance, or lilies. In other types of folksong, such natural imagery is basically
just setting, but in lyric songs, nature enjoys a far more prominent role and far
more semiotic significance:
I thrust my hand into some young bush Thinking there the sweetest flower
to find I pricked my finger to the bone
And left the sweetest flower alone.
I leaned my back up against some young oak Thinking it was a trusty tree
But first it bended and then it broke
And so my true love did to me.
Perhaps the most complex trait of lyric songs is their semantic structure, by which
we mean the particular kind of relationships the essential images in the text bear to
each other. In other genres of song, this structure is quite straightforward: In the bal-
lad, for example, relationships are causal and sequential; in catalog songs—such as
lullabies, work songs, ritual songs, and play songs—images are related by part/
whole correspondences, by physical propinquity, or by some other shared empirical
characteristic. In lyric song, however, the dominant relationship is what might be
called thematic resonance; for example, there is clear association in the vitality of
soaring birds, burning sun, frolicking lambs, or a girl running through meadows
gathering flowers indiscriminately, as there is in the immobility of a dead lover, a
marble tombstone, or a hushed cuckoo. These images can truly be called symbols;
they signify such concepts as amplification, intensity, profusion, verticality, activity,
and their opposites—silence, stillness, singleness, and so on—that cluster around
548 | Folksong, Lyric
the two paradigmatic themes of life and death, with their associated emotions of joy
and sorrow, as in this Russian example:
‘‘Ah, why, little dove, are you sitting so unhappy So unhappy are you sit-
ting and so sad?’’
‘‘How can I, a little dove, be happy,
Be happy and joyful?
Last evening a pretty dove was with me,
A pretty dove who sat by me,
In the morning my dove lay slain,
Lay slain, shot!’’
Although enough songs in folk tradition exhibit the features here enumerated to
gain them recognition as a type, none of the traits, not even the type’s most essential
ingredient—that it treats emotional effects of a significant experience—is necessar-
ily restricted to lyric songs. Employment of an emotional perspective is only one
way of representing and communicating about human affairs; recounting their evolu-
tion over time is another way, and anatomizing their constituent parts (the approach
taken here in elucidating lyric song itself, for instance) is yet another. These three
ways of articulating experience in sung verse are the most common in British and
Anglo-American tradition, and any single song will invariably draw upon the con-
ventions of more than one method. Thus, a narrative stanza or two will often appear
in a lyric song, telling at least a bit of the lovers’ original meeting, for instance, but
ballads will frequently arrest the progress of their narratives to express affective
response to the events so far recounted. Indeed, some songs may so vary from singer
to singer that ballad stanzas may be dropped wholesale and lyric stanzas may be aug-
mented—or the other way round—so that genetically related versions of the same
song may be categorized differently, one as ballad, another as lyric. When we cate-
gorize any version of a song, then, whether as a lyric or as something else, we are
saying only that it draws upon certain formal conventions more than on others.
Roger deV. Renwick
See Also Hymn, Folk; Music, Folk.
References
Belden, Henry M., and Arthur Palmer Hudson, eds. 1952. The Frank C. Brown Col-
lection of North Carolina Folklore, Vol. 3. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Granet, Marcel. 1932. Festivals and Songs of Ancient China. New York: E. P. Dutton.
Reeder, Roberta, trans. and ed. 1993. Russian Folk Lyrics. With an Introduction by
V. Ja. Propp. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Renwick, Roger deV. 1980. English Folk Poetry: Structure and Meaning. Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania Press.
Folksong, Narrative | 549
Folksong, Narrative
A concept that assumes two things: first, that the item or complex in question is
linked to the repertoire of a particular group (that is, it must have entered tradi-
tion at some level), and second, that its textual material is rooted in a sequence
of past actions of dynamically involved characters, normally progressing through
stages of stasis, disequilibrium, and resolution.
The recognition of narrative as a significant category of folksong has a long-
standing history, dating in British scholarship to correspondence between Thomas
Percy and the poet William Shenstone in the 1760s. On at least two occasions,
Shenstone proposed a distinction between ballads, whose defining feature was
action, and songs, which expressed emotion. To eighteenth-century neoclassicists,
it made perfect sense to conscript two of Aristotle’s divisions of poetry—epic and
lyric—as frames for sung verse. It is perhaps more surprising that this literary
generic construct remains accepted in today’s more ethnographically oriented stud-
ies. Indeed, constituting genres solely on the basis of textual features may seem
regressively item oriented, possibly obscuring relationships between songs within
particular contexts and distorting our view of the cultural function of song. In some
cases, however, ethnographic research reveals corresponding native distinctions: In
Scotland, the concept of muckle sang corresponds generally to the notion of ballad,
and in Newfoundland, a distinction between songs and ditties or, in some areas,
between stories, songs, and ditties, embodies a separation of narrative and lyric. So
the categories are not completely analytic, but as with any generic frame, they must
not be adopted in a way that prioritizes one group or the other or in a way that fails
to account for how the various categories interrelate in practice. Conversely,
researchers should be alive to formal, thematic, and poetic differences within cate-
gories, as they too may contain clues for the interpretation of cultural processes.
An apposition between the narrative and the emotive, unfortunately, does not
pave the way to a clear and easy means of classifying songs. With the broadening
of the term folksong as an intellectual concept in the twentieth century, not only
has the bipartite division proven insufficient but there also has been little progress
toward the development of a system of classification that is both comprehensive
and based on truly logical principles. Folklorists have expanded the literary model
to include descriptive songs, which are purely expository and document certain
aspects of a situation without weaving them into a story or presenting one’s opinion
of them one way or another. Moniker songs, which name and then briefly charac-
terize members of a group, are good examples. But the model leaves little room for
songs in which mode of expression is secondary to function, as, for example, in
some work songs or in dance or game accompaniments. Further, beyond the diffi-
culty of establishing suitable categories, there is the equally problematic question
of deciding where a specific song might fit. If a moniker song characterizes
550 | Folksong, Narrative
Work Song
Songs used to pace work, not songs that happened to be sung while work was
going on. Work songs were used in most of the world for such varied activities as
making tweed (in the Hebrides), stamping barley (in ancient Greece), mashing grain
(on Georgia Sea Islands), rowing boats (in the Caribbean), and felling and cutting
trees, hoeing ground, picking cotton, and cutting sugarcane (on plantations and in
prisons in the southern United States). Political prisoners forced to crush rocks in
South Africa prison quarries often sang work songs. And in much of West Africa,
songs were used for almost every kind of physical work.
Work songs helped workers in communal tasks apply maximum power at appro-
priate moments in the work cycle (railroad gangs lining track, sailors turning winches
and pulling lines, oarsmen rowing boats). They timed individual body movements in
activities in which body position was critical for worker safety (roustabouts on the
Mississippi River and Chesapeake Bay docks used songs to time their steps on sway-
ing gangplanks to avoid being swung off into the water; African American convicts in
Southern prisons used songs to avoid hitting one another with their axes while fell-
ing large trees). The songs also provided emotional outlets for workers in oppres-
sive situations (African American slaves and convicts could often sing things about
their situation they could not say in ordinary speech).
Where work songs survive, their aesthetics are keyed to participation rather than
performance. In group songs with a leader, the ability to keep the beat going and to be
heard matters more than a nice voice or wide tonal range. In Southern prisons, for
example, tenors were more valued as group leaders than singers in any other vocal
range because their voices were more likely to be heard over a large work area. Work
songs are occasionally accompanied by musical instruments (on some boats, for exam-
ple, drummers paced rowers), but instrumentation is most often provided by the
work itself: by field-workers’ axes or hoes, railroad workers’ mauls, or stampers’ feet.
Except for remote areas where group work is still done manually, the work song
is a disappearing genre. Ships are loaded by crane operators in rooms 200 feet from
the sealed containers being moved, large trees are felled by individuals wielding
chainsaws, hard ground is turned by diesel-powered diskers, and cotton is picked by
machine. The last place in North America where work songs survived as a viable
tradition was in Southern agricultural prisons because many of those institutions
maintained, until the 1960s and 1970s, the racially segregated and physically brutal
culture of the nineteenth-century plantation.
Bruce Jackson
century, it does not logically follow that all ballads are medieval, as was the tacit
assumption in earlier scholarship. Contemporary approaches urge that ballads be
treated as coterminous with the lives of the singers, even if chivalric themes sug-
gest a more antiquated setting and despite purported links with such late-medieval
literary genres as metrical romance. Within this framework, the cultural trait over-
arching classical ballad style is orality, that is, the genre appears to emanate from
552 | Folksong, Narrative
owe at least part of their circulation to print. Where such exchanges occur, it has
been widely demonstrated that songs can become shaped by the aesthetic conven-
tions of the adopted milieu. Emendations to classical ballad stories reworked for
the broadside press commonly include the addition of descriptive detail, nonfor-
mulaic language, subjective interpolation by the narrator, and other typically
broadside traits. Similar processes are operative in oral transmission in later stages
of tradition, as, for example, the tendency toward the lyrification of classical bal-
lads in the nineteenth century, noted by Tristram Coffin.
Coping with the sheer dynamism of tradition has proven the greatest obstacle to
a clear definition of balladry at any level or in any form, which, coupled with the
divergent intellectual and cultural interests of those who have studied the form, has
meant that virtually all efforts toward ballad classification and analysis have been
open to challenge. Understanding something of the history of the scholarship may
at least put some of the debate in perspective, even if it resolves nothing com-
pletely. Much of the early antiquarian writing probably was based on a familiarity
with the urban broadsides, as is evidenced by the general adoption of the term bal-
lad, or ballet as it was frequently spelled, which in the seventeenth and early eigh-
teenth centuries normally indicated a song printed or written on a sheet of paper.
Ongoing antiquarian research, particularly in the wake of Percy’s Reliques of An-
cient English Poetry (1765), led to the ‘‘discovery’’ of the traditional (classical) bal-
lad, then still common in rural areas of Britain, especially in northern England and
lowland Scotland. Subsequent collectors, influenced by national-romantic concep-
tions of das Volk, became increasingly drawn to the ballad as folk poetry, and by
the time William Motherwell collected in the 1820s, there was at least an intuitive
understanding of the difference between the classical and broadside forms. During
roughly the same period, the Grimms formulated their notion of das Volke dichtet
to account for the esoteric features stamped on the products of oral tradition.
The central figure of late nineteenth-century Anglo-Scots ballad studies was
Harvard professor Francis James Child, whose monumental anthology The Eng-
lish and Scottish Popular Ballads appeared between 1882 and 1898. Years earlier,
his curiosity about the nature of ballads had been piqued while preparing an edi-
tion for a general series on British poets, and in subsequent research, conducted in
collaboration with the Danish folklorist Svend Grundtvig, he attempted to concen-
trate solely on the traditional form, which he termed ‘‘popular.’’ What he could not
ignore, of course, was the degree of mutual exchange between the popular and the
‘‘vulgar’’ (broadside) forms, and he often gave the nod to print material that possi-
bly had traditional roots or parallels. It is also quite possible that he was unable to
break completely free of the antiquarians, who had derived their understanding of
the ballads largely from broadsides. Several of the most famous ballad types—
‘‘The Chevy Chase’’ and much of the Robin Hood material, for example—existed
only in versions that displayed greater stylistic affinity with the broadside than
Folksong, Narrative | 555
with the oral form. Unfortunately, Child died before writing the essay explaining
the process that guided his specific choices, and in the absence of this statement,
the collection was left to speak for itself.
Where Child’s erudition carried the voice of authority, The English and Scottish
Popular Balads stood as a five-volume definition of the ballad, and more ardent
disciples granted traditional status only to versions of Child ballads. Broadsides
were regarded as, at best, poor cousins, and those that Child himself included were
assumed coarse vestiges of once pristine traditional compositions. Critics, on the
other hand, insisted that the collection be taken at face value, and because of
the multiformity of its content, they argued that a distinction between broadside and
traditional forms was if not arbitrary then virtually impossible to define, concluding,
as Thelma James did, that a Child ballad was little more than a ballad selected and
anthologized by Child. This position became increasingly tenable in light of
renewed song collection, which revealed traditions in which classical ballads
mingled freely with broadsides and singers who rarely made any palpable distinc-
tion between them. Even though most song collections deferred to the influence of
Child by placing classical ballads first, a practice D. K. Wilgus criticized as consti-
tuting a ‘‘Child and other’’ approach, the bulk of the narrative material in tradition in
the twentieth century consisted of either broadside versions or the two other forms
of modern balladry—the so-called native American ballad and the ‘‘blues’’ ballad.
The native American ballad (NAB) is very closely related to the broadside; many
types within this subgenre are, in fact, products of the American broadside trade and
are, at times, stylistically indistinguishable from British broadsides. As a subgenre
in its own right, however, the NAB brings to the fore three elements that either are
not apparent or exist as secondary considerations in the print ballads: (1) a concern
for occupation, (2) journalistic style, and (3) in contrast to the ribaldry and moraliza-
tion of the broadsides, a focus on puritanism, sentimentalism, and an often fatalistic
resignation to the hand of providence. It should be pointed out that none of these
characteristics makes the NAB a distinctly American form, for contemporaneous
songs in Europe—Scottish bothy ballads, Norwegian rallarviser, Irish street ballads,
and even many Victorian broadsides—reveal similar influences, which highlights
one problem in discussing this form—the inadequacy of the term that defines it.
Moreover, the current understanding of the NAB tends to exclude non-English-
American parallels, such as the Mexican/Chicano corrido in the Southwest and the
francophone complaintes in Canada. Proposing a term that successfully encom-
passes all these traditions is no easy task, but it is possible to account briefly for
some of the features common to many, if not all, of them. The style appears to be a
logical evolution of the broadsides, conditioned by a number of social developments
of the late eighteenth and the nineteenth centuries. The concern for occupation can
be correlated to the transition from petty production to industrial labor as the basis
of rural working-class economy, particularly in resource-based industries (such as
556 | Folksong, Narrative
narrative; it leaps but rarely lingers. In addition to textual features, a crucial ele-
ment of blues ballad style is the accompaniment, provided by guitar or banjo, that,
as in the blues proper, acts as an independent voice within the song, providing a
textural response to the vocal line and, through the placement of instrumental
breaks, structures groups of stanza into thematically connected units.
To varying degrees, collectors and analysts in the twentieth century have been
confronted with all the styles simultaneously, and no ethnographically sound
study of modern tradition should regard them as discrete but should explore their
many interconnections in all their richness. Nor will such a study find that the
interrelationships fall neatly into a historical model, with one form evolving into
another. If the stanzaic form of the classical ballad turns up in the blues ballad, it
is equally true that the instrumental component of the blues ballad, by virtue of
its broad influence on contemporary popular music, has ultimately shaped the
performance of classical ballads in the folksong revival. From an ethnohistorical
perspective, however, individual styles can remain the subject of focused analy-
ses. The development of the oral-formulaic theory and other approaches to the
study of formulaic poetry have reawakened scholarly interest in the classical bal-
lad, which remains the most broadly documented example of oral literature in
anglophone culture and offers great potential for research into our preliterate
past. Likewise, a number of recent works have examined the broadside as a dom-
inant form of early popular culture. Regardless of perspective, the study of both
theme and style in narrative folksong can contribute to the understanding of tra-
dition, for there is as much to learn from the way a story is told as from the tale
itself.
James Moreira
See Also Ballad; Broadside Ballad; Epic Laws; Music, Folk; Oral-Formulaic Theory.
References
Cohen, Anne B. 1973. Poor Pearl, Poor Girl!: The Murdered-Girl Stereotype in
Ballad and Newspaper. American Folklore Society, Memoir Series, Vol. 58. Austin:
University of Texas Press.
Dugaw, Diane. 1989. Warrior Women and Popular Balladry, 1650 1850. Cambridge
Studies in Eighteenth-Century English Literature and Thought. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press.
Green, Archie. 1972. Only a Miner. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Ives, Edward D. 1978. Joe Scott, The Woodsman-Songmaker. Urbana: University of
Illinois Press.
Jackson, Bruce. 1972. Wake Up Dead Man: Afro-American Worksongs from Texas
Prisons. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Laws, G. Malcolm. 1950. Native American Balladry. American Folklore Society,
Bibliographic and Special Series, Vol. 1. Philadelphia: American Folklore Society.
558 | Folktale
Folktale
Variant
The concrete realization of an abstract structural unit or an entity—for example, a
tale, ballad, or proverb type. The famous tale about Cupid and Psyche presented in
the novel Metamorphoses (The Golden Ass) by Apuleius (b. ca. 125 CE) is an early
variant of the tale type ‘ The Mysterious Being (Monster, Animal) as Bridegroom’’; this
tale type was defined by Antti Aarne and Stith Thompson as the type number 425 A.
Some scholars consider variant and version synonymous. Others, however, rec-
ommend the use of the term version because variant is so strongly associated with
the old typological and comparative text analysis—the historic-geographic method.
If the terms are used together, variant may refer to those versions that differ appre-
ciably from the most common, ‘ typical’’ forms.
Variants can be compared and categorized; it is up to the scholar to decide
whether those variants of a tale type closely resembling each other make up a sub-
type (or redaction or oikotype).
Satu Apo
the world, but in different cultures, they tend to follow different patterns. The ani-
mals talk and act like humans, and some of the tales correspond exactly to anec-
dotes with human agents. For example, in AT 43, ‘‘The Bear Builds a House of
Wood, the Fox, of Ice,’’ corresponds to AT 1097, ‘‘The Ice Mill’’; AT 153, ‘‘The
Gelding of the Bear and the Fetching of Salve,’’ corresponds to AT 1133, ‘‘Making
the Ogre Strong (by Castration).’’ Many other animal tales duplicate or reflect on
motifs in human-populated tales. For example, in AT 50, ‘‘The Sick Lion,’’ and AT
91, ‘‘Monkey Who Left His Heart at Home,’’ victims are to be sacrificed for the
alleged curative properties of parts of their bodies, just as in human-populated ta-
les, a diseased character hopes or pretends to hope to be cured at the expense of a
sacrificial victim. Animal judges mock corrupt and foolish human judges. Animal
tales make use of stock characters, and different animals assume some of the same
roles: the fox, the jackal, the monkey, or the coyote is clever, as are the rabbit and
the hare; the bear, the wolf, or even the human is stupid. Other objects, even inani-
mate ones, occasionally appear as folktale characters. In an African tale that was
carried to the New World, one or two people are terrified by objects and animals
that speak (Motif B210.1).
Tall tales (tales of lying, AT 1875–1999) are anecdotes that begin realistically
but culminate in the incredible. When they are performed, the narrator takes the
role of the con artist, and the audience becomes the dupe. Tall tales, especially
about hunting and farming, have flourished in the New World in response to its
promise of abundance. Formula tales (AT 2000–2399), which rely on a firm struc-
ture, are similar to formulaic prayers. Some of these tales, evidently honed on
audiences of young children, are silly; others explore sacred subjects. This affinity
560 | Folktale
Motifeme
The highly abstract unit of a narrative plot. In the structural analyses of folktales by
Alan Dundes, the abstract units of actions or states are designated motifemes and
their manifestations are motifs. The different realizations of a given motifeme are
called allomotifs. The motifeme ‘ Lack’’, for example, is realized in the North Ameri-
can tales as the motifs ‘Once there was no earth,’’ ‘ Water was where earth is now,’’
and ‘ A long time ago there was no sun.’’ Allomotifs—also abstractions—would be,
for example, ‘Earth is missing’’ and ‘Sun is missing.’’
In Dundes’s model, the relationships between an invariant unit and its variants
are the same as the relationships between phoneme, phone, and allophone or mor-
pheme, morph, and allomorph in linguistic analysis.
Dundes abstracted several motifemes from North American tales. The units
appear interconnected, as pairs and ‘patterns.’’ One of these patterns is Lack (L) þ
Lack liquidated (LL); the lack of earth is liquidated in Indian myths, for example, by
bringing up mud from the bottom of the primordial sea. Because a lack is sometimes
fulfilled through the act of cheating, the motifemes Deceit þ Deception can be added
to the basic pattern L þ LL. Another common scheme consists of the motifemes
Interdiction þ Violation þ Consequence þ Attempted Escape. Motifeme sequences
may combine to form more complex plots.
Satu Apo
Folktale | 561
of the sacred and the profane is expressed overtly in a tale in which a man,
reproved for playing cards, assigns to each a symbolic, religious significance (AT
1613, ‘‘Playing-Cards Are My Calendar and Prayerbook’’). Cumulative tales, such
as ‘‘The House That Jack Built’’ (AT 2035), add one phrase at a time and require
the narrator to rattle off a series of events, often in reverse order. In an endless tale,
numerous sheep have to cross a bridge or ants have to move a heap of sand; a
round (AT 2320) is a story that ends where it began and then begins again.
Some folktales depend on the response of an audience. Dilemma tales, which
are popular in Africa, involve the audience in a particularly important role: The
story sets up a situation with no easy answer, such as one in which various char-
acters must share an indivisible reward, and the audience discusses the merits of
the possible solutions (e.g., AT 653, 945 II). In catch tales (AT 2200–2205), also
called hoax stories, the audience is asked what it thinks will happen next, and it
responds with a well-known folktale convention (‘‘The lost object is in the fish’s
stomach’’ [Motif N2 11.1], ‘‘The attic is full of horrors’’). But in the end, all is
mundane (the fish’s stomach contains only guts).
Tales with divine characters, such as God, Jesus, St. Peter, or an angel, are
grouped together (AT 750–849). These naturally tend to be didactic, but even here,
some are humorous. Tales composed of more than a single episode are called com-
plex. The best-known complex folktales are those with magical motifs (AT 300–
749). Realistic complex tales are called novellas or novelle (AT 850–999). Many
depict cleverness and wisdom: A clever hero wins the hand of the princess, a clever
woman proves herself worthy of her husband, or a wise peasant out-riddles the
king. Sage advice leads either to success or, just as often, to disaster. Some novelle
describe social and marital problems: A poor peasant obtains the property of the
rich man; an innocent woman suffers unjustly; a haughty wife is reformed. Others
testify to the inevitability of fate.
Traditional tales and episodes are combined in various ways. Many complex tale
types are composed of a string of episodes that relate to a particular theme, such as
persecution, separation, or heroism. Animal tales and humorous anecdotes are some-
times joined together on the basis of a similar cast of characters: the fox and the
wolf or the rogue and the dupe. Such combinations can become traditional. Other
humorous complex tales consist of a frame into which various short tales are set: for
example, ‘‘The Bargain Not to Become Angry,’’ AT 1000; ‘‘The Husband Hunts
Three Persons as Stupid as His Wife,’’ AT 1384; and ‘‘Clever Elsie,’’ AT 1450.
Frame tales are also noteworthy features that lend unity to several literary collec-
tions of folktales: the pilgrimage in Chaucer’s Canterbury Tales; the house party in
Straparola’s Pleasant Nights; the storytelling session set into a magic tale (a version
of ‘‘The Needle Prince,’’ AT 437) in Basile’s Pentamerone; Shahrazad in The Thou-
sand and One Nights. Modern literary authors, balancing a need for realism with a
desire to tell a good story, occasionally employ embedded narrative, establishing a
562 | Folktale
situation in which a character narrates a folktale. The same device, which distances
the author from the tale, has been used in films (e.g., Dead of Night [1945]).
The categories that Aarne devised for The Types of the Folktale represent qual-
ities that are not exclusive to the tales listed for each. For example, the clever cat
in ‘‘Puss in Boots’’ (AT 545B) is a close relative of the clever fox in animal tales.
Many tales not classed as formula tales depend on accumulations of events. The
hero meets a series of strong men with special abilities, all of whom, usually in
order, help with the quest or task (‘‘The Helpers,’’ AT 533), or traveling compan-
ions learn a few words of a new language that, recited in order, convict them of a
crime they did not commit (‘‘We Three, for Money,’’ AT 1697). Magic tales can
include religious motifs: The foster parent in ‘‘Our Lady’s Child’’ (AT 710) can be
either a religious character (the Virgin Mary), a demonic woman, or a male ghoul.
Humor is not confined to anecdotes but is important in both magic tales and
novelle. In several tale types, in which the hero must make the melancholy prin-
cess laugh or speak, the audience too will be amused (AT 559, 57 1–574, 945). In
‘‘The Rabbit Herd,’’ AT 570, and in ‘‘The Birthmarks of the Princess,’’ AT 850,
members of the royal family put themselves in compromising positions in an
effort to obtain some special object from the hero, and then they have to give him
whatever he wants to prevent him from broadcasting what they did. The humor of
‘‘The Hero Catches the Princess with Her Own Words,’’ AT 853, comes from
conversational double entendre.
Puns and verbal misunderstandings are common sources of folktale humor. Of-
ten, a misunderstood statement leads to surprising success (AT 1641, ‘‘Doctor
Know-All’’; AT 1563, ‘‘Both?’’). Other misunderstandings are unfortunate. A fool,
thinking that a messenger has come from heaven, gives the messenger valuables to
take to a dead relative (AT 1540, ‘‘The Student from Paradise’’), or another fool
gives away the family savings, earmarked for ‘‘Hard Times,’’ to someone who
claims to be just that (AT 1541, ‘‘The Long Winter’’). Anecdotes about the misun-
derstandings of deaf people (AT 1698) are very much current in oral tradition, as
are dialect stories that make fun of heavily accented speech.
The Types of the Folktale is intended to be a finding list (an index), not a logical
classification. However, Aarne’s arrangement corresponds in a general way to the
noteworthy aspects of the tales: animal or supernatural characters, magic objects,
wise answers, and so forth. In many cases, the purpose of a tale seems to be to per-
mit the expression of a particular, interesting episode or motif. Rhymes or songs
are also memorable features that help to stabilize tales: Any reader of the Grimms’
collection recognizes ‘‘mirror, mirror, on the wall’’ and ‘‘flounder, flounder in the
sea.’’ The plaints of murdered or transformed souls are often versified (AT 403,
720, 780), as are riddles (AT 851, 927) and warnings (AT 955, 1360C). Prose tales
interspersed with songs or rhymes, called cante fables, are known from Indian,
Arabian, Persian, and medieval European literary traditions.
Folktale | 563
that refer to incidents. Some of these are known, as independent tales or as com-
ponents of longer tales, throughout most of the world.
One ubiquitous episode is the ‘‘Obstacle flight’’ (Motif D672), in which objects
thrown to hinder pursuit grow into obstacles: a twig into a forest, a stone into a
mountain, or a flask of water into a lake. In Europe and Asia Minor, this motif
appears sporadically in several different magic tales and regularly in AT 313, ‘‘The
Girl as Helper in the Hero’s Flight.’’ The oldest example of the ‘‘Obstacle flight’’
motif comes from eighth-century Japan in a myth about an escape from the land of
the dead. The motif is also known in Polynesia and Africa. In the Americas, it has
come from prehistoric Asia and, more recently, from Europe. There is an analo-
gous episode of a ‘‘Transformation flight’’ (Motif D67 1), in which the fugitives
disguise themselves in other forms, such as a church and a priest or a lake and a
duck. In the ancient Greek story of Jason and the Argonauts, objects are thrown to
hinder pursuit, with no transformations (Motif R23 1, ‘‘Obstacle flight—Atalanta
type’’): Medea scatters pieces of the dismembered body of her brother, which her
father, who is pursuing her ship, stops to gather.
Another such episode is the ‘‘Mysterious housekeeper’’ (Motif N83 1.1), in
which a woman emerges, unobserved, from an object (such as an animal or a
chip of wood) and secretly does the housework. The fortunate resident, puzzled,
hides and spies to see what is happening and then disenchants the housekeeper.
This is part of AT 408, ‘‘The Three Oranges,’’ in the Middle East, Europe, and
India, and is an independent tale or a part of other tales in Africa, Southeast Asia,
China, and the Americas.
‘‘The disguised flayer’’ (Motif K1941) is also widespread. The idea of putting
on a skin disguise may not be distinctive enough to warrant being called a tale
type, but, in places as far apart as northern Africa (Berber), Madagascar, Japan,
and (native) America, this happens just after a particular scene in which a charac-
ter discovers someone hiding in a tree that hangs over a well, and one of them
kills the other. Widespread, presumably ancient episodes such as these can be
found by looking for large blocks of references in the Motif-Index.
In addition to motifs and episodes, there are other characteristics of folktales
that warrant cross-cultural investigation. A significant part of folktale humor is not
bound to any single culture: Paul Radin noticed qualities of the trickster (which he
identified in the tales of the Winnebago Indians) in clowns and in Punch-and-Judy
shows, both of which come from commedia dell’arte tradition. Quests, too, are
universal—this common pattern in hero tales and myths has long been recognized.
Other patterns that describe other broad genres of tales—for example, stories in
which the protagonist is a victim of persecution—can be identified. Oral-formulaic
theory is investigating, among other things, the idea that there are general princi-
ples such as those expressed in Axel Olrik’s Epic Laws of Folk Narrative. Poetic
devices such as contrast and exaggeration are common in folktales. Rhythmic
Folktale | 565
properties, not only repetition and replication but also framing, anticipation, and
recapitulation, are quite general. People use narrative to give form to both real and
imaginary events, and folktales are an important source of material that shows
how this happens.
Thompson developed his expertise at motif classification using material from
Native Americans and Europeans. Folktales from other continents were not so well
indexed. Fortunately, since the motif index was last revised in six volumes (1955–
1958), a considerable amount of additional narrative material from underrepre-
sented regions has been published and indexed. The South American collections of
Johannes Wilbert and Karen Simoneau are indexed with motif numbers, and sev-
eral indexes are now available for Africa. Recent indexes in the Folklore Fellows
Communications series include Lee Haring’s for Madagascar (FFC 231, 1982),
Nai-tung Ting’s for China (FFC 223, 1978), Hiroko Ikeda’s for Japan (FFC 209,
1971), and Patricia Waterman’s for aboriginal Australia (FFC 238, 1987).
Genres of narrative defined according to European concepts are not always
generalizable, for example, in Asia, Africa, Australia, and the Americas, there are
mythical folktales, cosmogony used for entertainment. Two such examples are
‘‘Snaring the sun’’ (Motif A728), in which the sun is caught with ropes, and the
‘‘Earth diver’’ (Motif A812), in which, when the world is flooded, an animal
brings some earth to the surface and thus creates the land. Certain tales have been
shown to have migrated from Asia to (prehistoric) America or from Africa to the
Americas. This latter migration is recent enough that tales of the same type can
be identified with certainty.
Although they also can be dramatized or written, folktales are most often mani-
fested as oral performances. Almost anyone who can understand the simplest folk-
tales can narrate those, but elaborate stories require special expertise to be told
properly (that is, not just as a summary). Accomplished narrators are able to ani-
mate a bald plot, turning it into a fascinating story. They can add to and delete
from traditional tales, but, in Europe at least, the continuation of the same tale
types proves that narrators are often happy to retell the same old story. Depending
on social expectations and the personality of the individual narrator, folktale per-
formance can be understated or highly dramatic (see Performance). Dialogues
between the characters alternate with descriptive passages. Like the product of any
traditional artist, a version of a folktale belongs both to tradition and to its narrator.
Occasionally, a narrator creates a new tale from traditional structures and motifs. It
has sometimes been difficult to separate traditional tales (folktales) from idiosyn-
cratic, individual tales, especially outside of Europe, but as more and better
indexes have become available, it becomes easier to identify traditional elements.
The apt term Homo narrans was coined by Kurt Ranke to remind us how
peculiarly human is the ability to tell stories. Tale telling is undoubtedly as old
as humankind, and written examples of folktales begin early. The oldest magic
566 | Folktale
tale, ‘‘The Two Brothers or Bata and Anubis,’’ from ancient Egypt (1250 BCE), is
described as a composite of AT 302B, 318, 516B, and 870C*. There are Sumer-
ian fables, with the usual characters such as the fox, the wolf, the sheep, and the
dog, from the sixth century BCE, and the Gilgamesh epic, which is Sumerian and
Babylonian, contains a number of important folktale motifs. Stories of the Assyr-
ian sage Achikar (ca. 420 BCE) come from the same mold as do modern wisdom
tales. Written folktales from ancient times seldom are the same as later complex
tales, but simple tales are easily recognizable as identical to modern ones. Odys-
seus’s blinding of the Cyclops (in book 9 of The Odyssey) is now told as an oral
tale (AT 1137), as is the idea that a sailor should walk inland until no one recog-
nizes his oar (in book 11). Apuleius’s Metamorphoses (also called The Golden
Ass, from the second century CE), contains several witch legends and the earliest
version of a magic tale corresponding to a complete modern tale type (‘‘Cupid
and Psyche,’’ AT 425B). The tradition of Aesopic fables has long been both oral
and written; in addition to Greek and Roman texts, there are fables in the San-
skrit Pa~nchatantra (before 500 CE). The beast epics (Reynard the Fox) of the
Middle Ages reveal the satirical potential of animal tales.
Another Eastern source of early tales, in addition to the Pa~ nchatantra, are the
Jatakas, describing the former lives of the Buddha, which are replete with magical
transformations. Some of these motifs and tales exist in oral tradition—for exam-
ple, one in which a self-sacrificing hare, who immolated himself to feed a beggar,
is sent to the moon, where he can still be seen (no. 316; compare Motif A751.2,
‘‘Man in the moon a rabbit’’). An eleventh- century Indian collection, Somadeva’s
Odysseus and his companions gouge out the eye of the Cyclops Polyphemus, illustration
from an antique Greek vase, 1887. (Archives Charmet/The Bridgeman Art Library
International)
Folktale | 567
Ocean of the Streams of Story, is an early source for many of the motifs in Euro-
pean magic tales. The Arabian Nights was first published in French as Mille et line
Nuit (1703–1713), but part of it is as old as the ninth century; it includes tales from
Persia (tenth century), from Baghdad (tenth and twelfth centuries), and from Egypt
(eleventh to fourteenth centuries), as well as contemporary material.
Anecdotes and novelle are present in the works of Boccaccio and Chaucer (four-
teenth century). Collections of humorous anecdotes were made in Germany, begin-
ning in the thirteenth century and continuing, there and elsewhere in Europe,
through the eighteenth century. There are anecdotes, magic tales, and novelle in
Straparola’s Pleasant Nights (1550–1553) and magic tales in Basile’s Pentamerone
(1634–1636). Collections of fairy tales were popular in France in the eighteenth
century. In contrast to the Enlightenment belief in the superior virtue of reason,
magic tales represent fantasy. Beginning in the 1760s, folktales were the basis of
dramatic entertainments, homely subjects chosen for their contrast with the preten-
tious ones favored by aristocratic culture. Spectacular entertainments (films, musi-
cals, operas, puppet shows, and British Christmas pantomimes) continue to employ
folktale plots in this manner.
In the modern world of mass culture, anecdotes are still oral, but longer folk-
tales are more often printed or filmed. Traditional tales are rewritten and illus-
trated for children and occasionally also for adults. Children hear a variety of
folktales from parents, teachers, and librarians and are encouraged to discuss the
precepts therein. ‘‘The Three Bears,’’ which is easy to narrate, is one of these ju-
venile mainstays, as is ‘‘The Little Red Hen,’’ which is also easy to tell and in
addition endorses a work ethic. Folktales from foreign countries are used in
schools to teach geography and multiculturalism. In spite of a general feeling that
folktales (as opposed to jokes) have been relegated to the nursery, many adults
still appreciate them. Cartoons in magazines and newspapers refer to well-known
nursery tales. Storytellers tell folktales even to adult audiences, and some psy-
chotherapists use them with their patients. Fables are sustained by proverbial
references, for example, to sour grapes and putting all the eggs in one basket. In
the scholarly realm, anthropologists utilize folktales to elucidate subtle aspects
of the cultures they seek to describe, and the idea of using folktales to explore
the human psyche was legitimized by Sigmund Freud and C. G. Jung.
Folktales have long been central to folklore scholarship, which is often said to
have begun with Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm. In their Kinder- und Hausm€ archen
(Children’s and household folktales; 1812–1815 and later editions), they identi-
fied many of the narrators who told them the tales and included references to
other oral and written variants. Although they did not believe that variants of the
same tale had developed from an identifiable original form, later scholars did.
The comparative method, adapted from philology, was applied to folktales in the
belief that the tale’s original form and original home could be identified.
568 | Folktale
expressions of the German spirit. This attitude is untenable when the folklore in
question is also found in other cultures. Most collections of folktales are intended
to represent particular countries or regions—many books are titled something like
Folktales of [wherever], or [African/Italian/Mayan/etc.] Folktales, and folklore
archives are regional or national. But most of the tales in such books and archives
are told in other places as well. The borders between cultures are indistinct and
constantly shifting because contact between neighbors and traders is and always
has been very common, and folktales, which can be given away for nothing or
swapped for a drink or a meal, are among the most often-traded commodities.
The romantic attitude of the Grimms is still present in the idea that an apprecia-
tion of cultural and social context is important for understanding why a particular
tale (or a particular joke or song) is performed. (This idea is not very different
from that of the historic-geographic scholars regarding the importance of estab-
lishing the period and place of origin of each folktale, in order that its origins, his-
tory, and prehistory could be determined.) But the same tale, if it is at all popular,
is also performed in other, quite different social and cultural contexts. Thus, a tale
is able, to some extent, to transcend its context. It is this property that justifies
comparative folktale scholarship. It is to be hoped that, as more tales are collected
as performed in their natural contexts, the extra information thus obtained will be
used along with the knowledge about the forms of the tale that only a comparative
study can provide, thereby enhancing our understanding of the tradition.
Christine Goldberg
See Also Dilemma Tales; Epic Laws; Fabulate; Historic-Geographic Method; Legend;
Legend, Contemporary; Legend, Urban; Magic Tale; Motif; Myth; Oral-Formulaic
Theory; Romantic Nationalism; Tale Type.
References
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1961. The Types of the Folktale. Helsinki: Aca-
demia Scientiarum Fennica.
Bascom, William R. 1975. African Dilemma Tales. Chicago: Aldine.
Bascom, William R. 1992. African Folktales in the New World. Bloomington: Indi-
ana University Press.
Bolte, Johannes, and Georg Polıvka. 1913 1932. Anmerkungen zu den Kinder- und
Hausm€archen der Br€ uder Grimm. 5 vols. Leipzig, Germany: Dieterich.
Dawkins, R. M. 1953. Modern Greek Folktales. Oxford: Clarendon.
Doughty, Amie A. 2006. Folktales Retold: A Critical Overview of Stories Updated
for Children. Jefferson, NC: McFarland.
Espinosa, Aurelio M. 1946 1947. Cuentos populares espa~noles. 3 vols. Madrid: S.
Aguirre.
Finnegan, Ruth. 1992. Oral Traditions and the Verbal Arts: A Guide to Research
Practices. London: Routledge.
570 | Foodways
Klipple, May Augusta. 1992. African Folktales with Foreign Analogues. New York:
Garland.
Radin, Paul. 1955. The Trickster: A Study in American Indian Mythology. London:
Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Ranke, Kurt, ed. 1977. Enzyklop€
adie des M€
archens. Berlin: Walter de Gruyter.
Ranke, Kurt, ed. 1977. The Folktale. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1955 1958. Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. 6 vols. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
von Sydow, C. W. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and
Bagger.
Wilbert, Johannes, and Karen Simoneau. 1992. Folk Literature of South American
Indians: General Index. Los Angeles: UCLA Latin American Center Publications.
Young, Terrell A. 2004. Happily Ever After: Sharing Folk Literature with Elemen-
tary and Middle School Students. Newark, DE: International Reading Association.
Foodways
The culture-based definition of the edible and the body of customary, verbal, and
material traditions that pertain to the utility of food as an instrument of cultural
continuity, a sign of group identity, and a significant aspect of folk culture.
The term foodways is more unique among the lexicon of folklore and folklife
than the concept behind it. When William Graham Sumner introduced the term
folkways in 1906, he intended to provide a way of describing the knitted whole-
ness of folk culture—the way in which custom, belief, and expression yield a
unique imprint for each of the world’s observably different societies. Among the
many kinds of things folklorists study, only food approaches the broad vision of
Sumner’s coinage—an attribution that holds interesting clues to the oddly tan-
gential position foodways has held within the range of folk expression.
Foodways means nothing less than the full consideration of how food and cul-
ture intersect—what food says about the people who prepare and consume it and
how culture shapes the dietary choices people make.
The first of these areas has more often been the province of popular and aca-
demic ethnographers, for whom the observation of eating habits has provided a
primary means of differentiating between peoples, often according to the locales
they inhabit. The most basic and stereotypical of cultural characterizations—the
stuff of elementary school geographies and popular travelogues—make primary
reference to the specific foods various peoples eat and often describe the physical
or cultural attributes of whole societies in terms of these foods.
Whatever the accuracy of statements about the foods particular people subsist
upon, folklore’s relatively late coming to the study of food and culture has meant
that folklorists are more likely to focus upon particular foods as significant
Foodways | 571
But it was not so much the grand interdisciplinary purpose of folklife studies—
to identify and document tradition wherever and however it expressed itself in
community life—that opened the door for folklorists’ study of food. Rather, it was
the specific attention Yoder, Warren Roberts, Louis Jones, and others devoted to
activities less frequently regarded by folklorists as culturally significant—most
notably, cookery and costume.
The entry of foodways into the canon of traditional expression had the unin-
tended effect of making the methods and materials of narrowly focused European
folklife studies the means to a more inclusive view of tradition in contemporary
American society. Foodways rendered moot standing distinctions between ‘‘the
folk’’ and ‘‘nonfolk’’ based upon individual repertories of traditional expression.
Since these distinctions were in turn based upon well-established folklore genres
of considerable tenure, the folklife movement, with foodways at its ideological
bow, succeeded where the folksong revival had failed in reconnecting the notion
of tradition to ordinary people and the communities they constituted. Today, food-
ways and its fellow folklife emigres suggest a domestic, conservative profile of an
established discipline against which the idiosyncratic folk artist or protest singer
departs. The fact that these contemporary impressions vary so greatly from histori-
cal and ideological realities confirms both the infusive effects of folklife studies
and American cultural predispositions toward hearth and home.
Even as foodways came to be recognized in American society at large as properly
belonging in the niche created for the handmade, the old-fashioned, and the home-
spun, the ubiquity of the edible made the topic an odd fit for academic taxonomies
and nomenclature. Whereas terms like folk art, folksong, and folk craft had come to
refer as much to the formal (i.e., informal) character of these expressions than the
people who produce or understand them, folk foods or even folk cookery failed to
register a comparable degree of recognition or usage. In this regard, foodways bene-
fited considerably from those theoretical advances in folklore studies during the
1970s and 1980s that pushed performance to the forefront of analysis. Proponents of
performance theory were not particularly concerned with using its precepts to expand
the canon of folk expression, but foodways studies benefited from the introduction of
larger units of study, including events that display skill, symbol, and strategy.
If the American vocabulary used to describe culture-as-food and food-as-cul-
ture has lagged, foodways by any name has advanced in less than one generation
from import to export. Folklorists have laid claim to foodways. In a real sense,
foodways seems equally at home in a discipline concerned with how commu-
nities express and (in so doing) sustain identity. A five-part division of both the
subject and its scholarship reveals what one might expect from a relatively young
discipline: a little theory, a great deal of description, efforts toward definition,
and a refreshingly high degree of respect for the work of journalists, nutritionists,
historians, critics, and social scientists of every stripe.
Foodways | 573
Distribution of Foodstuffs
This area of foodways study considers how the products of farm and stockyard
find their way to the cooks who transform them into food. Calls of street vendors
and tobacco auctioneers, pyramids of grapefruit meticulously arranged for mar-
ket display—these are the artistic evidence of a culture of commerce. Underpin-
ning this culture are assumptions about regions and regionalism that inform a
large part of American folklore scholarship. Boundaries observed and crossed
construct patterns of place, as specific as a roadside stand in corn country and as
general as the custom of giving fruit baskets as a sign of hospitality or sympathy.
Cookery
For much of the relatively brief history of American foodways, cookery has held
the high ground, subjugating all else to context. Most apt for performance studies,
the centrality of cooking as transformation focuses attention on skills as well as
secrets. Unfairly reduced to the brief notation of recipes, cooking is, by definition,
individuated and nonreproducible. The traditions associated with cooking range
from gender-specified roles and settings to elaborate ‘‘scripts’’ that contain, enact,
and signify the relationship between master and apprentice, mother and daughter.
Distribution of Foods
What people do with food when it is ready to be eaten is simply to express with it
and through it the substance of identity, sentiment, and community. Such matters as
why homemade cakes are being sold at a church bazaar or how the individual bakers
who prepared them are identified may matter more than recipes or taste. Yet virtu-
ally everything a potluck casserole, table for two, or clambake signifies is allusive
and implicit. By examining the array of events in which food is sold or shared, folk-
lorists connect the descriptions of food and travel writers to basic tenets of social sci-
ence. Image and action are complementary—the groaning table and the feast.
Consumption of Foods
Because we are dominated by an obsessive self-consciousness about what we eat,
such matters as when, where, and how food is taken have been largely overlooked.
574 | Foodways
Yet the rules that govern a child’s behavior at mealtime or the custom of eating
Thanksgiving dinner in midafternoon are as fixed in most American households as
preferences for particular foods (enjoyed or forbidden). Oreo cookies consumed
filling first or pie-eating contests are obvious examples of how well food serves
other needs beyond nourishment—to play, to compete—and a confirmation of
how seldom the consumption of food is driven and determined by hunger alone.
Foodways provides a vocabulary of experience that demonstrates the presence
and power of tradition in everyday life. The variety of this vocabulary is ample
evidence of cultural continuities and identities that are not always easy to exem-
plify by other means. However, the degree to which food and culture are inter-
twined renders much of what may be gleaned from the arrangement of a place
setting or the clientele of an ethnic food store too common to matter. In this
regard, foodways presses a point about which much is assumed but little is said:
Is tradition cause or consequence? Is the observable fact that people express
themselves—who they are, what they value—through food an imperative for fur-
ther inquiry or a truism too trite to pursue?
Foodways foregrounds the ordinary in a rhetorical sense but enables, as do other
kinds of expression, the extraordinary to become distinguished as the consequence
of reasonable comparison. People who do not sing, whistle, or play a musical instru-
ment every day may consider themselves uninvolved in musical traditions. Such
people are often gladdened by reminders of the lullabies they have sung to their
Fool | 575
children or the evening in a tavern when verses of popular songs rose unexpectedly
in their throats. In the same sense, it is not the fact that all people eat that makes
foodways culturally significant. Many people do not cook, are not choosy, and eat
alone. Such people are involved in foodways when food enables them to connect
with family members or friends, practice their faith, or assist someone less fortunate.
Special occasions in which food plays a prominent role, such as Thanksgiving
dinner or a country fair, are of particular interest because they are invested by
those who participate with a high degree of significance and importance. What has
been too frequently overlooked is the less conspicuous role food plays in other
sorts of social commerce—from courtship to wedding cake, from potluck to pot-
latch. Locating significance in this muddy mix of subject, appetite, science, sym-
bol, currency, and taste is a daunting but engaging task. The need to ask (and to
know) how people express themselves through food demands attention to circum-
stance and process, intention and outcome. The contexts in which food assumes
significance are as many and as varied as songs and singers, but they often lack the
recognizable features that signal a performance in progress. So it is that foodways
is perhaps the most common and least comprehended of traditional expressions.
Charles Camp
See Also Custom; Feast; Festival; Folklife.
References
Arnott, Margaret L., ed. 1975. Gastronomy: The Anthropology of Food and Food
Habits. Paris: Mouton.
Camp, Charles. 1989. American Foodways. Little Rock, AR: August House.
Cussler, Margaret, and Mary L. de Give. 1952. ‘Twixt the Cup and the Lip: Psycho-
logical and Socio-Cultural Factors Affecting Food Habits. New York: Twayne.
Gutierrez, C. Paige. 1992. Cajun Foodways. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi.
Jones, Michael Owen, Bruce Giuliano, and Robert Krell, eds. 1983. Foodways &
Eating Habits: Directions for Research. Los Angeles: California Folklore Society.
Mintz, Sidney W. 1986. Sweetness and Power. New York: Penguin Books.
Neustadt, Kathy. 1992. Clambake: A History & Celebration of an American Tradi-
tion. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press.
Vennum, Thomas, Jr. 1988. Wild Rice and the Ojibway People. St. Paul: Minnesota
Historical Society Press.
Fool
figures over great historical and cultural range. Basic to the fool role is actual or
performed madness or idiocy. Due to a mental deficiency and consequent inabil-
ity to function in ordinary society, the fool occupies the margins of culture. Here,
the fool gains license to speak freely and to reflect on the foibles of others. The
familiar costume and cliche antics of the fool frame this ‘‘free speech’’ so that it
seems to be mere playful babble or nonsense. However, many cultures perceive a
certain wisdom or at least alternative view of the world underlying the contrary,
topsy-turvy behavior of the fool. This ability to see the world differently than
others and to remain isolated from the mainstream invests the fool with consider-
able ambiguity, which is sometimes believed to afford this individual divine or
clairvoyant powers.
The specifically European fool role and imagery have rather limited historical
contexts and, in some cases, very specific allegory. Yet many characteristics of
the fool resonate widely with other figures. Inversion, antiauthoritarianism, par-
ody, sexuality, ambiguity, and earthiness are essential to fools, tricksters, shamans,
and clowns. On the one hand, these figures are essential to their cultural contexts;
on the other hand, they reveal the weaknesses and limits of their cultures by bur-
lesquing and debasing sacred ceremonies and objects, highlighting the foreign,
playing with language, and associating with misfortune. The linguistic play of
Groucho Marx may be worlds away from Zuni clowns speaking Spanish or Eng-
lish to the gods, but both demonstrate the power of foolery.
from Eastern, Celtic, and Roman predecessors. Court fools often had physical
deformities, which, like mental flaws, prevented them from participating in ordi-
nary social roles. In this regard, they are similar to the ‘‘freaks’’ (e.g., dwarfs and
grotesques) and exotics who appeared at carnivals and fairs. The activities of
court fools ranged from serving as a sort of lap dog accompanying royalty or
roaming in and out of the court and into local taverns and establishments (much
like a village idiot) to more formal performances at feasts and gatherings. Some
court jesters would regularly read the news to the court, much like contemporary
comics such as Jay Leno or Howard Stern who base their routines on reading and
commenting on news stories.
Mimetic fool performances occur in the theater, folk dramas, and festivals.
Numerous playwrights, Shakespeare foremost among them, have relied on the
characteristics of fools for dramatic effect. Often, fool figures serve to point out
the foolishness in all people, that is, they provide a mirror in which other charac-
ters and the audience may see themselves so that they may correct their weak-
nesses. In act 1, scene 2 of As You Like It, Celia remarks to Touchstone, the fool:
‘‘By my troth, thou sayest true; for, since the little wit that fools have was
silenced, the little foolery that wise men have makes a great show.’’ Until the late
sixteenth century, theatrical fools were modeled primarily on the existing social
type of the fool. By the seventeenth century, a purely theatrical creation, the har-
lequin, began to provide the model. The harlequin role emphasizes physical agil-
ity rather than the traditional symbolism associated with the fool. Although
retaining the fool’s lack of moral sense, the harlequin does not derive from social
ideology and therefore has no mystical or subversive tendencies.
A variety of traditional plays also feature fools in important roles. Among
these plays are the sketches performed by traveling troupes that thrived prior to
the Enlightenment. These skits often revolve around jest figures, such as Hans
Wurst (John Sausage), who fail to perceive basic realities of everyday life prop-
erly, thus finding themselves in all manner of laughable predicaments. Similar
sketches are featured at local celebrations where town residents become amateur
performers to stage humorous plays, such as ‘‘The Old Wives’ Mill’’ in which a
series of farmers rejuvenate their haggard wives until the fool causes the mill to
malfunction and produce an even less desirable mate. These amateur comic plays
provide a counterpoint to local productions of religious plays (such as reenact-
ments of the Passion of Christ).
Certain calendrical festivals, such as carnival or the Feast of Fools (December
28), have given rise to special groups of fools (fools’ guilds, soci et
es joyeuses)
that perform their antics in public. Unlike professional fools, these actors do not
take their roles because of their physical or mental disabilities but rather because
of the license provided them—often as one of various rights given to trade
guilds—by civic authorities. Festival fools draw on the same costume elements,
Fool | 579
behavior, and symbolism as other fools. They also go beyond these specific
motifs and engage more generally in the inversion of the ordinary by construct-
ing entire worlds in the mirror image of the normal, thus criticizing and satirizing
ordinary society and engaging in licentious behavior. These fools do not provide
an ongoing voice opposed to the mainstream but rather engage themselves and
their audiences in a periodic release of the tensions of the everyday and offer al-
ternative visions of social organization.
Fools also appear as central characters in European popular literature, begin-
ning in the late Middle Ages. Works such as The Ship of Fools and Till Eulens-
piegel continue to be widely translated and read and to provide inspiration for
new representations. The former recounts, in rhyming verse, many of the features
of the fool and relates how these characteristics afflict many of us. The latter fol-
lows the life of a rogue. Although Eulenspiegel does not dress like a typical fool,
his adventures come about because his limited wisdom and understanding lead
him to perceive situations and language incorrectly or literally. For example, he
mistakes a kitchen mustard plant for hemp and defecates on it as he was
instructed to do when encountering the latter plant. In some episodes, Eulenspie-
gel is downright malicious rather than ignorant. His antics resemble those of
tricksters found in various oral traditions as much as those of traditional fools.
Despite their differences, both of these character types share an emphasis on
lower bodily strata—sexuality, excretion, exhibitionism—and antiauthoritarian
tendencies. Audiences for these works in different eras and cultures certainly
have different understandings of the motifs depicted, but these general tendencies
seem to have universal appeal.
Peter Tokofsky
See Also Carnival; Drama, Folk; Festival; Trickster.
References
Brant, Sebastian. [1494] 1944. The Ship of Fools. Trans. Edwin H. Zeydel. New
York: Columbia University Press.
Erasmus, Desiderius. [1511] 1958. In Praise of Folly. Trans. John Wilson. Ann
Arbor: University of Michigan Press.
Foucault, Michel. 1965. Madness and Civilization: A History of Insanity in the Age
of Reason. Trans. Richard Howard. New York: Vintage.
Steward, Julian. 1931. The Ceremonial Buffoon of the American Indian. Papers of
the Michigan Academy of Science, Arts and Letters 14: 189 198.
Sypher, Wylie, ed. 1956. Comedy. Garden City, NY: Doubleday.
Welsford, Enid. 1966. The Fool: His Social and Literary History. Gloucester, Eng-
land: Peter Smith.
Willeford, William. 1969. The Fool and His Scepter: A Study in Clowns and Jesters
and Their Audience. Evanston, IL: Northwestern University Press.
580 | Formula
Formula
whole, and that this network persists after the advent of texts as long as there is
an audience able to ‘‘speak the language.’’ Phrases such as ‘‘swift-footed Achil-
leus’’ are neither merely mechanistic nor uniquely appropriate to each context;
rather, they use a telltale detail to summon the named character, object, or situa-
tion in its full traditional resonance. Formulas do much more than provide ready
metrical solutions for compositional challenges, then; they amount to keys to the
implicit word-hoard of tradition.
John Miles Foley
See Also Bard; Oral-Formulaic Theory.
References:
Foley, John Miles. 1985. Oral-Formulaic Theory and Research: An Introduction and
Annotated Bibliography. New York: Garland.
Foley, John Miles. 1991. Immanent Art: From Structure to Meaning in Traditional
Oral Epic. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1995. The Singer of Tales in Performance. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Lord, Albert B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Lord, Albert B. 1991. Epic Singers and Oral Tradition. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Univer-
sity Press.
Parry, Milman. 1971. The Making of Homeric Verse: The Collected Papers of Mil-
man Parry, ed. Adam Parry. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
Frame
Goffman also raised the issues of frame anchoring, frame clarity, frame involve-
ment, and out-of-frame activity. According to Goffman, framed activity is anch-
ored to (i.e., grounded in) the environing world in several ways, among them: (1)
through participants’ use of initial, medial, and/or terminal framing devices called
brackets (e.g., the chairman’s gavel calling a meeting to order and later adjourning
it; narrative beginning and ending formulas, such as ‘‘once upon a time’’ and ‘‘they
lived happily ever after’’; or the signals given for time-outs during a football game),
and (2) through the fact of participants’ bodily presence in the interaction (e.g., the
physical relationship of person to adopted interactional role is said to be in balance
when an actor is hired to play the role of a villain in part because the actor can
sneer in a particularly effective manner; alternatively, in Goffman’s words, ‘‘role
gives way to person’’ when, for instance, a performer must cancel a performance
due to personal illness). Frame clarity (i.e., the arrangement obtaining when all
participants share a working consensus as to what is going on) can become ambig-
uous during instances of (1) misframing (as when the sound of a car backfiring is
mistaken for the sound of a gunshot), or (2) frame disputes (e.g., husband-wife
arguments about who did what to whom and why). A participant’s frame involve-
ment (i.e., the level of engrossment in a framed activity) is held up to question
when the participant breaks frame (i.e., he or she engages in activity to which the
official frame cannot be applied). Examples include: (1) flooding-out (e.g., when
an individual dissolves into laughter or anger at an inappropriate moment); and (2)
downkeying—that is, frame movement toward or into a primary framework (e.g.,
when playfulness gets out of hand—perhaps during the use of ritual insults—and a
participant becomes angry, feeling that his or her personal interests have been vio-
lated). Finally, Goffman argued that multiple laminations (i.e., layers of frame) can
be developed in any situation and that information from multiple channels can
become available during any given interaction. Some of this latter information can
result from out-of-frame activity (i.e., activity that is alternate to the interaction’s
official focus and to which participants either only partially attend or try officially
to ignore). Examples include information presented (1) through an overlay channel
(e.g., the announcement of a storm warning that runs across [i.e., overlays] the bot-
tom of one’s television screen while another program is in progress), or (2) in
sounds that participants relegate to the disattend track (e.g., participants’ trying to
ignore the sound of a baby crying during a church service).
In contrast to Goffman, who often based his consideration of frame on anecdotes
of behavioral situations drawn from mainstream American life, sociolinguist John
Gumperz treated frame in light of conversational discourse obtained from members
of culturally heterogeneous, urbanized communities. Gumperz argued that cultures
can differ markedly in their expectations for communicative competence, which
(when viewed in interactional terms) includes knowledge not only of linguistic
grammar and the lexicon but also of the social conversations by which speakers
584 | Frame
‘‘a set of expectations that rests on previous experience.’’ To Gumperz, the interpre-
tive process in a conversation begins with the participants’ making implicit but cul-
turally informed guesses about the type of speech activity being developed—for
example, ‘‘chatting about the weather’’ or ‘‘telling a story.’’ Participants base their
guesses on their previous experience with similar situations and on cultural knowl-
edge. Informed guesses allow participants to anticipate, for instance, the turn-taking
procedures, overall themes, and possible outcomes of the conversation. Whether
treating frame in the sense of schemata or of interactive frame, Gumperz pointed
out that frames relevant later in a conversation are subject to interpretation in terms
of frames that were pertinent earlier in the same conversation. Alternately, frames
pertinent later in a conversation can be used to reframe understandings believed to
be relevant earlier in the same conversation. Gumperz emphasized that the develop-
ment of meaning in and throughout a conversation is not a matter of unilateral
action but is ‘‘rather [one] of speaker-listener coordination involving [the] rhythmic
interchange of both verbal and nonverbal signs.’’
Since verbal folklore (story and joke telling, riddling, ballad singing, and so
forth) and nonverbal folklore (such as folk gestures) constitute either framed ac-
tivity or behavior that can frame other activity, the consideration of contexualiza-
tion cues and frame use is especially pertinent to folklore study. Many
contextualization cues (such as the shrugging of one’s shoulders to indicate
doubt) are culturally learned and thus traditional. Some, though, are emergent
within their context of use (e.g., a storyteller’s marked [perhaps sarcastic or
exaggerated] reuse of a particular phrase or gesture in order to suggest narrative
continuity or to encourage audience participation). Whether the cueing devices
are traditional or emergent, participants’ use and understanding of them represent
valuable information for the field-worker, signaling the participants’ commit-
ment to the interaction as well as the participants’ attitudes toward each other.
An example of a study of framing in the domain of storytelling is Katharine
Young’s ‘‘Frame and Boundary in the Phenomenology of Narrative.’’ Influenced
in part by the work of Gregory Bateson in defining frame, Young has explored
how frame operates in conversational narration. She sets the stage for this explo-
ration by distinguishing two ontological presentations of stories in conversation:
stories as a ‘‘realm of discourse transpiring in the here and now,’’ which she calls
a ‘‘storyrealm,’’ and stories as a ‘‘realm of events transpiring in another space and
time,’’ which she calls a ‘‘taleworld.’’ Tale characters and events inhabit the tale-
world, whereas the storyrealm is inhabited by the participants of the storytelling
event as they interact with one another as the event transpires. Young’s investi-
gation considers four types of narrative frame: frames and evaluations of the
story and frames and evaluations of the events the story is about.
Frames in the form of prefaces and codas operate as boundaries between the
realm of conversation and either the taleworld or the storyworld. Both prefaces
586 | Freedom Songs
and codas function within the domain of conversation. Prefaces may, for instance,
announce a new speech event by saying, ‘‘I’ve got a new story for you.’’ Codas
follow the end of the events in the tale and are designed to link that just past realm
to the present-time conversation. In discussing frames that are not boundaries,
Young begins with orientations that provide information deemed necessary in
order to understand what is happening in the taleworld (e.g., ‘‘Jean and I were
going up a narrow lane in Cornwall’’). In establishing the background against
which events unfold, orientations ‘‘set up the angle from which hearers apprehend
those events.’’ Next, Young takes up those frames she calls evaluations. Evalua-
tion has been described by sociolinguist William Labov as the ‘‘means used by
the narrator to indicate the point of the narrative, its raison d’^
etre: why it was told
and what the narrator was getting at.’’ Young fine-tunes this point to show a dis-
tinction between the point of the story and the point of telling the story. The first
‘‘pertains to the relationship between events in the story and the second to the
relationship between the story and the occasion on which it is told.’’ Labov com-
ments that to identify the evaluative portion of a narrative it is ‘‘necessary to know
why the narrative is tellable.’’ Young rejoinders that events are not just tellable,
but tellable on occasions, and that it is their relevance to an occasion that is the
point of the telling. Young concludes by pointing out that not all types of frames
occur in every story in her corpus, and only four types seem to be essential: a
preface, the beginning and ending, and some sort of evaluation.
Danielle M. Roemer
See Also Discourse Analysis; Linguistic Approach; Performance.
References
Bateson, Gregory. [1955] 1972. A Theory of Play and Fantasy. In Steps to an Ecol-
ogy of Mind, ed. Gregory Bateson. San Francisco: Chandler.
Goffman, Erving. 1974. Frame Analysis: An Essay on the Organization of Experi-
ence. New York: Harper & Row.
Goffman, Erving. 1981. Forms of Talk. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania
Press.
Gumperz, John J. 1982. Discourse Strategies. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Young, Katharine. 2004. Frame and Boundary in the Phenomenology of Narrative.
In Narrative Across Media: The Languages of Storytelling, ed. Marie-Laure Ryan. Lin-
coln: University of Nebraska Press.
Freedom Songs
The umbrella term describing the diverse body of songs adapted, adopted, or com-
posed for use during the American civil rights movement. These songs had their
highest public profile during so-called Freedom Summer (1964), when hundreds of
Freedom Songs | 587
Arthur Fredericks, center, leads singing marchers onto Boston Common for a civil rights
rally, May 9, 1968. The march from the Roxbury area is part of the northern leg of the
Poor People’s March on Washington. (AP/Wide World Photos)
extensive general use joined black performance practice with relatively simple me-
lodic contours and highly repetitive lyrics easy for less-skilled locals and visiting
white volunteers to grasp. Those volunteers, whom Student Nonviolent Coordinat-
ing Committee (SNCC) leaders had justifiably worried would include patronizing
or simply harmfully innocent individuals, were impressed (and usefully humbled)
by local blacks’ greater command of oral skills, including singing. Thus, the basic
nature of the repertoire embodied interracial diplomacy, and blacks’ singing skill
helped keep that fragile diplomacy from foundering. Song was also important in
black activists’ convincing black citizens to risk their jobs and safety by attempting
to register to vote. Indeed, church music in many black communities was changed
by the arrival of freedom songs, the black singer-teachers of which incorporated
more physical motion and musical liberties than many local black churchgoers had
been accustomed to employing. Since most of the most popular freedom songs
issued from black religious tradition (that is, were black hymns or spirituals with
the words changed slightly), and since most mass meetings were held in churches,
it became natural for freedom song performances to contribute to a more ardently
black performance style on Sundays.
Chris Goertzen
See Also African American Folklore; Folksong, Narrative; Music, Folk.
References
Carawan, Guy and Candie, comps. 1963. We Shall Overcome! Songs of the Southern
Freedom Movement. New York: Oak Publications.
Reagon, Bernice Johnson. 1975. Songs of the Civil Rights Movement, 1955 1965:
A Study in Culture History. Dissertation, History, Howard University.
Sanger, Kerran. 1996. ‘‘When the Spirit Says Sing!’’ The Role of Freedom Songs in
the Civil Rights Movement. New York: Garland Publishing.
Freudian Psychology
The theory and techniques developed by Sigmund Freud (1856–1939), the foun-
der of psychoanalysis. The term is also applied liberally by nonspecialists to
label approaches of ‘‘depth psychology’’ investigating unconscious mental pro-
cesses and to certain methods of psychotherapy that are attributable, directly or
indirectly, to Freud. Such approaches and methods are so characterized when
they address data that are erotic, incestuous along parent-child lines, noncogni-
tive, and symbolic.
Freud was born in Freiberg, Moravia (now in P€ıbor, Czech Republic), and
raised in Vienna. He was considered the brightest of the eight children of a Jewish
businessman of modest means and given preferential treatment; he was trained as
Freudian Psychology | 589
a medical doctor and began his professional life as a clinical neurologist. He soon
became aware of the profound impact that sexual experiences had exerted on the
minds and bodies of certain patients, and his search for explanations of this phe-
nomenon led him gradually to the components of his theories. The cornerstones
of Freud’s psychoanalytic approach are the interplay between unconscious and
conscious psychological processes, the hereditary nature of instinctual drives, and
the three-level systemic structure of the mind (or psyche).
One of Freud’s cardinal contributions to the study of human psychology was
his identification of the unconscious as a psychic entity controlled by considera-
tions and forces different than those governing the conscious mind. Within the
unconscious, feelings and ideas assume ever-shifting patterns—combinations and
configurations of the concrete and the abstract, the tangible and the intangible, the
known and the unknown, the logical and the illogical, and so on—all under sym-
bolic guises. Thus, two dissimilar ideas or images may be fused into one; experi-
ences that are interconnected may be shifted or displaced out of context; feelings
and thoughts may be portrayed in the form of dramatic images rather than
expressed as abstract concepts; and certain objects may be represented in symbolic
guise by images of other entities, although the resemblance between the symbol
and the original object may be incomprehensible.
Recognition of these unconscious mental modes of operation made possible
the understanding of such previously mystifying psychological phenomena as
dreaming and, by extension, such cultural phenomena as myth making, and simi-
lar group experiences.
A basic premise of Freudian theory is that instinctual impulses (drives), espe-
cially the sexual, which originate in childhood, trigger unconscious conflicts. Thus,
adult sexuality is a product of a complex process of biological development begin-
ning in childhood; this development goes through stages determined by a variety of
body functions or areas (zones) and the child’s relation to adults, especially to
parents. These psychosexual stages are: the oral, the anal, and the phallic or genital.
According to Freud, the child becomes capable of an emotional attachment to
the parent of the opposite sex for the first time during the Oedipal stage (four to
six years of age). However, physical and intellectual immaturity prevent the
child from satisfying these desires (that is, they frustrate realization of fantasies);
consequently, the desires are unconsciously associated with failure and sup-
pressed. These early patterns of conflict serve as prototypes for an individual’s
development (and conflicts) during later stages of life, especially in such situa-
tions as relationships to parental figures and authority and dependency on others.
The structure of the psychic system is designated in a three-level hierarchy: the
id, ego, and superego. The id signifies the sexual and aggressive tendencies that
arise from the Triebe (primary or biological drives, libido, and so forth); it is
primitive and pleasure oriented. The superego refers to internalized standards
590 | Freudian Psychology
References
Adler, Alfred. 1925. The Practice and Theory of Individual Psychology. New York:
Harcourt, Brace, and World.
Brill, A. A., tr. ed. 1938. The Basic Writings of Sigmund Freud. New York: Modern
Library.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. Analytic Essays in Folklore. The Hague: Mouton.
Freud, Sigmund. [1913] 1938. Totem and Taboo. New York: New Republic.
Freud, Sigmund. 1939. Moses and Monotheism. New York: A. A. Knopf.
Freud, Sigmund. 1950. The Interpretation of Dreams. New York: Modern Library.
Fromm, Erich. 1955. The Sane Society. New York: Holt.
Frontier Folk Heroes | 591
Frontier nations of the New World, including the United States of America, Can-
ada, Australia, and New Zealand, have all developed distinctive folk heroes and
heroines that are usually associated with pioneering activities such as exploring,
subduing indigenous peoples, stock droving, lumbering, mining, and other forms
of mainly rural life and labor. Most of these characters have a larger-than-life
quality and are typically braggarts and liars of sometimes astounding audacity.
Notable in this respect was the American figure Davy Crockett.
As well as their propensity to exaggeration, pioneer heroes are often credited
with a down-to-earth wisdom, usually expressed in pithily humorous form and of-
ten collected into books and almanacs sold in great numbers, thus helping to
spread the fame and folklore of their subjects. A well-known American example
of this type was the frontiersman Daniel Boone (1734–1820). He is credited with
the discovery of the Cumberland Gap through the Appalachian Mountains, and
over a long and adventurous life he became the center of many legends about his
strength, prowess, cunning, and scorn of danger and death. Jim Bowie, best known
as the inventor of the knife that bears his name, was another focus of pioneering
legends and traditions in Texas, while Kit (Christopher) Carson (1809–1868), pio-
neer and backwoodsman, achieved fame for his knowledge of the country and his
positive relationship with Native Americans. He is the subject of tall tales of back-
woods life, many of which are also told of other backwoods and frontier heroes.
A slightly later development usually found in New World societies is the frontier
‘‘type.’’ In the United States, this person is represented by the cowboy, and in Aus-
tralia by the bushman. Each of these types generates usually mythical characters
whose folklore is derived from the circumstances and imperatives of frontier life.
Thus Pecos Bill is a cowboy hero in the United States and elsewhere. Crooked
Mick is a shearer’s hero in Australia. In addition, there are usually historical charac-
ters who, to a greater or lesser extent, through their own self-aggrandizement, come
to be seen in the role of frontier heroes. These figures include William ‘‘Buffalo
Bill’’ Cody (1846–1917), army scout, pony express rider, showman, and buffalo
hunter, who earned his nickname for shooting almost 5,000 buffalo to supply rail-
way workers with fresh meat. His name and feats became more widely known
through his touring with his Wild West Show from 1883. James Butler ‘‘Wild Bill’’
Hickock (1837–1876) was a similar case.
592 | Frontier Folk Heroes
Such masculine activities and images also generate their gender opposites in
the form of the cowgirl, perhaps the best known being American rodeo rider and
sharp shooter Annie Oakley (Phoebe Annie Oakley Moses, 1860–1926), who
garnered a reputation as a frontier heroine who could equal or outdo men in the
male-dominated activities at which she excelled. Oakley is a historical character
squarely in the tradition of the female—usually fictional—who dresses in man’s
attire and operates in a man’s world. Annie Oakley was celebrated and romanti-
cized in Irving Berlin’s 1946 musical Annie Get Your Gun.
As well as their presence in folktales of various forms, frontier heroes may
also appear in songs and balladry associated with their deeds, both real and folk-
loric. All frontier societies have extensive bodies of such traditions. Frequently
the images of such characters have been considerably embellished and extended
by historians, writers, and filmmakers, often in relation to the development of
myths and stereotypes of national identity.
The other side of the frontier also tends to develop heroic characters. These her-
oes are noted either for the unselfish assistance they give to those who will inevita-
bly invade their land, such as Native American woman Pocahontas, also called
Matoaka, who, according to tradition, saved English explorer John Smith’s life on
Frontier Folk Heroes | 593
Johnny Appleseed
Known as Johnny Appleseed, John Chapman (1774–1845) traveled throughout the
American Midwest, planting apple seeds wherever he went. His ragged, unkempt
appearance, his knowledge of plant lore, and his simple philosophy made him a
much-loved figure and one around whom various traditions grew up. His love of na-
ture was said to be so great that he would extinguish his campfires rather than have
mosquitoes burned in the flames. There may be some truth in this legend, as Chap-
man died of exposure.
While there is more than a hint of the self-conscious and the manufactured sur-
rounding the Johnny Appleseed story, folklorists have discovered widespread evi-
dence of his persistence in oral tradition, with local orchards often being said to
have originated in the passing and casting of Johnny Appleseed. However, it seems
likely that these are retrospective traditions elaborated from the popularization of
Johnny Appleseed in children’s books, a Disney film, and the verse of popular poets
like Carl Sandburg and Vachel Lindsay. Johnny Appleseed has also been commemo-
rated on a U.S. postage stamp, a sure sign of national hero status.
Graham Seal
two occasions and was an important mediator between the newcomers and the in-
digenous people of what is now the state of Virginia. Other figures may be villains
to the pioneers they defy but heroes to the indigenous peoples who the pioneers
are, usually violently, displacing. Heroes of this type include the Native American
Cochise and the indigenous Australians Yagan, Pemulway, and Jandamurra
(‘‘Pigeon’’), among many others.
Graham Seal
See Also Culture Hero; Hero/Heroine, Folk; National Folk Heroes.
References
Aiken, R. 1980. Mexican Folktales from the Borderland. Dallas, TX: Southern Meth-
odist University Press.
Beatty, B. 1960. A Treasury of Australian Folk Tales and Traditions. Sydney: Ure Smith.
Botkin, B., ed. 1944. A Treasury of American Folklore: Stories, Ballads, and Tradi-
tions of the People. New York: Crown Publishers, esp. pp. 150 157 on Buffalo Bill.
Dobie, F. J. [1928] 1959. Tales of Old-Time Texas, London, esp. pp. 51 77 on Jim
Bowie.
Dorson, R. 1973. America in Legend. New York: Pantheon Books.
Edwards, R. 1991. The Overlander Songbook. St. Lucia, Qld.: University of Queens-
land Press.
Finger, C. 1927. Frontier Ballads. Garden City, NY: Doubleday, Page & Co.
Fowke, E., ed. 1976. Folklore of Canada. Toronto: McClelland and Stewart.
Gill, S. 1998. Storytracking: Texts, Stories, and Histories in Central Australia. New
York and Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Greenway, J., ed. 1969. Folklore of the Great West. Palo Alto, CA: American West
Publishing Company.
Jansen, W. 1977. Abraham ‘‘Oregon’’ Smith: Pioneer, Folk Hero, and Tale-Teller.
New York: Arno.
Larkin, M. 1931. The Singing Cowboy. New York: Alfred A. Knopf.
Lingenfelter, R. et al., eds. 1968. Songs of the American West. Los Angeles: Univer-
sity of California Press.
Paterson, A. B., ed. 1905. The Old Bush Songs. Sydney: Angus and Robertson, (vari-
ous, mostly revised, editions to 1931).
Rose, D. 1992. Dingo Makes Us Human: Life and Land in an Aboriginal Australian
Culture. Melbourne, Australia: Melbourne University Press.
Steckmesser, K. L. 1965. The Western Hero in History and Legend. Norman: Uni-
versity of Oklahoma Press.
Stewart, D., and N. Keesing, eds. 1955. Australian Bush Ballads. Sydney: Angus and
Robertson.
Wannan, W. 1954. The Australian. Adelaide: Rigby.
Functionalism | 595
Functionalism
In folklore studies, the view that every folklore item must have a function. Here,
the expectation is that every proverb, tale, folk belief, or ballad must satisfy some
important cultural, social, or psychological function. This view of the functional
in folklore is parallel to Bronislaw Malinowski’s position that everything in
human life must have a function.
On a more theoretical level, three kinds of functionalism play an important role
in social sciences literature on the topic. The first posits that it is the needs of the
psychobiological human entity that are at center stage, the second emphasizes the
roles and functions of social structures within the group, and the third approach to
functionalism argues for social cohesion through the shared mental structures of
the ‘‘conscience collective.’’ The first of these is represented by the work of Broni-
slaw Malinowski, the second by the writings of Reginald Radcliffe-Brown, and the
third by writings of Emile Durkheim and Marcel Mauss. Given that a great deal of
folklore consists of either beliefs or the oral aspects of culture, it would seem that
the works of Durkheim and Mauss are the most significant for many folklorists.
Malinowski’s biopsychological work, however, is relevant for folklorists who are
interested in material folklore.
As one of the great field-workers of all time, Malinowski was convinced that
every detail of a culture (and this most certainly would include its folklore) had a
function. If any social scientist would have the exclusive rights to be called an
archfunctionalist, that would certainly be Bronislaw Malinowski. In anthropol-
ogy, he and Radcliffe-Brown are viewed as the founders of modern functional-
ism. However, their functionalisms are dramatically different. Radcliffe-Brown’s
is a structural functionalism, whereas Malinowski’s functionalism is based on
human biology and psychology. It must be noted that this biopsychological
approach pays close attention to the individual and de-emphasizes the impor-
tance of the social system as having a reason of existence beyond that of the indi-
vidual; for Malinowski, functionalism is a metamorphosis of the seven needs of
the individual: nutrition, reproduction, bodily comforts, safety, relation, move-
ment, and growth into the secondary needs of society. The needs of the individ-
ual are satisfied by the social structure of his or her culture, whose function it is
to satisfy those human needs. In other words, every social institution has a need
to satisfy, and so does every item in a culture. For folklorists, this means that
even the smallest item one collects, such as a single folk belief, has a function to
perform both at the level of the individual and at the level of the society and the
culture. Malinowski gives us the ultimate in a functional approach. In contrast to
Malinowski’s interest in the individual and biopsychological approaches, Rad-
cliffe-Brown was interested in the functioning of the social structure.
596 | Functionalism
References
Durkheim, Emile. [1893] 1933. Division of Labor in Society. Trans. G. Simpson.
New York: Macmillan.
598 | Functionalism
Durkheim, Emile. 1915. The Elementary Forms of Religious Life. Trans. J. W.
Swain. London: Allen & Unwin.
Durkheim, Emile. 1951. Suicide. Trans. J. Spaulding and G. Simpson. New York:
Free Press.
Jarvie, I. C. 1973. Functionalism. Minneapolis, MN: Burgess.
Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1922. Argonauts of the Western Pacific. New York: Dutton.
Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1939. The Group and the Individual in Functionalist Analy-
sis. American Journal of Sociology 44: 938 964.
Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1944. A Scientific Theory of Culture. Chapel Hill: University
of North Carolina Press.
Parsons, Talcott. 1951. The Social System. Glencoe, IL: Free Press.
Radcliffe-Brown, Reginald. 1935. On the Concept of Function in Social Science.
American Anthropologist 37: 394 402.
Radcliffe-Brown, Reginald. 1952. Structure and Function in Primitive Society. New
York: Free Press.
G
Games, Folk
Play forms, usually with explicit rules, known to a particular group of people.
Although artifacts recognizable as games have been among the archaeological
finds of ancient Sumer, Egypt, Persia, Greece, Rome, and China, scholars continue
to disagree over definitions of the genre. Games range from the covert, xeroxed
visual riddles in office folklore, baby tickling styles, and adolescent courtship rit-
uals to the large-scale painted games within urban graffiti and performances at
public festivals.
Games are both observable and, simultaneously, inside the minds of the
players. Perhaps the most profound paradox in game scholarship was framed by
William Wells Newell, collector of children’s folklore, who noted that players
were simultaneously conservative and inventive with their games. Games are a
solid and collectible—yet slippery and evolving—phenomenon.
The Study of Games by Elliot M. Avedon and Brian Sutton-Smith contains his-
torical references for specific forms of games and traces the word game to its
Indo-European root—ghem, meaning ‘‘to leap joyfully, to spring.’’ The study iso-
lates the three most familiar usages for the word: first, ‘‘a form of play, amuse-
ment, recreation, sport, or frolic involving specific rules, sometimes utilizing a
set of equipment, sometimes requiring skill, knowledge, and endurance’’; second,
‘‘a condition of a leg, when someone is lame or injured and they limp’’; and third,
‘‘wild animals, birds, or fish that are hunted for sport, or for use as food.’’ A game
as folklore genre combines the notion of the form, condition, and object.
The prominence of rules in game definitions serves as the game’s primary
marker. Lev Semyonovich Vygotsky noted that in games, there are overt or revealed
rules and concealed drama, whereas in other forms of play, there is revealed drama
and concealed rules. As there are layers of rules to each game, one could argue, so
there are layers of drama. Historically, the overt thematic dramas of the games were
given research priority, with the emphasis on the game’s spoken texts. Recently, it
is the covert dramas that are being written about, with the emphasis on the game’s
symbolism and its connection to context and larger cultural patterns.
The more popular phenomena for game research have been: the verbal play of
jump rope rhymes, singing games, ball-bouncing rhymes, and riddles; board
games such as chess, backgammon, and Go; chasing and fighting games; and
games focused on objects, such as string games and doll plays. Typically, in the
599
600 | Games, Folk
In the mid-twentieth century, Iona and Peter Opie expanded upon the earlier,
primarily literary tradition of game collection with their direct observations in
Children’s Games in Street and Playground. Like Newell, the Opies gathered and
categorized texts of songs and games and printed them verbatim based upon field-
notes. Musical notation was included in this as in earlier studies, but there was a
great elaboration upon the comparative footnotes. Unlike the overt evolutionism
of the nineteenth-century cross-cultural game histories represented by the work of
E. B. Tylor, the works of the mid-twentieth century folklorists tended to empha-
size one region in detail. Brian Sutton-Smith’s A History of Children’s Play: The
New Zealand Playground, 1840–1950 exemplified this later focus. His study fur-
ther expanded upon the historical emphasis of earlier studies and introduced a
new research technique: the collection of games by means of the methodology of
oral history as well as through written documentation. In Sutton-Smith’s work,
the recording of individuals’ game recollections gracefully demonstrated the sig-
nificance of historical context in the development of the games themselves.
In the 1970s, Rivka Eifermann expanded upon the concept of geographic map-
ping developed in the earlier English works by surveying Israel’s games and com-
paring groups of players and their games by age, game size, physical context, and
ethnic variation. Unlike folklorists who conducted other psychological studies that
had appeared around this time, studies in which the game was examined in order
to understand some other process (e.g., cognition or moral judgment), Eifermann,
like Sutton-Smith, examined the game as a cultural form. The assumption behind
Eifermann’s study was that the games, like other cultural phenomena, served some
purpose: child training, subversive expression, or physical pleasure, for example.
The study of games in their varying contexts could then reflect and legitimate the
differing needs of the cultural communities in which the games were played.
The author of each of the classic works on games cited in the preceding pas-
sages attempted to categorize play forms in a particular way. The Opies catego-
rized by motion: ‘‘chasing’’ versus ‘‘catching,’’ or ‘‘seeking.’’ For Newell, the
categories were romance and survivalism: games of ‘‘love,’’ ‘‘histories,’’ and ‘‘my-
thology.’’ Categorization by action in general becomes difficult since the same
text may be a hand-clapping game in one area, a jump rope rhyme in another, and
a verbal taunt in a third. Similarly, a soccer game may be played with a ball in
one country but with bottle caps in another. Categorization by theme, on the one
hand, provides too little latitude for textual variation and, on the other, allows too
many opportunities for theoretical bias (e.g., game texts as ‘‘broken-down’’
myths). Sutton-Smith examined a century’s worth of games in his ethnographic
research and offered thematic patterns by era and indexed them by game name.
The alphabetical approach of the Gomme collection was an attempt to avoid the
classification problem by merely listing titles; however, even titles or first lines of
games are subject to change. Asking the participants in a specific study for their
602 | Games, Folk
own terms and classification often proves to be the most useful approach, as we
recognize that classification is in itself a game tradition, either imposed or brought
out by the players themselves.
Games also have been classified by occasion, and this raises questions regard-
ing the significance of spatial and temporal context in folk game research. Some
games only appear during certain seasons, over certain holidays, and among cer-
tain age groups (e.g., snowball fights, April Fool’s pranks on April 1, bobbing
for apples at Halloween, and adolescent kissing games). Even these patterns will
generally shift over time in any given place and across contexts.
For Roger Caillois, in Man, Play and Games, there were four basic categorical
elements in game play: agon (competition), alea (chance), mimicry (simulation),
and ilinx (vertigo). Caillois’ scheme remains a popular model among researchers,
despite the fact that though many games emphasize one of these elements, most
combine many. Categorizations, like any set of lenses, are useful in that they
allow new ways of seeing phenomena, but categories also can serve as blinders
as observations are placed into analytic boxes.
Dorothy Howard, in her introduction to Alice Bertha Gomme’s collection The
Traditional Games of England, Scotland, and Ireland, noted that methodologies of
game research have to be examined in their own historical context. In the late nine-
teenth century, Lady Gomme was not allowed to watch the playing of the games
she described, given her gender and nobility; therefore, her skills and interests had
to be limited to the antiquarian’s armchair. Collectors through the first half of the
twentieth century, although utilizing direct observation and fieldnotes, could not
capture as much detail as those who did fieldwork in the day of the audiotape
player. Currently, with the availability of film and videotape, subtleties in the per-
formance of games are recordable in a manner not possible a generation ago.
Pioneered by both anthropologists and psychologists in the 1940s and 1950s, the
use of ethnographic film and video is both highly valued and underutilized in game
study. Trobriander Cricket: An Ingenious Response to Colonialism, a 1973 film by
Jerry Leach and Gary Kildea, was able to capture not only the formal game rule adap-
tation of the colonial game among Melanesian Trobriander tribes but also the joking,
dancing, costumed midgame ceremonies that were their own play forms, parades,
and parodies. Pizza, Pizza, Daddy-O, a 1969 film by Bess Lomax Hawes and Robert
Eberlein, demonstrated the style, rhythm, formation, and mood of the singing games
of African American girls in a manner not tenable on the written page.
As ethnographic methodology became more accepted and recording technology
became more precise, the emphasis in game study shifted to the processes involved
in the playing of the game. Based upon his ethnographic study of the Balinese cock-
fight, Clifford Geertz developed the notion of ‘‘deep play,’’ a model in which the
game serves as an icon for a culture’s basic character. Geertz made the case for the
significance of folk games in understanding the values of the larger culture, and by
Games, Folk | 603
doing so, he elevated the game’s status from the peripheral to the central. B.
Whitney Azoy’s study Buzkashi: Game and Power in Afghanistan made a similar
argument and expanded the anthropology of gaming to a book-length ethnography.
For these researchers, the study of the game was synonymous with the study of the
larger culture, and the games were stylized models of that society.
The variety of research on folk games ranges from sociological and geographi-
cal surveys to psychological small-group studies, from sociolinguistic studies of
riddling and joking games to layered ethnographies of games and sports. In
1974, the Anthropological Association for the Study of Play formed and soon
reorganized as the Association for the Study of Play in order to incorporate a di-
versity of disciplines involved in the study of folk games. The types of questions
asked now vary almost as much as the forms of games themselves.
Work focusing on the highly studied, international game of hopscotch provides
a useful example of the range of folk game research and also of the significance
of audiovisual recording. Known in Australia as ‘‘hoppy,’’ in New York City as
‘‘potsie,’’ and in French Switzerland as ‘‘la marelle,’’ hopscotch has a sizable but
limited literature, in that the literature emphasizes almost exclusively the physical
construction of the hopscotch form. In this slow-paced game of physical skill,
each player typically tosses a marker, such as a stone, onto the chalked hopscotch
board, which contains squares in a pattern, each with a number from 1 to 10 or
more. Then, the players sequentially hop from square to square, alternately land
on one foot and then two feet, and then attempt to pick up the stone without
604 | Games, Folk
falling. It is a competitive game in which the player who progresses the farthest,
without erring in either tossing or hopping, wins.
Sometimes drawn in a spiral, sometimes as a large rectangle, and sometimes
in a circle, the form itself varies and is the most discussed variation in the game
literature. According to Newell, ‘‘This is one of the universal games, common
from England to Hindostan.’’ He noted it was called ‘‘The Bell’’ in Italy and
‘‘The Temple’’ in Austria, and in Italy, the last three divisions of the chalk pat-
terns are the Inferno, Purgatoria, and Paradiso. The Opies found English refer-
ences to the game in eighteenth-century documents, and American folklorists
Mary and Herbert Knapp claimed that a hopscotch diagram is still visible on the
pavement of the Roman Forum. Yet all this description in the literature, although
significant in our understanding of the game’s popularity in general, tells us
nothing of how the game has actually been played. For this, we need real voices
in transcription, stories about rules and the breaking of rules, and the ethno-
graphic description of real times and places where real people get to play.
Among European American and African American girls in an urban elementary
schoolyard in Pennsylvania, the folk variation lay not in the form or in the labels
of the boxes but in the rules themselves. In one study, carried out in 1991–1992 by
Ann Richman Beresin, children watched videotapes of themselves at play and
gave their own commentary on game meaning, rules, and style, and on the inter-
connection between game rules and power. Since the form of their hopscotch was
Games, Folk | 605
a rectangle with a rounded top, numbered and drawn in paint by the elementary
school officials, their folk variation was in the terminology and rule flexibility.
For example, they used rules such as ‘‘walksies’’ and ‘‘no walksies’’ or ‘‘helpsies’’
and ‘‘no helpsies,’’ meaning forms of acceptable movement in the game. All of
these stylized movements had to be ‘‘called’’ at the beginning of a game, and it
was the calling that shaped the game. The fixing of the game in paint by the school
officials, as opposed to the more-studied child-drawn chalk game, implicated
larger historical trends visible in Western children’s folklore—namely, the subtle
control exerted by adults over what had been a children’s domain. It can be said
that the new rules invented by the children were a direct response to such control.
Nowhere in the English-language folk game literature are such rule variations
examined, making one wonder how we can know a game without knowing the
players or the plays. The variations have been skipped over in most collections—
one could say, across the board. Audiovisual technology makes possible the
expansion of questions about the game process, and the opportunity for observa-
tion over time, in one place, allows for the examining of larger cultural patterns
related to the players, the school, and the larger society.
Descriptions of playful bodies and studies of their games, as in wrestling,
chasing, stunts, or pranks, are still rare, due in part to the underutilization of
audiovisual recording as a methodological tool and in part to the blinders of
Western culture’s romanticism. Speech and rhyme have been given priority, even
in the very physical games of rope jumping and hand clapping and ball bouncing.
Large-scale ethnographic studies of game genres and game processes are needed,
especially in this time of increased adult control over children’s play (particu-
larly in Western culture) and emphasis on official sports and generalized rules.
Also underrepresented in the English-language literature are the games of non-
Western countries and games of Western minorities. As Helen Schwartzman
pointed out, in the early ethnographic reports of tribal cultures listed in the Human
Relations Area Files, as well as in the modern psychological literature on minority
groups, peoples mistakenly have been described as not having any games at all. The
fallacy of such a notion lies in the complexity of fieldwork in unfamiliar cultures,
the misdirection of the questions asked about play and games, the lack of time depth
in most studies, and the secrecy often surrounding a folk group’s customs.
Another neglected area involves the pre- and postgame rituals that may be signifi-
cant to the playing of the game itself. Rituals and minigames—such as the opening
anthem before the ball game or the chanting and hand pointing of ‘‘Eeny, Meeny,
Miny, Moe,’’ and the making of a tower of fists in ‘‘One Potato, Two Potato’’ as
players set the terms of the game—often precede the full games and begin the com-
petition, drama, or performance. Real players of real games can attest that the boun-
daries researchers have made around the games listed in books are often neat and
artificial ones, as games often blend into one another or cross genres during play.
606 | Games, Folk
Seekers of information on other forms of folk games not readily found in the
game text literature need to comb ethnographies of particular populations, daily
life histories, and fictional and nonfictional films and narratives, as well as the
treasures hidden in the related areas of folk gesture, folk drama, dance, and ritual.
Students of adult festivals and observers of animal play will find games and a
corresponding relevant literature in these areas as well. Many games are listed as
songs, both in educational instructional publications as well as in ethnographic
reports, and sometimes a game description can be found hidden behind the folk
toy in a collection of material culture. For the most authoritative resource on folk
games, one should seek out the players. Through incorporating their views, the
folk game literature can be verified or challenged.
Anne Richman Beresin
See Also Children’s Folklore; Toy, Folk.
References
Avedon, Elliot M., and Brian Sutton-Smith, eds. 1971. The Study of Games. New
York: Wiley.
Azoy, G. Whitney. 1982. Buzkashi: Game and Power in Afghanistan. Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania Press.
Caillois, Roger. 1961. Man, Play, and Games. New York: Free Press.
Eifermann, Rivka. 1968. School Children’s Games. U.S. Department of Health, Edu-
cation, and Welfare. Office of Education, Bureau of Research, Washington, DC.
Geertz, Clifford. 1973. Deep Play: Notes on the Balinese Cockfight. In The Interpre-
tation of Cultures, ed. Clifford Geertz. New York: Basic Books.
Howard, Dorothy. [1884 1889] 1964. Introduction. The Traditional Games of
England, Scotland, and Ireland with Tunes, Singing-Rhymes, and Methods of Playing
According to the Variants Extant and Recorded in Different Parts of the Kingdom.
Collected and annotated by Alice Bertha Gomme. New York: Dover.
Knapp, Mary, and Herbert Knapp. 1976. One Potato, Two Potato: The Folklore of
American Children. New York: W. W. Norton.
Newell, William Wells. [1883] 1963. Games and Songs of American Children. New
York: Dover.
Opie, Iona, and Peter Opie. 1969. Children’s Games in Street and Playground.
Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Schwartzman, Helen. 1978. Transformations: The Anthropology of Children’s Play.
New York: Plenum.
Sutton-Smith, Brian. 1981. A History of Children’s Play: The New Zealand Play-
ground, 1840 1950. Wellington: New Zealand Council on Educational Research and
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Vygotsky, Lev Semyonovich. Mind in Society: The Development of Higher Psycho-
logical Processes, eds. Michael Cole et al. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Gay (LGBTQ) Studies and Queer Theory | 607
Gay rights demonstration at the Democratic National Convention, New York City, on July
11, 1976. (Library of Congress)
fought back when the police raided the bar on June 28, 1969. The struggle con-
tinued for the rest of that month.
Seemingly overnight, gay organizations sprang up, including organizations
solely for lesbians (there was a problem with sexism during the first years of gay
liberation; even the term gay was too often assumed to refer to only men), and
with them came a significant increase in the attention paid by scholars to homo-
sexuality. The medical and psychological studies that had predominated in the
field gave way to more ethnographic depictions of gay life published throughout
the 1970s. The latest Kinsey studies documented a variety of lifestyles, embodied
in the title of one of the volumes: Homosexualities.
In the 1980s, gay (LGBTQ) studies exploded. The existence of gay male, les-
bian, bisexual, and trans culture—or cultures—became irrefutable. In 1980, one
could have read virtually everything published in the field (usually called ‘‘gay
and lesbian’’); by 1990, however, one would have been hard pressed to read most
of the titles on a single aspect of same-sex orientation and gender variance.
Corey Creekmur and Alexander Doty’s 1995 Out in Culture included a twenty-
four-page bibliography of publications on gay popular culture alone.
Although Christopher Isherwood made a foray into gay-related studies in The
World in the Evening (1956) by mentioning camp—a prototypical gay sensibil-
ity—Susan Sontag might be credited with making the first theoretical contribution
to the field with her 1964 essay ‘‘Notes on Camp.’’ (Camp is a style of humor that
Gay (LGBTQ) Studies and Queer Theory | 609
inverts and subverts values, often by playing with stereotypes. It frequently has a
serious edge, serving to mock heterosexual norms.) Several writers contributed
articles on gay men’s language to both popular magazines and scholarly journals
during the 1960s and 1970s. Esther Newton’s 1972 volume Mother Camp: Female
Impersonation in America was a cultural anthropological study of drag queens. In
1982, Margaret Cruikshank released an anthology, Lesbian Studies: Present and
Future. Michael Bronski, in his 1984 book Culture Clash: The Making of Gay
Sensibility, documented the impact of Gay culture on popular culture. Another
1984 volume, Judy Grahn’s Another Mother Tongue: Gay Words, Gay Worlds,
offered an interesting but largely unsubstantiated speculation about the origins
of gay traditional culture. Many homosexual people embraced Grahn’s book
because it proposed a gay mythos. The first book on gay men’s folklore, Joseph P.
Goodwin’s More Man than You’ll Ever Be: Gay Folklore and Acculturation in
Middle America, appeared in 1989. In 1994, there was a special issue of New York
Folklore entitled ‘‘Prejudice and Pride: Lesbian and Gay Traditions in America.’’
Books on lesbian studies in the 1990s include Lesbian Studies: Setting an Agenda
by Tamsin Wilton (1995), Lesbian Subjects: A Feminist Studies Reader by Martha
Vicinus (1996), and The New Lesbian Studies: Into the Twenty-First Century (a
follow-up to Cruikshank’s 1982 volume).
As the field of LGBTQ studies has grown, the terminology has changed.
‘‘Homosexual’’ gave way to ‘‘gay,’’ which in turn was expanded to ‘‘gay and les-
bian.’’ In the late 1980s, homosexual people increasingly began to appropriate the
term ‘‘queer,’’ which had been used as a tool of oppression for decades by the ma-
jority culture. Adapting the term as an emic concept (a name the community
applied to itself) imbued it with pride, inverted it, denied the conflation of sex acts
with homosexuality, pointed out the ridiculous aspects of the stereotypes the word
referred to, and threw the term back into the faces of those who opposed equal
rights for queers. But the word has a more mundane value, as well: It subsumes
not only Gay and Lesbian identities (capitalized to signify identities-within-
community nouns, such as national and religious nouns like ‘‘American’’ and
‘‘Buddhist’’), but also Bisexual, Transsexual, and Transgendered (Transsexual
and Transgender are also known together as Trans), offering a succinct term for
several categories of outsiders. Queer is a subversive concept since it calls into
question traditional gender roles and ideas of what constitutes appropriate behav-
ior. The study of queer culture contradicts traditional notions of homosexuality as
sin or illness. It documents the existence of a dynamic, widespread, living culture.
(‘‘Queer,’’ however, has not been accepted by all, and ‘‘gay’’ is making a come-
back as the default term, basically interchangeable with ‘‘LGBTQ.’’)
About 1990, ‘‘gay and lesbian studies’’ gave rise to ‘‘queer theory.’’ Although
not yet codified, queer theory has had a great impact on recent studies of LGBTQ
culture. (Studies on the culture of bisexual and trans people only began to appear
610 | Gay (LGBTQ) Studies and Queer Theory
References
Abelove, Henry, Michele Aina Barale, and David M. Halperin. 1993. The Lesbian
and Gay Studies Reader. New York: Routledge.
Butler, Judith. 1990. Gender Trouble: Feminism and the Subversion of Identity. New
York: Routledge.
Case, Sue-Ellen, Philip Brett, and Susan Leigh Foster. 1995. Cruising the Performa-
tive: Interventions into the Representation of Ethnicity, Nationality, and Sexuality.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Creekmur, Corey K., and Alexander Doty. 1995. Out in Culture: Gay, Lesbian, and
Queer Essays on Popular Culture. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Cruikshank, Margaret. 1980. Lesbian Studies: Past and Present. Westbury, NY: The
Feminist Press.
de Lauretis, Teresa, ed. 1991. Queer Theory: Lesbian and Gay Sexualities. differences:
A Journal of Feminist Cultural Studies 3.
Dynes, Wayne, ed. 1990. Encyclopedia of Homosexuality. New York: Garland.
Foucault, Michel. 1978. The History of Sexuality, Vol. 1: An Introduction. Trans.
Robert Hurley. New York: Pantheon Books.
Goodwin, Joseph P. 1989. More Man than You’ll Ever Be: Gay Folklore and Accul-
turation in Middle America. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Horton-Stallings, LaMonda. 2007. Mutha’ is Half a Word: Intersections of Folklore,
Vernacular, Myth, and Queerness in Black Female Culture. Columbus: Ohio State Uni-
versity Press.
612 | Gender
Sontag, Susan. 1964. Notes on Camp. Partisan Review 31: 515 530.
Summers, Claude J., ed. 1995. The Gay and Lesbian Literary Heritage: A Reader’s
Companion to the Writers and Their Works, from Antiquity to the Present. New York:
Henry Holt.
Vicinus, Martha. 1996. Lesbian Subjects: A Feminist Studies Reader. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Wilton, Tamsin. 1995. Lesbian Studies: Setting an Agenda. New York: Routledge.
Zimmerman, Bonnie, and Toni A. H. McNaron. 1996. The New Lesbian Studies: Into
the Twenty-First Century. New York: Feminist Press at the City University of New York.
Gender
We-Wa, a Zuni man dressed as a woman, weaving a belt on a waist loom with a reed
heddle. (National Archives)
Gender | 613
denotes that much larger body of behaviors, roles, and expectations that, although
regarded by members of a society as appropriate only for members of one biological
sex or the other, vary considerably across cultures and historical periods and hence
must be culturally conditioned rather than biologically determined. Though it is
common if not universal to make the male/female distinction the first and most cru-
cial division among people, this does not mean that the concepts ‘‘woman’’ and
‘‘man’’ are universal categories since what it means to behave appropriately for
one’s gender may be radically different in different societies.
In most if not all societies and cultural traditions, including the Euroamerican
cultural and philosophical tradition from which the discipline of folklore emerged,
those distinct roles seen as proper for men and women are believed to be natural,
that is, biologically determined and/or divinely ordained. These roles are not only
in specifically sexual activity but also in work, family, religion, government, re-
creation, expressive culture, and other aspects of social interaction. A gender per-
spective decouples the biological structure and function of the male or female
body from the behaviors, feelings, and roles deemed appropriate to that body.
Thus, a gender-informed perspective is often linked with a critical feminist philos-
ophy that seeks to free women from the (generally devalued and limited) social
roles to which they were formerly restricted, although the study of how to be a
(cultural) man is as significant as, if less common than, the study of how to be a
(cultural) woman. The study of gender likewise implicates the study of sexuality
since the structure/behavior decoupling fundamental to this perspective argues
that even the apparently inevitable roles within intimate sexual relationships and
an individual’s sexual attraction to persons of the same or opposite gender are
substantially influenced by cultural attitudes. A gender-informed approach to
folklore thus has strong connections to gay and lesbian theory and serves as a
counterbalance to psychoanalytic approaches to the extent that they posit univer-
sal and distinct psychosexual developmental pathways for women and men.
Both biology and culture may contribute to those behaviors seen as gender
specific, but it is rarely possible to determine the exact extent of their relative
contributions. Empirical research and philosophical debate continue. The crucial
contribution of a gender perspective is to recognize that there is a separation, not
a complete congruence, between biological and cultural factors and that conse-
quently the question must always be asked about the extent and nature of possi-
ble connections between them. This inherently cultural-constructivist perspective
also makes it clear that the very perception of a characteristic as natural, biologi-
cal, or hormonal can itself be a social expectation. For example, those societies
that attribute greater aggressiveness to males may perceive aggression as an
essential, hormonally determined male trait, but other cultures see aggressiveness
and the willingness to fight fiercely (usually to protect the young rather than to
acquire territory) as an essential female trait.
614 | Gender
The study of gender in folklore has historical roots extending back as far as the
1920s. Mark Azadovskii’s work revealing the influence of gender on tale-tellers’
repertoire and performance choices (1926) and Margaret Mead’s comparative
study documenting extreme cultural variability in gender roles in tribal societies
(1935) presaged issues still being considered today. Simone de Beauvoir’s philo-
sophical exploration of the way women have been defined as ‘‘not man’’ (1953)
was particularly important in sparking the political feminism of the 1960s and the
explosion of feminist scholarship in folklore as well as other disciplines in the
1970s and 1980s. Works by Carol Gilligan and the multiple authors of Women’s
Ways of Knowing further elaborated the groundwork of the gender perspective,
arguing that women in Euroamerican cultures have been culturally conditioned to
have fundamentally different (but not deficient) ways of understanding and
responding intellectually and ethically to the world. The constructivist position on
gender is closely tied to the de-privileging of authoritative discourses and decenter-
ing of the unitary subject central to deconstruction and poststructuralism. This per-
spective is also entirely congruent with the movements within folklore that
stressed the value of contextual interpretation, with the role folklore plays in com-
munication between persons who identify with distinct and even hostile groups as
well as within homogenous folk groups (differential identity), and with the dia-
logic construction of identity through aesthetic expression—that is, with the para-
digms of the contextual/performance revolution in folklore theory of the 1970s
and 1980s. Significantly, however, gender was not taken into account in the origi-
nal formulation of these theories. Feminist critics have had to note the telling omis-
sion and argue for the essential place of gender in approaches to folklore study that
rely upon a problematized notion of personal identity and group membership.
A gender-informed perspective also has shaped both topical and methodological
considerations in the study of folklore. In terms of topic, perceiving gender as a
cultural construct has prompted the realization that gender roles and identities are
themselves traditional forms of expressive communication, that is, they are social,
aesthetic accomplishments and forms of folklore in their own right. Groups defined
by gender and/or sexual orientation are appreciated as significant folk groups with
their own lore, practices, and types of group-internal and group-external communi-
cation. New genres and new perspectives on genre have emerged as folklorists
realized that one’s practice as a narrator, humorist, craftsperson, singer, or per-
former/creator of any type is likely to be influenced by one’s gender and one’s
responses to gender norms in one’s society. An awareness that gays and lesbians as
well as heterosexual women have been defined primarily in terms of absences and
deficiencies (in contrast to heterosexual male practice, silently accepted as the
human norm) has prompted explorations of the positive qualities of the expressive
skills practiced within these groups. Conversely, folklorists now recognize that
gender must be taken into account as a source of potential difference within
Gender | 615
families and ethnic or racial groups formerly treated as homogeneous. The recogni-
tion of cross-cultural, cross-racial, cross-class, and historical variation in definitions
of gender also deflects feminist folkloristics from the attractions of essentialism,
counterbalancing the disposition to identify universal ‘‘women’s styles’’ or ‘‘wom-
en’s experiences.’’
In terms of fieldwork methodology, a gender-informed perspective has been one
of the theoretical approaches most influential in overturning formerly dominant
concepts of objectivity in research. Feminist folklore scholars (following the critical
work of Evelyn Fox Keller and Sandra Harding in the natural and social sciences,
respectively) argue that the valorization of objectivity and distance in ethnographic
research has been a way of privileging a conventionally male interaction style. Cur-
rent practice recognizes that the self does not have to be defined by separation from
the other and that empathic and participatory ways of understanding the ethno-
graphic subject are as valid as an objectifying, purely intellectual approach. While
insisting that gender identity is variable and changeable, this perspective recognizes
that the researcher’s effective or perceived gender identity and sexual identity have
a profound effect on fieldwork. One’s own perceptions and experiences (including
the lived experience of gender and sexual orientation) will necessarily influence
what issues are important to the researcher and hence not only what questions one
asks but also what one sees and hears in the course of complex aesthetic communi-
cative events. Gender identity also influences access: Who the researcher is per-
ceived to be will have an effect on how people make sense of that individual, what
they think they should talk to her or him about, and hence what she or he learns
about a culture or situation. Ethnographers need to learn to capitalize on the oppor-
tunities afforded by gender. Particularly for stigmatized groups—gay and lesbian
communities as well as heterosexual women—many communicative activities are
intentionally coded to avoid exposure. Thus, potential informants are likely to be
willing to reveal themselves and share lore only with those who share their gender
or sexual identity or who demonstrate that they are sympathetic. A shared gender
identification may also be crucial in enabling the researcher to make sense of cues
or to interpret communicative forms properly. A complete commonality between
researcher and informant on the basis only of shared gender should not be assumed,
however, given the variation within gender definitions.
In studying folklore through the lens of gender or studying gender by means of
its expression in folklore, a constant tension exists between constructivist and
essentialist tendencies. The role of ethnographic and empirical work in the social
sciences (in contrast to philosophical and psychoanalytically informed theories) is
to document actual cultural, racial, and class variation in gender roles, practices,
and expectations. Nevertheless, given the logical explanatory connections between
observed expressive forms and common gender-based activities (for example,
between intentionally interruptible narrative styles employed by women and the
616 | Gender
References
Azadovskii, Mark. 1974. A Siberian Tale Teller. Trans. James R. Dow. Austin, TX:
Center for Intercultural Studies in Folklore and Ethnomusicology.
Belenky, Mary Field, Blythe McVicker Clinchy, Nancy Rule Goldberger, and Jill
Mattuck Tarule. 1986. Women’s Ways of Knowing: The Development of Self, Voice,
and Mind. New York: Basic Books.
Blincoe, Deborah, and John Forrest. 1993. Prejudice and Pride: Lesbian and Gay
Traditions in America. Special issue of New York Folklore 19(1 2).
Collins, Camilla A., ed. 1990. Folklore Fieldwork: Sex, Sexuality, and Gender. Spe-
cial issue of Southern Folklore 47(1).
de Beauvoir, Simone. 1953. The Second Sex. New York: Knopf.
Fuss, Diana. 1989. Essentially Speaking: Feminism, Nature, and Difference. New
York: Routledge.
Gilligan, Carol. 1982. In a Different Voice: Psychological Theory and Women’s
Development. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Goodwin, Joseph P. 1989. More Man than You’ll Ever Be: Gay Folklore and Accul-
turation in Middle America. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Harding, Sandra, ed. 1991. Feminism and Methodology. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Herzfeld, Michael. 1985. The Poetics of Manhood: Contest and Identity in a Cretan
Mountain Village. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Horton-Stallings, LaMonda. 2007. Mutha’ Is Half a Word: Intersections of Folklore,
Vernacular, Myth, and Queerness in Black Female Culture. Columbus: Ohio State Uni-
versity Press.
Genre | 617
Kailo, Kaarina. 2008. Wo(men) and Bears: The gifts of Nature, Culture, and Gender
Revisited. Toronto: Inanna.
Keller, Evelyn Fox. 1985. Reflections on Gender and Science. New Haven, CT: Yale
University Press.
Mead, Margaret. 1935. Sex and Temperament in Three Primitive Societies. New
York: William Morrow.
Mills, Margaret. 1993. Feminist Theory and the Study of Folklore: A Twenty-Year
Trajectory toward Theory. Western Folklore 52: 173 192.
Genre
A French word, from the Latin genus, used to describe a basic concept in literary
theory and criticism, variably termed form, kind, or type, depending upon the pe-
riod and the theory. Plato (The Republic) distinguishes, in the arts of the rhapsody
between narration, imitation, and the mixture of the two, while considering the art
of the actor essentially mimetic. In his Poetics, Aristotle differentiates narrative
epic poetry from the imitative action of drama. The basic triad of generic catego-
ries—the epic, the dramatic, and the lyrical—is a Renaissance formulation that has
remained viable in literary discourse up to the present. From the inception of folk-
lore scholarship, the definitions of specific genres—the M€ archen, the Sage, the
legend, the ballad, the proverb, the riddle, the fable, and many others—have forged
the genre as a principle concept of the discipline. Referring particularly to its liter-
ary renditions, Johann Gottfried von Herder (1744–1803) compares the M€ archen
with the Romane (romance, novel), considering the former to be not just a genre
but also an entity that possess a spiritual quality that permeates other literary forms.
Jacob (1785–1863) and Wilhelm (1786–1859) Grimm’s assertion that ‘‘the fairy
tale is more poetic, the legend is more historical’’ remains the cornerstone of many
analyses of folk narrative.
Such descriptive definitions, which project the writer’s own attitude, emotions,
and response to the text, have failed to provide the precision in generic distinc-
tions that is necessary for systematic research. To complicate matters, genre
terms are words in ordinary languages, subject to ambiguity, vagueness, synon-
ymy, and historical changes. The attempt to employ them with analytic precision
inevitably has been burdened by their semantic history in multiple languages.
Comparative analysis has addressed the problems of differing cultural perspec-
tives, attitudes, and belief systems that have made the construction of an analyti-
cal system of genres even more difficult.
Faced with such complex systems of generic distinctions, folklorists have
taken two distinct directions in their attempts to resolve the indefiniteness of
folklore genres and the concept of genre in folklore. The first approach seeks
ways to overcome these difficulties and to construct the concept of genre as a
618 | Genre
forms by approximation only. Lauri Honko, who has been the principal propo-
nent of this theory, considers genres to be distinct configurations of contents,
form, style, structure, function, frequency, distribution, age, and origin. Each
genre is a construct category that involves an ideal configuration and criteria that
are appropriate for each form. No single folktale, ballad, legend, or proverb, to
use some common folklore forms as examples, has to meet all the standards of
its ideal types; it can and need only approximate them. Genres are, hence, classi-
ficatory categories that involve not one but several distinctive features, and it is
the task of researchers to determine the relations between the category and the
texts that people narrate, sing, or utter in society. A failure to establish such a
relation may be indicative of the formation of a new genre, the criteria of which
require formulation. Honko himself has not outlined a systematic scheme of folk-
lore genres as ideal types, but others have, even though they do not refer explic-
itly to Honko’s theoretical formulation.
Limiting himself to the three basic forms in prose narrative—myth, legend,
and folktale—and summarizing the scholarly consensus of his time, William
Bascom proposes the following generic configuration:
Principal
Form Belief Time Place Attitude Characters
Scott Littleton adds history and sacred history to the genres he considers, posi-
tioning them on a grid of two polarities: the fabulous and the factual, the secular
and the sacred. As the configuration between these four components changes,
historically and culturally, the narration of a particular theme moves from one
ideal generic pattern to another. In this scheme of analytical categories, folktale
is fabulous and secular, myth is fabulous and sacred, history is factual and secu-
lar, and sacred history is sacred by definition and factual. The legend occupies a
central position in relation to all four factors.
Heda Jason and Roger Abrahams, respectively, propose two of the most com-
prehensive schemes for the classification of folklore genres. Jason employs, first,
620 | Genre
a five-part classification system of modes: the realistic, the fabulous, the numi-
nous, the marvelous, and the symbolic. These modes then manifest themselves in
the realistic, fabulous, and symbolic genres of folklore. In her descriptions of
specific genres, Jason retains theme, time, space, structure, and function as terms
of analysis. Abrahams, on the other hand, extends the classificatory principles to
account for the rhetoric of folklore and its social interaction. Consequently, he
divides all folklore genres into three major groups: conversational genres, play
genres, and fictive genres. In his scheme, it is not only the genre itself that is an
analytical category. He constructs a graded scale between two polarities of inter-
personal involvement and detachment (his term is removal). Each genre, not each
text of each genre, relates to these two extreme configurations by approximation.
In turn, each performance of each text may have its own position on the generic
arch that Abrahams constructs.
The theories of primary forms and ideal types assume the universality of folk-
lore genres, and in their applications to the available classificatory models, they
provide for variation, modification, change, and transformation that are inherent
in the social dynamics of folklore.
for their performance, and the textual and social interrelations between the genres
themselves.
Morphological-structural analysis explores generic discourse on a semantic,
dramatic, or metaphoric level. The sequence of episodes in a narrative—the rela-
tionship between actions, characters, objects, or other symbols, whether in a tale,
a legend, a ballad, or an epic—constitutes a dimension of the generic discourse
that distinguishes one genre from another in specific societies. Morphological-
structural relations serve as the generic grammar of folklore forms. Speakers,
narrators, and singers—though they may not be able to formulate the grammar—
have the ability to be aware of that grammar. Therefore, such an analysis becomes
an essential part of the ethnography of folklore genres. Although morphological-
structural analysis originally purported to advance definitions of folklore genres,
assuming them to have similar patterns in all traditions, it is possible to modify
this methodology in order to examine the ethnic genres of specific traditions.
In many societies, the generic system amounts to a complex set of relations
between folklore forms, which their speakers relate to other domains of social
life, such as religion and politics. As people establish connections between their
speech genres and their ideas about their world, they establish a cosmology of
speech that includes ideas about the creation of speech in general and certain
genres in particular. They place religious value on traditional genres of prayers,
invocations, and ritual songs and consider other forms of speech as mundane,
profane, or ordinary. There are narratives that account not only for the creation
of speech but also for its different forms and stories about great orators and sing-
ers who excelled in delivering one genre or another. Such a ‘‘mythology of folk-
lore genres’’ is an essential aspect of genres of discourse because it provides the
basis for the use of such genres in society as rooted in cultural ideology.
The pragmatic exploration of ethnic genres requires an examination of their
names, their cultural taxonomies, and their performances in social life. Their names
reflect their cultural conception and significance, their history in tradition, and their
import and function as their speakers view them. Their taxonomies underscore their
relations to each other in terms of their prosodic features, the spaces and times of
their performances, and their association with particular segments of society. Their
performances are the basis for any analysis of the poetics of folklore genres, the
use of formulas and frames, the alteration between prose and poetry, and the use of
any genres of speech within or in relation to other genres of speech.
There is not a necessary and exclusive direct correspondence between genres
and events as cultural categories of folklore. A single cultural event is often the
occasion for the performance of several genres. The rules that dictate which genres
are appropriate for which occasions are part of the cultural conventions. Similarly,
a single genre may include other culturally recognized genres. Tales often include
songs, epics include other tales as well as proverbs and riddles, and proverbs and
622 | Genre
riddles, when performed by themselves, may allude to tales and songs, thus seman-
tically including themes known in different genres. Such combinations do not nec-
essarily imply neglecting the principles of genres but rather an artistic and often
playful use of these cultural categories of discourse.
Dan Ben-Amos
See Also Aesthetics; Ethnoaesthetics; Ethnopoetics; Linguistic Approach; Literary
Approach; Text.
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1969. The Complex Relation of Simple Forms. Genre 2: 104 128.
Bakhtin, Mikhail M. 1986. Speech Genres and Other Late Essays. Trans. Vern W.
McGee and eds. Caryl Emerson and Michael Holquist. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Bascom, William R. 1965. The Forms of Folklore: Prose Narratives. Journal of
American Folklore 78: 3 20.
Bauman, Richard, ed. 1977. Verbal Art as Performance. Rowley, MA: Newbury House.
Bausinger, Hermann. 1968. Formen der ‘‘Volkspoesie’’ (Forms of folk ‘‘poesy’’).
Grundlagen der Germanistik 6. Berlin: Erich Schmidt.
Ben-Amos, Dan, ed. 1976. Folklore Genres. Publication of the American Folklore
Society, Bibliographical and Special Series, Vol. 26. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Ben-Amos, Dan, ed. 1992. Do We Need Ideal Types (in Folklore)?: An Address to
Lauri Honko. NIF Papers 2. Turku, Finland: Nordic Institute of Folklore.
Briggs, Charles L., and Richard Bauman 1992. Genre, Intertextuality, and Social
Power. Journal of Linguistic Anthropology 2(2): 131 172.
Gossen, Gary. 1971. Chamula Genres of Verbal Behavior. Journal of American Folk-
lore 84: 145 167.
Honko, Lauri. 1968. Genre Analysis in Folkloristics and Comparative Religion.
Temenos 3: 48 66.
Honko, Lauri. 1989. Folkloristics Theories of Genre. Studies in Oral Narrative, ed.
AnnaLeena Siikala. Special issue of Studia Fennica 33: 13 28.
Honko, Lauri, and Vilmos Voigt, eds. 1980. Genre, Structure and Reproduction in
Oral Literature. Bibliotheca Uralica 5. Budapest: Akademiai Kiado.
Jason, Heda. 1977. Ethnopoetry: Form, Content, Function. Forum Theologiae Lin-
guisticae 11. Bonn: Linguistica Biblica.
Jolles, Andre. 1930. Einfache Formen (Primary forms). 2nd ed. T€ubingen, Germany:
Max Niemeyer.
Littleton, Scott C. 1965. A Two-Dimensional Scheme for the Classification of Narra-
tives. Journal of American Folklore 78: 21 27.
Ranke, Kurt. 1967. Einfache Formen (Primary forms). Journal of the Folklore Insti-
tute 4: 17 31.
Rosenberg, Bruce A. 1978. The Genres of Oral Narrative. In Theories of Literary
Genres, ed. Joseph P. Strelka. Yearbook of Comparative Criticism 8. University Park:
Pennsylvania State University Press.
Gesture | 623
Ryan, Marie-Laure 1979. Introduction: On the Why, What and How of Generic Tax-
onomy. Poetics 10: 109 126.
Ryan, Marie-Laure 1979. Toward a Competence Theory of Genre. Poetics 8: 307 337.
Sydow, Carl Wilhelm von. 1934. Kategorien der Prosa-Volksdichtung (The catego-
ries of prose tradition). In Volkskundliche Gaben John Meier zum 70 Geburtstag darge-
bracht, ed. W. Heiske. Berlin: Walter de Gruyter. (A brief synopsis in English can be
found in von Sydow’s Selected Papers on Folklore, ed. Laurits Bdker, Copenhagen:
Rosenkilde and Bagger, 1948.)
Todorov, Tzvetan 1990. Genres in Discourse. Trans. Cathrine Porter. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
Toporov, V. N. 1974. Toward the Problem of Genres in Folklore. In Semiotics and
Structuralism: Readings from the Soviet Union, ed. Henryk Baran. White Plains, NY:
International Arts and Sciences Press.
Voigt, Vilmos 1976. Towards a Theory of Theory of Genres in Folklore. In Folklore
Today: A Festschrift for Richard M. Dorson, eds. Linda Degh, Henry Glassie, and Felix
J. Oinas. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Gesture
Movement of the body, including the face, that expresses an idea or emotion.
The study of such movement, called kinesics, has a place in several disciplines
concerned with human communication, especially linguistics, psychology, an-
thropology, and ethnology. Folkloristic interest in gestures, though drawing from
these branches of study, has focused in two particular directions: on body move-
ments and facial expressions that contribute to the articulation of verbal and ma-
terial folklore forms—that is, gestures that contribute to the paralinguistics of
folklore performance—and on movements that have traditional meaning in their
own right. Although recognizing that every movement means something either
latently or overtly, folklorists have concentrated primarily on those gestures that
are conscious and traditional.
One major category of gestures studied by folklorists is that known as emblems.
These gestures have a direct verbal translation, generally known throughout the
folk community. Performers use them with the conscious intent of sending a spe-
cific message, particularly when such factors as distance or poor acoustics have
made verbal communication impractical. Emblems may stand on their own, with-
out any verbalization. One of the simplest emblems used in various cultures is
nodding one’s head to signal either the affirmative or the negative. Waving upon
greeting or upon leave-taking is another widely known emblem. Other familiar
examples of gestures that function as emblems are ‘‘the bird,’’ the upraised middle
finger used as an insult, and a shrug of the shoulders, suggesting the gesturer’s ig-
norance of the subject under consideration.
624 | Gesture
may have difficulty integrating them into the text of the performance. General
comments about body language in a performance note may substitute for precise
indication of which gestures appeared at what precise point in the performance.
William M. Clements
See Also Frame; Performance.
References
Barakat, Robert A. 1973. Arabic Gestures. Journal of Popular Culture 6: 749 793.
Birdwhistell, Ray L. 1970. Kinesics and Context: Essays on Body Motion Communi-
cation. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
de Laban, Juana. 1954. Movement Notation: Its Significance to the Folklorist. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 67: 291 295.
Dorson, Richard M. 1956. Negro Folktales in Michigan. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
Fine, Elizabeth C. 1984. The Folklore Text from Performance to Print. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Graber, Robert Bates, and Gregory C. Richter. 1987. The Capon Theory of the Cuck-
old’s Horns: Confirmation or Conjecture? Journal of American Folklore 100: 58 63.
Mallery, Garrick. 1879 1880. Sign Language among North American Indians Com-
pared with That among Other Peoples and Deaf Mutes. First Annual Report of the
Bureau of Ethnology. Washington, DC: GPO.
Morris, Desmond, Peter Collett, Peter Marsh, and Marie O’Shaughnessy. 1979. Ges-
tures: Their Origins and Development. New York: Stein and Day.
Rickford, John A., and Angela E. Rickford. 1976. Cut-Eye and Suck-Teeth: African
Words and Gestures in New World Guise. Journal of American Folklore 89: 294 309.
Taylor, Archer. 1956. The Shanghai Gesture. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Gesunkenes Kulturgut
The idea that noteworthy cultural materials originated among the elite (or upper
stratum of society) and subsequently descended to (were copied by) the lower
stratum, or folk. A movement in the opposite direction is termed gehobenes
Kulturgut (elevated culture materials). If the process involves social groups at
various levels within the same presumed evolutionary stage, it may not be la-
beled as evolution or devolution.
The term gesunkenes Kulturgut was coined by the German Hans Naumann at
the beginning of the twentieth century. In 1902, Eduard Hoffmann-Krayer sug-
gested that folktales did not spring from a particular social class present in all
societies, contrary to the views of romantic nationalism. He further postulated:
‘‘The folk do not produce, they re-produce.’’ Naumann—who had espoused
Gesunkenes Kulturgut | 627
(in company with other folklorists such as Arnold van Gennep and Pierre Saint-
yves) the view that folklore originated in primitive rituals—embraced this new
argument and developed it into a theory. His new postulate credited the origin of
folklore to a socially superior Oberschicht (upper stratum, intelligentsia), whose
creative responses were borrowed, copied, or imitated by the socially inferior
Unterschicht (lower stratum, peasantry, folk). From a psychological standpoint,
although the process was one of ‘‘matched dependent behavior,’’ the behavior of
the model (the Oberschicht) degenerated into folklore in the course of being
acquired and reproduced by the Unterschicht. These folkloric responses of the
Unterschicht were degenerated imitations of the original Oberschicht models
because they were garbled and because they reflected the ignorance and misun-
derstanding of the unsophisticated Unterschicht. Naumann called the product of
what was adopted from the Oberschicht models gesunkenes Kulturgut.
The arguments of Naumann, Hoffmann-Krayer, and others who viewed folk-
lore in nationalistic terms were later incorporated into Nazi political ideology.
Thus, what began as an academic, sociological, and anthropological thesis
became fundamental to the development of the extreme nationalistic Herrenvolk
(master race) ideology. The roots of this doctrine lie deep in German political
theory and practice, backed by the firm beliefs that racial and folk ideals are ba-
sic to the state and that intense nationalism is an important means of survival.
In their search for the spiritual and national ancestry of the German peoples,
Nazi folklorists adopted this view. Thus, the theory of the Herrenvolk became
synonymous with the earlier concepts of the leading, higher, or formative social
strata of a population—respectively, the F€ uhrerschicht, Oberschicht, and
Bildungsschicht. All of these strata were thought to have served as models for
the imitative behavior of lower, less gifted social groups or nations.
Thus, the first step toward a theory of imitative learning in culture was intro-
duced by folklorists at the beginning of the twentieth century but never gained
popularity because it was used by political ideologists as a scientific justification
for extreme nationalism. The defeat of the ideology doomed the theory as well.
With the violent downfall of the Nazi regime, Naumann’s theory became debased,
and the concept of imitative learning in culture was aborted.
Another form of gesunkenes Kulturgut is that designated in the idea of the dete-
rioration of higher forms of cultural expressions into lesser forms. Within the
realm of verse (poetry-song), this phenomenon was labeled Zersingen (to sing to
pieces) by Friedrich von Schlegel (1772–1829)—a philologist and ideologue of
German romanticism. He postulated that folksongs are formulated by a process of
deterioration through transmission, whereby sophisticated poems are unwittingly
rendered into songs. This hypothesis was accepted by folk narrative scholar
Albert Wesselski, who was convinced that only through writing, a higher level of
culture, could narrative survive. Wesselski sought to use Schlegel’s postulate in
628 | Gesunkenes Kulturgut
order to discredit Walter Anderson’s theory that attributed the stability of folk-
tales to oral transmission and audience.
The turbulent career of Naumann’s imitative-degenerative theory concerning
the acquisition of folkloric responses by the Unterschict from the Oberschicht cre-
ated a hostile attitude toward the mere discussion of such a learning process. Ironi-
cally, a similar theory proposed by Lord Raglan remains little known in European
folklore circles because it did not acquire the political notoriety of Naumann’s
theory. Without referring to any specific race, nation, or social class, Raglan for-
mulated a theory of the ritualistic origin of folklore. According to Raglan, the ori-
gins of narrative genres are to be sought in ancient, dramatic ‘‘royal ritual,’’
developed and phrased by the royal and priestly classes. This ritual drama was imi-
tated by the masses (lower classes), who were too unsophisticated to understand its
meaning, and through an evolving process of degeneration, the ritual drama
reached its present state as folklore. Thus, epic, legend, myth, and folktale were
invented by an upper class and imitated by a lower class, which rendered them into
their present forms.
Raglan argued that the invention of such genres could not be credited to ‘‘peas-
ants’’ and ‘‘savages’’ (his labels for nonliterate peoples). ‘‘No popular story-teller
has ever been known to invent anything,’’ Raglan asserted, and ‘‘the peasant and
the savage, though they are great hands at making up stories, are nevertheless inca-
pable of making up the simplest story of the doings of ordinary human beings.’’
Raglan’s theory implies that creative imagination is a sophisticated phenom-
enon found only among the upper classes and that the peasant and savage or illit-
erate possesses only ‘‘memory [which] is more or less retentive, but will add
nothing to his or anyone else’s ideas since it can invent nothing.’’ Thus, the peas-
ant and savage or illiterate merely imitates and distorts, responding negatively,
and is unable to create anything himself.
In summary, Raglan’s theory of the imitative learning of folkloric responses
from superior classes is almost identical to Hans Naumann’s. Raglan merely
spoke in general terms of royalty and peasantry, whereas Naumann’s theory
described European Oberschicht and Unterschicht, which would later be inter-
preted as definite F€ uhrerschicht (leader stratum; as opposed to the ignorant
masses) and German Herrenvolk (in contrast to inferior races).
At the close of the twentieth century, the concept of or belief in the principle of
sunken culture materials saw a political renaissance. The argument that culture and
its institutions (economic, political) flow from the upper strata of society down to
the lower strata and that the lower strata benefit from the upper’s riches (posses-
sions) became a viable theory (ideology) and social program (policy) attributed to
the Republican Party in the United States. In the parlance of contemporary eco-
nomic theory, it is referred to as ‘‘trickle-down economics’’ or ‘‘Reaganomics.’’
Hasan El-Shamy
Giants | 629
References
Bach, Adolf. 1960. Deutsche Volkskunde (German folklore), 3rd. ed. Heidelberg:
Quelle and Meyer.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. Analytic Essays in Folklore. The Hague: Mouton.
El-Shamy, H. 1967. Folkloric Behavior. PhD thesis, Indiana University, Bloomington.
Hoffmann-Krayer, Eduard. 1902. Die Volkskunde als Wissenschaft (Folklore as sci-
ence). Zurich: F. Amberger.
Naumann, Hans. 1921. Primitive Gemeinschaftskultur. Jena, Germany: Diederich.
Naumann, Hans. 1922. Grundz€ uge der deutschen Volkskunde. Leipzig, Germany:
Quelle & Meyer.
Raglan, Lord. 1934. The Hero of Tradition. Folklore 45: 212 231.
Raglan, Lord. 1936. The Hero: A Study of Tradition Myth and Drama. London:
Methuen.
Saintyves, Pierre. 1923. Les contes de Perrault et les recits paral
elles. Paris: Librarie
Critique.
van Gennep, Arnold. 1910. La formation des legendes (The formation of legends).
Paris: E. Flammarion.
Wesselski, Albert. 1931. Versuch einer Theorie des M€
archens. Reichenberg, Ger-
many: F. Kraus.
Young, Kimball. 1934. Introduction to Sociology. New York: American Book.
Giants
mighty hammer and power over the lightning, defended the gods from the threat
of cold, darkness, and sterility.
The giants are sometimes called ‘‘frost giants.’’ Their aim was to carry away Freyja,
goddess of fertility, as well as the golden apples that gave the gods perpetual youth,
and the sun and moon, thereby causing the return of chaos. Surviving myths show the
constant threat the giants posed to the gods. They sought to obtain Thor’s hammer,
the weapon they feared most, or else to lure him unarmed into J€otunheim. One giant,
Hrungnir, made his way into Asgard, but was slain by Thor in a duel. Another giant
built a wall around Asgard, but demanded Freyja and the sun and moon as payment,
so Loki prevented him from completing his work, and he was slain.
Myths recounting Thor’s, Odin’s, or Loki’s entrance to the realm of the giants
are found in some of the earliest surviving poems from pre-Christian Iceland,
and some are illustrated in carvings considerably older than the literary sources.
One such journey, ending with the battering to death of the giant Geirr€od and his
two daughters after they attempted to destroy Thor, was known to Saxo Gram-
maticus, the thirteenth-century Danish historian.
A long comic tale of about the same date in the Prose Edda relates how Thor
was humiliated when he visited the hall of the huge giant Utgard-Loki, skilled in
deceptive magic. Thor only discovered too late how he had been hoodwinked,
but he had terrified the giants by his divine strength. When Thor went fishing for
the Midgard serpent, he was accompanied by a sea giant, Hymir, who was so
Giants | 631
frightened when Thor hooked the monster that he cut the line at the crucial
moment of the catch. Thor went to the hall of the giant Thrym to recover his sto-
len hammer, disguised by Loki as the goddess Freyja, coming to be wed, and
once he got his hammer back he slew the giant and all the wedding guests.
Odin overcame the giants by disguise and cunning rather than by brute force,
and a famous and possibly ancient myth relates how he recovered the magic
mead of inspiration, which the giant Suttung had taken and kept within a moun-
tain. In serpent form, Odin crawled through a crack in the rock and then made
love to the giant’s daughter in return for three drinks of mead. He emptied the
three vessels that held it and flew back in the form of an eagle, to vomit up the
precious liquid when he reached Asgard. In another tale Loki rescued the stolen
golden apples, along with the goddess Idun, and flew off in bird form, pursued
by the giant Thjazi in the form of an eagle, but the gods prepared a fire that
singed the giant’s wings when he flew into Asgard, and he was slain by Thor.
Thus, it can be seen that a number of early and powerful myths are concerned
with the struggle of gods against giants to preserve the culture that they had cre-
ated, until the end comes at Ragnar€ok. In this battle the giants at last gain en-
trance to Asgard, accompanied by the monsters that also threaten the gods, and
by the treacherous Loki, sometimes represented as a giant. In the final battle both
gods and giants perish, while the earth is destroyed by fire and sinks into the sea.
But it is fated to rise again from the cleansing waters, to be ruled by the sons of
the gods in a new age.
A different relationship between supernatural beings is indicated by marriages
between the gods and the daughters of giants. In the poem Skirnismal (The Lay
of Skirnir), Skirnir woos the fair maiden Gerd on behalf of Frey; she is the
daughter of a giant in the underworld and can only be reached by a long and per-
ilous journey. Skadi, daughter of the giant Thjazi, married the god Njord,
although the marriage failed because she belonged to the world of mountains and
he belonged to the world of the sea.
These northern giants possess a certain power and dignity not retained in later
medieval literature. There are traces of a powerful giant race among the Germans.
Weland, known to the Anglo-Saxons as a supernatural smith and associated with
an ancient burial mound on the Ridgeway in southern England, was a member of a
family remembered in heroic poetry. His father was the giant Wade, remembered
in English local tradition, and his son was the famous hero Widia. In the romances
and folktales, however, giants appear as powerful but rather stupid unnamed
beings who wreak havoc in the land, capture maidens and imprison them in their
castles, feast on human flesh, and hurl stones and boulders about the landscape.
They are overthrown by valiant knights or deceived by intelligent young heroes. In
postmedieval folktales, the giant’s wife often assists the hero by concealing him
from her husband, as in the widespread tale of ‘‘Jack the Giant-Killer.’’
632 | Giants
welcoming Henry V in 1415 after his victory over the French in the battle of
Agincourt. The present figures replaced eighteenth-century ones—14 feet, 6
inches high—burned in the London Blitz. They were successors to an older pair,
destroyed in the Great Fire of London.
Processional giants have fared better in continental Europe and flourished in
the Netherlands, Belgium, and northern France, where many are still paraded at
festivals. Some are accompanied by dragons and monsters of various kinds, like
the Salisbury Hob-Nob, a horse-like figure with snapping jaws that might tear
the clothes of people in the crowd.
The folklore of giants is a mixture of horror and comedy, with the latter ele-
ment predominating. Tales of a local giant getting the better of a villain or of a
powerful but simple giant overcome by a quick-witted young opponent are popu-
lar because they are amusing. The various landmarks and objects associated with
giants are shown to children and thus keep their memory alive. Jesting tales of
their exploits, however, are still told among adults, as well as among children,
and so it must have been in medieval times.
Hilda Ellis Davidson
See Also Myth.
References
Davidson, Hilda Roderick Ellis. 1964. Gods and Myths of Northern Europe. Balti-
more: Penguin.
Davidson, Hilda Roderick Ellis. 1993. The Lost Beliefs of Northern Europe. New
York: Routledge.
Knudsen, Shannon. 2010. Giants, Trolls, and Ogres. Minneapolis: Lerner.
Malam, John. 2010. Giants. Irving, CA: QEB.
Simpson, Jacqueline. 1987. European Mythology. New York: P. Bedrick Books.
Globalization
because folklore has long been concerned with cultural production in relation to
local community, nationalism, diaspora, ethnicity, identity, politics, economics,
and various expressions of power. In general, folklorists have not theorized global-
ization but have worked to interpret local cultural practices within broader global
contexts. To understand the dynamics of globalization, it is necessary to first
sketch some of the background theories against which folklorists work and then
address issues of particular relevance to folklorists—specifically whether global-
ization leads to increased worldwide cultural homogenization and whether the
local might play a role in processes of globalization. Although there are many
ways in which folklorists engage questions of globalization, these exemplify folk-
lorists’ concerns with the local production of culture and how shifting notions of
community, nationality, and locality influence such productions.
No single theorist can fully capture the unsystematic complexity that characterizes
globalization. Systems approaches like those outlined by Wallerstein (1974) and
Robertson (1992) provide necessary structural features, overviews of macro-
processes, and historical perspectives, which offer a loose framework for envisioning
the world at one level. Although these systems approaches obviously overlook the
micro-processes of individual ‘‘face-to-face’’ interactions (virtual or real) and the
impact that global interconnectedness has on individuals, they do provide useful
bases for thinking about the world as a single place. At the other end of the spectrum,
theorists such as Hannerz (1996) and Pieterse (1995) stress the micro-level aspects of
globalization through their discussions of creolization and hybridity. Hannerz ana-
lyzes concrete instances of exchange between traditional ‘‘centers’’ and ‘‘peripheries’’
to provide another level at which to think about globalization, offering glimpses
into the immediate effects of global culture on local people. While the traditional
anthropological notion of centers and peripheries may seem outdated in an increas-
ingly interconnected world marked by global flows and virtual locales, the center-
periphery paradigm, even when removed from specific geographical contexts, can
still usefully highlight the power imbalances that remain integral aspects of globaliza-
tion. As Arjun Appadurai (1996) proposes, centers and peripheries might be linked to
diffuse configurations of power, which take the form of transnational corporations or
other entities that control or influence the global flows of capital, technologies, ideol-
ogies, and media images. In addition, Appadurai’s prioritization of rupture and ‘‘non-
isomorphic’’ global flows goes the furthest in modeling the global condition.
That globalization entails cultural homogenization, most commonly in the guise
of Americanization, is a popular belief that has been theorized in models of cultural
imperialism and confirmed by returning tourists, discussed by anthropologists, and
commodified in American advertisements and movies. Barber (1995) argues that
the process of ‘‘McWorld’’ is one of soft hegemony, an easy way to export Ameri-
can capitalist ideologies to the world, thereby making the world safe for the free
market. He grants immense power to the forces of McWorld. In fact, he suggests
Globalization | 635
that McWorld will eventually defeat what he perceives to be its alternative evil—
Jihad (that is, tribalism and radical identity politics). Based on his belief that global
information and global culture will eventually kill off parochialism, Barber holds
that the culture of McWorld will ultimately be the culture of the world.
On the other hand, Mike Featherstone (1995) and Ulf Hannerz (1996) complicate
theories of cultural imperialism in their reflections on the increasingly local nature
of the global and the simultaneous global nature of the local. When people migrate,
the culture traditions that travel best—those with sensory power like music, folk-
tales, foodways, and festivals—travel with them. At the same time, the sensory
power of these traditions delivers them to the market, incorporates them into multi-
cultural policy work, and allows them to serve as somewhat superficial points of
cultural exchange. In some senses, the local is globally homogenized in the same
way that American (or Western) culture is said to homogenize all other cultures: not
only does one find McDonald’s, Coca-Cola, and Nike around the world, but one
also finds Chinese food, African music, and May Day celebrations. Of equal impor-
tance, then, is Amy Shuman’s article ‘‘Dismantling Local Culture’’ (1993), in which
she reminds folklorists that the category of the local has been used uncritically to
signal a natural, authentic, romantic response to globalizing forces at the expense of
local cultural practices and the people who sustain them.
As the world grows more interconnected and as emergent technologies allow
more of us to experience this global interconnectedness, the global cultural homoge-
nization thesis may seem attractive. However, general impressions and observations
are not enough to sustain theory. Only continued investigations of local practice with
respect to global commodities, images, and information will help us answer the
pressing question of how we are to read instances of global-local cultural exchange.
Kimberly J. Lau
See Also Worldview.
References
Appadurai, Arjun. 1996. Modernity at Large: Cultural Dimensions of Globalization.
Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Barber, Benjamin R. 1995. Jihad vs. McWorld: How the Planet Is Both Falling
Apart and Coming Together and What This Means for Democracy. New York: Random
House.
Featherstone, Mike. 1995. Undoing Culture: Globalization, Postmodernism, and
Identity. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications.
Hall, Stuart. 1991. The Local and the Global: Globalization and Ethnicity. In Culture,
Globalization, and the World-System: Contemporary Conditions for the Representation
of Identity, ed. Anthony D. King. Binghamton: State University of New York Press.
Hannerz, Ulf. 1996. Transnational Connections: Culture, People, Places. New York:
Routledge.
636 | Gossip
Gossip
tabloids, of People magazine and its imitators, and of television shows such as
Hard Copy that center on the dissemination of personal information about celebri-
ties. Stories about ‘‘personalities’’ have long had an important role in popular out-
lets. Sociologists Jack Levin and Arnold Arluke (1987) emphasized that media
gossip has its own rules and limits, and they demonstrated that most media gossip
is positive and that most gossip reporters behave in an ethical fashion.
Because oral gossip is moral discourse, concerned with the reputation of the
teller and the target, its production in conversation is quite complex. In the words
of Jorg Bergmann, gossip is ‘‘discreet indiscretion.’’ The parties delicately con-
struct the meaning of the gossip in such a way that their views of proper behavior
are upheld by others. Gossip topics are proposed and accepted. Moral indignation
is deployed and responded to. As Bergmann and others have demonstrated, the
conversation analysis of gossip holds considerable promise for demonstrating the
significance of this traditional genre.
Gary Alan Fine
See Also Rumor.
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1970. A Performance-Centered Approach to Gossip. Man 5:
290 301.
Bergmann, Jorg. 1993. Discreet Indiscretions: The Social Organization of Gossip.
New York: Aldine.
Fine, Gary Alan, and Ralph Rosnow. 1978. Gossip, Gossipers, Gossiping. Personal-
ity and Social Psychology Bulletin 4: 161 168.
Haviland, John B. 1977. Gossip, Reputation and Knowledge in Zincantan. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
Levin, Jack, and Arnold Arluke. 1987. Gossip: The Inside Scoop. New York: Plenum.
Rosnow, Ralph, and Gary Alan Fine. 1976. Rumor and Gossip: The Social Psychol-
ogy of Hearsay. New York: Elsevier.
Sparks, Patricia. 1985. Gossip. New York: Knopf.
Yerkovich, Sally. 1977. Gossiping as a Way of Speaking. Journal of Communication
27: 192 196.
Graffiti
the fine arts building or the men’s gym versus the women’s gym. Of course, the
graffiti in these specialized locales generally reflects the interests and concerns
of the students (and faculty) who frequent them.
Another characteristic of graffiti is its interactive quality, expressed as conver-
sations or ‘‘runs’’ in which a variety of successive writers add to and comment on
the original statement. For example, many sources report variations on the fol-
lowing run: ‘‘God is dead’’—‘‘Don’t worry, Mary is pregnant again’’—‘‘God isn’t
dead. He just doesn’t want to get involved’’—‘‘Who is God anyway?’’ Some-
times these runs continue until the available wall space is used up.
At the opposite end of the spectrum is urban graffiti that consists of a single
person’s nickname or a gang name or symbol. As a rule, the defacing of such
graffiti is the catalyst for gang retaliation. A distinctive Mexican American graf-
fito, con safos (or its abbreviation, c/s), functions to prevent the defacement of
any name graffiti that it accompanies because of the folk belief among Mexican
Americans that to deface such distinctively protected graffiti is to reflexively
harm oneself. An oral folk rhyme expressing this same sentiment is ‘‘I’m rubber,
you’re glue. What you throw at me, sticks to you.’’
As mentioned, much urban graffiti is gang or ‘‘turf’’ related, and thus it functions
as a boundary marker. In hotly contested areas or intersections, practically all of
the walls and sidewalks may be covered with contrasting graffiti. The subway cars
of New York City have provided the most dramatic example of excessive graffiti.
Such gang-related graffiti utilizes a combination of gang colors, names, and sym-
bols. In such cases, municipal authorities usually regard creating graffiti as defac-
ing public property or vandalism punishable by fines and imprisonment. The
problem with such regulations, however, is that the writers of graffiti are inherently
anonymous, which usually precludes their apprehension by the authorities. In some
communities, as part of negotiations to end gang violence, the authorities will
work out a truce in which the various gangs come together publicly to wash off
and paint over the offending graffiti of all the involved groups.
Graffiti can be classified as folklore for many reasons. Although most research-
ers regard graffiti as a separate and distinct genre, others make a strong case that
graffiti is a specialized kind of written folk speech because of its poetic and narra-
tive characteristics. Regardless of genre classification, graffiti is undoubtedly tra-
ditional, with a pedigree extending back historically to the ancient Romans and
possibly further. It also employs traditional, doggerel verse forms that reappear
generation after generation, such as latrinalia with the common introduction
‘‘Here I sit. . . .’’ The anonymity of the graffiti writers is another characteristic that
places graffiti squarely in the purview of folklore. Finally, graffiti is associated
with distinctive folk groups, ranging from the habitues of various university build-
ings to socially deviant groups such as gangs to various ethnic groups.
Sylvia Grider
640 | Great Tradition/Little Tradition
References
Blake, C. Fred. 1981. Graffiti and Racial Insults: The Archaeology of Ethnic Rela-
tions in Hawaii. In Modern Material Culture: The Archaeology of Us, eds. Richard A.
Gould et al. New York: Academic.
Castleman, Craig. 1982. Getting Up: Subway Graffiti in New York. Cambridge, MA:
MIT Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1966. Here I Sit A Study of American Latrinalia. Kroeber Anthropo-
logical Society Papers 34: 91 105.
Grider, Sylvia. 1975. Con Safos: Mexican-Americans, Names, and Graffiti. Journal
of American Folklore 88: 132 142.
Grieb, Kenneth J. 1984. The Writing on the Walls: Graffiti as Government Propa-
ganda in Mexico. Journal of Popular Culture 18(1): 78 91.
Hentschel, Elke. 1987. Women’s Graffiti. Multilingua: Journal of Cross Cultural
and Interlanguage Communication 6(3): 287 308.
Melhorn, J. Jack. 1985. Rest Room Graffiti: A Descriptive Study. Emporia State
(KS) Research Studies 34(2-3): 29 45.
Ong, Walter J. 1990. Subway Graffiti and the Design of the Self. In The State of the
Language, eds. Christopher Ricks and Leonard Michaels. Berkeley: University of Cali-
fornia Press.
Proctor, Lenore Feltman. 1991. Graffiti Writers: An Exploratory Personality Study.
PhD dissertation, Pace University, New York.
Read, Alan W. 1988 1989. Folk Criticism of Religiosity in the Graffiti of New York
City. Maledicta: The International Journal of Verbal Aggression 10: 15 30.
Smith, Moira. 1986. Walls Have Ears: A Contextual Approach to Graffiti.
International Folklore Review 4: 100 105.
Stein, Mary Beth. 1989. The Politics of Humor: The Berlin Wall in Jokes and Graf-
fiti. Western Folklore 48(2): 85 108.
Stewart, Susan. 1987. Ceci Tuera Cela: Graffiti as Crime and Art. In Life after Post-
modernism: Essays on Value and Culture, ed. John Fekete. New York: St. Martin’s.
Tanzer, Helen H. 1939. The Common People of Pompeii: A Study of the Graffiti.
Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
The distinction between the higher, elite levels of a civilization (great tradition)
and the folk or popular levels (little tradition). Little traditions are most often
associated with the pre-urban stages or non-urban, nonliterate/illiterate levels of
society and are products of the village or the common people. The basis of the
great tradition is rooted in the little traditions of the folk level. As a society
Great Tradition/Little Tradition | 641
undergoes primary urbanization, the little traditions become codified, evolve into
great traditions, and often fall subordinate to the aesthetics and learning of the
great traditions.
In contrast to little traditions, great traditions represent the highest levels of
the intellectual and aesthetic achievements of a civilization, and as such, they are
transmitted and preserved in some codified, stylized ‘‘text’’ form. As the codified
and developed cultural heritage of the society, they provide the sources for iden-
tity among members of the society by providing the rules of conduct, the primary
philosophy, religion, standards, cultural norms, and aesthetic sensibilities. Great
traditions are the product of the reflective, literate, philosophic few, and they are
a result of urbanization. Further, they represent the mediated, codified, and intel-
lectualized little traditions extant in a culture. The existence of a set of great and
little traditions within a civilization depends upon consciousness of a common
culture built on the common cultural artifacts within the little traditions.
The study of great traditions is most often associated with textual studies, such
as history, the classics, or comparative religion. The focus of these disciplines is,
typically, the understanding of various cultures through their great traditions.
Most of these studies find their models in the traditional studies of ancient
Greece and Rome and the ‘‘Oriental Renaissance’’ studies of classic Persian, Chi-
nese, Japanese, and Indic texts. Little traditions, however, are most often the
realm of the cultural anthropologist, the ethnographer, and the folklorist.
The useful definition and study of great and little traditions began in earnest
with Robert Redfield’s studies in the 1930s and with his joint projects with Milton
Singer in the 1940s and 1950s. Basic to these definitions was Redfield’s idea of
the folk-urban continuum, which traces societies on a scale from tribal to urban as
a part of human cultural development. According to this system, a society evolves
from a simpler, tribal system, with its own sets of beliefs, norms, and standards
(little traditions), to a more sophisticated, primary urban center, with a codified
set of norms, beliefs, and aesthetic and intellectual achievements interpreted by a
ruling elite (great traditions). The creation of these primary urban centers occurs
in a process that Redfield defined as orthogenetic transformation, in which an
evolving ruling group interprets and mediates between the several little traditions
surrounding the developing urban center to develop and codify a great tradition.
Like little traditions, great traditions can evolve when a primary urban center
comes in conflict with another culture or even with conflicting ideologies. The
mediation between the cultures leads to the development of a secondary (or terti-
ary, quaternary, ad infinitum) urban center, with the conflicting traditions medi-
ated by a select intelligentsia who present the new traditions to the indigenous
culture and explain the existing great traditions to the interlopers. Robert Redfield
defined this process as heterogenetic transformation, in which a conquering group
destroys and replaces the great traditions of the indigenous group by way of the
642 | Grimm Brothers
References
Bauman, Richard, ed. 1992. Folklore, Cultural Performances, and Popular Entertain-
ments: A Communications-Centered Handbook. New York: Oxford University Press.
Redfield, Margaret Park, ed. 1966. Human Nature and the Study of Society: The
Papers of Robert Redfield, Vol. 1. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Singer, Milton B. 1972. When a Great Tradition Modernizes: An Anthropological
Approach to Indian Civilization. New York: Praeger Publishers.
Grimm Brothers
German scholars and writers: Jakob Ludwig (1785–1863) was a pioneer of linguis-
tics whose theory of consonantal evolution became known as Grimm’s Law,
whereas Wilhelm Karl (1786–1859) was a literary historian. They combined their
talents in a project to record the folktales of the German-speaking nations, issuing
the first version of their classic collection in two volumes as Die Kinder- und
H€asm€archen (1812–1814); later editions were substantially expanded and revised.
Many selections from the collection were translated into English, some of the ta-
les—including ‘‘Hansel and Gretel,’’ ‘‘Rapunzel,’’ ‘‘Rumpelstiltskin,’’ ‘‘The Twelve
Dancing Princesses,’’ ‘‘The Little Tailor,’’ and ‘‘Snow White and Rose Red’’—
becoming very familiar, usually but not exclusively in bowdlerized versions.
Wilhelm Grimm encouraged this process by adding more literary polish and toning
Grimm Brothers | 643
down the tales in later editions, but translators usually felt free to make alterations of
their own: Edgar Taylor, their first English translator, insisted on substituting giants
for demons and refused to reproduce the celebrated climactic scene in which Snow
White’s stepmother is fitted with red-hot iron shoes to make her dance herself to
death. A complete modern translation of 241 stories, which attempts to recover the
original versions—including some the brothers wrote down but never published—is
The Complete Fairy Tales of the Brothers Grimm, edited by Jack Zipes (2003).
The Grimms were closely involved with the evolution of the German Roman-
tic movement and enthusiasts for German idealistic philosophy; their endeavors
played a major part in the attempt to discover an authentic German Volksgeist
(‘‘spirit of the people’’) in folktales and folksongs that allegedly preserved the
roots of Germanic culture and language. (A similar thesis regarding the complic-
ity of folk art in the evolution of language was developed in England by Owen
Barfield, a member of the Inklings whose ideas provided an ideological basis for
excursions into fantastic fiction by J. R. R. Tolkien and C. S. Lewis.) Referring
to comparisons carried out by Heinz R€olleke, however, John M. Ellis (1983)
complained in One Fairy Story Too Many that the Grimms were never true to
Jakob’s original intention to preserve the tales as they were actually told, and
collected most of them from middle-class friends. The Grimms’ printed versions,
Ellis alleges, gave much more attention to story structure and character motiva-
tion than the versions in their handwritten notes, but this criticism may not take
644 | Grimm Brothers
fully into account the essential differences between oral and written discourse, or
the extent to which the written notes were aide-m emoire rather than verbatim
transcriptions.
The tales collected by the Grimms are considerably darker and nastier than
those adopted into literary form by French writers a century before, as can read-
ily be ascertained by comparing their ‘‘Ashputtle’’ with Perrault’s ‘‘Cendrillon.’’
This endears them to folklorists ambitious to recover folktales from the morass
of children’s literature, and to modern writers ambitious to exploit the horrific
potential of revisionist folktales, who delight in the fact that their name is an
English pun; a cardinal example of that relish is Tanith Lee’s (1983) Red as
Blood; or, Tales from the Sisters Grimmer. The antiquity of many of the tales is
doubtful; although the overlap between the Grimms’ collection and Perrault’s
might be partly due to the tales being handed down from remote sources in paral-
lel traditions, the fact that it includes a version of ‘‘Little Red Riding Hood’’—
which Perrault appears to have originated—suggests that direct transmission is
more likely. If so, the darker elements may have more to do with the generous
license granted to contemporary German child carers to indulge in vivid moral
terrorism—graphically illustrated by Heinrich Hoffmann’s (1845) Struwwel-
peter—than with any deep-seated aspect of the German Volksgeist (although
Nazi ideology was later to make much of the stoical aspects of that alleged
Volksgeist, and the Disney version of Snow White and the Seven Dwarfs was
rumored to be Adolf Hitler’s favorite film). The Grimms’ hypothesis that ‘‘Briar
Rose’’ is a demotic variant of the enchantment of Brynhild in the Volsungasaga
rather than an adaptation of Perrault’s ‘‘Sleeping Beauty’’ is not entirely implau-
sible, but the idea of a beautiful woman awaiting a magical kiss to awaken
her from suspended animation is surely not so esoteric that it might have
remained forever uninvented but for the inspiration of some unknown Bronze
Age genius. The tale in question has spawned so many spectacular deliberate
variants—of which the most spectacular include Leon Garfield’s (1985) The
Wedding Ghost, Jane Yolen’s (1992) Briar Rose, and Robert Coover’s (1996)
Briar Rose—that the basic metaphor obviously strikes a powerful resonance in
many would-be tellers.
The Grimms might be reckoned slightly fortunate to have hijacked the credit
for committing so many narrative formulas to print, given that they were only
occasionally the first to do so and that their versions are primarily important as
stimuli to further and finer literary endeavor, but few other writers have been
privileged to leave such an indelible stamp on the imaginative produce of genera-
tions to come.
Brian Stableford
See Also Fairy Tale Heroes.
Grimm Brothers | 645
References
Coover, Robert. 1996. Briar Rose. New York: Grove Press.
Ellis, John M. 1983. One Fairy Story Too Many: The Brothers Grimm and Their
Tales. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Garfield, Leon. 1985. The Wedding Ghost. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Hoffmann, Heinrich. [1845] 1995. Struwwelpeter: In English Translation. New
York: Dover.
Lee, Tanith. 1983. Red as Blood; Or, Tales from the Sisters Grimmer. New York:
Daw Books.
Yolen, Jane. 1992. Briar Rose. New York: T. Doherty Associates.
Zipes, Jack. 2003. The Complete Fairy Tales of the Brothers Grimm. New York:
Bantam.
H
Helpers, Folk
Heroes frequently have help from various sources in the pursuit of their quests
and in overcoming the obstacles presented to them. The helper may be an older
person, as in some versions of Havelock the Dane; a member of the opposite sex,
as in Hansel and Gretel; a supernatural or otherwise invisible helper, such as the
Fairy Godmother of Cinderella; or one or more magical objects, such as a cloak
of invisibility or a magical sword, staff, or other device. The tambourine of
Miriam, sister of Moses, for example, enables a rabbi to open the book that confers
one Jew from each generation with the knowledge to make him advisor to the king
of Babylon. Even a doll may be a helper, as in the Russian story of Vasilisa.
Birds, fish, rabbits, mice, dogs, cats, lions, or other animals are found as helpers
of heroes and heroines in the folklore of many nations and cultures, a representa-
tive example being Bahram, son of a poor Persian couple who peels silkworm
cocoons for their meager living. Bahram rescues a cat, a dog, and a snake from
various forms of mistreatment, and these grateful animals help him through a long
series of adventures, at the end of which he marries the beautiful princess.
Helpers are also common in the lore of historical figures. The late twelfth-
century French minstrel Blondel de Nesle appears in legend as a companion of
Cinderella and her Fairy Godmother, illustrated by Nadir Quinto (1918–1994). (Look and
Learn/The Bridgeman Art Library International)
647
648 | Hemispheric Approach
References
Mehdevi, A. 1966. Persian Folk and Fairy Tales. London: Chatto and Windus.
Propp, V. 1968. Morphology of the Folktale. Trans. L. Scott. Austin: University of
Texas Press.
Hemispheric Approach
Theory that each Western Hemisphere country’s folklore should be studied in its
distinctive ethnic and historical contexts. Developed by Richard M. Dorson in
the 1950s, the approach sought to distinguish American folklore (specifically,
Hemispheric Approach | 649
that of the United States) from the traditions of Europe and other sources of im-
migration. The initial colonization of the Americas, the importation of slaves
from Africa, and continuing waves of immigration from various cultures, espe-
cially Europe and Asia, created a set of folk traditions that lacked the holistic
national identity and long-standing rootedness found in Old World societies.
Western Hemisphere folklore emerged from such processes of culture contact as
acculturation, retention, and revitalization. Coupled with the particular histories
of Western Hemisphere nations, these processes have generated heterogeneous
sets of folklore traditions.
Dorson focused primarily on the folklore of the United States. He identified
several historical forces that contributed to the distinctiveness of American folk-
lore. His list of these forces changed with the development of the approach; the
final catalog of them (published posthumously) cited colonization, the revolu-
tion, the frontier, slavery, the Civil War, immigration, and industrialization.
(Earlier lists had also included the presence of aboriginal Americans and the
influence of the mass media.) Dorson contrasted his hemispheric approach with
theories and methodologies that focused cross-culturally on themes, symbols, or
patterns in folklore without regard to their cultural contexts and with approaches
that examined a limited number of texts or performances of folklore only in
terms of their immediate situation. A folklorist who adopted Dorson’s hemi-
spheric approach, by contrast, would place the materials of folklore within the
broad currents of American cultural history. The ways in which folklore rein-
forced the dominant ethos of a particular society became the most important tar-
get of investigation.
Dorson positioned his approach as contrasting ‘‘American folklore’’ with ‘‘folk-
lore in America.’’ The latter perspective analyzed folklore encountered in the
United States using the same methods that applied to folklore encountered else-
where. A structural study of an Appalachian Jack tale, for instance, would utilize
structural methodology that might work equally well on a M€ archen collected in
Germany. However, the hemispheric approach would consider the folktale in the
context of American history and life, perhaps emphasizing the importance of
regionalism in shaping its content.
The hemispheric approach’s almost exclusive focus on surface content and
lack of interest in structure, function, symbolism, and performance limited its
appeal for folklorists concerned with those features of folklore. Moreover, folklo-
rists who did not study Western Hemisphere folklore (or that of Australia, whose
cultural history Dorson believed to be similar to that of Western Hemisphere
nations) found little to interest them in the hemispheric approach. Consequently,
when Dorson reviewed the approach a decade after he first published it as a formal
statement, he could cite only a few studies besides his own that might be identified
as using that approach. His final articulation of the approach, published two years
650 | Hero/Heroine, Folk
after his death, concluded by noting that very little had been done by folklorists
using the perspective.
William M. Clements
See Also Historical Analysis; Worldview.
References
Dorson, Richard M. 1959. American Folklore. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Dorson, Richard M. 1971. American Folklore and the Historian. Chicago: University
of Chicago Press.
Dorson, Richard M. 1973. America in Legend: Folklore from the Colonial Period to
the Present. New York: Pantheon.
Dorson, Richard M. 1983. A Historical Theory for American Folklore. In Handbook
of American Folklore, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Hero/Heroine, Folk
Villains, Folk
Heroes cannot exist without villains. Generally these figures represent evil or
wrongdoing of some kind and span an amazing array of types, including magicians,
sorcerers, ogres, giants, fairies, elves, dwarves, witches, demons, the Devil, tempt-
resses, dragons, giant worms, and snakes. The purpose of such characters is to
oppose, obstruct, or undermine the hero and in many cases to personify the princi-
ple of evil. As such, villains represent a force that is out of kilter with the rightful
order of things, and accordingly, in folklore at least, they must be overcome so that
the natural balance can be restored.
The Baba-Yaga (Iaga) of Russian and Slavic tradition exemplifies most of the char-
acteristics of folk villains. She is an evil, often cannibalistic witch figure, similar in
many respects to the witch who plans to eat Hansel and Gretel. She lives away
from humankind, deep in remote forests, and has great magical powers that she
uses to attain her usually wicked ends, although like some other villains of the su-
pernatural type, the Baba-Yaga is occasionally helpful to heroes.
Similar in many ways are the tall, big-bosomed wild women of Polish tradition
known as Dwi-Wozoney, and as the Diva-ta-Zena in Bulgarian belief. Despite their
frigid hearts, these women are passionate lovers, often enslaving younger humans.
They may tickle humans to death, and, like the fairies, they are said to substitute
changelings for human children. They are symbolic of the villainy that heroes must
overcome in all traditions.
The principle of evil may be present in anything and anywhere and, in a wide
range of possibilities and permutations, is a constant feature of world folklores. It is
most vividly and consistently a principal component of folktales, though it may also
be important in ballads and other forms of folk expression, such as traditional
drama, proverbial sayings, folk belief and customs.
Graham Seal
The Witch Baba Yaga by Wassily Kandinsky (1866–1944). (Re union des Musees
Nationaux/Art Resource, NY/
C 2010 Artists Rights Society (ARS), New York/ADAGP,
Paris)
652 | Hero/Heroine, Folk
and to the traits and behaviors associated with heroism, which humanity has felt the
urge to accentuate, glorify, and record in oral, graphic, and written form.
Heroic behaviors include saving individuals and nations from destructive forces
or leading them from danger, discovering hidden treasure, and reuniting people
with deities or the life principle. Moreover, among hero/heroine figures, there is a
great variety of types—for instance, the deity-like culture hero, the historical fig-
ure, the trickster, the strong man, the strong woman, the ignorant hero, the ingenue,
the beautiful youth, the saint, and the magician. A small sample of motifs dealing
with heroes/heroines may illustrate the great diversity of this theme as it occurs in
folk literature: A500–A599, ‘‘Demigods and culture-heroes’’; A5 11.1.2, ‘‘Culture-
hero speaks before birth’’; A5 11.1.3.2, ‘‘Demigod son of king’s unmarried sister
by her brother’’; A5 11.3.2, ‘‘Culture-hero reared (educated) by extraordinary (su-
pernatural) personages’’; A512.3, ‘‘Culture-hero as son of god’’; A522.3.1, ‘‘Spider
as culture-hero’’; A5 22.22, ‘‘Raven as culture-hero’’; L100–L199, ‘‘Unpromising
hero (heroine)’’; L101, ‘‘Unpromising hero (male Cinderella)’’; L102, ‘‘Unpromising
heroine’’; L11 1.3, ‘‘Widow’s son as hero’’; L11 1.5, ‘‘Bastard hero’’; L11 2.3,
‘‘Deformed child as hero’’; L1 14. 1, ‘‘Lazy hero’’; L1 14.4, ‘‘Cheater as hero’’;
L160, ‘‘Success of the unpromising hero (heroine)’’; M361, ‘‘Fated hero. Only cer-
tain hero will succeed in exploit’’; Z292, ‘‘Death of hero’’; and Z293, ‘‘Return of
hero’’ (compare K2200–K2299, ‘‘Villains and traitors’’).
Joseph Campbell has shown that although hero/heroine tales and myths occur
around the world and may vary in detail, close analysis reveals these stories have
structural similarities that persist across cultures and historical periods. Such sto-
ries have, in other words, a universal pattern, despite arising from groups or indi-
viduals having no direct contact with each other. Repeatedly, one observes tales
describing a miraculous but common birth, demonstration of superhuman strength
and ability, rapid rise to prominence or power, triumphant struggle with the forces
of evil, proneness to pride, and ultimate decline through betrayal or sacrifice
resulting in death. Moreover, in many such stories, early weakness is offset by the
emergence of a powerful mentor or guardian figure who assists in the execution
of superhuman tasks that cannot be accomplished alone. For example, among
Greek heroic figures, Theseus had Poseidon, god of the sea, Perseus had Athena,
goddess of wisdom, and Achilles had Chiron, the centaur, as guides.
The central example of the hero/heroine motif in Western culture is the story
of Jesus Christ, who is born humbly but with numerous associated miracles,
reveals superhuman abilities and wonders, rises quickly to a position of high
esteem among his followers, struggles with the forces of evil represented by
Satan, and then suffers death through betrayal as the ultimate sacrifice for
humanity. The only one of the elements listed earlier that does not appear in the
Hero/Heroine, Folk | 653
Dragon-Slayers
A major class of heroes and heroines, dragon-slayers and their victims are a con-
stant feature in the traditions of the world. As with many other categories or types
of hero, dragon-slayers are predominantly, though not exclusively, male. Closely
allied to giant-killers, dragon-slayers often begin life as good-for-nothing layabouts
and youngest or only sons, their adventures and misadventures leading to the revela-
tion of unsuspected bravery, strength, and skill. Usually dragon-slayers survive their
combats with the scaly fire-breathers and go on to win the gold, the girl, and the
kingdom. In one case, at least, that of St. George, a dragon-slayer has become a
national and culture hero in a number of different countries and cultures.
Folk heroes generally consider dragons to be in the same general class as ser-
pents, giant worms, sea monsters, and even giant man-eating boars, as in a Papuan
tale. Whenever they appear—which is often—dragon-slayers are usually interpreted
as culture heroes and/or warrior heroes, such as the princess-rescuing dragon-slayer
of Russian folktales, Frolka-Stay-at-Home.
Fresco of Saint George killing the dragon on a medieval castle’s wall. (Claudio Divizia/
Dreamstime.com)
654 | Hero/Heroine, Folk
Christ-as-hero story is proneness to pride. Also, the Christ story contains the
added component of a miraculous return to physical life after death.
More typically, the hero/heroine sets out from a mundane home environment,
is called to a quest or adventure, crosses a threshold of some kind, and is sub-
jected to a number of trials or ordeals, culminating in an ultimate test of will and
virtue—a struggle with a dragon or other creature representing the forces of dark-
ness (in psychological terms, the unconscious). Victory over the monster is
rewarded with a treasure, such as a kingdom and a beautiful princess as bride.
Cross-culturally, the hero/heroine’s first goal is the conquest of self; so, besides
folklorists, psychologists and students of religion are attracted to the study and analy-
sis of heroic myth and lore. For instance, according to dream and folktale psychoan-
alytic interpretation, the hero/heroine embodies the triumph of the developed ego
over the primitive forces of the id, or primal instincts. And from the more heterodox
psychoanalytic perspective of Otto Rank, the following elements are typical of the
lives of heroic figures such as Moses, Paris, Siegfried, Romulus, and Lohengrin:
1. Birth to royal or noble parents, with gestation and birth being shrouded in
secrecy.
2. A tyrannical father who wishes to suppress or kill his offspring.
3. Abandonment of the offspring in a mysterious place until the child is found
and raised by impoverished parents, by a poor woman, or by animals.
4. Growth to maturity, discovery of the tyrannical father, and vengeful killing
of him.
5. Elevation to the father’s status, along with celebration as a hero or deification.
This sequence of life events differs markedly from the one noted by Campbell
as occurring in heroic myth and folklore, and it reflects early psychoanalytically
inspired ideas on the universal occurrence of infantile fantasies about the father, or
‘‘the Oedipal complex,’’ in which the father is an object of sexual envy by the son.
In contrast, from the perspective of Jungian analysis, the hero/heroine’s life
takes on a more spiritual cast, in which his or her typical solar attributes reflect a
Hero/Heroine, Folk | 655
pride or ego—in folk or mythic terms, the jealousy of the gods. The Twins, Flesh
and Stump, although said to be sons of the Sun, are basically human and comprise
a single individual, reflecting the two sides of human nature—introversion or
inward directedness and extroversion or assertiveness, respectively. For a long pe-
riod during the tale cycle, these figures appear to be invincible, defeating all chal-
lengers. But over time, they fall victim to pride, and their unbridled behavior
brings about their downfall. Their sentence is death, but since they have become
so frightened by their own reckless abuse of power, they agree to live in a constant
state of rest—symbolically, the two sides of human nature thus become balanced.
The universal or archetypal quality of hero/heroine myths and folktales has
given them great appeal for people of all cultures through the ages. Since they
symbolize and reflect the process of both individual and societal growth and de-
velopment, they resonate with the inner and outer needs and desires of all human
beings and have thus attained a place of cross-cultural prominence.
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Culture Hero; Folktale; Jungian Psychology; Myth.
References
Campbell, Joseph. 1949. The Hero with a Thousand Faces. New York: Pantheon.
Cirlot, J. E. 1962. A Dictionary of Symbols. New York: Philosophical Library.
El-Shamy, H. 1967. Folkloric Behavior. PhD thesis. Indiana University, Bloomington.
Jung, C. G., ed. 1982. Man and His Symbols. New York: Dell.
Matthews, Boris, trans. 1986. The Herder Symbol Dictionary. Wilmette, IL: Chiron.
Rank, Otto. 1970. The Myth of the Birth of the Hero: A Psychological Interpretation
of Mythology. New York: Johnson.
Stevens, Anthony. 1982. Archetypes: A Natural History of the Self. New York: Quill.
Thompson, Stith. 1955 1958. Motif-Index of Folk-Literature. 6 vols. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
von Franz, Marie-Louise. 1970. Interpretation of Fairy Tales. Dallas, TX: Spring.
Zhao, Q. 1992. A Study of Dragons, East and West, New York: Peter Lang Publishing,
pp. 119 141.
Historical Analysis
Method of scholarship that examines folkloric texts over time and as a process.
Since folklore is a discipline that studies traditional processes (i.e., items or perfor-
mances that are rooted in the past but continue to adapt and change for current use),
most folklorists have looked at historical developments to shed light on changes in
a particular tradition rather than to study history as an element of folklore. Scrutiniz-
ing folklore as a process that changes over time enables us to recognize patterns and
Historical Analysis | 657
structures. This method also reveals versions and variations among and between
texts and cultures, which would not be recognizable without some degree of histori-
cal depth. Thus, studies of material culture, folksong, traditional narrative, folk
drama, and so on include, of necessity, a historical component. Although there are
folkloric theories that do not depend upon the development and change of tradi-
tional culture to explain their perspectives, those that do look to those processes to
explicate a particular outcome, provide a model to test a particular theory, or recon-
struct a group’s perspective of its past and rationale for the present.
The study of folklore began as the search for survivals of elite culture among
European peasants. The eighteenth-century German theologian Johann Gottfried
von Herder, known as the father of romantic nationalism, regarded the oral tradi-
tions of the ‘‘folk’’ as encompassing the wisdom of the Germanic forefathers; in
the face of the French domination of Europe, such a philosophy provided a refuge
in a historical past whose traditions could serve only to inspire the cultural and po-
litical unification of the Germanic states. Nineteenth-century philologists such as
Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm collected and arranged M€ archen (or folktales) in order
to justify their theories about language and culture transmission, as well as to
rediscover the authentic soul of ‘‘the people’’ during the development and consoli-
dation of European nationalism. In nineteenth-century England, Edward Tylor,
like other evolutionary anthropologists and early folklorists who were followers of
social Darwinism, regarded items of traditional culture as evidence of stages in the
social evolution of colonial and European cultures: Customs and beliefs among
Africans or Pacific Islanders could be taken as representative of the primitive stage
of humankind, and the survivals of folk customs among European peasants illus-
trated the barbaric stage of European peoples. Although not very good historical
analysis, the perspective of Tylor and other evolutionists did depend upon a notion
about historical processes that strongly influenced folklore scholarship—that the
past could be reconstructed by studying contemporary ‘‘survivals’’ of traditional
culture. Hence, the ballad studies of Francis Gummere, George Lyman Kittredge,
Francis J. Child, and others constituted attempts to prove that contemporary frag-
ments or whole texts of folksongs represented the survivals of a historical golden
age, rather than functional living texts for those who performed them.
Myth-ritual scholars also were fascinated with the evolutionary question of
whether ritual (action) or myth (explanation) came first. Most of the early scholars in
this field did not investigate living cultures but speculated about the probable evolu-
tion and relation of myth and ritual based on classical texts. James Frazer, Max
M€uller, Jane Harrison, Stith Thompson, Lord Raglan, William Bascom, and others
carried on years-long scholarly debates over this issue. Such analyses came to be seen
as passe because of their emphasis on origins rather than function or cultural context.
Early social scientists Karl Marx, Emile Durkheim, Sigmund Freud, and Carl
Jung also looked to the folklore of ‘‘primitive’’ peoples to illustrate their theories
658 | Historical Analysis
impulse that inspired the Finnish School and instead use the motif index to show
how tales and fragments of tales from different cultures resemble each other.
Thompson, like American anthropologists, also looked to the folklore of indig-
enous peoples to demonstrate theories about the development of cultures.
He focused on the transmission of narrative motifs and still employed analysis
of texts as they existed over time; but others, such as Franz Boas, Melville
Herskovits, Ruth Benedict, and other students of Boas, tended to take into
account only ‘‘factual’’ history in their investigations of cultural psychology and
social organization. Unlike many cultural anthropologists, however, certain folk-
lorists who utilized a psychological or cultural approach continued to employ
historical analysis to elucidate the continued relevance of traditional narratives—
from blood libel legends to European M€ archen. Alan Dundes and Jack Zipes in
particular have fruitfully employed an examination of beliefs, legends, and folk-
tales as they have developed over time to elucidate the persistence of anti-Semi-
tism and divergent national identities.
During the middle years of the twentieth century, a new sort of historical analy-
sis was coming into vogue, one that focused on the past and traditions of everyday
people as opposed to those of the elite. During the 1930s, the Federal Writers’
Project sponsored surveys by folklorists such as Benjamin Botkin, Zora Neale
Hurston, Alan Lomax, Herbert Halpert, and others. Their goal was to collect and
record on cylinders the lore of working people and that which exemplified re-
gional culture. Hurston, for example, did considerable work collecting the folk his-
tory, songs, and narratives of African Americans in her native state of Florida.
Best known for her fiction, Hurston used folkloric accounts of the past to construct
a feminist critique of Southern life during the first half of the twentieth century.
At the same time, anthropologists were taking a renewed interest in the history
of the peoples they studied. Ethnohistory, a scholarly account of a culture
group’s past (often before the time of contact), though recognized as a field in
the early 1950s, did not come into vogue until the 1960s and 1970s among
anthropologists who had come to recognize the fictive and ahistorical nature of
the concept of the ethnographic present. Although such scholars as Bronislaw
Malinowski and A. R. Radcliffe-Brown themselves engaged in historical
researches in the 1920s and 1930s, their students tended to disregard history in
the service of discovering the function of cultural practices and the structures of
social institutions. Anthropologists such as E. E. Evans-Pritchard reemphasized
the importance of historical research for anthropologists, but most scholars since
have tended to emphasize economic, social, and psychological structures when
they have looked at traditional cultural practices.
Even though such theoretical analyses did spur advances in one direction, they
begged the question of change and development among individual societies—as
opposed to the evolutionary stages of human society. Although scholars were
660 | Historical Analysis
slow to realize that oral tradition among both nonliterate and literate peoples
actually recorded a very specific view of the past, anthropologists and folklorists
eventually recognized that the native view of history was critical to understand-
ing motives and actions in the present.
During the egalitarian 1960s, folklorists began to employ the techniques of oral
history as well as library and textual sources to learn about context and function.
Those who have developed the most useful theories and models have disregarded
the anachronistic anthropological notion of the ethnographic present and incorpo-
rated folk and oral history from their informants into their investigations. Richard
Dorson, who came out of an American civilization background at Harvard, was par-
ticularly interested in the historical development of American folklore and American
and British folklorists. His book-length studies of those developments became as
seminal as the work of Wilgus in explicating how folklorists came to study and theo-
rize about their discipline. Dorson may be best known among folklorists for his use
of archival data to unveil the existence of fakelore employed by lumber companies,
which promulgated the legends of Paul Bunyan for commercial motives. Lynwood
Montell’s groundbreaking oral history of Coe Ridge demonstrated the rich possibil-
ities available to folklorists who investigated living memories. Henry Glassie’s stud-
ies of both architecture and later of Irish traditions also employed the techniques of
oral and folk history to elucidate the function and context of traditional processes.
Although his perspective is reminiscent of that of nineteenth-century romantic
nationalists, Glassie’s explicit political analysis of folk history was part of the focus
on cultural empowerment and authenticity that emerged in the 1980s.
Also working in the 1960s and relying on a communications model, Dell
Hymes shifted the focus of folklore research to performance studies in which
context and audience as well as aesthetic criteria were the topics of study.
Richard Bauman added a historical component to this approach by using records
of oral performances by seventeenth-century Quakers as case studies. His use of
archival texts to test an explicitly ahistorical theory reintroduced the notions
of process and time. Bauman’s work, combined with that of Roger Abrahams
and Americo Paredes in the 1970s, resulted in a series of studies examining the
historical development of perceptions about group identity. Works by Paredes,
Bauman, Abrahams, and Jose Limon laid the groundwork for studies of authen-
ticity and politics and the relationship of folklore to those issues.
Folklorists and anthropologists are not the only ones who have investigated
the history of traditional expressive culture. Historians, particularly those of the
Annales school in France and from the History Workshop and Manchester Uni-
versity in England, have looked specifically at folkloric items and events to con-
struct cultural histories of European society. Emmanuel LeRoy Ladurie, Eric
Hobsbawm, George Rude, Natalie Davis, Robert Darnton, Peter Burke, Bob
Bushaway, E. P. Thompson, Raphael Samuel, Peter Laslett, and Paul Thompson
Historical Analysis | 661
are just a few of the social historians who have noticed the persistence of pat-
terned behaviors and the commentary on them by contemporary peoples in their
letters, diaries, and memoirs. Unfortunately, most of these historians, because of
their Marxist perspective, tend to take the view that folklore is always dead or
dying, and they use that notion to prove that modernization, industrialization,
urbanization, and particularly capitalism were responsible for destroying the old
world of reciprocal responsibility between classes. Though none of those histori-
ans seems to have read any folklore studies, the analytic perspective is reminis-
cent of the folklore/fakelore debate; in the social historians’ analyses, however,
authenticity and invention are opposed with little comprehension of the complex-
ities of how traditional processes grow and change.
Barbara Babcock edited the seminal work that combined historical and sym-
bolic analysis of folklore in the 1970s, but it was not until the mid-1980s that
other folklorists picked up on her direction and insight. Studies by folklorists
interested in the relationship among politics, tradition, and display events and
those concerned with the construction of ethnic and regional identity have
engaged specifically in examinations of the historical roots and contexts of tradi-
tional enactments. Such studies both shed light on more general theoretical prob-
lems central to folklore, such as perceptions about authenticity and tradition, and
provide some of the most creative elucidations of unique historical processes,
which have in turn contributed to broader cultural discussions on the develop-
ment of social identity in a multicultural society.
Rachelle H. Saltzman
See Also Euhemerism; Evolutionary Theory; Gesunkenes Kulturgut; Historic-Geographic
Method; History, Folk; History, Oral; Myth-Ritual Theory; Philological Approach;
Romantic Nationalism; Transmission.
References
Babcock, Barbara, ed. 1976. The Reversible World. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Bauman, Richard. 1983. Let Your Words Be Few: Symbolism and Silence among
Seventeenth-Century Quakers. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Bauman, Richard, and Roger Abrahams, eds. 1981. ‘‘And Other Neighborly Names’’:
Social Process and Cultural Image in Texas Folklore. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Davis, Susan. 1986. Parades and Power. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania
Press.
Dorson, Richard. 1971. American Folklore and the Historian. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Dundes, Alan, ed. 1991. The Blood Libel Legend. Madison: University of Wisconsin
Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1982. Passing the Time in Ballymenone. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
662 | Historic-Geographic Method
Hobsbawm, Eric, and Terence Ranger, eds. 1985. The Invention of Tradition. Cam-
bridge: Cambridge University Press.
Montell, William Lynwood. [1970] 1972. The Saga of Coe Ridge. New York: Harper
and Row.
Vansina, Jan. 1985. Oral Tradition as History. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
Historic-Geographic Method
A research method developed for the study of folklore in the 1870s, based on the
comparison of variants and aimed initially at the discovery of the original form,
place of creation, and age of a given item of folklore, as well as its local redac-
tions and pathways of diffusion.
core of ancient mythology on the basis of extant folk beliefs. Current folklore
and belief were seen as the shattered fragments of a once-coherent system. This
devolutionary premise was countered in turn by the late nineteenth-century de-
velopment of evolutionary theory, which persuaded scholars that human expres-
sions began as scattered and unrelated elements and gradually evolved into
broader and more coherent entities.
Kaarle Krohn transformed his father’s so-called local-historical method into the
Finnish comparative method. In the process, the findings of experimental psychol-
ogists were brought to bear on the topic, especially their studies of the laws of
retention and loss of memory. Krohn conceived of the development of folk poems
as beginning with simple, isolated themes that subsequently underwent a long
process of growth and change. Later, he proposed an entirely different theory of
the development of Finnish folk poetry in his major study, Kalevalastudien (1924–
1931). According to this later view, the heroic poems had been composed in their
entirety in western Finland, undergoing transformation and devolution in the east-
ern tracts, where they had survived into the nineteenth and twentieth centuries. In
either case, however, the pathways of development were regarded as completely
predictable, demonstrable on the basis of extant evidence. The phenomena were
reducible to general patterns and laws.
The historic-geographic method was formulated to study the migration of folk-
lore and was evolutionist in the sense that it sought to apply Darwin’s theory in
detail to folklore itself. The discovery of mechanical laws of development
became a prime goal of research in all of the humanities during the nineteenth
century. Diffusionism is a broad-based research perspective that seeks to explain
similar features shared by different cultures as signs of earlier contact. It engen-
dered many similar approaches parallel to—but independent of—the Finnish
method in the folklore research of other countries as well.
The historic-geographic method has become so broadly and variously adapted,
however, that we can no longer speak of a single method but rather must include
differing methods, researchers, and schools of thought associated with it. The so-
called typological method replaced the geographic element by the 1930s. In this
later development, redactions are determined on the basis of formal typology
rather than geographic provenance. Because all research contains an element of
comparison, it becomes difficult at times to distinguish when a study is based on
the historic-geographic method itself, on a later derivative research trend of
refinement, or on some entirely unrelated method.
The main purpose of the Finnish method was to use existing performances of
folklore—a folk poem, M€ archen, belief, or other item—to determine its original
form, contents, idea, or core. During this early period of folklore study, research-
ers were less interested in what the item meant to its present performer than in
where it originated and how it had spread in the past.
664 | Historic-Geographic Method
UR-Form
The original, archetypal form, or in folk narrative research, the first form of a narra-
tive from which all known variants emerged; the archetype version that provides a
model and pattern for all variants (alternatively, Urform). The term comes from the
German Urform (plural, Urformen), meaning primitive form, original form, or arche-
type, and is derived from Ur, the mythological first city.
The search for the Ur-form of oral narratives is of particular importance in Fin-
nish or historical-geographic methodology. In this approach, it is believed that an
oral narrative originates in one geographic and temporal location and spreads from
there. The variants of the Ur-form spread through a process called wave diffusion,
wherein the kernel narrative, the Ur-form, travels in ever-widening geographic arcs
from its locus of creation. This diffusion occurs via contact with other groups
through group migration or through other avenues such as commerce, war, or
assimilation by another group.
The Finnish or historical-geographic method holds that an oral narrative and its
variants are the result of a single conscious act of creation at a specific time and
location. The Ur-form of a given narrative can be deduced by deconstructing the
known variants to get to the kernel form. What results from these studies is an ex-
haustive list of known variants of a particular narrative. From these lists, the
researchers then attempt to peel away the successive layers of time and geography
to get to the Ur-form. Stith Thompson’s Motif-Index of Folk-Literature and the
Aarne-Thompson type index of folktales are good examples of the kind of collec-
tion work involved in this methodology. American folklorist Archer Taylor and
others held that this method of folk narrative research was commonsensical and
that it provided a scientific method for finding the Ur-form of any given narrative.
The concept of the Ur-form is based on the theory of monogenesis, or one point
of origin. The early proponents rejected notions of polygenesis, the idea that there
could have been several loci of creation for a given type of narrative, each inde-
pendent of the others. They also rejected antidiffusionist arguments that narratives
could not overcome linguistic barriers and thus insert themselves into the tradi-
tions of a group that was not linguistically related. The Swedish folklorist Carl von
Sydow believed that rather than one Ur-form, there existed a multitude of Ur-
forms, or regional oikotypes, which melded together to create one international
Ur-form.
More recent criticism has focused on the literary versions of narratives. The
argument posited by Albert Wesselski was that literature impacted the spread and
form of narratives to such a great degree as to render the search for an Ur- form
invalid. More recent criticism has focused on newer forms of mass communication,
as well as on the concept that these narratives could and did arise through polygen-
esis. In this fashion, von Sydow’s regional forms combined to make an international
Ur-form become the concept of a Normalformen, an accepted base or kernel form
for the narrative.
Randal S. Allison
Historic-Geographic Method | 665
In the study of M€ archen, the work of Antti Aarne proved very significant.
Aarne’s type index, Verzeichnis der M€ archentypen, published in 1910, became the
basis of international folktale research. The numbering system contained in
Stith Thompson’s enlarged and reedited version of the index, published in 1961,
remains the internationally accepted standard for the field. In his Motif-Index of
Folk-Literature, Thompson further sought to classify and index all narrative motifs,
in other genres as well as in M€archen. Type indexes of M€ archen and other narrative
genres represent valuable tools for historic-geographic research, and the Folklore
Fellows Communications series alone has published some 49 separate indices of this
kind. The same typological method has been applied to other genres as well (e.g.,
Archer Taylor’s systematized catalog of riddles, Matti Kuusi’s index of proverbs),
aiming at the elucidation of the relations of different variants over space and time.
M€archen, because of their relative length, proved an apt genre for the applica-
tion of the historic-geographic method: They were international in distribution,
and their types could be characterized readily. Walter Anderson’s 1923 Kaiser
und Abt (Emperor and abbot) was one of the classic applications, after which a
long series of other monographs appeared devoted to specific M€ archen or legend
types. Typical examples are Jan-Ovind Swahn’s Tale of Cupid and Psyche and
Anna-Birgitta Rooth’s Cinderella Cycle. The method has been applied to riddles,
games, and legends. Of comparative studies of proverbs, Matti Kuusi’s mono-
graph on proverbs related to the co-occurrence of rain and sunshine (Regen bei
Sonnenschein) has provided the greatest breadth. The author carefully deter-
mined the genetic relations of an international collection of variants.
In Finland, the typological method was aptly suited to the study of epic and
lyric folk poetry. Matti Kuusi’s major work has been to further the historic-
geographic study of this genre through redaction analysis. Using this method,
Kuusi discovered stylistic periods that could be differentiated from each other by
formal features. He placed a large portion of the collected folk poetry in the old-
est stylistic category, ascribing it to a period extending from the arrival of the
Finns in Finland to the beginning of the current era.
Cartographic studies and folklore atlases, a side development of the historic-
geographic method, became popular in the 1930s under the influence of German
Volkskunde. Cartographic methods are useful for representing essential similarities
and differences in redactions in all kinds of genres, oral as well as material. The
map always requires some explanation, however, since diffusion not only occurs
as a simple product of geographic proximity alone but also reflects historical and
economic relations, religion, cultural differences, and, occasionally, temporary or
nebulous factors. For example, the study of cultural similarity or difference
through the quantitative comparison of proverbs is an area of historic-geographic
research pioneered in the study Proverbia Septentrionalia: 900 Balto-Finnic Prov-
erb Types with Russian, Baltic, and German Scandinavian Parallels (1985).
Historic-Geographic Method | 667
Redaction analysis can bring forth a picture of the typical singing style of a
given area. With this picture as a reference point, it becomes possible to examine
a singer’s own improvisation or typicality of repertoire on a line-by-line basis.
Groundwork of this kind also contributes to the study of collage-like techniques
of composition. The personal styles of M€ archen raconteurs also can be character-
ized with reference to norms of narrative performance specific to a given area
and recognizable through historic-geographic analysis.
Appraisals
The historic-geographic method was criticized from the outset, and many critical
characterizations have helped hone and strengthen the theory. It has been claimed
that researchers do not pay enough attention to literary influences, although the
study of a given folklore item itself generally began with the scrutiny of written
and ‘‘nonauthentic’’ sources. Scholars have been criticized for paying too much
attention to geographic aspects and too little to historical ones—for example,
overlooking the possibility of vertical diffusion. The best results have been
obtained when the method has been applied to folklore within a single language
area; international and global connections usually prove more speculative.
Although the method stresses careful attention to detail and great exactness, the
conclusions of historic-geographic studies sometimes have been (somewhat mali-
ciously) characterized as claims to scholarly clairvoyance, especially when chart-
ing diffusional pathways on a global level.
Although the historic-geographic method always has been informed by its own
issues, it is nonetheless only a scholarly tool—a system of characterization that
can be used as the basis for a variety of different kinds of study. It has been used
too generally and for purposes for which it is ill suited. Often, the method’s harsh-
est critics have relied on the method itself as a basis for arriving at their view-
points, rendering their criticisms more like adaptations or by-products than real
challenges. Such can be said, for instance, of structuralist approaches, which repre-
sent but one of many analytical frameworks suitable for the study of folklore.
The contribution of the Finnish method to folklore research is to be found not
only in the range of applications offered for redaction analysis but also in the
method’s insistence on consistent, scientific criteria as the basis of research.
Scholars aimed at the goal of completeness in collection and analysis, preventing
them from drawing conclusions based solely on a handful of selected examples.
All source materials must be carefully considered and ranked according to
accepted criteria. Further, the argument, once assembled, must be presented in
such a way that any other scholar trained in the method could reach similar con-
clusions. The notion that another scholar should be able to reach the same con-
clusions on the basis of the material presented and principles followed remains
important today.
668 | History, Folk
References
Aarne, Antti. 1913. Leitfaden der vergleichendon M€
archenliteratur. Helsinki: Suo-
malainen Tiedeakatemia.
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1961. The Types of the Folktale. Helsinki: Suo-
malainen Tiedeakatemia.
Anderson, Walter. 1930 1940. Geographisch-historische Methode (Geographic-
historic method). In Handw€ orterbuch des deutschen M€ archens (Handbook of German
folktales), ed. Lutz Mackensen. Vol. 1, pp. 508 522. Berlin: Walter de Gruyter.
Boberg, Inger M. 1953. Folkmindeforskningens Historie I Mellem-og Nordeuropa
(The history of folklore research in central and northern Europe). Danmarks Folke-
minder 60. Copenhagen.
Hautala, Jouko. 1968. Finnish Folklore Research, 1828 1918. Helsinki: Societas Sci-
entiarum Fennica.
Honko, Lauri. 1985. Zielsetzung und Methoden der finnischen Erz€ahl forschung.
Fabula 26(3-4): 318 335.
Krohn, Kaarle. 1971. Folklore Methodology. Trans. Roger L. Welsh. Austin and
London: University of Texas Press. Originally published as Die folkloristische Arbeits
methods. Oslo, 1926.
Kuusi, Matti. 1974. ‘‘The Bridge and the Church’’: An Anti-church Legend. In Studia
Fennica 18: 27 75. Helsinki: Suomalainen Tiedeakatemia.
R€ohrich, Lutz. 1987. Geographisch-historische Methode (Geographic-historic
method). In Enzyklop€
adie des M€ archens (Encyclopedia of M€
archens), ed. Kurt Ranke,
Vol. 5, pp. 1011 1030. Berlin: Walter de Gruyter.
History, Folk
A community’s collective perceptions about past events. Every folk group has its
own notion of the past, which influences the thoughts, actions, and perceptions
of its members. Although often used as a synonym for oral history, ethnohistory,
and oral traditions, the term folk history is distinct in that it involves a collective
perception about what the members of a group determine to be significant about
the past and about how that past affects the present. In contrast, oral history per-
tains to a group’s or an individual’s commentary and recollections about events
History, Folk | 669
of what has occurred. Like other genres of folklore, it has been regarded as fic-
tive filler, as an invention, or as re-creation. In fact, there are common structural
elements or motifs in folk histories that are similar to those in local legends,
anecdotes, and personal experience narratives. And familiarity with such motifs
and/or the ability to spot probable structural patterns is necessary for a critical
use of folk history. Yet rather than revealing the unreliability or inauthenticity of
folk history, the very patterns and repetitious structures and motifs of community
histories reveal the culturally significant data they carry and transmit. Further-
more, the collection of folk histories of a community at different periods and
from different sources can reveal, as do more standard historical sources, the
ways in which a community’s or a status group’s perspectives on the past (and
thus on the present) change over time. Careful attention to folk history can there-
fore reveal the logic for revitalization movements, riots, massacres, wars, and
other apparently ‘‘irrational’’ and traditionally patterned behaviors.
Rachelle H. Saltzman
See Also Historical Analysis; History, Oral; Invented Tradition; Legend; Life History;
Memorate; Personal Experience Narrative.
References
Dorson, Richard, ed. 1971. Folklore and Traditional History. Special issue of Journal
of the Folklore Institute 8(2-3).
Glassie, Henry. 1982. Passing the Time in Ballymenone. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Hudson, Charles. 1966. Folk History and Ethnohistory. Ethnohistory 13: 52 70.
Mintz, Jerome. 1982. The Anarchists of Casas Viejas. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Montell, William Lynwood. [1970] 1972. The Saga of Coe Ridge. New York: Harper
and Row.
Morton, Robin. 1973. Come Day, Go Day, God Send Sunday. London: Routledge &
Kegan Paul.
Paredes, Americo. [1958] 1975. With His Pistol in His Hand. Austin: University of
Texas Press.
Vansina, Jan. 1985. Oral Tradition as History. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
Whisnant, David. 1983. All That Is Native and Fine. Chapel Hill: University of
North Carolina Press.
History, Oral
terms oral tradition and oral history synonymously, historians make the distinc-
tion between conducting formal interviews with directed questions and collecting
verbal traditions that comment directly or indirectly on historically significant
events.
For oral historians, historical significance resides in what scholars or other rec-
ognized authorities determine to be important to the society at large. Thus, oral
narratives about John Kennedy’s assassination or the depression are appropriate
topics, but individual or community recollections about a local murder or mining
disaster are relegated to the realm of folk history. The latter, in contrast to oral
history, provides commentary on what members of a socially ‘‘insignificant’’
group believe to have affected their lives. Although such distinctions exist, most
folklorists have disregarded them in practice and used the directed methods of
oral history to elicit full-fledged narratives as well as commentary about locally
and nationally significant events.
It was the advent of the tape recorder in the 1940s that made documenting the
words of regular people possible for those not in the broadcasting or recording
industries. In 1948, Alan Nevins founded the Columbia (University) Oral History
Collection to record the testimony of ‘‘great men’’ on their works, instead of rely-
ing on the evaluation of obituary writers. According to folklorist Neil Rosenberg,
not until the 1960s, however, was oral history regarded as more than a supplement
to the written record; in fact, the transcripts, not the tapes, were believed to be the
important documents. The Oral History Association, founded in 1966, heralded
the recognition that oral history was a special approach and not just a technologi-
cal development. Oral history, which documents recent history that would other-
wise go unrecorded, also gained popularity in reaction to the quantitative methods
of social and labor historians in the 1960s and 1970s. Records of the lives of
everyday people provide the human side of ‘‘scientifically’’ constructed statistics.
It could be argued, however, that the real shift in historical approach to sources
occurred during the late 1930s and early 1940s, when members of the Federal
Writers’ Project set out to interview people from all backgrounds and occupa-
tions about their experiences during the Great Depression and at the start of
World War II. Folklorists such as Benjamin Botkin, Zora Neale Hurston, and
Stetson Kennedy collected life histories of common people, of the ‘‘inarticulate’’
classes. Ralph Ellison, Richard Wright, Alan Lomax, Herbert Halpert, Studs
Terkel, and others also were involved in the Federal Writers’ Project, recording
vernacular speech and lore as well as the average person’s views on what was
significant about the 1930s.
In 1966, in an address to the Oral History Association, folklorist Wayland Hand
noted that folk legends and beliefs were particularly important sources of the his-
tory of the common man because such traditions provided oral history with a time
depth. Richard Dorson, writing in 1970, expressed the need to enlarge the scope
History, Oral | 673
of oral history to include folk history. He emphasized, as did his students Lyn-
wood Montell and William Ivey, the need to record a community’s view of what
was and is important in its past—not just commentary on elite categories.
Jan Vansina drew a further distinction between oral history and oral tradition
by specifying that the latter consists of verbal messages from the past beyond the
present generation; oral history consists of recollections and commentary about
events within the informant’s lifetime. Thus, oral history can be regarded as
comparable to written documents, media reports, and so on that involve a first
assessment of events. Because such narratives may be repeated or recorded at a
temporal distance from the original event, however, the interviewer needs to be
aware that memory, selection, elaboration, condensation, and the use of formu-
laic motifs as well as cultural styles of performance can all affect the historical
account. Such factors become even more apparent with folk history, which may
consist of reports passed along from previous generations.
Folklorists can provide a valuable perspective on oral history analysis because
of their familiarity with the processes of oral traditions. Combining the methods
of oral history with that of folklore collecting can serve as a corrective to cultur-
ally irrelevant questions on the part of the researcher. Ivey’s study of local history
in Michigan’s Upper Peninsula particularly made the point that faulty methodol-
ogy can skew the data. He noted that when he stopped asking the directed ques-
tions of the oral historian and began asking his informants to tell him what was
significant for them, he elicited historical commentary that was far more relevant
to the lives of those he was studying. That such data pointed to different or com-
plementary interpretations of events, or when significant socioeconomic change
occurred, only served to reconstruct a broader and more authentic history.
Montell’s ethnographic study of Coe Ridge, which combined the sources of
oral histories, local legends, anecdotes, ballads, letters and diaries, and archival
research, further demonstrated the necessity of gathering data from whatever is
available to reconstruct a community’s folk history. He also made the critical
point that oral histories are valuable historical documents in their own right and
not just merely supplements to the written record.
Folklorist Henry Glassie specifically described folklore as the discipline that
recorded the story of events and people that history had forgotten. In 1970,
Montell noted that oral folk history consisted of a core of truth with narrative
embellishments. The historical distortion that occurred could be attributed to pat-
terning, telescoping, and legend displacement. Montell stressed that oral folk his-
tory provided a complement to written historical literature, for it added the
human side and presented the individual as a person—a perspective usually
absent from written documents.
Scholars from the fields of anthropology, history, and folklore suggest that
what each has in common with the other is the oral interview. More than that,
674 | Holidays and Commemorations
however, they share the philosophical perspective that oral interviews can elicit
the stories of those ordinarily unheard by most of society. Dorson and Glassie
particularly made the point that folklorists ought to be more aware of the histori-
cal perspective of their informants. Ivey, Glassie, and Vansina further stressed
that oral history records the psychological truth about a community’s past and its
beliefs about the present.
Methodology as well as philosophy is critical to studying oral history. The
folklore and fieldwork guides of Kenneth Goldstein, Bruce Jackson, Edward
Ives, and Peter Seitel provide recommendations for approaching informants,
working with tape recorders, documenting contextual data, and eliciting usable
narratives. Although the techniques of folklore fieldwork overlap with those of
oral historians, there are some differences in perspective and purpose; thus, such
manuals should be read in conjunction with Vansina’s discussion of methodol-
ogy in researching oral traditions.
Rachelle H. Saltzman
See Also Fieldwork; Historical Analysis; History, Folk.
References
Allen, Barbara, and William Lynwood Montell. 1981. From Memory to History.
Nashville, TN: AASLH.
Banks, Ann. 1981. First Person America. New York: Vintage Books.
Glassie, Henry. 1982. Passing the Time in Ballymenone. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Ives, Edward D. 1980. The Tape Recorded Interview: A Manual for Fieldworkers in
Folklore and Oral History. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Montell, William Lynwood. [1970] 1972. The Saga of Coe Ridge. New York: Harper
and Row.
Mullen, Pat. 1992. Listening to Old Voices. Chicago: University of Illinois Press.
Olch, Peter D., and Forrest C. Pogue, eds. 1972. Selections from the Fifth and Sixth
National Colloquia on Oral History. New York: Oral History Association.
Rosenberg, Neil, ed. 1978. Folklore and Oral History. St. John’s, Newfoundland:
Memorial University of Newfoundland.
Terkel, Studs. 1970. Hard Times. New York: Pantheon Books.
Vansina, Jan. 1985. Oral Tradition as History. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
Although holiday is derived from ‘‘holy day,’’ many American holidays are not
religious observations but secular commemorations to honor and preserve the
memory of a person or event. American holidays reflect a wide diversity of
Holidays and Commemorations | 675
cultural, ethnic and racial, and religious practices. Most holidays allow for a brief
cessation of work, although many religious holidays are not observed by the
wider public. American holidays are intimately tied to the consumerism that
dominates other areas of American cultural life. In fact, most holidays would be
unrecognizable without the trappings of the commercial material culture accom-
panying celebrations: from greeting cards and decorations to dress and food.
Other holidays once widely celebrated throughout the nation have disappeared
from the national calendar. Bird Day (May 4), for example, was combined with
Arbor Day (the last Friday in April) as a means to teach children the values of
conservation. (Earth Day, instituted in 1970, revives these values by encouraging
environmentalism and anti-consumption.) Still other holidays are celebrated on
the state level and are growing in popularity. Juneteenth (June 19), or Emancipa-
tion Day, commemorates the end of slavery in the United States and is observed
in fourteen states and many communities.
Federal Holidays
Commemorating the American Civil War (1861–1865) was the impetus for
many of the national holidays now recognized in federal law. For example,
George Washington (1732–1799) served as a figure to unite both North and
South, leading to a national observance of his birth date. Abraham Lincoln
Book, as a means by which the nation could unite in the midst of the Civil War.
President Abraham Lincoln proclaimed the observance in 1863. Full of historical
inaccuracies, Thanksgiving has been criticized for its simplistic rendering of the
complex relationships between Native Americans and European colonizers.
Religious Holidays
In recent years, official (that is, in the form of school and work breaks) notice of reli-
gious holidays has shifted from a Christian-centered tradition to one encompassing
678 | Holidays and Commemorations
Santa Claus
The modern folk hero of Christmas consumerism originally went by various names
in different countries and has a long and complex history that probably began with
the Norse winter god, Odin. The Christian version is based on St. Nicholas
(‘‘St. Nick’’), said to have been a fourth-century bishop of the city of Myra in Asia
Minor. ‘‘Santa Claus’’—increasingly just ‘‘Santa’’—is an American term that began to
influence British usage from the 1870s. However, in the English form of ‘‘Father
Christmas,’’ the figure was known in the fifteenth century, when houses were
opened up at Christmas time with the cry, ‘‘Welcome, old Father Christmas.’’ He
went underground during the Cromwellian period, along with many other folk cus-
toms, but was brought back to life in the Restoration of 1660. He has been with us
ever since, receiving various boosts to his image, such as the ballad ‘‘’Twas the
Night before Christmas,’’ composed in 1822 by the American clergyman Clement
Clark Moore. In 1863, Thomas Nast drew an illustration for Harpers Bazaar maga-
zine that portrayed ‘‘Santa’’ as a jolly, tubby man in white whiskers, wearing red,
with a wide leather belt, smoking a pipe, and carrying gifts. The modern Father
Christmas had arrived. In the 1930s, an advertising campaign for the Coca-Cola
Company further developed these essentials into the jolly, round figure we know
today, a figure spread around the world by the ever-more-influential channels of the
mass media and its commercial imperatives.
There are numerous other similar folk figures, including the French Pere Fouet-
tard, who accompanies the Bonhomme No€el, and the German Knecht Ruprecht.
Dutch tradition supports the figure of Sinter or Sante Klaas, who rides a white
horse and is accompanied by two ‘‘Black Peters,’’ young boys with blackened skin
dressed in page uniforms.
Graham Seal
other religious traditions. Christmas (December 25), marking the birth of Jesus, and
Easter Sunday (late March or early April), marking the resurrection of Jesus, were
often the only religious holidays for which accommodations were made, but today
Jewish, Hindu, Muslim, and other religious traditional days are increasingly noted.
Though little observed in the first two centuries of European settlement in North
America, the celebration of Christmas in the United States since the mid-nineteenth
century has become a thoroughly commercialized event. Much of the nation’s
retail industry’s profit is derived in the shopping season commencing on the day af-
ter Thanksgiving through Christmas Eve, symbolized, perhaps, by the appearance
of Santa Claus at the end of the Macy’s Thanksgiving Day parade. The trappings
of the modern Christmas, with its decorated and lighted tree (dating from the
1820s–1850s), Santa Claus, holiday lights, greeting cards, and, of course, wrapped
presents, serve as material evidence of the secularization of the observance.
Ethnic Holidays
Holidays reflect the cultural diversity of the nation’s population. Ethnic celebrations
are regional, marking culturally and historically immigrant groups’ settlement in the
United States. Some of the more common include Chinese New Year (sometime
between January 21 and February 19), Mardi Gras (February/March), St. Patrick’s
Day (March 17), Cinco de Mayo (May 5), and Kwanzaa (December 26–January 1).
Mardi Gras (French for ‘‘Fat Tuesday’’) combines religious tradition with a
carnival or festival to welcome spring, held the last day before Lent begins (usu-
ally sometime in February), although the parades and parties can start after the
Christmas season ends. The most notable Mardi Gras in the United States is Car-
nival in New Orleans, Louisiana, with the parades and parties; it may be consid-
ered a minor version of Carnival in Brazil and in other Latin American countries.
Mardi Gras is a state holiday in Alabama and Florida, and a holiday in eight Lou-
isiana parishes.
St. Patrick’s Day is observed in cities, mostly in the Northeast, with a large
population of Irish Americans. St. Patrick’s Day parades are held in New York
City, Boston, and Chicago and are often venues in which politicians serve as hon-
orary parade marshals. Cinco de Mayo marks Mexican independence in 1862.
680 | Holidays and Commemorations
Parade
Traditionally defined as a public procession, usually of a festive nature and accompa-
nied by music. Historically, the parade was often a military affair, a public display of
militia marching off to war or reenacting past victories.
The difference between a parade and a procession is not merely semantic, for
the two types of public linear display are distinct and separate entities. A proces-
sion is typified by its formal nature, usually with the participants moving in an
orderly succession. Processions are often expressions of the prevailing religious or
political ideology of the community.
The modern-day parade, however, is made up of several components that distin-
guish it from other public ceremonies. The parade has a secular ritual component
that expresses community values and sentiments. It is also a spirited and malleable
form of festival. In this capacity, the parade functions as a public spectacle, providing
the vehicle for positive group interaction between both participants and observers,
thus promoting social cohesion and reinforcing group identity within the commu-
nity. This is accomplished through certain traditional devices. These devices some-
times include myth or parody that subliminally conveys the political message of the
parade’s participants. Thus, the parade symbolizes the social and normative struc-
tures of the participating groups.
Since the Middle Ages, two types of parades have emerged side by side, express-
ing a tension between the established order and more marginal groups: the institu-
tionalized parade and the alternative parade.
During the Chingay Parade in Singapore that celebrates the Chinese Lunar New Year,
gaudily and fantastically dressed performers are transported on a mechanical elevator
platform, 2009. (Jeffery Koh/Dreamstime.com)
Holidays and Commemorations | 681
Local celebrations are not limited to the Southwest, where there is a high concen-
tration of Mexican American population, but occur throughout the nation. Kwan-
zaa is celebrated by some African Americans. Kwanzaa is a Swahili word
meaning ‘‘first fruit of the harvest,’’ and the holiday occurs annually from Decem-
ber 26 through January 1.
Specially designated months honor racial and ethnic groups. These months are
usually observed with speeches and special events, and all are heralded by a
proclamation by the United States president, noting their particular significance.
These are: Black History (February), Women’s History (March), Asian Pacific
American Heritage (May), Hispanic Heritage (September), and Native American
Heritage (November).
Martin J. Manning
See Also Belief, Folk; Folklife; Tradition Bearer.
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1967. An American Vocabulary of Celebrations. In Time Out of
Time: Essays on the Festival, ed. Alessandro Falassi. Albuquerque: University of New
Mexico Press.
Baker, M. [1968] 1992. Discovering Christmas Customs and Folklore, rev. ed., Prin-
ces Risborough, Buckinghamshire, England: Shire Publications.
Bellenir, Karen, ed. 1988. Religious Holidays and Calendars: An Encyclopedic
Handbook, 2nd ed. Detroit, MI: Omnigraphics.
DaMatta, Roberto. 1991. Carnivals, Rogues and Heroes: An Interpretation of the
Brazilian Dilemma. Notre Dame, IN: University of Notre Dame Press.
682 | Hybrid
Dennis, Matthew. 2002. Red, White and Blue Letter Days: An American Calendar.
Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Kugelmass, Jack. 1994. Wishes Come True: Designing the Greenwich Village Hal-
loween Parade. In Halloween and Other Festivals of Death and Life, ed. Jack Santino.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Litwicki, Ellen M. 2000. America’s Public Holidays: 1865 1920. Washington, DC:
Smithsonian Institution Press.
Schmidt, Leigh Eric. 1995. Consumer Rites: The Buying and Selling of American
Holidays. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Smith, Robert J. 1972. Festivals and Celebrations. In Folklore and Folklife, An Intro-
duction, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Hybrid
sense that it was ‘‘wild’’ or outside the normal power structures of Roman society.
In this sense, the hibrida was respected but also potentially feared and distrusted by
the establishment. Because she or he was the source of fear, the hibrida may have
been seen as needing extra oversight and control.
As the term came into use in biological sciences in the nineteenth century, it
generally referred to new forms of plants. In this context, it located the powerful
nature of the hybrid in the quality of heterosis or ‘‘hybrid vigor’’: the tendency for
hybrid organisms to develop features better adapted to their environments. As
human genetic science emerged in the late nineteenth century, however, the term
began to be associated with ideas of racial purity. In this context, the hybrid was
perceived negatively as a ‘‘half-breed’’ or ‘‘mongrel’’ and was considered inferior
to more ‘‘pure’’ individuals. The term entered into use for cultural analysis from
linguistics where it was first used to designate words that combined elements from
two or different languages. Later, it was associated with the ‘‘pidgin’’ or ‘‘creole’’
languages of the European colonies that combine entire other languages. Because
of the association between language and culture, the hybrid came to also refer to
the mixtures of dominant and subordinate cultural groups that characterize the
twentieth and twenty-first century’s postcolonial political structures.
As a result, the term continues to exhibit a problematic dual association. It is
positive when it is imagined as containing particular vigor as a result of new adap-
tation. In this sense, hybrid expression emerges at the intersections of significantly
different realms. By combining heterogeneous elements, individuals are empow-
ered to engage in expressive behaviors where transformational forms allow new
and diverse expressions and identities. From the most positive perspective, this
expression can offer the subordinated elements of the hybrid the possibility for li-
bratory expression. Often, these sorts of hybrids are associated with the resistant
acts of historically oppressed groups (Bhabha 1994, 361). The term, however,
takes on negative meaning when it is imagined as carrying some ‘‘foreign’’ features
into a previously ‘‘pure’’ realm. Also associated with disparities in power relations,
the term’s historical association with biology, generally, and theories of racial pu-
rity, in particular, is felt by some to reinscribe the subordinated position of the sup-
posedly ‘‘foreign’’ elements of the hybrid. By emphasizing the ‘‘newness’’ of the
hybrid, the subordinated culture’s contribution is disassociated from its preexisting
traditions and institutions. As a result, the subordinated cultural elements can be
overshadowed by an emphasis on the established nature of the dominant culture.
Despite these concerns, the term continues to be useful for scholars exploring
the complex new cultural forms and expressions made possible by the increasing
globalization of the twenty-first century. With network communication and
worldwide travel increasingly available, few traditions, cultures, or forms are
untouched by the influence of others. Today, it seems that hybridity is becoming
the norm instead of the exception. Imagined as ongoing and dynamic global
684 | Hymn, Folk
processes, hybridity can be seen giving rise to what postcolonial culture critics
Appadurai and Breckenridge have termed ‘‘zones of contestation’’ where
‘‘national, mass, and folk culture provide both mill and grist for one another’’
(1995, 5).
Robert Glenn Howard
See Also Amerasians; Asian American Humor and Folklore; Ethnic Folklore.
References
Appadurai, Arjun, and Carol A. Breckenridge. 1995. Public Modernity in India. In
Consuming Modernity: Public Culture in a South Asian World, ed. Carol A. Brecken-
ridge, pp. 1 20. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Bhabha, Homi. 1994. The Location of Culture. New York: Routledge.
Howard, Robert Glenn. 2008. Electronic Hybridity: The Persistent Processes of the
Vernacular Web. Journal of American Folklore 121(480): 192 218.
Kapchan, Deborah A., and Pauline Turner Strong. 1999. Theorizing the Hybrid.
Journal of American Folklore 112(445): 239 253.
Stross, Brian. 1999. The Hybrid Metaphor: From Biology to Culture. Journal of
American Folklore 112(445): 254 267.
Young, Robert J. C. 1995. Colonial Desire: Hybridity in Theory, Culture, and Race.
New York: Routledge.
Hymn, Folk
Most generally, a song praising God and sung in a folk group. Folk hymns may be
found today in two kinds of setting: as survivals of older (often quite elaborate) prac-
tices, usually among marginal religious groups or in folk revivals, and as compara-
tively informal and spontaneous music for worship both within and without the
religious mainstream. In the United States, folk hymns may be found among various
ethnic groups and religious denominations—Jewish, Islamic, African American,
Pentecostal, Amish, Baptist, and so forth. Since the 1960s, in an attempt to attract
youth, various mainstream churches have introduced innovations such as folk
masses and original songs accompanied by guitars in the style of folk music revivals.
Other mainstream churches have experimented with gospel music choruses charac-
teristic of charismatic denominations. Marriage ceremonies written in part by the
participants often have featured original or borrowed lyrics set to folklike melodies.
As a result of a research tradition in Europe and the United States, the term folk
hymn has come to stand more narrowly for a particular type of Christian song
whose tune exists in oral tradition. Irving Lowens defined folk hymn as a ‘‘secular
folk-tune that happens to be sung to a religious text.’’ Indeed, the practice of setting
Christian songs to secular tunes was endorsed by Martin Luther, who asked, ‘‘Why
Hymn, Folk | 685
should the devil have all the good tunes?’’ Lowens’s definition emphasizes that
though the words of a folk hymn may remain unchanged over time and place, the
tune exhibits the variations that one expects from oral tradition. Scholars have fur-
ther distinguished folk hymns from various other types of Christian religious folk-
song: religious ballads (folk ballads with religious texts, sung solo), camp-meeting
and revival spirituals (folk hymns to which refrains and choruses were added in
the nineteenth century), and gospel music (first-person texts that emphasize the
Christian’s relation to Jesus, trials and temptations in this life, and the joys of heav-
enly homecoming in the next). In most cases, Christian folk hymn texts are prod-
ucts of eighteenth-century hymn writers, such as Isaac Watts and Charles Wesley.
Many emphasize God’s grandeur and humankind’s depravity. The majority of
tunes tend to be in gapped or pentatonic modes rather than diatonic.
Lining-out is practiced in some folk hymn traditions. In this antiphonal prac-
tice, which dates back to the seventeenth century, a song leader gives out the
words to a line of verse by speaking, intoning, or singing them, and then the con-
gregation joins the leader to repeat the words, more or less in unison, to an elabo-
rate tune different from the lining tune. Lined-out folk hymns represent one of the
oldest layers of folk music tradition in the United States. They can be found
among the Amish, among Old Regular Baptists (and some United Baptists)
chiefly in southeastern Kentucky and southwestern Virginia, and in many African
American Baptist churches, where they are termed meter or Dr. Watts hymns.
Another major folk hymn tradition in the United States is a tradition of singing
conventions and gatherings using shape note songbooks. This is a part-singing
practice (the notes are written in the songbooks in various geometrical shapes to
aid in identifying pitch), in contrast to the unison singing of the lined-out folk
hymn tradition. Shape note hymnody originated in a late eighteenth-century music
literacy movement designed to supplant the lined-out ‘‘old way of singing.’’ Many
of the tunes in the shape note songbooks existed in oral tradition when they were
written down in the nineteenth century. Today, shape note hymnody is under-
going a revival, and singing conventions gather in most parts of the United States.
Musicological scholarship on folk hymnody has centered on the nineteenth-
century American shape note songbooks, chiefly in order to classify and analyze
the tunes and in an attempt to trace their histories. George Pullen Jackson pio-
neered in this area; Charles Seeger and Dorothy Horn employ more sophisticated
musical analysis. Using a broader definition of folk hymnody and within a
framework involving the study of performance and ritual, folklorists and ethno-
musicologists have done historical and ethnographic research on living tradi-
tions, in which one of the chief attractions is a well-articulated body of native
beliefs about the meaning of this music. Outside the United States, the School of
Scottish Studies has documented a tradition of lined-out folk hymns (psalms) in
Gaelic on the Isle of Lewis. Research of European folk hymn singing has been
686 | Hymn, Folk
References
Horn, Dorothy D. 1970. Sing to Me of Heaven. Gainesville: University of Florida
Press.
Jackson, George Pullen. 1933. White Spirituals in the Southern Uplands. New York:
Dover.
Patterson, Beverly Bush. 1994. The Sound of the Dove: An Ethnography of Singing
among Primitive Baptists. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Patterson, Daniel. 1982. The Shaker Spiritual. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University
Press.
Seeger, Charles. 1976. Studies in Musicology. Los Angeles: University of California
Press.
Smith, Timothy Allen. 1981. The Southern Folk-Hymn, 1802 1860: A History and
Musical Analysis, with Notes on Performance Practice. Master’s thesis, California State
University, Fullerton.
Suojanen, P€aivikki. 1984. Finnish Folk Hymn Singing: A Study in Music Anthropology.
Tampere, Finland: University of Tampere Institute for Folk Tradition.
Sutton, Brett, and Pete Hartman. 1982. Primitive Baptist Hymns of the Blue Ridge.
12’’ LP recording with book. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Temperley, Nicholas. 1981. The Old Way of Singing. Journal of the American Musi-
cological Society 34: 511 544.
Titon, Jeff Todd. 1988. Powerhouse for God: Speech, Chant, and Song in an Appala-
chian Baptist Church. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Wicks, Sammie Ann. 1983. Life and Meaning: Singing, Praying, and the Word
among Old Regular Baptists of Eastern Kentucky. Diss. University of Texas, Austin.
I
Icelandic Sagas
687
688 | Icelandic Sagas
Some scholars, proponents of the so-called bookprose view, downplay that role.
They consider oral tradition as only one of many sources and claim that the sagas
were literary products of medieval authors who merely used disconnected oral tra-
ditions as a way of lending an impression of authenticity to their mostly imagina-
tive evocations of the past. These scholars emphasize the influence of other written
sources available in Iceland during the thirteenth century: histories, genealogies,
law codes, and other sagas, as well as foreign secular and sacred works that were
imported to Iceland. On the other hand are scholars, adherents of the so-called free-
prose view, who propose that longer prose narratives might have taken shape
around the verses and local legends that had been preserved orally during the 250
years between the time the events took place and when the sagas were recorded.
Manuscripts
The most concrete evidence in this debate would seem to be manuscripts written
on vellum (treated animal skin; sheepskin in Iceland). However, none of the origi-
nal vellums of the Sagas of Icelanders have survived. A few fragments of vellum
contain sagas dated to the latter half of the thirteenth century, but most of the sur-
viving manuscripts are copies of earlier manuscripts made during the fourteenth,
fifteenth, and even sixteenth centuries. Dating the texts is therefore problematic.
Egil’s Saga, one of the more biographical sagas, is organized around the life of an
obstreperous poet (or skald) who feuds with the king and queen of Norway. This
saga is thought to have been recorded circa 1220–1240, that is, before the com-
monwealth collapsed. Some scholars believe that the great Icelandic historian and
chieftain Snorri Sturluson (1179–1241), who wrote the Heimskringla (History of
Norwegian Kings) and a treatise on poetic verse and Norse mythology (Prose
Edda, or Snorra Edda), also wrote Egil’s Saga, but this remains a conjecture.
Verses
Sagas of Icelanders, like the kings’ sagas, contain verses said to have been com-
posed at the time of the events. They are often situated in a historical context,
and the name of the poet is preserved as well. In his prologue to Heimskringla,
Snorri claims that these poems were memorized and transmitted orally. But the
dating of the skaldic verses recorded in the sagas is controversial. Some scholars
have questioned the authenticity of the verses spoken and composed by saga
characters and have suggested instead that the medieval author composed the
verses. They point out that the archaic style and poetic diction could have been
imitated by the authors, who composed the verses themselves to suit their prose
narrative. Snorri Sturluson’s Edda (ca. 1220) was probably written as a textbook
instructing younger poets in the old pagan techniques and myths that were losing
popularity and being replaced with newer forms. On the other hand, there are
Icelandic Sagas | 689
Detail of a manuscript containing the Icelandic Sagas, written between the twelfth and
fourteenth centuries. (Arctic-Images/Corbis)
scholars who distinguish between ‘‘authentic tradition’’ and ‘‘oral tradition,’’ not-
ing that the verses may not all have been composed in the tenth century by the
people in the sagas but, rather, could have been composed orally after the events
and become part of oral traditions about these historical people and events before
the sagas were finally recorded. In support of oral tradition, these scholars find
occasional conflicts between the verses and the prose in the sagas, conflicts that
an author, if not bound by tradition, would have reworked. Even Snorri himself,
they point out, at times did not necessarily understand the poetry he quotes.
Other Evidence
Although there is no concrete proof of the existence of oral sagas, other evidence
is commonly offered in support of the freeprose view: (1) allusions in the sagas to
saga telling and the naming of oral sources; (2) the availability and assumed com-
mon knowledge of saga tradition when Sturla Thordarson (1214–1284) revised
the Landnamabok (Book of Settlements); (3) allusions to other, divergent oral tra-
ditions that undermine the notion of an author in complete control of his sources;
(4) the recurrence of several notable Saga Age personalities in unrelated contexts;
and (5) the parallel tradition of the oral, legendary (heroic) saga—translated,
probably revised, and recorded in Latin around 1200 by the Danish historian Saxo
690 | Icelandic Sagas
Social Context
Egil’s Saga is decidedly antiroyalist; it favors the independent farmer-chieftains
who refuse to be intimidated by the Norwegian king, although they may be, like
Egil, flawed heroes. The masterful Njal’s Saga has a tragic tone; it leads the
reader to lament the loss of the most-valued members of society when their lives
get caught up in the tension between the old heroic values of honor and venge-
ance (associated with a decentralized, traditional system) and the new social
ideals. These new ideals, emphasizing moderate and socially responsible citizens
loyal to a centralized power figure, were ushered in along with the conversion to
Christianity.
These two sagas demonstrate why the thirteenth-century Icelanders thought
these traditions important enough to record—amid the turbulent events of the thir-
teenth century (called the Sturlung Age after one of the most powerful Icelandic
Icelandic Sagas | 691
dynasties, the one to which Snorri Sturluson belonged), chieftains fought bloody
battles to consolidate the power that was once distributed among thirty-nine chief-
tains into the hands of just a few. The Norwegian king and archbishop also
entered the fray, and the chieftains struggled not only to win dominance among
their peers but also to maintain local control against the centralizing power of
both the Norwegian monarchy and the universal Church. The Norwegian arch-
bishop’s goal was to separate Church affairs from those of the state and bring the
Icelandic Church in line with the laws and customs dictated from Rome. Prior to
this separation, Icelandic chieftains had their sons ordained as priests and sup-
ported a native church that was integrated with the Icelandic power structures.
The conflict came to a head in 1238 when Norwegian bishops replaced the Icelan-
dic ones. Deprived of their control over the Icelandic Church, the strife between
the chieftains grew so violent that some Icelanders thought, no doubt, that the best
way to end the bloodshed and restore the peace would be to be ruled by a king. In
1262–1264, the chieftains surrendered to the Norwegian king.
Thus, the saga makers, witnessing the end of the commonwealth period and of
the rule of the chieftains—who embodied this unique and local blend of sacred
and secular power—would record what they knew of a vanishing era, one that
began with the settlement of Iceland by their ancestors. Given the social context
of the thirteenth-century audience (it is generally assumed that the sagas were
read aloud from manuscripts to a socially mixed audience), one can see how
some sagas might have been made to encourage an audience to resist the central-
izing forces, while others were intended to offer solace to an audience as they
watched an era come to its inevitable end.
Recent Scholarship
Prompted by studies of orality and literacy and how they overlap and interact
within societies, Vesteinn Olason and other scholars have recently viewed the
Icelandic Family Sagas as a dialogue between the thirteenth century and the Saga
Age. Taking into account this thirteenth-century context, sagas are read today as
part literature, part social history. Influenced by the structuralist model that fore-
grounds the feud paradigm, saga scholarship in this century has emphasized
feuding, honor and shame, law, and gender relations. Not surprisingly, the sagas
that deviate most from the feud structure, Vatnsdla saga (The Saga of the Peo-
ple of Vatnsdal) and Eyrbiggja saga (The Saga of the People of Eyri), have
attracted the most attention among folklorists and anthropologists. These sagas
are more collections of local traditions than literary products shaped by an
author. This research has drawn attention to the mythic patterns, both pagan and
Christian, that inform these narratives and pays particular attention to how soci-
eties deliver, control, organize, and store knowledge of the past for audiences in
the present and future. These scholars note that whereas history functions as a
692 | Immigration
‘‘myth’’ for literate societies (we tend to believe what we have read), myths func-
tion as ‘‘history’’ for oral cultures, and they thus study sagas as cultural artifacts.
Putting history and fiction under one roof, they try to reconstruct the mental land-
scape of the medieval Icelanders by studying how they compiled and classified
sagas and other texts, as well as how they conceptualized interactions between
the natural and supernatural realms and human and mythic beings. Crossing
modern genre boundaries, they compare historical and mythic narratives or leg-
endary sagas and classical sagas to determine whether they share similar struc-
tural patterns and concepts and seek to identify the operative social and ethical
norms during the times these narratives evolved or were received.
Saga scholarship has thus come full circle, but with a reverse: When serious
study and collection of sagas began in the late sixteenth and early seventeenth
centuries, even the most mythical sagas were scrutinized for whatever insight
they might give on the early history of the Scandinavian nations. Now scholars
are subjecting the most historical texts to a similar process with hopes of reveal-
ing the underlying myths of those same cultures.
Zoe Borovsky
See Also Culture Hero.
References
Andersson, Theodore. 2006. The Growth of the Medieval Icelandic Sagas (1180
1280). New York: Cornell University Press.
Clover, Carol J., and John Lindow, eds. 2005. Old Norse-Icelandic literature: A Crit-
ical Guide. Toronto: University of Toronto Press.
Harris, Joseph. 2008. ‘‘Speak Useful Words or Say Nothing’’: Old Norse Studies.
New York: Cornell University Library.
Hreinsson, V., ed. 1997. The Complete Sagas of Icelanders, Including 49 Tales.
Reykjavik: Leifur Eiriksson.
Phelpstead, Carl. 2007. Holy Vikings: Saints’ Lives in the Old Icelandic Kings’
Sagas. Tempe, AZ: Arizona Center for Medieval and Renaissance Studies.
Immigration
Novels, poetry, and essays written by Amy Tan, Julia Alvarez, Chitra Banerjee
Divakaruni, Sandra Cisneros, and Eva Hoffman, among others, describe the
‘‘double otherness’’ (Zaborowska) of their experiences as immigrants and as
women, and suggest ways in which their acculturation narratives challenge male-
centered, dominant models of assimilation and integration. Yareli Arizmendi’s
work with Sergio Arrau for the film A Day without a Mexican (2004) reminds
viewers of the United States’ economic reliance on immigrant labor.
Amy Tan’s novels describe customs, rituals, folktales, recipes, and stories
about intergenerational struggles between Chinese American mothers and their
daughters. In The Opposite of Fate: Memoirs of a Writing Life, she clarifies that
her work should not be construed as emblematic of a ‘‘pan-Asian American’’ ex-
perience, but rather as the experiences of one woman who writes about her Chi-
nese American community as she remembers it. Yet, when she describes her
mother’s experiences with stockbrokers and doctors, noting that bad treatment
and lack of respect are the penalty for not speaking English in America, she is
describing the experiences of most newcomer women. Most women arrive with
skills and education, but find themselves in low-income jobs or secluded at home
because they don’t speak the language. As a result, lack of respect and miscon-
ceptions about their intelligence and abilities tend to permeate their experiences.
One of the most prolific areas for the study of immigrant women is that of
health and healing. The Spirit Catches You and You Fall Down, Anne Fadiman’s
(1997) poignant account of one Hmong family’s attempt to navigate the allopathic
medical system in the United States, draws on personal interviews to reveal not
only how language barriers confound a newcomer family’s efforts to understand
treatment strategies for their daughter, but, more importantly, how cultural values
and beliefs about health and healing are so deeply a part of the family’s world-
view as to make American medical practices unfathomable. Fadiman’s ethno-
graphic study offers a provocative look at the responsibilities of Euro–North
American medical practitioners to pay attention to cultural differences if they are
to be effective healers. Subsequent studies draw upon life histories to explore the
pluralistic health and illness practices of immigrants, who may have deeply held
beliefs about the interconnected nature of a person’s mind, body, and soul, a
holistic approach relatively absent in medicalized healing practice.
Food and the ability to obtain familiar spices, herbs, and staples in order to feed
one’s family is a powerful concern for most newcomer women, who seek to main-
tain continuity, reinforce cultural identity, and ensure the health and well-being of
their families. A woman from Ecuador living in Pennsylvania said, ‘‘I try to cook
the food from my country, but my kids won’t eat it. Sometimes I end up eating
every day for three days the same thing. I do cry sometimes when I have to eat it
myself and they request some American things. . . . They are rejecting my culture
and that makes me so sad’’ (B. A. Jones). Feminists and other scholars have
Immigration | 695
explored the relationship between foodways and cultural identity, using recipe
books as frames for telling stories of arrival and survival in a new country.
In recent years, scholars of feminism have begun to look at the relationships
between the feminist movement and ethnicity. Some immigrant women, faced with
new cultural and behavioral norms, challenge those of their countries of origin in
order to achieve and maintain their autonomy in North America; some maintain or
return to their original traditions to support political, religious, or cultural beliefs.
For example, prior to the attacks of September 11, 2001, many immigrant Muslim
women had put away their head- and body-scarves (hijab); some did so because
veiling symbolized an older, more conservative perspective on women, and some
so as to not stand out in their adopted country. After the attacks, however, many
women chose to reclaim the hijab as a statement in support of their beliefs and to
educate Americans about the depth and breadth of Muslim culture and religion.
Perhaps also in response to the 2001 attacks, increases in the number of crimi-
nal-justice units along the border have resulted in increased militarization of the
Mexico-U.S. borderlands. The cultural capital of female agents—more and more
of whom make up the ranks of the Border Patrol and Immigration and Customs
Enforcement—is often matched against that of immigrant women. As a result of
U.S. military interventions in Central America in the 1980s, there was an
increase in immigration from that region; the women who were apprehended or
survived without being detained often formed alliances and support groups. In
San Antonio, Texas, Laura Sanchez, for example, established a community-
based immigrant and refugee center to provide assistance to newcomers. Women
immigrants have enriched and preserved their traditional arts by becoming tradi-
tion bearers, continuing their cultural traditions’ practices and making sure that
the young do not forget them. Hmong embroidery, Guatemalan weaving, and
other material culture artifacts attest to the strength of the women’s commitment
to keeping their cultures alive in their new place.
Scholarly treatments of the experiences of newcomer women do provide
insights, but novels, poetry, and collections of essays written by immigrant
women themselves in their own voices offer powerful narratives that expose both
the personal and universal realities of the immigrant experience and chronicle
the impact of migration and immigration on traditional cultural expressions.
Amy E. Skillman
See Also Ethnic Folklore.
References
Alvarez, Julia. 1999. Something to Declare. Chapel Hill, NC: Algonquin Books.
Bardenstein, Carol. 2002. Transmissions Interrupted: Reconfiguring Food, Memory,
and Gender in the Cookbook: Memoirs of Middle Eastern Exiles. Signs: Gender and
Memory 28(1): 353 387.
696 | Indian Folklore
Indian Folklore
social organization they largely remain today in eastern India (Orissa and West
Bengal). Then, we know from firm archeological evidence that some time around
2500 BCE. a level of socioeconomic integration approaching civilization based in
urban administrative and rural agricultural production was established along the
Indus River system. This set the stage for a folk-urban distinction and many of
the sociological features, such as the caste system, that have played a major role
in the development of what distinguishes Indian folk traditions.
Although we have no conclusive knowledge as to when or from where Dravi-
dian lingual and cultural groups migrated and settled in southern Asia, many
authorities hold that these developments were the product of Dravidian cultural
influences. Recently, however, a number of Indian scholars dispute this. Just as the
urban-based civilization arose and flourished during a period of about a thousand
years from 2500 to 1500 BCE, the precursors to Indo-Aryan languages and culture
brought with them new worldviews, a pantheon of new gods, and a hierarchical
mode of social organization that established the preeminence of a priestly class,
the Brahmans. These two language and culture families have largely merged with
each other over the subsequent millennia. The fourth major body of cultural tradi-
tion, beginning perhaps as long ago as 2000 BCE, the Sino-Tibetan, came from the
north and east, bringing what today we see as a welter of different languages and
ethnic groups into the present Indian states of Assam, Nagaland, Manipur, Megha-
laya, Arunachal Pradesh, and Himachal Pradesh as well as into the countries bor-
dering India to the north and east—Nepal, Bhutan, Tibet, Burma, and Thailand.
Unfortunately, our attempts to understand India’s ancient ethnohistorical proc-
esses have often been misguided, contentious, and hegemonically presumptuous.
Earlier, nineteenth-century scholars trying to characterize and understand the di-
versity of traditions within the subcontinent emphasized the generic layering
brought about by successive historical migrations. These older views tended to
speak of culture in terms of race under the assumption that physical features com-
pounded with mother tongue formed the basis of behavior and thinking and
explained the differences among populations and their culture and folklore. In con-
trast to these racialist conceptualizations, most scholars today recognize the signifi-
cance of the blending and mutual borrowing that has taken place between these
bodies of tradition over time. One of the first scholars to outline the details of this
conceptualization with regard to India as a linguistic area was Murray Emeneau
(1980). Making a clear distinction between race and culture, he points out that the
languages of India have mutually influenced and borrowed from one another to
such an extent and so deeply that they now tend to share more features with one
another than they do with other languages of the family that lie outside of India.
There are many factors that combine to shape the folklore profile of a nation,
and thus various dimensions could be used to characterize it. One factor, the
number and heterogeneity of the populations’ ethnicity (languages and cultures
698 | Indian Folklore
within the four ‘‘families,’’ as broadly outlined before) suggests that South Asia
has one of the richest, most varied populations in the world and has one of its
most complex profiles. This is true. But another factor—how a region has been
carved up into its present national boundaries—also affects the profile of its
national segments. In this regard, because postcolonial contemporary South Asia
tended to divide itself along ethnic and religious lines, the national profile of
India is somewhat less complex than that of South Asia as a whole.
The homogenizing effect of major religions, with their canonical and linguistic
hegemonic tendencies, constitutes a determining factor in another sense too. In
this respect, the religions of South Asia differ. On the whole, Hinduism, India’s
predominant religion, is usually regarded as a relatively tolerant one. It has
tended to allow for considerable independent development of its folkloristic
potential. Nevertheless, Sanskrit and the values associated with the philosophies
of its priestly elite class, called Brahmans, have over the millennia tended to
encompass and incorporate considerable local and ethnic variation and relegate it
to the relatively lower status of ‘‘local,’’ ‘‘little,’’ or ‘‘folk’’ practice and belief.
The indigenous, Sanskritic term for this distinction is marga (path, highway) and
desi (provincial, country, local). The overall effect is sometimes seen as a top-
down homogenization process called ‘‘Sanskritization’’ or ‘‘Brahmanization.’’
As a fourth major factor, the nature and size of political units over time shape
a region’s profile: as sociocultural entities increase their territorial boundaries,
incorporating or annihilating neighboring sociocultural units, their cultural he-
gemony tends to lessen the region’s diversity and increase its homogeneity. India
has been fairly normal in this regard, but over the millennia the net result has
been a few large folkloristic territories, leaving only marginal areas such as
mountain ranges and dense jungles where the indigenous cultures retain a
high degree of independence. This process, the civilizational process or the
‘‘Folk-Urban Continuum,’’ is often summarized by means of social categories
associated with different ‘‘kinds’’ of culture: ‘‘urban’’ versus ‘‘folk’’ or village
(the agricultural countryside) versus tribal (isolated, remote, unincorporated).
While most folklorists now realize folklore exists in all societal categories
(urban, village, and tribal populations), folklore was once, in the minds of those
who studied it, only found among rural agricultural peasants. Regarding this
characterization of India’s folklore profile, what we see is an ever-decreasing
‘‘tribal’’ lore, a recently—but rapidly—decreasing ‘‘folk’’ lore, and the rapid rise
of popular urban tradition, perpetrated through mass media and having short-
term currency among specific urban-based social groups such as political parties,
institutions of education, and religious and occupational groups. While Indian
(even pan-Indian) urban lore is a vibrant body of tradition, it too will perhaps
give way to a Western-dominated global tradition. But in this regard, India is not
yet ready to relinquish its distinctiveness.
Indian Folklore | 699
It is perhaps worth noting that defining ‘‘folklore’’ within India’s complex mi-
lieu of tradition has not been easy. During British rule when folklore studies first
became popular, folklore was a term most often applied to the cultures of tribes
and the lower, less-literate castes. In the 1950s when American scholars began to
formulate their approach to the study of Indian civilization, they did so with the
idea of a folk-urban continuum. Folk culture lay in the middle region of a homo-
geneity-heterogeneity continuum at one end of which are the so-called tribal cul-
tures occurring widely all over the subcontinent, contrasted at the other end with
a pan-Indian culture. At about the same time, Indian folklorists developed new
terms in their languages to describe this level of tradition: janapada (jan meaning
‘‘people’’ or ‘‘of the people’’) or lok (lok meaning ‘‘place’’ or ‘‘of a place or
region’’) to distinguish it from the earlier indigenous dichotomy of marga-desi
categories. Although all folklorists working in the region at one time or another
have suffered from the limitations these kinds of categories impose on their think-
ing, on the whole the mix of Western and Indian conceptual paradigms has cre-
ated a balance, and dialogue at international meetings continues without undue
confusion and toward significant mutual benefit.
India’s regional subunits, the states, have a primary (or at most a bipolar) core
to their folklore profile. In different states, this core tends to be shaped by one or
more of the factors mentioned previously. In the case of Kashmir, the core is
bipolar along religious lines of Hinduism and Islam. In Orissa and Assam, on the
other hand, the core entails a distinctive bipolar core of tribal and folk tradition.
In other states, such as Karnataka, Uttar Pradesh, Haryana, and Bihar, the ‘‘folk-
lore’’ core is centered squarely in a uniform village lifestyle, only now beginning
to yield its distinctive character to the increased influence of urban and global
culture. The states of Nagaland, Himachal Pradesh, and Meghalaya are cultural
mosaics lying in jungle or steeply mountainous regions, composed of diverse,
relatively independent, and distinct tribal groups, speaking different languages
often belonging to different linguistic families. In this kind of situation each tribe
(linguistically defined) constitutes an independent genre paradigm, with the com-
monality between them due not to the effects of homogenization but to a family
resemblance retained through common cultural ancestry.
Caste
Despite a long history of reform movements and the many modern laws hoping
to eliminate it or minimize it as a social force, caste (jāti or kula) is a reality
throughout India. In Indian literary texts, another closely related term, varna, has
been used for centuries as a four-fold categorization of the thousands of jātis that
can be found throughout India. At base, both terms identify a named, hereditary
identity group, with its members largely adhering to a set of practices that
include such things as dietary food avoidances (see the later subsection ‘‘Food’’),
700 | Indian Folklore
manner of dress, specific customs associated with life cycle rituals, and a sense
of communal pride embodied in legend and myth. In this sense, a caste is some-
what similar to an ethnic group, and its traditions and customary practices are
something like ethnic folklore as may be found in many parts of the world.
Besides being a dominant characteristic of folk society, caste pervades the folk-
lore itself as a frequent motif, as a performer worldview that accounts for much
of the variation between different versions of a piece, and as a determinant of
who may and who may not perform it.
Although it might be an exaggeration to identify it as a system—let alone a pan-
Indian caste system (as they may have been codified as varna in ancient texts)—
the castes in a region do tend to see themselves in relation to one another, and many
see in those relationships a hierarchy of status (rights and duties), which is actual-
ized in the region’s traditional sets of privileges and regulatory rules of conduct and
assembly. Many of these sets of privileges and demeaning duties have been out-
lawed by modern legislation and are becoming irrelevant to life in the cities. None-
theless, both caste (as a kind of social group) and caste relationships remain infused
into all aspects of the folklore of rural villages and towns of every region.
Another dimension of folklore in India is the social specificity of performers
and patrons or audiences. Not all forms of folklore are open to all people. Many
traditions are carried by performers of a specific caste. For example, the perfor-
mance of caste origin myths (kula or jāti purāna) are patronized by the members
of that caste dispersed throughout the villages of a region. The performers are
usually of a different caste, and their profession is to travel to the locations where
the patron caste is found and narrate or enact (theatrically perform) the myth.
The performers are supported (paid, remunerated, sustained) by the patron caste.
The audience for such a performance may be primarily composed of members of
the patron caste, but usually villagers of other castes come for the entertainment
as well. Many kinds of village life cycle ritual performances such as weddings,
name ceremonies, and funerals are of this nature as well.
There is also a large variety of itinerant performers who still travel the coun-
tryside performing their traditions door-to-door in villages and on weekly market
days in the towns: acrobats, animal trainers, religious mendicants, singers, for-
tune tellers, and so forth. Most of these professional performers are members of
particular castes but are known publicly by the name of their performance. While
some regional drama troupes are also of this nature, most are not restricted to
caste. Drama and dance performance requires many years of study and appeals
to people of a certain personality, but it is generally not a caste profession.
Gender
Although there are a few folk traditions open to both sexes, for the most part, par-
ticipation is segregated by gender, with many kinds of performance being gender
Indian Folklore | 701
specific. Most dance and drama troupes, for example, are composed exclusively
of men, some of whom assume female roles. Most professional epic traditions are
performed only by men too. But tale traditions are broadly the dominion of
women, especially those associated with ritual and moral duties such as the vrat
katha (see the ‘‘Folktales’’ subsection) tradition. The Maitili house wall painting
tradition was also originally a woman’s tradition, practiced by young brides in
relation to the duties they are to perform toward their husband and his family and
the resultant environment of prosperity they, as wives and mothers, bring to it.
Song traditions associated with domestic life cycle ceremonies—particularly
births, weddings, and funerals—are women’s traditions too. Generally speaking,
public performance is the realm of men; domestic performance is that of women.
However, in certain regions of northern India, for several of these life cycle tradi-
tions, Hijras—transsexuals and transvestites—also hold rights to come and sing.
Hinduism
Hinduism is a term originally applied only by non-Indian commentators for the re-
ligious practices, beliefs, and philosophies they found in India. (The label-words
India, Hindu, Hindustan, Hindi, Sindhi, and Indus all derive from the same set per-
ceptions.) Hinduism’s comparatively decentralized authority structure allowed for
and to some extent acknowledged diversity and the difference between canonical
doctrine and local practice, while some of the other religious traditions of India
(e.g., Jainism, Christianity, and Islam) have been less willing to do so, claiming
essentially that folk practice is more or less based in ignorance and misunderstand-
ing and lies outside the purview of orthodox religion. They have thus not accepted
folk religious traditions within their community of believers. They are usually rele-
gated to the status of earlier belief and practice followed by the population before
it converted to doctrinal social and moral codes and came to regard its previous
beliefs as superstition, weakness, or vice. From a folkloristic perspective, however,
there is a great deal of obvious and overt syncretization not only between pre-
existing local custom and canonical doctrine but also among the different religious
communities. It has been somewhat easier to study this phenomenon within the
Hindu fold, and indeed the relationship between local and classical Hindu thought
and practice pervades most of the work that has been done—to the extent that of-
ten the relationship between local Hindu practice and the influence and borrowing
that has taken place between it and the other religious traditions (Islam, Christian-
ity, Jainism, and Buddhism) remains ignored and unexplored.
folklore, and it has greatly expanded our knowledge of the way society and per-
formance contexts affect the nature of many genres. While some genres of folklore
in the West have virtually disappeared as living traditions, and scholars have often
had to content themselves with what remains preserved in literary tradition as a sur-
vival of oral text, those working in India where these genres continue to exist in
vibrant living tradition can include the text’s larger context, which often involves
costumed dance, song, musical accompaniment, spirit possession, and a variety of
highly meaningful ritual acts. This opportunity has enabled folklorists to define
folklore in its performance context more fully and to investigate more closely what
contextual factors drive the shaping of an oral text. Thus, along with a huge body
of new material, new conceptualizations of folk genres and new methodologies
have been developed, while old ones have had to be modified or abandoned.
Folktales
Once upon a time, folklore scholars thought India was the very source of the folktale
as well the home of the vast majority of the tales themselves. It is now understood
that this is not exactly the case, but it was in India (or at least the greater South Asia
that was ‘‘India’’ at the time) that folktales were first collected, standardized, and
aggregated into didactic literature. Some of the largest and most influential tale
collections—the Hitopadesha, the Panchatantra, the Jataka tales, and the Kathasar-
asagar among others—were written or committed to memory and were carried
along Buddhist monastic and Hindu mercantile trade routes north and east into cen-
tral, eastern, and southeastern Asia, and west to Europe. These literary works pro-
vided not only form for the tales themselves but also a literary frame for the
aggregation of tale collection and a characterization and reputation of the folktale as
a medium for moral education. At least some of the oral narrative performance tradi-
tions seem to have been visualized in a variety of distinctive ‘‘picture story telling’’
traditions that then accompanied the spread of tale tradition from India throughout
East and Southeast Asia and westward into Europe. Some of these developed into
forms of marionette and shadow puppetry, scroll paintings, narrative picture boards,
cloth wall hangings and mural painting, and so forth. In contemporary India this
process continues into the mass media from its inception with the introduction of
printing presses to the beginnings of India’s comic books and children’s literature.
But folktales also thrive in oral tradition throughout the country. Increasingly, how-
ever, the oral tradition is being replaced with printed versions learned by educated
children at home and in school. Nevertheless, everyone loves to listen to tales, and
skilled tellers and their performances are still greatly appreciated and respected.
There are still a variety of occasions at which what we would call a folktale is
in India a mandatory part of rituals. Most widespread of these is the vrat katha
(vrat meaning ‘‘vow’’ and katha being the most usual term used for ‘‘tale’’ or
‘‘story’’). Another very widespread, but probably modern ritual form in which a
Indian Folklore | 703
Folk Epics
By most definitions a folk epic is any long, sung narrative performed in the oral
tradition. Even today India’s two major classical epics, the Mahābhārata and the
Rāmāyana, fit easily into this definition. And although before 1980 most of the
folklorists of the world were familiar with only these two Indian epics, dozens of
other epics all around the country have now been collected, published, and are
Illustration from the seventeenth century depicting a scene from the Ancient Indian epic
The Mahabharata. One of the heroes, Arjuna, is in a carriage behind Krishna, who is
mounted on a horse. (Jupiterimages)
704 | Indian Folklore
available for study. None are as long as the classical epics—which, with the for-
mer consisting of over 100,000 verses and the latter slightly less, are the world’s
two longest epics. But many of the regional folk epics are very long, taking days,
not minutes or hours to recite. But it must be kept in mind that in their perfor-
mance forms, the classical epics too are presented in episodes. Only rarely and
only in a few locations is a complete version of the epic presented.
Like other areas around the world, most Indian oral epic traditions are hero-
based and center on great battle scenes. The heroes of most Indian epics, though,
are gods, either incarnate human forms of deities (deva) or warriors (vra) deified
and worshiped by their communities after their heroic deaths. Epic performance
traditions are thus often embedded within forms of religious ritual, some of
which even include the hero’s possession of a professional medium through
whom he is able to dance and speak to the audience, receive honorific gifts, and
convey his blessings and promise continued protection of the community from
his spiritual realm. This is widely the case throughout southern India. The
Katama Rāju and Palnādu epics of Andhra Pradesh, the many bhuta kola and
teyyam traditions of Karnataka and Kerala, and the Annanmār Kathai of Tamil
Nadu are examples of this kind of performance. Another distinctive characteris-
tic of Indian oral epic traditions is the prominent role given to females either as
heroine and central figure of the epic, or as providing supernatural protection and
assistance to the central male hero. This is as true of the northern Alhā epic of
Uttar Pradesh as the Annanmār Kathai of Tamil Nadu.
Not all Indian epic traditions are epics about warrior heroes. Some are more
appropriately described as ‘‘Romantic’’ epics. The epic called the Chandaini, for
example, narrates the tragic love story of Lorik and Chanda, and another, the
holā, treats the love between Nala and Damyanti. Others deal with saints, or
rather deities incarnate as spiritual leaders, and the deeds and miracles they per-
formed to reveal their true identity and power and to effect moral precepts. The
Manteswāmi and Male Mādeshwara epics of Karnataka are some of the most
pure forms of this kind of epic, but versions of the Panch Pr and Rāmdev epics
of Rajastan in northern India also have heroes who are clearly regarded as saintly
teachers as well as protectors of the faithful.
One other notable feature of many Indian epic traditions is the props that are
used in performances. Often their very presence is essential to the performance,
even if they play no other function. In the bow song (vil pāttu) tradition of Tamil
Nadu, a manuscript version of the story must be present even if it is never read
from and the raconteur is illiterate. The bow (vil), too, from which the tradition
derives its name, a ten-foot-long instrument with bells hung along its string, which
jingle loudly when the string is struck with a stick, is also essential for the perfor-
mance. Several epic traditions in northern India require a cloth on which the story
is painted, such as the pār that depicts the Pabuji and Devnaryan epics of Rajastan,
Indian Folklore | 705
or the nine-yard-long scroll paintings accompanying the many caste purāna recita-
tions of Andhra Pradesh. In some instances at least these painted story cloths are
regarded as a sort of portable temple embodying the image of the deity or the
patron deity of the hero. Similarly, itinerant singers of epics, such as the Ellamma
epic, carry a ‘‘god-box,’’ a portable wooden temple containing an image of the
deity with pictures painted on it depicting the god’s or goddess’s deeds.
Dance
India abounds in local dance traditions. Most of the well-known, named Indian
dances depended on local royal and wealthy patronage and were nurtured within
an elite class of audiences and thus exist on the boundary between folk and classi-
cal. Most of these have in common a strongly narrative quality, enacting through
dance a series of pantomime gestural and postural representations of characters of
myth and legend (drawing primarily from the classical epics, the Mahābhārata
and Rāmāyana, as well as other religious texts [purānas]) whose endearing
behavior and qualities are familiar to the audience from poetic literature and song.
In this sense, they are as much drama as dance and are often identified as ‘‘dance-
dramas.’’ In some, musical accompaniment is provided only through instrumental
means (particularly various kinds of drums), while others emphasize specific
forms of semi-classical vocal music. Yakshagana, a dance-drama of Karnataka,
combines all of these with impromptu spoken lines by the dancers in a form
somewhat resembling opera in the West or the Beijing opera of China. Some,
such as Kathak, accentuate complex foot rhythms, while others, such as Kathakali
of Kerala, utilize highly refined traditions of facial and hand gestures (mudras).
Yet others (e.g., Rām Lla performances in some locations) are virtually motion-
less, conveying the narrative they celebrate through a series of tableaux, centered
on a procession involving the audience as well as the actors, or entailing circle
dances in which the distinction between actors and audience is further blurred
(e.g., the many forms of Rām Lla).
Many of these semi-folk/semi-classical dance traditions have roots in folk forms.
Kathak, for example, now regarded as a semi-classical form open to all who wish
to study it, was originally the purview of a caste of dancer-musicians who have
been performing and teaching this dance style within their community for hundreds
of years. Males of the Kathak caste were professional storytellers who enhanced
their recitations with song and dance in order to attract wider audiences as they
wandered from town to town. The origins of most of the dance forms still remain
obscure, sometimes somewhat purposefully so. Bharatha Natyam, now regarded as
almost a national dance form of classical nature, was once performed in south In-
dian temples and in some places by female dancers who were ‘‘gifted’’ to the tem-
ple and whose professional duties included sexual favors to the temple patrons.
The association between temple dance and this kind of religious devadāsi service
706 | Indian Folklore
(so-called ‘‘temple prostitution’’) was once widespread and common in the social
category of folk professions. It is still practiced today despite being outlawed.
Although many dance traditions are closely associated with religious narrative,
many that are clearly in the folk category are primarily secular in nature too. Some
of these are associated with seasonal activities, especially agricultural activities, or
life cycle events such as weddings. Large communal dances are quite common in
tribal areas. Most notable among these, and not confined to the tribal populations,
are the circle dances of Rajasthan and Gujarat. Rās, to use a Gujarati example, is a
circular dance performed by males who strike small sticks (dāndiā) against those
of their partners. Garbā (also Gujarati) is danced by women clapping their hands.
They go around an earthen pot called a garbo (meaning literally ‘‘womb’’) that has
tiny holes and a lit earthen lamp placed inside it, symbolizing the eternal light of
the goddess Amba. During Navarātri (the festival of nine nights), the whole of
Gujarat echoes with singing and dancing, the beating of the drums, striking of the
sticks, and clapping of hands. Similar circle dances are widespread: the Kodavas
of Karnataka, for example, have a number of variations on a ‘‘lamp dance’’
(bolkot), which include intricate circle dances by men using sticks and whisks and
a dance called umattāta performed by women around a large oil lamp placed in
the center of their circle. Generally men and women do not dance together or with
one another, though this is now popular in urban nightclubs.
Songs
Sung narrative—epic, ballad, song cycles, and others—do not easily fit into
Western categories. For example, folklorists label the Tuluva pāddana and Kerala
Torram song traditions variously as epic, ballad, myth, and legend. Like many of
the longer sung narrative traditions such as epic and ballad cycles, some of the
shorter song traditions are religious songs. Indeed, these often depend on frequent
allusions and reference to the epics and to literary works, but their emphasis here
is on blending image with song in order to inspire a deeply devotional mood. The
genre itself is called bhakti music. Bhajan, kirtan, dahe (a Muslim song tradition),
and the Baul songs of West Bengal are traditions of sung poetry inspired by
deeply religious and philosophical insight. On the other hand, there are many sec-
ular song traditions as well. Wedding songs, death songs (Tamil laments), birth
songs (sung by Hijras), lullabies, popular film songs, and many others at best
make only general or coincidental reference to religious themes.
The most common component of all Hindu religious festivals is a pujā. This is
a ritual that anyone can perform at home, usually in a shrine room, to an image
(murthi) or photo of a deity or saint. It can take as little as a few minutes or as
long as an hour or more, depending on the occasion. Daily household pujās are
usually done by the man of the house after gathering flowers and food offerings
on a metal platter and refilling oil lamps (these activities may be done by other
household members) and after bathing and changing into clean clothes. The pujā
begins with lighting the oil lamps and ‘‘awakening’’ the deity with a clap of the
hand, a song, or just mentally. The image may then be bathed in water or in milk
and dressed in clean cloth. An act called ārati is performed by encircling the
image an auspicious number of times—three being the minimum—with a hand-
held oil lamp. The ārati may be repeated with a variety of different lamps or with
a plate holding incense, camphor, or flowers. Next, pure foods, such as raw fruits
(a banana and coconut combination is most common) and sweet mixtures of
grains, generally uncooked or mixed with ghee, are offered, usually using the
same circular motion of the ārati, and ‘‘fed’’ to the deity by opening the fruit and
spooning out a small amount of the prepared food. Often, then, a song (bhajan or
kirtan) is offered, not so much as prayer but as sharing the pleasant recollection
of those deeds and acts of kindness and protection fondly remembered by his or
her followers and devotees. The plate of remaining offerings is brought or passed
around to anyone present so that they may share that blessed by the deity’s
‘‘touch.’’ The short ritual ends with an act of obeisance by the worshipers.
Sacred places abound in the Indian landscape, and whole sets of narrative and
ritual tradition aggregate into bodies of sacred geography. Sarnath, where the
Buddha gave his first sermon, and other locations are part of an extensive geogra-
phy of pilgrimage sites held sacred by Buddhists. Ayodhya, the birthplace of
Rama, the hero of the Rāmāyana epic and incarnation of Lord Vishnu, has sky-
rocketed in fame as a pilgrimage site in recent times due to its disputed status as a
holy site also for Muslims. The Ganges, of course, is a sacred river; and on it lies
Banares (Varanasi), which, as the result of the coalescence of many historical and
geographical factors, is a sacred place renowned for funerals and as repository for
cremated ashes. It is a pilgrimage place that most Hindus wish to visit at some
time in their lives. At the confluence of the Ganges, the Yamuna, and the invisible
Saraswati rivers lies Allahabad, a medium-size mercantile city most of the time;
but it is where once every twelve years some 45 million Hindus gather at a time to
bathe. The world famous Taj Mahal has become the site of choice for urban Indi-
ans and as a modern day secular pilgrimage site for lovers and honeymooners.
Apart from the sacred place itself, the destination of pilgrims, pilgrimage is itself a
form of folklore. Replacing the well-known customs and practices associated with
traditional pilgrimages are thousands of modern tour bus companies, a huge busi-
ness providing Indian tourists with highly standardized tours to largely secular
708 | Indian Folklore
over India people celebrate Dipawali by honoring the goddess Lakshm with a
display of lamps and lanterns, the farmers in coastal Karnataka celebrate it by
constructing a shrine in their fields for Baliyendra, a demon conquered by the
Vamana incarnation of Vishnu, and then calling him in the middle of the night.
Some have rather dissimilar variations in different parts of the country. In north-
ern India, Hol is associated with burning the demoness Holikā in a huge commu-
nal bonfire, role reversals that would be unthinkable at other times of the year,
and wild splashing of one another with dye-colored water, but in the south it is
associated with Parvati arousing her future husband, Shiva, from his deep state
of meditation. And in Kerala women perform a ritual bathing ceremony symbol-
izing the death of Kāma, the god of love.
Food
A brief discussion of common folk food beliefs and customs and their associations
with ethnicity and religion is necessitated by the fact that Indians themselves
overtly and readily make these identifications. One of the most widely known
‘‘facts’’ about Indian culture is its practice of vegetarianism. What is not well
known, apparently, is the reality that only a relatively small percentage of the pop-
ulation is vegetarian, and most of those are of a particular caste, Hindu Brahmans.
Most other segments of the population eat meat. But here, the situation becomes
more complicated—most Hindus will not eat beef. It is regarded as ‘‘lowly,’’ not
because cattle are lowly or impure—quite the opposite: they are ‘‘sacred.’’ It is
those who consume beef that are regarded as ‘‘low’’ and ‘‘impure.’’ The pig, on the
other hand, is regarded by many castes (it is a folk tradition of those castes) as
‘‘low’’ and ‘‘impure,’’ and those who consume its flesh are regarded as impure.
Muslims believe pork to be impure, but Christians do not. Among Hindus, on the
whole, pigs are merely ‘‘disgusting’’ in their habits, and most Hindu castes pro-
scribe its consumption. In parts of India some castes regard chicken as similarly
dirty—indeed, almost all animals living among human populations have dirty eat-
ing habits—and proscribe eating their flesh but allow eating animals hunted in the
wild. The animals preferred by those who permit the consumption of meat are
sheep and goats, the latter preferred over the former for matters of taste. Clearly,
eating food is a language of meaningful discourse and practice as well as of ri-
valry, contention, and religious and ethnic identity. And it goes much beyond this
deeply into the social interactions of every day life.
Another dimension to food classification and eating is who cooks the food and
how. Pakka food is that cooked in ghee (clarified butter fat, a product of the cow,
held sacred by Hindus) and metal vessels (most preferably ‘‘higher class’’ metals:
gold, silver, copper, and brass); kacca food is that cooked in water and earthen-
ware vessels. Pakka food is associated with festivals and celebrations; kacca food
is everyday, ordinary, home food. Pakka food is more widely acceptable than
710 | Indian Folklore
kacca food. Somewhat similarly, food cooked by a higher caste person (Brahman
being the highest) is more widely acceptable than that cooked by someone of a
lower caste. The result is that the vegetarian food cooked in ghee and metal ves-
sels by Brahmans is relished by the greatest number of people, making it the food
of festivals and large gatherings. These kinds of food classification continue into
the realms of vegetables and grains and processed foods. The system is summar-
ized in a three-fold classification of food into satvika, rajas, and tamas foods.
It is also believed that the body, mind, and personality are formed by the foods
one eats. Ultimately this theory is sometimes used to explain the personality
characteristics of the caste (primarily varna) system. Another important classifi-
cation of foods into hot and cold categories is used to explain causes of illness
and the practice of medicine and cure. So, as we might expect, diet is carefully
watched, and the women, the cooks of the family (mothers, wives, and sisters),
watch after and protect their family’s health in the foods they prepare. Many of
these food preparations embody customary sets of ingredients balanced to con-
tribute to the family members’ health and prosperity. A knowledgeable woman,
then, is like a goddess (the goddess Lakshm) to the family.
tradition productions, elements of these inescapably were brought into the series
both unconsciously and overtly.
In such new media as these, traditional folklore has managed to overcome the
forces of Western-based globalization at least temporarily. However, India itself
is generating its own global cultural hegemony, and the force of this as an influ-
ence on folk oral tradition is both powerful and subtle, with some folksongs
sounding more and more like film song productions, for example.
Not long after India’s independence, Milton Singer wrote in the preface to
Tradition and Change, ‘‘Modern nationalism in India has always shown a strong
interest in the recovery or reinterpretation of India’s traditional culture,’’ and sug-
gested, ‘‘The professional student of culture and civilization may contribute
something to this inquiry through an objective study of the variety and changes
in cultural traditions.’’ This call generally has been met with enthusiasm by
scholars. Many universities all around India now have folklore departments and
offer degrees in folklore. Part of this is due to Indian states being established on
the basis of language and regional pride, which resulted in folklore becoming a
part of departments of literature that included the preservation and promotion of
not only written literature, but also non-written arts preserved in oral folk tradi-
tion such as dance, drama, material culture, and song.
India’s central government and most of the state governments have aided folk
performance forms by providing monetary support to particular genre performan-
ces (especially dance-drama forms); supporting folk festivals (regionally and
nationally, as well as internationally); recognizing, organizing, and listing bodies
of state-licensed folk performers; and establishing state cultural boards. Equiva-
lent to America’s Smithsonian Institution, the Central Government’s Indira Gan-
dhi National Centre for the Arts (IGNCA; see ignca.nic.in/js body.htm) in Delhi
has a division devoted to the collection and analysis of folklore materials through-
out all of India. The Central Institute of Indian Languages in Mysore also has a
folkore division. More pragmatically, most states have established centers helping
folk artists make the transition to new urban contexts and new urban patrons. Cen-
tral and state folk arts and crafts centers have played a particularly strong role
training young artists, providing design advice, and establishing distribution and
sales outlets. Ironically, perhaps, these efforts have sometimes produced the unde-
sirable results of a decline in the quality of folk crafts and a dependence by artists
on politicians and the government rather than the folk as patrons of their art.
Some support for Indian folklore has also come from abroad. In 1985, the
United States held a Festival of India, which brought many folk performers and
craftsmen from around India to Washington, DC. The event, organized at the dip-
lomatic level between the Indo-American Council in Delhi and the Smithsonian
Institution, not only demonstrated tremendous world interest in India’s folk tradi-
tions but also gave a great boost to the legitimacy of India’s wealth of diversity in
712 | Indian Folklore
folk forms, a legitimacy that has subsequently served to preserve them from anni-
hilation in the face of widespread globalization. Similar festivals were held in a
number of European countries.
References
Ashton-Sikora, Martha. 2004. Bhuta Kola. In South Asian Folklore: An Encyclopedia,
eds. Peter J. Claus, Margaret Mills, and Sarah Diamond. New York: Routledge, pp. 65 66.
Beck, B. E. F. 1982. The Three Twins: The Telling of a South Indian Folk Epic.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Benfey, Theodor. 1859. Pantschatantra. F€ unf B€
ucher indischen Fabeln, M€ archen
und Erz€ahlungen. 2 vols. Leipzig: F. A. Brockhaus.
Blackburn, Stuart, and Joyce B. Flueckiger. 1989. Introduction. In Oral Epics of
India, eds. Stuart Blackburn, Peter J. Claus, Joyce B. Flueckiger, and Susan S. Wadley.
Berkeley: University of California Press, pp. 1 14.
Blackburn, Stuart H., and A. K. Ramanujan, eds. 1986. Another Harmony: New
Essays on the Folklore of India. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Blackburn, Stuart, Peter J. Claus, Joyce B. Flueckiger, and Susan S. Wadley, eds.
1989. Oral Epics in India. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Claus, Peter J. 1998. Folklore. In India’s Worlds and U.S. Scholars, 1947 1997, eds.
Joseph W. Elder, Edward C. Dimock Jr., and Ainslie T. Embree. New Delhi: Manohar,
pp. 211 236.
Indian Folklore | 713
Claus, Peter J. 2004. Kātāmarāju. South Asian Folklore: An Encyclopedia, eds. Peter
J. Claus, Margaret Mills, and Sarah Diamond. New York: Routledge, pp. 329 330.
Claus, Peter J., Margaret Mills, and Sarah Diamond, eds. 2004. South Asian Folk-
lore: An Encyclopedia. New York: Routledge.
Diamond, Sarah. 1999. Karagattam: Performance and the Politics of Desire in Tamil
Nadu, India. Dissertation., University of Pennsylvania.
Eck, Diana. 1982. Banaras: City of Light. New York: Alfred A. Knopf.
Egnor, Margaret. 1986. Internal Iconicity in Paraiyar Crying Songs. In Another Har-
mony: New Essays on the Folklore of India, eds. Stuart Blackburn and A. K. Ramanu-
jan. Berkeley: University of California Press, pp. 294 344.
Emeneau, M. B. 1980. Language and Linguistic Area: Essays, ed. Anwar S. Dil.
Stanford: Stanford University Press.
Feldhaus, Anne. 1995. Water and Womanhood: Religious Meanings of Rivers in
Maharashtra. New York: Oxford University Press.
Gentes, M. J. 2004. Puja. In South Asian Folklore: An Encyclopedia, eds. Peter J.
Claus, Margaret Mills, and Sarah Diamond. New York: Routledge, pp. 493 495.
Gold, Ann Grozdins. 1992. A Carnival of Parting: The Tales of King Bhartari and
King Gopi Chand, as Sung and Told by Madhu Natisar Nath of Ghatiyali. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Gold, Ann Grodzins, and Gloria G. Raheja. 1994. Listen to the Heron’s Words:
Reimagining Gender and Kinship in North India. Berkeley: University of California
Press.
Mair, Victor. 1988. Painting and Performance: Chinese Picture Recitation and Its
Indian Genesis. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press.
Marglin, Frederique Apffel. 1985. Wives of the God-King: The Rituals of the Deva-
dasis of Puri. Delhi: Oxford University Press.
Marriot, McKim. 1955. Village India: Studies in the Little Community. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
Ramanujan, A. K. 1997. A Flowering Tree and Other Oral Tales from India, eds.
Stuart Blackburn and Alan Dundes. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Redfield, Robert. 1956. Peasant Society and Culture: An Anthropological Approach
to Civilization. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Richman, Paula, ed. 1991. Many Ramayanas: The Diversity of a Narrative Tradition
in South Asia. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Richmond, Farley P., Darius L. Swann, and Phillip Zarrilli, eds. 1990. Indian Thea-
tre: Traditions of Performance. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press.
Roghair, Gene. 1982. The Epic of Palnād u: A Study and Translation of Palnādi
Vrula Katha, a Telugu Oral Tradition from Andhra Pradesh. New York: Oxford Uni-
versity Press.
Schubel, Vernon James. 1993. Religious Performance in Contemporary Islam: Shi’i
Devotional Rituals in South Asia. Columbia: University of South Carolina Press.
Singer, Milton B. 1959. Traditional India: Structure and Change. Philadelphia:
American Folklore Society.
714 | Inscription
Singer, Milton B., ed. 1966. Krishna: Myths, Rites, and Attitudes. Honolulu: East-
West Center Press.
Smith, John D. 1991. Pābuj: A Study, Transcription, and Translation. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
Vatsyayan, Kapila. 1976. Traditions of Indian Folk Dance. New Delhi: Clarion Press.
Wadley, Susan S. 1994. Struggling with Destiny in Karimpur, 1925 1984. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Welbon, Guy R., and Glenn Yocum. 1982. Religious Festivals in South India and
Sri Lanka. Delhi: Manohar.
Inscription
References
Dundes, Alan. 1962. Some Examples of Infrequently Reported Autograph Verse.
Southern Folklore Quarterly 26: 127 130.
Entenmann, Lloyd L. 1991. Love Tokens as Engraved Coins. Audubon, NJ: Lloyd L.
Entenmann.
Key, Wilson Bryan. [1981] 1973. Subliminal Seduction: Ad Media’s Manipulation of
a Not So Innocent America. New York: New American Library.
716 | Internet
Nilson, Don L. F. 1981. Sigma Epsilon XI: Sex in the Typical University Classroom.
Maledicta 5: 79 91.
Preston, Michael J. 1995. In Addition to Xeroxlore: Related Subversive Traditions. In
The Other Print Tradition: Essays on Chapbooks, Broadsides, and Related Ephemera,
eds. Cathy Lynn Preston and Michael J. Preston. New York: Garland.
Riley, Sam G. 1991. GR8 PL8ES: The Best of America’s Vanity Plates. Pound
Ridge, NY: New Chapter.
Wolfstine, Manfred R. [1981] 1970. The Manual of Brands and Marks. Ed. and
intro. by Ramon F. Adams. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.
Woodward, Robert H. 1962. Folklore Marginalia in Old Textbooks. New York Folk-
lore Quarterly 18: 2417.
Internet
The digital revolution in the last quarter of the twentieth century gave way to new
means of communication, new ways of telling tales, and new dimensions in research-
ing narrative culture, especially since personal computers and local networks became
connected to each other in a worldwide Web called the Internet. In the 1980s, digital
communication took off when a growing number of people were able to afford per-
sonal computers and modems and began using e-mail, joining mailing lists, and visit-
ing newsgroups, such as Usenet. The 1990s brought many improvements to personal
computers, modems, communication software, and Internet service providers. Not
only could plain messages be sent by e-mail, but so could larger files with text, pic-
tures, animated gifs (photos with moving details), and animation. Internet browsers
such as Mosaic, Netscape, and Explorer were being developed; Web pages gained
more visual features and symbols; and hyperlinks led to unprecedented intertextual-
ity. Sites with discussion forums also appeared on the Web, and it was in this era that
the first folktale collections and databases were published on the Internet.
In the twenty-first century, hardware and software became cheaper and faster.
Chatting on the Internet became very popular, especially among children and
adolescents. At first, conversations in chat rooms consisted of participants typing
and sending text to each other, but software such as PalTalk and MSN Messenger
made live chat sessions possible with the use of a microphone and a webcam.
Meanwhile, mobile phones could function as small computers themselves, send-
ing e-mail by Short Messaging Services (SMS) and mailing pictures and small
movies by Multimedia Messaging Services (MMS). These mobile phone mes-
sages are good for sending jokes, riddles, and funny pictures. A new MSN and
SMS language evolved, using abbreviations (e.g., lol ¼ laughing out loud; CU
l8er ¼ see you later) and emoticons (smileys).
Within a quarter of a century, the possibilities for storing and exchanging folk
narratives digitally have expanded dramatically, and technological developments
Internet | 717
€u
Young Estonians visit near a sign giving directions to an Internet cafe in Hu €ru, Estonia.
(EPA Photo/NIPA/Timur Nisametdinov)
have turned the world into a ‘‘global village’’ where English is the foremost lin-
gua franca. The democratic medium of the Internet has made it possible for many
to share their stories with others. Due to the Internet, tales travel faster than ever.
A story can now be disseminated around the world in just a few seconds. The
exchange of jokes and contemporary or urban legends is a popular pastime
among youngsters and inside office culture. The enormous expansion of folklor-
istic and folk-narrative material on the Internet is making it more difficult to
retrieve the information one is looking for, and therefore the importance of
search engines like Yahoo and Google is increasing. It seems as if all information
can be found on the World Wide Web. More data are added every day, and we
sometimes tend to forget that data are changing, moving to other addresses, or
even disappearing completely. A joke, a piece of Photoshop lore (a funny,
manipulated digital picture), or a discussion on the subject of urban legendry can
be here today and gone tomorrow. Google’s cache is often a last resort before
folkloristic bits and bytes disappear permanently. The Internet even has a patron
saint, who is, as far as legend goes, Isidore of Seville (ca. 560–636).
Folktale Collections
One of the earliest (1994) and still one of the finest folktale collections is the Ger-
man Gutenberg Project, which as of 2006 contained some 1,600 fairy tales, 1,200
718 | Internet
joke is transmitted from person to person(s); (3) The joke comments on subjects
that—at least according to the narrator and audience—really matter in present-
day society; (4) The Photoshop joke deals with the same taboos, frustrations,
prejudices, and fantasies as the traditional oral joke; and (5) As in traditional jok-
ing, Photoshop jokes are recycled every once in a while—lying politicians, for
instance, have repeatedly been depicted as Pinocchio with a long nose. The phe-
nomenon of Photoshop lore has existed since the late 1990s, as soon as enough
people were able to receive e-mails with attachments. Still, its popularity
increased after the terrorist attacks on the World Trade Center and the Pentagon
on September 11, 2001. E-mailboxes in the Western world immediately became
inundated with Photoshop humor about the Twin Towers, George W. Bush,
Osama bin Laden, Afghanistan, al-Qaida, and Muslim terrorism in general. Since
then, Photoshop lore has been made on every subject worth joking about; there
even exist Internet contests. The visualization of jokes has not stopped at pic-
tures: they are disseminated as PowerPoint presentations, Macromedia anima-
tions, and QuickTime movies as well.
As far as narrating on the Internet is concerned, it appears that the telling of
jokes, riddles, rumors, and (urban) legends is more popular than telling a tradi-
tional fairy tale. Every now and again, fairy tale parodies (see Parody) surface,
both as texts and as pictures. Sexual relationships between fairy tale figures from
Disney seem to be especially favored, for instance between Beauty and the Beast
or Snow White and the seven dwarfs.
Another old form of folklore has infested the Internet: the chain letter. The
e-mail must be forwarded to multiple persons to avoid (personal) harm and bring
about happiness and good fortune. Sometimes it is necessary to forward the
e-mail to raise money for a sick child who needs an operation. In other cases, Bill
Gates will reward people with a large sum of money for testing his new e-mail
tracking software. Of course, these are all hoaxes, as are the many alerts for com-
puter viruses that never come. The first e-mail of this kind started circulating in
1994 as a warning against the (nonexistant) Good Times virus. Many of these vi-
rus alerts followed (Irina, Deeyenda, Join the crew, Penpal greetings, It Takes
Guts to Say ‘‘Jesus,’’ Your friend D@fit, etc.). Most of the time, it is said that
opening the e-mail will cause a virus to forward itself to everyone in the address
book and to erase all of their hard drives. Companies such as IBM, AOL, Micro-
soft, and McAfee are mentioned to make the message more believable. In some
cases, the e-mail advises recipients to delete a certain file when present, after
which the users soon find out they did not erase a virus but a part of the standard
Windows software. As a reaction to the virus hoaxes, obvious parodies or anti-
legends circulated, in which the virus was said to wipe out all of your credit
cards, date your girlfriend, and drink all of your beer. Another story that dupes
the unwary is the so-called Nigerian Scam. The reader is requested by a very
722 | Internet
Playing Tales
Finally, it is not only possible to tell or listen to a tale. Thanks to computer tech-
nology, one can also play and experience a tale—at least in virtual reality. Soon
after consumers started buying personal computers, the first computer games
were developed. Today, the game industry is making more money than the film
industry. Many games—especially adventure games—take their themes, motifs,
and structures from fairy tales, myths, and legends. This applies to early games
such as the King’s Quest series, as well as to later productions such as the Final
Fantasy series. Interactivity has been added since computers and game consoles
can be plugged into the Internet. Now players can simultaneously play their
own roles in folktale-like adventures thanks to the MMORPGs: the Massively
Multiplayer Online Role-Playing Games, bearing names such as Ultima Online,
EverQuest, and World of Warcraft.
For many people in the early days, the personal computer started out as just
another electronic typewriter. The machine with its monochrome screen was
mainly used for storing data and texts. Soon it changed from an electronic book
into a sort of television due to the addition of audiovisual features: color, icons,
Internet | 723
References
Blank, Trevor J., ed. 2009. Folklore and the Internet: Vernacular Expression in a
Digital World. Logan, UT: Utah State University Press.
Brednich, Rolf W. 2005. www.worldwidewitz.com: Humor im Cyberspace. Freiburg
im Breisgau: Herder.
Brunvand, Erik. 2000. The Heroic Hacker: Legends of the Computer Age. In The
Truth Never Stands in the Way of a Good Story. Urbana: University of Illinois Press,
pp. 170 198.
Degh, Linda. 1999. Collecting Legends Today: Welcome to the Bewildering Maze
of the Internet. In Europ€aische Ethnologie und Folklore im internationalen Kontext:
Festschrift f€
ur Leander Petzoldt zum 65. Geburtstag, ed. Ingo Schneider. Frankfurt
a.M.: P. Lang, pp. 55 66.
Ellis, Bill. 2005. Legend/AntiLegend: Humor as an Integral Part of the Contempo-
rary Legend Process. In Rumor Mills: The Social Impact of Rumor and Legend, eds.
Gary Alan Fine, Veronique Campion-Vincent, and Chip Heath. New Brunswick, NJ:
Aldine Transaction, 123 140.
Fialkove, Larissa, and Maria N. Yelenevskaya. 2001. Ghosts in the Cyber World: An
Analysis of Folklore Sites on the Internet. Fabula 42: 64 89.
Foley, John Miles. 2006. Oral Tradition and the Internet: Navigating Pathways. FF
Network 30(June): 12 19.
Kuipers, Giselinde. 2002. Media Culture and Internet Disaster Jokes: Bin Laden and the
Attack on the World Trade Center. European Journal of Cultural Studies 5(4): 451 471.
Meder, Theodoor. 2001. Viruspaniek: E-mail-lore van Good Times tot Polleke den
Hacker. http://www.meertens.nl/medewerkers/theo.meder/viruspaniek.html.
Murray, Janet H. 1998. Hamlet on the Holodeck: The Future of Narrative in Cyber-
space. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
724 | Invented Tradition
Pearce, C. 2002. Story as Play Space: Narrative in Games. In Game On: The History
and Culture of Video Games, ed. Laurence King. London: Laurence King Publishing,
pp. 112 119.
Schneider, Ingo. 1996. Erz€ahlen im Internet: Aspekte kommunikativer Kultur im
Zeitalter des Computers. Fabula 37: 8 27.
Wiebe, Karl. 2003. This Is Not a Hoax: Urban Legends on the Internet. Baltimore:
PublishAmerica.
Invented Tradition
References
Alonso, Ana Maria. 1988. The Effects of Truth: Re-Presentations of the Past and the
Imagining of Community. Journal of Historical Sociology 1: 33 57.
Anderson, Benedict. 1983. Imagined Communities. London: Verso.
Bommes, Michael, and Patrick Wright. 1982. Charms of Residence: The Public and
the Past. In Making Histories, eds. Richard Johnson, Gregor McLellen, Bill Schwarz,
and David Sutton. Centre for Contemporary Cultural Studies. London: Hutchinson.
Handler, Richard, and Jocelyn Linnekin. 1984. Tradition, Genuine or Spurious. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 97: 273 286.
Hanson, Allan. 1989. The Making of the Maori: Culture Invention and Its Logic.
American Anthropologist 91: 890 902.
Harker, Dave. 1985. Fakesong: The Manufacture of British ‘‘Folksong,’’ 1700 to the
Present Day. Milton Keynes, England: Open University Press.
Hobsbawm, Eric, and Terence Ranger, eds. 1983. The Invention of Tradition. Cam-
bridge: Cambridge University Press.
726 | Invented Tradition
O’Brien, Jay, and William Roseberry, eds. 1991. Golden Ages, Dark Ages: Imagin-
ing the Past in Anthropology and History. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Paredes, Americo, and Richard Bauman, eds. 1972. Toward New Perspectives in
Folklore. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Urban, Gregory, and Joel Sherzer, eds. 1991. Nation-States and Indians in Latin
America. Austin: University of Texas Press.
J
Jack and the Beanstalk
‘‘Jack and the Beanstalk’’ is one of the most widespread and most studied of all folk-
tales. In its basic version, the story is that of a boy called Jack who lives on a farm
with his widowed mother. They are poor and often have no food. Their only posses-
sion is their cow, which, of course, provides them with milk, butter, and cheese.
One day, Jack’s mother tells him that their circumstances are so desperate that they
must sell the much-loved and valuable cow. Unhappily, Jack agrees to take the cow
to market for sale. Along the way, he meets a strange, wizened little man who asks
him where he is going. On hearing that Jack is off to market to sell the cow, the little
man offers to buy it from Jack for three magic beans. Jack, somewhat spellbound
by the man, agrees and returns home with the beans in great excitement.
When he tells his mother what he has done and shows her three beans, she is
furious, pointing out in no uncertain terms that Jack has been well and truly taken
in by this strange man and has given away their only hope of survival for three
worthless beans. In her rage, she throws the beans out the window and into the
garden.
727
728 | Jack and the Beanstalk
Miserable and hungry, Jack goes upstairs to bed, berating himself for his fool-
ishness. He goes to sleep and wakes at dawn the next day to see through his bed-
room window that an enormous beanstalk has sprouted from the discarded beans.
The beanstalk is so thick that it is like a tree and so high that it disappears into the
clouds.
Full of youthful curiosity, and against his mother’s orders, Jack climbs the
beanstalk, going up through the clouds and arriving in a strange land ruled over
by an ogre and his wife. Jack befriends the ogre’s wife, and she hides him when
the ogre returns to their castle, hungry as usual, for some small boy to eat and
chanting some variant of the famous:
With the help of the ogre’s wife, Jack discovers that the ogre has some useful
treasures stored in his castle, including a magic singing harp and a goose that
lays golden eggs. Jack resolves to steal these items in order to improve his and
his mother’s lot.
After a greater or shorter number of adventures and close calls with the ogre,
depending on the length of story required by teller and audience, Jack finally
escapes down the beanstalk with the golden-egg-laying goose, hotly pursued by an
angry ogre. Fortunately, young Jack is fit, which, together with his fright, helps
him move quickly. He makes it to the bottom of the beanstalk and into his house
as the ogre is still descending through the clouds. Grabbing an axe, Jack rushes out
to the garden and desperately chops away at the beanstalk as the ogre gets nearer
and nearer. In the nick of time, the beanstalk is felled and the ogre crashes to earth
and dies. Jack and his mother now have the golden goose and become enormously
wealthy. Jack usually marries a beautiful princess, and they live happily ever after.
Versions of the tale are told throughout the English-speaking world and Europe,
and it is also known in Asian tradition. There have been many attempts to explain
the popularity and significance of this story and its hero since it first became
widely popular in the early eighteenth century. Interpretations include the wilder
shores of Freudian analysis represented by Desmonde, in which the beanstalk is
treated as a phallic symbol; the therapeutic approach of Bettelheim; the compari-
son of national stereotypes by Wolfenstein; and the attempt to trace the story to an
actual tropical plant by Humphreys. As well, there is a considerable literature
about ‘‘Jack and the Beanstalk’’ in the fields of folklore and fairy tale studies.
Graham Seal
See Also Fairy Tale Heroes.
Japanese Folklore | 729
References
Bettelheim, B. 1976. The Uses of Enchantment: The Meaning and Importance of
Fairy Tales. New York: Knopf.
Briggs, K., ed. 1970 1971. A Dictionary of British Folk-Tales in the English Lan-
guage, 2 vols., London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Chase, R., ed. 1943. The Jack Tales. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Desmonde, W. 1958. Jack and the Beanstalk. American Imago 8.
Hallett, M., and B. Karasek, eds. 1996. Folk and Fairy Tales. Ontario: Broadview
Press.
Humphreys, H. 1948. Jack and the Beanstalk. Antiquity 22: 36 38.
Jacobs, J., ed. 1968. English Fairy Tales. London: The Bodley Head, pp. 297ff;
reprint of English Fairy Tales, 1890, pp. 40 45 and More English Fairy Tales, 1894.
Szumsky, B. 1999. The House That Jack Built: Empire and Ideology in Nineteenth-
Century British Versions of Jack and the Beanstalk. In Marvels and Tales: Journal of
Fairy-Tale Studies 13(1): 11 30.
Wolfenstein, M. 1955. Jack and the Beanstalk: An American Version. In Childhood
in Contemporary Culture, eds. M. Mead and M. Wolfenstein. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Japanese Folklore
The Nihon shoki (Chronicle of Japan) is a history of Japan from the mythical
age of the gods to the empress Jito, who ruled in the late seventh century. While
it covers much of the same time period as the Kojiki, the Nihon shoki focuses
much more on the day-to-day activities of the emperors and empresses. This
early history is also of interest because it provides multiple versions of many of
the myths, legends, and stories.
Approximately sixty fudoki were compiled in the eighth century by order of
the emperor. Each of the fudoki focused on a specific geographical area and
reported on the local topography, etymologies of place names, natural resources,
local legends, folktales, deities, and folk beliefs. Of the sixty original fudoki, only
five have survived in a form close to the originals.
Most of the records that have come down to us from the Nara (710–784 CE)
and Heian (794–1185 CE) periods derive from aristocratic life. Some of these
materials provide information about local legends and folktales and often contain
a wealth of information about the folk belief system. An excellent example is
The Tale of Genji, written in the eleventh century by Murasaki Shikibu (978–ca.
1016), a lady-in-waiting to the empress. The Tale of Genji, which is often cited
as the first great novel in world literature, contains a number of episodes of spirit
possession, still a commonly held belief in Japan. The two most famous episodes
of possession relate to the death of Genji’s young lover Yugao and then eventu-
ally the death of his pregnant wife Aoi. Both occur at the hands of the possessing
spirit of an earlier jilted lover. Recently, Doris Bargen (1997) has done a detailed
study of these possession episodes, comparing and contrasting male-centered and
female-centered interpretations of these spirits.
The Heian and Kamakura (1185–1333 CE) periods mark a high point in the col-
lection and publication of Buddhist and secular tales including almost fifty differ-
ent titles. The Nihon ryoiki, which contains 116 Buddhist tales and legends, was
compiled in the 820s. Many other collections of Buddhist tales exist—two of the
most important being the Dainihonkoku Hokekyokenki, which was compiled in
the mid-eleventh century and contains 129 tales, and Muju Ichien’s Shasekishu,
which was compiled in the late thirteenth century. A number of collections
contain mixtures of Buddhist and secular tales. The two most important are the
Konjaku monogatari, which was compiled in the early twelfth century and is one
of the great tale collections in the world, containing 1,039 tales, and the early thir-
teenth-century Uji shui monogatari, which contains 197 tales. These tale collec-
tions were compiled for a number of reasons, but the two most important are for
the compiler to gain merit for his next rebirth and for use by itinerant priests who
traveled the countryside to spread Buddhist teachings and collect donations for
the construction of temples and statues.
The recitation and eventual transcription of the great Japanese war epic The
Tale of the Heike occurred during the Kamakura and Ashikaga (1338–1573)
Japanese Folklore | 731
Illustration from an 1885 edition of The Tale of the Heike depicting the Japanese warrior
Nasu no Yoichi seated on a horse and looking back at enemy vessels offshore. (Library of
Congress)
periods. This collection of martial exploits and legends is based on the great civil
war between the Heike and Genji clans, which took place from 1180 to 1185, and
is one of the most powerful examples in Japanese literature of the Buddhist con-
cept of mujo (impermanence/change). A tradition arose of mostly blind itinerant
jongleurs (biwa hoshi) who traveled the countryside singing and reciting famous
episodes from this war. Eventually, a longer version of the tale recited by the
great biwa hoshi Kakuichi was recorded in 1371 and quickly became the standard
text for reading and recitation. Many of the individual stories and legends have
been used by dramatists to write plays of great pathos. Some of the most moving
examples are the warrior ghost plays in the Noh theater, which not only relate fa-
mous tales but also illustrate Buddhist ideas and ideals of death and the afterlife
as well as belief in spirits of the dead and their ability to interact with the living.
During the Edo (1600–1868) period a group of scholars began to study
Japanese classical literature and ancient writings in a search for the true Japanese
spirit (Yamato gokoro). The scholars of note in this investigation of Japanese
thought and culture, called kokugaku (National learning), were Kada no Azuma-
maro (1669–1736), Kamo no Mabuchi (1697–1769), Motoori Norinaga (1730–
1801), and Hirata Atsutane (1776–1843). By means of philological studies of the
classics, including the Manyoshu (an eighth-century poetry collection), the
732 | Japanese Folklore
Kojiki, the Nihon shoki, and The Tale of Genji, these scholars attempted to iden-
tify the roots of Japanese culture before the introduction of Chinese influence in
the sixth to ninth centuries. While their focus varied, an underlying ideological
foundation came to support a very nationalistic view of Japan and Japanese his-
tory in the nineteenth century. The influence of kokugaku thought on the eventual
overthrow of the Tokugawa family and military rule in Japan in 1868 and the
‘‘restoration’’ of the emperor to his rightful place as ruler of Japan cannot be
underestimated. An underlying problem that they faced, and one that has interest-
ing parallels elsewhere in the world (e.g., the Grimm brothers in Germany and
L€onnrot in Finland), was the fact that all of the classical documents studied from
earlier times were written in a script borrowed from China. How could the true
Japanese spirit be expressed and discovered in a foreign language?
Religious Beliefs
Buddhism and Confucianism were introduced to Japan from China in the sixth cen-
tury. Both had a profound effect on Japanese culture. Buddhism introduced elite
Japanese to higher Chinese culture. A close connection between Buddhism and the
state also developed over time with imperial support of priests and temples. A sys-
tem of kokubunji (country protecting temples) was constructed in the eighth cen-
tury by order of the emperor. Strong ties between families and clans also
developed initially with aristocratic families building their own temples and later
(from the seventeenth century) with most families establishing family gravesites at
a particular temple. Another area of interest was the esoteric side of Buddhism,
which along with the shamanistic elements already in Japan, is still popular today.
These practices connect practitioners to the world of spirits, ancestors, and genze
riyaku (this world benefits).
Finally, Confucianism has had tremendous impact on Japanese society. The
dissemination of this Chinese import has been promoted by most Japanese gov-
ernments and elite society because it makes a very strong argument for a hierarch-
ical society in which everyone must understand his or her place. When people
understand their places, live according to their stations in life, interact with those
above with deference and with those below with kindness and forbearance, then
all will be well in Heaven, in nature, and among humans. If strictly practiced,
Confucianism argues against social change and for the status quo.
The fifth through the eighth centuries CE saw a tremendous Chinese influence
on Japanese culture. Prior to this time the Japanese did not have a written script
and therefore borrowed the Chinese writing system. The Japanese also borrowed
and modified Chinese historical writing, legal codes, layout of the capital city,
Buddhism (with all of its attendant art, literature, and architecture), Confucian-
ism, Daoism, painting, and poetry among other aspects of culture. The influence
is of such major proportions that a movement that lasted from the seventeenth to
Japanese Folklore | 733
the nineteenth centuries aimed to eliminate Chinese cultural influence and dis-
cover the true Japanese spirit (Yamato gokoro).
gendered nature of certain games, and the importance in many of the games of imi-
tating adult behaviors. Many scholars have lamented that because of the juku
(cram school) system of education now in place children do not have time to inter-
act and play with their peers. The play that they do participate in is often limited to
computer games. Sports, especially baseball, sumo, and the martial arts, have
received more attention. Robert Whiting has written about the history and pecu-
liarly Japanese way of playing baseball, which is arguably the national sport. He
has clearly shown that cultural factors are very important in sport and can alter the
way a game is played in important ways. Sumo and the other martial arts, which
are often considered quintessentially Japanese, have also been widely studied.
Some of the recent scholarship, taking their cue from Benedict Anderson, looks at
these sports and their histories as forms of invented tradition.
on the history and folklore of the area, and outreach programs aimed at students
and local residents.
Along with the increased interest in the academic study of folklore, a concomi-
tant interest in creating or recreating local festivals grew as part of the nostalgia
boom. Villages, towns, and cities vied with each other in marketing their ‘‘tradi-
tional’’ crafts and festivals as tourist attractions. The Japanese National Railway
(JNR) recognized this trend early in its development and began to take an active
interest in the promotion of such activities in an attempt to increase their reve-
nues through increased travel. JNR began national advertising campaigns (cre-
ated by Dentsu, the largest advertising agency in the world), which were aimed
at encouraging people to travel from large metropolitan areas back to the coun-
tryside to discover and participate in ‘‘traditional Japan’’ firsthand. This was seen
as a way to reconnect with the true Japanese spirit, which seemed to have gone
awry during the brutality of the war and the focus on materialistic aspects of life
during the subsequent recovery. This phenomenon led to further academic study
of tradition and the invention of tradition.
began to take shape in the 1920s. Yanagi was not only a collector but also a
sponsor and mentor of traditional crafts and craftsmen. The artists most promi-
nently associated with Yanagi’s attempts to revive folk crafts were the potters
Hamada Shoji, Kawai Kanjiro, and the English potter Bernard Leach, the wood-
block print artist Munakata Shiko, and the textile designer and dyer Serizawa
Keisuke. In the early 1930s, Yanagi began publishing a journal focusing on the
decorative arts, and in 1936 he established the Japan Folk Crafts Museum to pre-
serve and display traditional folk crafts. A visit to this museum, located in
Komaba in Tokyo, illustrates his principal areas of interest: textiles; ceramics;
objects made of wood, lacquer, and metal; and pictorial art. In his writings,
Yanagi attempted to explain the appeal of everyday objects made by the hands of
skilled craftsmen. The appeal was not only esthetic but also religious in nature
and, if made properly and approached properly, could enrich one’s life in innu-
merable ways. Yanagi’s major writings are collected in ten volumes.
The third great figure in the early development of folklore studies in Japan
was Orikuchi Shinobu. Orikuchi, a scholar of classical Japanese literature and a
poet, focused his folklore studies on literary-philological approaches; that is, in
many ways he was continuing in the kokugaku tradition. Orikuchi’s approach has
often been said to be the opposite of Yanagita’s because Orikuchi studied ancient
sources first and then searched for modern remnants, while Yanagita began with
the present tradition and then tried to relate it to the past. His major works are
collected in eighteen volumes.
During the Pacific War (1937–1945), it was difficult for most scholars to
undertake serious research. The government encouraged folklorists to continue
their work, however, because it was seen as an investigation of the Japanese spirit,
which the government was interested in promoting for the war effort. Some folk-
lorists were also sent overseas, especially to Korea and China, to conduct field-
work among the subjected peoples. During this period of military expansionist
policies in Asia, folklore—in particular folk narrative—was put to use by the gov-
ernment to further its policies. One of the most prominent examples is the use of
the famous folktale of Momotaro (Peach Boy), who is born into humble origins,
grows up to be a paragon of virtue and filial piety, and with some animal helpers
encounters and defeats some ogres and devils who are plaguing the virtuous peas-
ants. Making the connection between Momotaro and the Japanese, who were
attempting to free enslaved Asians from the American and European imperialist
powers, and between the ogres and devils and the imperialist West, was easy.
The thought of Yanagita, Yanagi, and Orikuchi dominated Japanese folklore
studies through the 1960s and beyond. One of the major problems for later scholars
was distancing themselves from these founders without appearing to disrespect
their life’s work. The collection and analysis of folklore materials in the twentieth
century focused on a number of areas. One main area of interest was oral
Japanese Folklore | 737
References
Addiss, Stephen, ed. 1985. Japanese Ghosts and Demons: Art of the Supernatural.
New York: George Braziller.
Anderson, Richard W. 1995a. Social Drama and Iconicity: Personal Narratives in
Japanese New Religions. Journal of Folklore Research 32(3): 177 205.
Anderson, Richard W. 1995b. Vengeful Ancestors and Animal Spirits: Personal Narra-
tives of the Supernatural in a Japanese New Religion. Western Folklore 54(2): 113 140.
Anderson, Richard W. 1999. Religious Tales and Storytelling in Japan. In Tradi-
tional Storytelling Today: An International Sourcebook, ed. Margaret Read MacDonald.
Chicago: Fitzroy Dearborn Publishers, pp. 114 118.
Araki, James T. 1978. The Ballad-Drama of Medieval Japan. Rutland: Charles E.
Tuttle.
Averbuch, Irit. 1995. The Gods Come Dancing: A Study of the Japanese Ritual
Dance of Yamabushi Kagura. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University East Asia Program.
Averbuch, Irit. 1990. Yamabushi Kagura: A Study of a Traditional Ritual Dance in
Contemporary Japan. Dissertation, Harvard University.
Bargen, Doris G. 1997. A Woman’s Weapon: Spirit Possession in The Tale of Genji.
Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press.
Blacker, Carmen. 1975. The Catalpa Bow: A Study of Shamanistic Practices in Ja-
pan. London: George Allen and Unwin.
Bonnefoy, Yves. 1991. Asian Mythologies, trans. Wendy Doniger. Chicago: Univer-
sity of Chicago Press.
Brandon, Reiko Mochinaga. 1986. Country Textiles of Japan: The Art of Tsutsugaki.
New York: Weatherhill.
Butler, Kenneth Dean. 1969. The Heike Monogatari and the Japanese Warrior Ethic.
Harvard Journal of Asiatic Studies 29: 93 108.
Chingen. 1987. Miraculous Tales of the Lotus Sutra from Ancient Japan: The Daini-
honkoku Hokekyokenki of Priest Chingen, trans. Yoshiko K. Dykstra. Honolulu: Uni-
versity of Hawai’i Press.
Cort, Louise Allison. 1992. Seto and Mino Ceramics: Japanese Collections in the
Freer Gallery of Art. Honolulu: Freer Gallery of Art and University of Hawai’i Press.
Czaja, Michael. 1974. Gods of Myth and Stone: Phallicism in Japanese Folk Reli-
gion. New York: Weatherhill.
de Bary, Wm. Theodore, Donald Keene, George Tanabe, and Paul Varley, eds. 2001.
Sources of Japanese Tradition: From Earliest Times to 1600. 2nd ed. New York: Co-
lumbia University Press.
Dorson, Richard. 1961. Folk Legends of Japan. Rutland: Charles E. Tuttle.
Gordon, Andrew, ed. 1993. Postwar Japan as History. Berkeley: University of Cali-
fornia Press.
Guttman, Allen, and Lee Thompson. 2001. Japanese Sports: A History. Honolulu:
University of Hawai’i Press.
Heineken, Ty, and Kiyoko Heineken. 1981. Tansu: Traditional Japanese Cabinetry.
New York: Weatherhill.
Japanese Folklore | 739
Hori, Ichiro. 1968. Folk Religion in Japan, eds. Joseph M. Kitagawa and Alan L.
Miller. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Ikeda, Hiroko. 1971. A Type and Motif Index of Japanese Folk-Literature. Helsinki:
Folklore Fellows Communications No. 209.
Inoue, Shun. 1998. The Invention of the Martial Arts: Kano Jigoro and Kodokan
Judo. In Mirror of Modernity: Invented Traditions of Modern Japan, ed. Stephen Vlas-
tos. Berkeley: University of California Press, pp. 163 173.
Itoh, Teiji. 1973. Kura: Design and Tradition of the Japanese Storehouse. Seattle:
Madrona Publishers.
Ivy, Marilyn. 1995. Discourses of the Vanishing: Modernity, Phantasm, Japan. Chi-
cago: University of Chicago Press.
Japanese Folk Crafts Museum, ed. 1991. Mingei: Masterpieces of Japanese Folk-
craft. Tokyo: Kodansha International.
Joly, Henri L. [1908] 1967. Legend in Japanese Art: A Description of Historical Epi-
sodes, Legendary Characters, Folk-Lore, Myths, Religious Symbolism Illustrated in the
Arts of Old Japan. Rutland: Charles E. Tuttle.
Kawashima, Chuji. 1986. Minka: Traditional Houses of Rural Japan, trans. Lynne E.
Riggs. Tokyo: Kodansha International.
Koschmann, J. Victor, Oiwa Keibo, and Yamashita Shinji, eds. 1985. International
Perspectives on Yanagita Kunio and Japanese Folklore Studies. Ithaca, NY: Cornell
University China-Japan Program.
Kyokai. 1973. Miraculous Stories from the Japanese Buddhist Tradition: The Nihon
Ryoiki of the Monk Kyokai, trans. Kyoko Moromochi Nakamura. Cambridge: Harvard
University Press.
Levy, Dana, Lea Sneider, and Frank Gibney. 1983. Kanban: Shop Signs of Japan.
New York: Weatherhill.
Lock, Margaret M. 1980. East Asian Medicine in Urban Japan. Berkeley: University
of California Press.
Malm, William P. 2001. Traditional Japanese Music and Musical Instruments. To-
kyo: Kodansha International.
Mayer, Fanny Hagin, ed. and trans. 1985. Ancient Tales in Modern Japan.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
McCullough, Helen Craig, trans. 1988. The Tale of the Heike. Stanford: Stanford
University Press.
Miyake, Hitoshi. 1972. Folk Religion. In Japanese Religion: A Survey by the Agency
for Cultural Affairs, eds. Hori Ichiro, Ikado Fujio, Wakimoto Tsuneya, and Yanagawa
Keiichi. Tokyo: Kodansha International. pp. 121 143.
Moeran, Brian D. 1981. Yanagi Muneyoshi and the Japanese Folk Craft Movement.
Asian Folklore Studies 40: 87 100.
Moeran, Brian D. 1984. Lost Innocence: Folk Craft Potters of Onta, Japan. Berke-
ley: University of California Press.
Muju, Ichien. 1985. Sand and Pebbles (Shasekishu): The Tales of Muju Ichien, A
Voice for Pluralism in Kamakura Buddhism, trans. Robert E. Morrell. Albany: State
University of New York Press.
740 | Jewelry
Mullins, Mark R., Shimazono Susumu, and Paul L. Swanson, eds. 1993. Religion
and Society in Modern Japan. Berkeley: Asian Humanities Press.
Murasaki, Shikibu. 1982. The Tale of Genji, trans. Edward G. Seidensticker. New
York: Knopf.
Reader, Ian, and George J. Tanabe. 1998. Practically Religious: Worldly Benefits
and the Common Religion of Japan. Honolulu: University of Hawai’i Press.
Sasakura, Gensho. 1987. Tsutsugaki Textiles of Japan. Kyoto: Shikosha.
Seki, Keigo. 1966. Types of Japanese Folktales. Asian Folklore Studies 25: 1 220.
Seki, Keigo, ed. 1963. Folktales of Japan. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Shimazaki, Chifumi. 1993. Warrior Ghost Plays from the Japanese Noh Theater.
Ithaca, NY: Cornell University East Asia Program.
Shimazaki, Chifumi. 1995. Restless Spirits from Japanese Noh Plays of the Fourth
Group. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University East Asia Program.
Smith, Robert J. 1974. Ancestor Worship in Contemporary Japan. Stanford: Stanford
University Press.
Thompson, Lee A. 1998. The Invention of the Yokuzuna and the Championship
System, Or, Futahaguro’s Revenge. In Mirror of Modernity: Invented Traditions of
Modern Japan, ed. Stephen Vlastos. Berkeley: University of California Press. 174 187.
Ury, Marian. 1979. Tales of Times Now Past: Sixty-Two Stories from a Medieval
Japanese Collection. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Vlastos, Stephen, ed. 1998. Mirror of Modernity: Invented Traditions of Modern Ja-
pan. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Yamamoto, Yoshiko. 1978. The Namahage: A Festival in the Northeast of Japan.
Philadelphia: Institute for the Study of Human Issues.
Yanagi, Soetsu. 1972. The Unknown Craftsman: A Japanese Insight into Beauty.
Tokyo: Kodansha International.
Yanagita, Kunio. 1957. Japanese Manners and Customs in the Meiji Era, trans.
Charles S. Terry. Tokyo: Obunsha.
Yanagita, Kunio. 1986. The Yanagita Kunio Guide to the Japanese Folk Tale, ed.
and trans. Fanny Hagin Mayer. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Jewelry
culturally significant objects. Then jewelry enters its second cycle of creation, in
which men and women use the item in producing an assemblage, a personally
meaningful ensemble of clothing and ornaments that is worn on various social
occasions. Makers and wearers express themselves and their cultures through the
vehicle of jewelry. All reveal personal aesthetic standards and shared cultural
values as they seek approval. The maker wants to sell the piece; the wearer
wishes to be admired.
Jewelry is beautiful to make and wear, and it has vital social functions. One is
the amassing and displaying of wealth to achieve status. Buried jewelry discov-
ered archaeologically signals the dead of high rank, as in the gold of Pre-Colum-
bian America and the valuable stones of ancient Egypt. European paintings
portray monarchs in precious ornaments. Many items of jewelry are owned but
never worn; they are stockpiled, kept for a moment of distress and financial need,
or passed on as heirlooms, connecting generations and families.
In many parts of the world, jewelry, as part of the dowry, functions to secure a
daughter’s marriage through the gift of wealth, and to secure the daughter’s
social position in her new home. In India, the dowry customarily consists of
presents for the new household, such as furniture or appliances, but it also
includes jewelry for the bride, the best pieces to be worn during the marriage cer-
emony. This jewelry is kept for the duration of the woman’s life, and it may be
recycled to provide a dowry for her daughter. In this case, items of adornment
are usually melted down; the daughter receives new, currently fashionable pieces
made from the mother’s old-fashioned ornaments. Jewelry has the symbolic
function of unifying two families and two individuals in marriage, and it func-
tions to communicate wealth, providing a source of economic security, showcas-
ing the generosity and good taste of the giver, the good fortune of the recipient.
Due to its durability, sturdy construction, and permanent materials, jewelry is
one item of material culture—and of personal adornment—that lasts through the
decades and centuries, and contemporary jewelry often makes reference to its his-
torical context. For example, Varanasi (Banaras), in northeastern India, an impor-
tant Hindu pilgrimage site, boasts thousands of craftsmen who shape ornaments in
gold and precious stones. Most of these jewelers are Hindu men, yet their work cel-
ebrates the splendors of the Muslim Mughal past. Old items on display at museums
and new ones made today exhibit the kundan setting—gemstones placed on a back-
ing of beaten gold or silver and enveloped with incised ribbons of pure gold. On
the back of these sumptuous ornaments one finds the pink enameling—gulabi
mina–for which the city is famous. Both of these techniques speak of the impor-
tance of Banaras today as a nexus for the maintenance of traditional crafts, and both
preserve the Muslim aesthetic in the production of items of personal adornment.
Another example is Navajo silver in the southwestern United States. The Navajo
learned the craft of silversmithing in the mid-nineteenth century from Mexican
742 | Jewelry
smiths who worked in a Spanish style. Later in that century, they developed a way
of making beads from silver coins. The skills combine in the famous squash blos-
som necklace with its crescent pendant, the naja, a protective symbol used by the
Muslims in Spain. A squash blossom necklace, handmade today and sold at Indian
markets throughout the country, celebrates its historical and cultural influences,
and the mastery and innovation in the art of the Navajo people.
The protective function of jewelry is central to its symbolic power. Items of
jewelry, whether crafted of metal, stone, or beads, often served as amulets. In the
Middle East, blue beads adorn all who need protection—babies, women and
men, as well as horses, sheep, and houses. Beads in specific colors and combina-
tions provide the wearer with the protection of the orisas in Africa, and in Cuba,
Haiti, and Brazil.
In many cultures, items of jewelry represent the sacrament of marriage—con-
doned by religion and imbued with supernatural blessings. In the United States,
it is the wedding band; in India, bangles or the manglasutra necklace serve to
mark a woman as married. In Scandinavian folk dress, the silver brooch, worn by
the bride, protected her from supernatural beings and fairies. This brooch tradi-
tionally carries the motif of a heart and a crown, representing love crowned by
the sacrament. The crown and heart motif, found on brooches in Scandinavia
and Scotland, is flanked by hands on the claddagh ring worn by Irish and Irish
American men and women as a symbol of national pride and historical and geo-
graphic connection. This popular ring, like many items of jewelry, is simultaneously
beautiful, socially meaningful, historically charged, and symbolically evocative.
Pravina Shukla
See Also Art, Folk; Material Culture.
Jewish Folktales | 743
References
Dubin, Lois Sherr. 1999. North American Indian Jewelry and Adornment: From Pre-
history to the Present. New York: Harry N. Abrams, Inc.
Gilbertson, Laurann. 1999. To Ward off Evil: Metal on Norwegian Folk Dress. In Folk
Dress in Europe and Anatolia, ed. Linda Welters. Oxford: Berg Publishers: 199 210.
McCourt, Malachy. 2004. Claddagh Ring. Philadelphia, PA: Running Press.
Shukla, Pravina. 2008. The Grace of Four Moons: Dress, Adornment, and the Art of
the Body in Modern India. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Jewish Folktales
An exceptional feature of the Jewish folktale is that part of the corpus has been
preserved in writing since the biblical era. Although these stories—found in the
Bible, Apocrypha, rabbinic literature, and medieval texts—have been edited,
they are readily identifiable as folktales for a number of reasons: there are fre-
quently multiple versions of the same story; they employ the typical poetics of
folk literature; and they belong to folk literary genres.
Ethnographic transcription of Jewish folktales for documentary and scholarly
purposes did not begin until the nineteenth century, under the influence of ideo-
logical currents in Europe such as Romanticism and nationalism. The fact that
these tales have been preserved in writing for so many generations enables in-
depth historical research of the Jewish folktale.
The most prominent genre in the Bible is the myth (the creation stories); how-
ever, we also encounter foundation stories, naming stories, and legends, such as
those of the patriarchs in Genesis and of the prophets in the Book of Kings. There
are legendary elements in the book of Jonah and the book of Job. The parable is
represented by that of Jotham (Judg. 9.6–20), the story of the poor man’s ewe
lamb (2 Sam. 12.1–4), and Jehoash of Israel’s story of the thistle and the cedar
(2 Kings 14.8–11; 2 Chron. 25.17–19). There are also novellas, including the judg-
ment of Solomon (1 Kings 3.16–27), the Joseph story, and the book of Esther.
treated, in the materials used, and in the literary genres. Here we can mention
stories that expand on biblical accounts and praise-tale cycles (for example, the
stories of Daniel). Some of the stories, however, do not have biblical antecedents,
although they later became patterns of Jewish folk literature. These include the
narratives of coping with life in the Diaspora, which tell of the deliverance of a
Jewish community and the doom of those who sought to destroy it. This pattern
can be traced back to the book of Esther, but here it is significantly expanded.
There are also two stories whose heroines became the archetypes for women in
times of persecution: the story of the mother and her seven sons, recounted in
two versions in the Books of Maccabees (2 Macc. 7 and 4 Macc. 8–15), whose
heroine became the archetype of the mother who dies a martyr’s death; and
Judith, who became the model for female bravery in times of persecution.
of their folklore origins, as are the elements of folk-literature poetics that inform
them. In some, one can clearly discern the influence of the folk literature of neigh-
boring peoples, and especially Babylonian and Persian motifs.
historical novel typical of the period. Another historical composition is the Megi-
lat Ahima’az (Scroll of Ahima’az), a family chronicle written by Ahima’az ben
Paltiel in southern Italy in the eleventh century. The Sefer Ha’Zikhronot (Book of
Memoirs), produced in Germany in the early fourteenth century, is a Jewish folk
history running from the Creation until the End of Days. Shalshelet ha-kabbalah
(The Chain of Tradition) by Gedaliah ben Joseph Ibn Yahya (Italy, sixteenth cen-
tury), makes extensive use of hagiographic legends in its presentation of the
annals of Torah scholars from the earliest times to the author’s own day.
Animal fables and parables were also popular genres in the Middle Ages. They
can be found in various works, of which the most important is the Mishlei shua-
lim (Fox Parables) of Berechiah ben Natronai the Punctuator (thirteenth century).
the Mitteilungenf€ ur j€
udische Volkskunde, from 1898 to 1922. In Eastern Europe,
the collection of folk materials began in the nineteenth century and accelerated
in the early twentieth century. Between 1912 and 1914, the first ethnographic
expedition, headed by S. An-Ski (Solomon Zainwil Rapaport), traveled through
the small towns of Volhynia and Podolia collecting folk materials, including
folktales. A group of transcribers led by Noah Prylucki, who was inspired by the
author J. L. Peretz, was active in Warsaw. The institution that collected folktales
most intensively was YIVO, the Jewish Scientific Institute, established in 1920.
Many of its treasures were lost during the Holocaust; some are now housed at the
YIVO Institute for Jewish Research in New York City.
In Israel, Dov Noy founded the Israel Folktale Archives in Haifa in 1955.
Housed today at the University of Haifa, its holdings of 23,000 tales constitute
the largest single collection of Jewish folktales in the world.
One of the unusual traits of Jewish folktales is their polyglot existence. Jews
generally told their stories in the vernacular of their own community—Yiddish,
Judezmo (Ladino), Judeo-Arabic, and so on. Jewish folktales include all of the
genres found in the poetics of folk literature. The topics are diverse: there are
accounts of the relations between Jews and Gentiles, deliverance from blood
libels, martyrdom, and so forth; stories about Jewish settlements in various coun-
tries and the founding of major Jewish communities there; legends about holy
men, ghosts, and demons; ethical principles such as charity, and the ritual pre-
cepts between human beings and God and the social precepts governing relations
among people; and stories about festivals and life-cycle ceremonies, including
circumcision, bar mitzvah, marriage, burial, and the comforting of mourners.
International wonder tales have also penetrated the corpus. The holdings of
the Israel Folktale Archives include many of these. Sometimes, distinctly Jewish
elements have penetrated these global stories, in the person of King Solomon,
the prophet Elijah, and so on. Sometimes the plot format is modified to create a
Jewish oikotype. Another interesting phenomenon is the alteration that takes
place in an international wonder tale when it is transmuted from a M€ archen into
a Jewish legend.
Modern Israel is developing its own ethnic culture. The folktales of the various
groups of immigrants draw on the stories they have brought with them from their
countries of origin, but in Israel they are substantially transformed by the new
culture. In addition, new stories of immigration and social integration are created
to express the encounter with Israeli landscapes, food, other Jewish groups, and
Arab society. The emerging myths of Israeli society constitute another important
genre. These are the ‘‘big’’ cultural stories that seek to reinforce the glue that
holds the new society together. They include stories about the defense of Tel
Hai, the Masada narrative, the Tower and Stockade settlements, the submarine
Dakar, and others. Place stories have also been created. These focus on the early
Jewish Folktales | 749
days of Zionist settlement and are linked with local personalities. Kibbutz stories
are central to this category.
Israeli culture also has many humorous stories, jests, and jokes. Scholars compare
them to the humor of Jews in the diaspora. The most thoroughly studied form of the
Israeli humorous tale is the Palmach chizbat. These are humorous tales that are iden-
tified with Palmach, the elite military units of the Jewish underground during the last
years of the British mandate in Palestine. According to the popular image, the stories
were told in the evenings, around the campfire as members of the Palmach enter-
tained themselves. With the publication of a collection of these tales, this genre came
to symbolize quintessential Israeli humor. However, the term is borrowed from dia-
lectical Palestinian Arabic, in which it is the feminine plural form of the word
chizba, a lie. Although the stories include, in addition to original tales, Hebrew ver-
sions of Arabic, traditional Jewish tales, and internationally known narratives, they
express the symbols and views of Israeli youth in their attempt to distance them-
selves from the cultural heritage of the diaspora. The chizbat is always associated
with Israeli reality, often containing a grain of truth. It deals with real events and real
people who are familiar to the narrating society. Its language is Hebrew, interspersed
with words in Arabic, Yiddish, Russian, and English. After the establishment of the
state of Israel, there was a marked decline in the narration of these tales, although a
popularly published additional collection purported to prove the opposite. In the
transformation of the genre, the narration situation remained, but its content
changed, and the term refers to horror stories told by teenagers around the campfire.
Haya Bar-Itzhak
See Also Ethnic Folklore; Folktale; Religion, Folk.
References
Bar-Itzhak, Haya. 2005. Israeli Folk Narratives: Settlement, Immigration, Ethnicity.
Detroit: Wayne State University Press.
Bar-Itzhak, Haya, and Aliza Shenhar. 1993. Jewish Moroccan Folk Narratives from
Israel. Detroit: Wayne State University Press.
Ben-Amos, Dan, ed. 1970. In Praise of the Baal Shem Tov [Shivh: ei ha-Besht]: The
Earliest Collection of Legends about the Founder of Hasidism, trans. Jerome R. Mintz.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Ben-Amos, Dan, ed. 1992. Jewish Folktales. Jewish Folklore and Ethnology Review
14(1 2): 3 25.
Ben-Amos, Dan. 1999. Jewish Folk Literature. Oral Tradition 14(1): 140 274. http://
journal.oraltradition.org/issues/14i/ben-amos.
Ben-Amos, Dan, ed. 2006. Folktales of the Jews. Philadelphia: Jewish Publication
Society.
Gaster, Moses, trans. and ed. 1934. Ma’asseh Book: Book of Jewish Tales and
Legends. 2 vols. Philadelphia: Jewish Publication Society of America.
750 | Joke
Hasan-Rokem, Galit. 2000. The Web of Life: Folklore and Midrash in Rabbinic Lit-
erature. Trans. Batya Stein. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.
Noy, Dov, and Dan Ben-Amos, eds. 1963. The Folktales of Israel. Trans. Gene
Baharav. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Oring, Elliott. 1981. Israeli Humor: The Content and Structure of the Chizbat of the
Palmah. Albany: State University of New York Press.
Yassif, Eli. 1999. The Hebrew Folktale: History, Genre, Meaning. Trans. Jacqueline
S. Teitelbaum. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Joke
question of why jokes are funny by focusing on linguistic and semantic inap-
propriateness: the use of exaggeration and distortion, misdirection, paradox, dou-
ble entendre, the disclosure of hidden similarities between dissimilar things, and
the linking of that which is pragmatically plausible and that which is not. In other
words, jokes play with forms of textual and extra-textual incongruity and the tenu-
ous resolution of such incongruities. Two formulations of the cognitive-perceptual
approach are Victor Raskin’s ‘‘semantic script-based theory’’ and Arthur Koes-
tler’s ‘‘bisociation theory.’’ Raskin, for example, proposes that each joke evokes
culturally extant linguistic scripts (a reference to language and its nuances) and
nonlinguistic scripts (pragmatic or ‘‘encyclopedic’’ knowledge of the culture),
which are in some way opposite to each other. Humor is thus explained in terms
of the performer’s ability to play on these scripts and the audience’s ability to
decode the (in)appropriate relationship between the scripts evoked by the perfor-
mance. Similarly, Koestler argues that humor results when a situation, experience,
or idea is associated or bisociated with ‘‘two self-consistent but habitually incom-
patible frames of reference.’’ But rather than arguing for an aesthetic resolution,
Koestler foregrounds the ways in which jokes creatively ‘‘vibrate simultaneously
on two different wavelengths.’’ Humor is thus the product of the slippage between
otherwise disassociated contexts. Christie Davies applies Raskin’s theory to ethnic
jokes, particularly those told by dominant groups about subordinate groups:
Americans about Poles, the French about Belgians, Mexicans about Regiomontanos,
the English about Scots, Indians about Sikhs, Greeks about Pontians, Brazilians
about the Portuguese, and eastern Canadians about Newfoundlanders. And Kenneth
Lincoln uses Koestler’s theory to analyze bicultural play in Native American humor.
Although cognitive-perceptual theorists address incongruity in order to explain
why jokes are humorous, sociobehavioral theorists examine joking relationships
in order to identify social structure (kin-based joking relationships in preindustrial
societies and such non-kin-based joking relationships as small-group formations
based on friendship or work in industrial society) and to explain the purposes that
joking serves, for example, how ‘‘social structure is linked to life processes’’
through actual joking performances. Anthropologists, as Mahadev Apte notes,
have explained how joking releases sexual and aggressive impulses, provides
emotional catharsis and communication, establishes social etiquette, enhances
and defines small-group identity, releases work-related tension, and enables social
bonding and an exploration of closeness or intimacy in social relations. R. H.
Lowie was, for instance, among the first anthropologists to suggest that joking
functions as a form of social control—in other words, that jokes enculturate peo-
ple within extant power relations. A. R. Radcliffe-Brown has argued that by serv-
ing as a means to reduce hostility, release tension, and avoid conflict, joking
enhances social harmony and stability. And Mary Douglas, though acknowledg-
ing that jokes are a form of ‘‘permitted disrespect,’’ has disclosed the ways in
Joke | 753
which jokes provide ‘‘an image of the leveling of hierarchy, the triumph of inti-
macy over formality, of unofficial values over official ones.’’ As Lincoln explains,
‘‘it could be that jokes disorganize the monostructures of society in order to reor-
ganize a static and suspect order into polymorphous, kinetic ‘play.’’’
Whereas sociobehavioral approaches examine joking relationships in order to
theorize social relations, psychoanalytic and related ‘‘release’’ theories explore
suppression/repression in respect to the individual psyche. Arguing that all peo-
ple operate under constraints to think, speak, and act in certain ways, release the-
ories suggest that laughter ‘‘provides relief from mental, nervous and/or psychic
energy and thus ensures homeostasis after a struggle, tension, strain, etc.’’
(Lincoln 1993). Thus, Freud suggests that the ‘‘pleasure in jokes has seemed to
us to arise from an economy in expenditure upon inhibition,’’ or, as others also
argue, ‘‘our sense of humor frees us from the chains of our perceptual, conven-
tional, logical, linguistic, and moral systems.’’ Freud further explains that when
‘‘a joke is not an aim in itself—that is, where it is not an innocent one—there are
only two purposes that it may serve, and these two can themselves be sub-sumed
under a single heading. It is either a hostile joke (serving the purpose of aggres-
siveness, satire, or defense) or an obscene joke (serving the purpose of expo-
sure).’’ Martha Wolfenstein’s Children’s Humor: A Psychological Analysis and
Gershon Legman’s No Laughing Matter: An Analysis of Sexual Humor apply the
psychoanalytic approach, respectively, to the jokes of children and of adult
males. Alan Dundes and Roger Abrahams have drawn on Freudian analysis to
theorize racial and sexual displacement and aggression in the American elephant
joke cycle that was popular in the 1960s. And in a reflexive turn, Elliott Oring’s
Jokes of Sigmund Freud: A Study in Humor and Jewish Identity examines Jewish
identity through an analysis of Freud’s favorite jokes.
Although Freudian analysis has been productively applied to male joking pat-
terns, other theories, women argue, need to be explored in order to address
female joking. One possibility is suggested by a turn to Jacques Lacan and the
French feminists (Helene Cixous, Luce Irigaray, and Julia Kristeva) influenced
by Lacan’s description of Western discourse as ‘‘phallogocentric’’ (centered and
organized through the symbolic phallus). Phallogocentrism, Lacan argues, mani-
fests itself in Western discourse in terms of vocabulary and syntax, rules of logic,
inclination toward fixed classifications and oppositions, and paradigms equating
validity and objectivity. In order to counter phallogocentrism, French feminists
urge women to turn to their own bodies and, like their American counterparts, to
their own experiences in order to define and redefine female realities. This is,
Regina Barreca argues, exactly what women do when they tell jokes. Thus, as
Cathy Preston, discussing a bawdy Cinderella joke, has noted, ‘‘just as our bodies
may be said to laugh at our attempts to control and thereby erase them, so, when
we tell the joke, we laugh at cultural attempts to control and thereby erase us.’’
754 | Jungian Psychology
References
Apte, Mahadev L. 1985. Humor and Laughter: An Anthropological Approach.
Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Barreca, Regina. 1991. They Used to Call Me Snow White . . . but I Drifted: Wom-
en’s Strategic Use of Humor. New York: Penguin.
Bennett, Gillian, ed. 1991. Spoken in Jest. Sheffield, England: Sheffield Academic
Press.
Davies, Christie. 1990. Ethnic Humor around the World: A Comparative Analysis.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1987. Cracking Jokes: Studies of Sick Humor Cycles and Stereotypes.
Berkeley, CA: Ten Speed Press.
Freud, Sigmund. [1905] 1960. Jokes and Their Relationship to the Unconscious.
New York: Norton.
Green, Archie. 1993. Boss, Workman, Wife: Sneaking-Home Tales. Journal of
American Folklore 106: 156 170.
Green, Rayna. [1977] 1990. ‘‘Magnolias Grow in Dirt’’: The Bawdy Lore of South-
ern Women. In Calling Home: Working-Class Women’s Writings, An Anthology, ed.
Janet Zandy. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.
Lincoln, Kenneth. 1993. Indi’n Humor: Bicultural Play in Native America. New
York: Oxford University Press.
Oring, Elliott, ed. 1984. Humor and the Individual. Los Angeles: California Folklore
Society.
Preston, Cathy Lynn. 1994. ‘‘Cinderella’’ as a Dirty Joke: Gender, Multivocality, and
the Polysemic Text. Western Folklore 53: 27 49.
Jungian Psychology
perspective than that of Freud by including spiritual and futuristic factors; it also
interpreted disruptive emotional processes in the individual as a search for
wholeness, termed individuation.
Jung, the son of a Protestant cleric, showed from childhood an inclination toward
solitude, daydreaming, and imaginative thinking; he also admired archaeology and
hoped to make it his career (but ended up studying medicine and related sciences).
These early tendencies greatly influenced his adult work. After graduating in medi-
cine in 1902, Jung developed a diagnostic system in which patients were asked to
respond to stimulus words; this technique of ‘‘word association’’ revealed the pres-
ence of what Jung called ‘‘complexes.’’ This novel approach became widely
adopted and led to a close collaboration with Freud, whose book The Interpretation
of Dreams (1900) Jung had read. Subsequently, Jung became one of Freud’s disci-
ples and proteges; Freud referred to him as the ‘‘crown prince.’’
However, a divergence of views began to grow between the two after a fairly short
period of formal association. Perhaps the most basic points of disagreement between
Freud and Jung focused on the nature of libido (psychic energy or instinctual mani-
festations that tend toward life) and the structure of the psyche (mind or personality).
Their differences became pronounced with the publication of Jung’s Psychology of
the Unconscious, in which he deemphasized the role of sex and expressed a different
view of the biological force Freud had labeled the libido. Jung continued on this in-
dependent path, and his break with Freud, whom he still admired, became total in
1914. During the next 47 years, Jung cultivated his own theories, drawing on a wide
knowledge of religion, mythology, history, and non-European cultures; he observed
native cultures in Asia (India), North America (New Mexico), and Africa (Kenya)
and found his own dreams and the fantasies of his childhood to be quite relevant
to the cultures he was observing. In 1921, he published Psychological Types, in
which he dealt with the relationship between the conscious and unconscious and pro-
posed the ‘‘extrovert’’ and the ‘‘introvert’’ personality types.
Whereas Freud saw the libido in predominantly sexual and ‘‘savage’’ terms,
Jung perceived the libido to be generalized life energy, with biological-sexual
drives constituting only one of its parts. Jung saw this energy as expressing itself
in growth and reproduction, as well as in other kinds of human activities depend-
ing on the social and cultural milieu. Thus, according to Jung, libidinal energy in
the presexual phase (3 to 5 years of age) is basically asexual; it serves the func-
tions of nutrition and growth—not the Oedipal complex, as Freud postulated.
Conflict and rivalries develop among siblings dependent on a mother for the sat-
isfaction of such basic needs as food and safety. As the child matures, these
essentially nonsexual needs become overlaid with sexual functions. Libidinal
energy takes a heterosexual form only after puberty.
With reference to the structure of personality, Jung saw the psyche, or mind,
as consisting of three levels: the personal conscious, the personal unconscious,
756 | Jungian Psychology
and the collective unconscious. Like a small island in the ocean, the tip visible
above the water corresponds to the personal conscious, the submerged portion
that can be seen corresponds to the personal unconscious, and the invisible foun-
dation that connects the island to the earth’s crust corresponds to the collective
unconscious. This paradigm reflects the influence of archaeological stratigraphy
on Jung’s worldview.
Jung’s approach to therapy may be seen as holistic; it rests on a rationale of
showing the close parallels between ancient myths and psychotic fantasies and
explaining human motivation in terms of a larger creative energy. He aimed at
reconciling the diverse states of personality, which he saw as being divided into
the introvert-extrovert polarity mentioned earlier, as well as into the four func-
tions of sensing, intuiting, feeling, and thinking. And by understanding how the
personal unconscious is unified with the collective unconscious, a patient can
achieve a state of individuation, or wholeness of self.
Hasan El-Shamy
See Also Archetype; Psychological Approach.
References
Adler, Gerhard. 1948. Studies in Analytical Psychology. New York: W. W. Norton.
El-Shamy, H. 1980. Folktales of Egypt. Chicago: University of Chicago.
Jung, C. G., and C. Kerenyi. 1969. Essays on a Science of Mythology. Trans. R. F.
C. Hull. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Progoff, Ira. 1953. Jung’s Psychology and Its Social Meaning. New York: Grove.
Schultz, Duane. 1987. A History of Modern Psychology. New York: Academic.
K
King Arthur
757
758 | King Arthur
References
Alcock, Leslie. 1971. Arthur’s Britain: History and Archaeology, AD 367 634. Har-
mondsworth, England: Penguin.
Crossley-Holland, Kevin. 1999. The World of King Arthur and His Court: People,
Places, Legend, and Lore. New York: Dutton Children’s Books.
Geoffrey of Monmouth. 1966. The History of the Kings of Britain. Trans. Lewis
Thorpe. Harmondsworth, England: Penguin.
King Arthur | 759
Gildas. 1978. The Ruin of Britain and Other Works. Ed. and trans. Michael Winter-
bottom. London and Chichester: Phillimore.
Jones, Gwyn, and Thomas Jones, trans. 1949. The Mabinogion. London: Dent; New
York: Dutton.
Malory, Sir Thomas, 1966. Le Morte d’Arthur. Ed. Norma Lorre Goodrich. New
York: Washington Square Press.
L
Language, Play
761
762 | Language, Secret
targets of such verbal forms. Similes, exaggerations, metaphors, adult retorts, and
Wellerisms all add color and texture to the basic requirement of communication.
The vast array, universally attested, of riddles and related traditions demon-
strates the pleasure humans always have found in the clever use of language and
its ability to express realities in unusual and striking ways. Particularly appealing
to young adults may be the pretended obscene riddle (which suggests an off-
color answer while having a bland solution in reality), but the most commonly
appealing form of riddle is undoubtedly that based on a pun. Indeed, puns and
punning, which clearly attest to a conscious awareness of the play potential of
speech, permeate jokes, riddling questions, and, indeed, ordinary conversation.
Gerald Thomas
See Also Children’s Folklore; Games, Folk.
References
Opie, Iona, and Peter Opie. 1959. The Lore and Language of Schoolchildren.
Oxford: Clarendon.
Taylor, Archer. 1951. English Riddles from Oral Tradition. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Taylor, Archer. 1962. The Proverb and an Index to the Proverb. Hatboro, PA: Folk-
lore Associates.
Language, Secret
Language that allows its speakers to communicate with each other without being
understood by noninitiates, that is, by people with whom its speakers come into
contact on a more or less regular basis but from whom certain kinds of informa-
tion must be withheld.
The earliest forms of secret language are found in magical formulas, the eso-
teric languages of primitive initiation rites, and passwords in secret societies—in
other words, where the language functions as a barrier between insiders and out-
siders. This function has been nowhere better documented than in the language
of the criminal underworld. Indeed, the word jargon, now used to refer to the
technical language of a trade or profession, was originally used to refer to the se-
cret language of twelfth-century French criminals.
There is, however, a crucial difference between the jargon of doctors, nurses,
hospital workers, airline pilots, military personnel, and members of other such
legitimate occupations and the language of the criminal underworld. The former
terminology arises out of the technical complexities of everyday life but is not
usually used with the intent of deliberately deceiving or misleading the general
public; the latter, by contrast, has been used both as a class badge and as a means
Latino Folklore | 763
of masking the true meaning of its discourse to potential victims. This intent has
long been documented by the police of numerous countries, and those who use
such languages have given them precise names. Thus, the terms Rotwelsch (in
Germany), argot (in France), furbesco (in Italy), germania (in Spain), and cant
(in England) have all been used at different times to designate the language of
the criminal classes. Likewise, in Germany, France, Spain, and England, Latin
has also been used for the same purpose, an echo of which is to be found in the
term pig latin often used by children in English-speaking countries to refer to
their own brands of secret talk.
Two chief principles govern the formation of secret languages. The first
involves the change of meanings for words that exist in the standard language, of-
ten by reliance on metaphorical processes, as when ‘‘automobile’’ is referred to as
one’s ‘‘wheels’’ or ‘‘to kill’’ is rendered as ‘‘to chill.’’ The second principle is that
of a change in the form of words, usually by means of a code. This is the principle
behind the creation of pig latin, documented with a variety of codes and a variety
of names. A version recorded in South Wales in the 1950s and used by a group of
ten-year-old boys, Eguage, required the addition of the syllable -eg before audible
vowel sounds; in France in the 1960s, teenagers made use of Javanais, involving
the addition of the syllable -av before vowel sounds.
Such secret languages tend to be restricted to youthful peer groups, however,
and the sheer joy of mastering and using the code, especially in front of teachers
or parents, is certainly more important than any criminal design. This was true
for the short-lived Californian language Boontling, which flourished between
1880 and 1920 and was created by young boys. It relied chiefly on the abbrevia-
tion and deformation of words rather than on the addition of syllables.
Gerald Thomas
See Also Children’s Folklore; Esoteric/Exoteric Factor.
References
Adams, Charles C. 1971. Boontling: An American Lingo. Austin: University of Texas
Press.
Berkovits, Rochele. 1970. Secret Languages of Schoolchildren. New York Folklore
Quarterly 26: 127 152.
Guiraud, Pierre. 1969. L’Argot. Paris: Presses Universitaires de France.
Latino Folklore
hold a predawn service called ‘‘Las Ma~nanitas.’’ Mariachi bands visit the church
at 4:00 A.M. to serenade the Virgin with a version of the Mexican birthday song:
‘‘Estas son las ma~nanitas que cantaba el Rey David. Hoy por ser dıa de tu santo,
te las cantamos a ti. Despierta, mi bien despierta, mira que ya amanecio, ya los
pajaritos cantan, la luna ya se metio’’ (This is the song that King David sang.
Today, for your saint’s day, we sing it to you. Wake up, my friend, wake up.
Look it’s already morning. The little birds are already singing. The moon has
gone in.). Such rituals demonstrate the loving familiarity the faithful feel toward
the miraculous Virgin.
Many communities also perform a children’s pageant that reenacts the Vir-
gin’s apparition in 1531, shortly after the conquest. Legend has it that the Virgin
ordered the Indian shepherd Juan Diego to tell the bishop to build her a church
where a temple to the Aztec goddess Tonantzin had stood. She directed him to
pick flowers on an ordinarily barren hill and wrap them in his cloak. When Juan
Diego unfurled the cloak, the authorities found the image of the Virgin imprinted
on the cloth and built the church. The Virgin of Guadalupe is an extremely popu-
lar icon for Latinos/as. Wrapped in a blue cloak decorated with golden stars and
surrounded by a golden halo, she can be seen not only in churches and home
altars but also in or on murals, calendars, T-shirts, and body tattoos.
On the nine nights preceding Christmas, many Latino/a communities host Las
Posadas. These partly chanted play processions reenact Joseph and Mary’s search
for shelter in Bethlehem. Costumed participants travel from house to house
requesting entry, while homeowners ceremoniously refuse to let them in. Finally,
a host admits the group and rewards them with festival foods. On the final night,
Christmas Eve, the performing group reenacts Christ’s birth in the manger. A sim-
ilar tradition from the Southwest is called Los Pastores, the shepherds’ play.
Of course, the growing number of Latino/a Protestants do not participate in re-
ligious customs involving the worship of saints or the Virgin Mary. They may,
however, perform plays from the Protestant tradition, such as The Everyman Play,
where Satan and Jesus battle for a poor sinner’s soul. Protestant churches also
possess their own body of hymns and contemporary religious music in Spanish.
Another Latino/a theater tradition is rooted in the history of Latino/a labor
organizing. These theater groups use improvisational techniques to raise public
consciousness about community problems such as worker exploitation, police
brutality, domestic violence, and alcohol and drug addiction. The United Farm
Workers’ Organizing Committee’s El Teatro Campesino, which initially formed
in Southern California in the mid-1960s, was one of the earliest and most active
of these groups. Latino/a mural art also developed out of earlier social and even
revolutionary movements (see Chicano Mural Movement). The brilliant murals
found in poor and working-class urban barrios document a history of struggle,
contemporary social ills, and ethnic pride. In the late 1980s and 1990s, graffiti
Latino Folklore | 767
writers also began to paint murals using their distinctive graphic style. In large
cities like New York and Philadelphia, these self-taught artists spray-painted elab-
orate memorial walls in remembrance of those who had been murdered in gang
wars. Residents’ attitudes toward these memorial walls were mixed—were they
warnings against or glorifications of gang violence?
Latino/a families celebrate many individual rites of passage, but none has
become so popular as the quincea~ nera, or fifteenth birthday. Once a coming-out
party for the daughters of society families, the ‘‘sweet fifteen’’ party is now a
popular family celebration among all social classes. The young debutante,
accompanied by a court of friends, presides at a formal party that includes danc-
ing and a festive meal. In Puerto Rican neighborhoods, one can find small busi-
nesses devoted to the production of capias, or hand-made party favors for
quincea~ neras and other rites of passage. These favors, assembled from lace, rib-
bon, manufactured plastic ornaments, paper, wire, and other materials, serve as
treasured mementos of important events. Another fixture in Puerto Rican neigh-
borhoods is the casita, small one-room wooden house built in a vacant lot or gar-
den. Casitas serve as retreats for men, who visit and play cards together in these
nostalgic invocations of their rural island homes.
768 | Latino Folklore
Latino/a communities also share a rich tradition of alternate medical beliefs and
practices. The humoral theory of medicine, that is, the notion that illnesses and
cures can be categorized as hot or cold, forms the basis for many home remedies.
According to this theory, a healthy body is warm and moist. A person may become
ill either because she/he experiences a dramatic change in temperature, as would
occur if one took a cold shower immediately after working up a sweat, or by over-
consuming substances categorized as hot or cold. Many Latino/a community mem-
bers consult curanderos (healers), espiritistas (spiritual healers), or santeros
(artisans of religious images) for medical, psychological, and social problems
before or in addition to seeking standard medical treatment. In the Southwest, the
caso, or account of a miraculous healing, is so common that folklorists regard it as
a specific genre of folk narrative. There is even a strong tradition of parody casos,
jokes told by some Latinos/as disparaging the beliefs of others. Certain healers
achieved widespread and long-lasting fame, becoming the subjects of folk legend.
Such was the case of turn-of-the-century south Texan Don Pedro Jaramillo. Rudolfo
Anaya’s novelistic account, in Bless Me, Ultima (1972), of a rural New Mexican
childhood, contains a compelling literary portrait of a Latina curandera. Yet urban
salseros (salsa musicians) also commonly pay tribute to the alternative medicine of
mamis (mothers), abuelitas (grandmothers), and curanderos, as is evident in Eddie
Palmieri’s 1998 composition ‘‘Due~no del Monte’’ (King of the Mountain).
In Latino communities of Caribbean origin, an individual may visit a bot anica,
a kind of alternative pharmacy that offers both spiritual and herbal supplies.
There she may consult a spiritualist, a person who communes with the dead to
advise clients on personal or medical problems. Spiritualism is a nineteenth-cen-
tury religion that continues to have followers in both Anglo-American and Latin
American communities. Alternately, a devotee of santerıa may visit a santero
for advice or ritual cure. Santerıa is an African-derived religion that involves
divination, spirit possession, and a strong respect for nature. Practiced in casas,
or houses, outside the Catholic Church, santerıa has its own priests and rituals.
Yet practitioners see no conflict between their Roman Catholic and santerıa
beliefs. In colonial-era Cuba, enslaved Africans worshipped their orishas
(powers or divine emissaries). Yet they disguised this ‘‘pagan’’ religion by asso-
ciating each orisha with a Catholic saint. Thus, Santa Barbara was identified
with Chango, the Yoruba God of fire and thunder. Today, Latinos/as of many
nationalities embrace santerıa. The film documentary The King Does Not Lie:
The Initiation of a Shango Priest (1992) shows how santerıa is a growing, multi-
racial religion that continues to speak to contemporary human needs.
Latinos/as’ common bilingual experience has led to interesting forms of code-
switching, verbal play, and a great wealth of jokes. Spanish-language jokes main-
tain boundaries not only between Latinos and ‘‘gringos’’ but also between Latinos
who remain outside the mainstream culture and those who are more assimilated.
Latino Folklore | 769
Joking also reinforces class and gender boundaries, as well as interethnic bounda-
ries among different Latino nationalities. For instance, in Miami, newer Nicara-
guan and South American immigrants express hostility toward entrenched
Cubans by making them the butts of their jokes. Joking may equally function to
express solidarity—some Guatemalans in southern Delaware use their native
Maya tongue only to trade jokes on rare occasions when they encounter others
who speak their natal language.
In this television age, one is more likely to find folktales about the idiot-heroes
Pedro de Urdemales and Juan Bobo, or the wiley Tıo Conejo and Tıo Coyote, in
cartoons or in children’s books rather than recited orally. These trickster figures
demonstrate a blatant disregard for custom and morality but often triumph in the
end anyway.
Legends about encounters with the devil, or demonic dogs or pigs, however,
continue to be recounted among friends. One of the most popular revenants is La
Llorona, or the weeping woman, who lingers near bodies of water. Legend has it
that La Llorona either married a man without her parents’ approval or became
pregnant by him before marriage. She had one or more children, whom either she,
their father, or her own father drowned. Subsequently, the young woman went mad
and wandered the countryside weeping for her lost children. She led a dissolute
life, died, went to heaven, and was sent back to earth to search for her children.
The legend has been dramatized repeatedly on television. Poet and novelist Sandra
Cisneros alludes to it in her short story ‘‘Woman Hollering Creek’’ (1991). Singer
Joan Baez takes up the theme in her 1972 song ‘‘La Llorona.’’ Oral transmission
has been equally powerful; teens of many ethnicities and regions today relate their
own strange encounters with the wailing woman.
Another storytelling tradition, the corrido, or ballad, is a narrative song usu-
ally performed with the accompaniment of a guitar. Americo Paredes wrote
extensively both about the corrido and the distinctive new world communities
that produced them (1995). Sung in the language of a dominated group, they pro-
vided a unique perspective on society and history that was rarely voiced in main-
stream U.S. history books or media. For instance, the nineteenth-century Texas
Ranger was romanticized in the Anglo television program The Lone Ranger. For
Tejanos (Texans of Mexican descent) he was a despised tyrannical figure, the
henchman of invading Anglo ranchers. In his influential work With a Pistol in
His Hand (1958), Paredes pieces together existing legends, corridos, and journal-
istic accounts to tell the story of Gregorio Cortez, an honest farmer who fought
the Rangers to protect his land, his family, and his honor.
Today, the enemy that the corrido hero must elude and overcome is more
likely to be a representative of the Immigration and Naturalization Service (INS)
border patrol. A recent corrido, titled ‘‘Superman es ilegal,’’ provides an undocu-
mented immigrant’s perspective on the racism inherent in U.S. immigration
Corrido
Broadside shows a full-length figure of a simply dressed woman with a shawl around her
shoulders and hands on her hips. The song conveys the story of la cucaracha. Cucaracha
literally means cockroach, but during the Mexican Revolution this term was synonymous
with ‘‘camp follower’’ and referred to women who would follow and live with their male part-
ners in the war camps. (Library of Congress)
Latino Folklore | 771
The Mexican American corrido is one of several folkloric expressions that emerged
as a truly native musical and literary form throughout greater Mexico. The corrido
gained a unique status following the 1860s, amid the ongoing and often violent cul-
ture clash between Mexican and Anglo Americans along the lower Rio Grande
Texas–Mexican border area. The historical function of the Mexican corrido has been
described as a social barometer of Mexican attitudes toward events affecting their
lives. Its contents, poetic organization, musical form, and aesthetic history lead to
an alternative interpretation of the nature of violence in Mexican and American
societies as seen through the Mexican’s sense of history, music, and culture. Today
most corridos follow a straightforward, simple narrative format providing a date,
place, exposition, development, and farewell, or despedida. Corridistas (corrido sing-
ers), like their troubadour ancestors, sing about any newsworthy event. Many of
the corridos from the nineteenth and early twentieth century deal with heroes like
revolutionary leaders Pancho Villa and Emiliano Zapata.
Narrative folk ballads of Mexican origin typically have regular metrical features
such as rhyming quatrains (abcb) and use traditional imagery. Those of ‘‘epic
themes’’ typically refer to conflict—sometimes personal, more often social between
men. One important aesthetic feature affecting both structure and style is called
fragmentismo, the process by which fragments of ballads are torn from their con-
text, leaving much unexplained and producing, at times, abrupt beginnings and end-
ings. Of far greater importance than the limited negative and positive female images
is the corrido’s larger gender politics and poetics of exclusion and repression.
Peter J. Garcıa
References
Anaya, Rudolfo. 1972. Bless Me, Ultima. Berkeley, CA: TQS Publications.
Borland, Katherine. 1993. Folklife of Miami’s Nicaraguan Communities. http://www
.historical-museum.org/folklife/folknica.htm.
Cisneros, Sandra. 1991. Woman Hollering Creek and Other Stories. New York:
Random House.
Cooper, Martha, and Joseph Sciorra. 1994. ‘‘R.I.P.’’: Memorial Wall Art. New York:
Thomas and Hudson.
DeBouzek, Jeanette. 1992. Gathering Up Again: The Fiesta of Santa F e. VHS.
Color. 47 min. Albuquerque, NM: Quotidian Independent Documentary Research.
Garcıa, Juan, ed. 1989. Perspectives in Mexican American Studies I: Readings in
Southwestern Folklore, an Anthology. Tucson: University of Arizona Mexican Ameri-
can Studies and Research Center.
Gleason, Judith, and Elisa Mereghetti. 1992. The King Does Not Lie: The Initiation
of a Shango Priest. VHS. 50 min. New York: Filmmakers Library.
Herrera-Sobek, Marıa.1991. Corridos and Canciones of Mica, Migra, and the Coy-
otes: A Commentary on Undocumented Immigration. In Creative Ethnicity: Symbols
and Strategies of Contemporary Ethnic Life, eds. Stephen Stern and John Allan Cicala.
Logan: Utah State University Press.
Lewis, Huw. 2007. A History and Anthology of the Spanish Folktale, with Studies of
Selected Texts. Lewiston: Edwin Mellen Press.
Monta~no, Mary. 2001. Tradiciones nuevomexicanas: Hispano Arts and Culture of
New Mexico. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.
Paredes, Americo. 1958. With His Pistol in His Hand: A Border Ballad and Its Hero.
Austin: University of Texas Press.
Schoemaker, George H., ed. 1990. The Emergence of Folklore in Everyday Life:
A Fieldguide and Sourcebook. Bloomington, IN: Trickster Press.
Legend
Short, oral prose narrative based in the reality of performers and audiences. The
term legend is derived from the Latin word legere (to read); thus, the term origi-
nally labeled a piece of reading, referring to a book containing accounts of the
lives of the saints arranged in the order of the Christian calendar and read on the
saints’ feast days at divine office. The Christian or hagiographic legend (legende
r
eligeuse) as a genre of literature and history can be traced to the times of the
apostles. By the eighth century CE, however, numerous stories about the miracles
of saints had become increasingly apocryphal and, therefore, were omitted from
the official canon of the Christian church. After the division of the one and only
Christian church into a multitude of denominations, religious legends prolifer-
ated, and they have continued their spread both as the authoritative voice of reli-
gious education and as its antagonist, the voice of the folk, to this day.
Legend | 773
It is no wonder that by the end of the Middle Ages, the word legend had come
to mean ‘‘inauthentic information’’ or an improbable story. During the Reforma-
tion, it became understood as a lie or fiction (Martin Luther made the pun
legende—l€ ugende [legend-lie]), indicating the recognition of the controversial
nature of the legend applied in religious debate. Today, in common parlance, a
legend is still regarded as an untrue story believed by the gullible.
Encompassing a broad category of works, the heroic legend (legende
heroique—legende epique) is identified as a long epic poem composed of tradi-
tional motifs and performed orally in song, accompanied by a musical instrument.
Heroic legend tells about a known or fictional historical hero or heroine (from the
Greek her os). Because of their miraculous origins and supernatural associations,
these protagonists are endowed with supernatural powers and knowledge. Their
adventures, on earth and beyond, consist of struggles against evil mortals and
demons. Heroic legend of some kind is known around the world; it combines his-
torical facts with myth and folktale elements in diverse ways, adjusting to given
cultural environments. Its contents are not always easy to distinguish from parallel
myths and tales.
The folk legend, sharing traditional elements with the religious and the heroic
legend, has been defined by folklorists as one of the folklore genres. As a short,
oral prose narrative, created by the people and transmitted orally from generation
to generation, it has been characterized as a story that treats its unusual, extranor-
mal, metaphysical, or supernatural topics from the vantage point of the real world
of its tellers and audiences. Bearers of legend tradition identify the legend in their
native terminology as ‘‘a true story,’’ ‘‘an account,’’ ‘‘what is being told,’’ ‘‘some-
thing passed around,’’ ‘‘a saying,’’ ‘‘a chronicle,’’ or ‘‘a history.’’ In scholarly prac-
tice, Germans and Scandinavians have opted for ‘‘a saying’’ or ‘‘what has been
spoken’’ (Sage, sagn, s€ agen), and various forms of the Latin word legenda are
adopted as the technical terms used by Anglo American and Romance language
authors—legend (in English), legende (in French), leggenda (in Italian), leyenda
(in Spanish), and so on.
Definition of the legend began with the founders of folkloristics, Jacob and
Wilhelm Grimm. They pointed out its main characteristic by contrasting it to the
tale in the introduction of the collection Deutsche Sagen (1816). They saw the
two genres as peoples’ guides and true companions through life:
The M€ archen is more poetic [and] the legend is more historical; the former
exists securely almost in and of itself in its innate blossoming and consum-
mation. The legend, by contrast, is characterized by a lesser variety of col-
ors, yet it represents something special in that it adheres always to that
which we all are conscious of and know well, such as a locale and a name
that has been secured through history. Because of this local confinement, it
774 | Legend
William Tell
Like the English Robin Hood, the fourteenth-century Swiss William Tell remains a
figure of myth rather than history. Like many such figures, though, his legend has
great staying power, not only in the folk legends and ballads of his home country
but in literature, film, television, and children’s literature and theater, as well as in
Schiller’s famous play Wilhelm Tell (1804).
In the basic story, the Austrian occupiers of Switzerland in the province of Uri are
commanded by a despotic individual named Herman Gessler. Wishing to further
humiliate the Swiss, Gessler orders a pole set up in the village square. He has his hat
nailed to the top of the pole and commands that all the Swiss must bow to it. Tell, a
noted archer, refuses, and so Gessler has Tell’s son tied to a tree with an apple upon
his head. Tell is told to split the apple in two with an arrow or bolt (some versions
speak of bows, others of crossbows). Tell takes two bolts and with the first performs
this near-miraculous feat. Gessler then asks why Tell had taken two bolts. The hero
replies that if he had killed his own son he would have used the second bolt to kill
Gessler. Doubly embarrassed, the outraged Gessler has Tell arrested and placed
aboard a ship for prison. In a storm, Tell escapes from the ship by leaping onto a
rock still known as ‘‘Tell’s Leap.’’ He returns to his home region and kills Gessler,
providing the spark that ignites a general Swiss uprising, the eventual expulsion of
the Austrians, and the establishment of the Helvetian Confederation.
These events are not recorded before the late fifteenth century, nearly two hun-
dred years after they are supposed to have occurred. Nor is there any other evi-
dence for the existence of a historical figure named William Tell. There is also little
consistency in the dates and other details of the Tell legend. Although sources
sometimes give a precise date for Tell’s archery feat (1307), there is little or no evi-
dence that such an event ever took place.
The apple-shooting incident is found in mythology and folklore around the world,
including that of ancient Greece, Denmark, England, northern Europe, Russia, Per-
sia, Turkey, Mongolia, and India. Like Robin Hood, Tell inhabits the shady area
between the outlaw hero and the national hero.
Graham Seal
follows that the legend cannot, like the tale, find its home anywhere. Instead
the legend demands certain conditions without which it either cannot exist
at all, or can only exist in less perfect form. There is scarcely a spot in all
of Germany where one cannot hear elaborate tales, locales on which legends
are usually sown only quite sparsely. This apparent inadequacy and insignif-
icance is conceded, but in compensation we find legends far more intimately
representative. They are like the dialects of language, in which time and
again one encounters the strangest words and images that have survived
from ancient times—while the tales, by contrast, transport a complete piece
of ancient poetry to us from the past in a single breath (Ward 1981).
M€archen is the career story of a symbolic central heroic figure, but the legend has
no hero or heroine—it concerns us. The purpose of telling a legend is to report,
inform, explain, teach, advise, warn, help, or enlighten. The legend answers unut-
tered questions of common concern: What is it? Why is it so? Can this be true?
How can such a thing happen? What can be done about it? How can it be avoided
or made to happen? And since the legend seeks an answer, its message need not be
encased in an artistically constructed and stabilized or conventionalized talelike
frame. The ambiguity of feelings, the uncertainty, the hope, and the despair sur-
rounding the message create a specific narrational form and style for the legend
and keep the narrated text eternally unfinished, amplifiable, and fragmentary. Con-
sequently, the researcher has to assemble numerous variants of the same story to
get an idea of the extent of a type.
The form of the text is shaped by the conditions surrounding its telling. The oral
legend may be performed by persons in all walks of life, among all layers of soci-
ety—rich and poor, young and old, educated and uneducated. It might crop up any
place where people gather for work or leisure—at village firesides; on the road to
work; while walking, riding a train, or driving; or at family dinners, church socials,
banquets, and professional get-togethers. In short, legends may be exchanged
informally at any time, without requiring a prepared telling session.
Consequently, the teller of a legend does not have to be a recognized artist but
rather someone who is interested in legendry and who has experienced at least
one legendary event that attracts the attention of others. Thus, when this person
proposes a story, the audience knows what to expect. Culturally, the teller and the
audience share a common knowledge of legendry, and the story brought up is
based on a shared frame of reference whereby the telling becomes conversational.
The proponent who starts a story will be joined by co-proponents who add their
information to the telling as the story unfolds. Those present contribute to a com-
munal version, adding their information, making corrections, and expressing their
opinions concerning the veracity of the event. Because the legend by its very na-
ture provokes debate, questioning the nature of human destiny, its telling is not
limited to the story proper.
The construction of a narrative begins informally, in conversation when some-
one brings up a peculiar experience of common interest. Then, the best-informed
member of the group begins by setting the frame. The event is described by pre-
senting evidence: Those involved are named; eyewitnesses are mentioned; and
the place, the time, and the environmental conditions are—often meticulously—
stated. After amplifications, the teller comes to the point and presents the story
that happened to him or her or to someone else—a reliable, respected person, an
acquaintance of a trustworthy person, or someone more distant, such as ‘‘a friend
of a friend.’’ The core narrative is accompanied by comments expressing the am-
biguous feelings of the participants about its veracity: for example, ‘‘I am not
Legend | 777
sure if this is true or not, but . . .’’; ‘‘I’ve seen it with my own eyes’’; ‘‘This is all
baloney, but some people would swear . . .’’; or ‘‘My grandfather is an honest
man, and he never told a lie.’’ At the conclusion of the performance, as at the be-
ginning, the question is raised again: Could this be true or not? Throughout the
narrative process, the legend manifests conflicting opinions expressed in contra-
dictions, additions, approvals, and disapprovals. As a conversation about the
truth of the presented case, the legend is a discussion between believers, doubt-
ers, skeptics, and nonbelievers. It is this discussion of the feasibility of the nar-
rated legend that is essential, not its resolution or the settling of the dispute. It is
also inconsequential whether the tellers are believers or nonbelievers; what
counts is that they are attracted to the universal questions of the world and human
life entertained by the legend and that they like to express their attitudes toward
it. The text of the legend is generated by the power of its inherent dialectics.
The legend is not limited to oral existence in face-to-face communication
within small groups. Throughout the history of Western civilization, legends
have abounded in written sources. Chronicles, annals, local and national histor-
ies, tractates (medical, natural historical, legal, and ecclesiastical), travelogues,
diaries, and literary works inform us of the wealth of an essentially homogeneous
body of legendry that has persisted in both oral and literary tradition to the pres-
ent time. For example, the late fifteenth-century witch hunt manual Malleus
Maleficarum (The witch hammer), written by two Dominican priests, contains
the same witch and devil legends that are commonly known today, as does
The Discoverie of Witchcraft, written about a century later by Reginald Scot in
Elizabethan England. Legend transmission from the sixteenth to the twentieth
centuries by Swiss legend collectors who were also writers and retellers of their
texts is well documented in the collection of Rudolf Schenda.
The Industrial Revolution multiplied the communication channels that accom-
modated legend transmission, among other cultural messages. It sped up the cir-
culation of legends while reaching out far beyond the small group, creating a
global village that unified and homogenized mass society. The multivocal mass
media today have a more potent influence on legend dissemination than does
ongoing oral tradition in isolated small groups. Now, individuals communicate
their legends through the telephone, tape recorder, videotape, e-mail, fax, or pho-
tocopier. On a broader scale, beyond the unofficial confines, legend events are
further relayed to society at large by professional mediators who, like oral narra-
tors, modify and re-create their versions to fit their purposes. Emergent legends
are immediately reported in the daily news and the popular press, radio, and tele-
vision; they are topics of talk shows, docudramas, and motion pictures; and they
appear in popular science and literary works. The media also reconstruct and
update old legends attached to current social concerns, keeping the public
attracted and simultaneously confused about what to believe or what to doubt.
778 | Legend
Grace O’Malley
Grace O’Malley, the anglicized name for Gaelic Gra’inne Ni’ Mha’ille or Granuiale,
was born around 1530 and died around 1600. Historically she was a pirate and
sometimes successful marital opportunist who amassed considerable property and
wealth. She was said to be ‘‘the nurse of all rebellions in the province’’ (of Con-
nacht). In folklore she is a swashbuckling defier of Spaniards, oppressors, and any-
one else who gets in her way. Her exploits are told and retold in tales that have
made her name synonymous with the Irish nation itself.
In Legends from Ireland, Sean O’Sullivan relates two stories that convey the fear-
some nature of the legendary Grace O’Malley. In the first story, Grace O’Malley’s
son is abducted by the Flaherties and imprisoned in their castle at Renvyle. Grace
sails into Renvyle harbor, gives birth to a baby, and on the same day sallies forth
against the Flaherties in their stronghold, threatening them with dire consequences
if they do not free her son. So frightened are the Flaherties that they release the
son, though in her anger, Grace still has her cannon do some damage to their castle.
The second story involves Grace O’Malley’s brother, the Red-Haired Smith. Grace
thinks he is an even finer man than her husband, Burke. Burke is jealous and tells
Grace he will prove his superiority when the Red-Haired Smith next comes to visit.
Over dinner, Burke tells the Red-Haired Smith that Grace thinks he is the better
man, an opinion that, Burke says, he finds insulting. A fight ensues in which the Red-
Haired Smith is killed. Burke then beheads the body and carries the head to Grace,
inviting her to cry all she wishes. Instead, Grace takes hold of her own rapier, goes
into the garden where her two teenage sons are playing, and cuts off their heads.
She carries these to her husband saying, ‘‘’Tis your turn to cry now! . . . While you
weep for your two sons, I’ll weep for my brother, the Red-Haired Smith.’’
Grace O’Malley’s seagoing exploits, factual and fictional, also make her a cele-
brated figure in sailor lore.
Graham Seal
children between ages two and fourteen are about ghosts, witches, monsters, devils,
werewolves, mad murderers, and cataclysmic disasters—rich in images and charac-
ters but weak in narrative construction. These images include all manner of slimy,
pukey, bloody, putrefied, rotten, and disgusting horrors.
Adolescents and young adults are the largest consumers of ‘‘horror art,’’ or
legends provided by movies, comics, Halloween spook houses, and daring initia-
tion rituals into adulthood for both sexes. These legends are complex events
combining ritual and narration. Young people (the legend-telling group) visit
scary places (haunted by the dead who perished there, prowled by disfigured and
crazy killers, or consecrated as human sacrifice sites by devil worshipers, for
example) and expose themselves to danger. They simulate reenactment of the
event and retell a legend of their participant involvement—a narrow escape.
These quest stories are all localized supernatural and extranormal horrors show-
ing great variability, informed by the popular press’s sensationalized national
and international coverage of occult, lunatic, and criminal acts.
The legends of adults are much more diffuse and varied. Basically, the stock
contains family tradition: inherited legendry about locally famous and infamous
people, haunts, violence, predictions that have come true, miraculous healings,
and curses taking effect. As mentioned, the stock also contains childhood memo-
ries of youth legendry. The rest, the larger contingent, occupies the space
between science and religion and is distributed according to free choice among
the adults’ underlying systems of belief. Since the late nineteenth century, West-
ern society has institutionalized its factions that try to explain unknown mysteries
of life, death, and the hereafter both by rationalized interpretation of the
irrational and by cultic-religious mystification, opening the way for a never-
anticipated legend explosion. Legends emerged as charters of establishment in
support of Spiritism and Fundamentalism, of charismatic, mystic sects, and of
Christian and Eastern religions, as well as Satanism, Wicca, and Paganism, and
the so-called occult sciences (parapsychology, astrology, study of extrasensory
perception, psychic forces, clairvoyance, the study of unidentified flying objects
[UFO] phenomena) and have contributed greatly to the scientification of folk
belief and elements of legendry. Through the intervention of the ever-present
mass media, this legendry has become common knowledge in modern technolog-
ical society. Mass media also have become the source of a special type of horror
legend that spreads as rumor related to emergent accusations, such as willful
food contamination (by big companies or foreign restaurants), affliction of mor-
tal diseases (AIDS, leprosy), ritual child abuse and cannibalism (blood sucking
for empowerment), and kidnapping of children (to harvest their organs as trans-
plant merchandise), to name only a few of the themes.
In view of the unprecedented proliferation of legends in our time, folklore
scholars have begun to raise questions concerning the increase of irrationality in
Legend | 781
References
af Klintberg, Bengt. 1990. Do the Legends of Today and Yesterday Belong to the
Same Genre? In Storytelling in Contemporary Societies, eds. Lutz R€ohrich and Sabine
Weinker-Piepho. T€ubingen, Germany: Gunter Narr.
Brunvand, Jan Harold. 1981. The Vanishing Hitchhiker: American Urban Legends
and Their Meanings. New York: Norton.
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1974. The Memorate and the Proto-Memorate.
Journal of American Folklore 87: 225 239.
782 | Legend, Contemporary
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1976. Legend and Belief. In Folklore Genres,
ed. Dan Ben-Amos. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Fishcher, Helmut. 1991. Der Rattenhund: Sagen der Gegenwart. Cologne: Rheinland
Verlag GmbH.
Hand, Wayland D. 1965. Status of European and American Legend Study. Current
Anthropology 6: 439 446.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1971. American Folk Legend: A Symposium. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
L€uthi, Max. 1966. Volksm€
archen und Volkssage: Zwei Gruundformen erz€
ahlender
Dichtung. Bern: Francke.
O’Sullivan, S. 1977. Legends from Ireland. Totowa, NJ: Rowman and Littlefield, pp.
122 123.
Peuckert, Will-Erich. 1965. Sagen: Geburt und Antwort der mythischen Welt. Berlin:
Erich Schmidt.
Schenda, Rudolf, and Hans ten Dornkaat. 1988. Sagenerz€ ahler und Sagensammler
der Schweiz. Bern: Paul Haupt.
Smith, Paul, and Gillian Bennett, eds. 1984 1990. Perspectives on Contemporary
Legend, vols. 1 5. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press.
Ward, Donald, trans. 1981. The German Legends of the Brothers Grimm. Philadelphia:
Institute for the Study of Human Issues. (Originally, Deutsche Sagen by Jacob and
Wilhelm Grimm, 1816.)
Legend, Contemporary
References
Bennett, Gillian, and Paul Smith, eds. 1988. Monsters with Iron Teeth: Perspectives
on Contemporary Legend, Vol. 3. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press.
Bennett, Gillian, and Paul Smith, eds. 1989. The Questing Beast: Perspectives on
Contemporary Legend, Vol. 4. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press.
Bennett, Gillian, and Paul Smith, eds. 1990. Contemporary Legend: The First Five
Years. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press.
Bennett, Gillian, and Paul Smith, eds. 1990. A Nest of Vipers: Perspectives on Con-
temporary Legend, Vol. 5. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press.
Bennett, Gillian, and Paul Smith, eds. 1993. Contemporary Legend: A Folklore Bibli-
ography. New York: Garland.
Bennett, Gillian, and Paul Smith, eds. 1995. Contemporary Legend: A Reader. New
York: Garland.
Bennett, Gillian, Paul Smith, and J. D. A. Widdowson, eds. 1987. Perspectives on
Contemporary Legend, Vol. 2. Sheffield, UK: Sheffield Academic Press/Centre for
English Cultural Tradition and Language.
Fine, Gary Alan. 1992. Manufacturing Tales: Sex and Money in Contemporary
Legends. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Kapferer, Jean-Noel. 1990. Rumours: Uses, Interpretations, and Images. New Bruns-
wick, NJ: Transaction Publishers.
Smith, Paul, ed. 1984. Perspectives on Contemporary Legend: Proceedings of the
Conference on Contemporary Legend, Sheffield, July 1982. Sheffield, UK: Centre for
English Cultural Tradition and Language.
Legend, Urban | 785
Legend, Urban
A popular term for a narrative concerning some aspect of modern life that is
believed by its teller but is actually untrue. The concept has its origins in the debate
over whether folklore was characteristic of rural cultures or if it extended to edu-
cated classes as well. French folklorists in the 1880s first showed interest in a dis-
tinctively ‘‘urban’’ legend parallel to the ‘‘traditional’’ (i.e., supernatural) legend.
Under the leadership of Paul Sebillot, scholars published a large number of actively
circulating rumors and narratives collected in Paris, Danzig, and other urban areas.
Their lead, however, was not communicated to their counterparts in the Finnish-
German and Anglo-American scholarly traditions, who continued to overempha-
size legends that appeared to reflect survivals of ‘‘primitive’’ rural belief systems.
Interest in city-based legends appeared only sporadically in American publica-
tions until the 1950s, when Richard M. Dorson highlighted them as examples of
‘‘modern’’ folklore. He called attention to several common legends of this type,
including ‘‘The Death Car,’’ in his influential 1959 textbook American Folklore.
Subsequently, a number of studies and collections of similar legends were published
by his colleagues and students at Indiana University. Initially, Dorson called such
narratives ‘‘city legends,’’ but he later used several different terms for them, includ-
ing ‘‘urban belief tales,’’ ‘‘modern legends,’’ and (at least by 1968) ‘‘urban legends.’’
The related concept, ‘‘urban myth,’’ was coined by the American social anthro-
pologist William H. Friedland in a paper presented at a 1960 meeting of the
Rhodes-Livingstone Institute for Social Research in Lusaka, Northern Rhodesia
(now Zambia). A group of European social scientists, led by Max Gluckman (later a
leading sociologist at the University of Manchester), met to discuss ‘‘Myths in Mod-
ern Africa.’’ The conference focused on the effect of ‘‘detribalization’’ [i.e., the influ-
ence of Western-style urbanism] on the culture of previously rural Africans. The
key term myth was then understood as an account of events that was represented as
factual but could be proven to be fictional or at least a serious misrepresentation of
what had actually happened. Nevertheless, speakers agreed, myths reflected social
realities and could either support or challenge the political status quo.
Friedland’s paper, ‘‘Some Urban Myths of East Africa,’’ identified the alleged
‘‘friend of a friend’’ authority as one of the hallmarks of the narrative type. His
examples include several since collected and characterized as ‘‘urban legends,’’
notably the claim that Europeans kidnapped native Africans to use their body parts
for medical purposes. However, he differed with other researchers in arguing that
an ‘‘urban myth’’ was not necessarily fictitious but a set of ideas that satisfied a
social need and could be used as a basis for political action. This sense of the term
became a useful one in the conference’s discussion, and it, with the synonymous
‘‘modern myth,’’ became the dominant name among European scholars for beliefs
or rumors with controversial political implications that spread quickly.
786 | Legend, Urban
The term urban legend was given wide exposure in 1981 when Jan Harold
Brunvand summed up folkloristic research on such narratives in The Vanishing
Hitchhiker. Brunvand, like Monica Wilson, characterized urban legends as liter-
ally false—that is, they could not have happened in the precise way in which the
narrative stated. ‘‘A story too good to be true’’ later became his nutshell definition
of the genre. But urban legends were, he added, metaphorically true, in that they
revealed concerns about modern society and often contained explicit or symbolic
criticisms of urban conditions. His book was widely read, and through its sequels
and a weekly news column, Brunvand’s approach to such narratives became fa-
miliar to many nonfolklorists. Urban legend, like ‘‘urban myth,’’ soon became
understood as an erroneous belief among the general public and has been applied
to a wide range of material, from non-narrative beliefs (sadists put razor blades in
apples) to ‘‘unbelievable’’ personal experience stories (satanic cult or UFO abduc-
tion accounts).
Brunvand’s approach has been criticized by some folklorists, who find that his
stress on the fallacy of legends demeans their performers. Others argue that his
use of summary or media versions to extract broad cultural meanings was often
impressionistic and superficial. Scattered but persistent records of analogs in tra-
ditional rural contexts also suggest that the ‘‘urban’’ context of modern variants
may be an artifact of changes in fieldwork methodology: Supernatural legends
may have been overcollected in the past. Further, popular use of the term urban
legend to refer to any narrative that appears to reflect an ‘‘urban’’ or ‘‘modern’’
context often groups narratives of disparate content and reflects different modes
of narration. Some seem close to jokes or tales in performance; others, like UFO
abduction accounts, are narrated as personal experiences. Finally, the effort to
distinguish legends from other forms of rumor or collective belief has been prob-
lematized by recent sociologists like Dan E. Miller since a distinction cannot be
supported by empirical observation of communities, in which such information
is passed on and discussed in a dynamic, collaborative process. Considering
legends as ‘‘believed but untrue’’ stories ignores important differences in their
social contexts and dynamics. Hence, many folklorists prefer to use the term con-
temporary legend, a more neutral but equally vague and problematic concept.
Daniel R. Barnes, however, has argued that the term is accurate in referring to
one subset of legends. These, like ‘‘The Vanishing Hitchhiker,’’ are formally sim-
ilar in that they deliberately withhold an important clue from the audience (the
fact that the hitchhiker is actually a ghost) until the ‘‘punch line’’ at the end of
the narrative. Such a narrative device, he argues, is similar to those used in popu-
lar literature forms such as the detective story, whose growth in popularity paral-
lels urbanization.
Interest in urban legend studies has created an international network of ama-
teur and professional collectors, who have brought a diverse and challenging
Life-Cycle Ritual | 787
base of data to academics’ attention. Analysis of these data may well lead to a
more precise definition of the legend and related concepts.
Bill Ellis
See Also Legend; Legend, Contemporary; Myth.
References
af Klintberg, Bengt. 1990. Do the Legends of Today and Yesterday Belong to the
Same Genre? In Storytelling in Contemporary Societies, eds. Lutz R€ohrich and Sabine
Wienker-Piepho. T€ubingen, Germany: Gunter Narr.
Barnes, Daniel R. 1984. Interpreting Urban Legends. ARV 40: 67 78.
Brunvand, Jan Harold. 1981. The Vanishing Hitchhiker: American Urban Legends
and Their Meanings. New York: Norton.
Brunvand, Jan Harold. 2000. Richard M. Dorson and the Urban Legend. In The
Truth Never Stands in the Way of a Good Story! Urbana: University of Illinois Press,
pp. 13 22.
Dorson, Richard M. 1959. American Folklore. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Dubb, Allie, ed. 1960. Myth in Modern Africa: The Fourteenth Conference Proceed-
ings of the Rhodes-Livingstone Institute for Social Research. Lusaka: Rhodes-Living-
stone Institute.
Ellis, Bill. 2006. The Roots of ‘‘Perspectives on Contemporary Legend’’: Urban
Myths. In the 1960 Rhodes-Livingstone Institute for Social Research Conference.
Miller, Dan E. 2005. Rumor: An Examination of Some Stereotypes. Symbolic Inter-
action 28: 505 519.
Renard, Jean-Bruno. 1994. Old Contemporary Legends: 19th-Century French Folk-
lore Studies Revisited. FOAFtale News 32: 1 4.
Life-Cycle Ritual
References
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1968. The Nordic Dead-Child Tradition: Nordic Dead-Child
Beigns A Study in Comparative Religion. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1986. Transition Rites. In Transition Rites: Cosmic, Social and
Individual Order, ed. Ugo Bianchi. Rome: L’Erma di Bretschneider.
Turner, Victor W. 1969. The Ritual Process: Structure and Anti-Structure. Chicago:
Aldine.
Life History | 789
Turner, Victor W. 1974. Dramas, Fields and Metaphors: Symbolic Action in Human
Society. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
van Gennep, Arnold. 1960. Rites of Passage. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Life History
References
Bertaux, Daniel, ed. 1981. Biography and Society: The Life History Approach in
Social Sciences. Beverly Hills, CA: Sage.
Geertz, Clifford. 1988. Works and Lives: The Anthropologist as an Author. Stanford,
CA: Stanford University Press.
Langness, L. L. 1965. Life History in Anthropological Science. New York: Holt,
Rinehart and Winston.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 219.
Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Reynolds, Frank E., and Donald Capps, eds. 1976. The Biographical Process: Stud-
ies in the History and Psychology of Religion. The Hague: Mouton.
Liminality
A special state in a transition ritual. The term liminality, derived from the Latin
limen (meaning threshold), identifies the condition opposing the normal, hier-
archical, structured state or the fixed point in the social structure both on the
Liminality | 791
individual and on the societal level, particularly when this state arises in the
course of transformative rituals. This marginal period is an interstructural situa-
tion opposing a relatively fixed or stable condition.
Ritual subjects—individuals—can be termed ‘‘transitional beings’’ or ‘‘liminal
personae’’ during the period of liminality. During the marginal period in the
process of rites of passage, ritual subjects are in a somehow undefined, ambigu-
ous status. This liminal phase exists between the act of separation from the par-
ticipants’ old status and the neophytes’ induction into a new one. The threefold
model of the nature of rites of passage was put forward by Arnold van Gennep in
his Rites of Passage, published in 1909.
Victor W. Turner has further developed van Gennep’s concept of liminal rites.
Turner’s process-oriented method focuses on the structural analysis of rites and
symbols. In his terminology, the concept of structure coincides with social structure
as employed in British social anthropology. The concepts of antistructure and com-
munitas are both used in the description of the liminal stage. In Turner’s opinion,
during the liminal stage, communitas tends to characterize relationships between
those jointly undergoing ritual transformation. The bonds of communitas are anti-
structural in the sense that they are undifferentiated, egalitarian, direct, extant, non-
rational, existential, I-thou relationships. Communitas is spontaneous, immediate,
concrete; it is not shaped by norms, not institutionalized, and not abstract.
Within the liminal stage, participants (e.g., initiands) are beyond the bounda-
ries of the normal social structure and its values, norms, and obligations. The
marginal state that begins with rites of separation is an abnormal condition,
beyond society and time. For that reason, it is possible for people to behave in
ways that do not coincide with those of the ‘‘normal’’ social structure and its con-
ditions. For instance, sexual freedom is a common characteristic of the marginal
period in the initiation rites of many peoples. The marginal abnormal condition
of anarchy is terminated by rites of aggregation, which make new status relation-
ships public to the community.
The abnormal and antistructural liminal stage deviates from the norm to such
an extent that, depending on the culture and religion, people at that phase are
considered to be more susceptible to the influence of the supernatural than usual.
For example, the frequency of supranormal experiences is quite high during or
around liminal periods among people going through rites of passages. Thus, the
presence of the supernatural is a common characteristic of the liminal phase. Su-
pernatural experiences are even expected, and the manifestations of supranormal
beings are believed to have a positive effect on the community. It is important
from the point of view of any community for the liminal stage to be safely passed
over and for life to return to normal.
Liminality also can become a continuous problem that disturbs the life of the
community. An example of such turmoil arising from unresolved liminality can
792 | Linguistic Approach
be found in religious beliefs dealing with the so-called dead without status. The
problem of the dead without status (e.g., unbaptized babies) seems to be their
eternal liminality. Such ‘‘betwixt and between’’ status is an exceptional, unsatis-
factory condition primarily inflicted on those who are regarded as responsible for
the supranormal manifestations.
Turner makes a distinction between the terms liminal and liminoid, emphasizing
the need for a proper terminology to describe ritual life even in industrialized and
highly developed cultures. Turner claims that in such societies, the liminoid is not
only removed from the rite of passage context but also ‘‘individualized.’’ A solitary
artist creates liminoid phenomena, a group experiences collective liminal symbols.
Studies on threshold experiences and the liminal stage also might lead to a bet-
ter understanding of creativity. Individuals who are distinguished for their crea-
tivity seem to enjoy an anarchic way of life and put a great emphasis on marginal
experiences, which seem to be a necessary catalyst for their creativity.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Anthropology, Symbolic.
References
Ashley, Kathleen M., ed. 1990. Victor Turner and the Construction of Cultural
Criticism: Between Literature and Anthropology. Bloomington: Indiana University
Press.
Douglas, Mary. 1975. Implicit Meanings: Essays in Anthropology. London: Rout-
ledge & Kegan Paul.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1986. Transition Rites. In Transition Rites, ed. Ugo Bianchi.
Rome: L’Erma di Bretschneider.
Turner, Victor W. 1974. Dramas, Fields and Metaphors: Symbolic Action in Human
Society. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Turner, Victor W. 1967. The Forest of Symbols: Aspects of Ndembu Ritual. Ithaca,
NY: Cornell University Press.
Turner, Victor W. 1969. The Ritual Process: Structure and Anti-Structure. Chicago:
Aldine.
Linguistic Approach
The transferal of methods from the study of language to the study of folklore. In
many respects, folklore and language are similar, and their commonalities have
led to productive exchanges between the disciplines created to account for them.
In both folklore and linguistics, researchers examine complex creations that unite
and at the same time distinguish their users. Both language and folklore convey
meaning that, shared within a community, endures over time but that nonetheless
Linguistic Approach | 793
always varies in response to performer, audience, and context. Both are shaped
by the experiences and ways of life of their users, and in turn, they help shape
their ambient cultures and communities.
Linguistics played an important role in the formation of folklore studies.
Language was one of the central interests of romanticism, the eighteenth- and
nineteenth-century intellectual movement that gave rise to the field itself, and
many of the leaders of folklore studies have maintained professional identities as
linguists as well. Linguistic concepts and methods have been adapted to the myriad
cultural forms that folklorists investigate, and they are reflected particularly in his-
torical and geographic approaches, the study of worldview, the work of the Prague
school and structuralists, the ethnography of communication, and ethnopoetics.
Worldview
Ethnolinguistic studies of Native American idioms expanded the range of notions
concerning language and its form and helped dismantle the Eurocentric tenets of
linguistic theory. Crucial to the development of folkloristics, however, was the
concurrent realization of linguistic relativism. Writing in the first half of the twen-
tieth century, linguists Edward Sapir and Benjamin Lee Whorf posited that lan-
guage shapes and largely determines our understandings of the world. Rather than
viewing language as an objective expression of reality, the ‘‘Sapir-Whorf hypothe-
sis’’ portrays language as a subjective expression of an imagined reality, one that
will vary from culture to culture. One’s very thoughts—or at least the forms of
those thoughts—are shaped by one’s native language. Language thus becomes
central to any investigation of culture and serves as the foundation for worldview.
This realization remains productive in the fields of folklore, linguistics, and anthro-
pology today, and it has enjoyed a resurgence through scholars’ interest in folk tax-
onomies, such as those studied by Gary Gossen in Chamula culture. By attending
Linguistic Approach | 795
to the systems by which the world is classified within a given language, the scholar
can make judgments about the worldview and values of the people studied. Per-
haps no other area of folkloristic research seeks to make such minute and yet all-
encompassing judgments about human thought as this branch of folkloric/linguis-
tic inquiry.
Noam Chomsky (1928– ) is an American linguist, MIT professor, and a leading political
dissident. (AP/Wide World Photos)
language rather than the analysis of language in use. Nonetheless, even Chomskean
linguistics proved an important model for folklorists, particularly in the study of
material culture, where Henry Glassie’s adaptation of generative grammar theory
to vernacular architecture touched off a major research trend.
Language in Context
In the 1960s and 1970s, the interests of a number of folklorists and linguists again
converged, contributing to the inception of the performance school of folklore
studies and the further development of sociolinguistics. Researchers such as Dell
Hymes, Richard Bauman, John Gumperz, Joel Sherzer, and others focused atten-
tion on language function in context, particularly with reference to the speech
community. Indeed, the speech community—the union of persons sharing a given
form of speech in a given place at a given moment—became a key means of
defining one’s ethnographic object. Language becomes one of the resources avail-
able to the community for the accomplishment of communication. Speech acts
can be analyzed to discover the ways of speaking that are permissible in a given
community and the intricacies of discourse as it occurs naturally. Just as a speaker
in Chomskean linguistics could be assumed to possess a basic competence in the
abstract langue, so a speaker in this performance-oriented linguistics could be
assumed to possess ‘‘communicative competence,’’ that is, the ability to use or
Linguistic Approach | 797
References
Bauman, Richard. 1977. Verbal Art as Performance. Rowley, MA: Newbury House.
Briggs, Charles. 1988. Competence in Performance: The Creativity of Tradition in
Mexicano Verbal Art. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Butler, Gary. 1990. Saying Isn’t Believing: Conversation, Narrative and the Dis-
course of Belief in a French Newfoundland Community. St. John’s, Newfoundland:
Institute of Social and Economic Research and the American Folklore Society.
Cassidy, Frederick Gomes, ed. 1985 . Dictionary of American Regional English.
Cambridge, MA: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press.
Duranti, Alessandro, and Charles Goodwin, eds. 1992. Language as an Interactive
Phenomenon. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1975. Folk Housing in Middle Virginia. Knoxville: University of
Tennessee Press.
Gossen, Gary. 1974. Chamulas in the World of the Sun: Time and Space in a Maya
Oral Tradition. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Hewitt, Roger. 1986. White Talk Black Talk: Inter-Racial Friendship and Communi-
cation amongst Adolescents. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Hymes, Dell. 1981. ‘‘In Vain I Tried To Tell You’’: Essays in Native American Eth-
nopoetics. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Hymes, Dell, ed. 1983. Essays in the History of Linguistic Anthropology. Philadel-
phia: John Benjamins.
K€ong€as-Maranda, Elli. 1971. The Logic of Riddles. In Structural Analysis of Oral
Tradition, eds. P. Maranda and E. K€ong€as-Maranda. Philadelphia: University of Penn-
sylvania Press.
McDowell, John H. 1979. Children’s Riddling. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Mills, Margaret. 1991. Rhetorics and Politics in Afghan Traditional Storytelling.
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Pepicello, W. J., and Thomas A. Green. 1984. The Language of Riddles: New Per-
spectives. Columbus: Ohio State University Press.
Saville-Troike, Muriel. 1989. The Ethnography of Communication, 2nd ed. New
York: Basil Blackwell.
Sebeok, Thomas A. 1974. Structure and Texture: Selected Essays in Cheremis
Verbal Art. The Hague: Mouton.
Sherzer, Joel. 1990. Verbal Art in San Blas: Kuna Culture through Its Discourse.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Weijnen, Antonius, ed. 1975 . Atlas Linguarum Europae. Assen, Netherlands: Van
Gorcum.
Literary Approach
A folkloristic methodology that (1) emphasizes the idealized folk as the carrier of
artistic tradition and limits the scope of research to traditional forms regarded as
Literary Approach | 799
is, however, necessary to emphasize that the use of refashioned folklore material
reveals and expresses fundamental cultural, ideological, and political processes.
The research of the second life of folklore (or, as some authors call it, contextual-
ization and textualization processes) is essential in the research of texts as a
means of creating identity, power relations, and cultural authority.
Just as genuine or supposed folklore materials have provided frameworks for lit-
erary creations, literary methods have provided tools for analyzing and authenticat-
ing texts. One of the classical literary methods applied to folklore materials was
textual criticism. This method, aimed at establishing primary and authentic texts
and sources, included a careful recension and examination of different manuscripts
and variants (or readings) of texts, as well as subsequent emendation and conjec-
ture if the available evidence was inadequate. In its earliest form, this kind of pro-
cedure was applied to Homeric texts, for example, by Aristarkhos (207–145 BCE),
the librarian of the Alexandrian Library; a number of scholars, especially in the
nineteenth century, also applied it to biblical texts. In folkloristics, textual criticism
was used mainly by adherents of the Finnish historic-geographic school, but it also
was employed by literary scholars and folklorists trying to disentangle the prehis-
tory of such classical epic texts as the Iranian epics Shahnama in attempts to iden-
tify Ferdousi’s sources (as done by Theodore N€oldeke) or the different readings of
the German Nibelungenlied (as done by Andreas Heusler). The text-critical histor-
ies of the classical Indian epics Mahabharata and Ramajana reveal the enormity
of different languages and scripts dating from different times. It took a team of In-
dian scholars thirty-five years to prepare the nineteen-volume ‘‘critical edition’’ of
Mahabharata. The work detected an astonishing number of interpolations, con-
taminations, and emendations, and in the end, the editors concluded that the com-
pound text could not be adequately dated since the manuscripts formed a huge
mosaic of old and new material—truly an intertextual network that contained ele-
ments of countless heterogeneous parts of varying ages.
In Finnish folkloristics, textual criticism was connected to an evolutionary
framework in the diachronic comparative studies and to the laws of geographic
distribution that emerged as the historic-geographic school during the transition
to the twentieth century. On the basis of the collected texts, the adherents of this
approach hoped to reconstruct the prototypes or archetypes of the texts, segregate
the original and secondary features, and extrapolate the hypothetical primary
form or content of the research object, deducing the place and origin of the phe-
nomenon in question whenever possible.
Later, toward the middle of the twentieth century, the guiding principle of the
‘‘Finnish method’’ became the practice of arranging the text variants by typologi-
cal variant groups called redactions, rather than primarily by area. According to
subscribers to this procedure (e.g., Walter Anderson and Matti Kuusi), the hypo-
thetical primary form was supposed to have generated initial redactions and
802 | Literary Approach
References
Bauman, Richard. 1993. The Nationalization and Internationalization of Folklore:
The Case of Schoolcraft’s ‘‘Gitshee Gauzinee.’’ Western Folklore 52: 247 269.
Hautala, Jouko. 1969. Finnish Folklore Research 1828 1918. Helsinki: Finnish
Academy of Sciences.
Jia Zhi. 1986. On Collection and Collation of Chinese Folk Literature. NIF Newslet-
ter (Turku, Finland: Nordic Institute of Folklore) 14: 2 3.
Kuusi, Matti. 1974. ‘‘The Bridge and the Church’’: An Anti-church Legend. Studia
Fennica 17. Helsinki: Finnish Literature Society.
McDonell, Diane. 1986. Theories of Discourse: An Introduction. Oxford: Basil
Blackwell.
Moi, Toril. ed. 1986. The Kristeva Reader. New York: Columbia University Press.
Oinas, Felix, ed. 1978. Heroic Epic and Saga: An Introduction to the World’s Great
Folk Epics. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Prince, Gerald. 1987. Dictionary of Narratology. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.
Little Red Riding Hood | 803
Little Red Riding Hood is a multifaceted heroine with a checkered history. The
first printed version of the story is that of Charles Perrault, published in Paris in
1697 as ‘‘Le petit chaperon rouge’’ (The Little Red Hat) in his Histoires du temps
pass e: Avec des moralitez (Stories of Times Past: With Morals). As the subtitle
of Perrault’s work indicates, he was especially concerned to use the stories con-
tained in his work as moral tales, warnings for the young and their adult care-
takers of the dangers that lurked in the everyday world. Because of this intent,
and because Perrault was very much an upper-middle-class man of his era, he
rewrote the orally circulating folktales he selected for an educated, affluent, and
discerning audience, excising and ameliorating certain unacceptable elements of
the folk versions.
A number of scholars have shown how, and why, Perrault adapted the folk
versions of the Little Red Riding Hood story in the way he did. It is now known
that tales of ogres, wolves, werewolves, and other monsters threatening to devour
small children were commonplaces of European medieval life and that supersti-
tions and beliefs of this sort persisted well into the early modern period. In some
parts of France there was endemic dread of walking in the woods alone, and
throughout these areas in the fifteenth to the sixteenth centuries, there were innu-
merable persecutions and trials of individuals believed to be werewolves. Signifi-
cantly, it is from these areas that many of the folk versions of the Little Red
Riding Hood story have been collected by folklorists and others interested in
popular traditions. It seems that Perrault, probably through family tradition, had
heard some of these stories and used them as the basis for his own moralistic and
literary rewrite.
What were the earlier stories like? As far as we are able to tell from oral ver-
sions collected in the nineteenth century, they did not mention a ‘‘little red riding
hood’’ at all. The version collected by Delarue in Nievre around 1885 is often put
forward as a likely form of the tale. Known simply as ‘‘The Story of Grand-
mother,’’ the story concerns an unnamed little girl who is dispatched to her
grandmother’s house with bread and milk. On the way she meets a werewolf
who asks her which way she is taking—the path of needles or the path of pins.
She replies that she is taking the path of needles, and the werewolf says he will
take the path of pins. Along the way the little girl collects needles, allowing the
werewolf to race ahead along the path of pins to grandmother’s house. Here he
immediately kills grandmother, puts some of her flesh and a bottle of her blood
in the cupboard, and presumably (it is not stated in the text) jumps into grand-
mother’s bed to await the arrival of the little girl.
When she arrives, the girl assumes that the werewolf in the bed is her grand-
mother, and the werewolf tells her to eat the meat and wine in the cupboard. She
does as she is told, and then the murdered woman’s cat accuses the girl of being
a slut who has eaten the flesh and drunk the blood of her grandmother. The were-
wolf then tells the little girl to undress and get into bed with him. The little girl,
still apparently suspecting nothing amiss, asks where she should put the various
items of her clothing. The werewolf replies that she should put them all in the
fire, as she will have no further need for them. She does so and then gets into the
bed and begins asking the questions that feature in most versions of the story:
‘‘Oh, Granny, how hairy you are!’’ The werewolf replies, ‘‘The better to keep
myself warm, my child.’’ The girl works her way through the werewolf’s nails,
shoulders, ears, and nostrils to his mouth, to which the response is, ‘‘All the bet-
ter to eat you with, my child.’’
Finally realizing her peril, the girl pleads to be let outside the house, as she
needs to go to the toilet. The werewolf wants her to defecate in the bed, but she
insists on going outside. The werewolf allows her to go only after tying a woolen
rope to her foot. When she gets outside, having only feigned her need for relief,
the girl ties her end of the rope to a plum tree. When she does not return the wolf
calls out, ‘‘Are you making a load out there?’’ When there is no reply, he realizes
that the girl has tricked him and pursues her. Just in time, the little girl reaches
the safety of her own house before the werewolf catches up with her.
Little Red Riding Hood | 805
Versions similar to this earthy folktale have been collected throughout Europe,
the New World, Africa, and Asia. Such stories contain elements that the sophisti-
cated, urban audience Perrault wrote for did not welcome. Thus, the werewolf
became a wolf, still dangerous but not as disturbing as a human that transforms
into a ravening beast and preys on human beings. The down-to-earth ruse the lit-
tle girl employs to escape the werewolf’s intentions disappears, as does her can-
nibalistic consumption of grandma’s flesh and blood. The paths of pins and
needles are lost, and the strong sexual connotations of ‘‘grandma’s’’ hairy body
are quietly forgotten.
As well as dropping certain motifs, Perrault added some. Few, if any, of the
earliest collected versions of this story mention a red riding hood or any other
colored hat. Perrault introduced this element and also invented the characteriza-
tion of the heroine as spoiled, gullible, and ill prepared to deal with the horrors
of the wolf. Because of his strong moralizing aim, Perrault was also compelled
to have Red Riding Hood eaten by the wolf instead of saving herself by her own
wits as does the much more capable heroine of ‘‘The Story of Grandmother’’ and
most of the other folk versions, including an Italian rendition La Finta Nonna
(The False Grandmother) that features an ogress in the role of the wolf.
Despite, or perhaps because of, these additions and deletions, Perrault’s
reworking managed to retain much of the flavor and many of the implications of
the oral versions, while presenting them in a form acceptable to a growing urban
middle-class audience of the kind that would continue to polish Perrault’s ver-
sion of the story for subsequent generations of children.
So appropriate, powerful, and often reprinted were Perrault’s and other literary
adaptations of this story, that they generated folk versions of their own. It was
probably one of these comparatively sophisticated, urban, middle-class versions
that the Grimms heard from their informant, Marie Hassenpflug, an educated and
well-bred woman of French and German Huguenot heritage. This version was the
basis of their story, first published in 1812 in their Kinder-und Hausm€archen, more
generally and less accurately called in English ‘‘Grimms’ Fairy Tales.’’ Research
has also shown that various literary and by now folkloric versions of Perrault’s
‘‘Little Red Riding Hood’’ were well known in Germany and that the Grimms
would in all likelihood have heard these stories in their own childhood. They were
also familiar with a play by Ludwig Tieck titled Leben und Tod des kleinen
Rotk€ appchens: eine Trag€ odie (1800), in which a woodsman kills the wolf that has
eaten Little Red Cap. The Grimms, perhaps following this lead, and also drawing
on motifs from other folktales, introduced the happy ending of their heroine,
‘‘Rotk€appchen’’ (Little Red Cap), and her granny, both of whom are saved by a
woodsman. The Grimms also introduced an additional sequence, intended to point
to a moral, in which Little Red Cap has an encounter with another wolf. She runs
to grandma’s house and is given advice on how to trick the wolf into death by
806 | Little Red Riding Hood
drowning. This coda ends with the sentence, ‘‘But Red-Cap went joyously home,
and never did anything to harm any one.’’
So popular was this version that it has become—usually without the second anti-
climactic encounter with a wolf—the standard form of the story. As many scholars
have pointed out in relation to this much-studied narrative, in addition to sanitizing
the folktale versions and giving them a happy ending, these literary versions pro-
foundly alter the character of the heroine. Thus Little Red Riding Hood, or Little
Red Cap, is made into a not-very-competent and rather silly little girl who has to
depend on grandma and the woodsman or hunter to get her out of trouble. In the
folk versions, the heroine is duped because of her youth and inexperience, but once
she realizes her plight, she uses her own wit and cunning to escape the wolf’s or
werewolf’s jaws. However, so intertwined have the literary, artistic, filmic, mass
media, and folkloric representations of Little Red Riding Hood become that it is
now difficult, and for practical purposes pointless, to separate them.
‘‘Little Red Riding Hood,’’ with its implicit and explicit suggestions of vio-
lence, bestiality, sexuality, and cannibalism has become a near-universal item in
the modern popular consciousness. The story and its heroine have been used in
advertising, in animated films, in children’s storybooks, pantomimes, paintings,
and even in pop songs, as in a late 1960s hit that proclaims:
interpretations is generally to develop methods of using the story (and other folk-
tales) as a form of psychological and emotional therapy.
Jack Zipes is the most prominent of a number of scholars who have argued at
length that ‘‘Little Red Riding Hood’’ represents a significant case of a European
(and, by implication, Western) cultural expression whose purpose is to regulate
sexuality, and that the story in its many guises is a symbolic initiation of the
young into the ‘‘rape culture’’ of modern times. Robert Darnton, in The Great Cat
Massacre, uses a version (apparently incomplete) of ‘‘Little Red Riding Hood’’ to
suggest that it is a warning of inevitable disaster and is therefore a means of
understanding the mental world of the eighteenth-century French peasantry.
Anthropologist Mary Douglas, using the fieldwork of Yvonne Verdier, offers a
reading that stresses the cannibalistic elements of the rustic French versions of the
tale and interprets them as part of the private world of village women.
When considering this story, folklorists generally espouse an intercultural
approach that reflects the fundamental comparative basis of folklore studies, and
they are often uncomfortable with the many interpretations of the ‘‘meaning’’ of
‘‘Little Red Riding Hood’’ (or any other folktale) that depend on what they see as an
inadequate number of often poorly sourced texts, or even on digests and summaries
of texts. But even in a coherent field of study with a well-developed ethnographic
and conceptual framework, there are many different interpretations. Some folklorists
are even inclined toward a Freudian-influenced psychoanalytic approach, as exem-
plified in the final essay of Alan Dundes’s Little Red Riding Hood: A Casebook.
While these differences simply reflect the variety of approaches to folktale
heroes, they also reinforce the status of ‘‘Little Red Riding Hood’’ as a serious
element of the everyday lives of millions of human beings over many hundreds
of years—rather more than just a ‘‘fairy tale.’’ But it may be that the tale of Little
Red Riding Hood is loosening its strong grip on us. When a fourteen-year-old
girl was asked in 1999 what she knew of Little Red Riding Hood, the response
was, ‘‘She killed a wolf or something, didn’t she?’’
Graham Seal
See Also Fairy Tale Heroes; Hero/Heroine, Folk.
References
Bettelheim, B. 1976. The Uses of Enchantment: The Meaning and Importance of
Fairy Tales. New York: Knopf.
Bottigheimer, R. 1987. Grimms’ Bad Girls and Bold Boys: The Moral and Social
Vision of the Tales. New Haven: Yale University Press.
Bottigheimer, R., ed. 1986. Fairy Tales and Society: Illusion, Allusion, and Para-
digm. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Darnton, R. 1984. The Great Cat Massacre and Other Episodes in French Cultural
History. New York: Basic Books.
808 | Local Heroes
Local Heroes
This category of heroism includes figures, real and imaginary, who are celebrated
within a particular community or region. In many cases these heroes are unknown
or little known outside their areas of origin. They may be local ‘‘characters,’’ cele-
brated for their eccentricities; they may be men or women who have carried out
deeds of special significance to their local communities; or they may simply be
figures who, often for unknown reasons, are part of local lore and custom. Some-
times these local figures may be animals, as in the case of the ‘‘Red Dog of the
Pilbara,’’ a cattle dog famous for its ability to survive and return home in this
extremely inhospitable and isolated area of northwest Australia. While Red Dog
was alive, his exploits were widely known in the Pilbara region, and after his
death in the mid-1990s, his legend was even further exaggerated. The legends of
the dead dog were featured in a small, illustrated booklet published locally, a typi-
cal method of celebrating and perpetuating the folklore of such figures.
Generally, figures of this type have not achieved the national or international
recognition of some folk heroes, such as some fairy tale characters, noted outlaws,
numskulls, and some occupational heroes, among others that are repeatedly anthol-
ogized or are the subjects of various forms of commercialization. Nevertheless, the
origins, motivations, and manifestations of local heroes are often similar from cul-
ture to culture. Favored types of local heroism include liars or tellers of tall tales;
odd or eccentric characters; individuals who carried out feats notable to the locals;
individuals who participated in, or sometimes caused, significant local events or
processes; and those who gave their name to local places and/or physical features,
or who have some other association, often legendary, with local places.
Local Heroes | 809
Clearly such figures are, by definition, vast in number and difficult to locate
and identify. Some other examples include the English Tyneside heroine, Elsie
Marley; the Vermont hero of the American War of Independence, Ethan Allan
(1738–1789); and the Serbian Lazar, among others. Heroes of this type are part
of the lore of local folk groups and contribute to the sense of place and of belong-
ing that is the center of much community life.
Some heroes who begin their celebrity at the local level may become more
widespread, sometimes through word of mouth, though much more powerfully
through media networks. The Russian Dobrynya Nikitich is one example. Lady
Godiva, naked horse rider of the English city of Coventry, is another, while Paul
Bunyan and Febold Feboldson are American occupational heroes who have
undergone similar processes. Billy the Kid is an especially useful illustration of
the means through which local heroes may attain broader celebration. He was
barely known outside the area in which he operated until journalists and dime-
novel authors grabbed hold of his image, helping to cast it in the mold of the out-
law hero and also to spread his reputation to a wider audience and, crucially, to
other media, such as theater and, ultimately, film. Other outlaw figures, with as
good if not better claims to hero status, nevertheless remain largely within
the folk knowledge of their local communities, as is the case with western
Australia’s bushranger hero, Moondyne Joe. On the other hand, the Italian boy,
Giovan Battista Perasso, locally known as ‘‘Balilla,’’ is said to have started an
insurrection against the occupying Austrians in the city of Genoa in December
1746 by throwing a stone at an imperial officer. According to research by Maria
Pia Di Bella, from this act of local heroism, Balilla went on to become a national
hero, the subject of songs and widespread folkloric, and even official, celebration
in later nineteenth-century schoolbooks.
Mythical characters of local notoriety may also achieve a wider fame, as in the
example of Uncle Tom Cobleigh, a character in a southwest English song about
seven men who borrow Tom Pearce’s mare to go to Widdecombe Fair. The song
includes the phrase ‘‘Uncle Tom Cobleigh and all’’ in its chorus. This phrase has
passed into many varieties of the English language as a catchphrase for complete
inclusivity, the equivalent of ‘‘everything but the kitchen sink.’’
Graham Seal
See Also Hero/Heroine, Folk; Legend.
References
Baker, R. 1982. Hoosier Folk Legends. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Cheney, T. 1974. The Golden Legacy: A Folk History of J. Gordon Kimball. Salt
Lake City: Peregrine Smith.
Dorson, R. 1946. Johnathan Draws the Long Bow. Cambridge: Harvard University
Press.
810 | Local Heroes
811
812 | Magic
verbal, physical, and material but also and at the same time mental, emotional,
and intentional in method and operation.
Magic has often been associated, in scholarship and in popular awareness, with
the supernatural and identified as the occult. Magic and the occult share certain
qualities and associations. They both rely upon a concept of truth encoded in hid-
den, secret, inner knowledge and practice that is available only to the initiate, giv-
ing the believer extraordinary access to the mysteries of the divinely created and
existent universe. The term occult science refers to an esoteric, veiled, and tran-
scendent reality, mediated by intuitive inspiration, understanding, and knowledge
and interpreted by methods of study, experimental investigation, and disciplinary
practice. The ‘‘occult sciences,’’ also known as Hermeticism or the Hermetic sci-
ences, traditionally have included such diverse systems of magical belief and
practice as alchemy, astrology, numerology, magical herbalism, talismanry, and
amuletry, as well as systems of divining and dream interpretation, theurgy, and so
forth. The occult sciences exist within a mode of knowledge and practice that
accepts and even insists upon the parallelism of the natural and supernatural, a
chain of causality based on empirical and nonempirical factors, and a system of
explanation and instruction that contends that some of the truth (maybe the most
important and central part) may not be fully disclosed but must be kept hidden.
The mysteries can be interiorly apprehended as ‘‘gnosis’’ and even outwardly
814 | Magic
experienced in practice, but they cannot be definitively expressed and are thus
‘‘occult’’ or divine secrets. The first term in the expression occult science is more
about knowledge, the second is more about action. But both share aspects of
knowledge and action. There is a need to balance the treatment of the magical, or
occult, disciplines as manifestations of ‘‘folk’’ or ‘‘primitive’’ tradition divorced
from the theoretical and intellectual strata of communities, cultures, and religious
systems by concentrating attention on the links in magic between learned and
common belief and practice.
One result of the detailed and mold-breaking ethnographic work in the latter
half of the twentieth century is that it has become more difficult, if not impossi-
ble, for scholars in anthropology, sociology, the history of religion, and folk reli-
gion to speak of magic or the magical arts and occult sciences as survivals of
earlier unsophisticated, primitive, irrational, or illogical beliefs and practices. To
categorize magic and occult phenomena as cultural survivals is to call upon a di-
chotomous model of cultural development. The concept of survivals belongs to a
methodological orientation toward religion and magic that continues to oppose
an orthodoxy, embodying the normative values and institutions of official reli-
gion, to various heterodoxies, such as folk religious belief and practice. In gen-
eral, when the beliefs and practices of actual believers diverge from a notion of
prescribed institutional norms, they have been judged both heterodox and mar-
ginal, whether through the ascription of heterodoxy to sectarian communities or
the marginalization of magical practice and occult knowledge.
The history of the scholarly literature on magic may be summarized, in great
part, by reviewing the main features of the scholarly debate regarding the defini-
tion and relationship of magic, science, and religion; this debate began in the nine-
teenth century, principally among anthropologists and the pioneers of sociology,
and continued through most of the twentieth century. This scholarly debate has
revealed a rationalist bias against magic. Magic, like religion, has been predomi-
nantly characterized as not real according to the utilitarian approach of functional-
ist and empiricist scholarship. And the psychologizing of believers’ magical
worldviews and practices often has been accompanied by an unfortunate stigmati-
zation of magic as individual and/or social illusion, confusion, ignorance, or fraud,
justified by a scholarly assumption of an irrational or pathological psychology.
By the same token, the debate regarding the relationship of magic to science
has been perhaps most lively in the analysis of the late antique and medieval Her-
metic or occult sciences (alchemy, astrology, talismanry, divining, and so forth).
In scholarly representation, the relationship of magic to science has often been
constrained by the historical ‘‘success’’ of the Western definitions of rationality
and empirical method. Science in the Western mode is credited (by early anthro-
pologists such as Edward B. Tylor and James G. Frazer, as well as historians of
science) as the empirically based, technically proficient, and experimentally
Magic | 815
sound realization of its earlier and evolutionary precursor, magic. In this perspec-
tive, magic becomes demoted to a pseudo-science. The medieval-based systems
of knowledge and experimentation that may be called magical are labeled, there-
fore, pseudo-science, which is another way of saying ‘‘bad science’’ or ‘‘no sci-
ence.’’ From the perspective of contemporary history of science, the magico-
scientific traditions of classical and medieval civilizations for which we have
extensive textual records (Hindu, Chinese, Greco-Roman, Islamic, and Chris-
tian), for example, become interesting anachronisms, failed cultural and intellec-
tual paradigms, and flawed experimental models based on insufficient empirical
evidence and incorrect interpretation of the evidence available.
Magic has also been defined in its most absolute negative—that is, as not
religion—in the scholarly debate. It is always something other, usually something
less, and it is often assigned the dismissive synonym superstition. In turn, magical
belief and practice often have been devalued and characterized as primitive, vulgar,
crude, material, mechanical, irrational, and nonsensical or, in other words, the op-
posite of religion, which is characterized as civilized, cultured, pure, spiritual, non-
instrumental, rational, and meaningful. A related tendency in the debate has been
to see magic as a purely antisocial response by psychologically and socially malad-
justed individuals—the repository of the resentment and ill will (if not actual evil)
of a society. The classic remedy is countermagic, as in the typical relationship
between malicious witchcraft and witch-doctoring of tribal societies, according to
germinal anthropological studies and historical studies of witchcraft in early mod-
ern peasant societies. The intellectual history of this prejudicial opposition of
magic and religion has been described by a number of historians and anthropolo-
gists (e.g., Keith Thomas, Frances Yates, Carlo Ginzburg, Jon Butler, and Valerie
Flint). They clearly state that the cultural bias against magic in the academic study
of religion and magic (in both the humanities and the social sciences) is an inher-
ited one, stemming originally from Christianity’s complex and increasingly hostile
relationship to magic from the late antique era through the early modern era.
A corrective response to the functionalist and empiricist negation of magic
that explains it away as addressing purely human social and psychological needs
is the awareness among contemporary scholars that magic (whether defined
within a religious system or constituting in itself a religious system) was and is
considered real and effective by its community of belief and practice, above and
beyond its social and psychological dynamics. The question of effectiveness and
its emic criteria has received variable treatment from scholars of magic over
time. Earlier anthropological and historical opinion on the efficacy of magical
action emphasized the irrationality and illogic of magic, based upon Eurocentric
empirical standards of the day. Later and current interdisciplinary opinion has
acknowledged that magical belief and practice have a solid empirical basis in
physical observation and experience. Magical practice is aimed at ordering and
816 | Magic
making meaningful human experience and individual and social control or medi-
ation through symbolic representation. Scholarly views that are not grounded in
the actuality of magic, as a system of change on the natural and cosmic as well
as personal and social levels, are not really engaged with its concerns; they can-
not begin to represent what magic practitioners have believed and continue to
believe they are doing and what they understand as the results of their practices.
Similarly, in response to the history of science approach to magical systems,
there is no reason, based upon the ethnographic evidence available, to continue to
dismiss or deny the technological competence, intellectual sophistication, and ex-
perimental/observational vigor of the diversity of historical and contemporary mag-
ical arts and occult sciences by the standards of the Western sciences. That these
magical systems are not conceived to achieve the same results or establish the same
paradigms as the modern Western physical sciences does not invalidate or diminish
their activities. The history of science approach to them, however, does tend to dis-
tort and even block scholarly perception of the meaningful interactions of magical,
scientific, and religious systems. To cite a historical example of magical science,
medieval Christian and Islamic alchemy utilized the laws of physical causality for
both physical and nonphysical goals considered to be outside the purview of mod-
ern Western science; thus, it is not surprising that their results should diverge.
Viewed from the vantage point of Western results, the actual results achieved
become invisible and incomprehensible. The ‘‘operation’’ or ‘‘art,’’ as alchemy
termed itself, showed not only a philosophical orientation toward nature but simul-
taneously a material and processual response to nature. Alchemy as a theoretical as
well as a practical expression of magic represented the union of nature and artifice.
Historical and contemporary cultures of magical belief and practice have been
witnessed by extensive interpenetrating magical traditions of both learned texts (in
manuscript and print) and popular/folk texts (in print and manuscript). For exam-
ple, learned theoretical texts on alchemical talismanry interact with popular chap-
books of talisman and charm recipes, and theoretical texts of philosophical
cosmology and astrology are matched by popular manuals of horoscope casting
and astrological interpretation, as well as astrological folk almanacs. Although
many cultures possess rich traditions of literate magic, all world cultures possess
vast treasures of oral and ritual magical devotions expressed by ordinary believers
and practitioners, as well as by magico-religious ‘‘professionals.’’ In the study of
folk religion and folk magic, folklore and folklife scholars have compiled exten-
sive field reports of contemporary magical belief and practice that are, in many
cases, the oral observations and testimony of the living remnants of older historical
traditions. Oral traditional links of this type (such as that detailed by the scholar-
ship on oral traditional literatures) can potentially assist in the ethnographic recon-
struction of magical and other kinds of folklife from earlier historical periods and
also enlighten contemporary understanding.
Magic | 817
The folkloristic study of magic has focused attention primarily upon collecting
ethnographic information on folk healing systems and, in particular, on the inter-
action of spell magic and the material magical techniques and rituals of folk reli-
gious healing. Collection and classification of the oral components and contents
of these two overlapping categories of folk magic have produced a number of eth-
nographic studies of the magical practices of individual small communities world-
wide and many comparative typologies of magical healing lore by region; the
variations of their material and ritual contexts are detailed, but only vestiges of a
theoretical approach to magic and a small amount of systematic or rigorous con-
textualization of magical belief are articulated. Folklore has largely transmitted
the inherited theoretical constructs of earlier (and in many cases, now outmoded)
anthropological theories on magic, with comparatively little development of its
own unique theoretical perspective on the subject. Folklore’s strength in the study
of magic, however, has been its consistent and detailed attention to the oral and
material culture of magic and its delineation of the unique culture of magic
expressed by the ordinary believing person and small community.
Folkloristic interest in spell magic is an obvious outgrowth and a parallel devel-
opment to folkloristics’ strong emphasis on traditional oral poetry and the artistry
of traditional and received oral forms. Folklore scholarship on the oral epic and
other genres of verse and song testifies to the numinous transformative power in-
herent in the performance of contemporary oral art in the works of Albert Bates
Lord and Milman Parry, John Miles Foley, Robin Horton, Ruth Finnegan, and
others. These oral traditional arts are reminiscent of and, in many cases, directly
descended from rich multicultural historical traditions of the sacred and magical
power of cadenced speech; examples include the jinn- inspired gnomic utterance of
poetesses and poets of pre-Islamic Arabic, the guided speech of ancient Greek
poesy and late Greek oracle possessed and transfigured by an indwelling spirit, and
the fiery exhortatory poetry of the ancient Israelite prophets and judges compelled
by divine mission. These historical and contemporary conjunctions of the sacred in
oral art are strongly akin to the magical use of orality in spell magic, ritual chant,
and incantational songs often produced and performed during states of expanded
consciousness (trance, conscious dreaming, vision questing, and others) by magico-
religious officiants, whether priestesses and priests, medicine workers and shamans,
or witches and magicians. The deeply empowered contents, performance, and gen-
res of oral traditional art (particularly epic and other forms of poetic oral art) have
substantive and historical affinities with the sacred contents, ritual performance,
and verbal genres of folk religion and magic (chant, mantra, spell, and incantation).
Word magic is thus embodied for folklore in the universal genres of verbal art: oral
poetry, folksong, rhyme, riddle, proverb, folk narrative or story, and memorate.
There is a representative body of folklore material, more often than not labeled
superstition, relating to the oral lore on magical belief and practice within
818 | Magic
science when redefined as a part of religion will highlight the nature of various
sciences (whether medieval-based sciences such as alchemy, astrology, and talis-
manry or modern sciences such as biology, chemistry, and medicine) as systems
of belief interacting with parallel, complementary, or competing religious sys-
tems of belief. Finally, redefinition of magic as a part of religion by folklorists
and other scholars also will highlight the complex and subtle interrelationship
between institutional forms of religion and the beliefs and practices of actual
believers that often become most visible on the threshold of magic.
Kathleen Malone O’Connor
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Belief, Folk; Charm; Divination; Exorcism; Fairy Tale
Heroes; Medicine, Folk; Religion, Folk; Ritual.
References
Butler, Jon. 1979. Magic, Astrology, and the Early American Religious Heritage,
1600 1760. American Historical Review 84(2): 317 346.
Douglas, Mary. 1970. Purity and Danger: An Analysis of Concepts of Pollution and
Taboo. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Driver, Tom F. 1992. The Magic of Ritual: Our Need for Liberating Rites That
Transform Our Lives & Our Communities. San Francisco: Harper Collins.
Evans-Pritchard, Edward E. 1937. Witchcraft, Magic, and Oracles among the
Azande. Oxford: Clarendon.
Flint, Valerie I. J. 1990. The Rise of Magic in Early Medieval Europe. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Frazer, James G. [1890] 1922. The Golden Bough. London: Macmillan.
Ginzburg, Carlo. [1966] 1985. Night Battles: Witchcraft and Agrarian Cults in the
Sixteenth and Seventeenth Centuries. New York: Penguin.
Halpern, Barbara Kerewsky, and John Miles Foley. 1978. The Power of the Word:
Healing Charms as an Oral Genre. Journal of American Folklore 91: 903 924.
Hand, Wayland D. 1961. Introduction to Popular Beliefs and Superstitions from
North Carolina. In The Frank C. Brown Collection of North Carolina Folklore, ed.
Newman Ivey White, Vol. 6. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Hand, Wayland D. 1980. Magical Medicine: The Folkloric Component of Medicine
in the Folk Belief, Custom, and Ritual of the Peoples of Europe and America. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Hufford, David J. 1988. Contemporary Folk Medicine. In Other Healers: Unortho-
dox Medicine in America, ed. Norman Gevitz. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins Univer-
sity Press.
Malinowksi, Bronislaw. [1925] 1954. Magic, Science and Religion and Other Essays
by Bronislaw Malinowski, ed. R. Redfield. Garden City, NY: Doubleday and Anchor
Books.
Mauss, Marcel, and Henri Hubert. [1904] 1972. A General Theory of Magic. Trans.
R. Brain. New York: W. W. Norton.
Magicians | 821
Neusner, Jacob, Ernest S. Frerichs, and Paul Virgil McCracken Flesher, eds. 1989.
Religion, Science, and Magic: In Concert and in Conflict. New York: Oxford Univer-
sity Press.
O’Keefe, Daniel L. 1982. Stolen Lightning: The Social Theory of Magic. New York:
Vintage.
Tambiah, Stanley J. 1969. The Magical Power of Words. Man 3: 175 208.
Tambiah, Stanley J. 1990. Magic, Science, and the Scope of Rationality. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
Thomas, Keith V. 1971. Religion and the Decline of Magic: Studies in Popular
Beliefs in Sixteenth and Seventeenth Century England. London: Weidenfield &
Nicolson.
Winkelman, Michael. 1982. Magic: A Theoretical Reassessment. Current Anthropol-
ogy 23(1): 37 66.
Yates, Frances A. 1979. Giordano Bruno and the Hermetic Tradition. Chicago: Uni-
versity of Chicago Press.
Yoder, Don. 1972. Folk Medicine. In Folklore and Folklife, An Introduction, ed.
Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Magicians
The hero with supernatural powers is a figure found frequently in folk tradition.
Often these characters employ their magical abilities in contests with similarly
endowed villains, as is the case with the diminutive African hero Fereyel, among
many others. Magical powers may also be employed to predict the future, one of
Merlin’s abilities. They may be employed to immediately transport characters
large distances, as in the story of Aladdin. They may enable the magician to cast
various spells and charms or to speak with and/or to command animals, as in the
Korean story of Marshall Gang Gam-Chan. Heroes with magical powers may
also use them to benefit their community, as in the case of the Australian Abo-
riginal hero Wirreenun. Magicians may also be healers who use their magic to
cure illness, as in the case of the Eight Immortals of China.
Magicians are sometimes cast in the role of national or culture hero, as in the
case of Saemund Sigfusson the Wise (1056–1133) of Iceland. A priest-prince of
Oddi in southern Iceland renowned during his lifetime for his learning and wis-
dom, Saemund became by the seventeenth century an Icelandic people’s hero,
symbol of their dislike of and resistance to Danish rule. He was said to have
learned his magic at the Black School and was widely credited with cheating the
Devil, an attribute often attached to magicians.
Other national figures sometimes attract magical attributes, including Francis
Drake, Walter Raleigh, Owen Glendower, and even Oliver Cromwell. Drake, known
to the Spaniards as ‘‘El Draco,’’ was widely believed to be in league with the Devil,
822 | Magic Tale
and there are numerous traditions about his use of this connection to protect the
nation against the Armada and to provide his local community with a water supply.
Magicians, depending on their positive or negative status, go by various names
in folklore, including sorcerers, wizards, wise men or wise women, magi, witches,
warlocks, demons, dervishes, and so forth. One of the most commonly encountered
magical abilities is the skill of shape-shifting, or transmogrification. Being able to
turn oneself, or others, into different forms has many applications, including dis-
guise, invisibility, escape, the attainment of power, and so forth. Believed to have
lived in the last half century or so before the Christian era commenced, Vikramadi-
tya was the Raja of Ujjayini. He features in numerous folktales as a magician who
can send his soul into any other body and is also able to fly. He is a wanderer and
wise man with characteristics similar to those attributed to the biblical Solomon.
Magic is one of the relatively few areas of folk tradition in which heroines
approach heroes in number. However, magical villainesses are also extremely
common, most usually in the form of the witch, such as the Russian Baba Yaga.
Graham Seal
See Also Fairy Tale Heroes; Helpers, Folk; Hero/Heroine, Folk.
References
Leach, M., ed. 1972. Funk and Wagnall’s Standard Dictionary of Folklore, Mythol-
ogy, and Legend. London: New English Library, 1975. Abridged one-volume edition of
Funk and Wagnall’s Standard Dictionary of Folklore, Mythology, and Legend, 2 vols.,
New York: Funk and Wagnall, pp. 660 663.
Simpson, J., trans. and B. Benedikz, intro. 1975. Legends of Icelandic Magicians.
London: Brewer/Rowan and Littlefield, The Folklore Society.
Westwood, J. 1985. Albion: A Guide to Legendary Britain. London: Granada,
pp. 16 18.
Wherry, B. 1904. Wizardry on the Welsh Border. Folklore 15: 75 86.
Magic Tale
magic tale in order to distinguish oral folktales from literary tales of fantasy.
Because oral and literary traditions have intermingled repeatedly in European
tales during the past few centuries, favoring the term magic tale over the more
widely known fairy tale is simply a matter of taste.
A number of hypotheses have been raised about the age of the magic tale
genre. The suggested time of origin has ranged from the Neolithic Stone Age to
the seventeenth century. Contemporary scholars, however, consider the majority
of the known European magic tales to have been composed relatively late, in me-
dieval times at the earliest. Nevertheless, magic tales may include elements
(images, concepts) much older than the entire plots familiar to us today.
The most famous early anthologies of European fairy tales are Giovanni Fran-
cesco Straparola’s I piacevoli notti (1550–1553), Giambattista Basile’s Il pen-
tamerone (1634), and Charles Perrault’s Contes de ma mere l’oye (1697). Jacob
and Wilhelm Grimm published their Kinder- und Hausm€ archen (Children’s and
household folktales) in several editions from 1812 to 1858.
Magic tales fall into a number of subcategories. The Russian formalist A. I.
Nikiforov introduced the distinction between ‘‘masculine’’ and ‘‘feminine’’ magic
tales in 1928. The former deal with the feats of male heroes, and the latter concern
the vicissitudes of young women’s lives. A prototypical example of a masculine
tale is the ‘‘Dragon Slayer’’; feminine tales include ‘‘Sleeping Beauty’’ and ‘‘Snow
White.’’ Some popular magic tales, however, such as ‘‘Strong John’’ and ‘‘Tom
Thumb,’’ are founded on hyperbolic, carnivalistic fantasy.
Because of the breadth of the magic tale’s plot spectrum, one need not force
the tales into the straitjacket of only one plot scheme, as the Russian folklorist
Vladimir Propp attempted to do. According to him, all oral fairy tales can be mor-
phologically deduced from the tales about the kidnapping of a princess by a
dragon; the hero of these stories travels to the Otherworld, overcomes the monster
with his magic object, rescues the girl, and marries her at the happy end. Propp’s
‘‘mytho-heroic’’ scheme covers masculine magic tales well; the scheme is, how-
ever, less suitable in describing the plots of feminine and carnivalesque tales.
The main protagonists of magic tales are type characters: penniless boys or
girls, nameless princes and princesses. The fantasy figures appear as animals,
goblins, trolls, witches, spirits, dead people, devils, or human actors endowed
with marvelous and incredible abilities. Although Christian or ethnic belief fig-
ures may appear in magic tales, the basic attitude or mode found in most oral
magic tales is amoral and nonreligious.
Even though the magic tale is a prose narrative, it may include poetic lines or
songs. Openings and closings are often formulaic: ‘‘Once upon a time’’ and ‘‘Then
they lived happily ever after’’ transport the storyteller and audience in and out of
the fictitious world. A familiar feature of this type of folktale’s style and structure
is repetition: the presentation of the same element in two or three versions.
824 | Martial Arts and Folklore
References
Aarne, Antti. 1910. Verzeichnis der M€archentypen (The types of folktale). Folklore
Fellows Communications, no. 3. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1961. The Types of the Folktale: A Classification
and Bibliography. Second revision. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 184. Hel-
sinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Apo, Satu. 1994. Narrative World of the Finnish Fairy Tale: Structure, Agency, and
Evaluation in Southwest Finnish Folktales. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 255.
Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Degh, Linda. 1969. Folktales and Society: Story-Telling in a Hungarian Peasant
Community. Bloomington: Indiana University Press. (Originally published as M€ archen,
Erz€
ahler und Erz€ ahlgemeinschaft: Dargestellt an der ungarischen Volks€uberlieferung,
Berlin, 1962.)
Jason, Heda. 1977. Ethnopoetry: Form, Content, Function. Bonn: Linguistica Biblica.
L€uthi, Max. 1985. The European Folktale: Form and Nature. Trans. John D. Niles.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press. (Originally published as Das europ€ aische
Volksm€ archen: Form und Wesen, Bern and Munich, 1947.)
Moser, Dietz-R€udiger. 1975. Alterbestimmungen des M€archens. In Enzyklop€ adie des
M€archens, ed. Kurt Ranke et al., Vol. 1. New York: Walter de Gruyter.
Nikiforov, A. I. 1975. Towards a Morphological Study of the Folktale. In The Study
of Russian Folklore, ed. and trans. Felix J. Oinas and Stephen Soudakoff. Paris: Mou-
ton. (Originally published as K voprosu o morgologiceskom izucenii narodnoj skazki,
Leningrad, 1928.)
Propp, V. 1970. Morphology of the Folktale, 2nd ed. Trans. Laurence Scott. Austin:
University of Texas Press. (Originally published as Morfologija skazki, Leningrad, 1928.)
Thompson, Stith. 1946. The Folktale. New York: Holt, Rinehart and Winston.
Back when fighting arts operated at the village or family level, all knowledge
was folk knowledge—stories were told over drinks, around the campfire, and so
on, much as family stories are told and retold today, at every holiday. At the vil-
lage or family level, changes to the existing narrative only occurred with the tacit
Martial Arts and Folklore | 825
agreement of the listeners. Change the story without the agreement of listeners,
and the listeners would soon start telling new stories about the silly person who
tried to change the narrative.
Today, few martial arts operate solely at the village or family level. Instead,
most of them are regulated by bureaucracies. Bureaucracies produce formalized
curricula, sanctioned histories, and so on, and change is approved from above. The
advantage of this system is that it standardizes practices and curriculum, thereby
allowing an art to survive, reasonably intact, even during times of rapid expansion.
A bureaucracy keeps money and power flowing to the center. Thus, the people
nearest the center (the elite) tend to rewrite their practices and curricula to pro-
tect their own political and economic interests. For example, elite members are
usually given disproportionate coverage in official histories, whereas people who
have displeased the elite are written out of the official histories altogether. None-
theless, even in the most bureaucratic systems, folklore continues to circulate
informally. Some people still have the old text, or the old curriculum, or simply
dislike the central leaders, and have no problem telling anyone who will listen.
Martial arts provide a rich medium for folklore studies. For traditional sys-
tems, folklore provides insight into a worldview, whereas for bureaucratic sys-
tems, folklore provides clues into what may have actually happened (as opposed
to what the elite wishes had happened).
Put another way, folklore consists of a store of traditional knowledge embod-
ied in the customs (e.g., rituals and costumes) and art forms (e.g., proverbs and
tales) that are transmitted among members of a group. The folklore in turn helps
build and maintain group identity. In this context, the label ‘‘folk’’ is not a preju-
dicial comment on the validity of the material so labeled. Neither should any-
thing labeled ‘‘folk’’ be discounted as nonsense. Even if folk stories cannot be
proven using historical documents, the stories often lead researchers to more
concrete data. Even when documentation and archaeological evidence actually
disproves individual stories, such elements of expressive culture reflect qualities
of self-image and worldview current at the time the story was told. Thus, folk
perspectives warrant our respect and attention.
Narrative
Martial folk narratives should be viewed as efforts to ‘‘flesh out’’ the practical
aspects of the system of which they are a part. Although many of the tales even-
tually find their way into print, the tales frequently exist apart from written
media. Committing a narrative to print, however, does not change the folk status,
but print versions do give the impression of the story being genuine.
At one level, orally transmitted narratives are suspect. As any trial lawyer, police
officer, or parent can attest, stories change once you get somebody on the stand. In
addition, if we tell the story enough, we start to believe it ourselves. Moreover, the
826 | Martial Arts and Folklore
child, he resolved to answer his mother’s call by roaming the mountainous area
around the monastery after dark, striking stones and trees with his wooden prac-
tice sword. In this manner, he intended to teach himself the art of swordsman-
ship. The King of the Tengu, observing his dedicated practice, appeared to the
youth, defeated him using only a feathered fan, and then took on the task of
teaching him to master the sword.
Another common motif credits the animal world with laying the foundation of a
new martial art or technique. For example, although the particulars of the sur-
rounding events vary, tradition indicates that Praying Mantis quanfa was devel-
oped after a Chinese martial artist known as Wang Lang heard a ferocious hissing
from the bushes. He went to look, and witnessed a struggle between a praying
mantis and another insect (a cicada, grasshopper, or fly, depending on the version).
Many other martial creation legends hinge on the founder witnessing a life and
death struggle between different animal species. Indeed, some plots recur so fre-
quently and are dispersed so widely that they should be considered international
tale types. For instance, a clash between a snake and a bird has been claimed as
the origin legend of the Chinese arts of taijiquan and yongchun (wing chun) and
the Sumatran art of pencak silat; the clash also appears on the Mexican flag.
The animal-modeling motif incorporated into the taijiquan, yongchun, and
Silat legends is not limited to Asia. In the Gidigbo wrestling of the Yoruba of
West Africa, there is a technique of snatching an opponent’s arm in an attempt to
dislocate the shoulder or elbow. The technique is called ja-di ilafa (‘‘he who
fights like a gorilla’’), and is said to have been derived from watching the goril-
la’s attempt to intimidate rival gorillas by snatching and breaking young trees.
The reasons for basing martial arts on animal models are open to speculation.
More important at this point is the fact that these origin narratives provide a point
of common reference and a source of core attributes (e.g., strength, ferocity, or
endurance) that encourages bonding among practitioners of a martial art.
Another common genre consists of stories about the system’s heroes. For
example, a traditional history of yongchun maintains that this system was created
by the Buddhist nun named Wu Mei (Ng Mui) who had escaped from a destroyed
Shaolin Temple (various locations are identified) following an attack by the
forces of the Qing dynasty (1644–1911). The widely spread legend continues that
Wu Mei created a simple, quickly learned fighting system that she transmitted to
Yan Yongchun, after whom the martial art was named.
In the United States, a unique variant of the Wu Mei legend is perpetuated
within the contemporary Won Hop Loong Chuan (WHLC) system. According to
this group’s traditional history, Ng Mui (their preferred pronunciation) was
allowed to leave the temple at the conclusion of the battle because she was ‘‘only
a woman.’’ (This feature was emphasized by one of the WHLC’s female senior
instructors.) Ng Mui was accompanied by her children: one who held her hand,
828 | Martial Arts and Folklore
one she bore in her arms, and a third whom she carried in her womb. The oldest
child was named Soy, and the fact that the family was later attacked by Qing
troops is commemorated in a WHLC form called Inky Toy San Soy, a name said
to mean ‘‘The Three Steps of Little Soy.’’ To continue the WHLC story, Ng Mui
was said to have raised a family of ten sons and several daughters (the number
varies). She developed Wing Chun (their preferred pronunciation) as a relatively
low level art (in contrast to the secret family styles taught to the sons) so that the
daughters could barter these arts to their husbands (famous martial artists all) in
exchange for learning the spouse’s superior arts. Thus, thanks to Ng Mui, students
of WHLC are ultimately heirs to the ‘‘best of the best’’ martial arts (Green 1997).
In Brazil, King Zumbi (1655–1695) is both a historical figure and a legendary
hero, especially for capoeiristas of African descent. According to oral tradition,
Zumbi was the last leader of the quilombo (runaway slave colony) of Palmares, in
what is now the state of Alagoas, Brazil, and for years, Zumbi led resistance against
conquest of his quilombo and recapture of his people using his skills as a capoeir-
ista. Like the WHLC version of the Ng Mui saga, the legends of Zumbi argue for a
truly superior martial art, one that enabled unarmed resistance against swords and
guns. Solid early evidence connecting Zumbi to capoeira is lacking. Nevertheless,
Zumbi’s central role in the African Brazilian martial arts community is attested to
both by the persistence of his legends and by the commemoration of November 20,
the anniversary of his execution, as a day for African Brazilian awareness.
In some cases, legendary heroes cross beyond specific martial arts groups and
become the property of most of the martial arts community. Following the U.S.
releases of the films Fists of Fury (Golden Harvest, 1971) and The Chinese Connec-
tion (Golden Harvest, 1972), Bruce Lee (Li Xiaolong, 1940–1973) ‘‘mania’’ gener-
ated a spate of contemporary legends focused on Lee’s martial prowess. Among
these was a narrative that was transmitted from Hong Kong by students studying at
the University of Texas at El Paso in 1972. This tale described a challenge to Lee
by a cast member in one of Lee’s films who was an accomplished martial artist. In
response to the invitation to combat, Lee was said to have walked over to an oil
drum and pierced its metal side with a single thrust of his index finger. This act
squelched the fight before it began. Both the narrator and his audience were active
practitioners of yongchun, the system Lee had studied in Hong Kong, and, most im-
portant, the performer was an instructor and the audience members were his stu-
dents. The tale used Lee as an example of what diligent practice could produce.
Counter claims regarding Lee’s superhuman abilities also have surfaced within
the martial arts community. For example, Gene LeBell (1932– ), a former Amateur
Athletic Union judo champion, professional wrestler, and stunt man, allegedly gave
Lee a beating while working on the set of Lee’s Green Hornet television series
(ABC, 1966–1967). According to some versions, LeBell choked the actor into
unconsciousness. The actual event, according to LeBell’s Web site, was a prank
Martial Arts and Folklore | 829
during which the stunt man lifted Lee onto his shoulders and refused to put him
down until the actor promised not to kill him. The two then became close friends
(LeBell). The tale entered oral circulation around 2000 (probably as a result of its
being posted on LeBell’s Web site in that year), long after Bruce Lee’s death and vir-
tual canonization by his admirers. Reasons for the story’s popularity include debunk-
ing the Lee mythology and exemplifying the maxim that no one is invulnerable.
Folk Belief
Unsurprisingly, folktales embody folk beliefs. Folk beliefs in the martial arts can
range from the mundane to the fantastic, and tend to articulate relationships
between the fighting system itself and larger belief systems, such as religion, poli-
tics, or medicine. Folk belief may be cast in narrative form, exist as a succinct
statement of belief, or simply as allusions to common knowledge within the group.
A mundane folk belief is the one common among martial arts that the cloth
belt or sash used as a mark of rank should not be washed. The usual folk explana-
tion for this custom is that the white belt of the beginner eventually turns black
through years of wear, and then, after countless more hours, turns back to a
threadbare white. Thus, the natural (dis)coloration represents the effort expended
in developing one’s expertise, and washing unnaturally changes the color,
thereby leading to a misrepresentation of the wearer’s place in the martial order.
Beliefs in esoteric powers are also common. Examples are the concept known as
qi (in Chinese) or ki (in Japanese). Other martial arts have comparable beliefs. For
example, Southeast Asian Silat preserves a concept of supernormal power. The
sources vary but are internally consistent with the prevailing religious systems (in
this case, Islam). Gurus in the Sumatran style of Silat, called Silek Bayang (shadow
Silat), reportedly have the power to kill opponents by directing their power at the
victim’s head, neck, stomach, or navel; some even claim to have the ability to kill
with a glance. Equally esoteric Silat is said to render a practitioner invulnerable.
The signature weapon of Silat, the keris or kris, is believed to have an animating
presence akin to a soul that can trap a slain victim’s soul at the moment of death,
thus increasing its own power (Farrer 2006, 32–33). Some krisses are said to have
the ability to rattle inside their sheaths, thereby warning their owners of danger,
and some are said to leap from the sheath unbidden (Draeger 1972, 86). In the
drive for Indonesian independence following World War II, some nationalists who
were Silat practitioners credited the supernatural powers of their art (rather than
international political pressure) for the success of their efforts to force the Nether-
lands in 1949 to abandon colonialism in Southeast Asia.
Similarly, belief in the anting-anting (a physical charm or amulet) persists
among some practitioners of the Filipino martial arts. The anting-anting is said
to confer invulnerability on the bearer, as long as it remains in his possession.
The belief in the animate nature of weapons that was noted in the Indonesian
830 | Martial Arts and Folklore
Silat community is also found among some members of the Filipino martial arts
community. For example, a particular bladed weapon can have the power to cut
the person who removes it from its sheath. Protection against being cut is pro-
vided by ownership of an anting-anting or by personal charisma that confers pro-
tection against such a ‘‘malicious’’ weapon.
In capoeira, the power of corpo fechado (‘‘closed body’’), a practice by which
the body becomes invulnerable not only to the blows encountered in the roda (the
circle in which capoeira is played) but against blades and bullets, is sometimes
claimed. The closed body was achieved by the use of amulets. Oral tradition also
attributes the power of shape-shifting to some capoeiristas of the past, claiming that
they had the power to transform into an animal or tree, or to vanish into thin air.
Folklore, as a consequence of arising from members of a group needing to crys-
tallize and express identity, reflects the preoccupations of the group, embodies col-
lective self-image, projects images of others, and crystallizes worldview. Wherever
it exists, folklore serves the ends of defining the group and the group’s relation-
ships to a given social, cultural, or historical environment.
Thomas A. Green and Stanley E. Henning
See Also Art, Folk; Asian American Humor and Folklore; Chinese Folklore; Japanese
Folklore.
References
Chozanshi, Issai. 2006. The Demon’s Sermon on the Martial Arts. Trans. William
Scott Wilson. Tokyo: Kodansha International.
Draeger, Donn. 1972. The Weapons and Fighting Arts of Indonesia. Rutland, VT:
Charles F. Tuttle.
Farrer, Douglas. 2006. Deathscapes of the Malay Martial Artist. Social Analysis
50(1, Spring): 25 50, DOI: 10.3167/015597706780886076.
Green, Thomas A. 1997. Historical Narrative in the Martial Arts: A Case Study. In
Usable Pasts: Traditions and Group Expressions in North America, ed. Tad Tuleja.
Logan: Utah State University Press, pp. 156 174.
Green, Thomas A. 2003. Sense in Nonsense: The Role of Folk History in the Martial
Arts. In Martial Arts in the Modern World, ed. Thomas A. Green and Joseph R. Svinth.
Westport, CT: Praeger, pp. 1 11.
Henning, Stanley. 1994. Ignorance, Legend and Taijiquan. Journal of the Chen Style
Taijiquan Research Association of Hawaii 2(3, Autumn/Winter): 1 7. http://seinenkai
.com/articles/henning/il&t.pdf (accessed October 26, 2008).
LeBell, Gene. Stories. http://www.genelebell.com/stories.html (accessed October 29,
2008).
Lewis, J. Lowell. 1992. Ring of Liberation: Deceptive Discourse in Brazilian
Capoeira. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Ozaki, Yei Theodora. 1909. Warriors of Old Japan and Other Stories. New York:
Houghton Mifflin.
Marxist Approach | 831
Marxist Approach
Various methodological approaches to the study of folklore that are based on the
writings of Karl Marx (1818–1883) and Friedrich Engels (1820–1895). There is
no unified Marxist approach in the study of folklore, nor is there any Marxist
school allied with the study of folklore. Instead, scholars have incorporated vari-
ous aspects of Marxist philosophies either in their interpretive methodology or in
the selection of the folklore that they study. A great number of the Marxist theo-
ries and Marxist-informed studies in folklore are closely related to the interpreta-
tion of Marxism in the study of anthropology.
Marxism, which is generally considered to be a critique of capitalism, views
capitalism as historically bounded and not a natural, universal system. Marxist
theories engage several key concepts important to the study of culture and cultural
expressions. Perhaps the most important among these concepts is that of dialectal
historical materialism. Marxism is based on a dialectical model—one that accepts
the often contradictory nature of phenomena. Materialism, usually contrasted with
idealism, posits the primacy of matter. Thus, in Marxist dialectical historical
materialism, the consciousness of humanity stems from the relationships with ma-
terial existence. By incorporating the concept of dialectics—a theory of contradic-
tion—with materialism, Marx and Engels provided a basis for the evaluation of
history based in materialism. Nature, in this view, is not considered static; further-
more, the often contradictory phenomena of rapid change compared to slow de-
velopment can be accounted for in this theory. Dialectical historical materialism
thus forms the foundation for the critique of the development of capitalism and
the concomitant effects of this development on cultural expressions.
Capital, in Marxism, is not a ‘‘thing’’ but rather both a process and a social
relationship. Capital is based on the commodity. All commodities have use value
and exchange value. The use value of a commodity stems from its ability to sat-
isfy human needs, and the exchange value stems from its fixed-sum distribution.
The concept of surplus value, the difference between the worker’s wages and the
exchange value added to the commodity, allows for the accumulation of capital.
832 | Marxist Approach
Mode of production and social and economic formation also are essential terms
in the Marxist social critique and are used to describe stages in the development
of capitalism, a system that suggests both the existence of alienable labor and
global exchange networks. The term mode of production incorporates both the
technical, physical processes of commodity production and the social relation-
ships that underlie production in a society. This level of relationships is referred
to as the infrastructure. The term social and economic formation refers to the
interrelatedness of several coexisting modes of production in a given society.
This level of relationships is referred to as the superstructure. Given this intense
focus on processes and relationships, Marxism can be viewed as primarily con-
cerned with the analysis of social relationships and how they are articulated.
Thus, in Marxism, there is an intense scrutiny of class, ethnicity, family organi-
zation, and the division of labor along gender lines.
Neither Marx nor Engels wrote specifically on folklore or its study, although
they were aware of problems associated with the study of folklore. Perhaps the
two works that come closest to folklore studies in these original Marxist writings
are Marx’s Ethnological Notebooks of Karl Marx and Engels’s Origin of the Fam-
ily, Private Property and the State. The former work engaged the concept of primi-
tive society and precapitalist modes of production, and in the latter, Engels
provided a critique of the development of the division of labor between men and
women in the preindustrial household. The household, for Engels, was the original
economic unit of organization, one in which all of the work was done for the bene-
fit of the entire household. Although Marxist anthropologists have been actively
engaged in the study of the development of modes of production and social and
economic formation throughout history, Marxist folklorists have generally been
interested in how these developments are expressed in or articulated as folklore.
One can make several major divisions to describe the practice of Marxist theo-
ries in folklore. The first major division is that between Western Marxism and
Soviet-bloc Marxism. Although there has been a generally consistent develop-
ment in Western Marxism and its application to the study of folklore, the develop-
ment of Soviet folkloristics has been somewhat fragmented. Therefore, it may be
useful to view the study of folklore in the Soviet Union and the Eastern-bloc
countries in several periods: immediately following the Russian Revolution, the
years under Stalin, and the years after Stalin. Given the breakup of the Soviet
Union in the early 1990s, there will undoubtedly be a significant change in the
study of folklore in the years ahead, particularly in regard to the Marxist analysis
of folklore. In recent years, two major trends in the study of folklore have
emerged that are closely linked to Marxist-informed approaches. The first of these
trends is the documentation and analysis of ‘‘workers’ folklore.’’ The second of
these trends is the increased interest in Third World folklore, particularly expres-
sions associated with colonialism, imperialism and state-sponsored oppression.
Marxist Approach | 833
collective spirit of the working classes and therefore was a valuable achievement
gained acceptance and influenced the direction of Soviet folkloristics.
In the 1930s, folklore studies moved toward an examination of both ideology
and social problems as expressed by the workers in their songs and stories. The
study of individual narrators and the interplay between ideology and individual
creativity became a major area of study, as evidenced by B. M. Sokolov’s study
of byliny singers. The prior view of the aristocratic origins of the byliny was
rejected and replaced by the new interpretation of the genre as a creation of the
people. Another area in which Soviet folklorists began to work was the collection
and analysis of previously ignored folk genres, such as satires on religious figures
and aristocrats, skazy (or personal experience narratives), the folklore associated
with the revolution, and the folklore of workers. Folklore also was used as a
source for and an object of propaganda. Not only was there an interest in the folk-
lore of the workers and the revolutionary spirit expressed in traditional genres,
there were also new ideological songs and stories composed in folkloristic style.
With the advent of Stalinism, the study of folklore in the Soviet Union became
somewhat constricted, and folklorists were forced to abandon all forms of com-
parative studies and focus instead on the uniquely Soviet aspects of revolutionary
cultural expression. After de-Stalinization in 1956, Soviet folklorists were once
again allowed to make reference to Western works in their scholarship. Also,
folklorists attacked the manifestly nonfolkloric forms of byliny that detailed the
exploits of heroes of the revolution and Soviet leaders. Soviet folklorists also
began to study the folklore of ethnic minorities living in the Soviet Union. The
ideological slant of these studies was closely linked to the dialectical historical
materialism of classical Marxism. By studying the folklore of the minority popu-
lations, their cultural expressions could be included by folklorists in the analysis
of the historical development of societies. With the collapse of the Soviet Union,
it is unclear what the future holds for Marxist approaches to both the analysis
and collection of folklore in these previously Marxist-informed societies.
The study of workers’ folklore also has become a significant object of study out-
side of Soviet-influenced countries. In Scandinavia, numerous scholars have been
involved in both the collection and analysis of workers’ lore, and throughout the
1980s, several conferences were held specifically concerned with workers’ culture
inside and outside of Scandinavia. In the United States, the study of workers’ folk-
lore is often considered under the rubric of ‘‘occupational folklore.’’ Studying the
folklore of workers contrasts with the romantic project of studying the folklore of
peasants, dominant in nineteenth- and early twentieth-century folklore studies.
The fastest-growing field of study in Marxist folkloristics involves the Third
World countries and their development. The transition from precapitalist to capi-
talist modes of production is a significant historical change. Michael Taussig, in
his study of Latin American plantation and mining communities, examined how
Marxist Approach | 835
precapitalist symbols, particularly the devil, are used to negotiate the fearful tran-
sition to capitalism. In his study, he linked the devil as manifest in the folklore of
the workers to commodity fetishism. According to Marxist theory, abstractions
and social relations tend to become regarded as things—they are objectified. In
the extreme case, the objectified becomes reified and appears to take on its own
agency—it becomes fetishized. In the Marxist critique of capitalism, commodities
are seen as becoming fetishized, and this fetishism, in turn, finds expression in
folklore, according to Taussig. Precapitalist symbols, such as the devil, are then
used to express phenomena of the emergent capitalism. Studies based on Taus-
sig’s evaluation of the use of precapitalist symbols to explain emergent capitalist
phenomena could include the examination of economic exchange in peasant soci-
eties as expressed in their oral narratives.
Timothy R. Tangherlini
See Also Cultural Studies; Historical Analysis.
References
Bausinger, Hermann, Felix J. Oinas, and Carl Stief. 1972. Folklore. In Marxism, Com-
munism and Western Society: A Comparative Encyclopedia, ed. C. D. Kerning. New
York: Herder and Herder.
Choi, Chungmoo. 1993. The Discourse of Decolonization and Popular Memory:
South Korea. Perspectives 1: 77 102.
Hemmersam, Flemming. 1991. Worker’s Folklore and Worker’s Ethnology in Scan-
dinavia in the 1980s. ARV 47: 59 118.
Jay, Martin. 1973. The Dialectical Imagination: A History of the Frankfurt School
and the Institute of Social Research 1923 1950. Boston: Little, Brown.
Limon, Jose. 1983. Western Marxism and Folklore: A Critical Introduction. Journal
of American Folklore 96: 34 52.
Lombardi-Satriani, Luigi. 1974. Folklore as Culture of Contestation. Journal of the
Folklore Institute 2: 99 121.
Marx, Karl. 1974. The Ethnological Notebooks of Karl Marx. Ed. and trans. Law-
rence Krader. Assen, Netherlands: Van Gorcum.
Oinas, Felix J. 1973. Folklore and Politics in the Soviet Union. Slavic Review 32:
45 58.
Oinas, Felix J., and Steven Soudakoff, eds. 1975. The Study of Russian Folklore.
The Hague and Paris: Mouton.
Taussig, Michael. 1980. The Devil and Commodity Fetishism. Chapel Hill: Univer-
sity of North Carolina Press.
Zipes, Jack. 1979. Breaking the Magic Spell: Radical Theories of Folk and Fairy
Tales. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Zipes, Jack. 1984. Folklore Research and Western Marxism: A Critical Reply. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 97: 329 337.
836 | Mask
Mask
Any sort of facial transformation or adornment and the costume and behavior
that necessarily accompany it. In this sense, masks can range from the applica-
tion of makeup to the use of elaborate head coverings. As the basic sites of com-
municative expression and identity, the head and face are subject to extremely
diverse forms of masking in cultures throughout the world. Masks and masking
techniques can be viewed as arts and crafts, but their cultural function of altering
the faces of individuals in everyday life, drama, ritual, and celebration also must
be considered. The concept of ‘‘face’’ implies more than anatomical features. It
includes all of the social and symbolic meanings members of a society associate
with specific physical appearances. The considerable social significance of the
face accounts for stereotyping based on facial features, such as eye shape, nose
size, and skin color, and for the human propensity to distort these features
through masking. By simultaneously releasing individuals from their accustomed
face and burdening them with expectations associated with another, masking
reveals individual and cultural explorations of personality.
The production of masks consists of several stages: collection of raw materi-
als, preparation of the materials, crafting the mask from them, and application of
the mask. Materials for mask making include wood, shells, grasses, feathers, and
other natural products, papier-m^ache, ceramic, treated animal skins, plastic, rub-
ber, and metal. The raw materials may be carved, shaped, combined, painted, or
otherwise manipulated. In some contexts, any member of the given society may
perform each of these preparatory tasks; in others, the tasks may be restricted
to professionals and those in other specialized roles. For example, although many
participants in European carnivals purchase their masks from professional crafts-
people who use materials procured commercially, their New World counterparts
more readily construct their own, original masks from materials at hand. Appli-
cation and use of certain masks may likewise be restricted to specific individuals,
groups, or occasions, such as shamans in some rituals. Some masks may be re-
served for use by one gender.
The functions, meanings, and significations of masks must be determined in rela-
tion to the specific cultures and events of which they are a part. A surgical mask
means something very different in an operating room than on the street at Hallow-
een. Many Native American masks have religious significance restricted to specific
rituals and dances, including healing and puberty ceremonies. Some masks have the
power to transform the person wearing them into the figures they represent.
Traditional occasions for masking generally cluster at points of transition in the
annual cycle and the life cycle, such as changes in seasons, birth, and death. Most
European scholars formerly took this as an indication that all masking events origi-
nated in a primitive, pre-Christian mentality geared toward spirits of nature that
govern fertility and renewal or spirits of the dead that can affect the living. From a
different perspective, transitional points can be seen as pauses in the productive
cycles. The increased leisure time during these phases allows for eased structures of
social engagement. In this context, masking occasions, like other forms of play and
fantasy, provide a possibility for the exploration of alternative identities. This ex-
ploratory operation often focuses on inversions, opposites, and exaggerations. Some
of the most common masking strategies involve the conflation of incompatible
binaries: male/female in cross-dressing and androgynous masks; human/beast in the
many animal masks found globally, in wild man figures, and in the Kwakiutl man
within a raven within a bull; plant/animal in vegetation demons made of agricul-
tural waste or excessive local natural products, such as bog moss creatures; insider/
outsider in the frequent, stereotyped depiction of ethnic groups, such as Jews, Gyp-
sies, and Moors in Europe, Indians and Africans in North America, and white
anthropologists in Africa; and human/supernatural in masked depiction of deities.
Exaggeration takes the form of extended and exploded features. Bulbous
noses, puffy cheeks, and monstrous mouths appear on masks in many societies.
Giant figures walking on stilts or carried in processions also utilize this trope, as
do ‘‘big-heads’’ with their oversized heads dwarfing the bodies on which they sit.
Jewelry, implants, and means of extending features offer other techniques for fa-
cial distortion. Rarely does a mask attempt an accurate representation of a human
838 | Material Culture
face. Seemingly human masks often involve subtle caricature or reduction of dis-
tinctive features. Some masks, such as stockings or plastic Halloween faces, take
the reduction of facial features to an extreme, creating eerie effects.
Although the disguise afforded by masks frees wearers from their conventional
personalities, it does not allow unrestricted exploration of alternative roles. Cul-
tural expectations, explicit or perceived, also impose restrictions on the sounds,
gestures, and movements made when wearing certain masks. In the carnival of
Elzach, Germany, masked Schuttig figures must speak in a falsetto or emit gruff
growls. In ritual and drama, maskers often have precisely choreographed roles. A
child dressed for Halloween is likely to behave in a manner associated with the
figure represented by the mask, just as the performer of a Navajo bear has specific
duties and roles. However, the behavior of these maskers may tend toward carica-
ture and exaggeration, much like the facial features presented in their masks.
Outside of their culture contexts, masks often retain elements of their power
and fascination. The booming market for masks as art pieces, the popularity of
plastic surgery, even the effect of dismembered heads displayed in various ways
all reaffirm the significance of the face in human communication and thought.
Peter Tokofsky
See Also Carnival; Costume, Folk; Drama, Folk; Festival; Mumming.
References
Alford, Violet. 1978. The Hobby Horse and Other Animal Masks. London: Merlin.
DeMott, Barbara. 1982. Dogon Masks: A Structural Study of Form and Meaning.
Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research.
Goonatilleka, M. H. 1978. Masks and Mask Systems of Sri Lanka. Colombo, Sri
Lanka: Tamarind.
Hammoudi, Abdellah. 1993. The Victim and Its Masks. Trans. Paula Wissing. Chi-
cago: University of Chicago Press.
Leach, Edmund. 1961. Time and False Noses. In Rethinking Anthropology, ed.
Edmund Leach. London: Athlone.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1982. The Way of the Masks. Trans. Sylvia Modelski. Seattle:
University of Washington Press.
Napier, David. 1986. Masks, Transformation and Paradox. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Material Culture
the maintenance of human life, material culture also includes objects that may be
classed as amenities, such as varieties of household implements, and luxuries,
such as paintings or items of jewelry. Since human beings are constantly making
or using things, a person’s entire biography from birth to death can effectively be
monitored by following the flow of objects throughout his or her life. Larger
social themes can be investigated as well by making similar observations across
the experience of an entire community. Thus, students of material culture, though
they are expected to pay close attention to the description and evaluation of arti-
facts, are even more concerned with how people use objects and assign meanings
to them. The thought and behavior associated with material items is, in the end,
considered more important than their physical attributes.
Within the phrase material culture, culture is ultimately the more significant
term, for no matter how intriguing or emotionally satisfying an object’s form,
color, or texture, its deepest significance will not differ in any fundamental way
from the prime messages of music, oral literature, dance, or any other expressive
form. Material culture specialists should be seen, then, as students of a segment
of human conduct. They even may play the lead role in the study of particular
locales where things and property are deemed crucially important or where arti-
sans are highly esteemed. In materialistic places where the production, accumu-
lation, and display of goods are central to social definition, it would seem most
prudent to concentrate the greater share of scholarly inquiry on aspects of mate-
rial culture. And where there is little in the way of firsthand data about a group,
particularly for those vanished historical communities that have left little or no
legacy in written or documentary form, material culture provides the most secure
means for retrieving salient features of everyday life. This is because an object,
unlike a story or a song, does not require the presence of a living performer; an
artifact can be said to ‘‘perform’’ its biography by the simple fact of its presence.
Although the mission of material culture study may complement a wide array of
disciplines, including art history, the decorative arts, architectural history, geog-
raphy, and social history, the greatest similarities are found with the objectives
of anthropology, particularly with its subfield archeology. Indeed, material cul-
ture research is, because of its utility as a means of historical recovery, often
referred to as ‘‘aboveground archaeology.’’
The study of any object proceeds via the analysis of its components or attrib-
utes. Although these may be prioritized in different ways, all objects, it is agreed,
have a physical form, a method of manufacture or construction, and a pattern of
use. Of these features, form is usually the first to be considered since it provides
the most trustworthy basis for developing a typology and then for making assess-
ments about definitive characteristics and relevant comparisons. Through formal
analysis, one develops a three-dimensional description of an object, and once a
particular object—a chair, for example—is compared with other objects of a
840 | Material Culture
Artifact
Any object made or modified by humans. The term derives from the Latin arte fac-
tum, meaning something made with skill. The object expresses the mental template
of its maker and the culture at large, through the shaping of raw materials that
result in the artifact’s tangible form. The attributes seen in an artifact are based on
traditional, functional, and/or technological requirements of the user and culture.
For these reasons, few artifacts have only one attribute or meaning.
The varied approaches used during the last century to study artifacts began with
the description and classification of objects, usually by museum curators. The arti-
facts were grouped according to type, based on their morphological features. Nine-
teenth-century evolutionary theory, combined with the diffusionist theories of early
twentieth-century anthropologists, contributed to the development of stylistic anal-
yses of artifacts, as well as interest in the techniques and technology used in making
them. The early fieldwork of cultural anthropologists such as Bronislaw Malinowski,
Franz Boas, and Ruth Benedict and archaeologists such as A. V. Kidder focused on
the interrelationship of objects to sociocultural patterns and structures.
Since the 1960s, the study of artifacts has drawn on a number of disciplines in
the physical and social sciences to extract information not readily apparent to the
observer. The most recent efforts now inform an integrated approach that includes
aspects of the previous approaches. Artifacts now ‘‘speak’’ to the observer as repo-
sitories of human communication and interaction. Reading the text of an artifact,
rather than just focusing on its physical attributes, is another way of accessing the
culture being studied.
Although artifacts occupy a central place in anthropology and folklore studies,
each discipline differs in its approach and analyses. It is understood that through arti-
facts, researchers in both disciplines can attempt to comprehend the beliefs, values,
attitudes, ideas, and assumptions of a society or group of people at a given point in
time. So the main distinction that separates the two disciplines is the factor of time.
For the archaeologist, the processes (both mental and physical) by which an artifact
is produced are less tangible than for the folklorist since archaeologists often study
cultures that are extinct. At best, the archaeologist can only hope to accurately
guess at these processes through the reconstruction of events and scientific study.
For the folklorist, however, the artifact or folk object is part of an informal learning
process whereby, through tradition, the mental and physical aspects of the object’s
manufacture are seen in the creative process of the producer and are recorded by
the folklorist. In turn, when the artifact’s form is read like a text, then certain motifs
can be recognized and compared to known traditions. In this context, the artifact is
complete and historical, so there is no mystery as to its relative context or creator.
Regardless of disciplinary orientation, the artifact continues to play a central role
in bringing the culture to the researcher. In this sense, the artifact, as reference
point, mirrors for posterity the ideas and systems of the culture that produces it
purposefully or accidentally.
Georgia Fox
Material Culture | 841
‘‘social life’’ of an artifact is a distinct task of material culture research that may
take one well beyond an object’s apparent function.
A quilted bedcover, for example, is generally understood as an item of sleeping
equipment meant to protect and comfort a sleeping person through a cold night. Yet
a quilt does so much more than that. The design of its top side, often colorful and
geometrically complex, warms the spirit as much as the body. Intriguing to look at,
it may even affect the overall look of the space in which it is used, simply by being
the largest item in the room. Further, since quilts are usually produced by women,
their decorative impact brings a woman’s signature to a building that was likely
constructed by men. A quilt may then constitute a crucial feminizing component in
the effort to transform a house into a nurturing home. Since the materials used in
quilts frequently were scavenged from other sewing projects, various bits of cloth
will serve as mnemonic devices that awaken recollection of poignant moments in
the family’s history. A quilt may then enhance solidarity by encouraging the telling
of important narratives. Because any artifact will simultaneously serve several pur-
poses, there is an obligation in material culture research to portray something of the
daily life of objects. Consequently, one is inevitably led beyond discussions of
expected pragmatic functions to considerations of such aspects as aesthetics, ethical
responsibilities, gendered social roles, or the preservation of memory. This is
because in studying how artifacts are used, one is soon drawn into the social con-
texts that surround objects. In considerations of form and construction, the artifact is
the center of attention, but in discussions of use, the artifact may only serve as a
means of entry into other social concerns. In this sort of inquiry, the artifact even
may seem to fade into the background as other matters are highlighted.
The study of the social contexts surrounding artifacts provides the most com-
mon meeting ground for the various disciplines with proclaimed interests in
Material Culture | 843
material culture. But if the commentary about material culture is not grounded in
things—in the concrete experience of the artifact—objects are reduced to mere
illustrations, to pictures that serve only to adorn the pages of a scholar’s text. It is
a fundamental assumption in material culture research that artifacts are texts,
albeit in tangible form. Thus, they have to be treated as vital, firsthand evidence
and not as ornaments that will enhance accounts generated primarily from writ-
ten records. That the reputation of the artifact still lags well behind the document
as the datum of choice is due to a long-standing bias in scholarly tradition that
favors words over things. There is, consequently, a general lack of what might be
termed ‘‘artifactual literacy’’ among scholars who, though they can read docu-
ments, do not know how to look beneficially at material evidence. Until the abil-
ity to ‘‘read’’ objects is more widespread, the study of material culture will
continue to be snubbed as ‘‘pots and pans history.’’
Since material culture is so pervasive in human history, it makes little sense to
ignore the ever-present, ever-constant messages that it provides. Folklorist Henry
Glassie argues that via the artifact, scholars might recover truly scientific proce-
dures for their enterprise, avoid the biases of elitism, and develop more convinc-
ing explanations—all of which should lead to what he calls a ‘‘more human
history.’’ Such a laudatory project, however, is not easily achieved. Artifacts are
complex texts layered with subtleties and the seeming contradictions of simulta-
neous functions. Although all objects convey cultural meaning, some convey that
meaning more effectively and with greater impact. Therefore, in selecting an
object or class of objects to study, it is important to choose well. One should
select things that are complex and thus invested by their makers with considerable
effort in design and manufacture: The investment of time, resources, and energy
provides assurance of significance. The most preferable object also should be tied
to a place, that is, rooted to a locale in the case of a building or intimately con-
nected to a family in the case of a cherished keepsake. In either instance, the
object is less likely to be removed from its original context and will more readily
allow access to the circumstances of its creation and use and therefore to its social
meanings. Finally (and this is perhaps obvious for historically motivated projects),
one should select artifacts that are durable and enduring. Things that have sur-
vived the assaults of time have the capacity to take us back directly to the periods
when these items were first made. They thus are quite useful in developing an
accurate historical baseline. Things that continue to be made according to the dic-
tates of traditional authority and in large numbers illuminate well the satisfactions
of custom and the dynamics of social identity. Used together with very old items,
they facilitate confident analysis both of origins and subsequent developments,
involving a complex balance of continuity and change over time.
Material culture research is, among American folklorists, a relatively young
enterprise. Even though a number of the founding members of the American
844 | Material Culture
Folklore Society in the late nineteenth century were associated with museums
and were thus students of artifacts, it was not until the 1960s that material culture
began to be more fully accepted. However, studies of folk architecture, art, craft,
foodways, costume, and agriculture published since then have effectively dem-
onstrated the value of this specialization. Indeed, material culture courses have
become regular offerings in university curricula, and papers on tangible aspects
of traditional culture are now a staple of academic conferences. One suspects that
in the future, it will be normal practice for folkloric ethnographies to incorporate
and blend together evidence of oral, musical, and material traditions.
John Michael Vlach
See Also Architecture, Folk; Art, Folk; Costume, Folk; Craft, Folk.
References
Appadurai, Arjun. 1986. The Social Life of Things: Commodities in Cultural Per-
spective. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Armstrong, Robert Plant. 1971. The Affecting Presence: An Essay in Humanistic
Anthropology. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Babcock, Barbara A. 1992. Artifact. In Folklore, Cultural Performances, and Popu-
lar Entertainments, ed. Richard Bauman, pp. 204 215. New York: Oxford University
Press.
Bronner, Simon J., ed. 1992. American Material Culture and Folklife: A Prologue
and Dialogue. Logan: Utah State University.
Bronner, Simon J. 1992. The Idea of the Folk Artifact. In American Material Culture
and Folklife: A Prologue and Dialogue, ed. Simon J. Bronner. Logan: Utah State Uni-
versity Press.
Csikszentmihaly, Mihaly, and Eugene Rochberg-Halton. 1981. The Meaning of
Things: Domestic Symbols and the Self. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Deetz, James. 1967. Invitation to Archaeology. New York: Natural History Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1968. Pattern in the Material Folk Culture of the Eastern United
States. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Glassie, Henry. 1975. Folk Housing in Middle Virginia: A Structural Analysis of His-
toric Artifacts. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1989. Craftsman of the Cumberlands: Tradition & Continuity.
Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Schlereth, Thomas J., ed. 1982. Material Culture Studies in America. Nashville, TN:
American Association for State and Local History.
Upton, Dell, and John Michael Vlach, eds. 1986. Common Places: Readings in
American Vernacular Architecture. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Vlach, John Michael, and Simon J. Bronner, eds. 1992. Folk Art and Art Worlds.
Logan: Utah State University.
Walls, Robert E. 1990. Folklife and Material Culture. In The Emergence of Folklore
in Everyday Life, ed. George H. Schoemaker. Bloomington, IN: Trickster.
Medicine, Folk | 845
Medicine, Folk
‘‘Unofficial’’ health practices and beliefs found in all societies. These are both re-
ligious (e.g., the use of prayers for healing or the belief that sin is a cause of dis-
ease) and material (e.g., the belief that eating a hot breakfast will prevent winter
colds or the use of jewel weed to treat poison ivy). These beliefs and practices
exist as complex systems related to the other beliefs, values, and attitudes of
those who hold them. Folk medicine is not considered ‘‘false belief,’’ and con-
ventional medicine has, in fact, adopted many items from folk tradition. The old-
est modern conception of folk medicine placed it within a system of layers, lying
between official, scientific medicine (the top layer) and primitive medicine (the
bottom layer). This scheme reflected the nineteenth-century view of cultural evo-
lution in which medicine, like the rest of culture, was seen as having developed
from its crudest, most primitive form into its modern, Western, highly sophisti-
cated state. All that was most effective in medicine was retained during this evo-
lutionary ascent, while discarded and obsolete ideas drifted downward and were
preserved in the lower layers. This notion is summed up in the German term
gesunkenes Kulturgut (sunken cultural materials). Although this model remains
influential in popular thought, the evolutionary view of culture on which it was
based has now been discarded or extensively revised by most scholars.
Current definitions of folk medicine show two main influences. Folklorists
interested in health beliefs and practices in modern, technologically advanced
societies have focused primarily on those found in specific cultural and subcultural
groups and transmitted, in large part, by oral tradition. Examples would be the
brauche, or ‘‘powwow,’’ tradition among Pennsylvania Germans, curanderismo
among Mexicans and Mexican Americans, and the herbalism traditions found in
Appalachia. Anthropologists usually have studied folk medicine in developing
countries. This setting has led them to emphasize the culture-exchange relation-
ship of folk medical systems both with local, indigenous traditions and with the of-
ficial medical system of the politically dominant national culture. The latter is
often modern, Western medicine. From the fieldwork of these two disciplines, a
general definition of folk medicine has evolved, encompassing health traditions
that exist alongside but at variance with whatever other medical system is recog-
nized as ‘‘official’’ in the local context. As a result, the concept of folk medicine
has broadened.
If folk medicine is unofficial health beliefs and practices, it must be recog-
nized that officialness is a relative term, rooted in context. Something is official
if it is authorized in a formal way. Scientific medicine is the official medicine of
the United States through authorization by a host of government sources (e.g.,
the office of the surgeon general), the bodies that accredit medical schools, and
so forth. Folk health traditions are not given official standing by such agencies,
846 | Medicine, Folk
and many lack formal authority structures of their own. There is no office or
agency among folk herbalists in a region that can specify standard procedure or
regulate practice. Oral tradition has processes that support standards and con-
strain practice, but they do not speak with one voice. They also do not command
the resources and power that more formal institutions do. Therefore, folk medi-
cine tends to rely heavily on oral tradition, and this is one reason why it tends to
develop locally distinct forms, whereas official medicine shows much greater
consistency across large distances.
The more complex and the more integrated such a health system is—that is,
the greater the number of orderly relationships among its parts—the more stable
it will be. One very important element that adds complexity is the tendency of
folk medicine traditions to combine both natural elements, such as herbs, mas-
sage, and dietary rules, with supernatural elements, such as divine sanction for
the natural approach, the efficacy of prayer, the idea of supernaturally caused
disease, witchcraft, or the evil eye. The division of folk medicine into ‘‘natural’’
and ‘‘magico-religious’’ domains, common through much of twentieth-century
scholarship, misses the powerfully integrative tendency of most traditions. This
integration of material and spiritual elements is one of the great attractions of
folk medicine to many of its users.
No matter how complete and exclusive a consensual health system may
appear, the individual systems of those who comprise it will be somewhat eclec-
tic. The individual systems of most folk healers and their patients will include
ideas not only from their folk tradition but also from modern medicine, from reli-
gion, and so forth. By the same token, most medical doctors hold some folk
beliefs along with their scientific beliefs and values. This individual diversity
encourages the constant flow of influences among the health systems within a so-
ciety because each person actually constitutes a bridge connecting two or more
traditions.
848 | Medicine, Folk
and other forces that reduce cultural isolation have not led to the demise of folk
medicine—quite the contrary. A study published in the New England Journal of
Medicine in 1993 found that 34 percent of Americans had used what the investi-
gators called ‘‘unconventional interventions’’ within the preceding 12 months.
Among those practices mentioned in the survey were several forms of folk medi-
cine, including herbs and spiritual healing. This high rate of use came in spite of
the exclusion from the survey of basic prayer for healing, probably the most
widely used variety of folk healing. The survey also found, as have other studies
in the United States and Europe, that use of these traditions was positively associ-
ated with higher education.
This finding comes as no surprise to scholars who do fieldwork in contempo-
rary folk medicine. Although the children and grandchildren of some immigrant
groups have rejected traditions including folk medicine as impediments to
‘‘Americanization’’ and their social aspirations, others in the community have
shown great interest in folk medicines with which they did not grow up. The Ca-
ribbean traditions of spiritism, espiritismo (Puerto Rican) and santeria (Cuban),
both with strong healing elements, now attract supplicants and members from
the Anglo community in the northeastern United States. In Puerto Rico and the
northeastern United States, there have even been projects to bring spiritists and
mental health professionals into a collaborative, collegial relationship to work to-
gether in community mental health. Like acupuncture (which it accompanied to
the United States), classical Chinese herbalism is sought out by patients from all
kinds of ethnic groups and social classes. Psychotherapists and psychoneuroim-
munology researchers are turning to the techniques of shamans to treat both psy-
chological illnesses and physical diseases such as cancer. There is, in fact, a
‘‘neoshamanic movement’’ whose members seek to use drumming and other sha-
manic techniques to attain trance states both for self-fulfillment and for the treat-
ment of others.
In the 1960s, cross-traditional influence and the adoption of beliefs and prac-
tices by people not raised with them would have been seen as ‘‘contaminating’’
tradition. The result, especially when it began to be transmitted in books and
magazines, might have been called ‘‘fakelore.’’ But it is clear that this view is
outmoded today, particularly concerning folk medicine. Folk medicine always
has exchanged materials and ideas with official medicine, and it always has been
an important competitor with official medicine. In the nineteenth century, it was,
in fact, almost impossible to tell which tradition was the official and dominant
one. At present, a variety of factors, including the increasing costs of high-tech
medicine, a widely expressed desire for a philosophy of healing that is more
‘‘holistic,’’ and ready access to many cultural traditions due to modern communi-
cation and migration patterns, have led to an efflorescence of folk medicine
traditions.
Medicine, Folk | 851
group as compared to a control group. The fact that such studies are being carried
out and published by medical doctors is perhaps as significant as their results.
But a consideration of folk medical efficacy cannot be restricted to medical
definitions. Several researchers have reported that even when the clients of folk
healers show no objective improvement in their symptoms, they often say they
feel better and may say that they have been healed. Such observations indicate
that folk medicine does more than address physical malfunctions. That broader
effect is indicated by healing, a central concept in many folk medicine systems.
Healing is one in a series of English words that have developed from the single,
ancient, Indo-European root word kailo, meaning ‘‘whole, uninjured, or of good
omen.’’ The linguistic descendants of kailo include the following: hale (as in
‘‘hale and hearty’’), health, whole, and holy. The ancient connections of health
with wholeness and holiness give some indication of why the connotations of
healing have always been larger than those of curing or treating, to choose words
more readily associated with medicine. One may or may not be made whole by
being cured of a particular condition, but no cure or remedy is likely to be said to
have rendered the patient more holy. Many forms of folk medicine deal directly
with the metaphysical issues raised by illness and the social disruption that it of-
ten brings. So even when physical disease remains, the peace and satisfaction of
having one’s spiritual welfare and one’s continuing place in the community
affirmed may constitute the most personally important form of healing.
David J. Hufford
See Also Midwifery; Religion, Folk.
References
Block, Eric. 2010. Garlic and Other Alliums: The Lore and the Science. Cambridge:
RSC Publishers.
Cavender, Anthony. 2003. Folk Medicine in Southern Appalachia. Chapel Hill: Uni-
versity of North Carolina Press.
De la Portilla, Elizabeth. 2009. They All Want Magic: Curanderas and Folk Healing.
College Station, TX: Texas A&M.
DeStefano, Anthony M. 2001. Latino Folk Medicine: Healing Herbal Remedies from
Ancient Traditions. New York: Ballantine Books.
FC&A Medical Publishing. 2004. The Folk Remedy Encyclopedia: Olive Oil, Vine-
gar, Honey and Other Health Remedies. Peachtree City, GA: FC&A Medical
Publishers.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1976. American Folk Medicine: A Symposium. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
Hand, Wayland D., ed. 1980. Magical Medicine: The Folkloric Component of Medi-
cine in the Folk Belief, Custom, and Ritual of the Peoples of Europe and America
Selected Essays of Wayland D. Hand. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Memorate | 853
Hatfield, Gabrielle. 2004. Encyclopedia of Folk Medicine: Old World and New
World Traditions. Santa Barbara, CA: ABC-Clio.
Hufford, David J. 1983. Folk Healers. In Handbook of American Folklore, ed. Rich-
ard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Kirkland, James W., Holly F. Mathews, C. W. Sullivan III, and Karen Baldwin, eds.
1991. Traditional Medicine Today: A Multidisciplinary Perspective. Durham, NC: Duke
University Press.
Kleinman, Arthur. 1980. Patients and Healers in the Context of Culture: An Explo-
ration of the Borderland between Anthropology, Medicine, and Psychiatry. Berkeley:
University of California Press.
McClenon, James. 1994. Wondrous Events: Foundations of Folk Belief. Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania Press.
McGuire, Meredith. 1988. Ritual Healing in Suburban America. New Brunswick,
NJ: Rutgers University Press.
Mitchem, Stephanie. 2007. African American Folk Healing. New York: New York
University.
O’Connor, Bonnie Blair. 1994. Healing Traditions: ‘‘Alternative’’ Medicines and the
Health Professions. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Rubel, Arthur J., Carl W. O’Nell, and Rolando Collado-Ardon. 1984. Susto: A Folk
Illness. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Sieling, Peter. 2003. Folk Medicine. Broomall, PA: Mason Crest.
Trotter, Robert C., and Juan Antonio Chavira. 1981. Curanderismo: Mexican Ameri-
can Folk Healing. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Yoder, Don. 1972. Folk Medicine. In Folklore and Folklife, ed. Richard Dorson.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Memorate
cognitive level manifests itself, above all, in rites and the ritualistic descriptions
of such rituals as sacrifices, prayers, or charms.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Anecdote; Belief Tale; Legend.
References
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1974. The Memorate and Protomemorate. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 87: 225 239.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Stahl, Sandra Dolby. 1989. Literary Folkloristics and Personal Narrative. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
von Sydow, Carl Wilhelm. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore: Published on the
Occasion of His 70th Birthday. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and Bagger.
Memorial Shrine
Kathleen Olivo of Stroudsburg, Pennsylvania, who lost her sister on September 11, 2001,
looks at a memorial wall in front of St. Paul’s Chapel in New York City, blocks from the
World Trade Center site. (AP/Wide World Photos)
This interaction between visitors and items left at the shrine—as each item con-
tributed changes the memorial, if only slightly—has led scholars to theorize
about memorial shrines’ communicative and performative qualities.
Memorial shrines are temporary constructions, generally remaining at a site for
a few months to a few years if the assemblage is not considered a hazard to public
safety or commerce. The highest levels of re/creation and visitation generally
occur right after the death(s) commemorated, and to a lesser extent on holidays,
birthdays of the deceased, and anniversaries of the incident. Activity at the memo-
rial may decrease due to the transference of material culture–centered mourning
to the cemetery or home. In other cases, memorial shrine creators may fix a spe-
cific date for its termination, such as the date the deceased would have graduated
from high school. However, activity at the site may be prolonged if: decorating at
the cemetery is prohibited or restricted; the shrine commemorates a public figure
whose burial site is not accessible to the general population; a large number of
people are memorialized at the same site; the incident causing the death(s) is con-
troversial in some way; or the shrine itself becomes a political statement. Memo-
rial shrines constructed following terrorist attacks are examples of the latter three
858 | Memorial Shrine
conditions, although roadside memorial shrines are also a frequent focus of local
or regional controversy and lead to official policy creation or change.
Some of these same conditions may also discourage or prevent a memorial
shrine from developing. As a matter of policy, vernacular memorial shrines are
sometimes banned by municipal or regional authorities. Death sites related to
recent or ongoing political or military conflict may be considered too dangerous
to visit, both physically and politically. Concerns for the maintenance of com-
merce near a death site may also dissuade the construction of a memorial shrine.
If family and friends live far away from the site of death, the construction and
maintenance of a shrine is less likely. Finally, surviving family and friends may
wish to avoid the death site altogether and therefore have little or no interest in
constructing and maintaining a memorial.
Considering the factors that contribute to or discourage the construction of a
memorial shrine leads to contemplation of the social meanings of such assemb-
lages. The roadside memorial tradition, perhaps one of the earliest forms of me-
morial shrines, developed as a material focus for prayers for the souls of the
deceased, to assist those who may have been spiritually unprepared for death.
Individuals interviewed regarding contemporary memorials speak of the assemb-
lages’ role in reclaiming a site that has been tainted by accidental or intentional
violence. In this way, memorial shrines may function as both physical and psy-
chological healing mechanisms. Scholarship on contemporary vernacular memo-
rial shrines has also identified them as a way of expressing grief in a public and
participatory manner, a break from the conventional Western denial of death. The
interaction between people and artifacts at memorial shrines also supports the
interpretation of these shrines as a new kind of mourning. Other scholars have
focused on the political or more broadly social declarations communicated both
by the artifacts and those who visit the shrines—statements about the dangers of
drunk driving; the importance of religion, patriotism, or public safety; affection
for a particular school or team; condemnation of politically motivated violence.
However, memorial shrines are not always judged positively. Some journalists
and academics view these assemblages as manifestations of excessive or even
pathological grief, narcissism, and consumer culture at its worst, telling the
viewer more about the people that visit the memorial than those they commemo-
rate or the circumstances that led to their death. By visiting and contributing
items to memorial shrines, some argue, individuals prolong and make public
emotion that has historically been expressed in more private contexts. Moreover,
the accumulation of artifacts at a shrine may be interpreted as: a demonstration
of consumer culture excess, a fetishistic display of consumer goods meant to
rehabilitate a scarred site and assuage feelings of loss and vulnerability, as well
as an element identified in the impulse to transform accident victims into heroes
or heroines, regardless of the circumstances of their death. Such interpretations,
Metacommunication | 859
References
Doss, Erika. 2008. The Emotional Life of Contemporary Public Memorials. Amster-
dam: Amsterdam University Press, 2008.
Everett, Holly. 2002. Roadside Crosses in Contemporary Memorial Culture. Denton:
University of North Texas Press.
Grider, Sylvia. 2001. Spontaneous Shrines: A Modern Response to Tragedy and Dis-
aster. New Directions in Folklore 5(October). http://www.temple.edu/isllc/newFolk/
shrines.html.
Margry, Peter Jan. 2007. Performative Memorials: Arenas of Political Resentment in
Dutch Society. In Reframing Dutch Culture: Between Otherness and Authenticity, eds.
P. J. Margry & H. Roodenburg. Aldershot, UK: Ashgate, pp. 109 133.
Santino, Jack, ed. 2006. Spontaneous Shrines and the Public Memorialization of
Death. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Metacommunication
‘‘you’ve heard’’ and ‘‘you know’’) to suggest an explanatory link between the
huge tree of his story and his audience’s knowledge of large trees in the ‘‘real
world’’: ‘‘You’ve heard o’ those big ol’, uh, trees in California, you know, bein’ so
big’’ (italics added). Metacommunication focusing on topic or message can deal,
for example, with the contextual appropriateness of topic (e.g., ‘‘Johnny, we don’t
talk about such things in public’’) or with the repetition of message for the pur-
pose of clarification or emphasis (e.g., ‘‘I said, ‘Pass the butter’’’). For his part,
storyteller Bell used a metacommunicative aside to comment humorously on his
own ability to provide a convincing story, on the problem of whether his audience
was convinced, and on the believability of the story (i.e., the message) itself:
‘‘And I don’t blame y’all if you don’t believe me about this tree, because I
wouldn’t believe it either if I hadn’ta seen it with my own eyes. I don’t know
whether I can tell ya how you could believe it or not, but that was a big tree.’’
Metacommunication dealing with communicational contact between the par-
ticipants can announce the opening of a communication channel (e.g., saying
‘‘Hello’’ after picking up a telephone receiver), or it can check whether the chan-
nel is indeed open (e.g., ‘‘Can you hear me?’’). In folklore performance, a blues
singer’s line, ‘‘Hear me singing to you,’’ refers to the singer, the audience, and
the communication channel (oral channel, or singing), as well as offering a
request for communicational contact (‘‘Hear me’’). Metacommunication treating
code (i.e., a system of information) might refer to whether the participants share
a particular cultural code. For example, the mother’s utterance in the following
exchange comments metacommunicatively on an ambiguous message and thus
on a lack of cultural sharing: Adolescent son: ‘‘That’s bitchin’ [a term of appro-
bation], Mom!’’ Disconcerted mother: ‘‘What do you mean?’’
Metalinguistic utterances focus on aspects of the linguistic code (e.g., grammar,
lexicon, orthography). For instance, they may refer to words as words (e.g., ‘‘I
can’t find macabre in the dictionary’’) or to the spelling of words (as in the spell-
ing riddle ‘‘How do you spell enemy in three letters?—N M E’’). Metageneric
utterances refer to conventions associated with a particular generic code. In the
following catch riddle, for example, the riddler ‘‘catches’’ the addressee in the
conventional assumption that riddlers already know the answer to the questions
they pose: A: ‘‘What’s red, purple, green, yellow, gray, sky-blue, and green?’’ B:
‘‘I don’t know.’’ A: ‘‘I don’t know either, that’s why I’m asking you.’’
Metanarration is metacommunication that refers to or comments on aspects of
a narrative or on aspects of a storytelling event. Excerpts given earlier from story-
teller Ed Bell illustrate some metanarrational functions. In addition, Barbara Bab-
cock has distinguished two types of metanarration. Explicit metanarration calls
attention deliberately to the narrative and/or to the storytelling event. For instance,
narrative beginning and ending formulas (e.g., ‘‘Once upon a time’’ and ‘‘they
lived happily ever after’’) establish and conclude, respectively, a metanarrational
Midwifery | 861
References
Babcock, Barbara. 1977. The Story in the Story: Metanarration in Folk Narrative. In
Verbal Art as Performance, ed. Richard Bauman. Rowley, MA: Newbury House.
Bauman, Richard. 1986. Story, Performance, and Event. Cambridge: Cambridge Uni-
versity Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1966. Metafolklore and Oral Literary Criticism. The Monist 50: 505 516.
Midwifery
The knowledge and practices associated with the experience of pregnancy and
childbirth. Ritual birth practitioners exist in all cultures. Since birth is a complex
cultural and biological process, midwifery encompasses belief systems about
healing as well as medical treatment. In some societies, midwives function as an
occupational group, often in conjunction with other medical personnel in the
public sphere. Traditional midwives, in contrast, aid the birth process in the pri-
vate realm as unpaid work or for a nominal or in-kind fee. In all cases, midwifery
involves prenatal and antenatal care as well as aid with the birth process. Prenatal
862 | Midwifery
practices include massage, the use of steam baths, and nutritional advice regard-
ing proper foods and/or medicinal herbs. Assistance with birth often requires
emotional as well as physical support, ‘‘catching’’ the baby, cutting the cord, and
treatment of the afterbirth, which has sacred significance in many cultures. In
caring for the mother and infant, midwives may stay with a woman for a week or
more. Traditional midwives perform a wide variety of other social functions,
which may include circumcision, preparation of the dead for burial, and quasi-
legal services such as establishing claims of virginity or alleged rape. Despite tre-
mendous cultural variation, midwifery practices underscore birth as a universal
and often highly structured ritual in modern industrial cultures as well as in tradi-
tional societies.
Early folk medicine scholarship in the United States and Europe incorporated
midwifery under studies of superstition and folk belief. At the turn of the twenti-
eth century, a number of articles appeared in the Journal of American Folklore
on myths, rituals, and beliefs surrounding childbirth. Early collections offer a
compendium of beliefs about the evil eye, breech births, being born with a
‘‘caul,’’ foods to eat to avoid miscarriage, and similar topics.
Recent analysis of midwifery reflects the shift in folkloristics from collection
of static phenomena and classificatory schemes to the study of dynamic proc-
esses and context. Often structural and comparative in nature, many studies con-
trast ethnomedical and biomedical worlds or compare midwifery as folk healing
with popular and academic medicine.
Early research concentrated on folk practitioners in rural settings and among
specific ethnic groups, such as African American midwives, Native American
practitioners, and Hispanic women who practice midwifery as part of curander-
ismo (folk healing). Comparative studies have expanded to include the practice
of nurse-midwives, who exist between the folk and biomedical worlds. A number
of scholars have moved beyond particular ethnic groups to examine birth as a
widespread rite of passage in technological societies.
Complementing and sometimes replacing comparative views, hermeneutic/inter-
pretive approaches focus on the meaning of midwifery practice. In the convergence
of studies of folk healing and systems of meaning, gender is pivotal. Although early
studies assumed gender, it was not an analytic focus. More recent work problemat-
izes gender, seeing midwives as women healers whose practice exists in a web of
gender/power relations. Focus shifts to the midwife as social actor, recruitment to
her role, and her place in the larger social order. Gender-focused studies also look
at informal healing roles in order to include a broader range of women’s experien-
ces and pose new questions about gender and healing. In some studies, midwives
are marginal figures, mediating between public and domestic worlds and nature
and culture; in others, midwives’ knowledge is central but ‘‘coded’’ by their subor-
dinate position in male-dominated social worlds and medical structures.
Migration | 863
Other works examine myths, other narratives, and broader cosmologies related
to creation and procreation. These offer a movement beyond nature/culture divi-
sions that contrast the female realm of procreation as ‘‘merely physical’’ with the
creative realms of art and ritual that constitute culture.
Joanne Mulcahy
See Also Childbirth and Childrearing; Family Folklore; Feminist Perspectives on Folk-
lore Scholarship; Gender; Medicine, Folk.
References
Davis-Floyd, Robbie E. 1992. Birth as an American Rite of Passage. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Hand, Wayland, ed. 1975. The Frank C. Brown Collection of North Carolina Folk-
lore. Vols. 6 and 7. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Jordan, Brigette. 1983. Birth in Four Cultures: A Cross-Cultural Investigation of
Childbirth in Yucatan, Holland, Sweden and the United States. Montreal: Eden.
Kay, Margarita, ed. 1982. Anthropology of Human Birth. Philadelphia: Davis. Mar-
tin, Emily. 1987. The Woman in the Body. Boston: Beacon.
McClain, Carol S., ed. 1989. Women as Healers: Cross-Cultural Perspectives. New
Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.
Michaelson, Karen, ed. 1988. Childbirth in America: Anthropological Perspectives.
South Hadley, MA: Bergin and Garvey.
Susie, Debra Ann. 1988. In the Way of Our Grandmothers: A Cultural View of
Twentieth Century Midwifery in Florida. Athens: University of Georgia Press.
Weigle, Marta. 1989. Creation and Procreation: Feminist Reflections on Mytholo-
gies of Cosmology and Parturition. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Migration
The movement of people, animals, or things from one location to another. Human
migration refers to the movements of people, often in large groups or along spe-
cific routes. In folkloristics, migration usually refers to human migration. Migra-
tion can refer to the movement of people from one country to another, or
movements of people within a country, for example, migration from rural areas to
urban areas. Motivations for migration are often economic though they can also be
political or religious. Nations, towns, or communities from which migrants origi-
nate are referred to as ‘‘sending’’ nations, towns, or communities. The destinations
or migrants are referred to as ‘‘receiving’’ nations, towns, or communities. ‘‘Immi-
gration’’ refers to settling in another nation or area; ‘‘emigration’’ refers to the act
of leaving one’s region of residence to settle elsewhere.
Not all migration is intended to result in permanent settlement. Workers
may migrate seasonally; this is common among agricultural laborers. In early
864 | Migration
major wave of European migration to the United States was one of settlement,
taking place in the seventeenth and early eighteenth centuries. These migrants
were almost exclusively from Western Europe, primarily the British Isles. Studies
of migration, however, have tended to focus on later waves of migration occurring
in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries. The next major wave of migration
began in the mid-nineteenth century, and though these migrants were still primar-
ily European peasants, they became an increasingly diverse group than before,
including Southern, Northern, and Eastern Europeans. The Irish Potato Famine
(1845–1852) led to mass emigration from Ireland, primarily to the United States.
Growing population pressures in the East and the lure of economic opportunity in
the West created an internal western migration in nineteenth-century America as
well. In the twentieth and into the twenty-first century, the largest number of
immigrants entering the United States has come from Mexico. The United States
Immigration Reform and Control Act (IRCA) in 1986 had a significant impact on
this migrant population by granting amnesty to certain undocumented migrants
on the condition of continuous residency in the United States. It impacted the im-
migration process for both documented and undocumented immigrants (Hondag-
neu-Sotelo 1994, xiv).
In Europe, the two World Wars caused massive shifts in political boundaries,
which in turn prompted an increase in human migration. The years after World
War II marked the highest point of migration within Europe since the eighteenth
century (Degh 1975, 122). The creation of the European Union has changed the
866 | Migration
References
Degh, Linda. 1975. The Study of Ethnicity in Modern European Ethnology. Journal
of the Folklore Institute 12(2-3): 113 130.
Georges, Robert A., and Stephen Stern. 1982. American and Canadian Immigrant
and Ethnic Folklore: An Annotated Bibliography. New York: Garland.
Hondagneu-Sotelo, Pierrette. 1994. Gendered Transitions: Mexican Experiences of
Immigration. Berkeley: University of California Press.
868 | Mnemonic
L’Estoile, Federico Neiburg, and Lygia Sigaud, eds. 2005. Empires, Nations, and
Natives. Durham: Duke University Press.
Leeds, Morton. 1971. The Process of Cultural Stripping and Reintegration: The Rural
Migrant in the City. In The Urban Experience and Folk Tradition, ed. Americo Paredes
and Ellen J. Stekert. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Peregrine, Peter N., Ilia Peiros, and Marcus Feldman. 2009. Ancient Human Migra-
tions: A Multidisciplinary Approach. Salt Lake City: University of Utah Press.
Pozzetta, George E., ed. 1991. Folklore, Culture, and the Immigrant Mind in the se-
ries American Immigration & Ethnicity. New York: Garland Publishing, Inc.
Stern, Stephen, and John Allan Cicala, eds. 1991. Creative Ethnicity: Symbols and
Strategies of Contemporary Ethnic Life. Logan: Utah State University Press.
Mnemonic
Aid for memory. Many professions and academic specialties use mnemonics for
teaching and remembering, and educators endorse them for classroom and other
formal educational contexts. Some mnemonics, especially those in oral circula-
tion, have currency as folklore. They may assume several forms that encourage
the memorization of facts or procedures that are otherwise difficult to retain.
Mnemonics often assume the form of rhyming verse. The rhyme that begins
‘‘Thirty days hath September,’’ for example, helps to recall the number of days in
each month. A rhyme that assists in spelling certain English words reminds us that
it is ‘‘i before e except after c.’’ Those faced with emergency situations can remem-
ber the proper treatment for accident victims by recalling, ‘‘If the face is red, raise
the head. If the face is pale, raise the other end’’ (alternatively, ‘‘raise the tail’’).
Memorization of some facts may receive assistance from songs. Children often
learn the alphabet by singing ‘‘The Alphabet Song,’’ for example. Setting the
multiplication table to the tune of ‘‘Yankee Doodle’’ once facilitated arithmetic
instruction in New England classrooms. Matching geographical facts to familiar
tunes was once a favorite mnemonic device, and some traditional songs—such as
‘‘The Brazos River,’’ which lists the principal rivers of Texas—aided the memory
of such information.
Less complex mnemonic devices include acronyms. The name ‘‘ROY G. BIV,’’
for example, enables one to remember the colors of the light spectrum. ‘‘HOMES’’
is a mnemonic acronym for the names of the Great Lakes. The initial letters of the
words comprising certain traditional sentences may form an acrostic that recalls
difficult facts: ‘‘George eat old gray rat at pa’s house yesterday’’ reminds one how
to spell geography. The names of the lines on the musical scale in the treble clef
correspond to the beginning letters in ‘‘every good boy does fine.’’ The initial let-
ters of ‘‘my very educated mother just served us nine pickles’’ represent the names
of the planets in order, moving away from the sun.
Mobility | 869
References
Dundes, Alan. 1961. Mnemonic Devices. Midwest Folklore 11: 139 147.
Finnegan, Ruth. 1977. Oral Poetry: Its Nature, Significance, and Social Context.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1988. The Theory of Oral Composition: History and Methodol-
ogy. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Lord, Albert B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Ong, Walter. 1982. Orality and Literacy: The Technologizing of the Word. London:
Methuen.
Yates, Frances A. 1966. The Art of Memory. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Zumthor, Paul. 1990. Oral Poetry: An Introduction. Trans. Kathryn Murphy-Judy.
Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Mobility
The principle that people, objects, and ideas are in motion, and a corresponding
set of ethnographic practices and sensibilities employed by researchers to repre-
sent this complex reality.
The last two decades have witnessed an unprecedented rise in the mobility of
peoples, objects, and ideas as a consequence of increasingly sophisticated
870 | Mobility
incorporate transportation modes into our subjectivity when we operate (in) them,
dovetailing into a new terrain of automobilities. As mobility, connectivity, dis-
placement, and diaspora increasingly define our world, social science will con-
tinue to refine its concepts and methodologies to keep up with its complexities.
Dana Hercbergs
See Also Ethnography; Ethnology; Historic-Geographic Method.
References
Clifford, James. 1997. Routes: Travel and Translation in the Late Twentieth Century.
Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
De Certeau, Michel. 1984. The Practice of Everyday Life. Trans: Steven F. Rendall.
Berkeley: University of California Press.
Del Negro, Giovanna P. 2004. The Passeggiata and Popular Culture in an Italian
Town: Folklore and the Performance of Modernity. Montreal: McGill-Queen’s Univer-
sity Press.
Noy, Chaim. 2009. On Driving a Car and Being a Family: A Reflexive Ethnography.
In Material Culture and Technology in Everyday Life: Ethnographic Approaches, ed.
Phillip Vannini. New York: Peter Lang Publishing, pp. 101 113.
Sklar, Deidre. 1994. Can Bodylore Be Brought to Its Senses? Journal of American
Folklore 107: 9 22.
Urry, John. 2007. Mobilities. Cambridge: Polity Press.
Modernization
with the modern or urban legend; and the ‘‘ballad of tradition’’ with topical street
ballads and ditties. The print and electronic media in particular have changed the
forms and genres of folklore and produced new forms and subgenres, such as
broadside ballads, newspaper legends, movie M€ archen, political jokes, black
humor, and Internet witchcraft tales.
Modernization has deeply affected the means and media, the performances and
contexts, of folklore. Contrary to romantic ideas, literacy and print have been
highly important for folklore ever since the Renaissance, through broadsides, chap-
books, dime novels, newspapers, and other reading material. In the twentieth cen-
tury, electronic devices and media (the telephone, the phonograph, radio, movies,
television, audio and video recorders, and the Internet) became important means of
transmission, diffusion, and performance as well as of collection and preservation
of folklore. Alongside festivals, exhibitions, concerts, and shows, the modern media
have created new stages and contexts that allow folklore to reach larger audiences
at a faster pace than ever before in history. Folklore as part of mass culture has
become a public commodity that can be technically reproduced and used almost
infinitely in advertising, sports, tourism, politics, and other contexts, while contents
of the mass media enter everyday narrating and oral tradition. There is a permanent
exchange between oral, literal, and visual representations of folklore; between tradi-
tion and modernity; and between folk culture and modern mass culture.
Klaus Roth
See Also Urban Folklore; Worldview.
References
Abrahams, Roger. 1964. Deep Down in the Jungle: Negro Narrative Folklore from
the Streets of Philadelphia. Hatboro: Folklore Associates.
Bausinger, Hermann. 1971. Volkskunde. Darmstadt: Habel.
Bausinger, Hermann. 1990. Folk Culture in a World of Technology. Trans. Elke
Dethmer. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Bausinger, Hermann. 1991. Tradition und Modernisierung. Schweizerisches Archiv
f€
ur Volkskunde 87: 5 14.
Bausinger, Hermann. 1999. Modernismen. In Enzyklop€ adie des M€
archens, eds. Rolf
Brednich et al. Berlin: Walter de Gruyters, vol. 9, pp. 747 750.
Brednich, Rolf W. 1990. Die Spinne in der Yucca-Palme: Sagenhafte Geschichten
von heute. Munich: C. B. Beck.
Brunvand, Jan H. 1981. The Vanishing Hitchhiker: American Urban Legends and
Their Meaning. New York: Norton.
Degh, Linda. 1971. The ‘‘Belief Legend’’ in Modern Society: Form, Function, and
Relationship to Other Genres. In American Folk Legend: A Symposium, ed. Wayland D.
Hand. Berkeley: University of California Press, pp. 55 68.
Degh, Linda. 1994. American Folklore and the Mass Media. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Monogenesis/Polygenesis | 875
Degh, Linda. 2001. Legend and Belief. Dialectics of a Folklore Genre. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Degh, Linda, Henry Glassie, and Felix Oinas, eds. 1976. Folklore Today: A Fes-
tschrift for Richard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana University Center for Research
in Language and Semiotic Studies.
Dundes, Alan. 1969. The Devolutionary Premise in Folklore Theory. Journal of the
Folklore Institute 6: 5 19.
Dundes, Alan. 1971. A Study of Ethnic Slurs: The Jew and the Polack in the United
States. Journal of American Folklore 84: 186 203.
Dundes, Alan, and Carl R. Pagter. 1975. Urban Folklore from the Paperwork
Empire. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Dundes, Alan, and Carl R. Pagter. 1987. When You’re Up to Your Ass in Alligators:
More Urban Folklore from the Paperwork Empire. Detroit: Wayne State University Press.
Fine, Gary A. 1992. Manufacturing Tales: Sex and Money in Contemporary Legends.
Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Fischer, Helmut. 1991. Kontinuit€at oder Transformation: Die m€undliche
Volks€uberlieferung im Zeitalter der Massenkultur. Schweizerisches Archiv f€
ur Volk-
skunde 87: 93 106.
Giddens, Anthony 1990. The Consequences of Modernity. Stanford: Stanford Univer-
sity Press.
Jason, Heda. 1966. Jewish Narrating Art in Yemen and Israel. Fabula 8: 93 106.
K€ostlin, Konrad. 1991. Folklore, Folklorismus und Modernisierung. Schweizerisches
Archiv f€
ur Volkskunde 87: 46 66.
Paredes, Americo, and Ellen J. Stekert, eds. 1971. The Urban Experience and Folk
Tradition. Austin: University of Texas Press.
R€ohrich, Lutz. 1964. M€archen und Wirklichkeit. Wiesbaden: F. Steiner.
R€ohrich, Lutz. 1977. Der Witz: Figuren, Formen, Funktionen. Stuttgart: Metzler.
Roth, Klaus. 1983. M€archen als Lesestoff f€ur alle. Populare M€archenb€uchlein in Bul-
garien. In Dona ethnologica monacensia, eds. H. Gerndt et al. Munich: Institut f€ur
Deutsche und Vergleichende Volkskunde, Universit€at M€unchen, pp. 267 288.
Roth, Klaus. 1992. Narrating in Socialist Everyday Life: Observations on Strategies
of Life Management in Southeast Europe. In Creativity and Tradition in Folklore, ed.
Simon Bronner. Logan: Utah State University Press, pp. 127 139.
Roth, Klaus, and J. Roth. 1996. Modernisierungsprozesse in der bulgarischen Gesell-
schaft im Spiegel der Popularliteratur (1880 1914). Narodna umjetnost 33(2): 325 355.
Schenda, Rudolph. 1991. Folklore und Massenkultur. Schweizerisches Archiv f€ ur
Volkskunde 87: 15 27.
Monogenesis/Polygenesis
Origin from a single source (mono) or from multiple sources (poly), or the theory
that an item has a point of beginning or origin (its genesis) and that the beginning
876 | Monogenesis/Polygenesis
may have been from one single source (monogenesis) or from two or more sources
(polygenesis). Drawn from the sciences and social sciences, the theories of mono-
genesis and polygenesis are used to explain the origin of such diverse phenomena
as species, government, ethnicities, and aesthetics. In folkloristics, the theories are
used to explain the origins of specific items of folklore and their variants.
Monogenesis, or monogenetic transformation, holds that for any given artifact,
there is one and only one point of origin. For example, most religions hold that
mankind came about as the creation of a supernatural power. From that original
creation came all of the members of the group and all of the others who inhabit
the earth. In the sciences, monogenesis has been used to support theories of spe-
cies evolution from one common ancestor to the forms now known. In folklore,
the Finnish, or historic-geographic, method of narrative research relies on the
theory of monogenesis. In this method, the Ur-form, the archetype for a narrative,
is the result of a conscious act of creation at a specific time and location. From
this Ur-form came all known variants. For example, some scholars hold that the
similarities in the creation stories of various religions point to a common point of
ancestry from which all people and their religions spring. In like manner, lan-
guages are thought to have one point of origin. The group of languages classified
as Indo-European is sometimes used as evidence for monogenesis of language. A
few scholars hold that, given enough time and data, they can find a proto-Indo-
European language from which all known languages of this stock emerged.
In 1524, Paracelsus argued for the theory of polygenesis. Using the available
scholarly evidence, he posited that all the known varieties of mankind could not
have evolved solely from the union of Adam and Eve. Proponents of the theory
of polygenesis, or polygenetic transformation, and the allied parallel evolution
hold that similar needs and development can create similar cultural artifacts in
different, independent groups. Under the theory of polygenesis, the similarities
in language groups or creation stories are just that—similarities. Antidiffusionist
folklore scholars argue that linguistic barriers are too hard for an item of oral
folklore to overcome. Instead, they believe that similar items arose in divergent
language areas independently. The Swedish folklorist C. W. von Sydow held that
the unique qualities of history and culture in various regions pushed the creation
of similar types of tales, or regional oikotypes, each with its own unique history.
Similar creation stories, under the theory of polygenesis, arose out of similar
needs to explain the universe rather than out of a single point of origin.
The use of monogenesis and polygenesis as analytical tools has its merits and
limitations. Certain items of folklore may be traced to an original source and sup-
port the theory of monogenesis. Other items, though similar among diverse
groups and locations, are the result of similar needs and multiple creations and
thus support the theory of polygenesis.
Randal S. Allison
Motif | 877
References
Degh, Linda. 1972. Folk Narrative. In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed.
Richard M. Dorson. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Dorson, Richard M. 1972. Introduction: Concepts of Folklore and Folklife Studies.
In Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
von Sydow, C. W. 1965. Folktale Studies and Philology: Some Points of View. In
The Study of Folklore, ed. Alan Dundes. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Motif
References
Dundes, Alan. 1962. From Etic to Emic Units in the Structural Study of Folktales.
Journal of American Folklore 75: 95 105.
Finnegan, Ruth. 1992. Oral Traditions and the Verbal Arts: A Guide to Research
Practices. London: Routledge.
Goldberg, Christine. 1986. The Construction of Folktales. Journal of Folklore
Research 23: 163 176.
Krohn, Kaarle. 1971. Folklore Methodology. Trans. Roger L. Welsh. Austin: Univer-
sity of Texas Press. (Originally published as Die folkloristische Arbeitsmethode, Oslo,
1926.)
Siikala, Anna-Leena. 1990. Interpreting Oral Narrative. Folklore Fellows Communi-
cations, no. 245. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Thompson, Stith. 1946. The Folktale. New York: Holt, Rinehart and Winston.
Thompson, Stith. 1966. Motif-Index of Folk-Literature: A Classification of Narrative
Elements in Folktales, Ballads, Myths, Fables, Mediaeval Romances, Exempla,
Fabliaux, Jest-Books, and Local Legends. Second printing. Bloomington: Indiana Uni-
versity Press.
Mumming
Seasonal custom in which one or more disguised figures intrude into private
households with the purpose of engaging in traditional, convivial interaction with
the residents. Observance is invariably associated with the season of winter revels,
encompassing (in Christian communities) Christmas, New Year’s, and Twelfth
Night. Interaction takes the form of various pastimes, many of which might figure
in the revelry of a festive gathering independently of the intrusion by the
Mumming | 879
References
Alford, Violet. 1978. The Hobby Horse and Other Animal Masks. London: Merlin.
Halpert, Herbert, and G. M. Storey, eds. 1969. Christmas Mumming in Newfound-
land: Essays in Anthropology, Folklore and History. Toronto: University of Toronto
Press.
Lovelace, Martin J. 1980. Christmas Mumming in England: The House-Visit. In
Folklore Studies in Honour of Herbert Halpert, eds. Kenneth S. Goldstein and Neil V.
Rosenberg. St John’s, Newfoundland: Memorial University of Newfoundland.
Welsford, Enid. 1927. The Court Masque: A Study in the Relationship between Po-
etry and the Revels. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Museum, Folk
References
Anderson, Jay. 1984. Time Machines: The World of Living History. Nashville, TN:
American Association for State and Local History.
Music, Folk | 883
Bronner, Simon J., ed. 1982. American Material Culture and Folklife: A Prologue
and Dialogue. Logan: Utah State University Press.
Bronner, Simon J., ed. 1987. Folklife Studies from the Gilded Age: Object Rite, and
Custom in Victorian America. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research Press.
Hall, Patricia, and Charlie Seemann, eds. 1987. Folklife and Museums: Selected
Readings. Nashville, TN: American Association for State and Local History.
Higgs, J. W. Y. 1963. Folklife Collection and Classification. London: Museums
Association.
Ice, Joyce, ed. 2009. On Collecting: From Private to Public, Featuring Folk and
Tribal Art from the Diane and Sandy Besser Collection. Santa Fe, NM: Museum of
International Folk Art.
Jenkins, J. Geraint. 1972. The Use of Artifacts and Folk Art in the Folk Museum. In
Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction, ed. Richard Dorson. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Loomis, Ormond. 1977. Sources on Folk Museums and Living History Farms. Folk-
lore Forum Bibliographic and Special Series. Bloomington: Indiana University Folklore
Institute.
McLerran, Jennifer. 2009. A New Deal for Native Art: Indian Arts and Federal Pol-
icy, 1933 1943. Tucson: University of Arizona Press.
Owen, Trefor. 1972. Welsh Folk Museum Handbook. St. Fagans: National Museum
of Wales.
Steenberg, Axel. 1966. Dansk Folkmuseum and Frilandsmuseet. Andelsbogtrykkerirt
and Odense, Denmark: Nationalmuseet.
Zippelius, Adelhart. 1974. Handbuch der Europ€
aischen Freilichtmuseen (Handbook
of European open-air museums). Cologne: Rheinland-Verlag GMbH.
Music, Folk
its own needs and values. Here, melodies are considered as texts, too, and those
that are transmitted aurally are privileged over sight-readable music ‘‘texts.’’ The
formative scholarship on folk music stressed its value as a representation of a
special kind of community, one imagined to exist among a homogeneous group
of non-elite people within a peasant, working-class, ethnic, or regional commu-
nity. These types of communities were held to be particularly important by early
folklore scholars who were strongly influenced by populist cultural nationalist
agendas. Thus, through processes of borrowing, co-optation, and canon forma-
tion, the music associated with non-elite communities became an important sym-
bol of identity for intellectual elites involved in nationalist enterprises.
Consequently, folk music was analyzed in terms of musical elements thought
to be characteristic of such national/communal settings. Because one type of
verbal folksong text, the ballad, was recognized in the eighteenth century as hav-
ing important connections with elite literature, its musical aspects received con-
siderable scholarly attention. The ballad, as performed in Western Europe and in
other parts of the world colonized from this region, was typically performed solo
and a cappella. Consequently, musicologists who focused upon folksong gener-
ally concerned themselves with monophonic sound. This concern reflected, as
well, the limitations of data collection in the era prior to the widespread use of
sound recordings, for at that time, it was rarely possible to accurately notate more
than a single line of melody. In this context, certain aspects of melody—particu-
larly scale and, to a lesser extent, melodic contour—were thought by influential
scholars such as Cecil Sharp to be diagnostic of cultural geists (spirits). So, for
example, considerable weight was given to tunes with scales that, because they
had less than a full octave or were modal rather than harmonic, might be consid-
ered to be survivals of very old music practices. Considerable attention was also
paid to developing the idea of the ‘‘tune family,’’ utilizing selected aspects of
melody for comparative analysis that paralleled the research into the history of
verbal folksong texts that led to schemes of classification and typology, such as
those of Francis James Child and Malcolm Laws.
The growth of the discipline of ethnomusicology in the twentieth century,
coupled with the advent of convenient sound-recording technology, led to a
broadening of perspective. Alan Lomax, studying the relationships between folk-
song style and culture, developed cantometrics, a system of analysis designed to
describe recorded musical performances using standardized terminology. Canto-
metrics’ thirty-seven different parameters encompass a variety of factors, includ-
ing: the social organization of vocal groups and orchestras, levels of cohesiveness
and explicitness, rhythmic organization, melodic complexity, embellishment, and
vocal stance. Lomax sought to describe aspects of texture as well as text.
As a descriptive system, cantometrics is much more inclusive than previous
musical analysis systems, most of which have suffered from the fact that they
Music, Folk | 885
utilize the prescriptive notation developed by Western art music, which biases
the description. Lomax’s analytic uses of his descriptive system, however, also
have proven contentious. Utilizing Freudian ideas about human behavior, he sug-
gested certain relationships between aspects of sound and musical organization,
on the one hand, and broadly conceived cultural patterns, on the other. This
reflected Lomax’s own preference for theory-driven survey research rather than
in-depth, data-driven field studies.
Nevertheless, Lomax’s work served to broaden the scope of musical descrip-
tion, something that was necessary given the contemporary approach described
at the beginning of this entry. Indeed, the problem folk music scholars now face
is one of the boundaries of their field. Is, for example, the music made by of a
group of friends who gather occasionally to play Bach or Beethoven for their
own enjoyment to be considered folk music? One argument against calling such
performances folk music is that in these performances the musicians intend to
follow closely the composer’s original score; the emphasis in folk music, by con-
trast, is upon a variety of intentions related to the perceived history, meaning,
and uses of the music. Clearly, though, the differences between these intentions
are a matter of degree rather than of opposition, for folklorists have shown that
noncommercial musical traditions such as fiddling and Sacred Harp religious
singing often place considerable emphasis upon the score as a document of the
intention of the composer. However, such musics tend to fall outside the realm
886 | Music, Folk
of elite art music, which is perpetuated through formal training based not just
upon scores but also upon an extensive interpretive literature.
A second parallel dilemma is raised by the fact that there are many examples of
musical performance that are called folk music but that take place in commercial
or formal settings. These examples may reflect an understanding of folk music in
cultural nationalist terms. Or they may be using folk music as a metaphor for the
values associated with informality and noncommercialism. Whatever the case,
when one analyzes the musical aspects of such performances, one usually finds
considerable differences, particularly in terms of textures, in comparison with the
same musics in noncommercial and informal settings. So, for example, when folk-
lorist MacEdward Leach collected ‘‘The Blue Velvet Band’’ from folksinger Wil-
liam Riley of Lance au Loup, Labrador, in 1960, Riley closely followed the lyrics
and melody of the song as first recorded by its author—professional country
music singer Hank Snow—in 1937. But in terms of texture, there is a world of
difference: Riley sings a cappella in a rubato parlando style; Snow accompanies
himself with a guitar to a faster fixed tempo. Further, Riley’s performance omits
both Snow’s opening spoken introduction, which contextualizes the song as a fic-
tional cowboy bunkhouse performance, and Snow’s closing yodel, an ornamental
feature characteristic of his commercial musical domain.
This example reminds us that folk music researchers continue to focus upon
issues of variation—whether in text, texture, or context—reflecting an underly-
ing assumption that individual folk music pieces are, to a greater extent than
other forms of music, constantly changing. The idea of viewing folk music as a
mode of expression that frees singers and instrumentalists to re-create and impro-
vise within the arena of a collective or shared music-culture (a term coined by
Mark Slobin and Jeff Titon) recalls the IFMC’s communalist definition men-
tioned earlier and suggests the importance of a perspective that moves beyond
individual items and performances to consider entire repertoires.
Many studies of individual folk tunes exist, but folk music is nonetheless con-
ventionally thought of in a plural sense as an aggregation of tunes. Although con-
temporary scholars tend to follow the strategy of viewing folk music in terms of
individual behaviors in specific contexts (as suggested in the definition offered at
the outset), a considerable number of those who speak of folk music think of it in
these aggregational terms. It is useful to think of such aggregations as canons.
Philip Bohlman suggests that canon formation is an essential aspect of folk music
in the modern world. He offers several models of canon formation, ranging from
local to national, in his discussion of the ways in which groups of people partici-
pating in folk music performances perceive their repertoire. Such canon forma-
tion is assessed critically and analytically by contemporary scholars as a source
for data about the realities of folk music from a contextual point of view. Beyond
this, however, it must be recognized that the entire body of writing about folk
Music, Folk | 887
Fiddling
Playing traditional folk music on the violin, generally without the aid of written music
(although many a fiddler is musically literate to some degree). Wherever the remark-
ably versatile violin has traveled to play art music, from Italy to Scotland to South
India, fiddling has gone too. Fiddling is differentiated from formal violin performance
by customary functions, venues, and repertoires. Also, in several locations in the
North Atlantic sphere, including the southern United States, playing techniques are
distinctive, as are uses of the scordaturas that American fiddlers call ‘‘cross-tunings’’
(ones other than the usual low-to-high G-D-A-E, for example, A-E-A-E, which allows
easy double-stops and maximum overall resonance in the key of A Major). In com-
parison to the violin, the fiddle is more loosely defined in construction materials and
techniques, and, especially, in range of desirable timbres. In fact, in many times and
places, the relatively nasal and penetrating timbres of fiddles have been favored
because this helps the music be heard above the clatter of dancers’ feet.
Today, in North America, Britain, Ireland, and Scandinavia, fiddling constitutes the
most vigorous surviving folk music. Fiddlers in the American British colonies drew
especially on Scottish traditions for tunes and for ways of writing their own new
tunes (playing and composing new tunes within established dance genres, then
retaining each new generation’s dance types as those faded in urban popular use).
In 18th-century America there was not always a clear line between violin perfor-
mance and fiddling, since plenty of what were already traditional dance tunes—plus
Naomi Martin, age six, of Willmar, Minnesota, competes in the fiddle contest, August 8,
2003, at the Iowa State Fair in Des Moines. (AP/Wide World Photos)
888 | Music, Folk
tunes that would become traditional—were fashionable and in print, both in Britain
and the United States. But during the first half of the nineteenth century, American
fiddling took on an identity of its own partly due to rural fiddlers insisting on draw-
ing idiosyncratically on repertoires that had fallen out of fashion, and partly due to
the widespread popularization of blackface minstrelsy, which incorporated white
performers’ interpretations and caricatures of slave fiddling.
Fiddlers usually play in styles specific to the regions where they live, though those
regions are more broadly defined today than formerly. ‘Old-Timey’ fiddlers in the
Southeast still perform rustic ‘ breakdowns’’ in heterophony (approximate unison)
with banjos that are played with techniques invoking nineteenth-century blackface
minstrelsy (tunes such as ‘ Sail Away Ladies’ and ‘Cluck Old Hen’), while Texas fid-
dlers in ‘ contest style’’ vary breakdowns, waltzes, polkas, and rags systematically
and virtuosically (a pair of common tunes: ‘Sally Johnson’’ and ‘ Dusty Miller’’). Most
of English-speaking North America replicates the Texas contest model or imitates
it to some degree; regional forms of the Texas-based contest style are emerging,
particularly in the Pacific Northwest and in the Tennessee Valley.
Today, most fiddlers’ repertoires still focus on genres of bipartite dance tunes and
songs stemming from the eighteenth through early twentieth centuries, even though
during the last half-century bluegrass venues and especially fiddle contests have sup-
planted actual dances as the focus for most public fiddle performance. These con-
tests represent different flavors of a pan-North-Atlantic matrix of nativistic folk
revivals, in which a rainbow of blends of rural and urban brands of nostalgia, the
modern luxury of plentiful practice time, and adjustments made for more attentive
listeners in this concert-like venue have again obscured the line between art and folk
performance and between the cultivated violin and the rough-and-ready fiddle.
Chris Goertzen
music, scholarly and otherwise, constitutes the most important and influential
canon that shapes perceptions about what is and what is not folk music.
Neil V. Rosenberg
See Also Ballad; Broadside Ballad; Cantometrics; Ethnomusicology; Folksong, Lyric;
Folksong, Narrative.
References
Alves, William. 2010. Music of the Peoples of the World. Boston, MA: Schirmer
Cengage Learning.
Bohlman, Philip V. 1988. Folk Music in the Modern World. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Child, Francis James. 1965. The English and Scottish Popular Ballads. New York:
Dover. International Folk Music Council. 1955. Resolutions: Definition of Folk Music.
International Folk Music Journal 7: 23.
Dunaway, David King, and Molly Beer. 2010. Singing Out: An Oral History of
America’s Folk Music Revivals. New York: Oxford University Press.
Musical Instrument, Folk | 889
Epstein, Lawrence J. 2010. Political Folk Music in America from Its Origins to Bob
Dylan. Jefferson, NC: McFarland.
Goertzen, Chris. 1996. Balancing Local and National Fiddle Styles at American Fid-
dle Contests. American Music 14(3): 352 381.
Laws, G. Malcolm. 1957. American Balladry from British Broadsides. Philadelphia:
American Folklore Society.
Laws, G. Malcolm. 1964. Native American Balladry. Philadelphia: American Folk-
lore Society.
Leach, MacEdward. 1965. Folk Ballads and Songs of the Lower Labrador Coast.
Ottawa: National Museum.
Ledgin, Stephanie P. 2010. Discovering Folk Music. Santa Barbara: Praeger.
Lomax, Alan. 1968. Folk Song Style and Culture. Washington, DC: American Asso-
ciation for the Advancement of Science.
Moore, Robin. 2010. Music in the Hispanic Caribbean: Experiencing Music,
Expressing Culture. New York: Oxford University Press.
Slobin, Mark, and Jeff Todd Titon. 1992. The Music-Culture as a World of Music.
In Worlds of Music, ed. Jeff Todd Titon et al. New York: Schirmer.
Titon, Jeff Todd. 2001. Old-Time Kentucky Fiddle Tunes. Lexington: University of
Kentucky Press.
In their most basic denotation, traditional objects used to produce and control
musical sound. Folk musical instruments are tools or technological extensions to
the sound-producing capabilities and kinetic expressions of the human body.
Although instruments often are viewed as distinct from the human body and
voice (manifest in culture-based distinctions between instrumental and vocal
musics), they effectively intensify and complement communicative facets of
speech and song and the rhythmical features of movement and dance.
Comparable to distinctions between music and nonmusic, the precise factors
that differentiate any sound-producing object from a musical instrument result
from the beliefs and practices of individual cultures. Whatever their design—
from common objects to those of elaborate construction—musical instruments
generally exhibit characteristic timbres appropriate to music performance, as
well as some degree of pitch and loudness variation, and they allow for the con-
trol of sound over an interval of time. Widely distributed conch-shell trumpets,
the hourglass-shaped kotsuzumi drum of the Japanese noh orchestra, the African
plucked lamella instrument sanza or mbira, the lute of East Asia and North
Africa known as the ‘ud, and the mechanically bowed hurdy-gurdy from medie-
val Europe all illustrate distinctive sound colors and allow control of pitch, loud-
ness, and rhythm. Such acoustical properties neither limit a musical instrument
890 | Musical Instrument, Folk
to one use nor require that music performance be the instrument’s primary pur-
pose. Music performance may employ ritual articles, cooking utensils, agricul-
tural tools, or any number of other objects, temporarily or otherwise. Moreover,
depending upon its cultural context, distinctions between a musical use and any
other use of an object need not be demarcated clearly. Although long a debated
issue, African musical bows resemble hunting bows in form and suggest another
purpose, as does the ghatam (literally, waterpot), a clay-pot percussion instru-
ment of the Indian subcontinent.
With historical depth extending from prehistory to the present and a geo-
graphic scope encompassing six continents and nearly all societies, musical
instruments challenge holistic considerations. Several cultures have developed
instrument classifications to account for their instruments and performance
ensembles, most notably China, which uses eight divisions based on the material
that produces the sound or contains the vibrating air, and India, which has four
instrument divisions organized by the sounding element. However, like the Euro-
pean classification with its divisions of winds, strings, and percussion (still
applied to the Western orchestra), they all fail to adequately explain basics of
design or to clarify relationships for the large number of instruments known
today. Museum curators, instrument collectors, and scholars have sought more
systematic and comprehensive means to describe and categorize the vast array of
musical instruments; the standard that has emerged comes from a system devel-
oped by Erich M. von Hornbostel and Curt Sachs.
To distinguish and organize musical instruments, most systems of classification
take as a fundamental principle the importance of the vibrating, or sounding, mate-
rial. Drawing examples from historically and geographically disparate cultures, the
Hornbostel and Sachs classification system, published in 1914 as the ‘‘Systematik
der Musikinstrumente: Ein Versuch,’’ follows this principle to divide instruments
into four groups, based on their physical characteristics of sound production; fur-
ther subdivisions are based on the form of the instrument. With some modifications
and extensions, the Hornbostel and Sachs classification remains the most influen-
tial today. Its four large categories are aerophones, wind instruments or instruments
with a vibrating column of air such as trumpets and flutes; chordophones, or string
instruments; idiophones, instruments of self-sounding materials such as scrapers or
bells; and membranophones, drums with stretched skin or other membranes.
Aerophones are subdivided into types according to the manner of producing
vibration. The first group, free aerophones, consists of whirling instruments such
as the bullroarer in which the vibrating air is not confined. An instrument found
in ancient Greece, among aboriginal Australians, and among Native Americans,
the bullroarer’s thin blade of wood rotates at the end of a swung chord that
excites the air to produce its characteristic roaring sound. The second group of
aerophones contains those in which the air is constrained by a tube or vessel,
Musical Instrument, Folk | 891
Two Chinese men blow their suonas (Chinese reeded horn) to accompany a group of folk
dancers on a Beijing sidewalk, during the city’s first snow of the winter, November 30,
1997. (AP/Wide World Photos)
with the vibration created by the breath or wind. This is a much larger group of
instruments, with three further subdivisions. First, flutes consist of instruments in
which the air is blown against an edge of the tube, such as with the Andean
notched flute of cane, the kena. The next are reeds, such as the Western clarinet
or oboe, in which the airstream is excited by a beating reed or reeds. The khaen,
from Southeast Asia, is an example of a reed aerophone. Similar to the Chinese
sheng and Japanese sho, the khaen is a mouth organ made of up to sixteen bam-
boo pipes arranged into two rows, each with a brass reed. Finally, there are trum-
pets, such as the aforementioned conch-shell trumpet or the large, wooden Swiss
alphorns, in which the airstream is blown through a player’s vibrating lips.
The term chordophone refers to instruments with one or more strings stretched
between supporting structures or across a resonating body or sound box. Com-
mon examples include the guitar and Appalachian dulcimer. Although chordo-
phones are sometimes grouped by how the strings are set in motion (struck,
plucked, or bowed), they first subdivide by the shape of the sound box and neck,
if the instrument has one. The simplest chordophone is the musical bow, a string
stretched between two ends of a flexible stick. Some musical bows have attached
resonators, such as the Brazilian berimbau and its small gourd that amplifies the
sound of the single, struck string. Harps are plucked instruments with strings
892 | Musical Instrument, Folk
stretching between a sound box and a straight or curved neck. The small Celtic
harp, for instance, has a triangular frame, one side of which is a sound box, the
other a pillar, and the third a curved neck. Strings of graduated lengths connect
the sound box to the neck. Zithers, such as the Appalachian dulcimer, have
^ also a zither, has
strings attached parallel to the sound box. The Hindustani bin,
seven strings (three of which sound sympathetically as drones) stretched above a
fretted, bamboo tube, with two large gourd resonators attached below and near
the tube’s ends. Lutes and fiddles have one or more strings across a sound box
and a straight neck, as with the ancient Chinese pipa, a strummed, pear-shaped
lute. The pipa has four strings that run from a bridge on the flat-topped sound
box to tuning pegs at the head of the neck. One fiddle from Iran, more precisely
a spike fiddle, is the kamanche. Across this instrument’s neck stretch three
strings played with a bow; the neck pierces a round wooden resonator, forming a
spike at the end of the instrument.
Drums with stretched skins or membranes are membranophones. Various cri-
teria distinguish the subdivisions of membranophones: whether the instrument is
a percussion drum or a friction drum, the number of vibrating heads, the shape of
the drum frame, the material of its construction, the manner in which the mem-
brane is attached to the frame, and so forth. Examples of percussion drums—
those struck with the hand, sticks, or something else—include kalangu and
kendang drums. The kalangu of the Hausa of Nigeria is a kind of talking drum, a
double-headed, hourglass-shaped drum laced so that, when squeezed, its pitch
changes. Another example, this one from Indonesia, is the kendang. This is the
laced, double-headed, barrel-shaped drum of the Gamelan orchestra. The ken-
dang derives from the South Indian mrdanga. The cuıca is a friction drum from
Brazil played with a stick attached to the membrane and rubbed with wetted
hands or a damp cloth to create its sound.
Idiophones are instruments that produce sound by the material of their con-
struction, without the addition of strings or membranes. Structural features of idi-
ophones do not distinguish subcategories, as with the other divisions. Instrument
shape has little significance for the subdivisions of idiophones; rather, playing
techniques subdivide the group: by concussion, striking, stamping, shaking,
scraping, friction, or plucking. The number of instruments that fall within these
various subdivisions is immense. A few illustrative examples include: the solid-
body concussion sticks, or claves, of Latin America; the struck, fixed-keyed
xylophones, such as the balo of West Africa and the marimba of Guatemala; the
ganbo stamping tubes of Haiti; the angklung rattle of Java and Bali (played by
shaking its sliding bamboo tubes); the scraped African American washboard; the
tortoise-shell ayotl, a friction idiophone of the Maya-Quiche of Central America;
and the plucked lamellaphones or mbiras of South Africa and sanzas of Came-
roon, which consist of sets of graduated metal tongues on boards or sound boxes.
Musical Instrument, Folk | 893
References
Baily, John. 1976. Recent Changes in the Dut^
ar of Herat. Asian Music 8(1): 29 63.
Becker, Judith. 1979. Time and Tune in Java. In The Imagination of Reality, eds. A.
L. Becker and A. A. Yengoyan. Norwood, NJ: Ablex.
Buchner, Alexander. 1972. Folk Music Instruments. New York: Crown.
Buchner, Alexander. 1973. Musical Instruments: An Illustrated History. New York:
Crown.
Dournon, Genevieve. 1992. Organology. In Ethnomusicology: An Introduction, ed.
H. Myers. New York: W. W. Norton.
Kartomi, Margaret J. 1990. Concepts and Classifications of Musical Instruments.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Lysloff, Rene T. A., and Jim Matson. 1985. A New Approach to the Classification
of Sound-Producing Instruments. Ethnomusicology 29(2): 213 236.
Marcuse, Sibyl. 1964. Musical Instruments: A Comprehensive Dictionary. Garden
City, NY: Doubleday.
Sachs, Curt. 1940. The History of Musical Instruments. New York: Norton.
Schaeffner, Andre. [1936] 1968. Origine des instruments de musique: Introduction
ethnologique a l’histoire de la musique instrumentale. New York: Johnson Reprint
Corporation.
Schaeffner, Andre. 1946. Les Instruments de musique. In La Musique des origines a
nos jours, ed. N. Dufourcq. Paris: Libraire Larousse.
Turino, Thomas. 1983. The Charango and the Sirena: Music, Magic, and the Power
of Love. Latin American Music Review 4(1): 81 119.
von Hornbostel, Erich M. 1933. The Ethnology of African Sound Instruments. Africa
6(2): 129 157, 277 311.
von Hornbostel, Erich M., and Curt Sachs. 1914. Systematik der Musikinstrumente:
Ein Versuch. Zeitschrift f€
ur Ethnologie 46: 553 598. Translated in 1961 by Anthony
Baines and Klaus P. Wachsmann as Classification of Music Instruments. Galpin Society
Journal 14: 3 29.
Wachsmann, Klaus P. 1961. The Primitive Musical Instruments. In Musical Instru-
ments through the Ages, ed. A. Baines. New York: Walker.
Zemp, Hugo. 1979. Aspects of ’Are’are Musical Theory. Ethnomusicology 23(1): 5 48.
Myth
among myth, folktale, and legend, as have many other scholars in several parts
of the world.
The eminent Austrian psychoanalyst Carl Gustav Jung, who worked in the late
nineteenth and early twentieth centuries, proposed that myth arises from the col-
lective unconscious—that portion of the unconscious mind common to all human
beings. In his formulations, myth shares common archetypes (or deeply and men-
tally embedded recognizable patterns) with dreams and other workings of the
unconscious. Archetypes are to psychological processes as instincts (such as
sucking) are to physiological ones. It is the archetypes, Jung advocated, that
account for commonalities in mythic stories and events that are seen across cul-
tures and time periods.
Others, such as Max M€uller (who worked in Great Britain in the middle and
latter parts of the nineteenth century), have believed myths to be metaphors for
processes of nature. For example, M€uller, a Sanskrit scholar and comparative phi-
lologist, believed that the folklore and especially the mythology of his day in Eng-
land were the survivals of a presumed Aryan past, which he thought retrievable
through careful comparisons of languages, beginning with Sanskrit. He noted sim-
ilarities among the metaphorical names of the ancient gods of ancient civilizations
from India to Greece to Rome. Through what he termed the ‘‘disease of lan-
guage,’’ processes of forgetfulness, and improper translations, myths were coded
metaphoric mnemonics not only for the gods and their actions but also for the nat-
ural processes of the world, especially the movements of the sun. He believed that
myths arose when people were capable of reasoning but not capable of very
abstract thinking. Both a number of words and a particular god, he suggested,
could symbolize one natural process: the movement of the sun through the day
and year. Thus, for M€uller and others who reasoned in a similar vein, myths were
metaphors that, through time, lost their original meanings and became entities that
896 | Myth
Some other researchers, particularly those who work with Native Americans,
have found difficulties with Bascom’s categories because myths are not always
prose narratives and because the issue of time is not so clear-cut as Bascom pro-
posed. Oftentimes, myths are in poetic language and follow the canons of poetics
for the culture in which the myths are present. Both Dell Hymes and Dennis Ted-
lock are credited with forcing folklorists to recognize the poetic structure not only
of myths but also of other forms of narrative through their insistence that rendering
the narratives of other cultures in prose, rather than seeking to present them in the
manner in which they are spoken, robs those narratives of their poetic structure
and power. Their work demands careful typesetting and reading in order to assist a
reader in appreciating the quality of the spoken, in contrast to the written, word.
A cross-culturally sound and minimal definition of the term myth, as distinct
from other forms of narrative, is that it is sacred narrative that is most often
believed to be true. Because myth is of such a sacred nature, many people object
to the very word myth when it is attached to their own sacred narratives. For
those in whose culture the myth is embedded, the truth of the myth may be literal
or figurative. Literalists believe fully in the absolute truth of myth, whereas figu-
rativists believe in myth as metaphor.
For example, believing Jews, Christians, and Muslims who consider them-
selves to be fundamentalists assert that the biblical Genesis is literal truth: Yah-
weh/God/Allah created the world and universe in which we live in six of our
experienced days (twenty-four hours, more or less) and rested on the next, the
seventh day.
By contrast, believing Jews, Christians, and Muslims who consider themselves
to be less doctrinaire assert that the biblical Genesis is to be understood as a
metaphor: Yehweh/God/Allah created the world and universe in which we live
in six episodes called ‘‘days’’ that do not correspond to our experience of days;
further, the creator (whatever name is given in the particular culture) inaugurated
a pattern of alternating work (creation and creative effort) and rest.
This latter view of Genesis as metaphor allows for accommodation between
religion and science in that the biblical Genesis of separation of light and dark,
water and firmament, with the further differentiation of species culminating in
human beings, follows evolutionary theory precepts as well.
For some people, the very words of myth are in themselves sacred. Even to
utter such words is to call into presence, if not being, the referent. For example,
recitations of the ‘‘beginningtime’’ by Mescalero Apache religious specialists are
done in vernacular Apache or in English on most occasions; only during impor-
tant ceremonials is the ritual language used, for that language had its own genesis
in the ‘‘beginningtime’’ and, therefore, is intrinsically powerful. When speaking in
the ritual language, religious specialists are extremely cautious, obeying many
injunctions, speaking only in allusion and metaphor, and explaining to the powers
898 | Myth
that be that they are welcome among their people once again, for the speaking of
them in the ritual language—the language of myth—calls them and demands their
presence. It is also this power of word in sacred context that gives rise to the
mythic present, the re-creation of mythic past in contemporary time and experi-
ence. By such a process of speaking/calling into being, myth is accorded an im-
portance not only in the long-ago past but also in the here and now.
The power of the word was used very effectively by a mesmerizing speaker,
the late Joseph Campbell. During the 1980s, no one was more closely associated
with myth in the popular mind than Campbell. Not only a captivating speaker, he
was also a fine storyteller, whether in lectures or on television. In general, Camp-
bell’s approach to myths and mythology (the study of myths) was a universalist
one. He maintained, much as had the psychologist Jung before him, that myths
embody the same stories for disparate cultures and that they were retellings of
each other; his data were garnered from pieces of myths taken out of context
from many narrative traditions. Because of his selective comparisons, he is usu-
ally not granted much scholarly credence. His lack of analysis of complete myths
in their appropriate contexts has lessened his credibility, especially among folk-
lorists and anthropologists.
Yet there is a certain appeal to a universalist explanation of myths. The French
scholar Claude Levi-Strauss is perhaps the best-known scholarly student of the
world’s mythology; although, if the truth be told, most of his data are from Native
American sources in all the Americas. Levi-Strauss has reached his audience pri-
marily through the written word rather than through visual media. But, like Camp-
bell, he has been roundly criticized for taking material out of context and
comparing what may roughly be termed apples and bricks. However, in Levi-
Strauss’s rationale, the lack of contextualization is permissible since he avers that
all myths, wherever they are found, share a common structure that he has reduced
to an algebraic formula. He also maintains that myths are binary structures, setting
up and resolving contrasts and contradictions within the culture and society. For
Levi-Strauss, the universalist position is an acceptable one since all people in the
world share common brain structure—structure that he sees replicated in myths.
Therefore, myths become both good to think and a reflection of the thought proc-
ess itself. His is a complex argument, and it often seems that no one can utilize
the Levi-Strauss analytic technique quite as well as can Levi-Strauss.
Alan Dundes, a contemporary folklorist, also has devoted considerable effort
to the analysis and explanation of myth. Rather than a universalist approach,
however, he utilizes a neo-Freudian schema for analysis, finding that myths
(products of adult minds, he avers) are one of the adult projective systems. As
such, they are universal, in that all adults around the world use projective techni-
ques that often are expressed in myths. Whereas followers of Jung maintain that
archetypes are the same throughout the world, followers of the Freudian analysis
Myth | 899
of myth maintain that the symbols found in myth will be culturally relative but
nonetheless a projection of infantile and child socialization systems. Many non-
Freudian-oriented scholars marvel at the number of times neo-Freudians, such as
Dundes, find that the myth under analysis has a sexual component somehow
related to toilet training and Oedipus or Electra complexes.
The links among symbols and myths, myths and rituals, and heroes and myths
also have been explored. Similarly, the syntagmatic (ordering) and paradigmatic
(substituting) aspects of myth have been of interest to scholars. In the latter part
of his career, the late Edmund R. Leach, a British social anthropologist, turned to
a consideration of Christian and Jewish myths. Utilizing biblical myths, he dem-
onstrated the redundancy in myth, maintaining that the episodes within myths
make the same essential point or points over and over again as a means of rein-
forcing the importance of the message. His work has been said by some to be
both a distillation and an extension of that of Levi-Strauss, although Leach did
not make claims to the universality of myth messages in general. But it was his
earlier work that had a greater impact on those who study myth, for he demon-
strated how myth is fluid, rather than being fixed for all time, in his discussion of
the manipulation of myth and genealogy to reinforce land claims or settle other
political issues.
Indeed, the permeability of myth is one of its essential characteristics. If myth,
once constructed, were immutable, it would soon lose its value for people since
it would not be able to accommodate changes in culture or the society’s knowl-
edge base. Myth lends itself to reinterpretation, but myth also adjusts to incorpo-
rate the new as well as celebrate the old—at least in the societies where myth is
alive in verbal tellings and not subject to the orthodoxy that accompanies the fix-
ing of myth in writing. In the 1960s, LaVerne Harrell Clark provided examples
of myth’s permeability through a study of how horses, a late postcontact phe-
nomenon, were thoroughly incorporated into Navajo and Apache narrative.
Most folklorists and anthropologists continue to consider myth in its cultural
context rather than simply as literature or philosophy. Sometimes, it has been the
fashion for myth to be termed a mirror of culture, and at other times, it has been
fashionable to subject myth to computer analyses. At still other times, myth has
been pointed to as the philosophy of the unlettered, completely ignoring that the
lettered also have and believe in their own myths. What is enduring is myth itself.
It does not vanish with increased complexity of social life. Worldwide trade and
politics do not cause it to wither and die from lack of use. It can stand—indeed, it
has stood—scrutiny as metaphor, as literal truth as well as a synonym for untruth,
as lessons for life, as components in an algebraic system, as manifestations of psy-
chological processes, as exemplar of properness and simultaneously as warning of
the consequences of impropriety, as philosophy of the Other, as engaging litera-
ture, as being universal as well as being particular to a group of people at a
900 | Myth
specific time. Whatever else it may be, myth authorizes the present in terms of
the past. Myth, quite simply, is.
Claire R. Farrer
See Also Anthropology, Symbolic; Comparative Mythology; Cosmology; Culture Hero;
Hero/Heroine, Folk; Myth-Ritual Theory; Religion, Folk; Ritual; Romantic Nationalism;
Structuralism; Trickster.
References
Bascom, William. 1965. The Forms of Folklore: Prose Narratives. Journal of Ameri-
can Folklore 78: 3 20.
Boas, Franz. 1916. The Development of Folk-Tales and Myths. Scientific Monthly 3:
335 343.
Campbell, Joseph. 1949. The Hero with a Thousand Faces. New York: Pantheon
Books.
Campbell, Joseph. 1969. The Masks of God, Vol. 1: Primitive Mythology. New York:
Viking.
Clark, LaVerne Harrell. 1966. They Sang for Horses. Tucson: University of Arizona
Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1962. Earth-Diver: Creation of the Mythopoeic Male. American
Anthropologist 64: 1032 1050.
Farrer, Claire R. 1994. Thunder Rides a Black Horse. Prospect Heights, IL:
Waveland.
Frazer, Sir James G. 1958. The Golden Bough (abridged edition). New York:
Macmillan.
Hymes, Dell. 1981. ‘‘In Vain I Tried To Tell You’’: Essays in Native American Eth-
nopoetics. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Jung, Carl Gustav. 1958. Psyche and Symbol. New York: Doubleday Anchor.
Jung, Carl Gustav, and Carl Kerenyi. 1963. Essays on a Science of Mythology. Trans.
R. F. C. Hull. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Kearns, Emily. 2010. Ancient Greek Religion: A Sourcebook. Chichester: Wiley-
Blackwell.
Leach, Edmund. 1965. Political Systems of Highland Burma. Boston: Beacon.
Leach, Edmund. 1976. Culture and Communication: The Logic by Which Symbols
Are Connected. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1969. The Raw and the Cooked: Introduction to a Science of
Mythology. Trans. John Weightman and Doreen Weightman. New York: Harper & Row.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1967. The Story of Asdiwal. In The Structural Study of Myth
and Totemism, ed. Edmund Leach. London: Tavistock Publications.
Middleton, John, ed. 1967. Myth and Cosmos: Readings in Mythology and Symbol-
ism. New York: Natural History Press.
M€uller, Max. 1889. Natural Religion: The Gifford Lectures Delivered before the
University of Glasgow in 1888. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Myth-Ritual Theory | 901
Peregrine, Peter N., Ilia Peiros, and Marcus Feldman. 2009. Ancient Human Migra-
tions: A Multidisciplinary Approach. Salt Lake City: University of Utah Press.
Rank, Otto. 1964. The Myth of the Birth of the Hero and Other Writings. New York:
Alfred A. Knopf and Random House.
Sebeok, Thomas A., ed. 1972. Myth: A Symposium. Bloomington: Indiana University
Press.
Tedlock, Dennis. 1983. The Spoken Word and the Work of Interpretation. Philadel-
phia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Myth-Ritual Theory
the data illustrating the argument have been (and have had to be) inferential and
comparative, drawn from the behavior and beliefs of so-called primitive peoples
who became known to Europeans during the imperialist expansion of the nine-
teenth century and who, it was claimed, stood at the same stage of mental evolu-
tion as did the peoples of classical antiquity. Generally speaking, scholars in
disciplines with historical methodologies have regarded such evidence as exces-
sively speculative and have refused to make the intellectual leaps that are often
called for by myth-ritualists.
From the point of view of the history of ideas, myth-ritualism was part of the
wave of irrationalist thought that crested throughout Europe just before World War
I. The movement passed through two phases. The founding generation, the afore-
mentioned Cambridge Ritualists (1890–1914), analyzed Greek drama (both tragedy
and comedy) and found its ‘‘deep structure’’ to consist of a ritual pattern of death
and rebirth based ultimately on the reconstructed stages of the Dionysian mysteries.
In a series of publications leading up to Harrison’s Themis (1912)—a volume that
included chapters by Murray and Cornford—the group, led by Harrison and basing
itself on the anthropology of J. G. Frazer, the vitalism of Henri Bergson, and the
sociology of Emile Durkheim, turned away from the traditional image of the bright,
shining Greeks and instead presented them and their religious belief and behavior as
essentially ‘‘primitive.’’ By the late 1920s, most classicists had, in turn, dismissed
the Cambridge Ritualists’ general theory of Greek religion and their specific analy-
sis of the historical and formal origins of drama. By then, however, the theory had
already been picked up elsewhere in the intellectual world, most notably by biblical
critics (among whom it was in vogue in Scandinavia from the late 1920s through
the 1940s) and especially by English-speaking literary critics.
Although a few scholars (such as the Marxist classicist George Thomson) contin-
ued to embrace myth-ritualism, the second phase of myth-ritualism (1930–1965)
was essentially literary-critical. During those years, a number of critics rejected the
classicists’ rejection, simply assumed the correctness of the Cambridge Ritualists’
method, and proceeded to apply it to postclassical texts, mostly dramatic but also
including medieval poems, folk ballads, and novels. As time passed, myth-ritualism,
when used at all, was increasingly encountered as only one element in a complex
critical approach. The most notable critics associated with the second phase were
the Americans Kenneth Burke, Francis Fergusson, and Stanley Edgar Hyman and
the Canadian Northrop Frye. When the members of this second generation died or
became inactive, no successors emerged. Perhaps because it was essentially a for-
malist method, myth-ritualism seems to have died unnoticed and unmourned in the
mid-1970s, as the energy and attention of literary criticism in North America turned
toward politics, in the forms of poststructuralism and especially deconstruction.
Robert Ackerman
See Also Evolutionary Theory; Myth.
Myth-Ritual Theory | 903
References
Ackerman, Robert. 1991. The Myth and Ritual School: J. G. Frazer and the
Cambridge Ritualists. New York: Garland.
Cornford, F. M. 1914. The Origin of Attic Comedy. London: Edward Arnold.
Else, Gerald F. 1965. The Origin and Early Form of Greek Tragedy. Cambridge,
MA: Harvard University Press.
Harrison, Jane Ellen. [1912] 1927. Themis. 2nd ed. Cambridge: Cambridge Univer-
sity Press.
Hyman, Stanley Edgar. 1968. The Ritual View of Myth and the Mythic. In Myth:
A Symposium, ed. T. A. Sebeok. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
N
National Folk Heroes
Often synonymous with culture heroes and heroines, national heroes are those
figures who are widely considered by the members and government of a nation-
state to be especially outstanding. They tend to have a strong presence in the
formal apparatus and activities of government, especially in education, civic
observances, and public holidays, and in statues, place-names, and other public
memorials. They may also feature in official national projections and expres-
sions, on postage stamps, for instance. While the status of these figures as folk
heroes is sometimes uncertain, depending on political and social circumstances,
they may have a purchase in the popular consciousness and feature in folk
expressions.
In some cases these heroes are historical figures, like the English Alfred the
Great (849–899) or the American Betsy Ross (1752–1836), designer and maker
of the American flag, the ‘‘Stars and Stripes.’’ In other cases, they are legendary
figures or icons, such as the American Uncle Sam.
National heroes, historical or not, may be stereotypes of national characteris-
tics, real or imagined. The figure of ‘‘the jolly swagman’’ in Australia, for
instance, is representative of the pioneering, antiauthoritarian values many Aus-
tralians consider to be part of their national identity. Australia is perhaps unique
in boasting as a national hero the figure of Ned Kelly, a bushranger or outlaw
hero who murdered three policemen and robbed banks. More often, national her-
oes are associated with resistance to foreign domination. Typically such heroes
are warriors who fight valiantly and cleverly, heroes of struggle who represent
their people in their hour of need. Some examples of this type include Rakoczi of
Hungary, Holger Dankse of Denmark, and El Cid of Spain.
Wars are often the source of national folk hero stereotypes, which include the
American ‘‘doughboy,’’ the British ‘‘tommy,’’ the French ‘‘poilu,’’ and the ‘‘digger’’
of Australia and New Zealand. Such generic figures, all male, have a good deal in
common with the warrior hero as well as with the culture hero. National heroine
types exist in the figure of the nurse, the mother who weeps and waits, and the
brave young woman who prefers death to sexual capitulation, as in the story of the
Serbian heroine Dojrana.
National heroes are frequently the ‘‘discoverers,’’ claimers, and explorers of
New World nations. Thus Christopher Columbus has this role in the United
905
906 | National Folk Heroes
Yankee Doodle
The earliest reference to the well-known ditty and its eponymous hero seems to be
in a Boston periodical, Journal of the Times, in September 1768, though the tune, at
least, was apparently well known for some time before this date. Various claims for
the origins of the catchy tune (which was used by both the British and American
sides during the War of Independence) and words have been made, and there are
many different versions of the lyrics. Yankee Doodle’s reported exploits, the best
known of which is to ‘‘stick a feather in his hat and call it macaroni,’’ are whimsical
rather than heroic.
The term itself originally referred to a person from the New England states and
was used by the Confederate forces in the Civil War as a slur against the Union
side. As often happens in such cases, the Yankees took up the insult and wore it as
a badge of pride, further developing the character into something of a roguish trick-
ster figure. As is usual with such widely known and culturally significant names, its
origins are the subject of considerable folk etymologizing. There are claims for a
Native American origin and, perhaps more likely, for an origin in the nicknames
Dutch settlers gave their English neighbors in the New England region. Over time,
the name ‘ Yankee Doodle’’ became synonymous with the national spirit and identity
of the United States and came to personify the American way, both at home and
abroad.
Graham Seal
States of America, while Captain Cook has it in Australia. Such figures, as well
as other types of national hero, are frequently held in high esteem as representa-
tives of national identity, actual or imagined.
Heroes who have been chosen or developed as national figures are often said
to be sleeping until their nation needs them once more. The king of Spain who
died in 711, Roderick or Roderigo, was the last of the Visigoth monarchs. He
was killed by the North African Muslims under Tariq ibn Ziyad and became the
center of numerous legends. In some stories, he ends his days as a hermit, dev-
oured by snakes, and in others he is a sleeping monarch, waiting to come again
in the time of his country’s need.
The processes by which real and mythic folk heroes become national heroes
are generally complex and of considerable historical duration. These processes
involve an ongoing and often intense interaction between the folk traditions that
celebrate such figures and their representation in nonfolkloric form, including
formal art, literature, and popular culture.
Graham Seal
See Also Children’s Folk Heroes; Hero/Heroine, Folk; Local Heroes; Occupational Folk
Heroes.
References
Alver, B. 1989. Folklore and National Identity. In R. Kvideland and H. Sehmsdorf,
eds., Nordic Folklore: Recent Studies. Bloomington and Indianapolis: Indiana Univer-
sity Press.
Botkin, B., ed. 1944. A Treasury of American Folklore: Stories, Ballads, and Tradi-
tions of the People. New York: Crown Publishers.
Clough, B., ed. 1947. The American Imagination at Work: Tall Tales and Folk Tales.
New York: Knopf.
Dorson, R. 1959. American Folklore. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, pp. 41, 47.
Hosking, G., and J. Sch€opflin, eds. 1997. Myths and Nationhood. London: Hurst
and Co.
Neck Riddle
A genre integrating traditional enigma and narrative. The neck riddle is usually
thought of as a riddle told by the hero of a tale, either to win the hand of a prin-
cess (AT 851, ‘‘The Princess Who Cannot Solve the Riddle’’) or to save his neck
from a sentence of death (AT 927, ‘‘Out-Riddling the Judge’’). The riddle also
contains a narrative. Its solution lies in the recent experience of the hero. Since
the experience is private and always of a bizarre character, the princess or the
executioner is unable to solve the riddle, and the hero triumphs. For example, the
908 | Neck Riddle
hero (like the biblical Samson) has seen a bird’s nest or beehive in the carcass of
an animal:
Other neck riddles have to do with inversion—a man walking under gravel
and on top of leaves, a daughter suckling her father—or more explicitly with
incest, as in the Greek romance of Apollonius of Tyre, the source for Shake-
speare’s Pericles. Still other grotesque solutions relate to posthumous birth, dis-
membered bodies, or poisoned meat.
Many commentators have remarked upon the relationships of neck riddle
themes to the imagery of carnival as described by Mikhail Bakhtin. Unlike the
true riddle, which describes ordinary things in unexpected language, the neck rid-
dle uses simple language to speak of the most shocking fusions of incompatibles:
parent and child, life and death. Its challenging of culturally decreed separations
reinforces the action of the frame narrative, in which a structurally weak chal-
lenger gains power over the powerful by the use of wit.
Recent scholarship has addressed the generic status of the neck riddle. John Dorst
proposes that the neck riddle is not a stable genre but ‘‘an arena of intergeneric con-
flict’’ in which narrative and riddle struggle to impose their respective orientations
on reality. Thus, the atemporal compression of the riddle reduces the narrative solu-
tion to a static tableau, but the narrative’s unfolding in time opens up the riddle to
the instabilities of experience. As Dorst notes, the same material emerges as narra-
tive and as riddle in the West Indies. Seizing the West Indian examples, Roger D.
Abrahams points out that there, as in other creole cultures, the neck riddle’s generic
flexibility is more the norm than the exception. Perhaps the neck riddle, and not
tightly framed European genres such as the ‘‘true riddle,’’ should be our model and
point of departure in examining the history of folklore forms.
Dorothy Noyes
See Also Enigma, Folk.
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1980. Between the Living and the Dead. Folklore Fellows Com-
munications, no. 225. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1985. A Note on West Indian Neck-Riddles as They Comment
on Emergent Genre Theory. Journal of American Folklore 98: 85 94.
Dorst, John D. 1983. Neck-Riddle as a Dialogue of Genres: Applying Bakhtin’s
Genre Theory. Journal of American Folklore 96: 413 433.
Night Hag | 909
Night Hag
activity, intrude upon either the hypnagogic (falling asleep) or the hypnopompic
(waking) phase of sleep. Recent research indicates that the night hag may play a
role in the sudden unexpected nocturnal death syndrome (SUNDS) afflicting
Hmong refugees in the United States.
Leah Carson Powell
See Also Assault, Supernatural.
References
Adler, Shelley R. 1991. Sudden Unexpected Nocturnal Death Syndrome among
Hmong Immigrants: Examining the Role of the ‘‘Nightmare.’’ Journal of American
Folklore 104: 54 71.
Hufford, David. 1982. The Terror That Comes in the Night. Philadelphia: University
of Pennsylvania Press.
Jones, Ernest. 1931. On the Nightmare. London: Hogarth.
O
Obscenity
911
912 | Obscenity
company in the past. Examples are M€ archen and legends containing descriptions
of the dismembering or torture of women. Customs such as bundling—a court-
ship pastime in which a couple slept together in the same bed, although
clothed—were considered innocent in many agrarian communities in the past but
are regarded as illicit in similar communities today.
In many cultures the world over, obscenity—particularly lewd behavior—
correlates with sacredness. Deities are represented as lascivious, and calendar
customs marking the agricultural or ritual year may include days of obscene
license (e.g., carnival). Such moments may include lewd dancing, cross-gender
behaviors, nudity, and sexually explicit masks or costumes. Initiations to college
fraternities often contain similar occasions. Obscene folklore was an important
part of Irish wakes as well. In all of these cases, obscenity plays a part in the
ritual inversion of everyday life; after the completion of the ritual or outside of
the celestial pantheon, such behaviors may again be strongly censured by the
community at large.
Folklorists often have faced difficult decisions when collecting and presenting
obscene lore. In the past, many collectors rejected such items at the time of per-
formance or conveyed to the performers beforehand an unwillingness to record
such materials. Other collectors recorded obscene items but decided against pub-
lishing them, presumably out of deference to the sensibilities of the reading audi-
ence or the reputation of the editor or performers. Still others devised methods of
obscuring or diluting the force of the items, bowdlerizing explicit passages,
translating key words into Latin, or replacing letters of obscene words with
dashes (e.g., c––t for cunt). Early collectors, such as the Englishman Sabine
Baring-Gould, even occasionally supplied entirely new texts for folksongs they
collected. Folklorists involved in the systematization of folklore often avoided
classification of obscene materials altogether; Stith Thompson includes a section
for obscene erotic materials in his Motif-Index of Folk-Literature (X700–799,
‘‘Humor Concerning Sex’’) but refrains from further detailing of elements that
might belong under the rubric.
During the nineteenth century, folklorists occasionally circulated obscene
materials in ‘‘gentlemen’s editions,’’ with limited subscriptions, plain covers, and
little or no advertisement. Robert Burns’s Merry Wives of Caledonia—a collec-
tion of bawdy folksongs from Scotland—is a particularly noteworthy private
edition that appeared posthumously. The great Russian folktale collector
Alexander Afanas’ev grouped his informants’ bawdy tales together into a single
final volume of his extensive anthology, labeling the material ‘‘secret tales’’ and
marketing the volume to a limited circle of scholars. Limited-circulation schol-
arly series, such as the French and Italian Kryptadia, sought to present examples
of the entire world’s erotic folklore for the benefit of interested scholars. The
American journal Maledicta seeks to accomplish a similar goal in a more open
Obscenity | 913
manner and for a broader audience today and includes treatments of erotica,
verbal obscenities, insult, and off-color humor.
Although folklorists today may smile at the seeming prudishness or reserve of
previous collectors, many of the same questions remain difficult for field-work-
ers in contemporary contexts. Considerable public debate and legal dispute, for
instance, has centered on the appropriateness of publishing or marketing obscene
lines in contemporary rap music. Various forms of pornography remain illegal to
publish or sell, limiting the editorial decisions of even the most liberal-minded
collector. Questions of interracial or interdenominational slurs often pose prob-
lems to editors concerned with presenting lore that conveys a positive image of
the informants and their community. Is it right or fair to the informant to publish
remarks that may have seemed appropriate in the locker room or around the
campfire but that may brand the informant as racist, sexist, or coarse when
appearing in print? Are there genres of behavior that have become traditional—
for example, sadism or the making of obscene phone calls—that do not merit
inclusion in general anthologies of folklore? Should one anthologize a case of
‘‘mooning’’ (showing the buttocks) by fax or a case of ‘‘flaming’’ (writing a litany
of coarse insults) by e-mail? Some newer technologically mediated obscenities
pose problems for editors today equivalent to those facing nineteenth-century
collectors of folktales and ballads. The transgressive nature of obscenity itself
makes such questioning inevitable; when an item ceases to arouse a reader’s sur-
prise (if not consternation), its significance as true obscenity has probably come
to an end. Folklorists, as members of cultures, participate in the same processes
of definition and decision as their informants and readers, even if they would
sometimes prefer to stand outside or above such debates. Thus, the decision to
publish obscene materials may change their reception within the source commu-
nity, altering, for better or worse, the culture under examination.
Thomas A. DuBois
See Also Carnival; Scatology; Verbal Duel.
References
Abrahams, Roger. 1964. Deep Down in the Jungle: Negro Narrative Folklore from
the Streets of Philadelphia. Hatboro, PA: Folklore Associates.
Afanas’ev, Alexander N. 1970. The Bawdy Peasant. Ed. Gordon Grimley. London:
Odyssey.
Brand, Oscar. 1958. Bawdy Songs and Backroom Ballads. Sound recording. New
York: Audio Fidelity.
Burns, Robert. 1959. The Merry Muses of Caledonia. Ed. P. Ferguson. Edinburgh:
Macdonald.
Goldstein, Kenneth S. 1967. Bowdlerization and Expurgation: Academic and Folk.
Journal of American Folklore 80: 374 386.
914 | Occupational Folk Heroes
Jackson, Bruce. 1974. Get Your Ass in the Water and Swim Like Me: Narrative Po-
etry from Black Oral Tradition. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Legman, G. 1964. The Horn Book: Studies in Erotic Folklore and Bibliography.
New Hyde Park, NY: University Books.
Legman, G. 1990. Erotic Folksongs and Ballads: An International Bibliography.
Journal of American Folklore 103: 417 501.
Randolph, Vance. 1976. Pissing in the Snow and Other Ozark Folktales. Urbana:
University of Illinois Press.
Randolph, Vance. 1992. Blow the Candle Out: Unprintable Ozark Folksongs and
Folklore, vol. 2. Ed. G. Legman. Fayetteville: University of Arkansas Press.
Randolph, Vance. 1992. Roll Me in Your Arms: Unprintable Ozark Folksongs and
Folklore, vol. 1. Ed. G. Legman. Fayetteville: University of Arkansas Press.
One of the most prolific fields for the creation of folklore is work. Since the
industrial revolution defined work as we know it, trades, professions, and occu-
pations of all kinds have developed. Many of these have long histories and proud
traditions of struggle and development. An important aspect of these traditions
may be a heroic, larger-than-life figure, usually a male, who represents the skills,
values, and beliefs of an industry, trade, or occupation. Typically these figures
are superhuman axmen, shearers, train drivers, sailors, or cowboys about whom
numerous tall tales are woven.
In English-language tradition at least, there is sometimes a close connection
between occupational folk heroes who are the product of working groups and
heroes who are inventions of fiction writers. The controversy about whether Paul
Bunyan was an ‘‘authentic’’ folk hero of timber workers or a literary creation
has been echoed in studies of a number of lesser-known American figures. One
of these figures is the African American Annie Christmas, who is said to be
almost seven feet tall, to have twelve even taller sons, and to run a floating
brothel. Neither her prodigious drinking nor her wild ways ended her days,
though. Instead, she is said to have killed herself for the love of one who did not
want her. According to folklorist Richard Dorson, Annie was solely the creation
of Louisiana writer Lyle Saxon. The legendary Febold Feboldson, occupational
hero of Scandinavian American farmers, is probably based on the stories told
about Olof Bergstrom, a Swedish immigrant to America who appears in newspa-
pers and comics of the early twentieth century and about whom many local tales
were told around Stromsburg and Gothenburg, Nebraska. Paul Beath put many
of these tales in literary form, furthering the Paul Bunyan–like legendry of
Febold, which included such widely told tall tales as hitching a bee to a plow
to plow a ‘‘beeline,’’ along with a host of traditional lies involving giant
Occupational Folk Heroes | 915
mosquitoes, hoop snakes, and the business of cutting and selling frozen postholes.
The steel mill worker Joe Magarac, created by writer Owen Francis in the 1930s,
is a similar instance of an invented hero. Joe, whose surname means ‘‘jackass’’ in
Slovak, is seven feet tall, works all day and night, eats enormous meals, molds
molten steel through his fingers, and finally melts himself down into steel to prove
that he can, literally, make a higher quality product than iron ore.
A number of other occupational heroes have similarly murky folkloric prove-
nances. Old John was said to be the hero of American printers. All printers knew
someone who had seen him, or even spoken with him. Old John was so superna-
turally skilled that he could wave his hand across the composing desk and all the
type would fall magically into its proper place. He always quit at the most critical
moment of a job, when the type was being placed. According to the traditions of
the printing trade, when John died, he, along with all other printers, would go to
compositor’s heaven, a print room with all new presses and type. Another exam-
ple is the occupational hero of American signwriters, Slappy Hooper. Slappy
was a larger-than-life character who painted the biggest, best, and fastest signs.
He painted on the sky using ‘‘skyhooks’’ to hold his scaffold, and he once painted
a red stove that was so realistic it radiated enough heat to make flowers and
weeds bloom in winter. Doubts have been raised from time to time about the au-
thenticity of some occupational heroes of other cultures, such as the Australian
figure Crooked Mick, who first came to light in literary rather than folkloric
contexts.
Despite the largely, perhaps solely, literary origins of many of these characters,
some of them so convincingly echoed the interests and concerns of the occupational
groups they purported to represent that they were adopted by those very groups.
This was certainly the case with Paul Bunyan and Febold Feboldson and is very
much in accord with the processes of folklore, where ideas, characters, and other in-
formation originating in nonfolkloric sources may be taken over and adapted by
members of folk groups for their own ends and purposes. Broadly distributed
themes and story elements of the kind found in most of these occupational hero tra-
ditions may be adapted to local places, events, and characters. To describe tales
about characters who do not have ‘‘authentic’’ origins within a particular folk group
as ‘‘fakelore’’ is to ignore this important aspect of cultural process and implicitly to
denigrate those groups who have adopted such characters as occupational heroes.
Occupational heroes should not be confused with the patron saints of many
industries and occupations. Such saints are often selected on the basis of the rela-
tionship between their skills or attributes and the tasks they perform. So, for
example, St. Nikolai is the patron saint of Russian seafarers because he rescues
the musician and merchant Sadko of Novgorod from the clutches of the sea czar.
Graham Seal
See Also Children’s Folk Heroes; Hero/Heroine, Folk; Local Heroes; National Folk Heroes.
916 | Occupational Folklife/Folklore
References
Beath P. 1948. Febold Feboldson: Tall Tales from the Great Plains. Lincoln:
University of Nebraska Press.
Botkin, B., ed. 1944. A Treasury of American Folklore: Stories, Ballads, and
Traditions of the People. New York: Crown Publishers.
Dorson, R. 1959. American Folklore. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
‘‘Febold Feboldson.’’ In Leach, M., ed. 1975. Funk and Wagnall’s Standard Diction-
ary of Folklore, Mythology, and Legend. London: New English Library.
Francis, O. 1931. Joe Magarac, Scribner’s Magazine 90(5. November): 505 511.
Pound, L. [1913] 1987. Nebraska Folklore. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.
Occupational Folklife/Folklore
regional and national identities linked to the need for raw materials. Mining, fish-
ing, building construction, farming, ranching, and timber harvesting became the
foci of the first occupational researchers. In Europe, particularly Scandinavia and
Germany, this early research focused on preindustrial technologies and occupa-
tional structures linked to traditional village economies. The emphasis in much
of this research was on craft and traditional forms of technology that were
viewed in an evolutionary context, from the earliest periods of settlement to more
contemporary, nineteenth-century occupational complexes. This focus on craft
as a part of community and family life created a holism in European folklife
studies that continues today. Occupational folklife—the entire range of verbal
and nonverbal traditional expression—continues to shape this approach. Early
occupational folklorists in Denmark, Sweden, England, and the Soviet Union
drew direct connections between craft and guild solidarity and the ‘‘aristocracy
of labor.’’ More elaborate forms of political resistance and class formation during
the industrialization period created a linkage of worker and labor consciousness
that continues to shape much research in this field throughout the world.
In the United States, this historical response to emergent forces of work in a
new physical environment resulted in a more nationalistic and romantic view of
work culture. John Lomax and N. Jack Thorp, collected and reinterpreted the
songs, stories, and verbal arts of the American buckaroo (cowboy) as an embodi-
ment of a frontier, democratic ideal. These early American folklorists paid little
attention to the economic or structural responses of buckaroo employment, with
its nomadic uncertainty and state capitalist support of the railroads. Ironically,
the occupational folklore of this group continues to contain much material
expressing workers’ opposition to these various forms of exploitation. Lomax
and Thorp focused instead on popular concepts of the trade, paying particular
attention to the way in which the western landscape and the expansive hardships
of frontier life in America created new and unique forms of traditional expres-
sion or provided opportunities for the adaptation of Anglo or European tradi-
tional forms to the American context. The ballad, tall tale, and etiological legend
forms of Europe were transformed to depict the heroic exploits of cowboy lore.
Lomax, Thorp, and later Frank Dobie relegated the craft, techniques, and struc-
tural concerns of this trade to virtual invisibility in order to foreground a popular
mythology of primitive romanticism that more closely reflected their externally
derived concepts of class and culture. In contrast to European folklore collections
of this period, however, there was some diversity and internal ethnic confronta-
tion within these early collections. Whereas the European scholars focused more
on work craft and traditional technology in homogeneous communities as an em-
bodiment of national or regional character, the Americans devoted some of their
energies to collecting verbal forms that depicted women, African Americans,
Mexican Americans, and Native Americans in a more diverse, but often
918 | Occupational Folklife/Folklore
noted that early occupational folklorists in the Soviet Union used early collec-
tions of workers’ folklore as means of ‘‘folklorism,’’ the use of folk material for
political purposes. In Germany, according to Hemmersam, Robert Michels and
Will-Erick Peuckert paralleled the politically motivated work in the Soviet
Union, but the historical and comparative methods of German linguistic and ety-
mological research drew these earlier studies into more academic and less politi-
cally oriented collections. The contemporary research of Lutz Rohrich and
Herman Bausinger reflects these influences. British and Italian interests in work-
ers’ songs, stories, and popular media led occupational folklorists into more
careful examinations of the relationship between mass media and local work cul-
tures, and Scandinavian scholars, drawing on regional and nationalist frame-
works for the identification and collection of agricultural and resource
occupations, developed a systematic method for documenting both the material
and the verbal aspects of work culture that continues to inform occupational folk-
lore researches in those countries.
Turning to developments in the United States, one of the earliest American
folklorists interested in industrial folklore, George Korson, was drawn to collect-
ing miner’s lore and personal experiences through his journalistic focus on re-
gional lore in Pennsylvania. As Archie Green stated in his two overviews of
occupational folklore, unlike many of his colleagues before and since, Korson was
able to work with the United Mine Workers, publishing collected songs and sto-
ries in its journal and relying on contacts and union support to make contact with
individual miners. In his many books and articles, Korson walked a fine line
between describing actual work experiences (dangers of the work, songs, and cus-
toms of above- and underground experience, customs, and work traditions) and
making various political characterizations of the mine workers’ resistance to capi-
talist exploitation. Korson recorded protest songs, strike ballads, and laments for
workers killed in disasters and labor struggles, yet he never overtly aligned him-
self or his work ideologically with the causes expressed in these materials. In
bringing miners and their occupational folklore to the attention of a national audi-
ence, Korson led the way toward state-supported programs designed to document
occupational folklore as a means of articulating emergent and resilient forms of
national character. At the same time, his populist and progressive political motiva-
tions remained largely implicit in his writings and public presentations.
In the 1930s, the Works Progress Administration provided an opportunity for
writers and intellectuals in the United States to develop an array of public proj-
ects aimed at restoring a sense of national pride in the everyday experiences of
American citizens. As a part of this movement, folklorist Ben Botkin and writers
Nelson Algren and Jack Conroy began to collect and present aspects of worker
stories and perspectives that they termed ‘‘occupational folklore.’’ These collec-
tions paralleled the approach of Korson in their attention to the words and stories
920 | Occupational Folklife/Folklore
of industrialized, urban workers, but they did not have the sophistication
and holistic sweep of Korson’s work. Wayland D. Hand, a folklorist from
Utah, extended his interest in the folklore of hard rock miners into an interna-
tional, comparativist study of occupational folklore—primarily verbal arts and
legends—that linked American research to European antecedents and parallels.
Unfortunately, this comparativist approach remains one of the few international
studies of occupational folklore written by an American scholar, and Hand’s call
for more cross-cultural research in this area largely has gone unanswered.
In the 1960s, a former shipwright in the United States and a historian in
England reformulated the field of occupational folklore. With a background in
both an industrial trade and organized labor, Archie Green’s research into labor
and occupational folklore reflected a division between the political and ideologi-
cal culture of the labor movement itself. What is most important in Green’s
work, particularly his early descriptions of labor and occupational folklore and
his investigation of the relationship between popular and local working-class
culture in the production of popular/folk music, is his ability to bring together
academic interests in occupational traditional culture with an appreciation
within the labor movement for cultural expression and ideology through folklore.
Green’s innovations in occupational research led to the first collaboration
between the American Federation of Labor and Congress of Industrial Organiza-
tion (AFL-CIO) and occupational folklorists at the Smithsonian Institution’s
1976 Festival of American Folklife; in addition, he also drafted and lobbied for
the passage of the American Folklife Act that established a permanent American
Occupational Folklife/Folklore | 921
Folklife Center at the Library of Congress. This foray into public support of
occupational folklife parallels museum and archival networks already well estab-
lished in Europe and Great Britain.
In England, E. P. Thompson’s view of class formation within British society
shifted historical and cultural studies away from the somewhat mechanical forms
of Marxist interpretation, which had characterized earlier exploitations of work
culture for socialist ends, and toward a more processural, humanist social history
of work culture. Raphael Samuel, Thompson, and a whole generation of work-
ing-class intellectuals sought to identify and describe the contexts within which
cultural resistance to capitalism on a local, regional, and international scale took
place. Folklorists within this emergent social and critical reshaping of the intel-
lectual relationship between academics and the world of work emerged from the
workplace itself, with miners, industrial laborers, and building trades workers
becoming the collectors and interpreters of working-class culture within these
various trades.
In the United States, Archie Green’s ability to bridge the academic-labor public
contexts, within which occupational folklore and the more inclusive folklife have
developed, has brought us to the current generation of occupational folklorists in
Europe and the United States. Hemmersam, in his summary of European and
American research in workers’ folklore, stated that there are basically four diver-
gent approaches to the field. Interestingly, he divided these approaches into their
respective ideological strategies, that is, with regard to the ‘‘system of attitudes,
concepts and ideas behind the researcher’s concern with workers’ culture.’’ The
four ideological approaches are: (1) the classic folkloristic and ethnological
approach, (2) bourgeois research of workers’ culture, (3) a socialist/communist-
oriented school, and (4) empirical research on workers’ culture.
Viewed from this perspective, the classic folkloristic approach maintains the
antiquarian’s ideological commitment to a peasant model of work. Here, the
researcher adopts a historical, regional, and often nationalistic theoretical position,
through which surviving work traditions of the past are maintained and/or repre-
sented through material culture into the present. Flemming Hemmersam cited the
work of Europeans Vesa Kurkela and Matz Rehnberg. In the United States, the
work of Bruce Nickerson and Michael Owen Jones fell into this category.
This is contrasted with a more contextualized, ethnographic approach to work
culture that maintains some of the elements of folkloristic research in its empha-
sis upon specific expressive forms within broader social and political contexts.
In Europe, this approach is exemplified in the work of Birgitta S. Frykman in
England and Hemmersam in Sweden. In the United States, it is evident in the
work of Robert McCarl, Jack Santino, and Paula Johnson.
Bourgeois research of workers’ culture maintains the position that mass media,
public schooling, and the uniform experiences of urban life have penetrated
922 | Occupational Folklife/Folklore
working-class culture to the point that there are virtually no unique or opposi-
tional forms remaining. Hemmersam cited the work of German scholar Herman
Bausinger as a proponent of this approach, and in the United States, the works of
Richard Dorson, Hennig Cohen, and Tristram Coffin fall into this category.
Socialist/communist approaches to workers’ culture see a culture that has been
created exclusively in opposition to capitalism and capitalist modes of produc-
tion. In Europe, this approach has a rich and deep history, and Hemmersam cited
Anders Bj€orklun and G€osta Arvastson as the two main proponents of this
approach. In the United States, the approach has not been as actively expressed,
although certainly more Marxist views of work culture, from the work of Harry
Braverman and Archie Green to the folkloristic writings of Jose Limon and
Manuel Pe~na, have been informed by a more oppositional view of cultural for-
mation in working-class communities.
Finally, the empirical approach has produced large collections of the cultural
materials of work with little attention to social or ideological context. Hemmer-
sam noted the work of Simo Laaksovirta and Ulla-Maija Peltonen as providing a
useful description of how this approach is employed in Europe. In the United
States, this type of research has been conducted primarily by Wayland Hand and
Horace Beck.
It is difficult to summarize all of the approaches to occupational folklore to
date, but beyond discussing Hemmersam’s useful divisions, it might be helpful
to suggest how these various forms of research are related. In this era, Marxism
has virtually disappeared as a viable political structure, yet the theoretical tools
of Marxist analysis provide a useful perspective from which to critically evaluate
the development of occupational folklore in the West, and Renato Rosaldo has
provided a theoretical framework that might pull these disparate elements to-
gether. In brief, Marx stated that the mode of production—the technology and
practices of producing food and energy—to a great extent determine or influence
all other forms of social life. Human reproduction, social organization, economic
life, and belief or ‘‘superstructural’’ aspects of a culture are based on these struc-
tural constraints. The following characterization simplifies this culturally materi-
alist approach to an examination of structure—the received circumstances of a
particular historical response to economic and physical conditions that result in
forms of social, political, and demographic response within a particular work or-
ganization. Beyond simply a labor market, the inherited structure of a particular
type of work generates a mode of production that elicits a specific, concrete his-
torical response. This response is made up of two elements, the relational and the
practical. A worker responds to and becomes a part of the forces of production
(the tools, techniques, hierarchies, and economic constraints of a particular type
of work); at the same time, he or she creatively and informally participates in an
informal world of human relations that, to a great extent, responds to and resists
Occupational Folklife/Folklore | 923
the very forces of production in which the work is conducted. A welder in the
Portland shipyards in World War II, for example, acquiesced to the speedup and
shortcuts of a wartime economy and its concomitant demands on production,
while at the same time, the subculture of welders within the shipyard work cul-
ture determined the limits and boundaries of their complicity in this process.
Work culture and its resulting occupational folklore is shaped by the forces of
production, but it is born and given life by the informal relations of production
that put a human face to work experiences and provide the technical means of
opposition.
In addition to structure, it also is important to investigate agency—the infor-
mally held value system that is born at the point where the primary work group
defines its independence from and opposition to all other hierarchies and groups
within the workplace. Agency is the collective expression of specific individual
choices that are made by workers as they form a class response to the constraints
imposed by supervisors, union representatives, other workers, and even family
and community members. Agency is defined by the primary work group, that
face-to-face ensemble of individuals who respond to the occupational constraints
of structure, and it defines the informal boundaries of cultural experience within
that structure. A firefighter, for example, must respond to the physical realities of
a high-rise building fire using the technical (structural) techniques of his or her
trade. At the same time, however, he or she does so using knowledge and ideolo-
gies (agency) engendered by fellow workers, who inform and evaluate the
performance.
Finally, there are border zones and boundaries that are constantly shifting in
the world of work and are irreducible to a particular category or characterization
as aspects of work structure or agency. Underemployed workers, the arrival of
various ethnic, generational, or sexual preference groups, radical shifts in labor
markets that export entire industries and relegate an entire generation of skilled
tradespeople to obsolescence, as well as the depictions of workers in the media
and in the representations created by folklorists—these are transition points or
boundaries within the global economy that create the dynamic fluidity of work in
the contemporary world. Increasingly, the worker today has no security but exists
in a liminal context of tension between his or her historical preparation for a par-
ticular work structure, a set of personal values and ethos born of informally gen-
erated responses (agency) that reflect the primary work group’s ability to accept
or reject, assimilate, or alter the internal and external assaults on its collective
will. New workers, loss of a labor market, or de-skilling force all workers into a
daily reappraisal of how the unavoidable evolution of structure will affect our
ability to survive. For their part, women, people of color, and a new generation
of workers with new values experience internal boundaries caused by a denial of
communication across the ever-increasing number of challenges to the status
924 | Occupational Folklife/Folklore
References
Botkin, Benjamin. 1949. Industrial Lore. In Standard Dictionary of Folklore, Mythol-
ogy and Legend, ed. Maria Leach. New York: Funk and Wagnalls.
Beck, Horace. 1973. Folklore and the Sea. Middletown, CT: Wesleyan University
Press.
Coffin, Tristram, and Hennig Cohen. 1973. Folklore from the Working Folk of
America. Garden City, NY: Doubleday.
Dorson, Richard. 1981. Land of the Millrats. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Green, Archie. 1971. Only a Miner: Studies in Recorded Coal Mining Songs.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Green, Archie. 1978. Industrial Lore: A Bibliographic-Semantic Query. In Working
Americans: Contemporary Approaches to Occupational Folklife, ed. Robert H. Byington.
Smithsonian Folklife Studies No. 3. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Green, Archie. 1993. Wobblies, Pile Butts and Other Heroes: Laborlore Explora-
tions. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Hand, Wayland D. 1969. American Occupational and Industrial Folklore: The Miner.
In Kontakte und Grenzen: Probleme der Volks-, Kultur-, und Sozialforschung: Festschrift
fur Gerhard Heilfurth, ed. Hans Foltin. G€ottingen, Germany: Verlag Otto Schwartz.
Heilfurth, Gerhard. 1976. Work in Industrial Culture Aspects and Trends. In Folk-
lore Today: A Festschrift for Richard Dorson, eds. Linda Degh, Henry Glassie, and
Felix Oinas. Bloomington, IN: Research Center for Language and Semiotic Studies.
Oikotype/Oicotype | 925
Hemmersam, Flemming. 1985. Worker Lore and Labor Lore. ARV: Scandinavian
Yearbook of Folklore 41: 17 29.
Hemmersam, Flemming. 1988. Workers’ Folklore and Worker Culture. ARV: Scandi-
navian Yearbook and Folklore 44: 49 102.
Hemmersam, Flemming. 1991. Worker’s Folklore and Worker’s Ethnology in Scan-
dinavia in the 1980s. ARV: Scandinavian Yearbook of Folklore 47: 59 117.
Holtzberg-Call, Maggie. 1992. The Lost World of the Craft Printer. Urbana: Univer-
sity of Illinois Press.
Johnson, Paula. 1988. Working the Water. Charlottesville: University Press of
Virginia.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1984. Introduction Works of Art, Art as Work, and the Arts
of Working. Western Folklore 43: 172 178.
Korson, George. 1938. Minstrels of the Mine Patch. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Limon, Jose. 1983. Western Marxism and Folklore: A Critical Introduction. Journal
of American Folklore 96: 34 52.
Lomax, John, and Allen Lomax. [1910] 1948. Cowboy Songs and Other Frontier
Ballads. New York: Macmillan.
McCarl, Robert S. 1978. Occupational Folklife: A Theoretical Hypothesis. In Working
Americans: Contemporary Approaches to Occupational Folklife, ed. Robert Byington.
Smithsonian Folklife Studies No. 3. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
McCarl, Robert S. 1985. The District of Columbia Fire Fighters’ Project: A Case
Study in Occupational Folklife. Smithsonian Folklife Studies No. 4. Washington, DC:
Smithsonian Institution Press.
Nickerson, Bruce. 1974. Is There a Folk in the Factory? Journal of American Folk-
lore 87: 133 139.
Pe~na, Manuel. 1985. The Texas-American Conjunto. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Rosaldo, Renato. 1989. Culture and Truth: The Remaking of Social Analysis. Boston:
Beacon Press.
Santino, Jack. 1989. Miles of Smiles, Years of Struggle: Stories of Black Pullman
Porters. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Thompson, E. P. 1963. The Making of the English Working Class. London: Victor
Gollancz.
Thorpe, N. Jack. 1968. Songs of the Cowboys. Variants, Commentary, Notes and
Lexicon by Austin and Alta Fife. New York: Clarkson Potter.
Oikotype/Oicotype
The local form of a text type (known as either oikotype or oicotype). C. W. von
Sydow, who introduced the concept into folklore studies, borrowed it from biol-
ogy, where ecotype means a variety of a species that possesses inherited charac-
teristics that enable them to thrive in a particular habitat. Usually applied to
926 | Oikotype/Oicotype
longer folklore forms such as folktales and ballads, oikotypification occurs when
regular changes occur in a text type’s content, style, or structure as it adapts to
the preferred patterns of a particular locality or culture group. Von Sydow’s con-
cern was the manner in which folktale performers who moved across regional
and national boundaries told their stories in ways that conformed with the story-
telling norms of their new cultural milieus. If a story caught the imagination of
storytellers native to the new environment, it gradually would change from its
original form while assuming characteristics suitable for its adopted locale.
An oikotype may be thought of as a special kind of subtype, one that is tied ex-
plicitly to a particular cultural setting. The process of oikotypification resembles
localization, but the latter phenomenon usually refers to relatively superficial
adaptations of a text type to a locality, such as changes in place- or personal
names. Oikotypification suggests changes that affect the text type’s narrative
core. For example, the repetition by threes that characterizes most traditional nar-
ratives from Indo-European traditions may become repetition by fours when a
tale is taken up by narrators from Native American cultures such as the Navajo,
whose pattern number is four. Von Sydow’s borrowing from biology was refined
in the work of Roger Abrahams. Working with the narrative folklore of urban
African Americans, Abrahams sought an approach to identifying what was cul-
turally characteristic of the material these people performed. Many of their jokes,
for example, were versions of international tale types, but Abrahams believed
that an examination of their folklore would reveal particular ways of narrating
that the African American performers found especially attractive. These tropisms
might involve the content that had been von Sydow’s principal interest but could
also include structural properties, diction, framing devices, imagery, and sym-
bols. Once the oikotypal pattern for a particular locality or group had been iso-
lated, Abrahams noted, examination of a single piece of lore might reveal
whether it came from that group.
Versions of the British ballads anthologized by Francis James Child that have
been encountered among American traditional singers often reflect the process
of oikotypification. For example, the texts may be shorter than their British coun-
terparts, often pared down to what has been called the ‘‘emotional core.’’ More-
over, supernatural elements may become rationalized, and topics of high
seriousness may be treated with earthy matter-of-factness. Moral preachments
may be added to those ballad narratives that lend themselves to such homiletics.
Although von Sydow’s approach to folklore studies was exclusively textual,
the concept of oikotype may have applications for performance-oriented folklo-
rists. The geographically distinct styles of singing identified by Alan Lomax’s
cantometrics project, for instance, may amount to an identification of oikotypes
of approaches to song performance.
William M. Clements
Onomastics | 927
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1970. Deep Down in the Jungle: Negro Narrative Folklore from
the Streets of Philadelphia. First revised edition. Chicago: Aldine.
Coffin, Tristram P. 1977. The British Traditional Ballad in North America. Revised
edition with supplement by Roger deV. Renwick. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Lomax, Alan. 1976. Cantometrics: A Method in Musical Anthropology. Berkeley:
University of California Extension Media Center.
von Sydow, C. W. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and
Bagger.
Onomastics
From the Greek word onoma, meaning ‘‘a name,’’ the term onomastics (or ono-
matology, as it is sometimes called) means the study of names. Onomastics has
two chief subdivisions, toponymy (the study of place-names) and anthroponymy
(the study of personal names). Each of these categories can be further subdi-
vided, and the relationship of these divisions to folklore may vary considerably.
Historically, the scholarly study of names was begun by European linguists to-
ward the end of the nineteenth century, and it acquired a solid scientific basis in
the early years of the twentieth century. The first meeting of the International Con-
gress of Onomastic Sciences was held in Paris in 1938, but it was not until 1987
that the eminent folklorist and onomastician W. F. H. Nicolaisen proposed, at the
sixteenth congress, held at Laval University in Quebec, that onomastics be treated
as a distinct discipline with its own philosophy and its own theories, rather than as
a subspecialty of linguists, philosophers, folklorists, sociologists, psychologists,
geographers, historians, and students of literature and aesthetics. Nicolaisen out-
lined a framework in which like-minded scholars could pursue this goal.
The study of place-names certainly became an important adjunct to nine-
teenth-century language studies. At the end of the eighteenth century, it was dis-
covered that Sanskrit, the sacred language of ancient India, was, in fact, related
to Greek and Latin. This discovery initiated a period of intense research into
European languages, resulting in the development of a comparative approach to
language—it was soon realized that modern European languages such as French,
Italian, Spanish, Portuguese, and Romanian, for example, could all be traced
back to earlier forms of Latin. By the end of the nineteenth century, a very
refined methodology existed that enabled scholars to pinpoint sound changes as
they occurred in time and the concomitant changes to the shape and meaning of
words. Theories could be tested because there was a substantial body of data
attesting to the nature of Latin during the centuries of Roman domination of
Europe and the Mediterranean world. Modern French and Spanish words, for
928 | Onomastics
example, could be traced back by applying the laws that seemed to have gov-
erned their evolution, with known Latin forms acting as a control.
As comparative methodology was refined, a second important discovery was
made—that not only were many modern European languages sister languages
descended from Latin but also that other, seemingly unrelated language families
were also related to Latin, Greek, and Sanskrit. Thus, the many Germanic lan-
guages, including modern English, Dutch, German, and Scandinavian languages,
were seen to be connected, with the Romance tongues, to Celtic languages such
as Welsh, Irish, Cornish, and Breton and the great family of Slavic languages,
including Russian, Polish, Serbo-Croat, and Bulgarian. All these languages and
others not mentioned here were, in turn, related to Iranian and languages of
India—hence the term Indo-European used to indicate the geographical spread
of these distant but related languages. Awareness of this Indo-European family
of languages was to influence the study of the folktale in the latter half of the
nineteenth century and much of the twentieth.
The reason linguists turned more and more to the study of toponymy is not hard
to find. It soon became apparent that contemporary place-names often incorporated
elements whose meaning was now opaque, the careful study of which, however,
suggested the influence of languages now dead or no longer spoken in a given geo-
graphical region.
Building a hypothetical picture of primitive or proto-Indo-European languages
by careful comparison of root words common to all, scholars began hypothesiz-
ing about the spread of these languages, finding in place-names the earliest evi-
dence of language movement. Indeed, the existence of non-Indo-European roots
in certain place-names was the first clue about even earlier human settlement in
some countries. As a result, the use of comparative linguistic methodology was
seen as central to the study of place-names, the more so because careful analysis
revealed considerable layering of languages. Thus, in France, for example, it was
possible to isolate place-name roots predating the arrival of Celtic-speaking peo-
ples, who, in turn, adapted earlier forms to their language, only to have their own
forms adapted and modified by subsequent external influences—of Latin with
the colonizing Romans and later by Germanic speakers. Much of Europe shows
this kind of depth and richness with its toponyms, be they towns and cities, riv-
ers, lakes, mountains, or hills. This explains why so much onomastic research in
Europe has been focused on unraveling the etymologies or history and meaning
of place-names and so dominated by linguists. That historians have been so inti-
mately connected with European place-name study is also logical since they
were the scholars whose study of ancient documents produced the earliest known
or attested forms of place-names.
This same preoccupation with the history of place-names led to a growing in-
terest in personal names. All personal names seem to have meant something
Onomastics | 929
when they were first applied, but few contemporary names drawn from European
languages have transparent meanings. Nowadays, people give names to their
children that may come from any European language, regardless of the language
spoken by the namer. Yet people often want to know what their names mean.
Using the same principles applied to tracing the history of place-names, scholars
are usually able to suggest the original meaning of personal names; the diversity
of popular books available to facilitate the choice of names for new babies sug-
gests that many people attach great importance to the names they choose, believ-
ing perhaps that names have power and that the name’s original meaning
somehow imprints itself on its bearer.
Underlying this desire to know the origin and meaning of names, be they
place-names or personal names, is the fundamental need felt by humans to iden-
tify the physical world around them and to identify other humans. The naming
and identifying of individuals creates a sense of social order and establishes sets
of relationships; the naming of places helps make the unknown and potentially
threatening known and familiar. Naming thus allows humans to domesticate the
world about them, to acquire a sense of control, however illusory in reality that
control might be. The fact remains that all human societies name themselves and
name features of the world around them, as they perceive the world to be. As
such, naming is therefore a very ancient and a very traditional preoccupation.
And since tradition remains a central concern of the folklorist, the folklorist is
interested in names and the process of naming. However, since tradition is not
immutable but instead subject to the forces of change, the folklorist is also inter-
ested in the patterns that develop and emerge in space and time, though focusing
more on the informal process than, for example, on the institutionalized pro-
cesses established by governmental bureaus and boards of names and naming
that are in charge of official naming (though even formally constituted naming
institutions are subject to the vagaries of fashion).
It is not easy to establish how very ancient place-names were first given or,
indeed, how very ancient personal names were first attributed, though one may
find ample clues in the naming processes still functioning among many non-
European peoples (the 1990 movie Dances with Wolves owes its title to just such
a process). European place-names and personal names were very much in their
present form, however, when, at the end of the fifteenth century, Europeans first
came to the New World, as they quickly named the Americas.
European exploration and subsequent settlement drew on contemporary
European patterns of naming in the wake of post-Renaissance voyages around
the world. Wherever Europeans passed and wherever they settled, the place-
names they created tended to follow recognizable trends. Prominent features, at
first observed from the sea, were named to reflect their appearance, the date on
which they were encountered (and were often named after that day’s saint in the
930 | Onomastics
about regional and dialectal European influences and philosophical views popu-
lar at a given period.
Because of the relatively recent settlement in the New World that has given rise
to place-names whose earliest forms are readily identifiable if one has sufficient
knowledge of post-Columbian history, place-name studies have, with the excep-
tion perhaps of names of Native American origin, been a good deal less etymolog-
ically oriented in North America than in Europe. Interest has tended to focus more
on social and historical factors in the patterns of naming, rather than on the origi-
nal meaning of names. To this end, though it is still necessary to make the best
use of all available documents in order to identify the earliest and subsequent
forms of names, contemporary onomastic studies recognize that names are far
more than the meaning of the words that become names and that central to the
study of names today should be the namer, the name, the naming process, and
name usage. Such an approach requires familiarity with a wide variety of human-
istic disciplines, not simply with the history of languages or of colonization.
It was noted earlier that folkloristic interest in naming is fundamental but that
not all subdivisions of onomastics are necessarily of equal interest to the folklo-
rist. What follows is an outline of most of the main and some of the minor areas
of naming that may concern the folklorist, beginning with the broad subfield of
toponymy.
Among the oldest features named by humans must stand elevations, be they
mountains, hills, ridges, or crests, since elevations have always been convenient
reference points. The technical term for the study of elevations is oronymy; it
includes not only the names of heights but also the terms used to name kinds of
geographical elevations. These reflect settlement patterns, insofar as early set-
tlers would have used their native, dialectal terms. It is possible to use a knowl-
edge of, for example, regional English terminology as a clue to the peopling of
the regions of North America. The folklorist will be particularly interested in the
etymologies offered by locals to explain or justify the use of such-and-such a
name, as when the name seems to refer to a historical event or when its meaning
is not immediately evident and a story is created to provide an apparently satis-
factory meaning.
Alongside the naming of elevations stands the naming of bodies or courses of
water, or hydronymy. Folklorists are particularly interested in microhydronymy,
the names given to small bodies of water or water courses not usually large
enough to figure on maps but to which some significance is attached by the local
population. These may range in size from duck ponds and swimming holes to
alleged bottomless lakes or holes, about which there frequently is a body of anec-
dotes of legendary nature.
An area of naming that seems to have attracted little scholarly attention until
recently is what one might term hydroronymy, or naming used to designate the
932 | Onomastics
Phyllis Wheatley Elementary School in the northwest area of Miami. (AP/Wide World
Photos)
trucks, spaceships, and ocean-going vessels; the process is clearly both personal
and important since people also name stuffed toys, plants, and even ‘‘pet stones.’’
Insofar as insight can be gained both on an ancient and traditional practice and
on very personal processes, such study is clearly of interest to the folklorist.
The second major element of onomastics, anthroponymy, also deals with a
wide range of naming practices. Although contemporary surnames are generally
inherited and of interest chiefly for historical reasons, first names are of interest
for very immediate reasons. Depending on a community’s history and its open-
ness to innovation, different patterns of naming can be observed. In some fami-
lies, for example, there is a very strict adherence to tradition, with the eldest son
taking his father’s or grandfather’s name; male and female children may be
named according to a strictly observed hierarchy. The folklorist will attempt to
uncover such patterning, in addition to noting changes in the pattern. In the last
few generations, there has been, in some segments of society, considerable inno-
vation based on the influence of the cinema, television, and popular music
(although there is nothing new about naming children after famous, powerful, or
otherwise influential people).
934 | Onomastics
References
Baker, Ronald L., ed. 1991. The Study of Place Names. Terre Haute: Indiana Council
of Teachers of English and Hoosier Folklore Society.
Oral-Formulaic Theory | 935
Oral-Formulaic Theory
The approach to the study of oral tradition and works with roots in oral tradition
that prescribes a specialized language or idiom as the basis of composition in
performance. Also known as the Parry-Lord theory, after its founders, this
approach puts a premium on the utility of patterned phraseology (formulas), typi-
cal narrative scenes (themes), and large-scale organization (story-patterns) in
providing ready solutions to the performer’s ongoing challenge of maintaining
fluent, intelligible composition. In addition to applying the theory to living tradi-
tions, chiefly poetry, scholars have retrospectively analyzed ancient and medie-
val works to determine the extent of their dependence on such paradigms and, in
some cases, their ‘‘oral’’ or ‘‘literary’’ character. With typical structures demon-
strated in more than 130 separate language areas, the most pressing question has
become how to interpret works composed in this specialized idiom.
The oral-formulaic theory began with Milman Parry’s pioneering studies of
the Homeric epics, the Iliad and Odyssey, which reveal systematic patterning
behind the recurrence of particular phrases, especially noun-epithet expressions
such as ‘‘swift-footed Achilleus’’ and ‘‘goddess bright-eyed Athena.’’ Instead of
explaining the great epics as either conglomerate editions of smaller poems
(according to the analyst school) or the personal and individual achievements of
a single genius (the unitarian school), Parry argued that a poetic diction as sys-
tematized as the language of the Homeric poems must be the legacy of genera-
tions of bards, who perfected the idiom over centuries. His fundamental insight
was thus that the language of Homer was traditional.
The core of Parry’s theoretical proposal was the formula, which was defined
as ‘‘an expression regularly used, under the same metrical conditions, to express
an essential idea.’’ Parry eventually enlarged this definition beyond the noun-
epithet phrase to include any metrically determined unit of Homeric diction. Thus,
for example, recurrent expressions for speech introduction (e.g., ‘‘As so he/she
spoke’’) were shown to combine with recurrent names for mortals or gods to pro-
duce predictable—and in terms of oral-formulaic theory, useful—hexameter lines.
936 | Oral-Formulaic Theory
Theme
Narrative ‘‘words’’—recurrent actions or scenes—in oral-formulaic theory; defined by
Albert Lord as ‘‘groups of ideas regularly used in telling a tale in the formulaic style of tradi-
tional song.’’ First suggested by Milman Parry in his review of Walter Arend’s 1933 mono-
graph on typical scenes in Homer, the theme has a heritage in earlier studies of repeated
actions in various narrative works, just as the Parry-Lord formula can be traced to the ear-
lier analysis of Parallelstellen (parallel passages) in ancient and medieval poetry. What distin-
guishes both formula and theme from this background is the insistence that they
constitute a performance idiom, a special compositional language that was both tradi-
tional, in the sense of inherited and collective, and oral, in the sense of unwritten or pre-
textual. Examples of themes in various traditions include: assembly, arming for combat,
boasting before battle, sea voyage, feasting, exile, and the ‘‘beasts of battle’’ (carrion
animals).
Lord, to whom the concept of theme should largely be attributed, conceived of
the unit as an idea pattern together with a relatively stable core of verbal expres-
sion. As he demonstrated in Homer and in the south Slavic epic tradition, occur-
rences of themes in those traditions correspond in terms of the actual formulas
employed, with predictable flexibility due to different singers or regional dialects.
South Slavic bards also were shown to adapt their thematic patterns to individual
songs or performances. Likewise, narrative inconsistencies—cases of Homer or his
counterparts ignoring content and thereby allowing apparent contradictions within
a given work—were explained in terms of themes that have lives of their own. A
contradiction within a single performance fades in importance when weighed
against the expressive impetus of a theme in the tradition as a whole. That is, the
individual instance always draws its most fundamental meaning from the larger tra-
ditional context, which dwarfs any single performance.
As with other aspects of the oral-formulaic theory, studies of theme spread out-
ward from ancient Greek and south Slavic traditions, especially to Old and Middle
English, Old French, Biblical studies, Hispanic, central Asian epic, Irish, Welsh, and
other traditions. With that growth, the original definition and concept shifted some-
what, coming to emphasize idea pattern over verbal correspondence among instan-
ces; eventually, efforts were mounted to understand the theme within its many
different, tradition-dependent contexts. Questions of what mechanisms control aes-
thetics and whether thematic mechanisms persist when epics become transmitted by
writing rather than orally can, as with the formula, be put to rest by viewing themes
as metonymic of the tradition at large, with the concrete part standing for a much
larger implied whole. One particular feast or battle, for example, is always echoic of
other feasts or battles in the audience’s experience of the tradition at large.
John Miles Foley
For Parry, utility in formulaic diction derived from the participation of individ-
ual phrases in larger, generative formulaic systems, groups of items fitting the
same metrical slot that also are related by common semantic and syntactic fea-
tures. Although this aspect of the poetic idiom furnished the composing poet a
Oral-Formulaic Theory | 937
12,311-line oral epic performed for Parry and Lord in 1935 by the preliterate
singer Avdo Medjeovi’c of Bijelo Polje in Herzegovina. The latter volume is a
collection of some of his most wide-ranging and important essays, treating
Homer, south Slavic, Finnish, Old English, Bulgarian, and central Asiatic epic.
In the wake of the publication of The Singer of Tales, the Parry-Lord theory
underwent vigorous translation and application to Old English, Middle English,
Old French, Hispanic, American folk preaching, biblical studies, and scores of
other areas; it also continued to expand in ancient Greek studies. A history of the
comparative methodology is available in John Miles Foley’s Theory of Oral
Composition; an annotated bibliography appears in his Oral-Formulaic Theory
and Research, with updates in Oral Tradition.
With formulas, themes, and story-patterns identified in traditions worldwide,
new questions began to arise about the implications of oral-formulaic theory for
interpretation, especially in relation to texts with extensive prior critical histories,
such as the Homeric poems. One of the central tenets of the approach as origi-
nally stated held that a certain percentage of formulas and formulaic systems
constituted proof of the ultimately oral provenance of a given text, independent
of any supporting testimony for that claim. The reasoning proceeded from the
criterion of utility: If a poet had regular recourse to ready-made diction and nar-
rative patterns, then he or she was composing traditionally and thus orally. Quan-
titative measurement of this sort did not take into account the inevitable
differences among languages, traditions, or genres, nor did it consider the persist-
ence of the formulaic idiom after the introduction of writing.
Indeed, as the oral-formulaic theory has expanded to more and more traditions,
many of them still living, it has become increasingly apparent that an absolute di-
chotomy of oral versus written does not fit the evidence. Manuscript works that
presumably represent freestanding compositions by individual authors still show
extensive use of the formulaic language, and different rules govern the structure
and texture of formulas and themes from one language to another or even from
one genre to another. Additionally, the issue of performance and all that it entails
has come to the fore: Oral tradition presents many channels for communication
(linguistic, paralinguistic, and nonlinguistic), only a limited number of which are
reflected in what we conventionally reduce to a transcribed text.
Another area in which the theory has been modified is in response to the charge of
mechanism, that is, the perception that formulas and themes imprison a verbal artist,
restricting originality and diluting expressivity. Although based primarily on literary
criteria, not all of them applicable to oral tradition, this objection has stimulated a
reexamination of what is meant by the ‘‘essential ideas’’ of formulas and the ‘‘typi-
cal’’ content of themes. One proposed answer to the quandary consists of understand-
ing the oral-formulaic idiom as a highly focused species of communication, one that
encodes complex information in simple forms within the enabling event of perfor-
mance and by institutionalized reference to the immanent tradition. By employing this
Oral Tradition | 939
special register of language, in other words, performer and audience (and later, writer
and reader, if properly prepared) communicate with greatly enhanced economy. Of
course, the traditional language cannot accomplish all of the quotidian tasks nor-
mally assigned to a much more generalized register, but as long as audience and
reader are fluent in the traditional tongue, its dedicated function promotes a unique
economy of expression and reception.
John Miles Foley
See Also Bard.
References
Amodio, Mark C. 2005. New Directions in Oral Theory. Tempe, AZ: Arizona Center
for Medieval and Renaissance Studies.
Culley, Robert C. 1986. Oral Tradition and Biblical Studies. Oral Tradition 1:
30 65.
Edwards, Mark W. 1986 1992. Homer and the Oral Tradition. Oral Tradition 1:
171 230, 3: 11 60, 7: 284 330.
Foley, John Miles. 1985. Oral-Formulaic Theory and Research: An Introduction and
Annotated Bibliography. New York: Garland.
Foley, John Miles. 1988. The Theory of Oral Composition: History and Methodol-
ogy. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1990. Traditional Oral Epic: The Odyssey, Beowulf, and the
Serbo-Croatian Return Song. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1991. Immanent Art: From Structure to Meaning in Traditional
Oral Epic. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1995. The Singer of Tales in Performance. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Lord, Albert B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Lord, Albert B. 1991. Epic Singers and Oral Tradition. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Univer-
sity Press.
Parry, Milman. 1971. The Making of Homeric Verse: The Collected Papers of Mil-
man Perry. Ed. Adam Parry. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
Parry, Milman, Albert B. Lord, and David E. Bynum, colls., eds., and trans. 1953.
Serbocroatian Heroic Songs (Srpskohrvatske junacke pjesme). Cambridge, MA, and
Belgrade: Harvard University Press and the Serbian Academy of Sciences.
Oral Tradition
A Brief Definition
Whether we define the utterances of an oral tradition broadly, as any customary
oral expression, or more specifically, as verbal arts using a ‘‘poetic’’ form of spo-
ken language unlike everyday speech, it is generally recognized that oral
940 | Oral Tradition
Texture
A general term for the poetic devices of the surface level of texts, such as allitera-
tion, assonance, consonance, anaphora, and rhyme. Sometimes, the term texture has
been used to cover even broader concepts of diction and meter. According to
some authors, texture is distinguished from structure. The former comprises the or-
ganization of prosodic and stylistic features and syntax, and the latter encompasses
the large-scale elements such as organization of narration, plot, and story. Heda
Jason, in her narrative structural model, separates texture from such categories as
wording, narration, and dramatization.
According to some tenets of text linguistics, texture is imbued with cohesive
relations. As M. A. K. Halliday and R. Hasan maintain, the text is distinguished from
something that is not a text because the parts of a text form a coherent whole: A
text has a texture.
Lauri Harvilahti
942 | Oral Tradition
(phrases and verses that sometimes vary little from telling to telling) reso-
nate idiomatically with far greater meaning than would, say, the same num-
ber of words utilized in everyday, nontraditional conversation. The same
holds true for images, motifs, type-scenes, and story patterns. Consider, for
example, such tale types as the Cinderella story or the narrative etiologies
that recur in folktales. Rather than being trite, the ongoing reframing of a
tale draws its power from a simultaneous responsiveness to the newness of
the immediate situation and the traditional weight of a narrative that reso-
nates with prior instances of its telling and reception.
4. While we think of words as units delimited by white space upon the page, a
traditional poet or storyteller often conceives of whole units of acoustically
encoded information as ‘‘words,’’ whether this means a line of verse, a scene,
or an entire story. Each ‘‘word,’’ long or short, forms a part of the perform-
er’s repertoire. Thus, to understand oral expressions properly, we need to
learn the working vocabulary, the ‘‘words,’’ of the tradition.
5. A ‘‘great divide’’ was once imagined to exist between oral-folkloric and writ-
ten-literary works, but the actual practices of tradition bearers have
debunked this myth. Artists (among others) negotiate ongoing alliances
between the literary and the oral in their creation of verbal expressions.
Hybrid compositions in written form—the Middle English Pearl and Sir
Gawain and the Green Knight, for instance—employ an oral poetics. Liter-
ate tradition bearers and their audiences could (and can) use resources
944 | Oral Tradition
provided by both the oral-traditional and literary paradigms, much the same
way that communities of bi- and trilingual speakers may switch languages
multiple times within a single conversation.
6. The following ‘‘media morphology’’ (Foley, 39–53) addresses the adaptabil-
ity of oral traditions with respect to writing: ‘‘voices from the past’’ (e.g.,
Homeric epics, the medieval Japanese Tale of the Heike, and the Old French
chansons de geste), ‘‘voiced texts’’ (slam poetry), ‘‘written oral poems’’ (Pje-
vannija, Finnish Kalevala, and the works of Lydia Cabrera), and ‘‘oral per-
formance’’ (Tenore Song, Mongolian Long Song [Urtiin Duu], Palestinian
Hikaye, and Tibetan Gesar). ‘‘Oral performance’’ contains by far the most
diverse species of oral traditions, and the features of oral traditions in the
foregoing section derive mainly from the study of oral performances. Due to
their various relationships with the technology of writing, performances and
works in the other categories—‘‘voices from the past’’ and ‘‘written oral
poems’’—may be mistakenly treated as literary. Recognition that these
pieces rely upon oral-traditional modes of composition helps audiences
reframe their expectations, avoid depending too heavily on the wrong set of
interpretive tools (that is, the literary), and learn a new set (the oral).
Repertoire
In general, the stock of skills a person or persons are prepared to execute; with spe-
cific relevance to folklore, the complex sets of interrelated skills, knowledge, and
achievements that highlight a person or group’s unique abilities in a particular genre
(or genres) of traditional performance.
A performer’s repertoire is generally used to denote an individual’s particular skill,
achievement, or knowledge. The term repertoire also applies to the same areas on a
group level. An example of the former would be the narrative repertoire of a particular
raconteur who is recognized for a knowledge of trickster tales or, in the latter case, the
craft repertoire of a group known for particular skill at producing specific types of pot-
tery in a style in which the designs and techniques are common to the entire group.
Though generally seen as a discrete set of forms, a person or group’s repertoire
is built upon a complex of interrelated items that both shape and are shaped by the
particular skill being focused upon. For example, the narrative repertoire of the
storyteller known for trickster tales not only reflects a learned set of traditional ta-
les but also calls forth a variety of questions about the performer’s social and artis-
tic backgrounds. From whom were the narratives learned and how? Were they
passed orally from a particular relative, or were they acquired from a number of
sources? What were the circumstances surrounding the performance of each par-
ticular tale? Was there an associated task or event that precipitated the perfor-
mance, such as weaving a rug, quieting a child, or entertaining and educating the
group? What other skills and activities reinforce or detract from the performer’s
narrative skills? What is the performer’s individual and family status in the commu-
nity? These are among the variables that affect individual repertoires.
The study of a person’s or a group’s repertoire requires a multifaceted approach that
accounts for as many of the variables involved as possible. The study also requires a rec-
ognition of the multiple genres involved in a repertoire. Folklorist Barre Toelken
describes repertoire in terms of multiple repertoires. That is, a person’s or group’s rep-
ertoire is a collection of interrelated genres of folklore that reflect and are shaped by the
aesthetics of the performers’ folk group. On occasion, a specific genre may be the main
focus of the performance, but the rendering of each individual item is shaped by the full
range of identifiable folklore genres that a particular individual or group possesses, and
these are shaped by the aesthetics of the group with which the performers identify. This
ideational context thus informs us what the genres of a particular performance are, as
well as the realities of the aesthetics and traditions of the group in which the performers
live. In addition, it is necessary to be aware of the roles of not only active bearers of tra-
dition (i.e., performers) but also inactive bearers (i.e., those who know but do not
actively perform folklore). Both sorts of tradition bearers are vital to the development
and perpetuation of repertoires. Thus, the term repertoire refers to the full range of
knowledge and abilities of the performers as shaped by the relationship among the folk
genres in their repertoire and to the traditional aesthetics of the group to which the per-
formers belong.
Randal S. Allison
948 | Oral Tradition
References
Amodio, Mark C. 2004. Writing the Oral Tradition: Oral Poetics and Literate Cul-
ture in Medieval England. Notre Dame, IN: University of Notre Dame Press.
Del Giudice, Luisa, ed. 2009. Oral History, Oral Culture, and Italian Americans.
New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Falola, Toyin, and Fallou Ngom, eds. 2009. Oral and Written Expressions of African
Cultures. Durham, NC: Carolina Academic Press.
Fine, Elizabeth C. 1994. The Folklore Text: From Performance to Print. 1984. Bloom-
ington: Indiana University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1990. Traditional Oral Epic: The Odyssey, Beowulf, and the
Serbo-Croatian Return Song. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Foley, John Miles. 2002. How to Read an Oral Poem. Urbana: University of Illinois
Press. eCompanion at http://www.oraltradition.org/hrop.
Folklore Fellows, Finnish Academy of Science and Letters, University of Helsinki.
http://www.folklorefellows.fi.
Honko, Lauri. 1998. Textualising the Siri Epic. Helsinki: Suomalainen Tiedeakatemia.
Lord, Albert Bates. 2000. The Singer of Tales. Revised edition. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press.
Oral Tradition: An Interdisciplinary Academic Journal. http://www.oraltradition.org.
UNESCO Culture Sector. Intangible Heritage. http://www.unesco.org/culture.
Zumwalt, Rosemary Levy. 1998. A Historical Glossary of Critical Approaches. In
Teaching Oral Traditions, ed. John Miles Foley. New York: Modern Language Associ-
ation, pp. 75 94.
Organizational Folklore
Coors Company with the American Nazi Party; and Uncle Ben’s Rice and
Church’s Fried Chicken with the Ku Klux Klan). A fourth image sketches the be-
neficent organization, particularly in redemption rumors claiming that a certain
company will purchase expensive medical equipment (a dialysis machine, an
iron lung) for a needy child if customers send discarded items such as cigarette
packages, the pull tabs from aluminum cans, or the tags from tea bags.
Folklorists have documented and analyzed such stories, hypothesizing that
some reflect major structural changes in society as communities move from self-
sufficiency to dependency on large, impersonal organizations, which generate
anxieties or fears expressed symbolically (e.g., legends about ‘‘Kentucky Fried
Rat’’ in which a patron of a fast food franchise discovers a crispy coated rodent
in the bucket of chicken because of unsanitary conditions or a prank by a dis-
gruntled employee). Other accounts may convey concern over an invasion of
foreign goods and threats to a country’s economy by competitors abroad (allega-
tions of contaminated, defective, or dangerous products from Third World coun-
tries). Some likely involve transference (the redemption rumors can assuage
feelings of guilt over unhealthful habits). Whether or not accounts are based on
actual experience, they are significant in their pervasiveness.
Folklore also pervades the organizational workplace. Much of photocopier
lore focuses on points of strain inherent in formal organizations, occasioned by
institutional controls, supervision, and structure at the expense of individual
freedom and personal power. The familiar drawing of a person with an enor-
mous screw through the midriff and the caption ‘‘Work hard and you shall be
rewarded’’ communicates the feelings that organizational life can produce much
too easily. Fake memos, usually ascribed to the personnel office, set forth
changes in policies. For example, one describes a new restroom trip policy limit-
ing use of facilities to twice a day and warning of a thirty-second buzzer that
will sound before the roll of paper automatically retracts, the toilet flushes, and
the stall door opens. Another informs employees of a forced early retirement
plan called RAPE (Retire Aged Personnel Early). A third presents a new sick
leave policy stating that a physician’s statement will no longer be accepted as
proof (‘‘if you are able to go to the doctor, you are able to come to work’’) and
that death will not be accepted as an excuse for absence unless it is the employ-
ee’s own (in which case, ‘‘we would like a two-week notice as we feel it is your
duty to train someone else for your job’’). Sometimes, photocopier lore evincing
criticism circulates sub rosa; on other occasions, members of an organization
openly display it (feeling, perhaps, that it refers to the larger organization but
not their department or to other institutions but, thankfully, not their own).
Many people decorate their work area with mementos, posters, postcards, car-
toons, photocopier lore, or other items. Placement may be as important as content
in regard to function (whether something expressing criticism is hidden or in
952 | Organizational Folklore
public view, where items that one looks at for diversion or reverie are located,
and so on). The nature and extent of personalization reveals a great deal about
the individual, management attitudes, and organizational climate.
In addition, much talk (illustrated with numerous stories) about beating the sys-
tem, engaging in prohibited behavior, and so forth suggests worker dissatisfaction.
The presence of celebratory events, festive occasions (such as birthday parties),
joking, and food sharing signal cordial relations, cooperativeness, and ready com-
munication. Recounting oft-told tales about a worker insulting an impudent cus-
tomer, getting back at a supervisor, or violating rules and regulations express
frustrations and serves as a means of coping with stress. Stories about critical inci-
dents in the organization’s history can reveal beliefs about the institution and its
environment as well as the organization’s preparedness for and responsiveness to
change. Traditional expressions and metaphors often encapsulate values and influ-
ence perceptions, decisions, and actions; consider, for example, cowboy manage-
ment metaphors (‘‘earning his spurs,’’ ‘‘gunning for the opposition,’’ ‘‘a Smith &
Wesson beats four aces’’) that justify extreme behavior, in contrast to what is con-
veyed by frequent reference to ‘‘family,’’ ‘‘teams,’’ or ‘‘nurturing.’’ In sum, stories,
ceremonies, rituals, rites of passage, festive events, play, metaphorical language,
and other examples of folklore in organizational settings may instruct, persuade,
entertain, express the ambiance of the workplace, help an individual cope, protect
personal integrity, stimulate a sense of community, guide decision making and
action, reinforce factionalism, and help or hinder organizational effectiveness.
Folklore can serve the researcher as a source of information, a diagnostic tool to
uncover problems and their causes, and a means of improving organizational func-
tioning and the conditions under which people labor.
Michael Owen Jones
See Also Occupational Folklife/Folklore.
References
Collins, Camilla. 1978. Twenty-Four to the Dozen: Occupational Folklore in a Ho-
siery Mill. PhD dissertation, Indiana University, Bloomington.
Dundes, Alan, and Carl Pagter. 1978. Work Hard and You Shall Be Rewarded:
Urban Folklore from the Paperwork Empire. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Fine, Gary Alan. 1992. Manufacturing Tales: Sex and Money in Contemporary
Legends. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Humphrey, Theodore C., and Lin T. Humphrey, eds. 1988. ‘‘We Gather Together’’:
Food and Festival in American Life. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research Press; reprinted by
Utah State University Press, 1991.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1987. Exploring Folk Art: Twenty Years of Thought on Craft,
Work, and Aesthetics. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research Press; reprinted by Utah State
University Press, 1993.
Organizational Folklore | 953
Jones, Michael Owen, ed. 1990. Emotions in Work. Special issue of American Be-
havioral Scientist 30(January-February): 3.
Jones, Michael Owen, Michael Dane Moore, and Richard Christopher Snyder, eds.
1988. Inside Organizations: Understanding the Human Dimension. Newbury Park, CA:
Sage Publications.
Nickerson, Bruce. 1976. Industrial Lore: A Study of an Urban Factory. PhD disserta-
tion, Indiana University, Bloomington.
Porter, Kenneth. 1944. The Business Man in American Folklore. Bulletin of the
Business Historical Society 18: 113 130.
Santino, John Francis. 1978. The Outlaw Emotions: Workers’ Narratives from Three
Contemporary Occupations. PhD dissertation, University of Pennsylvania, Philadelphia.
P
Paradigmatic/Syntagmatic
955
956 | Parody
Pierre Maranda. The concept of paradigmatic structure also has influenced work
in ethnopoetics by Dell Hymes and others, who have applied it to texts of Native
American verbal art. Using an approach he called ‘‘verse analysis,’’ Hymes, for
example, discovered repeated patterns in narratives from Native American peo-
ple along the northwest coast that provide the molds by which storytellers shape
their specific performances.
The oral-formulaic theory of Milman Parry and Albert Lord exemplifies the
combination of paradigmatic and syntagmatic approaches. On one hand, Parry
and Lord argued, epic singers work from syntagmatic outlines of the epics they
spontaneously compose. On the other hand, they plug into the outlines various
formulas, many of them interchangeable paradigms, that fit the poems’ metrical
and narrative needs.
William M. Clements
See Also Diachronic/Synchronic; Ethnopoetics; Folktale; Linguistic Approach; Oral-
Formulaic Theory; Structuralism.
References
de Saussure, Ferdinand. 1966. Course in General Linguistics. Trans. Wade Baskin.
New York: McGraw-Hill.
Dundes, Alan. 1975. On the Structure of the Proverb. Proverbium 25: 961 973.
Dundes, Alan. 1980. The Morphology of North American Indian Folktales. Helsinki:
Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Georges, Robert A., and Alan Dundes. 1963. Toward a Structural Definition of the
Riddle. Journal of American Folklore 76: 111 118.
Hymes, Dell H. 1981. ‘‘In Vain I Tried To Tell You’’: Essays in Native American
Ethnopoetics. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
K€ong€as-Maranda, Elli, and Pierre Maranda. 1971. Structural Models in Folklore and
Transformational Essays. The Hague: Mouton.
Leach, Edmund R. 1961. Levi-Strauss in the Garden of Eden. Transactions of the
New York Academy of Sciences 23(4): 386 396.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1955. The Structural Study of Myth. Journal of American
Folklore 67: 428 444.
Lord, Albert B. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Propp, Vladimir. 1968. Morphology of the Folktale. 2nd ed. Trans. Laurence Scott.
Austin: University of Texas Press.
Parody
Parodia, the Greek term from which the English word parody derives, is com-
posed of two morphemes, par-, which can be translated as ‘‘beside, against or
Parody | 957
counter,’’ and -odia, meaning song. Hence in its original usage it appears to be a
type of song that imitates another song for humorous effect. The important point
is that the listener or audience is able to recognize the pale reflection of the more
serious original in the imitation. As Humberto Eco notes in Carnival! ‘‘the law
[meaning in this case the song, narrative, etc.] must be so pervasively and pro-
foundly introjected as to be overwhelmingly present at the moment of its viola-
tion’’ (1984, 6). Or as any standup comedian knows, it’s always helpful to have a
straight man.
This process can be seen clearly in the Mexican coloquios or traditional nativ-
ity plays described by Bauman (1996, 318). Here the parody is effected by ena-
bling the audience to hear both the narrator or prompter’s rendition of a written,
religious text (the straight verse) and the actor’s parodic counterstatement, a type
of word play in which syntactic and phonological parallelism foreground humor-
ous semantic differences. For example, while the prompter states, ‘‘It appears
that I am getting out without losing a step’’ (Parece que voy saliendo sin perder
una pisada), the Hermitano, the parodic figure of the drama, remarks, ‘‘Now I
am getting used to it without missing even a single fuck.’’ (Ya me estoy poniendo
sin perder ni una pisada.)
Parody is, of course, no longer limited to song if it ever was. It can be found in
all of the arts and the humanities—literature, painting, poetry, theatre, dance, and
more recently in film. One that readily comes to mind is Charlie Chaplin’s The
Great Dictator, which ridiculed Adolf Hitler through exaggerated imitation of
the Fuhrer’s violent gestures and shrill tone. An oft-cited theatrical example is
Tom Stoppard’s Rosencrantz and Guildenstern Are Dead, an absurdist drama
first staged in 1966, which borrows two minor characters from Shakespeare’s
Hamlet and turns tragedy into comedy.
Ironically, some literary parodies, such as Don Quixote, live on long after the
work on which it was based; Amadis de Gaula, has been forgotten. Moreover,
thanks to new technologies that allow us to juxtapose photographic images, vis-
ual parodies that require few if any words can be found all over the Internet. One
famous or infamous example, depending on your political perspective, is the
side-by-side photos of George Bush and a variety of chimpanzees that appeared
sometime after the 2000 election. Although the person who designed the Web
site claimed he was not politically motivated—he supposedly just thought Bush
looked like an ape—the author’s intentions are probably less important than the
reader’s response.
Among the ‘‘folk,’’ parodies not only abound during carnival, but also during
the ‘‘profane’’ activities that precede or follow processionals held in honor of the
patron saint of a town or village. On September 29, following the mass said in
honor of St. Michael the Archangel, the patron saint of Maxcanu, Mexico, the
congregants pour into the street behind the church and reassemble in their
958 | Parody
Oxp’e dia ma’ haantken tinwatan For three days my wife doesn’t eat me
Mix inwatan tsenken xan Nor does my wife feed me either
Yaan tun kubo’otik bin up’ax She must, then, pay the debt she owes
[inaudible] ko’olibi bo’otik xan [inaudible] the virgin pays it too
(Translated from Yukatek Maya by author).
the ejemplo or example, a more or less true story, was a tool for teaching chil-
dren to avoid saying inappropriate things. ‘‘People said that I had twins
because the children had two fathers. But God punished them for talking this
way. It is not good to talk about other people, and so these same women had
twins too’’ (1937, 26).
In contrast, revised folktales, like Bob Hartman’s The Wolf Who Cried Boy
(2004), Susan Meddaugh’s Cinderella’s Rat (1997), Simon Puttock’s Big Bad
Wolf Is Good (2002), Jon Sciezka’s The True Story of the Big Bad Wolf (1999),
and my favorite, Eugene Trivizas’s The Three Little Wolves and the Big Bad Pig
(1993), show little concern about upholding community standards or maintaining
wholesome ‘‘family values.’’ The goal may be to question the nature of stereo-
types, poke fun, raise contemporary political issues, or simply use an old story to
create a new one.
In Trivizas’s revision of the Three Little Pigs, for example, the roles are
entirely reversed. Three tender, fluffy wolves seek refuge from a maniacal pig
by building successively stronger houses. Beginning with brick, they move on
to reinforced concrete, and, finally, a house made out of iron bars, armor plates,
and heavy metal padlocks. Pig, however, is able to destroy all of them with the
help of a sledge hammer, a pneumatic drill, and dynamite. The wolves are
saved only by the beautiful scent of flowers they get from Flamingo. The scent
is so enticing that Pig sniffs and sniffs until he decides to become a good pig,
and he and the wolves become friends. Trivizas’s tale may very well be a be-
lated celebration of flower power as Amie Doughty argues in Folk Tales Retold
(2006). However, as a child of Dr. Seuss and the Butter Bean War, I can’t help
but see a comment on the massive growth of prisons or the Star Wars Defensive
Initiative—both of which were costly and controversial issues in the 1990s—
and an admonition that we will either learn to live together or we will surely
die together.
The relationship between the original tale and the revised tale, of course,
varies from tale to tale. In some cases, the original is retold with a few new twists
or a different ending; in other cases, as in Cinderella’s Rat, minor characters are
elevated to major characters to create a ‘‘new’’ tale. In either case, however, it is
the intertextual play between the old and the new that lends rhetorical force to
the tale and helps it succeed.
Although parody is often used to address social or political issues of the day,
not all parodies are satires, and not all satires involve parody. Satire often
involves a variety of different rhetorical devices such as sarcasm, irony, bur-
lesque, and innuendo, and may or may not be parodic. The question that is more
difficult to answer is whether parody must be humorous. In the last year or so,
Participant-Observation Method | 961
side-by-side images comparing the mistreatment of the Jews by the Nazis and
the mistreatment of Palestinians by Israelis have been circulating on the Internet.
Although the juxtaposition of these images can be viewed as poignant, provoca-
tive, or even inflammatory, neither side views them as humorous.
Ronald Loewe
See Also Asian American Humor and Folklore; Carnival; Folktale; Joke.
References
Bauman, Richard. 1996. Transformations of the Word in the Production of Mexican
Festival Drama. In Natural Histories of Discourse, eds. Michael Silverstein and Greg
Urban. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, pp. 301 328.
Doughty, Amie. 2006. Folktales Retold: A Critical Overview of Children’s Stories.
Jefferson, NC: McFarland and Company.
Eco, Umberto, V. V. Ivanov, and Monica Reed. 1984. Carnival! (Approaches to
Semiotics). New York: de Gruyter.
Hartman, Bob, and Tim Raglin. 2004. The Wolf Who Cried Boy. New York: Puffin Press.
Loewe, Ronald. 2003. Yucatan’s Dancing Pig’s Head: Icon, Carnival and Commod-
ity. Journal of American Folklore 462: 420 443.
Meddaugh, Susan. 1997. Cinderella’s Rat. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Perez Sabido, Luis. 1983. Bailes y Danzas Tradicionales de Yucat
an. Merida,
Mexico: DIF.
Redfield, Margaret Park. 1937. The Folk-Literature of a Yucatecan Town. Contribu-
tions to American Archaeology. Vol. 3. Washington, DC: The Carnegie Institute of
Washington.
Puttock, Simon, and Lynne Chapman. 2002. Big Bad Wolf Is Good. New York:
Sterling Publication Company.
Scieszka, Jon, and Lane Smith. 1999. The True Story of the Three Little Pigs. New
York: Viking Juvenile Press.
Trivizas, Eugene. 1993. The Three Little Wolves and the Big Bad Pig. New York:
Mammoth Press.
Participant-Observation Method
into a formalized summary. The method’s goal is to account for the subject’s
point of view within a general theoretical framework.
The participant-observation method necessitates a long-term approach, for it
usually takes field-workers an extended period of time in order to become func-
tioning members of the target community. Until the researcher achieves this sta-
tus, the data obtained by using the method will reflect an abnormal routine since
the target community is likely to change its routines when outsiders impose on or
cross its boundaries. These anomalies will appear for a number of reasons,
including the suspicion of the field researcher and strangers in general, the
attempt to hide secrets from the outsider, the fear of being mocked because of
so-called primitive ways, and the desire to remain insulated from the forces of
change. However, once the field-worker becomes accepted by the target commu-
nity and is allowed to participate in its daily affairs, he or she is able to accumu-
late data from which an accurate ethnography can be written or a particular
problem can be studied.
Although the researcher must become accepted by the target community for
this method to be productive, complete acceptance is rare. Furthermore, it is use-
ful for the researcher to maintain some distance from the target group so that the
second dimension of the method, the observation, can be undertaken with as
much integrity and objectivity as possible. Nonobjective observations result in
data that cannot be verified; therefore, they are useless except as commentary on
the field researcher’s experience itself.
Proponents of the participant-observation method have recognized the need to
reconsider some of the basic premises surrounding the approach. Primary among
the assumptions that must be questioned is the idea that field researchers can be
objective, for field-workers themselves are born into situations that imbue them
with particular ways of perceiving, with particular agendas, and with particular
biases. Many field-workers, in response to this situation, make their reflexivity, the
revelation of themselves, a strength of the research by providing their audience
with data that aids in interpreting their work. Additionally, these field-workers
are acknowledging the voice of the Other as a significant factor in the participant-
observation method. This voice—which is not only the voice of the subjects being
studied but the field-worker’s voice as well—is made manifest in the presentation
of the field research, and it acknowledges that the field-worker’s objective observa-
tion is always incomplete. This incompletion implies that understanding and
interpretation emerge from participation in the experience itself, and accurate repre-
sentation will result only from the field-worker’s acknowledgment that participa-
tion is nonrepresentational in any objective sense.
Charlie T. McCormick
See Also Fieldwork.
Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore | 963
References
Jackson, Bruce. 1987. Fieldwork. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Kerr, David. 1991. On Not Becoming a Folklorist: Field Methodology and the
Reproduction of Underdevelopment. Folklore 102: 48 61.
Kodish, Debora. 1987. Absent Gender, Silent Encounter. Journal of American Folk-
lore 100: 573 578.
May, Tim, ed. 2002. Qualitative Research in Action. London: Sage.
Murchison, Julian. 2010. Ethnography Essentials: Designing, Conducting, and Pre-
senting Your Research. Hoboken: John Wiley & Sons.
Okely, Judith, and Helen Callaway, eds. 1992. Anthropology and Autobiography.
New York: Routledge.
Turner, Edith. 1992. Experiencing Ritual: A New Interpretation of African Healing.
Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
A rural red barn with Pennsylvania Dutch hex signs. (Cynthia Farmer/Dreamstime.com)
patterns, both churchly and sectarian, were planted in all the diaspora settle-
ments. The German language was spread via sermon, everyday speech, and print
(newspapers, books, and broadsides). In all the diaspora areas, Pennsylvania
Dutch foods and foodways, customs of the year, and other folkloric elements
spread widely with the transplanted Dutchmen of the nineteenth century: Penn-
sylvania’s manuscript art called ‘‘fraktur,’’ its legacy of fantastic quilt patterns on
the distaff side, traditional pottery, and, for those who can appreciate it, that vast
store of native wit and humor, folksongs, folktales, and other folkloric elements,
preserved in the dialect, now properly a language, called Pennsylvania Dutch.
Research Survey
America’s rediscovery of itself through the trauma of the Civil War and the cen-
tennial of the American Revolution in 1876 with the unparalleled Centennial Ex-
position in Philadelphia, exercised a catalytic effect in all American ethnic
groups, including the Pennsylvania Dutch. With the upswing in ethnic pride that
produced such late nineteenth-century institutions as the Scotch-Irish Society
Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore | 965
(1888) for the Ulster heritage, the Welcome Society (1889) for Pennsylvania
Quakers, the Pennsylvania Dutch followed in 1891 with their own Pennsylvania
German Society. The intellectuals among the founders of this society—ministers,
lawyers, and others—were influenced also by the national foundation of the
American Folklore Society in 1898, which brought the concept of ‘‘folklore’’ in
the British Thomsian sense, with its division into ‘‘genres,’’ to the attention of
several native Pennsylvania Dutch scholars, who began to apply the concepts to
their own culture. Among these was Dr. Walter J. Hoffman of the Smithsonian
Institution, whose folkloric surveys of Pennsylvania Dutch culture appeared in
the Journal of American Folklore in its very first volume (1888–1889). This
influence of the American Folklore Society on selected scholars continued in the
work of John Baer Stoudt, whose seminal work, The Folklore of the Pennsylva-
nia Germans, appeared in 1916. The pioneer work of such scholars as Marion
Dexter Learned and his pupil and successor Edwin M. Fogel at the University of
Pennsylvania in Philadelphia furthered the cause, with Dr. Learned’s ethno-
graphic questionnaires (the first in the nation) focused on folksongs and other
genres of Pennsylvania Dutch folklore, in 1899–1900, followed by Dr. Fogel’s
equally seminal volumes on Pennsylvania Dutch folk beliefs, proverbs, and
‘‘superstitions.’’
The discovery of ‘‘Elizabethan’’ balladry existing in Appalachia spurred on
much work on the Pennsylvania Dutch folksong traditions, with a Dutch Coun-
try–wide recording of dialect folksongs by Thomas R. Brendle, reformed clergy-
man, and William S. Troxell, Allentown journalist and prolific producer of
dialect literature under the pen name of ‘‘Pumpernickle Bill.’’ A selection of their
recordings appeared in George Korson’s Pennsylvania Songs and Legends
(1949), although the first complete book on the subject, Songs along the Mahan-
tongo, appeared in 1951.
In the 1930s, centering in Allentown and Lehigh County, a strong dialect-speak-
ing area, a renaissance of Pennsylvania Dutch studies began that extended into the
people’s sector with dialect radio programs, dialect church services, and the inven-
tion of the ‘‘Grundsow Lodch’’ (Groundhog Lodge)—an all-dialect evening ban-
quet and performance where amid the festivity and feasting, one was fined for
speaking English! At the same time, the team of Preston A. Barba and Harry S.
Reichard, both dialect-speaking professors of German at Muhlenberg College in
Allentown, Pennsylvania, produced Dr. Barba’s long-lasting (1936–1969) weekly
newspaper column, ‘S Pennsylfawnisch Diesch Eck (The Pennsylvania Dutch Cor-
ner), which is a treasure trove of folklore as well as historical material. Dr. Reich-
ard also joined the Lehigh County folk artist and dialect playwright Paul R.
Wieand in a weekly radio dialect skit called ‘‘Assebe and Sabeina,’’ reporting very
966 | Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore
amusingly on the ups and downs in the life of a typical Dutch farmer and his wife
and their circle of archetypical Dutch friends.
At the same time in the 1930s, the folk festival movement was brought to
Pennsylvania by George Korson, America’s first industrial folklorist. In 1935, he
began the Pennsylvania Folk Festival at Allentown, which later moved to Buck-
nell University at Lewisburg in central Pennsylvania. These festivals featured
Pennsylvania Dutch singing groups, Conestoga waggoners, miners’ songs, and
other products of Pennsylvania’s rich ethnic heritage. This led eventually to the
Pennsylvania Dutch Folk Festival at Kutztown, founded in 1950 and still going
strong sixty years later.
The ethnographic work begun at Franklin and Marshall College at Lancaster,
Pennsylvania, in 1949 by the research triumvirate of Alfred L. Shoemaker, J.
Willim Frey, and Don Yoder, led to the establishment of the journal The Penn-
sylvania Dutchmen (1949; it became Pennsylvania Folklife in 1968), the Penn-
sylvania Dutch Folklore Center (1949; which was incorporated in 1958 as the
Pennsylvania Folklife Society), and the Pennsylvania Dutch Folk Festival at
Kutztown (1950). This concerted approach united all phases of Pennsylvania
Dutch folklore, but broadened it into the European ‘‘folklife’’ approach, using
both current ethnography (interviews and questionnaires) and historical ethnog-
raphy (using historical documentation to reconstruct past levels of the culture).
The ‘‘folklife studies movement,’’ which began in America with the work of
these three scholars, has had a wide influence on the American folklore research
scene, with the establishment of such national institutions as the American Folk-
life Center at the Library of Congress and the Folklife Program of the Smithso-
nian Institution.
Folksong Research
The first genre of Pennsylvania Dutch folklore to be investigated thoroughly was
the folksong. The culture’s song repertoire represented three historical strands.
First are the songs, jingles, and rhymes that are so widespread they were obvi-
ously brought to Pennsylvania in the memories of the eighteenth-century emi-
grants. The second layer, drinking songs and other amusing genres, were
evidently brought here by the nineteenth-century emigrants and spread through
the countryside by itinerants like the colorful Fritter mit der Zitter—a zither-
playing emigrant-German tramp who sang often raunchy songs in the country
taverns—veritable men’s clubs of the culture—until his lamented death, reported
in the Lebanon County newspapers in 1880. This tradition of the lone singer-
entertainer continued into the twentieth century, represented by such memorable
Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore | 967
(Die Berg-Maria, Maria Jung) of the Oley Hills, whose benevolence to her
neighbors, her freely given healing procedures, and other virtues were noted and
written about throughout the nineteenth century long after her death in 1819.
Finally, the folktale repertoire of the Pennsylvania Dutch was often mirrored
in the local color fiction by such early twentieth-century writers as Elsie Sing-
master, especially in the volume Bred in the Bone (1925), Fred Lewis Pattee’s
The House of the Black Ring, and even some of Henry W. Shoemaker’s books,
although many have found his attempts to write about folklore too fictionalized
for the taste of an academic folklorist.
The numerous collections of folktale recordings by individual scholars, most
of them unpublished, deserve to be surveyed, and more recording needs to be
pursued while significant numbers of Pennsylvania Dutchmen still speak full and
perfect Dutch. Also, more of the printed literature of the culture, especially from
the nineteenth- and twentieth-century newspapers, needs to be culled for folktale
materials.
Proverbial Lore
Proverb research among the Pennsylvania Dutch was largely initiated by Edwin
Miller Fogel of the University of Pennsylvania, with his Beliefs and Superstitions
of the Pennsylvania Germans (1915). Fogel’s materials were gathered by inter-
views in the Dutch Country, and then collated with the European proverb collec-
tions. Typical of the times is the fact that Fogel omitted from his book a
substantial corpus of ‘‘erotic’’ materials, which he allowed to appear in a ‘‘Sup-
plement’’ (1915) ‘‘for private distribution, not for public perusal.’’ The transla-
tions of the Pennsylvania Dutch originals appeared in decorous Latin. Inevitably,
the ‘‘Supplement’’ found its way into print, the Latin rendered into very readable
English.
In 1925, Dr. Fogel’s major proverb collection, Proverbs of the Pennsylvania
Germans, appeared. This was reprinted later in the century in two different anno-
tated editions, by Wolfgang Mieder, proverb scholar of the University of
Vermont, and C. Richard Beam of Millersville University.
Proverbs and proverbial sayings exist by the thousands in the literature of the
Pennsylvania Dutch people, whether in dialect, High German, or English, and a
concerted effort to cull them from the printed sources and record them from liv-
ing speakers of Pennsylvania Dutch is overdue.
Folk Medicine
Pennsylvania’s most distinctive form of folk medicine is the ancient procedure
called in English ‘‘powwowing’’ or ‘‘powwow medicine.’’ The term powwow
Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore | 969
itself is from an Algonquin word that, according to the Oxford English Diction-
ary, came over into English in New England in the 1640s. It was used first for
Indian healers and healing procedures, then applied to the colonial healers.
While the practice was once universal in the states, under various names, the
Pennsylvania Dutch culture would seem to be its center and fountainhead today.
While certain Indian herbal remedies were appropriated and used by the colo-
nial white settlers, the name alone is the only element of powwowing that has
any connection with the American Indians. Powwow medicine involves the use
of magical formulas (Zauberformeln in German) brought from Central Europe
by the emigrants. The charms were put into print, and therefore canonized, by
the 1802 emigrant John George Hohman (Homan), whose book Der Lang
Verborgene Freund (usually translated ‘‘The Long Lost Friend’’) appeared at
Reading, Pennsylvania, in 1819/1820, and spread widely.
The Pennsylvania Dutch word for powwowing is Brauche or Braucherei, and
for powwow practitioners, Braucher. Synonyms in English include ‘‘to use’’ and
‘‘to try for,’’ although my most important powwow contact, Sophia Bailer of
Tremont in Schuylkill County, preferred ‘‘calling a blessing on’’ the patient.
In the past few decades, there have been several new and novel developments in
the field of powwow medicine. The proliferation of ‘‘Indian Readers’’ and ‘‘Healers
by Prayer’’ in the Eastern cities following World War II also has been registered in
the Dutch country. Several of these practitioners have subtly added the word pow-
wow to their printed advertisements, usually broadsides, distributed in parking lots
and other city venues to attract susceptible Dutchmen to their services.
There also seems to be an upswing in the number of practicing powwow doc-
tors, several of whom have written books describing and defending their healing
techniques. It appears also that some of the newer, younger practitioners have
been reading anthropological literature, since they are attributing their therapeu-
tic powers to a ‘‘soul journey’’ similar to those claimed by the Asian shamans.
Such claims, of course, were never part of the classic powwower’s understanding
of his craft.
Folk Religion
The Pennsylvania Dutch essentially was a Protestant culture. In its own terminol-
ogy, it was divided down the middle into ‘‘churchmen’’ and ‘‘sectarians.’’ The
churchmen included the major denominations of the Protestant Reformation, the
Lutherans and the Reformed. The sectarians, led by the Mennonites and their
stricter offshoot the Amish, included the Church of Brethren (Dunkards), the
River Brothers, and the Schwenkfelders. There were, in addition, revivalist sects
modeled on Methodism—the United Brethren, the Evangelical Association, and
970 | Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore
the Church of God, and their late nineteenth-century offspring the Holiness
groups. In between the Kirchenleute and the Sektenleute were the Moravians, or
Herrnhuter, who operated with episcopacy and liturgical services, but originally
were communitarian. Finally, there were two strictly defined communitarian
groups, the Ephrata Cloister and the Harmony Society.
Apart from these organized, official forms of Pennsylvania Dutch religion,
there existed vast areas of folk religion or folk spirituality—beliefs and customs
held by the people but not necessarily condoned or applauded by the clergy. A
prime example is the document, usually printed as a broadside, called the Him-
melsbrief or Heaven-Letter. Said to have been written by Jesus himself and sent
down to earth mysteriously, the text gives a kind of Protestantized version of the
Ten Commandments, urging the hallowing of Sunday as the Sabbath, avoidance
of fancy dress, pride, and so forth. But the document had a magical side and
attraction that has kept it in print into this century. It specifically states that any-
one who copies it and spreads it will be blessed, and whoever keeps it in his
blouse or on his person will be safe from flood, pestilence, and violent death.
The letters were carried by Pennsylvania Dutch soldiers in all of America’s
wars from the Revolution on, and printed in innumerable editions, in German or
English, by upstate country printers.
But folk religion involves more than personal and household protection. Prac-
tical matters involved seating in the churches and burial patterns in the church-
yards. Since the Pennsylvania Dutch individual, as in European peasant society,
was in earlier days subsumed under the community concept, men and women sat
apart in the churches, not in family groups as today, and the dead were buried
not in family plots, as today, but in the time slot beside the last community mem-
ber buried. In the older cemeteries, the dead were buried facing eastward, sym-
bolically toward the rising sun of the Resurrection morning.
On the negative side, the Pennsylvania Dutch folk worldview included, as did
every ethnic community of early America, a strong belief in witchcraft, the trans-
fer of evil from person to person by occult means. Every Dutch community has
nineteenth-century stories of persons accused of witchcraft and their devious,
devil-inspired doings—plus stories of how one countered witchcraft by going to
the local ‘‘witch doctor’’ (Hexe-Doktor) for a written country charm. See Richard
M. Dorson’s Buying the Wind for several examples of witch tales recorded from
a believer in the 1950s, including the classic Central Pennsylvania folktale ‘‘The
Bewitched Automobile.’’
scene. The principal examples are Christmas and Easter customs. The first
American evidence for both the Christmas tree and the Easter rabbit come from
Pennsylvania sources. However, the Pennsylvania Dutch Christmas involved
many more folkloric elements in the past. The modern Santa Claus was absent
from the earlier Pennsylvania Dutch Christmas celebration. In his place were the
gift-giver, the Christ-Child (Pennsylvania Dutch Grischtkindel), who left gifts
for the children, unseen, during the night, and the frightening Belsnickel, of
which there were two varieties.
On Christmas Eve, the father of the house, often masked and dressed in tat-
tered clothing, went outside, tapped on the window, was let in, scattered nuts and
candy on the floor, and when his children scurried to pick them up, gave them a
token switching, all in fun. But the Belsnickel concept had other dimensions—in
some cases groups of masked and sometimes cross-dressed teenagers and unmar-
ried young people went around from farm to farm on Christmas Eve, put on vari-
ous acts, and collected goodies that were divided at the end of the circuit. Most
frequently, these bands of masked and curiously dressed people paraded or rode
into the neighboring towns on ‘‘Second Christmas,’’ the day after Christmas, or
on New Year’s Day. This satisfied the human yen for dressing up and masking,
which other Americans confined to Halloween, and in Europe, to Fastnacht
(Shrove Tuesday). Striking photographs of troops of Belsnickels from the period
1900–1915 have recently turned up and have been used to illustrate the third and
fiftieth-anniversary edition of Alfred L. Shoemaker’s Christmas in Pennsylvania.
Alas, the colorful Belsnickel custom has faded from history, and most Pennsyl-
vania Dutch families now honor Santa Claus. The custom, however, occasionally
has been revived by local museums, in celebrations called ‘‘Belsnickel Days.’’
Another custom, now unfortunately gone, is the New Year’s shoot—shooting
in the New Year, with the accompanying chanted German blessing. A group of
eight to ten men, one with a rifle, circulated to neighboring farms on New Year’s
Eve. At each home, after asking permission to shoot, the shot was fired into the
winter sky, and then there was the Neujahrswunch, blessing the family, the
household, the animals in the barn, and extending the blessing to ‘‘all of Chris-
tendom.’’ This was a folk-religious ritual that was looked forward to from year to
year, and any family that was missed on the rounds was insulted! Recordings
exist form traditional ‘‘wishers’’ like Willy Brown, mentioned in the folksong
section. A few contemporary Dutchmen, like Peter V. Fritsch of Longswamp
Township in Berks County, are carrying on the tradition at the present time.
A third Pennsylvania Dutch holiday celebration, of more recent origin, is
‘‘Groundhog Day,’’ February 2, and has spread widely in the United States and
Canada. Known as Candlemas in the medieval European church calendar, the
day united two Christian festivals, the Purification of Mary (forty days after the
birth of Christ) and the Presentation of Christ in the Jerusalem Temple. In
972 | Pennsylvania Dutch Folklore
continental Europe, the day developed into a weather predictor. An animal, the
badger (Dachs) and originally the sacred bear of the alpine cultures, both hiber-
nators, were believed to issue from their winter quarters on February 2. If the day
was sunny and the animal saw its shadow, the winter weather was predicted to
continue for six more weeks. If the day was cloudy, rainy, or snowy, and the ani-
mal did not see its shadow, this was taken as a sign of an early spring.
The Pennsylvania Dutch brought the custom to America, and lacking badgers,
chose the native groundhog or woodchuck in its place, likewise a hibernating ani-
mal. There are two Pennsylvania centers of the cult at present—Punxsutawney in
Jefferson County in northwestern Pennsylvania, and Quarryville in Lancaster
County in southeastern Pennsylvania. In both cases, talented, innovative journalists
created the outline of the current holiday through their columns. In Punxsutawney,
the movement began in the 1880s, and in Quarryville after 1900. Both centers
developed elaborate scenarios—Punxsutawney’s ritual begins at 3 A.M. on
Gobbler’s Know outside the city. And, of course, the clever film Groundhog Day
helped the cause and the custom has now spread to at least twenty-five states and
several Canadian provinces. It is a fun and tongue-in-cheek holiday, providing some
ritualistic humor in the calendric doldrums between New Year’s Day and Easter.
Recent Developments
There have been three major research developments in the study of Pennsylvania
Dutch folklore. Professor C. Richard Beam, founder and director of the Pennsyl-
vania German Center at Millersville University, has recently completed and pub-
lished his lifetime work, the eleven-volume Pennsylvania German Dictionary.
This is now the ultimate authority on vocabulary and its usage in Pennsylvania
Dutch, besides being full of traditional sayings, proverbial lore, and folklore in
general.
Across the Atlantic, the Palatine linguist Dr. Michael Werner of the University
of Mainz, Germany, has established an international journal devoted to the Penn-
sylvania Dutch language. Called Hiwwe wie Driwwe, the title—‘‘over here like
over there’’—reflects the frequent feeling experienced by a Pennsylvania Dutch-
man in the Central Rhineland, where his language is understood, and the same
for the visiting Rhinelander over here. The journal is entirely in Pennsylvania
Dutch, except for occasional letters in High German or English. And the letters
are sent from every area in the United States and Canada where Pennsylvania
Dutch is still spoken and appreciated.
The third noteworthy item is Kutztown University’s Pennsylvania German
Cultural Heritage Center, founded by Dr. David Valuska and now headed by
Dr. Robert Reynolds. The center offers academic work, a major in Pennsylvania
German Studies with a minor in the language, and a twenty-two-acre open air
Performance | 973
References
Kirchner, Audrey Burie, and Margaret R. Tassia. 1996. In Days Gone By: Folklore
and Traditions of the Pennsylvania Dutch. Englewood, CO: Libraries Unlimited.
Kriebel, David W. 2007. Powwowing among the Pennsylvania Dutch: A Traditional
Medical Practice in the Modern World. University Park: Pennsylvania State University
Press.
Varr, Richard. 2007. Philadelphia and the Pennsylvania Dutch Country. New York: DK.
Yoder, Don. 1989. Hex Signs: Pennsylvania Dutch Barn Symbols and Their Mean-
ing. New York: E. P. Dutton.
Yoder, Don. 1990. Discovering American Folklife: Studies in Ethnic, Religious, and
Regional Culture. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research Press.
Yoder, Don. 2003. Groundhog Day. Mechanicsburg, PA: Stackpole.
Yoder, Emma Jean S. 2006. Cooking as Cultural Communication: How Pennsylva-
nia Dutch Women Construct Cultural Identities and Group Membership through Cook-
ing. Dissertation.
Performance
mime, music, and dance with performed ballads. For him, they project authenticity
and antiquity that are inevitably lost in the printed text or the affectation of drawing
room singing. Performance connotes the vigor of delivery that is knowable through
experience only. Methodologically, Kenneth S. Goldstein defines performance as
the occurrence of folklore in its ‘‘normal social context’’ prior to being collected.
The technology of recording and the emerging theories in the humanities and
social sciences have contributed to a renewed inquiry into the dynamics of folk-
lore performance. This quest builds upon the concept of orality that has domi-
nated folklore research from its inception and recognizes the primacy of any
performed act over any form of its abstracted documentation. It also has recov-
ered the meanings of performed speech associated with such terms as epic and
myth that connote discourse as distinguished from action, colored by its context.
The study of performance has shifted the claims folklore has had on national
traditions and histories, on cultural cosmologies, and on social ethos. The notion
has been rethought in terms of searching for a dynamic, interactive force in soci-
ety that is an agent of communication subject to the wills of its performers and to
the contingent interpretations of its audiences. From this perspective, folklore no
longer studies tradition as a superstructure or as an expression or mirror of
national culture but as a set of artistic acts that are an integral part of the fabric
of social life and religious and political rituals. The application of the concept of
performance to folklore, hence, has transformed its subject from being a cultural
metanarrative to becoming acts of narrating, singing, and speaking.
There are two basic assumptions that guide the different approaches to per-
formance analysis. First, is the idea that a society has a set of systemic conven-
tions and rules that regulate and generate folklore acts. Second, is the notion that
while speakers are in performance mode, their verbal behavior has an acceptable
range of deviance from the common use of language in society. Native speakers,
whether performers or listeners, adhere to the rules of performance and to its
socially accepted margin of variance. Methodologically, in the presence of an
outsider, speakers may heighten the principles of performance or seek to present
certain aspects of their culture through the selection of themes, genres, and
modes of folkloric display they deem as markers of their ethnic identity.
Ethnography of Performance
The fundamentals of any performance analysis require an adequate ethnographic
description of speech acts in a given society, accounting for the reasons and pur-
poses of speaking, the participants and performers in the occasion, and the
speech genres they employ. All these aspects of performance are interdependent,
and there is a degree of correlation between them that a description must make
explicit. Therefore, the description of performance focuses on the relations
within the occasion as much as on the nature and meaning of each of its
Performance | 975
Catch Question
A type of traditional enigma designed to ‘‘catch’’ the respondent by frustrating
expectations. The catch question may exploit syntactic ambiguities: ‘‘I saw Esau sit-
ting on a see-saw, how many s’s in that?—None’’ (the word that has no s’s). Or the
catch question may use homonyms: ‘‘I know three monkeys. One’s called Doh,
one’s called Ray. What’s the third one called?—Me.—Oh, I didn’t know you were a
monkey.’’ Or the question may give a personal application to an apparently general
question: ‘‘What do virgins eat for breakfast?—I don’t know’’ (thus, the respondent
must not be a virgin).
Just as it shifts the frame of reference, the catch question also shifts the perfor-
mance frame. Its efficacy results from a surprising emergence in another kind of dis-
course. In the middle of a riddling session, someone asks, ‘‘What has four legs, a
tail, and barks?’’ The respondent, expecting a metaphorical or punning solution,
ponders, gives up, and at last volunteers, ‘‘A dog?’’ The poser gives a condescending
smile and replies, ‘‘Oh, you’ve heard that one.’’ The catch question may break into
ordinary conversation: ‘‘You know your great-grandfather?—Yes.—No you don’t,
he’s dead!’’ Sometimes, it comes disguised as a clever question with a recondite an-
swer: ‘‘Where did King John sign the Magna Carta?—At the bottom.’’
The catch question is used to embarrass, obliging the respondent to utter an ob-
scenity, make an unintended admission, or simply appear foolish. It may serve to
upset the accepted hierarchy of wit, pulling the rug from under a clever person. Or
it may simply introduce variety into a riddling session.
A subtype of the catch question is the mock-obscene or double-entendre riddle,
found widely around the world and often in cultures with strict norms of sexual
propriety. The mock-obscene riddle presents a question with an apparently sexual
solution. The respondent betrays awareness by offering this answer or by blushing;
the poser then provides an innocent solution. An example is this Italian riddle:
‘‘You stick it in hard, it comes out soft. What is it?—Spaghetti.’’ Such catches are
generally exchanged among children, as a way of introducing a forbidden but end-
lessly interesting topic, and in cross-gender gatherings of adolescents, among
whom, as Anniki Kaivola-Bregenhj has said, the mock-obscene riddle acts as ‘‘kin-
dler of an erotic atmosphere.’’
Dorothy Noyes
and the participants, such as gender and age, as well as those features that require
specific inquiry or knowledge. These involve the training of the performer, his or
her position in the society (and in any sect or cult organization), and the exis-
tence or absence of any patronage system. Also correlated with any performance
are the locations and times that a society designates for performance, as well as
the genres, themes, and speech modes that are appropriate for each occasion.
Performance as Quality
To a degree, the ethnography of performance adheres to the theoretical and meth-
odological principles of the ‘‘ethnography of speaking,’’ which considers speech
as an activity in its own right. Yet the former has a narrower focus in concentrat-
ing upon a particular mode of communication. The elucidation of the qualitative
nature of performance is central to the understanding of folklore in society.
William Hugh Jansen proposes that ‘‘performance does not exist until the ‘‘doer,’’
the speaker, or the reciter of the bit of folklore steps outside himself as an indi-
vidual and assumes a pose toward his audience, however small, that differs from
his everyday, every-hour-in-the-day relationship to the same audience.’’ Theatri-
cality, however minute and fleeting, has become a key quality in the folklore per-
formance. The quality can manifest itself when an individual adopts the role of
performer by engaging in conventional behaviors dictated by tradition (e.g.,
introducing a proverb by ‘‘you know what they always say . . . ‘‘). Most instances
of folklore performance fall between these two minimal and maximal acts, when
speakers take upon themselves, for a limited time and on a specific occasion, the
role of singers, narrators, and riddlers. In those roles, they assume responsibility
for presentation to an audience, as Dell Hymes has said, or they display commu-
nicative competence, as Richard Bauman asserts. These two conceptions of per-
formance share the principle of display and involve a transformation of the
performing self and a transition from an everyday mode of communication to an
exhibitory one.
linguistics. Hymes and Charles L. Briggs argue that competence involves mas-
tery of communication that extends beyond the utterance of sentences into the
social and cultural rules that generate performance.
Coping with similar issues, albeit not within the discourse of linguistics, Roger
D. Abrahams proposes considering performance and enactment as the heightened
performance of cultural experiences in rituals and festivals, and John Miles Foley
suggests regarding performance as immanent art, displaying the images of the
mind. These and other solutions point to a synthesis that encompasses cultural
knowledge and experience—as they are available to members of the community
in verbal, visual, musical, and mimetic symbolic forms—as the substance of per-
formance. The knowledge accumulated in the collective memory becomes the
subject of performance in society. Both the substance and the rules for its com-
munication are essential knowledge for socially responsible performances.
In practice, it is possible to paraphrase or report such cultural knowledge,
squeezing out its performative quality, but such an account becomes a secondary
representation of the knowledge that is culturally available for performance.
Lord have suggested regarding the formula in epic, but their occurrence in a
broad range of genres is indicative that they are intrinsic to performance, distin-
guishing them from everyday discourse. The marking of performance language
from everyday discourse has a scale of deviation in which prose narration is most
similar to speech and the language of magical formulas is most removed from it,
often jumbling sounds into utterances whose meaning is known only to the
speaker. On the semantic level, there is an increased use of metaphors, allusions,
and quotations that construct the themes in performance into interwoven domains
and images that are connected to other principles of ‘‘interperformance,’’ to use
Lee Haring’s term. They constitute the narrated, the sung, and the recited cultural
experiences and imagined worlds.
Universals of Performance
The study of folklore performances is grounded in the ethnographic descriptive
tradition, yet because such performances occur in societies all over the world,
the search for universals is inevitable. Although the definition of a human char-
acteristic as universal logically implies that it has a biological basis, it is possible
to describe a behavior as universal without defining its biological foundation in
the case of cultural performance.
Victor Turner proposes that performances are universally playful, framed,
symbolic, and in the ‘‘subjunctive mood’’—that is, they assume an ‘‘as if’’ posi-
tion toward their substance. The applicability of these four features is most
appropriate to ritual and drama, yet the features are relevant to verbal genres as
well. Narratives require verbal frames that open and conclude them as specific
social discourse, and so do songs. In fact, the frames have the capacity of being
cultural identity markers for specific genres, indicating to speakers and listeners
the attitudes they could assume toward a narration or a song. The performance of
other speech genres, such as proverbs, requires at least an introductory formula
Performance | 979
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1977. Toward an Enactment-Centered Theory of Folklore. In
Frontiers of Folklore, ed. William Bascom. Boulder, CO: Westview Press.
Bauman, Richard, ed. 1977. Verbal Art as Performance. Rowley, MA: Newbury House.
Bauman, Richard, and Charles L. Briggs. 1990. Poetics and Performance as Critical
Perspectives on Language and Social Life. Annual Review of Anthropology 19: 59 88.
Blackburn, Stuart H. 1988. Singing of Birth and Death: Texts in Performance. Phila-
delphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Briggs, Charles L. 1988. Competence in Performance: The Creativity of Tradition in
Mexicano Verbal Art. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Degh, Linda. 1995. Narratives in Society: A Performer-Centered Study of Narration.
Folklore Fellows Communications. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Dougherty, Carol, and Leslie Kurke, eds. 1993. Cultural Poetics in Archaic Greece:
Cult, Performance, Politics. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Drewal, Margaret Thompson. 1991. The State of Research on Performance in Africa.
African Studies Review 34: 1 64.
Entwhistle, William J. 1939. European Balladry. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
Fabian, Johannes. 1990. Power and Performance: Ethnographic Explorations
through Proverbial Wisdom and Theater in Shaba, Zaire. Madison: University of
Wisconsin Press.
Fine, Elizabeth C. 1984. The Folklore Text: From Performance to Print. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1991. Immanent Art: From Structure to Meaning in Traditional
Oral Epic. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Foley, John Miles. 1992. Word-Power, Performance, and Tradition. Journal of
American Folklore 105: 275 301.
Foley, John Miles. 1995. The Singer of Tales in Performance. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Fox, James J., ed. 1988. To Speak in Pairs: Essays of the Ritual Languages of East-
ern Indonesia. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
980 | Personal Experience Narrative
style. The personal experience narrative also has been labeled personal experi-
ence story or personal legend.
The interest in and study of this narrative type has gained in popularity since
the 1970s. Few other forms of narrative expression can provide the same depth
of revelation of the social life of a community as can the personal experience
narratives of its members. As a narrative form, the stories arise out of the experi-
ences of their individual performers—and out of a felt need to relate those expe-
riences. Performers develop their own repertoire of narratives, and individual
personal experience narratives are readily identifiable by group members as to
their ‘‘owners.’’ Like other narrative genres, their form and structure—though it
is always relatively loose, especially when compared to genres such as the
M€ archen—may become more polished over time with retelling. Conversely, they
arise within conversational contexts, may be communally constructed within
such settings, and may be so closely tied to a given interaction that their texts
almost disintegrate outside the original setting.
As a separate genre, personal experience narratives do not necessarily fit
neatly within the traditional canons of folklore. By their nature as personal
accounts, they may not be correlated to a stock of identifiable narratives, and
these accounts are necessarily idiosyncratic. Folklorist Sandra K. D. Stahl coun-
ters, though, that these narratives do fit within the context of folklore. Personal
experience narratives have long been a part of the oral tradition but as a genre
have been ignored in favor of more established areas of narrative research. Stahl
asserts that this general type of folklore (the new label for the type notwithstand-
ing) has long been of interest, as evidenced by research into first-person anec-
dotes, tall tales, and jokes, for example.
Moreover, personal experience narratives do manifest characteristics of many
of the recognized oral narrative genres. Like legends, they recount an experience
of a particular person or group; they follow accepted structural and performance
patterns; and they rely on a set of understandings common to the group in their
transmission of meaning. Personal experience narratives, like other smaller nar-
rative categories such as family stories or anecdotes, have a limited circulation
and, in certain instances, a limited lifespan. The standardization in form of the
personal experience narratives has prompted some researchers, such as Juha Pen-
tik€ainen and Linda Degh, to suggest that it is nearly impossible to distinguish
between early forms of legends and those having roots as personal experience
narratives or as narrative accounts told in the first person.
As a genre for scholarly research, personal experience narratives provide an
opportunity to learn about the functional norms of a group on a micro level. As
performances, these narratives reflect what is important to the group in terms
of performance style, narrative content, and social concerns and norms of the
group. These narratives also reflect how individual performers interpret these
982 | Phenomenology
performative and social standards in order to present the narratives for group ap-
proval. Yet, unlike other types of narrative performance, personal experience
narratives place fewer demands on the performer. Whereas many narrative types
require performers who have a polished repertoire to draw upon for performance
and are thus recognized for their skills, personal experience narratives can be
performed by any group member. Personal experience narratives also may reveal
more of the day-to-day realities of group standards than other traditional narra-
tive forms in that they are drawn from (or at least are alleged to be drawn from)
the real experiences of their performers in the present, rather than from the near
or distant past life of the group or its legendary figures.
Randal S. Allison
See Also Anecdote; Family Folklore; Legend; Memorate.
References
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1974. The Memorate and the Proto-Memorate.
Journal of American Folklore 87(2): 225 239.
Mulrooney, Kristin J. 2009. Extraordinary from the Ordinary: Personal Experience
Narratives in American Sign Language. Washington, DC: Gallaudet University Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha. 1973. Belief, Memorate, and Legend. Folklore Forum 6:
217 241.
Pentik€ainen, Juha. 1983. Personal Experience Stories. In Handbook of American
Folklore, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha. 1989. Literary Folkloristics and Personal Narrative. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Stahl, Sandra K. D. 1977. The Personal Narrative as Folklore. Journal of the Folk-
lore Institute 14: 9 30.
Phenomenology
This characteristic use of the phenomenological ‘‘I’’ acknowledges the locus of per-
ception in the body of the perceiver. The usage does not refer to any particular indi-
vidual but to an incarnated self. From that perspective, the world is not only
differentiated in substance but differential in significance: Where I look from is tied
up with how I see. It is the centrality of embodied experience in phenomenology
that has given the term phenomenological its narrow interpretation in folklore and
the social sciences as ‘‘subjective.’’
But to distribute the distinction between subjectivity and objectivity over a
contrast between the body and things, phenomenologists contend, would be a
misunderstanding. Things are entangled with the body. I enter as a material
object a world rendered intelligible by virtue of my presence in it. The French
phenomenologist Maurice Merleau-Ponty writes, ‘‘We grasp external space
through our bodily situation. A ‘corporeal or postural schema’ gives us at every
moment a global, practical, implicit notion of the relation between our body and
things, of our hold in them. A system of possible movements, or ‘motor projects,’
radiates from us to our environment. Our body is not in space like things; it
inhabits or haunts space’’ (Merleau-Ponty 1971).
The body is a central term in the old philosophical dispute between material-
ism and idealism. It partakes of the nature of both things and thoughts. To keep
the mind/body problem unsolved by coming down neither on the side of materi-
alism, which grants objects priority, nor on the side of idealism, which privileges
consciousness, is one of the tricks of phenomenology. The haunting body and the
incarnated mind are modes of being in a world in which subjects materialize in
the flesh. Bodylore is one of the areas of inquiry in contemporary folklore that
investigates the symbolic properties of the body and the corporeal properties of
thought.
The world holds me bodily as consciously I hold it, ‘‘consciousness, under-
stood as a directional force sustaining the entire range of perceptual experience,’’
as Natanson puts it. Consciousness is not a mental event secreted in the cranium
but a constitutive act, the invention of a world. I am, Natanson continues, a ‘‘self
constructing for itself the world it then finds and acts in’’ (Natanson 1970). The
constructedness of my world becomes explicit in narrative and ritual genres that
describe or fabricate a reality. This constitutive gesture is what phenomenolo-
gists call intentionality or the intentionality of consciousness. Over the course of
its recent history, folklore, like other humanistic disciplines, has become more
inclined to take meaning out of the artifact and reinsert it in the intentionality of
its perceiver or producer.
The world I intend becomes fixed or typified so that the phenomena I retrieve
from it take on the quality of objects. In this undertaking, the American phenom-
enologist Alfred Schutz notes, ‘‘the constituting process itself is entirely ignored,
while the objectivity constituted by it is taken for granted’’ (Schutz 1973).
984 | Phenomenology
Some genres elaborate and so inscribe the realm of the ordinary as gestures;
for instance, elaborate body movement and costumes expand the expressive
capacity of skin, architecture reconstitutes the world as a bony carapace around
Phenomenology | 985
the body, or foodways inflect ingestion. All of these genres carry the imprint of
the body on the world, most articulately in the form of tools or weapons, one end
of which fits the body and the other the world. Speech forms, as it were, use the
voice to lift thought out of the body and convey it to our social others. Thus,
greetings and farewells acknowledge the boundaries of social encounters. Some
genres close themselves off from the realm of the ordinary as separate realities,
as when gesture is formalized as dance, sound transpires as music, or tools pro-
duce crafts. Folklorist Susan Stewart, perhaps following the title of Merleau-
Ponty’s book Sense and Non-sense, calls genres that catch ordinary phenomena
and uproot them from their ordinary ground nonsense.
Representational genres invoke and fabricate other realms. Not only narrative
genres such as myths, epics, legends, folktales, anecdotes, and jokes, but also
folk painting, folk costume, folk theater, and such cross-genres as folk poetry
and folksong conjure up alternate realities. Some representational genres invoke
two realities at once: Fables, proverbs, puns, riddles, and folk metaphors offer
their own fictive worlds and also direct attention to the realm of the ordinary.
Other genres reframe reality. Genres from cosmologies to confidence tricks rep-
resent reality under a different description, a particular set of assumptions about
the nature of the given, the apparent, the real. Some of these reframings of the
realm of the ordinary themselves become inhabitable worlds. Rituals and reli-
gious ceremonies, feasts, festivals and carnivals, and games and play are experi-
enced as realities, at least temporarily. Mary Hufford, for instance, reconstitutes
the domain of hunting over the topography of the ordinary. Sometimes, frag-
ments of alternate realities appear to be embedded in the realm of the ordinary as
what Schutz calls ‘‘enclaves’’ of a different ontological status. Thus, supersti-
tions, charms and amulets, curses, blessings, and oaths, along with such entities
as gods, ghosts, angels, devils, or witches, trail through the fabric of the real,
ephemera of a different domain. So Erving Goffman, heir to the phenomenologi-
cal tradition in the social sciences, writes, ‘‘Realms of being are the proper
objects here for study; and here the everyday is not a special domain to be placed
in contrast to the others, but merely another realm’’ (Goffman 1974).
Katharine Young
See Also Frame.
References
Bazerman, Charles, ed. 2010. Traditions of Writing Research. New York: Routledge.
Berger, Peter, and Thomas Luckmann. 1967. The Social Construction of Reality.
Garden City, NY: Anchor.
Garfinkel, Harold. 1977. Background Expectancies. In Rules and Meanings, ed.
Mary Douglas. Middlesex, England: Penguin.
Goffman, Erving. 1974. Frame Analysis. New York: Harper Colophon.
986 | Philological Approach
Philological Approach
Finnish method, named after the country in which the method was codified. As
implied by its name, the method is concerned with the historical development
and geographic dissemination of folklore. It is diachronic in nature, using the
comparison of folklore texts as a means to elucidate and reconstruct textual
histories.
The methodological basis of the historic-geographic method lies in philologi-
cal text criticism, a branch of literary research that goes back some 2,000 years
to the comparisons between different Homeric texts. Since the Renaissance,
this method has been much employed in the study of biblical and medieval
manuscripts.
The application of text criticism to materials recorded from oral tradition,
especially folktales, myths, and ballads, was popular among nineteenth-century
philologists. Even earlier, the method had been employed on, for example,
Finnish folk poetry, by Henrik Gabriel Porthan. Some of the best-known
nineteenth-century scholars in this field were Elias L€onnrot in Finland, the broth-
ers Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm in Germany, Svend Grundtvig in Denmark, and
Francis James Child in the United States.
In text criticism, the scholar aims at establishing a relationship between two or
more manuscript versions of the same text, studying whether manuscript A is the
source of manuscript B or vice versa, or whether they are both derived from a
common source. Analogically, the text-critical folklorist makes comparisons
between a number of versions of a given folklore item in order to determine their
relationship of descent. The underlying postulate here is that the paradigmatic
variation of similar traits in different versions indicates a linear process of
change.
Since the manuscript is the cognitive and conceptual model for the explanation
of variants in oral tradition, a folklore item in text-critical logics is a text that is a
copy of another text. As is often the case with manuscripts, copies contain errors
made by the copyist, and analogically, difference in folklore variants is regarded
as due to errors, flaws, and other alterations made in their replication. In error
analysis, the text-critical scholar uses errors as clues pointing to the relationship
between different copies and establishes their chronological order. The perceived
gaps and errors in one version are then eliminated with material taken from
another version, by replacing, say, a flawed line with one that is considered more
correct. The scientific aim is to reconstruct a text that could be considered com-
plete and original and that would then give information about the customs and
beliefs of earlier generations. To meet the other scientific requirements, a publi-
cation of such a study must contain a critical apparatus that lists the alternative
folklore sources and their variant readings.
Text criticism was developed and codified into the historic-geographic folk-
lore method by Julius and Kaarle Krohn, father and son, in the 1870s and 1880s
988 | Philological Approach
in Finland. Although originally designed for the study of Finnish Kalevala metric
oral poetry, the new method became internationally known as a tool mainly to be
used in folktale scholarship, primarily because Kaarle Krohn applied it first to
animal tales in his influential dissertation of 1889, and his pupil Antti Aarne
wrote the method’s guidelines (1913) with a focus on the comparative study of
folktales. With these and other publications, especially those published in the
Helsinki-based series entitled Folklore Fellows Communications, they set a new
course for the already well-established line of comparative-philological research
into folktales, whose best-known nineteenth-century representatives had been
Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm and the Indologist-linguist Theodor Benfey.
Influenced by Herderian romanticism, the Grimm brothers believed that folk-
tales—or fairy tales, as they have also been called—are not mere products of
imagination but aesthetically structured historical documents about the ways in
which people in ancient (especially medieval) times thought. As anonymous
products of a collective national spirit and as survivals of forgotten myths, folk-
tales, as well as other oral poetry, are subjected to both historical-mythological
research and artistic-philological reconstructions. The brothers’ famous collec-
tions of tales, especially Kinder- und Hausm€ archen (Children’s and household
tales; 1812, 1815), became evergreens as children’s literature and, as such, mod-
els for many later publications in the literary fairy tale genre. In addition to fol-
lowing their own artistic intuition in order to make the tales, as it were, speak the
‘‘voice of the folk,’’ the brothers employed text-critical principles to combine dif-
ferent versions of the same tale and reconstruct them in their alleged ‘‘essential’’
and authentic form.
The comparative emphasis in European folktale study had received a dramatic
impetus from the discovery of the relationship of Sanskrit to Greek, Latin, and
many other major European languages. By analogy, the Indo-European linguistic
connection was soon extended, as suggested by the Grimm brothers, to fables,
folktales, and other oral narratives whose origins, it was thought, were to be
looked for in India. While Max M€uller, a student of Vedic texts and Aryan my-
thology, theorized on the relationship between language and myth and on the ori-
gin of religion, Theodor Benfey compared Greek fables, traditionally credited to
Aesop, with Indic texts and came up a with a diffusionistic theory according to
which India was the source of most folktales in the world. Much of this diffusion
took place, according to Benfey, as early as the Middle Ages, through the many
oral and literary readaptations and translations of the Panchatantra collection of
tales, which he himself translated into German in 1859.
As far as the migration of folklore is concerned, one of the main issues for the
Krohns and other historic-geographers in the Finnish context was the politically
charged question of whether the Kalevala-metric runes originated in western or
eastern Finland—in other words, whether they had been composed under
Philological Approach | 989
References
Aarne, Antti. 1913. Leitfaden der vergleichende M€ archenforschung. Helsinki: Aca-
demia Scientiarum Fennica.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1993. Phantoms of Romantic Nationalism in Folkloristics. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 106: 3 37.
Briggs, Charles L. 1993. Metadiscursive Practices and Scholarly Authority in Folk-
loristics. Journal of American Folklore 106: 387 434.
Cocchiara, Giuseppe. 1981. The History of Folklore in Europe. Trans. John N.
McDaniel. Philadelphia: Institute for the Study of Human Issues.
Dundes, Alan. 1986. The Anthropologist and the Comparative Method in Folklore.
Journal of Folklore Research 23: 125 146.
Foley, John Miles. 1988. The Theory of Oral Composition: History and Methodol-
ogy. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Goldberg, Christine. 1984. The Historic-Geographic Method: Past and Future. Jour-
nal of Folklore Research 21: 1 18.
Hautala, Jouko. 1969. Finnish Folklore Research, 1828 1918. Helsinki: Academia
Scientiarum Fennica.
Holbek, Bengt. 1983. Nordic Research in Popular Prose Narrative. In Trends in Nor-
dic Tradition Research, eds. Lauri Honko and Pekka Laaksonen. Studia Fennica, no.
27. Helsinki: Finnish Literature Society.
Honko, Lauri. 1979. A Hundred Years of Finnish Folklore Research: A Reappraisal.
Folklore 90: 141 152.
Krohn, Kaarle. 1971. Folklore Methodology, Formulated by Julius Krohn
and Expanded by Nordic Researchers. Trans. Roger L. Welsch. Publications of
the American Folklore Society, Bibliographical and Special Series, Vol. 21. Austin:
University of Texas Press.
Kuusi, Matti. 1974. ‘‘The Bridge and the Church’’: An Anti-Church Legend. In Finnish
Folkloristics 2nd ed. Pentti Leino, with the assistance of Annikki Kaivola-Bregenhj and
Urpo Vento. Studia Fennica, no. 18. Helsinki: Finnish Literature Society.
Taylor, Archer. 1928. Precursors of the Finnish Method of Folk-Lore Study. Modern
Philology 25: 481 491.
Photography, Folk | 993
von Sydow, C. W. 1948. Folk-Tale Studies and Philology: Some Points of View. In
Selected Papers on Folklore by C. W. von Sydow. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and Bagger.
Zumwalt, Rosemary Levy. 1988. American Folklore Scholarship: A Dialogue of
Dissent. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Photography, Folk
Interviews, oral histories, and other records of personal contact may then accom-
pany visual scholarship. With good fieldwork, the student of photography and its
lore can capture and preserve interactions between people and their contexts
through material images. Daniel Wojcik’s study of photographs purportedly rep-
resenting apparitions of the Virgin Mary is a good example.
While photography receives explanation and embellishment from verbal expres-
sion, it is a language in itself. Every photographic image has a surface and a deep
structure. The communication of a photographic message is coded, containing a
subtle set of rules for the transmission and reception of visual information. People
assign their own meanings to images, and yet, when viewed in large numbers, snap-
shots begin to resemble each other, falling into recognizable categories. Photo-
graphic images are, therefore, generalizable, signaling social and aesthetic meanings
using consensually agreed upon patterns (e.g., obligatory smiles, the group shot with
an identifying placard placed in front) and visual tropes (newlyweds with all
the reception guests, the new baby peering from beneath a crib blanket), at once
showing the unique faces of family members and the familiar poses and occasions
American viewers have come to regard as emblems of a family’s history.
In this sense, the study of photographs concerns itself with the history of everyday
life. Once the hand-held camera had freed photographers from costly and cumber-
some tripods and flash units, shooting in more remote locations and with quicker
Pilgrimage | 995
References
Adams, Timothy Dow. 1999. Light Writing and Life Writing: Photography in
Autobiography. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Coke, Van Deren, ed. 1975. One Hundred Years of Photographic History. Albuquer-
que: University of New Mexico Press.
Hirsch, Marianne, ed. 1997. Family Frames: Photography, Narrative, and Postme-
mory. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Hirsch, Marianne, ed. 1999. The Familial Gaze. Hanover, NH: University Press of
New England.
Ohrn, Karen Becker. 1980. Dorothea Lange and the Documentary Tradition. Baton
Rouge: Louisiana State University Press.
Rosenheim, Jeff. 2009. Walker Evans and the Picture Postcard. New York: Metro-
politan Museum of Art.
Sayre, Maggie Lee. 1995. ‘‘Deaf Maggie Lee Sayre’’: Photographs of a River Life.
Ed. Tom Rankin. Oxford: University Press of Mississippi.
Wojcik, Daniel. 1966. ‘‘Polaroids from Heaven’’: Photography, Folk Religion, and
the Miraculous Image Tradition at a Marian Apparition Site. Journal of American Folk-
lore 109: 129 148.
Pilgrimage
landscape onto physical space and as the amelioration of bodily illness and injury
through arduous physical exertion with a spiritual focus.
Although the term pilgrimage may be used in a secular sense to denote a sojourn
or personal odyssey and is often invoked in discussions of tourist experiences, the
word most often describes an act of piety, penitence, or thanksgiving—an ascetic
journey of religious obligation to obtain healing and purification. Pilgrimage is also
used to describe the interiorized journey of the religious mystic.
Pilgrimage, at the nexus of official and local religious systems, often generates
vehement ecclesiastical responses. Though strongly rooted in popular tradition, pil-
grimage is a displacement of individuals from their local communities and may be
in tension with the usual hierarchies of religious organization and administration.
Pilgrimage has been described by Victor Turner and Edith Turner as a tripar-
tite rite-of-passage experience: the journeying to (separation), the experience of
the destination (liminality), and the returning home (reaggregation).
The pilgrim’s departure may be marked by special preparations, consecrations,
and celebrations. Arduous means of travel (e.g., procession) and/or bodily posture
(e.g., walking on the knees) may often be prescribed (although technological advan-
ces in transportation have transformed the pilgrimage route). Pilgrims may be sick
and travel with the assistance of others, or a proxy may make the pilgrimage on behalf
of an ill person. The temporary exile of the pilgrim and the difficulties and dangers of
the pilgrimage route are endured in exchange for the ultimate rewards of the journey.
The travel route is highly marked, often dotted with signs, sacred precincts,
and facilities to provide for the traveler’s corporeal and spiritual needs. The jour-
ney out is often characterized as an ascent, a time for exploration and greater
freedom than subsequent phases of pilgrimage. As the destination is neared, rit-
uals of preparation may be intensified: Special interdictions, ablutions, and pray-
ers may commence, and special vestments may be donned. The destination of
pilgrimage may be surrounded by a sacred precinct, often a set of lesser shrines
that direct visitors toward their ultimate goal.
The pilgrim’s destination may be a site where something extraordinary
occurred, such as a miracle or an apparition, or a place where a revered individ-
ual was born, lived (or lives), or died. The material representation of such an
individual might take the form of relics. A shrine may be seen as a specially
energized place. The spiritual efficacy of a shrine as an auspicious place for com-
munication between humans and deities is seen to be enhanced by the visits of
successive waves of pilgrims. The visitor will typically leave some form of offer-
ing as witness to the pilgrimage: a consecrated object brought from home or a
representation of self such as a snippet of hair or clothing, money, or food.
Returning home, the pilgrim brings something of the experience back, possi-
bly in the form of a tangible souvenir, token, or relic. The returning pilgrim may
experience an enhanced status in his or her community of origin.
Pilgrimage | 997
The Kaaba is a shrine that houses the Black Stone of Mecca, the focal point for Muslim
prayer and final destination for pilgrims to Mecca. (Ayazad/Shutterstock)
References
Eade, John, and Michael J. Sallnow, eds. 1991. Contesting the Sacred: The Anthro-
pology of Christian Pilgrimage. London: Routledge.
Jha, Makhan, ed. 1991. Social Anthropology of Pilgrimage. New Delhi: Inter-India
Publications.
Kamal, Ahmad. 1961. The Sacred Journey: Being a Pilgrimage to Makkah. New
York: Duell.
Morinis, E. Alan. 1984. Pilgrimage in the Hindu Tradition: A Case Study of Rural
Bengal. Delhi: Oxford University Press.
Munro, Eleanor. 1987. On Glory Roads: A Pilgrim’s Book about Pilgrimage. New
York: Thames and Hudson.
Nolan, Mary Lee, and Sidney Nolan. 1989. Christian Pilgrimage in Modern Western
Europe. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.
Ousterhout, Robert, ed. 1990. The Blessings of Pilgrimage. Urbana: University of
Illinois Press.
Sallnow, Michael J. 1987. Pilgrims of the Andes: Regional Cults in Cusco. Washing-
ton, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Sumption, Jonathan. 1975. Pilgrimage: An Image of Medieval Religion. Totowa, NJ:
Rowman and Littlefield.
Turner, Victor, and Edith Turner. 1978. Image and Pilgrimage in Christian Culture:
Anthropological Perspectives. New York: Columbia University Press.
Place | 999
Place
Denotes the ways locations are made meaningful through the experiences of
inhabitants; closely associated in folkloristics with notions of ‘‘regionalism’’ and
the ‘‘sense of place,’’ sometimes contrasted with concepts of ‘‘space’’ or ‘‘land-
scape,’’ which indicate more abstract or outsider perspectives.
In the early years of American folkloristics, little attention was given to the idea
that a place or region could have a relationship to the expressive culture being col-
lected. However, by the mid-1900s, the concept of regionalism began to develop,
and the work of folklorists such as Herbert Halpert, Benjamin Botkin, and Americo
Paredes moved the field closer toward a coherent regionalist approach, which sol-
idified in the 1960s with the revolution in folklife studies, the reconceptualization
of folklore as process, and expanded notions of the folk (Allen 1990,7–10). Folklo-
rists began to look at region as a geographical boundary that constructed a shared
identity for folk groups and thus a shared body of lore and to see, for example, the
regionalization of folklore as a rhetorical strategy (see Jones 1976).
More recently, influenced by the work of Yi-Fu Tuan and Edward Casey,
among others, the contributions of folklore as a discipline have been especially
central to the study of how collaboratively produced and continually reproduced
forms of (artistic) expression and communication generate a ‘‘sense of place,’’
the subjective and emotional attachment people have to a place (as examples of a
few different types of approaches, see Glassie 1982, Pocius 1991, Hufford 1992,
Feld and Basso 1996, and Dorst 1999; see Ryden 1993 for the relationship
between folklore’s emergent studies of place and humanistic geography).
At the same time, folklorists have also called attention to the rather ‘‘unmarked’’
construction of locality (Shuman 1993) sometimes characterized by these studies
and have turned to the concept of ‘‘critical regionalism’’ (see the work of Hufford
2002, Reid and Taylor 2002, Miller 2007, Thorne 2004) to address the relationship
between local and global constructions of place and the connections between people
characterized by the ‘‘global sense of place’’ (Massey 1994).
Another productive strand of place studies, indebted to the work of Michel de
Certeau, Edward Soja, and Henri Lefebrve, envisions places as events or per-
formances that make available the human practices and processes involved in
their construction, as a way to understand that places are never ‘‘finished’’ or
complete but are always becoming. As Cresswell articulates, ‘‘Place in this sense
becomes an event rather than a secure ontological thing rooted in notions of the
authentic. Place as an event is marked by openness and change rather than
boundedness and permanence’’ (Cresswell 2004, 39). See also the special issue
of Western Folklore (2007), ‘‘Space, Place, Emergence,’’ for more detailed dis-
cussions of perspectives on place.
1000 | Place
In the realm of public folklore, exciting projects that map personal experiences
and places in very local and interactive ways are being carried out online through
nonprofit organizations. For example, ‘‘Place Matters,’’ a project of City Lore
and New York’s Municipal Art Society, ‘‘seeks to promote and protect places
that connect us with the past, sustain community life, and make our surroundings
distinctive’’ (http://www.placematters.net). PhilaPlace, a multimedia project of
the Pennsylvania Historical Society, connects stories by people of all back-
grounds and historical records with places across time in different Philadelphia
neighborhoods to present an interpretive picture of the rich history, culture, and
architecture of neighborhoods, past and present (http://www.philaplace.org).
Rosina S. Miller
See Also Folk Culture; Material Culture.
References
Allen, Barbara. 1990. Regional Studies in American Folklore Scholarship. In Sense
of Place: American Regional Cultures, eds. B. Allen and T. J. Schlereth. Lexington:
University Press of Kentucky.
Cresswell, Tim. 2004. Place: A Short Introduction. Malden, MA: Blackwell Publishing.
Dorst, John. 1999. Looking West. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Feld, Steven, and Keith Basso, eds. 1996. Senses of Place. Santa Fe, NM: School of
American Research.
Gabbert, Lisa, and Paul Jordan-Smith. 2007. Introduction: Space, Place, Emergence.
Western Folklore 66(3-4): 217 232.
Glassie, Henry. 1982. Passing the Time in Ballymenone: Culture and History of an
Ulster Community. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Hufford, Mary. 1992. Chaseworld: Foxhunting and Storytelling in New Jersey’s Pine
Barrens. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Hufford, Mary. 2002. Interrupting the Monologue: Folklore, Ethnography, and Criti-
cal Regionalism. Journal of Appalachian Studies 8(1): 62 78.
Jones, Suzi. 1976. Regionalization: A Rhetorical Strategy. Journal of the Folklore
Institute 8(1): 105 120.
Massey, Doreen. 1994. Space, Place, and Gender. Minneapolis: University of Min-
nesota Press.
Miller, Rosina. 2007. Sharing Prosperity: Critical Regionalism and Place-Based
Social Change. Western Folklore 66 (3-4): 351 381.
Pocius, Gerald. 1991. A Place to Belong: Community Order and Everyday Space in
Calvert, Newfoundland. Athens: University of Georgia Press; Montreal: McGill-Queen’s
University Press.
Reid, Herbert, and Betsy Taylor. 2002. Appalachia as a Global Region: Toward
Critical Regionalism and Civic Professionalism. Journal of Appalachian Studies 8(1):
9 32.
Poetry, Folk | 1001
Ryden, Kent C. 1993. Mapping the Invisible Landscape: Folklore, Writing, and the
Sense of Place. Iowa City: University of Iowa Press.
Shuman, Amy. 1993. Dismantling Local Culture. Western Folklore 52(2-4):
345 364.
Thorne, Cory. 2004. Come from Away: Community, Region, and Tradition in New-
foundland and Expatriate Identity. Dissertation, Folklore and Folklife, University of
Pennsylvania, Philadelphia.
Poetry, Folk
Rhythmic and/or rhyming texts, intended for reading, chanting, recitation and/or
singing, including local compositions as well as traditional verse, often highly
symbolic and relevant to a community’s knowledge, beliefs, and views, are con-
sidered folk poetry.
Folk poetry is an extremely diverse genre. It can include verse for or by
children—nursery and skipping rhymes; materials related to particular occupa-
tions from peddlers’ cries and military cadences to cowboy poetry; written short
verses communicated in graffiti and autograph books; lyric, narrative, and epic
song texts; traditional as well as event-specific recitations, including African
American toasts; and written verses for family and community circulation. Argu-
ably, many kinds of folk poetry—ballads, lyric folksongs, epics, and newer
forms like rap—are distinctive because of the integral importance of tunes and
musical accompaniment. However, folklorists have often considered together
verses intended for singing, recitation, and reading, and the line between them is
a particularly difficult one to draw in current societies, as it was in literate cul-
tures of the past. The texts or the rhymical/verse structures of songs may be the
bases for both serious and parodic folk poetry for singing, reciting, or reading,
suggesting that the distinctions between them may be detected primarily in terms
of performance. And the same tunes can be used for entirely different song texts,
suggesting a less-than-unbreakable link between music and verse content.
Folk poems of various types—original and traditional, irrespective of perfor-
mance mode—say a great deal about the perspectives of women and men on
their society, and about sociocultural organizations of gender in general. Many
religious poetic texts like the Ramayanas of India are recited, and probably also
authored, by men. In Iran, historical battle poetry is associated with men, dirges
and laments with women, and wedding verse is recited by both sexes. Seven of
the fifteen ‘‘amateur poets’’ whose gender could be identified in Cynthia Lam-
son’s collection of Newfoundland counterprotest verse about seal hunting are
women; one used a feminine pseudonym ‘‘Minnie Ha-Ha.’’ However, in the addi-
tional categories of published, performer, and public-figure poets, only one
1002 | Poetry, Folk
Lament
An improvised folksong or poem following a traditional pattern in metaphorical
language to express sorrow and other strong feelings and states of mind. Function-
ally, laments can be classified into wedding laments, death laments, going-to-war
laments, autobiographical laments, and recompensive laments.
Laments are nearly always chanted by women and often by professional mourn-
ers at funerals, for example. In Europe, the tradition of lamentation has been pre-
served at its best within the Russian Orthodox Church. Lament chants are
encountered, for the most part, east of a line drawn from Greece to Finland, but in
earlier periods, they were not uncommon in Western Europe as well. Laments are
associated with funerals, weddings, and the departure of soldiers to military service
or battlefields. Above all, they are the ritual poetry of parting and separation.
Laments belong to the sacred language of a rite. They make it possible to ensure
that social relations and values of a delicate nature are handled correctly and with
due respect. Although laments are primarily performed in rites of passage, they can
also be improvised to be used on particular occasions—for example, when friends
meet or part, as thanks for hospitality, as a means to break the monotony of a long
and boring job, or just to provide an outlet for a mood of depression. At its best,
the performance of a lament is a channel to ecstatic anarchy, helping to penetrate
deeply into the spirit of the occasion and normally accompanied by tears, with the
chanting interrupted at intervals by sobbing.
Laments originated as a form of ritual poetic keening that comments on social
relations. When lamenting, the chanter regularly brings into focus either the subject
or the object of the lament. Laments reveal clearly the social position and interac-
tion of participants. Lamenting is regularly practiced during wedding ceremonies
and rites for the dead, thus referring to the most important transition periods in
social relations. Wedding laments and death laments represent ritual poetry and
are a form of sacred communication within these critical moments of transition. By
means of these performances, the lamenters and the community seek to pass safely
through these delicate periods of transition.
Juha Pentik€ainen
woman is found, leaving a maximum of nine out of twenty-six writers who could
be women.
Though some Eastern European folk poetic traditions have historically been
restricted to male bards, many others are strongly associated with women.
Women often perform ritual songs associated with weddings, funerals, and cal-
endar customs—Christmas, Easter, Saints’ Days, and so forth. In Brazil, the
broadside literatura de cordel is almost exclusively masculine, since it is a pro-
fessional activity requiring literacy and conflicting with women’s traditional
roles. But many forms traditionally associated with men, and misogynist lyrics
Poetry, Folk | 1003
like those found in many forms of male rap, also offer sites wherein women can
express themselves.
The gendering of folk poetry can be deceptive. It might seem that cowboy poetry,
relating to a quintessentially masculine occupation, would not be written or performed
by women; however, they are performers as well as audience members at cowboy po-
etry gatherings in Canada and the United States. In the Canadian province of Alberta,
women and men write and perform poetry about pioneer life—farming and home-
steading—more than about ranching. Much of what is called ‘‘cowboy’’ poetry in the
United States may similarly refer to any and all aspects of life on the western plains.
The groups or communities to which folk poetry is directed are extremely
diverse. They may be ethnic groups, rural communities, age groups, religious con-
gregations, or special populations like prisoners, friends, families, and so on. Folk
poetry is read, recited, or sung because of its expression of ideas and sentiments that
the poet or presenter feels will be useful to the community or group to which it is
directed. Since gender relations are pervasively significant in all cultures, folk po-
etry often says a great deal about women and men and their interactions with one
another. Take, for example, this song text from nineteenth-century Iran:
Folk poetry may at times reflect social relations, but it may sometimes also
address them adversarially, as in this Brazilian folheto, based on the Jorge
Amado novel, Tereza Batista, in which the male author counters conventional
views of sex workers:
While not the most progressive view imaginable, this perspective counters the
notion that all sex workers are irredeemably damned.
Not all folk poetry by men shows women in a negative light, but such presen-
tation is not uncommon, as in Texas prisoner Johnny Barone’s poem about his
life experiences:
The poet makes his wife directly responsible for most of the evil in his life.
However, as Roger Renwick noted, folk poets may extol the conventional virtues
of women, too, as in verses composed to nurses as thank-yous after a hospital
visit, praising their nurturance, kindness, and so on.
A Macedonian wedding text speaks eloquently about the bride’s situation:
Many ritual occasions call for focus upon particular female participants. In
Luri (Macedonian) wedding verse, the mother-in-law is an ambivalent figure:
The previous text also reflects the structuring of much folk poetry in terms of
parallels and opposites, as will be discussed following. Luri dirges also reflect
gender relations between women:
Or:
Or:
Cross-culturally, women are frequently placed in the role of mourners, often as semi-
professionals extemporizing chanted dirges and/or mourning songs. Irish Gaelic lament
poetry—keening—allows a mourning woman to express praise for the deceased. But a
woman can also direct anger against a priest who tells her to accept her lot as a widow,
against her husband for dying and leaving her, or against the abuser she is burying:
Much folk poetry paints a bleak picture of women’s lives. Ingrian (Finnish/
Russian) wedding songs advise the groom to beat his wife, but not to injure her
excessively, and indoors rather than publicly. Women ethnographers often un/
dis/cover resistance in verse-making traditions. Lila Abu-Lughod shows that
Bedouin women’s poetry does not indulge in the stereotypical representations of
compliant, invisible Islamic women. She cites a Bedouin wedding verse that
offers a negative view of polygyny:
Or:
This traditional Euro–North American song text exemplifies the repetitive and paral-
leling structures that make folk poetry so easy to remember, but it also says much about
gender assumptions and relations in Euro-North American society. Most readers/listen-
ers would assume that the first speaking persona is male. He is probably addressing a
woman who is his lover or some other relative, questioning her about her economic sit-
uation, but also about her sexual availability. The woman’s response in the second
verse implies familial dependence but sexual autonomy—or even lesbianism.
Folk poetry is highly adaptable to circumstances. Note the extreme semantic
shift when the identities your/my are reversed (as is frequently the case in tradi-
tional versions of this text):
Now the first speaker is female, and her questions have become somewhat
plaintive, while the second speaker could be male or female, the tone either dis-
missive or reassuring. The structures of folk poetry make it not only memorable,
but also multiply interpretable.
Pauline Greenhill
See Also Ballad; Ethnopoetics; Folksong, Lyric; Performance.
1008 | Popular Culture
References
Abu-Lughod, Lila. 1986. Veiled Sentiments: Honor and Poetry in a Bedouin Society.
Berkeley: University of California Press.
Amanolahi, Sekandur, and W. M. Thackson. 1986. Tales from Luristan: Tales,
Fables and Folk Poetry from the Lur of B^
al^ ^ Cambridge, MA: Harvard Univer-
a-Gariva.
sity Press.
Bourke, Angela. 1993. More in Anger than in Sorrow: Irish Women’s Lament Po-
etry. In Feminist Messages: Coding in Women’s Folk Culture, ed. Joan Newlon Radner.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press, pp. 160 182.
Dugaw, Dianne. 1989. Warrior Women and Popular Balladry. Cambridge: Cam-
bridge University Press.
Green, Chris. 2009. The Social Life of Poetry: Appalachia, Race, and Radical Mod-
ernism. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Greenhill, Pauline. 1989. True Poetry: Traditional and Popular Verse in Ontario.
Montreal: McGill-Queen’s University Press.
Greenhill, Pauline, ed. 1993. Special Issue: Folk Poetry. Canadian Folklore canadien
15(1). Also see intra Richard A. Burns, ‘‘Prison Folk Poetry: The Barone Trilogy,’’ pp.
41 53.
Greenhill, Pauline. 1997. ‘‘Who’s Gonna Kiss Your Ruby Red Lips?’’: Sexual Scripts
in Floating Verses. In Ballads into Books: The Legacies of Francis James Child, eds.
Tom Cheesman and Sigrid Rieuwerts. Berne: Peter Lang, pp. 225 236.
Lamson, Cynthia. 1979. ‘‘Bloody Decks and a Bumper Crop’’: The Rhetoric of Seal-
ing Counter-Protest. St. John’s, NF: ISER.
Renwick, Roger. 1980. English Folk Poetry: Structure and Meaning. Philadelphia:
University of Pennsylvania.
Sazdov, Tome. 1991. Macedonian Folk Poetry, Principally Lyric. Oral Tradition
6(2-3): 186 199.
Slater, Candace. 1982. Stories on a String: The Brazilian Literatura de Cordel.
Berkeley: University of California Press.
Soroudi, Sorour S. 1990. Folk Poetry and Society in Nineteenth-Century Iran. In
Proceedings of the First European Conference of Iranian Studies, eds. Gherardo Gnoli
and Antonio Panaino. Rome: Instituto Italiano Per Il Medio Ed Estremo Oriente, pp.
541 552.
Zimmerman, Devrnja. 1986. Serbian Folk Poetry. Columbus, OH: Kosovo Publishing.
Popular Culture
Materials and activities widely disseminated in a society. Like folklore, the term
popular culture is also used as the name of a scholarly discipline. Popular culture
studies involves the scholarly investigation of expressive forms widely dissemi-
nated in society. These materials include but are not restricted to products of the
mass media—television, film, print, and recording. Thus, popular culture studies
Popular Culture | 1009
may focus on media genres such as situation comedies, film noir, bestselling
novels, or rap music. Other, nonmediated aspects of popular culture would
include such things as clothing styles, fads, holidays and celebrations, amuse-
ment parks, and both amateur and professional sports. Ideally, the study of these
or any other popular materials should be done holistically, viewing them both
aesthetically and also within the social and cultural contexts in which the materi-
als are created, disseminated, interpreted, and used. In this way, the study of pop-
ular culture, like the study of folklore, involves the use of methodologies from
both the humanities and the social sciences in the effort to interpret expressive
cultural forms, specifically those that are widely disseminated (that is, popular)
in a group as part of dynamic social intercourse.
Many definitions of folklore have tended to be enumerative, naming genres
such as beliefs, customs, ballads, and proverbs as examples of folklore, thus
assuming a self-evident, inherent similarity among them. Some scholars have
suggested that folklore is that portion of a culture or society that is passed on
orally or by imitation. In 1972, Dan Ben-Amos defined the term folklore as artis-
tic communication in small groups. In this formulation, the concept of the small
group replaces the ‘‘folk’’ determination, and the ‘‘lore’’ becomes identified as
artistic communication. This communication need not necessarily be verbal, but
it will be stylized and expressive, thus calling attention to itself. The ‘‘small
groups’’ referred to requires that the genre be performed in company small
enough in number and in close enough proximity to be able to affect the perfor-
mance and to contribute to it.
Popular culture, by contrast, has often been equated with the mass media:
products of film, television, recordings, and print that are widely disseminated in
society or at least created with widespread dissemination in mind. Thus, when a
friend tells us a joke, this is, by the preceding definition, a folk event. When we
watch a comedian on television tell the same joke, we have entered the realm of
popular culture. We can have only indirect influence on the products of mass
media, but we can have direct effects on small-scale, interpersonal communica-
tions. American scholars often distinguish folklore, or folk culture, from popular
culture along many lines, including the communicative nature of the materials
themselves: Are they mediated or unmediated? That is, do we hear the story, or
listen to the music, or see the dance directly? Can we join in, or are we watching
a film, listening to a recording, or looking at a videotape?
Many of those who consider folklore as unmediated, small-group, face-to-
face expressive culture and popular culture as large-scale, mass-mediated forms
view the two as antithetical. That is, simply put, folklore thrives where the mass
media have not taken hold. Conversely, by this formulation, popular culture kills
folklore: Where once people entertained each other with storytelling, instead
they now watch television. Many see a moral dimension here: Storytelling (or
1010 | Popular Culture
whatever genre of folklore we are talking about) is seen as active and creative,
whereas consuming mass-mediated forms is described as passive and numbing.
Thus, the former is said to be superior to the latter. Other scholars might view
the folk genres pejoratively, describing them as unsophisticated, primitive, or
naive.
However, some scholars use the terms folklore and popular culture more or
less interchangeably. Social historians, for instance, who have researched every-
day life in medieval, late medieval, and early modern societies (frequently recon-
structing popular rituals, festivals, and celebrations), generally prefer the term
popular culture to folk culture, possibly owing to romantic or pejorative associa-
tions of the concept of folk. In these cases, culture and society are more likely to
be viewed in dichotomous terms, with allowances for overlap between the
courtly culture of the socially elite and the popular culture of the masses. Some
popular culturalists accept this view, maintaining that only after the Industrial
Revolution and its attendant urbanization and the development of a middle class
does it make sense to speak of a tripartite model of culture that includes folk,
popular, and elite. In this formulation, the folk represent peasant society—a
semiautonomous group that depends on a nation-state for at least part of its
subsistence.
The point here is not to argue for a specific definition but to indicate some of
the ranges of thought that accompany the terminologies employed herein. To a
large extent, definitions indicate methodologies: The definitions one works with
influence both what is studied and how it is studied. In recent years, many schol-
ars, folklorists included, have begun to look at popular culture not simply as the
mass media but also as the popular use of the mass media. Janice Radway’s study
of a group of women who read romance novels is an example of the application
of social science and ethnographic techniques to an area that had been dominated
by humanities approaches. In the past, popular genre fiction such as romances
would be studied as texts only and found lacking in aesthetic merit as defined by
Western European high art critics. Radway (and other cultural studies scholars)
expanded the area of study to transcend the written text and to include ethno-
graphic considerations, such as who exactly was reading the novels, when, for
what purposes, and what meanings and values they derived from them. In order
to determine such things, the readers were interviewed to ascertain their own per-
spectives on and understandings of the materials. Instead of condemning a genre
in which millions of people find something of value, Radway attempted to under-
stand what aesthetic principles were at work and how readers of popular roman-
ces themselves understand the texts.
Radway’s work and that of others has shown that people are not as passive as
was once thought in their interactions with mass or popular forms. In addition,
there are a great many areas of overlap between folk and popular culture. As
Popular Culture | 1011
Youths wearing Halloween masks receive candies and sweets during the ‘‘Trick or Treat’’
tradition in Manila’s Makati city in the Philippines, on October 31, 2008. (AP/Wide World
Photos)
concepts that refer to social dynamics rather than things, the two feed off each
other. The examples in this regard are too numerous to attempt to quantify, but
two brief illustrations will suffice. Children’s jump-rope rhymes, a folk genre,
commonly use well-known celebrities, popular songs, and commercial jingles
for their subject matter, and the converse is also true: Many popular songs and
commercial jingles are derived from the poetry and song of the streets. Another
example would be the relationship of the so-called slasher or stalker films, such
as Nightmare on Elm Street, to the modern legends in oral circulation that tell of
similar horrific killings.
Celebrations of contemporary holidays, life passages, and other special occa-
sions are an area in which many of the various aspects of culture are coterminous.
The use of yellow ribbons publicly displayed during wartime is one such example.
Holidays such as Halloween are good examples of contemporary phenomena that
combine customary behaviors and traditions carried out on the personal level
(e.g., trick-or-treating, learning to carve a jack-o’-lantern) with the tremendous
commercialization having to do with the marketing of cards, candies, and cos-
tumes; media products such as episodes of television programs with Halloween
themes or specials such as It’s the Great Pumpkin, Charlie Brown; mass behavior;
and even church-sponsored events and, in certain cases, condemnations.
1012 | Popular Culture
Both folklorists and popular culture scholars study created, expressive, and
artistic materials as their primary data, much as literary scholars take the novel
or the sonnet as their primary data. In this way, they are both within the tradition
of the humanities. However, the disciplines of folklore studies and popular cul-
ture studies differ from traditional humanities studies in that they recognize the
existence of alternative systems of aesthetics that guide the creation of popular
materials and the evaluation of those materials by an audience. Albert Lord, in
his important work The Singer of Tales (1960), identified the ways singers of
epics in Eastern Europe learn their art orally and how they compose as they per-
form. He suggested that these performances and the poems themselves be judged
according to the specific goals of the artists and the audiences and according to
an understanding of the problems unique to an oral poet. In other words, oral po-
etry is a different genre than written poetry. Each has its own aesthetic standards,
and it is misguided to judge one by the standards of the other. Popular culture
scholars recognize this principle and extend it to the popular arts, such as televi-
sion programs, popular films, popular music, best-selling novels, genre fiction
(e.g., mysteries or romances), and so on.
Each medium or genre has an audience that can and does make evaluations
according to aesthetic criteria. These criteria are usually unarticulated, but they
are no less real because of it. People regularly make choices as to which book to
read or movie to see and just as regularly evaluate the experience: This was a
good thriller, this is a great party song. Because these aesthetic criteria are gener-
ally unarticulated, it is the task of the researcher to identify them through ethno-
graphic methods such as interviews and participant observation, as well as
humanities techniques such as textual analysis. The term ethnography refers to
the cultural description of any event or artifact, usually as expressed and per-
ceived by those people who are participants in the event, by producers, consum-
ers, or users of the artifact, or by members of the cultural group in question.
After these insider (or native) perceptions and categories are documented, the
researcher may undertake the scholarly analysis of the materials as components
of a dynamic social and cultural field of behavior. These methods enable the
scholar to situate the discussion of any aspect of folklore or popular culture
within the larger context of the meanings and values of the society within which
it exists—to determine, as Clifford Geertz has suggested, what we need to know
in order to make sense of something. Social science methodologies enable the
popular culture scholar to root an expressive form in its social context and to
uncover the aesthetic system upon which it is judged. Humanities approaches
provide models for the appreciation of aesthetic forms and enable the scholar to
apply theories of genre and make comparative analytical statements. As social
science and humanities methodologies are combined in the study of artistic forms
of expression that are broadly based in society, scholars can begin both to
Possession | 1013
References
Burke, Peter. 1978. Popular Culture in Early Modern Europe. New York: Harper
and Row.
Gans, Herbert. 1974. Popular Culture and High Culture. New York: Basic Books.
Geertz, Clifford. 1984. The Interpretation of Cultures. New York: Basic Books.
Le Roy Ladurie, Emmanuel. 1979. Carnival in Romans. New York: George Braziller.
Lord, Albert B. 1964. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Nye, Russel. 1970. The Unembarrassed Muse: The Popular Arts in America. New
York: Dial.
Paredes, Americo, and Richard Bauman. 1972. Towards New Perspectives in Folk-
lore. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Perez, Domino Renee. 2008. There Was a Woman: La Llorona from Folklore to
Popular Culture. Austin, TX: University of Texas Press.
Toelken, Barre. 1979. The Dynamics of Folklore. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Possession
The taking over of a person by an outside spirit. The possessed person may undergo
hysterical fits, show drastic changes in physiognomy, go into a catatonic state, show
no reaction to pain, or speak in an altered voice that is taken for the voice of the
possessing spirit. Often, the subject professes total ignorance of what has taken
place during the fit, although the possessing spirit is usually aware of the existence
of the subject. The transition into and out of possession is often abrupt.
Possession can occur because, in the traditional view, the human spirit has
only a tenuous connection to the body, so that it may be dislodged and replaced
by another spirit. This spirit may be seen as a demon, as a spirit of disease, or as
a spirit of the dead, sometimes an ancestor of the possessed, that may be either
1014 | Possession
References
Lewis, I. M. 1989. Ecstatic Religion: A Study of Shamanism and Spirit Possession.
London: Routledge.
Ludwig, Arnold. 1968. Altered States of Consciousness: Trance and Possession
States. In Proceedings of the Second Annual Conference, R. M. Bucke Memorial Soci-
ety, ed. Raymond Prince. Montreal: R. M. Bucke Memorial Society.
Metraux, Alfred. 1972. Voodoo in Haiti. Trans. Hugo Charteris. New York:
Schocken.
Oesterreich, T. K. 1974. Possession, Demoniacal & Other, among Primitive Races,
in Antiquity, the Middle Ages, and Modern Times. Secaucus, NJ: Citadel.
Siikala, Anna-Leena. 1978. The Rite Technique of the Siberian Shaman. Folklore
Fellows Communications, no. 220. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Walker, D. P. 1981. Unclean Spirits: Possession and Exorcism in France and Eng-
land in the Late Sixteenth and Early Seventeenth Centuries. Philadelphia: University of
Pennsylvania Press.
Postfolklore
Urban cultural traditions that developed over the twentieth century independently
of, or parallel to, archaic and agricultural traditional folklore. The term was intro-
duced by Russian folklorist Sergey Neklyudov in his 1995 article ‘‘After Folk-
lore’’ to denote ‘‘city traditions that create their own texts and that function in
oral and written forms equally actively.’’ Neklyudov and his adherents consider
twentieth-century urban oral traditions to differ from earlier archaic and village
oral traditions, and to not fit the traditional canons of folklore, while still mani-
festing some characteristics of traditional folklore genres.
Other folklorists have suggested terms such as urbanized folklore, anti-folk-
lore, and folklore of the third culture to denote the state of folk culture in recent
decades. Common to all these terms is the idea that the (e.g.) folklore of the New
Times differs substantially from what we know as traditional folklore genres.
Postfolklore’s main characteristics are its urban and marginal nature, its close
connection to mass culture, and the frequent ‘‘birth’’ of new genres and texts.
Anatoly Kargin and Sergey Neklyudov wrote that postfolklore is ‘‘ideologically
marginal, polycentric and fragmented, in accordance with social, professional
and even age divisions of city residents. . . . In contrast to the local phenomenon
1016 | Postfolklore
References
Anikin, Vladimir. 1997. Ne ‘‘Postfolklore’’ a Folklore: K Postanovke Voprosa o ego
Sovremennykh Traditsiyakh (Not ‘‘Postfolklore’’ but Folklore: On the Problem of Con-
temporary Traditions). In Slavyanskaya Traditsionnaya Kultura: Sbornik Materialov
Nauchno Practicheskoy Konferentsii, Vypusk 2. Moscow: State Republican Center for
Folklore.
Kargin, Anatoly, and Sergei Neklyudov. 2005. Folklore i Folkloristika Tretyego
Tysyacheletiya (Folklore and Folkloristics in the Third Millennium). In Pervy
1018 | Postmodernism
Postmodernism
Various aesthetic and cultural trends that arise in the context of advanced con-
sumer culture and that stand in contrast to modernism. The rapid spread of the
term postmodernism in academic and increasingly in popular discourse suggests
that it has all the attractions and defects of a superficial fashion but also perhaps
that it is a response in language to a legitimate perception that our current histori-
cal moment has distinctive qualities for which we need a new name. This latter
possibility makes a consideration of postmodernism worthwhile in general and
of some relevance to folklore studies in particular.
Amid the welter of its applications, one can distinguish three broad uses of the
term postmodernism that folklorists might want to keep in mind. The most recent
and most problematic is its use as an umbrella term for all of the new theoretical
and methodological strands that now crisscross the academic terrain of the
human sciences. These strands, first woven firmly together in the 1970s (though
many of them were spun earlier), are associated particularly with the triumvirate
of French theorists Jacques Derrida, Jacques Lacan, and Michel Foucault. Their
work forms the foundation of poststructuralism, so called not because these
scholars reject and abandon the structuralist project but rather because they carry
it to some of the logical conclusions that high structuralism did not pursue. In
doing so, the poststructuralists have called into questions many of the stabilities
upon which previous cultural analysis depended—stabilities of language, of em-
pirical inquiry, and even of the human subject itself. These largely philosophical
insights have had a profound effect on the intellectual practice of many disci-
plines, not to mention on the very nature of disciplinarity itself. Most promi-
nently in literary studies—but for folklorists perhaps more importantly in
historical and ethnographic studies—this wholesale reorientation stands at the
heart of much current intellectual debate. It is worth noting that whereas structur-
alism significantly influenced folklore studies, poststructuralist trends have had
only marginal impact on the field, though there are indications this may be
Postmodernism | 1019
References
Connor, Steven. 1989. Postmodern Culture: An Introduction to Theories of the
Contemporary. New York: Basil Blackwell.
Dorst, John D. 1989. The Written Suburb: An American Site, An Ethnographic
Dilemma. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Jameson, Frederic. 1984. The Cultural Logic of Late Capitalism. New Left Review
144: 53 92.
Jencks, Charles. 1986. What Is Post-Modernism? London: St. Martin’s Press.
Lyotard, Jean-Francois. 1984. The Postmodern Condition: A Report on Knowledge.
Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.
Warshaver, Gerald E. 1991. On Postmodern Folklore. Western Folklore 50: 219 229.
Protest
Types of Protest
Protest comes in various forms including public demonstrations, written demon-
strations, and other creative modes. Marches and rallies are public demonstra-
tions that are visible and energizing. Protests at places of employment include
picketing, lockdowns, strikes, and walkouts. Occupational protest has an impor-
tant place in labor lore. Written demonstrations include petitions and letter-
writing campaigns. Sometimes protestors circulate censored materials, known as
samizdat, as a way of spreading a message. Numerous protests involve the use of
civil disobedience as a strategy to communicate opinions and effect change. Peo-
ple may erect tents on government property, refuse to pay taxes, or boycott cer-
tain goods. More extreme means of protest include flag desecration, suicide, and
hunger strikes. Protest also uses artistic vehicles to convey messages in a power-
ful way, whether through the performance of a protest song or the creation of lit-
erature, paintings, and films that focus on themes of dissent. There are protests
within religious traditions, certain occupations, and social groups.
1024 | Protest
Protest songs include those of the civil rights movement. They are an example
of both expressive culture and folk art. Protest songs are centered on the concerns
and struggles of the ordinary people. Through their lyrics the artists purport to
express social and political ideas.
The folk protest movement encompassed a group of individuals who believed
that folksingers should act as spokesmen for the common people by expressing
their feelings and opinions to the general public. Among its prominent leaders
was Alan Lomax, a folklorist. Another important figure was Moses Asch, who
owned Folkway Records and had committed himself to recording and preserving
the expressions of minorities. Pete Seeger, a well-known folksinger, cofounded
the periodical Broadside alongside Agnes Cunningham and Gordon Friesen, who
were spouses and former members of the Almanac Singers. Sing Out! magazine
was the key medium for the movement. Its editor, Irwin Silber, was passionate
about advocating for the common people and using folk music to give them a
voice. The leaders of the movement criticized the vagueness they felt permeated
the folk music of the 1960s. Famous folk musicians who wrote and performed
protest songs included Woody Guthrie, Bob Dylan, Phil Ochs, and Joan Baez.
Jaclyn Ozzimo
See Also Folk Culture; Folksong, Narrative.
References
Brown, Stuart M. 1961. Civil Disobedience. Journal of Philosophy 58: 669 681.
Denisoff, R. Serge. 1970. Protest Songs: Those on the Top Forty and Those of the
Streets. American Quarterly 22: 807 823.
Denselow, Robin. 1990. When the Music’s Over: The Story of Political Pop. London
and Boston: Faber & Faber.
Dunlap, James. 2006. Through the Eyes of Tom Joad: Patterns of American Ideal-
ism, Bob Dylan, and the Folk Protest Movement. Popular Music and Society 29: 549
572.
Greenway, John. 1970. American Folksongs of Protest. New York: Octagon Books.
Rodnitzky, Jerome L. 1976. Minstrels of the Dawn: The Folk-Protest Singer as a
Cultural Hero. Chicago: Nelson-Hall.
Proverb
Ukiyo-e print illustration showing Rokurokubi and Mikoshi-nyudo, demons from Japanese
folklore, frightening noodle shop customers to illustrate the proverb that ‘‘resistance is fu-
tile,’’ ca. 1863. (Library of Congress)
Wellerism
Traditional expression that includes both a quotation and a putative speaker of that
quotation. Most commonly, some contrast, incongruity, or other relationship
between speaker and spoken creates humor or irony in the Wellerism, as in such
well-known examples as ‘‘‘I see,’ said the blind man, as he picked up his hammer
and saw’’ and ‘‘‘Neat but not gaudy,’ as the monkey said when he painted his tail
blue.’’ Wellerisms may also involve punning or other word play. Although the term
Wellerism is derived from the name of a character who used such phrases in
Charles Dickens’s Pickwick Papers (1836–1837), the genre itself is much older, exam-
ples being found in classical writings.
Wellerisms have been considered a type of proverb and have much in common
with other types. However, little attention has been given to how Wellerisms may
actually function in oral contexts, and their usage may differ in some respects from
that of other proverbs. They may be used solely as witticisms, as their appearance
in nineteenth-century newspapers along with other humorous filler material sug-
gests (this also suggests that some Wellerisms may have subliterary rather than oral
currency). However, like other proverbs, they can be used rhetorically or to com-
ment on life situations. If proverbs in general distance a speaker from a situation
commented on (by providing a traditional observation that gives a generalized
rather than a personal statement), so may Wellerisms create even greater distanc-
ing by providing a fictional speaker. Such may certainly be the case when the quota-
tion element is itself a traditional proverb, as in ‘‘‘All’s well that ends well,’ said the
monkey when the lawnmower ran over his tail.’’
Frank de Caro
include contextual materials with his 250,000 German proverbs in his massive,
five-volume Deutsches Sprichw€ orter-Lexikon? But like other historically inter-
ested paremiographers, Wander does include references to all major German
proverb collections from the Middle Ages to the nineteenth century, and he also
presents dialect variants and parallels from numerous foreign languages.
The U.S. paremiographer Bartlett Jere Whiting has developed a lexicographi-
cal methodology for diachronic proverb collections that is now considered as the
model for any national language collection. In his classic collection Proverbs,
Sentences, and Proverbial Phrases from English Writings Mainly before 1500,
he has arranged the proverbs alphabetically according to their key words (usually
the subject noun or a verb). Each entry starts with a lemma that lists the prover-
bial text in its standard form and is preceded by the first letter of the key word
and a consecutive number (e.g., F194 ‘‘No fire without some smoke’’). The many
references that Whiting has located in various early English publications follow
in chronological order, and at the end, the author adds cross- references to other
scholarly proverb collections. Whiting also uses this system in his invaluable
Early American Proverbs and Proverbial Phrases, which records the proverbial
language used in American writings from the first decades of the seventeenth
century to about 1820. Other scholars have followed Whiting’s lead, and a num-
ber of excellent national proverb collections based on historical principles now
exist for French, Polish, and other languages.
There is yet another type of proverb collection that deserves to be considered.
People in general and scholars in particular often have wondered about the simi-
larities and differences among proverbs of different languages. Those proverbs
that go back to Greek or Roman antiquity or to biblical traditions for the most
part have been loan translated into many languages, and they usually exist as
identical texts from one language to another (loan translation is the direct transla-
tion of a foreign proverb into the ‘‘borrower’’ language). The same is true for
many medieval European proverbs that became current as loan translations due
to social and commercial intercourse. The tradition of serious comparative and
polyglot proverb collections goes back to the late Middle Ages. Today, scholars
have assembled impressive collections for the Germanic, Romance, and Slavic
languages, for example. A particularly valuable collection of this type is Matti
Kuusi’s Proverbia Septentrionalia: 900 Balto-Finnic Proverb Types with Rus-
sian, Baltic and German Scandinavian Parallels. This collection represents a
major step toward identifying those universal proverb types that have an interna-
tional and perhaps global distribution. Proverbs such as ‘‘One hand washes the
other’’ and ‘‘Big fish eat little fish’’ are examples of widely disseminated prov-
erbs. But much work remains to be done by comparative paremiographers. A
similar collection for the proverbs of the African continent is sorely needed, and
there are also no polyglot collections of this value for the Oriental languages.
Proverb | 1031
References
Bryant, Margaret M. 1945. Proverbs and How to Collect Them. Greensboro, NC:
American Dialect Society.
Carnes, Pack, ed. 1988. Proverbia in Fabula: Essays on the Relationship of the
Fable and the Proverb. Bern: Peter Lang.
Dundes, Alan, and Claudia A. Stibbe. 1981. The Art of Mixing Metaphors: A Folk-
loristic Interpretation of the ‘‘Netherlandish Proverbs’’ by Pieter Bruegel the Elder.
Helsinki: Suomalainen Tiedeakatemia.
Krikmann, Arvo. 2009. Proverb Semantics: Studies in Structure, Logic, and Meta-
phor. Burlington, VT: University of Vermont.
1034 | Psychoanalytic Interpretations of Folklore
References
Devereux, George. 1980. Basic Problems of Ethnopsychiatry. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1962. Earth-Diver: Creation of the Mythopoeic Male. American
Anthropologist 64: 1032 1051.
Erikson, Erik. 1963. Childhood and Society. New York: W. W. Norton.
Freud, Sigmund. 1965. The Interpretation of Dreams. New York: Basic Books.
Jacobs, Melville. 1959. The Content and Style of an Oral Literature. Chicago: Uni-
versity of Chicago Press.
Jones, Ernest. 1959. On the Nightmare. New York: Grove.
Oring, Elliott. 1984. The Jokes of Sigmund Freud: A Study in Humor and Jewish
Identity. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Roheim, Geza. 1950. Psychoanalysis and Anthropology. New York: International
Universities Press.
Psychological Approach
The work of Sigmund Freud, C. G. Jung, Franz Boas, Otto Rank, and other
psychologists and anthropologists during the late nineteenth and early twentieth
centuries set the stage for more recent approaches to the psychological study of
folklore. These pioneering figures viewed folklore and folklife as products of
inner psychodynamic processes, such as unconscious imagery and repressed feel-
ings, that function as catalysts for folkloric expressions as well as for personal
and culturewide psychological dynamics. During this period, for instance, Freud
and his disciples used folklore for much of their analytic work with dreams, fairy
tales, jokes, and slips of the tongue. Freud observed the ambivalent reactions of
modern people to ‘‘something familiar and old-established in the mind which has
been estranged only by the process of repression.’’ For him, the distant past, hid-
den in the unconscious and reflected in folkloric symbols, was particularly evi-
dent in folklife and childhood and was regarded as the key to understanding
present repressed feelings and urges. This general view of the ties between child-
hood, the past, and folklore was reflected in the thinking of early American folk-
lorists such as Alexander Chamberlain (1865–1914), editor of the Journal of
American Folklore, who emphasized this perspective in The Child and Child-
hood in Folk-Thought.
The psychoanalytic approach to folklore around the turn of the twentieth cen-
tury borrowed the concept of ‘‘survivals’’ from evolutionary theory and psycho-
analysis. Although existing in altered form and generally beyond conscious
awareness, the traditions of the hidden past were seen to survive for the individ-
ual as dreamlike images reflecting a developmental sequence and amenable to
mythic interpretation by an analyst. Likewise, folklorists saw a unified cultural
past reflecting a series of human developmental stages, or ‘‘the varieties of
man.’’ Even after this notion had waned in folklore studies, the related idea of a
personal past lived on.
In the work of the Swiss psychologist C. G. Jung, for example, notions of a
personal and cultural past took on a central position. Delving into folklore and
the past represented a significant human activity by which individuals could
derive inner symbols and imagery for use in the process of psychospiritual inte-
gration, or individuation. Jung’s influence on folklore studies is still being felt.
The impact of Charles Darwin can be seen in the psychological approaches of
folklorists during this period as well, in frequent references to folklore’s links
with the ‘‘history and psychology of man,’’ and the ‘‘psychic unity of man’’ main-
taining the natural evolution of culture. At the time, psychological views of folk-
lore conceived of psychology as developmental, addressing the discontent,
alienation, and anxieties of modern industrial society.
During subsequent decades, these approaches were countervailed in anthropol-
ogy and, by extension, folklore studies by behavioristic analyses involving the
learned or acquired aspects of cultural and folklore expressions as responses to a
1038 | Psychological Approach
general nature of that force. In other words, the folk narrative is viewed as a
response to specific stimuli or an integrated behavioral event in which motiva-
tion (stimuli, wants, or goals) and intermediary stimuli (cues, or the context in
which narration occurs), as perceived by the narrator, invoke the tale. Thus, the
folktale as a whole may be seen as the measurement of that response and an
instrument for accomplishing the narrator’s goals. Moreover, both the affective
and cognitive elements of the narrative are seen to parallel other cognitive sys-
tems, schemata, or worldviews typical of the narrator and his or her cultural
group.
The motivating force that determines the sequencing of events in traditional
Arab tales reflecting the brother-sister syndrome is that the brother and sister
desire to be together. The narrator perceives this force and behaves within its
framework. With the fulfillment of the brother’s and sister’s wishes at the end of
the tale, the underlying motivation diminishes in power, and the story reaches a
conclusion that is emotionally satisfying to both narrator and listeners.
El-Shamy supported his views on the brother-sister syndrome in Arab folktales
through numerous examples from the Middle East and North Africa, all of which
reflect the international folktale type AT 872: ‘‘Brother and Sister.’’ His study
aimed to establish the extent to which this tale type is ‘‘an integrated cognitive
system,’’ in which the various parts of the tale are interconnected and congruent
with each other and the tale operates as functional social behavior that helps to
realize the narrator’s goals. Thus, El-Shamy combined concepts from cognitive
psychology (e.g., ‘‘integrated cognitive system’’) and behaviorism (e.g., the nar-
rator’s goals) to show that AT 872 represents an interpersonal behavioral event
and is ‘‘an integrated instrumental (goal-oriented) social act.’’
In recent decades, directly cognitive approaches to folk expressions and sym-
bols have emerged in folklore studies as well. Henry Glassie, for example, exam-
ined the trend toward symmetry and enclosure in folk housing in colonial
Virginia as a cognitive-affective need for order in the midst of perceived chaos
during the American Revolution. Similarly, Michael Owen Jones has analyzed
the transformations in the cognitive schemata of a folk artisan, a maker of hand-
made furniture. Jones noted that when this craftsperson worked near crowded
urban areas, his cognitive schemata and work reflected a sense of enclosure. But
when ‘‘drawn back into the countryside, his chairs opened up,’’ which Jones
interpreted as a change in cognitive-affective states.
Another area of inquiry derived from cognitive psychology that has been
addressed recently in folklore scholarship is memory storage and retrieval, spe-
cifically, memory for stories. Robert A. Georges examined the complementarity
and conflict between folklorists’ and psychologists’ views on memory, challeng-
ing the long-standing notion that individual folklore items are simply stored in
‘‘inventorylike fashion’’ for subsequent retrieval on command. In contrast to this
Psychological Approach | 1041
view, Georges stated that many folklorists and psychologists are adopting a more
dynamic, generative, context-specific model of memory, supported by data from
neuroscience. And yet others favor neither the static storage-and-retrieval model
nor the dynamic and generative view. Instead, these researchers posit that mem-
ory may be both stable and variable, depending on the situation. Implicit in such
a view are the assumptions that what is most readily remembered in a given item
of folklore is its ‘‘basic plot or central theme, while what is likely to be forgotten
and perhaps replaced are specifics and details.’’ This approach is widespread in
folklore studies, with those parts of stories or songs that are best remembered
being identified variously as ‘‘normalforms,’’ ‘‘kernel stories,’’ ‘‘emotional
cores,’’ or ‘‘ideational cores.’’ Georges pointed out that, whatever the model or
approach a folklorist adopts, memory is a central concept in folklore studies and
deserves to be examined and discussed more vigorously in future research and
theory in the field. He stated that folklorists have the experience and skills
needed to test hypotheses and assess generalizations made by nonfolklorists, as
well as the responsibility to reveal to nonfolklorists theories about memory that
have guided and emerged from their own inquiries.
Other psychological concepts that have influenced folklore studies in recent
years have come from the area of social psychology. For instance, the concept of
‘‘conduit’’ proposed by Linda Degh and Andrew Vazsonyi, in their influential
‘‘The Hypothesis of Multi-Conduit Transmission in Folklore,’’ is essentially the
social psychological technique of ‘‘sociogram.’’ Robert A. Georges discussed
‘‘communicative role and social identity in storytelling,’’ noting that since the
1970s, folk narratives have begun to be studied as social behaviors, such as
‘‘communication,’’ ‘‘interaction,’’ ‘‘performance,’’ and ‘‘art.’’ And folktales have
been seen as ‘‘situated in’’ and ‘‘emergent from’’ cultural or social contexts, with
narrators being described as ‘‘performers,’’ ‘‘artists,’’ and ‘‘followers or trans-
formers of rules.’’ Georges saw such trends as a move toward a new model of
folklore studies emphasizing the social behavior of participants in storytelling, as
opposed to the older text-transmitting-and-receiving model. He felt that the con-
ceptualizing and identifying of tale narration or storytelling as a panhuman, role-
based communication mode, with participants’ behaviors being determined by
manifestations of their communicative roles and identities, ‘‘provide part of the
intellectual foundation for an alternative model for folk narrative research.’’ Such
a psychologically based approach counters the culture-based construct that has
dominated folklore studies for many decades, which assumes that folk narrators
and other performers identify themselves exclusively in cultural terms.
The emotional aspects of folk narrative also have been discussed in the psycho-
logical approaches of numerous folklorists, who have used ideas and principles
derived mainly from psychoanalysis and neopsychoanalytic schools. Such efforts
generally have focused on the panhuman, hereditary, or archetypal bases for the
1042 | Psychological Approach
origin and continuity of ‘‘emotional’’ patterns in folktales. Other work has employed
vaguely defined concepts, such as feelings, attitudes, love, hate, and affect.
However, two general aspects of the emotional experience are of special im-
portance in folklore research and may be defined and used precisely: emotions
and sentiments. These terms have been used in the folklore literature inter-
changeably, but recent psychological research differentiates them from each
other. Emotions may be defined as complex arousals that stem from an organ-
ism’s attempts to cope with a given environment. They emerge through disturb-
ance or sudden success in activities basic to biological survival and well-being,
being acute, intense, and often disruptive in nature. By contrast, sentiments are
affective experiences with a cognitive basis, such as patriotic, religious, ethical,
aesthetic, or intellectual ideas, and they are based on past life experiences and
education. They are usually enduring and should be distinguished from transient
cognitive experiences, such as the memorization of facts for academic purposes.
Given these definitions, behavior in folk narratives that depicts sudden, intense,
disruptive affective experiences largely connected with basic biological needs
may be seen as describing emotions. Examples of this group include AT 1119
(‘‘The Ogre Kills His Own Children’’) and AT 931 (‘‘Oedipus’’). Another appli-
cation of the psychological approach to folklore is the recent adoption of key
principles from cognitive psychological literature as classificatory devices, espe-
cially as motifs recurrent in ‘‘folk literature’’ and other facets of traditional com-
munity life. The assumption here is that if a psychological theory is ‘‘correct,’’
with reproducible results, it must be applicable to instances of actual living expe-
riences as portrayed in the cultural sphere that emphasizes the stable reproduci-
bility of traditions (i.e., folklore). Although Stith Thompson had expressed some
doubts in this regard (probably with reference to the psychoanalytic approach),
there are indications that such psychological (and sociological) concepts do recur
in folk expressions as a matter of empirical observation by folk groups and that
they can be of significant classificatory (indexing) usefulness. Examples of these
newly devised motifs are the following:
References
Bronner, Simon J. 1986. American Folklore Studies: An Intellectual History. Law-
rence: University of Kansas Press.
1044 | Public Sector Folklore
The presentation and interpretation of folklore outside its original context. The
term public sector folklore, in use since approximately 1980, can be taken in ei-
ther a narrow or a broad sense, according to Archie Green. The narrow sense
emphasizes certain types of activities carried out by folklorists to present folklore
to ‘‘the public,’’ together with the host institutions that house and support such
activities. In this sense, public sector folklore includes distinctive research and
presentation activities (including the production of festivals or live performances,
media programming, exhibitions, publications, and other educational programs)
that have flourished in large part since the early 1970s but that have important
earlier roots; these activities are carried on by folklorists working primarily out-
side academic life, in arts councils, museums, historical societies, and other pub-
lic or quasi-public institutions.
Robert Baron and Nicholas Spitzer’s Public Folklore gives a concise state-
ment of a broader view of the term: ‘‘Public folklore is the representation and
application of folk traditions in new contours and contexts within and beyond the
communities in which they originated, often through the collaborative efforts of
tradition bearers and folklorists or other cultural specialists.’’
Public Sector Folklore | 1045
In this instance (though these authors use a slightly different term), public sec-
tor folklore includes all activities, since the beginning of the discipline over a
century ago, that have represented or applied folk traditions in some new way or
to some new audience. In this light, any or all of the following contemporary
phenomena can be understood as public sector folklore:
Colombian women’s singing group at a Las Americas venue at the Smithsonian Folklife
Festival on the Mall in Washington D.C., July 2, 2009. (Richard Gunion/Dreamstime.com)
folklore, the festival (particularly the enormous 1976 undertaking) has served as
the annual training ground for young public sector folklorists.
Their mid-1970s Smithsonian experience enabled these young folklorists to
occupy the dozens of ‘‘state folklorist’’ posts and other more local public sector
folklore positions that were created between 1975 and 1990. Most of these posi-
tions are located in state arts councils (and a minority in state humanities coun-
cils, historical societies, departments of culture, or other similar agencies), and,
like state arts councils themselves, they were a direct result of the initiative of
the Folk Arts Program (now renamed the Folk and Traditional Arts Program) of
the National Endowment for the Arts (NEA).
The Folk and Traditional Arts Program began in 1974 and, over the next sev-
eral years, grew from within the NEA’s special projects office to take on inde-
pendent status. It was headed until 1976 by Alan Jabbour, folk music scholar and
former head of the Library of Congress’s folk music archive, and from 1977 to
1992 by Bess Lomax Hawes, who joined the NEA following an extensive career
in folklore as a collector, performer, teacher, and writer. Longtime deputy Dan
Sheehy took over direction of the program after Hawes’s departure.
1048 | Public Sector Folklore
Early in the program’s history, the staff set several objectives, including that
of firmly establishing folklore in the landscape of public support for culture and
the arts. In part, they went about achieving that objective by offering grants to
state arts councils to establish folk arts programs, staffed by professional folklor-
ists, to serve artists and art forms not served by state councils’ more typical
music and visual arts programs. In this way, the Folk and Traditional Arts Pro-
gram has attempted to do in the world of government what academic folklorists
had attempted to do in the world of universities: establish institutional territory
but, in this case, without needing to disparage other aspects of folklore work.
For reasons ranging from a belief in the necessity of support for folk expression
to a desire for federal funds, many state arts councils and other agencies took
advantage of this NEA support. Among the first states to begin folk arts programs
were Alabama, Florida, Maryland, North Carolina, Ohio, Oregon, Tennessee, and
Utah. These programs’ early activities—more often than not, statewide folk festi-
vals or folk arts exhibitions, both based on field research and documentation—
were intentionally chosen to establish visibility and territory for folk arts, folk
artists, and folklorists. Since both were considered comparable in impact, the
choice between them, in fact, was often determined by the interests of the new
state folklorist or by the preferences of state arts council directors or boards.
Each of these presentational modes has its advantages and disadvantages. Folk
festivals tend to be large and therefore highly visible, and as celebratory media,
they are associated in the public mind with fairs, outdoor concerts, and other vis-
ually and programmatically similar events. To be sure, exposure and celebration
are powerful cultural tools, especially when festival artists and audiences come
from different cultural backgrounds. Nevertheless, festival producers’ educa-
tional aims are often frustrated by audience perceptions of these events as pri-
marily for entertainment—again, as are state fairs and other celebratory events.
Festivals’ presentational settings and techniques have concentrated on (and the
wandering behavior of festival audiences favors) performing artists as opposed
to craftspeople and large-scale events as opposed to intimate ones. Finally, festi-
vals tend to be quite expensive and can be short-lived and ephemeral unless plans
are made to build more lasting community programs on the foundation of festival
celebrations or to extend the life spans of festivals by tours, residencies, and
other movable or smaller-scale presentational activities.
Exhibitions, by contrast, favor the presentation of material culture. They can
be broader and more flexible in approach, devoting attention to dimensions of
medium, theme, cultural and social context and the development of a tradition
over time that are often difficult to convey effectively in live events. Exhibitions
can travel to several sites and thus reach more diverse and larger audiences, and
exhibition catalogs, when carefully prepared, become valuable, permanent edu-
cational products. Without creative conception and design, however, exhibitions
Public Sector Folklore | 1049
can become only static inventories of objects that do not convey the vitality and
depth of their home traditions and communities.
Since the mid-1970s, state folk arts programs have built on this heritage to
design and produce their own locally appropriate repertoire of activities. These
include conducting and documenting field research; providing advice and assis-
tance to folk artists; producing festivals, exhibitions, media programs, publica-
tions, educational residencies, and other public presentations; and giving grants
to artists and community-based organizations. Committees of public sector folk-
lorists conducted surveys of these state programs’ funding and activities in 1983,
1984, 1989, and 1994 for the Folk and Traditional Arts Program and the Public
Programs Section of the American Folklore Society (the society’s interest group
for public sector folklorists).
At present, forty-eight of the fifty-six states and territories have such pro-
grams. Their increasing establishment and maturity—and funding—also has sup-
ported the growth, especially since the mid-1980s, of a significant number of
public folk cultural programs in cities and counties that concentrate on local
artists and traditions. Finally, several of the regional consortia of state arts coun-
cils, which foster cooperative activities among the states (the Mid-Atlantic Arts
Federation, the New England Foundation for the Arts, the Southern Arts Federa-
tion, and the Western States Arts Foundation), now include folk arts among their
presentations and folklorists on their staffs.
Since the mid-1970s, the NEA Folk and Traditional Arts Program has shaped
the public sector folklore landscape in other ways. The program gives grants
throughout the country to community-based nonprofit organizations for the pre-
sentation and media documentation of traditional arts and artists, as well as for
various services to the field. In the late 1970s and early 1980s, the program sup-
ported regular meetings of state folklorists in Washington, DC, and more
recently has convened meetings and designed projects on support for crafts and
craftspeople, on folk arts in education, and other special topics. The program pio-
neered the awarding of small grants to support apprenticeships in the folk arts,
and it has passed on to many states the responsibility and the funding to continue
such programs. In 1982, the program began honoring the nation’s finest and most
respected practitioners of tradition through an annual set of a dozen or more
National Heritage Fellowships, thereby also giving larger visibility to folk tradi-
tion and the field of folklore.
During this same period, other federal programs were created or expanded. An
intensive lobbying effort, spearheaded by Archie Green, for a federal institution
specifically devoted to folklore led to the passage of the American Folklife Pres-
ervation Act in 1976, which established an American Folklife Center to be
housed in the Library of Congress to ‘‘preserve and present American folklife,’’
in the language of the act. In 1978, the center incorporated the Library’s Archive
1050 | Public Sector Folklore
of Folk Culture, created in 1928 as the Archive of Folksong and directed, over
the years, by several of the most significant ‘‘popularizers’’ of American folk cul-
ture: John Lomax, Alan Lomax, Benjamin Botkin, and Duncan Emrich. The cen-
ter, directed by Alan Jabbour since its establishment, carries out its own program
of team field research projects, archival organization and preservation, reference
services, conferences, educational programs and publications, and services to the
field.
Since the publication in 1983 of its study Cultural Conservation: The Protec-
tion of Cultural Heritage in the United States, the center also has devoted effort
to working out the implications of the concept of ‘‘cultural conservation.’’ This
concept is both an end—the expression of an ideal, in thinking and planning, of
concern for the processes and products of everyday culture—and a means—a
way of saying ‘‘folklore’’ to professionals and policy makers in other fields in a
manner they are more likely to understand.
The National Endowment for the Humanities, since it is not internally organ-
ized according to humanities disciplines, has no folklore program or staff posi-
tions per se. However, NEH has had folklorists on its staff for some years who
serve as important advisers to and conduits from the field.
The Festival of American Folklife, originally produced by the Smithsonian’s
Division of Performing Arts, became a production of the newly created Office of
Folklife Programs in 1976. In 1987, the office acquired the enormous recorded
holdings of Moses Asch’s Folkways Records after Asch’s death. It now both dis-
tributes existing Folkways recordings and vigorously issues new recordings
under its Smithsonian Folkways label.
In line with the recent development of interdisciplinary university programs
and scholarly journals in ‘‘cultural studies,’’ the office was renamed the Center
for Folklife Programs and Cultural Studies in 1992. In addition to the annual fes-
tival and ongoing recording activities, the center produces documentary publica-
tions and films and works closely with the cultural groups featured in the festival
to plan continuing folk cultural programs in their home communities. Among its
other activities is an annual workshop, coinciding with the festival, to bring folk-
lorists together with ‘‘community scholars’’ (those many skilled and devoted non-
professionals with a long history of commitment to documenting, presenting, and
supporting local folk traditions) to exchange the useful philosophies and prac-
tices developed by both groups.
This same twenty-year period has seen the development of energetic private,
nonprofit organizations engaged in local, state, or national folklore research and
programming. The oldest of these—actually founded well before this period—is
the National Council for the Traditional Arts (NCTA) in Silver Spring, Mary-
land. Founded by Sarah Gertrude Knott in 1934 as the National Folk Festival
Association to produce the event of the same name, the organization was
Public Sector Folklore | 1051
essentially devoted only to that project until recently. Since beginning in the
early 1970s, NCTA (under the direction of Joe Wilson) has designed and tested
many new models for the presentation of (mostly performing) folk arts. Most no-
table among these is the ‘‘inreach’’ tour, which presents respected local perform-
ers to other communities around the country or world that share the performers’
culture (as opposed to ‘‘outreach’’ tours, much more common in the mainstream
arts world, that present performances to culturally unfamiliar audiences).
Several private, nonprofit organizations, headed by former state folklorists,
carry on work once done by public sector programs in their state’s government,
as well as newer, unique programs. These include the Alabama Center for Tradi-
tional Culture, Texas Folklife Resources, the Vermont Folklife Center, and the
Western Folklife Center in Elko, Nevada. Similar organizations focused at the
community level include City Lore and the Ethnic Folk Arts Center in New York
City, Cityfolk in Dayton, and the Philadelphia Folklore Project. In addition,
many other arts, cultural, and educational institutions support their own public
sector folklore and folk arts programs, from the California Academy of Sciences
in San Francisco to the Institute of Texan Cultures in San Antonio and the
McKissick Museum at the University of South Carolina in Columbia. Finally,
several folk museums and historical archaeology sites—among them the Conner
Prairie Pioneer Settlement outside Indianapolis, the Jensen Living Historical
Farm in Logan, Utah, the Museum of American Frontier Culture in Staunton,
Virginia, and Plimoth Plantation in Plymouth, Massachusetts—carry on in the
European tradition by presenting reconstructions and reenactments of rural
folklife.
This network of public sector folklorists and institutions keeps written track of
itself through the twice-yearly issues of the Public Programs Newsletter, the pe-
riodical of the American Folklore Society’s Public Programs Section. A typical
example of the Newsletter, the first issue of 1993, ran to eighty-seven double-col-
umn pages and contained discussions of cultural conservation matters and other
professional issues, news of public sector activities throughout the country, and a
directory of 177 entries for public sector folklore programs and independent folk-
lorists. By contrast, the American Folklore Society’s Journal of American Folk-
lore (JAF), as well as other significant American folklore serials (Western
Folklore, Southern Folklore) have devoted relatively little attention to public
sector folklore, at least until recently. JAF, for instance, now prints reviews of
some public sector presentations—exhibitions, festivals, and the like—and has
included several articles on issues of authenticity and representation that draw on
public sector experience.
The society’s annual meeting in late October, however, is the largest gathering
of public sector folklorists in the country. Since the late 1980s, about one in ev-
ery eight sessions at the meeting has been explicitly ‘‘about’’ public sector
1052 | Public Sector Folklore
folklore. (At the 1993 meeting, for example, 14 sessions of 115 total, at least one
during every time slot in the program fit this description.) Many others are
informed by current work in this area but have been given some other title. Other
regional meetings offer more focused gatherings: Public sector folklorists from
the Western states have met in parallel with Utah State University’s annual Fife
Folklore Conference since around 1980, and the Southern Arts Federation spon-
sors biannual retreats for folklorists from the Southeast.
Thus, there are many indications that the entire field of folklore and related
fields of cultural study are again positively incorporating public sector work and
are again incorporating as central those issues that have been at the heart of the
public sector enterprise from the start. These include issues of representation
(How are folk traditions, artists, and communities depicted through the work of
folklorists and others?), authority (By whom are folk traditions, artists, and com-
munities depicted and in whose terms?), responsibility (for informed, sensitive,
and accurate representation), and collaboration (among tradition bearers, other
community members, and folklorists or other outside workers to achieve the
most appropriate representation).
Responding to these sorts of issues requires integrative education: extensive
fieldwork experience; a solid grounding in the materials, history, theories, and
techniques of the entire discipline of folklore (including the discipline’s always-
present public aspects); and direct experience in public sector folklore work,
from teaching to presentation planning and community service, along with
reflection on that work. For the most part, graduate programs in folklore and
folklife do not provide public sector experience or reflection as a formal part of
their curricula, though this is changing, especially at younger programs. The
effective collaboration of community members and folklorists that is a goal of
contemporary public sector folklore work also requires shared and integrative
learning, based in carefully planned projects that serve communities well.
Timothy C. Lloyd
See Also Archives and Archiving; Folklife; Folklore; Museum, Folk.
References
Baron, Robert, and Nicholas R. Spitzer, eds. 1992. Public Folklore. Washington,
DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Bronner, Simon J. 1986. The Usable Hidden Past of Folklore. In American Folklore
Studies: An Intellectual History, Simon Bronner. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas.
Byington, Robert H. 1989. What Happened to Applied Folklore? In Time and Tem-
perature, ed. Charles Camp. Washington, DC: American Folklore Society.
Camp, Charles, and Timothy Lloyd. 1980. Six Reasons Not to Produce Folk Festi-
vals. Kentucky Folklore Record 26: 1 2, 67 74.
Puppetry | 1053
Puppetry
distinct voices for each of the puppet characters, who engage in dramatic dialogue
with one another. The voices may be distinguished by speaking style, vocabulary,
voice quality, or the use of distinct dialects or languages. The Indonesian dalang
(puppeteer) makes use of different levels or styles of language (from colloquial to
royal, informal to elegant) as well as different vocal qualities (smooth and gentle for
refined characters and rough and abrupt for ruffians or clowns). Similarly, the chiv-
alric marionettes of Liege or Palermo are endowed by their operators with identifia-
ble voices and appropriate vocabularies and speaking styles. In other cases, the
puppeteer is assisted by actors who provide the voices for each of the characters, as
one or more manipulator operates the puppets. In many traditions (especially those
of the Punch-and-Judy family), the puppeteer makes use of an instrument in his or
her mouth that distorts the natural voice and produces a semi-nonsensical squeaking
or buzzing voice. The puppeteer will then carry on a dialogue between the distorted
voice and a natural one, often assisted by an interlocutor or musician who takes one
of the parts in the dialogue. In other traditions, the spoken element of the perfor-
mance takes the form of a narrative rather than a dialogue, and there is no effort to
make it appear that the puppets are carrying on conversations among themselves.
The subject matter of puppetry performances may range from slapstick, topi-
cal humor, and ribaldry to highly serious sacred rituals. Often, puppets are used
to enact semi-historical legends, such as the chivalric epics of Roland or Orlando
or the Indic Ramayana epic. Such extended works may be presented serially,
with each performance featuring a single episode, or in performances that last all
night or several days. The dramatis personae may be numerous or relatively few.
The Punch-Pulcinella-Petrushka tradition of glove puppets typically includes a
handful of characters who engage the hero in dyadic encounters. These forms
also typically feature a substantial degree of involvement by one or more mem-
bers of the audience, and they often make humorous reference to the events of
the day or the attributes of the spectators or their context. In repressive sociopo-
litical settings, puppets are a favorite voice for the downtrodden or rebellious
since they may be granted a degree of license to make critical remarks that would
be punished if uttered by human actors. And because they are not human, pup-
pets can easily be beheaded or otherwise victimized. Folk puppetry traditions of-
ten have been taken up by elite artists and writers, who find them a flexible
medium through which to engage in theatrical experimentation or innovation.
Frank Proschan
See Also Mask.
References
Darkowska-Nidzgorska, Olenka. 1980. Th ea^tre populaire de marionettes en Afrique
sudsaharienne (Folk puppet theater in sub-Saharan Africa). Bandundu, Zaire: Centre
d’Etudes Ethnologiques.
1056 | Puppetry
Keeler, Ward. 1987. Javanese Shadow Plays, Javanese Selves. Princeton, NJ: Prince-
ton University Press.
Malkin, Michael R. 1977. Traditional and Folk Puppets of the World. New York: A.
S. Barnes.
Pasqualino, Antonio. 1977. L’Opera dei pupi. Palermo: Sellerio Editore.
Proschan, Frank. 1981. Puppet Voices and Interlocutors: Language in Folk Puppetry.
Journal of American Folklore 94: 527 555.
Sherzer, Dina, and Joel Sherzer, eds. 1987. Humor and Comedy in Puppetry. Bowl-
ing Green, OH: Popular.
Speaight, George. 1990. The History of the English Puppet Theatre. 2nd ed. Carbon-
dale: Southern Illinois University Press.
R
Rapunzel
1057
1058 | Rapunzel
up. At first Rapunzel is frightened because apart from her father she has never
seen a man before. The prince then seduces Rapunzel—though the Grimm
tale says simply that he ‘‘talked in a loving way to her’’—and the lovers plot
Rapunzel’s escape. She tells the prince that each evening when he comes to her,
he should bring a skein of silk, which she will then weave into a ladder that will
allow her to escape with the prince. This plan proceeds happily until Rapunzel
lets slip to the witch that the prince makes a visit on the day the witch is else-
where. In a fury, the witch hits Rapunzel, cuts off her hair, and takes the girl to a
desert, leaving her ‘‘to die in great misery and grief.’’
Back at the tower, the witch ties the tresses to the window, and when the
prince returns in search of his love, the witch throws the hair down as if all is
well. When the prince reaches the top, he finds the witch waiting for him, and
she tells him that his beloved is lost. In grief and fear he throws himself out the
window, falling into thorns that break his fall but blind him. He then wanders the
wild wood in mourning, living off berries and roots for many years, until one day
he arrives at the desert where the witch had left Rapunzel to die. Hearing a famil-
iar voice, he makes his way toward it. By some miracle, Rapunzel has survived
and given birth to twins, a boy and a girl. Rapunzel recognizes her prince and
embraces him, weeping for joy. Her tears fall upon his eyes, freeing him of blind-
ness. The prince then takes Rapunzel (and, presumably, the twins) back to his
kingdom ‘‘where he was received with great demonstrations of joy.’’
Rapunzel | 1059
In the usual manner of the fairy tale, events in this story occur with little or no
motivation, preparation, or even logic. Rapunzel is inexplicably born to a previ-
ously barren couple for no good reason other than to fulfill the witch’s condition
that she should have the couple’s child. The witch then locks Rapunzel away for
no apparent purpose, in an isolated tower to which entry and exit is unnecessarily
difficult. Rapunzel and the prince’s escape plan is annoyingly long-winded. Why
can’t he simply bring back a rope on his next visit? Rapunzel, who shows no
other signs of idiocy, blurts out the secret of her lover to the witch and then
somehow survives in the desert, giving birth to twins and keeping them alive
until the prince miraculously stumbles across his new family some years later.
Her tears magically cure the prince’s blindness, and he is free to take her back to
his kingdom in the traditional fairy tale manner, though in the Grimms’ version
we are not told whether he also takes his two children or leaves them to perish in
the desert.
Of course, in collusion with the genre of the fairy tale we suspend our disbelief
for the reward of having the tension resolved in the happy ending, which, after
all, is what these narratives are all about. The means by which the hero and hero-
ine reach the end of the story are less important than the fact that they reach it
and that things conclude with smiles all around. Even the defeat of the villain has
not anywhere near the same importance as reaching the happy ending. In the
fairy tale of Rapunzel, the pointlessly malevolent witch suffers no punishment
for her actions.
We are, it seems, meant to interpret these stories and the often odd events that
constitute them as metaphors. In the story of Rapunzel, the common motifs of
the promised (usually female) child, the imprisonment to preserve the heroine’s
virginity, the rescue by the handsome prince (well, almost), the mutilation of the
hero, his wandering in the wilderness, the abandonment in the desert, the healing
power of the heroine’s tears, and the inevitable happy closure are all classic ele-
ments of fairy tale fantasy—even though there is not a fairy in, or out, of sight.
Our need for such narratives has ensured their perpetual popularity. In the
form we call the ‘‘fairy’’ tale, such stories date from the seventeenth century, and
the earthier folktales on which many of the fairy tale encounters of princes, beau-
tiful singing maidens, and the like are based date from some considerable num-
ber of centuries earlier. Scholars will continue to offer new interpretations of the
significance of such fairy tales (‘‘Rapunzel’’ being an obvious favorite for psy-
choanalytic approaches), while we continue to read them, turn them into films,
and, sometimes, tell them to our children.
Graham Seal
See Also Cinderella; Fairy Tale Heroes; Jack and the Beanstalk; Sleeping Beauty; Snow
White.
1060 | Rebus
References
Bettelheim, B. 1976. The Uses of Enchantment: The Meaning and Importance of
Fairy Tales. New York: Knopf.
Bottigheimer, R., ed. 1986. Fairy Tales and Society: Illusion, Allusion, and Para-
digm. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Hallett, M. and B. Karasek, eds. 1996. Folk and Fairy Tales. Ontario: Broadview
Press.
Hunt, M., trans. and ed. 1884. Grimm’s Household Tales (with the author’s notes
and an introduction by Andrew Lang), 2 vols. London: George Bell and Sons.
L€uthi, M. 1976. Once upon a Time: On the Nature of Fairy Tales. Trans. L.
Chadeayne and P. Gottwald. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Minard, R. 1975. Womenfolk and Fairy Tales. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Opie, I. and P. Opie. 1974. The Classic Fairy Tales. London: Oxford University Press.
Rebus
often to distract from it because they are literal puns. A drawing of an eye fol-
lowed by a drawing of a saw does not necessarily suggest ‘‘I saw.’’ That example,
of course, conforms to Gelb’s notion of the principle of phonetization, with one
word or syllable represented by a drawing of a more concrete homonym. In more
modern societies, however, words are sufficiently stable that they have become
things, and as a result, a nonpictorial rebus (i.e., a literal rebus) is the following:
HAbirdND ¼ BUtwoSH (‘‘A bird in the hand is worth two in the bush’’), with
the only clue to its resolution being the change in type. A different kind of rebus,
WORL signifies ‘‘world without end.’’ It is of no little significance that the word
processor used to write this entry makes it impractical to represent less linear
rebuses, such as those that signify ‘‘back-up lights’’ and ‘‘John Underwood, An-
dover, Mass.’’ Such rebuses, playing as they do upon our left-to-right linear con-
cept of language representation, violate assumptions about language that
underlie our word-processing software. Thus, the workaday-world practicality of
computer technology reinforces the ‘‘enigmatic’’ quality of rebuses. Rebuses
today are generally considered humor for children or, at best, ‘‘language arts’’
exercises in elementary schools; illustrative examples are David A. Adler’s
Happy Thanksgiving Rebus and Lisa Rojany’s Story of Hanukkah: A Lift-the-
Flap Rebus Book. In the late eighteenth century, however, a number of ‘‘hiero-
glyphic epistles’’ were printed on broadsides for adult readers. One of these was
printed by W. Allen, Dame Street, Dublin, in 1779. It begins as follows (an inter-
pretation is enclosed in brackets following each word that involves rebuses of the
various kinds):
Printed in Ireland and on a topic that concerns England, this hieroglyphic epis-
tle lends itself to a pro-revolution reading through its many uses of ‘‘pistol’’ and
even ‘‘hoe,’’ weapons of the Irish peasantry that were not included in the printing
of a variant of this broadside in Scotland. Thus, such rebus writing may contain a
higher level of meaning than the literal, but on the literal level, this item illus-
trates a range of practices that contradict Gelb’s idea of one syllable or word for
one image. Here, there is a mixture of ways of representing spoken syllables and
words (Under-stand-ing) and their spelling (t-hat). Indeed, this text plays off of
the various ways we read and speak. If we consider its possibly revolutionary
1062 | Recitation
intent, we should not consider its arbitrary mix of rebus applications out of line.
In its complexity, it contrasts strikingly with the various ‘‘hieroglyphic’’ Bibles
and love letters of the period.
Rebus writing has a long history, and the play with those principles has a
shorter history. That certain words, word fragments, and syllables were repre-
sented in conventional ways within a given culture should surprise no one
because the fit between the available visual images and the current state of lan-
guage is ever-shifting. That a subversive representation should have developed
in a country as repressed as Ireland also should surprise no one.
Michael J. Preston
See Also Enigma, Folk.
References
Augarde, Tony. 1984. The Oxford Guide to Word Games. Oxford: Oxford University
Press.
Ceard, Jean, and Jean-Claude Margolin. 1986. R
ebus de la Renaissance: Des images
qui parlent (Renaissance rebus: Images who speak), 2 vols. Paris: Maisonneuve and
Larose.
Dupriez, Bernard Marie. 1991. Gradus: Les Procedes litteraires (Gradus: The
literary proceedings). Trans. and adapted by Albert W. Halsall. Toronto: University of
Toronto Press.
Gelb, I. J. 1952. A Study of Writing. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, reprinted
in 1963.
Higgins, Dick. 1987. Pattern Poetry: Guide to an Unknown Literature. Albany: State
University of New York Press.
Preston, Michael J. 1982. The English Literal Rebus and the Graphic Riddle Tradi-
tion. Western Folklore 41: 104 138.
Recitation
social drinking pubs; and in Canada, dialect poems and monologues are recited
at house parties and community entertainment events (‘‘times’’). The preceding
examples single out reports from the English language; a more comprehensive
and indicative survey would include a vast compilation of evidence from addi-
tional world culture areas, countries, linguistic traditions, and folk groups. This
observation holds as well for documented recitation evidence among children.
Numerous collections and accompanying commentary have dealt with childlore
recitation. In its Western European, British Isles, and North American manifestations,
examples include childhood recitations of traditional verse accompanying folk
games; recited parodies of well-known, adult literary passages and revered songs;
‘‘tangle-talk’’ mock speeches and nonsense verse; chanted boasts and taunts; and, pri-
marily among urban adolescents and young adults affiliated with street gangs, reciting
of mini-epic rhymed folk verse that boasts of real or fantasized contest and conquest.
Since the 1970s, a number of folklorists in Great Britain, Australia, and the
United States—together with recitation performers—have singled out, for greater
attention, late-Victorian, Edwardian, and twentieth-century English-language popu-
lar poetry as a primary source for reciters dually influenced by anglophonic folk tra-
dition and popular culture antecedents. Whether labeled popular poetry, vernacular
popular poetry, or poetry of the people, such rhymed verse compositions are distin-
guishable from elite poetry by their commonplace diction and tendency to present
subject matter dealing with real or fictional adventure, faraway dramatic encounter,
community happenstance, or rural domestic experience. Narrative and humorous
popular poetry recitation texts, often authored and performed by men, appear to out-
number others; women’s authored and performed texts, at least in anglophonic tradi-
tion, are frequently lyrical, sentimental, and homiletic. Many widely circulated
popular poetry compositions are attributable to regionally, nationally, and interna-
tionally known authors: in England, notably Rudyard Kipling and George R. Sims;
in Canada, Robert W. Service and William Henry Drummond; in Australia, A. B.
Paterson and Henry Lawson; in the United States, Eugene Field and Will Carleton.
In the western United States, rhymed popular poetry suited to oral recitation has
flourished among cowboys and ranchers since the late 1800s, and there are numer-
ous renowned and lesser-known self-identified ‘‘bunkhouse folk poets’’ within their
ranks. In the late twentieth century, American ‘‘cowboy poetry’’ in four-line or lon-
ger stanzas vies with Australian ‘‘bush verse’’ as ongoing, freshly creative, and com-
mercially evolving oral recitation within conventions and precedents found
worldwide. Representative and widely heralded twentieth-century American cow-
boy and rancher poet-reciters include Curley Fletcher, Baxter Black, and Waddie
Mitchell; Australian counterparts include C. J. Dennis and others who have fore-
grounded their continent’s history, popular culture, and western Queensland bush.
In all, oral recitation endures from ancient times into the present in diversified tex-
tual evidence and situated occasioning. Increasingly, inquiries into the phenomenon
Regional Approach | 1065
among adults need to contend with expanding global public access to printed publica-
tions, audio recordings, radio and television, videotape, emerging electronic and com-
puter media, and commercial popular culture generally. Tourism-related displays and
events that serve nostalgia sometimes introduce new and wider audiences to reciters
and the recitation format. Emergent commercial outlets also may bring established
recitation tradition to mass-public familiarity, as happened with the rhymed ‘‘rap’’
recitations found in American popular music since the late 1970s, which derived from
African American ‘‘street poetry’’ current a generation earlier. Scholars might also
consider the indebtedness, interconnections, or departure of childlore recitation texts
and performances from those of culture-sharing adults. Whatever and wherever the
evidence, recitation continues as one of the major oral performance varieties in global
consideration.
Robert D. Bethke
See Also Oral-Formulaic Theory; Performance; Popular Culture.
References
Cannon, Hal, ed. 1985. Cowboy Poetry: A Gathering. Layton, UT: Gibbs M. Smith.
Cunningham, Keith, ed. 1990. The Oral Tradition of the American West: Adventure,
Courtship, Family, and Place in Traditional Recitation. Little Rock, AR: August House.
Goldstein, Kenneth S. 1993. Recitations and Monologues. In Folk Literature: Voices
through Time, eds. Bill Butt and Larry Small. St. John’s, Newfoundland: Breakwater Books.
Goldstein, Kenneth S., and Robert D. Bethke. 1976. Monologues and Folk Recita-
tion. Special issue, Southern Folklore Quarterly 40(1-2).
Greenhill, Pauline. 1989. True Poetry: Traditional and Popular Verse in Ontario.
Montreal: McGill-Queen’s University Press.
Jones, Sanford W., ed. 1976. Great Recitations. New York: Hart.
Kochman, Thomas, ed. 1972. Rappin’ and Stylin’ Out: Communication in Urban
Black America. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
McHenry, Keith. 1993. Folk Poetry and Recitation. In The Oxford Companion to
Australian Folklore, eds. Gwenda Beed Davey and Graham Seal. Melbourne: Oxford
University Press.
Opie, Iona, and Peter Opie. 1959. The Lore and Language of Schoolchildren. Oxford,
UK: Clarendon.
Rosenberg, Bruce A. 1988. Can These Bones Live?: The Art of the American Folk
Preacher. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Regional Approach
in a mutually responsive relationship with the area. Although all of the folklore
of a particular place is important and can reveal much about its inhabitants, con-
temporary folklorists distinguish between the folklore of regions and regional
folklore. Regional folklore, unlike traditions that appear and function widely,
exists in what Archie Green calls a ‘‘reflexive’’ relationship with a spatially
defined group, rather than one conceptualized on the basis of such other factors
as age, gender, occupation, ethnicity, avocation, or lifestyle. Truly regional folk-
lore expresses and articulates a place’s worldview, while at the same time shap-
ing and informing it. In other words, as Green puts it, ‘‘Lore delineates region
and region delimits lore. In either direction each turns back, or is bent, to the
other’’ (Green 1978). This reflexivity is not operative insofar as the folklore of
regions is concerned. For example, catastrophe jokes, the proverb ‘‘Haste makes
waste,’’ the ballad ‘‘Barbara Allen,’’ and the belief that a copper bracelet cures
arthritis are part of the traditional inventories of many regions, but corridos
(Mexican American folk ballads), stories about the Brown Mountain lights,
sneakboxes (small boats made and used by duck hunters in southern New
Jersey), sang hoes (three-pronged hoes for extracting ginseng), and the ballad
‘‘Talt Hall’’ are most certainly not. Moreover, these latter forms are inextricably
connected to the specific geographic contexts in which they appear, both
expressing regionality and informing it. As Barre Toelken puts it: ‘‘We learn our
culture by hearing its expressions, and we in turn express our culture whenever
we engage in performing any of its vernacular genres’’ (Allen & Schlereth 1990).
Indeed, regional analysis provides excellent insights into the relationships
between people, their place, and their lore. Understanding spatially defined
groups enhances our understanding of their folklore, and the regionally bound
folklore facilitates our understanding of the group: To know Appalachian folk-
lore, we must know Appalachia; to know Appalachia, we must know its folklore.
Whether concerned with the folklore of regions or regional folklore, however,
most folklorists would agree with Howard Odum and Harry Moore, who write in
American Regionalism that the ‘‘geographic factor’’ is the ‘‘mudsill’’ of the con-
cept of regionalism and that ‘‘social phenomena may best be understood when
considered in relation to the area in which they occur as a cultural frame of refer-
ence’’ (Odum & Moore 1938).
During the first few decades of American folklore scholarship, many folklo-
rists were interested in the ‘‘geographic factor,’’ framing the traditions they col-
lected in spatial terms. These studies focused on the folklore of regions, paying
little attention to regional theory or analysis, but they nevertheless afforded valu-
able texts and indicated that scholars were at least thinking about the connections
between land and lore. Perhaps the first regional folklore collection in the United
States was the 1867 book Slave Songs of the United States, in which the authors,
William Francis Allen, Charles P. Ware, and Lucy M. Garrison, arranged 136
Regional Approach | 1067
Localization
The process by which folklore develops to conform to the preferred patterns of
folk cultural regions; alternatively, the products of such a process. Folk cultural
regions are self-conscious, multileveled assemblies of folk as specific as ‘‘Arizona
White River Apache’’ and as broad as ‘ the Southwest,’’ but members of all regions
share a traditional aesthetic sense that regulates folklore. Localization reshapes lore
to fit these varied senses of form.
Literary folklorists analyzed texts as products of localization and found that char-
acters’ names and the settings of oral folklore were frequently localized. One of
the most notable Anglo-American ballad localizations, for example, is the substitu-
tion of familiar names for unfamiliar ones, so that names acceptable to audience
and performers replace characters of long ago or far away in localized versions.
The settings of folk narrative are also frequently localized in response to the tra-
ditions of folk cultural regions. Most Anglo-American urban legends, for example,
are introduced as having happened recently and nearby, but they lack exact settings.
Field-based folklorists and anthropologists concentrated upon the localization of
folklore performance and upon the process by which localization took place. Field
researchers investigating localization focused on the unconscious process of selec-
tion and adaptation by which folk cultural regions create their lore. Localization, in
both the literary and field research senses of the term, is an important concept in
cultural studies, explaining one of the major ways in which folklore develops and
examining the results of this process.
Keith Cunningham
Regional Approach | 1069
Virginia ghost tales, for example—but the decade is best characterized by the
integration of folkloric and geographic approaches. Geographers had been inter-
ested in the concept of regionalism since the publication in 1789 of Jedidiah
Morse’s American Geography, in which the author attempted to make explicit
implied assumptions about major American ‘‘sections,’’ but oddly, substantial
geographically oriented folklore studies did not appear until 1968. That year saw
the publication of the cultural geographer E. Joan Wilson Miller’s ‘‘Ozark Cul-
ture Region as Revealed by Traditional Materials,’’ in which Miller argued that
‘‘regionalized’’ folklore (specifically, narratives collected by Vance Randolph)
could contribute to ‘‘an understanding of forms and processes of settlement’’
within a cultural region. Miller (1968) later suggested that superstitions, too,
could facilitate the discovery of a region’s ‘‘resource base,’’ which supplies the
physical and spiritual needs of a folk group. Also in 1968, Alan Lomax published
Folk Song Style and Culture, a collection of essays supporting his thesis that
singing styles defined large, worldwide musical regions. And 1968 was the year
that Henry Glassie, following Fred Kniffen’s groundbreaking work on the diffu-
sion of folk house types, published his influential Pattern in the Material Culture
of the Eastern United States. Like Lomax, Glassie identified regions on the basis
of folk cultural expressions, in this case, architecture and artifacts. The book rep-
resents the high watermark of geographical folklore scholarship.
This geographically oriented folklore approach carried over into the 1970s,
especially in the work of W. F. H. Nicolaisen, who became involved with the So-
ciety for the North American Cultural Survey, a consortium of geographers, folk-
lorists, anthropologists, and historians that has as its mission the production of an
atlas of North American cultures. Nicolaisen’s interest in ‘‘the reciprocal ways in
which folklore creates region while at the same time being shaped by it’’ mir-
rored exactly Archie Green’s thinking outlined in ‘‘Reflexive Regionalism,’’
which appeared in 1978. Regional theory also was advanced by Suzi Jones in her
1976 article ‘‘Regionalization: A Rhetorical Strategy,’’ in which she, like Miller,
emphasized the importance of transformations of folk materials based on a
response to a specific place. Other important regional studies in the 1970s were
those of Henry Glassie on folk housing in Middle Virginia, Roger Welsch’s work
on tall tales in the northern plains, and George Carey’s study on the folklore of
both Maryland and the Eastern Shore. Moreover, Richard Dorson, perhaps think-
ing about his upcoming handbook on American folklore, encouraged two of his
graduate students, Howard Marshall and William E. Lightfoot, to undertake re-
gional projects for their dissertations at Indiana University. Marshall, in ‘‘The
Concept of Folk Region in Missouri: The Case of Little Dixie’’ (1976), analyzed
both verbal and nonverbal traditions, especially those that tended to reveal ‘‘re-
gional personality,’’ concluding that architecture most clearly expressed Little
Dixie’s identification ‘‘as an island of Southern folk culture in the lower
1072 | Regional Approach
References
Allen, Barbara, and Thomas J. Schlereth, eds. 1990. Sense of Place: American
Regional Cultures. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Dewhurst, C. Kurt, and Marsha MacDowell. 1984. Region and Locality. In American
Folk Art: A Guide to Sources, ed. Simon J. Bronner. New York: Garland.
Dorson, Richard M. 1959. A Theory for American Folklore. Journal of American
Folklore 72: 197 242.
Religion, Comparative | 1075
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1964. Buying the Wind: Regional Folklore in the United
States. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1983. Handbook of American Folklore. Bloomington: Indi-
ana University Press.
Gardner, Emelyn E. 1937. Folklore from the Schoharie Hills, New York. Ann Arbor:
University of Michigan Press.
Green, Archie. 1978. Reflexive Regionalism. Adena 3: 3 15.
Jones, Suzi. 1976. Regionalization: A Rhetorical Strategy. Journal of the Folklore
Institute 13: 105 120.
Miller, E. Joan Wilson. 1968. The Ozark Culture Region as Revealed by Traditional
Materials. Annals of the Association of American Geographers 58: 51 77.
Odum, Howard W., and Harry E. Moore. 1938. American Regionalism. New York:
Henry Holt.
Paredes, Americo. 1958. ‘‘With His Pistol in His Hand’’: A Border Ballad and Its
Hero. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Religion, Comparative
material in order to prove its historical and religious value is a fundamental part
of such study, and the methods used depend on the nature and quality of the mate-
rial. It is common practice to divide religions into two categories, depending on
whether their sources are principally in written documents or oral traditions. In
the former case—in the so-called historical, or literate, religions—the study is
based primarily on the historical analysis of texts and documents. In the case of
cultures not based on written materials, known as primitive or illiterate (nonliter-
ate) religions, conclusions concerning their history have to be arrived at on the ba-
sis of oral tradition.
The phenomenology of religion is principally a comparative discipline. Its task
is to seek out regularly occurring patterns, repeatedly encountered phenomena,
and recurring structures and functions in the religious field. The phenomena
studied need not necessarily be interdependent from the point of view of their
genetic history. The phenomenology of religion is more interested in the phe-
nomena than in the historical relationships among them. The material is usually
arranged not chronologically but systematically. The task of religious phenome-
nology is to classify various forms, structures, and functions of religions. The
approach corresponds, to a large extent, to the study of structures and substruc-
tures in cultural anthropology. Methods of typological comparison have been
very important for this kind of study. As in cultural anthropology, cross-cultural
research occupies a prominent position, offering more-exact methods for meas-
uring differences between cultural mechanisms and finding common denomina-
tors. In contemporary practice, the phenomenology of religion aims to ensure
that neither the social nor the cultural context of those phenomena is neglected.
To draw up a workable religio-phenomenological model, in general, presupposes
historical, ecological, and sociological analysis within a relatively homogenous
cultural area. Regional phenomenology of religion as practiced by Scandinavian
and Finnish scholars has incorporated the methods of folkloristics into religious
studies.
Sociology of religion is a branch of the study of religion that occupies a rather
independent position; its methods and problems are much the same as those in
general sociology. From the sociological viewpoint, religion is principally a
group phenomenon that has been adopted by a limited, cohesive group. Sociolo-
gists examine religion as a social system that maintains certain ideas about what
is sacred and what is not, as well as the norms and roles associated with sacred
and secular phenomena and beings, together with regular patterns of behavior
that recur at fixed intervals.
Psychology of religion, on the one hand, forms a sector of the wide field cov-
ered by modern psychology; on the other hand, it is a branch of the study of reli-
gion. Most of the methods employed today in the psychology of religion have
been developed in other branches of psychology. Examples of these methods are
1078 | Religion, Comparative
References
Evans-Pritchard, E. E. 1965. Theories of Primitive Religion. Oxford: Oxford Univer-
sity Press.
Kitagawa, Joseph M. 1987. The History of Religions: Understanding Human Experi-
ence. Atlanta, GA: Scholars.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 219.
Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Segal, Robert A. 1989. Religion and Social Sciences: Essays on the Confrontation.
Atlanta, GA: Scholars.
Sharpe, Eric J. 1975. Comparative Religion: A History. London: Duckworth.
Sharpe, Eric J. 1983. Understanding Religion. London: Duckworth.
Religion, Folk | 1079
Smart, Ninian. 1989. The World’s Religions: Old Traditions and Modern Transfor-
mations. London: Cambridge University Press.
Tambiah, Stanley Jeyaraja. 1990. Magic, Science, Religion, and the Scope of Ration-
ality. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Religion, Folk
Animism
Term derived from the Greek anima, meaning spirit or soul, and used to signify ei-
ther: (1) the belief in indwelling spirits (souls, ghosts, and other invisible beings) in-
herent in people, animals, plants, or even lifeless things and often presented in
personalized or anthropomorphized images, or (2) the theory that accounts for the
origin of religion on the basis of this kind of anima. The anima is believed to be like
a soul, a self, or an ego, able to leave the body either temporarily (e.g., in sleep, ec-
stasy, or fright) or permanently (e.g., on the occasion of death).
The theory of animism as the basis of the earliest form of religion was set forth
by the pioneer English anthropologist E. B. Tylor (1832–1917) in his book Primitive
Culture. Tylor bridged the evolutionary and diffusionist theories of culture of his
times in his own psychologically inspired reasoning. The general evolutionary per-
ception of that age proposed a gradual development of the natural, social, and spir-
itual worlds toward more complex and higher modes of existence. In the evolution
of man’s religious ideas, monotheistic Christianity was placed at the pinnacle of the
developmental scale as the highest form of spirituality.
Tylor stated that primitive religion was rational in its own way, supporting his
premises with an image of the ‘ancient savage philosophers.’’ The theory of animism
was thought to reveal the psychological mechanisms of primitive man and the origi-
nal form of religion in human history. However, Tylor’s hypotheses were not based
on reliable scientific data, and the premise of unilinear cultural evolution ultimately
could not prevail in the face of accumulating evidence regarding early man. Scientific
accumulation of knowledge on the so-called primitive religions and on continuous
contacts between these tribes and peoples of different modes of production and
belief systems forced scholars to abandon the theory that claimed that the nine-
teenth-century aboriginal tribes represented the pristine state of human cultural
evolution.
Despite the fact that the theoretical value of animism has been disproved, it
played an influential role in the study of man for decades before the rise of func-
tionalism in the field of anthropology. It also made an important contribution to the
search for the origins of human civilization.
Juha Pentik€ainen
and the study of the folk (a group of religious people). This can be called ‘‘reli-
gious folklore.’’ Folk religion also has represented for folklorists a specific group
of religious people, such as ‘‘the folk church,’’ which stands independent of a cul-
ture’s normative religious communities or organizations. Finally, ‘‘folk religion’’
has been conceived as the entire body of interpreted and negotiated religious
beliefs and practices of individuals and communities fluidly interacting with
organized religious traditions. The diverse subjects examined have included the
collection and analysis of Christian saints’ legends; supernatural narratives from
Religion, Folk | 1081
Mormon Utah; American regional spirituals; witch tales from eastern Pennsylva-
nia counties; popular beliefs concerning the cycles of human life, luck, magic,
and the supernatural given the pejorative designation ‘‘superstitions’’; and the
cultural continuities categorized as survivals of distinct ethnic and linguistic
regions and peoples, such as the ancient Celts, Germans, Mediterranean peoples,
Eastern Europeans, Middle Eastern and Far Eastern communities, Africans, and
Native Americans. The breadth of folkloristic interests in religion is shown in the
range of other historical and contemporary work, such as the study of Bavarian
pilgrimage devotionalism and its associated material culture of medals and
badges; French, French Canadian, and German holy cards and other religious
prints; Holy Week processions of southern Italians; Swedish Lutheran peasants’
use of the Bible; devotion in Newfoundland to particular Roman Catholic saints;
healing narratives associated with a European or American saint’s shrine; the use
of talismans in Greek American culture; New England tombstone designs; oral
expression of Pentecostal women in Indiana, Illinois, and Missouri; speech,
chant, and song in an Appalachian Independent Baptist congregation; voudon
and other African Caribbean syncretized forms of belief; urban and rural Italian
and Italian American home altars and street and lawn shrines; apparitions of holy
persons in Europe and the Americas; contemporary Wicca and goddess religion
in England and the United States; and the negotiated beliefs of gay and lesbian
urban Roman Catholics.
Folklorists have studied religion and religious material in a number of ways.
The earliest research into folk religion was accomplished by German folklife
scholars, and it was the Lutheran minister Paul Drews who coined the term reli-
gi€
ose Volkskunde in 1901 to prepare young seminary graduates for the radically
different religious ideas of their rural congregants. Throughout the twentieth cen-
tury, German, Austrian, Swiss, and Swedish folklife scholars (Georg Schreiber,
Wolfgang Br€uckner, Richard Weiss, and Hilding Pleijel among them) studied the
religious customs of Roman Catholic and Protestant peasant and rural (and gradu-
ally urban) populations continuing Drews’s dichotomous conception of folk
religion as the religious elaborations of the faithful juxtaposed to the religion of
self-designated official institutions and their functionaries. Other European re-
gional ethnologists, such as southern Italian scholars influenced by Antonio
Gramsci (e.g., Ernesto De Martino and Luigi Lombardi-Satriani) became espe-
cially interested in the autonomous devotions of the dominated classes, which they
interpreted as a means of cultural and political resistance. Gradually throughout
the century, archives and museums were established in Europe for the preserva-
tion, study, and display of the oral, literary, and material evidence of the people’s
traditional religious beliefs.
The American folklife scholar Don Yoder adapted the European approach to
the study of the religion of folk cultures in the context of North America. His
1082 | Religion, Folk
Manism
Belief in the deification of deceased ancestors or the hypothesis that ancestor wor-
ship is a primary source of religion. The term manism is derived from the Latin
manes, meaning ‘ departed spirits, ghosts, souls of the deceased.’ The concept
implies both the practice of worshipping deceased ancestors and the theoretical
orientation that suggested this worship was the origin of religion. According to this
hypothesis, ghosts developed into gods, with remote and important deceased
ancestors becoming divinities and their offering places developing into the shrines
for ritual propitiation.
As a belief in a continual relationship between the spirits of the deceased and the
community of the living, manism was thought, during the nineteenth century, to
have characterized the primal forms of religion, the religion still to be found among
‘ the primitives.’ According to the British philosopher Herbert Spencer (1820–
1903), manism offered a sort of rational explanation for otherwise mysterious or
inexplicable events and phenomena. The unilineal scheme of evolution had become
a dominant theory by Spencer’s time, a time of increasing interest in the compara-
tive study of mankind and its religions. His theory of religion was both psychological
and evolutionary in its style. Spencer, who was the first to advocate the theory of
manism, claimed that ancestor worship was the root of every religion, and he
hoped that knowing the origin of religion would reveal the later developments in
its unilineal evolution. He further believed that the idea that worship of ancestors
or ghosts gradually developed into the belief in gods clarified the general direction
of cultural evolution. However, as an explanation for the origins of religion, manism
never enjoyed great popularity, not even during Spencer’s lifetime.
Juha Pentik€ainen
systems of religious belief that folklore and folklife today encounter the innumer-
able and wondrous variations of human religiosity.
Folklorists have left a considerable amount of potential religiosity out of con-
sideration if all religion need be traditional, inherited, group-oriented, deliberate,
and involved in performative verbal art to be considered folk religion. Surely, in
an effort to study such religion in the context of holistic systems, folkloristic
attention needs to be focused not only on the products of religious lives but also
on their processes. It is, of course, well within the domain of folklore and folklife
scholars to be concerned with the creative products of religious lives, and,
indeed, this is a major contribution of the discipline to the study of religious cul-
ture. Manifestations of religious ideas and practices should not only be studied as
products (e.g., narratives with a religious theme or about a religious context) and
performance genres (e.g., the study of the verbal art of conversion testimonies).
The notion of folklore as expressive culture is a concept often espoused by
folklorists but not explicitly defined within the discipline’s literature. Folklorists
usually study belief as expressive culture, through its contextual manifestations
(oral, material, aural, ritual, kinesic, or proxemic). The entirety of expressive cul-
ture, however, is not to be found merely in its manifestations or outward phe-
nomena but also in the holistic study of these products of communication as
dynamic processes within their attendant conscious, unconscious, aesthetic, and
affective contexts. The actual human activity of believing something is itself a
form of expression and self-communication before it is manifested into particular
products. Thus, belief and the action of personally believing also should be con-
sidered as expressive culture, not immediately to be gentrified and studied as
products. Through exhibiting a sensitivity to the integrity of the very act of
believing by the individual, the term expressive culture can identify for scholars
the internal processes as well as products of human religiosity, a notion that folk-
lorists have pursued in the later half of the twentieth century under the rubric of
performance theory.
A potentially useful new term that focuses upon the process of belief and the
believing individual is vernacular religion, which may serve as a methodological
tool for studying the conjunction of religious, folklore, and folklife studies. Ver-
nacular religion is, by definition, religion as it is lived: as human beings encoun-
ter, understand, interpret, and practice it. Since religion inherently involves
interpretation, it is impossible for the religion of an individual not to be vernacu-
lar. Vernacular religious theory involves an interdisciplinary approach to the
study of the religious lives of individuals, with special attention to the complex
process of acquisition and formation of beliefs that is always accomplished by
the conscious and unconscious negotiations of and between believers; to the
verbal, behavioral, and material expressions of religious belief; and to the ulti-
mate object of religious belief.
1086 | Religion, Folk
It is relatively easy for the folklorist to understand the vernacular nature of the
religion of the common people. It is less easy for folklorists, as well as other
scholars of religion, to grasp the vernacular nature of the institutionalized ele-
ments of organized religion: their clerical functionaries, their oral and written
statements, and their ritualized or sacramental occasions and observances. A ver-
nacular religious viewpoint shows that designations of institutionalized religion
as official are inaccurate. What scholars have referred to as official religion does
not, in fact, exist. The use of the term official religion as a pedagogical tool has
helped explain scholarly perspectives to the uninitiated, but it remains an inad-
equate explanation for the nature of religion. Although it may be possible to refer
to various components within a religious body as emically official, meaning au-
thoritative when used by empowered members within that religious tradition,
such a designation when used by scholars is limited by the assumption that reli-
gion is synonymous with institutional or hierarchical authority.
‘‘Official religion’’ as a Western scholarly concept has been sustained partly
out of deference to the historical and cultural hegemony of Christianity, which
has set the dominant tone for Western culture. Through a process of reification,
‘‘institution’’ has become equated for both believers and scholars, whether lay or
clerical, with Church/church, with valid, and with official. Religion as institution
has been mistakenly identified as the religious reality itself and not as an ideal
type. We must be aware that this process of reification has taken place when we
consider the concretization of the human religious impulse. There are bodies and
agencies of normative, prescriptive religion, but there is no objective existence
of practice that expresses official religion. No one—no special religious elite or
member of an institutional hierarchy, not even the pope in Rome—lives an ‘‘offi-
cially’’ religious life in a pure, unadulterated form. The members of such hierar-
chies themselves are believing and practicing vernacularly, even while
representing the most institutionally normative aspects of their religious tradi-
tions. There is always some passive accommodation, some intriguing survival,
some active creation, some dissenting impulse, or some reflection on lived expe-
rience that influences how these individuals direct their religious lives.
Scholars have studied and continue to study institutional religion as official re-
ligion, maintaining it as the standard against which the varieties of people’s reli-
gious impulses are measured. To continue to compare the vernacular religious
ideas of people of any culture to the construct ‘‘official religion’’ is to perpetuate
the value judgment that people’s ideas and practices, because they do not repre-
sent the refined statements of a religious institution, are indeed unofficial and
fringe. This attitude is particularly faulty because it is believers’ ideas that
inspire the formation of institutional religion in the first place. Vernacular reli-
gion takes into consideration the individual convictions of official religious
membership among common believers, as well as the vernacular religious ideas
Religion, Folk | 1087
at the root of the institution itself. In such a situation, the concept of vernacular
religion can highlight the creative interpretations present in even the most ardent,
devout, and accepting religious life, while also being sensitive to the context of
power that makes the validity of ‘‘official’’ religion so convincing. The possible
evolution of the folkloristic study of religion would be the adoption of this new
terminology in lieu of the term folk religion and the dichotomous conceptualiza-
tions that it has carried with it.
Leonard Norman Primiano
See Also Belief, Folk; Belief Tale; Divination; Magic; Medicine, Folk; Religion, Com-
parative; Supernatural/Supranormal.
References
Badone, Ellen, ed. 1990. Religious Orthodoxy and Popular Faith in European Soci-
ety. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Bruckner, Wolfgang. 1968. Popular Piety in Central Europe. Journal of the Folklore
Institute 5: 158 174.
Byrne, Donald E., Jr. 1988. Folklore and the Study of American Religion. In Ency-
clopedia of the American Religious Experience, eds. Charles H. Lippy and Peter W.
Williams, vol. 1. New York: Charles Scribner’s Sons.
Christian, William A., Jr. 1981. Local Religion in Sixteenth-Century Spain. Prince-
ton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Clements, William M. 1983. The Folk Church: Institution, Event, Performance. In
Handbook of American Folklore, ed. Richard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana Univer-
sity Press.
Danielson, Larry. 1986. Religious Folklore. In Folk Groups and Folklore Genres: An
Introduction, ed. Elliott Oring. Logan: Utah State University Press.
De Martino, Ernesto. 1968. La Terra del rimorso (The land of remorse), 2nd ed. Mi-
lan: Alberto Mondadori.
Drews, Paul. 1901. Religi€ose Volkskunde, eine Aufgabe der praktischen Theologie
(Religious folklore: A challenge to applied theology). Monatsschrift fur die kirchliche
Praxis 1: 1 8.
Hand, Wayland D. 1961. Introduction to Popular Beliefs and Superstitions from
North Carolina. In The Frank C. Brown Collection of North Carolina Folklore, ed.
Newman Ivey White, vol. 6. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.
Honko, Lauri. 1964. Memorates and the Study of Folk Beliefs. Journal of the Folk-
lore Institute 1: 5 19.
Hufford, David J. 1982. The Terror That Comes in the Night: An Experience-Centered
Study of Supernatural Assault Traditions. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Hufford, David J. 1985. Ste. Anne de Beaupre: Roman Catholic Pilgrimage and
Healing. Western Folklore 44: 194 207.
Isambert, Francois-Andre. 1982. Le Sens du sacr e: F^ete et religion populaire (The
sense of the sacred: Festivity and popular religion). Paris: Les Editions de Minuit.
1088 | Religious Folk Heroes
Lawless, Elaine J.1988. God’s Peculiar People: Women’s Voices and Folk Tradition
in a Pentecostal Church. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Lawless, Elaine J. 1988. Handmaidens of the Lord: Pentecostal Woman Preachers
and Traditional Religion. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Lombardi-Satriani, Luigi. 1978. Attuale problematica della religione popolare (Current
problems of popular religion). In Questione meridionale religione e classi subalterne
(Matters of southern religion and the lower classes), ed. Francesco Saija. Naples: Guida.
Noy, Dov. 1980. Is There a Jewish Folk Religion? In Studies in Jewish Folklore, ed.
Frank Talmage. Cambridge, MA: Association for Jewish Studies.
Pleigel, Hilding. 1959. Kyrklig Folklivsforskning: Fragelista I (Folklife studies in re-
ligion: Issues I). Meddelanden fran Kyrkohistoriska Arkivet i Lund (Bulletin from the
archives of church history in Lund), Vol. 1. Lund, Sweden: Gleerup.
Primiano, Leonard Norman. 1993. Intrinsically Catholic: Vernacular Religion and
Philadelphia’s ‘‘Dignity.’’ PhD dissertation, University of Pennsylvania, Philadelphia.
Primiano, Leonard Norman. 1995. Vernacular Religion and the Search for Method in
Religious Folklife. Western Folklore 54: 37 56.
Titon, Jeff Todd. 1988. Powerhouse for God: Speech, Chant, and Song in an Appala-
chian Baptist Church. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Tyson, Ruel W., Jr., James L. Peacock, and Daniel W. Patterson, eds. 1988. Diver-
sities of Gifts, Field Studies in Southern Religion. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Vrijhof, Pieter, and Jacques Waardenburg, eds. 1979. Official and Popular Religion:
Analysis of a Theme for Religious Studies. The Hague: Mouton.
Williams, Peter W. 1989. Popular Religion in America: Symbolic Change and the
Modernization Process in Historical Perspective. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Yoder, Don. 1974. Toward a Definition of Folk Religion. Western Folklore 33(1):
2 15. Reprinted in 1990 in Discovering American Folklife: Studies in Ethnic, Religious,
and Regional Culture, ed. Don Yoder. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research.
This large category includes heroes of all kinds: founders of faiths, martyrs, saints,
the pious, the brave, the compassionate, and the wise. The religious traditions of
most cultures and peoples, whether written or oral, are full of heroic stories, many of
which appear as discrete narratives in other cultures, usually disassociated from their
religious significance. The Christian Bible, notably the Old Testament, the Koran,
the Torah, and many other such holy books are vast repositories of folk heroism. As
is well known, many of these works share common characters and incidents, even
though these may be interpreted in different ways according to the various belief
systems in which they appear. In addition to such authorized works, there usually
exist considerable bodies of apocryphal material that contain even more lore.
Religious belief is a fertile ground for the creation of folk heroes. Those who
are celebrated may be founders of their religions (Nanak Chand, founder of
Religious Folk Heroes | 1089
holy man. One example given by Dorson is the south Texas folk healer Pedro
Jaramillo of Los Olmos, celebrated as a miraculous healer among Mexican fami-
lies from the 1880s. Stories of Jaramillo emphasize his magical ability to effect
cures, often involving prescribed actions being performed nine times.
Christian religious figures often have a role in folk drama, especially in Latin
cultures. Jesus, Mary, and Joseph, for example, are found in the Nativity and also
in other forms of traditional theater. God is also featured in some traditions, often
those of a humorous nature.
Religious heroes are frequently found in folklore as helpers, sometimes as
healers, and generally combine their status as official figures of veneration with
the unofficial tales and beliefs that are popularly held or told about them. Like
most folk heroes, they straddle the boundaries between different, often opposi-
tional, cultural spaces, in these cases between the spiritual and the mundane.
Graham Seal
See Also Culture Hero; Drama, Folk; Helpers, Folk; Religion, Comparative; Religion,
Folk.
References
Ausubel, N., ed. [1948] 1972. A Treasury of Jewish Folklore. London: Vallentine,
Mitchell, pp. 104 223.
Blum, R. and E. 1970. The Dangerous Hour: The Lore of Crisis and Mystery in
Rural Greece. London: Chatto and Windus, pp. 88 94.
Dorson, R. 1964. Buying the Wind: Regional Folklore in the United States. Chicago:
University of Chicago Press, pp. 500 508.
El-Shamy, H., coll., trans., ed. 1980. Folktales of Egypt. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, pp. 149 169.
Espinosa, A. 1985. The Folklore of Spain in the American Southwest: Traditional Span-
ish Folk Literature in Northern New Mexico and Southern Colorado, ed. M. Espinosa.
Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, pp. 201 213.
Frazer, Sir J. 1918. Folk-Lore in the Old Testament, 3 vols. London: Macmillan.
Gaer, J. 1951. The Lore of the Old Testament, Boston: Little, Brown.
Gaer, J. 1952. The Lore of the New Testament, Boston: Little, Brown.
Heath-Stubbs, J. 1975. The Hero as a Saint: St. George. In Legends of Icelandic
Magicians (with an introduction by B. Benedikz), trans. J. Simpson. London: Brewer/
Rowman and Littlefield, The Folklore Society, pp. 1 15.
Hunt, M., trans. and ed. 1884. Grimm’s Household Tales (with the author’s notes
and an introduction by Andrew Lang), 2 vols. London: George Bell and Sons, pp. 312
324, 440 452.
Ivanits, L. 1989. Russian Folk Belief, Armonk and London: M. E. Sharpe Inc., pp.
136 153.
L€uthi, M. 1976. Once upon a Time: On the Nature of Fairy Tales, trans. L.
Chadeayne and P. Gottwald. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, pp. 35 46.
Revenant | 1091
Revenant
relations, children, or property; a person who hid his or her money; or someone
who left behind a task undone or a promise unfulfilled; (2) the avengers, for
instance, people who were maltreated, bewitched, or murdered; slaughtered chil-
dren; aborted fetuses; or unaccepted potential children; and (3) those dissatisfied
with the manner of their burial, burial place, or the behavior of the mourners, for
example, those negligently or wrongly shrouded, unburied, or buried in unconse-
crated ground; those not buried as they wished; those mourned for excessively or
not mourned at all; and those buried with incomplete body or belongings. Mem-
bers of the third group also might be termed the ‘‘unprovided.’’ Ancestor worship
has always been a central cult in the societies that hold beliefs in figures such as
home-wanderers and revenants. The dead are conceived as guardians of morals,
arbiters of behavior, and supporters of an organized society. The dead who reveal
themselves to the living people fulfill their obligations to proper norms.
Deceased children of Nordic tradition provide an illustrative example of reve-
nants who interfere in the life of their community. This category of revenant—a
wandering, placeless soul lacking a position or status in the twin community of the
living and the dead—is in a permanent transition phase. The basic problem con-
cerning the majority of the Nordic deceased children is that they have no status ei-
ther among the living or the dead. These ‘‘supranormal dead children’’ may be
divided into many categories, such as those murdered or abandoned, those who
died before being baptized or given a name, those who were stillborn, those prema-
turely born, and so on. What is common to all of them is that they all died before
the completion of the rites necessary for establishing their first status in the society.
Their position is problematic, as they did not have time to join any living social
group. A common means of signaling membership is naming. In fact, the name
was the most important symbol of status long before the advent of Christianity,
with its emphasis on the Christian baptismal rite as the entrance of a newborn child
into legitimate status. So vital was the name that Icelandic sagas and Old Nordic
provincial laws of the missionary period state that abandoning a child with a name
was considered murder. If a child had not belonged to the community of the living,
he or she could not be incorporated among the dead. Burial rites were either not
performed at all or performed in a special way.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Belief, Folk; Religion, Folk; Vampire.
References
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1968. The Nordic Dead-Child Tradition: Nordic Dead-Child
Beigns A Study in Comparative Religion. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1989. The Dead without Status. In Nordic Folklore: Recent
Studies, eds. Reimund Kvideland and Henning K. Sehmsdorf, with Elizabeth Simpson.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Reversal | 1093
Reversal
The common view that the spirit world is an opposite version of the phenomenal
world, in both form and function. In the spirit world of the Hopi, ‘‘everything is the
other way around, just the opposite.’’ According to Mircea Eliade, ‘‘The peoples of
North Asia conceive the otherworld as an inverted image of this world. Everything
takes place as it does here, but in reverse. When it is day on earth, it is night in the
beyond (this is why festivals of the dead are held after sunset; that is when they
wake and begin their day); the summer of the living corresponds to winter in the
land of the dead; a scarcity of game or fish on earth means that it is plentiful in the
otherworld.’’ The dead may be buried face down (a reversal of the sleeping position
of the living), so as to ensure their passage to the other world, or their clothing may
be put on (or, in ancient Egypt, be put into the tomb) inside out. Clothing also may
be reversed to undo the effects of the evil eye. Since the spirit world is frequently
consulted by means of reflecting surfaces—mirrors, water, oil, crystal balls—it is
likely that the phenomenon of mirror image brings this conception into being.
The reversed quality of the spirit world reveals itself not only in actions but also
in the distinction between left and right. Perhaps because most people are right-
handed (but their reflection is left-handed), the left is taken to be the side of the
spirits, and left-handed people are often viewed with suspicion. In Henri Boguet’s
sixteenth-century account, the werewolf was said to eat only from the left side of
the children it killed. In Paleolithic impressions of the human hand, according to
G. Rachel Levy, ‘‘the negative impressions, produced by painting or blowing col-
our on to the rock surface round the flattened member, are generally of the left
hand; the positive records of the paint-covered palm and fingers are chiefly of the
right.’’ The plastic mani cornute, or horned hands, which are worn to ward off the
evil eye, always represent the left hand. It is easy to see why the left is associated
with awkwardness, as is suggested by such words as the French (and English)
gauche, German linkisch, and Norwegian keitet: Most people are right-handed
and less ‘‘adroit’’ with their left. But because of its association with the spirit
world, the left also has a spooky quality, as is suggested by the Latin word for
‘‘left’’ that has given us sinister in English. Latin scaevus means ‘‘left, awkward,
unlucky,’’ as does Greek skai os. In Hungarian, the word for ‘‘left’’ is bal. Balfog
as
is ‘‘blunder’’ or ‘‘mistake,’’ but baljoslat
uis ‘‘ill-omened’’ or ‘‘ominous.’’
The distinction between right and left shows up in a great deal of folklore. Tra-
ditionally in Europe, people were enjoined to get out of the right side of the bed
in the morning, rather than the left. But the word right, since it is associated with
the human world rather than the world of the spirits, has come to have the mean-
ing of ‘‘correct,’’ so that it is opposed not just to left but also to wrong, and nowa-
days one hears the remark, when someone shows ill temper, that he or she must
have ‘‘gotten out of the wrong side of the bed.’’
1094 | Revitalization
Relics of this sort of reversal are still common, as when one wishes an actor
well by telling him or her to break a leg. In Popular Beliefs and Superstitions, an
informant from Ohio says, ‘‘You should always say, ‘I hope you break a leg.’ If
you wish them good luck, it means bad luck for them.’’ That is, the spirits may
respond with a reversal of the outcome that is appealed for. Thus, there is a com-
mon belief that it is unwise to praise anything good or valuable, as such praise is
apt to spoil it. Such a custom as couvade (in which a father-to-be may dress in
women’s clothing and feign birthing) is probably to be understood in terms of
this reversal of the spirit world, and this may be true also of the transvestitism
sometimes practiced by shamans.
Paul Barber
See Also Belief, Folk; Shamanism.
References
Boguet, Henri. 1590. Discours des sorciers (Passage on werewolves). Translated in
1986, A Lycanthropy Reader: Werewolves in Western Culture, ed. Charlotte F. Otten.
Syracuse, NY: Syracuse University Press.
Courlander, Harold, ed. 1982. Hopi Voices: Recollections, Traditions, and Narratives
of the Hopi Indians. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.
Eliade, Mircea. 1972. Shamanism: Archaic Techniques of Ecstasy. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Levy, G. Rachel. 1963. Religious Conceptions of the Stone Age. New York: Harper
& Row.
Puckett, Newbell Niles. 1981. Popular Beliefs and Superstitions: A Compendium of
American Folklore, eds. Wayland D. Hand, Anna Casetta, and Sondra B. Thiederman.
Boston: G. K. Hall.
Revitalization
References:
Aberle, David F. 1966. The Peyote Religion among the Navaho. Chicago: Aldine Press.
Burridge, Kenelm. 1969. New Heaven, New Earth: A Study of Millenarian Activities.
New York: Schocken Books.
Durkheim, Emile. 1957. Elementary Forms of Religious Life. Glencoe, IL: Free
Press.
1096 | Revivals
Spier, Leslie. 1935. The Prophet Dance of the Northwest and Its Derivatives: The
Source of the Ghost Dance. Menasha, WI: Banta Press.
Wallace, Anthony F. C. 1969. The Death and Rebirth of the Seneca. New York:
Random House.
Wilson, Bryan R. 1973. Magic and the Millennium. New York: Harper and Row.
Revivals
References
Boyes, Georgina. 1993. The Imagined Village: Culture, Ideology and the English
Folk Revival. Manchester, England: Manchester University Press.
Stekert, Ellen J. 1993. Cents and Nonsense in the Urban Folksong Movement: 1930
66. In Transforming Tradition: Folk Music Revivals Examined, ed. Neil V. Rosenberg.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Wilson, Joe, and Lee Udall. 1982. Folk Festivals. Knoxville: University of Tennes-
see Press.
Rhetorical Analysis
In its most general terms, the study of the relations between language and inten-
tion, especially the function of discourse in communicating ideas and shaping
knowledge. Rhetoricians since Plato have placed emphasis on the speaker, the
audience, the nature of the message, and the constitution of persuasive form.
Each historical period has created its own configuration of primary rhetorical
issues, such as the relation of rhetorical principles to pedagogy, treatment of the
rhetorical processes of composition (that is, canons of invention, arrangement,
style, memory, and delivery), and attention to either performance or text. Since
the classical period, rhetoricians have remained committed to the following
assumptions: (1) The rhetorician must have a command of conventional dis-
course forms and a complementary understanding of the contextual variables that
define and constrain performance occasions; (2) although they recognize the con-
ventional nature of language, rhetoricians have typically assumed that human na-
ture could be defined in universal terms, thus allowing the rhetorician to predict
how to create certain persuasive effects; (3) rhetoricians have promoted the study
of rhetorical theory and practice as a pursuit that is fundamental to the develop-
ment of intellectual skills and moral character; and (4) rhetoricians in every era
have associated an education in rhetorical skills with the development of a liter-
ate citizenry.
Rhetorical analysis had its greatest impact on folklore scholarship of the sec-
ond half of the twentieth century when Dell Hymes, Roger Abrahams, and
others, adapting rhetorical principles of situations and strategies as outlined by
Kenneth Burke, reconceptualized folklore as a study of performance. Abrahams
saw Burke’s concept of persuasion and performance as a means to integrate
diverse approaches to the study of art. The introduction of the concept of per-
formance provided an alternative to the text-centered perspective scholars had
previously utilized; now, scholars considered questions of form and the relation
between components as part of a larger performance context involving the rela-
tions between performer, text or object, and audience. With the influence of
Burke’s rhetorical approach to art as persuasive communication, folklore studies
Rhetorical Analysis | 1099
References
Abrahams, Roger D. 1968. A Rhetoric of Everyday Life: Traditional Conversational
Genres. Southern Folklore Quarterly 32: 44 59.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1968. Introductory Remarks to a Rhetorical Theory of Folklore.
Journal of American Folklore 81: 143 158.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1977. Toward an Enactment-Centered Theory of Folklore. In
Frontiers of Folklore, ed. William R. Bascom. Boulder: Westview Press.
Burke, Kenneth. 1961. The Philosophy of Literary Form. New York: Vintage.
Burke, Kenneth. 1962. A Grammar of Motives. Berkeley: University of California
Press.
Burke, Kenneth. 1966. Language as Symbolic Action: Essays on Life, Literature and
Method. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Conquergood, Dwight. 1992. Ethnography, Rhetoric, and Performance. Quarterly
Journal of Speech 78: 80 123.
Hymes, Dell. 1972. The Contribution of Folklore to Sociolinguistic Research. In
Toward New Perspectives in Folklore, eds. Americo Paredes and Richard Bauman.
Austin: University of Texas Press.
Schaffer, John D. 1989. The Use and Misuse of Giambattista Vico: Rhetoric, Orality,
and Theories of Discourse. The New Historicism, ed. H. Aram Veeser. New York:
Routledge.
Shotter, John. 1993. Cultural Politics of Everyday Life: Social Constructionism,
Rhetoric, and Knowing of the Third Kind. Toronto: University of Toronto Press.
Riddle
The best-known and best-studied form of traditional enigma. The riddle is gener-
ally agreed to consist of a description and its referent—the first posed by the rid-
dler, the second guessed by the respondent. The enigma comes from the
incorporation of a ‘‘block element’’ in the description: an ambiguity that prevents
Riddle | 1101
the description from being obvious. The ambiguity may occur at any level of the
linguistic code from the phonological to the semantic, and it is often presented as
an opposition or paradox within the description (‘‘What has eyes but cannot
see?—A potato’’).
The ‘‘true riddle,’’ as it is often called, relies on concrete, familiar objects in the
culture, and it equates two things through the use of a metaphor. The implications
of favorite metaphors are elaborated through numerous riddles in a given tradition.
In Finnish riddles, for example, women are commonly compared to trees:
Rowan tree on a sacred hill, sacred leaves in the rowan tree. (Bride)
A sacred rowan tree, on the edge of a sacred field, a sacred berry in the
rowan tree.
(Pregnant woman)
A widow in the fall, a widow in the winter, a new bride in summer.
(Deciduous tree)
A thousand-year-old woman has a child every year. (Pine tree with cones)
and homogeneous societies, where the narrow range of material culture limits
the universe of riddle referents and, more important, where a common system of
beliefs and values can be taken for granted.
The riddles of paradox and anomaly belong to heterogeneous societies in which
paradox and anomaly are likely to figure prominently in everyday experience.
Riddle anomalies tend to occur at the level of language rather than in the world
referred to: They are problems in the code (‘‘What room can no one enter?—A
mushroom’’). Indeed, as W. J. Pepicello and Thomas A. Green suggest, the real
referent of contemporary riddles is the linguistic code itself. And the question of
code is perhaps the real challenge of contemporary culture; before any debate on
the nature of reality can take place, a common language has to be established. The
presence of conflicting cultural codes may enter riddling directly. In one session,
a Chicano child asked the Anglo folklorist John McDowell, ‘‘Why do you need a
moustache?—So you won’t be a bolillo [white].’’
Generalizing broadly, then, members of traditional societies use riddles to pro-
pound their culture’s rules and to integrate these rules into a larger synthesis. In
complex societies, in which riddling is generally limited to children, riddling
teaches the importance of message form and the particular context. The analyti-
cal skills and cognitive flexibility learned in riddling prepare children for the pit-
falls inherent in reading contemporary messages.
Dorothy Noyes
See Also Enigma, Folk.
References
Fernandez, James. 1986. Edification by Puzzlement. In Persuasions and Performan-
ces. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
K€ong€as-Maranda, Elli. 1971. The Logic of Riddles. In The Structural Analysis of
Oral Tradition, eds. Elli K€ong€as-Maranda and Pierre Maranda. Philadelphia: University
of Pennsylvania Press.
McDowell, John. 1979. Children’s Riddling. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Pepicello, W. J., and Thomas A. Green. 1984. The Language of Riddles. Columbus:
Ohio State University Press.
Taylor, Archer. 1951. English Riddles from Oral Tradition. Berkeley and Los
Angeles: University of California Press.
Riddle Joke
A joke in the form of a traditional enigma. Although the riddle joke is couched
as a question, the respondent is not expected to arrive at a solution; rather, the
poser follows up with the answer after a short pause.
Riddle Joke | 1103
Riddle jokes often circulate in cycles relating to a current event, such as the
1986 explosion of the U.S. space shuttle Challenger, the 1986 meltdown at the
Chernobyl nuclear plant in the Ukraine, a political campaign, or a celebrity scan-
dal. Other foci of cycles include stigmatized social groups (such as Polish immi-
grants in the United States); powerful public figures (such as the hated Romanian
dictator Nicolae Ceauşescu); an action frame (screwing in a light bulb); and such
absurd or horrific dramatis personae as elephants and dead babies. The poser of-
ten tops one joke with another, and jokes build on the form of earlier jokes in a
kind of dialogue. Such cycles circulate rapidly and enjoy wide popularity while
the topic or the jokes themselves are current.
Riddle joke cycles address, whether openly or in symbolic disguise, matters
that deeply trouble a society. Disasters and scandals undermine the claims of the
established order to competence and integrity. Dominated populations, by their
very existence and certainly by their movements to gain equal treatment, threaten
the position of those already inside the structures of power. The anxieties of
the privileged persist even when overt prejudice has been eschewed: Roger D.
Abrahams and Alan Dundes, observing that the vogue of elephant jokes in the
United States coincided with the rise of the civil rights movement, suggest that
the images of elephant footprints in refrigerators or elephants in treetops
expressed unconscious fear of African Americans ‘‘forgetting their place.’’
Finally, unsettling social change emerges in such cycles as the dead-baby jokes
of the 1970s, apparently linked to the new visibility of divorce, contraception,
and abortion in North America.
Children’s riddle joke cycles are particularly apt to test the margins of the
speakable, as in the well-known ‘‘gross jokes.’’ Their covert circulation in class-
rooms and schoolyards challenges the world of euphemism and normative con-
duct constructed in children’s textbooks. In the same way, the much-condemned
brutality of the Challenger jokes (‘‘What was the last thing that went through
Christa McAuliffe’s head?—Her ass’’) is seen by Elliott Oring as a critique of
the media’s banalization of disaster. He notes the jarring effect of commercial
interruptions upon images of catastrophe and how the jokes play upon this juxta-
position by frequent use of advertising slogans and brand names. ‘‘Sick’’ or
obscene jokes, then, restore the horror of the world suppressed in official dis-
course. Unprintable, they resist co-optation into that discourse.
The performance of riddle jokes is often buffered by disclaimers on both ends.
The joke is presented as something heard recently, thus not originating with the
poser; the poser may add further distance by disparagement (‘‘I heard an awful
one yesterday’’). The respondent mitigates his or her laughter by exclamations of
disgust or by apology (‘‘I shouldn’t laugh, but it’s such a bad pun’’).
The form of the riddle joke may ease the broaching of these delicate matters in
conversation. Its brevity and tight construction (rendering it impersonal and
1104 | Ritual
almost aphoristic) and its topicality (giving it the status of news) remove the bur-
den of responsibility for its content from the poser. Moreover, the collaborative
form of the riddle, which demands at least a ritual grunt of interest after the ques-
tion is posed, implicates the respondent in the joke. Both parties have collabo-
rated in allowing the unspeakable to be spoken.
The riddle joke is one of the most common joking forms today, and individual
jokes are probably the most widely transmitted items of folklore in the contempo-
rary United States. The same formal qualities that allow them to speak of controver-
sial matters make them memorable and conducive to rapid transmission. Moreover,
the focus on topics made general throughout a national population by the mass
media allows jokes to be passed between comparative strangers. Although commu-
nity-specific riddle joke cycles do exist, local background knowledge is unneces-
sary for the appreciation of most riddle jokes. Thus, riddle jokes are widely used as
social icebreakers. Dealing with general issues, they can serve as a basis for broad
consensus and become a means of testing the waters in the establishment of provi-
sional solidarities between new acquaintances. The respondent’s appreciation or
disapproval of a joke is a measure of social and political affiliations—it indicates
the respondent’s willingness to form an alliance with the poser in the face of a puta-
tive Other.
Dorothy Noyes
See Also Enigma, Folk; Ethnic Folklore; Joke; Popular Culture.
References
Dundes, Alan. 1987. Cracking Jokes: Studies of Sick Humor Cycles and Stereotypes.
Berkeley, CA: Ten Speed Press.
Oring, Elliott. 1987. Jokes and the Discourse on Disaster. Journal of American Folk-
lore 100: 276 286.
Wolfenstein, Martha. 1954. Children’s Humor: A Psychological Analysis. Glencoe,
IL: Free Press.
Ritual
set of events is well known to the participants of the ritual, and there are certain
conventionalized expectations concerning their behavior. Although very important
symbols and central values of a group are evoked, it would be false to assume any
direct link between the outward expressions and inner states of the participants in
a ritual. In order to find a satisfactory definition of the term ritual, the partici-
pants’ attitudes concerning the ceremony, social custom, and religious doctrine
should be taken into consideration.
Ritual as a category of action is characterized by predictable structure over
time, a structuring that is commonly labeled repetitive. In distinguishing ritual
from other behavior, it is imperative to establish the difference between compul-
sive actions, private repetitive idiosyncrasies, and ritual per se. Ritual is separa-
ble from individual compulsive behavior by reference to the social dimension of
the former.
Initiation
Rites formalizing the passage of an individual or group into a new social or religious
status. Puberty rites, ceremonies that symbolize the transformation of youths into
adults, are the most common form of initiation worldwide. However, formal cere-
monies of initiation precede admission into communal organizations of all kinds,
including priesthoods, military orders, schools, sodalities, secret societies, and clubs.
Aboriginal boy being painted for his important initiation and circumcision ceremony at
Yathalamarra, Arnhem Land, Australia. (Penny Tweedie/Corbis)
1106 | Ritual
The nature of initiation rites varies widely. Some are intensely public occasions
distinguished by ritual scarification or circumcision. Others, especially if initiation
entails the acquisition of secret or special knowledge, take place away from the
public eye under remote or private circumstances. Extraordinary ordeals and rigor-
ous group tests are commonly part of the initiation procedure if solidarity among
initiates and the organization they are entering is a primary goal. Still other initia-
tions merely signal the altered status of the initiates with unexceptional rituals little
removed from ordinary social behavior. Among occupational groups, initiation may
take the form of pranks in which the new person on a crew is made the butt of a
work-related practical joke.
The French folklorist Arnold van Gennep (1873–1957) was the first to recognize
that, despite specific differences in content, initiation rituals throughout the world
tend to have similar, tripartite structures. According to him, such rites invariably
consist of an initial phase that symbolically separates the initiates from their
former status, a marginal or liminal period of transition, and a final phase of reincor-
poration with the group at the new status. Van Gennep also noted that initiation
rituals share this tripartite form with weddings and funerals, two other key rites de
passage that ritually symbolize and sanctify progressive transit through life and
society.
D. Bruce Dickson
with the shifts in seasonal employment, such as rites for sowing and harvesting
grain and ceremonies for opening a new year. The third group consists of rites of
passage, rituals that are associated with different phases of human life such as
birth, childhood, puberty, initiation or entry into adult status, engagement, mar-
riage, maternal confinement, fatherhood, transfer into another social status, and
death. Lauri Honko defines rites of passage as traditional ceremonies organized
by the community through which the individual is transferred from one social
status to another.
The focus of each of the types differs not only in terms of occasion but also
in terms of the subjects of the rites. Rites of passage focus tightly on changes in
the social position of the individual, whereas calendrical rites or ceremonies con-
cerning changes in seasonal employment generally affect the entire community
Rites of Passage
A category of rituals or rites that accompany change of place, state, social status,
and age. A human life cycle is marked by these passages from one social and physi-
cal position to another, in a pattern determined by the physiological and psychologi-
cal maturation of an individual as well as the cultural socialization pattern and
worldview of the community. Some of these transitions take place only once in an
individual’s life (e.g., birth, initiation, death), and some may occur repeatedly (transi-
tion from a profane role to the holy one as a specialist of the sacred).
This theory was set forth by anthropologist Arnold van Gennep in his influential
book The Rites of Passage, published in 1909. Van Gennep was particularly interested
in crossing territorial borders. According to him, all the rites of passage fall naturally
into three phases: rites of separation, when the individual is removed from a previous
status; rites of transition, when one is prepared to transfer to a new position; and rites
of incorporation, when the individual takes on a new status role. In rites of passage,
both the individual, as a ritual subject, and those present at the rites undergo a
clear-cut change in their social relationships and, in this way, are afforded formal ac-
ceptance and recognition. The transfer does not take place suddenly but is a gradual
process when the individual who is going through this stage takes on a temporary
and intermediary role during the process of transition (e.g., the role of an initiate).
Van Gennep’s basic model is structural. According to his definition, rites of passage
accompany every change of place, state, social position, and age. In many traditional
communities, these changes generally are made public, with their importance reinforced
by specifically structured rites. First comes the stage of separation in which the individual
is removed from a previous social position. This is followed by an interim period, marge,
during which the individual is poised on the borderline between two positions (a previ-
ous status and a new one). The third and last phase is the full entry into the new status
(aggregation). The impact that van Gennep’s theory has had on the study of ritual and
religions is wide ranging, having influenced scholars in a variety of disciplines.
Juha Pentik€ainen
1108 | Ritual
Newlyweds tour on boats during a traditional Chinese group wedding in the Shajiabang
Scenic Spot in Changshu, east China’s Jiangsu Province, 2008. The couples wear the tra-
ditional red. (AP/Wide World Photos)
Ritual | 1109
Transition Ritual
A category of ritual by which a symbolic threshold is crossed; a status-free period
in which participants enter a betwixt and between state that is trespassed upon
and left behind, and the status structure is set anew. Transition rituals are transfor-
matory by nature. In the course of a transition ritual, the status of the participant is
transformed to a new and ordered one. In that respect, a transition ritual might be
viewed as a means of safeguarding culturally patterned structures and overcoming
the difficulties of status changes and other periods of potential confusions. In the
terminology suggested by Arnold van Gennep, transition rites are a subcategory of
rites of passage. Crossing a threshold is a necessary minimal criterion for the defini-
tion of transition rites.
According to social anthropologist Victor W. Turner (1920–1983), a shift from a
temporary liminal phase is accomplished by means of transition rituals. Using a sym-
bolic approach, Turner attempts to identify the essential and primary attributes of a
ritual as perceived by participants in that ritual. A transition rite can be conceived
of as a process of transformation that, in Turner’s opinion, could be compared to
heating water to the boiling point or the change a pupa goes through to become a
moth. Transitional rituals can take a variety of forms, including calendrical rites, con-
secration rituals and conversions, initiations (or confirmations), and funeral rites.
Juha Pentik€ainen
1110 | Ritual
activity that, under specific circumstances, either confirms or transforms the relation-
ships and boundaries that prevail between the individual, community, and cosmos.
Various other areas of ritual research remain viable. The historical approach is
mainly centered on the role that ritual plays in the process of transmitting the cul-
tural and religious knowledge and symbols and in the formation of the identity
and invention of the past of the society, community, or group. Related to the his-
torical approach is the problem of the relation of myth to ritual; there is no uni-
versal pattern or consistent theory on the priority of either myth or ritual. A final
group of approaches compares ritual actions and means of performance to the
means and modes of dramatic actions.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Anthropology, Symbolic; Divination; Liminality; Magic; Medicine, Folk;
Myth-Ritual Theory; Religion, Folk.
References
Grimes, Ronald. 1985. Research in Ritual Studies: A Programmatic Essay and Bibli-
ography. Metuchen, NJ: Scarecrow.
Kusch, Rodolfo. 2010. Indigenous and Popular Thinking in America. Durham, NC:
Duke University Press.
Lewis, Gilbert. 1980. Day of Shining Red: An Essay on Understanding Ritual. Cam-
bridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological Study
of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1986. Transition Rites. In Transition Rites, ed. Ugo Bianchi.
Rome: L’Erma di Bretschneider.
Pilgrim, Richard B. 1978. Ritual. In Introduction to the Study of Religion, ed.
William T. Hall. San Francisco: Harper and Row.
Skorupski, John. 1976. Symbol and Theory: A Philosophical Study of Theories of
Religion in Social Anthropology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Stavans, Ilan, ed. 2010. Quincea~
nera. Santa Barbara, CA: Greenwood.
Turner, Victor W. 1969. The Ritual Process: Structure and Anti-Structure. Chicago:
Aldine.
Turner, Victor W. 1974. Dramas, Fields and Metaphors: Symbolic Action in Human
Society. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
van Gennep, Arnold. 1960. Rites of Passage, trans. Monika B. Vizedom and
Gabrielle L. Caffee. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Zuesse, Evan M. 1987. Ritual. In Encyclopedia of Religion, vol. 12, ed. Mircea
Eliade. New York: Macmillan.
Zumwalt, Rosemary Levy. 1988. The Enigma of Arnold van Gennep (1873 1957):
Master of French Folklore and Hermit of Bourg-la-Reine. Helsinki: Academia Scientia-
rum Fennica.
Robin Hood | 1111
Robin Hood
English outlaw hero and archer who first appears in Langland’s Piers Plowman
(ca. 1377). This source is not explicit on Robin’s status as a robber of the rich,
but by the first half of the following century, his persona as a noble robber and
friend of the poor and oppressed is commonplace. The means of Robin Hood’s
early celebration are a number of early ballads and the major work known as A
Mery Geste of Robyn Hoode. Although Robin is a commoner in these works (he
is not elevated to the aristocracy until the seventeenth century), the world of the
Geste is that of the rich and powerful. The Sheriff of Nottingham appears in his
role of arch villain. There are knights, abbots, nobles, and notables, as well as the
king himself. In the end, Robin helps the king and is received into his service.
But after a while, Robin’s nostalgia for the greenwood compel him to ask
the king for permission to visit his old haunts again. The king grants him a week.
Robin returns to the forest, rejoins his band, and his week’s holiday extends to
twenty-two years, during which time he refuses to accept the monarch’s author-
ity. Finally, he is betrayed to death by the prioress and Sir Roger. As given by F.
1112 | Robin Hood
J. Child, the various versions of the Geste present Robin as a heroic figure and
usually conclude unequivocally with the verse:
References
Chappell, W. [1859] 1965. Popular Music of the Olden Time, 2 vols. New York:
Dover Publications.
Child, F. J. [1882 1898] 1965. The English and Scottish Popular Ballads, 5 vols.
New York: Dover.
Romantic Nationalism | 1115
Dobson, R. B., and J. Taylor. [1976] 1989. Rymes of Robin Hood: An Introduction
to the English Outlaw, 2nd. rev. ed. Gloucester, UK: Allan Sutton.
Keen, M. 1961. The Outlaws of Medieval Legend. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Knight, S. 1994. Robin Hood: A Complete Study of the English Outlaw. Oxford, UK:
Blackwell.
Lloyd, A. [1967] 1970. Folksong in England. New York: International Publishers, 1970.
Maddicott, J. R. 1978. The Birth and Setting of the Ballads of Robin Hood. English
Historical Review 93.
Page, D. 1973. Folktales in Homer’s Odyssey. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press.
Purslow, F., ed. 1965. Marrow Bones: English Folk Songs from the Hammond and
Gardiner Mss. London: EFDS Publications.
Vaughan Williams, R., and A. Lloyd, A., eds. 1959. The Penguin Book of English
Folk Songs. Harmondsworth, Middlesex: Penguin, esp. pp. 88 89 for ‘‘Robin Hood and
the Pedlar.’’
Williams, A. 1923. Folk Songs of the Upper Thames. London: Duckworth & Co.
Romantic Nationalism
A cultural movement combining the romantic focus on the primitive or the com-
mon man or woman and older literary forms with the advocacy of national and
ethnic pride through the development of the literature, language, and traditions
of the group. Romantic nationalism led to the collection and literary imitation of
traditional art forms, and as a consequence, it gave impetus to the discipline of
folklore during its formative stage.
Ideas of romanticism and romantic nationalism developed toward the end of
the eighteenth century. By the beginning of the nineteenth century, this phenom-
enon already had become a large-scale movement that had deeply influenced
ideas and ideals of individuality, creativity, and personal experience. Romantic
trends also played a significant role in the development of nationalism and the
concept of nation-state. The ideals of romantic nationalism inspired an interest in
antiquity, ancient traditions, and folklore. The works of philosophers such as
Johann Wolfgang von Goethe, A. W. and Friedrich von Schelling, Friedrich von
Schlegel, and Jean-Jacques Rousseau formed part of the necessary ideological
background of romanticism. Among a number of emerging nations arose a need
for re-creating or reconstructing indigenous mythical pasts, poetic landscapes,
and golden ages, often for the purpose of supporting a case for nation-state status.
Idealistic initiatives inspired an interest in folklore, and thus awoke wide-scale
activity for collecting folklore materials in nineteenth-century Europe.
By 1765, Thomas Percy already had published a collection entitled Reliques
of Ancient English Poetry. This work provided great impetus for the publishing
1116 | Romantic Nationalism
the Renaissance (serving as a model for Paradise Lost by John Milton). This was
the case especially in western and southern Europe. German romanticism, how-
ever, took Homer’s works as the primary pattern for the epos at the end of the
eighteenth century. Examples following this model are the national epics of some
Finnic and Baltic peoples. Elias L€onnrot compiled the Finnish national epic, The
Kalevala, on the basis of folk poetry. The first edition appeared in 1835, the sec-
ond and greatly enlarged edition in 1849. The Estonian counterpart of the Finnish
Kalevala was the epic called Kalevipoeg (1857–1861), compiled by F. R.
Kreutzwald. He used as building material local legends and tales of origin.
Andrejs Pumpurs, the author of the Latvian national epos L~ acpl~esis (Bear slayer;
1888), created his epic poem on the basis of Latvian etiological tales, folktales,
local legends, wedding songs, and other items excerpted from folklore. The Song
of Hiawatha (1855), by Henry Wadsworth Longfellow, also follows a similar
pattern of development.
In Germany, Wilhelm Jordan created the epic Die Nibelunge (The Nibelungs [a
family name]), consisting of two parts: Die Sigridsage (The story of Sigrid; 1868)
1118 | Romantic Nationalism
and Hildebrands Heimkehr (1874). In his Epische Briefe (Epic epistle), Jordan
declared that he was in fact ‘‘the German Homer,’’ a kind of embodiment or incar-
nation of an epic poet, matured in the right stage of development of the people.
A similar phenomenon, though one based within a different ideological frame-
work, was characteristic of numerous ethnic minorities in the former Soviet
Union. Romantic nationalism in its Soviet incarnation sprang originally from a
statement emphasizing the creation of a high culture national in form, socialist in
content, and international in spirit. Cultural life in many of the Soviet Union’s
socialist republics was, for the most part, based on traditional forms. Many of the
peoples in these areas did not previously have arts based on so-called modern
civilization. The culture witnessed a merging of old forms and new contents.
Cultural clubs and circles began to form, especially during the mid 1930s. At its
inception, the program consisted of pure folk performances. Gradually, texts
propagating the new system began to be devised according to the traditional
schemes, and new melodies greatly reminiscent of folksongs were composed.
During the Soviet period, a great number of epics were published. Those compo-
sitions created on the basis of diverse versions of the K€ oroglu (Korogly, Gurguli)
epics known, among others, to the Azers, Uzbeks, Turkmens, and Tajiks serve as
examples. There are also epics based on a version by a particular singer. The Uzbek
epics Alpamys and Rustamhan, published on the basis of versions performed by
Fazil Coldas-ogli
(F. Juldasevic), serve as examples. During the Soviet period,
these and many other epics were subjected at times to censure and became the
focus of ideological debate, but this is something that seems to be the fate of epics
in general.
During the twentieth century, various manifestations of romantic and political
nationalism have flourished in Asia, Africa, and South America. The role folklore
has played in the cultural and social processes of these continents varies from pre-
liminary efforts in collecting folklore items to diverse uses of folklore in cultural
and national movements. Nationalism is unique to the specific contexts in which
it develops, and the historical and political conditions under which it may arise
are diverse. However, it may not be appropriate to use the term nationalism in an
excessively wide range of contexts.
For numerous nations, folklore collections have been crucial for the creation
of indigenous identity, cultural life, and fine arts; in some cases, collections have
provided an impetus for the development of the written language. An interest in
traditional culture characteristically has been stimulated by a romantic idealistic
current represented by a nucleus group of cultural activists or some idealistic or-
ganization. The wide-scale collection and publication of folklore arising out of
such stimuli has often been the last opportunity to record a nation’s vanishing
cultural heritage. Generally speaking, the wide-scale activation of interest in
folklore has emerged from a desire to reinforce the nation’s self-esteem and to
Romantic Nationalism | 1119
arouse respect for the nation’s own language and culture. Wide-scale collection
has been the starting point for the creation of archives and collections and for
publications of folk material. It also has acted as a source for a mainstream in
which literary epics and other literary products based on folklore are born and
for pictorial, musical, and dramatic art drawing on traditional themes and ele-
ments. Arguments that the collection does not displace attention to the past but
rather that the past is in service of the collection are contradicted by a broad
knowledge of cultural history across national and historical contexts. In fact,
folklore should be studied not only in ‘‘pristine’’ but also in applied forms.
According to some authors, the discipline of folklore arose partly from back-
ward-looking or anti-modern perspectives. It is possible that the feeling of ‘‘over-
civilization’’ in the West during the modernization period was in the air in the
western regions of nineteenth-century Europe or the United States, but that was
not the case in central, eastern, and northern regions of Europe.
The discipline of folklore arose in the period of romantic nationalism from an
essentially modern perspective. It was the aspiration toward modernity in eastern
and northern Europe that led intellectuals to promote broad interest in folklore,
language, and heritage. Thus, toward the end of the nineteenth century, national
awakening and social mobility—and, as a consequence, education in the native
tongue—represented the road leading to modernity. Peoples without their history,
language, and identity created national literature and literary language, discovered
or re-created their roots in the past, and formed a compendium of (modern) national
myths and symbols, including flags, anthems, and national festivities. Romantic
nationalism has not only been able to resist the rational and secular force of mod-
ernity, it has also been part of the modernization process and complemented politi-
cal, technical, and scientific development of the period. It was an inspiring force in
the creation process of nations, especially among peoples struggling for indepen-
dence in nineteenth-century Europe and also in countries striving for national unity.
It is true that, in many cases, nation-states are composed of more or less heter-
ogeneous cultural, economic, linguistic, ethnic, or religious elements. Further-
more, it is necessary to keep in mind that the romantic movement developed and
was manifested in many different ways, and nationalism has taken distinct phe-
notypes at different times and in diverse types of states. It is possible to make the
distinction between cultural nationalism, aiming mainly at the creation of cul-
tural identity through the use of folklore, art, music, literature, and political
nationalism, striving for national identity through political movements and in
times with uncompromising imperatives. In the nineteenth century, the most
powerful ideological bases were the Herderian humanist cultural and national
idealism and (especially toward the end of the century) the Hegelian doctrines of
national spirit and its evolutionary power. The expansionist forms of political
nationalism periodically rushed forward during the twentieth century with
1120 | Romantic Nationalism
different applications, the results of which are well known. Such forms of politi-
cal nationalism seem to show up regularly, despite the fact that some scholars
have thought that the impulse was already past its peak.
In our times, the resurrection or actualization of romantic nationalism, often
based on ancient mythic and heroic figures and symbols, is, in many cases, a
response to the decline of the modernist identity. In its entirety, the situation is
very complex, with traditionalist, religious, and ethnic variations. But as we have
witnessed, during this new era as well, national identity takes on many forms
according to the political situation—from forms of peaceful rediscovery or crea-
tion of cultural identity to expansionist tendencies leading, in the worst cases, to
situations wherein we can no longer speak about romantic but only about tragic
nationalism. Romantic nationalism is not a homogeneous or unitary phenom-
enon, and all nationalistic uses of folklore materials are not necessarily romantic.
The rhetoric of nationalism is based on diverse cultural, social, and political
processes, and the role that folklore (and folklorists) plays in them is dependent
on varying political aims and sociohistorical and sociocultural contexts.
Lauri Harvilahti
See Also Ethnic Folklore; Folklorismus/Folklorism; Literary Approach.
References
Abrahams, Roger. 1993. Phantoms of Romantic Nationalism in Folkloristics. Journal
of American Folklore 106: 33 37.
Anderson, Benedict. 1983. Imagined Communities: Reflections on the Origin and
Spread of Nationalism. London: Verso.
Friedman, Jonathan. 1992. Narcissism, Roots and Postmodernity: The Constitution
of Selfhood in the Global Crisis. In Modernity and Identity, eds. S. Lash and J. Fried-
man. Oxford: Blackwell.
Hobsbawm, E. J. 1990. Nations and Nationalism since 1780: Programme, Myth,
Reality. Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.
Hobsbawm, Eric J., and Terence Ranger. 1983. The Invention of Tradition. Cam-
bridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.
Hroch, Miroslav. 1985. Der Wachen kleiner Nationalen als Problem der kompara-
tiven sozialgeschichtlichen Forschung. In Nationalismus, ed. H. A. Winkler. K€onigstein,
Germany: Athen€aum.
Oinas, Felix J. 1978. Folklore, Nationalism and Politics. Columbus, OH: Slavica Publishers.
Smith, Anthony D. 1984. Ethnic Myths and Ethnic Revivals. European Journal of
Sociology 25: 283 305.
Trap~ans, J. A. 1989. Krisj~anis Barons: His Life and Times. In Linguistics and Poetics
of Latvian Folk Songs, ed. Vaira Vikis-Freibergs. Kingston, Ontario: McGill-Queen’s
University Press.
Wilson, William A. 1976. Folklore and Nationalism in Modern Finland. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press.
Rumor | 1121
Rumor
Unsecured information. People have a strong desire to make sense of the ambigu-
ities of their world; certainty is a human goal. In this way, rumor serves as the cor-
nerstone of epistemology. People make an ‘‘effort after meaning’’ and strive to
explain uncertain or unknown events. Rumors frequently emerge in the aftermath
of the breakdown of normal communication channels and become, in the words of
sociologist Tamotsu Shibutani, ‘‘the cooperative improvisation of interpretations.’’
Because of its centrality as a sense-making device, rumor has been examined
from a wide spectrum of disciplines, including psychology, sociology, anthropol-
ogy, political science, journalism, business, social work, law, and, of course,
folklore. The classic definition of rumor proposed by Gordon Allport and Leo
Postman is ‘‘a specific (or topical) proposition for belief, passed along from per-
son to person, usually by word of mouth, without secure standards of evidence
being present.’’ The key to the definition is the fact that the transmitter of rumors
is not relying on secure standards of evidence, although what constitutes secure
standards may be contested.
In the discipline of folklore, the study of rumor has been closely linked to that
of contemporary legend, so much so that the lines between them are often
blurred. In general, contemporary legends are traditional and have more complex
narrative structures than rumor. A rumor is often a briefer and more evanescent
communication than a contemporary legend. Yet there is considerable overlap
between these two discursive genres.
The intensity of rumor has traditionally been expressed in the basic law of ru-
mor, as proposed by Allport and Postman, which can be represented as follows:
R ¼ i a. That is, the amount of rumor in circulation varies with the importance
of the subject matter multiplied by the ambiguity of the evidence. Despite the
appeal of this equation, the data on the effects of ambiguity are generally stron-
ger than the effects of importance per se. Some have argued that the critical abil-
ity of the listeners needs to be considered; those with lower critical ability are
more likely to believe and spread rumor. As a result, rumor transmission may be
linked to personality or emotional state.
Most rumors are brief, often no more than three related propositions. This is
consistent with the processes of rumor memory and transmission: leveling,
sharpening, and assimilation. In rumor transmission, most details of an original
event are quickly forgotten (leveled). After most of the potential information has
been lost, a rumor kernel remains, which is fairly stable. The second feature of
rumor recall (sharpening) consists of the selective perception, retention, and
reporting of a few details. Sharpening is the inverse of leveling: Sharpened
details remain when others have been leveled. The extent of leveling and sharp-
ening is a result of narrative content, the circumstances of transmission, and the
1122 | Rumor
narrator’s reputation as a credible source and of whether she or he has a clear in-
terest in the topic and in our belief in the claims being put forward.
Truth is not handed to us; truth claims are. Our goal as an audience is to make
reasonable judgments, while at the same time making the conversation flow as
smoothly as possible. Rumor, being entertaining discourse, plays an important
role in the free flow of communication.
Gary Alan Fine
See Also Gossip; Legend; Legend, Contemporary; Legend, Urban.
References
Allport, Gordon, and Leo Postman. 1947. The Psychology of Rumor. New York:
Holt.
Fine, Gary Alan. 1992. Manufacturing Tales: Sex and Money in Contemporary
Legends. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Kapferer, Jean-Noel. 1990. Rumors: Uses, Interpretations, and Images. New Bruns-
wick, NJ: Transaction Press.
Koenig, Fredrick. 1985. Rumor in the Marketplace: The Social Psychology of
Commercial Hearsay. Dover, MA: Auburn House.
Morin, Edgar. 1971. Rumor in Orleans. New York: Pantheon.
Rosnow, Ralph, and Gary Alan Fine. 1976. Rumor and Gossip: The Social Psychol-
ogy of Hearsay. New York: Elsevier.
Shibutani, Tamotsu. 1966. Improvised News: A Sociological Study of Rumor.
Indianapolis, IN: Bobbs-Merrill.
S
Sacred
1125
1126 | Sacred
attraction. These feelings are engendered, he contended, by the presence of the holy
or sacred, the numen, or numinous objects and signs that participate with or represent
the holy. He claimed that the experience of the holy or sacred by people is itself the
source that generates folktale, myth, saga, legend, supernatural belief, and memorate,
sometimes by direct experience and sometimes because of the stimulation of the
numen as the mysterious, which he called the mysterium tremendum. Otto felt that
language actually fails to provide an adequate medium through which to describe
the numinous experience. Working from the heritage established by Otto, folklorist
David J. Hufford has made similar claims in his experience-centered approach to su-
pernatural assault traditions. Hufford has carefully examined the language of belief,
whether it be testimony, memorate, or other narrative structure, noting the individu-
al’s tendency to rely on simile and metaphor in an effort to provide an adequate
description of a particular phenomenon.
Lauri Honko, Leea Virtanen, Hufford, Christine A. Cartwright, Gillian Ben-
nett, and Diane E. Goldstein have contributed to the debate about academic tradi-
tions of belief and disbelief. This debate assumes that belief traditions involving
feelings of the mysterious or supernatural grounded in awareness of the sacred
are either true or arise from certain kinds of error. These folklorists have been
especially interested in the analysis of the reasoned use of evidence within
believers’ narratives, and their testing of alternatives falls within the context of
narration regarding supernatural experience. Another area of special interest in
contemporary folkloristics is fieldwork within communities of believers who
actively engage with the sacred as a serious and important part of their lives. This
situation is especially challenging for folklorists who are themselves believers or
who, though not believers, are nonetheless impacted by the strength of such
beliefs due to their empathy with their informants.
Leonard Norman Primiano
See Also Belief, Folk; Religion, Folk; Supernatural/Supranormal.
References
Bennett, Gillian. 1987. The Rhetoric of Tradition. Talking Folklore 1(3): 32 46.
Bennett, Gillian. 1987. Traditions of Belief: Women, Folklore and the Supernatural
Today. London: Penguin Books.
Cartwright, Christine. 1982. ‘‘To the Saints Which Are at Ephesus . . .’’: A Case
Study in the Analysis of Religious Memorates. New York Folklore 8: 47 55.
Eliade, Mircea. 1969. Preface. In The Quest: History and Meaning in Religion,
Mircea Eliade. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Goldstein, Diane E. 1991. Perspectives on Newfoundland Belief Traditions: Narrative
Clues to Concepts of Evidence. In Studies in Newfoundland Folklore: Community and Pro-
cess, eds. Gerald Thomas and J. D. A. Widdowson. St. John’s, Newfoundland: Breakwater.
Sacrifice | 1127
Goldstein, Diane E. 1983. The Language of Religious Experience and Its Implica-
tions for Fieldwork. Western Folklore 42: 105 113.
Honko, Lauri. 1964. Memorates and the Study of Folk Beliefs. Journal of the Folk-
lore Institute 1: 5 19.
Hufford, David J. 1982. The Terror That Comes in the Night: An Experience-
Centered Study of Supernatural Assault Traditions. Philadelphia: University of Pennsyl-
vania Press.
Hufford, David J. 1985. Commentary. In The World Was Flooded with Light, ed.
Genevieve W. Foster. Pittsburgh, PA: University of Pittsburgh Press.
Hufford, David J. 1982. Traditions of Disbelief. New York Folklore 8: 47 55.
Otto, Rudolf. 1958. The Idea of the Holy: An Inquiry into the Non-Rational Factor
in the Idea of the Divine and Its Relation to the Rational. Trans. John W. Harvey. New
York: Oxford University Press. Originally published as Das Heilige, 1917.
Schoemaker, George H. 1990. Folklore and Religion: Approaches to Folklore
Research. In The Emergence of Folklore in Everyday Life, ed. George H. Schoemaker.
Bloomington, IN: Trickster.
Virtanen, Leea. [1977] 1990. ‘‘That Must Have Been ESP!’’ An Examination of Psy-
chic Experiences. Trans. John Atkinson and Thomas DuBois. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Sacrifice
Killing with a spiritual or religious motivation, usually, but not exclusively, accom-
panied by ritual and performed in a sacred place. Indeed, the term sacrifice is
derived from a word meaning ‘‘to make sacred.’’ The practice of sacrifice follows
no historical pattern in cultures—levels of incidence can remain fairly constant for
long periods, or the use of sacrifice may wax and wane over time. Accounts of sac-
rifices include seventeenth-, eighteenth-, and nineteenth-century eyewitness reports
by English officers in India, visitors to Africa, and Spanish chroniclers in Central
America, as well as cryptic texts from the Mediterranean world and China.
The purposes of sacrifice include purification, renewal, atonement, and unifi-
cation. According to Edward Westermarck, sacrifice may include burying the
living with the dead to memorialize; burning or burying family members and
slaves to accompany an individual in the afterlife; making offerings to ensure
success in wars or to stave off epidemics of disease thought to be punishment
from the gods, including the making of medicine from the bodies of sacrifice vic-
tims; and interring adults or children in the foundations of new buildings or
under city gates and bridges as peace offerings and as a means of protection,
springing from a fear of anything new or doing an act for the first time.
Sacrifice can involve one or many bodies or the body parts of both humans and
animals. Human sacrifice, in its highest expression, is a voluntary act, undertaken
1128 | Sacrifice
as a pledge for the common good, and suffering is often a preparation for the
death.
Animals substitute for humans and for other animals as sacrificial victims
regardless of the complexity of the civilization. Claude Levi-Strauss insists that
the choice of victim varies widely in accordance with what is available at the
time. According to E. E. Evans-Pritchard’s study of the Nuer religion, differen-
ces in substitutes are minimized. Romans, Greeks, Vikings, and Druids fre-
quently offered humans and animals together on the same altar, to the same god,
to obtain the same favors. And W. Robertson Smith has pointed out that human
life is not viewed as more sacred than animal life in all contexts: For example,
the eighteenth-century English would hang a man for stealing a sheep. Humans
and beasts are leveled at the sacrificial altar when there is an unshakable belief in
the blessings in store in the hereafter.
Sacrifice for purification purposes can be motivated by a fear of supernatural
powers or by the desire to win favor or achieve a state of closer union with the
god whose protection is sought. Or victim and sacrificer can join in seeking to
bring about a better world as an act of hope. The rite can affect the sacrificer as
much as the victim in the sense that the sacrificer is transformed as well and
moved to a new sacred place.
Sacrifice for the purpose of renewal is inextricably linked to a belief that pro-
visions will cease unless gods are propitiated. Fertility rites include sprinkling
blood or burying pieces of human flesh in the fields before sowing to obtain a
good harvest or ward off famine; making sacrifices to river gods for the neces-
sary water; or sacrificing the firstborn, in the belief that if one child were given
back to the gods, more would be provided.
The act in which one dies for the many is an act of atonement. In the hopes of
saving their own lives, individuals may offer a human sacrifice as a method of
life insurance—giving the one for the many, sacrificing an inferior individual to
prevent the death of one more privileged, or offering one held personally respon-
sible for a calamity.
H. Hubert and M. Mauss, French sociologists, contend that sacrifice is aimed
at cementing the bonds between humans and gods in an act of communion
through which the victim becomes an intermediary between the human and the
divine. By means of the rite, the victim becomes part of the divine, and the sacri-
ficer is brought into a state of union with the god.
Modern scholars accept varieties of these premises of purpose with a differ-
ence in emphasis or with a combined emphasis. According to Rene Girard, for
instance, the main aim of sacrifice is to bring back social union and to restore the
cosmic order. In the absence of a true judicial system to deal with violence, coun-
terviolence is part of the divine order, in which case a scapegoat is found. Ten-
sion reduced, the crisis is resolved. Mircea Eliade proposes that blood sacrifices
Saga | 1129
replay the original act of creation and restore equilibrium by reenacting the origi-
nal deed of violence, catering to the specific needs created by the deed.
Margaret Bruchez
See Also Myth-Ritual Theory; Ritual.
References
Eliade, Mircea. 1954. The Myth of the Eternal Return. Princeton, NJ: Princeton
University Press.
Evans-Pritchard, E. E. 1956. Nuer Religion. Oxford: Clarendon.
Girard, Rene. 1977. Violence and the Sacred. Trans. Patrick Gregory. Baltimore,
MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Hubert, H., and M. Mauss. 1964. Sacrifice: Its Nature and Function. Trans. W. E.
Halls. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1966. The Savage Mind. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Smith, W. Robertson. 1889. Lectures on the Religion of the Semites. Edinburgh:
Black.
Westermarck, Edward. 1932. Ethical Reality. New York: Harcourt, Brace.
Saga
Irish Sagas
The Irish saga tradition predated the Scandinavian. Latin biographies (vitae) con-
cerning Irish saints appeared during the seventh century, and court poetry and
prose writing began in the following century. As manuscripts deteriorated,
scribes recopied them, often altering the narratives markedly. Since the earliest
extant manuscripts date from the twelfth century, their textual history is a com-
plex web of superimposed oral and literary influences.
The oldest prose material in the tradition, the mythological cycle, depicted
Celtic mythology from an antiquarian perspective. Tales of the Tuatha De
1130 | Saga
Many of the Fenian tales were recognizable M€ archen types, and Fenian bal-
lads began appearing in the twelfth century as well. The popularity of the cycle
is demonstrated by its persistence in twentieth-century oral tradition.
The sagas were performed in the evening, with a single saga sometimes lasting
many nights. The basic narrative frame was often overshadowed by long descrip-
tive asides, fanciful etymologies regarding place-names, and meticulous descrip-
tions of warriors or retinues. Such ‘‘digressions’’ are often dismissed as
professional pedantry, but they may equally have reflected different aesthetics
with regard to narrative form and content.
Icelandic Sagas
The term saga derives from the Old Norse verb meaning ‘‘to say,’’ connoting a
lengthy reported narrative. A number of subgenres were recognized, varying in
focus, historicity, tone, and style. Some of this variation stemmed from historical
changes in both the saga and Scandinavian culture from the twelfth through the
fourteenth centuries. Regional differences existed as well.
As in Ireland, the earliest Scandinavian sagas were written in Latin and
focused on saints. Icelandic clerics soon opted for the vernacular, however.
Closely related to the saints’ lives were the sagas of kings (konungas€ ogur), royal
biographies set in various parts of Scandinavia. Composed primarily in the
twelfth and early thirteen centuries, these sagas often had lay authors. Heimskrin-
gla, for instance, a compendious saga of the kings of Norway, was authored by
Snorri Sturluson.
This biographic tendency carried over into the Islendingas€ ogur of the thir-
teenth century—sagas concerning famous Icelanders. The text often focused on
heroes (Nj als saga), outlaws (Grettis saga), explorers (Eirıks saga rauqa—the
saga of Eirık the Red), districts (Laxdoela saga), or poets (Egils saga). Often
termed family sagas, the narratives sometimes followed several generations
within a family or district. In addition, they often included poetry, legendary ma-
terial, and other items of folklore. In contrast to the kings’ sagas, they were usu-
ally anonymous works.
As western Scandinavia came into greater contact with Europe, the sagas
changed. On the one hand, authors turned to the legendary and mythological past
of their people, writing sagas about ancient times (fornaldurs€ ogur). On the other
hand, the European romance became a prime court entertainment, and derivative
or translated sagas known as riddaras€ ogur, or ‘‘knights’ sagas,’’ were produced
both in Norway and in Iceland. M€ archen elements figured prominently in these
late works.
On saga performance and use, we know relatively little. Evidence from the
thirteenth-century Sturlunga saga indicates that traditional storytellers recounted
1132 | Scatology
sagas orally; performers in the cosmopolitan court of Norway may have read
aloud from manuscripts. Performance occurred in the evening, and a single nar-
rative could stretch over days or weeks. Further, sagas could be commissioned or
presented as gifts.
Thomas A. DuBois
See Also Epic; Hero/Heroine, Folk.
References
Boatright, Mody. 1958. The Family Saga and Other Phases of American Folklore.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Boberg, Inger. 1966. Motif-Index of Early Icelandic Literature. Copenhagen:
Munksgaard.
Carney, James. 1955. Studies in Irish Literature and History. Dublin: Dublin Institute
of Advanced Studies.
Clover, Carol, and John Lindow, eds. 1985. Old Norse Icelandic Literature: A Crit-
ical Guide. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Mitchell, Stephen. 1991. Heroic Sagas and Ballads. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University
Press.
Nagy, Joseph. 1985. The Wisdom of the Outlaw: The Boyhood Deeds of Finn in
Gaelic Narrative Tradition. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Corrain, Donnchadh, Liam Breatnach, and Kim McCone, eds. 1989. Sages, Saints
O
and Storytellers. Maynooth, Republic of Ireland: An Sagart.
hOg
O ain, Daithı. 1991. Myth, Legend & Romance: An Encyclopaedia of the Irish
Folk Tradition. New York: Prentice-Hall.
Wolf, Lois. 1991. Medieval Heroic Traditions and Their Transitions from Orality to
Literacy. In Vox Intexta: Orality and Textuality in the Middle Ages, eds. A. Doane and
C. Pasternack. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
Scatology
Expressions such as ‘‘visit the restroom,’’ ‘‘powder one’s nose,’’ or ‘‘pass wind’’
constantly come in and out of fashion, as speakers grapple with whether to sound
coarse or prudish. Additional terms are used when discussing scatology with
children (e.g., kaka, poop, doo-doo, pee-pee). Using euphemisms or child speech
in unusual contexts leads to humor, as in the case of a police officer saying,
‘‘You’re in deep doo-doo’’ for the expected ‘‘You’re in deep shit’’ (i.e., ‘‘You’re
in trouble’’). Despite this pattern of historical shifts, however, certain terms (e.g.,
fart, shit) have existed in the language for millennia and will certainly remain
part of North American culture in the future.
Children’s folklore offers some of the richest stores of scatological material.
Feces and urine figure prominently in the narratives of young children, and scat-
ological terms become important in insults and jokes throughout childhood and
adolescence. The ‘‘hand-fart,’’ made with the hand under the armpit, or the ‘‘rasp-
berry,’’ made with the lips, constitute potent comments and put-downs. Jokes
and folk sayings about flatulence (e.g., ‘‘He who smelled it, dealt it’’) offer young
performers the opportunity to match situation with witticism. Telling scatologi-
cal ‘‘dirty jokes’’ can build solidarity among children vis-a-vis their teachers or
other adults, who usually disapprove of the subject or performance. Taunts aver-
ring misuse of excrement or problems in defecation abound as well. Folklore of
this sort, once common to adult and preadult communities alike, has apparently
grown more taboo among adults during the last several centuries throughout
Europe and North America.
Scatological imagery pervades folk perceptions of other communities or cul-
tures. Interethnic stereotypes often focus on the means of defecation as well as
the sexual habits and diets of strangers. Unwelcome outsiders are said to use rest-
rooms incorrectly or to dispose of excrement in foolish or dangerous ways. They
are accused of attracting rodents and insects through their lack of hygiene and
their ignorance of toilets. Interethnic scatological humor reflects deep misgivings
about the nature of people of differing cultures and is widespread throughout the
world.
Often, such stereotyped scatological lore becomes compared in jokes shared by
two communities. In an English-French interethnic joke, for instance, an English-
man criticizes a Frenchman for France’s deplorable restrooms. The Frenchman’s
reply uses scatology as a prime metaphor for cultural imperatives: ‘‘We eat well,
you shit well. It’s all a question of priorities.’’ The joke encapsulates both English
and French stereotypes about each others’ cuisines, toilets, and obsessions. Occa-
sionally, groups will depict themselves as coarser than their counterparts in other
cultures, as in Australian interethnic jokes in which the hypermasculine Australian
hero displays sneering disregard for societal rules of hygiene and decorum, such as
where to urinate and how to refer to excretions. Seemingly self-denigrating humor
of this type often occurs in postcolonial situations, in which one culture (i.e., that
1136 | Scatology
of the colonized) has long been viewed as inferior to another (i.e., that of the colo-
nizer). The Australian joke allows tellers to embrace their country’s negative ste-
reotype and transform it into a virtue, with a frankness superior to the supposedly
overly refined and delicate manners of the English.
Scatological folklore is closely linked to sexual folklore and obscenity. All of
these topics have posed difficulties to folklorists since they are traditionally ta-
boo subjects in academic discourse. Many of the contributors to the journal Mal-
edicta, for instance, use pseudonyms when publishing their studies. Folklorists
run the risk of upsetting their informants as well when they transform remarks
made in an intimate context into a scholarly text available for all to read. And
newspaper journalists surveying the proceedings of academic conferences may
ridicule the profession by citing scatological references as illustrations of the
triviality or perversity of folklore studies. Despite these drawbacks, however,
scatological folklore offers intriguing insights into the transformation of human
physical experiences into cultural symbols and perceptions.
Thomas A. DuBois
See Also Belief, Folk; Joke; Obscenity.
References
Afanas’ev, A. N. 1966. Russian Secret Tales: Bawdy Folktales of Old Russia.
New York: Brussel and Brussel.
Alford, Richard D., and William J. O’Donnell. 1983. Linguistic Scale: Cursing and
Euphemisms. Maledicta 7: 155 163.
Allen, Irving Lewis. 1983. The Language of Ethnic Conflict: Social Organization
and Lexical Culture. New York: Columbia University Press.
Brians, Paul, ed. 1972. Bawdy Tales from the Courts of Medieval France. New York:
Harper & Row.
Davies, Christie. 1990. Ethnic Humor around the World. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Fine, Gary Alan. 1981. Rude Words: Insults and Narration in Preadolescent Obscene
Talk. Maledicta 5(1-2): 51 68.
o Aheedlıinii Version.
Haile, Berard. 1984. Navajo Coyote Tales: The Curly T
Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.
Lancashire, I. 1981. Moses, Elijah, and the Back Parts of God: Satiric Scatology in
Chaucer’s Summoner’s Tale. Mosaic 14(3): 17 30.
Legman, Gershon. 1982. No Laughing Matter: An Analysis of Sexual Humor.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Lindahl, Carl. 1987. Earnest Games: Folkloric Patterns in The Canterbury Tales.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Oberman, Heiko. 1988. Teufelsdreck: Eschatology and Scatology in the ‘‘Old’’
Luther. Sixteenth Century Journal 19(3): 435 450.
Semiotics | 1137
Semiotics
The study of signs used to communicate. Folklore studies and semiotics, both of
which offer interdisciplinary or transdisciplinary perspectives on human commu-
nication, have mutually influenced each other as they have developed over the
last century or so. Each, of course, has various schools and traditions, but there
are important convergences between them, both in the history of the disciplines
and in current practice. Within semiotics, we can usefully distinguish an Ameri-
canist tradition drawing its insights and methods from the polymath Charles
Sanders Peirce, a French (and, more broadly, European) tradition inspired by the
Geneva linguist Ferdinand de Saussure (often denominated by Saussure’s pre-
ferred term, semiology), and a Slavic tradition—elaborated especially in Prague,
Moscow, and Tartu—whose prominent practitioners include several with strong
interests in folklore traditions. Common to all three schools of thought is a con-
cern with the functioning of signs as the means for interpersonal communication,
especially the highly elaborated sign systems that characterize artistic communi-
cation. Although each school conceives the sign in slightly different ways, all
might agree to define the sign as something that stands for something else, to
some person and in some respect. Signs may be typologized differently by each
tradition (sign versus symbol, symbol versus icon versus index, arbitrary versus
motivated sign, and so on), but semioticians share an interest in understanding
how people and societies utilize signs to embody meanings and values and to
communicate them to one another. Each intellectual tradition offers certain
insights or approaches of potential use to folklorists, and each has been influ-
enced to greater or lesser degree by their application to folklore materials.
Of the three trends, the Slavic tradition is most heavily indebted to the work of
folklorists, who had a formative role in its evolution. Developing first in the
Moscow Linguistic Circle and then in the Prague Linguistic Circle, Slavic semi-
otics numbered among its founders several individuals with strong interests in
folklore texts and traditions. The most prominent figure, Roman Jakobson, later
made contributions to linguistics, ethnology, cognitive science, philology, and
literary studies, but he began his lifelong inquiries into the sign by studying Rus-
sian folklore texts, to which he returned periodically throughout his life. One of
Jakobson’s close colleagues was the folklorist Petr Bogatyrev, who remained
1138 | Semiotics
focused on folk traditions throughout his career, from his early days studying
folk theater and puppetry in cooperation with Jakobson to his later concern with
folk costume, folk poetry, magic, and ritual laughter. The two men were found-
ing members of both the Moscow and the Prague circles. Jakobson’s folkloric
concerns centered on the poetics of traditional Slavic verse, wherein he noticed a
pervasive use of poetic parallelism—the repetition from line to line of a stable
phrase with variable contents. In the folk poetry traditions he studied, Jakobson
saw parallelism as a canonical feature defining the construction of verse; this
became the key to his broader explorations of parallelism in the artistic verse of
various authors.
Bogatyrev’s most important contributions to folklore theory grew out of his
attention to the function of folklore materials and texts in social interactions.
Reacting to the excessive ahistoricism and decontextualization of the emerging
trend of formalist literary criticism, Bogatyrev insisted on the variable meanings
that any sign may have when situated in concrete sociohistorical and social-inter-
actional contexts or when moved from one to another. Drawing examples from
folksong, folk costume, and especially folk theater and puppetry, Bogatyrev
explored, with rich ethnographic detail, the interactions of structure and function
in folklore. Studying the folk costumes of Moravian Slovakia, he showed how
costumes indexed certain social statuses (e.g., single versus married, male versus
female) and how the costume system generated a larger sense of ethnic identity,
of ‘‘our-ness.’’ His works on folk theater genres contributed both to the emerging
Prague Circle theories of theatrical semiotics and to the avant-garde experimen-
tations of interwar Prague.
Two other important Russian thinkers of the same generation significantly
contributed to the development of semiotics and folklore, although both took
care to distance themselves in certain ways from formalism and semiotics. Vladi-
mir Propp devised a method of morphological analysis and applied it to Russian
magic tales; he found that, despite their quite different surface features of charac-
ter and plot, the tales shared a single compositional framework or morphology.
His book, once translated into English in 1958, had very wide influence on both
literary theorists and folklorists as they sought to articulate structural analyses of
both artistic and folkloric narratives. Mikhail Bakhtin never counted himself a
folklorist but took advantage of the contemporary fascination with folk culture
among Soviet cultural commissars to argue his theories of dialogism in language
and life. He traced styles and elements of folk humor as they were incorporated
historically into the emergent literary genres and offered a brilliant analysis of
Rabelais that indeed constituted a richly detailed ethnography of the folklife of
Europe in the Middle Ages and Renaissance.
Jakobson left the Soviet Union for exile in Prague and the United States; Bakh-
tin suffered many years of internal exile during which he had few opportunities to
Semiotics | 1139
publish or teach. Bogatyrev returned from Prague to the Soviet Union, where he,
like Propp, taught for decades but in relative obscurity; neither again achieved the
kind of insights or influence they had had in their earlier days. The conjunction of
folklore and semiotics was picked up again only in the 1960s, when a circle of
scholars in Tartu and Moscow once more turned to folkloric texts, especially
myths, as elements in constructing a semiotics of culture.
The Slavic semioticians were inspired by Saussure’s crucial programmatic
work suggesting a transdisciplinary semiology to be developed from the science
of linguistics, although they soon found fault with Saussure and explored other
conceptions of the sign. But Saussure had continued to have both direct and indi-
rect influence, especially among francophone scholars. One of the foundational
figures of modern structuralism, Claude Levi-Strauss, employed folkloric texts
(especially myths) in his elaboration of a method of structural anthropology
(drawing inspiration as well from Propp’s morphological method but criticizing
it as inadequate). His contemporary, Roland Barthes, employed folklore and,
more often, popular culture in propagating a Saussurean semiology that pro-
foundly influenced literary and cultural theory in the 1960s and later. Extending
Levi-Strauss’s and Barthes’s structural method—some would say to the point of
reductio ad absurdum—A. J. Greimas continued to employ folkloric texts as the
testing ground of a theory and a method that were briefly in vogue but now seem
to be of little interest (especially to American scholars).
The giant of American semiotics, Charles S. Peirce, had virtually nothing to
say about folklore in his massive oeuvre, which, in any case, remained little
known until recent decades. But his systematic investigation of the sign in all its
aspects and functions provided an analytical tool and perspective that crystallized
the thinking of contemporary American semioticians in crucial ways. Two fig-
ures were pivotal here: again Jakobson, who discovered Peirce upon arriving in
the United States during World War II, and Thomas A. Sebeok, who has been
both an intellectual and an institutional father of modern semiotics. Jakobson did
not incorporate Peirce’s ideas into his own analyses of folkloric or literary texts
to any great extent but instead celebrated Peirce and promoted interest in his
writings.
Within a vast and complex schema of sign modes and functions, Peirce distin-
guished three ways in which a sign can relate to its object: An icon is related by
similarity, an index is related by real connection, and a symbol is related by con-
vention. Jakobson took up this triple distinction to refocus his long-standing con-
cerns with the nature of signs in social and especially artistic communication.
Revising Peirce’s tripartite scheme, Jakobson took the two oppositions of actual
versus imputed and similarity versus contiguity and elaborated a four-way dis-
tinction between icon (actual similarity), index (actual contiguity), symbol
(imputed contiguity), and artifice (imputed similarity, which for Peirce would be
1140 | Semiotics
References
Bakhtin, Mikhail. 1968. Rabelais and His World. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Bakhtin, Mikhail. 1981. The Dialogic Imagination. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Bauman, Richard. 1982. Conceptions of Folklore in the Development of Literary
Semiotics. Semiotica 39: 1 20.
Bogatyrev, Petr. 1971. The Functions of Folk Costume in Moravian Slovakia. The
Hague: Mouton.
Jakobson, Roman. 1987. Language in Literature. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Univer-
sity Press.
Shamanism | 1141
Shamanism
shamanism and the invisible, latent meanings and messages in the depth structure
motivating the behavior of the people who share a shamanic culture as a basis for
their societies.
Recently, the concept of shamanism has been extended to an unwarranted
degree in the popular press. The term shamanism has not only been used to charac-
terize certain ecstatic and other traditional rituals of so-called primitive peoples but
also to describe phenomena of Christianity and even the personae cultivated by
popular rock musicians. Experts in shamanistic research regard this trend as a
devaluation of the concept. Many criticize the overemphasis on ecstasy as a reli-
gious experience par excellence, as described, for example, by Mircea Eliade.
Since the middle of the nineteenth century, attempts have been made to
account for shamanism as a mental disorder (e.g., schizophrenia or epilepsy). In
such hypotheses, however, the problem has been oversimplified. Although the
aptitude for exceptional experiences is one of the criteria of ‘‘shamanhood,’’ and
though periods of madness seem inherent in shamanic initiation, shamans usually
are ordinary men and women who, often involuntarily, have to accept the painful
vocation of shamanizing.
Phenomenologically, shamanism could be defined on the basis of a number of
criteria. Ecstatic techniques are used to find a way into other worlds or dimensions
Shamanism | 1143
of reality. There is a belief in more than one soul; therefore, a free soul is believed
to leave the body in trance to make trips to the other world, where it assumes vari-
ous shapes (e.g., animal shapes). There is a three-level model of the universe, and
the role of the shaman is to mediate between these levels. There is also a belief in
helping spirits who assist the shaman. In addition, the shaman achieves his or her
ends by using ritual paraphernalia, which vary culturally: drum, dress, bag, mask,
and so forth.
When using shamanic categories, it is important to make a distinction between
such cultures as that of a number of Mandshu-Tungusian peoples who have the
concept of saman as a linguistic entry in their native lexicon and those who know
parallel phenomena but do not have a lexical entry for the concept (e.g., most Arc-
tic peoples or the Ob-Ugric people of the Khanty). Furthermore, many cultures
have neither the word nor the phenomenon. According to the proposed definition,
African American spirit possession cults, for example, are not shamanistic.
Generally speaking, the ideological aspect of shamanism has been underesti-
mated in research into the phenomenon. The transmission of the traditional
knowledge from one shaman to another is a major element of shamanistic initia-
tion. One of the most important criteria in the choice of a new shaman is cer-
tainly the candidate’s expertise in the ideological traditions of the culture.
Efforts toward a more holistic interpretation of shamanic folklore texts should
determine their cosmological and astral mythical background and the way this
relationship is revealed in rituals, expressed in mythic narratives, and interpreted
and understood by the members of the culture.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Divination; Medicine, Folk; Religion, Folk.
References
Aboensis XII. 1989. Kalevala Mythology, trans. Ritva Poom. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Aldhouse-Green, Miranda. 2005. The Quest for the Shaman: Shapeshifters, Sorcerers
and Spirit-Healers of Ancient Europe. London: Thames & Hudson.
Blackburn, Stuart. 2010. The Sun Rises: A Shaman’s Chant, Ritual Exchange and
Fertility in the Apatani Valley. Boston: Brill.
Edson, Gary. 2009. Shamanism: A Cross-Cultural Study of Beliefs and Practices.
Jefferson, NC: McFarland.
Eliade, Mircea. 1971. Shamanism: Archaic Techniques of Ecstasy. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Harner, Michael. 2009. The Way of the Shaman: The Definitive Handbook. New
York: Harper.
Hoppal, Mihaly, ed. 1984. Shamanism in Eurasia. G€ottingen, Germany: Herodot.
1144 | Shape-Shifters
Hoppal, Mihaly, and Juha Y. Pentik€ainen. 1992. Northern Religion and Shamanism.
Budapest: Akedemiai Kiado.
Lewis, I. M. 1989. Ecstatic Religion: A Study of Shamanism and Spirit Possession.
London: Routledge.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1987. Saami Shamanic Drum in Rome. In Saami Religion, ed.
Tor Ahlback. Scripta Instituti Donneriani. Abo, Finland: Almqvist & Wiksell
International.
Siikala, Anna-Leena. 1978. The Rite Technique of the Siberian Shaman. Helsinki:
Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Siikala, Anna-Leena, and Mihaly Hoppal, eds. 1992. Studies on Shamanism. Buda-
pest: Akedemiai Kiado.
Tolley, Clive. 2009. Shamanism in Norse Myth and Magic. Helsinki: Academia Sci-
entiarum Fennica.
Shape-Shifters
extremely widespread and usually associated with trickster figures such as Coy-
ote, Hare, and Rabbit. The African Anansi, or Spider, is a great shape-shifter. In
Chinese and Japanese tradition, shape-shifting is common, especially in relation
to the fox.
Graham Seal
See Also Magic; Magicians; Magic Tale; Trickster.
References
Aldhouse-Green, Miranda. 2005. The Quest for the Shaman: Shapeshifters, Sorcerers
and Spirit-Healers of Ancient Europe. London: Thames & Hudson.
Del Negro, Janice M. 2007. Passion and Poison: Tales of Shape-shifters, Ghosts,
and Spirited Women. New York: Marshall Cavendish.
Porter, J., and W. Russell, eds. 1978. Animals in Folklore, London: Brewer/Rowman
and Littlefield, The Folklore Society, pp. 113 182.
Radin, P. 1956. The Trickster: A Study in American Indian Mythology, New York:
Philosophical Library.
Seki, K., ed. 1963. Folktales of Japan. Trans. R. Adams. London: Routledge and Kegan
Paul.
Sleeping Beauty
Usually titled in books of fairy tales ‘‘The Sleeping Beauty,’’ this widespread, an-
cient, and well-known folktale is almost always told in English simply as ‘‘Sleep-
ing Beauty.’’ Known in one version or another since at least the fourteenth
century, ‘‘Sleeping Beauty’’ has had a long literary as well as folkloric life. Suc-
cessive tellers of the tale, such as Perrault (‘‘La Belle au Bois Dormant’’) and the
Grimms (in English, ‘‘Little Briar Rose’’), have added to it or subtracted from it
in various ways, leaving us with the modern version as more-or-less solidified in
the Disney animated feature film.
Most readers will be familiar with the Grimm plot, in which a queen, after many
years of unsuccessful attempts, finally gives birth. Overjoyed, the king and queen
invite everyone in the kingdom to come to the palace to celebrate the birth of their
daughter. There are thirteen wise women in the kingdom, and all must be invited.
Unfortunately, the king has only twelve gold plates and so, to avoid embarrassment,
invites only twelve. While these women bestow gifts of beauty and happiness on the
royal baby, the offended thirteenth wise woman angrily curses the child, saying that
she will die at fifteen years of age through a prick in her finger. One of the invited
wise women is able to lighten the curse from death to one hundred years of sleep.
Spinning machines and their sharp spindles are immediately banned in the
kingdom, but in her fifteenth year, the princess comes across an old woman
1146 | Sleeping Beauty
spinning in a castle tower. The princess picks up the spindle and pricks herself,
bringing the prophetic curse into effect. She falls asleep, and so does everyone
else in the palace, from the king and queen down to the lowliest servant and even
the flies on the wall. A great thorn hedge grows around the palace, cutting it off
from the world. The legend of the sleeping beauty attracts many young men to
the palace, but despite their skill, strength, and determination they all fail to
break through and waken the sleeping beauty with a kiss. Eventually, one hun-
dred years pass, and a prince does succeed in breaking through. He kisses the
sleeping princess, and she wakes, along with everyone and everything else in the
palace. Life returns to normal, and the young prince and Sleeping Beauty marry.
Some elements of the story can be traced to Greek myth, though the motifs of
a sleeping princess and magic sleep in general are widely distributed in the
world’s folktale traditions. The popularity and wide spread of this story and its
variants have attracted extensive comment and analysis. Psychological and psy-
choanalytic approaches generally interpret the story as a metaphor of the sexual
awakening of young women that, whatever the parents may think or do about it,
is bound to occur sooner or later. In Bettelheim’s The Uses of Enchantment, for
example, there is an extended discussion of the Sleeping Beauty stories along
these lines, stressing that the theme of the futility of trying to prevent the child’s
sexual maturity is common to all versions of the story.
Snow White | 1147
Folklorists would perhaps be more inclined to argue that it is unlikely that ev-
ery version of ‘‘The Sleeping Beauty,’’ past and present, revolves around this
theme or that the story was or is told with such intentions. While Bettelheim and
other psychoanalysts may be right about some, even many, tellings of this tale, it
is not likely to have the same significance in all the societies and in all the peri-
ods in which it has been told, a notion akin to the Jungian ‘‘one-symbol-does-for-
all’’ archetype. Only on-the-ground fieldwork can determine the significance of
any particular telling of ‘‘The Sleeping Beauty,’’ or any other folktale. The fact
that there have been and continue to be so many differing interpretations of the
story is a testament to its popularity, longevity, and wide distribution. That so
many meanings can be found within it is due to that peculiar magic we continue
to find in those reworked folktales known as ‘‘fairy tales.’’
Graham Seal
See Also Cinderella; Fairy Tale Heroes; Shape-Shifters; Snow White.
References
Bettelheim, B. 1976. The Uses of Enchantment: The Meaning and Importance of
Fairy Tales, New York: Knopf.
Bottigheimer, R., ed. 1986. Fairy Tales and Society: Illusion, Allusion, and Para-
digm. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Calvino, I. [1956] 1980. Italian Folk Tales: Selected and Retold by Italo Calvino.
Trans. G. Martin. New York: Harcourt Brace Jovanovich, Penguin.
Einfeld, Jann, ed. 2001. Fairy Tales. San Diego, CA: Greenhaven Press.
L€uthi, M. 1976. Once upon a Time: On the Nature of Fairy Tales. Trans. L.
Chadeayne and P. Gottwald. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Massignon, G., ed. 1968. Folktales of France. J. Hyland. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, pp. 133 135.
Tatar, M. 1987. The Hard Facts of the Grimms’ Fairy Tales. Princeton, NJ: Prince-
ton University Press.
Snow White
In their version of this favorite and widely known fairy tale, ‘‘Little Snow White’’
(no. 53), the Grimms begin like this: ‘‘Once upon a time, in the middle of winter
when the snow flakes fell like feathers from the sky, a queen sat at a window
which had a frame of black ebony. And as she was sewing while looking at the
snow, she pricked her finger with the needle and three drops of blood fell on the
snow. The red looked so beautiful on the white snow that she thought to herself,
‘I wish I had a child as white as snow, as red as the blood, and with hair as black
as the wood of the window frame.’’’
1148 | Snow White
Thus the scene is set for the birth of Snow White, the death of her mother, and
the taking of a new wife by the king, Snow White’s father, one year later. All
goes well until Snow White turns seven. Then the trouble begins. The stepmother
turns out to be of the wicked variety and is insanely envious of Snow White’s
beauty, imploring the magic ‘‘mirror, mirror on the wall’’ to tell her ‘‘who is the
fairest of them all’’ and receiving the answer she does not wish to hear.
As most children know from either the Disney animated feature (the first version
of which was released in 1937) or from any number of children’s books, Snow
White is expelled from the castle. The wicked queen orders a woodsman to murder
the young girl in the forest, but the man cannot bring himself to commit this cold-
blooded deed and instead leaves Snow White alone in the wilderness. Here she is
found and looked after by seven dwarfs. But the wicked queen discovers that Snow
White is not dead and disguises herself in various forms in attempts to kill her. At
her third attempt, the queen tricks Snow White into eating a poisoned apple, and
the girl dies. She is laid out in a crystal coffin and mourned over by the dwarfs and
birds until a handsome prince arrives. He kisses her and, bumping the coffin in the
process, wakens her from what was only a deeply drugged sleep after all. She mar-
ries the prince, and the wicked stepmother is punished by being made to wear red-
hot shoes in which she must dance until her death. The young couple lives happily
ever after and, in the manner of most fairy tales and folktales, the cultural equilib-
rium is reestablished with the defeat of evil and the succession of the generations.
This version of Snow White is satisfyingly complete, with its elaborated narra-
tive structure, its deployment of many ancient and widespread motifs of myth
and legend (including the helpers, the wicked stepmother, the narcissistic streak
of the queen, the sleep of the heroine, and her awakening with a kiss), and its just
rewards and deserts for heroine, hero, and villainess. Most of the many other ver-
sions of the tale are less refined and extended, though they tend to retain the sym-
bolic elements of blood, whiteness, and black hair and the motivations of the
wicked stepmother as essentially sexual jealousy.
Differences between various versions of Snow White–type tales are high-
lighted in a number of analyses undertaken from various perspectives. Steven
Swann Jones, for instance, shows how the pattern of action varies in three differ-
ent versions of ‘‘Snow White.’’ Nevertheless, comparison of the versions reveals
an underlying structure. The heroine may be killed by a poisoned apple in one
version, by a raisin in another, or by a poisoned needle in yet another; nonethe-
less, she is killed, and the narrative proceeds to the next significant action. In
comparing the Grimms’ version of Snow White with French and Italian versions,
Jones points to the quite different ways in which each of the significant actions
within the story is accomplished.
In the Grimms’ opening situation a queen learns from a magical mirror that
the heroine is more beautiful than she. In the Italian version, it is a stepmother
Snow White | 1149
who resents her new stepdaughter. In the French version, the stepmother is jeal-
ous of her husband’s apparent preference for the stepdaughter. In the second sig-
nificant action, the Grimms’ version has the queen ordering a servant to kill the
heroine, but instead the servant leaves her in the forest. In the Italian version, the
stepmother commands the stepdaughter to tend a dangerously located basil plant.
In the French version the stepmother asks her husband to abandon the heroine on
a distant mountain.
The third significant action in the Grimms’ version involves the dwarfs taking
in the heroine. In the Italian version an eagle carries her to a fairy palace. In the
French version, the heroine surreptitiously performs domestic chores in the pal-
ace of forty giants until they find her out and adopt her. In the fourth significant
action the Grimms have the wicked queen discover her location by the magic
mirror. In the Italian version, the eagle tells the stepmother the heroine’s where-
abouts. The French story has the stepmother consulting the sun about any woman
more beautiful than herself and discovering the heroine’s whereabouts accord-
ingly. In the fifth significant action the Grimms’ persecuting queen attempts to
murder the heroine, first with a poisoned staylace and comb; eventually she suc-
ceeds with the poisoned apple. In the Italian tale, the stepmother enlists the aid
of a witch, who fails to kill the heroine with poisoned sweetmeats but succeeds
with a poisoned dress. Finally, in the Grimms’ version a prince obtains the her-
oine’s body. He bumps her coffin, and Snow White revives and marries him. In
1150 | Snow White
the Italian version, the prince obtains the heroine’s body, and his mother then
removes the poisoned dress in order to wash it, thus causing the heroine to return
to life. Heroine and hero are married. In the French conclusion, the father of the
prince who discovers the body presses the heroine’s chest, causing her to regurgi-
tate the raisin and to breathe again. Prince and heroine then marry.
Jones’s purpose in carrying out this enlightening analysis is to pursue a larger
argument about narrative structure in folktales, but his analysis also usefully
reveals the extent to which all versions of a particular tale are essentially differ-
ent ways of telling the same story. The means by which the significant actions
that make up the core story are brought about is not as important as the carrying
out of the actions themselves. The actions, usually strung together in the same
sequence, lead inexorably to the climax of the story and to its resolution in the
traditional happy ending in which hero and heroine are united in marriage. This
narrative structure and its culmination are a symbolic parallelism of the male and
female principles that motivate many folktales, especially those of the fairy tale
variety. Similar comparisons are possible between different versions of most
folktales.
Like most fairy tales, Snow White has numerous international parallels,
including the Jewish story of Romana. In her tale, of Middle Eastern origin and
perhaps the archetype of ‘‘Snow White and the Seven Dwarves,’’ Romana falls in
with forty thieves rather than the seven dwarves. The rest of the story is remark-
ably similar to that of Snow White, with much the same happy ending. Likewise,
the theme of the mother, or stepmother, attempting to harm her children or step-
children is found in many traditions. The brothers S’ad and Sa’id, the sons of a
poor woodworker, feature in Persian and Middle Eastern tradition. Their mother
falls in love with a wealthy man and, in order to please him, plots to kill her two
sons. They escape and after many adventures become rich and honored rulers.
Graham Seal
See Also Cinderella; Fairy Tale Heroes; Shape-Shifters; Sleeping Beauty.
References
Bettelheim, B. 1976. The Uses of Enchantment: The Meaning and Importance of
Fairy Tales. New York: Knopf.
Briggs, K., ed. 1970 1971. A Dictionary of British Folk-Tales in the English Lan-
guage, 2 vols. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
Dawkins, R., comp. and trans. 1974. Modern Greek Folktales. Oxford: Clarendon
Press, 1953; reprint Westport, CT: Greenwood Press.
Einfeld, Jann, ed. 2001. Fairy Tales. San Diego: Greenhaven Press.
Hallett, M., and B. Karasek, eds. 1996. Folk and Fairy Tales, Ontario: Broadview
Press, pp. 65 73.
Speech, Folk | 1151
Jones, S. 1986. The Structure of ‘‘Snow White.’’ In Fairy Tales and Society: Illusion,
Allusion, and Paradigm, ed. R. Bottigheimer. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania
Press, pp. 165 186.
Klipple, M. 1992. African Folktales with Foreign Analogues. New York: Garland,
pp. 244 248.
Kurti, A., trans. [1958] 1971. Persian Folktales. London: Bell and Sons, pp. 96 108.
Zipes, J. 1997. Happily Ever After: Fairy Tales, Children, and the Culture Industry.
New York and London: Routledge.
Speech, Folk
The expressive language use of any group of people sharing a greater or lesser
number of local cultural traits. In any living language, there is constant tension
between forces promoting stability and uniformity and forces promoting frag-
mentation and diversity. This essentially dynamic situation is especially evident
in languages that have many speakers occupying a large territory and engaged in
a wide variety of occupations and activities. In such a context, public education
systems and the media consciously or otherwise promote a standard form of
speech or forms of speech thought to approach what is considered to be standard
and desirable. One of the principal agents of linguistic diversity is the expressive
speech of homogeneous groups of people whose geographic location, ethnic
background, religion, and occupations, to name the most important features,
allow them to be distinguished from other speakers of the same language.
It should be stressed that regional or local speech characteristics, however dis-
tinctive, rarely modify the underlying structure of the dominant language; even
peculiarities of sound usage (phonology), word shape (morphology), and word
order and sentence structure (syntax) do not disguise the fact that a regional or
local variety of language belongs to the acknowledged standard tongue. When
such changes do operate over a long period of time, new languages come into ex-
istence. This is how Latin, once the common language of most of Western
Europe, evolved into such modern languages as French, Spanish, Portuguese,
Italian, and Romanian, with their numerous regional varieties.
Although these questions of language evolution, regional varieties of lan-
guage, and the mechanics of language are chiefly the domain of linguists and
dialectologists, the folklorist has a nonetheless valid interest in them, too. Dialec-
tologists map the distribution of words, both from the perspective of the varying
meaning of a given word and from that of the different words used to identify a
specific object or concept; folklorists may do much the same thing or make use
of such linguistic mapping in order to cast light, for example, on the movements
of peoples and the cultures they carry with them. Careful comparisons, taking
1152 | Speech, Folk
Argot
A special linguistic code whose purpose is to conceal and to exclude. Also called
cant, this genre of folk speech differs from standard language principally in vocabu-
lary. However, argots based upon a language (the use of Romanes by Gypsies in Eng-
lish-speaking societies, for instance) or dialect differing from that in mainstream
social use may diverge from standard speech in more complex ways. Argot’s non-
standard diction allows its users to communicate with one another secretively.
Hence, it most usually occurs among speakers with reasons to hide what they are
saying from uninitiated listeners. Argots may merge with other folk speech genres
such as jargons and slang.
Groups that have developed argots include persons whose activities are regarded
as either illegal or immoral in some social contexts—for example, professional
criminals, drug users, and homosexuals. Other groups may develop argots because
their activities, though not illegal, require secrecy. Occupations that depend, in part,
on tricking clients—gambling and carnival operations, for instance—may generate
argots, as may competitive activities in which one team of players wishes to conceal
its intentions from another team. Some ethnic groups use their native language as
an argot in occupational contexts. Others may employ their language in the same
way in social situations to guarantee the privacy of their communication. Argots
also may have generational significance; adolescents, for example, often adopt vo-
cabulary usages that exclude their parents from their communications. Argots may
also develop in ritual situations, thus allowing religious specialists to deal with
topics of esoteric spirituality without revealing sacred secrets to the profane
masses. Another possible context for argot development involves communication
among members of one sex that is designed to exclude persons of the other sex.
Argots received scholarly attention as early as the fifteenth century, though the
first formal dictionary of a cant was probably issued in the 1700s. Francis Grose’s
Classical Dictionary of the Vulgar Tongue, first published in 1785, remains an important
source of vocabulary usage by British criminals. Folklorists had included argot in
their new discipline by the late 1800s. In 1890, the Journal of American Folklore pub-
lished materials on Shelta, an argot used by British tinkers. Most studies of argot by
folklorists and others (many of which have appeared in the periodical American
Speech) have focused only on the compilation of word lists and their definitions.
These glossaries may provide general comments about the group that uses the
argot but often do not deal with specific usages in particular contexts.
More contextually oriented research could identify (1) particular situations in
which groups employ specific words and phrases from the argot vocabulary, (2)
whom such groups intend to exclude through their use of argot, and (3) the socio-
psychological functions, such as group integration, that argots may perform in addi-
tion to their practical role in promoting secrecy and privacy of communication.
Moreover, the playful dimension of argot, though noted by several commentators,
has not received the attention that it deserves. Often, what appear to be attempts
at communicative concealment may be artful linguistic flourishes that demonstrate
the verbal agility of the speakers more than their desire for secrecy.
William M. Clements
Speech, Folk | 1153
into account other cultural and historical phenomena, enable the folklorist to
understand the social pressures involved in producing cultural change or cultural
conservatism.
Furthermore, some knowledge of regional forms of speech and the history of a
given language is useful, not to say essential, for the complete understanding of
the texts of narratives and songs, rhymes, proverbs, riddles, and other forms of
verbal expressive folklore in which nonstandard vocabulary and nonstandard
usages are embedded. It is axiomatic that the field-worker embarking on the
study of the folklore of a particular group must make every effort necessary to
master the local idiom. Without a thorough familiarity with the subtleties of local
usage, the researcher will be deprived of the insights to be gained from such
knowledge, and he or she may miss the significance of words and nuances of
meanings in the very texts that are the subject of study. Without such knowledge,
the student of a regional or local folklore will focus on what seem to be curious
words or phrases (which may be a good deal less curious than the field-worker
thinks) and give them more emphasis than they merit.
An important corollary to the issue of nonstandard speech is the question
of transcription. On the one hand, some scholars believe regional forms should
be standardized when setting the spoken word into a written form, retaining pe-
culiar local words and phrases for ‘‘local color.’’ Such scholars maintain that the
use of ‘‘eye dialect’’—approximate renderings of nonstandard pronunciations
based on the transcriber’s own speech habits (e.g., writing ‘‘wuz’’ for ‘‘was’’)—
unnecessarily portrays the original speaker in a demeaning fashion and, in any
case, is rarely an accurate rendering of a phonological reality. On the other hand,
some scholars, for theoretical reasons, prefer to attempt as accurate an approxi-
mation of the spoken word as is possible. The best of these approximations are
usually based on a solid grounding in phonetics and the history of the language.
It is certain that a standardized version of a text and a so-called folkloric tran-
scription of the same text give two very different visions of the material. It is
clearly important both to justify the approach one adopts on theoretical grounds
and to provide a clear guide to the system of written conventions used to render
the nonstandard forms. Of immediate interest to the field-worker exploring the
traditions of a social group is the specialized vocabulary related to the group’s
primary and other occupations. One cannot appreciate the creative artistry
involved in the making of a loggers’ song or a song about (and by) members of
any other occupation without some familiarity with the technical terms and
phrases that are part and parcel of that occupation. The folklorist will need to
know the names of tools used by potential informants. For example, to the aver-
age person, a plane is a plane, but to a carpenter, it may be no more than a
generic term for which the profession has five or six specialized names, each re-
ferring to a particular type; to most people, snow is snow, but to the Inuit of the
1154 | Speech, Folk
high Arctic, there may be no single word for snow at all but thirty or forty differ-
ent words describing particular kinds of snow.
Similarly, it is important to list the folk names for animals, fish, insects, or
plants (in addition to learning about the traditional uses to which these may be
put); in other words, establishing the local names for things is a first step in
defining local taxonomies and a preliminary to understanding the relationship of
the social group to the world around it. And lest the impression be given that
there is too great a preoccupation with the rural or marginal in society, it should
be stressed that scholars have long been preoccupied with creating vocabularies
peculiar to urban groups—there are gay lexicons and lexicons of the underworld,
of the church, of the military, of airline pilots, and the like. If in the beginning
was the word, then the word—the vocabulary of a social group—is one of the
first things to be studied.
Also of interest in this area is the field of naming. Nicknames, pet names,
names given to domestic animals, the calls used to summon animals, and the vo-
cabulary of animal husbandry all reflect sets of preoccupations. Local history is
echoed in the place-names of an area, and not infrequently, local sayings allude
to local references, be they to places or people. Thus, the form of the widespread
proverbial comparison ‘‘as big a liar as . . .’’ may simply be concluded with the
name of a local teller of tall tales. Or the comparison ‘‘as deep as Dead Man’s
Pond’’ will allude to a local body of water believed to be bottomless, for exam-
ple. There are many such reports of traditional genres, including proverbs and
riddles, whose effectiveness depends on knowledge of local events or characters.
Not infrequently, demands for explanations of the meanings of such local sayings
will lead to a variety of anecdotes—some humorous, others serious—knowledge
of which further adds to the investigator’s appreciation of the cultural texture of
the community under examination.
Many characteristic forms of folk speech are embedded in rhymes. Children’s
lore is replete with rhymes, beginning with the nursery rhymes and jingles used by
adults or older children with small infants. Then, as children enter school, they learn
the teases, the jeers, the taunts and reproofs, the retorts and parodies, the rhymes
meant to shock and upset, the epithets and euphemisms, the insults, the tongue
twisters, the catches, the wisecracks, and, sometimes, the secret languages shared
by their peers, all of which may involve rhyme in part or in whole, not infrequently
rhymes that are rhymes only because of the peculiarities of local pronunciation.
Rhyme often goes hand in hand with naming customs. This has long been
attested in the area of blasons populaires, the nicknames attributed by the mem-
bers of one community to the inhabitants of neighboring communities. Blasons
populaires are not, of course, necessarily in rhyme, and folk speech will incorpo-
rate pejorative forms of epithet in all manner of colorful sayings. Indeed, an
interesting though relatively little studied area of folk speech is that of oaths and
Speech, Folk | 1155
Tongue Twister
A linguistic sequence with difficult phonological combinations. Also called tongue
tanglers, tongue teasers, and jaw busters, tongue twisters require agility in articulating
sequences of similar sounds at a rapid rate. Sound similarities usually involve long
strings of alliteration (the repetition of initial consonant sounds, as in ‘‘Peter Piper
picked a peck of pickled peppers’’), assonance (the repetition of vowel sounds, as in
‘‘How now brown cow?’’), consonance (the repetition of final consonant sounds, as
in ‘‘He thrusts his fists against the posts / And still insists he sees the ghosts’’), or a
combination of these and other sound patterns. Sometimes, tongue twisters utilize
elaborate sound inversions in complex juxtapositions—for example, ‘‘How much
wood would a woodchuck chuck if a woodchuck could chuck wood?’’ Homophones
(words and syllables that sound the same) also often occur in tongue twisters (‘‘I
saw Esau sitting on a seesaw’’). Frequently, tongue twisters rhyme, and most evince
regular rhythmic qualities. Some are extremely short, amounting to only a phrase
(‘‘rubber baby buggy bumpers’’), and others extend for several sentences.
Tongue twisters seem to flourish most among children, who delight in challenging
one another to demonstrate their speaking ability. If the tongue twister is brief, the
challenge may be to say it several times as quickly as possible. For longer tongue twist-
ers, the challenge is simply to get through it rapidly without making a mistake. A com-
petitive element figures in the performance of tongue twisters when one child recites
a difficult text and then calls upon another to do likewise. Some tongue twisters
assume the form of a question and answer, one child articulating a traditional allitera-
tive question and expecting another to respond in kind. Often, children delight most
when a pronunciation error occurs, especially if that error involves the utterance of a
taboo word. For example, a slight juxtaposition of vowel sounds in ‘‘I’m not a fig
plucker nor a fig plucker’s son, but I’ll pluck figs till the fig plucker comes’’ can allow a
child to say with impunity a word that might otherwise be forbidden.
Though competitive in their own right, tongue twisters may figure into other
games, particularly those requiring the payment of a ‘‘forfeit.’’ Drinking games, pop-
ular with high school and college students, often focus on the proper enunciation
of a tongue twister to an increasingly accelerated rhythm. When someone makes
an error, he or she must quickly consume a quantity of beer or other alcoholic
drink, thus further impairing the ability to articulate. Some traditional songs incor-
porate tongue twisters. These verbal challenges may serve as informal, semiserious
measures of one’s ability to speak a foreign language. Tongue twisters also have
served as formal exercises in elocution, speech therapy, and foreign language
instruction.
Though many studies of tongue twisters by folklorists simply provide lists, others
have investigated the linguistic patterns and the geographical and generational distri-
bution of the tongue twister. Among topics that merit further attention are studies
of similarities and differences in tongue twisters from different languages, the rela-
tionship between the popularity of particular texts and the demographics of the
children who perform them, and the use of tongue twisters in informal educational
contexts.
William M. Clements
1156 | Speech, Folk
swearing. More tastefully, folk speech also includes a variety of blessings and
graces, prayers, and toasts, which may be both serious and humorous.
Two types of folk speech that have received attention from scholars are prov-
erbs and proverbial speech and the riddle and riddling question. In the past,
scholars tended simply to make lists of examples of proverbs, rarely providing
the contextual data essential to understanding how the proverbs were used; yet
such data are clearly essential since proverbs may make use both of local words
and of allusions to local events or characters. One of the most distinctive features
of folk speech, indeed, is the colorful imagery embedded in proverbial similes,
exaggerations, metaphors, retorts, and Wellerisms, in which the ‘‘color’’ is an
expression of the group’s relationship to its own world and its own worldview.
The same comment can be made about the language of riddles and related
forms. The so-called true riddle—a riddle that asks a question in metaphorical
terms but that the listener may take literally and that has an answer involving the
same opposition between the literal and the metaphorical—frequently refers to
local realities. A person unfamiliar with kerosene lamps, for instance, will be
stumped when asked what it is that drinks its blood and eats its own guts. The
outsider learns not only what is a familiar feature of a local environment but also
the characteristic ways in which such features are expressed locally, that is, the
nature of local imagery.
A final aspect of folk speech worthy of examination is the relationship between
speech and communication. All speech attempts to communicate, but not all com-
munication is necessarily in the form of speech. Much communication is made
through gesture, and all cultures have an unwritten code of gestural communica-
tion. It is important to take note of the vocabulary of gesture in any community,
not because the body of gestures that are locally meaningful may differ greatly or
be in some way alien to the dominant culture (though they may be) but because
without such a vocabulary, the researcher is denied complete access to local
speech. Thus, although gestures signaling greeting or farewell, anger or insult, or
directions may be common beyond the local context, some may have evolved spe-
cific to a given occupation or activity. Gestures made during card games may not,
for example, be noticed by an outsider observing the play, or they may be misinter-
preted; similarly, there may be formalized gestures with local significance embed-
ded in traditional performance contexts such as storytelling or singing.
The idiom of any social group emerges in the many kinds of discourse charac-
teristic of the communicative contexts proper to that group. Some of these con-
texts, in which well-established folkloric genres are embedded, have been well
documented and carefully studied from a variety of perspectives. Others have
been, until recently, somewhat neglected because of the apparent absence of eas-
ily recognizable genres in such discourse contexts. Yet most speech is conversa-
tional rather than performative, and it is in conversational speech that local
Spirit | 1157
References
Botkin, B. A. 1944. A Treasury of American Folklore. New York: Crown.
Brunvand, Jan Harold. 1978. The Study of American Folklore. An Introduction. 2nd
ed. New York: W. W. Norton.
Butler, Gary. 1991. ‘Saying Isn’t Believing’: Conversation, Narrative and the Dis-
course of Tradition in a French Newfoundland Community. St. John’s, Newfoundland:
Institute of Social and Economic Research, Memorial University of Newfoundland.
Dundes, Alan. 2008. ‘‘The Kushmaker’’ and Other Essays on Folk Speech and Folk
Humor. Burlington: University of Vermont.
Maurer, David W. 1981. Language of the Underworld, eds. Allan W. Futrell and
Charles B. Wordell. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
Murray, Thomas E. 1993. The Folk Argot of Midwestern Gangs. Midwestern Folk-
lore 19: 113 148.
Preston, Dennis R. 2003. Needed Research in American Dialects. Durham: Duke
University Press.
Thomas, Gerald, and J. D. A. Widdowson, eds. 1991. Studies in Newfoundland Folk-
lore: Community and Process. St. John’s, Newfoundland: Breakwater Books.
Thompson, Harold W. [1939] 1962. Body, Boots & Britches: Folktales, Ballads and
Speech from Country New York. New York: Dover Publications.
Spirit
ones be warded off; at death, it is vital that the old spirit successfully makes its
way out of the body.
Anything that creates images may be taken for a conduit into the separate, nor-
mally invisible world where spirits live. In other words, spirits may manifest
themselves in dreams (as Patroclus’s spirit appears to Achilles in the Iliad); in
mirrors (such as the magic mirror in Snow White); in water (which has a reflect-
ing surface and is commonly used in divination); or in the figures seen in tea
leaves or coffee grounds, which can be interpreted by someone familiar with the
ways of spirits. Mental imagery, induced through a variety of methods—sensory
deprivation, hallucinogenic drugs, fasting, meditation, repetitive sounds—is of-
ten taken for a manifestation of the spirit world.
In industrial societies, some of these methods have lived on in the belief sys-
tem known as ‘‘spiritualism.’’ Spiritualism stresses one aspect of the traditional
beliefs, namely, the idea that one can consult the spirits of specific dead people,
which is done at seances. Such consultation is an ancient tradition and has often
been done at burial places, as in the early Russian steppes, where figures known
as ‘‘stone women’’ were erected on grave mounds; relatives would sleep at the
graves and communicate with the dead through their dreams.
Such figures illustrate a common quality of spirits: They have an affinity for any-
thing that has their shape. To capture a spirit, one may create an image in the shape
of its corresponding body. Since spirits also have an affinity for reflecting surfaces,
mirrors and vessels of water are often used to hold them in place. These may be
placed in or above graves to prevent the spirit of the deceased from wandering about.
Perhaps because they may be manifested in reflections, spirits are taken to be
exact opposites (that is, mirror images) of the phenomenal world. Therefore, the
spirit world is typically appealed to and approached by means of reversals: The
shaman may enter his or her hut backwards in preparing to make contact with
the spirits. Traditional dream interpretation, as far back as Artemidorus’s Inter-
pretation of Dreams, has assumed that the meaning of a dream is based on such
reversal—to dream of sorrow means happiness and vice versa.
What is commonly called the ‘‘soul’’ differs from the traditional spirit.
Whereas the spirit has a loose connection to the body and, when on temporary
furlough from it, is capable of acting on its own, the soul is generally assumed to
maintain its connection to the body until death. But like spirits, souls also may
stay around after death, sometimes haunting the location where death occurred,
and then, once disembodied, they are referred to as ‘‘ghosts.’’ Both the term ghost
and the term spirit also are used to refer to the third member of the Trinity in
Christianity: the Holy Ghost (or Holy Spirit).
Paul Barber
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Divination; Medicine, Folk; Religion, Folk.
Storytelling | 1159
References
Brain, James L. 1979. Ancestors as Elders in Africa Further Thoughts. In Reader
in Comparative Religion: An Anthropological Approach, eds. William A. Lessa and
Evon Z. Vogt. New York: Harper & Row.
Downs, James F. 1985. Spirits, Power, and Man. In Magic, Witchcraft, and Religion:
An Anthropological Study of the Supernatural, eds. Arthur C. Lehmann and James E.
Myers. Palo Alto, CA: Mayfield.
Furst, Peter T. 1976. Hallucinogens and Culture. Novato, CA: Chandler & Sharp.
Goodman, Felicitas D. 1990. Where the Spirits Ride the Wind: Trance Journeys and
Other Ecstatic Experiences. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Storytelling
The definition crafted in 2000 after much debate by the board of directors of the
National Storytelling Network, the principal professional storytelling organiza-
tion in the United States, reads: ‘‘Storytelling is the interactive art of using words,
vocalizations, and/or physical movement and gesture to reveal the elements and
images of a story to a specific live audience.’’ The definition is suggestive in
what it excludes as well as what it includes. It does include interactivity, the re-
ciprocal flow of energy between teller, audience, and narrative in the moment of
live performance. It thus excludes writing, filmmaking, television, video gaming,
and other mediating frameworks that interpose between teller and listeners.
These later arts, however, grounded as they are upon the genres and principals of
storytelling, are ever willing to appropriate the hallowed name of their ancestor
for its intimacy and mythic resonance. In its essence, storytelling as we will use
the term here is a live and living art, a process of communication and commun-
ion between teller and listeners, shaped by various traditions but mediated as lit-
tle as possible by distancing technologies.
The difficulty in maintaining a definition of storytelling as storytelling and not
as a metonymy for something quite different is to be found less in the word or
the process it denotes than in the cultural mindset within which the act of defini-
tion must be attempted. Walter Ong has pointed out that the assumptions of liter-
acy-based civilization have so permeated our thought processes as to breed
unchallenged oxymorons such as ‘‘oral literature’’ (or ‘‘literary storytelling’’). In
Image, Music, Text, Roland Barthes has beautifully enumerated how narrative
(as opposed to storytelling) can exist in ‘‘a prodigious variety of genres, them-
selves distributed among different substances—as if any material were fit to
receive man’s stories.’’ Marshall MacLuhan postulated that ‘‘environments are
invisible’’; and the environment of literature- and media-saturated culture has
certainly hidden in plain sight our dependence on the technological artifacts of
1160 | Storytelling
Storyteller Rosie Chapman, second from right, tells the story of ‘‘Molly the Mouse’’ as
Tatyanna Todd, Khadidja Ngom, and Aryanna Young act out characters during the 2002
Storytelling Festival at the Detroit Public Library. (AP/Wide World Photos)
Storytelling in peasant or servant groups tends toward the wonder tale, as Max
L€uthi, Jack Zipes, and others have shown, to provide imaginative release from
the harsh conditions of workaday life. They are often performed as an accompa-
niment to repetitive menial tasks, such as food storage (picking, canning, drying,
and threshing), cloth-weaving, or net-mending, as Appalachian, Hebridean, and
Hungarian storytellers have testified. Or they can be just vessels to carry commu-
nity spirits across the long winter nights. The hero or heroine’s journey from out-
cast wayfarer through magical trials to blessed estate seems designed to lift the
laboring heart and mind and to anaesthetize sore fingers. Animal tales are wide-
spread in African, African American, Native American, European, and Asian tra-
ditions. Stories in which human and divine traits and conflicts are embodied in
animal forms, these tales range in function from simple children’s fables and
jests to sacred creation myths. M€ archen and animal tales may thrive in less-for-
mal contexts than bardic or ritual tellings; yet there remains something ceremoni-
ous about the repetition of traditional stories, whether in ceili houses (the houses
where neighbors gather in rural Irish and Scottish communities for music, danc-
ing, and storytelling) or fishing shacks, around a shaman’s fire or a child’s bed,
or, more recently, at library story hours or revival storytelling festivals.
The storytelling process is often imprecisely understood from opposite sides
of the orality/literacy divide. Milman Parry and Albert B. Lord reported that the
illiterate bards from whom they collected South Slavic epics naturally assumed
that their literate interlocutors could perform such feats of memory as the singers
themselves had just demonstrated, and much more as well, since the educated
folk had the additional power of literacy. And literate persons often still make
the error of assuming that oral traditional storytellers are reciting their stories
and verses word for word, as literates would memorize a play or a poem.
Only since we have transited into the epoch of electronic recording and trans-
mitting media has it become possible to examine such notions with any preci-
sion, as Parry and Lord were able to in the Balkans in the 1930s and again in the
1950s with their early recording devices. They recognized that oral memory is a
process of stitching together performances out of formulaic elements—tradi-
tional images, metaphors, stylized action passages, and a range of other syntactic
and discursive chunks, arranged with some improvisatory freedom to fit the audi-
ence and the occasion. A traditional storyteller learns from hearing these ele-
ments repeated in sufficient variety yet stylistic consistency that he or she can
make use of their patterns to freely reproduce the community’s repertoire of ta-
les, adding their own variations, reflections, and responses to the pressures of the
environment. Thus, oral storytelling performances can emerge rather fluidly
from the language web of community talk, as Henry H. Glassie beautifully eluci-
dates in the Irish ceili storytelling in Passing the Time in Ballymemnone (1982).
A particular tale may appear in multiple variants, from different narrators in
1162 | Storytelling
different settings, yet each variation can be experienced by the group authenti-
cally as ‘‘the story.’’
While tellers in bardic or religious orders are often trained to what amounts to
professional standards and lineages, and perform a distinct high-status social
function, tellers in rural or peasant communities can be equivalently recognized
and valued by their own peers. In cultures around the world where orality
remains a dominant force of cultural transmission, tellers such as the seanachies
of rural Ireland recorded by the Irish Folklore Commission, or Jack tale tellers of
the Hicks-Harmon-Ward extended family of Beech Mountain, North Carolina,
are well known as cultural resources and authorities both within and beyond their
immediate communities. Yet, as these redoubts of oral culture are increasingly
encroached upon first by literacy and then still more disruptively by electronic
culture, the practices and repertoires of traditional storytelling are subject to the
twin perils of attrition or revival.
The vanishing subject has been both the lamentation and driving force of folk-
lore scholarship since its inception with Johann Gottfried Herder and Jacob and
Wilhelm Grimm. When Hector Urquhart, friend and informant of the great Scot-
tish folktale collector John Francis Campbell, was a young man in the early nine-
teenth century, he wrote of the common custom in the Gaelic Highlands of his
childhood of gathering to listen to folktales and fairy tales (or sgeulachd) as told
by itinerant tailors, shoemakers, or other traveling folk. ‘‘It was also the custom,’’
he wrote, ‘‘when an aoidh, or stranger, celebrated for his store of tales, came on a
visit to the village, for us, young and old, to make a rush to the house where he
passed the night . . . just as I myself have seen since when a far-famed actor came
to the Glasgow theater’’ (Campbell, 5). Yet Urquhart goes on to report that, after
the minister and the schoolmaster came to the village in the 1830s, their disap-
proval of the practice and their teaching of the written word caused oral storytell-
ing to die away almost completely.
More than a century later, African storyteller Raouf Mama described a similar
turn in his native Benin: In the space of twelve years—from 1960, when Benin
was granted independence, to 1972, the year of the Beninese revolution—story-
telling evenings in Beninese homes declined considerably. Today, that time-hon-
ored tradition has gone out of existence. Much of the blame for this must be laid
on the colonial educational system, which sought to make the Beninese look
down on his native tongue, customs and tradition, culture, and folklore (Mac-
Donald, 9–10).
Similarly, the Appalachian storyteller Ray Hicks, an iconic fixture at the
National Storytelling Festival from 1973 to 2000, often said that the doctrinaire
ministers of the hardshell Baptist churches drove the traditional wonder tales out
of his region of the mountains. ‘‘They teached ‘em out,’’ he would say. ‘‘Said
they’s wrong.’’ The coming of television to rural areas has had a particularly
Storytelling | 1163
corrosive impact on the customs of social gathering and listening that are the
necessary habitat of extended-form storytelling sessions in the home. These fac-
tors and others have driven the transposition of storytelling to more formally con-
structed contexts, such as libraries, schools, and storytelling revival festivals.
Anthony Wallace placed revivals as one class of revitalization movement,
which he defined in general as ‘‘the deliberate, organized, conscious effort on the
part of members of a society to construct a more satisfying culture’’ (Wallace,
265). Revival movements celebrate values, customs, and rituals that are thought
to have been part of the everyday lives of earlier generations, and whose eclipse
is held to symbolize a larger decline in the cultural health of the present. Such
movements have long been part of the self-regenerating fabric of cultural life.
They tend to emerge in periods when social, political, economic, or technological
changes put great stress on cultures and individuals. Though their explicit agenda
is to bring back practices belonging to an idealized past, their actual mechanisms
are usually homeostatic, and serve to integrate contemporary innovations in con-
text and process by buffering them with traditional imagery and reassuring ritual.
Folk arts in general and storytelling in particular have regularly served as grist
for the cultural revival mill. The revival of storytelling in the latter three decades
of the twentieth century was part of a pattern that reaches back to include the
fairy tale enthusiasm at the court of Versailles that produced the works of
Charles Perrault, Marie-Catherine d’Aulnoy, and their peers; the Hasidic move-
ment in eighteenth and nineteenth-century Judaism, which gave a central sacred
role to storytelling and generated both the legends of the Baal Shem Tov and the
mystical fairy tales of his great-grandson Nachman of Bratslav; the German
Romantic movement, fired by the folkloristic proclamations of Herder and the
Brothers Grimm; and the Romantic-nationalist movements that followed the
German lead in nearly every country in Europe and the Americas, producing
great collections of national and regional folklore and often serving as cultural
cover for significant political and social consolidation and change.
In the United States, there was an important if now nearly forgotten revival of
storytelling in the 1890s and the first decades of the 1900s that neatly mirrored
the storytelling movement at the century’s close. It began in the emerging library
and public school systems. Library story hours were established in the Carnegie
and New York Public Library systems in the 1890s, and the training of children’s
librarians came to include storytelling as an essential vocational skill (Alvey).
The National Story Tellers’ League was founded in 1903 by Richard Wyche at a
summer school for public school teachers in Knoxville, Tennessee, to promote
storytelling in schools. Manuals and inspirational tracts on storytelling as an art
form were published by Sarah Cone Bryant, Marie Shedlock, Wyche, and others,
all recommending folktales, fairy tales, and literary fairy tales by the likes of
Hans Christian Andersen, Oscar Wilde, or Howard Pyle, and biblical stories,
1164 | Storytelling
identification with tradition and their naturalness in solo and small group per-
formance; but it may also owe to the fact that the form of the wonder tale as
described by Joseph Campbell or Vladimir Propp uncannily mirrors the process
of a revitalization movement itself.
Wallace described periods of increasing individual or communal stress (sepa-
ration), followed by a revealed vision of a new way of life (initiation), often
based on earlier, forgotten forms and rituals. These revitalizing breakthroughs
lead to the creation of organizations, such as the National Story Tellers’ League
or the National Storytelling Network, to communicate the new path and assimi-
late it into existing social forms (return). Revival storytellers tend to see them-
selves as heroes or heroines of their own wonder tale quests, with storytelling as
the magical gift enabling them to vanquish the glass mountain of alienated labor,
and to make a meaningful living from their art in order to live ‘‘happily ever af-
ter.’’ Regardless of the status of the ever after, storytelling as a potential of
human expression promises to remain with us for as long as we remain human.
Joseph Daniel Sobol
See Also Animal Tale; Epic; Folktale; Legend; Myth; Oral-Formulaic Theory; Oral
Tradition.
References
Alvey, Richard G. 1974. The Historical Development of Organized Storytelling for
Children in the United States. Dissertation, University of Pennsylvania.
Barthes, Roland. 1977. Image, Music, Text. New York: Noonday.
Campbell, J. F., trans. 1994. Popular Tales of the West Highlands: Orally Collected.
New edition. 2 vols. Edinburgh: Birlinn.
Glassie, Henry. 1982. Passing the Time in Ballymenone. Bloomington: Indiana Uni-
versity Press.
Lord, Albert M. 1960. The Singer of Tales. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
MacDonald, Margaret Read, ed. 1999. Traditional Storytelling Today: An Interna-
tional Sourcebook. Chicago: Fitzroy Dearborn.
McLuhan, Marshall. 1965. Understanding Media: The Extensions of Man. New
York: McGraw.
Ong, Walter. 1982. Orality and Literacy: The Technologizing of the Word. London:
Routledge.
Pellowski, Anne. 1990. The World of Storytelling. Expanded and revised edition.
Bronx, NY: Wilson.
Schneider, William. 2008. Living with Stories: Telling, Re-telling, and Remembering.
Logan: Utah State University Press.
Sobol, Joseph Daniel. 1999. The Storytellers’ Journey: An American Revival.
Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
Wallace, Anthony F. C. 1956. Revitalization Movements. American Anthropologist
58: 264 281.
1166 | Structuralism
Structuralism
aspects of Levi-Strauss’s work can be summarized under three headings: (1) alli-
ance theory, (2) human mental processes, and (3) structural analysis of myth.
Alliance Theory
Alliance theory stresses the importance of marriage in society as opposed to the
importance of descent. Its basic supposition is that the exchange of women
between groups of related men results in greater social solidarity and that the
product of this cohesion is a greater chance of survival for all members of the re-
sultant kin group. Levi-Strauss claims that the regulating of marriages through
prescription and preference and the proscription of other types of marriage create
an ‘‘exchange’’ of women in simple societies. This, accompanied by exchanges
of gifts, ensures the cooperation of the members of these groups.
His analysis of the incest taboo is seminal. For Levi-Strauss, the link between
nature and culture in humankind comes from this universal proscription. In the
incest taboo, nature transcends itself and creates culture as the controlling ele-
ment of human behavior. Sex and other drives are regulated by culture; human-
kind has become a cultural entity.
Binary oppositions occur in nature and, naturally, in the human mind. They
are such things as night and day, left and right, or nature and culture. Nature and
culture often function as a binary opposition in tales. However, depending on the
tale or myth, the binary opposition changes. For example, the binary opposition
life and death is useful in explicating Sleeping Beauty. Here, the deep structure
of the story suggests that when the thirteenth fairy declares that Sleeping Beauty
is to die at her fifteenth birthday, a life-versus-death binary opposition is posited.
A mediation to solve the problem is now necessary.
A binary opposition can be mediated by finding a solution to the opposition
created by the binary. The mediation to the culture/nature binary opposition is
that culture transcends nature. In the case of Sleeping Beauty, the nature of the
mediation is quite different but equally embedded within the subject matter.
Here, the life-versus-death binary opposition is mediated by the twelve fairies’
actions: Death is transformed into a hundred-year sleep.
In Sleeping Beauty or in any myth, the deep structure of the narrative is ana-
lyzed through the discovery of a binary opposition and the resultant mediation.
This process may, in itself, create new binary oppositions in the story that need
to be followed until one arrives at a final mediation for the narrative.
Structuralism is an intellectual movement that bases its analyses on the reduc-
tion of materials into models referred to as structures. These structures are not
concrete manifestations of reality but cognitive models of reality. Levi-Strauss
stresses that all cultures (not just scholars) understand the universe around them
through such models and that humankind comprehends the world on the basis of
these mental structures.
Mark Glazer
See Also Linguistic Approach; Semiotics.
References
Barthes, Roland. 1967. Elements of Semiology. London: Cape.
Barthes, Roland. 1973. Mythologies. London: Paladin.
Barthes, Roland. 1975. S/Z. London: Cape.
de Saussure, Ferdinand. 1966. Course in General Linguistics. New York: McGraw-Hill.
de Saussure, Ferdinand. 1972. The Archaeology of Knowledge. London: Tavistock.
Foucault, Michel. 1970. The Order of Things: An Archeology of the Human Sciences.
London: Tavistock.
Hawkes, Terence. 1977. Structuralism and Semiotics. Berkeley: University of
California Press.
Lacan, Jacques. 1968. The Language of the Self: The Function of Language in Psy-
choanalysis. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1967. Structural Anthropology. Garden City, NY: Anchor
Books.
Style | 1169
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1967. The Story of Asdiwal. In The Structural Study of Myth
and Totemism, ed. Edmund Leach. London: Tavistock.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1969. The Elementary Structures of Kinship. Boston: Beacon.
Turner, Bryan. 2009. The New Blackwell Companion to Social Theory. Chichester,
UK: John Wiley & Sons.
Style
Textual pattern or the exploitation of available patterns within given contexts. The
concept of style and the scholarly pursuit devoted to its study, stylistics, are slippery
intellectual commodities. A positive assessment of their characteristics might describe
such patterns as multifaceted; in less optimistic terms, they might be called indefina-
ble. With regard to the description and analysis of this complex phenomenon, folklo-
rists might be wise to be guided by important developments in linguistic stylistics,
although not all the concerns of value to the student of language in this respect are
also of interest to the investigators of folk culture. For example, of the three types of
style that Donald C. Freeman highlights—style as deviation from the norm, style as
recurrence or convergence of textural pattern, and style as a particular exploitation of
the grammar of possibilities—the first is clearly inapplicable in the absence of any
normative element in folk culture, the second has limited applicability but cannot be
discarded altogether, and the third would appear to be of special significance in the
study of the variety and range of actualizations of the ‘‘grammar’’ of tradition. Or, as
John Spencer puts it, ‘‘a writer’s style may be regarded as an individual and creative
utilization of the resources of language which his period, his chosen dialect, his genre
and his purpose within it offer him.’’ Substitute storyteller, singer, fiddle player, pot-
ter, house builder, or weaver for writer and tradition/folk culture for language, and
this statement could easily have been made by a folklorist. Add the notion of usage,
as the sum of individual or particular ‘‘utilizations,’’ and we find ourselves benefi-
cially borrowing ideas from yet another area of language study—sociolinguistics—
which has, as one of its focal interests, the study of variation or variants, which also
goes to the heart of practically every manifestation of folklore ever investigated.
As has often been pointed out with justification, folklorists have, in the past,
paid comparatively little attention to matters of style, except for students of folk
narrative who have, in some measure, investigated the performance style of
storytellers or the style of given texts. A notable exception is Max L€uthi who, in
his overview of the form and nature of the European folktale, devotes a whole
chapter to what he terms the ‘‘abstract style of the folktale,’’ which, for him, is a
concept that goes far beyond mere linguistic considerations. It was not until
1980, however, that the question of ‘‘appropriateness’’ was added to the study of
‘‘usage’’ by W. F. H. Nicolaisen, opening the door for yet another sociolinguistic
1170 | Supernatural/Supranormal
References
Ball, John. 1954. Style in the Folktale. Folklore 65: 170 172.
Dorson, Richard M. 1960. Oral Styles of American Folk Narrators. In Style in Lan-
guage, ed. Thomas A. Sebeok. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Freeman, Donald C. 1970. Linguistic Approaches to Literature. In Linguistics and
Literary Style, ed. Donald C. Freeman. New York: Holt, Rinehart and Winston, pp. 3 17.
Jansen, Wm. Hugh. 1952. From Field to Library. Folklore 63: 152 157.
L€uthi, Max. [1947] 1982. The European Folktale: Form and Nature (Das europ€ asche
Volksm€ archen: Form und Wesen). Reprint translated by John D. Niles. Philadelphia:
Institute for the Study of Human Issues.
Nicolaisen, W. F. H. 1980. Variant, Dialect and Region: An Exploration in the Geog-
raphy of Tradition. New York Folklore 6: 137 149.
Spencer, John. 1964. Introduction. In Linguistics and Style, eds. Nils Erick Enkvist,
John Spencer, and Michael J. Gregory. London: Oxford University Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1946. The Folktale. New York: Holt, Rinehart and Winston.
Supernatural/Supranormal
The entities, beings, or other phenomena that form, control, and manifest human-
ity’s ultimate concerns, those that are believed to be beyond human control but
that can be experienced in ritual encounters and within other supranatural spheres
of activity or circumstances.
Supernatural/Supranormal | 1171
Many theories of religion point out that the belief in a supernatural order is a
sign of religion rather than a criterion for it. Religions usually use a power or
powers beyond this world as a reference point—that is, the fundamental questions
regarding humanity and its place in the universe are answered by projecting them
against a supernatural background. This supernatural realm is populated by a vari-
ety of beings whose existence is manifested by various means cross-culturally.
The affective level of religiosity is particularly manifested in man’s experiences
with the supernatural. The difference between the definitions given by an official
religion and those derived from individual perceptions is crucial. Such a distinction
is necessary because experiences and the reporting thereof are products not only of
religious myths, dogmas, and values but also of the individual idiosyncrasies that
influence perception and interpretation, as well as the social situations that condi-
tion perception, interpretation, and other relevant dimensions of behavior.
Supernatural experiences may be classified as casual or ritual encounters with
supernatural beings. A casual encounter generally is unexpected and, thus, sur-
prising in nature. The experiencer feels he or she is both at the mercy of a super-
natural being and the focus of its actions. Often, fright ensues, along with the
realization that the experience is somehow ‘‘abnormal.’’ Usually, the person flees
and, in distress, resorts to some incantation, prayer, or other protective rite.
The elements of surprise and fright are lacking from ritual encounters. Here, a
Homo religiosus, a religious person, seeks contact with the supernatural by
means of traditional ritual formulas. For example, the fisher may offer a part of
the first spring catch to the water spirit, the herder may sacrifice a cow’s first calf
to the spirit of the cow shed, or the residents of a household in mourning may
take offerings of food to the graveside of the deceased. In these cases, believers
are the subject of the activity, not the object. They command the ritual techni-
ques needed and know beforehand how to act and why. The appearance of the
supernatural being or some other influence exerted by it is believed to be favor-
able and thus serves a positive social function.
Traditions concerning casual encounters are transmitted primarily through
memorates, whereas more formal ritual descriptions and incantations provide
sources of information about ritual encounters with supernatural beings.
Juha Pentik€ ainen
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Belief, Folk; Religion, Folk.
References
Davidson, Hilda Ellis, and Anna Chaudhri. 2001. Supernatural Enemies. Durham,
NC: Carolina Academic Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
1172 | Superorganic Theories
Superorganic Theories
Postulates that hold culture at a unique level above the individualistic and the
social. The perceiving of culture as a superorganic entity presupposes that
although culture is created by human beings, it functions at a level above and
beyond the individualistic organic and social levels of human existence. How-
ever, arguments on behalf of continuity between the organic (psychological), the
social, and the cultural have led to reinforcement of racist ideologies. Within Eu-
ropean anthropological schools, especially British social anthropology, that con-
tinuity was taken to mean that clearly superior cultures or nations (with
technologically advanced bases, as those of civilized colonial Western powers)
would necessarily be products of superior societies and, consequently, superior
psyches (minds or individuals); coupled with the evolutionary doctrine of the
survival of the fittest, this was also taken as justification for imperial European
policies toward colonized peoples at the stages of so-called savagery and barba-
rism. This ideology coincided with the independent introduction of the psychoan-
alytic approach to the study of culture and society, which, along with similar
psychological notions, comprised an influential trend in the study of humankind
at the beginning of the twentieth century. Among anthropologists in the United
States, a reinterpretation of the superorganic concept took place, and the postu-
lated continuities among the organic, the social, and the superorganic (i.e., cul-
tural) were to be negated. American cultural anthropology developed in
contradistinction to British social anthropology.
The psychoanalytic approach to the study of culture has been attacked on theo-
retical grounds. The problem is a philosophical one, considering the ontological
aspects of culture regarding allied levels of human activities, such as the psycho-
logical, social, and cultural. In 1911, Franz Boas observed that the social or cul-
tural phenomenon is ‘‘in its very essence’’ nonindividualistic. He argued further
that the explanation of cultural phenomena in terms of innate biological differen-
ces leads to the assumption that the whole problem of the development of culture
is reduced to the study of psychological and social conditions, among other fac-
tors such as the effects of the natural environment.
Boas’s criticism of the psychological treatment of culture as reductionism was
persuasively expressed by Alfred Kroeber, one of his disciples. Kroeber’s theory
Superorganic Theories | 1173
Mentifact
A constituent of culture that exists primarily in the minds of the adherents of that
culture. As a classificatory concept, the term mentifact overlaps with covert culture,
or aspects of culture that are not directly observable, and nonmaterial culture, or
aspects of culture that are not expressed via solid matter (e.g., stone, wood, ink).
The term mentifact has been loosely applied to designate mentalistic, intellectual
facts (e.g., sheer knowledge), as well as affective experiences involving feeling (e.g.,
biologically determined emotions, as well as learned sentiments).
The term emerged at the beginning of the twentieth century as part of the
debate over the nature of culture in relation to humanity, and the introduction of
the idea of culture as superorganic. Culture was perceived as referring to both the
process of learning, or human self-cultivation (enculturation), and the resultant
product of that process. Human beings, it was argued, cultivate not only their own
natural potentialities but also the physical objects of the natural environment in
which they live. Consequently, individuals invent instruments for the better satisfac-
tion of their needs; these constitute a second class of cultural products, namely,
artifacts. Since these objects or artifacts exist independently of their human inven-
tors, all such culture products were designated, in Herbert Spencer’s term,
superorganic.
Two additional categories of superorganic products of the cultural process were
identified: mentifacts and socifacts. The first word was introduced to label concep-
tual symbols comprising such products of culture as language, morals, aesthetics,
religious ideals, intellectual aspects of scientific research, and similar mental phe-
nomena. The second word labels aspects of social interaction within a community,
such as social norms and organizations that serve to regulate the conduct of indi-
viduals within society, as well as the conduct of society as a whole in relation to
other societies.
The sum total of the artifacts, socifacts, and mentifacts that comprise superorganic
culture, it has been argued, constitutes the surplus resulting from cultural life. This total
is commonly referred to as a given society’s ‘‘social heritage’’ or ‘‘cultural capital.’’
Hasan El-Shamy
1. The ‘‘Law of Opening’’ and the ‘‘Law of Closing,’’ which result in moving
from calm to excitement and from excitement to calm; consequently, the
Sage does not begin with sudden action and does not end abruptly.
2. The ‘‘Law of Repetition,’’ which allows folk literature to compensate for the lack
of techniques producing full-bodied detail through various sorts of repetition. By
contrast, academic literature employs many means of producing ‘‘emphasis,
means other than repetition.’’ Thus, in European folk literature, we encounter the
‘‘Law of Three,’’ whereas in Indic stories, it is ‘‘Law of Four.’’
3. The ‘‘Law of Two to a Scene.’’
4. The ‘‘Law of Contrast,’’ according to which the Sage is always polarized
and opposites or different but complementary qualities exist side by side.
5. The ‘‘Law of the Importance of Initial and Final Positions,’’ which contrib-
utes to the ‘‘Unity of Plot.’’
6. The ‘‘Law of Concentration on Leading Character,’’ which is, for Olrik, ‘‘the
greatest law of folk traditions.’’
Superorganic Theories | 1175
References
Boas, Franz. 1921. The Mind of Primitive Man. New York: Macmillan.
Bidney, David. 1953. Theoretical Anthropology. New York: Columbia University
Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1965. The Study of Folklore. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
El-Shamy, Hasan. 1967. Folkloric Behavior. PhD thesis, Indiana University,
Bloomington.
Jolles, Andre. 1958. Einfache Formen: Legende, Sage, Mythe, R€
atsel, Spruch, Kasus,
Memorabile, M€ archen, Witz (Primary forms: Religious legend, legend, myth, riddle,
proverb, Kasus, memorate, folktale, joke).T€ubingen, Germany: Halle Saale.
Kroeber, Alfred. 1917. The Superorganic. American Anthropologist. 19: 183 213.
Levi-Strauss, Claude. 1964. Le Cru et le cuit (The raw and the cooked). Paris: Plon.
Palombo, Joseph, Harold K. Bendicsen, and Barry J. Koch. 2009. Guide to Psycho-
analytic Developmental Theories. New York: Springer.
T
Tale Type
1177
1178 | Tale Type
offer an ample overview of a given culture’s narrative tradition and its key
themes in a concise form. Examples of regional type indexes are The Types of
the Norwegian Folktale (edited by Ornulf Hodne) and A Type and Motif Index of
Japanese Folk-Literature by Hiroko Ikeda. The concept of the tale type involves
both empirical and theoretical problems. Foremost among the empirical prob-
lems is the issue of the universality of Aarne and Thompson’s ‘‘international’’
tale types. Because these types were defined on the basis of tales collected
in Europe and neighboring regions, their applicability when describing non-
European tales is often limited. Examples of type indexes in which Aarne and
Thompson’s categorizations and plot definitions have been discarded are Lee
Haring’s Malagasy Tale Index and Patricia P. Waterman’s A Tale-Type Index of
Australian Aboriginal Oral Narratives.
As a theoretical reservation, it is useful to remember that the definition of tale
types depends on the scholar’s understanding of the semantics of the narratives
and his or her interpretation of what kind of similarities (homologies) and differ-
ences appear in the texts. Thus, ‘‘scientific’’ or purely objective definitions and
classifications of folktales are hard to attain.
The most articulate and insightful critics of the concept of the tale type were
the Russian formalists Vladimir Propp and A. I. Nikiforov in the 1920s. Accord-
ing to Propp and Nikiforov, narrators do not rely on single, fixed plots to produce
their tales. Instead, storytellers have a collection of episodes, sequences of
events, and minor elements (motifs) at their disposal, and they use these compo-
nents to fabricate their tales during narrative performances.
In later studies on storytellers and extensive text materials, scholars have
reached a diplomatic solution concerning the problem of the stability of tale
types by recognizing at least two ways of producing tales. The storyteller may
use a well-known plot as the basic structure of his or her tale, or the narrator may
create a new plot by combining traditional and individual elements.
Satu Apo
See Also Folktale; Magic Tale; Motif; Oikotype/Oicotype.
References
Aarne, Antti. 1910. Verzeichnis der M€ archentypen (Types of the folktale). Folklore
Fellows Communications, no. 3. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Aarne, Antti, and Stith Thompson. 1961. The Types of the Folktale: A Classification
and Bibliography. Second revision. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 184.
Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Azzolina, D. S. 1987. Tale-Type and Motif-Indexes: An Annotated Bibliography.
Garland Folklore Bibliographies, no. 12. New York: Garland.
Haring, Lee. 1982. Malagasy Tale Index. Folklore Fellows Communications, no.
231. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Text | 1179
Hodne, Ornulf. 1984. The Types of the Norwegian Folktale. Oslo: Universitetsforlaget.
Ikeda, Hiroko. 1971. A Type and Motif Index of Japanese Folk-Literature. Folklore
Fellows Communications, no. 209. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Jason, Heda. 1970. The Russian Criticism of the ‘‘Finnish School’’ in Folktale Schol-
arship. Norweg 14: 285 294.
Krohn, Kaarle. 1971. Folklore Methodology. Trans. Roger L. Welsh. Austin: Univer-
sity of Texas Press. Originally published as Die folkloristische Arbeitsmethode, Oslo,
1926.
Nikiforov, A. I. 1975. Towards a Morphological Study of the Folktale. In The Study
of Russian Folklore, eds. Felix J. Oinas and Stephen Soudakoff. The Hague: Mouton.
Originally published as K voprosu o morfologiceskom izucenii narodnoj skazki, Lenin-
grad, 1928.
Propp, V. 1970. Morphology of the Folktale, 2nd ed. Trans. Laurence Scott. Austin:
University of Texas Press. Originally published as Morfologija skazki, Leningrad, 1928.
Waterman, Patricia P. 1987. A Tale-Type Index of Australian Aboriginal Oral Narratives.
Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 238. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Text
The basic ‘‘object’’ of folklore research. Folklore texts can be recorded (and pre-
served) by using a variety of writing implements, electromagnetic or visual
facilities, and other media. It is hardly possible to offer a definition for the term
text in the study of folklore that is not ambiguous. If, for instance, the target of
the research is diachronic, the texts that seem to unveil something of the earlier
history of the phenomenon under research would be regarded as relevant. From
the synchronic perspective, the requirements would concern the usefulness of the
texts for the analyses of folklore as incorporated into living human interaction.
There is no doubt that a text written in shorthand from a singer in the nineteenth
century and a text recorded in a performance situation by means of modern tech-
nology are both folklore texts. The problem is whether there is a point of depar-
ture, according to which we may judge some texts as objects of research that
ought to be regarded as more (or less) valuable than others.
The variety of criteria established for folklore texts arises from diverse meth-
odological frameworks, and very often, research practice is a result of following
axioms based on the scientific practices or dominant paradigms currently in fash-
ion. A range of problems surround the concept of text in folkloristics.
To fulfill the demands of proper research as construed during the dominant pe-
riod of the historic-geographic school, scholars were required to develop the
complete body of text variants in their studies, taking into account the time and
place of collection for each text and all available information on the tradition
carrier’s background. This was justified on the assumption that the geographic or
1180 | Text
typological distribution of the preserved texts would reveal the prehistory of the
texts and that some texts might work as a ‘‘codex unicus,’’ a unique and most origi-
nal version, having a key importance. In the beginning of the twentieth century,
the adherents of the historic-geographic school strove to reconstruct metatexts,
archetypes, or invariants. Thus, for example, the typology of folktales proposed by
Antti Aarne and Stith Thompson was originally based on the assumption that each
type had a prehistory and an archetype. It is necessary, however, to note that var-
iants assigned to the same typological category are not necessarily genetically de-
pendent on one another. Furthermore, such a taxonomy cannot fully accommodate
the constant variation of a living tradition. In practice, numerous codes are needed
simultaneously for classifying the majority of folktale texts, and new types to
which no existing codes apply are always being discovered.
In the structural analysis of folktales, or morphology, developed by the Rus-
sian formalist Vladimir Propp, the structure of the text consists of a syntagmatic
order of narrative units called functions. For Propp, unlike many later structural-
ists or structurally oriented folklorists (e.g., Alan Dundes), the bias was dia-
chronic, as the final purpose of the analysis was to reveal the archetype of
folktales and the myth forming the original basis of this archetype. Propp’s anal-
ysis of narrative was synchronic since he used a corpus consisting of 100 folk-
tales and aimed at establishing the syntagmatic system of invariant functions of
folktales on the basis of this corpus.
The French structuralists, by contrast, concentrated on deep structures of the
narrative. In his analysis of myths, Claude Levi-Strauss segmented the corpus
into basic units called mythemes and attached these units into a paradigmatic ma-
trix in order to extract the fundamental meanings of the myth. Algirdas Julien
Greimas also strove to determine an abstract deep structure, which, according to
him, might be exposed from beneath every narrative text.
Later, scholars who advocated the functionalistic paradigm rejected the value of
texts dating from the nineteenth century or earlier, regarding them as dead arti-
facts; it was argued by folklorists such as Kenneth Goldstein and Linda Degh that
those texts were not collected in a natural social context (the proper context
of functioning of the folklore in society) but in artificial situations. Folklore
texts, according to Roger Abrahams, were regarded as folklore only if actually per-
formed, and the folklore discipline was redefined (most notably by Dan Ben-
Amos) as artistic communication in small groups. Suddenly, there was living
folklore all around us: workplace lore, various contemporary tales, legends and
anecdotes, rumors, gossip, graffiti, parodies on proverbs and riddles, the abundant
children’s tradition, jokes, tall tales and jests, and marketplace lore, for example.
The springs of folklore texts certainly do not show any signs of running dry,
despite the fact that scholars at the end of the nineteenth century felt everything
of any importance already had been collected. The questions of where, when, and
Text | 1181
from whom the text originated were no longer regarded as sufficient. It was possi-
ble to discern active and passive tradition bearers, the event of performance, and
the communication process; the whole context became important. The problem of
how to define the context and how to cope with the text/context dichotomy
arose—a concern that continues even now.
Consequently, many of the synchronically oriented approaches to textual anal-
ysis in folkloristics have been influenced since the 1970s by text linguistics, by
sociolinguistics, and subsequently, by discourse analysis. During the develop-
ment of text linguistics, the notions of context and the communicative function
were emphasized as a counterbalance to the abstract models created by structur-
alists (such as Propp, Levi-Strauss, and Greimas) or in opposition to the genera-
tive transformational theory developed by Noam Chomsky, based on the analysis
of separate texts without context. The main bias of sociolinguistics is the use of
language in social contexts as an empirical object of research. Text linguistics
and sociolinguistics gave new impetus to folkloristics, and the birth of the per-
formance (and contextual) school is, in many ways, connected with the develop-
ment of modern linguistics and the sociologically oriented analysis of discourse.
Through the approaches mentioned earlier, the social variation of texts becomes
an important object of study. One of the key notions is communicative compe-
tence, the ability of the performer to produce texts (e.g., of a given genre) coher-
ently and to relate them to the situation of performance, audience, and other
elements of context.
Many other approaches have stressed the importance of the performance situa-
tion. Milman Parry and Albert Lord suggested that the performers of epic texts
did not reproduce their poems as complete entities drawn from memory but used
instead an internalized system of poetic devices of oral-formulaic technique, pro-
viding the basic tools (formulas, themes, and story patterns) for the production of
folk poetry that varied from one performing situation to another (composition
in performance). According to John Miles Foley, formulas and story patterns
function not so much as compositional conventions but as cognitive immanent
categories. One important branch influenced by oral tradition studies is the
orality-literacy discussion and the theories of development (and coexistence) of
orality, writing, and print.
The ethnopoetic approach has focused on revealing narrative patterns reaching
from the level of stylistic features and other formal elements of surface structure
up to the overall meaning structures or focused on transcription systems of
recorded performances in order to visualize such ‘‘paralinguistic’’ meaningful
features as pitch, quality of voice, loudness, or pause, for example.
One of the key issues in the debate concerning folklore texts is the notion of
genre. The concept of genre and the practice of dividing folklore texts into a system
of genres (e.g., for purposes of classification) have been among the fundamental
1182 | Text
functional tools used in the analysis of folklore. The majority of the genre terms used
by folklorists are devised by researchers and refer to concepts aiming at universal use
(e.g., in archives). From the point of view of the producer (performer) and the re-
ceiver (audience) of folklore, genres, however, are not, in themselves, important, and
they are not recognized as systems. In analyzing folklore texts as genres, we are, in
fact, analyzing the means of expression of different channels available to folk culture
for describing, interpreting, or explaining life and the environment. Genre should not
be an analytical fossil constructed by researchers and existing outside the realm of liv-
ing folklore. If, for example, a commonly used archive classification does not seem
to apply to the folklore of some ethnic minority or other special group, researchers
should take heed of classifications to be found in the culture in question.
The processes of creating, collecting, and recording folklore texts are taking
place in constantly changing sociohistorical, cultural, and political settings. For
this reason, the texts are not products of arranging symbolic objects in any stable
content, order, or structure having fixed meanings; rather, they constitute a multi-
dimensional and multilevel network of forms of manifestation and interdepen-
dences. The different types of discourse and genres and the pertinent elements of
texture serve the purpose of making distinctions, enabling the suitable choice in
the jumble of possible realizations in a given situation.
During the history of folkloristics, folklore texts have been exposed to a meth-
odological cross fire. A productive synthesis is needed. Since the 1960s, the inte-
gration of various approaches has yielded promising results in the study of
folklore texts: structuralism, oral-formulaic theory, ethnopoetics, cognitive scien-
ces, computer analysis, sociolinguistics and discourse analysis, the notions of
folkloristic variation and intertextuality, and studies on gender and power.
The field is open to fruitful discussion, but the era of rigid axioms has not yet,
it seems, come to an end. The biggest problem concerning future prospects for
research on folklore texts appears to be how to prevent fruitless, authoritative
discourse according to which only the approach presented by a given scholar or a
dominant school or paradigm is the one leading to the ‘‘truth.’’
Lauri Harvilahti
See Also Literary Approach.
References
Bauman, Richard, and Americo Paredes. 1972. Toward New Perspectives in Folklore.
Austin: University of Texas Press.
Ben-Amos, Dan. 1971. Toward a Definition of Folklore in Context. Journal of American
Folklore 84: 3 15.
Briggs, Charles. 1993. Metadiscursive Practices and Scholarly Authority in Folkloris-
tics. Journal of American Folklore 106: 387 437.
Textiles | 1183
Textiles
Cultural products of cloth. Often regarded as creative objects subject to the imagi-
nation and ingenuity of a community of creators, textiles reveal much about stylis-
tic choice and the aesthetics of experience based on local ways of being creative.
They are also practical objects. In the domestic realm, textiles cover floors, walls,
furniture and people. They not only offer warmth and material comfort but also
symbolize personal, ethnic, regional and national identities through artistic meth-
ods (weaving, sewing, plaiting, etc.) and the use of decorative motifs. The iconog-
raphy of each textile is frequently based on symbolic patterning and is imbued
with cultural meaning extending through space and time. Textiles have the
capacity of ‘‘diffusing mythology into daily life’’ (St. George 2006).
In terms of creativity and construction, folklorists examine the range of inven-
tive processes associated with textile making to determine the degree that genres
such as weaving, bark cloth, felt, pieced quilts, painted fabric, embroidery, and
so forth are cultural and social productions as well as technical ones. The notion
of the textile as an interactive, performance-conditioned object—that is, a cata-
lyst and agent—is also compelling. As such, it suggests an array of interpretive
possibility from the pictorial narrative traditions of Southeast Asian story cloths
with their visual portrayal of sequenced life experiences to South Pacific plant
fiber cloaks bearing the physical imprint or traces of generations of owners and
wearers, which evoke complex stories of lineage, legacy, and dispute. Folklore
methodology with its emphasis on tradition, innovation, process, and perfor-
mance is particularly effective when applied to textile interpretation and to the
substantive yet fluid meanings of design patterns shifting within cultural contexts.
The term textile derives from texere, a Latin verb denoting ‘‘to construct,’’ ‘‘to
weave,’’ or ‘‘to plait’’ (to braid). Both textile and text share this root verb and are
linked to the notion of weaving (or composing) a tangible, visual or literary
object virtually out of nothing in order to create an aesthetically or culturally
1184 | Textiles
intelligible entity. Folklorists discern cultural meaning from textiles by not only
analyzing the way these objects are made but also by assessing how a society
continues to regard and represent singular textiles in their narrative repertoire long
after the objects have lost their usefulness or immediate relevancy. This is signifi-
cant for understanding the symbolic power and value of textiles within a group
context. For example, today Maori woven cloaks belonging to nineteenth-century
chiefs are stored in museum collections out of social circulation. Nevertheless, in
Maori oral tradition these cloaks have names. Stories are still recounted with allu-
sions to events belonging to different cloak biographies. Hidden from public view
but narratively ‘‘alive,’’ these cloaks can be considered ‘‘objects in action.’’ Stories
are told about these objects as well as told in conjunction with these objects. Thus,
relative to textiles and material culture, folklorists examine the resonance of
objects activated through exchanges among makers, curators, chroniclers, collec-
tors, viewers, and so forth with certain objects. The folklore theory of practice as
applied to textiles addresses a range of human-object relations and performances
inclusive of conception and production, cultural behavior around objects, social
context, cultural discourse, and self-reflexivity.
Folktale Themes
Textile lore appears in many folktales as stories of magical performance and
prowess (e.g., magic carpets, cloth of gold, etc.). One dominant theme in Euro-
pean folklore is a belief in clandestine nocturnal spirit helpers who perform tasks
of spinning, weaving, and sewing during the night. Other tales narrate stories
about na€ve and inexperienced characters caught in untenable situations where
they must spin, weave, and sew staggering amounts of raw material in record
time (e.g., flax into gold). In these tales, dwarfs, supernaturals, and evil outcasts
rescue the distressed spinner (weaver, stitcher, etc.) and drive dangerous bargains
in exchange for their help. Regarding folklore analysis, textile themes also high-
light contemporary cultural attitudes toward textile creation and bestow a kind of
agency on textiles relative to human behavior vis-a-vis creativity, social rela-
tions, and historical circumstances (Schneider 2006).
A woman spins wool during the International Poncho Day in Nobsa, Colombia, June 21,
2009. Local craftsmen make sheep’s wool ponchos using ancestral techniques. (AP/Wide
World Photos)
banana leaf loincloths and Buddhist ceremonial robes made from the leaf stems
of the aquatic lotus plant are historically or iconographically rooted, they are not
limited to solely reproducing or replicating cultural identity but also ‘‘mediate
between self and society in ways that make visible how people reposition them-
selves in times of dramatic change’’ (Hamilton and Milgram 2007). By analyzing
textile creation in terms of its social, political and religious significance, it is
apparent that eclectic identities bound up with cloth production and display are
diverse, often fragmented, in flux, and rarely stable. Within the interplay among
textile creation, a community’s value system and its history, the evolution and
mutability of artistic, cultural and social domains define and determine the main
constituents of continuity, change, and creative innovation.
Aesthetics
Folk aesthetics or ethnoaesthetics pertain to a micro-level of artistry in local or
regional cultural zones and are grounded in ‘‘aesthetics of experience’’ where art
and life are not necessarily separate realities. An internal (insider) understanding
of ethnoaesthetics is shared by a community of textile makers and users and is
based on personal and group identity, knowledge, and appreciation of technical
skill and virtuosity, complexity, customary design concepts, and judgments about
symbolically important themes. In Joyce Ice’s study of aesthetics and quilting
groups, she emphasizes the social considerations of reaching group consensus
about pattern, choice of color, stitching, and so forth as part of the process of col-
lective artistic decision making. The quilt becomes both the social and aesthetic
product of this collaborative creative process (Ice 1993).
Gender
Worldwide there are variations on gender-based division of artistic labor in the
traditional production of textiles. In various geographical locations, women
Textiles | 1187
weave and men decorate and embellish or vice versa. Today, however, the clas-
sic dichotomies counterbalancing women’s work of weaving and dyeing with
men’s farming and fighting activities are now scrambled, where women are
cultivators, processors, textile artists, innovators, and entrepreneurs. The old
prevailing attitude in Indonesia where weaving symbolized the ‘‘women’s war-
path’’ as paired with men’s headhunting battles (loom and spear) is now super-
seded by the reality and extent of women’s multiple roles in commerce,
finance, and creative areas of responsibility. Locally produced textiles’ popu-
larity in the global marketplace also offers more opportunities to women artists
and marketers in distant places. At the same time, the dynamics and asymme-
tries of globalization shift and realign relationships between marginal or pe-
ripheral societies and world trade centers. Global developments figure in
folklore theory where questions are asked from the vantage point of a scholarly
tradition operating at microlevels of society. These queries are about power of
place, centrality, regional, ethnic and national identities, subaltern groups, and
social change.
Textile scholarship focuses on the object as agent (‘‘objects in action’’),
where the engagement with the textile and the action of artistic creativity and
its consequences are paramount (Gell 1998). Folklore has long been inter-
ested in communication and is ideally suited to explore the communica-
tive power of textiles as well as their function, aesthetics, and performative
associations.
Suzanne P. MacAulay
See Also Art, Folk; Material Culture.
References
Gell, Alfred. 1998. Art and Agency: An Anthropological Theory. Oxford: Clarendon.
Gillow, John, and Bryan Sentance. 1999. World Textiles. London: Thames & Hudson.
Hamilton, Roy W., and B. Lynne Milgram, eds. 2007. Material Choices. Los
Angeles: Fowler Museum Textile Series, No. 8.
Ice, Joyce. 1993. Women’s Aesthetics and the Quilting Process. In Feminist Theory
and the Study of Folklore, eds. Susan Tower Hollis, Linda Pershing, and M. Jane
Young. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.
St. George, Robert. 2006. Home Furnishings and Domestic Interiors. In Handbook of
Material Culture, eds. Christopher Tilley et al. London: Sage Publications.
Schneider, Jane. 2006. Cloth and Clothing. In Handbook of Material Culture, eds.
Christopher Tilley et al. London: Sage Publications.
Schoeser, Mary. 2003. World Textiles: A Concise History. London: Thames & Hudson.
Weiner, Annette B., and Jane Schneider. 1989. Cloth and Human Experience.
Washington: Smithsonian Institution Press.
1188 | Thompson, Stith
Thompson, Stith
communicative event, Thompson’s research, his scholarly editions, and his influ-
ence began to decline. Nevertheless, his contributions have been enormous; no
other American scholar has been as important or as influential.
Warren Roberts
See Also Historic-Geographic Method.
References
Thompson, Stith. 1955 1958. Motif Index of Folk Literature. 6 vols. Rev. ed.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1929. Tales of the North Americans Indians. Cambridge: Harvard
University Press.
Thompson, Stith. 1946. The Folktale. New York: Dryden Press.
Thompson, Stith, and Antti Aarne. 1964. The Types of the Folktale: A Classification
and Bibliography. Folklore Fellows Communication no. 184. Helsinki: Academia Sci-
entiarum Fennica.
Tourism
scholars, and practitioners. Tourism also provides an important tool for examining
and interpreting globalization, the most transformative process in the world today.
As a mode of travel, communication, visualization, and experience, tourism not
only reaches isolated parts of the world but also transforms social life and identity
at home. Tourism has become an integral part of all societies, and—perhaps, more
importantly—the tourism industry is one of the largest and most dynamic eco-
nomic forces in the world.
Francesca M. Muccini
See Also Beliefs, Folk; Folk Culture; Folklife.
References
AlSayyad, Nezar. 2001. Consuming Tradition, Manufacturing Heritage: Global
Norms and Urban Forms in the Age of Tourism. New York: Routledge.
Bull, Adrian. 1991. The Economics of Travel and Tourism. New York: Longman
Cheshire.
Burn, Peter. 1999. An Introduction to Tourism and Anthropology. New York:
Routledge.
Clifford, James. 1997. Routes: Travel and Translation in the Late Twentieth Century.
Cambridge: Harvard University Press.
Cohen, Erik. 1984. The Sociology of Tourism: Approaches, Issues, and Findings. An-
nual Review of Sociology 10: 373 392.
Coleman, Simon, and Mike Crang. 2002. Tourism: Between Places and Perform-
ance. Oxford: Berghahn Books.
Crick, M. 1989. Representations of International Tourism in the Social Sciences:
Sun, Sex, Sights, Savings and Servility. Annual Review of Anthropology 18: 307 344.
Feifer, M. 1985. Going Places. London: Macmillan.
Feifer, M. 1986. Tourism in History. New York: Stein and Day.
Graburn, Nelson. 1989. Tourism: The Sacred Journey. In Hosts and Guests: The An-
thropology of Tourism, ed. Valene Smith. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania
Press, pp. 21 36.
Hanna, Stephen P., and Vincent J. Del Casino Jr. 2003. Mapping Tourism. Minneap-
olis: University of Minnesota Press.
Leed, Eric J. 1991. The Mind of the Traveler: From Gilgamesh to Global Tourism.
New York: Basic Books.
MacCannell, Dean. 1989. The Tourist. New York: Schocken.
Mazanec, Josef A. 1985. Constructing Traveller Types. In Change in Tourism: Peo-
ple, Places, Processes, eds. Richard Butler and Douglas Pearce. New York: Routledge,
pp. 137 158.
Ringer, Greg. 1998. Destinations: Cultural Landscapes of Tourism. New York:
Routledge.
Rojek, Chris. 1993. Ways of Escape: Modern Transformations in Leisure and Travel.
London: Macmillan.
Toy, Folk | 1193
Rojek, Chris, and John Urry. 1997. Touring Cultures: Transformations of Travel and
Theory. New York: Routledge.
Rowan, Yorke, and Uzi Baram. 2004. Marketing Heritage: Archaeology and the
Consumption of the Past. Oxford: Altamira Press.
Smith, S. L. J. 1989. Tourism Analysis: A Handbook. New York: Wiley.
Turner, Louis, and John Ash. 1975. The Golden Hordes: International Tourism and
the Pleasure Periphery. London: Constable.
Urry, John. 1995. Consuming Places. New York: Routledge.
Urry, John. 2002. The Tourist Gaze: Theory, Culture and Society Series, 2nd ed.
London: Sage Publications.
Toy, Folk
Play objects, often although not always, rendered in miniature. Toys belong to
the realm of fantasy, even though they are material objects. The object may have
been created for one purpose, but we only know it is actually a ‘‘toy’’ if we see
someone playing with it. Stones can be toys, but clearly not all stones are toys,
and dolls certainly can be toys, yet we cannot assume that every small, doll-like
human figure is actually a toy. The oldest of what we now recognize as toys—
balls, tops, and human doll figures—may have been utilized for magical-
religious or healing purposes in one context and then used either for reenactment
or for parody when placed in the hands of a child. The separation of the category
‘‘folk toy’’ from ‘‘toy’’ is itself controversial, reflecting basic disagreements over
definitions, players, and usage.
Toys as Culture, an elaborate, book-length essay by Brian Sutton-Smith,
makes the point that although toys are often thought of as realistic miniatures,
they vary from ‘‘those which perfectly resemble that which they signify . . . to
those which are quite schematic and convey only those salient traits of those
objects they signify . . . to those which distort or have little realistic signification
whatsoever.’’ In the popular sense, the toy is considered, according to the Oxford
English Dictionary, ‘‘a thing of little or no value or importance; a foolish or
senseless affair, a piece of nonsense, a material object for children or others to
play with (often in imitation of some familiar object); a plaything; also some-
thing contrived for amusement rather than for practical use.’’ However, despite
all their divergent views, scholars interested in folk toys would likely contend
that the toy is anything but ‘‘senseless’’ or of ‘‘no value or importance.’’ Rather,
they would suggest, it is precisely in the small things—such as songs, poems,
gestures, and toys—that one sees the larger cultural patterns.
The small but varied literature on folk toys can be divided into three main
groups, each giving a different meaning to the term folk toy: the historical study
1194 | Toy, Folk
of folk toys as artifacts; the exhibition of specific toy collections primarily con-
sisting of photographic displays, often of specific ethnic groups or regions; and
the hidden literature on folk toys, embedded in larger ethnographies. In the first
genre of folk toy literature, the historical study of toys as artifacts, the emphasis
is on the description of the object and its basic historical context. We can only
speculate whether children played with toys or whether the toys they utilized
merely did not survive the years like their sturdier adult counterparts did. In the
second genre, toys as ethnicity on display, folk toys are seen alongside ritual
objects as items made in a specific locale, and the makers of the toys are empha-
sized. In this view, toys are considered reflective of a specific cultural style or
people, and they may be objects for either children or adults. In the third genre of
folk toy literature, toys as a part of ethnographic description, folk toys are typi-
cally seen as those objects made exclusively by children for children of a specific
culture.
In the literature that treats folk toys as artifacts, folk toys are generally hand-
made objects and are said to represent the daily life of specific peoples in history.
The primary research tools in this literature are archaeological, and the texts are
typically comparative. Some conjecture has been made evaluating which minia-
tures or instruments or dolls were used for recreational purposes and which were
employed for religious or magical purposes.
Two classic texts examining toys through time, beginning with antiquity, are
Antonia Fraser’s History of Toys and Max von Boehn’s Dolls and Puppets. Both
Boehn and Fraser warn of confusing ancient dolls and ritual figures, and their
pages are filled with photographs of ancient toys from a variety of world muse-
ums. Both texts mention the ancient throwballs, dolls, and animal figures found
in Egyptian tombs, possibly for the entertainment of the dead, although these
were not found in the tombs of children, only adults. Chapters on Greek and
Roman toys consistently mention Roman dice, knucklebones, and other games of
chance in archaeological finds, although these items also could have been used
for divination. It seems that the first record of kite flying was made in China, in
206 BCE when General Han-Sin used kites to measure the distance from his camp
to the royal palace. We are left questioning whether these objects were tools or
toys or both.
Boehn, because of his focus on a particular type of toy, is able to include pre-
historic idols, ancestor images, fetishes, amulets, talismans, funeral images, and
mannequins. He then examines the early European doll and dolls in literature
and proceeds to the most mobile of dolls: the automata, movable images, and
the early puppet shows. Unfortunately, although it is rich with detail, much of
the book has an evolutionary tone as the author makes logical leaps about the
supposed developmental connections between ancient dolls, ‘‘exotic dolls,’’ and
the dolls of Western Europe. Fraser, too, links ‘‘ancient and primitive playthings’’
Toy, Folk | 1195
Ethnographies that have specifically examined the toy as part of a larger sys-
tem are associated with ethnographies of child life or child cultures. These stud-
ies promulgate the view of the folk toy as a recreational object made by the
children themselves—for developmental, functional purposes. Most significant
among the authors writing in this vein is the neo-Freudian Erik Erikson, who, in
his collection of essays entitled Toys and Reasons, argues that the body is the
first toy and that toying and toys are involved with the child’s attempt to master
the environment in miniature.
Helen Schwartzman’s Transformations: The Anthropology of Children’s Play
is an excellent source guide and leads the reader through the culture and person-
ality studies and through comparative classics such as the Children of Six Cul-
tures: A Psycho-Cultural Analysis, compiled in 1975 by Beatrice and John
Whiting; Cora Dubois’ 1944 Indonesian study called The People of Alor; T.
Centner’s 1962 L’Enfant Africain et ses jeux; Wayne Dennis’s 1940 journal
study The Hopi Child; and the early works of Margaret Mead and Gregory Bate-
son. In all of these studies, the emphasis is on the understanding of the entire cul-
ture of the child in order to examine cross-culturally the relationship of culture to
personality in the development of humans. The details about toys may be sparse in
any individual work, but each offers insights about the use of such objects in child-
ren’s cultures—information not found in the first two categories of toy literature.
Centner’s study of the Bantu-speaking groups includes much on dolls, dollhouses,
cars, weaponry, and a seasonal creation of a children’s village. Schwartzman refers
to Dubois’ description of ‘‘ingenious’’ child-made squirt guns made of bamboo,
tops, cats’ cradles, marbles, and jacks. Dennis, too, has described ‘‘ingenious’’
child-made playhouses constructed of mud and sand, dolls made from found
bones, and peach-seed sheep. In all of these examples, the ‘‘folk toys’’ have been
made by the players themselves, with little or no guidance from the adults.
One modern American example of a work on folk toys as those made by the
children themselves is Simon Bronner’s American Children’s Folklore. In an
otherwise generalized text broadly collected across the United States with little
ethnic or regional information, there is a wealth of information in a chapter enti-
tled ‘‘We Made It Ourselves.’’ Chewing gum wrapper chains, string friendship
bracelets, paper fortune-telling squares, and slingshots and tree forts are given as
examples of children’s own folk toys and constructions, along with diagrams and
photographs of the child as toy maker.
As with many other genres of traditional expression, perhaps we should focus
not on origin but on issues of use in context to arrive at conclusions regarding the
nature of the folk toy. If the child-made ingenious invention travels and is made by
adults elsewhere, is it no longer a folk toy? If a hero toy is made by machine from
another country but labeled as a local hero, is it not also a folk toy? Fraser and
Boehn suggest that machine production and large-scale distribution of toys led to
1198 | Tradition
the disappearance of the folk toy, reinforcing the notion that the term refers to the
handmade process distributed locally. But if the German top with Hebrew letters
known as a dreidel is made in plastic and by machine in the United States, is it no
longer a folk toy? Although some toys are indeed traditional in a certain locale and
among a certain group of players, it is only the unused toy—unchallenged by
any player and, therefore, divorced from both a performance context and ludic
tradition—that may not become an actual folk toy.
Ann Richman Beresin
See Also Childbirth and Childbearing; Children’s Folklore; Games, Folk.
References
Bronner, Simon J. 1988. American Children’s Folklore. Little Rock, AR: August
House.
Chanan, Gabriel, and Hazel Francis. 1984. Toys and Games of Children of the
World. Paris and Barcelona: UNESCO and Serbal.
Erikson, Erik. 1977. Toys and Reasons. New York: W. W. Norton.
Datta, Birendranath. 1986. Folk Toys of Assam. Assam, India: Directorate of Cultural
Affairs, Government of Assam.
Fraser, Antonia. 1966. A History of Toys. London: Wiedenfield and Nicolson.
Hercik, Emanuel. 1952. Folk Toys: Les Jouets Populaires. Prague: Orbis.
May, Roland. 1992. Les Jeux de table dans l’antiquite (Table games in antiquity).
Special issue entitled Jeux et jouets dans l’antiquit
e et au Moyen Age (Games and toys
in antiquity and the Middle Ages). Les Dossiers d’archaelogie No. 168, February.
Opie, Iona, Robert Opie, and Brian Alderson. 1989. The Treasures of Childhood:
Books, Toys, and Games from the Opie Collection. London: Pavilion.
Pettit, Florence H., and Robert M. 1978. Mexican Folk Toys, Festival Decorations,
and Ritual Objects. New York: Hastings House.
Schwartzman, Helen. 1978. Transformations: The Anthropology of Children’s Play.
New York: Plenum.
Sutton-Smith, Brian. 1986. Toys as Culture. New York: Gardner.
von Boehn, Max. 1966. Dolls and Puppets. New York: Cooper Square.
Tradition
Repeated pattern of behaviors, beliefs, or enactment passed down from one genera-
tion to the next. Traditions are culturally recognized and sustained; in general, folklo-
rists have maintained a particular interest in those that are orally transmitted. Within
the discipline of folklore, the historicity of tradition has been subjected to a variety of
interpretations—for example, a set of cultural ideals regarded as a coherent unit in
which past ideals influence the present patterns of behavior in the group, a recognized
Tradition | 1199
set of present practices with origins in the past, or a set of practices created in the past
that is purposefully maintained by the group in the present.
Thus, the definition of the term tradition elicits a variety of responses. One
definition would deem tradition as something passed down from one generation
to the next, generally by informal means, with little or no change in the transmis-
sion of that item or in the item that is transmitted. However, particularly in the
latter decades of the twentieth century, many folklorists have asserted that tradi-
tion entails a complex set of relationships between the past and the present, in
which the past sets precedent for the present and the present reflects the past in
its adherence to a particular tradition. Tradition is often defined as an adjective
in relation to specific genres, such as a ‘‘traditional ballad,’’ ‘‘traditional narra-
tive,’’ or traditional belief,’’ or in terms of technical use, such as ‘‘traditional
modes of transmission.’’ In these and like constructions, tradition is understood
as a set of preexisting values and materials particular to a genre, which have been
passed from one generation to the next. In the performance of a traditional genre,
these preexisting values are of greater importance than the performers’ individual
Dia de Los Muertos celebrations have their roots in pre-Columbian Aztec and other native
festivals memorializing departed loved ones. The celebration occurs annually on Novem-
ber 1 and November 2, coinciding with the similar Roman Catholic celebrations of All
Saints Day and All Souls Day. During the holiday, departed friends and family return from
the land of the dead to visit with the living. The living prepare special offerings of food and
gifts, which are placed on the family altar, or ofrendas, either in the home, in the local par-
ish chapel, or outside the family cemetery. (Zepherwind/Dreamstime.com)
1200 | Tradition
tastes, and judgment of the relative success or failure of the performance is based
on these constructs. As folklorist Jan Brunvand asserts, there is a relative fixity
of form that causes these art forms to be regarded as traditional.
For the bearers of a particular tradition or set of traditions, the performance
establishes a connection between the present group and their predecessors. There
is an understanding that a tradition is important with linking the past to the pres-
ent as a form of identity making. This continuity over time venerates the tradition
as something of central importance to the group. Distinct from a custom, for
example, a tradition bears the patina of time and takes on something of a near-
sacred role within the group’s worldview. A seemingly nonsensical activity can be
elevated within a group if that activity is classified as a tradition. Markers such as
‘‘tradition dictates’’ or ‘‘it’s part of our tradition’’ set the activity described apart
from the day-to-day realities of the group and ascribe a special status to it.
Traditions remain recognizable through successive performances, but certain
variations within group standards may be allowed. Traditions represent both con-
tinuity through time and innovation within particular performances. The continu-
ity (or sedimentation, as it is defined by Paul Ricoeur) manifests itself through
the consistently identifiable features within the tradition and its repeated per-
formances. Innovation is manifest in each particular performance, wherein cer-
tain deviations from the tradition are allowed and even expected within group
normative standards. How long it takes for an item to become a tradition—for sed-
imentation to produce a consistently identifiable core to the tradition—is subject to
the dynamics of the group and the role that particular tradition fills. For a transient
group such as college students, a particular cheer, hand gesture, or greeting may
become a tradition relatively quickly. In these cases, the rapid turnover rate of
group members dictates that the process of tradition creation be accelerated. For
other groups, though, the development from simple repetition and handing down
of a certain practice or belief into an accepted tradition may take several years,
decades, or generations before it is understood and accepted to be a tradition.
Within the scholarly use, traditions represent a core set of traits handed down
through succeeding generations, and they often identify and are identified with spe-
cific groups. The word tradition is used to define and to identify both methods of
transmission and specific practices. As such, a definition of the term is based on two
key elements. First, it is understood as something passed through succeeding genera-
tions in a relatively fixed form. There is an identifiable core within a specific tradi-
tion or mode of transmission that is identifiable through time and among various
performances. Second, individual performances reflect a continuity in performance
and an adherence to the central core of the tradition to a degree at which any given
performance is recognized as fulfilling the dictums of that particular tradition. How-
ever, there may be certain variations on the core elements in the individual perfor-
mances that are idiosyncratic to those performances. These variations, which are
Tradition | 1201
Procession
The act of moving along in an orderly fashion or in a ceremonious or formal man-
ner. The procession dates back to ancient times and serves as an official part of a
ceremony during ritualistic activities or festivities. As a form of ritual, the proces-
sion can represent a public display of an established social institution. As a struc-
tural component of festival, the procession often provides the opportunity for
positive group interaction in the community.
The procession is characterized by a display of individuals and institutions who, in the
act of moving along in succession, reaffirm their place within the given social structure of
a community. In this manner, dominant community values are expressed as a formal
event in which the order of the procession is prescribed. Common examples include
the processional in a wedding and the procession generale in eighteenth-century Montpe-
lier, France, which, as Robert Darnton observed, symbolized the corporate order of
urban society. That procession, composed of municipal officials, members of the clergy,
and leading officials of the town, was a public statement taken to the streets, whereby
the city represented itself to itself, to inspire both power and awe in its observers.
Processions differ from parades in their form and content. The Day of the Dead
procession held throughout Mexico every October–November is a religious
expression of the temporary merging of the living and spirit worlds to pay tribute
to deceased family and friends.
In contrast, the parade is a more flexible and loose form of public display that of-
ten conveys sentiments opposed to those in power. Robert DaMatta demonstrated
this difference by distinguishing between the ritualistic expressions of Brazil’s Inde-
pendence Day and the world of carnival. Independence Day is associated with the
armed forces and national authorities, but carnival is associated with the common
people. The procession of authoritarian figures on Independence Day represents
the social mechanism of reinforcement that acts to strengthen social roles through
the separation of elements, categories, or rules. In contrast, carnival employs the
mechanism of inversion that works to unite normally separate social roles and rela-
tionships that are rigidly segregated in daily life.
Georgia Fox
or beliefs based on a connection with past practices and beliefs and that these are
accepted by the group and fulfill a specific role in group identity.
Randal S. Allison
See Also Aesthetics; Family Folklore; Festival; Invented Tradition; Ritual; Transmission.
References
Bauman, Richard. 1992. Folklore. In Folklore, Cultural Performances, and Popular
Entertainments: A Communications Centered Handbook, ed. Richard Bauman. New
York and Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Beardslee, Karen E. 2004. Translating Tradition: A Longman Reader. New York:
Pearson Longman.
Brunvand, Jan. 1986. The Field of Folklore. In The Study of American Folklore, 3rd
ed. New York: W. W. Norton.
DaMatta, Roberto. 1991. Carnivals, Rogues and Heroes: An Interpretation of the
Brazilian Dilemma. Notre Dame, IN: University of Notre Dame Press.
DeCaro, Frank. 2004. Re-situating Folklore: Folk Contexts and Twentieth-Century
Literature and Art. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press.
Graber, Christoph Beat, and Mira Burri-Nenova. 2008. Intellectual Property and Tradi-
tional Cultural Expressions in a Digital Environment. Northampton, MA: Edward Elgar.
Hobsbawm, Eric, and Terence Ranger, eds. 1985. The Invention of Tradition.
Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.
Jones, Michael Owen. 1989. Craftsman of the Cumberlands: Tradition and Creativ-
ity. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky.
De L’Estoile, Benoit, Federico Neiburg, and Lygia Sigaud, eds. 2005. Empires,
Nations, and Natives: Anthropology and State-Making. Durham: Duke University Press.
Moore, Henrietta. 1990. Paul Ricoeur: Action, Meaning, and Text. In Reading Mate-
rial Culture: Structuralism, Hermeneutics and Post-Structuralism, ed. Christopher
Tilley. Oxford: Basil Blackwell.
Ruggles, D. Fairchild, and Helaine Silverman, eds. 2009. Intangible Heritage
Embodied. New York: Springer.
Schneider, William. 2008. Living with Stories: Telling, Re-telling, and Remembering.
Logan: Utah State University Press.
Stoeltje, Beverly J. 1992. Festival. In Folklore, Cultural Performances and Popular-
Entertainments, ed. Richard Bauman. New York: Oxford University Press.
Toelken, Barre 1979. Describing Folklore. In The Dynamics of Folklore, by Barre
Toelken. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Traditionalization
The active process by which people situate their creative acts within a history of
similar acts either as part of a recognizable tradition or as imbued with the
Traditionalization | 1203
References
Bauman, Richard. 2004. A World of Others’ Words: Cross-Cultural Perspectives on
Intertextuality. Malden, MA: Blackwell Publishers.
Gilman, Lisa. 2004. The Traditionalization of Women’s Dancing, Hegemony, and
Politics in Malawi. Journal of Folklore Research 41(1): 33 60.
Handler, Richard, and Jocelyn Linnekin. 1984. Tradition, Genuine or Spurious. Jour-
nal of American Folklore 97(385): 273 290.
Hobswam, Eric, and Terrence Ranger. 1983. The Invention of Tradition. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
Hymes, Dell. 1975. Folklore’s Nature and the Sun’s Myth. Journal of American
Folklore 88(350): 345 369.
Tradition Bearer | 1205
Mould, Tom. 2005. The Paradox of Traditionalization: Negotiating the Past in Choc-
taw Prophetic Discourse. Journal of Folklore Research 42(3): 255 294.
Ruggles, D. Fairchild, and Helaine Silverman, eds. 2009. Intangible Heritage
Embodied. New York: Springer.
Tradition Bearer
References
Ben-Amos, Dan, and Liliane Weissberg, eds. 1999. Cultural Memory and the Con-
struction of Identity. Detroit: Wayne State University Press.
Geertz, Clifford. 1973. The Interpretation of Cultures. New York: Basic Books.
Niles, John D. 1999. Homo Narrans: The Poetics and Anthropology of Oral Litera-
ture. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Pentik€ainen, Juha Y. 1978. Oral Repertoire and World View: An Anthropological
Study of Marina Takalo’s Life History. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
von Sydow, Carl Wilhelm. 1948. Selected Papers on Folklore: Published on the
Occasion of His 70th Birthday. Copenhagen: Rosenkilde and Bagger.
Transformation
The changing between human and animal. It is widely believed that some human
beings are able to transform themselves into animals at will. In European lore,
the lycanthrope, or werewolf, is a common form of this transformation, but such
figures are common around the world, and they are thought to occur for a variety
of purposes. Often (as with the wolf in Europe, the jaguar in South America, and
the lion and leopard in Africa), it is a large and dangerous predator whose shape
is taken on by a human being. In China and Japan, the fox often functions as a
were-animal. Such animals, unlike the were-animals of the movies, look just like
other animals of their type; they are not half-man, half-animal creatures. As
Johannes Wilbert points out, ‘‘Jaguars being alter egos of shamans, one can never
be sure whether a jaguar is really an animal, or, rather, a man.’’ Because the
transformation involves a substitution of spirits and because the spirit world is a
reversed form of the human world, it is not uncommon for the animal transfor-
mation to involve an efficacious reversal of some sort: The shaman may somer-
sault one way to turn into a jaguar, then the other way to regain his human form.
A common form of the belief involves a sorcerer who changes periodically into
another creature and does terrible damage in animal form. He or she is usually
Transformation | 1207
gaining revenge on someone who has given offense. This version of the belief
shows up in the following (typical) account: A woman is out in the woods with her
husband, but he leaves her alone for a short time, whereupon a wolf attacks her.
She defends herself, perhaps aided by another person, and injures the wolf, then
sets out to find her husband. But when she finds him, she sees that he has a wound
that corresponds to the one the wolf had suffered or has some of her clothing in his
teeth. In Europe, the werewolf was believed to undergo transformation by means
of a salve and a wolf skin or sometimes a girdle, and he or she might be con-
demned to live as a wolf for a specified period of time.
The crucial event in such transformations is a movement of the spirit from one
body into another; the spirit is commonly viewed as a kind of interchangeable
part. Therefore, a human spirit can enter a wolf, for instance, and operate its
body, or the wolf’s spirit can operate a human body (but in general, it is much
more common for a human to turn into an animal). Because such exchanges of
spirit occur also with other supernatural figures, it is not surprising that the were-
animal belief is not strongly differentiated from some other beliefs that seem, at
first glance, to be quite different. In some Slavic areas, werewolves may turn into
vampires when they die. And though there are specific apotropaics for warding
1208 | Transformation
Just as the spirits of human beings return to animate the bodies of later genera-
tions, the same is assumed to be true of the spirits of animals. It is important,
therefore, to ensure that this process is not disturbed, so that culturally important
animals are not depleted. Among the northern Eurasian peoples, the bones of ani-
mals that are used for food may be carefully kept together to allow another ani-
mal to come into existence. And since spirits have an affinity for anything that
has their form, they may be encouraged to remain in the area by the use of
images or drawings of the animal they represent, which hold them in place until
they are reincorporated. Although we will surely never know much about the ra-
tionale behind the Paleolithic cave drawings, parallels from ancient and modern
cultures suggest that they may have been intended as a kind of spiritual template
for the physical body, designed to ensure its maintenance or return.
Paul Barber
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Magic; Shape-Shifters; Werewolf.
References
Opler, Morris E. 1960. Myth and Practice in Jicarilla Apache Eschatology. Journal
of American Folklore 73: 133 153.
Otten, Charlotte F., ed. 1986. A Lycanthropy Reader: Werewolves in Western Cul-
ture. Syracuse, NY: Syracuse University Press.
Westermarck, Edward. 1926. Ritual and Belief in Morocco. London: Macmillan.
White, David Gordon. 1991. Myths of the Dog-Man. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Wilbert, Johannes. 1987. Tobacco and Shamanism in South America. New Haven,
CT: Yale University Press.
Transmission
The process of passing on themes and symbols in language, music, design, move-
ment, and action by which a society forms its tradition. The selection of subjects
and forms for transmission is a conscious and unconscious social and individual
creative act that ideology, cultural values, and personal emotions influence. The
process empowers these subjects with the authority of the past. Oral transmis-
sion, in particular, is a key term in the conception and definition of folklore.
Orality has become a central issue in most inquiries into the possibility of trans-
mission as a natural process governed by natural laws.
Theoretically, in the formulation of Cecil J. Sharp, transmission is subject to
three abstract principles: continuity, variation, and selection. Continuity operates
through the cultural maintenance of narrative and poetic types and in the reten-
tive memory of performing artists. Variation is a consequence of performance
1210 | Transmission
References
Anderson, Walter. 1923. Kaiser und Abt: Die Geschichte eines Schwanks (Emperor
and abbot: The history of a joke). Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 42. Helsinki:
Academia Scientiarum Fennica.
Ben-Amos, Dan, and Liliane Weissberg, eds. 1999. Cultural Memory and the Con-
struction of Identity. Detroit: Wayne State University Press.
Bertrand H. 1954. The Morphology of the Ballad-Tunes: (Variation, Selection, and
Continuity). Journal of American Folklore 67: 1 13.
Coffin, Tristram P. 1957. Mary Hamilton and the Anglo-American Ballad as an Art
Form. Journal of American Folklore 70: 208 2 14. Reprinted in The Critics and the
Ballad, eds. MacEdward Leach and Tristram P. Coffin. Carbondale: Southern Illinois
University Press, 1961.
Degh, Linda. 1995. Narratives in Society: A Performance-Centered Study of Narra-
tion. Folklore Fellows Communications, no. 255. Helsinki: Academia Scientiarum
Fennica.
Degh, Linda, and Andrew Vazsonyi. 1975. The Hypothesis of Multi-Conduit Trans-
mission. In Folklore: Performance and Communication, eds. Dan Ben-Amos and
Kenneth S. Goldstein. The Hague: Mouton.
Dorson, Richard M. 1972. The Debate over the Trustworthiness of Oral Traditional
History. In Folklore: Selected Essays, by Richard M. Dorson. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press.
Dundes, Alan. 1969. The Devolutionary Premise in Folklore Theory. Journal of the
Folklore Institute 6: 5 19.
Finkelstein, Louis. 1941. The Transmission of the Early Rabbinic Tradition. Hebrew
Union College Annual 16: 135 155.
Gerhardsson, Birger. 1961. Memory and Manuscript: Oral Tradition and Written
Transmission in Rabbinic Judaism and Early Christianity. Trans. Eric J. Sharpe. Acta
Seminarii Neotestamentici Upsaliensis XXII. Uppsala and Lund, Sweden: Gleerup and
Copenhagen: Munksgaard.
Goldstein, Kenneth S. 1971. On the Application of the Concepts of Active and Inac-
tive Traditions to the Study of Repertory. Journal of American Folklore 84: 62 67.
Reprinted in Toward New Perspectives in Folklore, eds. Americo Paredes and Richard
Bauman. Publications of the American Folklore Society Bibliographical and Special Se-
ries, Vol. 23. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Goldstein, Kenneth S. 1963. Riddling Traditions in Northeastern Scotland. Journal
of American Folklore 76: 330 336.
Goody, Jack. 1985. Oral Composition and Oral Transmission: The Case of the
Vedas. Oralit
e: Cultura, Letteratura, Discorso. Atti del Convegno Internazionale
(Urbino 21 25 luglio 1980), eds. Bruno Gentili and Giuseppe Paioni. Rome: Ateneo.
Henige, David P. 1974. The Chronology of Oral Tradition: Quest for a Chimera.
Oxford Studies in African Affairs. Oxford: Clarendon.
Labrie-Bouthillier, Vivian. 1977. Les Experiences sur la transmission orale: D’un
Modele individuel a un modele collectif (Experiments in oral transmission: From an
individual model to a collective model). Fabula 18: 1 17.
1214 | Trickster
Trickster
The central figure in one of the most characteristic worldwide myth cycles—a
god, animal, and human all in one who is always duping others and is always
duped in return and whose stories tell of experiences involving a lengthy series
of dangerous, outrageous, and often obscene adventures and behaviors marked
by trickery. The trickster as a character of myth—and the problems of interpret-
ing the ambiguous nature of the figure presented—were noted and described at
some length using comparative materials by Franz Boas in an introduction he
wrote for a collection of Thompson River Indian stories, published in 1898. The
best-known and most influential discussion of the trickster figure, however, is
the 1956 book The Trickster written by Paul Radin, a later ethnographer much
influenced by Boas. The book—actually a collaborative effort of Paul Radin,
Karl Kerenyi, and Carl Jung—contained the major Winnebago Native American
trickster cycle, the secondary Winnebago Hare trickster cycle, and summaries of
Assiniboine and Tlingit Native American trickster myth cycles extensively anno-
tated by Radin. In addition, the book contained an article on the trickster in rela-
tion to Greek mythology by Kerenyi, a well-known historian of religion of the
time, and a psychological interpretation of worldwide trickster myths by Jung.
A special 1990 feature in the culture and folk wisdom section of The World
and I contained seven articles on the trickster by scholars, offering a more recent
discussion of the subject. Researchers from a number of disciplines also pub-
lished studies and interpretations of trickster figures in many cultures in the years
Trickster | 1215
between Radin and the special magazine section. Despite using different
approaches, all the researchers agreed on the fact that the trickster figure is found
in clearly recognizable form among all known tribal cultures and in the folklore
of most nontribal cultures as well. The researchers noted a host of central figures
in trickster cycles: the Native American figure known as Coyote in some groups
and Hare, Mink, Blue Jay, or Raven in others; African figures including Spider,
Tortoise, Hare, and Jackal; the Japanese Fox; the African American Brer Rabbit
and High John the Conqueror; and the Middle Eastern figures of Juha, Mullah
Nasruddin, and Nasruddin Hoja.
The character and stories about the trickster show a good deal of variation
from culture to culture in terms of the values they reflect, but they share a fine
disregard for boundaries. In an Omaha tale noted by Roger Welsh, Rabbit saves
members of the tribe from a hill that is destroying them and then sends his penis
underwater to impregnate the women and humiliate the tribe.
Radin also noted that the trickster survived in the figure of the medieval jester
and continues in Euro-American culture in such forms as Punch and Judy and
clowns, and more recent scholarship has shown the trickster’s continuing pres-
ence in American popular culture. Film tricksters include the central characters
in the Keystone Cops series and the many Police Academy films, as well as Char-
lie Chaplin’s ‘‘little tramp’’ character and Steve Martin’s various comic creations.
David Letterman and Johnny Carson, American television’s most famous late-
night hosts, are tricksters. American popular music stars Bob Dylan and Prince
also fit the generally accepted definition of the trickster.
Research and interpretation concerning tricksters explain the appeal, persist-
ence, and function of the figure either in terms of the culture from which a partic-
ular cycle of stories had been collected or in terms of all of humanity. The
earliest explanations for the strange mix of the trickster figures who make the
world safe for humans and ludicrously attempt the inappropriate were framed in
terms of a universal history of religion or a universal human psychology, and
many recent studies have followed the same path. David Brinton argued that the
trickster figure came about as a degeneration of an older culture hero, whereas
Boas claimed that the trickster was older than the serious culture heroes. Paul
Radin agreed with Boas and initially attempted to find the meaning of the Win-
nebago trickster within Winnebago culture. Although he provided a careful set
of notes that explained the stories in terms of ethnological detail, his final con-
clusions were psychological. Karl Kerenyi noted the similarities between the
Winnebago trickster and figures in Greek myth and explained the figure in
Freudian terms. Jung himself explained the trickster figures in Native American
narrative traditions in terms of his posited universal human psychology and espe-
cially in terms of his own theory of the etiology of the human mind and con-
sciousness. Similarly, more recent interpretations of the trickster have explained
1216 | Trickster
and destroyer, giver and negator, wise and foolish—is of the past and the present,
of folk and popular culture, culturally bound and a part of the psychology of all
peoples. And it is this destruction of boundaries, the greatest trick of all, that is
the essential nature of the trickster and that should serve as the principle for fur-
ther studies of the figure.
Keith Cunningham
See Also Culture Hero; Shape-Shifters.
References
Babcock, Barbara. 1975. ‘‘A Tolerated Margin of Mess’’: The Trickster and His
Tales Reconsidered. Journal of the Folklore Institute 11(3): 147 186.
Evans-Pritchard, E. E., ed. 1967. The Zande Trickster. Oxford: Clarendon.
M’Baye, Babacar. 2009. The Trickster Comes West: Pan-African Influence in Early
Black Disporan Narratives. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi.
Radin, Paul. 1956. The Trickster: A Study in American Indian Mythology with Com-
mentaries by Karl Ker
enyi and C. J. Jung. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul.
El-Shamy, Hasan M. 1980. Folktales of Egypt. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Welsch, Roger L., ed. 1990. All Fools’ Month. The World and I 5(April): 612 669.
U
UFOs and Folklore
What place do real UFOs (unidentified flying objects)—if any exist—hold within
the perennial fabric of folk belief? Folklorists cannot say whether UFOs are genu-
ine spaceships or only Venus and airplanes mistaken for something more, but they
have gained respect for human experience as a necessary source and sustainer of
tradition. The former understanding of folklorists sided with tradition as the basis
for apparent experiences. By hearing ghost stories an individual learned to expect
ghosts at midnight in a graveyard. That same individual passing a cemetery at
night and seeing moonlight on a patch of fog might reshape the vague form to fit
his expectations and fears, with the outcome a ghost complete with shroud and
chains. The ‘‘witness’’ would then reinforce the belief of others by adding his testi-
mony to tradition, though in fact the ghost amounted to mist and misperception
force-fitted into an imaginative preconception, nothing more.
In recent years, some investigators have turned this explanation upside down
and argued that some traditions endure, even against the rationalistic opposition of
official culture, because they have independent experience to back them up. Folk-
lorist David Hufford investigated the ‘‘Old Hag’’ tradition of Newfoundland, a
belief that a witch was responsible for experiences of people who wakened in the
night unable to move while some evil presence entered the bedroom and choked
the victim. The tradition with all its interpretations was well known and long estab-
lished in Newfoundland, but Hufford found that some of his students in Pennsylva-
nia had suffered similar experiences, even though they knew nothing of the
tradition. If the experience was widespread but the tradition was not, the standard
explanation that expectations create the experience quite simply fell apart. He
established that ‘‘supernatural assault traditions’’ had worldwide distribution. The
basic experiential features remained the same whatever the folk explanation might
be, and included in part a physiological condition known as sleep paralysis. In this
case, the tradition seemed to begin with experience and not the other way around.
A great deal of UFO lore depends on observation. Tens of thousands of people
have seen something in the sky that they could not explain, and whether they
reported the sighting or not, to them it became a UFO. In most of those cases the
expectation led the way as it lent an aura of mystery and significance to an ordi-
nary planet or meteor, a sight the witness would not imagine to be a spaceship
without the preparation of tradition. In March 1967, a Soviet moon probe fell
1219
1220 | UFOs and Folklore
back into the atmosphere and burned up over several Midwestern states. The
U.S. Air Force received about 70 reports of this reentry, and most observers gave
an accurate description of half a dozen flaming, meteor-like bodies high in the
atmosphere. Some even recognized the nature of the objects. But there were a
few individuals who saw something entirely different. One reported a UFO fly-
ing at treetop level with six lighted windows, fiery exhaust, and riveted steel
plates along the hull. Either this witness misinterpreted the reentry in terms of
UFO expectations, or two of the most spectacular aerial sights of a lifetime
occurred at once, and this witness missed one of them. A great many UFO
reports have an experiential basis, but not necessarily an extraterrestrial one.
They originate in the eyes of believers and take the shape of a spaceship, where
another observer not under the influence of the UFO tradition looks at the same
sight and sees nothing more than the evening star.
At the same time, a remainder of reports continues to puzzle the investigator,
and the most determined effort to find a conventional solution leaves behind evi-
dence that refuses to fit. Even as fantastic a story as alien abduction defies the
typical dynamics of folklore by varying very little from one narrator to another.
UFOs and Folklore | 1221
phenomenon, no one can hope to study UFOs without recognizing the role of
human beliefs and concerns in UFO lore.
James R. Lewis
See Also Belief, Folk; Folklore; Myth; Night Hag.
References
Lovern, Kyle. 2009. Appalachian Case Study: UFO Sightings, Alien Encounters, and
Unexplained Phenomena. Chapmanville, WV: Woodland Press.
Saler, Benson, Charles A. Ziegler, and Charles B. Moore. 1997. UFO Crash at Ros-
well: The Genesis of a Modern Myth. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.
Tumm, Diana G., ed. 2009. Alien Worlds: Social and Religious Dimensions of Extra-
terrestrial Contact. Syracuse: Syracuse University Press.
Yomtov, Nelson. 2010. Secret American Places: From UFO Crash Sites to Govern-
ment Hideouts. Mankato, MN: Edge Books.
Urban Folklore
ancient history, and poetry that could be transformed into national culture. The
British anthropologists collected reports of archaic customs and superstitions sur-
viving among the ‘‘uncivilized’’ people of the world. City traditions and urban cul-
ture as a whole were usually not addressed by these folklorists.
At the turn of the twentieth century, the folklore of the urban working classes
attracted the attention of socialist agitators, who saw in the narratives and songs
of factory workers powerful symbols that could be used to mobilize mass labor
movements. The resulting popular publications contain a rich variety of urban
labor lore, but they should be consulted with care. Just as peasants and rural folk-
lore were idealized in the service of nationalist ideologies, so also was labor lore
often romanticized, manipulated, or even invented by political activists. The
same was true of the more recent publications in the Soviet Union, which selec-
tively described the forms of workers’ culture and urban traditions that corre-
sponded to government ideology and the official cultural and economic
programs.
During the 1920s and 1930s in Germany, pioneering research was published
about workers and their traditions. At the same time in the United States, sociolo-
gists were turning to the study of city populations and producing the first studies
of ethnic groups, criminals, and various members of the urban lower classes.
Their research is still a useful source of information about everyday traditions
and folklore in the city.
In the late 1960s and 1970s, American folklorists moved away from a past-ori-
ented study of culture in the rural periphery, grappling instead with the topic of
American folk culture in the modern world. Richard Dorson and Linda Degh
rejected the ideological manipulation of folklore characteristic of works by Ben-
jamin Botkin and other American romantics and attempted instead to develop
the methods needed for accurate ethnographic description of folklore in the city.
The 1968 symposium entitled ‘‘The Urban Experience and Folk Tradition’’ posed
the question, ‘‘Is there a folk in the city?’’ and answered it with the observation
that there was indeed a ‘‘folk’’ but that the materials of folklore had changed.
When rural people moved to the city, older genres of folklore lost the traditional
performance occasions of the village community and had to either adapt to the
urban context or be functionally replaced by other forms. Intensive fieldwork in
the steel-mill region around Gary, Indiana, inspired the revision of earlier folk-
lore theories and the recognition of new categories of folklore, such as ‘‘personal
revelation’’ and ‘‘folklore of crime.’’
Urban folklore research led to a change in the approaches to fieldwork and the
people to be studied. Urban folk are knowledgeable about recording technology
and the uses or misuses of the folklore they perform; they are literate and read
the results of research about themselves; they are articulate and forceful in their
criticism of people writing about them. No longer could field-workers collect
1224 | Urban Folklore
and publish whatever they pleased. After the urbanization of folklore research,
discussions emerged about accurate description, rapport, respect, and responsi-
bility toward the people studied.
Interest in urban culture also grew outside the academic discipline of folklore.
Urban anthropology, urban geography, sociology, and social history produced
many ethnographies of city life. Municipal governments became aware of the
commercial potential (tourism) and political uses (multiculturalism) of urban
folklore and hired folklorists to study, stimulate, and celebrate the aesthetically
pleasing urban traditions.
In Germany during the 1950s, folklorists rebelled against the rural, preindus-
trial orientation of earlier scholars. Taking leads from sociology, they refash-
ioned folkloristics as an ‘‘empirical science’’ and set as their goal the study of
people in the contemporary world. In 1961, Hermann Bausinger demonstrated
that modernity had not destroyed folklore, as generally believed, but that folklore
had changed to encompass modern technology and the mass media of communi-
cation. Traditional magic, for example, was replaced in its functions by machines
and science. Not limited to the study of urban folklore, the German theories
nevertheless opened the city as the main setting in which folklore research
continued.
The German shift to urban folklore settings culminated in a 1983 conference
entitled ‘‘The Large City: Aspects of Empirical Cultural Research.’’ Participants
surveyed the history and goals of urban folklore research in nine European coun-
tries. The historical development of the modern city and its effect on everyday
life, work, and leisure were recurrent themes. Like the earlier American discus-
sions of urban folklore, conference papers described the survival, continuation,
and transformation of pre-urban traditions. Others emphasized the city itself as a
topic of study. Helge Gerndt, for example, called for the study of three aspects of
the city: the city as a structure encompassing and bounding a specific world of
everyday culture, the city as a mediator of culture or setting in which unique
forms of everyday life are communicated, and the city as a cultural phenomenon
with a specific meaning of its own.
The American and German conferences on urban folklore represent a turning
point in Western folklore research, a point that has not been reached in many
other parts of the world. East European critics observe that reality preceded
theory in both cases. The traditional rural village communities and the gifted per-
formers of archaic folklore could be found only with difficulty in modern Ger-
many and the United States, and folklorists in these countries were forced to
change their methods, theories, and object of research in order to survive in their
professional careers. Whatever the case might be, the shift in approaches uncov-
ered the rich world of urban folk culture and the unique traditions of gifted, crea-
tive individuals in urban communities. The urban setting remains a frontier in
Urban Folklore | 1225
folklore research. The existing case studies of separate traditions and groups or
even of entire cities have yet to be placed in a broad, internationally valid com-
parative theoretical framework.
Folklore emerges in the city in diverse contexts. Urban folklorists have
favored the study of relatively small groups: families, ethnic or religious com-
munities, associations based on occupation or leisure-time activities, and groups
defined by geography—for example, the inhabitants of a building, a city block, a
neighborhood, or a district. These enclaves provide a personal, mutually support-
ive environment based on face-to-face communication, in contrast to what is
thought to be the anonymous, impersonal urban environment. Community events
encourage the cohesion of these groups.
Communities in urban enclaves announce their presence in traditional actions
charged with symbolism (processions, demonstrations, eating, dancing, music
performance) and in tangible objects (clothes, flags, food, icons) representing the
culture that both holds the group together and distinguishes it from the larger so-
ciety. The urban context fosters conscious maintenance, revival, and traditionali-
zation of folklore. Extra money and leisure time allow members of the middle
classes to create new associations based on shared interests and to establish tradi-
tions that hold these groups together. Folklore, understood to be a symbol of a
simpler, better way of life in the preindustrial past, is revived as an escape from
the perceived evils of modern urban society. Thus, traditions that are being
replaced by mass culture in their original rural settings—crafts, costume, custom,
music, dance, song—are given a second life in the city.
Ethnic identity acquires special significance when people of many back-
grounds must live and work in close proximity. The folklore of ethnicity is dis-
played in public settings where cultures meet, clash, or confront mainstream
traditions. Dense urban housing is another factor leading to the creation of com-
munities. Informal social programs and anticrime (‘‘neighborhood watch’’)
organizations, for example, set an area apart from the dangers of urban decay,
welding coalitions of trust and familiarity among closely spaced but otherwise
isolated households. In the city, events such as block parties, neighborhood pic-
nics, or concerts and local outdoor markets (or sidewalk sales) are a few of the
traditionalized occasions in which a sense of local community is constructed.
Material traditions mark off enclaves within the city. Municipal ordinances
stipulate some degree of uniformity in house facades, but many more unofficial,
traditional aesthetic norms produce, for example, similarities in house colors,
exterior decorations, and front gardens. Residents learn which ‘‘weeds’’ should
be removed and which vegetable- or fruit-bearing plants are appropriate for pub-
lic view by observing other gardens in the community. Less-visible communities
such as American street gangs leave visible signs marking their territory (‘‘turf’’)
in elaborate graffiti spray-painted on fences or walls.
1226 | Urban Folklore
National Puerto Rican Day Parade in New York City, 2010. (Shiningcolors/Dreamstime.com)
The urban setting gives a double stimulus to folklore: On the one hand, folk-
lore is used to strengthen small communities, and on the other hand, it provides
traditional ways for individuals to personalize and humanize the mass-produced,
industrial setting of the city. Communal traditions provide their performers with
a means of artistic creativity and the possibility to express individual identity.
Within certain limits, individual artistic expression is prized in the city, and street
performers—musicians, actors, jugglers, speakers, artists—are given money by
admiring passersby. It is not, however, the most original art that extracts the
greatest resonance (and financial gain) from the fleeting audience; folklore and
folklorized elite or popular culture flourish here.
The personal revelation, an expression of individual experience, philosophy,
and worldview, gains importance in the egalitarian urban context. In everyday
conversations, persons set themselves apart from the faceless, anonymous mil-
lions by telling autobiographical stories (personal narratives). Folklore character-
istics of these seemingly nontraditional narratives appear in the commonly held
themes, beliefs, and fears that they contain. Narratives about rapes, muggings,
robbery, and theft, told by the victims or their acquaintances, express both the
widespread fears of encountering urban crime and the relief of sharing such fears
with reliable, trusted persons.
Urban Folklore | 1227
Many other forms of urban folklore have been described in detail. Problems of
terminology emerge whenever a specific genre is placed under scrutiny. For
example, two of the most popular forms of folklore that have become known as
‘‘urban’’ are not exclusively urban. Urban legend, a term popularized during
recent decades, denotes legends containing references to modern technology and
circulating among urban populations. The term is misleading, for it refers to nar-
ratives that have been collected in urban, suburban, and rural areas alike and that
contain both modern and archaic motifs. Moreover, other forms of folklore com-
municated by means of modern technology (via fax or ‘‘Xerox’’) are not found
only in cities, as implied by the frequently used term urban folklore. These are
primarily examples of folklore transmitted through the modern mass-media net-
work, which is both urban and rural.
There are few qualitative differences between urban folklore and any other
folklore touched by the modern world. All folklore found in cities is a part of
modern urban culture, but it is usually not exclusively urban. Some forms of
folklore, however, arise directly out of the urban experience.
Everyday life in cities follows many rhythms of work and leisure, acted out
differently in various districts. Daytime and nighttime activities will follow iden-
tifiable schedules (clocked by factory whistles and the bells of churches and
schools), and a calendrical cycle appears in the sequence of workdays and holi-
days. Business, shopping, and leisure habits are traditional, known by all but
rarely prescribed by law. They give observable and recordable evidence about
the urban dweller’s perceptions of time.
There are also traditional divisions of space as known by people in a city. The
geographical landscape of a city is sometimes printed on maps for use by visitors
or municipal governments, but many other maps exist in the minds of people going
about their daily existence. Different landmarks reveal different ways of looking at
the city: For children, a street is punctuated by stones, gutters, and tree stumps used
as markers in games of stickball; for a homeless beggar, the daily circuits revolve
around places where money, food, and drink may be obtained, followed by a place
to sleep. Other lives are passed on a circle joining home, work, a food store, and a
community gathering place. A tourist imagines the city as a cluster of skyscrapers,
museums, and parks. Persons in the city have a mental image of the city and the
various districts that lie beyond the familiar neighborhood, but this traditional
sense of place rarely resembles commercially produced maps. Informal place-
names and stories about the city reveal a traditionally formulated landscape of
wealth and poverty, work and leisure, history, beauty, and progress and decay.
Images of the city and its everyday life as perceived by the urban dwellers
reveal contrasts between, for instance, the cultures of the city and the country-
side. Whereas the stereotypical city rigidly follows the clock and calendar, the
life of a rural farmer is governed by the weather and the seasons, regardless of
1228 | Urban Folklore
dates. Other everyday traditions indicate that a historical break has occurred
between urban and rural folklore. In the twentieth century, cities have fostered
the growth and expansion of the middle social classes; it is no surprise, then, that
the typically middle-class values concerning time, cleanliness, work, and leisure
often predominate in urban culture as a whole.
Everyday culture reveals subtle changes in the characteristics of cities over
time. Festivals place these differences in open view, to be identified by urban
folklorists. Historical studies show, for example, that public celebrations moved
from outlying districts into central areas of the city with the rise of liberal de-
mocracy and populist movements; family customs such as weddings, by contrast,
have been transformed from public events in rural villages to private affairs
among the urban middle classes. Changes in perceptions of openness and privacy
signal that larger changes are taking place in cultures.
Images of the city appear in crystallized form in public festivals held by munici-
pal organizations: Parades and pageants address the many cultures of the city, giv-
ing every inhabitant occasion to identify with the local government and to
recognize its place in the local hierarchy of power. Public political demonstrations
are recognized both from above and from below as traditional instruments of social
change; memorials construct the city’s history, re-creating the past to validate or
challenge the present. The mass media and the tourism industry diffuse concen-
trated images of the city (silhouettes of the skyline, pictures of value-charged sites
such as the Brooklyn Bridge in New York), identifying these symbols with the
given city and its inhabitants. When the mass-produced images find resonance and
are accepted by portions of the urban population, they folklorize, becoming part of
the city’s informally transmitted culture. Distinctive urban identities form through
images constructed in political and commercial processes. Sports, weather, and
news broadcasts on television and the other mass media have made people very
aware of the existence of their city among many other cities in their country and
abroad, intensifying their sense of belonging to a specific place in the transurban
context. Audiences struggle and suffer with the eleven football players represent-
ing their hometown; sports rivalries between cities run deep in the identities of
fans, sometimes even leading them to violence.
The study of urban folklore provides the views of the average city dweller on
the great social and cultural changes currently taking place in the world. As peo-
ple of many backgrounds continue to migrate to ever-expanding cities, rural
identities are transformed by the traditions of the city, which are in turn tightly
intertwined with national and international culture. If solutions to the world’s
intercultural conflicts exist at all, then they are to be found in the city.
Guntis Smidchens
See Also Legend, Urban; Xeroxlore.
Urban Folklore | 1229
References
Bausinger, Hermann. 1961. Volkskultur in der technischen Welt. Stuttgart: Kohlham-
mer GMbH. Trans. Elke Dettmer, as Folk Culture in a World of Technology. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press, 1990.
Botkin, Benjamin. 1954. Sidewalks of America: Folklore, Legends, Sagas, Tradi-
tions, Customs, Songs, Stories, and Sayings of City Folk. Indianapolis, IN: Bobbs-
Merrill.
Dorson, Richard Mercer. 1981. Land of the Millrats. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Uni-
versity Press.
Dundes, Alan, and Carl R. Pagter. 1991. Never Try to Teach a Pig to Sing: Still
More Urban Folklore from the Paperwork Empire. Detroit, MI: Wayne State University
Press.
€
D€uding, Dieter, Peter Friedmann, and Paul M€unch, eds. 1988. Offentliche Festkultur:
Politische Feste im Deutschland von der Aufkl€ arung bis zum Ersten Weltkrieg. Ham-
burg: Kohlhammer GMbH.
Frykman, Jonas, and Orvar L€ofgren. [1979] 1987. Culture Builders: A Historical An-
thropology of Middle-Class Life. Trans. Alan Crozier. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers
University Press.
Kirshenblatt-Gimblett, Barbara. 1983. The Future of Folklore Studies in America:
The Urban Frontier. Folklore Forum 16(2): 175 234.
Kohlmann, Theodor, and Hermann Bausinger, eds. 1985. Großstadt: Aspekte empiri-
scher Kulturforschung. Berlin: Staatliche Museen Preußischer Kulturbesitz.
Mohrmann, Ruth-E. 1990. Die Stadt als volkskundliches Forschungsfeld.
€
Osterreichis-che Zeitschrift f€
ur Volkskunde 44: 129 149.
Paredes, Americo, and Ellen J. Stekert, eds. 1971. The Urban Experience and Folk
Tradition. Austin: University of Texas Press.
Wachs, Eleanor F. 1988. Crime-Victim Stories: New York City’s Urban Folklore.
Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
V
Vampire
In European folklore, the spirit of a dead person that returns after death to haunt
the living. This spirit (the body remains in the grave) attacks the relatives and
friends of the deceased and is viewed as the party responsible for any number of
disastrous and actual events, including bad weather, bad crops, sickness, and
death. During epidemics, it was assumed that the first person who had died was a
vampire, but otherwise, the suspects were commonly murder victims, suicides,
alcoholics, and anyone who, during life, had fallen under suspicion of evildoing.
In order to end the vampire’s depredations, the living would exhume a suspect
corpse and examine it for evidence that it was the guilty party. Because literate
outsiders have occasionally attended such exhumations, we know what the vam-
pire looked like as it reposed in its grave: The body had decomposed less than
expected and was bloated; it was a darker color than it had been during life; the
mouth was open and had blood in it; the skin and nails had peeled away, reveal-
ing fresh skin and nails; the hair and beard appeared to have grown after death;
the blood had not coagulated; there was no evidence of rigor mortis; and the
body had a strong smell. These accounts of the vampire in his or her grave, how-
ever startling they appear at first glance, have proven to be accurate descriptions
of decomposing corpses in the grave, and they clear up some details of the folk-
lore. For example, the belief that the vampire sucked blood appears to be an
interpretation of the bloating and the blood at the lips of the corpse. As the corpse
bloats from the gases given off by the microorganisms of decay, the pressure in
the abdomen forces blood from the decomposing lungs out of the mouth and
nose. This blood is taken to be the blood of the vampire’s victims and the cause
of the corpse’s increased size. ‘‘Not without astonishment,’’ says an eighteenth-
century observer of the exhumation of a vampire, ‘‘I saw some fresh blood in his
mouth, which, according to the common observation, he had sucked from the
people killed by him.’’
If the corpse was found to be a vampire, it was ‘‘killed.’’ Because its blood
was thought to be dangerous, people commonly killed the vampire in ways that
allowed them to keep their distance. If killed with a stake, the corpse might be
covered with a hide or blanket to prevent its blood from spurting onto the people
killing it. But staking was just one method of killing the vampire and perhaps not
even the most common. In northern Europe, the corpse might be decapitated with
1231
1232 | Vampire
a shovel—a tool that was already at hand and that kept some distance between
the vampire and the person killing it. The vampire might also be cut into pieces,
excoriated, cremated, or left out for scavengers. Often, several methods were
used, the last of which was usually cremation, and the remains were then thrown
into running water (water is believed to capture spirits, and running water carries
them away). From one geographic area to the next, there are differences in the
habits of the vampire, the interpretations of the body in the grave, and the meth-
ods of killing it. The Greek version of the vampire, for example, the vrykolakas,
is not believed to suck blood.
The relationship of the vampire’s spirit and corpse is also subject to great geo-
graphic variation. Often, the spirit is seen as an insubstantial version of the body,
identical in appearance. It is commonly thought to function as a kind of servo-
mechanism for the body, so that sleep, unconsciousness, and death are all taken
for evidence of a separation of spirit from body. When someone dies properly
and is given appropriate funeral and burial rites, his or her spirit makes its way to
the afterworld. If death is violent or if the corpse does not undergo the usual rites,
the spirit remains behind and returns to the body. Then, the body remains alive
in some sense and functions as a dwelling place for the spirit during the day. At
night, the spirit wanders about on its own and causes trouble. If the body is
destroyed, the spirit has no dwelling place and departs for the afterworld. Alter-
nately, one could destroy the vampire by capturing his or her spirit. In some
areas, sorcerers made a living by claiming to be able to see and capture these spi-
rits, even during daylight, although most people saw the vampire’s spirit only at
night, during sleep. In the Balkans, there was a common belief that vampires
could be seen by their sons or by people born on a Saturday, a day when vam-
pires were obliged to remain in their graves.
Among the many apotropaics reported for warding off the vampire are sharp
objects (thorns, sickles, hair needles, awls, knives) and anything with a strong
smell (incense, cow dung, garlic). A knife might be placed under the pillow to
keep vampires away during sleep, and sharp objects might be buried with the
corpse to prevent it from being reanimated. (The common practice of burying
sickles with corpses has a reflex in our traditional personification of death: a
skeleton in a shroud bearing a sickle or scythe.) Another traditional apotropaic is
the rose, presumably because of its thorns (at the end of Faust, the angels strew
roses to disperse the devils). In Slavic areas, roses were commonly embroidered
onto the cuffs and neck openings of shirts and blouses, not just as decoration but
also to protect against the spirits of the dead.
The vampire of European folklore bears little resemblance to the vampire in
popular films and literature, although it provided the inspiration for them. Suave
counts in evening dress, castles, and even bats were donated to the traditional
lore by nineteenth-century writers of fiction. (The bat made its way into the
Vampire | 1233
On board the Demeter, the vampire Count Orlok emerges from one of his coffins before
they can be destroyed by the ship’s first mate in a scene from F. W. Murnau’s expression-
ist horror film Nosferatu (1922), based on Bram Stoker’s novel Dracula (1897). (Hulton
Archive/Getty Images)
fiction after a Central American bat, which lives on blood, got its name from the
vampire of folklore.) Vlad Dracul himself, a Romanian hero of the fifteenth cen-
tury, had no connection at all with the history of the vampire except that he con-
tributed his epithet (dracul is the Romanian word for devil plus the definite
article) to Bram Stoker’s fictional character Dracula.
Paul Barber
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Revenant; Shape-Shifters; Werewolf.
References
Barber, Paul. 1988. Vampires, Burial and Death: Folklore and Reality. New Haven,
CT: Yale University Press.
Blum, Richard, and Eva Blum. 1970. The Dangerous Hour: The Lore of Crisis and
Mystery in Rural Greece. New York: Scribner.
Butler, Erik. 2010. Metamorphoses of the Vampire in Literature and Film. Rochester,
NY: Camden House.
1234 | Verbal Art
Lecouteux, Claude. 2010. The Secret History of Vampires: Their Multiple Forms and
Hidden Purposes. Rochester, VT: Inner Traditions.
Noll, Richard. 1992. Vampires, Werewolves and Demons: Twentieth Century Reports
in the Psychiatric Literature. New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Otten, Charlotte F., ed. 1986. A Lycanthropy Reader: Werewolves in Western Cul-
ture. Syracuse, NY: Syracuse University Press.
Perkowski, Jan L. 1989. The Darkling: A Treatise on Slavic Vampirism. Columbus,
OH: Slavica.
Senn, Harry A. 1982. Were-Wolf and Vampire in Romania. New York: Columbia
University Press.
Trigg, Elwood B. 1973. Gypsy Demons and Divinities: The Magic and Religion of
the Gypsies. Secaucus, NJ: Citadel.
Vukanovic, Tatomir P. 1957 1960. The Vampire. Journal of the Gypsy Lore Society
36: 125 133, 37: 21 31, 38: 111 118, 39: 44 55.
Verbal Art
A branch of folklore encompassing all orally performed genres and ways of speak-
ing. Verbal art has usually been defined according to its constituent varieties (e.g.,
myths, legends, M€ archen, proverbs, riddles, song texts) and has been viewed in
contrast with nonverbal folklore, on the one hand, and literary narrative genres, on
the other. The inclusive sense of the term verbal art makes it of value to folklor-
ists, especially those interested in broad, overarching aesthetic and performative
features of oral culture. The study of verbal art draws on analytical methods such
as ethnopoetics, discourse analysis, and linguistic approaches.
The term verbal art was proposed by William Bascom in 1955. Bascom’s con-
cern (still a problem in folklore research today) was that the term folklore does
double duty, leading to confusion. On the one hand, folklore is used holistically
to denote the entirety of the field, including verbal art, customs, material culture,
and so on. On the other hand, many folklorists and anthropologists reserve the
term folklore exclusively for the purely verbal genres. By using verbal art, Bas-
com argued, folklorists can avoid such confusion and further promote the use of
the term folklore in its broadest sense.
In practice, the term verbal art has not spread as widely as Bascom might have
hoped. It is used most extensively by folklorists with anthropological training, and
it tends to be found in studies of African or Native American peoples. The fact that
many of the most promising methods for verbal art analysis have come from studies
of non-European communities may bode well for the term verbal art in the future.
Contemporary verbal art studies often focus on strategic and stylistic choices
made during oral performance. For instance, a performer may express identity or
Verbal Duel | 1235
References
Bascom, William. 1955. Verbal Art. Journal of American Folklore 68(269): 245
252.
Bauman, Richard. 1977. Verbal Art as Performance. Rowley, MA: Newbury House.
Briggs, Charles L. 1988. Competence in Performance: The Creativity of Tradition in
Mexicano Verbal Art. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.
Finnegan, Ruth. 1970. Oral Literature in Africa. London: Clarendon Press.
Kofi, Anyidoho. 1983. Oral Poetics and Traditions of Verbal Art in Africa. PhD dis-
sertation, University of Texas, Austin.
Verbal Duel
A bounded series of linked insults usually involving two combatants and per-
formed before a wider audience of peers. The verbal duel genre is found most of-
ten among males and occurs in cultures throughout the world. It has been observed
in various forms among indigenous peoples of the Americas, north Eurasia, and
Africa, in agrarian European and Middle Eastern cultures, and in urban African
American and Puerto Rican social life, as well as in certain historical sources (e.g.,
the Viking age flyting [exchange of personal abuse in verse form] of Scandinavia).
The contexts for dueling vary cross-culturally, ranging from impromptu sessions
during conversation to elaborate formal competitions performed at assemblies or
weddings. In any case, the performance is set apart from normal discourse by for-
mal bounds, including the use of poetic vocabulary, stock images or topics, exag-
geration, overt innuendo and double entendre, rhythm, rhyme, or melody. Key to
1236 | Verbal Duel
the competition is the ability of combatants to match the insults of their opponents
with equal or preferably more effective retorts until one player loses temper, con-
cedes defeat, or is unable to come up with a reply. Invariably, the audience plays a
central role in judging the success of the insults and retorts, approving of the com-
batants’ wit and monitoring the players’ reactions. Often, reports of particularly
artful or fierce verbal duels pass into narrative tradition and are recounted by for-
mer witnesses as evidence of an individual’s wit or prowess. Such reports of verbal
duels constitute a secondary narrative genre of great importance in determining the
form and frequency of future duels and in creating folk heroes or cycles.
In the folklore research of the performance school, boundedness refers to the
existence of verbal, paralinguistic, or behavioral markers that signal to the co-
performer or audience a shift from ordinary discourse to active performance. In
the most widely studied forms of verbal dueling—African American dozens and
Turkish boys’ rhymed insults—such signals include the use of metrically regular
lines and rhyme as well as shifts in stance and voice quality. Similar features
characterize the Chamula and Lebanese varieties of verbal dueling. In the north
Eurasian cultural region, performance boundaries are created through adherence to
musical conventions (e.g., melody, alliteration, rhyme, rhythm) and through the
existence of clearly demarcated ritual contexts. The Faroese drunnur tradition, per-
formed during weddings, as well as the wedding insult sessions of Karelian and
Ingrian tradition, rely on a broader ritual context for justification and performative
bounds. The Inuit song dance, performed at a communal assembly after a long pe-
riod of preparation and composition, constitutes one of the most clearly demar-
cated and formal varieties of the genre. Similarly, the Ewe people of Ghana
perform insult songs as part of an annual festival and rely on the genre as an im-
portant means of social control and community maintenance.
Performative boundaries permit combatants to invoke and maintain what the theo-
rist Gregory Bateson terms a play frame, a marked departure from the rules of ordi-
nary behavior during which all actions are interpreted as non-serious. Maintenance
of the play frame allows opponents to broach topics otherwise taboo in ordinary con-
versation and to make accusations that would normally lead to serious conflict. Such
topics include claims of sexual promiscuity on the part of the opponent or the oppo-
nent’s family, accusations of homosexuality or incest, and assertions of culturally
stigmatized characteristics (e.g., selfishness, conceitedness, physical deformity, im-
potence). As long as the accusations are made within the overt guise of play, the op-
ponent must accept them as humorous or lose the game. Inevitably, the limits of
decorum within such play are subject to negotiation and testing, and verbal duels
may result in physical conflict in many cultures. Alternatively, remarks made in a
verbal duel may permanently damage interpersonal relations, leading to long-stand-
ing grudges or even hatred. Success or failure in verbal duels may influence one’s
overall status in the community and determine one’s success in future endeavors.
Verbal Duel | 1237
The topics covered in verbal duels vary cross-culturally but always indicate im-
portant concerns or taboos. Generally, the topics characteristic of the genre in any
one culture are fairly restricted in number, consisting of three or four primary cate-
gories of frailty or transgression and usually closely tied to notions of face and sta-
tus within the community. In African American dozens, for instance, insults often
focus on the sexual promiscuity of the opponent’s female relatives, particularly the
mother. In Turkish duels, the insults may focus on homosexual tendencies. In Inuit
song duels, insults may aver the opponent’s lasciviousness, incest, or greed. Faro-
ese duels center on such topics as marital conduct, sexual appetite, and impotence.
The successful retort usually continues the initiated theme, elevating the stakes
of the competition by making more extreme accusations in the same vein against
the opponent. Switching topics—that is, failing to produce a linked insult—can be
interpreted as a loss of the competition and is thus avoided. Linkage is further
achieved through metrical reproduction of the prior utterance, use of rhyme to bind
utterances together, metaphoric plays or double entendres based on key words
from the prior utterance, and other verbal patternings. Because many verbal duel-
ing traditions demand speedy replies, retorts may be memorized and drawn upon
by performers at appropriate moments. Memory becomes as important an attribute
of the expert player as wit in such traditions, although the truly remarkable retort is
always one that combines elaborate formal linkage with novelty and aptness.
As with other forms of joke, the verbal duel has been interpreted generally
along functionalist and psychoanalytical lines. When the genre occurs among
male adolescents—as in the case of African Americans, Turks, or Chamula—
folklorists have viewed it as a testing ground for the development of adult
oratory skills. When the genre exists among adult males bound together in am-
biguous but important alliances—for example, in-law status in some African cul-
tures or trading partnerships in Inuit communities—folklorists have viewed the
genre as a safety valve for alleviating attendant strains and hostilities. Verbal
dueling within the wedding context or shamanic system has been seen as expres-
sive of conflicts of values or interests inherent in certain social institutions.
When examining folklore genres from a cross-cultural perspective, it is impor-
tant to distinguish between genres that display clear evidence of diffusion across
linguistic and cultural lines (e.g., M€ archen, legends) and genres that appear to
occur more or less independently in various cultures. Verbal dueling belongs to
the latter category, although the overall origins of the genre may indeed lie in a
single ancient tradition. Apparent similarities between verbal duels from culture
to culture may mask marked differences in the symbolic or functional implica-
tions of the genre. Thus, in African American, Puerto Rican, Chamula, Lebanese,
or Turkish cultures, community members may regard the genre as informal and
inappropriate to more decorous occasions, whereas members of other cultures in
northern Europe, Siberia, Africa, and North America may regard it as a central
1238 | Verbal Duel
Boast
Formulaic praise of self or one’s property and associates. The boast as a distinct
verbal art genre almost always occurs in association with other forms, and boasting
may occur in folklore when the boast as genre is not present. In most cases, formu-
laic boasts are specific to particular contexts, especially those defined by age and
gender. They are often a component of competitive displays that may be ends in
themselves or that may lead to further competition, even physical violence.
Verbal dueling, usually an activity of adolescent males, provides an important con-
text in which boasts occur cross-culturally. For example, the ritual exchange of
insults that characterizes what is called ‘‘dozens,’’ ‘‘joning,’’ or ‘‘snaps’’ among young
African American males focuses principally on derogating the opponent and his fam-
ily. But frequently, boasts of one’s prowess, especially sexual, contribute to the
duel’s outcome, which depends upon verbal agility and one’s ability to undercut
the opponent’s masculinity. Reducing the opponent to an image of passivity can be
achieved at least partially through boasting of one’s active masculinity, a technique
that also has been reported in verbal dueling among Turkish youths.
Boasts also occur in longer forms of folk literature. One characteristic of the epic
hero, be he Achilles or Odysseus from Homeric Greece, Beowulf from Old English
tradition, or the protagonists of the Balkan epics reported by Milman Parry and
Albert Lord, is his boasting, an act that may figure into council scenes, serve as
preparation for battle, or comprise a warrior’s account of an action in which he has
participated. The humor of the American frontier produced similar boasts, which
probably served to burlesque the characters’ uncivilized manners. Davy Crockett
or Mike Fink would claim to be ‘‘half horse, half alligator’’ and able to ‘‘lick [his]
weight in wildcats’’ before scuffling with an opponent. The toast, a long narrative
poem recited by African American males, often features a boastful protagonist who
extols his own violent disregard of convention. Among Native Americans of the
plains, boasts became part of the formula for coup tales, stories in which warriors
recounted their military exploits, especially those that evinced particular daring.
The tall tale provides another folk literary context for the boast. The focus of tall
tales, though, may not be praise of self as much as of the country where one lives.
For example, tall tales often include boasts about a land’s fertility and richness, the
size and accessibility of its game, and the beauty of its women.
Boasts also may assume a negative cast, though their ultimate purport redounds
to the boaster’s credit. For example, American humor includes boasts about the
excessively inclement weather and general insalubrity of rural areas and the tough-
ness of city neighborhoods. On one hand, these boasts derogate, but on the other,
they stress the speaker’s prowess in being able to survive unpleasant, dangerous
conditions.
Formulaic boasting seems to flourish in societies that stress the so-called ‘‘mascu-
line’’ virtues of aggressiveness toward other males, women, and the environment.
Folklore research has tended to examine such boasting in terms of its linguistic pat-
terning and psychological importance, the latter usually informed by Freudian
assumptions.
William M. Clements
Verbal Duel | 1239
References
Abrahams, Roger. 1962. Playing the Dozens. Journal of American Folklore 75(297):
209 220.
Abrahams, Roger D. 1970. Deep Down in the Jungle: Negro Narrative Folklore from
the Streets of Philadelphia. 1st rev. ed. Chicago: Aldine.
Awoonor, Kofi. 1975. The Breast of the Earth. New York: Doubleday.
Balikci, Asen. 1970. The Netsilik Eskimo. Garden City, NY: Natural History Press.
Bateson, Gregory. 1972. Steps to an Ecology of Mind. New York: Ballantine.
Boatright, Mody C. 1949. Folk Laughter on the American Frontier. New York:
Macmillan.
Coffey, Jerome E. 1989. The Drunnur A Faroese Wedding Custom. ARV 45: 7 16.
Dundes, Alan, Jerry W. Leach, and Bora Ozkok. 1970. The Strategy of Turkish
Boys’ Verbal Dueling Rhymes. Journal of American Folklore 83: 325 349.
Gossen, Gary. 1974. Chamulas in the World of the Sun. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
Haydar, Adnan. 1989. The Development of the Lebanese zajal: Genre, Meter, and
Verbal Duel. Oral Tradition 4(1 2): 189 212.
Labov, William. 1972. Language in the Inner City. Philadelphia: University of Penn-
sylvania Press.
Lauria, A. 1964. Respeto, Relajo and Interpersonal Relations in Puerto Rico. Anthro-
pological Quarterly 37: 53 67.
Murray, Stephen O. 1983. Ritual and Personal Insults in Stigmatized Subcultures:
Gay-Black-Jew. Maledicta 7: 189 211.
Radcliffe-Brown, A. 1940. On Joking Relationships. Africa 13: 195 210.
Swenson, Karen. 1988. Verbal Duels and the Heroic Self: Genre Definition in Old
Norse Literature. PhD dissertation, Cornell University, Ithaca, NY.
1240 | Vernacular
Vernacular
The term’s most significant uses in folklore studies today are in three areas.
First, vernacular architecture refers to those building designs that are known and
practiced in specific communities instead of by professional architects such as
nomadic peoples’ tent-making practices (Rapoport 1969, 4). Second, vernacular
religion refers to the everyday lived religion of specific individuals such as the
communities of alternate Catholicism created by homosexuals (Primiano 1995,
51). Third, vernacular discourse refers to communication practices that are not
necessarily traditional, but emerge dialectically distinguished from institutionally
sanctioned communication (Howard 2008b, 490). With the emergence of net-
work communication technologies, the term has gained new life as a way to des-
ignate the expression of communal authority that is often found embedded in or
intertwined with institutional media communication (Howard 2008a, 192).
the institutional language natively. While some see this history of slavery as a
reason to avoid using the term, others find that it renders the term more flexible.
This flexibility emerges because the dialectical nature of the term suggests inter-
dependence or even hybridity between everyday or folkloric cultural elements
and institutional structures.
Accepting its hybridity, Henry Glassie has argued that the vernacular should be
conceptualized as embodying ‘‘values alien to the academy’’ (Glassie 2000, 20). In
this sense, vernacularity emerges into meaning only in relation to the institutional
that must be logically prior to it. That is to say, its meaning relies on its apparent dis-
tinction from institutionally empowered cultural forms—what Glassie terms ‘‘the
academy.’’ The ‘‘alien’’ is alien precisely because it is found alongside the locally
born. Accepting this interdependence, the vernacular cannot be fully disentangled
from its opposite. As a result, the term can refer to one layer of meaning that resides
among others—even in a single object or behavior. Because it can emerge as one
layer among others, the vernacular can be a component part of the behaviors or
products of institutions, their documents, or their officials just as easily as it can des-
ignate a more obviously folkloric expression. This sense of the vernacular was most
vividly captured by Leonard Primiano’s argument that when the pope or Dalai Lama
performs a private personal prayer, even that expression is vernacular (1995, 46).
example, when a world leader such as a U.S. president uses a regional pronuncia-
tion or speaks in colloquial language, she or he is a fully institutional actor who is
accessing a vernacular mode of expression. Here, the vernacular can support or
contest the institutional because its definition is not based on any authentic coun-
ter-hegemonic or subaltern identity for the individual engaging it. Instead, the ver-
nacular emerges even when a president or the pope seeks to express her or himself
in terms that suggest they are alternate to the institutional structures of power.
Much as the verna was in the unique position of being able to introduce extra-
institutional influence into the very institutions that rendered her or his enslave-
ment, a dialectical conception of the vernacular imagines vernacularity as a quality
of any expressive discourse that attempts to convey meaning by distinguishing
itself from institutions to which it is subordinated. This paradoxical relationship is
embedded in the historical meanings of the term vernacular, and it points away
from the strict separation from the institutional in the both the subaltern and com-
mon resource conceptions of the vernacular.
Because access to vernacular authority is not granted based on participation in
any specific local community, it is accessible to everyone. At the same time,
however, this universal access does not diminish the authenticity of any specific
vernaculars because vernacularity is granted whenever an individual performs
her or his own position as subordinate to the institutional. Because this subordi-
nation is emergent in discourse, access to such authority is possible only in
degrees as alterity from institutional power is asserted. Thus all that is vernacular
relies on the institutional to make its meaning. As a result, vernacularity is
always empowered by the very institutions from which it seeks alterity.
A subaltern vernacular sees noninstitutional expression as a means to
empower marginalized groups. So doing, it locates an essential identity in the
individuals enacting the vernacular as necessarily disempowered. The common
resource conception locates its essential identification of the term in the situa-
tions that allow for informal social forces to shape the discourse of agents over
time. Both conceptions of the vernacular seek to account for noninstitutional
power by imagining a strict division between the vernacular and institutional that
has probably never really existed. Distinct from these two theoretical concep-
tions, the dialectical vernacular accounts for hybrid expressions that are both
institutional and vernacular even while it avoids the necessity of establishing an
essential authentic identity or folkloric origin for the vernacular elements.
References
Blank, Trevor J., ed. 2009. Folklore and the Internet: Vernacular Expression in a
Digital World. Logan: Utah State University Press.
Bradley, Keith R. 1987. On the Roman Slave Supply and Slave Breeding. In Classi-
cal Slavery, ed. M. Finley. London: Cass Publishers, pp. 42 64.
Cicero, Marcus Tullius. 1971. Brutus and Orator. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Univer-
sity Press.
Gates, Henry Louis. 1988. The Signifying Monkey: A Theory of African-American
Literary Criticism. Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.
Glassie, Henry. 2000. Vernacular Architecture. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
1246 | Volkskunde
Hauser, Gerard. 1999. Vernacular Voices: The Rhetoric of Publics and Public
Spheres. Columbia: University of South Carolina Press.
Howard, Robert Glenn. 2008a. Electronic Hybridity: The Persistent Processes of the
Vernacular Web. Journal of American Folklore 121(Spring): 192 218.
Howard, Robert Glenn. 2008b. The Vernacular Web of Participatory Media. Critical
Studies in Media Communication 25(December): 490 512.
Lantis, Margaret. 1960. Vernacular Culture. American Anthropologist 62(2): 202
116.
Ono, Kent A., and John M. Sloop. 1995. The Critique of Vernacular Discourse.
Communication Monographs 62(1): 19 46.
Plato. 1989. Meno. In Collected Dialogues of Plato, ed. Edith Hamilton and trans.
W. K. C. Guthrie, pp. 353 384. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Primiano, Leonard Norman. 1995. Vernacular Religion and the Search for Method in
Religious Folklife. Western Folklore 54: 37 56.
Rapoport, Amos. 1969. House Form and Culture. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-
Hall, Inc.
Volkskunde
The description of the entire lifestyle of the folk or the interpretation of folk groups
as revealed through the study of their traditions, customs, stories, beliefs, dances,
songs, and other forms of folk art. Literally meaning ‘‘folklore,’’ the word is
derived from the German Volk (people or nation) and Kunde (information). Coined
by Clemens Brentano and Achim von Arnim, Volkskunde as a concept achieved
currency after Jacob and Wilhelm Grimm began using the term to discuss oral folk
narratives and Germanic mythology in works such as their two-volume collection
of German folk narrative, Kinder- und Hausm€ archen (1812–1815).
Specifically, the early nineteenth-century German scholars such as the
Grimms applied the term to describe the study of the entirety of the life of rural
peoples, who were removed from modern culture by virtue of their habitat. These
antiquarians viewed the peasant class as a something of a pure, original group
and looked upon their traditions as remainders of an earlier time. By collecting
these remnants and studying them, the antiquarians hoped to piece together a pic-
ture of the origin of the groups’ traditions and lifeways. The emergence of
romantic nationalism led its adherents to begin to focus on these remnants as a
means of encapsulating national or ethnic identity. The term folk began to
replace peasant as a preferred term, and the former term came to denote common
unity rather than class distinctions.
Spurred on by the rise of romantic nationalism and an interest in antiquarian
studies, the term Volkskunde was adopted by scholars outside of Germany as a
Volkskunde | 1247
cover term for folklore and folklore studies. In the early nineteenth century, the
term popular antiquities was widely used among English-speaking scholars to
denote the areas of study that the Grimms and others were undertaking. In a nod
to the German term Volkskunde and the changing attitudes of the scholars, Eng-
lish antiquarian William John Thoms suggested in 1846 that the term folklore be
adopted as the preferred term for antiquarian studies among English-speaking
scholars.
Volkskunde, like folklore, is still an appropriate cover term for the field of folklore
studies. However, both terms have fallen under attack as being too broad in mean-
ing. As a result, in Germanic usage at least, terms denoting the specific areas of
study are becoming more common and are often used in place of the overall term
Volkskunde. Among these terms and areas are: Volkerkunde (ethnology), Volkschar-
akter (folk or national identity), Volksleben (folklife), Volkslied (folksong), Volksme-
dizin (folk medicine), Volkssitte (folk or national custom), Volkssprache (folk or
vernacular speech), and Volkstracht (folk or national costume).
Randal S. Allison
See Also Folklife; Folklore; Gesunkenes Kulturgut.
References
Brunvand, Jan Harold. 1986. The Study of American Folklore: An Introduction. 3rd
ed. New York and London: W. W. Norton.
Dorson, Richard M., ed. 1972. Folklore and Folklife: An Introduction. Chicago and
London: University of Chicago Press.
Dow, James R., and Hannjost Lixfeld, eds. and trans. 1986. German Volkskunde: A
Decade of Theoretical Confrontation, Debate, and Reorientation (1967 1977). Bloom-
ington: Indiana University Press.
Toelken, Barre. 1979. Introduction. The Dynamics of Folklore. Boston: Houghton
Mifflin.
W
Werewolf
Literally, a ‘‘man-wolf’’ (from the Old English wer, or man, and wulf, or wolf); a
human being transformed into a wolf by witchcraft or by the person’s own
power. The belief in werewolves is international. The first information comes
from Herodotus (fifth century BCE) attributing lycanthropy (werewolfism) to the
Neuroi (Proto-Slavs or Proto–Eastern Balts): ‘‘Scyths and Greeks who live in
Scythia tell that every Neuroi is transformed once a year for some days to wolf,
after which he resumes his former shape.’’ In the Ukraine and Belorussia, the
belief in werewolves is especially strong. It is believed there that werewolves
can change themselves further to dogs, cats, bushes, or tree stumps.
The bloodthirsty werewolves primarily hunt animals, infrequently human
beings. They move at night and must assume the human form before daybreak. If
they are wounded, the wound appears on the human body of the person who was
transformed into the wolf. This belief is widespread. James Frazer gives exam-
ples from Livonia, the mountains of Auvergne, Padua, and the French district of
Beauce. The same belief also is encountered in Estonia, Finland, and Russia.
To change into a werewolf, a human throws on a wolf skin or puts on a magic
belt. In Estonia, one can crawl through openings, such as the bow formed by the
trunk of a tree and its top when it grows back to the earth, and say a magic for-
mula. In Lithuania, a human changes into a werewolf by somersaulting over a
tree stump, crawling backward under the space between a pine tree root and the
ground, turning two somersaults in the area between two stakes driven into the
ground, passing under the bow formed by four poles driven into the ground, and
so forth. The Belorussians and Ukrainians turn into werewolves by going into the
woods to somersault over a tree stump into which a knife has been driven.
Among the Balts and Slavs, transformation can also be accomplished by putting
on a magical belt or a wolf skin.
The ritual donning of the wolf skin can be understood as causing a radical
change in the person’s behavior, as the transformation from human to carnivore
occurs. Crawling through a narrow opening can be explained as the imitation of
rebirth, that is, the ‘‘sham birth,’’ of the person into a new being because of the
similarity of the opening to the birth canal.
To regain human form, the tricks for becoming a werewolf are usually per-
formed in reverse. The lasting effect is achieved by burning the wolf skin used by
1249
1250 | Werewolf
the person for transformation or giving food to the werewolf. In the Baltic coun-
tries, a legend is told that a man offered a wolf a piece of bread on the tip of a
knife. The wolf grabbed the bread together with the knife and ran away. When the
man recognized his knife at a merchant’s in Riga, he was amply rewarded by
the merchant for the kindness he had shown to the werewolf. This legend reflects
the popular belief that a supernatural being becomes human by eating human food.
Stories are told of wedding parties transformed into werewolves, who, as a
group, roamed and plundered in neighboring countries. According to Felix
Oinas, werewolves were called viron sudet, ‘‘Estonian wolves’’ in southeast Fin-
land since they were believed to have come from Estonia, where they had been
changed by a witch, a Russian, or a Latvian. The transformed wedding parties
also came to Finland from Russia and Lapland. Such transformations also were
known in Belorussia. In general, the people are inclined to consider werewolves
as belonging to another nation or as having been transformed by foreign sorcer-
ers. This conclusion is in line with the so-called out-group attitude that attributes
everything negative to foreigners, especially to neighboring nationalities.
The werewolf eats the meat of the animal raw. In the Baltic area (Estonia,
Livonia, Latvia), if someone asks the werewolf about this or curses the creature,
Werewolf | 1251
the werewolf hits the person’s face with the animal’s leg or with another piece of
meat. The meat gets instantly roasted and burns the face of the person who was
hit. This incident signifies the werewolf’s transition from the world of raw to the
world of cooked, that is, from the supernatural world to the human world.
Among the south Slavs, werewolves have merged with vampires; the term for
werewolf, vukodlak, volkodlak (literally, wolf’s hair), has become the name for
the combined werewolf-vampire. In Yugoslavia, there are only a few traces of
the vukodlak’s lycanthropy. Most often, however, the vukodlak appears as a vam-
pire, which comes out of the grave at night to attack people at home.
In countries where there are no wolves, the place of the werewolf is taken by the
fiercest wild animal in that region. Thus, there is the weretiger in India, Borneo,
and western Asia; the tiger in China and Japan; the boar in Turkey and Greece; the
hyena, leopard, and crocodile in Africa; and the jaguar in South America.
Lycanthropy, according to psychiatrists, is a kind of mental illness that causes
the victim to feel like a carnivore, a predatory beast, and to act accordingly. Reli-
gio-phenomenologically, it is interpreted as being connected with the idea of the
free or detachable soul that can leave the body, assume the shape of an animal,
wander around, and return again to the body. This belief is attested in Serbia,
Sweden, Livonia, and Estonia. It was reported from Livonia in the nineteenth
century that when the soul of a werewolf was abroad on its particular business,
its body was lying dead as a stick or stone. However, if during this time the body
were moved to another place or even if the position were accidentally shifted,
the soul could not find its way back and had to remain in the body of a wolf until
death. Oskar Loorits reports that ‘‘the soul of an evil man or sorcerer wandered
around as a wolf causing damage to other people, while the man himself slept.’’
Occasionally, Latvian werewolves function as protectors of communities. At a
witch trial in 1691, as Leopold Kretzenbacher reports, an old Latvian, Thies (Mat-
iss), claimed to be a werewolf, a ‘‘dog of God’’ (Dievs), and to work with his com-
panions against the sorcerers, who were allied with the devil (velns). The devil,
through sorcerers, took fertility (blessing) away into hell, but the werewolves stole
it back. The preceding year, the Russian werewolves had arrived earlier at hell and
had taken away the blessing of Latvian land. Therefore, there was a good crop in
Russia, but the Latvians had a crop failure. This year, the Latvian werewolves had
come sooner, and they expected Latvia to have a fertile flax year.
The tendency of people to believe in good werewolves who counteract the
reign of evil through the powers of good can be compared with similar beliefs
about vampires. Thus, according to Balkan belief, the classic vampire has an an-
tagonist, a ‘‘good’’ vampire (‘‘vampire’s son’’), who is destined to detect and kill
the bad vampires. Kretzenbacher reports that the Russian villages are said to
have two kinds of vampires—one bad and the other good: ‘‘More frequently
encountered was the belief that while a dead vampire destroyed people, a live
1252 | Women’s Folklore
one, on the contrary, defended them. Each village had its own vampire, as if it
were a guard, protecting the inhabitants from his dead companions.’’
Felix J. Oinas
See Also Assault, Supernatural; Magic; Shape-Shifters; Transformation; Vampire.
References
Frazer, James George. 1935. The Golden Bough, vol. 10. New York: Macmillan.
Kretzenbacher, Leopold. 1968. Kynokephale D€
amonen s€
udosteurop€
aischer Volksdichtung.
Munich: R. Trofenik.
Loorits, Oskar. 1949. Grundz€uge des estnischen Volksglaubens, I. Skrifter utgivna av
kungl. Gustav Adolfs Akademien, 18: 1. Lund, Sweden.
Moszynski, Kazimierz. 1934. Kultura ludowa slowian. I. Krakow: Polska Akademja
Umiejetnosci.
Odstedt, Ella. 1943. Varulven i svensk folktradition (Werewolves in Swedish folk tra-
dition). Uppsala, Sweden: Lundequistska Bokhandeln.
Oinas, Felix J. 1979. Introduction to The Werewolf. In The Golden Steed: Seven Baltic
Plays, ed. Alfreds Straumanis. Prospect Heights, IL: Waveland.
Oinas, Felix J. 1979. Viru susi. In Kalevipoeg k€
utkeis. Alexandria, VA: Mana. (This
volume contains English summaries of each article.)
Pipe, Jim. 2007. Werewolves. New York: Bearport.
Senn, Harry A. 1982. Were-Wolf and Vampire in Romania. New York: Columbia
University Press.
Women’s Folklore
Folklore and ‘‘women’’ are terms that have been linked in scholarship only
recently. Expressive, artistic behavior, whether verbal or plastic, used to be con-
sidered an activity exclusive to men. Women’s expressive behavior was assigned
categories such as ‘‘decorative’’ or ‘‘utilitarian,’’ thus denying the conscious
manipulation of form and content for effect or aesthetics.
The American Folklore Society was founded in 1888; from the beginning,
women scholars were represented in its publications as well as in other popular
and scholarly publications of the time. However, the perceptions of women’s
contributions, whether as scholars or consultant/informers, were limited by pre-
vailing ideas about women and their abilities.
Today, women are actively challenging the preconceptions about themselves
and their scholarship, sometimes with a strident rhetoric, sometimes with a comi-
cal or ironic attitude, but always with a plethora of knowledge and references.
Indeed, the adage about women having to be ‘‘better than’’ to be considered ‘‘equal
to’’ is demonstrated repeatedly in women’s reports of their difficulties in being
Women’s Folklore | 1253
taken seriously and being published in premier outlets. While we like to think that
our times are considerably different from those of a hundred years ago, in practice
we now find many similarities to the situation that existed when folklore first
became a scholarly presence on the American scene.
Early collectors, whether men or women, preferred to gather stories from men,
unless, of course, the stories concerned hearth and home, charms or lullabies,
children’s games or cooking, which, it was believed, were the province of
women. Despite the fact that the Grimm brothers reported collecting their fairy
tales primarily from serving-women, men were believed to be the bearers of the
important and lengthy traditions, while women were believed to be more capable
of, and interested in, things that surrounded what was considered to be their pri-
mary role—household duties and child care. Even when women’s knowledge
was demonstrated to be superior to that of men in a particular genre, the words of
men were preferred.
Gradually, during the 1950s and 1960s, information about women in journals or
books was expanded to include their roles in cultures other than those founded on
Western European models. At times some of this information related to folklore.
African American woman doing laundry with a scrub board and tub, girl stirring pot with
three other children on the ground watching, and a woman in the background spreading
laundry, ca. 1900. (Library of Congress)
1254 | Women’s Folklore
But usually it was folklore about women rather then the kinds of expressive behav-
ior in which women engaged, whether in groups of women, women with children,
or mixed gender groups. Occasionally, there was a single publication focusing on
the repertoire of this female storyteller or that woman singer; such publications
were exceptions to an otherwise firm rule that significant folklore study was predi-
cated on working with men’s knowledge.
By the late 1960s and the early 1970s, the situation was changing rapidly. It is
not a coincidence that this change occurred coterminously with the so-called
women’s movement and court cases affirming the rights of minorities and
women. Many graduate school programs, previously de facto closed to women,
began to reserve slots for women in order to ensure the continuance of federal
funding for other sectors of the university.
Older women, those with children, and those who lived on the margins longing
for the opportunities of their brothers and husbands were represented in dispro-
portionate numbers in these early graduate classes. These women, predominantly
in our country at the University of Texas in Austin, at Stanford University, at the
University of Pennsylvania, and at Indiana University–Bloomington, had life
experiences and artistic/folkloristic repertoires that were neither described in
literature nor accorded legitimacy. These women began to be heard in the mid-
1970s, when there was a sudden explosion of literature about women, their folk-
lore, their roles, their self-perceptions, and even their bawdy jokes, stories, and
tales—more often than not with men as the butt of the joke. With the increasing
availability of funding for women and their concerns, stories began to circulate
of the women’s folklore from this country or that and its similarities and differ-
ences compared with American folklore. Much of this cross-cultural work, how-
ever, was not published until the late 1970s and early 1980s.
Also during the late 1960s and early 1970s, women’s groups were formed;
originally these were consciousness-raising or rap groups, but now they are
termed support groups and have generalized to society as a whole. Women
delighted in finding their commonalities, especially in sharing their ways of
relating experiences about such commonalities in these groups. Some of the ear-
lier published and scholarly work in women’s folklore grew from such associa-
tions of women.
The numbers of books, articles, and chapters on women and their folklore
being produced in the mid- and later 1980s reached such proportions as to make
it impossible for any one person to keep adequate track of the literature without
devoting full time to it. Primarily the work has focused on women’s roles and
women’s expressions of and about them in cultures throughout the world as well
as in our own country. There has also been a coming together of feminism and
scholarship. Women have been freed, one hopes permanently, from the bonds of
being passive to the recognition that women are active agents, often agencies as
Women’s Folklore | 1255
well, for the enactment of their lives. Even in repressed situations, such as can be
seen in some back-to-the-past Middle Eastern cultures, women scholars are dem-
onstrating the expressive ways in which women manipulate and comment upon
their condition through folkloristic resources.
Theoretical work in women’s folklore currently follows the same trends and
paradigms as does any other subject in an academic discipline. There are those
studies that focus on ethnography, on a Marxist perspective, on a structural pre-
sentation, on a semiotic interpretation, or on a performance enactment, as well as
those that take a tone of literary criticism; additionally, many works reinterpret
past canon on the basis of contemporary insight. Previously taboo topics, such as
lesbianism, receive their fair share of scholarly attention and are now publish-
able, whereas a few years ago they were not—save in the so-called underground
press. What were once accepted social ‘‘facts,’’ as, for instance, the concept of
universal male dominance, have recently been shown to be as much a product of
our own mythology concerning proper roles of men and women as they were
social reality. The genres and paradigms that have been utilized to discuss
women and their folklore or to trivialize them both are more reflective of the
scholars and the zeitgeist than they are of the actual situation obtaining in any
one time or place.
In the late 1980s, attention is being given to the effects of colonialism, of cul-
tural recidivism, of feminism, of text versus performance, of performance of text,
and of alphabetic literacy on the production, recording, and interpretation of
folklore and women. The topic of folklore and women now encompasses folklore
of women, folklore about women, women’s folklore, and metafolklore—the
folklore about the folklore.
In 1888, understanding of folklore and women was a foregone conclusion:
everyone knew the kinds of folklore women had and the areas in which they
could be expected to demonstrate competency, and everyone knew that real folk-
lore was a possession of men. It took almost one hundred years, until 1972,
before the first scholarly session on women’s folklore was presented at the
American Folklore Society meetings; two years later, in 1974, the interest was so
intense that there was a double session (four hours of papers). In 1986, the soci-
ety’s annual meeting featured an entire day of scholarly papers on women’s folk-
lore, with multiple sessions running concurrently. Unfortunately, few men
attended the sessions. This precis of the American Folklore Society’s record con-
cerning folklore and women replicates the situation in other disciplines and
scholarship in general.
Five women have had a significant impact upon the thinking of those who
write about folklore and women: Barbara Babcock and Claire R. Farrer, whose
books and articles are repeatedly cited; Marta Weigle, who presents images of
women from many cultures throughout history; and, Michelle Zimbalist Rosaldo
1256 | Worldview
References
Babcock, Barbara, ed. 1978. The Reversible World. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.
Farrer, Claire R., ed. 1986. Women and Folklore: Images and Genres. Prospect
Heights, IL: Waveland Press.
Kailo, Kaarina, ed. 2008. Wo(men) and Bears: The Gifts of Nature, Culture, and
Gender. Toronto, CA: Inanna Publications and Education.
Locke, Liz, Theresa A. Vaughan, and Pauline Greenhill. 2009. Encyclopedia of
Women’s Folklore and Folklife. Westport, CT: Greenwood Press.
Weigle, Marta. 1982. Spiders and Spinsters. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico
Press.
Zimbalist Rosaldo, Michelle, and Louise Lamphere, eds. 1974. Women, Culture and
Society. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.
Worldview
The way in which a person or group views the world; the complex interaction of
culture, language, and mental constructs utilized to make sense of the world
around us; alternately, Weltanschauung, or the view of life, philosophy of life, or
ideology. Studies of worldview focus on how culture and language are utilized to
interpret and mediate the experiences and sensory data from the world at large.
The concept of worldview is understood to be a complex idea that can vary
greatly from group to group. Most research views worldview as a function of pat-
terns of native language and group culture. The patterns are internalized within
the members of a group by way of group interaction. These patterns are passed
through each succeeding generation and become an integral part of the life of the
group. Indeed, it is improbable that the people of any given culture can under-
stand the world without these native patterns. The development of an individu-
al’s worldview begins in infancy and continues throughout life. Along with the
complexities of linguistic development, the individual is subjected to a myriad of
behavioral and perceptual norms. One group may develop fine distinctions
between colors, another might focus on linear forms, and another might focus on
temporal and spatial relations to each other and to other groups. Thus, each cul-
ture utilizes a different methodology for processing perceived reality; reality is
processed through filters of language and culturally provided ideas. These
learned patterns allow members of a group to orient themselves to the world
Worldview | 1257
around them in terms they understand. Euro-Americans, for example, tend to ori-
ent themselves in terms of linear relations to people and places, a concept they
begin to internalize early on and that is reinforced through regular interaction
with others from their group.
Linguist and anthropologist Edward Sapir developed a concept of culture as
something internalized by the individuals who make up a given group to create a
‘‘world of meanings.’’ This world of meanings was something that the individual
abstracted through language and interaction with other members of the group,
and it conditioned the way in which these individuals as a group were able to
build a worldview. From this and the later Sapir-Whorf hypothesis, which holds
that language affects the way in which worldviews are perceived, grew the more
recent ideas on worldview.
One key to understanding the worldview of a group is through its folklore. If
worldview can be understood to be the mediating filter through which an individ-
ual or group perceives the world, then traditional renderings of the group’s
orderly principles (e.g., myth, belief systems) can be utilized as the key to appre-
hending its worldview. More recent research attends to the fact that observers,
too, have their own worldviews and that these act on what the observers per-
ceive. This informed perspective, sometimes called ‘‘new reflexivity,’’ builds the
observer’s bias into any discussion of worldview. By recognizing this double
mediation, a more accurate picture of worldview is believed to emerge.
Randal S. Allison
See Also Acculturation; Linguistic Approach; Myth.
References
Dundes, Alan. 1971. Folk Ideas as Units of Worldview. Journal of American
Folklore 84: 93 103.
Hodder, Ian. 1992. The Problem. In Reading the Past: Current Approaches to
Interpretation in Archeology. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Langness, L. L. 1990. American Developments. In The Study of Culture. San Fran-
cisco: Chandler and Sharp.
Rabinow, Paul. 1977. Ali: An Insider’s Outsider and Self-Consciousness. In Reflec-
tions on Fieldwork in Morocco. Los Angeles: University of California Press.
Toelken, Barre. 1979. Folklore and Cultural Worldview. In The Dynamics of
Folklore. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
X
Xeroxlore
Although the technology often serves more seemingly innocuous ends, such as
the circulation of favorite recipes, chain letters, and favorite published cartoons,
even these are reproduced despite official restrictions on what may be copied
and in violation of copyright laws; their circulation may also violate postal regu-
lations. It is a small step from such unofficial uses of the technology to the photo-
copying of body parts.
Just as the technology is an extension of human faculties, so also is xeroxlore an
extension of traditional oral joking practices and of the making of material culture,
novelty items in particular. The folk make their own uses of technological innova-
tions as they become available, just as they always have. The fragmentary record
of the past includes typeset folk verse and World War II–era blueprints of female
nudes with their body parts labeled as if they were airplanes. Present practice
1259
1260 | Xeroxlore
References
Barrick, Mac E. 1972. The Typescript Broadside. Keystone Folklore Quarterly 17:
27 38.
Bell, Louis Michael, Cathy Makin Orr [Preston], and Michael James Preston, eds.
1976. Urban Folklore from Colorado: Photocopy Cartoons. Research Monographs,
LD00079. Ann Arbor, MI: Xerox University Microfilms.
Dundes, Alan, and Carl R. Pagter, eds. 1975. Urban Folklore from the Paperwork
Empire. Memoir Series, Vol. 62. Austin, TX: American Folklore Society.
Kofod, Else Marie, ed. 1988. Chefens Sekretaer Og andre beske kommentarer til
hverdagens fortraedeligheder. Aalborg, Denmark: Det Schonbergske Forlag.
Kutter, Uli, ed. 1982. Ich Kundige!!! Zeurnisse von Wunschen und Angsten am
Arbeitsplatz Eine Bestandsaufnahme. Marburg, Germany: Jonas Verlag.
Orr [Preston], Cathy Makin, and Michael James Preston, eds. 1976. Urban Folklore
from Colorado: Typescript Broadsides. Research Monographs, LD00069. Ann Arbor,
MI: Xerox University Microfilms.
Preston, Michael J. 1974. Xerox-Lore. Keystone Quarterly 19 : 11 26.
Smith, Paul, ed. 1984. The Complete Book of Office Mis-Practice. London: Rout-
ledge & Kegan Paul.
Index
Aarne, Antti, 372, 558, 658, 666, 719, dozens, 27 28; field hollers and work
990, 1177, 1189 songs, 29; proverbs and rumor stories,
Abominable Snowmen (ABSMs), 326 28; roots of, 19 21; slavery and
Abraham, Sippur, 746 spirituals, 22 25; toasts, 26 27;
Abrahams, Roger, 184, 421, 433, 619, trickster tales, 25 26
660 661, 751, 753, 926, 1098, 1180 African Anansi, 1145
academic programs in folklore: African folklore, 35–40
international, 1–3; North American, Agee, James, 440
3–8 ageism, 40
acculturation, 9–11 Age of Enlightenment, 1075
Achebe, Chinua, 1033 aging, 40–44
activism, 11–15 Ahei, 275
Addams, Jane, 115 Alabama Center for Traditional Culture,
Adenhart, Nick, 856 1051
Adler, David A., 1061 Aladdin, 126, 129 130, 821
Adler, Guido, 447 ‘‘Aladdin and the Lamp,’’ 130
Adler, Thomas, 480 Alexander, Meena, 169
Administrative Assistant’s Day, 677 Alexandrian Library, 801
Adorno, Theodor, 337, 833 Alfonsi, Petrus, 83
Aesop, 82 83 Ali, Naazima, 540
aesthetics, 15–19; in communication, alien ethnic colonies, 426
16 17; contrastive analysis, 17; Allan, Ethan, 809
ethnoaesthetics, 18; tradition and Allen, Barbara, 193
innovation, 15 16 Allen, William Francis, 1066
Afanasev, Aleksandr, 496 Allison, Lelah, 1068
Afanti, 275 allomotifs, 560
Afghanistan, 47, 721, 893 Allport, Gordon, 1121
Africa, 19 21, 35 36, 38 39, 72, 130, Alonso, Ana Maria, 725
196 197, 235, 291, 310, 355 356, 360, altar, home, 44–47
375, 521 522, 564 565, 805 806, Althusser, Louis, 337
1235 Alu, Zhyge, 274 275
African American folklore, 19–35; arts, Alvarez, Julia, 694
crafts, and architecture, 31 33; al-wasm, 123
blues, rap, and hip-hop, 29 31; Amado, Jorge, 1003
I-1
I-2 | Index
Catholic Church, 42, 236, 768, 1240 oral traditions, 272 273; paper cutting,
Caxton, William, 83 285; sports and games, 282 283;
Celtic folklore and mythology, 239–246 storytelling, 279 280; studies of, 287
‘‘cement men,’’ 135 Chinese Lunar New Year, 680
Census Bureau, 171 Cho, Henry, 160 161
Center for Contemporary Cultural Cho, Margaret, 159 160,
Studies, Birmingham, 337 162 164, 172 174
Center for Folklife Programs and Chomsky, Noam, 795 796, 1181
Cultural Studies, 1050 choreometrics, 288–289
Center for Folklore and Cultural Christianity, 66, 171, 414, 424, 541, 633,
Studies, 8 687, 690, 701, 744, 815, 1014, 1076,
Center for Studies in Oral Tradition, 1086, 1089, 1092
University of Missouri, 287 Christie, Agatha, 1033
Central Institute of Indian Languages, Christmas, 101, 262, 345, 347, 484, 500,
Mysore, 711 513, 678 679, 764 766, 878 879, 971,
Chafin, Reverend Dewey, 105 1002
Chamberlain, Alexander, 1037 Christmas, Annie, 914
Chandaini, 704 Chua, Lawrence, 170
Chang, Eliot, 161 Churchill, Winston, 625, 1032
Channing, Walter, 256 Church of Brethren, 969
Chaoxuan, Du, 276 Church of England, 100 101
chapbook, 246–248 Church of God, 970
Chaplin, Charlie, 957, 1215 Cicala, John Allan, 435 436, 772, 868
Chapman, John, 593 Cinderella, 290–293
chapmen, 246 Cisneros, Sandra, 694, 769
charivari/shivaree, 249–250 ‘‘city legends,’’ 785
charm, 250–252 Clark, LaVerne Harrell, 899
Chaucer, Geoffrey, 1033 cleromancy, 379
Chesson, Nora, 1146 clever question/wisdom question,
Child, Francis James, 3, 191, 554, 293–294
657 658, 884, 926, 987, 990, 1008 Clodd, Edward, 461
childbirth and childrearing, 252–261 Clover, Carol J., 690
children’s folk heroes, 261–264 Cocteau, Jean, 204
children’s folklore, 264–271 Cody, William ‘‘Buffalo Bill,’’ 591
Chinese Academy of Social Sciences, Coffin, Tristram, 554, 922
272, 287 Coggeshall, John Michael, 1073
Chinese folklore, 271–288; arts, crafts, Cohen, Anne B., 556
and architecture, 283 284; and Cohen, Hennig, 922, 924
challenges of modern world, 285 287; Cohen, John, 511, 512
drama, 281 282; folksongs, 276 279; Coincy, Gautier de, 88
folktales and legends, 275 276; Coke, Edward, 100
musical performance, 279 280; Cold War, 171, 349, 445, 475
myths, 273 274; narrative poems, Coleman, Loren, 327
274 275; opera, 280 281; collation, 800
Index | I-7
David, Gerald, 298 660, 670, 672, 853, 883, 922, 924,
Davies, Christie, 752 914, 1070 1071, 1223
Davis, Jefferson, 676 Dorst, John, 338, 908, 1021
Davis, Madeline D., 420 Doty, Alexander, 608, 611
Davis, Natalie, 660 Doughty, Amie, 960
Davis, Susan, 338 Douglas, Mary, 97, 750, 752, 807, 985
Davis, Winston, 463 Douglass, Frederick, 39
deathlore, 363–365 Doyle, Arthur Conan, 467
de Beauvoir, Simone, 41 Dracul, Vlad, 1233
de Caro, Frank A., 488 Dragon Boat Festival, 498
deconstruction, 365–366 dragon-slayers, 653 654
Delargy, James H., 527 drama, folk, 391–397
Delaware Valley Quakers, 1074 Drews, Paul, 1081
Deleuze, Gilles, 337 Driver, Tom, 819
Deloria, Vine, Jr., 55, 754 Drummond, William Henry, 1064
De Martino, Ernesto, 1081 Dubai, 122
Dennis, Wayne, 1197 Dubois, Cora, 1197
Densmore, Frances, 56, 448 DuBois, Rachel Davis, 116
Derrida, Jacques, 337, 799, 1018 Dugaw, Dianne, 1006
de Saussure, Ferdinand, 1137 Dumezil, Georges, 304
Desjarlais, Robert, 98 Dundes, Alan, 291
Devereux, George, 1035 Du Toit, Brian M., 342
DeVoto, Bernard, 4 Dwi-Wozoney, 651
diachronic/synchronic, Dylan, Bob, 279, 510, 889, 1025
366–368
dialogism, 368–370 Earth Day, 675
Dickens, Charles, 1027, 1033 Earth Diver Creation, 325
Dickson, Bruce, 1106 Eastern Europe, 358, 361, 447, 539, 543,
Diego, Juan, 766 747 748, 1012
diffusion, 370–374 Easter Sunday, 679
dilemma tales, 374–375 Eberhard, Wolfram, 287
Diop, Birago, 39 40 Eberlein, Robert, 602
‘‘disco dances,’’ 361 Eckstorm, Fanny Hardy, 1067
discourse analysis, 375–377 Eco, Humberto, 957
‘‘disease of language,’’ 895 economic miracle, 734
dite, 377–378 Edison, Thomas, 448
Divakaruni, Chitra Banerjee, 694 Effendi, 275
divination, 378–391 Egil’s Saga, 688, 690
Dobie, Frank, 917, 1068 Egypt, 22 23, 126, 129, 248, 358, 375,
Doe, John, 349 567, 599, 744, 756, 1069 1070,
Donnelly, Ignatius, 457 1073 1074, 1090, 1217
Doress-Worters, Paula, 42 Eifermann, Rivka, 601
Dorson, Richard, 20, 24, 146, Eisteddfod, 196
271, 319, 346, 457, 501, 517, 521, El Cid, 905
Index | I-9
701 702; Hinduism, 701; songs, 706; Jakobson, Roman, 16, 303, 799, 1137
studies of, 712 James, Thelma, 555
‘‘Indian Readers,’’ 969 James, William, 984
individuation, 655, 755 Jameson, Frederic, 337, 1020
informant, 503 Jansen, William Hugh, 425, 433, 976
Ingram, Blanche, 406 Japanese folklore, 729–740; arts, crafts,
initiation, 1105 1106 and architecture, 734; and challenges
inscription, 714–716 of modern world, 734 735; modern
interaction order, 582 studies of, 735 737; periods of cultural
International Association ‘‘Epics of the history, 729 732; religious beliefs,
World’s Peoples’’ (IAEWP), 948 732 733; sports and games, 733 734
International Congress of Onomastic Japanese National Railway (JNR), 735
Sciences, 927 Jaramillo, Don Pedrito, 227, 768
International Folk Music Council Jason, Heda, 619, 941
(IFMC), 451, 883, 888 Jefferson, Thomas, 138
International Poncho Day, 1185 Jemie, Onwuchekwa, 28
International Society for Contemporary Jerusalem Talmud, 745
Legend Research, 2 Jesus Christ, 113, 652
Internet, 716–724; folktale collections, jewelry, 740–743
717 719; narratives, 719 722; playing Jewish folktales, 743–750; Apocrypha,
tales, 722 723 744 745; in Middle Ages, 746 747; in
invented tradition, 724–726 modern era, 747 749; Old Testament,
‘‘invisible landscape,’’ 1073 743 744; Rabbinic literature, 745 746
Iraq War, 1022 Jewish Scientific Institute, 748
Irish Manannan, 240 Jiangnu, Meng, 275
Irish Potato Famine, 865 Jiegang, Gu, 277
Irish sagas, 1129 1131 Joe, Moondyne, 809
Irwin, Robert, 127 Johann Gottfried von Herder, 427, 531,
Isherwood, Christopher, 608 568, 617, 989, 1116
Italian Renaissance, 129 John Henry Days Festival, 108
Ivanovich, Dunai, 1114 Johnny Appleseed, 593
Ives, Edward, 674 Johnson, Paula, 921
Ivey, William, 670, 673 Johnson, Virginia E., 420
joke, 750–754
Jabbour, Alan, 1047, 1050 JokeCenter, 719
Jack and the Beanstalk, 727–729 Jokes Galore, 718
Jackson, Bruce, 26, 422, 490, Jones, Howard Mumford, 4
506, 551, 674 Jones, Louis, 572
Jackson, George Pullen, 685, 1068 Jones, Margaret, 255
Jackson, Michael, 98 Jones, Michael Owen, 16, 120, 150, 322,
Jacobi, Mary Putnam, 256 437, 440, 921, 952, 1040
Jacobs, Joseph, 471 Jones, Steven Swann, 1148
Jacobs, Melville, 4, 52, 311 Jones, Suzi, 1071
ja-di ilafa, 827 Jones, William, 61, 301
Index | I-15